This is a modern-English version of The Home of the Blizzard: Being the Story of the Australasian Antarctic Expedition, 1911-1914, originally written by Mawson, Douglas, Sir. It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling, and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.

Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.





THE HOME OF THE BLIZZARD:

BEING THE STORY OF THE AUSTRALASIAN ANTARCTIC EXPEDITION, 1911-1914;

By Sir Douglas Mawson, D.Sc., B.E.

ILLUSTRATED IN COLOUR AND BLACK AND WHITE ALSO WITH MAPS

WITH 260 FULL-PAGE AND SMALLER ILLUSTRATIONS BY DR. E. A. WILSON
AND OTHER MEMBERS OF THE EXPEDITION, PHOTOGRAVURE FRONTISPIECES,
12 PLATES IN FACSIMILE FROM DR. WILSON'S SKETCHES, PANORAMAS AND MAPS

TO THOSE WHO MADE IT POSSIBLE: THE SUBSCRIBERS AND CO-OPERATORS

TO THOSE WHO MADE IT A SUCCESS: MY COMRADES

AND TO THOSE WHO WAITED










TABLE OF CONTENTS

ILLUSTRATIONS






AUTHOR'S PREFACE

The object of this book is to present a connected narrative of the Expedition from a popular and general point of view. The field of work is a very extensive one, and I feel that this account provides a record inadequate to our endeavours. However, I am comforted by the fact that the lasting reputation of the Expedition is founded upon the scientific volumes which will appear in due course.

The goal of this book is to tell a cohesive story of the Expedition from a broad and accessible perspective. The scope of this work is quite large, and I realize that this account falls short of capturing our efforts. Still, I'm reassured by the knowledge that the Expedition's lasting legacy will be based on the scientific volumes that will be published eventually.

Allusion to the history of Antarctic exploration has been reduced to a minimum, as the subject has been ably dealt with by previous writers. This, and several other aspects of our subject, have been relegated to special appendices in order to make the story more readable and self-contained.

All references to the history of Antarctic exploration have been minimized, since previous writers have already covered the topic well. This, along with several other aspects of our subject, has been moved to specific appendices to make the narrative easier to read and more self-contained.

A glossary of technicalities is introduced for readers not familiar with the terms. In the same place is given a list of animals referred to from time to time. There, the common name is placed against the scientific name, so rendering it unnecessary to repeat the latter in the text.

A glossary of technical terms is provided for readers who aren’t familiar with the terminology. Also included is a list of animals mentioned throughout the text. In this list, the common name is given next to the scientific name, making it unnecessary to repeat the latter in the main text.

The reports handed to me by the leaders concerning the work of sledging journeys and of the respective bases were in the main clearly and popularly written. Still it was necessary to make extensive excisions so as to preserve a "balance" of justice in all the accounts, and to keep the narrative within limits. I wish to assure the various authors of my appreciation of their contributions.

The reports given to me by the leaders about the sledging journeys and their respective bases were mostly clear and easy to understand. However, I had to make a lot of cuts to maintain a "balance" of fairness in all the accounts and keep the story within certain limits. I want to express my gratitude to the different authors for their contributions.

Mr. Frank Hurley's artistic taste is apparent in the numerous photographs. We who knew the circumstances can warmly testify to his perseverance under conditions of exceptional difficulty. Mr. A. J. Hodgeman is responsible for the cartographical work, which occupied his time for many months. Other members of the Expedition have added treasures to our collection of illustrations; each of which is acknowledged in its place.

Mr. Frank Hurley's artistic taste is clear in the many photographs. Those of us who understand the circumstances can genuinely attest to his determination in extremely challenging conditions. Mr. A. J. Hodgeman handled the cartographical work, which took him many months to complete. Other members of the Expedition have contributed valuable pieces to our collection of illustrations, each of which is credited in its respective section.

To Dr. A. L. McLean, who assisted me in writing and editing the book, I am very greatly indebted. To him the book owes any literary style it may possess. Dr. McLean's journalistic talent was discovered by me when he occupied the post of Editor of the 'Adelie Blizzard', a monthly volume which helped to relieve the monotony of our second year in Adelie Land. For months he was constantly at work, revising cutting down or amplifying the material of the story.

To Dr. A. L. McLean, who helped me write and edit this book, I owe a huge debt of gratitude. Any literary style the book has is thanks to him. I discovered Dr. McLean's journalistic talent when he was the Editor of the 'Adelie Blizzard,' a monthly publication that helped break the monotony of our second year in Adelie Land. For months, he worked tirelessly, revising, trimming, or expanding the material of the story.

Finally, I wish to express my thanks to Dr. Hugh Robert Mill for hints and criticisms by which we have profited.

Finally, I want to thank Dr. Hugh Robert Mill for the suggestions and feedback that have helped us.

DOUGLAS MAWSON

DOUGLAS MAWSON

London, Autumn 1914.

London, Fall 1914.






FOREWORD

                            Nor on thee yet
     Shall burst the future, as successive zones
     Of several wonder open on some spirit
     Flying secure and glad from heaven to heaven.
                                          BROWNING
                            Nor on you yet
     Shall the future unfold, as different realms
     Of various wonder reveal themselves to a spirit
     Soaring confidently and joyfully from one heaven to another.
                                          BROWNING

The aim of geographical exploration has, in these days, interfused with the passion for truth. If now the ultimate bounds of knowledge have broadened to the infinite, the spirit of the man of science has quickened to a deeper fervour. Amid the finished ingenuities of the laboratory he has knitted a spiritual entente with the moral philosopher, viewing:

The goal of geographical exploration today is intertwined with the quest for truth. As the limits of knowledge have expanded to the infinite, the spirit of the scientist has intensified with a deeper passion. In the refined innovations of the laboratory, he has formed a spiritual connection with the moral philosopher, observing:

    The narrow creeds of right and wrong, which fade
    Before the unmeasured thirst for good.
    The strict beliefs of right and wrong, which disappear
    In the face of an endless desire for good.

Science and exploration have never been at variance; rather, the desire for the pure elements of natural revelation lay at the source of that unquenchable power the "love of adventure."

Science and exploration have always been in sync; instead, the yearning for the fundamental aspects of natural discovery fueled that unstoppable force known as the "love of adventure."

Of whatever nationality the explorer was always emboldened by that impulse, and, if there ever be a future of decadence, it will live again in his ungovernable heritage.

No matter what nationality the explorer was, he was always driven by that urge, and if there is ever a future of decline, it will revive in his uncontrollable legacy.

Eric the Red; Francis Drake—the same ardour was kindled at the heart of either. It is a far cry from the latter, a born marauder, to the modern scientific explorer. Still Drake was a hero of many parts, and though a religious bigot in present acceptation, was one of the enlightened of his age. A man who moved an equal in a court of Elizabethan manners was not untouched by the glorious ideals of the Renaissance.

Eric the Red; Francis Drake—the same passion ignited in both of them. It's a long way from the latter, a natural raider, to today’s scientific explorer. Still, Drake was a multifaceted hero, and although he was a religious bigot by today’s standards, he was one of the enlightened figures of his time. A man who mingled with the elite in a court of Elizabethan customs was not unaffected by the inspiring ideals of the Renaissance.

Yet it was the unswerving will of a Columbus, a Vasco da Gama or a Magellan which created the devotion to geographical discovery, per se, and made practicable the concept of a spherical earth. The world was opened in imaginative entirety, and it now remained for the geographer to fill in the details brought home by the navigator.

Yet it was the unwavering determination of someone like Columbus, Vasco da Gama, or Magellan that sparked the passion for geographical discovery itself and made the idea of a spherical Earth feasible. The world was unveiled in its imaginative completeness, and it was now up to the geographer to fill in the details brought back by the navigator.

It was long before Thule the wondrous ice-land of the North yielded her first secrets, and longer ere the Terra Australis of Finne was laid bare to the prying eyes of Science.

It took a long time before Thule, the amazing ice land of the North, revealed its first secrets, and even longer before the Terra Australis of Finne was exposed to the curious gaze of Science.

Early Arctic navigation opened the bounds of the unknown in a haphazard and fortuitous fashion. Sealers and whalers in the hope of rich booty ventured far afield, and, ranging among the mysterious floes or riding out fierce gales off an ice-girt coast, brought back strange tales to a curious world. Crudely embellished, contradictory, yet alluring they were; but the demand for truth came surely to the rescue. Thus, it was often the whaler who forsook his trade to explore for mere exploration's sake. Baffin was one of those who opened the gates to the North.

Early Arctic navigation explored the unknown in a random and fortunate way. Sealers and whalers, hoping for great rewards, traveled far and wide. As they navigated the mysterious ice floes or weathered fierce storms along ice-covered coasts, they returned with fascinating stories for a curious world. These tales were often exaggerated, contradictory, yet captivating; however, the need for truth eventually emerged. Consequently, it was often the whalers who left their trade to explore just for the sake of exploration. Baffin was one of those who opened the doors to the North.

Then, too, the commercial spirit of the generations who sought a North West Passage was responsible for the incursions of many adventurers into the new world of the ice.

Then, the commercial ambitions of the generations looking for a Northwest Passage drove many adventurers to explore the icy new world.

Strangely enough, the South was first attacked in the true scientific spirit by Captain Cook and later by Bellingshausen. Sealing and whaling ventures followed in their train.

Surprisingly, the South was first explored in a genuine scientific way by Captain Cook and later by Bellingshausen. This was followed by sealing and whaling expeditions.

At last the era had come for the expedition, planned, administered, equipped and carried out with a definite objective. It is characteristic of the race of men that the first design should have centred on the Pole—the top of the earth, the focus of longitude, the magic goal, to reach which no physical sacrifice was too great. The heroism of Parry is a type of that adamant persistence which has made the history of the conquest of the Poles a volume in which disaster and death have played a large part. It followed on years of polar experience, it resulted from an exact knowledge of geographical and climatic conditions, a fearless anticipation, expert information on the details of transport—and the fortune of the brave—that Peary and Amundsen had their reward in the present generation.

At last, the time had come for the expedition, which was planned, managed, equipped, and executed with a clear goal in mind. It's typical of humanity that the initial aim focused on the Pole—the highest point on Earth, the center of longitude, the enchanting target for which no sacrifice was too great. The bravery of Parry exemplifies the unwavering determination that has characterized the history of polar exploration, a narrative filled with both disaster and death. This mission was built on years of polar experience, based on a thorough understanding of geographic and climatic conditions, fearless foresight, expert knowledge of transport details—and the luck of the courageous—that Peary and Amundsen ultimately found success in this generation.

Meanwhile, in the wake of the pioneers of new land there were passing the scientific workers born in the early nineteenth century. Sir James Clark Ross is an epitome of that expansive enthusiasm which was the keynote of the life of Charles Darwin. The classic "Voyage of the Beagle" (1831-36) was a triumph of patient rigorous investigation conducted in many lands outside the polar circles.

Meanwhile, following the pioneers of new territory, there were the scientists born in the early nineteenth century. Sir James Clark Ross embodies that spirit of adventure that defined the life of Charles Darwin. The classic "Voyage of the Beagle" (1831-36) was a success of thorough, meticulous research carried out in many regions outside the polar circles.

The methods of Darwin were developed in the 'Challenger' Expedition (1872) which worked even to the confines of the southern ice. And the torch of the pure flame of Science was handed on. It was the same consuming ardour which took Nansen across the plateau of Greenland, which made him resolutely propound the theory of the northern ice-drift, to maintain it in the face of opposition and ridicule and to plan an expedition down to the minutest detail in conformity therewith. The close of the century saw Science no longer the mere appendage but the actual basis of exploratory endeavour.

The methods of Darwin were developed during the 'Challenger' Expedition (1872), which even reached the edges of the southern ice. And the pure light of Science was passed on. It was the same intense passion that drove Nansen across the Greenland plateau, which made him confidently propose the theory of the northern ice drift, defend it against criticism and mockery, and plan an expedition with meticulous attention to detail in line with that theory. By the end of the century, Science was no longer just a supplement but the actual foundation of exploratory efforts.

Disinterested research and unselfish specialization are the phrases born to meet the intellectual demands of the new century.

Disinterested research and selfless specialization are the terms created to address the intellectual needs of the new century.

The modern polar expedition goes forth with finished appliances, with experts in every department—sailors, artisans, soldiers and students in medley; supremely, with men who seek risk and privation—the glory of the dauntless past. A.L.M.

The modern polar expedition sets out with state-of-the-art equipment, featuring experts in every field—sailors, craftsmen, soldiers, and students all together; most importantly, with individuals who embrace risk and hardship—the honor of the fearless past. A.L.M.






INTRODUCTION

One of the oft-repeated questions for which I usually had a ready answer, at the conclusion of Sir Ernest Shackleton's Expedition (1907-09) was, "Would you like to go to the Antarctic again?" In the first flush of the welcome home and for many months, during which the keen edge of pleasure under civilized conditions had not entirely worn away, I was inclined to reply with a somewhat emphatic negative. But, once more a man in the world of men, lulled in the easy repose of routine, and performing the ordinary duties of a workaday world, old emotions awakened. The grand sweet days returned in irresistible glamour, faraway "voices" called:

One of the questions I often got asked, and I usually had a quick response for, after Sir Ernest Shackleton's Expedition (1907-09) was, "Would you want to go to Antarctica again?" In the initial excitement of being back home, and for many months after, when the thrill of civilized life hadn't completely faded, I tended to answer with a pretty strong no. But, after settling back into the normal flow of everyday life, going through my usual routines and responsibilities, those old feelings came back. The amazing days of adventure returned with an irresistible charm, and distant "voices" called to me:

  ...from the wilderness, the vast and Godlike spaces,
    The stark and sullen solitudes that sentinel the Pole.
...from the wilderness, the vast and divine expanses,  
    The bleak and moody solitude that watches over the Pole.

There always seemed to be something at the back of my mind, stored away for future contemplation, and it was an idea which largely matured during my first sojourn in the far South. At times, during the long hours of steady tramping across the trackless snow-fields, one's thoughts flow in a clear and limpid stream, the mind is unruffled and composed and the passion of a great venture springing suddenly before the imagination is sobered by the calmness of pure reason. Perchance this is true of certain moments, but they are rare and fleeting. It may have been in one such phase that I suddenly found myself eager for more than a glimpse of the great span of Antarctic coast lying nearest to Australia.

There always seemed to be something in the back of my mind, saved for later reflection, and it was an idea that mainly developed during my first time in the far South. Sometimes, during the long hours of steady trekking across the endless snowfields, my thoughts would flow like a clear and fresh stream, my mind calm and collected, and the thrill of a big adventure suddenly sparking in my imagination would be tempered by the serenity of pure logic. Maybe this is true for certain moments, but they are rare and short-lived. It might have been in one of those moments that I suddenly found myself wanting more than just a glimpse of the vast Antarctic coastline closest to Australia.

Professor T. W. E. David, Dr. F. A. Mackay and I, when seeking the South Magnetic Pole during the summer of 1908-09, had penetrated farthest into that region on land. The limiting outposts had been defined by other expeditions; at Cape Adare on the east and at Gaussberg on the west. Between them lay my "Land of Hope and Glory," of whose outline and glacial features the barest evidence had been furnished. There, bordering the Antarctic Circle, was a realm far from the well-sailed highways of many of the more recent Antarctic expeditions.

Professor T. W. E. David, Dr. F. A. Mackay, and I, while searching for the South Magnetic Pole during the summer of 1908-09, had ventured the farthest into that area on land. The outer limits had been defined by other expeditions; at Cape Adare to the east and at Gaussberg to the west. Between them was my "Land of Hope and Glory," of which only the slightest evidence of its shape and glacial features had been provided. There, along the Antarctic Circle, was a territory far removed from the well-trodden paths of many of the more recent Antarctic expeditions.

The idea of exploring this unknown coast took firm root in my mind while I was on a visit to Europe in February 1910. The prospects of an expedition operating to the west of Cape Adare were discussed with the late Captain R. F. Scott and I suggested that the activities of his expedition might be arranged to extend over the area in question. Finally he decided that his hands were already too full to make any definite proposition for a region so remote from his own objective.

The idea of exploring this unknown coast really took hold in my mind while I was visiting Europe in February 1910. I talked about the possibilities of an expedition operating west of Cape Adare with the late Captain R. F. Scott, and I suggested that his expedition could be set up to cover that area. In the end, he decided that he already had too much on his plate to make any solid plans for a location so far from his main goal.

Sir Ernest Shackleton was warmly enthusiastic when the scheme was laid before him, hoping for a time to identify himself with the undertaking. It was in some measure due to his initiative that I felt impelled eventually to undertake the organization and leadership of an expedition.

Sir Ernest Shackleton was genuinely excited when the plan was presented to him, eager to connect himself with the project. It was partly because of his encouragement that I finally felt motivated to take on the organization and leadership of an expedition.

For many reasons, besides the fact that it was the country of my home and Alma Mater, I was desirous that the Expedition should be maintained by Australia. It seemed to me that here was an opportunity to prove that the young men of a young country could rise to those traditions which have made the history of British Polar exploration one of triumphant endeavour as well as of tragic sacrifice. And so I was privileged to rally the "sons of the younger son."

For many reasons, apart from the fact that it was my home country and where I studied, I wanted Australia to support the Expedition. I thought this was a chance to show that the young men of a young nation could embrace the traditions that have defined British Polar exploration, marked by both great achievements and tragic sacrifices. So, I had the honor of bringing together the "sons of the younger son."

A provisional plan was drafted and put before the Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science at their meeting held at Sydney in January 1911, with a request for approval and financial assistance. Both were unanimously granted, a sum of L1000 was voted and committees were formed to co-operate in the arrangement of a scientific programme and to approach the Government with a view to obtaining substantial help.

A temporary plan was created and presented to the Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science at their meeting in Sydney in January 1911, asking for approval and financial support. Both requests were approved unanimously, and a total of £1000 was allocated. Committees were established to work together on organizing a scientific program and to reach out to the Government for significant assistance.

The three leading members of the committees were Professor Orme Masson (President), Professor T. W. Edgeworth David (President Elect) and Professor G. C. Henderson (President of the Geographical Section). All were zealous and active in furthering the projects of the Expedition.

The three main members of the committees were Professor Orme Masson (President), Professor T. W. Edgeworth David (President Elect), and Professor G. C. Henderson (President of the Geographical Section). All were dedicated and engaged in promoting the goals of the Expedition.

Meanwhile I had laid my scheme of work before certain prominent Australians and some large donations** had been promised. The sympathy and warm-hearted generosity of these gentlemen was an incentive for me to push through my plans at once to a successful issue.

Meanwhile, I had shared my work plan with some prominent Australians, and they promised several large donations. Their sympathy and generous spirit motivated me to move forward with my plans immediately and successfully.

     ** Refer to Finance Appendix.
** Check Finance Appendix.

I therefore left immediately for London with a view to making arrangements there for a vessel suitable for polar exploration, to secure sledging dogs from Greenland and furs from Norway, and to order the construction of certain instruments and equipment. It was also my intention to gain if possible the support of Australians residing in London. The Council of the University of Adelaide, in a broad-minded scientific spirit, granted me the necessary leave of absence from my post as lecturer, to carry through what had now resolved itself into an extensive and prolonged enterprise.

I immediately left for London to arrange for a ship suited for polar exploration, to get sled dogs from Greenland and furs from Norway, and to order the construction of specific instruments and equipment. I also aimed to gain the support of Australians living in London if possible. The Council of the University of Adelaide, with a progressive scientific approach, granted me the leave of absence I needed from my position as a lecturer to pursue what had now turned into a large and lengthy project.

During my absence, a Committee of the Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science approached the Commonwealth Government with an appeal for funds. Unfortunately it was the year (1911) of the Coronation of his Majesty King George V, and the leading members of the Cabinet were in England, so the final answer to the deputation was postponed. I was thus in a position of some difficulty, for many requirements had to be ordered without delay if the Expedition were to get away from Australia before the end of the year.

During my absence, a Committee from the Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science reached out to the Commonwealth Government asking for funding. Unfortunately, it was 1911, the year of King George V's Coronation, and the key Cabinet members were in England, so the final response to the delegation was put on hold. This left me in a bit of a tough spot because many essentials needed to be ordered right away if the Expedition was going to leave Australia before the year ended.

At length, through the kindness of Lord Northcliffe, the columns of the Daily Mail were opened to us and Sir Ernest Shackleton made a strong appeal on our behalf. The Royal Geographical Society set the seal of its approval on the aims of the Expedition and many donations were soon afterwards received.

At last, thanks to the generosity of Lord Northcliffe, we were able to share our story in the columns of the Daily Mail, where Sir Ernest Shackleton made a compelling appeal for our cause. The Royal Geographical Society endorsed the mission of the Expedition, and shortly after, we received many donations.

At this rather critical period I was fortunate in securing the services of Captain John King Davis, who was in future to act as Master of the vessel and Second in Command of the Expedition. He joined me in April 1911, and rendered valuable help in the preliminary arrangements. Under his direction the s.y. Aurora was purchased and refitted.

At this crucial time, I was lucky to bring on board Captain John King Davis, who would be the Master of the ship and the Second in Command of the Expedition. He joined me in April 1911 and provided significant assistance with the initial preparations. Under his guidance, the s.y. Aurora was bought and refurbished.

The few months spent in London were anxious and trying, but the memory of them is pleasantly relieved by the generosity and assistance which were meted out on every hand. Sir George Reid, High Commissioner for the Australian Commonwealth, I shall always remember as an ever-present friend. The preparations for the scientific programme received a strong impetus from well-known Antarctic explorers, notably Dr. W. S. Bruce, Dr. Jean Charcot, Captain Adrian de Gerlache, and the late Sir John Murray and Mr. J. Y. Buchanan of the Challenger Expedition. In the dispositions made for oceanographical work I was indebted for liberal support to H.S.H. the Prince of Monaco.

The few months spent in London were stressful and challenging, but the memory of that time is made brighter by the generosity and support that I received from all sides. I will always remember Sir George Reid, the High Commissioner for the Australian Commonwealth, as a constant friend. The preparations for the scientific program got a strong boost from well-known Antarctic explorers, especially Dr. W. S. Bruce, Dr. Jean Charcot, Captain Adrian de Gerlache, and the late Sir John Murray and Mr. J. Y. Buchanan of the Challenger Expedition. For the planning of oceanographic work, I was very grateful for the generous support from H.S.H. the Prince of Monaco.

In July 1911 I was once more in Australia, a large proportion of my time being occupied with finance, the purchase and concentration of stores and equipment and the appointment of the staff. In this work I was aided by Professors Masson and David and by Miss Ethel Bage, who throughout this busy period acted in an honorary capacity as secretary in Melbourne.

In July 1911, I was back in Australia, spending a lot of my time on finance, buying and consolidating supplies and equipment, and hiring staff. I was helped in this work by Professors Masson and David, as well as Miss Ethel Bage, who served as an honorary secretary in Melbourne during this hectic time.

Time was drawing on and the funds of the Expedition were wholly inadequate to the needs of the moment, until Mr. T. H. Smeaton, M.P., introduced a deputation to the Hon. John Verran, Premier of South Australia. The deputation, organized to approach the State Government for a grant of L5000, was led by the Right Hon. Sir Samuel Way, Bart., Chief Justice of South Australia and Chancellor of the Adelaide University, and supported by Mr. Lavington Bonython, Mayor of Adelaide, T. Ryan, M.P., the Presidents of several scientific societies and members of the University staff. This sum was eventually forthcoming and it paved the way to greater things.

Time was running out, and the funds for the Expedition were completely inadequate for what was needed at that moment, until Mr. T. H. Smeaton, M.P., introduced a delegation to the Hon. John Verran, Premier of South Australia. The delegation, organized to request a grant of £5000 from the State Government, was led by the Right Hon. Sir Samuel Way, Bart., Chief Justice of South Australia and Chancellor of the University of Adelaide, and supported by Mr. Lavington Bonython, Mayor of Adelaide, T. Ryan, M.P., the Presidents of several scientific societies, and members of the University staff. This amount was eventually secured, paving the way for even greater achievements.

In Sydney, Professor David approached the State Government on behalf of the Expedition for financial support, and, through the Acting Premier, the Hon. W. A. Holman, L7000 was generously promised. The State of Victoria through the Hon. W. Watt, Premier of Victoria, supplemented our funds to the extent of L6000.

In Sydney, Professor David reached out to the State Government on behalf of the Expedition for financial support and, through the Acting Premier, the Hon. W. A. Holman, £7,000 was generously promised. The State of Victoria, through the Hon. W. Watt, Premier of Victoria, added to our funds by £6,000.

Upheld by the prestige of a large meeting convened in the Melbourne Town Hall during the spring, the objects of the Australasian Antarctic Expedition were more widely published. On that memorable occasion the Governor-General, Lord Denman, acted as chairman, and among others who participated were the Hon. Andrew Fisher (Prime Minister of the Commonwealth), the Hon. Alfred Deakin (Leader of the Opposition), Professor Orme Masson (President A.A.A.S. and representative of Victoria), Senator Walker (representing New South Wales) and Professor G. C. Henderson (representing South Australia).

Backed by the importance of a large meeting held at the Melbourne Town Hall in the spring, the goals of the Australasian Antarctic Expedition were shared more broadly. During that significant event, Governor-General Lord Denman served as the chair, and participants included the Hon. Andrew Fisher (Prime Minister of the Commonwealth), the Hon. Alfred Deakin (Leader of the Opposition), Professor Orme Masson (President of the A.A.A.S. and representative of Victoria), Senator Walker (representing New South Wales), and Professor G. C. Henderson (representing South Australia).

Soon after this meeting the Commonwealth Government voted L5000, following a grant of L2000 made by the British Government at the instance of Lord Denman, who from the outset had been a staunch friend of the Expedition.

Soon after this meeting, the Commonwealth Government voted £5,000, following a grant of £2,000 made by the British Government at the request of Lord Denman, who had been a strong supporter of the Expedition from the beginning.

At the end of October 1911 all immediate financial anxiety had passed, and I was able to devote myself with confidence to the final preparations.

At the end of October 1911, all immediate financial worries were gone, and I could confidently focus on the final preparations.

Captain Davis brought the 'Aurora' from England to Australia, and on December 2, 1911, we left Hobart for the South. A base was established on Macquarie Island, after which the ship pushed through the ice and landed a party on an undiscovered portion of the Antarctic Continent. After a journey of fifteen hundred miles to the west of this base another party was landed and then the Aurora returned to Hobart to refit and to carry out oceanographical investigations, during the year 1912, in the waters south of Australia and New Zealand.

Captain Davis brought the 'Aurora' from England to Australia, and on December 2, 1911, we left Hobart heading south. A base was set up on Macquarie Island, then the ship pushed through the ice and dropped off a team on an undiscovered part of the Antarctic Continent. After traveling fifteen hundred miles west from this base, another team was also landed, and then the 'Aurora' returned to Hobart to refit and conduct oceanographic research in the waters south of Australia and New Zealand throughout 1912.

In December 1912 Captain Davis revisited the Antarctic to relieve the two parties who had wintered there. A calamity befell my own sledging party, Lieut. B. E. S. Ninnis and Dr. X. Mertz both lost their lives and my arrival back at Winter Quarters was delayed for so long, that the 'Aurora' was forced to leave five men for another year to prosecute a search for the missing party. The remainder of the men, ten in number, and the party fifteen hundred miles to the west were landed safely at Hobart in March 1912.

In December 1912, Captain Davis returned to Antarctica to relieve the two groups that had spent the winter there. A tragedy struck my sledging party; Lieutenant B. E. S. Ninnis and Dr. X. Mertz both lost their lives. My return to Winter Quarters was delayed for so long that the 'Aurora' had to leave five men behind for another year to search for the missing party. The rest of the team, totaling ten men, along with the party fifteen hundred miles to the west, were safely landed in Hobart in March 1912.

Thus the prearranged plans were upset by my non-return and the administration of the Expedition in Australia was carried out by Professor David, whose special knowledge was invaluable at such a juncture.

Thus, the planned arrangements were thrown off by my failure to return, and the management of the Expedition in Australia was handled by Professor David, whose expertise was crucial at that moment.

Funds were once more required, and, during the summer of 1912, Captain Davis visited London and secured additional support, while the Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science again successfully approached the Commonwealth Government (The Right Hon. J. H. Cook, Prime Minister). In all, the sum of L8000 was raised to meet the demands of a second voyage of relief.

Funds were needed again, and during the summer of 1912, Captain Davis went to London and secured more support, while the Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science successfully reached out to the Commonwealth Government (The Right Hon. J. H. Cook, Prime Minister). In total, £8000 was raised to cover the costs of a second relief voyage.

The party left on Macquarie Island, who had agreed to remain at the station for another year, ran short of food during their second winter. The New Zealand Government rendered the Expedition a great service in dispatching stores to them by the 'Tutanekai' without delay.

The group staying on Macquarie Island, who had agreed to stay at the station for another year, ran low on food during their second winter. The New Zealand Government did them a huge favor by quickly sending supplies via the 'Tutanekai.'

Finally, in the summer of 1913, the 'Aurora' set out on her third cruise to the far South, picking up the parties at Macquarie Island and in the Antarctic, carried out observations for two months amid the ice and reached Adelaide late in February 1914.

Finally, in the summer of 1913, the 'Aurora' set off on her third cruise to the far South, picking up the groups at Macquarie Island and in Antarctica, conducted observations for two months amid the ice, and arrived in Adelaide late in February 1914.

Throughout a period of more than three years Professors David and Masson—the fathers of the Expedition—worked indefatigably and unselfishly in its interests. Unbeknown to them I have taken the liberty to reproduce the only photographs at hand of these gentlemen, which action I hope they will view favourably. That of Professor David needs some explanation: It is a snapshot taken at Relief Inlet, South Victoria Land, at the moment when the Northern Party of Shackleton's Expedition, February 1909, was rescued by the S.Y. 'Nimrod'.

Throughout a period of more than three years, Professors David and Masson—the founders of the Expedition—worked tirelessly and selflessly for its success. Without their knowledge, I took the liberty of sharing the only available photographs of these gentlemen, and I hope they will appreciate this gesture. The photo of Professor David requires some clarification: it's a snapshot taken at Relief Inlet, South Victoria Land, at the moment when the Northern Party of Shackleton's Expedition was rescued by the S.Y. 'Nimrod' in February 1909.

In shipping arrangements Capt. Davis was assisted throughout by Mr. J. J. Kinsey, Christchurch, Capt. Barter, Sydney, and Mr. F. Hammond, Hobart.

In arranging the shipping, Capt. Davis was supported throughout by Mr. J. J. Kinsey from Christchurch, Capt. Barter from Sydney, and Mr. F. Hammond from Hobart.

Such an undertaking is the work of a multitude and it is only by sympathetic support from many sources that a measure of success can be expected. In this connexion there are many names which I recall with warm gratitude. It is impossible to mention all to whom the Expedition is indebted, but I trust that none of those who have taken a prominent part will fail to find an acknowledgment somewhere in these volumes.

Such a project requires a lot of people, and it’s only through support from various sources that we can hope for any success. In this regard, there are many names I remember with deep appreciation. It’s impossible to name everyone the Expedition owes thanks to, but I hope that all those who played a key role will find their acknowledgment somewhere in these volumes.

I should specially mention the friendly help afforded by the Australasian Press, which has at all times given the Expedition favourable and lengthy notices, insisting on its national and scientific character.

I want to specifically acknowledge the friendly support provided by the Australasian Press, which has consistently given the Expedition positive and extensive coverage, emphasizing its national and scientific significance.

With regard to the conduct of the work itself, I was seconded by the whole-hearted co-operation of the members, my comrades, and what they have done can only be indicated in this narrative.

With respect to how the work was carried out, I was fully supported by the cooperation of my team members, my colleagues, and what they accomplished can only be summarized in this narrative.










CONTENTS


AUTHOR'S PREFACE

FOREWORD

INTRODUCTION

LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS

COLOUR PLATES


CHAPTER I.   THE PROBLEM AND PREPARATIONS

CHAPTER II.   THE LAST DAYS AT HOBART AND THE VOYAGE TO MACQUARIE ISLAND

CHAPTER III.   FROM MACQUARIE ISLAND TO ADELIE LAND

CHAPTER IV.   NEW LANDS

CHAPTER V.   FIRST DAYS IN ADELIE LAND

CHAPTER VI.   AUTUMN PROSPECTS

CHAPTER VII.   THE BLIZZARD

CHAPTER VIII.   DOMESTIC LIFE

CHAPTER IX.   MIDWINTER AND ITS WORK;

CHAPTER X.   THE PREPARATION OF SLEDGING EQUIPMENT

CHAPTER XI.   SPRING EXPLOITS

CHAPTER XII.   ACROSS KING GEORGE V LAND

CHAPTER XIII.   TOIL AND TRIBULATION

CHAPTER XIV.   THE QUEST OF THE SOUTH MAGNETIC POLE

CHAPTER XV.   EASTWARD OVER THE SEA-ICE

CHAPTER XVI.   HORN BLUFF AND PENGUIN POINT

CHAPTER XVII.   WITH STILLWELL'S AND BICKERTON'S PARTIES

CHAPTER XVIII.   THE SHIP'S STORY

CHAPTER XIX.   THE WESTERN BASE—ESTABLISHMENT AND EARLY ADVENTURES

CHAPTER XX.   THE WESTERN BASE—WINTER AND SPRING

CHAPTER XXI.   THE WESTERN BASE—BLOCKED ON THE SHELF-ICE

CHAPTER XXII.   THE WESTERN BASE—LINKING UP WITH KAISER WILHELM II LAND

CHAPTER XXIII.      A SECOND WINTER

CHAPTER XXIV.   NEARING THE END

CHAPTER XXV.   LIFE ON MACQUARIE ISLAND

CHAPTER XXVI.   A LAND OF STORM AND MIST

CHAPTER XXVII.   THROUGH ANOTHER YEAR

CHAPTER XXVIII.   THE HOMEWARD CRUISE

APPENDIX.   

CONTENTS


AUTHOR'S PREFACE

FOREWORD

INTRODUCTION

LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS

COLOUR PLATES


__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_5__  THE PROBLEM AND PREPARATIONS

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_6__  THE LAST DAYS AT HOBART AND THE VOYAGE TO MACQUARIE ISLAND

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_7__  FROM MACQUARIE ISLAND TO ADELIE LAND

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_8__  NEW LANDS

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_9__  FIRST DAYS IN ADELIE LAND

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_10__  AUTUMN PROSPECTS

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_11__  THE BLIZZARD

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_12__  DOMESTIC LIFE

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_13__  MIDWINTER AND ITS WORK;

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_14__  THE PREPARATION OF SLEDGING EQUIPMENT

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_15__  SPRING EXPLOITS

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_16__  ACROSS KING GEORGE V LAND

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_17__  TOIL AND TRIBULATION

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_18__  THE QUEST OF THE SOUTH MAGNETIC POLE

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_19__  EASTWARD OVER THE SEA-ICE

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_20__  HORN BLUFF AND PENGUIN POINT

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_21__  WITH STILLWELL'S AND BICKERTON'S PARTIES

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_22__  THE SHIP'S STORY

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_23__  THE WESTERN BASE—ESTABLISHMENT AND EARLY ADVENTURES

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_24__  THE WESTERN BASE—WINTER AND SPRING

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_25__  THE WESTERN BASE—BLOCKED ON THE SHELF-ICE

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_26__  THE WESTERN BASE—LINKING UP WITH KAISER WILHELM II LAND

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_27__  A SECOND WINTER

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_28__  NEARING THE END

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_29__  LIFE ON MACQUARIE ISLAND

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_30__  A LAND OF STORM AND MIST

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_31__  THROUGH ANOTHER YEAR

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_32__  THE HOMEWARD CRUISE

__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_33__  










LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS

Sir Douglas Mawson (Photogravure)

In Memoriam cross at Cape Denison (Photogravure)

In Memoriam cross at Cape Denison (Photogravure)





COLOUR PLATES

Virgin solitudes

A weather-worn snow-berg

A weathered iceberg

A grottoed iceberg

A cave-filled iceberg

The Mertz Glacier Tongue, at a point 50 miles from the land

The Mertz Glacier Tongue, located 50 miles from the land

The Grey Rock Hills at Cape Denison

The Grey Rock Hills at Cape Denison

Winter quarters, Adelie Land

Winter quarters, Adélie Land

The Alpine-glow

The Alpenglow

"Antarctica is a world of colour, brilliant and intensely pure..."

"Antarctica is a vibrant world, bright and incredibly pure..."

Sledging in Adelie Land

Sledding in Adelie Land

[Volume II]

[Volume 2]

Islets fringing the mainland: view looking west from Stillwell Island

Islets along the mainland: view looking west from Stillwell Island

Rafts of floe-ice

Ice floes

Before sunrise: camped near the Hippo Nunatak

Before sunrise: camped near the Hippo Nunatak

Avalanche rocks

Avalanche boulders

Delay Point

Delay Point

The great "Bergschrund" of the Denman Glacier

The large "Bergschrund" of the Denman Glacier

Tussock slopes and misty highlands

Tussock hills and misty highlands

The shack and its vicinity

The shack and surrounding area

A Victoria penguin on the nest

A Victoria penguin on the nest

A growth of lichen on red sandstone

A growth of lichen on red sandstone

Antarctic marine life

Antarctic ocean life

Brought up in the deep-sea trawl

Brought up in the deep-sea trawl

PLATES

Dishes

Professor T. W. Edgeworth David

Professor T.W. Edgeworth David

Professor Orme Masson

Professor Orme Masson

Captain John King Davis

Captain John King Davis

The wall of the Antarctic Continent

The wall of the Antarctic Continent

Finner whales of the South

Southern fin whales

The 'Aurora' crossing the equator, August 1911

The 'Aurora' crossing the equator, August 1911

Frank Wild

Frank Wild

Ginger and her family on the voyage from London

Ginger and her family on the trip from London

Queen's Wharf, Hobart, an hour before sailing, December 2, 1911

Queen's Wharf, Hobart, one hour before departure, December 2, 1911

The last view of Hobart nestling below Mt. Wellington

The final glimpse of Hobart resting below Mt. Wellington

A big, following sea

A huge following sea

McLean walking aft in rough weather

McLean walking towards the back in bad weather

Cruising along the west coast of Macquarie Island

Cruising along the west coast of Macquarie Island

A Giant Petrel on the nest

A giant petrel on the nest

A Young Giant Petrel on the nest. Caroline Cove

A young giant petrel on the nest. Caroline Cove

The wreck of the "Clyde"

The wreck of the "Clyde"

The boat harbour—Hassleborough Bay

The marina—Hassleborough Bay

The North End of Macquarie Island showing Wireless Hill. The living hut is at the north end of the isthmus, with North-East Bay on the right and Hassleborough Bay on the left side

The North End of Macquarie Island showing Wireless Hill. The living hut is at the north end of the isthmus, with North-East Bay on the right and Hassleborough Bay on the left side.

The 'Aurora' anchored in Hassleborough Bay. In the foreground giant seaweed is swinging in the wash of the surge

The 'Aurora' anchored in Hassleborough Bay. In the foreground, giant seaweed is swaying in the wake of the waves.

A Wanderer Albatross at rest on the water

A Wanderer Albatross resting on the water

Hunter tickles a sleeping baby Sea Elephant

Hunter tickles a sleeping baby sea elephant.

A typical Table-Topped neve berg originating from floating Shelf Ice

A typical table-topped iceberg that comes from floating shelf ice.

An Antarctic iceberg with a reticulation of crevasses on its tilted surface. This berg had no doubt taken its origin from the ice of the coastal cliffs of Adelie Land

An Antarctic iceberg with a network of cracks on its slanted surface. This iceberg likely originated from the ice of the coastal cliffs of Adelie Land.

In Pack-Ice

In Icepack

A cavern in the wall (120 feet) of the shelf ice of the Mertz Glacier-Tongue

A cave in the wall (120 feet) of the shelf ice of the Mertz Glacier-Tongue

A glimpse from within the cavern (shown in the preceding illustration)

A look from inside the cave (shown in the previous illustration)

The 'Aurora' in Commonwealth Bay; the rising plateau of Adelie Land in the distance

The 'Aurora' in Commonwealth Bay; the elevated plateau of Adelie Land in the distance

The invaluable motor-launch; left to right, Hamilton, Bickerton, and Blake

The priceless motorboat; left to right, Hamilton, Bickerton, and Blake

The whale-boat with passengers for the shore; Wild at the steering oar

The whale boat with passengers heading to the shore; Wild is at the steering oar.

First steps in the formation of the Main Base Station; landing of stores and equipment at the head of the Boat Harbour, Cape Denison. In the distance men are to be seen sledging the materials to the site selected for the erection of the hut

First steps in setting up the Main Base Station; unloading supplies and equipment at the head of Boat Harbour, Cape Denison. In the distance, you can see men hauling the materials to the chosen location for building the hut.

A view of a rocky stretch of the Adelie Land Coast west of Commonwealth Bay

A view of a rocky section of the Adelie Land Coast west of Commonwealth Bay

A panorama looking west from winter quarters. On the left and in the distance are the rising slopes of the inland ice. The moraine is in the foreground

A view looking west from the winter base. On the left and in the distance are the ascending hills of the inland ice. The moraine is in the foreground.

A panorama of the sea front looking eastward from winter quarters. The plateau slopes are visible to a height of l500 feet

A view of the seaside looking east from the winter quarters. The slopes of the plateau are visible up to a height of 1,500 feet.

In open pack-ice

In open sea ice

The face of the Shackleton Ice-Shelf 100 miles north of the mainland. Each strongly-marked horizontal band on the sheer wall represents a year's snowfall

The front of the Shackleton Ice Shelf, 100 miles north of the mainland. Each clearly defined horizontal band on the steep wall signifies a year's worth of snowfall.

The 'Aurora' anchored to thick floe-ice 100 miles north of the western base, Queen Mary Land. In this region the annual snowfall is very heavy, so that it is possible that the great thickness of floe is due to the accumulation of one year

The 'Aurora' anchored to thick floe-ice 100 miles north of the western base, Queen Mary Land. In this area, the annual snowfall is quite heavy, so it's possible that the great thickness of the floe is due to the accumulation from a single year.

A berg with inclusions of mud and rock. Long. 10 degrees E.

A mountain with bits of mud and rock. Long. 10 degrees E.

The 'Flying-Fox' viewed from the floe-ice below the brink of the shelf ice on which the western party wintered

The 'Flying-Fox' seen from the ice floe below the edge of the shelf ice where the western party spent the winter

Summer at the boat harbour, Cape Denison

Summer at the boat harbor, Cape Denison

An Adelie penguin on the nest defending her eggs

An Adelie penguin on the nest guarding her eggs

The living-hut, nearing completion. The tents and shelter built of benzine cases used as temporary quarters are shown

The living hut is almost finished. The tents and shelters made from gasoline cases, used as temporary housing, are shown.

The completion of the hut—cheering the Union Jack as it was hoisted on the flag pole

The completion of the hut—cheering as the Union Jack was raised on the flagpole.

Adelie penguins at home, Cape Denison

Adelie penguins at home, Cape Denison

A view of the main base hut in February 1912, just prior to its completion. Within a few days of the taking of this picture the hut became so buried in packed snow that ever afterwards little beyond the roof was to be seen

A view of the main base hut in February 1912, just before it was finished. Within a few days of taking this picture, the hut got so buried in packed snow that from then on, only the roof was visible.

Weddell seals asleep on pancake ice

Weddell seals napping on pancake ice

Adelie penguin after weathering a severe blizzard. observe the lumps of ice adhering to it

Adelie penguin after enduring a harsh blizzard. Check out the chunks of ice stuck to it.

A Panoramic view looking south from near the hut. In the distance are the slopes of the inland ice-sheet. In the foreground is the terminal moraine. Between the rocks and the figure is a zone where rapid thawing takes place in the summer owing to the amount of dirt contained in the ice

A panoramic view looking south from near the hut. In the distance are the slopes of the inland ice sheet. In the foreground is the terminal moraine. Between the rocks and the figure is a zone where rapid melting occurs in the summer due to the amount of dirt in the ice.

A panoramic view looking north towards the sea. In the middle of the picture is Round Lake. The hut is towards the left-hand side and the anemograph is on the hill. The men are practising ski running

A wide view facing north toward the sea. In the center of the picture is Round Lake. The hut is on the left side, and the anemograph is on the hill. The men are practicing ski running.

An evening view from Cape Denison

An evening view from Cape Denison

The head of a Weddell seal

The head of a Weddell seal

A Weddell seal scratching himself. "Drat those fleas!"

A Weddell seal scratching itself. "Ugh, those fleas!"

The meteorologist with an ice-mask

The meteorologist with an ice mask

Where the plateau descends to Commonwealth Bay

Where the plateau drops down to Commonwealth Bay

MacCormick Skua gull on the nest with egg

MacCormick Skua gull on the nest with an egg

Chick of MacCormick Skua gull on the nest

Chick of MacCormick Skua gull on the nest

Protection—Adelie penguin and chick

Protection – Adélie penguin and chick

The lower moraine, composed of water worn boulders, Cape Denison

The lower moraine, made up of water-worn boulders, Cape Denison

An ice-polished surface, Cape Denison

An ice-smooth surface, Cape Denison

The boat harbour in March. The hut is seen dimly through light drift

The boat harbor in March. The hut is faintly visible through the light mist.

"Race of the Spray Smoke's Hurtling Sheet"

"Race of the Spray Smoke's Hurtling Sheet"

Walking against a strong wind

Walking into a strong wind

Picking ice for domestic purposes in a hurricane wind. Note the high angle at which Webb is leaning on the wind

Picking ice for home use in hurricane-force winds. Notice the steep angle at which Webb is leaning into the wind.

Leaning upon the wind; Madigan near the meteorological screen

Leaning against the wind, Madigan stood by the weather monitor.

Stillwell collecting geological specimens in the wind

Stillwell gathering geological samples in the wind

In the blizzard; getting ice for domestic purposes from the glacier adjacent to the hut

In the blizzard; getting ice for household use from the glacier next to the cabin

An incident in March soon after the completion of the hut: Hodgeman, the night watchman, returning from his rounds outside, pushes his way into the veranda through the rapidly accumulating drift snow

An incident in March soon after the completion of the hut: Hodgeman, the night watchman, returning from his rounds outside, makes his way into the veranda through the quickly piling up snow.

Mertz in the snow tunnels on his way to the interior of the hut with a box of ice for the melters

Mertz navigated through the snow tunnels, making his way to the inside of the hut with a box of ice for the melters.

Mertz emerging from the trap-door in the roof

Mertz coming out of the trapdoor in the roof

Working in the hurricane wind, Adelie Land

Working in the hurricane wind, Adelie Land

Getting ice for domestic purposes. Whetter picking; Madigan with the ice-box

Getting ice for home use. Whetter picking; Madigan with the icebox

The ice-cliff coastline east of winter quarters

The ice-cliff coastline east of winter quarters

Madigan's frostbitten face

Madigan's frostbitten face

Correll, Bage, McLean, Hodgeman, Hunter, and Bickerton

Correll, Bage, McLean, Hodgeman, Hunter, and Bickerton

A winter afternoon scene in the hut. From the left: Mertz, McLean, Madigan, Hunter, Hodgeman. High on the left is the acetylene generator

A winter afternoon scene in the hut. From the left: Mertz, McLean, Madigan, Hunter, Hodgeman. High on the left is the acetylene generator.

Taking a turn in the kitchen department. Hunter, Hodgeman, Bage. The doorway on the right is the entrance to the workroom

Taking a turn in the kitchen area. Hunter, Hodgeman, Bage. The doorway on the right is the entrance to the workshop.

A corner of the hut—Bage mending his sleeping bag. The bunks in two tiers around the wall are almost hidden by the clothing hanging from the ceiling

A corner of the hut—Bage fixing his sleeping bag. The bunks stacked in two tiers around the wall are nearly obscured by the clothes hanging from the ceiling.

A winter evening at the hut. Standing up: Mawson, Madigan, Ninnis, and Correll. Sitting round the table from left to right: Stillwell, Close, McLean, Hunter, Hannam, Hodgeman, Murphy, Lasebon, Bickerton, Mertz, and Bage

A winter evening at the hut. Standing up: Mawson, Madigan, Ninnis, and Correll. Sitting around the table from left to right: Stillwell, Close, McLean, Hunter, Hannam, Hodgeman, Murphy, Lasebon, Bickerton, Mertz, and Bage.

A morning in the workshop. From left to right: Hodgeman, Hunter, Lasebon, Correll, and Hannam. The petrol engine part of the wireless plant on the right

A morning in the workshop. From left to right: Hodgeman, Hunter, Lasebon, Correll, and Hannam. The gas engine part of the wireless setup is on the right.

Welding by thermit in the workroom, Adelie Land. Bickerton, Correll, Hannam and Mawson

Welding with thermit in the workshop, Adelie Land. Bickerton, Correll, Hannam, and Mawson

In the catacombs. Ninnis on the right

In the catacombs. Ninnis on the right

Bage and his tide gauge which was erected on the frozen bay ice

Bage and his tide gauge, which was set up on the frozen bay ice.

Raising the lower section of the northern wireless mast

Raising the lower part of the northern radio tower

The weathered cliffs of a glacier sheet pushing out into the frozen sea east of Cape Denison

The worn cliffs of a glacier extending into the icy ocean east of Cape Denison

Bage at the door of his astronomical transit House

Bage at the door of his astronomy observatory.

Webb and his magnetograph house

Webb and his magnetograph lab

At work on the air-tractor sledge in the hangar; Bage, Ninnis, and Bickerton

At work on the air-tractor sled in the hangar; Bage, Ninnis, and Bickerton

Webb adjusting the instruments in the magnetograph house a calm noon in winter, Cape Denison

Webb tweaking the equipment in the magnetograph house on a quiet winter noon at Cape Denison.

The ridged surface of a lake frozen during a blizzard

The bumpy surface of a lake frozen during a snowstorm

A lively scene in the vicinity of an Antarctic Petrel rookery, Cape Hunter

A vibrant scene near an Antarctic Petrel nesting site, Cape Hunter

A Weddell seal swimming below the ice-foot

A Weddell seal swimming under the ice edge

A rascally Sea Leopard casting a wicked eye over the broken floe at Land's End. Main Base

A mischievous Sea Leopard watching slyly over the shattered ice at Land's End. Main Base

A Crab-Eater seal; common amongst the pack-ice

A Crab-Eater seal; common among the pack ice

The rare Ross seal

The elusive Ross seal

One of McLean's cultures; bacteria and moulds; illustrating micro-organisms in the hut

One of McLean's cultures: bacteria and molds; showcasing microorganisms in the hut.

Ice flowers on the newly formed sea-ice

Ice flowers on the newly formed sea ice

Madigan visiting the anemograph screen in a high wind

Madigan checks the anemograph display on a windy day.

The Puffometer, designed to record maximum gust velocities

The Puffometer, created to measure the highest wind speeds

An enormous cone of snow piled up by the blizzards under the coastal cliffs

An enormous pile of snow created by the snowstorms at the base of the coastal cliffs

The cliffs at Land's End, Cape Denison. On the brow of the cliff in front of the figure (Mertz) is a good example of a snow cornice

The cliffs at Land's End, Cape Denison. On the edge of the cliff in front of the figure (Mertz) is a nice example of a snow cornice.

On the frozen sea in a cavern eaten out by the waves under the coastal ice-cliffs

On the icy sea in a cave carved out by the waves beneath the coastal ice cliffs

Ice stalactites draping the foreshores

Icicles hanging from the shores

A grotto of "mysteries"

A grotto of "secrets"

The relief of Wild's party. The "Aurora" approaching the floe at the western base, February 1913

The relief of Wild's team. The "Aurora" nearing the ice floe at the western edge, February 1913

Pacing the deck: Capt. John King Davis and Capt. James Davis

Pacing the deck: Capt. John King Davis and Capt. James Davis

An Adelie penguin feeding its young

An Adelie penguin feeding its chicks

"Amundsen", one of the sledge dogs sent down to us from Amundsen's South Polar Expedition

"Amundsen," one of the sled dogs sent to us from Amundsen's South Polar Expedition

At the foot of a snow ramp beneath the coastal ice-cliffs, Commonwealth Bay

At the bottom of a snow ramp under the coastal ice cliffs, Commonwealth Bay

At Aladdin's Cave. The vertical passage leading down into the cave itself is situated immediately behind the figure on the right

At Aladdin's Cave. The vertical passage that goes down into the cave is located right behind the figure on the right.

Beneath the surface of the plateau. Bage preparing a meal in Aladdin's Cave in August

Beneath the surface of the plateau. Bage is preparing a meal in Aladdin's Cave in August.

Laseron and Hunter using the collapsible steel handcart in preparing for dredging on the frozen sea

Laseron and Hunter are using the collapsible steel handcart to get ready for dredging on the frozen sea.

Greenland Sledging Dogs—"John Bull" and "Ginger"—tethered on the rocks adjacent to the hut

Greenland Sledging Dogs—"John Bull" and "Ginger"—tied up on the rocks next to the hut

The Mackellar islets viewed from an elevation of 800 feet on the mainland

The Mackellar islets seen from 800 feet up on the mainland

Snow Petrels preparing to nest, Cape Denison

Snow Petrels getting ready to nest, Cape Denison

A Snow Petrel on the nest

A Snow Petrel on its nest

Adelie penguins diving into the sea in quest of food

Adelie penguins diving into the ocean in search of food

Adelie penguins jumping on to the floe

Adelie penguins jumping onto the ice.

Mertz in an icy ravine

Mertz in a frozen canyon

Mertz and Ninnis arrive with the dogs at Aladdin's Cave

Mertz and Ninnis show up with the dogs at Aladdin's Cave.

Mertz emerging from Aladdin's Cave

Mertz coming out of Aladdin's Cave

A team of dogs eagerly following Ninnis

A group of dogs eagerly following Ninnis

The dogs enjoy their work

The dogs love their job.

Speeding east

Heading east

A distant view of Aurora Peak from the west

A distant view of Aurora Peak from the west

Lieutenant B. E. S. Ninnis, R.F.

Lieutenant B. E. S. Ninnis, R.F.

Mertz, Ninnis, and Mawson erecting the tent in a high wind

Mertz, Ninnis, and Mawson setting up the tent in strong winds

A later stage in erection of the tent in a wind (one man is inside)

A later stage in setting up the tent in the wind (one person is inside)

Dr. Xavier Mertz

Dr. Xavier Mertz

Pages from Dr. Mertz' diary

Pages from Dr. Mertz's diary

Mawson emerging from his makeshift tent

Mawson stepping out of his temporary tent

The half-sledge used in the last stage of Mawson's journey

The half-sledge used in the final stage of Mawson's journey

"...The long journey was at an end—a terrible chapter of my life was finished!"

"...The long journey was over—a tough chapter of my life was done!"

The southern supporting party on the plateau. Hunter, Murphy and Laseron

The southern support team on the plateau: Hunter, Murphy, and Laseron.

The southern and supporting parties building a depot on the plateau

The southern and supporting parties are constructing a depot on the plateau.

Depot made by the southern and supporting parties at a point 67 miles south of Commonwealth Bay. Murphy, Laseron, and Hunter packing sledge in the foreground; Bage in the distance

Depot set up by the southern and supporting teams at a spot 67 miles south of Commonwealth Bay. Murphy, Laseron, and Hunter are packing the sled in the foreground; Bage is in the distance.

A rough sledging surface of high Sastrugi encountered by the southern party 200 miles S.S.E. of the hut

A bumpy sledding surface with huge Sastrugi was faced by the southern team 200 miles S.S.E. of the hut.

Farthest south camp of southern party, 17 "minutes" (about 50 miles) from the South Magnetic Pole. Bage near sledge; Webb taking set of magnetic observations behind snow barricade

Farthest south camp of the southern party, 17 "minutes" (about 50 miles) from the South Magnetic Pole. Bage is near the sledge; Webb is taking a set of magnetic observations behind a snow barricade.

Sastrugi furrowed by the mighty winds of the plateau, 250 miles S.S.E. of winter quarters, Adelie Land

Sastrugi shaped by the powerful winds of the plateau, 250 miles S.S.E. of winter quarters, Adelie Land

Under reefed sail. Southern party 290 miles S.S.E. of winter quarters, Adelie Land

Under reduced sail. Southern party 290 miles S.S.E. of winter quarters, Adelie Land

Hurley in sledging gear

Hurley in sledding gear

Correll on the edge of a ravine in the ice sheet

Correll on the brink of a ravine in the ice sheet

Madigan's, Murphy's, and Stillwell's parties breaking camp at Aladdin's Cave at the commencement of the summer journeys

Madigan's, Murphy's, and Stillwell's groups packing up at Aladdin's Cave as summer journeys begin.

The surface of the continental ice sheet in the coastal region where it is badly crevassed

The surface of the continental ice sheet in the coastal area where it is heavily cracked.

Working the sledge through broken sea ice, 46 miles off King George V Land. Madigan, Correll and McLean

Working the sled through shattered sea ice, 46 miles off King George V Land. Madigan, Correll, and McLean.

The "Organ-Pipes" of Horn Bluff (1000 feet in height) pushing out from the mainland

The "Organ-Pipes" of Horn Bluff (1000 feet high) jutted out from the mainland.

Madigan, Correll and McLean camped below the cliffs of Horn Bluff (1000 FEET IN height). Columnar Dolerite is seen surmounting a sedimentary series partly buried in the talus-slope

Madigan, Correll, and McLean set up camp below the cliffs of Horn Bluff (1000 FEET HIGH). You can see columnar dolerite sitting on top of a sedimentary layer that's partially buried in the talus slope.

An outcrop of a sedimentary formation containing bands of coal projecting through the talus slope below the columnar dolerite at Horn Bluff

An exposed section of sedimentary rock featuring coal seams sticking out from the debris slope beneath the columnar dolerite at Horn Bluff.

The face of a granite outcrop near penguin point. At its base is a tide crack and ice foot

The face of a granite outcrop near Penguin Point. At its base is a tidal crack and ice foot.

The granite cliffs at Penguin Point where Cape Pigeon and Silver Petrel rookeries were found; the site of New Year's Camp

The granite cliffs at Penguin Point, where you could find the nesting areas of Cape Pigeon and Silver Petrel; the location of New Year's Camp.

[VOLUME II]

[VOLUME II]

Madigan Nunatak—Close and Laseron standing by the sledge

Madigan Nunatak—Close and Laseron standing next to the sled.

A desolate camp on the plateau

A deserted camp on the plateau

Sledging rations for three men for three months

Sledging supplies for three men for three months

Stillwell Island—a haunt of the Silver-Grey petrel

Stillwell Island—a hangout for the Silver-Grey petrel

"The Bus", the air-tractor sledge

"The Bus," the air tractor sled

Bickerton and his sledge with detachable wheels

Bickerton and his sled with removable wheels

Amongst the splintered ice where the ice-sheet descends to the sea near Cape Denison

Among the broken ice where the ice sheet meets the sea near Cape Denison

The big winding-drum for the deep-sea dredging cable

The large winding drum for the deep-sea dredging cable

Fletcher with the driver loaded ready to take a sounding

Fletcher with the driver loaded, set to take a measurement.

At the provision depot for castaways provided by the New Zealand Government, Camp Cove, Carnley Harbour, Auckland Island. Primmer on the right

At the supply depot for castaways run by the New Zealand Government, Camp Cove, Carnley Harbour, Auckland Island. Primmer on the right

The brick pier erected at Port Ross, Auckland Islands, by the magneticians of Sir James Clarke Ross's Expedition

The brick pier built at Port Ross, Auckland Islands, by the scientists of Sir James Clarke Ross's Expedition

The "Aurora" at anchor in Port Ross, Auckland Islands

The "Aurora" docked in Port Ross, Auckland Islands

The Monagasque trawl hoisted on the derrick: Gray standing by

The Monagasque trawl lifted on the crane: Gray standing by

A remarkable berg, two cusps standing on a single basement. Note that it has risen considerably out of the sea, exposing old water lines

A striking iceberg, with two peaks rising from a single base. Notice how it has emerged significantly from the ocean, revealing ancient water lines.

A portal worn through a berg by the waves

A passage worn through an ice mountain by the waves

A turreted berg

A turreted mountain

A Midsummer view of the hut and its neighbourhood, looking S.E.

A Midsummer view of the hut and its surroundings, facing S.E.

Forging through pack-ice

Navigating through sea ice

Members of the main base party homeward bound, January 1913. From left to right: back row, Whetter, Hurley, Webb, Hannam, Laseron, Close; front row, Stillwell, Hunter, Correll, Murphy

Members of the main base party heading home, January 1913. From left to right: back row, Whetter, Hurley, Webb, Hannam, Laseron, Close; front row, Stillwell, Hunter, Correll, Murphy

"Wireless" Corner in the workshop. Our link with civilization

"Wireless" Corner in the workshop. Our connection to the outside world.

The "Aurora" anchored to the floe off the western base

The "Aurora" is anchored to the ice floe near the western base.

The establishment of the western base. Hauling stores to the top of the ice-shelf

The setup of the western base. Transporting supplies to the top of the ice shelf.

The western base hut in winter. Note the entrance; a vertical hole in the snow in the foreground

The western base hut in winter. Notice the entrance; a vertical hole in the snow in the foreground.

The western base hut—The Grottoes—in summer

The western base hut—The Grottoes—in summer

An evening camp, Queen Mary Land

An evening camp, Queen Mary Land

A man-hauled sledge

A man-pulled sled

In the veranda of the western base hut—The "Grottoes"—looking towards the entrance dug vertically down through the snow drift

In the veranda of the western base hut—The "Grottoes"—looking toward the entrance that was dug straight down through the snow drift.

The wind-weathered igloo built for magnetic observations—western base

The wind-worn igloo created for magnetic observations—western base

Nunatak—Queen Mary Land: showing remarkable moat on windward side and ramp on lee

Nunatak—Queen Mary Land: showing a notable moat on the windward side and a ramp on the leeward side.

Midwinter's dinner in Queen Mary Land, 1912. From left to right: Behind—Hoadley, Dovers, Watson, Harrisson, Wild. In Front—Jones, Moyes, Kennedy

Midwinter dinner in Queen Mary Land, 1912. From left to right: Behind—Hoadley, Dovers, Watson, Harrisson, Wild. In front—Jones, Moyes, Kennedy

A bevy of Emperor penguins on the floe

A group of Emperor penguins on the ice floe

A yawning crevasse

A gaping crevasse

Wild's party making slow progress in dangerous country

Wild's group is making slow progress in a risky area.

Wild, Kennedy, and Harrisson amongst the abysses of the Denman glacier

Wild, Kennedy, and Harrisson among the depths of the Denman glacier

"The whole was the wildest, maddest and yet the grandest thing imaginable"

"The whole thing was the wildest, craziest, and yet the most magnificent thing you could imagine."

Wild's party working their sledges through the crushed ice at the foot of Denman glacier

Wild's team maneuvering their sleds over the broken ice at the base of Denman Glacier

The Hippo Nunatak

The Hippo Nunatak

Dog-sledging

Dog sledding

Where the floe-ice meets the Shackleton Shelf

Where the ice flow meets the Shackleton Shelf

The hummocky floe on the southern margin of the Davis Sea

The bumpy ice on the southern edge of the Davis Sea

View showing the young birds massed together at the Emperor penguins' rookery at Haswell Island

View showing the young birds gathered together at the Emperor penguins' nesting site at Haswell Island.

Antarctic petrels on the nest

Antarctic petrels nesting

A Snow petrel chick on the nest

A Snow petrel chick on the nest

A Silver-Grey petrel on the nest

A silver-grey petrel on the nest

The symmetrically domed outline of Drygalski Island, low on the horizon. The island is 1200 feet high and 9 miles in diameter

The evenly rounded shape of Drygalski Island, present on the horizon. The island stands 1,200 feet tall and spans 9 miles in diameter.

The main western party on their return to the "Grottoes." from the left: Hoadley, Jones and Dovers

The main western party on their way back to the "Grottoes." from the left: Hoadley, Jones, and Dovers

Blizzard-harassed penguins, after many days buried in the snow

Blizzard-battered penguins, after many days trapped in the snow

The pancake ice under the cliffs at Land's End

The pancake ice beneath the cliffs at Land's End

A wonderful canopy of ice

A stunning ice canopy

Sastrugi sculptured by the incessant blizzards

Sastrugi shaped by the constant snowstorms

The terminal moraine, near the hut, Cape Denison

The terminal moraine, located near the hut at Cape Denison

Disappearing in the drift

Fading into the drift

The hut looming through the drift

The hut standing out through the snow drift

A wall of solid gneiss near winter quarters

A solid gneiss wall near the winter quarters

An erratic on the moraine. Cape Denison

An unpredictable feature on the hillside. Cape Denison

Frozen spray built up by the blizzards along the shore

Frozen spray accumulated by the snowstorms along the shore

A view of the mainland from the Mackellar Islets: ice-capped islets in the foreground: the rock visible on the mainland is Cape Denison

A view of the mainland from the Mackellar Islets: ice-covered islets in the foreground; the rock you can see on the mainland is Cape Denison.

A Wilson petrel on the nest, Mackellar Islets

A Wilson's petrel on the nest, Mackellar Islets

The "Aurora" lying at anchor, Commonwealth Bay; in the distance the ice-slopes of the mainland are visible rising to a height of 3500 feet. In the foreground is a striking formation originating by the freezing of spray dashed up by the hurricane wind

The "Aurora" anchored in Commonwealth Bay; in the distance, the ice slopes of the mainland rise to a height of 3,500 feet. In the foreground is a striking formation created by the freezing of spray kicked up by the hurricane-force winds.

The shack: showing the natural rocky protection on the windward side

The shack: displaying the natural rocky shelter on the windward side

The interior of the operating hut on Wireless Hill

The inside of the operating hut on Wireless Hill

Weka pecking on the beach

Weka foraging on the beach

Chicks of the Dominican gull

Dominican gull chicks

Macquarie Island Skuas feeding

Macquarie Island Skuas eating

Bull Sea Elephants fighting

Bull elephant seals fighting

The thermometer screen, Macquarie Island

The thermometer display, Macquarie Island

The wind-recording instruments, Macquarie Island

Macquarie Island wind recorders

"Feather bed" terrace near Eagle Point, Macquarie Island

"Feather bed" terrace close to Eagle Point, Macquarie Island

A glacial lake (Major Lake) on Macquarie Island, 600 feet above sea level

A glacial lake (Major Lake) on Macquarie Island, 600 feet above sea level

Victoria penguins

Victoria penguins

View of the wireless station on the summit of Wireless Hill

View of the wireless station on top of Wireless Hill

The wireless operating hut

The wireless operating station

The wireless engine hut

The wireless engine room

Panoramic view of Macquarie Island, as seen from Wireless Hill at the north extremity of the island. The shack is near the bottom of the picture on the left-hand side: the sealers' hut at the far end of the isthmus: the distant left-hand point of the coast is the Nuggets: north-east bay on the left: Hasselborough Bay on the right

Panoramic view of Macquarie Island, as seen from Wireless Hill at the north end of the island. The shack is near the bottom of the picture on the left side: the sealers' hut at the far end of the isthmus: the distant left point of the coast is the Nuggets: north-east bay on the left: Hasselborough Bay on the right.

A view of the shore at The Nuggets: the sealers' shed on the right. the bare patches far inland high on the hills above the shed are Royal penguins' rookeries, from which they travel to the beach in a long procession

A view of the shore at The Nuggets: the sealers' shed on the right. The bare spots far inland high on the hills above the shed are Royal penguins' rookeries, from which they make their way to the beach in a long line.

Sooty albatrosses nesting

Sooty albatrosses breeding

A white Giant Petrel on the nest

A white Giant Petrel sitting on the nest

A Giant Petrel rookery

A giant petrel nesting site

The Macquarie Island party. From left to right: Sandell, Ainsworth, Sawyer, Hamilton, Blake

The Macquarie Island group. From left to right: Sandell, Ainsworth, Sawyer, Hamilton, Blake

King penguins

King penguins

The head of a Sea Leopard, showing fight

The head of a Sea Leopard, looking aggressive

A precocious Victoria penguin

A smart Victoria penguin

Young male Sea Elephants at play

Young male sea lions playing

A large Sea Leopard on the beach

A large sea leopard on the beach.

A Sea Elephant

A Walrus

A cormorant rookery, Hasselborough Bay

A cormorant colony, Hasselborough Bay

A young King penguin

A young King penguin

A Sclater penguin

A Sclater's penguin

Royal penguins on the nest

Royal penguins on the nest

Gentoo penguin and young

Gentoo penguin and chick

A cow Sea Elephant and pup

A cow sea elephant and its pup

The head of a bull Sea Elephant

The head of a bull Sea Elephant

A rookery of Sea Elephants near the shore at the Nelson reef, chiefly cows and pups

A group of Sea Elephants near the shore at the Nelson reef, mainly females and their young.

A bull Sea Elephant in a fighting attitude

A male Sea Elephant ready to fight

A cormorant and young on nest

A cormorant and its chick on the nest

The wild West Coast of Macquarie Island

The rugged West Coast of Macquarie Island

A Royal penguins rookery

A Royal penguin colony

The wreck of the "Gratitude" on the Nuggets beach

The wreck of the "Gratitude" on Nuggets Beach

Kerguelen Cabbage

Kerguelen Cabbage

Flowering plant

Flowering plant

Darby and Joan. Two rare examples of penguins which visited the shack, Macquarie Island. On the left a Sclater penguin, on the right an albino Royal penguin

Darby and Joan. Two uncommon penguins that visited the shack on Macquarie Island. On the left is a Sclater penguin, and on the right is an albino Royal penguin.

Large erratics and other glacial debris on the summit of Macquarie Island

Large boulders and other glacial debris on the top of Macquarie Island

Pillow-form lava on the highlands of Macquarie Island

Pillow lava on the highlands of Macquarie Island

Waterfall Lake, of glacial origin

Glacial Waterfall Lake

On the plateau-like summit of Macquarie Island; a panorama near the north end. Glacial lakes and tarns in the foreground

On the flat-topped peak of Macquarie Island; a view near the northern end. Glacial lakes and small ponds in the foreground.

The King penguins rookery, Lusitania Bay

The king penguins’ colony, Lusitania Bay

The head of a bull Sea Elephant photographed in the act of roaring

The head of a bull sea elephant captured while it’s roaring

The rookery of Royal penguins at the south end, viewed from a cliff several hundred feet above it

The Royal penguin colony at the southern end, seen from a cliff several hundred feet above it.

Young Sea Elephants asleep amongst Royal penguins, south end rookery

Young sea elephants sleeping among royal penguins, south end rookery.

Hamilton inspecting a good catch of fish at Lusitania Bay

Hamilton checking out a great catch of fish at Lusitania Bay

Hamilton obtaining the blubber of a Sea Elephant for fuel

Hamilton getting the blubber from a Sea Elephant for fuel

An illustration of the life on the Mackellar Islets

An illustration of life on the Mackellar Islets

An ice mushroom amongst the Mackellar Islets

An ice mushroom among the Mackellar Islets

View looking out of a shallow ravine at the eastern extremity of the rocks at Cape Denison

View looking out of a shallow ravine at the eastern edge of the rocks at Cape Denison

"Hurley had before him a picture in perfect proportion...."

"Hurley had in front of him a picture in perfect proportion...."

Antarctic petrels resting on the snow

Antarctic petrels lounging on the snow

Silver-grey petrels making love

Silver-grey petrels mating

Looking towards the mainland from Stillwell Island: Silver-grey petrels nesting in the foreground

Looking towards the mainland from Stillwell Island: Silver-gray petrels nesting in the foreground

Antarctic petrels nesting on the rocky ledges of the cliffs near Cape Hunter

Antarctic petrels nesting on the rocky ledges of the cliffs near Cape Hunter

Icing ship in the pack north of Termination Ice-tongue

Icing ship in the group north of Termination Ice-tongue

Emperor penguins follow the leader into the sea

Emperor penguins follow their leader into the ocean.

Emperor penguins jumping on to the floe

Emperor penguins jumping onto the ice floe

Cape Hunter, composed of ancient sedimentary rocks (Phyllites)

Cape Hunter, made up of ancient sedimentary rocks (Phyllites)

Examples of Antarctic marine crustaceans

Examples of Antarctic marine shrimp

TEXT ILLUSTRATIONS

TEXT ILLUSTRATIONS

Antarctic discoveries preceding the year 1910

Antarctic discoveries made before the year 1910

Plan and section of the S.Y. 'Aurora"

Plan and section of the S.Y. 'Aurora'

Map of Macquarie Island by L. R. BLAKE

Map of Macquarie Island by L. R. BLAKE

Ships' tracks in the vicinity of Totten's Land and North's Land

Ships' routes near Totten's Land and North's Land

Ships' tracks in the vicinity of Knox Land and Budd Land

Ships' paths around Knox Land and Budd Land

Plan of the hut, Adelie Land

Plan of the hut, Adelie Land

Sections across the hut, Adelie Land

Sections across the hut, Adelie Land

The vicinity of the main base, Adelie Land

The area around the main base, Adelie Land

A section of the coastal slope of the continental ice-sheet inland from winter quarters, Adelie Land

A part of the coastal slope of the continental ice sheet located inland from the winter camp, Adelie Land

Wind velocity and wind direction charts for a period of twenty-four hours, Adelie Land

Wind speed and wind direction charts for a twenty-four hour period, Adelie Land

A comparison of wind velocities and temperatures prevailing at Cape Royds, McMurdo Sound, and at winter quarters, Adelie Land, during the months of May and June

A comparison of wind speeds and temperatures at Cape Royds, McMurdo Sound, and at winter quarters, Adelie Land, during May and June.

The drift-gauge

The drift gauge

The wind velocity and wind direction charts for midwinter day

The wind speed and wind direction charts for midwinter day

The tide-gauge

The tide gauge

Midwinter Day menu at the main base, Adelie Land, 1912

Midwinter Day menu at the main base, Adelie Land, 1912

Section through a Nansen sledging cooker mounted on the Primus

Section through a Nansen sledding cooker attached to the Primus

Map showing the track of the southern sledging party from the main base

Map showing the route taken by the southern sledging team from the main base

[VOLUME II]

[VOLUME II]

Map showing the remarkable distribution of islets fringing the coast-line of Adelie Land in the vicinity of Cape Gray

Map showing the impressive arrangement of small islands along the coastline of Adelie Land near Cape Gray

Map showing the tracks of the western sledging party, Adelie Land

Map showing the paths of the western sledging team, Adelie Land

Plan illustrating the arrangements for deep-sea trawling on board the "Aurora"

Plan showing the setup for deep-sea trawling on the "Aurora"

Map of the Auckland Islands

Auckland Islands Map

The "Contents" page of the first number of the "Adelie Blizzard"

The "Contents" page of the first issue of the "Adelie Blizzard"

The meteorological chart for April 12, 1913, compiled by the Commonwealth Meteorological Bureau

The weather chart for April 12, 1913, put together by the Commonwealth Meteorological Bureau

A diagrammatic sketch illustrating the meteorological conditions at the main base, noon, September 6, 1913

A diagram showing the weather conditions at the main base, noon, September 6, 1913

Plan of the hut, Macquarie Island

Plan of the hut, Macquarie Island

Map of the north end of Macquarie Island by L. R. Blake

Map of the northern part of Macquarie Island by L. R. Blake

A section across Macquarie Island through Mt. Elder, by L. R. Blake

A section across Macquarie Island through Mt. Elder, by L. R. Blake

A sketch illustrating the distribution of the Mackellar Islets

A drawing showing the layout of the Mackellar Islets

A section illustrating the moat in the Antarctic continental shelf

A section showing the moat in the Antarctic continental shelf

Signatures of members of the land parties

Signatures of members of the land parties

A section of the Antarctic plateau from the coast to a point 300 miles inland, along the route followed by the southern sledging party

A part of the Antarctic plateau from the coast to a point 300 miles inland, along the path taken by the southern sledging party

A section across a part of the Antarctic continent through the South Magnetic Pole

A section across a part of the Antarctic continent through the South Magnetic Pole

A section of the floor of the Southern Ocean between Tasmania and King George V Land

A part of the floor of the Southern Ocean between Tasmania and King George V Land

A section of the floor of the Southern Ocean between Western Australia and Queen Mary Land

A part of the floor of the Southern Ocean between Western Australia and Queen Mary Land

A map showing Antarctic land discoveries preceding 1838

A map displaying Antarctic land discoveries before 1838.

A map showing Antarctic land discoveries preceding 1896

A map showing Antarctic land discoveries made before 1896

A map of the Antarctic regions as known at the present day

A map of the Antarctic regions as we know them today

FOLDING MAPS

Foldable maps

Regional map showing the area covered by the Australasian Antarctic Expedition, 1911-1914

Regional map showing the area covered by the Australasian Antarctic Expedition, 1911-1914

King George V Land, showing tracks of the eastern sledging parties from the main base

King George V Land, showing trails of the eastern sledding teams from the main base.

Queen Mary Land, showing tracks of the sledging party from the main base

Queen Mary Land, showing the tracks of the sledding party from the main base





CHAPTER I THE PROBLEM AND PREPARATIONS

Notwithstanding the fact that it has been repeatedly stated in the public press that the Australasian Antarctic expedition had no intention of making the South Geographical Pole its objective, it is evident that our aims were not properly realized by a large section of the British public, considering that many references have appeared in print attributing that purpose to the undertaking. With three other Antarctic expeditions already in the field, it appeared to many, therefore, that the venture was entirely superfluous.

Despite the fact that it's been repeatedly mentioned in the media that the Australasian Antarctic expedition did not intend to make the South Geographical Pole its goal, it's clear that a big part of the British public didn't fully understand our intentions, given that many articles have been published claiming that was our aim. With three other Antarctic expeditions already underway, it seemed to many that this venture was completely unnecessary.

The Expedition had a problem sketched in unmistakable feature, and the following pages will shortly set forth its historical origin and rationale.

The Expedition had a clearly defined problem, and the following pages will soon outline its historical background and reasoning.

The Antarctic problem** assumed its modern aspect after Captain Cook's circumnavigation of the globe in high southern latitudes, accomplished between 1772 and 1775. Fact replaced the fiction and surmise of former times, and maps appeared showing a large blank area at the southern extremity of the earth, where speculative cartographers had affirmed the existence of habitable land extending far towards the Equator. Cook's voyage made it clear that if there were any considerable mass of Antarctic land, it must indubitably lie within the Antarctic Circle, and be subjected to such stringent climatic conditions as to render it an unlikely habitation for man.

The Antarctic issue took on its modern form after Captain Cook circumnavigated the globe in the high southern latitudes from 1772 to 1775. Facts replaced the myths and guesses of earlier times, leading to maps that showed a large blank area at the southern end of the Earth, where speculative cartographers had claimed there was habitable land extending far toward the Equator. Cook's voyage made it clear that if there were any significant mass of Antarctic land, it would definitely be within the Antarctic Circle and subjected to such harsh climatic conditions that it would be an unlikely place for humans to live.

     ** Dr. H. R. Mill has compiled a complete account of Antarctic
exploration in his "Siege of the South Pole." Refer also to the
Historical Appendix for an abridged statement.
     ** Dr. H. R. Mill has put together a comprehensive overview of Antarctic exploration in his "Siege of the South Pole." Also, check the Historical Appendix for a summarized version.

Cook's reports of seals on the island of South Georgia initiated in the Antarctic seas south of America a commercial enterprise, which is still carried on, and has incidentally thrown much light upon the geography of the South Polar regions. Indeed, almost the whole of such information, prior to the year 1839, was the outcome of sealing and whaling projects.

Cook's reports of seals on South Georgia Island started a commercial venture in the Antarctic seas south of America, which still continues today and has also provided valuable insights into the geography of the South Pole regions. In fact, nearly all the information available before 1839 was a result of sealing and whaling activities.

About the year 1840, a wave of scientific enthusiasm resulted in the dispatch of three national expeditions by France, the United States, and Great Britain; part at least of whose programmes was Antarctic exploration. Russia had previously sent out an expedition which had made notable discoveries.

About the year 1840, a surge of scientific enthusiasm led to the launch of three national expeditions by France, the United States, and Great Britain; part of their missions included exploring Antarctica. Russia had previously sent out an expedition that made significant discoveries.

The contributions to knowledge gained at this period were considerable. Those carried back to civilization by the British expedition under Ross, are so well known that they need not be described. The French under Dumont D'Urville and the Americans under Wilkes visited the region to the southward of Australia—the arena of our own efforts—and frequent references will be made to their work throughout this story.

The knowledge gained during this time was significant. The British expedition led by Ross brought back discoveries that are so well-known they don't need detailing. The French under Dumont D'Urville and the Americans under Wilkes explored the area south of Australia—the focus of our own efforts—and we will frequently reference their work throughout this narrative.

What has been termed the period of averted interest now intervened, before the modern movement set in with overpowering insistence. It was not till 1897 that it had commenced in earnest. Since then many adventurers have gone forth; most of the prominent civilized nations taking their share in exploration. By their joint efforts some, at least, of the mystery of Antarctica has been dispelled.

What has been called the period of averted interest now occurred, before the modern movement began with strong insistence. It wasn't until 1897 that it truly started. Since then, many explorers have set out; most of the major civilized nations have taken part in exploration. Through their combined efforts, some of the mystery of Antarctica has been uncovered.

It is now a commonplace, largely in the world of geographical concerns, that the earth has still another continent, unique in character, whose ultimate bounds are merely pieced together from a fragmentary outline. The Continent itself appears to have been sighted for the first time in the year 1820, but no human being actually set foot on it until 1895. The Belgian expedition under de Gerlache was the first to experience the Antarctic winter, spending the year 1898 drifting helplessly, frozen in the pack-ice, to the southward of America. In the following year a British expedition under Borchgrevinck, wintering at Cape Adare, passed a year upon the Antarctic mainland.

It's now widely accepted, especially in discussions about geography, that there’s another continent on Earth, unique in its nature, whose exact boundaries are only come together from bits and pieces. This Continent was first spotted in 1820, but no one actually stepped foot on it until 1895. The Belgian expedition led by de Gerlache was the first to endure the Antarctic winter, spending 1898 stuck and frozen in the pack ice south of America. The following year, a British expedition led by Borchgrevinck spent a year on the Antarctic mainland, wintering at Cape Adare.

The main efforts of recent years have been centred upon the two more accessible areas, namely, that in the American Quadrant** which is prolonged as a tongue of land outside the Antarctic Circle, being consequently less beset by ice; secondly, the vicinity of the Ross Sea in the Australian Quadrant. It is because these two favoured domains have for special reasons attracted the stream of exploration that the major portion of Antarctica is unknown. Nevertheless, one is in a position to sketch broad features which will probably not be radically altered by any future expeditions.

The main efforts in recent years have focused on two more accessible areas: first, the section in the American Quadrant, extending as a strip of land beyond the Antarctic Circle, which is therefore less affected by ice; and second, the region around the Ross Sea in the Australian Quadrant. These two favored regions have drawn the bulk of exploration for specific reasons, leaving most of Antarctica still unexplored. However, it’s possible to outline general features that are unlikely to change significantly with any future expeditions.

     ** For convenience, the Antarctic regions may be referred to in four
main divisions, corresponding with the quadrants of the hemisphere. Of
the several suggestions thrown out by previous writers, the one adopted
here is that based on the meridian of Greenwich, referring the quadrants
to an adjacent continent or ocean. Thus the American Quadrant lies
between 0 degrees and 90 degrees W., the African Quadrant between
0 degrees and 90 degrees E., and the Australian Quadrant between 90
degrees and 180 degrees E. The fourth division is called the Pacific
Quadrant, since ocean alone lies to the north of it.
     ** For convenience, we can divide the Antarctic regions into four main sections, matching the hemispherical quadrants. Among the various suggestions from previous authors, the one used here is based on the Greenwich meridian, linking the quadrants to a nearby continent or ocean. Therefore, the American Quadrant is located between 0 degrees and 90 degrees W, the African Quadrant between 0 degrees and 90 degrees E, and the Australian Quadrant between 90 degrees and 180 degrees E. The fourth section is called the Pacific Quadrant, as it is bordered only by ocean to the north.

Certain it is that a continent approaching the combined areas of Australia and Europe lies more or less buried beneath the South Polar snows; though any statement of the precise area is insufficient for a proper appreciation of the magnitude, unless its elevated plateau-like character be also taken into consideration. It appears to be highest over a wide central crown rising to more than ten thousand feet. Of the remainder, there is little doubt that the major portion stands as high as six thousand feet. The average elevation must far exceed that of any other continent, for, with peaks nineteen thousand feet above sea-level, its mountainous topography is remarkable. Along the coast of Victoria Land, in the Australian Quadrant, are some of the most majestic vistas of alpine scenery that the world affords. Rock exposures are rare, ice appearing everywhere except in the most favoured places.

It's certain that a continent roughly the size of Australia and Europe is mostly covered by the South Polar snow; however, any claim about its exact area doesn't fully convey its vastness unless you also consider its high, plateau-like nature. It seems to have a central peak that rises over ten thousand feet. As for the rest, it's clear that most of it sits around six thousand feet high. The average elevation is likely much higher than any other continent, as it features peaks that are nineteen thousand feet above sea level, making its mountainous landscape truly impressive. Along the coast of Victoria Land in the Australian Quadrant, you'll find some of the most stunning alpine views the world has to offer. Rock formations are rare; ice is found everywhere except in the most favored spots.

Regarding plant and animal life upon the land there is little to say. The vegetable kingdom is represented by plants of low organization such as mosses, lichens, diatoms and algae. The animal world, so far as true land-forms are concerned, is limited to types like the protozoa (lowest in the organic scale), rotifera and minute insect-like mites which lurk hidden away amongst the tufts of moss or on the under side of loose stones. Bacteria, most fundamental of all, at the basis, so to speak, of animal and vegetable life, have a manifold distribution.

When it comes to plant and animal life on land, there's not much to say. The plant kingdom includes simple organisms like mosses, lichens, diatoms, and algae. The animal life, in terms of true land forms, is mostly limited to basic types like protozoa (the simplest organisms), rotifers, and tiny mite-like insects that hide among moss tufts or under loose stones. Bacteria, the most basic of all, form the foundation of both animal and plant life and are found in a wide variety of places.

It is a very different matter when we turn to the life of the neighbouring seas, for that vies in abundance with the warmer waters of lower latitudes. There are innumerable seals, many sea-birds and millions of penguins. As all these breed on Antarctic shores, the coastal margin of the continent is not so desolate.

It’s a completely different situation when we look at the life in the neighboring seas, as it competes in richness with the warmer waters of lower latitudes. There are countless seals, many seabirds, and millions of penguins. Since all of these breed on the Antarctic shores, the coastal edge of the continent isn’t so barren.

In view of the fact that life, including land-mammals, is abundant in the North Polar regions, it may be asked why analogous forms are not better represented in corresponding southern latitudes. Without going too deeply into the question, it may be briefly stated, firstly, that a more widespread glaciation than at present prevails invested the great southern continent and its environing seas, within recent geological times, effectually exterminating any pre-existing land life. Secondly, since that period the continent has been isolated by a wide belt of ocean from other lands, from which restocking might have taken place after the manner of the North Polar regions. Finally, climatic conditions in the Antarctic are, latitude for latitude, much more severe than in the Arctic.

Given that life, including land mammals, is abundant in the North Polar regions, one might wonder why similar species aren’t more commonly found in corresponding southern latitudes. Without getting too deep into the topic, it can be briefly summarized that, first, a much larger extent of glaciation than what exists today covered the vast southern continent and its surrounding seas in recent geological history, effectively wiping out any land life that was there. Second, since then, the continent has been separated by a wide ocean from other land areas, which could have allowed for the reintroduction of species, similar to what has happened in the North Polar regions. Lastly, the climate in Antarctica is, for its latitude, much harsher than in the Arctic.

With regard to climate in general, Antarctica has the lowest mean temperature and the highest wind-velocity of any land existing. This naturally follows from the fact that it is a lofty expanse of ice-clad land circumscribing the Pole, and that the Antarctic summer occurs when the earth is farther from the sun than is the case during the Arctic summer.

With respect to climate, Antarctica has the lowest average temperature and the highest wind speeds of any land on Earth. This is a natural result of it being a high layer of ice-covered land surrounding the Pole, and the Antarctic summer happens when the Earth is farther from the sun compared to the Arctic summer.

There are those who would impatiently ask, "What is the use of it all?" The answer is brief.

There are some who might impatiently ask, "What’s the point of all this?" The answer is short.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Antarctic Land discoveries preceding the year 1910

Antarctic land discoveries pre-1910

The polar regions, like any other part of the globe, may be said to be paved with facts, the essence of which it is necessary to acquire before knowledge of this special zone can be brought to even a provisional exactitude. On the face of it, polar research may seem to be specific and discriminating, but it must be remembered that an advance in any one of the departments into which, for convenience, science is artificially divided, conduces to the advantage of all. Science is a homogeneous whole. If we ignore the facts contained in one part of the world, surely we are hampering scientific advance. It is obvious to every one that, given only a fraction of the pieces, it is a much more difficult task to put together a jig-saw puzzle and obtain an idea of the finished pattern than were all the pieces at hand. The pieces of the jig-saw puzzle are the data of science.

The polar regions, like any other part of the world, are filled with facts that are essential to understand before we can claim any accurate knowledge of this unique area. At first glance, polar research might seem specific and narrow, but it’s important to remember that progress in any one field of science, which we often separate for convenience, benefits all fields. Science is interconnected. If we overlook the facts from one part of the world, we are undoubtedly hindering scientific progress. It’s clear to everyone that if you only have a few pieces of a jigsaw puzzle, it’s much harder to see the full picture compared to having all the pieces in front of you. The pieces of the jigsaw puzzle represent the data in science.

Though it is not sufficiently recognized, the advance of science is attended by a corresponding increase in the creature comforts of man. Again, from an economic aspect, the frozen South may not attract immediate attention. But who can say what a train of enterprise the future may bring?

Though it's not widely acknowledged, the progress of science is accompanied by a corresponding rise in people's comforts. Additionally, from an economic standpoint, the frozen South may not catch immediate interest. But who can predict what opportunities the future might hold?

Captain James Cook, on his return to London after the circumnavigation of Antarctica, held that the far-southern lands had no future. Yet, a few years later, great profits were being returned to Great Britain and the United States from sealing-stations established as a result of Cook's own observations. At the present day, several whaling companies have flourishing industries in the Antarctic waters within the American Quadrant.

Captain James Cook, on his return to London after circumnavigating Antarctica, believed that the far-southern lands had no future. However, a few years later, significant profits were being generated for Great Britain and the United States from sealing stations established based on Cook's own observations. Today, several whaling companies have thriving industries in the Antarctic waters of the American Quadrant.

Even now much can be said in regard to the possibilities offered by the Antarctic regions for economic development, but, year by year, the outlook will widen, since man is constantly resorting to subtler and more ingenious artifice in applying Nature's resources. It will be remembered that Charles Darwin, when in Australia, predicted a very limited commercial future for New South Wales. But the mastery of man overcame the difficulties which Darwin's too penetrating mind foresaw.

Even now, there’s a lot to discuss about the economic development opportunities in Antarctica, but each year, the possibilities will grow as people find more clever and innovative ways to use nature's resources. It’s worth noting that Charles Darwin, during his time in Australia, predicted a very limited commercial future for New South Wales. However, human ingenuity has managed to overcome the challenges that Darwin’s insightful perspective anticipated.

What will be the role of the South in the progress of civilization and in the development of the arts and sciences, is not now obvious. As sure as there is here a vast mass of land with potentialities, strictly limited at present, so surely will it be cemented some day within the universal plinth of things.

What the South's role will be in the advancement of civilization and the growth of arts and sciences isn’t clear right now. Just as there is a huge expanse of land here with possibilities that are currently restricted, it will surely become an essential part of the overall foundation of things someday.

An unknown coast-line lay before the door of Australia. Following on the general advance of exploration, and as a sequel to several important discoveries, the time arrived when a complete elucidation of the Antarctic problem was more than ever desirable. In the Australian Quadrant, the broad geographical features of the Ross Sea area were well known, but of the remainder and greater portion of the tract only vague and imperfect reports could be supplied.

An unknown coastline stretched out before Australia. With the overall progress of exploration and as a continuation of several significant discoveries, the moment came when fully understanding the Antarctic issue was more important than ever. In the Australian Quadrant, the general geographical features of the Ross Sea area were well understood, but for the rest of the larger region, only unclear and incomplete reports were available.

Before submitting our plans in outline, it will be as well to review the stage at which discovery had arrived when our Expedition came upon the scene.

Before we submit our outline plans, it's a good idea to review the point that discovery had reached when our Expedition arrived.

The coast-line of the eastern extremity of the Australian Quadrant, including the outline of the Ross Sea and the coast west-north-west of Cape Adare as far as Cape North, was charted by Ross and has been amplified by seven later expeditions. In the region west of Cape North, recent explorers had done little up till 1911. Scott in the 'Discovery' had disproved the existence of some of Wilkes's land; Shackleton in the 'Nimrod' had viewed some forty miles of high land beyond Cape North; lastly, on the eve of our departure, Scott's 'Terra Nova' had met two patches of new land—Oates Land—still farther west, making it evident that the continent ranged at least two hundred and eighty miles in a west-north-west direction from Cape Adare.

The coastline of the eastern part of the Australian Quadrant, including the outline of the Ross Sea and the coast northwest of Cape Adare all the way to Cape North, was mapped out by Ross and later expanded upon by seven additional expeditions. In the area west of Cape North, recent explorers had done very little up until 1911. Scott in the 'Discovery' had proven that some of Wilkes's land didn’t exist; Shackleton in the 'Nimrod' had seen about forty miles of high land beyond Cape North; finally, just before our departure, Scott's 'Terra Nova' had encountered two new patches of land—Oates Land—further west, making it clear that the continent extended at least two hundred and eighty miles in a west-northwest direction from Cape Adare.

Just outside the western limit of the Australian Quadrant lies Gaussberg, discovered by a German expedition under Drygalski in 1902. Between the most westerly point sighted by the 'Terra Nova' and Gaussberg, there is a circuit of two thousand miles, bordering the Antarctic Circle, which no vessel had navigated previous to 1840.

Just beyond the western edge of the Australian Quadrant is Gaussberg, discovered by a German expedition led by Drygalski in 1902. There’s a route of two thousand miles between the furthest point seen by the 'Terra Nova' and Gaussberg, along the edge of the Antarctic Circle, that no ship had sailed before 1840.

This was the arena of our activities and, therefore, a synopsis of the voyages of early mariners will be enlightening.

This was the field of our activities, so a summary of the journeys of early sailors will be informative.

Balleny, a whaling-master, with the schooner 'Eliza Scott' of one hundred and fifty-four tons, and a cutter, the 'Sabrina' of fifty-four tons, was the first to meet with success in these waters. Proceeding southward from New Zealand in 1839, he located the Balleny Islands, a group containing active volcanoes, lying about two hundred miles off the nearest part of the mainland and to the north-west of Cape Adare. Leaving these islands, Balleny sailed westward keeping a look-out for new land. During a gale the vessels became separated and the 'Sabrina' was lost with all hands. Balleny in the 'Eliza Scott' arrived safely in England and reported doubtful land in 122 degrees E. longitude, approximately. Dr. H. R. Mill says: "Although the name of the cutter 'Sabrina' has been given to an appearance of land at this point, we cannot look upon its discovery as proved by the vague reference made by the explorers."

Balleny, a whaling captain, with the schooner 'Eliza Scott' weighing one hundred and fifty-four tons and a cutter named 'Sabrina' at fifty-four tons, was the first to find success in these waters. Heading south from New Zealand in 1839, he discovered the Balleny Islands, a group of active volcanoes located about two hundred miles from the nearest part of the mainland and to the northwest of Cape Adare. After leaving these islands, Balleny sailed westward, searching for new land. During a storm, the vessels got separated, and the 'Sabrina' was lost with all crew on board. Balleny returned safely to England on the 'Eliza Scott' and reported unclear land at approximately 122 degrees E. longitude. Dr. H. R. Mill states: "Although the name of the cutter 'Sabrina' has been given to a sighting of land at this location, we cannot consider its discovery confirmed based on the vague reference made by the explorers."

On January 1, 1840, Dumont D'Urville sailed southward from Hobart in command of two corvettes, the 'Astrolabe' and the 'Zelee'. Without much obstruction from floating ice, he came within sight of the Antarctic coast, thenceforth known as Adelie Land. The expedition did not set foot on the mainland, but on an adjacent island. They remained in the vicinity of the coast for a few days, when a gale sprang up which was hazardously weathered on the windward side of the pack-ice. The ships then cruised along the face of flat-topped ice-cliffs, of the type known as barrier-ice or shelf-ice, which were taken to be connected with land and named Cote Clarie. As will be seen later, Cote Clarie does not exist.

On January 1, 1840, Dumont D'Urville set sail south from Hobart in charge of two corvettes, the 'Astrolabe' and the 'Zelee'. With little obstruction from floating ice, he spotted the Antarctic coast, which would later be called Adelie Land. The expedition didn’t land on the mainland but on a nearby island. They stayed near the coast for a few days until a storm hit, which they managed to ride out on the windward side of the pack ice. The ships then sailed along flat-topped ice cliffs, known as barrier ice or shelf ice, which were thought to be connected to land and named Cote Clarie. As will be explained later, Cote Clarie doesn’t actually exist.

Dr. H. R. Mill sums up the work done by the French expedition during its eleven days' sojourn in the vicinity of the Antarctic coast:

Dr. H. R. Mill summarizes the work completed by the French expedition during its eleven-day stay near the Antarctic coast:

"D'Urville's discoveries of land were of but little account. He twice traced out considerable stretches of a solid barrier of ice, and at one point saw and landed upon rocks in front of it; but he could only give the vaguest account of what lay behind the barrier."

"D'Urville's discoveries of land weren't very significant. He traced large sections of a solid ice barrier twice, and at one point, he saw and landed on rocks in front of it; however, he could only provide the most general description of what was behind the barrier."

Wilkes of the American expedition proceeded south from Sydney at the close of 1839. His vessels were the 'Vincennes', a sloop of war of seven hundred and eighty tons, the 'Peacock', another sloop of six hundred and fifty tons, the 'Porpoise', a gun-brig of two hundred and thirty tons and a tender, the 'Flying Fish' of ninety-six tons. The scientists of the expedition were precluded from joining in this part of the programme, and were left behind in Sydney. Wilkes himself was loud in his denunciation both of the ships and of the stores, though they had been specially assembled by the naval department. The ships were in Antarctic waters for a period of forty-two days, most of the time separated by gales, during which the crews showed great skill in navigating their ill-fitted crafts and suffered great hardships.

Wilkes of the American expedition headed south from Sydney at the end of 1839. His ships included the 'Vincennes', a sloop of war weighing seven hundred and eighty tons; the 'Peacock', another sloop at six hundred and fifty tons; the 'Porpoise', a gun-brig weighing two hundred and thirty tons; and a tender, the 'Flying Fish', which weighed ninety-six tons. The scientists on the expedition were unable to participate in this part of the mission and stayed behind in Sydney. Wilkes himself was very critical of both the ships and the supplies, even though they had been specifically gathered by the naval department. The ships spent forty-two days in Antarctic waters, often separated by storms, during which the crews demonstrated great skill in navigating their poorly-equipped vessels and endured significant hardships.

Land was reported almost daily, but, unfortunately, subsequent exploration has shown that most of the landfalls do not exist. Several soundings made by Wilkes were indicative of the approach to land, but he must have frequently mistaken for it distant ice-masses frozen in the pack. Experience has proved what deceptive light-effects may be observed amid the ice and how easily a mirage may simulate reality.

Land was reported almost every day, but unfortunately, later exploration has shown that most of these landfalls don't actually exist. Several soundings taken by Wilkes suggested that land was near, but he often mistook distant ice formations in the pack for land. Experience has shown how misleading light effects can be among the ice and how easily a mirage can mimic reality.

Whatever the cause of Wilkes's errors, the truth remains that Ross sailed over land indicated in a rough chart which had been forwarded to him by Wilkes, just before the British expedition set out. More recently, Captain Scott in the 'Discovery' erased many of the landfalls of Wilkes, and now we have still further reduced their number. The 'Challenger' approached within fifteen miles of the western extremity of Wilkes's Termination Land, but saw no sign of it. The 'Gauss' in the same waters charted Kaiser Wilhelm II Land well to the south of Termination Land, and the eastward continuation of the former could not have been visible from Wilkes's ship. After the voyage of the 'Discovery', the landfalls, the existence of which had not been disproved, might well have been regarded as requiring confirmation before their validity could be recognised.

Whatever the reason for Wilkes's mistakes, the fact is that Ross sailed over land shown on a rough map that Wilkes had sent him just before the British expedition left. More recently, Captain Scott on the 'Discovery' removed many of Wilkes's landfalls, and now we have further reduced their number. The 'Challenger' came within fifteen miles of the western edge of Wilkes's Termination Land but saw no signs of it. The 'Gauss,' working in the same waters, mapped Kaiser Wilhelm II Land far to the south of Termination Land, and the eastern continuation of the former wouldn't have been visible from Wilkes's ship. After the journey of the 'Discovery,' the landfalls whose existence hadn’t been disproved might have been seen as needing confirmation before their validity could be accepted.

The only spot where rocks were reported in situ was in Adelie Land, where the French had anticipated the Americans by seven days. Farther west, earth and stones had been collected by Wilkes from material embedded in floating masses of ice off the coast of his Knox Land. These facts lend credence to Wilkes's claims of land in that vicinity. His expedition did not once set foot on Antarctic shores, and, possibly on account of the absence of the scientific staff, his descriptions tend to be inexact and obscure. The soundings made by Wilkes were sufficient to show that he was probably in some places at no great distance from the coast, and, considering that his work was carried out in the days of sailing-ships, in unsuitable craft, under the most adverse weather conditions, with crews scurvy-stricken and discontented, it is wonderful how much was achieved. We may amply testify that he did more than open the field for future expeditions.

The only place where rocks were found in their original position was in Adelie Land, where the French arrived seven days earlier than the Americans. Further west, Wilkes collected earth and stones from material embedded in floating ice near the coast of Knox Land. These facts support Wilkes's claims of land in that area. His expedition never actually set foot on Antarctic shores, and likely due to the lack of a scientific team, his descriptions tend to be vague and unclear. The soundings taken by Wilkes were enough to suggest that he was possibly fairly close to the coast in some areas, and given that his work was done during the era of sailing ships, in inadequate vessels, under extremely poor weather conditions, and with crews suffering from scurvy and dissatisfaction, it's impressive how much was accomplished. We can certainly affirm that he did more than just pave the way for future expeditions.

After we had taken into account the valuable soundings of the 'Challenger' (1872), the above comprised our knowledge concerning some two thousand miles of prospective coast lying to the southward of Australia, at a time when the plans of the Australasian expedition were being formulated.

After we considered the important findings from the 'Challenger' (1872), the information above represented our understanding of about two thousand miles of potential coastline south of Australia, at a time when the plans for the Australasian expedition were being developed.

The original plans for the expedition were somewhat modified upon my return from Europe. Briefly stated, it was decided that a party of five men should be stationed at Macquarie Island, a sub-antarctic possession of the Commonwealth. They were to be provided with a hut, stores and a complete wireless plant, and were to prosecute general scientific investigations, co-operating with the Antarctic bases in meteorological and other work. After disembarking the party at Macquarie Island, the 'Aurora' was to proceed south on a meridian of 158 degrees E. longitude, to the westward of which the Antarctic programme was to be conducted.

The original plans for the expedition were changed a bit when I returned from Europe. In short, it was decided that a group of five men would be stationed at Macquarie Island, which is a sub-antarctic territory of the Commonwealth. They were to be given a hut, supplies, and a complete wireless setup, and they would carry out general scientific research, working alongside the Antarctic bases on meteorological and other projects. After dropping off the group at Macquarie Island, the 'Aurora' would head south along the 158 degrees E longitude line, beyond which the Antarctic program would take place.

Twelve men, provisioned and equipped for a year's campaign and provided with wireless apparatus, were to be landed in Antarctica on the first possible opportunity at what would constitute a main base. Thereafter, proceeding westward, it was hoped that a second and a third party, consisting of six and eight men respectively, would be successively established on the continent at considerable distances apart. Of course we were well aware of the difficulties of landing even one party, but, as division of our forces would under normal conditions secure more scientific data, it was deemed advisable to be prepared for exceptionally favourable circumstances.

Twelve men, equipped and supplied for a year-long expedition and with wireless communication devices, were set to be landed in Antarctica at the earliest possible opportunity to establish a main base. After that, the plan was to head west, aiming to set up a second and a third team, made up of six and eight men respectively, at significant distances from each other on the continent. We fully understood the challenges of landing even one group, but since breaking up our teams would generally yield more scientific data, we decided it was wise to be ready for exceptionally favorable conditions.

Macquarie Island, a busy station in the days of the early sealers, had become almost neglected. Little accurate information was to be had regarding it, and no reliable map existed. A few isolated facts had been gathered of its geology, and the anomalous fauna and flora sui generis had been but partially described. Its position, eight hundred and fifty miles south-south-east of Hobart, gave promise of valuable meteorological data relative to the atmospheric circulation of the Southern Hemisphere and of vital interest to the shipping of Australia and New Zealand.

Macquarie Island, once a busy hub for early sealers, had become almost forgotten. There was little accurate information available about it, and no reliable map existed. A few scattered details about its geology had been collected, and the unique plants and animals were only partially described. Its location, eight hundred and fifty miles south-southeast of Hobart, held promise for valuable weather data concerning the atmospheric circulation of the Southern Hemisphere, which was crucial for shipping in Australia and New Zealand.

As to the Antarctic sphere of work, it has been seen that very little was known of the vast region which was our goal. It is sufficient to say that almost every observation would be fresh material added to the sum of human knowledge.

As for the work in Antarctica, it’s clear that very little was known about the huge area we aimed to explore. It’s enough to say that nearly every observation would contribute new information to the total understanding of humanity.

In addition to the work to be conducted from the land bases, it was intended that oceanographic investigations should be carried on by the 'Aurora' as far as funds would allow. With this object in view, provision was made for the necessary apparatus which would enable the ship's party to make extensive investigations of the ocean and its floor over the broad belt between Australia and the Antarctic Continent. This was an important branch of study, for science is just as much interested in the greatest depths of the ocean as with the corresponding elevations of the land. Indeed, at the present day, the former is perhaps the greater field.

In addition to the work being done from land bases, there were plans for oceanographic research to be carried out by the 'Aurora' as long as funding permitted. With this goal in mind, arrangements were made for the necessary equipment that would allow the ship's team to conduct extensive studies of the ocean and its floor across the wide area between Australia and the Antarctic Continent. This was an important area of study, as science is just as focused on the deepest parts of the ocean as it is on the highest points of the land. In fact, nowadays, the ocean depths may be the more significant area of exploration.

The scope of our intentions was regarded by some as over-ambitious, but knowing

The scope of our intentions was seen by some as overly ambitious, but knowing

    How far high failure overleaps the bound
    Of low successes,
How far a high failure surpasses the limits of low successes,

and seeing nothing impossible in these arrangements, we continued to adhere to them as closely as possible, with what fortune remains to be told.

and seeing nothing unfeasible in these plans, we kept following them as closely as we could, with whatever luck is left to be revealed.

To secure a suitable vessel was a matter of fundamental importance. There was no question of having a ship built to our design, for the requisite expenditure might well have exceeded the whole cost of our Expedition. Accordingly the best obtainable vessel was purchased, and modified to fulfil our requirements. Such craft are not to be had in southern waters; they are only to be found engaged in Arctic whaling and sealing.

To find a suitable vessel was extremely important. There was no option to have a ship built to our specifications, as the costs would likely exceed the entire budget of our Expedition. Therefore, the best available vessel was bought and adapted to meet our needs. You can't find such ships in southern waters; they are only used for Arctic whaling and sealing.

The primary consideration in the design of a vessel built to navigate amid the ice is that the hull be very staunch, capable of driving into the pack and of resisting lateral pressure, if the ice should close in around it.

The main factor in designing a ship intended to sail through ice is that the hull must be very strong, able to push into the ice pack and withstand pressure from the sides if the ice closes in around it.

So a thick-walled timber vessel, with adequate stiffening in the framework, would meet the case. The construction being of wood imparts a certain elasticity, which is of great advantage in easing the shock of impacts with floating ice. As has been tragically illustrated in a recent disaster, the ordinary steel ship would be ripped on its first contact with the ice. Another device, to obviate the shock and to assist in forging a way through the floe-ice, is to have the bow cut away below the water-line. Thus, instead of presenting to the ice a vertical face, which would immediately arrest the ship and possibly cause considerable damage on account of the sudden stress of the blow, a sloping, overhanging bow is adopted. This arrangement enables the bow to rise over the impediment, with a gradual slackening of speed. The immense weight put upon the ice crushes it and the ship settles down, moving ahead and gathering speed to meet the next obstacle.

So a thick-walled wooden vessel, with proper reinforcement in the framework, would be the solution. The wooden construction provides a certain flexibility, which is really beneficial in reducing the impact from collisions with floating ice. As has been tragically shown in a recent disaster, a regular steel ship would be torn apart on its first contact with the ice. Another method, to reduce the shock and help navigate through the ice floes, is to have the bow shaped below the waterline. Instead of facing the ice with a vertical front, which would instantly stop the ship and could cause significant damage due to the sudden force of the impact, a sloping, overhanging bow is used. This design allows the bow to rise over the obstacle, slowing down gradually. The immense weight on the ice crushes it, and the ship settles down, continuing forward and picking up speed to tackle the next challenge.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Plan and Section of S.Y. 'Aurora'

Plan and Section of S.Y. 'Aurora'

Of importance second only to a strong hull is the possession of sails in addition to engines. The latter are a sine qua non in polar navigation, whilst sails allow of economy in the consumption of coal, and always remain as a last resort should the coal-supply be exhausted or the propeller damaged.

Of importance second only to a strong hull is having sails in addition to engines. The latter are essential in polar navigation, while sails help conserve coal and always serve as a backup if the coal supply runs out or if the propeller gets damaged.

The 'Aurora', of the Newfoundland sealing fleet, was ultimately purchased and underwent necessary alterations. She was built in Dundee in 1876, but though by no means young was still in good condition and capable of buffeting with the pack for many a year. Also, she was not without a history, for in the earlier days she was amongst those vessels which hurried to the relief of the unfortunate Greely expedition.

The 'Aurora', part of the Newfoundland sealing fleet, was eventually bought and underwent essential modifications. Built in Dundee in 1876, she wasn’t exactly new but was still in good shape and able to handle the pack ice for many years to come. Plus, she had a history; in her earlier days, she was one of the ships that rushed to help the stranded Greely expedition.

The hull was made of stout oak planks, sheathed with greenheart and lined with fir. The bow, fashioned on cutaway lines, was a mass of solid wood, armoured with steel plates. The heavy side-frames were braced and stiffened by two tiers of horizontal oak beams, upon which were built the 'tween decks and the main deck. Three bulkheads isolated the fore-peak, the main hold, the engine-room and the after living-quarters respectively.

The hull was made of strong oak planks, covered with greenheart and lined with fir. The bow, designed with cutaway lines, was a solid mass of wood, reinforced with steel plates. The heavy side-frames were supported and strengthened by two layers of horizontal oak beams, on which the 'tween decks and the main deck were constructed. Three bulkheads separated the fore-peak, the main hold, the engine room, and the living quarters at the back.

A hull of such strength would resist a heavy strain, and, should it be subjected to lateral pressure, would in all probability rise out of harm's way. However, to be quite certain of this and to ensure safety in the most extreme case it is necessary that the hull be modelled after the design adopted by Nansen in the 'Fram'.

A hull built with that kind of strength would be able to handle a heavy load, and if it faced sideways pressure, it would likely lift itself out of danger. However, to be completely certain and to ensure safety in the worst-case scenario, it's essential that the hull follows the design used by Nansen in the 'Fram'.

The principal dimensions were, length one hundred and sixty-five feet, breadth thirty feet, and depth eighteen feet.

The main dimensions were, length 165 feet, width 30 feet, and depth 18 feet.

The registered tonnage was three hundred and eighty-six, but the actual carrying capacity we found to be about six hundred tons.

The registered tonnage was three hundred and eighty-six, but we discovered that the actual carrying capacity was around six hundred tons.

The engines, situated aft, were compound, supplied with steam from a single boiler. The normal power registered was ninety-eight horse-power, working a four-bladed propeller, driving it at the rate of sixty or seventy revolutions per minute (six to ten knots per hour).

The engines, located at the back, were compound and received steam from a single boiler. The typical power output was ninety-eight horsepower, operating a four-bladed propeller at a speed of sixty to seventy revolutions per minute (six to ten knots per hour).

Steam was also laid on to a winch, aft, for handling cargo in the main hold, and to a forward steam-windlass. The latter was mainly used for raising the anchor and manipulating the deep-sea dredging-cable.

Steam was also connected to a winch at the back for handling cargo in the main hold, and to a steam windlass at the front. The windlass was primarily used for raising the anchor and managing the deep-sea dredging cable.

The ship was square on the foremast and schooner-rigged on the main and mizen masts.

The ship had a square foremast and was rigged as a schooner on the main and mizen masts.

Between the engine-room bulkhead and the chain and sail locker was a spacious hold. Six large steel tanks built into the bottom of the hold served for the storage of fresh water and at any time when empty could be filled with seawater, offering a ready means of securing emergency ballast.

Between the engine room wall and the chain and sail locker was a spacious storage area. Six big steel tanks built into the bottom of the space were used to store fresh water and could be filled with seawater when empty, providing an easy way to secure emergency ballast.

On the deck, just forward of the main hatch, was a deckhouse, comprising cook's galley, steward's pantry and two laboratories. Still farther forward was a small lamp-room for the storage of kerosene, lamps and other necessaries. A lofty fo'c'sle-head gave much accommodation for carpenters', shipwrights' and other stores. Below it, a capacious fo'c'sle served as quarters for a crew of sixteen men.

On the deck, just in front of the main hatch, was a small building that included the cook's kitchen, the steward's pantry, and two labs. Further up was a small lamp room for storing kerosene, lamps, and other essentials. A tall forecastle head provided plenty of space for carpenters', shipwrights', and other supplies. Below it, a spacious forecastle served as sleeping quarters for a crew of sixteen men.

Aft, the chart-room, captain's cabin and photographic dark-room formed a block leading up to the bridge, situated immediately in front of the funnel. Farther aft, behind the engine-room and below the poop deck, was the ward-room(,) a central space sixteen feet by eight feet, filled by the dining-table and surrounded by cabins with bunks for twenty persons.

Aft, the chart-room, captain's cabin, and photographic darkroom formed a block leading up to the bridge, located right in front of the funnel. Further back, behind the engine room and below the poop deck, was the wardroom, a central area sixteen feet by eight feet, filled with a dining table and surrounded by cabins with bunks for twenty people.

From the time the 'Aurora' arrived in London to her departure from Australia, she was a scene of busy activity, as alterations and replacements were necessary to fit her for future work.

From the time the 'Aurora' got to London until she left Australia, she was buzzing with activity because changes and updates were needed to prepare her for future jobs.

In the meantime, stores and gear were being assembled. Purchases were made and valuable donations received both in Europe and Australia. Many and varied were the requirements, and some idea of their great multiplicity will be gained by referring to the appendices dealing with stores, clothing and instruments.

In the meantime, supplies and equipment were being gathered. Purchases were made and valuable donations came in from both Europe and Australia. There were many different needs, and you can get an idea of their great variety by looking at the appendices about supplies, clothing, and instruments.

Finally, reference may be made in this chapter to the staff. In no department can a leader spend time more profitably than in the selection of the men who are to accomplish the work. Even when the expedition has a scientific basis, academic distinction becomes secondary in the choice of men. Fiala, as a result of his Arctic experience, truly says, "Many a man who is a jolly good fellow in congenial surroundings will become impatient, selfish and mean when obliged to sacrifice his comfort, curb his desires and work hard in what seems a losing fight. The first consideration in the choice of men for a polar campaign should be the moral quality. Next should come mental and physical powers."

Finally, this chapter can touch on the staff. No leader can spend their time more wisely than in choosing the people who will get the job done. Even when the expedition is based on scientific goals, academic credentials take a backseat in selecting team members. Fiala, drawing from his Arctic experience, rightly states, "Many a guy who is great in comfortable surroundings can become impatient, selfish, and mean when he has to sacrifice his comfort, control his desires, and work hard in what feels like a losing battle. The top priority in choosing people for a polar expedition should be their moral character. Following that should be their mental and physical abilities."

For polar work the great desideratum is tempered youth. Although one man at the age of fifty may be as strong physically as another at the age of twenty, it is certain that the exceptional man of fifty was also an exceptional man at twenty. On the average, after about thirty years of age, the elasticity of the body to rise to the strain of emergency diminishes, and, when forty years is reached, a man, medically speaking, reaches his acme. After that, degeneration of the fabric of the body slowly and maybe imperceptibly sets in. As the difficulties of exploration in cold regions approximate to the limit of human endurance and often enough exceed it, it is obvious that the above generalizations must receive due weight.

For polar work, the key requirement is youthful energy. While one man at fifty may be just as physically strong as another at twenty, it’s clear that an exceptional fifty-year-old was also exceptional at twenty. On average, after around thirty, the body’s ability to handle emergencies starts to decline, and by the time a man reaches forty, he hits his peak, health-wise. After that, the body's deterioration begins, often slowly and subtly. Given that the challenges of exploring cold regions push human endurance to its limits—and often beyond—it's important to take these general observations seriously.

But though age and with it the whole question of physical fitness must ever receive primary regard, yet these alone in no wise fit a man for such an undertaking. The qualifications of mental ability, acquaintance with the work and sound moral quality have to be essentially borne in mind. The man of fifty might then be placed on a higher plane than his younger companion.

But even though age and the whole idea of physical fitness should always be a top priority, they alone don't prepare a person for such a task. Qualities like mental ability, familiarity with the work, and strong moral character must also be considered. Therefore, a fifty-year-old might actually be better suited than a younger colleague.

With regard to alcohol and tobacco, it may be maintained on theoretical grounds that a man is better without them, but, on the other hand, his behaviour in respect to such habits is often an index to his self-control.

When it comes to alcohol and tobacco, it can be argued that a person is better off without them, but on the flip side, their behavior regarding these habits often reflects their self-control.

Perfection is attained when every man individually works with the determination to sacrifice all personal predispositions to the welfare of the whole.

Perfection is reached when each person is committed to setting aside their personal biases for the benefit of everyone.

Ours proved to be a very happy selection. The majority of the men chosen as members of the land parties were young graduates of the Commonwealth and New Zealand Universities, and almost all were representative of Australasia. Among the exceptions was Mr. Frank Wild, who was appointed leader of one of the Antarctic parties. Wild had distinguished himself in the South on two previous occasions, and now is in the unique position of being, as it were, the oldest resident of Antarctica. Our sojourn together at Cape Royds with Shackleton had acquainted me with Wild's high merits as an explorer and leader.

Our selection turned out to be a very happy one. Most of the men chosen for the land parties were young graduates from universities in the Commonwealth and New Zealand, and almost all represented Australasia. One exception was Mr. Frank Wild, who was appointed leader of one of the Antarctic parties. Wild had distinguished himself in the South on two previous occasions, and now he is in the unique position of being, in a way, the longest-standing resident of Antarctica. My time at Cape Royds with Shackleton had made me aware of Wild's exceptional qualities as an explorer and leader.

Lieutenant B. E. S. Ninnis of the Royal Fusiliers, Dr. X. Mertz, an expert ski-runner and mountaineer, and Mr. F. H. Bickerton in charge of the air-tractor sledge, were appointed in London. Reference has already been made to Captain Davis: to him were left all arrangements regarding the ship's complement.

Lieutenant B. E. S. Ninnis of the Royal Fusiliers, Dr. X. Mertz, a skilled ski-runner and mountaineer, and Mr. F. H. Bickerton, who oversaw the air-tractor sledge, were appointed in London. Captain Davis has been mentioned before: he was responsible for all arrangements concerning the ship's crew.

A "Who's who" of the staff appears as an appendix.

A "Who's Who" of the staff is included as an appendix.





CHAPTER II THE LAST DAYS AT HOBART AND THE VOYAGE TO MACQUARIE ISLAND

    "Let us probe the silent places, let us seek what luck betide us;
      Let us journey to a lonely land I know.
      There's a whisper on the night-wind, there's a star agleam to
      guide us.
      And the Wild is calling, calling—Let us go."—SERVICE.
    "Let’s explore the quiet spots, let’s see what luck comes our way;  
      Let’s travel to a secluded place I know.  
      There’s a whisper in the night air, there’s a star shining  
      to guide us.  
      And the Wild is calling, calling—Let’s go."—SERVICE.

It will be convenient to pick up the thread of our story upon the point of the arrival of the 'Aurora' in Hobart, after her long voyage from London during the latter part of the year 1911.

It will be convenient to continue our story from the moment the 'Aurora' arrived in Hobart after her long journey from London during late 1911.

Captain Davis had written from Cape Town stating that he expected to reach Hobart on November 4. In company with Mr. C. C. Eitel, secretary of the Expedition, I proceeded to Hobart, arriving on November 2.

Captain Davis wrote from Cape Town saying he expected to arrive in Hobart on November 4. Accompanied by Mr. C. C. Eitel, the secretary of the Expedition, I headed to Hobart, arriving on November 2.

Early in the morning of November 4 the Harbour Board received news that a wooden vessel, barquentine-rigged, with a crow's-nest on the mainmast, was steaming up the D'Entrecasteaux Channel. This left no doubt as to her identity and so, later in the day, we joined Mr. Martelli, the assistant harbour-master, and proceeded down the river, meeting the 'Aurora' below the quarantine ground.

Early in the morning on November 4, the Harbour Board got word that a wooden ship, rigged as a barquentine and featuring a crow's nest on the mainmast, was making its way up the D'Entrecasteaux Channel. This made her identity clear, so later that day, we met up with Mr. Martelli, the assistant harbour-master, and headed down the river, encountering the 'Aurora' below the quarantine area.

We heard that they had had a very rough passage after leaving the Cape. This was expected, for several liners, travelling by the same route, and arriving in Australian waters a few days before, had reported exceptionally heavy weather.

We heard that they had a really rough trip after leaving the Cape. This was expected, since several liners traveling the same route and arriving in Australian waters a few days earlier had reported extremely heavy weather.

Before the ship had reached Queen's Wharf, the berth generously provided by the Harbour Board, the Greenland dogs were transferred to the quarantine ground, and with them went Dr. Mertz and Lieutenant Ninnis, who gave up all their time during the stay in Hobart to the care of those important animals. A feeling of relief spread over the whole ship's company as the last dog passed over the side, for travelling with a deck cargo of dogs is not the most enviable thing from a sailor's point of view. Especially is this the case in a sailing-vessel where room is limited, and consequently dogs and ropes are mixed indiscriminately.

Before the ship reached Queen's Wharf, which the Harbour Board generously provided, the Greenland dogs were moved to the quarantine area. With them went Dr. Mertz and Lieutenant Ninnis, who dedicated all their time during the stay in Hobart to caring for those important animals. A sense of relief washed over the entire crew as the last dog was brought on board, since traveling with a deck full of dogs isn’t exactly ideal from a sailor’s perspective. This is especially true on a sailing vessel where space is tight, leading to a messy mix of dogs and ropes.

Evening was just coming on when we reached the wharf, and, as we ranged alongside, the Premier, Sir Elliot Lewis, came on board and bade us welcome to Tasmania.

Evening was just setting in when we arrived at the wharf, and as we pulled alongside, the Premier, Sir Elliot Lewis, came on board and welcomed us to Tasmania.

Captain Davis had much to tell, for more than four months had elapsed since my departure from London, when he had been left in charge of the ship and of the final arrangements.

Captain Davis had a lot to share, as more than four months had passed since I left London, leaving him in charge of the ship and the final plans.

At the docks there had been delays and difficulties in the execution of the necessary alterations to the ship, in consequence of strikes and the Coronation festivities. It was so urgent to reach Australia in time for the ensuing Antarctic summer, that the recaulking of the decks and other improvements were postponed, to be executed on the voyage or upon arrival in Australia.

At the docks, there were delays and challenges in making the needed changes to the ship because of strikes and the Coronation celebrations. It was so important to get to Australia in time for the upcoming Antarctic summer that the recaulking of the decks and other upgrades were postponed to be done during the voyage or after arriving in Australia.

Captain Davis seized the earliest possible opportunity of departure, and the 'Aurora' dropped down the Thames at midnight on July 27, 1911. As she threaded her way through the crowded traffic by the dim light of a thousand flickering flames gleaming through the foggy atmosphere, the dogs entered a protest peculiar to their "husky" kind. After a short preliminary excursion through a considerable range of the scale, they picked up a note apparently suitable to all and settled down to many hours of incessant and monotonous howling, as is the custom of these dogs when the fit takes them. It was quite evident that they were not looking forward to another sea voyage. The pandemonium made it all but impossible to hear the orders given for working the ship, and a collision was narrowly averted. During those rare lulls, when the dogs' repertoire temporarily gave out, innumerable sailors on neighbouring craft, wakened from their sleep, made the most of such opportunities to hurl imprecations in a thoroughly nautical fashion upon the ship, her officers, and each and every one of the crew.

Captain Davis took the earliest chance to leave, and the 'Aurora' set off down the Thames at midnight on July 27, 1911. As she navigated through the crowded traffic under the faint glow of a thousand flickering lights shining through the foggy air, the dogs voiced their discontent in a way that's typical for their "husky" breed. After a brief warm-up through various pitches, they found a note that seemed to suit everyone and settled in for hours of nonstop and monotonous howling, as these dogs do when the mood strikes them. It was clear they weren’t looking forward to another sea trip. The chaos made it nearly impossible to hear the commands for operating the ship, and a collision was barely avoided. During the rare moments of quiet when the dogs’ howling paused, countless sailors on nearby vessels, awakened from their slumber, took advantage of the silence to shout curses in a very seafaring manner at the ship, her officers, and every member of the crew.

On the way to Cardiff, where a full supply of coal was to be shipped, a gale was encountered, and much water came on board, resulting in damage to the stores. Some water leaked into the living quarters and, on the whole, several very uncomfortable days were spent. Such inconvenience at the outset undoubtedly did good, for many of the crew, evidently not prepared for emergency conditions, left at Cardiff. The scratch crew with which the 'Aurora'journeyed to Hobart composed for the most part of replacements made at Cardiff, resulted in some permanent appointments of unexpected value to the Expedition.

On the way to Cardiff, where a full load of coal was supposed to be shipped, we ran into a strong gale that brought a lot of water on board, causing damage to the supplies. Some water leaked into the living quarters, and overall, we spent several very uncomfortable days. This inconvenience at the beginning actually turned out to be beneficial, as many crew members, clearly unprepared for emergency situations, left when we reached Cardiff. The temporary crew that the 'Aurora' took to Hobart was mostly made up of replacements from Cardiff, which ultimately led to some worthwhile permanent appointments for the Expedition.

At Cardiff the coal strike caused delay, but eventually some five hundred tons of the Crown Fuel Company's briquettes were got on board, and a final leave taken of English shores on August 4.

At Cardiff, the coal strike caused a delay, but eventually about five hundred tons of the Crown Fuel Company's briquettes were loaded onto the ship, and a final goodbye was said to English shores on August 4.

Cape Town, the only intermediate port of call, was reached on September 24, after a comparatively rapid and uneventful voyage. A couple of days sufficed to load coal, water and fresh provisions, and the course was then laid for Hobart.

Cape Town, the only stop on the route, was reached on September 24, after a fairly quick and uneventful journey. A couple of days were enough to load coal, water, and fresh supplies, and then the destination was set for Hobart.

Rough weather soon intervened, and Lieutenant Ninnis and Dr. Mertz, who travelled out by the 'Aurora' in charge of the sledging-dogs, had their time fully occupied, for the wet conditions began to tell on their charges.

Rough weather soon came in, and Lieutenant Ninnis and Dr. Mertz, who traveled out on the 'Aurora' in charge of the sled dogs, had their hands full, as the wet conditions started to affect their animals.

On leaving London there were forty-nine of these Greenland, Esquimaux sledging-dogs of which the purchase and selection had been made through the offices of the Danish Geographical Society. From Greenland they were taken to Copenhagen, and from thence transhipped to London, where Messrs. Spratt took charge of them at their dog-farm until the date of departure. During the voyage they were fed on the finest dog-cakes, but they undoubtedly felt the need of fresh meat and fish to withstand the cold and wet. In the rough weather of the latter part of the voyage water broke continually over the deck, so lowering their vitality that a number died from seizures, not properly understood at the time. In each case death was sudden, and preceded by similar symptoms. An apparently healthy dog would drop down in a fit, dying in a few minutes, or during another fit within a few days. Epidemics, accompanied by similar symptoms, are said to be common amongst these dogs in the Arctic regions, but no explanation is given as to the nature of the disease. During a later stage of the Expedition, when nearing Antarctica, several more of the dogs were similarly stricken. These were examined by Drs. McLean and Jones, and the results of post-mortems showed that in one case death was due to gangrenous appendicitis, in two others to acute gastritis and colitis.

On leaving London, there were forty-nine Greenland Eskimo sled dogs, which were purchased and selected through the Danish Geographical Society. They were brought from Greenland to Copenhagen, and then shipped to London, where Messrs. Spratt took care of them at their dog farm until the departure date. During the journey, they were fed the best dog biscuits, but they definitely needed fresh meat and fish to cope with the cold and wet conditions. In the rough weather towards the end of the voyage, water continuously splashed over the deck, lowering their vitality, resulting in several dogs dying from seizures that weren't well understood at the time. In every case, death was sudden and preceded by similar symptoms. A seemingly healthy dog would suddenly collapse in a fit, dying within a few minutes or during another fit a few days later. Epidemics with similar symptoms are said to be common among these dogs in Arctic regions, but no explanations are provided regarding the nature of the disease. Later in the Expedition, when approaching Antarctica, several more dogs were similarly affected. These were examined by Drs. McLean and Jones, and the results of the autopsies indicated that in one case, death was due to gangrenous appendicitis, while in two others, it resulted from acute gastritis and colitis.

The dog first affected caused some consternation amongst the crew, for, after being prostrated on the deck by a fit, it rose and rushed about snapping to right and left. The cry of "mad dog" was raised. Not many seconds had elapsed before all the deck hands were safely in the rigging, displaying more than ordinary agility in the act. At short intervals, other men, roused from watch below appeared at the fo'c'sle companion-way. To these the situation at first appeared comic, and called forth jeers upon their faint-hearted shipmates. The next moment, on the dog dashing into view, they found a common cause with their fellows and sprang aloft. Ere many minutes had elapsed the entire crew were in the rigging, much to the amusement of the officers. By this time the dog had disappeared beneath the fo'c'sle head, and Mertz and Ninnis entered, intending to dispatch it. A shot was fired and word passed that the deed was done: thereupon the crew descended, pressing forward to share in the laurels. Then it was that Ninnis, in the uncertain light, spying a dog of similar markings wedged in between some barrels, was filled with doubt and called out to Mertz that he had shot the wrong dog. In a flash the crew had once more climbed to safety. It was some time after the confirmation of the first execution that they could be prevailed upon to descend.

The dog’s sudden behavior caused a bit of panic among the crew. After collapsing on the deck from a fit, it got up and started running around, snapping at everything. Someone yelled “mad dog!” In just a few seconds, all the deck hands had climbed into the rigging, showing an impressive level of agility as they did so. At short intervals, other men, woken from their watch below, appeared at the fo'c'sle companion-way. To them, the situation seemed funny at first, leading them to mock their scared shipmates. However, when the dog suddenly appeared, they joined their fellows and quickly scrambled up into the rigging. Before long, the entire crew was up there, much to the amusement of the officers. By this point, the dog had disappeared beneath the fo'c'sle head, and Mertz and Ninnis went in to finish it off. A shot was fired and word spread that the job was done, prompting the crew to come down and claim their glory. But then Ninnis, with the light being dim, spotted another dog with similar markings wedged between some barrels and became anxious, calling out to Mertz that he might have shot the wrong dog. In an instant, the crew scrambled back up to safety. It took a while after confirming the first dog was indeed dead before they felt safe enough to come down again.

Several litters of puppies were born on the voyage, but all except one succumbed to the hardships of the passage.

Several litters of puppies were born during the journey, but all except one didn't survive the challenges of the trip.

The voyage from Cardiff to Hobart occupied eighty-eight days.

The journey from Cardiff to Hobart took eighty-eight days.

The date of departure south was fixed for 4 P.M. of Saturday, December 2, and a truly appalling amount of work had to be done before then.

The departure date for the south was set for 4 P.M. on Saturday, December 2, and there was an overwhelming amount of work to do before then.

Most of the staff had been preparing themselves for special duties; in this the Expedition was assisted by many friends.

Most of the staff had been getting ready for special tasks; in this, the Expedition received help from many friends.

A complete, detailed acknowledgment of all the kind help received would occupy much space. We must needs pass on with the assurance that our best thanks are extended to one and all.

A full, detailed acknowledgment of all the generous help we received would take up a lot of space. We must move on with the confidence that our heartfelt thanks go out to everyone.

Throughout the month of November, the staff continued to arrive in contingents at Hobart, immediately busying themselves in their own departments, and in sorting over the many thousands of packages in the great Queen's Wharf shed. Wild was placed in charge, and all entered heartily into the work. The exertion of it was just what was wanted to make us fit, and prepared for the sudden and arduous work of discharging cargo at the various bases. It also gave the opportunity of personally gauging certain qualities of the men, which are not usually evoked by a university curriculum.

Throughout November, the staff kept arriving in groups at Hobart, quickly getting to work in their respective departments and sorting through the thousands of packages in the large Queen's Wharf shed. Wild was put in charge, and everyone enthusiastically joined in on the tasks. The hard work was exactly what we needed to get fit and ready for the sudden and challenging job of unloading cargo at the various bases. It also allowed us to personally assess certain qualities in the men that you usually don't see in a university setting.

Some five thousand two hundred packages were in the shed, to be sorted over and checked. The requirements of three Antarctic bases, and one at Macquarie Island were being provided for, and consequently the most careful supervision was necessary to prevent mistakes, especially as the omission of a single article might fundamentally affect the work of a whole party. To assist in discriminating the impedimenta, coloured bands were painted round the packages, distinctive of the various bases.

Some five thousand two hundred packages were in the shed, ready to be sorted and checked. The needs of three Antarctic bases and one at Macquarie Island were being met, so careful supervision was essential to avoid mistakes, especially since missing even a single item could significantly impact the work of an entire team. To help differentiate the supplies, colored bands were painted around the packages, each representing the various bases.

It had been arranged that, wherever possible, everything should be packed in cases of a handy size, to facilitate unloading and transportation; each about fifty to seventy pounds in weight.

It was organized so that, whenever possible, everything would be packed in conveniently sized cases to make unloading and transporting easier; each weighing about fifty to seventy pounds.

In addition to other distinguishing marks, every package bore a different number, and the detailed contents were listed in a schedule for reference.

In addition to other distinguishing marks, every package had a different number, and the detailed contents were listed in a schedule for reference.

Concurrently with the progress of this work, the ship was again overhauled, repairs effected, and many deficiencies made good. The labours of the shipwrights did not interfere with the loading, which went ahead steadily during the last fortnight in November.

Concurrently with the progress of this work, the ship was once again overhauled, repairs were made, and many deficiencies were fixed. The efforts of the shipwrights didn't disrupt the loading, which continued smoothly throughout the last two weeks of November.

The tanks in the hold not used for our supply of fresh water were packed with reserve stores for the ship. The remainder of the lower hold and the bunkers were filled with coal. Slowly the contents of the shed diminished as they were transfered to the 'tween decks. Then came the overflow. Eventually, every available space in the ship was flooded with a complicated assemblage of gear, ranging from the comparatively undamageable wireless masts occupying a portion of the deck amidships, to a selection of prime Australian cheeses which filled one of the cabins, and pervaded the ward-room with an odour which remained one of its permanent associations.

The tanks in the hold that weren’t being used for our fresh water supply were filled with extra supplies for the ship. The rest of the lower hold and the bunkers were packed with coal. Gradually, the contents of the shed went down as they were moved to the 'tween decks. Then came the overflow. Eventually, every available space on the ship was crammed with a mix of gear, ranging from the relatively indestructible wireless masts taking up part of the deck in the middle, to a variety of top-quality Australian cheeses filling one of the cabins, which filled the wardroom with a smell that became one of its lasting features.

Yet, heterogeneous and ill-assorted as our cargo may have appeared to the crowds of curious onlookers, Captain Davis had arranged for the stowage of everything with a nicety which did him credit. The complete effects of the four bases were thus kept separate, and available in whatever order was required. Furthermore, the removal of one unit would not break the stowage of the remainder, nor disturb the trim of the ship.

Yet, even though our cargo seemed mismatched and chaotic to the curious onlookers, Captain Davis had meticulously arranged everything for storage, which was impressive. The complete belongings of the four bases were kept separate and accessible in any order needed. Additionally, taking out one unit wouldn't disrupt the storage of the others or affect the balance of the ship.

At a late date the air-tractor sledge arrived. The body was contained in one huge case which, though awkward, was comparatively light, the case weighing much more than the contents. This was securely lashed above the maindeck, resting on the fo'c'sle and two boat-skids.

At a later time, the air-tractor sledge showed up. The body was packed in one large case that, while bulky, was relatively lightweight; the case itself weighed significantly more than what it held. This was safely tied down on the main deck, resting on the forecastle and two boat skids.

As erroneous ideas have been circulated regarding the "aeroplane sledge," or more correctly "air-tractor sledge," a few words in explanation will not be out of place.

As incorrect ideas have been spread about the "aeroplane sledge," or more accurately "air-tractor sledge," a brief clarification seems necessary.

This machine was originally an R.E.P. monoplane, constructed by Messrs. Vickers and Co., but supplied with a special detachable, sledge-runner undercarriage for use in the Antarctic, converting it into a tractor for hauling sledges. It was intended that so far as its role as a flier was concerned, it would be chiefly exercised for the purpose of drawing public attention to the Expedition in Australia, where aviation was then almost unknown. With this object in view, it arrived in Adelaide at an early date accompanied by the aviator, Lieutenant Watkins, assisted by Bickerton. There it unfortunately came to grief, and Watkins and Wild narrowly escaped death in the accident. It was then decided to make no attempt to fly in the Antarctic; the wings were left in Australia and Lieutenant Watkins returned to England. In the meantime, the machine was repaired and forwarded to Hobart.

This aircraft was originally an R.E.P. monoplane, built by Vickers and Co., but it was fitted with a special detachable sledge-runner undercarriage to be used in Antarctica, turning it into a tractor for pulling sledges. It was meant to mainly serve as a way to draw public interest in the Expedition in Australia, where aviation was pretty much unknown at the time. With this goal in mind, it arrived in Adelaide early on, accompanied by the pilot, Lieutenant Watkins, along with Bickerton assisting him. Unfortunately, it had an accident there, and both Watkins and Wild narrowly escaped death. It was then decided to forgo any flying in Antarctica; the wings were left in Australia and Lieutenant Watkins went back to England. In the meantime, the aircraft was repaired and sent to Hobart.

Air-tractors are great consumers of petrol of the highest quality. This demand, in addition to the requirements of two wireless plants and a motor-launch, made it necessary to take larger quantities than we liked of this dangerous cargo. Four thousand gallons of "Shell" benzine and one thousand three hundred gallons of "Shell" kerosene, packed in the usual four-gallon export tins, were carried as a deck cargo, monopolizing the whole of the poop-deck.

Air tractors are big consumers of high-quality gasoline. This demand, along with the needs of two radio stations and a motorboat, forced us to take on more of this hazardous cargo than we would have preferred. Four thousand gallons of "Shell" gasoline and one thousand three hundred gallons of "Shell" kerosene, stored in the regular four-gallon export cans, were loaded as deck cargo, taking up the entire poop deck.

For the transport of the requirements of the Macquarie Island Base, the s.s. 'Toroa', a small steam-packet of one hundred and twenty tons, trading between Melbourne and Tasmanian ports, was chartered. It was arranged that this auxiliary should leave Hobart several days after the 'Aurora', so as to allow us time, before her arrival, to inspect the island, and to select a suitable spot for the location of the base. As she was well provided with passenger accommodation, it was arranged that the majority of the land party should journey by her as far as Macquarie Island.

For transporting the supplies needed for the Macquarie Island Base, the s.s. 'Toroa', a small steam-packet weighing one hundred and twenty tons and operating between Melbourne and Tasmanian ports, was hired. It was planned for this ship to leave Hobart a few days after the 'Aurora', giving us time to explore the island and choose a good location for the base before she arrived. Since it had plenty of passenger accommodations, most of the land party would travel on it to Macquarie Island.

The Governor of Tasmania, Sir Harry Barron, the Premier, Sir Elliot Lewis, and the citizens of Hobart extended to us the greatest hospitality during our stay, and, when the time came, gave us a hearty send-off.

The Governor of Tasmania, Sir Harry Barron, the Premier, Sir Elliot Lewis, and the people of Hobart welcomed us with amazing hospitality during our visit, and when it was time to leave, they gave us a warm send-off.

Saturday, December 2 arrived, and final preparations were made. All the staff were united for the space of an hour at luncheon. Then began the final leave-taking. "God speed" messages were received from far and wide, and intercessory services were held in the Cathedrals of Sydney and Hobart.

Saturday, December 2nd arrived, and final preparations were made. All the staff came together for an hour at lunch. Then the final goodbyes began. "Safe travels" messages were received from near and far, and prayer services were held in the Cathedrals of Sydney and Hobart.

We were greatly honoured at this time by the reception of kind wishes from Queen Alexandra and, at an earlier date, from his Majesty the King.

We were greatly honored at this time by the warm wishes from Queen Alexandra and, earlier, from His Majesty the King.

Proud of such universal sympathy and interest, we felt stimulated to greater exertions.

Proud of such widespread support and interest, we felt motivated to put in even more effort.

On arrival on board, I found Mr. Martelli, who was to pilot us down the river, already on the bridge. A vast crowd blockaded the wharf to give us a parting cheer.

On arriving on board, I found Mr. Martelli, who was going to guide us down the river, already on the bridge. A huge crowd gathered at the wharf to give us a farewell cheer.

At 4 P.M. sharp, the telegraph was rung for the engines, and, with a final expression of good wishes from the Governor and Lady Barron, we glided out into the channel, where our supply of dynamite and cartridges was taken on board. Captain G. S. Nares, whose kindness we had previously known, had the H.M.S. 'Fantome' dressed in our honour, and lusty cheering reached us from across the water.

At 4 P.M. on the dot, the telegraph signaled for the engines, and with one last round of good wishes from the Governor and Lady Barron, we smoothly moved out into the channel, where our load of dynamite and cartridges was brought on board. Captain G. S. Nares, whose generosity we were already familiar with, had the H.M.S. 'Fantome' decorated in our honor, and loud cheers came from across the water.

As we proceeded down the river to the Quarantine Station where the dogs were to be taken off, Hobart looked its best, with the glancing sails of pleasure craft skimming near the foreshores, and backed by the stately, sombre mass of Mount Wellington. The "land of strawberries and cream", as the younger members of the Expedition had come to regard it, was for ever to live pleasantly in our memories, to be recalled a thousand times during the adventurous months which followed. Mr. E. Joyce, whose name is familiar in connexion with previous Antarctic expeditions, and who had travelled out from London on business of the Expedition, was waiting in mid-stream with thirty-eight dogs, delivering them from a ketch. These were passed over the side and secured at intervals on top of the deck cargo.

As we made our way down the river to the Quarantine Station where the dogs were set to be taken off, Hobart looked stunning, with the sails of pleasure boats gliding near the shore, framed by the impressive, shadowy bulk of Mount Wellington. The “land of strawberries and cream,” as the younger members of the Expedition had come to see it, would forever remain a pleasant memory for us, recalled countless times during the adventurous months that followed. Mr. E. Joyce, a name well-known in relation to previous Antarctic expeditions, and who had traveled from London for Expedition business, was waiting in the middle of the river with thirty-eight dogs, unloading them from a ketch. These were passed over the side and secured at intervals on top of the deck cargo.

The engines again began to throb, not to cease until the arrival at Macquarie Island. A few miles lower down the channel, the Premier, and a number of other friends and well-wishers who had followed in a small steamer, bade us a final adieu.

The engines started thumping again, and wouldn’t stop until we arrived at Macquarie Island. A few miles further down the channel, the Premier and several other friends and supporters who had followed in a small steamer said their final farewells.

Behind lay a sparkling seascape and the Tasmanian littoral; before, the blue southern ocean heaving with an ominous swell. A glance at the barograph showed a continuous fall, and a telegram from Mr. Hunt, Head of the Commonwealth Weather Bureau, received a few hours previously, informed us of a storm-centre south of New Zealand, and the expectation of fresh south-westerly winds.

Behind us was a sparkling coastline and the Tasmanian shore; ahead, the blue southern ocean swelled ominously. A quick look at the barometer showed a steady drop, and a telegram from Mr. Hunt, Head of the Commonwealth Weather Bureau, received a few hours earlier, warned us about a storm system south of New Zealand and the forecast of strong south-west winds.

The piles of loose gear presented an indescribable scene of chaos, and, even as we rolled lazily in the increasing swell, the water commenced to run about the decks. There was no time to be lost in securing movable articles and preparing the ship for heavy weather. All hands set to work.

The heaps of scattered gear created a chaotic scene, and even as we drifted lazily in the growing swell, the water started to flow across the decks. There was no time to waste in securing loose items and getting the ship ready for bad weather. Everyone got to work.

On the main deck the cargo was brought up flush with the top of the bulwarks, and consisted of the wireless masts, two huts, a large motor-launch, cases of dog biscuits and many other sundries. Butter to the extent of a couple of tons was accommodated chiefly on the roof of the main deck-house, where it was out of the way of the dogs. The roof of the chart-house, which formed an extension of the bridge proper, did not escape, for the railing offered facilities for lashing sledges; besides, there was room for tide-gauges, meteorological screens, and cases of fresh eggs and apples. Somebody happened to think of space unoccupied in the meteorological screens, and a few fowls were housed therein.

On the main deck, the cargo was stacked up to the top of the bulwarks and included the wireless masts, two huts, a large motor launch, cases of dog biscuits, and various other items. A couple of tons of butter was mainly stored on the roof of the main deckhouse, keeping it out of the dogs’ reach. The roof of the chart house, which extended from the main bridge, wasn’t overlooked either, as the railing allowed for securing sledges. Additionally, there was space for tide gauges, weather screens, and boxes of fresh eggs and apples. Someone also thought to use the unused space in the weather screens to keep a few chickens.

On the poop-deck there were the benzine, sledges, and the chief magnetic observatory. An agglomeration of instruments and private gear rendered the ward-room well nigh impossible of access, and it was some days before everything was jammed away into corners. An unoccupied five-berth cabin was filled with loose instruments, while other packages were stowed into the occupied cabins, so as to almost defeat the purpose for which they were intended.

On the poop deck, there were the gasoline, sleds, and the main magnetic observatory. A jumble of instruments and personal gear made the wardroom nearly impossible to get into, and it took several days to get everything crammed into corners. An empty five-berth cabin was packed with loose instruments, while other packages were stuffed into occupied cabins, nearly undermining their intended use.

The deck was so encumbered that only at rare intervals was it visible. However, by our united efforts everything was well secured by 8 P.M.

The deck was so cluttered that it was only visible at rare moments. However, thanks to our combined efforts, everything was secured by 8 PM.

It was dusk, and the distant highlands were limned in silhouette against the twilight sky. A tiny, sparkling lamp glimmered from Signal Hill its warm farewell. From the swaying poop we flashed back, "Good-bye, all snug on board."

It was dusk, and the distant highlands were outlined in silhouette against the twilight sky. A small, sparkling lamp shone from Signal Hill, giving its warm farewell. From the swaying deck, we called back, "Goodbye, everyone cozy on board."

Onward with a dogged plunge our laden ship would press. If 'Fram' were "Forward," she was to be hereafter our 'Aurora' of "Hope"—the Dawn of undiscovered lands.

Onward with a determined push, our heavy ship would move forward. If 'Fram' meant "Forward," she was going to be our 'Aurora' of "Hope"—the Dawn of unexplored lands.

Home and the past were effaced in the shroud of darkness, and thought leapt to the beckoning South—the "land of the midnight sun."

Home and the past faded away in the darkness, and my mind jumped to the inviting South—the "land of the midnight sun."

During the night the wind and sea rose steadily, developing into a full gale. In order to make Macquarie Island, it was important not to allow the ship to drive too far to the east, as at all times the prevailing winds in this region are from the west. Partly on this account, and partly because of the extreme severity of the gale, the ship was hove to with head to wind, wallowing in mountainous seas. Such a storm, witnessed from a large vessel, would be an inspiring sight, but was doubly so in a small craft, especially where the natural buoyancy had been largely impaired by overloading. With an unprecedented quantity of deck cargo, amongst which were six thousand gallons of benzine, kerosene and spirit, in tins which were none too strong, we might well have been excused a lively anxiety during those days. It seemed as if no power on earth could save the loss of at least part of the deck cargo. Would it be the indispensable huts amidships, or would a sea break on the benzine aft and flood us with inflammable liquid and gas?

During the night, the wind and sea picked up steadily, turning into a full-blown gale. To reach Macquarie Island, it was crucial not to let the ship drift too far to the east, since the prevailing winds in this area always blow from the west. Because of this and the extreme intensity of the gale, the ship was held head-to-wind, struggling in massive waves. Witnessing such a storm from a large vessel would be awe-inspiring, but it was even more so in a small boat, especially since its natural buoyancy was severely compromised by being overloaded. With an unusual amount of deck cargo, which included six thousand gallons of benzine, kerosene, and spirits in tins that weren’t particularly strong, we certainly had every reason to feel anxious during those days. It seemed like nothing could prevent at least some of the deck cargo from being lost. Would it be the essential huts in the middle, or would a wave crash on the benzine at the back and inundate us with flammable liquid and gas?

By dint of strenuous efforts and good seamanship, Captain Davis with his officers and crew held their own. The land parties assisted in the general work, constantly tightening up the lashings and lending "beef," a sailor's term for man-power, wherever required. For this purpose the members of the land parties were divided into watches, so that there were always a number patrolling the decks.

Through hard work and skilled navigation, Captain Davis with his officers and crew managed to maintain their position. The land teams helped with the overall tasks, continuously tightening the ropes and providing "beef," a sailor's term for manpower, wherever it was needed. To facilitate this, the land teams were divided into shifts, ensuring that there were always a few people on deck.

Most of us passed through a stage of sea-sickness, but, except in the case of two or three, it soon passed off. Seas deluged all parts of the ship. A quantity of ashes was carried down into the bilge-water pump and obstructed the steam-pump. Whilst this was being cleared, the emergency deck pumps had to be requisitioned. The latter were available for working either by hand-power or by chain-gearing from the after-winch.

Most of us went through a phase of seasickness, but, apart from a couple of people, it quickly went away. Water flooded all areas of the ship. A lot of ash got into the bilge water pump and blocked the steam pump. While this was being cleaned out, we had to use the emergency deck pumps. These were able to work either manually or through chain gears from the aft winch.

The deck-plug of one of the fresh-water tanks was carried away and, before it was noticed, sea-water had entered to such an extent as to render our supply unfit for drinking. Thus we were, henceforth, on a strictly limited water ration.

The plug for one of the fresh-water tanks was lost, and before anyone noticed, sea-water got in so much that our supply became undrinkable. From that point on, we were on a strict water ration.

The wind increased from bad to worse, and great seas continued to rise until their culmination on the morning of December 5, when one came aboard on the starboard quarter, smashed half the bridge and carried it away. Toucher was the officer on watch, and no doubt thought himself lucky in being, at the time, on the other half of the bridge.

The wind picked up from bad to worse, and huge waves kept building until they peaked on the morning of December 5, when one crashed aboard on the starboard side, destroyed half the bridge, and swept it away. Toucher was the officer on watch and probably felt fortunate to be on the other half of the bridge at that moment.

The deck-rings holding the motor-launch drew, the launch itself was sprung and its decking stove-in.

The deck rings securing the motor launch pulled loose, and the launch itself was damaged with its decking caved in.

On the morning of December 8 we found ourselves in latitude 49 degrees 56 minutes S. and longitude 152 degrees 28' E., with the weather so far abated that we were able to steer a course for Macquarie Island.

On the morning of December 8, we found ourselves at latitude 49 degrees 56 minutes S and longitude 152 degrees 28' E, with the weather improved enough that we could set a course for Macquarie Island.

During the heavy weather, food had been prepared only with the greatest difficulty. The galley was deluged time and again. It was enough to dishearten any cook, repeatedly finding himself amongst kitchen debris of all kinds, including pots and pans full and empty. Nor did the difficulties end in the galley, for food which survived until its arrival on the table, though not allowed much time for further mishap, often ended in a disagreeable mass on the floor or, tossed by a lurch of more than usual suddenness, entered an adjoining cabin. From such localities the elusive piece de resistance was often rescued.

During the rough weather, food was prepared only with the greatest difficulty. The kitchen was flooded over and over again. It was enough to discourage any cook, repeatedly finding himself surrounded by kitchen scraps of all kinds, including full and empty pots and pans. The challenges didn’t stop in the kitchen, as food that made it to the table, even with little chance for mishaps, often ended up in a messy pile on the floor or, thrown by a sudden lurch, landed in a nearby cabin. From those places, the elusive main dish was often salvaged.

As we approached our rendezvous, whale-birds** appeared. During the heavy weather, Mother Carey's chickens only were seen, but, as the wind abated, the majestic wandering albatross, the sooty albatross and the mollymawk followed in our wake.

As we got closer to our meeting point, we saw some whale-birds. During the rough weather, we only spotted Mother Carey's chickens, but as the wind calmed down, the magnificent wandering albatross, the sooty albatross, and the mollymawk trailed behind us.

     ** For the specific names refer to Appendix which is a glossary of
special and unfamiliar terms.
** For the specific names, refer to the Appendix, which is a glossary of special and unfamiliar terms.

Whales were observed spouting, but at too great a distance to be definitely recognized.

Whales were seen spouting, but they were too far away to be clearly identified.

At daybreak on December 11 land began to show up, and by 6 A.M. we were some sixteen miles off the west coast of Macquarie Island, bearing on about the centre of its length.

At daybreak on December 11, land started to appear, and by 6 A.M., we were about sixteen miles off the west coast of Macquarie Island, aimed roughly at the center of its length.

In general shape it is long and narrow, the length over all being twenty-one miles. A reef runs out for several miles at both extremities of the main island, reappearing again some miles beyond in isolated rocky islets: the Bishop and Clerk nineteen miles to the southward and the Judge and Clerk eight miles to the north.

In general, it has a long and narrow shape, measuring a total of twenty-one miles in length. A reef extends for several miles at both ends of the main island, showing up again several miles further out as isolated rocky islets: the Bishop and Clerk are nineteen miles to the south and the Judge and Clerk are eight miles to the north.

The land everywhere rises abruptly from the sea or from an exaggerated beach to an undulating plateau-like interior, reaching a maximum elevation of one thousand four hundred and twenty-five feet. Nowhere is there a harbour in the proper sense of the word, though six or seven anchorages are recognized.

The land everywhere rises sharply from the sea or from an expansive beach to a rolling plateau-like interior, reaching a peak elevation of one thousand four hundred and twenty-five feet. There isn’t a proper harbor anywhere, although six or seven anchorages are acknowledged.

The island is situated in about 55 degrees S. latitude, and the climate is comparatively cold, but it is the prevalence of strong winds that is the least desirable feature of its weather.

The island is located at approximately 55 degrees S latitude, and the weather is relatively cold, but the most undesirable aspect of its climate is the frequent strong winds.

Sealing, so prosperous in the early days, is now carried on in a small way only, by a New Zealander, who keeps a few men stationed at the island during part of the year for the purpose of rendering down sea elephant and penguin blubber. Their establishment was known to be at the north end of the island near the best of the anchorages.

Sealing, which thrived in its early days, is now only done on a small scale by a New Zealander. He hires a few men to stay on the island for part of the year to process sea elephant and penguin blubber. Their operation is known to be located at the north end of the island, close to the best anchorage spots.

Captain Davis had visited the island in the 'Nimrod', and was acquainted with the three anchorages, which are all on the east side and sheltered from the prevailing westerlies. One of the old-time sealers had reported a cove suitable for small craft at the south-western corner, but the information was scanty, and recent mariners had avoided that side of the island. On the morning of our approach the breeze was from the south-east, and, being favourable, Captain Davis proposed a visit.

Captain Davis had been to the island on the 'Nimrod' and knew the three anchorages, all on the east side and protected from the prevailing westerlies. An old-time sealer had mentioned a cove suitable for small boats at the south-western corner, but the information was limited, and recent sailors had stayed away from that side of the island. On the morning we got closer, there was a breeze coming from the south-east, which was favorable, so Captain Davis suggested a visit.

By noon, Caroline Cove, as it is called, was abreast of us. Its small dimensions, and the fact that a rocky islet for the most part blocks the entrance, at first caused some misgivings as to its identity.

By noon, Caroline Cove, as it's called, was alongside us. Its small size, and the fact that a rocky islet mostly blocks the entrance, initially raised some doubts about its identity.

A boat was lowered, and a party of us rowed in towards the entrance, sounding at intervals to ascertain whether the 'Aurora' could make use of it, should our inspection prove it a suitable locality for the land station.

A boat was lowered, and several of us rowed toward the entrance, checking at intervals to see if the 'Aurora' could use it, if our inspection showed it to be a suitable spot for the land station.

We passed through a channel not more than eighty yards wide, but with deep water almost to the rocks on either side. A beautiful inlet now opened to view. Thick tussock-grass matted the steep hillsides, and the rocky shores, between the tide-marks as well as in the depths below, sprouted with a profuse growth of brown kelp. Leaping out of the water in scores around us were penguins of several varieties, in their actions reminding us of nothing so much as shoals of fish chased by sharks. Penguins were in thousands on the uprising cliffs, and from rookeries near and far came an incessant din. At intervals along the shore sea elephants disported their ungainly masses in the sunlight. Circling above us in anxious haste, sea-birds of many varieties gave warning of our near approach to their nests. It was the invasion by man of an exquisite scene of primitive nature.

We went through a channel that was no more than eighty yards wide, but the water was deep almost up to the rocks on either side. A stunning inlet came into view. Thick tussock grass covered the steep hillsides, and the rocky shores, from the high tide mark to the depths below, were filled with a dense growth of brown kelp. Penguins of various kinds jumped out of the water around us, reminding us of schools of fish being chased by sharks. Thousands of penguins were on the rising cliffs, and from rookeries near and far came a constant noise. Along the shore, sea elephants lounged awkwardly in the sunlight. Sea birds of many types circled overhead in a flurry, warning us of our close proximity to their nests. It was an invasion of a beautiful scene of untouched nature by humans.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Macquarie Island

Macquarie Island

After the severe weather experienced, the relaxation made us all feel like a band of schoolboys out on a long vacation.

After the rough weather we had, the relaxation made us all feel like a group of schoolboys enjoying a long break.

A small sandy beach barred the inlet, and the whaleboat was directed towards it. We were soon grating on the sand amidst an army of Royal penguins; picturesque little fellows, with a crest and eyebrows of long golden-yellow feathers. A few yards from the massed ranks of the penguins was a mottled sea-leopard, which woke up and slid into the sea as we approached.

A small sandy beach blocked the inlet, and the whaleboat was steered toward it. We quickly glided onto the sand among a bunch of Royal penguins; charming little guys with long, golden-yellow feathers for their crests and eyebrows. A few yards away from the crowd of penguins was a spotted sea-leopard, which woke up and slid into the ocean as we got closer.

Several hours were spent examining the neighbourhood. Webb and Kennedy took a set of magnetic observations, while others hoisted some cases of stores on to a rocky knob to form a provision depot, as it was quickly decided that the northern end of the island was likely to be more suitable for a permanent station.

Several hours were spent exploring the neighborhood. Webb and Kennedy took a set of magnetic readings, while others lifted some cases of supplies onto a rocky outcrop to create a storage depot, as it was quickly agreed that the northern part of the island was probably more suitable for a permanent station.

The Royal penguins were almost as petulant as the Adelie penguins which we were to meet further South. They surrounded us, pecked at our legs and chattered with an audacity which defies description. It was discovered that they resented any attempt to drive them into the sea, and it was only after long persuasion that a bevy took to the water. This was a sign of a general capitulation, and some hundreds immediately followed, jostling each other in their haste, squawking, whirring their flippers, splashing and churning the water, reminding one of a crowd of miniature surf-bathers. We followed the files of birds marching inland, along the course of a tumbling stream, until at an elevation of some five hundred feet, on a flattish piece of ground, a huge rookery opened out—acres and acres of birds and eggs.

The Royal penguins were almost as temperamental as the Adelie penguins we were about to meet further south. They surrounded us, pecked at our legs, and chatted with a boldness that’s hard to describe. We found out that they didn't like any attempt to push them into the sea, and it took a lot of convincing for a group to finally take to the water. This marked a sign of overall surrender, and hundreds quickly followed, bumping into each other in their rush, squawking, flapping their flippers, splashing, and stirring up the water, reminding us of a crowd of tiny beachgoers. We trailed behind the line of birds heading inland, along a rushing stream, until we reached a flat area at about five hundred feet high, where a massive rookery opened up—acres filled with birds and eggs.

In one corner of the bay were nests of giant petrels in which sat huge downy young, about the size of a barn-door fowl, resembling the grotesque, fluffy toys which might be expected to hang on a Christmas-tree.

In one corner of the bay were nests of giant petrels containing large downy chicks, about the size of a barn-door hen, looking like the quirky, fluffy toys that you might expect to see hanging on a Christmas tree.

Here and there on the beach and on the grass wandered bright-coloured Maori hens. On the south side of the bay, in a low, peaty area overgrown with tussock-grass, were scores of sea elephants, wallowing in bog-holes or sleeping at their ease.

Here and there on the beach and on the grass wandered brightly colored Maori hens. On the south side of the bay, in a low, damp area covered with tussock grass, there were numerous sea elephants lounging in muddy holes or resting comfortably.

Sea elephants, at one time found in immense numbers on all sub-antarctic islands, are now comparatively rare, even to the degree of extinction, in many of their old haunts. This is the result of ruthless slaughter prosecuted especially bY sealers in the early days. At the present time Macquarie Island is more favoured by them than probably any other known locality. The name by which they are popularly known refers to their elephantine proportions and to the fact that, in the case of the old males, the nasal regions are enormously developed, expanding when in a state of excitement to form a short, trunk-like appendage. They have been recorded up to twenty feet in length, and such a specimen would weigh about four tons.

Sea elephants, once found in huge numbers on all sub-Antarctic islands, are now relatively rare and even at risk of extinction in many of their former habitats. This decline is due to the brutal hunting carried out primarily by sealers in the early days. Currently, Macquarie Island is probably the most favored location for them. The name they are commonly known by comes from their large size and the fact that, especially in older males, their nasal areas are greatly developed, expanding in excitement to form a short, trunk-like extension. They have been reported to reach lengths of up to twenty feet, with such a specimen weighing around four tons.

Arriving on the 'Aurora' in the evening, we learnt that the ship's company had had an adventure which might have been most serious. It appeared that after dropping us at the entrance to Caroline Cove, the ship was allowed to drift out to sea under the influence of the off-shore wind. When about one-third of a mile north-west of the entrance, a violent shock was felt, and she slid over a rock which rose up out of deep water to within about fourteen feet of high-water level; no sign of it appearing on the surface on account of the tranquil state of the sea. Much apprehension was felt for the hull, but as no serious leak started, the escape was considered a fortunate one. A few soundings had been made proving a depth of four hundred fathoms within one and a half miles of the land.

Arriving on the 'Aurora' in the evening, we learned that the crew had faced a potentially serious adventure. It turned out that after dropping us off at the entrance to Caroline Cove, the ship was left to drift out to sea due to the offshore wind. When it was about a third of a mile northwest of the entrance, there was a violent jolt, and the ship slid over a rock that rose from deep water, coming within about fourteen feet of the high-water mark; it didn’t show on the surface because the sea was calm. There was a lot of concern for the hull, but since no serious leak developed, it was considered a lucky escape. A few depth readings were taken, showing a depth of four hundred fathoms within one and a half miles of the shore.

A course was now set for the northern end of the island. Dangerous-looking reefs ran out from many headlands, and cascades of water could be seen falling hundreds of feet from the highlands to the narrow coastal flats.

A course was now charted for the northern end of the island. Dangerous-looking reefs stretched out from many headlands, and waterfalls could be seen crashing down hundreds of feet from the highlands to the narrow coastal flats.

The anchorage most used is that known as North-East Bay, lying on the eastern side of a low spit joining the main mass of the island, to an almost isolated outpost in the form of a flat-topped hill—Wireless Hill—some three-quarters of a mile farther north. It is practically an open roadstead, but, as the prevailing winds blow on to the other side of the island, quiet water can be nearly always expected.

The most commonly used anchorage is the one called North-East Bay, located on the eastern side of a low spit that connects the main part of the island to a nearly isolated spot in the shape of a flat-topped hill—Wireless Hill—about three-quarters of a mile to the north. It’s basically an open roadstead, but since the prevailing winds blow to the opposite side of the island, calm waters can almost always be anticipated.

However, when we arrived at North-East Bay on the morning following our adventure; a stiff south-east breeze was blowing, and the wash on the beach put landing out of the question. Captain Davis ran in as near the coast as he could safely venture and dropped anchor, pending the moderation of the wind.

However, when we got to North-East Bay the morning after our adventure, a strong southeast breeze was blowing, and the waves on the beach made landing impossible. Captain Davis steered the boat as close to the shore as he could safely get and dropped anchor, waiting for the wind to calm down.

On the leeward slopes of a low ridge, pushing itself out on to the southern extremity of the spit, could be seen two small huts, but no sign of human life. This was not surprising as it was only seven o'clock. Below the huts, upon low surf-covered rocks running out from the beach, lay a small schooner partly broken up and evidently a recent victim. A mile to the southward, fragments of another wreck protruded from the sand.

On the sheltered side of a low ridge, extending onto the southern tip of the spit, there were two small huts, but no signs of people. This wasn’t surprising since it was only seven o'clock. Below the huts, on low rocks covered with surf jutting out from the beach, lay a small schooner that was mostly wrecked and clearly a recent casualty. A mile to the south, pieces of another shipwreck were sticking out of the sand.

We were discussing wrecks and the grisly toll which is levied by these dangerous and uncharted shores, when a human figure appeared in front of one of the huts. After surveying us for a moment, he disappeared within to reappear shortly afterwards, followed by a stream of others rushing hither and thither; just as if he had disturbed a hornets' nest. After such an exciting demonstration we awaited the next move with some expectancy.

We were talking about shipwrecks and the terrible cost that these dangerous and unknown shores take on people when a person appeared in front of one of the huts. After looking at us for a moment, he went inside, only to come back out shortly after, followed by a bunch of others running around in all directions, like he had stirred up a hornet's nest. After such an exciting display, we waited eagerly for what would happen next.

Planks and barrels were brought on to the beach and a flagstaff was hoisted. Then one of the party mounted on the barrel, and told us by flag signals that the ship on the beach was the 'Clyde', which had recently been wrecked, and that all hands were safely on shore, but requiring assistance. Besides the shipwrecked crew, there were half a dozen men who resided on the island during the summer months for the purpose of collecting blubber.

Planks and barrels were brought onto the beach, and a flagpole was put up. Then one of the group climbed onto a barrel and signaled to us with flags that the ship on the beach was the 'Clyde,' which had recently wrecked, and that everyone was safely on shore but needed help. In addition to the shipwrecked crew, there were also half a dozen men who lived on the island during the summer to collect blubber.

The sealers tried repeatedly to come out to us, but as often as it was launched their boat was washed up again on the beach, capsizing them into the water. At length they signalled that a landing could be made on the opposite side of the spit, so the anchor was raised and the ship steamed round the north end of the island, to what Captain Davis proposed should be named Hasselborough Bay, in recognition of the discoverer of the island. This proved an admirable anchorage, for the wind remained from the east and south-east during the greater part of our stay.

The sealers kept trying to reach us, but every time they launched their boat, it got washed up on the beach, flipping them into the water. Eventually, they signaled that it was possible to land on the other side of the spit, so we raised the anchor and the ship sailed around the north end of the island, to a place that Captain Davis suggested should be called Hasselborough Bay, in honor of the island's discoverer. This turned out to be an excellent anchorage, as the wind mostly came from the east and southeast during our stay.

The sealers pushed their boat across the spit, and, launching it in calmer water, came out to us, meeting the 'Aurora' some three miles off the land. The anchor was let go about one mile and a half from the head of the bay.

The sealers pushed their boat across the sandbar, and, launching it in calmer water, came out to us, meeting the 'Aurora' about three miles from the shore. The anchor was dropped about a mile and a half from the head of the bay.

News was exchanged with the sealers. It appeared that there had been much speculation as to what sort of a craft we were; visits of ships, other than those sent down specially to convey their oil to New Zealand, being practically unknown. For a while they suspected the 'Aurora' of being an alien sealer, and had prepared to defend their rights to the local fishery.

News was swapped with the sealers. It seemed there had been a lot of speculation about what kind of ship we were, since visits from other ships, aside from those sent specifically to bring their oil to New Zealand, were practically unheard of. For a time, they suspected the 'Aurora' of being a foreign sealer and were ready to defend their claims to the local fishery.

All was well now, however, and information and assistance were freely volunteered. They were greatly relieved to hear that our auxiliary vessel, the 'Toroa' was expected immediately, and would be available for taking the ship-wrecked crew back to civilization.

All is good now, though, and information and help were offered freely. They were very relieved to hear that our support vessel, the 'Toroa,' was expected any minute and would be ready to take the shipwrecked crew back to civilization.

Owing to the loss of the 'Clyde', a large shipment of oil in barrels lay piled upon the beach with every prospect of destruction, just at a time when the realization of its value would be most desirable, to make good the loss sustained by the wreck. I decided, therefore, in view of their hospitality, to make arrangements with the captain of the 'Toroa' to take back a load of the oil, upon terms only sufficient to recoup us for the extension of the charter.

Due to the loss of the 'Clyde', a large shipment of oil in barrels was stacked on the beach, with every chance of being destroyed, right when recognizing its value would be most beneficial to cover the loss from the wreck. I decided, taking their hospitality into account, to arrange with the captain of the 'Toroa' to take back a load of the oil, on terms just enough to reimburse us for extending the charter.

In company with Ainsworth, Hannam and others, I went ashore to select a site for the station. As strong westerly winds were to be expected during the greater part of the year, it was necessary to erect buildings in the lee of substantial break-winds. Several sites for a hut convenient to a serviceable landing-place were inspected at the north end of the beach. The hut was eventually erected in the lee of a large mass of rock, rising out of the grass-covered sandy flat at the north end of the spit.

In the company of Ainsworth, Hannam, and others, I went ashore to choose a location for the station. Since strong westerly winds were anticipated for most of the year, it was important to build in the shelter of sturdy breakwaters. We looked at several potential sites for a hut near a usable landing area at the north end of the beach. The hut was ultimately built in the shelter of a large rock formation that emerged from the grass-covered sandy flat at the north end of the spit.

It would have been much handier in every way, both in assembling the engines and masts and subsequently in operating the wireless station, had the wireless plant been erected on the beach adjacent to the living-hut. On the other hand, a position on top of the hill had the advantage of a free outlook and of increased electrical potential, allowing of a shorter length of mast. In addition the ground in this situation proved to be peaty and sodden, and therefore a good conductor, thus presenting an excellent "earth" from the wireless standpoint. In short, the advantages of the hill-site outweighed its disadvantages. Of the latter the most obvious was the difficult transportation of the heavy masts, petrol-engine, dynamo, induction-generator and other miscellaneous gear, from the beach to the summit—a vertical height of three hundred feet.

It would have been much easier in every way, both for putting together the engines and masts and for running the wireless station, if the wireless equipment had been set up on the beach next to the living hut. However, being on top of the hill had the perks of a clear view and better electrical potential, which allowed for a shorter mast. Plus, the ground there turned out to be peaty and soaked, making it a great conductor and an excellent "earth" for wireless. In short, the benefits of the hilltop location outweighed its downsides. The most obvious downside was the challenging task of transporting the heavy masts, petrol engine, dynamo, induction generator, and other various equipment from the beach to the top—a vertical height of three hundred feet.

To facilitate this latter work the sealers placed at our disposal a "flying fox" which ran from sea-level to the top of Wireless Hill, and which they had erected for the carriage of blubber. On inspecting it, Wild reported that it was serviceable, but would first require to be strengthened. He immediately set about effecting this with the help of a party.

To make this work easier, the sealers provided us with a "flying fox" that went from sea level to the top of Wireless Hill, which they had installed to transport blubber. After checking it out, Wild noted that it was functional but needed to be reinforced first. He quickly got to work on that with a team.

Hurley now discovered that he had accidentally left one of his cinematograph lenses on a rock where he had been working in Caroline Cove. As it was indispensable, and there was little prospect of the weather allowing of another visit by the ship, it was decided that he should go on a journey overland to recover it. One of the sealers, Hutchinson by name, who had been to Caroline Cove and knew the best route to take, kindly volunteered to accompany Hurley. The party was eventually increased by the addition of Harrisson, who was to keep a look-out for matters of biological interest. They started off at noon on December 13.

Hurley now realized that he had accidentally left one of his cinematography lenses on a rock where he had been working in Caroline Cove. Since it was essential and there wasn’t much chance of the weather permitting another ship visit, it was decided that he should take an overland trip to retrieve it. One of the sealers, Hutchinson, who had been to Caroline Cove and knew the best route, kindly volunteered to go with Hurley. The group later grew to include Harrisson, who would keep an eye out for any biological interests. They set off at noon on December 13.

Although the greater part of the stores for the Macquarie Island party were to arrive by the Toroa there were a few tons on board the 'Aurora'. These and the dogs were landed as quickly as possible. How glad the poor animals were to be once more on solid earth! It was out of the question to let them loose, so they were tethered at intervals along a heavy cable, anchored at both ends amongst the tussock-grass. Ninnis took up his abode in the sealers' hut so that he might the better look after their wants, which centred chiefly on sea elephant meat, and that in large quantities. Webb joined Ninnis, as he intended to take full sets of magnetic observations at several stations in the vicinity.

Although most of the supplies for the Macquarie Island crew were set to arrive on the Toroa, there were a few tons on board the 'Aurora.' These and the dogs were unloaded as quickly as possible. The poor animals were so glad to be back on solid ground! It was impossible to let them roam free, so they were tied at intervals along a heavy cable, secured at both ends among the tussock grass. Ninnis settled into the sealers' hut to better attend to their needs, which mainly revolved around large quantities of sea elephant meat. Webb joined Ninnis, as he planned to conduct full sets of magnetic observations at various locations nearby.

Bickerton and Gillies got the motor-launch into good working order, and by means of it the rest of us conveyed ashore several tons of coal briquettes, the benzine, kerosene, instruments and the wireless masts, by noon on December 13.

Bickerton and Gillies got the motor launch running smoothly, and with it, the rest of us brought several tons of coal briquettes, benzene, kerosene, tools, and the wireless masts ashore by noon on December 13.

Everything but the requirements of the wireless station was landed on the spit, as near the north-east corner as the surf would allow. Fortunately, reefs ran out from the shore at intervals, and calmer water could be found in their lee. All gear for the wireless station was taken to a spot about half a mile to the north-west at the foot of Wireless Hill, where the "flying fox" was situated. Just at that spot there was a landing-place at the head of a charming little boat harbour, formed by numerous kelp-covered rocky reefs rising at intervals above the level of high water. These broke the swell, so that in most weathers calm water was assured at the landing-place.

Everything except the wireless station equipment was unloaded on the spit, as close to the northeast corner as the waves would allow. Fortunately, reefs extended from the shore at various points, creating calmer water in their shelter. All the gear for the wireless station was taken about half a mile to the northwest, at the base of Wireless Hill, where the "flying fox" was located. Right at that spot, there was a landing area at the head of a charming little boat harbor, formed by numerous kelp-covered rocky reefs that rose above the high-water mark. These reefs broke the waves, ensuring calm water at the landing area in most weather conditions.

This boat harbour was a fascinating spot. The western side was peopled by a rookery of blue-eyed cormorants; scattered nests of white gulls relieved the sombre appearance of the reefs on the opposite side: whilst gentoo penguins in numbers were busy hatching their eggs on the sloping ground beyond. Skua-gulls and giant petrels were perched here and there amongst the rocks, watching for an opportunity of marauding the nests of the non-predacious birds. Sea elephants raised their massive, dripping heads in shoal and channel. The dark reefs, running out into the pellucid water, supported a vast growth of a snake-like form of kelp, whose octopus-like tentacles, many yards in length, writhed yellow and brown to the swing of the surge, and gave the foreground an indescribable weirdness. I stood looking out to sea from here one evening, soon after sunset, the launch lazily rolling in the swell, and the 'Aurora' in the offing, while the rich tints of the afterglow paled in the south-west.

This boat harbor was a fascinating place. The western side was home to a rookery of blue-eyed cormorants; scattered nests of white gulls brightened up the gloomy look of the reefs on the opposite side, while gentoo penguins were busy hatching their eggs on the sloping ground beyond. Skua-gulls and giant petrels perched here and there among the rocks, waiting for a chance to raid the nests of the non-predatory birds. Sea elephants raised their massive, dripping heads in the shallow waters and channels. The dark reefs, extending into the clear water, supported a vast growth of snake-like kelp, whose octopus-like tentacles, several yards long, writhed in shades of yellow and brown with the waves, giving the foreground an indescribable eeriness. I stood looking out to sea one evening, soon after sunset, as the launch gently rolled with the swell and the 'Aurora' was visible in the distance, while the rich colors of the afterglow faded in the southwest.

I envied Wild and his party, whose occupation in connexion with the "flying fox" kept them permanently camped at this spot.

I envied Wild and his crew, whose work with the "flying fox" kept them constantly stationed at this spot.

The 'Toroa' made her appearance on the afternoon of December 13, and came to anchor about half a mile inside the 'Aurora'. Her departure had been delayed by the bad weather. Leaving Hobart late on December 7, she had anchored off Bruni Island awaiting the moderation of the sea. The journey was resumed on the morning of the 9th, and the passage made in fine weather. She proved a handy craft for work of the kind, and Captain Holliman, the master, was well used to the dangers of uncharted coastal waters.

The 'Toroa' showed up on the afternoon of December 13 and dropped anchor about half a mile inside the 'Aurora'. Her departure had been held up by bad weather. After leaving Hobart late on December 7, she anchored off Bruni Island, waiting for the sea to calm down. The journey continued on the morning of the 9th, and the trip was made in nice weather. She turned out to be a capable vessel for this kind of work, and Captain Holliman, the captain, was experienced with the hazards of uncharted coastal waters.

Within a few minutes of her arrival, a five-ton motor-boat of shallow draught was launched and unloading commenced.

Within a few minutes of her arrival, a five-ton shallow-draught motorboat was launched, and unloading began.

Those of the staff arriving by the 'Toroa' were housed ashore with the sealers, as, when everybody was on board, the 'Aurora' was uncomfortably congested. Fifty sheep were taken on shore to feed on the rank grass until our departure. A large part of the cargo consisted of coal for the 'Aurora'. This was already partly bagged, and in that form was loaded into the launches and whale-boats; the former towing the latter to their destination. Thus a continuous stream of coal and stores was passing from ship to ship, and from the ships to the several landing-places on shore. As soon as the after-hold on the 'Toroa' was cleared, barrels of sea elephant oil were brought off in rafts and loaded aft, simultaneously with the unloading forward.

Those staff members arriving on the 'Toroa' were accommodated on land with the sealers because the 'Aurora' became uncomfortably crowded once everyone was onboard. Fifty sheep were taken ashore to graze on the overgrown grass until we left. A significant portion of the cargo was coal for the 'Aurora'. This was already partially bagged and was loaded into the launches and whale boats; the launches were towing the boats to their destination. This created a steady flow of coal and supplies moving from ship to ship and from the ships to various landing spots on shore. As soon as the after-hold on the 'Toroa' was cleared, barrels of sea elephant oil were brought off on rafts and loaded in the back, while unloading happened simultaneously at the front.

We kept at the work as long as possible—about sixteen hours a day including a short interval for lunch. There were twenty-five of the land party available for general work, and with some assistance from the ship's crew the work went forward at a rapid rate.

We worked as long as we could—around sixteen hours a day, including a brief break for lunch. There were twenty-five people from the land crew available for general tasks, and with some help from the ship's crew, the work progressed quickly.

On the morning of the 15th, after giving final instructions to Eitel, who had come thus far and was returning as arranged, the 'Toroa' weighed anchor and we parted with a cheer.

On the morning of the 15th, after giving final instructions to Eitel, who had come this far and was heading back as planned, the 'Toroa' raised its anchor and we said goodbye with a cheer.

The transportation of the wireless equipment to the top of the hill had been going on simultaneously with the un-loading of the ships. Now, however, all were able to concentrate upon it, and the work went forward very rapidly.

The transportation of the wireless equipment to the top of the hill had been happening at the same time as the unloading of the ships. Now, however, everyone was able to focus on it, and the work moved ahead very quickly.

All the wireless instruments, and much of the other paraphernalia of the Macquarie Island party had been packed in the barrels, as it was expected that they would have to be rafted ashore through the surf. Fortunately, the weather continued to "hold" from an easterly direction, and everything was able to be landed in the comparatively calm waters of Hasselborough Bay; a circumstance which the islanders assured us was quite a rare thing. The wireless masts were rafted ashore. These were of oregon pine, each composed of four sections.

All the wireless equipment and a lot of the other gear for the Macquarie Island team had been packed in barrels, as they were expecting to have to raft it ashore through the waves. Fortunately, the weather stayed stable from the east, and everything was successfully unloaded in the relatively calm waters of Hasselborough Bay; something the islanders told us was pretty unusual. The wireless masts were brought ashore on rafts. These masts were made of Oregon pine, each consisting of four sections.

Digging the pits for bedding the heavy, wooden "dead men," and erecting the wireless masts, the engine-hut and the operating-hut provided plenty of work for all. Here was as busy a scene as one could witness anywhere—some with the picks and shovels, others with hammers and nails, sailors splicing ropes and fitting masts, and a stream of men hauling the loads up from the sea-shore to their destination on the summit.

Digging the holes for setting the heavy wooden "dead men" and constructing the wireless masts, the engine hut, and the operation hut kept everyone busy. It was as bustling a scene as you could find anywhere—some people were using picks and shovels, others were hammering and nailing, sailors were splicing ropes and fitting masts, and a continuous flow of men was hauling loads up from the shoreline to their destination at the top.

Some details of the working of the "flying fox" will be of interest. The distance between the lower and upper terminals was some eight hundred feet. This was spanned by two steel-wire carrying cables, secured above by "dead men" sunk in the soil, and below by a turn around a huge rock which outcropped amongst the tussock-grass on the flat, some fifty yards from the head of the boat harbour. For hauling up the loads, a thin wire line, with a pulley-block at either extremity, rolling one on each of the carrying wires, passed round a snatch-block at the upper station. It was of such a length that when the loading end was at the lower station, the counterpoise end was in position to descend at the other. Thus a freight was dispatched to the top of the hill by filling a bag, acting as counterpoise, with earth, until slightly in excess of the weight of the top load; then off it would start gathering speed as it went.

Some details about how the "flying fox" works are interesting. The distance between the lower and upper terminals was about eight hundred feet. This was spanned by two steel-wire carrying cables, anchored above by "dead men" buried in the ground, and below by wrapping around a huge rock that jutted out among the tussock-grass on the flat, about fifty yards from the boat harbor. To haul up the loads, a thin wire line, with a pulley-block at each end, rolled along each of the carrying wires and passed around a snatch-block at the upper station. It was long enough that when the loading end was at the lower station, the counterweight end was ready to go down at the other end. This allowed a freight to be sent to the top of the hill by filling a bag, serving as a counterweight, with dirt until it was slightly heavier than the top load; then it would start gaining speed as it went up.

Several devices were developed for arresting the pace as the freight neared the end of its journey, but accidents were always liable to occur if the counterpoise were unduly loaded. Wild was injured by one of these brake-devices, which consisted of a bar of iron lying on the ground about thirty yards in front of the terminus, and attached by a rope with a loose-running noose to the down-carrying wire. On the arrival of the counterpoise at that point on the wire, its speed would be checked owing to the drag exerted. On the occasion referred to, the rope was struck with such velocity that the iron bar was jerked into the air and struck Wild a solid blow on the thigh. Though incapacitated for a few days, he continued to supervise at the lower terminal.

Several devices were created to slow down the freight as it approached the end of its journey, but accidents could still happen if the counterweight was overloaded. Wild got hurt by one of these braking devices, which was an iron bar lying on the ground about thirty yards in front of the terminal and connected by a rope with a loose noose to the descending wire. When the counterweight reached that spot on the wire, its speed would be reduced due to the drag created. On the occasion mentioned, the rope was hit with such force that the iron bar was flung into the air and hit Wild hard on the thigh. Although he was unable to work for a few days, he still managed to oversee operations at the lower terminal.

The larger sections of the wireless masts gave the greatest trouble, as they were not only heavy but awkward. A special arrangement was necessary for all loads exceeding one hundredweight, as the single wire carrier-cables were not sufficiently strong. In such cases both carrier-cables were lashed together making a single support, the hauling being done by a straight pull on the top of the hill. The hauling was carried out to the accompaniment of chanties, and these helped to relieve the strain of the Work. It was a familiar sight to see a string of twenty men on the hauling-line scaring the skua-gulls with popular choruses like "A' roving" and "Ho, boys, pull her along." In calm weather the parties at either terminal could communicate by shouting but were much assisted by megaphones improvised from a pair of leggings.

The larger parts of the wireless masts were the most challenging, as they were not only heavy but also awkward to handle. A special setup was required for any loads over one hundredweight, since the single wire carrier cables weren't strong enough. In these situations, both carrier cables were tied together to create a single support, with the hauling done by pulling straight from the top of the hill. The hauling was accompanied by shanties, which helped ease the strain of the work. It was a common sight to see a group of twenty men on the hauling line scaring away the skua gulls with popular songs like "A' Roving" and "Ho, boys, pull her along." In calm weather, the teams at either end could shout to each other, but they were much aided by makeshift megaphones made from a pair of leggings.

Considering the heavy weights handled and the speed at which the work was done, we were fortunate in suffering only one breakage, and that might have been more serious than it proved. The mishap in question occurred to the generator. In order to lighten the load, the rotor had been taken out. When almost at the summit of the hill, the ascending weight, causing the carrying-wires to sag unusually low, struck a rock, unhitched the lashing and fell, striking the steep rubble slope, to go bounding in great leaps out amongst the grass to the flat below. Marvellous to relate, it was found to have suffered no damage other than a double fracture of the end-plate casting, which could be repaired. And so it was decided to exchange the generators in the two equipments, as there would be greater facilities for engineering work at the Main Base, Adelie Land. Fortunately, the other generator was almost at the top of the ship's hold, and therefore accessible. The three pieces into which the casting had been broken were found to be sprung, and would not fit together. However, after our arrival at Adelie Land, Hannam found, curiously enough, that the pieces fitted into place perfectly—apparently an effect of contraction due to the cold—and with the aid of a few plates and belts the generator was made as serviceable as ever.

Considering the heavy weights we were dealing with and the speed we were working at, we were lucky to have only one breakage, and it could have been much worse. The incident involved the generator. To lighten the load, the rotor had been removed. When we were almost at the top of the hill, the weight we were lifting caused the carrying wires to sag unusually low, which caused it to hit a rock, dislodge the lashing, and tumble down, bouncing across the rubble slope and out into the grass below. Amazingly, it was discovered that it suffered no damage other than a double fracture of the end-plate casting, which could be repaired. So, it was decided to swap the generators in the two setups, since it would be easier to do engineering work at the Main Base in Adelie Land. Luckily, the other generator was near the top of the ship's hold, so it was accessible. The three pieces of the broken casting were found to be sprung and wouldn’t fit back together. However, after we arrived at Adelie Land, Hannam surprisingly found that the pieces fit together perfectly—likely due to contraction from the cold—and with a few plates and belts, the generator was made as good as new.

In the meantime, Hurley, Harrisson, and the sealer, Hutchinson, had returned from their trip to Caroline Cove, after a most interesting though arduous journey. They had camped the first evening at The Nuggets, a rocky point on the east coast some four miles to the south of North-East Bay. From The Nuggets, the trail struck inland up the steep hillsides until the summit of the island was reached; then over pebble-strewn, undulating ground with occasional small lakes, arriving at the west coast near its southern extremity. Owing to rain and fog they overshot the mark and had to spend the night close to a bay at the south-end. There Hurley obtained some good photographs of sea elephants and of the penguin rookeries.

In the meantime, Hurley, Harrisson, and the sealer, Hutchinson, returned from their trip to Caroline Cove after an interesting but challenging journey. They camped the first night at The Nuggets, a rocky point on the east coast about four miles south of North-East Bay. From The Nuggets, the trail went inland up the steep hills until they reached the summit of the island; then it continued over pebble-strewn, hilly terrain with a few small lakes, arriving at the west coast near its southern tip. Due to rain and fog, they missed their destination and had to spend the night near a bay at the southern end. There, Hurley got some great photos of sea elephants and the penguin rookeries.

The next morning, December 15, they set off again, this time finding Caroline Cove without further difficulty. Harrisson remained on the brow of the hill overlooking the cove, and there captured some prions and their eggs. Hurley and his companion found the lost lens and returned to Harrisson securing a fine albatross on the way. This solitary bird was descried sitting on the hill side, several hundreds of feet above sea-level. Its plumage was in such good condition that they could not resist the impulse to secure it for our collection, for the moment not considering the enormous weight to be carried. They had neither firearms nor an Ancient Mariner's cross-bow, and no stones were to be had in the vicinity—when the resourceful Hurley suddenly bethought himself of a small tin of meat in his haversack, and, with a fortunate throw, hit the bird on the head, killing the majestic creature on the spot.

The next morning, December 15, they set out again and easily found Caroline Cove. Harrisson stayed on the hilltop overlooking the cove and managed to catch some prions and their eggs. Hurley and his companion located the lost lens and made their way back to Harrisson, successfully catching a beautiful albatross along the way. This lone bird was spotted sitting on the hillside, several hundred feet above sea level. Its feathers were in such great shape that they couldn't resist the urge to add it to their collection, not thinking about the heavy burden they would have to carry. They had no firearms or an Ancient Mariner’s crossbow, and there were no stones in the area—when the clever Hurley suddenly remembered a small tin of meat in his bag, and with a lucky throw, he hit the bird on the head, killing the magnificent creature instantly.

Shouldering their prize, they trudged on to Lusitania Bay, camping there that night in an old dilapidated hut; a remnant of the sealing days. Close by there was known to be a large rookery of King penguins; a variety of penguin with richly tinted plumage on the head and shoulders, and next in size to the Emperor—the sovereign bird of the Antarctic Regions. The breeding season was at its height, so Harrisson secured and preserved a great number of their eggs. Hutchinson kindly volunteered to carry the albatross in addition to his original load. If they had skinned the bird, the weight would have been materially reduced, but with the meagre appliances at hand, it would undoubtedly have been spoiled as a specimen. Hurley, very ambitiously, had taken a heavy camera, in addition to a blanket and other sundries. During the rough and wet walking of the previous day, his boots had worn out and caused him to twist a tendon in the right foot, so that he was not up to his usual form, while Harrisson was hampered with a bulky cargo of eggs and specimens.

Shouldering their prize, they trudged on to Lusitania Bay, camping there that night in an old, run-down hut; a remnant of the sealing days. Close by, there was a large rookery of King penguins, a type of penguin with richly colored plumage on the head and shoulders, and the second largest after the Emperor—the sovereign bird of the Antarctic Regions. The breeding season was in full swing, so Harrisson collected and preserved a lot of their eggs. Hutchinson kindly volunteered to carry the albatross in addition to his original load. If they had skinned the bird, the weight would have been significantly reduced, but given the limited tools available, it would likely have been ruined as a specimen. Hurley, quite ambitiously, had brought a heavy camera, along with a blanket and some other supplies. During the rough and wet hiking the day before, his boots had worn out and caused him to twist a tendon in his right foot, so he wasn’t at his best, while Harrisson struggled with a bulky load of eggs and specimens.

Saddled with these heavy burdens, the party found the return journey very laborious. Hurley's leg set the pace, and so, later in the day, Harrisson decided to push on ahead in order to give us news, as they had orders to be back as soon as possible and were then overdue. When darkness came on, Harrisson was near The Nuggets, where he passed the night amongst the tussock-grass. Hurley and Hutchinson, who were five miles behind, also slept by the wayside. When dawn appeared, Harrisson moved on, reaching the north-end huts at about 9 A.M. Mertz and Whetter immediately set out and came to the relief of the other two men a few hours later.

Loaded with heavy burdens, the group found the return trip very exhausting. Hurley’s leg determined the pace, so later in the day, Harrisson decided to move ahead to deliver news, as they had orders to return as soon as possible and were overdue. When night fell, Harrisson was near The Nuggets, where he spent the night among the tussock grass. Hurley and Hutchinson, who were five miles behind, also slept by the roadside. When dawn broke, Harrisson continued on, reaching the north-end huts around 9 A.M. Mertz and Whetter quickly set out and reached the other two men a few hours later.

Fatigue and the lame leg subdued Hurley for the rest of the day, but the next morning he was off to get pictures of the "flying fox" in action. It was practically impossible for him to walk to the top of the hill, but not to be baffled, he sent the cinematograph machine up by the "flying fox," and then followed himself. Long before reaching the top he realized how much his integrity depended on the strength of the hauling-line and the care of those on Wireless Hill.

Fatigue and his injured leg kept Hurley down for the rest of the day, but the next morning he headed out to capture images of the "flying fox" in action. It was nearly impossible for him to walk to the top of the hill, but refusing to be defeated, he sent the film camera up with the "flying fox" and followed after it. Long before he reached the top, he understood how much his integrity relied on the strength of the hauling line and the attention of those on Wireless Hill.

During the latter part of our stay at the island, the wind veered to the north and north-north-east. We took advantage of this change to steam round to the east side, intending to increase our supply of fresh water at The Nuggets, where a stream comes down the hillside on to the beach. In this, however, we were disappointed, for the sea was breaking too heavily on the beach, and so we steamed back to North-East Bay and dropped anchor. Wild went off in the launch to search for a landing-place but found the sea everywhere too formidable.

During the last part of our stay on the island, the wind shifted to the north and north-north-east. We decided to take advantage of this change and head around to the east side, planning to fill up our supply of fresh water at The Nuggets, where a stream flows down the hillside onto the beach. However, we were disappointed because the waves were crashing too heavily on the beach, so we headed back to North-East Bay and dropped anchor. Wild took the launch to look for a landing spot but found the sea too rough everywhere.

Signals were made to those on shore, instructing them to finish off the work on the wireless plant, and to kill a dozen sheep—enough for our needs for some days.

Signals were sent to those on shore, telling them to complete the work on the wireless plant and to kill a dozen sheep—enough to last us for several days.

The ship was now found to be drifting, and, as the wind was blowing inshore, the anchor was raised, and with the launch in tow we steamed round to the calmer waters of Hasselborough Bay. At the north end of the island, for several miles out to sea along the line of a submerged reef, the northerly swell was found to be piling up in an ugly manner, and occasioned considerable damage to the launch. This happened as the 'Aurora' swung around; a sea catching the launch and rushing it forward so that it struck the stern of the ship bow-on, notwithstanding the fact that several of the men exerted themselves to their utmost to prevent a collision. On arrival at the anchorage, the launch was noticeably settling down, as water had entered at several seams which had been started.

The ship was now found to be drifting, and, since the wind was blowing toward the shore, the anchor was lifted. With the launch in tow, we steamed around to the calmer waters of Hasselborough Bay. At the north end of the island, for several miles out to sea along the line of a submerged reef, the northern swell was piling up in a dangerous way, causing significant damage to the launch. This happened as the 'Aurora' swung around; a wave caught the launch and pushed it forward, causing it to crash into the ship's stern head-on, even though several crew members did their best to prevent the collision. Upon arriving at the anchorage, the launch was noticeably taking on water, as it had leaked at several seams that had sprung open.

After being partly bailed out, it was left in the water with Hodgeman and Close aboard, as we wished to run ashore as soon as the weather improved. Contrary to expectation the wind increased, and it was discovered that the 'Aurora' was drifting rapidly, although ninety fathoms of chain had been paid out. Before a steam-winch** was installed, the anchor could be raised only by means of an antiquated man-power lever-windlass. In this type, a see-saw-like lever is worked by a gang of men at each extremity, and it takes a long time to get in any considerable length of chain. The chorus and chanty came to our aid once more, and the long hours of heaving on the fo'c'sle head were a bright if strenuous spot in our memories of Macquarie Island. In course of time, during which the ship steamed slowly ahead, the end came in sight—'Vast heaving!—but the anchor was missing. This put us in an awkward situation, for the stock of our other heavy anchor had already been lost. There was no other course but to steam up and down waiting for the weather to moderate. In the meantime, we had been too busy to relieve Close and Hodgeman, who had been doing duty in the launch, bailing for five hours, and were thoroughly soaked with spray. All hands now helped with the tackle, and we soon had the launch on board in its old position near the main hatch.

After being partially bailed out, it was left in the water with Hodgeman and Close on board, as we wanted to run ashore as soon as the weather got better. Unexpectedly, the wind picked up, and we realized that the 'Aurora' was drifting quickly, even though we had let out ninety fathoms of chain. Before a steam winch could be installed, we could only raise the anchor using an outdated manual lever windlass. In this setup, a see-saw-like lever is operated by a team of men at each end, and it takes a long time to pull in any significant length of chain. The chorus and chanty helped us once again, and the long hours of pulling at the fo'c'sle head were a bright but exhausting memory from our time at Macquarie Island. Eventually, while the ship moved slowly ahead, we spotted the end—“Heave, ho!”—but the anchor was gone. This put us in a tough spot since we had already lost the stock of our other heavy anchor. We had no choice but to steam back and forth, waiting for the weather to calm down. In the meantime, we were too busy to relieve Close and Hodgeman, who had been bailing in the launch for five hours and were completely soaked from the spray. Everyone pitched in to handle the tackle, and we quickly got the launch back on board in its usual spot near the main hatch.

     ** Fitted on return to Sydney after the first Antarctic cruise.
     ** Fitted upon returning to Sydney after the first Antarctic cruise.

These operations were unusually protracted for we were short handed; the boatswain, some of the sailors and most of the land party being marooned on shore. We were now anxious to get everybody on board and to be off. The completion of their quarters was to be left to the Macquarie Island party, and it was important that we should make the most of the southern season. The wind blew so strongly, however, that there was no immediate prospect of departure.

These operations took longer than usual because we were short-handed; the boatswain, some sailors, and most of the land party were stuck on shore. We were eager to get everyone on board and leave. Finishing their quarters would be up to the Macquarie Island party, and it was crucial that we made the most of the southern season. However, the wind was blowing so hard that there was no immediate chance of leaving.

The ship continued to steam up and down. On the morning of December 23 it was found possible to lower the whale-boat, and Wild went off with a complement of sturdy oarsmen, including Madigan, Moyes, Watson and Kennedy, and succeeded in bringing off the dogs. Several trips were made with difficulty during the day, but at last all the men, dogs and sheep were brought off.

The ship kept moving back and forth. On the morning of December 23, they were able to lower the whale boat, and Wild set off with a team of strong rowers, including Madigan, Moyes, Watson, and Kennedy, successfully bringing back the dogs. They made several challenging trips throughout the day, but eventually, all the men, dogs, and sheep were brought back.

Both Wild and I went with the whale-boat on its last trip at dusk on the evening of December 23. The only possible landing-place, with the sea then running, was at the extreme north-eastern corner of the beach. No time was lost in getting the men and the remainder of the cargo into the boat, though in the darkness this was not easily managed. The final parting with our Macquarie Island party took place on the beach, their cheers echoing to ours as we breasted the surf and "gave way" for the ship.

Both Wild and I took the whale boat on its last trip at dusk on the evening of December 23. The only possible place to land, with the sea rolling in, was at the far northeastern corner of the beach. We wasted no time getting the men and the rest of the cargo into the boat, although it wasn’t easy to manage in the dark. Our final goodbye with our Macquarie Island team happened on the beach, their cheers echoing ours as we fought against the surf and paddled out for the ship.





CHAPTER III FROM MACQUARIE ISLAND TO ADELIE LAND

The morning following our farewell to Ainsworth and party at the north end of the island found us steaming down the west coast, southward bound.

The morning after we said goodbye to Ainsworth and his group at the north end of the island found us steaming down the west coast, heading south.

Our supply of fresh water was scanty, and the only resource was to touch at Caroline Cove. As a matter of fact, there were several suitable localities on the east coast, but the strong easterly weather then prevailing made a landing impossible.

Our supply of fresh water was limited, and the only option was to stop at Caroline Cove. In fact, there were several good spots along the east coast, but the strong easterly winds at that time made it impossible to land.

On the ship nearing the south end, the wind subsided. She then crept into the lee of the cliffs, a boat was dropped and soundings disclosed a deep passage at the mouth of Caroline Cove and ample water within. There was, however, limited space for manoeuvring the vessel if a change should occur in the direction of the wind. The risk was taken; the 'Aurora' felt her way in, and, to provide against accident, was anchored by Captain Davis with her bow toward the entrance. Wild then ran out a kedge anchor to secure the stern.

On the ship getting close to the south end, the wind calmed down. She then edged into the shelter of the cliffs, a boat was lowered, and the depth showed a deep passage at the entrance of Caroline Cove with plenty of water inside. However, there wasn't much room to maneuver the vessel if the wind changed direction. The risk was taken; the 'Aurora' slowly made her way in, and to prepare for any mishap, Captain Davis anchored her with the bow facing the entrance. Wild then set out a kedge anchor to secure the stern.

During the cruise down the coast the missing stock of our only anchor had been replaced by Gillies and Hannam. Two oregon "dead men", bolted together on the shank, made a clumsy but efficient makeshift.

During the cruise down the coast, Gillies and Hannam replaced the missing stock of our only anchor. They used two Oregon "dead men," bolted together on the shank, creating a clumsy but effective makeshift solution.

Two large barrels were taken ashore, repeatedly filled and towed off to the ship. It was difficult at first to find good water, for the main stream flowing down from the head of the bay was contaminated by the penguins which made it their highway to a rookery. After a search, an almost dry gulley bed was found to yield water when a pit was dug in its bed. This spot was some eighty yards from the beach and to reach it one traversed an area of tussocks between which sea elephants wallowed in soft mire.

Two large barrels were brought ashore, consistently filled, and towed back to the ship. At first, it was tough to find clean water because the main stream flowing from the head of the bay was polluted by the penguins that used it as their path to the rookery. After some searching, an almost dry gully was found to produce water when a pit was dug in its bed. This location was about eighty yards from the beach, and to get there, one had to walk through an area of tussocks where sea elephants lounged in the soft mud.

A cordon of men was made and buckets were interchanged, the full ones descending and the empty ones ascending. The barrels on the beach were thus speedily filled and taken off by a boat's crew. At 11 P.M. darkness came, and it was decided to complete the work on the following day.

A line of men was formed, passing buckets back and forth, with the full ones going down and the empty ones coming up. The barrels on the beach were quickly filled and taken away by a boat crew. At 11 P.M., darkness fell, and it was decided to finish the work the next day.

As we rowed to the ship, the water was serenely placid. From the dark environing hills came the weird cries of strange birds. There was a hint of wildness, soon to be forgotten in the chorus of a 'Varsity song and the hearty shouts of the rowers.

As we paddled to the boat, the water was calm and smooth. From the dark surrounding hills came the eerie calls of unusual birds. There was a sense of wildness, which would soon be drowned out by the sounds of a college song and the cheerful shouts of the rowers.

About 2 A.M. the officer on watch came down to report to Captain Davis a slight change in the direction of the breeze. At 3 A.M. I was again awakened by hearing Captain Davis hasten on deck, and by a gentle bumping of the ship, undoubtedly against rock. It appeared that the officer on watch had left the bridge for a few minutes, while the wind freshened and was blowing at the time nearly broadside-on from the north. This caused the ship to sag to leeward, stretching the bow and stern cables, until she came in contact with the kelp-covered, steep, rocky bank on the south side. The narrow limits of the anchorage were responsible for this dangerous situation.

About 2 A.M., the officer on duty came down to inform Captain Davis about a slight change in the wind direction. At 3 A.M., I was once again awakened by hearing Captain Davis rush on deck and by the soft bumping of the ship, definitely against rock. It seemed that the officer on duty had stepped away from the bridge for a few minutes while the wind picked up and was blowing nearly sideways from the north. This caused the ship to tilt away from the wind, stretching the bow and stern cables, until it hit the kelp-covered, steep, rocky bank on the south side. The narrow limits of the anchorage were to blame for this dangerous situation.

All hands were immediately called on deck and set to work hauling on the stern cable. In a few minutes the propeller and rudder were out of danger. The engines were then started slowly ahead, and, as we came up to the bower anchor, the cable was taken in. The wind was blowing across the narrow entrance to the Cove, so that it was advisable to get quickly under way. The kedge anchor was abandoned, and we steamed straight out to sea with the bower hanging below the bows. The wind increased, and there was no other course open but to continue the southward voyage.

All crew members were immediately summoned to the deck and began working on the stern cable. Within a few minutes, the propeller and rudder were no longer in danger. The engines were then started slowly, and as we approached the bower anchor, the cable was reeled in. The wind was blowing across the narrow entrance to the Cove, making it necessary to get moving quickly. The kedge anchor was left behind, and we steamed straight out to sea with the bower hanging below the bow. The wind picked up, and the only option left was to continue heading south.

The day so inauspiciously begun turned out beautifully sunny. There was additional verve in our Christmas celebration, as Macquarie Island and the Bishop and Clerk, in turn, sank below the northern horizon.

The day that started off so poorly turned out to be beautifully sunny. Our Christmas celebration had even more energy as Macquarie Island and the Bishop and Clerk disappeared below the northern horizon.

During the stay at the island little attention had been given to scientific matters. All our energies had been concentrated on speedily landing the party which was to carry out such special work, so as to allow us to get away south as soon as possible. Enough had been seen to indicate the wide scientific possibilities of the place.

During our time on the island, we didn't focus much on scientific matters. All our efforts were directed towards quickly landing the team that was supposed to do the special work, so we could head south as soon as possible. We saw enough to suggest the vast scientific potential of the area.

For some days we were favoured by exceptional weather; a moderate breeze from the north-east and a long, lazy swell combining to make our progress rapid.

For several days, we enjoyed amazing weather; a gentle breeze from the northeast and a long, slow swell coming together to make our journey quick.

The sum of the experiences of earlier expeditions had shown that the prevailing winds south of 60 degrees S. latitude were mainly south-easterly, causing a continuous streaming of the pack from east to west. Our obvious expedient on encountering the ice was to steam in the same direction as this drift. It had been decided before setting out that we would confine ourselves to the region west of the meridian of 158 degrees E. longitude. So it was intended to reach the pack, approximately in that meridian, and, should we be repulsed, to work steadily to the west in expectation of breaking through to the land.

The experiences from previous expeditions showed that the main winds south of 60 degrees S. latitude were mostly coming from the southeast, causing the ice pack to continuously move from east to west. Our obvious plan when we encountered the ice was to head in the same direction as this drift. Before setting out, we had already decided to stay west of the 158 degrees E. longitude line. So, we aimed to reach the ice pack around that longitude, and if we were turned back, we would continue moving west in hopes of making it through to the land.

Regarding the ice conditions over the whole segment of the unknown tract upon which our attack was directed, very little was known. Critically examined, the reports of the American squadron under the command of Wilkes were highly discouraging. D'Urville appeared to have reached his landfall without much hindrance by ice, but that was a fortunate circumstance in view of the difficulties Wilkes had met. At the western limit of the area we were to explore, the Germans in the 'Gauss' had been irrevocably trapped in the ice as early as the month of February. At the eastern limit, only the year before, the 'Terra Nova' of Scott's expedition, making a sally into unexplored waters, had sighted new land almost on the 158th meridian, but even though it was then the end of summer, and the sea was almost free from the previous season's ice, they were not able to reach the land on account of the dense pack.

Regarding the ice conditions across the entire segment of the unknown area where we aimed to attack, not much was known. When closely examined, the reports from the American squadron led by Wilkes were quite discouraging. D'Urville seemed to have reached his destination with little trouble from the ice, but that was a lucky break considering the challenges Wilkes faced. At the western edge of the area we were set to explore, the Germans on the 'Gauss' had become stuck in the ice as early as February. At the eastern limit, just the year before, the 'Terra Nova' from Scott's expedition, while venturing into unexplored waters, spotted new land almost at the 158th meridian. However, even though it was the end of summer and the sea was nearly free from the ice of the previous season, they couldn't reach the land due to the thick pack ice.

In the early southern summer, at the time of our arrival, the ice conditions were expected to be at their worst. This followed from the fact that not only would local floes be encountered, but also a vast expanse of pack fed by the disintegrating floes of the Ross Sea, since, between Cape Adare and the Balleny Islands, the ice drifting to the north-west under the influence of the south-east winds is arrested in an extensive sheet. On the other hand, were we to wait for the later season, no time would remain for the accomplishment of the programme which had been arranged. So we were forced to accept things as we found them, being also prepared to make the most of any chance opportunity.

In the early summer in the South, when we arrived, the ice conditions were expected to be at their worst. This was because we would face not only local ice floes but also a massive area of pack ice fed by the breaking up of the ice in the Ross Sea. Between Cape Adare and the Balleny Islands, the ice drifting northwest due to the southeast winds gets trapped in a large sheet. However, if we waited for a later season, we wouldn’t have enough time to complete the planned activities. So, we had to accept the situation as it was and be ready to take advantage of any opportunities that came our way.

In planning the Expedition, the probability of meeting unusually heavy pack had been borne in mind, and the three units into which the land parties and equipment were divided had been disposed so as to facilitate the landing of a base with despatch, and, maybe, under difficult circumstances. Further, in case the ship were frozen in, "wireless" could be installed and the news immediately communicated through Macquarie Island to Australia.

In planning the expedition, we considered the likelihood of encountering unusually heavy pack conditions, and we organized the three units of the land parties and equipment in a way that would allow for a quick and efficient landing of a base, even under challenging circumstances. Additionally, if the ship were to get trapped in the ice, we could set up wireless communication and immediately relay news through Macquarie Island back to Australia.

At noon on December 27 whales were spouting all round us, and appeared to be travelling from west to east. Albatrosses of several species constantly hovered about, and swallow-like Wilson petrels—those nervous rangers of the high seas—would sail along the troughs and flit over the crests of the waves, to vanish into sombre distance.

At noon on December 27, whales were spouting all around us and seemed to be traveling from west to east. Albatrosses of several species constantly hovered nearby, and swallow-like Wilson petrels—those restless wanderers of the open sea—would glide along the troughs and dart over the crests of the waves, disappearing into the gloomy distance.

Already we were steaming through untravelled waters, and new discoveries might be expected at any moment. A keen interest spread throughout the ship. On several occasions, fantastic clouds on the horizon gave hope of land, only to be abandoned on further advance. On December 28 and 29 large masses of floating kelp were seen, and, like the flotsam met with by Columbus, still further raised our hopes.

Already we were moving through unexplored waters, and we could expect new discoveries at any moment. A strong interest spread throughout the ship. Several times, strange clouds on the horizon made us hopeful of sighting land, only to be let down as we approached. On December 28 and 29, we spotted large amounts of floating kelp, which, like the debris encountered by Columbus, lifted our hopes even higher.

The possibility of undiscovered islands existing in the Southern Ocean, south of Australia and outside the ice-bound region, kept us vigilant. So few ships had ever navigated the waters south of latitude 55 degrees, that some one and a quarter million square miles lay open to exploration. As an instance of such a discovery in the seas south of New Zealand may be mentioned Scott Island, first observed by the 'Morning', one of the relief ships of the British Expedition of 1902.

The chance that there were undiscovered islands in the Southern Ocean, south of Australia and beyond the icy areas, kept us on our toes. Very few ships had ever sailed the waters south of latitude 55 degrees, leaving about one and a quarter million square miles available for exploration. For example, Scott Island, which was first seen by the 'Morning', one of the relief ships from the British Expedition of 1902, serves as an example of such a discovery in the waters south of New Zealand.

The weather remained favourable for sounding and other oceanographical work, but as it was uncertain how long these conditions would last, and in view of the anxiety arising from overloaded decks and the probability of gales which are chronic in these latitudes, it was resolved to land one of the bases as soon as possible, and thus rid the ship of superfluous cargo. The interesting but time-absorbing study of the ocean-depths was therefore postponed for a while.

The weather stayed good for sounding and other ocean research, but since it was unclear how long these conditions would hold up, and considering the worry over overloaded decks and the likelihood of strong winds common in these areas, it was decided to unload one of the bases as soon as possible to lighten the ship's cargo. The fascinating but time-consuming study of the ocean depths was therefore delayed for a bit.

With regard to the Antarctic land to be expected ahead, many of Wilkes's landfalls, where they had been investigated by later expeditions, had been disproved. It seemed as if he had regarded the northern margin of the solid floe and shelf-ice as land; perhaps also mistaking bergs, frozen in the floe and distorted by mirage, for ice-covered land. Nevertheless, his soundings, and the light thrown upon the subject by the Scott and Shackleton expeditions, left no doubt in my mind that land would be found within a reasonable distance south of the position assigned by Wilkes. Some authorities had held that any land existing in this region would be found to be of the nature of isolated islands. Those familiar with the adjacent land, however, were all in favour of it being continental—a continuation of the Victoria Land plateau. The land lay to the south beyond doubt; the problem was to reach it through the belt of ice-bound sea. Still, navigable pack-ice might be ahead, obviating the need of driving too far to the west.

Regarding the Antarctic land expected ahead, many of Wilkes's landings, which were later investigated by subsequent expeditions, have been proven incorrect. It appeared as though he mistook the northern edge of the solid floe and shelf ice for land; he might have also confused icebergs, trapped in the floe and distorted by mirage, for ice-covered land. However, his soundings, along with the insights provided by the Scott and Shackleton expeditions, convinced me that land would be found relatively close to the location Wilkes indicated. Some experts argued that any land in this region would likely be isolated islands. However, those familiar with the neighboring land believed it was continental—a continuation of the Victoria Land plateau. There was no doubt that land lay to the south; the challenge was getting through the ice-bound sea. Still, navigable pack ice might be ahead, possibly eliminating the need to travel too far west.

"Ice on the starboard bow!" At 4 P.M. on December 29 the cry was raised, and shortly after we passed alongside a small caverned berg whose bluish-green tints called forth general admiration. In the distance others could be seen. One larger than the average stood almost in our path. It was of the flat-topped, sheer-walled type, so characteristic of the Antarctic regions; three-quarters of a mile long and half a mile wide, rising eighty feet above the sea.

"Ice on the right front!" At 4 P.M. on December 29, the shout went up, and soon after, we passed by a small, hollowed-out iceberg whose bluish-green colors drew everyone's admiration. In the distance, we could see more. One that was larger than usual was almost in our way. It had the flat-top, steep-wall shape that's typical of the Antarctic areas; it was three-quarters of a mile long and half a mile wide, rising eighty feet above the ocean.

It has been stated that tabular bergs are typical of the Antarctic as opposed to the Arctic. This diversity is explained by a difference in the glacial conditions. In the north, glaciation is not so marked and, as a rule, coastal areas are free from ice, except for valley-glaciers which transport ice from the high interior down to sea-level. There, the summer temperature is so warm that the lower parts of the glaciers become much decayed, and, reaching the sea, break up readily into numerous irregular, pinnacled bergs of clear ice. In the south, the tabular forms result from the fact that the average annual temperature is colder than that prevailing at the northern axis of the earth. They are so formed because, even at sea-level, no appreciable amount of thawing takes place in midsummer. The inland ice pushes out to sea in enormous masses, and remains floating long before it "calves" to form bergs. Even though its surface has been thrown into ridges as it was creeping over the uneven land, all are reduced to a dead level or slightly undulating plain, in the free-floating condition, and are still further effaced by dense drifts and repeated falls of snow descending upon them. The upper portion of a table-topped berg consists, therefore, of consolidated snow; neither temperature nor pressure having been sufficient to metamorphose it into clear ice. Such a berg in old age becomes worn into an irregular shape by the action of waves and weather, and often completely capsizes, exposing its corroded basement.

It’s noted that tabular icebergs are typical in Antarctica rather than the Arctic. This difference is due to varying glacial conditions. In the north, glaciation isn’t as pronounced, and typically, coastal areas are ice-free, except for valley glaciers that move ice from the higher regions down to sea level. There, the summer temperatures are warm enough that the lower parts of the glaciers erode significantly, leading to the breakup of the ice into many irregular, jagged icebergs. In the south, the flat-topped icebergs form because the average annual temperature is colder than that in the northern hemisphere. They form this way because even at sea level, there’s little melting during midsummer. The inland ice flows out to sea in massive chunks and stays afloat long before it calves into icebergs. Although its surface may be rough from moving over uneven terrain, everything gets smoothed out into a flat or slightly rolling surface while floating, and it gets further worn down by thick snow drifts and repeated snowfall on top. The upper part of a flat-topped iceberg is made up of compacted snow since neither temperature nor pressure has transformed it into clear ice. As it ages, the iceberg becomes irregularly shaped due to the effects of waves and weather, and it often tips over completely, revealing its worn base.

A light fog obscured the surrounding sea and distant bergs glided by like spectres. A monstrous block on the starboard side had not been long adrift, for it showed but slight signs of weathering.

A thin fog covered the nearby sea, and distant icebergs floated by like ghosts. A huge chunk on the right side hadn’t been drifting for long, as it showed only minimal signs of wear.

The fog thickened over a grey swell that shimmered with an oily lustre. At 7 P.M. pack-ice came suddenly to view, and towards it we steered, vainly peering through the mists ahead in search of a passage. The ice was closely packed, the pieces being small and wellworn. On the outskirts was a light brash which steadily gave place to a heavier variety, composed of larger and more angular fragments. A swishing murmur like the wind in the tree-tops came from the great expanse. It was alabaster-white and through the small, separate chips was diffused a pale lilac coloration. The larger chunks, by their motion and exposure to wind and current, had a circle of clear water; the deep sea-blue hovering round their water-worn niches. Here and there appeared the ochreous-yellow colour of adhering films of diatoms.

The fog grew thicker over a gray swell that shimmered with an oily sheen. At 7 P.M., pack ice suddenly came into view, and we headed toward it, straining to see through the mist ahead in search of a passage. The ice was tightly packed, with small, worn pieces. On the edge was light brash that gradually gave way to heavier ice made up of larger, more angular chunks. A swishing sound like wind in the treetops came from the vast expanse. It was pure white, and through the small, separate bits, a pale lilac hue spread out. The larger pieces, from their movement and exposure to wind and current, created a circle of clear water, with deep sea blue surrounding their water-worn areas. Here and there, the ochre-yellow color of adhering films of diatoms appeared.

As we could not see what lay beyond, and the pack was becoming heavier, the ship was swung round and headed out.

As we couldn't see what was ahead, and the load was getting heavier, the ship was turned around and sailed out.

Steering to the west through open water and patches of trailing brash, we were encouraged to find the pack trending towards the south. By pushing through bars of jammed floes and dodging numerous bergs, twenty miles were gained due southwards before the conditions had changed. The fog cleared, and right ahead massive bergs rose out of an ice-strewn sea. We neared one which was a mile in length and one hundred feet in height. The heaving ocean, dashing against its mighty, glistening walls, rushed with a hollow boom into caverns of ethereal blue; gothic portals to a cathedral of resplendent purity.

Steering west through open water and scattered chunks of ice, we were glad to see the ice pack moving south. By pushing through jammed floes and avoiding lots of icebergs, we made good progress, covering twenty miles due south before conditions changed. The fog lifted, revealing massive icebergs rising out of a sea full of ice. We approached one that was a mile long and one hundred feet tall. The rolling ocean crashed against its towering, shining walls, creating a hollow boom as it rushed into caverns of bright blue; gothic doorways leading into a cathedral of stunning purity.

The smaller bergs and fragments of floe crowded closer together, and the two men at the wheel had little time for reverie. Orders came in quick succession—"Starboard! Steady!" and in a flash—"Hard-a-port!" Then repeated all over again, while the rudder-chains scraped and rattled in their channels.

The smaller icebergs and chunks of floe moved close together, and the two men at the wheel barely had a moment to think. Orders came in rapid succession—"Turn right! Steady!" and in an instant—"Turn hard left!" Then it started all over again, while the rudder chains scraped and rattled in their tracks.

Gradually the swell subsided, smoothed by the weight of ice. The tranquillity of the water heightened the superb effects of this glacial world. Majestic tabular bergs whose crevices exhaled a vaporous azure; lofty spires, radiant turrets and splendid castles; honeycombed masses illumined by pale green light within whose fairy labyrinths the water washed and gurgled. Seals and penguins on magic gondolas were the silent denizens of this dreamy Venice. In the soft glamour of the midsummer midnight sun, we were possessed by a rapturous wonder—the rare thrill of unreality.

Gradually, the waves calmed down, smoothed by the weight of ice. The stillness of the water made the stunning beauty of this glacial world even more breathtaking. Majestic flat-topped icebergs with crevices that released a misty blue; tall spires, shining towers, and magnificent castles; honeycombed formations lit up by a pale green glow, where the water flowed and bubbled through enchanting passages. Seals and penguins on magical gondolas were the silent inhabitants of this dreamlike Venice. In the soft beauty of the midnight sun in midsummer, we were filled with a wonderful awe—the rare excitement of being in a surreal world.

The ice closed in, and shock after shock made the ship vibrate as she struck the smaller pieces full and fair, followed by a crunching and grinding as they scraped past the sides. The dense pack had come, and hardly a square foot of space showed amongst the blocks; smaller ones packing in between the larger, until the sea was covered with a continuous armour of ice. The ominous sound arising from thousands of faces rubbing together as they gently oscillated in the swell was impressive. It spoke of a force all-powerful, in whose grip puny ships might be locked for years and the less fortunate receive their last embrace.

The ice closed in, and shock after shock made the ship tremble as it hit the smaller chunks head-on, followed by a crunching and grinding as they scraped against the sides. The dense pack had arrived, and barely a square foot of space was visible among the blocks; smaller pieces filled in the gaps between the larger ones, turning the sea into a continuous armor of ice. The eerie sound of thousands of ice faces rubbing against each other as they swayed gently in the swell was striking. It hinted at a force beyond anything, capable of trapping tiny ships for years, with the unfortunate ones meeting their end.

The pack grew heavier and the bergs more numerous, embattled in a formidable array. If an ideal picture, from our point of view it was impenetrable. No "water sky" showed as a distant beacon; over all was reflected the pitiless, white glare of the ice. The 'Aurora' retreated to the open sea, and headed to the west in search of a break in the ice-front. The wind blew from the south-east, and, with sails set to assist the engines, rapid progress was made.

The pack became heavier and the icebergs more numerous, forming a daunting formation. From our perspective, it looked completely blocked. There was no "water sky" to serve as a distant signal; everything was just the harsh, white reflection of the ice. The 'Aurora' moved back to the open sea and headed west, looking for a gap in the ice. The wind blew from the southeast, and with the sails catching it to help the engines, we made quick progress.

The southern prospect was disappointing, for the heavy pack was ranged in a continuous bar. The over-arching sky invariably shone with that yellowish-white effulgence known as "ice blink," indicative of continuous ice, in contrast with the dark water sky, a sign of open water, or a mottled sky proceeding from an ice-strewn but navigable sea.

The southern view was disappointing because the thick pack ice formed a continuous barrier. The expansive sky always glowed with that yellowish-white brightness called "ice blink," which signals persistent ice, unlike the dark water sky, which indicates open water, or a patchy sky from an ice-covered but passable sea.

Though progress can be made in dense pack, provided it is not too heavy, advance is necessarily very slow—a few miles a day, and that at the expense of much coal. Without a well-defined "water sky" it would have been foolish to have entered. Further, everything pointed to heavier ice-conditions in the south, and, indeed, in several places we reconnoitred, and such was proved to be the case. Large bergs were numerous, which, on account of being almost unaffected by surface currents because of their ponderous bulk and stupendous draught, helped to compact the shallow surface-ice under the free influence of currents and winds. In our westerly course we were sometimes able to edge a little to the south, but were always reduced to our old position within a few hours. Long projecting "tongues" were met at intervals and, when narrow or open, we pushed through them.

Though we can make some progress in dense ice if it’s not too heavy, the advance is still really slow—only a few miles a day, and that takes a lot of coal. Without a clear "water sky," it would have been unwise to go in. Additionally, everything indicated that the ice conditions were getting worse to the south, and indeed, in several areas we explored, this was true. There were many large icebergs, which, because of their massive size and deep draft, were mostly unaffected by surface currents, and this helped to compact the shallow surface ice under the influence of currents and winds. While heading west, we sometimes managed to drift a little south, but we always ended up back in our original position within a few hours. We encountered long, protruding "tongues" at intervals, and when they were narrow or open, we pushed through them.

Whales were frequently seen, both rorquals and killers. On the pack, sea-leopards and crab-eater seals sometimes appeared. At one time as many as a hundred would be counted from the bridge and at other moments not a single one could be sighted. They were not alarmed, unless the ship happened to bump against ice-masses within a short distance of them. A small sea-leopard, shot from the fo'c'sle by a well-directed bullet from Wild, was taken on board as a specimen; the meat serving as a great treat for the dogs.

Whales were often spotted, including both rorquals and orcas. On the ice, sea leopards and crab-eater seals occasionally showed up. At one point, as many as a hundred could be counted from the bridge, while at other times not a single one could be seen. They weren't scared unless the ship accidentally bumped against ice masses nearby. A small sea leopard, shot from the forecastle by a well-aimed bullet from Wild, was brought on board as a specimen; the meat was a big treat for the dogs.

On January 2, when driving through a tongue of pack, a halt was made to "ice ship." A number of men scrambled over the side on to a large piece of floe and handed up the ice. It was soon discovered, however, that the swell was too great, for masses of ice ten tons or more in weight swayed about under the stern, endangering the propeller and rudder—the vulnerable parts of the vessel. So we moved on, having secured enough fresh-water ice to supply a pleasant change after the somewhat discoloured tank-water then being served out. The ice still remained compact and forbidding, but each day we hoped to discover a weak spot through which we might probe to the land itself.

On January 2, while driving through a section of packed ice, we stopped to get some "ice ship." Several men climbed over the side onto a large piece of floe and started passing up the ice. However, we soon realized that the swell was too strong, as massive chunks of ice weighing ten tons or more were shifting under the stern, putting the propeller and rudder—the most vulnerable parts of the vessel—at risk. So, we moved on after gathering enough fresh-water ice to provide a nice change from the rather murky tank water we had been using. The ice still looked dense and harsh, but each day we hoped to find a weak spot where we could break through to the land itself.

On the evening of January 2 we saw a high, pinnacled berg, a few miles within the edge of the pack, closely resembling a rocky peak; the transparent ice of which it was composed appeared, in the dull light, of a much darker hue than the surrounding bergs. Another adjacent block exhibited a large black patch on its northern face, the exact nature of which could not be ascertained at a distance. Examples of rock debris embedded in bergs had already been observed, and it was presumed that this was a similar case. These were all hopeful signs, for the earthy matter must, of course, have been picked up by the ice during its repose upon some adjacent land.

On the evening of January 2, we spotted a tall, pointed iceberg a few miles into the pack, closely resembling a rocky peak; the clear ice it was made of looked much darker than the surrounding icebergs in the dull light. Another nearby block had a large black patch on its northern face, but we couldn't determine exactly what it was from a distance. We had already seen examples of rock debris embedded in icebergs, so we assumed this was a similar situation. These were all encouraging signs, as the earthy material must have been picked up by the ice while it rested on some nearby land.

At this same spot, large flocks of silver-grey petrels were seen resting on the ice and skimming the water in search of food. As soon as we had entered the ice-zone, most of our old companions, such as the albatross, had deserted, while a new suite of Antarctic birds had taken their place. These included the beautiful snow petrel, the Antarctic petrel, and the small, lissome Wilson petrel—a link with the bird-life of more temperate seas.

At this same spot, large groups of silver-gray petrels were seen resting on the ice and gliding over the water searching for food. As soon as we entered the ice zone, most of our old companions, like the albatross, had left, while a new set of Antarctic birds had moved in. These included the beautiful snow petrel, the Antarctic petrel, and the small, graceful Wilson petrel—a connection to the bird life of more temperate seas.

On the evening of January 3 the wind was blowing fresh from the south-east and falling snow obscured the horizon. The pack took a decided turn to the north, which fact was particularly disappointing in view of the distance we had already traversed to the west. We were now approaching the longitude of D'Urville's landfall, and still the pack showed no signs of slackening. I was beginning to feel very anxious, and had decided not to pass that longitude without resorting to desperate measures.

On the evening of January 3, the wind was blowing strongly from the southeast, and the falling snow obscured the horizon. The pack ice made a definite turn to the north, which was especially disappointing considering the distance we had already traveled to the west. We were now nearing the longitude of D'Urville's landing, and yet the pack showed no signs of letting up. I was starting to feel very anxious and had decided not to pass that longitude without taking desperate measures.

The change in our fortunes occurred at five o'clock next morning, when the Chief Officer, Toucher, came down from the bridge to report that the atmosphere was clearing and that there appeared to be land-ice near by. Sure enough, on the port side, within a quarter of a mile, rose a massive barrier of ice extending far into the mist and separated from the ship by a little loose pack-ice. The problem to be solved was, whether it was the seaward face of an ice-covered continent, the ice-capping of a low island or only a flat-topped iceberg of immense proportions.

The shift in our luck happened at five o'clock the next morning when the Chief Officer, Toucher, came down from the bridge to report that the weather was improving and that there seemed to be land-ice nearby. Sure enough, on the port side, just a quarter of a mile away, a huge ice barrier rose, stretching far into the mist and separated from the ship by a small area of loose pack-ice. The question was whether it was the seaward face of an ice-covered continent, the ice cap of a low island, or just a massive flat-topped iceberg.

By 7 A.M. a corner was reached where the ice-wall trended southward, limned on the horizon in a series of bays and headlands. An El Dorado had opened before us, for the winds coming from the east of south had cleared the pack away from the lee of the ice-wall, so that in the distance a comparatively clear sea was visible, closed by a bar of ice, a few miles in extent. Into this we steered, hugging the ice-wall, and were soon in the open, speeding along in glorious sunshine, bringing new sights into view every moment.

By 7 A.M., we reached a point where the ice wall curved southward, outlined on the horizon with a series of bays and headlands. A paradise had opened up before us, as the winds from the southeast had pushed the ice pack away from the sheltered side of the ice wall, revealing a relatively clear sea in the distance, blocked by a strip of ice a few miles long. We steered into this, staying close to the ice wall, and soon found ourselves in the open, racing along in beautiful sunshine, with new sights appearing before us every moment.

The wall, along the northern face, was low—from thirty to seventy feet in height—but the face along which we were now progressing gradually rose in altitude to the south. It was obviously a shelf-ice formation (or a glacier-tongue projection of it), exactly similar in build, for instance, to the Great Ross Barrier so well described by Ross, Scott, and others. At the north-west corner, at half a dozen places within a few miles of each other, the wall was puckered up and surmounted by semi-conical eminences, half as high as the face itself. These peculiar elevations were unlike anything previously recorded and remained unexplained for a while, until closer inspection showed them to be the result of impact with other ice-masses—a curious but conceivable cause.

The wall on the northern side was low—between thirty and seventy feet tall—but as we moved south, it gradually got taller. It was clearly a shelf ice formation (or a glacier tongue projecting from it), very similar in structure to the Great Ross Barrier described by Ross, Scott, and others. In the north-west corner, at several spots within a few miles of each other, the wall was bunched up and topped with semi-conical peaks, about half the height of the wall itself. These unusual formations were unlike anything recorded before and remained a mystery for a while until a closer look revealed that they were caused by collisions with other ice masses—a strange but possible explanation.

On pieces of broken floe Weddell seals were noted. They were the first seen on the voyage and a sure indication of land, for their habitat ranges over the coastal waters of Antarctic lands.

On chunks of broken ice, Weddell seals were spotted. They were the first ones seen on the voyage and a clear sign of land, as their habitat extends over the coastal waters of Antarctic regions.

A large, low, dome-topped elevation, about one mile in diameter, was passed on the starboard side, at a distance of two miles from the long ice-cliff. This corresponded in shape with what Ross frequently referred to as an "ice island," uncertain whether it was a berg or ice-covered land. A sounding close by gave two hundred and eight fathoms, showing that we were on the continental shelf, and increasing the probability that the "ice island" was aground.

A large, low, dome-shaped elevation, about a mile in diameter, was passed on the right side, two miles away from the long ice cliff. This matched the shape of what Ross often called an "ice island," unsure whether it was a berg or ice-covered land. A nearby depth measurement revealed two hundred and eight fathoms, indicating that we were on the continental shelf and increasing the likelihood that the "ice island" was grounded.

Birds innumerable appeared on every hand: snow petrels, silver petrels, Cape pigeons and Antarctic petrels. They fluttered in hundreds about our bows. Cape pigeons are well known in lower latitudes, and it was interesting to find them so far south. As they have chessboard-like markings on the back when seen in flight, there is no mistaking them.

Birds countless were everywhere: snow petrels, silver petrels, Cape pigeons, and Antarctic petrels. They flitted in hundreds around our bows. Cape pigeons are familiar in warmer latitudes, and it was fascinating to see them so far south. With their chessboard-like markings on the back when flying, they are unmistakable.

The ice-wall or glacier-tongue now took a turn to the south-east. At this point it had risen to a great height, about two hundred feet sheer. A fresh wind was blowing in our teeth from the south-south-east, and beyond this point would be driving us on to the cliffs. We put the ship about, therefore, and made for the lee side of the "ice island."

The ice wall or glacier tongue now turned southeast. At this point, it had risen to a great height, around two hundred feet straight up. A strong wind was blowing against us from the south-southeast, and beyond this point, it would push us toward the cliffs. So, we changed the ship's direction and headed for the sheltered side of the "ice island."

In isolated coveys on the inclined top of the "island" were several flocks, each containing hundreds of Antarctic petrels. At intervals they would rise into the air in clouds, shortly afterwards to settle down again on the snow.

In isolated groups on the sloped peak of the "island" were several flocks, each made up of hundreds of Antarctic petrels. Every so often, they would take off into the air in swarms, only to settle back down on the snow shortly after.

Captain Davis moved the ship carefully against the lee wall of the "island," with a view of replenishing our water supply, but it was unscalable, and we were forced to withdraw. Crouched on a small projection near the water's edge was a seal, trying to evade the eyes of a dozen large grampuses which were playing about near our stern. These monsters appeared to be about twenty-five feet in length. They are the most formidable predacious mammals of the Antarctic seas, and annually account for large numbers of seals, penguins, and other cetaceans. The sea-leopard is its competitor, though not nearly so ferocious as the grampus, of whom it lives in terror.

Captain Davis maneuvered the ship carefully against the sheltered side of the "island," hoping to refill our water supply, but it was too steep to climb, and we had to pull back. Crouched on a small ledge near the water's edge was a seal, trying to avoid being seen by a dozen large grampuses playing around near our stern. These creatures looked to be about twenty-five feet long. They are the most powerful predatory mammals in the Antarctic seas and each year take a significant number of seals, penguins, and other cetaceans. The sea leopard competes with them, but it's nowhere near as vicious as the grampus, which it fears greatly.

The midnight hours were spent off the "ice island" while we wafted for a decrease in the wind. Bars of cirrus clouds covered the whole sky—the presage of a coming storm. The wind arose, and distant objects were blotted out by driving snow. An attempt was made to keep the ship in shelter by steaming into the wind, but as "ice island" and glacier-tongue were lost in clouds of snow, we were fortunate to make the lee of the latter, about fourteen miles to the north. There we steamed up and down until the afternoon of January 5, when the weather improved. A sounding was taken and the course was once more set for the south.

The midnight hours were spent off the "ice island" as we waited for the wind to die down. Thin clouds covered the entire sky, signaling a coming storm. The wind picked up, and distant objects disappeared in the swirling snow. We tried to keep the ship sheltered by heading into the wind, but when the "ice island" and glacier-tongue vanished in the snow, we were lucky to find a safe spot about fourteen miles north of it. We drifted up and down there until the afternoon of January 5, when the weather got better. We took a depth reading and set our course south again.

The sky remained overcast, the atmosphere foggy, and a south-south-east wind was blowing as we came abreast of the "ice island," which, by the way, was discovered to have drifted several miles to the north, thus proving itself to be a free-floating berg. The glacier-tongue on the port side took a sharp turn to the east-south-east, disappearing on the horizon. As there was no pack in sight and the water was merely littered with fragments of ice, it appeared most likely that the turn in the glacier-tongue was part of a great sweeping curve ultimately joining with the southward land. On our south-south-east course we soon lost sight of the ice-cliffs in a gathering fog.

The sky was overcast, the air was foggy, and a south-southeast wind was blowing as we approached the "ice island," which, by the way, had moved several miles to the north, proving it was a free-floating iceberg. The glacier tongue on the left side took a sharp turn to the east-southeast, disappearing into the horizon. With no pack ice in sight and the water only scattered with bits of ice, it seemed likely that the turn in the glacier tongue was part of a large sweeping curve leading down to the southern land. Following our south-southeast course, we soon lost sight of the ice cliffs in the thickening fog.

On the afternoon of January 6 the wind abated and the fog began to clear. At 5 P.M. a line of ice confronted us and, an hour later, the 'Aurora' was in calm water under another mighty ice face trending across our course. This wall was precisely similar to the one seen on the previous evening, and might well have been a continuation of it. It is scarcely credible that when the 'Aurora' came south the following year, the glacier-tongue first discovered had entirely disappeared. It was apparently nothing more than a huge iceberg measuring forty miles in length. Specially valuable, as clearing up any doubt that may have remained, was its re-discovery the following year some fifty miles to the north-west. Close to the face of the new ice-wall, which proved to be a true glacier-tongue, a mud bottom was found at a depth of three hundred and ninety-five fathoms.

On the afternoon of January 6, the wind died down, and the fog started to lift. At 5 P.M., we faced a line of ice, and an hour later, the 'Aurora' was in calm water beneath another massive ice wall blocking our path. This wall looked exactly like the one we had seen the night before and could easily have been an extension of it. It’s hard to believe that when the 'Aurora' came back south the next year, the glacier tongue we first discovered had completely vanished. It turned out to be nothing more than a huge iceberg about forty miles long. Its re-discovery the following year, roughly fifty miles to the north-west, was especially valuable in clearing up any lingering doubts. Close to the face of the new ice wall, which turned out to be a real glacier tongue, we found a mud bottom at a depth of three hundred and ninety-five fathoms.

While we were steaming in calm water to the south-west, the massive front, serrated by shallow bays and capes, passed in magnificent review. Its height attained a maximum of one hundred and fifty feet. In places the sea had eaten out enormous blue grottoes. At one spot, several of these had broken into each other to form a huge domed cavern, the roof of which hung one hundred feet above the sea. The noble portico was flanked by giant pillars.

While we were cruising smoothly through calm waters to the southwest, the impressive coastline, jagged with shallow bays and capes, stretched out before us in a stunning display. Its height reached a maximum of one hundred and fifty feet. In some areas, the sea had eroded massive blue caves. In one location, several of these caves had merged to create a large domed cavern, the ceiling of which was a hundred feet above the sea. The grand entrance was flanked by enormous pillars.

The glacier-tongue bore all the characters of shelf-ice, by which is meant a floating extension of the land-ice.** A table-topped berg in the act of formation was seen, separated from the parent body of shelf-ice by a deep fissure several yards in width.

The glacier-tongue showed all the features of shelf ice, meaning a floating extension of the land ice.** A table-topped iceberg in the process of forming was spotted, cut off from the main body of shelf ice by a deep crack several yards wide.

     ** Subsequently this shelf-ice formation was found to be a floating
glacier-tongue sixty miles in length, the seaward extension of a large
glacier which we named the Mertz Glacier.
     ** Subsequently, this shelf ice formation was found to be a floating glacier tongue sixty miles long, the seaward extension of a large glacier that we named the Mertz Glacier.

At 11 P.M. the 'Aurora' entered a bay, ten miles wide, bounded on the east by the shelf-ice wall and on the west by a steep snow-covered promontory rising approximately two thousand feet in height, as yet seen dimly in hazy outline through the mist. No rock was visible, but the contour of the ridge was clearly that of ice-capped land.

At 11 P.M., the 'Aurora' entered a bay that was ten miles wide, with a shelf of ice on the east and a steep snow-covered cliff rising about two thousand feet on the west, still faintly visible through the mist. No rocks were seen, but the shape of the ridge clearly indicated it was ice-capped land.

There was much jubilation among the watchers on deck at the prospect. Every available field-glass and telescope was brought to bear upon it. It was almost certainly the Antarctic continent, though, at that time, its extension to the east, west and south remained to be proved. The shelf-ice was seen to be securely attached to it and, near its point of junction with the undulating land-ice, we beheld the mountains of this mysterious land haloed in ghostly mist.

There was a lot of excitement among the spectators on deck at the sight. Every available binocular and telescope was pointed at it. It was almost certainly the Antarctic continent, although at that moment, its expanse to the east, west, and south still needed to be confirmed. The shelf ice was clearly attached to it, and near where it met the rolling land ice, we could see the mountains of this mysterious land shrouded in eerie mist.

While passing the extremity of the western promontory, we observed an exposure of rock, jutting out of the ice near sea-level, in the face of a scar left by an avalanche. Later, when passing within half a cable's length of several berg-like masses of ice lying off the coast, rock was again visible in black relief against the water's edge, forming a pedestal for the ice. The ship was kept farther offshore, after this warning, for though she was designed to buffet with the ice, we had no desire to test her resistance to rock.

While passing the edge of the western headland, we noticed a rock formation sticking out of the ice near sea level, in the area where an avalanche had left a scar. Later, when we were within half a cable's length of some icebergs lying offshore, rock was once again visible in dark contrast against the water's edge, acting as a base for the ice. After this warning, we kept the ship further out, because while she was built to handle ice, we didn’t want to test her durability against rock.

The bottom was very irregular, and as an extra precaution, soundings were taken every few minutes. Through a light fog all that could be seen landwards was a steep, sloping, icy surface descending from the interior, and terminating abruptly in a seaward cliff fifty to two hundred feet in height.

The bottom was quite uneven, so as an extra precaution, depth measurements were taken every few minutes. Through a light fog, all that could be seen toward the land was a steep, sloping, icy surface leading down from the interior, ending suddenly in a cliff by the sea that was fifty to two hundred feet high.

The ice-sheet terminating in this wall presented a more broken surface than the floating shelf-ice. It was riven and distorted by gaping crevasses; an indication of the rough bed over which it had travelled.

The ice sheet ending at this wall had a more uneven surface than the floating shelf ice. It was shattered and twisted with large cracks; a sign of the rough ground it had passed over.

Towards midnight another bay was entered and many rocky islets appeared on its western side. The engines were stopped for a few hours, and the voyage was resumed in clearer weather on the following morning.

Towards midnight, they entered another bay, and many rocky islets showed up on its western side. The engines were turned off for a few hours, and the journey started again in clearer weather the next morning.

All day we threaded our way between islands and bergs. Seals and penguins swam around, the latter squawking and diving in a most amusing manner.

All day we navigated through islands and icebergs. Seals and penguins swam around us, the penguins squawking and diving in a really entertaining way.

Cautiously we glided by an iceberg, at least one hundred and fifty feet high, rising with a faceted, perpendicular face chased with soft, snowy traceries and ornamented with stalactites. Splits and rents broke into the margin, and from each streamed the evanescent, azure vapour. Each puncture and tiny grotto was filled with it, and a sloping cap of shimmering snow spread over the summit. The profile-view was an exact replica of a battleship, grounded astern. The bold contour of the bow was perfect, and the massive flank had been torn and shattered by shell-fire in a desperate naval battle. This berg had heeled over considerably, and the original water-line ran as a definite rim, thirty feet above the green water. From this rim shelved down a smooth and polished base, marked with fine vertical striae.

We cautiously glided past an iceberg that was at least one hundred and fifty feet high, standing with a faceted, vertical face decorated with soft, snowy patterns and adorned with icicles. Cracks and breaks marred the edges, and from each one, a fleeting, blue vapor streamed out. Every puncture and little grotto was filled with it, and a sloping cap of shimmering snow covered the top. The profile looked exactly like a battleship stuck in shallow water. The sleek outline of the bow was flawless, and the sturdy side had been torn apart by shellfire in a fierce naval battle. This iceberg had tilted quite a bit, and the original waterline formed a clear edge, thirty feet above the green water. From this edge, a smooth and polished base sloped down, marked with fine vertical grooves.

Soundings varied from twenty to two hundred fathoms, and, accordingly, the navigation was particularly anxious work.

Soundings ranged from twenty to two hundred fathoms, making navigation especially stressful.

Extending along about fifteen miles of coast, where the inland ice came down steeply to the sea, was a marginal belt of sea, about two or three miles in width, thickly strewn with rocky islets. Of these some were flat and others peaked, but all were thickly populated by penguins, petrels and seals. The rocks appeared all to be gneisses and schists.

Extending along about fifteen miles of coast, where the inland ice came down steeply to the sea, was a narrow stretch of sea, about two or three miles wide, densely scattered with rocky islets. Some of these were flat while others were pointed, but all were heavily populated by penguins, petrels, and seals. The rocks seemed to be mostly gneisses and schists.

Later that night we lay off a possible landing-place for one of our bases, but, on more closely inspecting it in the morning, we decided to proceed farther west into a wide sweeping bay which opened ahead. About fifty miles ahead, on the far side of Commonwealth Bay, as we named it, was a cape which roughly represented in position Cape Decouverte, the most easterly extension of Adelie Land seen by D'Urville in 1840. Though Commonwealth Bay and the land already seen had never before been sighted, all was placed under the territorial name of Adelie Land.

Later that night, we identified a potential landing site for one of our bases, but after examining it more closely in the morning, we chose to move further west into a large bay that opened up ahead of us. About fifty miles away, on the opposite side of what we named Commonwealth Bay, there was a cape that roughly matched the position of Cape Decouverte, the easternmost point of Adelie Land spotted by D'Urville in 1840. Even though Commonwealth Bay and the land we had seen before had never been encountered, everything was designated under the territorial name of Adelie Land.

The land was so overwhelmed with ice that, even at sea-level, the rock was all but entirely hidden. Here was an ice age in all earnestness; a picture of Northern Europe during the Great Ice Age some fifty thousand years ago. It was evident that the glaciation of Adelie Land was much more severe than that in higher Antarctic latitudes, as exampled on the borders of the Ross Sea; the arena of Scott's, Shackleton's and other expeditions. The temperature could not be colder, so we were led to surmise that the snowfall must be excessive. The full truth was to be ascertained by bitter experience, after spending a year on the spot.

The land was so covered in ice that, even at sea level, the rock was almost completely hidden. This was truly an ice age; a snapshot of Northern Europe during the Great Ice Age around fifty thousand years ago. It was clear that the glaciation of Adelie Land was much more intense than that in the higher Antarctic latitudes, like on the edges of the Ross Sea, where Scott, Shackleton, and other expeditions took place. It couldn't possibly be colder, so we figured that the snowfall must have been excessive. The harsh reality would become clear through tough experiences after spending a year there.

I had hoped to find the Antarctic continent in these latitudes bounded by a rocky and attractive coast like that in the vicinity of Cape Adare; the nearest well-explored region. It had proved otherwise, only too well endorsing the scanty information supplied by D'Urville and Wilkes of the coastline seen by them. A glance at the austere plateau and the ice-fettered coast was evidence of a rigid, inhospitable climate. It was apparent, too, that only a short summer could be expected in these latitudes, thus placing limitations upon our operations.

I had hoped to find the Antarctic continent in these latitudes with a rocky and appealing coastline like that near Cape Adare, the closest well-explored area. It turned out to be quite the opposite, highlighting the limited information provided by D'Urville and Wilkes about the coastline they observed. A look at the stark plateau and the ice-locked coast showed a harsh, unwelcoming climate. It was clear, too, that only a brief summer could be expected in these latitudes, which would limit our activities.

If three bases were to be landed it was important that they should be spread at sufficiently wide intervals. If one were placed in Adelie Land, the ship would probably have to break through the pack in establishing each of the other two ba ses. Judging by our previous experience there was no certain prospect of this being effected. The successful landing of three bases in suitable positions, sufficiently far apart for advantageous co-operation in geographical, meteorological and other observations, had now become problematical. In addition, one of the parties was not as strong as I would have liked, considering what would be undoubtedly its strenuous future.

If we were to land three bases, it was crucial that they were spread out at wide enough intervals. If one was set up in Adelie Land, the ship would likely have to navigate through the ice to establish each of the other two bases. Based on our past experiences, there was no guarantee this could be achieved. Successfully landing three bases in suitable locations, far apart enough for effective cooperation in geographical, meteorological, and other observations, had now become uncertain. Additionally, one of the teams wasn't as strong as I would have hoped, given the challenging future they would undoubtedly face.

For some days the various phases of the situation had occupied my mind, and I now determined to risk two bases, combining the smallest of the three parties with the Main Base. Alterations in the personnel of the third party were also made, by which the Main Base would be increased in strength for scientific work, and the other party under the leadership of Wild would be composed of men of specially good sledging calibre, besides being representative of the leading branches of our scientific programme.

For several days, I had been thinking about the different aspects of the situation, and I finally decided to combine the smallest of the three groups with the Main Base. Changes were also made to the personnel of the third group, which would enhance the Main Base's capability for scientific work, while the other group, led by Wild, would consist of men specifically skilled in sledding and would also represent the key areas of our scientific agenda.

We had a splendid lot of men, and I had no difficulty in choosing for Wild seven companions who could be relied upon to give a good account of themselves. It was only by assuring myself of their high efficiency that I could expect to rest from undue anxiety throughout the year of our separation. The composition of the two parties was as follows:

We had a great group of guys, and I had no trouble choosing seven companions for Wild who I knew would perform well. It was only by confirming their high skill level that I could look forward to a year apart without too much worry. The makeup of the two teams was as follows:

Main Base: R. Bage, F. H. Bickerton, J. H. Close, P. E. Correll, W. H. Hannam, A. J. Hodgeman, J. G. Hunter, J. F. Hurley, C. F. Laseron, C. T. Madigan, A. L. McLean, X. Mertz, H. D. Murphy, B. E. S. Ninnis, F. L. Stillwell, E. N. Webb, L. H. Whetter and myself.

Main Base: R. Bage, F. H. Bickerton, J. H. Close, P. E. Correll, W. H. Hannam, A. J. Hodgeman, J. G. Hunter, J. F. Hurley, C. F. Laseron, C. T. Madigan, A. L. McLean, X. Mertz, H. D. Murphy, B. E. S. Ninnis, F. L. Stillwell, E. N. Webb, L. H. Whetter, and me.

Western Party: G. Dovers, C. T. Harrisson, C. A. Hoadley, S. E. Jones, A. L. Kennedy, M. H. Moyes, A. D. Watson, and F. Wild (leader).

Western Party: G. Dovers, C. T. Harrisson, C. A. Hoadley, S. E. Jones, A. L. Kennedy, M. H. Moyes, A. D. Watson, and F. Wild (leader).

I was now anxious to find a suitable location for our Main Base; two reasons making it an urgent matter. The first was, that as we advanced to the west we were leaving the South Magnetic Pole, and I was anxious to have our magnetographs running as near the latter as possible. Secondly, we would be daily increasing our distance from Macquarie Island, making wireless communication more uncertain.

I was now eager to find a good spot for our Main Base; there were two reasons this was urgent. First, as we moved west, we were getting further from the South Magnetic Pole, and I wanted to have our magnetographs operating as close to it as possible. Second, we would be increasing our distance from Macquarie Island every day, making wireless communication more unreliable.

At noon on January 8, while I was weighing the pros and cons with Captain Davis, Wild came in to say that there was a rocky exposure about fifteen miles off on the port side, and suggested altering our course to obtain a better view of it.

At noon on January 8, while I was discussing the advantages and disadvantages with Captain Davis, Wild came in to mention that there was a rocky outcrop about fifteen miles off on the left side and suggested we change our course to get a better look at it.

Just after 4 P.M., when the ship was about one mile from the nearest rocks, the whale-boat was lowered and manned. We rowed in with the object of making a closer investigation. From the ship's deck, even when within a mile, the outcrop had appeared to project directly from under the inland ice-sheet. Now, however, we were surprised to find ourselves amongst an archipelago of islets. These were named the Mackellar Islets, in remembrance of one who had proved a staunch friend of the Expedition.

Just after 4 P.M., when the ship was about a mile from the nearest rocks, the whale boat was lowered and crewed. We rowed in to get a closer look. From the ship's deck, even when we were within a mile, the outcrop seemed to stick out directly from beneath the inland ice sheet. However, we were surprised to find ourselves surrounded by a group of small islands. These were named the Mackellar Islets, in memory of someone who had been a loyal friend to the Expedition.

Weddell seals and Adelie penguins in thousands rested upon the rocks; the latter chiefly congregated upon a long, low, bare islet situated in the centre. This was the largest of the group, measuring about half a mile in length; others were not above twenty yards in diameter. As we came inshore, the main body of the archipelago was found to be separated by a mile and a half from the mainland. A point which struck us at the time was that the islets situated on the southern side of the group were capped by unique masses of ice; resembling iced cakes. Later we were able to see them in process of formation. In the violent southerly hurricanes prevalent in Adelie Land, the spray breaks right over them. Part of it is deposited and frozen, and by increments the icing of these monstrous "cakes" is built up. The amount contributed in winter makes up for loss by thawing in midsummer. As the islets to windward shelter those in their lee, the latter are destitute of these natural canopies.

Weddell seals and Adelie penguins rested by the thousands on the rocks; the penguins mostly gathered on a long, low, bare islet in the center. This was the largest in the group, about half a mile long; the others were no more than twenty yards across. As we approached the shore, we found that the main group of islands was about a mile and a half from the mainland. One thing that struck us at the time was that the islets on the southern side of the group were topped with unique ice formations that looked like iced cakes. Later, we were able to see them being formed. In the fierce southerly storms common in Adelie Land, the spray crashes over them. Some of it gets deposited and freezes, gradually building up the icing on these huge "cakes." The amount added in winter compensates for what melts away in midsummer. As the islets facing the wind protect those behind them, the latter lack these natural ice coverings.

Soundings were taken at frequent intervals with a hand lead-line, manipulated by Madigan. The water was on the whole shallow, varying from a few to twenty fathoms. The bottom was clothed by dense, luxuriant seaweed. This rank growth along the littoral was unexpected, for nothing of the kind exists on the Ross Sea coasts within five or six fathoms of the surface.

Soundings were taken regularly using a hand lead-line, handled by Madigan. The water was generally shallow, ranging from a few to twenty fathoms deep. The bottom was covered with thick, lush seaweed. This heavy growth along the shoreline was unexpected, as nothing like it can be found on the Ross Sea coasts within five or six fathoms of the surface.

Advancing towards the mainland, we observed a small islet amongst the rocks, and towards it the boat was directed. We were soon inside a beautiful, miniature harbour completely land-locked. The sun shone gloriously in a blue sky as we stepped ashore on a charming ice-quay—the first to set foot on the Antarctic continent between Cape Adare and Gaussberg, a distance of one thousand eight hundred miles.

Advancing toward the mainland, we saw a small island among the rocks, and the boat headed for it. We quickly found ourselves in a beautiful, tiny harbor completely surrounded by land. The sun shone brilliantly in a blue sky as we stepped onto a lovely ice quay—the first to set foot on the Antarctic continent between Cape Adare and Gaussberg, a distance of one thousand eight hundred miles.

Wild and I proceeded to make a tour of exploration. The rocky area at Cape Denison, as it was named, was found to be about one mile in length and half a mile in extreme width. Behind it rose the inland ice, ascending in a regular slope and apparently free of crevasses—an outlet for our sledging parties in the event of the sea not firmly freezing over. To right and left of this oasis, as the visitor to Adelie Land must regard the welcome rock, the ice was heavily crevassed and fell sheer to the sea in cliffs, sixty to one hundred and fifty feet in height. Two small dark patches in the distance were the only evidences of rock to relieve the white monotony of the coast.

Wild and I set out on an exploration tour. The rocky area at Cape Denison, as it was named, turned out to be about a mile long and half a mile wide. Behind it, the inland ice rose at a smooth incline and seemed to be free of crevasses—providing a passage for our sledging teams if the sea didn’t freeze over completely. On either side of this oasis, as a visitor to Adelie Land would see the welcoming rock, the ice was heavily crevassed and dropped straight down to the sea in cliffs, ranging from sixty to one hundred and fifty feet high. In the distance, two small dark patches were the only signs of rock to break the white monotony of the coast.

In landing cargo on Antarctic shores, advantage is generally taken of the floe-ice on to which the materials can be unloaded and at once sledged away to their destination. Here, on the other hand, there was open water, too shallow for the 'Aurora' to be moored alongside the ice-foot. The only alternative was to anchor the ship at a distance and discharge the cargo by boats running to the ideal harbour we had discovered. Close to the boat harbour was suitable ground for the erection of a hut, so that the various impedimenta would have to be carried only a short distance. For supplies of fresh meat, in the emergency of being marooned for a number of years, there were many Weddell seals at hand, and on almost all the neighbouring ridges colonies of penguins were busy rearing their young.64

In landing cargo on Antarctic shores, we usually take advantage of the floe ice, where materials can be unloaded and quickly sledged away to their destination. Here, however, there was open water that was too shallow for the 'Aurora' to be moored next to the ice foot. The only option was to anchor the ship offshore and unload the cargo using boats to the perfect harbor we had found. Close to the boat harbor was a good spot for building a hut, so we wouldn't have to carry the supplies very far. For fresh meat, in case we were stuck here for several years, there were plenty of Weddell seals nearby, and on almost all the neighboring ridges, colonies of penguins were busy raising their young.64

As a station for scientific investigations, it offered a wider field than the casual observer would have imagined. So it came about that the Main Base was finally settled at Cape Denison, Commonwealth Bay.

As a hub for scientific research, it provided a broader landscape than the casual onlooker would have thought. That's how the Main Base ended up being established at Cape Denison, Commonwealth Bay.

We arrived on board at 8 P.M., taking a seal as food for the dogs. Without delay, the motor-launch was dropped into the water, and both it and the whale-boat loaded with frozen carcasses of mutton, cases of eggs and other perishable goods.

We boarded at 8 P.M., bringing a seal to feed the dogs. Without wasting any time, the motor launch was lowered into the water, and both it and the whale boat were loaded with frozen mutton carcasses, cases of eggs, and other perishable items.

While some of us went ashore in the motor-launch, with the whale-boat in tow, the 'Aurora' steamed round the Mackellar Islets seeking for a good anchorage under the icy barrier, immediately to the west of the boat harbour. The day had been perfect, vibrant with summer and life, but towards evening a chill breeze sprang up, and we in the motor-launch had to beat against it. By the time we had reached the head of the harbour, Hoadley had several fingers frost-bitten and all were feeling the cold, for we were wearing light garments in anticipation of fine weather. The wind strengthened every minute, and showers of fine snow were soon whistling down the glacier. No time was lost in landing the cargo, and, with a rising blizzard at our backs, we drove out to meet the 'Aurora'. On reaching the ship a small gale was blowing and our boats were taken in tow.

While some of us went ashore in the motorboat, pulling the whale boat behind us, the 'Aurora' cruised around the Mackellar Islets looking for a good spot to anchor under the icy barrier just west of the boat harbor. The day had been beautiful, full of summer and life, but as evening approached a cold breeze picked up, and we in the motorboat had to fight against it. By the time we reached the head of the harbor, Hoadley had several frostbitten fingers and everyone was feeling the chill, since we were dressed lightly expecting nice weather. The wind got stronger by the minute, and soon fine snow was blowing down the glacier. We wasted no time unloading the cargo, and with a rising blizzard behind us, we headed out to meet the 'Aurora'. When we got to the ship, a small gale was blowing and our boats were taken in tow.

The first thing to be considered was the mooring of the 'Aurora' under the lee of the ice-wall, so as to give us an opportunity of getting the boats aboard. In the meantime they were passed astern, each manned by several hands to keep them bailed out; the rest of us having scrambled up the side. Bringing the ship to anchor in such a wind in uncharted, shoal water was difficult to do in a cool and methodical manner. The sounding machine was kept running with rather dramatic results; depths jumping from five to thirty fathoms in the ship's length, and back again to the original figure in the same distance. A feeling of relief passed round when, after much manoeuvring, the anchor was successfully bedded five hundred yards from the face of the cliff.

The first thing we needed to consider was securing the 'Aurora' behind the ice wall to allow us to bring the boats on board. In the meantime, the boats were passed back, each one manned by several crew members to keep them from filling with water, while the rest of us scrambled up the side. Anchoring the ship in such windy conditions in uncharted, shallow water was challenging to do calmly and systematically. The sounding machine was kept running, producing quite dramatic results; depths varied from five to thirty fathoms within the length of the ship, then back to the original figure in the same distance. A wave of relief spread through us when, after a lot of maneuvering, the anchor was finally set five hundred yards from the cliff face.

Just at this time the motor-launch broke adrift. Away it swept before a wind of forty-five miles per hour. On account of the cold, and because the engine was drenched with sea-water, some difficulty was found in starting the motor. From the ship's deck we could see Bickerton busily engaged with it. The rudder had been unshipped, and there was no chance of replacing it, for the boat was bobbing about on the waves in a most extraordinary manner. However, Whetter managed to make a jury-rudder which served the purpose, while Hunter, the other occupant, was kept laboriously active with the pump.

Just then, the motorboat broke free. It shot away, carried by winds of forty-five miles per hour. Because of the cold and the engine being soaked with seawater, they had some trouble starting it. From the ship's deck, we could see Bickerton working hard on it. The rudder had come off, and there was no way to fix it since the boat was bouncing around on the waves in a really wild way. However, Whetter managed to create a makeshift rudder that did the job, while Hunter, the other person on board, was busy working the pump.

They had drifted half a mile, and were approaching the rocks of an islet on which the sea was breaking heavily. Just as every one was becoming very apprehensive, the launch began to forge ahead, and the men had soon escaped from their dangerous predicament. By the united efforts of all hands the boats were hoisted on board and everything was made as "snug" as possible.

They had drifted half a mile and were getting close to the rocks of a small island where the waves were crashing hard. Just as everyone started to get really worried, the launch picked up speed, and the crew quickly got out of their risky situation. With everyone's combined efforts, they hoisted the boats on board and made everything as "cozy" as possible.

The wind steadily increased, and it seemed impossible for the anchor to hold. The strain on the cable straightened out a steel hook two inches in diameter. This caused some embarrassment, as the hook was part of the cable attachment under the fo'c'sle-head. It is remarkable, however, that after this was adjusted the ship did not lose her position up to the time of departure from Adelie Land.

The wind kept getting stronger, and it seemed like the anchor wouldn’t hold. The pressure on the cable straightened a steel hook that was two inches in diameter. This was a bit embarrassing since the hook was part of the cable attachment under the forecastle head. However, it’s impressive that after this was fixed, the ship maintained its position until we left Adelie Land.

Though we were so close under the shelter of a lofty wall, the waves around us were at least four feet in height and when the wind increased to sixty-five and seventy miles per hour, their crests were cut off and the surface was hidden by a sheet of racing spindrift.

Though we were so close under the protection of a tall wall, the waves around us were at least four feet high, and when the wind picked up to sixty-five or seventy miles per hour, their tops were blown off, and the surface was obscured by a layer of flying spray.

Everything was securely lashed in readiness for going to sea, in case the cable should part. Final arrangements were then made to discharge the cargo quickly as soon as the wind moderated.

Everything was securely fastened and ready for departure, just in case the cable broke. Final preparations were made to unload the cargo quickly as soon as the wind calmed down.

Two days had elapsed before the wind showed any signs of abatement. It was 8 P.M. on January 10 when the first boat ventured off with a small cargo, but it was not till the following morning that a serious start was made. In good weather, every trip between the ship and the boat harbour, a distance of a mile, meant that five or six tons had been landed. It was usual for the loaded launch to tow both whale-boats heavily laden and, in addition, a raft of hut timbers or wireless masts. Some of the sailors, while engaged in building rafts alongside the ship, were capsized into the water and after that the occupation was not a popular one.

Two days passed before the wind started to die down. It was 8 P.M. on January 10 when the first boat set off with a small load, but it wasn't until the next morning that a serious effort began. In good weather, every trip between the ship and the boat harbor, a mile apart, meant that five or six tons were unloaded. It was common for the loaded launch to tow both whale boats that were fully loaded, as well as a raft of hut timber or wireless masts. Some of the sailors, while building rafts next to the ship, fell into the water, and after that, the job wasn't a popular one.

Ashore, Wild had rigged a derrick, using for its construction two of the wireless royal masts. It was thus possible to cope with the heavier packages at the landing-place. Of the last-named the air-tractor sledge was by far the most troublesome. With plenty of manual labour, under Wild's skilful direction, this heavy machine was hoisted from the motor-launch, and then carefully swung on to the solid ice-foot.

Ashore, Wild had set up a crane using two of the wireless royal masts for its construction. This made it easier to handle the heavier packages at the landing area. Among these, the air-tractor sledge was by far the most challenging. With a lot of manual labor and Wild's expert direction, this heavy machine was lifted from the motor-launch and then carefully swung onto the solid ice.

Captain Davis superintended the discharging operations on the ship, effected by the crew and some of the land party under the direction of the ship's officers. Wild supervised conveyance ashore, and the landing, classification, and safe storage of the various boat-loads. Gillies and Bickerton took alternate shifts in driving the motor-launch. The launch proved invaluable, and we were very glad that it had been included in the equipment, for it did a remarkable amount of work in a minimum of time.

Captain Davis oversaw the unloading operations on the ship, carried out by the crew and some of the land team under the guidance of the ship's officers. Wild managed the transport to the shore, and the unloading, sorting, and safe storage of the different boat loads. Gillies and Bickerton took turns driving the motor launch. The launch was incredibly useful, and we were really glad that it had been part of the equipment, as it completed a lot of work in a short amount of time.

In view of the difficulty of embarking the boats, if another hurricane should arise, tents were erected ashore, so that a party could remain there with the boats moored in a sheltered harbour.

In light of the challenge of getting on the boats, if another hurricane were to hit, tents were set up on land, allowing a group to stay there with the boats docked in a protected harbor.

Everything went well until just before midnight on January 12, when the wind again swept down. Wild, four of the men and I were forced to remain ashore. We spent the time constructing a temporary hut of benzine cases, roofed with planks; the walls of which were made massive to resist the winds. This structure was henceforth known as the "Benzine Hut".

Everything went smoothly until just before midnight on January 12, when the wind picked up again. Wild, four of the men and I had to stay on land. We used that time to build a temporary shelter out of benzine cases, topped with planks; the walls were made strong to withstand the winds. This structure was thereafter called the "Benzine Hut."

The barometer dropped to 28.5 inches and the wind remained high. We were struck with the singular fact that, even in the height of some of these hurricanes, the sky remained serene and the sun shone brightly. It had been very different when the ship was amongst the pack a few miles to the north, for, there, cloudy and foggy conditions had been the rule. The wind coming to us from the south was dry; obviously an argument for the continental extension of the land in that direction.

The barometer dropped to 28.5 inches, and the wind stayed strong. We were struck by the unusual fact that, even during some of these hurricanes, the sky looked calm and the sun shone brightly. It had been quite different when the ship was among the pack a few miles to the north, where cloudy and foggy conditions were the norm. The wind coming from the south was dry; clearly, it suggested that the land extended in that direction.

At 2 A.M. on January 15 a pre-arranged whistle was sounded from the 'Aurora', advising those of us ashore that the sea had moderated sufficiently to continue unloading. Wild sped away in the launch, but before he had reached the ship the wind renewed its activity. At last, after 2 P.M. on the same day it ceased, and we were able to carry on work until midnight, when the wind descended on us once more. This time, eighteen men remained ashore. After twelve hours there was another lull, and unloading was then continued with only a few intermissions from 1 P.M. on January 16 until the afternoon of January 19.

At 2 A.M. on January 15, a pre-arranged whistle sounded from the 'Aurora', letting us onshore know that the sea had calmed enough to continue unloading. Wild took off in the launch, but by the time he reached the ship, the wind picked up again. Finally, after 2 P.M. that same day, the wind died down, and we were able to work until midnight when the wind came back. This time, eighteen men stayed onshore. After twelve hours, there was another lull, and we continued unloading with only a few breaks from 1 P.M. on January 16 until the afternoon of January 19.

Never was landing so hampered by adverse conditions, and yet, thanks to the assiduous application of all, a great assortment of materials was safely embarked. Comprised among them were the following: twenty-three tons of coal briquettes, two complete living-huts, a magnetic observatory, the whole of the wireless equipment, including masts, and more than two thousand packages of general supplies containing sufficient food for two years, utensils, instruments, benzine, kerosene, lubricating oils an air-tractor and other sledges.

Never had landing been so complicated by bad conditions, and yet, due to everyone's hard work, a wide variety of materials was safely loaded on board. These included: twenty-three tons of coal briquettes, two complete living huts, a magnetic observatory, all the wireless equipment, including masts, and more than two thousand packages of general supplies containing enough food for two years, utensils, instruments, gasoline, kerosene, lubricating oils, an air tractor, and other sledges.

Then came the time for parting. There was a great field before Wild's party to the west, and it was important that they should be able to make the most of the remainder of the season. My great regret was that I could not be with them. I knew that I had men of experience and ability in Davis and Wild, and felt that the work entrusted to them was in the best of hands. Through the medium of wireless telegraphy I hoped to keep in touch with the Macquarie Island party, the Western Base,** and the ship itself, when in Australian waters.

Then it was time to say goodbye. There was a vast field ahead for Wild's team to the west, and it was crucial for them to make the most of the rest of the season. I really wished I could be there with them. I knew I had experienced and skilled men in Davis and Wild, and I felt confident that the tasks assigned to them were in good hands. Through wireless communication, I hoped to stay connected with the Macquarie Island team, the Western Base,** and the ship itself when it was in Australian waters.

     ** They were supplied with masts and a receiving set sufficiently
sensitive to pick up messages from a distance of five or six hundred
miles.
     ** They were provided with masts and a receiving set that was sensitive enough to pick up messages from as far away as five or six hundred miles.

It was my idea that Wild's party should proceed west and attempt to effect a landing and establish a western wintering station at some place not less than four hundred miles west of Adelie Land. On the way, whenever opportunity presented itself, they were to cache provisions at intervals along the coast in places liable to be visited by sledging parties.

It was my idea that Wild's party should head west and try to land and set up a winter base at a location no less than four hundred miles west of Adelie Land. Along the way, whenever possible, they were to store provisions at intervals along the coast in spots likely to be visited by sledging teams.

The location of such caches and of the Western Base, it was hoped, would be communicated to us at the Main Base, through the medium of wireless telegraphy from Hobart.

The location of these caches and the Western Base was expected to be communicated to us at the Main Base via wireless telegraphy from Hobart.

All members of the land parties and the ship's officers met in the ward-room. There were mutual good wishes expressed all round, and then we celebrated previous Antarctic explorers, more especially D'Urville and Wilkes. The toast was drunk in excellent Madeira presented to us by Mr. J. T. Buchanan, who had carried this sample round the world with him when a member of the celebrated 'Challenger' expedition.

All members of the land teams and the ship's officers gathered in the ward-room. Everyone exchanged warm wishes, and then we honored past Antarctic explorers, especially D'Urville and Wilkes. We toasted with some excellent Madeira that Mr. J. T. Buchanan brought, which he had carried around the world when he was part of the famous 'Challenger' expedition.

The motor-launch was hoisted and the anchor raised. Then at 8.45 P.M. on January 19 we clambered over the side into one of the whale-boats and pushed off for Cape Denison, shouting farewells back to the 'Aurora'. Several hours later she had disappeared below the north-western horizon, and we had set to work to carve out a home in Adelie Land.

The motor-launch was lifted, and the anchor was pulled up. Then at 8:45 PM on January 19, we climbed over the side into one of the whale boats and pushed off toward Cape Denison, shouting goodbyes back to the 'Aurora.' A few hours later, it had vanished below the northwestern horizon, and we got to work carving out a home in Adelie Land.





CHAPTER IV NEW LANDS

Leaving the land party under my charge at Commonwealth Bay on the evening of January 19, the 'Aurora' set her course to round a headland visible on the north-western horizon. At midnight the ship came abreast of this point and continued steaming west, keeping within a distance of five miles of the coast. A break in the icy monotony came with a short tract of islets fronting a background of dark rocky coastline similar to that at Cape Denison but more extensive.

Leaving the land party I was in charge of at Commonwealth Bay on the evening of January 19, the 'Aurora' set its course to navigate around a headland visible on the north-western horizon. At midnight, the ship reached this point and continued heading west, staying within five miles of the coast. A brief change from the icy monotony appeared with a short stretch of islets in front of a backdrop of dark rocky coastline that resembled Cape Denison but was more extensive.

Some six miles east of D'Urville's Cape Discovery, a dangerous reef was sighted extending at right angles across the course. The ship steamed along it and her soundings demonstrated a submerged ridge continuing some twelve miles out to sea. Captain Davis's narrative proceeds:

Some six miles east of D'Urville's Cape Discovery, a hazardous reef was spotted stretching directly across the route. The ship moved along it, and her measurements showed a hidden ridge extending about twelve miles out to sea. Captain Davis's account continues:

"Having cleared this obstacle we followed the coastline to the west from point to point. Twelve miles away we could see the snow-covered slopes rising from the seaward cliffs to an elevation of one thousand five hundred feet. Several small islands were visible close to a shore fringed by numerous large bergs.

"After overcoming this hurdle, we followed the coastline to the west from point to point. Twelve miles away, we could see the snow-covered slopes rising from the sea cliffs to a height of one thousand five hundred feet. Several small islands were visible near a shore lined with many large icebergs."

"At 10 P.M. on January 20, our progress to the west was stopped by a fleet of bergs off the mainland and an extensive field of berg-laden pack-ice, trending to the north and north-east. Adelie Land could be traced continuing to the west. Where it disappeared from view there was the appearance of a barrier-formation, suggestive of shelf-ice, running in a northerly direction. Skirting the pack-ice on a north and north-west course, we observed the same appearance from the crow's-nest on January 21 and 22."

"At 10 PM on January 20, our progress west was halted by a fleet of icebergs near the mainland and a large area of pack ice filled with icebergs, extending to the north and north-east. Adelie Land could still be seen stretching westward. Where it went out of sight, there was a formation that looked like a barrier, resembling shelf ice, running northward. As we navigated around the pack ice on a north and north-west course, we noticed the same sight from the crow's-nest on January 21 and 22."

The stretch of open, navigable, coastal water to the north of Adelie Land, barred by the Mertz Glacier on the east and delimited on the west by more or less compact ice, has been named the D'Urville Sea. We found subsequently that its freedom from obstruction by ice is due to the persistent gales which set off the land in that locality. To the north, pack-ice in variable amount is encountered before reaching the wide open ocean.

The open, navigable coastal waters north of Adelie Land, blocked by the Mertz Glacier to the east and bordered by relatively solid ice to the west, have been called the D'Urville Sea. We later discovered that its lack of ice blockage is because of the constant strong winds coming from the land in that area. To the north, you'll find varying amounts of pack ice before reaching the vast open ocean.

The existence of such a "barrier-formation,"** as indicated above, probably resting on a line of reef similar to the one near Cape Discovery, would account for the presence of this ice-field in practically the same position as it was seen by D'Urville in 1840.

The existence of this "barrier-formation," as mentioned earlier, likely rests on a line of reef similar to the one near Cape Discovery, which would explain why this ice field is found in almost the same location as it was observed by D'Urville in 1840.

     ** An analysis of the data derived from the later voyages of the
'Aurora' makes it practically certain that there is a permanent obstacle
to the westerly drift of the pack-ice in longitude 137 degrees E. There
is, however, some uncertainty as to the cause of this blockage. An
alternative explanation is advanced, namely, that within the area
of comparatively shallow water, large bergs are entrapped, and these
entangle the drifting pack-ice.
     ** An analysis of the data from the later voyages of the 'Aurora' makes it highly likely that there is a permanent barrier preventing the pack-ice from drifting west at longitude 137 degrees E. However, there is some uncertainty about the cause of this blockage. Another possible explanation is that large icebergs get stuck in the area of relatively shallow water, which then entangle the drifting pack-ice.

At a distance, large bergs would be undistinguishable from shelf-ice, appearances of which were reported above.

At a distance, big icebergs would look just like shelf ice, as mentioned earlier.

Quoting further: "We were unable to see any trace of the high land reported by the United States Squadron (1840) as lying to the west and south beyond the compact ice.

Quoting further: "We couldn't find any sign of the high land mentioned by the United States Squadron (1840) that was said to be located to the west and south past the thick ice.

"At 1.30 A.M. on the 23rd the pack-ice was seen to trend to the south-west. After steaming west for twenty-five miles, we stood south in longitude 182 degrees 30' E, shortly afterwards passing over the charted position of Cote Clarie. The water here was clear of pack-ice, but studded with bergs of immense size. The great barrier which the French ships followed in 1840 had vanished. A collection of huge bergs was the sole remnant to mark its former position.

"At 1:30 A.M. on the 23rd, we noticed that the pack-ice was moving to the southwest. After heading west for twenty-five miles, we turned south at longitude 182 degrees 30' E, and soon passed over the mapped location of Cote Clarie. The water here was free of pack-ice but dotted with massive icebergs. The large barrier that the French ships sailed along in 1840 was gone. A cluster of gigantic icebergs was the only reminder of its previous location."

"At 10 A.M., having passed to the south of the charted position of D'Urville's Cote Clarie, we altered course to S. 10 degrees E. true. Good observations placed us at noon in latitude 65 degrees 2' S. and 132 degrees 26' E. A sounding on sand and small stones was taken in one hundred and sixty fathoms. We sailed over the charted position of land east of Wilkes's Cape Carr in clear weather.

At 10 A.M., after going south of the marked location of D'Urville's Cote Clarie, we changed our course to S. 10 degrees E. true. Accurate observations put us at noon at a latitude of 65 degrees 2' S. and 132 degrees 26' E. We took a soundings on sand and small stones at a depth of one hundred and sixty fathoms. We sailed over the marked position of land east of Wilkes's Cape Carr in clear weather.

"At 5.30 P.M. land was sighted to the southward—snowy highlands similar to those of Adelie Land but greater in elevation.

"At 5:30 PM, land was spotted to the south—snowy highlands similar to those of Adelie Land but taller."

"After sounding in one hundred and fifty-six fathoms on mud, the ship stood directly towards the land until 9 P.M. The distance to the nearest point was estimated at twenty miles; heavy floe-ice extending from our position, latitude 65 degrees 45' S. and longitude 132 degrees 40' E., right up to the shore. Another sounding realized two hundred and thirty fathoms, on sand and small stones. Some open water was seen to the south-east, but an attempt to force a passage in that direction was frustrated.

"After measuring a depth of one hundred and fifty-six fathoms in mud, the ship headed straight for the land until 9 P.M. The nearest point was estimated to be twenty miles away, with thick floating ice extending from our position at latitude 65 degrees 45' S and longitude 132 degrees 40' E, all the way to the shore. Another measurement showed a depth of two hundred and thirty fathoms in sand and small stones. Some open water was spotted to the south-east, but our attempt to navigate in that direction was unsuccessful."

"At 3 A.M. on the 24th we were about twelve miles from the nearest point of the coast, and further progress became impossible. The southern slopes were seamed with numerous crevasses, but at a distance the precise nature of the shores could not be accurately determined."

"At 3 A.M. on the 24th, we were about twelve miles from the closest point on the coast, and moving forward became impossible. The southern slopes were marked with many crevasses, but from a distance, the exact nature of the shores couldn't be clearly identified."

To this country, which had never before been seen, was given the name of Wilkes's Land; as it is only just to commemorate the American Exploring Expedition on the Continent which its leader believed he had discovered in these seas and which he would have found had Fortune favoured him with a fair return for his heroic endeavours.

To this country, which had never been seen before, was given the name Wilkes's Land; as it is only right to honor the American Exploring Expedition on the continent that its leader believed he had discovered in these seas and which he would have found if luck had favored him with a fair outcome for his heroic efforts.

"We steered round on a north-westerly course, and at noon on January 24 were slightly to the north of our position at 5.30 A.M. on the 23rd. A sounding reached one hundred and seventy fathoms and a muddy bottom. Environing us were enormous bergs of every kind, one hundred and eighty to two hundred feet in height. During the afternoon a westerly course was maintained in clear water until 4 P.M., when the course was altered to S. 30 degrees W., in the hope of winning through to the land visible on the southern horizon."

"We turned onto a north-west course, and at noon on January 24, we were slightly north of where we were at 5:30 A.M. on the 23rd. We took a measurement that reached one hundred and seventy fathoms to a muddy bottom. Surrounding us were massive icebergs of all shapes, ranging from one hundred eighty to two hundred feet tall. In the afternoon, we continued heading west in clear water until 4 P.M., when we changed our course to S. 30 degrees W., hoping to reach the land we could see on the southern horizon."

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Ship's tracks in the vicinity of Totten's Land and North's Land

Ship's trails near Totten's Land and North's Land

At 8 P.M. the sky was very clear to the southward, and the land could be traced to a great distance until it faded in the south-west. But the ship had come up with the solid floe-ice once more, and had to give way and steam along its edge. This floating breakwater held us off and frustrated all attempts to reach the goal which we sought.

At 8 PM, the sky was clear to the south, and we could see the land stretching far away until it disappeared in the southwest. But the ship had encountered the solid pack ice again, forcing us to go around and steam along its edge. This floating barrier kept us at bay and thwarted all our attempts to reach our desired destination.

"The next four days was a period of violent gales and heavy seas which drove the ship some distance to the north. Nothing was visible through swirling clouds of snow. The 'Aurora' behaved admirably, as she invariably does in heavy weather. The main pack was encountered on January 29, but foggy weather prevailed. It was not until noon on January 31 that the atmosphere was sufficiently clear to obtain good observations. The ship was by this time in the midst of heavy floe in the vicinity of longitude 119 degrees E., and again the course had swung round to south. We had soon passed to the south of Balleny's Sabrina Land without any indication of its existence. Considering the doubtful character of the statements justifying its appearance on the chart, it is not surprising that we did not verify them.

The next four days were filled with violent winds and rough seas that pushed the ship further north. Visibility was nonexistent due to swirling snow. The 'Aurora' performed incredibly well, as it always does in bad weather. We encountered the main ice pack on January 29, but foggy conditions persisted. It wasn't until noon on January 31 that the weather cleared enough for reliable observations. By then, the ship was surrounded by thick ice near longitude 119 degrees E., and once again, our course had turned south. We soon passed south of Balleny's Sabrina Land without any sign of it. Given the questionable nature of the claims justifying its presence on the map, it's not surprising we couldn't confirm its existence.

"At 11 A.M. the floes were found too heavy for further advance. The ship was made fast to a big one and a large quantity of ice was taken on board to replenish the fresh-water supply. A tank of two hundred gallons' capacity, heated within by a steam coil from the engineroom, stood on the poop deck. Into this ice was continuously fed, flowing away as it melted into the main tanks in the bottom of the ship.

"At 11 A.M., the ice floes were too thick to move forward. The ship was secured to a large floe, and a significant amount of ice was brought on board to refill the fresh-water supply. A 200-gallon tank, heated inside by a steam coil from the engine room, was located on the poop deck. Ice was continuously added to this tank, with the melted water flowing down into the main tanks at the bottom of the ship."

"At noon the weather was clear, but nothing could be discerned in the south except a faint blue line on the horizon. It may have been a 'lead' of water, an effect of mirage, or even land-ice—in any case we could not approach it."

"At noon, the weather was clear, but nothing could be seen in the south except a faint blue line on the horizon. It could have been a stretch of water, a mirage, or even ice—regardless, we couldn't get any closer."

The position as indicated by the noon observations placed the ship within seven miles of a portion of Totten's High Land in Wilkes's charts. As high land would have been visible at a great distance, it is clear that Totten's High Land either does not exist or is situated a considerable distance from its charted location. A sounding was made in three hundred and forty fathoms.

The noon observations showed that the ship was within seven miles of an area marked as Totten's High Land on Wilkes's charts. Since high land would be visible from far away, it’s evident that Totten's High Land either isn’t there or is much farther away than its marked spot. A depth measurement was taken at three hundred and forty fathoms.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Ship's track in the vicinity of Knox Land and Budd Land

Ship's route near Knox Land and Budd Land

Towards evening the 'Aurora' turned back to open water and cruised along the pack-ice. A sounding next day showed nine hundred and twenty-seven fathoms.

Towards evening, the 'Aurora' headed back to open water and sailed along the pack ice. A depth measurement the next day showed nine hundred and twenty-seven fathoms.

It was about this time that a marked improvement was noted in the compass. Ever since the first approach to Adelie Land it had been found unreliable, for, on account of the proximity to the magnetic pole, the directive force of the needle was so slight that very large local variations were experienced.

It was around this time that a significant improvement was observed in the compass. Ever since the initial approach to Adelie Land, it had been unreliable because, due to its closeness to the magnetic pole, the needle's directive force was so weak that it experienced very large local variations.

The longitude of Wilkes's Knox Land was now approaching. With the exception of Adelie Land, the account by Wilkes concerning Knox Land is more convincing than any other of his statements relating to new Antarctic land. If they had not already disembarked, we had hoped to land the western party in that neighbourhood. It was, therefore, most disappointing when impenetrable ice blocked the way, before Wilkes's "farthest south" in that locality had been reached. Three determined efforts were made to find a weak spot, but each time the 'Aurora' was forced to retreat, and the third time was extricated only with great difficulty. In latitude 65 degrees 5' S. longitude 107 degrees 20' E., a sounding of three hundred fathoms was made on a rocky bottom. This sounding pointed to the probability of land within sixty miles.

The longitude of Wilkes's Knox Land was now close. Other than Adelie Land, Wilkes's account of Knox Land is more convincing than any of his other claims about new Antarctic territory. If they hadn’t already disembarked, we hoped to land the western party nearby. It was, therefore, really disappointing when impenetrable ice blocked the way before reaching Wilkes's "farthest south" in that area. We made three serious attempts to find a weak spot, but each time the 'Aurora' had to pull back, and the third time it was only freed with great difficulty. At latitude 65 degrees 5' S, longitude 107 degrees 20' E, we took a sounding of three hundred fathoms on a rocky bottom. This sounding suggested that land was likely within sixty miles.

Repulsed from his attack on the pack, Captain Davis set out westward towards the charted position of Termination Land, and in following the trend of the ice was forced a long way to the north.

Repelled from his assault on the pack, Captain Davis headed west toward the marked location of Termination Land, and while following the ice's direction, he was pushed significantly northward.

At 7.40 A.M., February 8, in foggy weather, the ice-cliff of floating shelf-ice was met. This was disposed so as to point in a north-westerly direction and it was late in the day before the ship doubled its northern end. Here the sounding wire ran out for eight hundred and fifty fathoms without reaching bottom. Following the wall towards the south-south-east, it was interesting at 5.30 P.M. to find a sounding of one hundred and ten fathoms in latitude 64 degrees 45'. A line of large grounded bergs and massive floe-ice was observed ahead trailing away from the ice-wall towards the north-west.

At 7:40 A.M. on February 8, in foggy weather, we encountered the ice cliff of floating shelf ice. It was oriented in a northwesterly direction, and it wasn't until later in the day that the ship rounded its northern end. Here, the sounding wire extended for eight hundred and fifty fathoms without hitting the bottom. As we followed the wall south-southeast, it was fascinating to get a sounding of one hundred and ten fathoms at 5:30 P.M. in latitude 64 degrees 45'. Ahead, we observed a line of large grounded icebergs and massive floe ice stretching northwest away from the ice wall.

On plotting the observations, it became apparent that the shelf-ice was in the form of a prolonged tongue some seven miles in breadth. As it occupied the position of the "Termination Land" which has appeared on some charts, (after Wilkes) it was named Termination Ice-Tongue.

On mapping the observations, it became clear that the shelf ice was shaped like a long tongue, about seven miles wide. Since it was located where "Termination Land" is shown on some charts (after Wilkes), it was named Termination Ice-Tongue.

A blizzard sprang up, and, after it had been safely weathered in the lee of some grounded bergs, the 'Aurora' moved off on the afternoon of February 11. The horizon was obscured by mist, as she pursued a tortuous track amongst bergs and scattered lumps of heavy floe. Gradually the sea became more open, and by noon on February 12 the water had deepened to two hundred and thirty-five fathoms. Good progress was made to the south; the vessel dodging icebergs and detached floes.

A blizzard hit, and after safely waiting it out by some grounded icebergs, the 'Aurora' set off on the afternoon of February 11. The horizon was hidden by mist as the ship followed a winding path among icebergs and scattered blocks of heavy pack ice. Gradually, the sea opened up more, and by noon on February 12, the water depth reached two hundred and thirty-five fathoms. The ship made good progress south, avoiding icebergs and detached floes.

The discovery of a comparatively open sea southward of the main pack was a matter of some moment. As later voyages and the observations of the Western Party showed, this tract of sea is a permanent feature of the neighbourhood. I have called it the Davis Sea, after the captain of the 'Aurora', in appreciation of the fact that he placed it on the chart.

The discovery of a relatively open sea south of the main pack was significant. As later trips and observations from the Western Party revealed, this body of water is a constant part of the area. I've named it the Davis Sea, after the captain of the 'Aurora', to acknowledge his role in including it on the map.

At noon, on February 13, in latitude 65 degrees 54 1/2' S. longitude 94 degrees 25' E., the western face of a long, floating ice-tongue loomed into view. There were five hundred fathoms of water off its extremity, and the cliffs rose vertically to one hundred feet. Soon afterwards land was clearly defined low in the south extending to east and west. This was thenceforth known as Queen Mary Land.

At noon on February 13, at a latitude of 65 degrees 54 1/2' S and a longitude of 94 degrees 25' E, the western side of a long, floating ice tongue came into view. There were five hundred fathoms of water at its tip, and the cliffs rose straight up to a height of one hundred feet. Shortly after, land was clearly visible to the south, stretching out to the east and west. This area would later be known as Queen Mary Land.

The sphere of operations of the German expedition of 1902 was near at hand, for its vessel, the 'Gauss', had wintered, frozen in the pack, one hundred and twenty-five miles to the west. It appeared probable that Queen Mary Land would be found to be continuous** with Kaiser Wilhelm II Land, which the Germans had reached by a sledging journey from their ship across the intervening sea-ice.

The area of operation for the German expedition in 1902 was close by, as their ship, the 'Gauss', had spent the winter trapped in the ice, just one hundred and twenty-five miles to the west. It seemed likely that Queen Mary Land would be connected with Kaiser Wilhelm II Land, which the Germans had reached by sledging across the sea ice from their ship.

     ** Such was eventually proved to be the case.
     ** That turned out to be true.

The 'Aurora' followed the western side of the ice-tongue for about twenty miles in a southerly direction, at which point there was a white expanse of floe extending right up to the land. Wild and Kennedy, walking several miles towards the land, estimated that it was about twenty-five miles distant. As the surface over which they travelled was traversed by cracks and liable to drift away to sea, all projects of landing there had to be abandoned; furthermore, it was discovered that the ice-tongue, alongside of which the ship lay, was a huge iceberg. A landing on it had been contemplated, but was now out of question.

The 'Aurora' followed the western edge of the ice-tongue for about twenty miles to the south, where there was a white stretch of ice floe reaching all the way to the land. Wild and Kennedy, walking several miles towards the land, estimated it was about twenty-five miles away. Since the surface they traveled over was cracked and could easily drift out to sea, all plans for landing there had to be scrapped; additionally, it turned out that the ice-tongue the ship was next to was actually a massive iceberg. A landing on it had been considered, but that was no longer an option.

The main difficulty which arose at this juncture was the failing coal-supply. It was high time to return to Hobart, and, if a western base was to be formed at all, Wild's party would have to be landed without further delay. After a consultation, Davis and Wild decided that under the circumstances an attempt should be made to gain a footing on the adjacent shelf-ice, if nothing better presented itself.

The main problem that came up at this point was the dwindling coal supply. It was time to head back to Hobart, and if a western base was going to be established at all, Wild's group would need to be landed without any further delay. After discussing it, Davis and Wild agreed that, given the situation, they should try to secure a position on the nearby shelf ice if no better options came up.

The night was passed anchored to the floe, on the edge of which were numerous Emperor penguins and Weddell seals. A fresh south-easterly wind blew on February 14, and the ship was kept in the shelter of the iceberg. During the day enormous pieces were observed to be continually breaking away from the berg and drifting to leeward.

The night was spent anchored to the ice floe, where there were many Emperor penguins and Weddell seals on the edge. A strong southeast wind blew on February 14, and the ship stayed sheltered by the iceberg. Throughout the day, huge chunks were seen constantly breaking off from the iceberg and drifting away.

Captain Davis continues: "At midnight there was a strong swell from the north-east and the temperature went down to 18 degrees F. At 4 A.M., February 15, we reached the northern end of the berg and stood first of all to the east, and then later to the south-east.

Captain Davis continues: "At midnight, there was a strong swell coming from the north-east, and the temperature dropped to 18 degrees F. At 4 A.M. on February 15, we reached the northern end of the iceberg and initially headed east, and then later to the south-east.

"At 8.45 A.M., shelf-ice was observed from aloft, trending approximately north and south in a long wall. At noon we came up with the floe-ice again, in about the same latitude as on the western side of the long iceberg. Land could be seen to the southward. At 1 P.M. the ship stopped at the junction of the floe and the shelf-ice."

"At 8:45 A.M., we spotted some shelf ice from above, stretching roughly north and south in a long wall. By noon, we reached the floe ice again, roughly at the same latitude as the western side of the long iceberg. Land was visible to the south. At 1 P.M., the ship came to a stop at the point where the floe and shelf ice met."

Wild, Harrison and Hoadley went to examine the shelf-ice with a view to its suitability for a wintering station. The cliff was eighty to one hundred feet in height, so that the ice in total thickness must have attained at least as much as six hundred feet. Assisted by snow-ramps slanting down on to the floe, the ascent with ice-axes and alpine rope was fairly easy.

Wild, Harrison, and Hoadley went to check out the shelf ice to see if it would be good for a wintering station. The cliff was eighty to one hundred feet tall, so the total thickness of the ice must have been at least six hundred feet. With snow ramps sloping down onto the floe, the climb with ice axes and alpine rope was fairly easy.

Two hundred yards from the brink, the shelf-ice was thrown into pressure-undulations and fissured by crevasses, but beyond that was apparently sound and unbroken. About seventeen miles to the south the rising slopes of ice-mantled land were visible, fading away to the far east and west.

Two hundred yards from the edge, the shelf ice was pushed into pressure undulations and cracked with crevasses, but beyond that, it looked solid and unbroken. About seventeen miles to the south, the rising slopes of ice-covered land could be seen, tapering off to the far east and west.

The ice-shelf was proved later on to extend for two hundred miles from east to west, ostensibly fusing with the Termination Ice-Tongue, whose extremity is one hundred and eighty miles to the north. The whole has been called the Shackleton Ice-Shelf.

The ice shelf was later shown to stretch two hundred miles from east to west, seemingly merging with the Termination Ice Tongue, whose end is one hundred and eighty miles to the north. This entire area has been named the Shackleton Ice Shelf.

Wild and his party unanimously agreed to seize upon this last opportunity, and to winter on the floating ice.

Wild and his group all agreed to take this last chance and spend the winter on the floating ice.

The work of discharging stores was at once commenced. To raise the packages from the floe to the top of the ice-shelf, a "flying-fox" was rigged.

The process of unloading supplies started immediately. To lift the packages from the ice floe to the top of the ice shelf, a "flying-fox" was set up.

"A kedge-anchor was buried in the sea-ice, and from this a two-and-a-half-inch wire-hawser was led upwards over a pair of sheer-legs on top of the cliff to another anchor buried some distance back. The whole was set taut by a tackle. The stores were then slung to a travelling pulley on the wire, and hauled on to the glacier by means of a rope led through a second pulley on the sheer-legs. The ship's company broke stores out of the hold and sledged them three hundred yards to the foot of an aerial, where they were hooked on to the travelling-block by which the shore party, under Wild, raised them to their destination."

A kedge anchor was buried in the sea ice, and from this, a two-and-a-half-inch wire cable was run up over a pair of sheer legs at the top of the cliff to another anchor buried some distance back. Everything was tightened with a tackle. The supplies were then attached to a moving pulley on the wire and pulled onto the glacier using a rope that went through a second pulley on the sheer legs. The ship's crew took supplies out of the hold and sledged them three hundred yards to the base of a hoist, where they were connected to the moving block that the shore team, led by Wild, used to raise them to their destination.

"It was most important to accelerate the landing as much as possible, not only on account of the lateness of the season—the 'Gauss' had been frozen in on February 22 at a spot only one hundred and seventy miles away—but because the floe was gradually breaking up and floating away. When the last load was hoisted, the water was lapping within ten yards of the 'flying-fox'".

"It was crucial to speed up the landing as much as possible, not only because the season was getting late—the 'Gauss' had been stuck in ice on February 22 just one hundred seventy miles away—but also because the floe was slowly breaking apart and drifting away. When the final load was lifted, the water was lapping within ten yards of the 'flying-fox'."

A fresh west-north-west wind on February 17 caused some trouble. Captain Davis writes:

A new west-northwest wind on February 17 created some issues. Captain Davis writes:

"February 19. The floe to which we have been attached is covered by a foot of water. The ship has been bumping a good deal to-day. Notwithstanding the keen wind and driving snow, every one has worked well. Twelve tons of coal were the last item to go up the cliff."

"February 19. The ice sheet we’re attached to is covered by a foot of water. The ship has been bumping a lot today. Despite the biting wind and heavy snow, everyone has worked hard. Twelve tons of coal were the last thing to be hauled up the cliff."

In all, thirty-six tons of stores were raised on to the shelf-ice, one hundred feet above sea-level, in four days.

In total, thirty-six tons of supplies were lifted onto the shelf ice, a hundred feet above sea level, in four days.

"February 20. The weather is very fine and quite a contrast to yesterday. We did not get the coal ashore a moment too soon, as this morning the ice marked by our sledge tracks went to sea in a north-westerly direction, and this afternoon it is drifting back as if under the influence of a tide or current. We sail at 7 A.M. to-morrow.

"February 20. The weather is great today, a big change from yesterday. We didn't unload the coal ashore a second too soon, since this morning the ice marked by our sledge tracks moved out to sea in a north-westerly direction, and this afternoon it’s drifting back as if pulled by a tide or current. We're sailing at 7 A.M. tomorrow."

"I went on to the glacier with Wild during the afternoon. It is somewhat crevassed for about two hundred yards inland, and then a flat surface stretches away as far as the eye can see. I wished the party 'God-speed' this evening, as we sail early to-morrow."

"I went to the glacier with Wild in the afternoon. It’s pretty crevassed for about two hundred yards inland, and then a flat surface extends as far as the eye can see. I wished the group 'God-speed' this evening, as we set sail early tomorrow."

Early on February 21, the ship's company gave their hearty farewell cheers, and the 'Aurora' sailed north, leaving Wild and his seven companions on the floating ice.

Early on February 21, the ship's crew shouted their enthusiastic goodbyes, and the 'Aurora' headed north, leaving Wild and his seven companions on the drifting ice.

The bright weather of the immediate coastal region was soon exchanged for the foggy gloom of the pack.

The clear weather of the nearby coast was quickly replaced by the foggy gloom of the pack.

"February 21, 11 P.M. We are now passing a line of grounded bergs and some heavy floe-ice. Fortunately it is calm, but in the darkness it is difficult to see an opening. The weather is getting thick, and I expect we shall have trouble in working through this line of bergs.

"February 21, 11 P.M. We are currently going past a line of frozen icebergs and some thick pack ice. Luckily, it's calm, but it's hard to spot an opening in the dark. The weather is getting worse, and I think we'll have difficulty navigating through this line of icebergs."

"February 22. I cannot explain how we managed to clear some of the bergs between 11 P.M. last night and 3 A.M. this morning. At first stopping and lying-to was tried, but it was soon evident that the big bergs were moving and would soon hem us in: probably in a position from which we should be unable to extricate ourselves this season.

"February 22. I can't explain how we managed to get through some of the icebergs between 11 P.M. last night and 3 A.M. this morning. At first, we tried stopping and just drifting, but it quickly became clear that the large icebergs were shifting and would soon trap us in a spot from which we might not be able to escape this season."

"So we pushed this way and that, endeavouring to retain freedom at any cost. For instance, about midnight I was 'starboarding' to clear what appeared to be the loom of a berg on the starboard bow, when, suddenly, out of the haze a wall seemed to stretch across our course. There was no room to turn, so 'full speed astern' was the only alternative. The engines responded immediately, or we must have crashed right into a huge berg. Until daylight it was ice ahead, to port and to starboard—ice everywhere all the time. The absence of wind saved us from disaster. It was a great relief when day broke, showing clearer water to the northward."

"So we moved this way and that, trying to keep our freedom at any cost. For example, around midnight I was steering to the right to avoid what looked like the outline of an iceberg on the starboard side when, out of the fog, a wall seemed to block our path. There was no room to turn, so we had no choice but to go full speed in reverse. The engines reacted immediately, or we would have crashed straight into a massive iceberg. Until sunrise, it was ice ahead, to the left and to the right—ice everywhere all the time. The lack of wind saved us from disaster. It was such a relief when morning came, revealing clearer water to the north."

On February 23, the 'Aurora' left the shelter of Termination Ice-Tongue, and a course was set nearly true north. There was a fresh breeze from the north-east and a high sea. The ship was desperately short of ballast and the coal had to be carefully husbanded. All movable gear was placed in the bottom of the ship, while the ashes were saved, wetted and put below. The ballast-tanks were found to be leaking and Gillies had considerable trouble in making them watertight.

On February 23, the 'Aurora' left the protection of Termination Ice-Tongue, setting a course almost due north. There was a fresh breeze coming from the northeast and the sea was rough. The ship was seriously lacking in ballast, so the coal had to be used sparingly. All movable equipment was stored in the bottom of the ship, and the ashes were saved, dampened, and put below. The ballast tanks were leaking, and Gillies had a lot of trouble making them watertight.

The distance from the Western Base in Queen Mary Land to Hobart was two thousand three hundred miles, through the turbulent seas of the fifties and forties. It was the end of a perilous voyage when the 'Aurora' arrived in Hobart with nine tons of coal.

The distance from the Western Base in Queen Mary Land to Hobart was two thousand three hundred miles, through the stormy seas of the fifties and forties. It marked the end of a risky journey when the 'Aurora' reached Hobart with nine tons of coal.

On March 12, the captain's log records:

On March 12, the captain's log says:

"The 'Aurora' has done splendidly, beating all attempts of the weather to turn her over. We had two heavy gales during the first week of March, but reached Hobart safely to-day, passing on our way up the Derwent the famous Polar ship, 'Fram', at anchor in Sandy Bay. Flags were dipped and a hearty cheer given for Captain Amundsen and his gallant comrades who had raised the siege of the South Pole."

"The 'Aurora' has performed remarkably well, overcoming all the challenges posed by the weather. We faced two strong storms during the first week of March, but we safely arrived in Hobart today, passing the famous Polar ship, 'Fram', anchored in Sandy Bay as we made our way up the Derwent. We dipped our flags and gave a big cheer for Captain Amundsen and his brave crew who had successfully completed their mission at the South Pole."





CHAPTER V FIRST DAYS IN ADELIE LAND

The overcrowded whale-boat disgorged its cargo at 10 P.M. on the ice-quay at Cape Denison. The only shelter was a cluster of four tents and the Benzine Hut, so the first consideration was the erection of a commodious living-hut.

The overcrowded whale boat unloaded its cargo at 10 PM on the ice quay at Cape Denison. The only shelter was a group of four tents and the Benzine Hut, so the first priority was to set up a spacious living hut.

While the majority retired to rest to be ready for a fresh burst of work on the morrow, a few of us discussed the preliminary details, and struck the first blows in the laying of the foundations.

While most people went to rest to prepare for a new day of work tomorrow, a few of us talked about the initial details and took the first steps in laying the foundations.

A site for the living-hut was finally approved. This was a nearly flat piece of rocky ground of just sufficient size, partially sheltered on the southern side by a large upstanding rock. Other points to recommend it were, proximity to the boat harbour and to a good sledging surface; the ice of the glacier extending to the "front door" on the western side. Several large rocks had to be shifted, and difficulty was anticipated in the firm setting of the stumps. The latter were blocks of wood, three feet in length, embedded in the ground, forming the foundation of the structure. Unfortunately, no such thing as earth or gravel existed in which to sink these posts, and the rock being of the variety known as gneiss, was more than ordinarily tough.

A location for the living hut was finally approved. It was a nearly flat stretch of rocky ground that was just big enough, partially sheltered on the southern side by a large upright rock. Other advantages included being close to the boat harbor and a good sledding surface; the ice from the glacier extended right to the "front door" on the western side. Several large rocks needed to be moved, and there was expected to be difficulty in securely setting the stumps. These were blocks of wood, three feet long, embedded in the ground to serve as the foundation for the structure. Unfortunately, there was no earth or gravel available to sink these posts into, and the rock, which was gneiss, was particularly tough.

Since two parties had combined, there were two huts available, and these were to be erected so that the smaller adjoined and was in the lee of the larger. The latter was to be the living-room; the former serving as a vestibule, a workshop and an engine-room for the wireless plant. Slight modifications were made in the construction of both huts, but these did not affect the framework. After the completion of the living-hut, regular scientific observations were to commence, and the smaller hut was then to be built as opportunity offered.

Since two groups had come together, there were two huts available, and they were to be set up so that the smaller one was attached to and sheltered by the larger one. The larger hut would serve as the living room, while the smaller one would act as an entrance area, a workshop, and a control room for the wireless equipment. Minor changes were made to the design of both huts, but these didn't alter the basic structure. Once the living hut was finished, regular scientific observations were set to begin, and the smaller hut would be built as time allowed.

Nothing has so far been said about the type of hut adopted by our Antarctic stations. As the subject is important, and we had expended much thought thereon before coming to a final decision, a few remarks will not be out of place.

Nothing has been said so far about the type of hut used by our Antarctic stations. Since this topic is important and we put a lot of thought into it before reaching a final decision, a few comments are in order.

Strength to resist hurricanes, simplicity of construction, portability and resistance to external cold were fundamental. My first idea was to have the huts in the form of pyramids on a square base, to ensure stability in heavy winds and with a large floor-area to reduce the amount of timber used. The final type was designed at the expense of floor-space, which would have been of little use because of the low roof in the parts thus eliminated. In this form, the pyramid extended to within five feet of the ground on the three windward sides so as to include an outside veranda. That veranda, like the motor-launch, was a wonderful convenience, and another of the many things of which we made full use. It lent stability to the structure, assisted to keep the hut warm, served as a store-house, physical laboratory and a dogshelter.

Strength to withstand hurricanes, easy construction, portability, and resistance to cold weather were essential. My first idea was to build the huts in the shape of pyramids on a square base to ensure stability in strong winds and provide a large floor area to minimize the amount of timber used. The final design sacrificed some floor space, which wouldn't have been very useful due to the low roof in the areas that were eliminated. In this design, the pyramid reached within five feet of the ground on the three sides facing the wind, allowing for an outside veranda. That veranda, like the motorboat, was incredibly convenient and one of the many features we fully utilized. It provided stability to the structure, helped keep the hut warm, and served as a storage area, a physical lab, and a shelter for the dogs.

Round the outside of the three veranda walls boxes of stores were stacked, so as to continue the roof-slope to the ground. Thus, the wind striking the hut met no vertical face, but was partly deflected; the other force-component tending to pin the building to the ground.

Around the outside of the three veranda walls, stacks of boxes were arranged to extend the roof slope down to the ground. This way, when the wind hit the hut, it didn't hit a straight vertical wall but was partially deflected, helping to keep the building anchored to the ground.

All three huts were essentially of the same construction. The largest, on account of its breadth, had four special supporting posts, symmetrically placed near the centre, stretching from the ground to the roof framework. The only subdivisions inside were a small vestibule, a photographic darkroom and my own room. This rough idea I had handed over to Hodgeman, leaving him to complete the details and to draw up the plans. The frame timbers he employed were stronger than usual in a building of the size, and were all securely bolted together. The walls and roof, both inside and outside, were of tongued and grooved pine-boards, made extra wind-proof by two courses of tarred paper. As rain was not expected, this roofing was sufficient. There were four windows in the roof, one on each side of the pyramid. We should thereby get light even though almost buried in snow.

All three huts were basically built the same way. The largest one, because of its width, had four special support posts, placed symmetrically near the center, extending from the ground to the roof frame. The only divisions inside were a small entryway, a photographic darkroom, and my own room. I had given this rough idea to Hodgeman, leaving him to finish the details and create the plans. The frame timbers he used were stronger than usual for a building of this size and were all securely bolted together. The walls and roof, both inside and out, were made of tongue-and-groove pine boards, made extra windproof with two layers of tarred paper. Since rain was not expected, this roofing was adequate. There were four windows in the roof, one on each side of the pyramid, allowing us to get light even if we were almost buried in snow.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Below is a short piece of text (5 words or fewer). Modernize it into contemporary English if there's enough context, but do not add or omit any information. If context is insufficient, return it unchanged. Do not add commentary, and do not modify any placeholders. If you see placeholders of the form __A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_x__, you must keep them exactly as-is so they can be replaced with links.

Plan of the hut, Adelie Land

Plan of the hut, Adelie Land

The largest hut was presented by the timber merchants of Sydney, and proved its astonishing strength during the winter hurricanes. The smallest was purchased in Adelaide, the third was built and presented by Messrs. Anthony of Melbourne.

The biggest hut was provided by the timber merchants in Sydney and demonstrated its impressive strength during the winter storms. The smallest one was bought in Adelaide, and the third was constructed and donated by Messrs. Anthony from Melbourne.

On the morning of January 20 all were at work betimes. As we were securely isolated from a trades hall, our hours of labour ranged from 7 A.M. till 11 P.M.

On the morning of January 20, everyone was up and working early. Since we were completely cut off from a trades hall, our work hours were from 7 A.M. to 11 P.M.

Dynamite was to be used for blasting out the holes for the reception of the stumps, and so the steel rock-drills were unpacked and boring commenced. This was easier than it appeared, because the rock was much traversed by cracks. By the end of the day a good deal of damage had been done to the rock, at the expense of a few sore fingers and wrists caused by the sledge-hammers missing the drills. The work was tedious, for water introduced into the holes had a habit of freezing. The metal drills, too, tended to be brittle in the cold and required to be tempered softer than usual. Hannam operated the forge, and picks and drills were sent along for pointing; an outcrop of gneiss serving as an anvil.

Dynamite would be used to blast holes for the stumps, so they unpacked the steel rock-drills and started boring. This was easier than it looked because the rock was crisscrossed with cracks. By the end of the day, they had made a lot of progress on the rock, though a few sore fingers and wrists were the result of mis-hitting the drills with the sledgehammers. The work was slow, as water that got into the holes would freeze. The metal drills also became brittle in the cold, so they needed to be tempered softer than usual. Hannam ran the forge, and they sent picks and drills for sharpening, using a gneiss outcrop as an anvil.

Among other things it was found difficult to fire the charges, for, when frozen, dynamite is not readily exploded. This was overcome by carrying the sticks inside one's pocket until the last moment. In the absence of earth or clay, we had no tamping material until some one suggested guano from the penguin rookeries, which proved a great success.

Among other things, it was difficult to set off the charges because frozen dynamite doesn’t easily explode. This was solved by keeping the sticks in one’s pocket until the last moment. Since we didn’t have earth or clay, we lacked tamping material until someone suggested using guano from the penguin rookeries, which turned out to be a great success.

Next day the stumps were in place; most of them being fixed by wedges and other devices. Cement was tried, but it is doubtful if any good came of it, for the low temperature did not encourage it to set well. By the evening, the bottom plates were laid on and bolted to the tops of the stumps, and everything was ready for the superstructure.

The next day, the stumps were set up; most of them secured with wedges and other tools. They tried using cement, but it’s questionable whether it helped because the cold temperature didn’t allow it to set properly. By evening, the bottom plates were positioned on top of the stumps and bolted down, and everything was ready for the superstructure.

On January 22, while some were busy with the floor-joists and wall-frames, others carried boulders from the neighbouring moraine, filling in the whole space between the stumps. These were eventually embedded in a mass of boulders, as much as three feet deep in places. By the time both huts were erected, nearly fifty tons of stones had been used in the foundations—a circumstance we did not regret at a later date.

On January 22, while some people were working on the floor joists and wall frames, others were hauling boulders from the nearby moraine to fill the entire area between the stumps. These boulders eventually became part of a thick layer, about three feet deep in some spots. By the time both huts were built, nearly fifty tons of stones had been used in the foundations—a choice we didn't regret later on.

Hodgeman was appointed clerk of works on the construction, and was kept unusually busy selecting timber, patrolling among the workmen, and searching for his foot-rule which had an unaccountable trick of vanishing in thin air.

Hodgeman was hired as the clerk of works for the construction and was kept unusually busy choosing timber, checking in with the workers, and looking for his tape measure, which had an inexplicable habit of disappearing into thin air.

Hannam had various occupations, but one was to attend to the needs of the inner man, until the completion of the hut. There is no doubt that he was regarded at this time as the most important and popular member of the party, for our appetites were abnormally good. About an hour before meals he was to be seen rummaging amongst the cases of provisions, selecting tins of various brands and hues from the great confusion. However remote their source or diverse their colour, experience taught us that only one preparation would emerge from the tent-kitchen. It was a multifarious stew. Its good quality was undoubted, for a few minutes after the "dinner-bell rang" there was not a particle left. The "dinner-bell" was a lusty shout from the master cook, which was re-echoed by the brawny mob who rushed madly to the Benzine Hut. Plates and mugs were seized and portions measured out, while the diners distributed themselves on odd boxes lying about on the ice. Many who were accustomed to restaurants built tables of kerosene cases and dined al fresco. After the limited stew, the company fared on cocoa, biscuits—"hard tack"—and jam, all ad libitum.

Hannam had various jobs, but one of them was to take care of the needs of the group until the hut was finished. There’s no doubt that at this time he was seen as the most important and popular member of the team, since we all had huge appetites. About an hour before meals, you could see him going through the cases of food, picking out cans of different brands and colors from the big mess. No matter where they came from or how different they looked, we knew from experience that there would only be one dish coming from the tent kitchen. It was a mixed stew. Its quality was definitely on point, because just a few minutes after the "dinner bell rang," there was nothing left. The "dinner bell" was a loud shout from the head cook, which was echoed by the strong crowd who rushed eagerly to the Benzine Hut. Plates and mugs were quickly grabbed and portions served up, while the diners spread themselves out on random boxes lying on the ice. Many who were used to restaurants made tables out of kerosene cases and enjoyed their meals outside. After the limited stew, the group had cocoa, biscuits—"hard tack"—and jam, all they wanted.

On those rare summer days, the sun blazed down on the blue ice; skua gulls nestled in groups on the snow; sly penguins waddled along to inspect the building operations; seals basked in torpid slumber on the shore; out on the sapphire bay the milk-white bergs floated in the swell. We can all paint our own picture of the good times round the Benzine Hut. We worked hard, ate heartily and enjoyed life.

On those rare summer days, the sun beat down on the blue ice; skua gulls gathered in groups on the snow; sneaky penguins waddled by to check out the construction work; seals basked lazily on the shore; and out on the sparkling bay, the white icebergs floated in the waves. We can all imagine our own memories of the good times at the Benzine Hut. We worked hard, ate well, and enjoyed life.

By the evening of January 24 the floor and outside walls were finished, and the roof-frame was in position. Work on the roof was the coldest job of all, for now there was rarely an hour free from a cold breeze, at times reaching the velocity of a gale. This came directly down from the plateau, and to sit with exposed fingers handling hammer and nails was not an enviable job. To add to our troubles, the boards were all badly warped from being continually wet with sea-water on the voyage. However, by judicious "gadgetting," as the phrase went, they were got into place.

By the evening of January 24, the floor and outside walls were done, and the roof frame was in place. Working on the roof was the coldest job of all because there was hardly an hour without a cold breeze, sometimes reaching the strength of a gale. This wind came straight down from the plateau, and trying to work with exposed hands handling hammers and nails was not a desirable task. To make things worse, the boards were all badly warped from being soaked with seawater during the trip. However, with some clever "gadgetting," as people called it, they were managed to be put into place.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Sections across the hut, Adelie Land

Sections across the hut, Adelie Land

The windward roof was up on January 25, and several of us camped in sleeping-bags under its shelter. Already Hannam had unpacked the large range and put the parts together in the kitchen. Henceforth the cooking operations were simplified, for previously a sledging-cooker had been used.

The windward roof went up on January 25, and several of us set up camp in sleeping bags underneath it. By then, Hannam had already unpacked the large range and assembled the pieces in the kitchen. From that point on, cooking became much easier since we no longer had to use a sledging cooker.

Mention of the stove recalls a very cold episode. It happened that while our goods were being lifted from the boats to the landing-stage, a case had fallen into the harbour. When the parts of the stove were being assembled, several important items were found to be missing, and it was thought that they might compose the contents of the unknown case lying in the kelp at the bottom of the bay.

Mention of the stove brings to mind a very chilly moment. It happened that while our things were being moved from the boats to the landing stage, a case fell into the harbor. When the stove parts were being put together, several important pieces were missing, and it was believed that they might be in the unknown case resting in the kelp at the bottom of the bay.

Laseron and I went on board the whale-boat one day at low water, and located the box with a pole, but though we used several devices with hooks, we were unable to get hold of it. At last I went in, and, standing on tip-toe, could just reach it and keep my head above water. It took some time to extricate from the kelp, following which I established a new record for myself in dressing. The case turned out to be full of jam, and we had to make a new search for the missing parts. I do not think I looked very exhilarated after that bath, but strange to say, a few days later Correll tried an early morning swim which was the last voluntary dip attempted by any one.

Laseron and I boarded the whale boat one day at low tide and used a pole to locate the box, but despite trying several hook devices, we couldn’t grab it. Finally, I went in and, standing on tiptoe, just managed to reach it while keeping my head above water. It took a while to get it out of the kelp, after which I set a personal record for getting dressed. The case turned out to be full of jam, and we had to search again for the missing parts. I don’t think I looked very cheerful after that swim, but strangely, a few days later, Correll tried an early morning swim, which turned out to be the last voluntary dip anyone attempted.

The enthusiasm of the builders rose to its highest pitch as the roof neared completion, and we came in sight of a firm and solid habitation, secure from the winds which harassed us daily. A dozen hammers worked at once, each concentrated upon a specific job. The ardour with which those engaged upon the ceiling inside the hut plied their nails resulted in several minor casualties to those sitting on the roof, deeply intent on the outer lining. A climax was reached when McLean, working on the steeply inclined roof, lost his footing and, in passing, seized hold of the wire-stay of the chimney as a last hope. Alas, that was the only stay, and as he proceeded over the end of the roof into a bank of snow, Ninnis, within the hut, convinced that nothing less than a cyclone had struck the building, gallantly held on to the lower hot section amidst a shower of soot.

The builders' excitement peaked as the roof was almost finished, and we could finally see a strong and sturdy home, safe from the winds that troubled us every day. A dozen hammers were hammering away, each focused on a specific task. The intensity with which those working on the ceiling inside the hut swung their nails caused several minor injuries to those sitting on the roof, completely focused on the outer covering. The moment hit a high point when McLean, working on the steep roof, lost his balance and, as a last resort, grabbed the wire support of the chimney. Unfortunately, that was the only support, and as he slid off the roof and landed in a pile of snow, Ninnis, inside the hut, thinking that nothing less than a cyclone had hit the building, bravely held on to the lower hot section amid a shower of soot.

Everybody was in the best of spirits, and things went ahead merrily. On January 30 the main building was almost completed, and all slept under its roof. Bunks had been constructed, forming a double tier around three sides of the room. For the first time since coming ashore we retired to sleep in blankets; fur sleeping-bags had been previously used. That night the sky which had been clear for a fortnight banked up with nimbus cloud, and Murphy, who was sleeping under a gap in the roof, woke up next morning to find over him a fine counterpane of snow. He received hearty congratulations all round.

Everybody was in high spirits, and things were moving along happily. On January 30, the main building was almost finished, and everyone slept under its roof. Bunks were built, creating a double layer around three sides of the room. For the first time since arriving, we went to sleep in blankets; we had previously used fur sleeping bags. That night, the sky, which had been clear for two weeks, filled with thick clouds, and Murphy, who was sleeping under a gap in the roof, woke up the next morning to find a lovely layer of snow over him. He received warm congratulations from everyone.

Regular meteorological observations began on February 1. The various instruments had been unpacked as soon as the outer shell of the Hut was completed. The barometer and barograph were kept running inside. Outside there were two large screens for the reception of a number of the instruments. It was important to erect these as near the Hut as possible. The standard thermometer, thermograph and hygrograph were to occupy one of the screens, a convenient site for which was chosen about twenty yards to the east. Close by there was also a nephoscope for determining the motion of clouds. The immediate vicinity of the Hut, being a gully-like depression, was unsuitable for the wind and sunshine recorders. A more distant site, on a rocky ridge to the east, was chosen for these. There were set up a recording anemometer (wind-velocity meter), a sunshine-meter and the second screen containing the anemograph (wind-direction recorder).

Regular weather observations started on February 1. The various instruments were unpacked as soon as the outer shell of the Hut was finished. The barometer and barograph were kept running inside. Outside, there were two large screens for several instruments. It was important to place these as close to the Hut as possible. The standard thermometer, thermograph, and hygrograph were set up on one of the screens, with a good location chosen about twenty yards to the east. Nearby, there was also a nephoscope to track cloud movement. The area around the Hut, being a gully-like dip, wasn’t suitable for the wind and sunshine recorders. A more distant location on a rocky ridge to the east was selected for these. There, a recording anemometer (wind-velocity meter), a sunshine meter, and the second screen containing the anemograph (wind-direction recorder) were installed.

Madigan was to take charge of the meteorological observations and he, assisted by Ninnis and Mertz, erected the two screens and mounted the instruments. Special care was taken to secure the screens against violent winds. Phosphor-bronze wire-stays, with a breaking strength of one ton, were used, attached to billets of wood driven into fissures in the rock. Strong as these wires were, several breakages had to be replaced during the year.

Madigan was in charge of the weather observations, and with help from Ninnis and Mertz, he set up the two screens and installed the instruments. They took special care to secure the screens against strong winds. They used phosphor-bronze wire stays, which could withstand a breaking strength of one ton, attached to wooden blocks driven into cracks in the rock. Despite the strength of these wires, several had to be replaced throughout the year.

Webb was busy with the magnetic work. For this two huts were to be erected; the first for "absolute" determinations, the second for housing the recording instruments—the magnetographs. Distant sites, away from the magnetic disturbances of the Hut, were chosen. Webb and Stillwell immediately set to work as soon as they could be spared from the main building. For the "absolute hut" there were only scrap materials available; the "magnetograph house," alone, had been brought complete. They had a chilly job, for as the days went by the weather steadily became worse. Yet in a little over a week there were only the finishing touches to make, and the first observations were started.

Webb was busy with the magnetic project. Two huts needed to be built; the first for "absolute" measurements, and the second to house the recording instruments—the magnetographs. They chose distant locations, away from the magnetic interference of the main Hut. Webb and Stillwell got to work as soon as they could leave the main building. They only had scrap materials for the "absolute hut"; the "magnetograph house" had been delivered in full. It was a tough job, especially as the weather got worse day by day. However, in just over a week, they were only a few final touches away from completion, and the first observations began.

It was now necessary to institute a routine of nightwatchmen, cooks and messmen. The night-watchman's duties included periodic meteorological observations, attention to the fire in the range, and other miscellaneous duties arising between the hours of 8 P.M. and 8 A. M. The cook prepared the meals, and the messman of the day rendered any assistance necessary. A rotation was adopted, so arranged that those most actively engaged in scientific observations were least saddled with domestic duties. Thus each contributed his equivalent share of work.

It was now necessary to set up a routine for night watchmen, cooks, and messengers. The night watchman's duties included regular weather observations, monitoring the fire in the stove, and handling various tasks that came up between 8 P.M. and 8 A.M. The cook made the meals, and the messenger of the day provided any needed help. They established a rotation that ensured those most involved in scientific observations had the lightest load when it came to domestic chores. This way, everyone contributed their fair share of work.

Whilst others were occupied finishing off the interior of the hut, Whetter and Close sledged the cases of stores across from the landing-stage, classified them and stacked them against the veranda walls. An additional barricade was constructed of flour cases, in the form of a wall, which increased the breadth of the rocky break-wind on the southern side.

While others were busy finishing the inside of the hut, Whetter and Close dragged the supply cases from the landing stage, sorted them out, and stacked them against the veranda walls. They also built an extra barricade using flour cases, creating a wall that widened the rocky windbreak on the southern side.

Murphy, who was in charge of all the stores, saw that a good stock of food was accessible in the veranda. Here he put up shelves and unpacked cases, so that samples of everything were at hand on the shortest notice. Liquids liable to freeze and burst their bottles were taken into the Hut.

Murphy, who was in charge of all the stores, noticed that there was a good supply of food available on the veranda. He set up shelves there and unpacked boxes so that samples of everything were easily accessible at a moment’s notice. Liquids that could freeze and break their bottles were moved into the Hut.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

The vicinity of the main base, Adelie Land

The area around the main base, Adelie Land

Already we had several times seized the opportunity of a calm hour to take out the whale-boat and assist Hunter to set traps and make a few hauls with the hand-dredge. Even in five fathoms, bright red and brown star-fish had been caught in the trap, as well as numerous specimens of a common Antarctic fish known as 'Notothenia'. In ten fathoms and over the results were better, though in no case was the catch so abundant as one would expect from the amount of life in the water. The luxuriant kelp probably interfered with the proper working of the traps. Fish of the same species as the above were caught on a hand-line.

We had already taken several calm moments to bring out the whale boat and help Hunter set traps and make some catches with the hand dredge. Even in five fathoms, we managed to catch bright red and brown starfish in the trap, along with many examples of a common Antarctic fish called 'Notothenia'. In ten fathoms and deeper, the results improved, but the catches were still not as plentiful as we would expect given the amount of life in the water. The lush kelp likely affected how well the traps worked. Fish of the same species as mentioned before were caught on a hand line.

Hunter, our biologist, was very unfortunate in crushing some of his fingers while carrying a heavy case. This accident came at a time when he had just recovered from a severe strain of the knee-joint which he suffered during our activities in the Queen's Wharf shed at Hobart. Several of us were just going out to the traps one afternoon when the casualty occurred. Hunter was very anxious to go, so we waited until McLean had sewn up a couple of his fingertips.

Hunter, our biologist, was really unfortunate when he crushed some of his fingers while carrying a heavy case. This accident happened right after he had recovered from a bad knee strain he got during our work at the Queen's Wharf shed in Hobart. A few of us were about to head out to check the traps one afternoon when the incident occurred. Hunter was eager to go, so we waited while McLean stitched up a couple of his fingertips.

Weddell, and with them occasional crab-eater seals, were at this time always to be found in numbers sleeping on the ice-foot around the boat harbour. It appeared as if we would have plenty of meat throughout the year, so I waited until the building was completed before laying in a stock. The penguins, however, were diminishing in numbers fast and the young birds in the rookeries had grown very large and were beginning to migrate to warmer regions. Several parties, therefore, raided them and secured some hundreds for the winter.

Weddell seals, along with some crab-eater seals, were usually found in large numbers resting on the ice near the boat harbor. It looked like we would have plenty of meat for the whole year, so I decided to wait until the building was finished before stocking up. However, the penguin population was declining quickly, and the young birds in the rookeries had grown quite large and were starting to head to warmer areas. As a result, several groups went after them and collected hundreds to prepare for the winter.

Giant petrels and skua gulls swarmed in flocks round the seals' and penguins' carcases. These scavengers demolish an incredible amount of meat and blubber in a short time. It is a diabolical sight to witness a group of birds tearing out the viscera of a seal, dancing the while with wings outspread.

Giant petrels and skua gulls swarmed in flocks around the seals' and penguins' carcasses. These scavengers take down a huge amount of meat and blubber in no time. It's a shocking sight to see a group of birds ripping apart a seal's insides, all the while flapping their wings.

During the afternoon of February 11 Webb came in with the news that a sea elephant was making its way over the rocks near the shore. We rushed out in time to see it standing over Johnson, one of the dogs, who, true to his name, did not look abashed. Attracted by more formidable antagonists, the monster left Johnson and came towards us. He was a fair-sized male with a good skin, so we shot him before he had time to get back into the sea. His measurements were seventeen feet six inches in length and twelve feet in maximum circumference.

During the afternoon of February 11, Webb came in with the news that a sea elephant was making its way over the rocks near the shore. We rushed out just in time to see it standing over Johnson, one of the dogs, who, true to his name, didn’t look embarrassed at all. Drawn by more formidable challengers, the creature left Johnson and came towards us. He was a decent-sized male with a good hide, so we shot him before he could make it back into the sea. His measurements were seventeen feet six inches long and twelve feet at the widest point.

With the temperature well below freezing-point, skinning is cold work in the wind, and must be done before the animal has time to freeze stiff. A number of us set to work flaying. In order to move the mountain of flesh a Westing purchase and a "handy-billy" (rope and block purchase) had to be rigged. It was several hours before everything was disposed of; the skin and skull for the biological collection and the meat and blubber for the dogs. Ninnis and Mertz, who were the wardens of the dogs, cut up about one ton of meat and blubber, and stored it as a winter reserve for their charges.

With the temperature well below freezing, skinning is really tough in the wind, and it has to be done before the animal has a chance to freeze solid. A group of us started working on the skinning. To move the massive amount of flesh, we had to set up a Westing purchase and a "handy-billy" (which is a rope and block purchase). It took several hours to get rid of everything; the skin and skull went to the biological collection, while the meat and blubber were saved for the dogs. Ninnis and Mertz, who were in charge of the dogs, cut up about a ton of meat and blubber and stored it as a winter reserve for their animals.

It may be mentioned that sea elephants are sub-antarctic in distribution, and only rarely have these animals been observed on the shores of the Antarctic continent. As far as I am aware, the only other occasion of such an occurrence was noted by Captain Scott in MacMurdo Sound. Wilkes reported many of them on the pack-ice to the north of the Balleny Islands, so possibly they have a stronghold in that vicinity.

It should be noted that sea elephants are found in sub-Antarctic regions, and these animals have only been seen on the shores of the Antarctic continent on rare occasions. As far as I know, the only other time this happened was recorded by Captain Scott in McMurdo Sound. Wilkes reported many of them on the pack ice north of the Balleny Islands, so they might have a strong presence in that area.

The dogs, ever since their arrival ashore, had been chained up on the rocks below the Hut. The continuous wind worried them a good deal, but they had a substantial offset to the cold in a plentiful supply of seal-meat. On the whole, they were in a much better condition then when they left the 'Aurora'. Nineteen in all, they had an odd assemblage of names, which seemed to grow into them until nothing else was so suitable: Basilisk, Betli, Caruso, Castor, Franklin, Fusilier, Gadget, George, Ginger, Ginger Bitch, Grandmother, Haldane, Jappy, John Bull, Johnson, Mary, Pavlova, Scott and Shackleton. Grandmother would have been better known as Grandfather. He was said to have a grandmotherly appearance; that is why he received the former name. The head dog was Basilisk, and next to him came Shackleton.

The dogs, since they arrived on shore, had been tied up on the rocks below the Hut. The constant wind made them quite anxious, but they had plenty of seal meat to keep them warm. Overall, they were in much better shape than when they left the 'Aurora'. There were nineteen of them, each with unique names that seemed to fit them perfectly: Basilisk, Betli, Caruso, Castor, Franklin, Fusilier, Gadget, George, Ginger, Ginger Bitch, Grandmother, Haldane, Jappy, John Bull, Johnson, Mary, Pavlova, Scott, and Shackleton. Grandmother would have been more accurately called Grandfather. He was said to have a grandmotherly look, which is why he got that name. The lead dog was Basilisk, followed closely by Shackleton.

Early in February, after having experienced nothing but a succession of gales for nearly a month, I was driven to conclude that the average local weather must be much more windy than in any other part of Antarctica. The conditions were not at all favourable for sledging, which I had hoped to commence as soon as the Hut was completed. Now that the time had arrived and the weather was still adverse, it seemed clear that our first duty was to see everything snug for the winter before making an attempt.

Early in February, after dealing with nothing but a series of storms for almost a month, I had to conclude that the average weather here was likely windier than in any other part of Antarctica. The conditions were not at all good for sledging, which I had hoped to start as soon as the Hut was finished. Now that the time had come and the weather was still unfavorable, it was clear that our first priority was to make sure everything was secure for the winter before trying to head out.

Hannam, assisted by Bickerton, Madigan and others, had laid heavy and firm foundations for the petrol-motor and generator. The floor of the smaller room was then built around these bed-plates, and last of all came the walls and roof. Murphy, Bage and Hodgeman were chiefly responsible for the last-named, which was practically completed by February 10. Minor additions and modifications were added after that date. Meanwhile, Hannam continued to unpack and mount the instruments forming the wireless plants. Along one wall and portion of another, in the outer hut, a bench was built for mechanical work and for scientific purposes. This was in future to be the work-room.

Hannam, with help from Bickerton, Madigan, and others, laid strong foundations for the petrol motor and generator. They then constructed the floor of the smaller room around these base plates, and finally, they put up the walls and roof. Murphy, Bage, and Hodgeman were mainly responsible for the latter, which was nearly finished by February 10. Some minor additions and changes were made after that date. Meanwhile, Hannam continued to unpack and set up the instruments for the wireless plants. Along one wall and part of another in the outer hut, they built a bench for mechanical work and scientific purposes. This would become the workroom moving forward.

Our home had attained to a stage of complex perfection. To penetrate to the inside hut, the stranger reverently steps through a hole in the snow to the veranda, then by way of a vestibule with an inner and outer door he has invaded the privacy of the work-room, from which with fear and trembling he passes by a third door into the sanctum sanctorum. Later, when the snow-tunnel system came into vogue, the place became another Labyrinth of Minos.

Our home had reached a level of complex perfection. To enter the inside hut, the stranger carefully steps through a hole in the snow to the veranda, then goes through a vestibule with an inner and outer door to invade the privacy of the workroom, from which, with fear and trembling, he passes through a third door into the inner sanctum. Later, when the snow-tunnel system became popular, the place turned into another Labyrinth of Minos.

The three doors were fitted with springs to keep them shut unless they were jammed open for ventilation, which was at once obtained by opening an aperture in the cooking-range flue. A current of air would then circulate through the open doors. The roof windows were immovable and sealed on the inside by a thick accumulation of ice. An officer of public health, unacquainted with the climate of Adelie Land, would be inclined to regard the absence of more adequate ventilation as a serious omission. It would enlighten him to know that much of our spare time, for a month after the completion of the building, was spent in plugging off draughts which found their way through most unexpected places, urged by a wind-pressure from without of many pounds to the square foot.

The three doors had springs to keep them closed unless they were propped open for ventilation, which was achieved by opening a vent in the cooking-range flue. This would allow air to flow through the open doors. The roof windows were fixed and sealed on the inside by a thick layer of ice. A public health officer, unfamiliar with the climate of Adelie Land, might think that the lack of better ventilation was a serious issue. It would be enlightening for him to know that a lot of our free time for a month after finishing the building was spent sealing drafts that came from the most unexpected spots, pushed by a wind pressure from outside of many pounds per square foot.

Excepting the small portion used as an entrance-porch, the verandas were left without any better flooring than well-trodden snow. In the boarded floor of the porch was a trap-door which led down into a shallow cellar extending under a portion of the work-room. The cellar was a refrigerating chamber for fresh meat and contained fifteen carcases of mutton, besides piles of seal-meat and penguins.

Except for the small area used as an entrance porch, the verandas had no better flooring than well-trodden snow. In the boarded floor of the porch was a trap door that led down into a shallow cellar extending under part of the workroom. The cellar was a refrigeration chamber for fresh meat and contained fifteen carcasses of mutton, along with stacks of seal meat and penguins.

In preparation for our contemplated sledging, masts, spars and sails were fitted to some of the sledges, rations were prepared and alterations made to harness and clothing. Soon a sledge stood packed, ready to set out on the first fine day.

In preparation for our planned sledding, masts, poles, and sails were attached to some of the sledges, supplies were prepared, and adjustments were made to the harness and clothing. Soon a sledge was packed and ready to leave on the first nice day.

For several days in succession, about the middle of February, the otherwise continuous wind fell off to a calm for several hours in the evening. On those occasions Mertz gave us some fine exhibitions of skiing, of which art he was a consummate master. Skis had been provided for every one, in case we should have to traverse a country where the snow lay soft and deep. From the outset, there was little chance of that being the case in wind-scoured Adelie Land. Nevertheless, most of the men seized the few opportunities we had to become more practiced in their use. My final opinion, however, was that if we had all been experts like Mertz, we could have used them with advantage from time to time.

For several days in a row, around the middle of February, the usually constant wind calmed down for a few hours in the evening. During those times, Mertz put on some impressive skiing displays, as he was a true master of the sport. Skis had been provided for everyone, in case we needed to cross an area with soft, deep snow. From the start, it seemed unlikely that would happen in the wind-swept Adelie Land. Still, most of the guys took advantage of the few chances we had to practice using them. In the end, though, I felt that if we had all been experts like Mertz, we could have made better use of the skis from time to time.

The end of February approached. We were fully prepared for sledging, and were looking forward to it with great expectation. The wind still continued, often rising to the force of a hurricane, and was mostly accompanied by snow.

The end of February was coming up. We were totally ready for sledding and were excited about it. The wind kept blowing, often hitting hurricane strength, and was mostly bringing snow along with it.

One evening, when we were all at dinner, there was a sudden noise which drowned the rush of the blizzard. It was found that several sledges had been blown away from their position to the south of the Hut, striking the building as they passed. They were all rescued except one, which had already reached the sea and was travelling rapidly toward Australia.

One evening, while we were all having dinner, there was a loud noise that overpowered the sound of the blizzard. It turned out that several sledges had been blown from their spot south of the Hut, colliding with the building as they went by. We managed to rescue all of them except one, which had already made it to the sea and was speeding towards Australia.

Mertz, Bage and I had taken advantage of a lull to ascend the ice-slope to the south, and to erect a flag-pole at a distance of two miles. Besides being a beacon for sledging parties, it was used for ablation measurements. These were determinations of the annual wasting of the ice-surface, whether by evaporation, melting, or wind-abrasion.

Mertz, Bage, and I took advantage of a break in the weather to climb the ice slope to the south and set up a flagpole two miles away. Besides serving as a marker for sledding teams, it was also used for measuring ablation. These measurements helped us determine how much the ice surface decreased each year, whether from evaporation, melting, or wind abrasion.

Webb and Stillwell, assisted by others, had commenced to build the Magnetograph House. Dr. Chree, of the British National Physical Laboratory, had arranged that the German Antarctic Expedition, several observatories in low latitudes and our own Expedition, should take special "quick runs," synchronously, twice each month. A "quick run" was a continuous, careful observation made over a period of two hours, on a more searching time-scale then usual. Until the Magnetograph House was established this could not be done efficiently, and so the construction of this hut was pushed on as quickly as possible.

Webb and Stillwell, along with others, had started building the Magnetograph House. Dr. Chree from the British National Physical Laboratory had organized for the German Antarctic Expedition, several observatories in low latitudes, and our own Expedition to perform special "quick runs" twice a month in sync. A "quick run" was a continuous and careful observation conducted over two hours, using a more detailed time scale than usual. Until the Magnetograph House was completed, this couldn't be done efficiently, so the construction of the hut was prioritized and expedited.

Many other schemes required our attention, and there was not a spare moment for any one. Though we chafed at the delay in sledging, there was some consolation in the fact that the scientific programme was daily becoming more and more complete.

Many other plans needed our attention, and there wasn't a moment to spare for anyone. Although we felt frustrated by the delay in sledging, it was somewhat reassuring that the scientific program was becoming increasingly complete each day.





CHAPTER VI AUTUMN PROSPECTS

As far as we could see, the inland ice was an unbroken plateau with no natural landmarks. From the hinterland in a vast solid stream the ice flowed, with heavily crevassed downfalls near the coast. Traversing this from north to south was a narrow belt, reasonably free from pitfalls, running as a spur down to the sea. To reach the Hut in safety it would be necessary for sledging parties returning from the interior to descend by this highway. The problem was to locate the path. Determinations of latitude and longitude would guide them to the neighbourhood of Commonwealth Bay, but the coastline in the vicinity of Winter Quarters, with the rocks and islets, would not come into view until within two miles, as above that point the icy slopes filled the foreground up to the distant berg-studded horizon. Delays in reaching the Hut owing to the difficult descent might have serious consequences, for provisions are usually short near the conclusion of a sledging journey.

As far as we could see, the inland ice was a continuous plateau with no natural landmarks. From the interior, a massive solid stream of ice flowed, with heavily crevassed drops near the coast. Running north to south was a narrow belt, relatively free from hazards, extending down to the sea. To safely reach the Hut, sledding teams coming back from the interior would need to use this route. The challenge was finding the path. Calculations of latitude and longitude would help them get close to Commonwealth Bay, but the coastline around Winter Quarters, with its rocks and islets, wouldn't be visible until they were within two miles. Beyond that point, the icy slopes filled the view up to the distant horizon dotted with icebergs. Delays in reaching the Hut due to the tricky descent could have serious consequences, as supplies are usually low toward the end of a sledding trip.

The necessity of making artificial landmarks was, therefore, most obvious. Already we had a flagstaff two miles to the south. It was now my intention to run a line of similar marks backwards to the plateau.

The need to create artificial landmarks was clearly evident. We already had a flagpole two miles to the south. I now planned to set up a series of similar markers back to the plateau.

Bage, Madigan and I were to form a reconnoitring party to plant these flags, and to make a journey of a few days' duration into the hinterland, to see its possibilities, and with a view to an extended sledging campaign to commence as soon as possible after our return. It was decided not to make use of the dogs until later in the year, when they would be in better form.

Bage, Madigan, and I were going to form a scouting team to set up these flags and take a trip lasting a few days into the interior to explore its potential, planning for a larger sledding expedition to start as soon as we got back. We decided not to use the dogs until later in the year when they would be in better shape.

The wind continued, accompanied by more or less drift-snow. This appeared to be the settled state of the weather. We decided to move out as soon as a moderate phase should occur.

The wind kept blowing, along with some drifting snow. This seemed to be the usual weather pattern. We agreed to head out as soon as there was a bit of a break.

On the afternoon of February 28 the weather cleared up for several hours, and we decided to leave on the following day. The wind resumed operations once more, but fell off late on February 29, when we made a start. We intended to get the packed sledge up the first steep slope, there to leave it until the morrow. The drift was slight and low, flowing along like a stream below our knees. Bickerton, Hurley and Mertz assisted us with the hauling. At a distance of a little more than a mile, at an elevation of five hundred feet, the sledge was anchored and we returned to the Hut for the night.

On the afternoon of February 28, the weather cleared up for a few hours, and we decided to leave the next day. The wind picked up again but died down late on February 29, when we finally set off. We aimed to get the packed sled up the first steep slope and leave it there until tomorrow. The drift was light and low, flowing like a stream beneath our knees. Bickerton, Hurley, and Mertz helped us with the hauling. After traveling just over a mile and climbing five hundred feet, we secured the sled and returned to the Hut for the night.

Next morning the weather cleared still more, and we left just before noon. Three miles out, a mast and flag were erected, when our companions of the day before, who had again assisted us, turned back. At five and a half miles the brow of the main rise was reached, and the gradient became much flatter beyond it. The elevation was found to be one thousand five hundred feet.

Next morning, the weather got even better, and we set off just before noon. Three miles in, a mast and flag were put up, and our friends from the day before, who had helped us again, turned back. At five and a half miles, we reached the top of the main rise, and the slope became much gentler beyond that. The elevation was found to be one thousand five hundred feet.

To the south nothing was visible but a great, wan, icy wilderness. To the north a headland appeared on either hand, each about twenty-five miles away, and between them lay an expanse of sea dotted with many bergs. The nearer portions of the coast, together with the Mackellar Islets, were lost to view on account of the curvature of the foreground.

To the south, there was nothing but a vast, dim, icy wasteland. To the north, a headland was visible on each side, both about twenty-five miles away, and between them stretched a sea scattered with numerous icebergs. The closer parts of the coastline, along with the Mackellar Islets, were out of sight due to the curve of the foreground.

During most of the day we had travelled over a surface of clear ice, marked by occasional scars where fissuring, now healed, had at some time taken place. Beyond the three-mile flag, however, the ice was gashed at frequent intervals, producing irregular crevasses, usually a few yards in length and, for the most part, choked with snow. At five and a half miles we were on the edge of a strip of snow, half a mile across, whose whiteness was thrown in dazzling contrast against the foil of transparent, dark ice.

During most of the day, we traveled over a surface of clear ice, marked by occasional scars where cracks had formed and healed at some point. Beyond the three-mile marker, though, the ice was cut up at regular intervals, creating irregular crevasses, usually a few yards long and mostly filled with snow. At five and a half miles, we reached the edge of a strip of snow, half a mile wide, whose brightness stood out in stunning contrast to the transparent, dark ice.

It was dusk, and light drift commenced to scud by, so, as this was a suitable place to erect a flag, we decided to camp for the night. Some hours later I woke up to hear a blizzard blowing outside, and to find Madigan fumbling amongst some gear at the head-end of the tent. From inside my bag I called out to inquire if there was anything wrong, and received a reply that he was looking for the primus-pricker. Then he slipped back into his sleeping-bag, and all became quiet, except for the snow beating against the tent. So I presumed that he had found it. Revolving the incident in my mind, and dimly wondering what use he could have for a primus-pricker in the middle of the night, I again fell asleep. In the morning the blizzard was still blowing, accompanied by a good deal of drift. On inquiry I found that Madigan knew nothing of his midnight escapade. It was a touch of somnambulism.

It was dusk, and light snow had started to blow by, so since this was a good spot to set up camp, we decided to stay for the night. A few hours later, I woke up to the sound of a blizzard raging outside and saw Madigan rummaging through some gear at the front of the tent. From inside my sleeping bag, I called out to ask if everything was okay, and he replied that he was looking for the primus-pricker. Then he crawled back into his sleeping bag, and everything went quiet except for the snow hitting the tent. So I assumed he had found it. As I thought about the situation, wondering why he would need a primus-pricker in the middle of the night, I fell back asleep. In the morning, the blizzard was still blowing, and there was a lot of snow drifting around. When I asked him, I found out that Madigan had no memory of his late-night adventure. It was a case of sleepwalking.

It would serve no useful purpose to go on in thick drift, for the main object of our journey was to define the best route through the crevassed zone; and that could only be done on a clear day. I decided, accordingly, that if the weather did not improve by noon to leave the sledge with the gear and walk back to the Hut, intending to make another attempt when conditions became more settled.

It wouldn’t help at all to struggle through the heavy snow because the main goal of our trip was to find the best path through the crevassed area, and we could only do that on a clear day. So, I decided that if the weather didn’t get better by noon, I would leave the sled and gear behind and walk back to the Hut, planning to try again when conditions improved.

Whilst the others erected a flagstaff and froze the legs of a drift-proof box (containing a thermograph) into the ice, I made lunch and prepared for our departure. The tent was taken down and everything lashed securely on the sledge.

While the others set up a flagpole and embedded the legs of a drift-proof box (holding a thermograph) into the ice, I made lunch and got ready for our departure. The tent was taken down, and everything was securely tied onto the sled.

It was nearly 3 P.M. when we set out in thick drift, and in two hours we were at the Hut; the weather having steadily improved as we descended. On comparing notes with those at home it appeared that we, at the fifteen hundred feet level, had experienced much more wind and drift than they at sea-level.

It was almost 3 PM when we headed out through the thick snow, and after two hours, we reached the Hut; the weather had consistently gotten better as we descended. Comparing notes with those back home, it seemed that we, at the fifteen hundred feet level, had dealt with a lot more wind and snow than they did at sea level.

Webb and his assistants were beginning to make quite a display at the Magnetograph House. The framework, which had already been erected once, to be demolished by the wind, was now strongly rebuilt and was ready for the outside covering of boards.

Webb and his team were starting to put on quite a show at the Magnetograph House. The structure, which had already been put up once and knocked down by the wind, was now sturdily rebuilt and ready for the outer covering of boards.

From the night of our return to March 8 there was a high wind accompanied by much drift; for some hours it continued at eighty miles per hour, the mean temperature being about 15 degrees F., with a minimum of 5 degrees F.

From the night we got back until March 8, there was a strong wind with a lot of drifting snow; for several hours it blew at eighty miles per hour, with an average temperature of around 15 degrees F., and a low of 5 degrees F.

Up to this date the dogs had been kept on the chain, on account of their depredations amongst the seals and penguins. The severe weather now made it necessary to release them. Thenceforth, their abode for part of the day was inside the veranda, where a section was barricaded-off for their exclusive use. Outside in heavy drift their habit was to take up a position in the lee of some large object, such as the Hut. In such a position they were soon completely buried and oblivious to the outside elements. Thus one would sometimes tread on a dog, hidden beneath the snow; and the dog often showed less surprise than the offending man. What the dogs detested most of all during the blizzard-spells was the drift-snow filling their eyes until they were forced to stop and brush it away frantically with their paws. Other inconveniences were the icy casing which formed from the thawing snow on their thick coats, and the fact that when they lay in one position, especially on ice, for any length of time they become frozen down, and only freed themselves at the expense of tufts of hair. In high winds, accompanied by a low temperature, they were certainly very miserable, unless in some kind of shelter.

Up until now, the dogs had been kept on a chain because they were causing trouble with the seals and penguins. The severe weather made it necessary to let them loose. From then on, they spent part of the day inside the veranda, where a section was blocked off just for them. Outside, in heavy snow drifts, they liked to position themselves behind a large object, like the Hut. In that position, they would soon get completely buried and be unaware of the harsh weather. So, sometimes, someone would accidentally step on a dog hidden under the snow, and the dog often seemed less surprised than the person who stepped on it. What the dogs hated most during blizzard conditions was the snow drifting into their eyes, forcing them to stop and frantically clear it away with their paws. Other issues included the icy layer that formed on their thick fur from the melting snow, and the fact that when they lay in one spot, especially on ice, for too long, they would get frozen in place, and had to pull free at the cost of patches of fur. In strong winds and low temperatures, they were certainly quite miserable unless they had some sort of shelter.

Several families were born at this time, but although we did everything possible for them they all perished, except one; the offspring of Gadget. This puppy was called "Blizzard." It was housed for a while in the veranda and, later on, in the Hangar. Needless to say, Blizzard was a great favourite and much in demand as a pet.

Several families were born during this time, but despite our best efforts, they all unfortunately died, except for one: Gadget's offspring. This puppy was named "Blizzard." It was kept for a while on the veranda and later in the Hangar. Needless to say, Blizzard became a huge favorite and was highly sought after as a pet.

On the night of March 7, Caruso, who had been in poor condition for some time, was found to have a gaping wound around the neck. It was a clean cut, an inch deep and almost a foot in length. The cause was never satisfactorily explained, though a piece of strong string embedded in the wound evidently made the incision. Caruso was brought inside, and, whilst Whetter administered chloroform, McLean sewed up the wound. After careful attention for some days, it healed fairly well, but as the dog's general health was worse, it was deemed advisable to shoot him.

On the night of March 7, Caruso, who had been in bad shape for a while, was found with a deep cut around his neck. It was a clean cut, about an inch deep and almost a foot long. The cause was never clearly explained, but a piece of strong string stuck in the wound seemed to have created the cut. Caruso was brought inside, and while Whetter administered chloroform, McLean stitched up the wound. After careful treatment for several days, it healed reasonably well, but since the dog's overall health had deteriorated, it was decided that it was best to put him down.

The outer shell of the Magnetograph House was nearly completed, affording a protection for those who worked on the interior linings. When completed, the walls and roof consisted of two coverings of tongued and grooved pine boards and three layers of thick tarred paper.

The outer shell of the Magnetograph House was almost finished, providing protection for those working on the interior linings. When it's done, the walls and roof will have two layers of tongue-and-groove pine boards and three layers of heavy tar-paper.

While there still remained a breach in the wall, Hurley repaired there with his cinematograph camera and took a film showing the clouds of drift-snow whirling past. In those days we were not educated in methods of progression against heavy winds; so, in order to get Hurley and his bulky camera back to the Hut, we formed a scrum on the windward side and with a strong "forward" rush beat our formidable opponent.

While there was still a gap in the wall, Hurley set up his cinematograph camera and filmed the swirling clouds of drift-snow. Back then, we weren’t trained in ways to move against strong winds, so to get Hurley and his heavy camera back to the Hut, we formed a group on the side facing the wind and made a strong push to overcome our tough challenge.

On March 8 the blizzard died away and a good day followed. All hands joined in building a solid stone outside of the Magnetograph House. This piece of work, in which thirty tons of rock were utilized, was completed on the following day. The wall reached almost to the roof on every side. The unprotected roof was lagged with sacks and sheep-skins and, after this had been effected, the hut became practically windtight. The external covering controlled the influx of cold from the penetrating winds, and, on the other hand, the conduction of the sun's warmth in summer. Thus a steady temperature was maintained; a most desirable feature in a magnetograph house. Webb had the instruments set up in a few days, and they were working before the end of the month.

On March 8, the blizzard ended, and a beautiful day followed. Everyone helped build a sturdy stone wall outside the Magnetograph House. This project, which used thirty tons of rock, was finished the next day. The wall almost reached the roof on all sides. The exposed roof was covered with sacks and sheep skins, and once that was done, the hut became almost airtight. The outer layer kept the cold winds from coming in while also allowing the sun's warmth to come in during the summer. This kept a consistent temperature, which was essential for the magnetograph house. Webb set up the instruments in a few days, and they were operational before the month was over.

After the calm of March 8, the wind steadily increased and became worse than ever. Madigan, who was in charge of the whale-boat, kept it moored in the boat-harbour under shelter of the ice-foot. An excursion was made to the fish traps, buoyed half a mile off shore, on February 8, and it was found that one had been carried away in the hurricane. The other was brought in very much battered. That night it was decided at the first opportunity to haul up the boat and house it for the winter. Alas! the wind came down again too quickly, increasing in force, with dense drift. It was still in full career on the 12th, when Madigan came in with the news that the boat had disappeared. It was no fault of the rope-attachments for they were securely made and so we were left to conclude that a great mass of ice had broken away from the overhanging shelf and carried everything before it.

After the calm of March 8, the wind picked up steadily and became worse than ever. Madigan, who was in charge of the whale boat, kept it moored in the boat harbor, sheltered by the ice foot. An excursion was made to the fish traps, which were buoyed half a mile off shore, on February 8, and it was discovered that one had been swept away in the hurricane. The other was brought in, quite battered. That night, it was decided that at the first opportunity, they would haul up the boat and store it for the winter. Unfortunately, the wind picked up again too quickly, increasing in strength and bringing dense snow. It was still raging on the 12th when Madigan returned with the news that the boat had vanished. It wasn’t due to the rope attachments, as they were securely fastened, so we had to conclude that a large mass of ice had broken away from the overhanging shelf and swept everything away with it.

The regularity of the high-velocity winds was already recognized as one of the most remarkable features of Adelie Land. By itself such wind would have been bad enough, but, accompanied by dense volumes of drifting snow, it effectually put a stop to most outdoor occupations.

The consistent strong winds were already seen as one of the most notable features of Adelie Land. Just the winds alone would have been bad enough, but when combined with thick clouds of blowing snow, they effectively halted most outdoor activities.

The roof and walls of the veranda being covered with a single layer of tongued and grooved boards, the snow drove through every chink. The cases outside were a partial protection, but the cracks were innumerable, and in the course of twenty-four hours the snow inside had collected in deep drifts. This required to be shovelled out each day or the veranda would have been entirely blocked.

The roof and walls of the porch were covered with a single layer of tongue-and-groove boards, so snow pushed through every crack. The boxes outside offered some protection, but there were countless gaps, and within twenty-four hours, snow had piled up inside in deep drifts. This needed to be shoveled out each day, or the porch would have been completely blocked.

Much time was spent endeavouring to make it drift-tight; but as the materials at our disposal were very limited, the result was never absolutely satisfactory. The small veranda serving as an entrance-porch was deluged with snow which drove in past the canvas doorway. The only way to get over this trouble was to shovel out the accumulations every morning. On one occasion, when Close was nightwatchman, the drift poured through in such volume that each time he wished to go outside it took him half an hour to dig his way out. On account of this periodic influx, the vestibule doorway to the workroom was moved to the other end of the wall, where the invading snow had farther to travel and was consequently less obstructive.

A lot of time was spent trying to make it snow-tight, but since the materials we had were very limited, the outcome was never completely satisfactory. The small porch used as an entrance was flooded with snow that blew in past the canvas door. The only way to deal with this issue was to shovel out the snow every morning. One time, when Close was the nightwatchman, the snow came in so heavily that every time he wanted to go outside, it took him half an hour to dig his way out. Because of this regular influx, the doorway to the workroom was moved to the other end of the wall, where the snow had a longer distance to travel and was therefore less of a problem.

One advantage of the deposit of snow around the Hut was that all draughts were sealed off. Before this happened it was found very difficult to keep the inside temperature up to 40° F. A temperature taken within the Hut varied according to the specific position in reference to the walls and stove. That shown by the thermometer attached to the standard barometer, which was suspended near the centre of the room, was taken as the "hut temperature". Near the floor and walls it was lower, and higher, of course, near the stove. On one occasion, in the early days, I remember the "hut temperature" being 19° F., notwithstanding the heat from the large range. Under these conditions the writing-ink and various solutions all over the place froze, and, when the night-watchman woke up the shivering community he had many clamorous demands to satisfy. The photographer produced an interesting product from the dark room—a transparent cast of a developing-dish in which a photographic plate left overnight to wash was firmly set.

One benefit of the snow piled up around the Hut was that it blocked all drafts. Before this happened, it was very challenging to keep the indoor temperature above 40° F. The temperature inside the Hut varied based on its location relative to the walls and stove. The reading from the thermometer attached to the standard barometer, which hung near the center of the room, was considered the "hut temperature." It was lower near the floor and walls, and of course, higher near the stove. I recall one time, in the early days, when the "hut temperature" was 19° F., despite the warmth from the large stove. In those conditions, the writing ink and various solutions froze all over the place, and when the night watchman woke up the shivering group, he had a lot of noisy requests to handle. The photographer created an interesting item in the darkroom—a clear cast of a developing dish where a photographic plate had been left overnight to wash, now frozen solid.

We arranged to maintain an inside temperature of 40 degrees F.; when it rose to 50 degrees F. means were taken to reduce it. The cooking-range, a large one designed to burn anthracite coal, was the general warming apparatus. To raise the temperature quickly, blocks of seal blubber, of which there was always a supply at hand, were used. The coal consumption averaged one hundred pounds a day, approximately, this being reduced at a later date to seventy-five pounds by employing a special damper for the chimney. The damper designed for ordinary climates allowed too much draught to be sucked through during the high winds which prevailed continually.

We set the indoor temperature to stay at 40°F; when it climbed to 50°F, we took steps to bring it down. The cooking range, a large one made for burning anthracite coal, served as our main heating source. To quickly raise the temperature, we used blocks of seal blubber, which we always had on hand. On average, the coal consumption was around a hundred pounds a day, but this was later reduced to seventy-five pounds by using a special damper for the chimney. The damper designed for typical climates let in too much airflow during the strong winds that were always blowing.

The chimney was fitted with a cowl which had to be specially secured to keep it in place. During heavy drifts the cowl became choked with snow and ice, and the Hut would rapidly fill with smoke until some one, hurriedly donning burberrys, rushed out with an ice-axe to chip an outlet for the draught. The chimney was very short and securely stayed, projecting through the lee side of the roof, where the pressure of the wind was least felt.

The chimney had a cap that needed to be specially secured to stay in place. In heavy snow drifts, the cap would get blocked with snow and ice, causing the Hut to fill up with smoke until someone, quickly putting on their burberrys, ran outside with an ice axe to clear a way for the airflow. The chimney was very short and well-supported, sticking out through the protected side of the roof, where the wind pressure was the least.

The first good display of aurora polaris was witnessed during the evening of March 12, though no doubt there had been other exhibitions obscured by the drift. As the days went by and the equinox drew near, auroral phenomena were with few exceptions visible on clear evenings. In the majority of cases they showed up low in the northern sky.

The first impressive display of the northern lights was seen on the evening of March 12, although there were likely other sightings hidden by the snow. As the days passed and the equinox approached, auroral displays were visible almost every clear evening. Most of the time, they appeared low in the northern sky.

In the midst of a torment of wind, March 15 came as a beautiful, sunny, almost calm day. I remarked in my diary that it was "typical Antarctic weather," thinking of those halcyon days which belong to the climate of the southern shores of the Ross Sea. In Adelie Land, we were destined to find, it was hard to number more than a dozen or two in the year.

In the middle of a fierce windstorm, March 15 arrived as a lovely, sunny, almost calm day. I noted in my diary that it was "typical Antarctic weather," recalling those peaceful days associated with the climate of the southern shores of the Ross Sea. In Adelie Land, as we were about to discover, it was difficult to count more than a dozen or so in a year.

A fine day! the psychological effect was remarkable; pessimism vanished, and we argued that with the passing of the equinox there would be a marked change for the better. Not a moment was lost: some were employed in making anchorages for the wireless masts; others commenced to construct a Hangar to house the air-tractor sledge.

A beautiful day! The psychological impact was extraordinary; negativity faded away, and we believed that with the arrival of the equinox, there would be a noticeable improvement. We wasted no time: some worked on creating bases for the wireless masts, while others started building a hangar to store the air-tractor sled.

In building the Hangar, the western wall of the Hut was used for one side; the low southern end and the western wall were constructed of full and empty cases, the lee side was closed with a tarpaulin and blocks of snow and over all was nailed a roof of thick timber—part of the air-tractor's case. To stiffen the whole structure, a small amount of framework, in the form of heavy uprights, was set in the ground. The dimensions inside were thirty-four feet by eleven feet; the height, eleven feet at the northern and six feet at the southern end. As a break-wind a crescent-shaped wall of benzine cases was built several yards to the south. As in the case of the veranda, it was very difficult to make the Hangar impervious to drift; a certain quantity of snow always made its way in, and was duly shovelled out.

In constructing the Hangar, the western wall of the Hut served as one side; the low southern end and the western wall were made from full and empty cases, while the leeward side was covered with a tarpaulin and snow blocks. A thick timber roof—made from parts of the air-tractor's case—was nailed on top. To reinforce the entire structure, a small amount of framework with heavy uprights was positioned in the ground. The inside dimensions were thirty-four feet by eleven feet, with a height of eleven feet at the northern end and six feet at the southern end. To block the wind, a crescent-shaped wall of benzine cases was built several yards to the south. Like with the veranda, making the Hangar completely weatherproof was quite challenging; a certain amount of snow always found its way inside and had to be shoveled out.

Seals had suddenly become very scarce, no doubt disgusted with the continuous winds. Every one that came ashore was shot for food. Unfortunately, the amount of meat necessary for the dogs throughout the winter was so great that dog-biscuits had to be used to eke it out.

Seals had suddenly become really rare, probably fed up with the constant winds. Every one that came ashore was taken down for food. Unfortunately, the amount of meat needed for the dogs throughout the winter was so high that dog biscuits had to be used to stretch it out.

Only a few penguins remained by the middle of March. They were all young ones, waiting for the completion of their second moult before taking to the sea. The old feathers hung in untidy tufts, and the birds were often in a wretched plight owing to the wind and drift-snow. Many were added to the bleaching carcases which fill the crevices or lie in heaps on ancient rookeries among the rocky ridges. None were free from the encumbrance of hard cakes of snow which often covered their eyes or dangled in pendent icicles from their bodies. The result was very ludicrous.

Only a few penguins were left by mid-March. They were all young, waiting for their second molt to finish before heading to the sea. Their old feathers were hanging in messy clumps, and they often looked miserable because of the wind and blowing snow. Many had joined the bleached carcasses that filled the crevices or lay in piles on ancient nesting sites among the rocky ridges. None of them were free from the burden of hard snow clumps that often covered their eyes or hung like icicles from their bodies. It was quite a funny sight.

Hurley obtained some excellent photographs of the seals and penguins, as of all other subjects. So good were they that most of us withdrew from competition. His enthusiasm and resourcefulness knew no bounds. Occasional days, during which cameras that had been maltreated by the wind were patched up, were now looked upon as inevitable. One day, when Webb and Hurley were both holding on to the cinematograph camera, they were blown away, with sundry damages all around. It was later in the year when Hurley with his whole-plate camera broke through the sea-ice—a sad affair for the camera.

Hurley captured some amazing photos of the seals and penguins, along with everything else. They were so impressive that most of us stepped back from the competition. His enthusiasm and creativity were limitless. There were occasional days when we had to repair cameras that had been battered by the wind, and those became expected. One day, when Webb and Hurley were both holding onto the cinematograph camera, they were knocked over, causing various damages all around. Later in the year, Hurley, while using his whole-plate camera, broke through the sea ice—an unfortunate incident for the camera.

The good conditions on the 15th lasted only a few hours, and back came the enemy as bad as ever. On the 18th the wind was only thirty miles per hour, giving us an opportunity of continuing the buildings outside. It was only by making the most of every odd hour when the weather was tolerable that our outdoor enterprises made any headway. Sometimes when it was too windy for building we were able to improve our knowledge of the neighbourhood.

The good weather on the 15th lasted only a few hours, and the enemy returned just as bad as before. On the 18th, the wind was only thirty miles per hour, allowing us to continue the outdoor construction. We only made progress on our outdoor projects by taking advantage of every little bit of time when the weather was decent. Sometimes, when it was too windy to build, we were able to explore and learn more about the area.

A glance at Stillwell's map is instruct*e as to the extent and character of the rocky area. It is devoid of any forms of vegetation sufficiently prominent to meet the casual eye. Soil is lacking, for all light materials and even gravel are carried away by the winds. The bare rock rises up into miniature ridges, separated by valleys largely occupied by ice-slabs and lakelets. Snow fills all the crevices and tails away in sloping ramps on the lee side of every obstacle. In midsummer a good deal thaws, and, re-freezing, is converted into ice. The highest point of the rock is one hundred and forty feet. The seaward margin is deeply indented, and the islets off shore tell of a continuation of the rugged, rocky surface below the sea. On the northern faces of the ridges, fronting the ice-foot, large, yellowish patches mark the sites of penguin rookeries. These are formed by a superficial deposit of guano which never becomes thick, for it blows away as fast as it accumulates. Standing on the shore, one can see kelp growing amongst the rocks even in the shallowest spots, below low-water level.

A look at Stillwell's map shows the size and nature of the rocky area. It lacks any prominent vegetation that would catch the eye. There's no soil, as all light materials and even gravel are swept away by the winds. The bare rock rises into small ridges, separated by valleys mostly filled with ice slabs and small lakes. Snow fills all the cracks and slopes down on the sheltered side of every obstacle. In midsummer, a lot of it melts, and upon refreezing, turns into ice. The highest point of the rock is one hundred and forty feet. The seaside edge is deeply indented, and the islets offshore indicate that the rugged, rocky surface continues underwater. On the northern sides of the ridges, facing the ice, large yellowish patches show where penguin rookeries are located. These are created by a thin layer of guano that never gets thick, as it blows away as quickly as it builds up. From the shore, you can see kelp growing among the rocks even in the shallowest areas, below low tide.

To the south, the rocks are overridden by the inland ice which bears down upon and overwhelms them. The ice-sheet shows a definite basal moraine, which means that the lowest stratum, about forty feet in thickness, is charged with stones and earthy matter. Above this stratum the ice is free from foreign matter and rises steeply to several hundred feet, after which the ascending gradient is reduced.

To the south, the rocks are covered by the inland ice that presses down on and overwhelms them. The ice sheet has a clear basal moraine, indicating that the bottom layer, about forty feet thick, is filled with stones and dirt. Above this layer, the ice is free of debris and rises steeply for several hundred feet, after which the slope becomes less steep.

The continental glacier moves down to the sea, regularly but slowly; the rate of movement of some portions of the adjacent coastal ice cliffs was found to be one hundred feet per annum. The rocky promontory at Winter Quarters, acting as an obstacle, reduces the motion of the ice to an annual rate measured in inches only. Perhaps the conditions now prevailing are those of a comparative "drought," for there is clear evidence that our small promontory was at one time completely enveloped. In a broad way this is illustrated by the topography, but the final proof came when Stillwell and others discovered rock-faces polished and grooved by the ice.

The continental glacier flows slowly but steadily into the sea; some parts of the nearby coastal ice cliffs have been measured to move about one hundred feet each year. The rocky point at Winter Quarters, acting as a barrier, slows the ice's movement to just a few inches per year. It’s possible that the current conditions are somewhat of a "drought," as there’s clear evidence that our small promontory was once completely covered. This is broadly shown in the landscape, but the conclusive proof came when Stillwell and others found rock faces that had been smoothed and scratched by the ice.

Whatever "ice-floods" there may have been in the past, the position of the margin of the glacier must have remained for a long period in its present situation. The evidence for this is found in the presence of a continuous, terminal moraine, at or just in advance of the present ice-front. This moraine, an accumulation of stones of all kinds brought to their present resting-place by the ice-sheet, was in itself a veritable museum. Rocks, showing every variety in colour and form, were assembled, transported from far and wide over the great expanse of the continent.

Whatever "ice-floods" may have occurred in the past, the position of the glacier's edge must have stayed in its current location for a long time. The evidence for this is seen in the continuous terminal moraine, located at or just ahead of the current ice front. This moraine, a pile of stones of all types brought to their current spot by the ice sheet, was essentially a real museum. Rocks of every color and shape were gathered, transported from far and wide across the vast continent.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

A section of the coastal slope of the Continental Ice Sheet inland from Winter Quarters, Adelie Land

A part of the coastal slope of the Continental Ice Sheet located inland from Winter Quarters, Adelie Land

Stillwell found these moraines a "happy hunting-ground" for the geologist. His plane-table survey and rock collections are practical evidence of work carried out in weather which made it seldom short of an ordeal.

Stillwell found these moraines a "great place" for geologists. His plane-table survey and rock collections are practical evidence of work done in conditions that often felt like an ordeal.

The story of the buried land to the south is in large measure revealed in the samples brought by the ice and so conveniently dumped. Let us swiftly review the operations leading to the deposition of this natural museum.

The story of the buried land to the south is mostly uncovered in the samples brought by the ice and conveniently deposited. Let’s quickly go over the processes that led to the creation of this natural museum.

As the ice of the hinterland moves forward, it plucks fragments from the rocky floor. Secure in its grip, these are used as graving-tools to erode its bed. Throwing its whole weight upon them it grinds and scratches, pulverizes and grooves. The rocky basement is gradually reduced in level, especially the softer regions. The tools are faceted, polished and furrowed, for ever moving onwards. Finally, the rock-powder or "rock-flour," as it is termed, and the boulders, thenceforth known as "erratics," arrive at the terminal ice-face. Here, the melting due to the sun's heat keeps pace with the "on-thrust" and some of the erratics may remain stationary, or else, floating in the sea, a berg laden with boulders breaks off and deposits its load in the depths of the ocean. Each summer the ice-face above the rocks at Winter Quarters thawed back a short distance and the water ran away in rivulets, milky-white on account of the "rock-flour" in suspension. The pebbles and boulders too heavy to be washed away remained behind to form the moraine.

As the ice from the inner land moves forward, it picks up chunks from the rocky ground. Secure in its grip, these become tools that scrape away at its base. By pressing down hard on them, it grinds, scratches, pulverizes, and grooves. The rocky foundation is slowly worn down, especially in the softer spots. The tools become faceted, polished, and grooved, continually moving forward. Eventually, the rock dust, known as "rock-flour," and the boulders, referred to as "erratics," reach the edge of the ice. Here, the melting caused by the sun’s heat matches the ice's push, so some erratics might stay in place, or, if they're floating in the sea, a glacier filled with boulders breaks off and drops its load in the depths of the ocean. Every summer, the ice edge above the rocks at Winter Quarters melted back a bit, and the water flowed away in small streams, looking milky white because of the "rock-flour" mixed in. The pebbles and boulders that were too heavy to be washed away stayed behind to create the moraine.

The "erratics" comprised a great variety of metamorphic and igneous rocks, and, on a more limited scale, sedimentary types. Amongst the latter were sandstones, slates, shales and limestones.

The "erratics" included a wide range of metamorphic and igneous rocks, and, to a lesser extent, sedimentary types. Among the sedimentary rocks were sandstones, slates, shales, and limestones.

Apart from the moraines, the rock exposed in situ was mainly a uniform type of gneiss, crumpled and folded, showing all the signs of great antiquity—pre-Cambrian, in the geological phrase. Relieving the grey sheen of the gneiss were dark bands of schist which tracked about in an irregular manner. Sporadic quartz veins here and there showed a light tint. They were specially interesting, for they carried some less common minerals such as beryl, tourmaline, garnet, coarse mica and ores of iron, copper and molybdenum. The ores were present in small quantities, but gave promise of larger bodies in the vicinity and indicated the probability of mineral wealth beneath the continental ice-cap.

Besides the moraines, the exposed rock was mostly a consistent type of gneiss, crumpled and folded, showing clear signs of extreme age—pre-Cambrian, in geological terms. Breaking up the grey sheen of the gneiss were dark bands of schist that wandered around in an irregular pattern. Sporadic quartz veins sprinkled throughout showed a lighter color. They were especially interesting because they contained some rarer minerals like beryl, tourmaline, garnet, coarse mica, and ores of iron, copper, and molybdenum. The ores were in small amounts, but suggested the possibility of larger deposits nearby and indicated the likelihood of mineral wealth beneath the continental ice cap.





CHAPTER VII THE BLIZZARD

The equinox arrived, and the only indication of settled weather was a more marked regularity in the winds. Nothing like it had been reported from any part of the world. Any trace of elation we may have felt at this meteorological discovery could not compensate for the ever-present discomforts of life. Day after day the wind fluctuated between a gale and a hurricane. Overcast skies of heavy nimbus cloud were the rule and the air was continually charged with drifting snow.

The equinox arrived, and the only sign of stable weather was a more noticeable consistency in the winds. Nothing like it had been reported from anywhere in the world. Any excitement we may have felt about this weather finding couldn't make up for the constant annoyances of life. Day after day, the wind shifted between a strong breeze and a full-blown hurricane. Overcast skies filled with thick nimbus clouds were typical, and the air was always filled with drifting snow.

Lulls of a singular nature occasionally relieved the monotony. During these visitations the sequence of events could almost be predicted; indeed, they would often occur at the same time on several succeeding days.

Lulls of a unique kind occasionally broke the monotony. During these moments, the sequence of events could almost be anticipated; in fact, they often happened at the same time on several consecutive days.

On March 19 the first well-marked lull intervened at the height of a gale. On that day the wind, which had been blowing with great force during the morning, commenced to subside rapidly just after noon. Towards evening, the air about the Hut was quite still except for gusts from the north and rather frequent "whirlies."

On March 19, the first noticeable break came during the peak of a storm. That day, the wind, which had been blowing hard throughout the morning, began to die down quickly just after noon. By evening, the air around the Hut was pretty calm, except for occasional gusts from the north and some frequent little whirlwinds.

This was the name adopted for whirlwinds of a few yards to a hundred yards or more in diameter which came to be regarded as peculiar to the country. Similar disturbances have been observed in every part of the world, but seldom possessed of the same violence and regularity as is the case in Adelie Land.

This was the name given to whirlwinds that are a few yards to over a hundred yards in diameter, which were seen as unique to the country. Similar events have been noticed in every part of the world, but they rarely have the same intensity and consistency as those found in Adelie Land.

The whirlies tracked about in a most irregular manner and woe betide any light object which came in their path. The velocity of the wind in the rotating column being very great, a corresponding lifting power was imparted to it. As an illustration of this force, it may be mentioned that the lid of the air-tractor case had been left lying on the snow near the Hut. It weighed more than three hundredweights, yet it was whisked into the air one morning and dropped fifty yards away in a north-easterly direction. An hour afterwards it was picked up again and returned near its original position, this time striking the rocks with such force that part of it was shivered to pieces. Webb and Stillwell watched the last proceeding at a respectful distance.

The whirlies moved around in a very unpredictable way, and anyone who had a lightweight object in their path was in trouble. The wind speed in the rotating column was extremely high, which gave it strong lifting power. For example, the lid of the air-tractor case had been left on the snow close to the Hut. It weighed over three hundred pounds, yet one morning it was lifted into the air and tossed fifty yards away in a northeast direction. An hour later, it was found again and brought back near where it originally was, but this time it hit the rocks so hard that part of it shattered. Webb and Stillwell watched this last event from a safe distance.

Again, the radius of activity of these whirlies was strictly limited; objects directly in their path only being disturbed. For instance, Laseron one day was skinning at one end of a seal and remained in perfect calm, while McLean, at the other extremity, was on the edge of a furious vortex.

Again, the area these whirlies could affect was very limited; only objects directly in their way were disturbed. For example, one day Laseron was skinning one end of a seal and was completely calm, while McLean, at the other end, was caught in a wild vortex.

Travelling over the sea the whirlies displayed fresh capabilities. Columns of brash-ice, frozen spray and water-vapour were frequently seen lifted to heights of from two hundred to four hundred feet, simulating water spouts.

Travelling over the sea, the whirlies showed new abilities. Columns of ice, frozen spray, and water vapor were often seen reaching heights of two hundred to four hundred feet, looking like water spouts.

Reverting to the afternoon of March 19. Beyond the strange stillness of the immediate vicinity, broken occasionally by the tumult of a passing, wandering whirly, an incessant, seething roar could be heard. One could not be certain from whence it came, but it seemed to proceed either from the south or overhead. Away on the icy promontories to the east and west, where the slopes were visible, mounting to an altitude of several thousand feet, clouds of drift-snow blotted out the details of the surface above a level of about six hundred feet. It certainly appeared as if the gale, for some reason, had lifted and was still raging overhead. At 7.30 P.M. the sound we had heard, like the distant lashing of ocean waves, became louder. Soon gusts swept the tops of the rocky ridges, gradually descending to throw up the snow at a lower level. Then a volley raked the Hut, and within a few minutes we were once more enveloped in a sea of drifting snow, and the wind blew stronger than ever.

Reverting to the afternoon of March 19. Beyond the odd stillness of the immediate area, occasionally interrupted by the chaos of a passing, wandering whirl, there was a constant, seething roar in the background. It was hard to tell where it came from, but it seemed to be coming from either the south or above. Out on the icy cliffs to the east and west, where the slopes were visible, rising to several thousand feet, clouds of drifting snow obscured the details of the surface above about six hundred feet. It certainly looked like the gale had lifted for some reason and was still raging overhead. At 7:30 PM, the sound we had been hearing, similar to the distant crashing of ocean waves, grew louder. Soon gusts swept over the rocky ridges, gradually coming down to kick up the snow at a lower level. Then a strong blast hit the Hut, and within minutes we were once again surrounded by a sea of drifting snow, with the wind blowing stronger than ever.

The duration of the lulls was ordinarily from a few minutes to several hours; that of March 19 was longer than usual. In the course of time, after repeated observations, much light was thrown on this phenomenon. On one occasion, a party ascending the ice slopes to the south met the wind blowing at an elevation of four hundred feet. At the same time snow could be seen pouring over the "Barrier" to the west of the Winter Quarters, and across a foaming turmoil of water. This was evidently the main cause of the seething roar, but it was mingled with an undernote of deeper tone from the upland plateau—like the wind in a million tree-tops.

The lulls usually lasted from a few minutes to several hours; the one on March 19 was longer than normal. Over time, after numerous observations, we gained a better understanding of this phenomenon. One time, a group climbing the ice slopes to the south encountered wind blowing at an elevation of four hundred feet. At the same moment, snow could be seen cascading over the "Barrier" to the west of the Winter Quarters, and across a churning mass of water. This was clearly the main cause of the intense roar, but it was mixed with a deeper tone coming from the upland plateau—similar to the sound of wind in a million tree tops.

In the early spring, while we were transporting provisions to the south, frequent journeys were made to higher elevations. It was then established that even when whole days of calm prevailed at the Hut, the wind almost without exception blew above a level of one thousand feet. On such occasions it appeared that the gale was impelled to blow straight out from the plateau slopes over a lower stratum of dead-air. An explanation was thereby afforded of the movement of condensation clouds which appeared in the zenith at these times. A formation of delicate, gauzy clouds developed at a low altitude, apparently in still air, but doubtless at the base of a hurricane stratum. Whirling round rapidly in eddying flocculi, they quickly tailed away to the north, evaporating and disappearing.

In early spring, while we were transporting supplies to the south, we frequently made trips to higher elevations. It became clear that even when the weather was calm for entire days at the Hut, the wind almost always blew above a height of one thousand feet. During these times, it seemed that the strong wind was forced to blow straight out from the plateau slopes over a layer of still air below. This provided an explanation for the condensation clouds that appeared in the sky at these moments. A formation of delicate, wispy clouds developed at a low altitude, seemingly in calm air, but they were likely at the base of a layer of hurricane-force winds. Swirling rapidly in swirling fluffy masses, they quickly drifted to the north, evaporating and disappearing.

The auditory sense was strangely affected by these lulls. The contrast was so severe when the racking gusts of an abating wind suddenly gave way to intense, eerie silence, that the habitual droning of many weeks would still reverberate in the ears. At night one would involuntarily wake up if the wind died away, and be loth to sleep "for the hunger of a sound." In the open air the stillness conveyed to the brain an impression of audibility, interpreted as a vibratory murmur.

The sense of hearing was oddly impacted by these pauses. The contrast was so stark when the intense gusts of a fading wind suddenly shifted to a deep, eerie silence that the familiar hum from many weeks would still echo in one’s ears. At night, you would instinctively wake up if the wind stopped and be reluctant to fall asleep "for the craving of a sound." In the open air, the stillness gave the brain a sense of being able to hear, interpreted as a faint, vibrating murmur.

During one hour on March 22 it blew eighty-six miles. On the morning of that day there was not much snow in the air and the raging sea was a fearful sight. Even the nearest of the islands, only half a mile off the land, was partially hidden in the clouds of spray. What an impossible coast this would be for the wintering of a ship!

During one hour on March 22, it blew at eighty-six miles per hour. That morning, there wasn't much snow in the air, and the raging sea was a terrifying sight. Even the closest island, just half a mile from the shore, was partially obscured by clouds of spray. What an impossible coast this would be for a ship to spend the winter!

Everybody knows that the pressure exerted by a wind against an object in its path mounts up in much greater proportion than the velocity of the wind. Thus may be realized the stupendous force of the winds of Adelie Land in comparison with those of half the velocity which fall within one's ordinary experience. As this subject was ever before us, the following figures quoted from a work of reference will be instructive. The classification of winds, here stated, is that known as the "Beaufort scale." The corresponding velocities in each case are those measured by the "Robinson patent" anemometer; our instrument being of a similar pattern

Everybody knows that the pressure from wind hitting an object in its path increases much more than the wind’s speed. This shows just how powerful the winds in Adelie Land are compared to winds at half that speed that we usually experience. Since this topic was always relevant, the following figures quoted from a reference book will be helpful. The classification of winds mentioned here is known as the "Beaufort scale." The speeds given in each case were measured by the "Robinson patent" anemometer, and our device is a similar model.

  ___________________________________________________________________
  Beaufort scale    |Velocities|Pressures |     Apparent effect     |
                    | in miles | in lbs.  |                         |
                    | per hour | square   |                         |
                    |            foot     |                         |
                    |          |  area    |                         |
  __________________|__________| _________|_________________________|
   0|Calm           |    2     |    0.02  |May cause smoke to       |
    |               |          |          |   move form vertical    |
   1|Light air      |    4     |    0.06  |Moves the leaves of trees|
   2|Light breeze   |    7     |    0.19  |Moves small branches of  |
   3|Gentle breeze  |   10     |    0.37  | trees and blows up dust |
   4|Moderate breeze|   14     |    0.67  |                         |
   5|Fresh breeze   |   19     |    1.16  |Good sailing breeze and  |
   6|Strong breeze  |   25     |    1.90  |  makes white caps       |
   7|Moderate gale  |   31     |    2.81  |Sways trees and breaks   |
   8|Fresh gale     |   37     |    3.87  |  small branches         |
   9|Strong gale    |   44     |    5.27  |Dangerous for sailing    |
  10|Whole gale     |   53     |    7.40  |   vessels               |
  11|Storm          |   64     |   10.40  |Prostrates exposed trees |
  12|Hurricane      |   77     |   14.40  |    and frail houses     |
  ___________________________________________________________________
  ___________________________________________________________________
  Beaufort scale    |Velocities|Pressures |     Apparent effect     |
                    | in miles | in lbs.  |                         |
                    | per hour | square   |                         |
                    |            foot     |                         |
                    |          |  area    |                         |
  __________________|__________| _________|_________________________|
   0|Calm           |    2     |    0.02  |May cause smoke to       |
    |               |          |          |   move from vertical    |
   1|Light air      |    4     |    0.06  |Moves the leaves of trees|
   2|Light breeze   |    7     |    0.19  |Moves small branches of  |
   3|Gentle breeze  |   10     |    0.37  | trees and blows up dust |
   4|Moderate breeze|   14     |    0.67  |                         |
   5|Fresh breeze   |   19     |    1.16  |Good sailing breeze and  |
   6|Strong breeze  |   25     |    1.90  |  creates whitecaps      |
   7|Moderate gale  |   31     |    2.81  |Sways trees and breaks   |
   8|Fresh gale     |   37     |    3.87  |  small branches         |
   9|Strong gale    |   44     |    5.27  |Dangerous for sailing    |
  10|Whole gale     |   53     |    7.40  |   vessels               |
  11|Storm          |   64     |   10.40  |Knocks over exposed trees |
  12|Hurricane      |   77     |   14.40  |    and weak houses      |
  ___________________________________________________________________

Beyond the limits of this scale, the pressures exerted rise very rapidly. A wind recorded as blowing at the rate of a hundred miles per hour exerts a pressure of about twenty-three pounds per square foot of surface exposed to it. Wind above eighty miles per hour is stated to "prostrate everything."

Beyond the limits of this scale, the pressures involved increase very quickly. A wind blowing at a speed of a hundred miles per hour exerts a pressure of about twenty-three pounds per square foot of any surface it hits. Winds over eighty miles per hour are said to "knock everything down."

The mileages registered by our anemometer were the mean for a whole hour, neglecting individual gusts, whose velocity much exceeded the average and which were always the potent factors in destructive work.

The mileages recorded by our anemometer were the average for a full hour, overlooking individual gusts, whose speed often far surpassed the average and were always the main contributors to destructive effects.

Obviously the greatest care had to be taken to secure everything. Still, articles of value were occasionally missed. They were usually recovered, caught in crevices of rock or amongst the broken ice. Northward from the Hut there was a trail of miscellaneous objects scattered among the hummocks and pressure-ridges out towards Penguin Hill on the eastern side of the boat harbour: tins of all kinds and sizes, timber in small scraps, cases and boards, paper, ashes, dirt, worn-out finnesko, ragged mitts and all the other details of a rubbish heap. One of the losses was a heavy case which formed the packing of part of the magnetometer. Weighted-down by stones this had stood for a long time in what was regarded as a safe place. One morning it was discovered to be missing. It was surmised that a hurricane had started it on an ocean voyage during the previous day. Boxes in which Whetter used to carry ice for domestic requirements were as a rule short-lived. His problem was to fill the boxes without losing hold of them, and the wind often gained the ascendancy before a sufficient ballast had been added. We sometimes wondered whether any of the flotsam thus cast upon the waters ever reached the civilized world.

Clearly, a lot of care had to be taken to secure everything. Still, valuable items were sometimes lost. They were usually found again, stuck in rock crevices or among the broken ice. North of the Hut, there was a trail of various objects scattered among the mounds and pressure ridges out toward Penguin Hill on the eastern side of the boat harbor: cans of all shapes and sizes, small scraps of wood, crates and boards, paper, ashes, dirt, worn-out snow boots, tattered mittens, and all the other bits of a junk pile. One of the lost items was a heavy case that held part of the magnetometer. Buried under stones, it had been in what was considered a safe spot for a long time. One morning, it was found to be missing. It was suspected that a hurricane had sent it on a journey at sea the day before. The boxes Whetter used to carry ice for everyday needs were usually short-lived. His challenge was to fill the boxes without losing grip on them, and the wind often took control before enough weight had been added. Sometimes we wondered if any of the debris that ended up in the water ever made it to the civilized world.

Whatever has been said relative to the wind-pressure exerted on inanimate objects, the same applied, with even more point, to our persons; so that progression in a hurricane became a fine art. The first difficulty to be encountered was a smooth, slippery surface offering no grip for the feet. Stepping out of the shelter of the Hut, one was apt to be immediately hurled at full length down wind. No amount of exertion was of any avail unless a firm foothold had been secured. The strongest man, stepping on to ice or hard snow in plain leather or fur boots, would start sliding away with gradually increasing velocity; in the space of a few seconds, or earlier, exchanging the vertical for the horizontal position. He would then either stop suddenly against a jutting point of ice, or glide along for twenty or thirty yards till he reached a patch of rocks or some rough sastrugi.

Whatever has been said about the wind pressure on inanimate objects applies even more to us; navigating a hurricane became a real skill. The first challenge was a smooth, slippery surface that provided no grip for our feet. Stepping out of the Hut’s shelter, you could easily be sent sprawling downwind. No amount of effort would help unless you found a solid place to stand. Even the strongest person, stepping onto ice or hard snow in plain leather or fur boots, would start sliding away, gaining speed. In just a few seconds, or sooner, they would go from standing upright to lying flat. They would either come to a sudden stop against a jutting piece of ice or slide along for twenty or thirty yards until they hit some rocks or rough sastrugi.

Of course we soon learned never to go about without crampons on the feet. Many experiments in the manufacture of crampons were tried with the limited materials at our disposal. Those designed for normal Antarctic conditions had been found unserviceable. A few detachable pairs made of wrought iron with spikes about one and a half inches in length, purchased in Switzerland, gave a secure foothold. Some of the men covered the soles of their boots with long, bristling spikes and these served their purpose well. Ice-nails, screwed into the soles without being riveted on plates, were liable to tear out when put to a severe test, besides being too short. Spikes of less than an inch in length were inadequate in hurricanes. Nothing devised by us gave the grip of the Swiss crampons, but, to affix them, one had to wear leather boots, which, though padded to increase their warmth, had to be tightly bound by lashings compressing the feet and increasing the liability to frost-bite.

Of course, we quickly learned never to go out without crampons on our feet. We tried many experiments in making crampons with the limited materials we had. Those designed for typical Antarctic conditions proved useless. A few detachable pairs made of wrought iron with spikes about an inch and a half long, bought in Switzerland, provided a secure grip. Some of the guys covered the bottoms of their boots with long, sharp spikes, and these worked well for them. Ice nails, screwed into the soles without being attached to any plates, tended to rip out under serious strain, plus they were too short. Spikes under an inch long were inadequate in strong winds. Nothing we came up with had the grip of the Swiss crampons, but to attach them, you had to wear leather boots that, while padded for warmth, had to be tightly secured with lashings that compressed the feet and increased the risk of frostbite.

Shod with good spikes, in a steady wind, one had only to push hard to keep a sure footing. It would not be true to say "to keep erect," for equilibrium was maintained by leaning against the wind. In course of time, those whose duties habitually took them out of doors became thorough masters of the art of walking in hurricanes—an accomplishment comparable to skating or skiing. Ensconced in the lee of a substantial break-wind, one could leisurely observe the unnatural appearance of others walking about, apparently in imminent peril of falling on their faces.

With good spikes on your shoes and a steady wind blowing, you just had to push hard to maintain your footing. It wouldn't be accurate to say "to stay upright," since balance was kept by leaning into the wind. Over time, those whose jobs often took them outside became really good at walking in hurricanes—an skill similar to skating or skiing. Sheltered from the wind behind a solid barrier, you could watch the oddly unsteady way others walked, clearly at risk of falling flat on their faces.

Experiments were tried in the steady winds; firmly planting the feet on the ground, keeping the body rigid and leaning over on the invisible support. This "lying on the wind," at equilibrium, was a unique experience. As a rule the velocity remained uniform; when it fluctuated in a series of gusts, all our experience was likely to fail, for no sooner had the correct angle for the maximum velocity been assumed than a lull intervened—with the obvious result.

Experiments were conducted in steady winds; firmly planting our feet on the ground, keeping our bodies rigid and leaning over on the invisible support. This "lying on the wind," in equilibrium, was a unique experience. Generally, the speed remained consistent; but when it fluctuated in bursts, all our experience was likely to fail, because no sooner had we adapted to the right angle for the maximum speed than a lull would occur—with the obvious result.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

A copy of the wind-velocity (anenometer) and the wind direction (anemograph) for a period of twenty-four hours, Adelie Land

A copy of the wind speed (anemometer) and wind direction (anemograph) for a 24-hour period, Adelie Land

This particular record illustrates a day of constant high velocity wind. In the case of the upper chart each rise of the pen from the bottom to the top of the paper indicates that another 100 miles of wind has passed the instrument. The regularity of these curves shows the steadiness of the wind. It will be observed that the average velocity for twenty-four hours was 90.1 miles, and the maximum of the average hourly velocities throughout that period was ninety-seven miles. The lower chart, the record of the direction from which the wind blew, is marked only by a single broad bar in the position of South-by-East, the wind not having veered in the slightest degree.

This record shows a day of consistently high winds. In the upper chart, each rise of the pen from the bottom to the top of the paper indicates that another 100 miles of wind has passed the instrument. The smoothness of these curves demonstrates the stability of the wind. You'll notice that the average speed over twenty-four hours was 90.1 miles, with the highest average hourly speed during that time reaching ninety-seven miles. The lower chart, which records the direction the wind came from, is marked by a single broad bar pointing South-by-East, indicating that the wind didn't change direction at all.

Before the art of "hurricane-walking" was learnt, and in the primitive days of ice-nails and finnesko, progression in high winds degenerated into crawling on hands and knees. Many of the more conservative persisted in this method, and, as a compensation, became the first exponents of the popular art of "board-sliding." A small piece of board, a wide ice flat and a hurricane were the three essentials for this new sport.

Before the skill of "hurricane-walking" was developed, and during the early days of ice nails and snow boots, moving in strong winds turned into crawling on hands and knees. Many of the more traditional folks stuck to this method, and, as a result, became the pioneers of the popular activity known as "board-sliding." A small piece of board, a wide patch of ice, and a hurricane were the three essentials for this new sport.

Wind alone would not have been so bad; drift snow accompanied it in overwhelming amount. In the autumn overcast weather with heavy falls of snow prevailed, with the result that the air for several months was seldom free from drift. Indeed, during that time, there were not many days when objects a hundred yards away could be seen distinctly. Whatever else happened, the wind never abated, and so, even when the snow had ceased falling and the sky was clear, the drift continued until all the loose accumulations on the hinterland, for hundreds of miles back, had been swept out to sea. Day after day deluges of drift streamed past the Hut, at times so dense as to obscure objects three feet away, until it seemed as if the atmosphere were almost solid snow.

Wind by itself wouldn't have been so bad; it was accompanied by a massive amount of drifting snow. In the autumn, overcast skies with heavy snowfalls dominated, resulting in air that was rarely free of drift for several months. In fact, during that period, there weren’t many days where you could clearly see objects a hundred yards away. No matter what else happened, the wind never let up, and even when the snow stopped falling and the sky cleared, the drift continued until all the loose snow from the surrounding area, hundreds of miles back, had been blown out to sea. Day after day, torrents of drift swirled past the Hut, sometimes so thick that you couldn’t see objects just three feet away, making it feel like the air was almost solid with snow.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

A comparison of wind-velocities and temperatures prevailing at Cape Royds, Mcmurdo Sound, and at winter quarters, Adelie Land, during the months of May and June

A comparison of wind speeds and temperatures at Cape Royds, McMurdo Sound, and at winter quarters, Adelie Land, during the months of May and June

At the time of plotting only the above two months were available, but they are enough to illustrate the unusually severe winter conditions of Adelie Land. The data for Cape Royds is that supplied by the Shackleton Expedition. The solid black line refers to Adelie Land, the broken line to Cape Royds. It will be noted that whereas the average temperature conditions are closely similar at both stations, only on three days during the period did the average wind velocity at Cape Royds reach that of the lowest daily value of Adelie Land.

At the time of plotting, only the two months mentioned were available, but they are enough to show the unusually harsh winter conditions of Adelie Land. The data for Cape Royds comes from the Shackleton Expedition. The solid black line represents Adelie Land, while the dashed line represents Cape Royds. It’s notable that, although the average temperature conditions are quite similar at both locations, only on three days during this period did the average wind speed at Cape Royds match the lowest daily value recorded for Adelie Land.

Picture drift so dense that daylight comes through dully, though, maybe, the sun shines in a cloudless sky; the drift is hurled, screaming through space at a hundred miles an hour, and the temperature is below zero, Fahrenheit.** You have then the bare, rough facts concerning the worst blizzards of Adelie Land. The actual experience of them is another thing.

Picture snow so thick that daylight filters in dimly, even though the sun is shining in a clear sky; the snow is whirling, rushing through the air at a hundred miles an hour, and the temperature is below zero degrees Fahrenheit.** These are the basic, harsh facts about the worst blizzards in Adelie Land. Experiencing them firsthand is entirely different.

     ** Temperatures as low as -28 degrees F.
(60 degrees below freezing-point) were experienced in hurricane winds,
which blew at a velocity occasionally exceeding one hundred miles per
hour. Still air and low temperatures, or high winds and moderate
temperatures, are well enough; but the combination of high winds and low
temperatures is difficult to bear.
     ** Temperatures as low as -28 degrees F (60 degrees below freezing) were felt with hurricane-force winds that sometimes exceeded one hundred miles per hour. Calm air and low temperatures, or strong winds and moderate temperatures, are manageable on their own; however, the mix of high winds and low temperatures is really hard to tolerate.

Shroud the infuriated elements in the darkness of a polar night, and the blizzard is presented in a severer aspect. A plunge into the writhing storm-whirl stamps upon the senses an indelible and awful impression seldom equalled in the whole gamut of natural experience. The world a void, grisly, fierce and appalling. We stumble and struggle through the Stygian gloom; the merciless blast—an incubus of vengeance—stabs, buffets and freezes; the stinging drift blinds and chokes. In a ruthless grip we realize that we are

Shroud the angry elements in the darkness of a polar night, and the blizzard takes on a more severe form. Diving into the swirling storm leaves an indelible and terrifying impression that's rarely matched in all of nature's experiences. The world becomes a void, grim, fierce, and horrifying. We stumble and fight our way through the pitch-black darkness; the relentless wind—like a vengeful spirit—stabs, knocks us around, and freezes us; the biting snow blinds and suffocates. In a merciless grasp, we come to realize that we are

                        poor windlestraws
    On the great, sullen, roaring pool of Time.
                        poor windlestraws
    On the vast, dark, turbulent waters of Time.

It may well be imagined that none of us went out on these occasions for the pleasure of it. The scientific work required all too frequent journeys to the instruments at a distance from the Hut, and, in addition, supplies of ice and stores had to be brought in, while the dogs needed constant attention.

It’s safe to say that none of us went out during these times for fun. The research demanded way too many trips to the instruments far from the Hut, and on top of that, we had to bring in supplies of ice and other provisions, while the dogs needed our constant care.

Every morning, Madigan visited all the meteorological instruments and changed the daily charts; at times having to feel his way from one place to the other. Attending to the exposed instruments in a high wind with low temperature was bad enough, but with suffocating drift difficulties were increased tenfold.

Every morning, Madigan checked all the weather instruments and updated the daily charts; sometimes he had to navigate his way from one spot to another. Taking care of the exposed instruments in strong winds and low temperatures was tough enough, but dealing with heavy drifting made things ten times harder.

Around the Hut there was a small fraternity who chose the outside veranda as a rendezvous. Here the latest gossip was exchanged, and the weather invariably discussed in forcible terms. There was Whetter, who replenished the water-supply from the unfailing fountain-head of the glacier. For cooking, washing clothes and for photographic and other purposes, eighteen men consumed a good deal of water, and, to keep up with the demand, Whetter piled up many hardly-won boxes of ice in the veranda. Close unearthed coal briquettes from the heap outside, shovelled tons of snow from the veranda and made himself useful and amiable to every one. Murphy, our stand-by in small talk, travel, history, literature and what not, was the versatile storeman. The store in the veranda was continually invaded by similar snow to that which covered the provision boxes outside. To keep the veranda cleared, renew the supplies and satisfy the demands of the kitchen required no other than Murphy. Ninnis and Mertz completed the "Veranda Club," to which honorary members from within the Hut were constantly being added.

Around the Hut, a small group of guys gathered on the outside porch as their hangout spot. Here, they would share the latest gossip and always discuss the weather in strong terms. Whetter was in charge of refilling the water supply from the reliable glacier spring. For cooking, laundry, photography, and other needs, eighteen men used a lot of water, so Whetter stacked up many hard-earned boxes of ice on the porch. Close dug out coal briquettes from the pile outside, shoveled tons of snow off the porch, and made himself helpful and friendly to everyone. Murphy, our go-to guy for small talk, travel, history, literature, and more, was the adaptable storeman. The store on the porch was regularly piled with snow similar to that covering the supply boxes outside. Keeping the porch clear, restocking supplies, and meeting the kitchen's needs was all on Murphy. Ninnis and Mertz rounded out the "Veranda Club," which was always welcoming new honorary members from inside the Hut.

The meteorological instruments, carefully nursed and housed though they were, were bound to suffer in such a climate. Correll, who was well fitted out with a lathe and all the requirements for instrument-making, attended to repairs, doing splendid service. The anemometer gave the greatest trouble, and, before Correll had finished with it, most of the working parts had been replaced in stronger metal.

The weather instruments, despite being well taken care of and stored, were bound to struggle in such conditions. Correll, who was well-equipped with a lathe and everything needed for making instruments, handled the repairs and did a great job. The anemometer caused the most issues, and by the time Correll was done with it, most of the working parts had been replaced with stronger metal.

When the recording sheets of the instruments had been successfully changed, the meteorologist packed them in a leather bag, strapped on his shoulders, so that they would not be lost on the way to the Hut. As soon as he arrived indoors the bag was opened and emptied; the papers being picked out from a small heap of snow.

When he had successfully swapped out the recording sheets of the instruments, the meteorologist packed them into a leather bag, slinging it over his shoulders so they wouldn’t get lost on the way to the Hut. Once he got inside, he opened the bag and dumped it out; the papers were pulled free from a small pile of snow.

It was a fortunate thing that no one was lost through failing to discover the Hut during the denser drifts. Hodgeman on one occasion caused every one a good deal of anxiety. Among other things, he regularly assisted Madigan by relieving him of outdoor duties on the day after his nightwatch, when the chief meteorologist was due for a "watch below." It was in the early autumn—few of us, then, were adepts at finding our way by instinct—that Hodgeman and Madigan set out, one morning, for the anemometer. Leaving the door of the Hut, they lost sight of each other at once, but anticipated meeting at the instrument. Madigan reached his destination, changed the records, waited for a while and then returned, expecting to see his companion at the Hut. He did not appear, so, after a reasonable interval, search parties set off in different directions.

It was lucky that no one got lost trying to find the Hut during the heavier snow drifts. One time, Hodgeman caused everyone quite a bit of concern. Among other things, he regularly helped Madigan by taking on outdoor tasks the day after his night shift, when the chief meteorologist was scheduled for a "watch below." It was early autumn—none of us were very skilled at navigating by instinct back then—when Hodgeman and Madigan set out one morning to check the anemometer. As soon as they left the Hut, they lost sight of each other but expected to meet up at the instrument. Madigan arrived at his destination, updated the records, waited a bit, and then headed back, thinking he would find his companion at the Hut. When he didn’t see him, a reasonable amount of time passed before search parties started in different directions.

The wind was blowing at eighty miles per hour, making it tedious work groping about and hallooing in the drift. The sea was close at hand and we realized that, as the wind was directly off shore, a man without crampons was in a dangerous situation. Two men, therefore, roped together and carefully searched round the head of the boat harbour; one anchoring himself with an ice-axe, whilst the other, at the end of the rope, worked along the edge of the sea. Meanwhile Hodgeman returned to the Hut, unaided, having spent a very unpleasant two hours struggling from one landmark to another, his outer garments filled with snow.

The wind was howling at eighty miles per hour, making it a struggle to move around and shout through the snowdrift. The ocean was nearby, and we knew that since the wind was blowing straight off the shore, a person without crampons was in a risky spot. So, two guys tied together and carefully searched the area around the entrance of the boat harbor; one secured himself with an ice axe while the other, at the end of the rope, made his way along the shoreline. Meanwhile, Hodgeman made his way back to the hut on his own after spending a really tough two hours trying to get from one landmark to another, his outer clothes packed with snow.

The fact that the wind came steadily from the same direction made it possible to steer, otherwise outdoor operations would not have been conducted so successfully. For instance, Webb, who visited the Magnetograph House, a quarter of a mile distant, at least once a day, made his way between various "beacons" by preserving a definite bearing on the wind. His journeys were rendered all the more difficult because they were frequently undertaken at night.

The steady wind coming from the same direction made it possible to navigate; otherwise, outdoor operations wouldn’t have been as successful. For example, Webb, who visited the Magnetograph House, a quarter of a mile away, at least once a day, used specific "beacons" to maintain a clear direction based on the wind. His trips were even more challenging since he often made them at night.

In struggling along through very dense drifts one would be inclined to think that the presence of the sun was a matter of small concern. As a matter of fact there was, during the day, a good deal of reflected white light and a dark object looms up within a yard or two. In darkness there was nothing to recognize. So Webb would often run by dead reckoning on to the roof of the Hut, and would then feel his way round it till he caught the glimmer of a hurricane lantern coming through the veranda entrance.

In battling through thick snowdrifts, one might think that having the sun around was not very important. In reality, there was quite a bit of reflected white light during the day, and a dark shape could appear within a yard or two. In the dark, there was nothing to identify. So Webb often navigated by instinct right up to the roof of the Hut and then felt his way around until he saw the glow of a hurricane lantern shining through the veranda entrance.

I had always the greatest admiration for the unfailing manner in which those responsible for the tidal, magnetic and meteorological work carried out their duties.

I have always had the highest admiration for the consistent way that those in charge of the tidal, magnetic, and meteorological work performed their tasks.

As a measure of the enormous amount of drift, we set about constructing a gauge, which, it was hoped, would give us a rough estimate of the quantity passing the Hut in a year. Hannam, following the approved design, produced a very satisfactory contrivance. It consisted of a large drift-tight box, fitted on the windward side with a long metal cone, tapering to an aperture three-quarters of an inch in diameter. The drift-laden air entered the aperture, its speed was checked on entering the capacious body of the gauge and consequently the snow fell to the bottom of the box and the air passed out behind through a trap-door. The catch was taken out periodically through a bolted lid, the snow was melted, the resulting water measured and its weight calculated.

To measure the huge amount of drift, we started building a gauge that we hoped would give us a rough estimate of how much was passing the Hut in a year. Hannam, following the approved design, created a very effective device. It was a large drift-tight box, fitted on the windward side with a long metal cone that tapered to an opening three-quarters of an inch in diameter. The drift-filled air entered the opening, and its speed slowed down as it entered the large body of the gauge, causing the snow to fall to the bottom of the box while the air exited out the back through a trap-door. The catch was collected periodically through a bolted lid, the snow was melted, and the resulting water was measured and weighed.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

The drift gauge

The drift meter

In thick drifts, one's face inside the funnel of the burberry helmet became rapidly packed with snow, which, by the warmth of the skin and breath, was changed into a mask of ice. This adhered firmly to the rim of the helmet and to the beard and face. The mask became so complete that one had to clear away obstructions continually from the eyes. It was not easy to remove the casing of ice, outside in the wind, because this could only be done slowly, with bare fingers exposed. An experienced man, once inside the Hut, would first see that the ice was broken along the rim of the helmet; otherwise, when it came to be hastily dragged off, the hairs of the beard would follow as well. As soon as the helmet was off the head, the icicles hanging on the beard and glazing the eyelashes were gradually thawed by the fingers and removed. The above treatment was learned by experience.

In deep snow, when your face was inside the funnel of the burberry helmet, it quickly got packed with snow, which, due to the warmth of your skin and breath, turned into a mask of ice. This ice stuck firmly to the rim of the helmet as well as to the beard and face. The mask became so complete that you had to keep clearing your eyes from the obstructions. It wasn't easy to get rid of the ice outside in the wind because it could only be done slowly with bare fingers. An experienced person, once inside the Hut, would first break the ice along the rim of the helmet; otherwise, when it was yanked off hurriedly, it would pull out beard hairs too. As soon as the helmet was off your head, the icicles hanging from your beard and clinging to your eyelashes were gradually thawed and removed by your fingers. This method was learned through experience.

The abrasion-effects produced by the impact of the snow particles were astonishing. Pillars of ice were cut through in a few days, rope was frayed, wood etched and metal polished. Some rusty dog-chains were exposed to it, and, in a few days, they had a definite sheen. A deal box, facing the wind, lost all its painted bands and in a fortnight was handsomely marked; the hard, knotty fibres being only slightly attacked, whilst the softer, pithy laminae were corroded to a depth of one-eighth of an inch.

The impact of the snow particles was incredible. Ice pillars were sliced through in just a few days, ropes were worn down, wood was carved, and metal shined. Some rusty dog chains were exposed to it, and in a matter of days, they had a distinct shine. A wooden box, facing the wind, lost all its painted stripes and in two weeks was beautifully marked; the tough, knotty fibers were only slightly damaged, while the softer, pithy layers were eroded to a depth of an eighth of an inch.

The effect of constant abrasion upon the snow's surface is to harden it, and, finally, to carve ridges known as sastrugi. Of these much will be said when recounting our sledging adventures, because they increase so much the difficulties of travelling.

The effect of constant scraping on the snow's surface is to harden it, and eventually, to create ridges called sastrugi. We'll discuss these a lot when we talk about our sledding adventures because they significantly increase the challenges of traveling.

Even hard, blue ice may become channelled and pitted by the action of drift. Again, both neve and ice may receive a wind-polish which makes them very slippery.

Even hard, blue ice can become channelled and pitted from the movement of drift. Additionally, both neve and ice can be polished by the wind, making them very slippery.

Of the effect of wind and drift upon rock, there was ample evidence around Winter Quarters. Regarded from the north, the aspect of the rocks was quite different from that on the southern side. The southern, windward faces were on the whole smooth and rounded, but there was no definite polish, because the surface was partly attacked by the chipping and splitting action of frost. The leeward faces were rougher and more disintegrated. More remarkable still were the etchings of the non-homogeneous banded rocks. The harder portions of these were raised in relief, producing quite an artistic pattern.

Of the effect of wind and erosion on rock, there was plenty of evidence around Winter Quarters. From the north, the look of the rocks was quite different from that on the southern side. The southern, windward faces were generally smooth and rounded, but there was no clear polish because the surface was partly worn down by the chipping and splitting caused by frost. The leeward faces were rougher and more broken down. Even more striking were the patterns on the non-uniform banded rocks. The harder parts of these were raised, creating a pretty cool design.

In regard to the drift, a point which struck me was the enormous amount of cold communicated to the sea by billions of tons of low-temperature snow thrown upon its surface. The effect upon the water, already at freezing-point, would be to congeal the surface at once. Whilst the wind continued, however, there was no opportunity for a crust to form, the uppermost layers being converted into a pea-soup-like film which streamed away to the north.

In relation to the drift, one thing that stood out to me was the huge amount of cold transferred to the sea by billions of tons of low-temperature snow covering its surface. The impact on the water, which was already at freezing point, would be to freeze the surface immediately. However, while the wind kept blowing, there was no chance for a crust to develop, as the top layers turned into a thick, pea-soup-like film that flowed northward.

A description of the drifts of Adelie Land would not be complete without mentioning the startling electrical effects which were sometimes observed. The first record of these was made by McLean, when on night-watch on March 22. While taking the observations at midnight, he noticed St. Elmo's fire, a "brush discharge" of electricity, on the points of the nephoscope. As the weather became colder this curious phenomenon increased in intensity. At any time in the drift, an electroscope exposed outside became rapidly charged. A spark gap in a vacuum, connected with a free end of wire, gave a continuous discharge. At times, when the effects were strong, the night-watchman would find the edges and wire stays of the screen outlined in a fashion reminiscent of a pyrotechnic display or an electric street-advertisement. The corners of boxes and points of rock glowed with a pale blue light. The same appeared over points on the clothing, on the mitts and round the funnel of the helmet. No sensation was transmitted to the body from these points of fire, at least nothing sufficiently acute to be felt, with the drift and wind lashing on the body outside. However, the anemograph several times discharged a continuous stream of sparks into Madigan's fingers while he was changing the records. Once these sparks reached half an inch in length, and, as his fingers were bared for the work, there was no mistaking the feeling.

A description of the drifts of Adelie Land wouldn't be complete without mentioning the surprising electrical effects that were sometimes observed. The first record of these was made by McLean during his night watch on March 22. While taking observations at midnight, he noticed St. Elmo's fire, a "brush discharge" of electricity, at the tips of the nephoscope. As the weather got colder, this strange phenomenon became more intense. At any time in the drift, an electroscope placed outside became quickly charged. A spark gap in a vacuum, connected with a free end of wire, produced a continuous discharge. At times, when the effects were strong, the night watchman would see the edges and wire stays of the screen outlined like a fireworks display or an electric street advertisement. The corners of boxes and points of rock glowed with a faint blue light. The same light appeared on points of clothing, on mitts, and around the funnel of the helmet. No sensation was transmitted to the body from these points of light, at least nothing strong enough to be felt, especially with the drift and wind hitting the body. However, the anemograph several times sent a continuous stream of sparks into Madigan's fingers while he was changing the records. Once these sparks reached half an inch in length, and since his fingers were exposed, the sensation was unmistakable.

For regular observations on the subject, Correll fixed a pointed collector—a miniature lightning-conductor—above the flagpole on the summit of the roof. A wire was led through an insulator, so that the stream of electricity could be subjected to experiment in the Hut. Here a "brush" of blue light radiated outwards to a distance of one inch. When a conductor was held close to it, a rattling volley of sparks immediately crossed the interval and the air was pervaded with a strong smell of ozone. Of course sparks were not always being emitted by the collector, and it was important to determine the periods of activity. To ensure this, Hurley devised an automatic arrangement, so that an electric bell was set ringing whenever a current was passing; the night-watchman would then note the fact in the log-book. However, the bell responded so often and so vigorously that it was soon dismantled for the benefit of sleepers. It was singular that the "brush discharge" was sometimes most copious when the atmosphere was filled with very fine drift, and not necessarily during dense drift.

For regular observations on the topic, Correll installed a pointed collector—like a mini lightning rod—above the flagpole on the roof. A wire was routed through an insulator so that the stream of electricity could be tested in the Hut. Here, a "brush" of blue light spread out about an inch. When a conductor was held nearby, a rapid burst of sparks jumped across the gap, and the air was filled with a strong ozone smell. Of course, sparks weren't always produced by the collector, and it was crucial to figure out the active periods. To do this, Hurley created an automatic system that rang an electric bell whenever a current was flowing; the night watchman would then record it in the logbook. However, the bell rang so frequently and loudly that it was soon taken down so the sleepers could rest. It was interesting that the "brush discharge" was sometimes most intense when the air was filled with very fine drift, not just during heavy drift.

After what has been said, it will be obvious that the drift-laden hurricanes of the country were more than ordinarily formidable. They scarcely seemed to provide a subject for poetic inspiration; still the following effusion appeared by McLean, Editor of the 'Adelie Blizzard':—

After what has been said, it will be clear that the storm-filled hurricanes of the country were particularly intense. They hardly seemed to offer a topic for poetic inspiration; yet the following piece was published by McLean, Editor of the 'Adelie Blizzard':—

       THE BLIZZARD

    A snow-hush brooding o'er the grey rock-hills!
    A wold of silence, ominous, that fills
    The wide seascape of ice-roofed islands, rolls
    To ether-zones that gird the frigid Poles!

    Realm of purest alabaster-white,
    Wreathed in a vast infinitude of light;
    The royal orb swings to thy summer gaze
    A glitt'ring azure world of crystal days.

    The lorn bird-voices of an unseen land-
    No hue of forest, gleam of ocean sand-
    Rise in a ceaseless plaint of raucous din,
    On northern tides the bergs come floating in.

    The wind-sprites murmuring in hinter-snow-
    The pent heart-throbbings of the wan plateau-
    Wing through the pulsing spell thrown o'er the sea,
    In wild and shrieking blizzard minstrelsy.

    Swirl of the drift-cloud's shimm'ring sleet;
    Race of the spray-smoke's hurtling sheet
    Swelling trail of the streaming, sunbright foam,
    Wafting sinuous brash to an ice-field home.

    Eddy-wraiths o'er the splintered schist-
    Torrent spume down the glacier hissed!
    Throbbing surge of the ebbing seaward gust,
    Raping stillness vast in its madd'ning lust.

    Lotus-floe 'neath the Barrier brink,
    Starting sheer—a marble blink-
    Pelting shafts from the show'ring arrow-blast
    Strike—ill the blackened flood seethe riven past.

    Glow of the vibrant, yellow west
    Pallid fades in the dread unrest.
    Low'ring shades through the fury-stricken night
    Rack the screaming void in shudd'ring might.

    Requiem peace from the hinter-snows
    Soft as river music flows.
    Dawn in a flushing glamour tints the sea;
    Serene her thrill of rhythmic ecstasy.
       THE BLIZZARD

    A snow-laden hush settles over the grey rocky hills!  
    A silent landscape, foreboding, fills  
    The vast stretch of icy islands, rolling  
    To the edge of the world that surrounds the freezing Poles!  

    A realm of purest white,  
    Surrounded by a boundless light;  
    The sun swings to your summer gaze  
    A sparkling blue world of crystal-clear days.  

    The lost bird calls echo from an unseen land—  
    No colors of forest, no glimmer of ocean sand—  
    Rise in an unending cry of harsh noise,  
    As icebergs float in on northern tides.  

    The whispers of wind sprites in the snow—  
    The pounding heartbeats of the pale plateau—  
    Sweep through the pulsing spell cast over the sea,  
    In wild and shrieking blizzard melodies.  

    Swirling drifts of shimmering sleet;  
    The rush of spray and smoke’s hurtling sheet  
    Swells into the bright, sunlit foam,  
    Carrying sinuous ice to its frozen home.  

    Whirling wraiths over the shattered rocks—  
    Torrent of foam cascading down the glacier!  
    The throbbing surge of the seaward breeze,  
    Disturbing the stillness with its maddening tease.  

    A floating ice sheet beneath the Barrier edge,  
    Suddenly appearing—a marble glare—  
    Pounding shafts from the showering wind blast  
    Strike—while the dark flood surges and rushes past.  

    The glow of the vibrant, yellow west  
    Fades pallidly in the dreadful unrest.  
    Gathering shadows through the stormy night  
    Tear through the screaming void with shuddering might.  

    A peaceful requiem from the snow-covered hills  
    Flows softly like a river’s calming thrills.  
    Dawn dawns in a flush of color across the sea;  
    Serene in its rhythm, it fills with ecstasy.

Sledging was out of the question. Indeed, we recognized how fortunate we were not to have pushed farther south in March. Had we advanced, it is more than likely that provisions would have been exhausted before we could have located the Hut in the sea of drift. Our hopes were now centred on midwinter calms.

Sledding was not an option. In fact, we understood how lucky we were not to have gone further south in March. If we had moved ahead, it’s very likely that our supplies would have run out before we could find the Hut in the sea of snow. Our hopes were now focused on the calm of midwinter.

Looking through my diary, I notice that on March 24, "we experienced a rise in spirits because of the improved weather." I find the average velocity of the wind for that day to have been forty-five miles per hour, corresponding to a "strong gale" on the Beaufort scale. This tells its own story.

Looking through my diary, I see that on March 24, "we felt happier because of the better weather." I find that the average wind speed for that day was forty-five miles per hour, which is considered a "strong gale" on the Beaufort scale. That says a lot.

When the high wind blew off shore, there was no backswell, on account of the pack-ice to the north quelling the sea. The arrival of a true ocean swell meant that the pack had been dispersed. On March 24 such appears to have been the case, for then, during the day, a big northerly swell set in, dashing over the ice-foot and scattering seaweed on the rocks.

When the strong wind blew offshore, there was no backwash because the pack ice to the north calmed the sea. The appearance of a real ocean swell indicated that the pack had broken up. On March 24, this seemed to happen, as a large northerly swell moved in during the day, crashing over the ice edge and spreading seaweed on the rocks.

After the equinox, the temperatures remained in the vicinity of zero, Fahrenheit. The penguins took to the sea, and, save for the glimpse of an occasional petrel on the wing, the landscape was desolate.

After the equinox, the temperatures stayed around freezing, in Fahrenheit. The penguins headed to the sea, and besides the occasional sighting of a petrel flying by, the landscape was barren.

It was high time that our programme of construction was completed, but, however much we tried, it was impossible to do a great deal in winds exceeding fifty miles an hour. By taking advantage of days freest from drift, the exterior of the Hangar was completed by April 6. After the air-tractor sledge had been moved inside, the snow was piled so high on the leeward face, that the shelter became naturally blocked with a rampart of snow which served admirably in place of the wall of tarpaulin which we originally intended to use.

It was about time our construction project got finished, but no matter how hard we tried, we couldn't do much when the winds were over fifty miles an hour. By making the most of the days with the least snow drift, we finished the outside of the Hangar by April 6. After we moved the air-tractor sledge inside, the snow piled up so high on the sheltered side that it naturally blocked the entrance with a snow wall, which worked perfectly instead of the tarpaulin wall we originally planned to use.

Bickerton could now proceed at leisure to make any necessary alterations. The Hangar was also used as a store for many articles which had been crowded into odd corners or rescued from the snow outside. To increase its size, tunnels were afterwards driven into the bank of snow and timber was stowed in these so as to be safe from burial and loss.

Bickerton could now take his time to make any necessary changes. The Hangar was also used as a storage space for many items that had been crammed into odd corners or saved from the snow outside. To make it larger, tunnels were later dug into the snowbank, and timber was stored in these tunnels to keep it safe from being buried and lost.

The building was finished just in the nick of time. Snow came down so thickly that had the falls occurred a few days earlier, the cases from which the place was constructed would have been effectually buried and the construction made an impossibility.

The building was completed just in time. Snow fell so heavily that if it had happened a few days earlier, the materials used to build the place would have been completely buried, making construction impossible.

But for the wind, the Hut would have been lost to sight. Still, it was completely surrounded by massive drifts, and the snow was driven by the wind past the canvas flap and through the entrance, until the veranda became choked.

But for the wind, the Hut would have disappeared from view. Still, it was completely surrounded by huge snowdrifts, and the wind pushed the snow past the canvas flap and through the entrance, until the porch was completely blocked.

Close, who was night-watchman during the early morning hours of April 7, had the greatest difficulty in getting outside to attend to his duties. To dig his way through the entrance, reach the instruments and to return occupied a whole hour.

Close, who was the night watchman during the early morning hours of April 7, had a hard time getting outside to do his job. Digging his way through the entrance, getting the instruments, and coming back took him a full hour.

We were inundated with snow; even a portion of the roof was buried. The situation required immediate attention; so it was decided to make a tunnel connecting the entrance veranda with the store veranda. From the north-western end of the latter, an out-draught had established itself, preserving a vertical funnel-like opening in the snow bank, always free for entrance or exit. This proved a fortunate accident.

We were buried in snow; even part of the roof was covered. The situation needed urgent action, so we decided to create a tunnel connecting the entrance veranda with the store veranda. From the northwestern end of the store veranda, an outdraft formed, creating a vertical funnel-like opening in the snow bank that was always open for entering or exiting. This turned out to be a lucky break.

Further, a second tunnel, over twenty feet in length, was driven out from the original entrance with a view to reaching the surface at a point beyond the lee of the Hut. It was thought that the scouring effect of the wind, there, would keep the opening of the tunnel free of drift. But when completed, it filled rapidly with snow and had to be sealed. It was then used to receive slop-water. While the fever for excavation was at its height, Whetter drove, as an off-shoot to the first, another tunnel which came to be used as a nursery for the pups.

Further, a second tunnel, over twenty feet long, was dug out from the original entrance to reach the surface at a spot beyond the shelter of the Hut. It was believed that the wind would keep the tunnel opening clear of snow. However, once it was finished, it quickly filled with snow and had to be closed off. It was then used to collect wastewater. During the height of the digging craze, Whetter extended the first tunnel with another tunnel that ended up being used as a nursery for the pups.

At this stage, to leave the Hut, it was necessary to crawl through a low trap-door in the wall of the inside or entrance veranda; the way then led to the connecting tunnel and onwards to the store veranda; finally one climbed through a manhole in the snow into the elements without. From the store veranda there was access to the Hangar by a hinged door in the common wall, and, as an additional convenience, a trap-door was made in the roof of the inner veranda to be used during spells of clear weather or in light drift.

At this point, to exit the Hut, you had to crawl through a low trap-door in the wall of the inner or entrance veranda; the path then led to the connecting tunnel and further to the store veranda; finally, you climbed through a manhole in the snow into the outside elements. From the store veranda, you could access the Hangar through a hinged door in the shared wall, and, as an added convenience, a trap-door was created in the roof of the inner veranda for use during clear weather or light snow.

The old landmarks became smothered in snow, making the Hut's position a matter of greater uncertainty. A journey by night to the magnetic huts was an outing with a spice of adventure.

The old landmarks were buried in snow, making it harder to find the Hut's location. Traveling at night to the magnetic huts was an adventure with a bit of excitement.

Climbing out of the veranda, one was immediately swallowed in the chaos of hurtling drift, the darkness sinister and menacing. The shrill wind fled by—

Climbing out of the porch, one was immediately engulfed by the chaos of rushing snow, the darkness feeling sinister and threatening. The sharp wind raced past—

                ...the noise of a drive of the Dead,
    Striving before the irresistible will
    Through the strange dusk of this, the Debatable land
    Between their place and ours.
                ...the sound of a group of the Dead,  
    Struggling against the unstoppable force  
    Through the eerie twilight of this, the Debatable land  
    Between their territory and ours.

Unseen wizard hands clutched with insane fury, hacked and harried. It was "the raw-ribbed Wild that abhors all life, the Wild that would crush and rend."

Unseen wizard hands gripped with crazy anger, chopped and attacked. It was "the raw-boned Wild that hates all life, the Wild that would smash and tear."

Cowering blindly, pushing fiercely through the turmoil, one strove to keep a course to reach the rocks in which the huts were hidden—such and such a bearing on the wind—so far. When the rocks came in sight, the position of the final destination was only deduced by recognising a few surrounding objects.

Cowering blindly and pushing hard through the chaos, one tried to stay on track to reach the rocks where the huts were hidden—keeping such and such a direction with the wind—so far. When the rocks were finally visible, the exact location of the destination was only figured out by recognizing a few nearby features.

On the return journey, the vicinity of the Hut would be heralded by such accidents as tripping over the "wireless" ground wires or kicking against a box or a heap of coal briquettes. These clues, properly followed up, would lead to the Hut itself, or at least to its shelving roof. In the very thick drifts it was even possible to stand on portions of the roof without any notion of the fact. Fossicking about, one kept on the alert for the feel of woodwork. When found and proved to be too extensive to be a partially buried box, it might safely be concluded to be some part of the roof, and only required to be skirted in order to reach the vertical entrance. The lost man often discovered this pitfall by dropping suddenly through into the veranda.

On the way back, you could spot the area around the Hut by incidents like tripping over the "wireless" ground wires or kicking a box or a pile of coal briquettes. If you followed these signs closely, they would lead you to the Hut itself or at least to its slanted roof. In the really deep snowdrifts, it was even possible to stand on parts of the roof without realizing it. While rummaging around, you had to stay alert for the feel of wood. If you found some and it seemed too large to just be a buried box, you could safely assume it was part of the roof and could be avoided to reach the entrance. The lost person often realized this danger by suddenly falling through onto the porch.

At the entrance to the tunnel, the roar of the tempest died away into a rumble, the trap-door opened and perhaps the strains of the gramophone would come in a kind of flippant defiance from the interior. Passing through the vestibule and work-room one beheld a scene in utter variance with the outer hell. Here were warm bunks, rest, food, light and companionship—for the time being, heaven! Outside, the crude and naked elements of a primitive and desolate world flowed in writhing torrents.

At the entrance to the tunnel, the roar of the storm faded into a rumble, the trapdoor opened, and maybe the sounds of the gramophone would play in a sort of cheeky defiance from inside. As you walked through the vestibule and workroom, you saw a scene completely different from the chaos outside. Here, there were warm beds, rest, food, light, and companionship—at that moment, heaven! Outside, the rough and harsh forces of a primitive and barren world surged in twisting torrents.

The night-watchman's duty of taking the meteorological observations at the screen adjacent to the Hut was a small matter compared with the foregoing. First of all, it was necessary for him to don a complete outfit of protective clothing. Dressing and undressing were tedious, and absorbed a good deal of time. At the screen, he would spend a lively few minutes wrestling in order to hold his ground, forcing the door back against the pressure of wind, endeavouring to make the light shine on the instruments, and, finally, clearing them of snow and reading them. For illumination a hurricane lantern wrapped in a calico wind-shield was first used, to be displaced later by an electrical signalling-lamp and, while the batteries lasted, by a light permanently fixed by Hannam in the screen itself. To assist in finding the manhole on his return, the night-watchman was in the habit of leaving a light burning in the outer veranda.

The night watchman's job of taking weather observations at the screen next to the Hut was a minor task compared to what came before. First, he had to put on a full set of protective gear. Getting dressed and undressed was a hassle and took up quite a bit of time. Once at the screen, he would spend a few intense minutes struggling to stay upright, pushing the door against the wind, trying to shine a light on the instruments, and finally, clearing them of snow to read them. At first, he used a hurricane lantern covered with a calico wind shield for light, later switching to an electrical signaling lamp, and while the batteries lasted, a light that Hannam had installed permanently in the screen itself. To help him find the manhole when he returned, the night watchman usually left a light on in the outer veranda.

I remember waking up early one morning to find the Hut unusually cold. On rising, I discovered Hurley also awake, busy lighting the fire which had died out. There was no sign of Correll, the night-watchman, and we found that the last entry in the log-book had been made several hours previously. Hurley dressed in full burberrys and went out to make a search, in which he was soon successful.

I remember waking up early one morning to find the Hut unusually cold. When I got up, I found Hurley also awake, busy lighting the fire that had gone out. There was no sign of Correll, the night-watchman, and we noticed that the last entry in the logbook had been made several hours earlier. Hurley put on his full burberry gear and went outside to look for him, and he was soon successful.

It appeared that Correll, running short of coal during the early morning hours, had gone out to procure some from the stack. While he was returning to the entrance, the wind rolled him over a few times, causing him to lose his bearings. It was blowing a hurricane, the temperature was -70 F., and the drift-snow was so thick as to be wall-like in opacity. He abandoned his load of coal, and, after searching about fruitlessly for some time in the darkness, he decided to wait for dawn. Hurley found him about twenty yards from the back of the Hut.

It seemed that Correll, running low on coal in the early morning hours, had gone out to get some from the pile. While he was coming back to the entrance, the wind knocked him down a few times, disorienting him. It was blowing a hurricane, the temperature was -70°F, and the snow was so thick it was like a wall. He dropped his load of coal and, after searching around without success for a while in the dark, he decided to wait for dawn. Hurley found him about twenty yards from the back of the Hut.

The suppression of outdoor occupations reacted in an outburst of indoor work. The smaller room had been well fitted up as a workshop, and all kinds of schemes were in progress for adapting our sledging-gear and instruments to the severe conditions. Correll worked long hours to keep up with the demands made upon him. Nobody was idle during the day, for, when there was nothing else to be done, there always remained the manufacture and alteration of garments and crampons.

The restriction on outdoor jobs led to a surge in indoor activities. The smaller room was well-equipped as a workshop, and various plans were underway to modify our sledging gear and instruments for the harsh conditions. Correll put in long hours to meet the demands placed on him. No one was lazy during the day; whenever there was nothing else to work on, we could always make or alter clothing and crampons.

As soon as the wind abated to a reasonable velocity, there was a rush to the outside jobs. Lulls would come unexpectedly, activity inside ceased, and the Hut, as seen by a spectator, resembled an ants' nest upon which a strange foot had trodden: eighteen men swarming through the manhole in rapid succession, hurrying hither and thither.

As soon as the wind calmed down to a manageable speed, everyone rushed to do the outdoor tasks. The lulls would come out of nowhere, the work inside would stop, and the Hut, from an outsider's perspective, looked like an ant nest that had been stepped on: eighteen men pouring through the manhole in quick succession, darting around everywhere.

The neighbouring sea still remained free from an ice-crust. This, of course, did not mean that freezing was not going on continuously. On the contrary, the chilling was no doubt accelerated, but the bulk of the ice was carried off to the north as fast as it was formed. Quantities, however, remained as ground-ice, anchored to the kelp and stones on the bottom. Gazing down through the clear waters one saw a white, mamillated sheath covering the jungle of giant seaweed, recalling a forest after a heavy snowfall. The ice, instead of being a dead weight bearing down the branches, tended to float, and, when accumulated in large masses, sometimes succeeded in rising to the surface, uprooting and lifting great lengths of seaweed with it. One branching stem, found floating in the harbour, measured eighteen feet in length.

The nearby sea was still free of an ice layer. This didn’t mean that freezing wasn’t happening constantly. On the contrary, the cooling was likely speeding up, but the majority of the ice was being carried north as fast as it was forming. Still, some ice remained as ground ice, attached to the kelp and rocks on the sea floor. Looking down through the clear water, you could see a white, bumpy layer covering the jungle of giant seaweed, reminiscent of a forest after a heavy snowfall. The ice didn’t weigh down the branches; instead, it tended to float, and when it built up in large amounts, it sometimes rose to the surface, uprooting and lifting large sections of seaweed with it. One floating stem found in the harbor was eighteen feet long.

Whenever a temporary calm intervened, a skin of ice quickly appeared over the whole surface of the water. In the early stages, this formation consisted of loose, blade-like crystals, previously floating freely below the surface and rising by their own buoyancy. At the surface, if undisturbed, they soon became cemented together. For example, during a calm interval on April 6, within the interval of an hour, an even crust, one inch thick, covered the sea. But the wind returned before the ice was sufficiently strong to resist it, and it all broke up and drifted away to the north, except a piece which remained wedged firmly between the sides of the boat harbour.

Whenever a brief calm came, a layer of ice quickly formed over the entire surface of the water. In the beginning, this ice consisted of loose, blade-like crystals that had been floating freely just below the surface and rose due to their own buoyancy. If left undisturbed at the surface, these crystals quickly bonded together. For instance, during a calm period on April 6, within just an hour, a smooth crust an inch thick covered the sea. But the wind picked up again before the ice was strong enough to hold, causing it to break apart and drift away to the north, except for a piece that got stuck firmly between the walls of the boat harbor.

In the calm weather, abundant "worms" freely swimming, jelly-fish, pteropods and small fish were observed. Traps were lowered along the edge of the harbour-ice and dredgings were made in every possible situation. The bulk of the biological collecting was effected under circumstances in which Hunter and Laseron might well have given up work in disgust. For instance, I noted in my diary that on May 16, with an off shore wind of forty-three miles per hour, they and several others were dredging from the edge of the slippery bay-ice. The temperature at the time was -2 degrees F.

In the calm weather, plenty of "worms" were swimming freely, along with jellyfish, pteropods, and small fish. Traps were lowered at the edge of the harbor ice, and dredging was done in every possible situation. Most of the biological collecting happened under conditions where Hunter and Laseron might have easily given up in frustration. For example, I wrote in my diary that on May 16, with an offshore wind blowing at forty-three miles per hour, they and several others were dredging from the edge of the slippery bay ice. The temperature at that time was -2 degrees F.

During April the head of the boat harbour froze over permanently, the ice reaching a thickness of eighteen inches in ten days. By that time it was strong enough to be suitable for a tide-gauge. This was one of Bage's charges, destined to take him out for many months in fair and foul weather.

During April, the harbor's surface froze solid, with the ice thickening to eighteen inches in ten days. By then, it was sturdy enough to be used for a tide gauge. This was one of Bage's responsibilities, which would keep him out for many months in both good and bad weather.

There were several occasions in April when the velocity of the wind exceeded ninety miles an hour. On the evening of the 26th, the wind slackened, and for part of the 27th had almost fallen to a calm. This brought the optimists to the fore, once again, with the theory that the worst was over. The prediction was far from being fulfilled, for, as the days passed, the average velocity steadily rose. On May 11 the average for the twenty-four hours was eighty miles per hour. By that time the Hut had been further protected by a crescent of cases, erected behind the first break-wind. In height this erection stood above the Hangar, and, when the snow became piled in a solid ramp on the leeward side, it was more compact than ever. Inside the Hut extra struts were introduced, stiffening the principal rafters on the southern side. It was reassuring to know that these precautions had been taken, for, on May 15, the wind blew at an average velocity of ninety miles per hour throughout the whole twenty-four hours.

There were several times in April when the wind speed went over ninety miles an hour. On the evening of the 26th, the wind slowed down, and for part of the 27th, it almost became calm. This brought the optimists back, believing that the worst was over. However, that prediction didn't come true, as the average wind speed steadily increased over the days. On May 11, the average for the entire 24 hours was eighty miles per hour. By then, the Hut had been further reinforced by a crescent of cases set up behind the first windbreak. This structure was taller than the Hangar, and when the snow piled up into a solid ramp on the leeward side, it became even more compact. Inside the Hut, extra struts were added to strengthen the main rafters on the southern side. It was comforting to know that these precautions had been taken because, on May 15, the wind blew at an average speed of ninety miles per hour for the entire 24-hour period.

Having failed to demolish us by dogged persistence, the hurricane tried new tactics on the evening of May 24, in the form of a terrific series of Herculean gusts. As we learned afterwards, the momentary velocity of these doubtless approached two hundred miles per hour. At 11.30 P.M. the situation was cheerfully discussed, though every one was tuned up to a nervous pitch as the Hut creaked and shuddered under successive blows. It seemed very doubtful whether the roof would resist the gusts, and the feasibility of the meat cellar as a last haven of refuge was discussed. After the passage of each gust, the barometer dropped, rising again immediately afterwards. Similar pulsations of the barometer were observed many times later in the year. The maximum sudden movement noted was one-fifth inch. Had the interior of the Hut been more freely in communication with the outside air, instead of resembling a hermetically sealed box, the "kicks" would undoubtedly have been much greater.

Having failed to take us down with relentless pressure, the hurricane switched up its approach on the evening of May 24, unleashing an incredible series of powerful gusts. We learned later that the peak speed of these gusts likely reached nearly two hundred miles per hour. At 11:30 P.M., we cheerfully discussed the situation, though everyone was on edge as the Hut creaked and shook with each hit. It seemed very uncertain whether the roof would hold against the blasts, and we talked about the possibility of using the meat cellar as a last refuge. After each gust, the barometer dropped, then quickly rose again. We observed similar fluctuations in the barometer multiple times later in the year. The maximum sudden movement recorded was one-fifth of an inch. If the inside of the Hut had been more connected to the outside air, instead of feeling like a sealed box, those "hits" would definitely have been much stronger.

Cyclonic gusts were repeated a few days after, when the upper tiers of boxes composing the break-wind were thrown down and pebbles from the moraine were hurled on the roof. The average velocity of the wind for each of the three autumn months was as follows: March, 49 miles per hour; April, 51.5 miles per hour, and May 60.7 miles per hour.

Cyclonic gusts occurred again a few days later, when the top layers of boxes making up the windbreak were knocked down and pebbles from the moraine were thrown onto the roof. The average wind speed for each of the three autumn months was as follows: March, 49 miles per hour; April, 51.5 miles per hour; and May, 60.7 miles per hour.

On May 1 the temperatures became lower, so that it was difficult to move about in the gales without the face getting frost-bitten. Our usual remedy when this occurred was to hold a mitt over the part affected; thus sheltered, its circulation of blood was soon re-established, unless the cold were very intense. In the extremities—the fingers and toes—warmth was not so easily restored.

On May 1, the temperatures dropped, making it hard to be outside in the strong winds without getting frostbite on your face. Our typical solution for this was to cover the affected area with a mitt; with that protection, blood circulation would usually bounce back quickly, unless it was extremely cold. In the extremities—like fingers and toes—getting warm again was not as easy.

Returning from attending the instruments at noon on May 22, Madigan, according to the usual habit, before taking off his wind-proof clothes, commenced clearing away the ice adhering to his helmet and face. One white patch refused to leave the side of his face, until some one observed that it was a frost-bite, and acquainted him of the fact. Frost-bites that day were excusable enough, for the wind was blowing between ninety-five and hundred miles per hour, there was dense drifting snow and a temperature of -28 degrees F.

Returning from checking the instruments at noon on May 22, Madigan, as was his usual routine, started to clear the ice stuck to his helmet and face before taking off his wind-proof clothes. One white spot wouldn’t come off the side of his face until someone pointed out that it was a frostbite and let him know. Frostbites were understandable that day, considering the wind was blowing between ninety-five and a hundred miles per hour, there was heavy drifting snow, and the temperature was -28 degrees F.

We had found an accursed country. On the fringe of an unspanned continent along whose gelid coast our comrades had made their home—we knew not where—we dwelt where the chill breath of a vast, Polar wilderness, quickening to the rushing might of eternal blizzards, surged to the northern seas. Already, and for long months we were beneath "frost-fettered Winter's frown."

We had discovered a cursed land. On the edge of a vast continent, along whose icy coast our friends had settled—we didn't know where—we lived where the cold breath of a vast, Polar wilderness, rushing with the relentless force of endless blizzards, flowed into the northern seas. For a long time, we had been under "frost-fettered Winter's frown."





CHAPTER VIII DOMESTIC LIFE

Our hearth and home was the living Hut and its focus was the stove. Kitchen and stove were indissolubly linked, and beyond their pale was a wilderness of hanging clothes, boots, finnesko, mitts and what not, bounded by tiers of bunks and blankets, more hanging clothes and dim photographs between the frost-rimed cracks of the wooden walls.

Our home centered around the living hut, with the stove as its main feature. The kitchen and stove were inseparable, and beyond them was a chaotic mix of hanging clothes, boots, winter boots, mittens, and more, surrounded by layers of bunks and blankets, more hanging clothes, and blurry photographs peeking through the frost-covered cracks in the wooden walls.

One might see as much in the first flicker of the acetylene through a maze of hurrying figures, but as his eyes grew accustomed to the light, the plot would thicken: books orderly and disorderly, on bracketed shelves, cameras great and small in motley confusion, guns and a gramophone-horn, serpentine yards of gas-tubing, sewing machines, a microscope, rows of pint-mugs, until—thud! he has obstructed a wild-eyed messman staggering into the kitchen with a box of ice.

One could notice this in the initial glow of the acetylene amidst a crowd of rushing figures, but as his eyes adjusted to the light, the scene would become more complex: books neatly and messily stacked on bracketed shelves, cameras of all sizes in chaotic disarray, guns and a gramophone horn, tangled lengths of gas tubing, sewing machines, a microscope, and rows of pint mugs, until—thud! he accidentally blocked a wild-eyed kitchen worker struggling to carry a box of ice.

The wilderness was always inhabited, so much so that it often became a bear-garden in which raucous good humour prevailed over everything.

The wilderness was always full of life, to the point that it often turned into a lively place where loud laughter and good vibes ruled over everything.

Noise was a necessary evil, and it commenced at 7.30 A.M., with the subdued melodies of the gramophone, mingled with the stirring of the porridge-pot and the clang of plates deposited none too gently on the table. At 7.50 A.M. came the stentorian: "Rise and shine!" of the night-watchman, and a curious assortment of cat-calls, beating on pots and pans and fragmentary chaff. At the background, so to speak, of all these sounds was the swishing rush of the wind and the creaking strain of the roof, but these had become neglected. In fact, if there were a calm, every one was restless and uneasy.

Noise was a necessary annoyance, starting at 7:30 A.M. with the soft tunes of the record player, mixed with the stirring of the porridge pot and the clattering of plates placed roughly on the table. At 7:50 A.M., the loud call of "Rise and shine!" from the night watchman rang out, accompanied by a strange variety of catcalls, banging on pots and pans, and scattered shouts. In the background of all these sounds was the rushing wind and the creaking of the roof, but these were mostly ignored. In fact, if there was a calm, everyone felt restless and uneasy.

The seasoned sleeper who survived the ten minutes' bombardment before 8 o'clock was an unusual person, and he was often the Astronomer Royal. Besides his dignified name he possessed a wrist-watch, and there was never a movement in his mountain of blankets until 7.59 A.M., unless the jocular night-watchman chose to make a heap of them on the floor. To calls like "Breakfast all ready! Porridge on the table getting cold!" seventeen persons in varying stages of wakefulness responded. No one was guilty of an elaborate toilet, water being a scarce commodity. There were adherents of the snow-wash theory, but these belonged to an earlier and warmer epoch of our history.

The seasoned sleeper who made it through the ten minutes of noise before 8 o'clock was quite rare, often being the Astronomer Royal. Along with his impressive title, he had a wristwatch, and there was never a stir in his mountain of blankets until 7:59 A.M., unless the playful night-watchman decided to toss them onto the floor. Calls like, "Breakfast is ready! Porridge is on the table getting cold!" prompted seventeen people at different levels of wakefulness to respond. No one was inclined to go through an elaborate morning routine since water was a limited resource. There were some who subscribed to the snow-wash theory, but they were from an earlier and warmer time in our history.

For downright, tantalizing cheerfulness there was no one to equal the night-watchman. While others strove to collect their befuddled senses, this individual prated of "wind eighty miles per hour with moderate drift and brilliant St. Elmo's fire." He boasted of the number of garments he had washed, expanded vigorously on bread making—his brown, appetizing specimens in full public view—told of the latest escapade among the dogs, spoke of the fitful gleams of the aurora between 1.30 and 2 A.M., of his many adventures on the way to the meteorological screen and so forth; until from being a mere night-watchman he had raised himself to the status of a public hero. For a time he was most objectionable, but under the solid influence of porridge, tinned fruit, fresh bread, butter and tea and the soothing aroma of innumerable pipes, other public heroes arose and ousted this upstart of the night. Meanwhile, the latter began to show signs of abating energy after twelve hours' work. Soon some wag had caught him having a private nap, a whispered signal was passed round and the unfortunate hero was startled into life with a rousing "Rise and shine!" in which all past scores were paid off.

For pure, captivating cheerfulness, no one could match the night-watchman. While everyone else tried to gather their scattered thoughts, he chatted away about "winds at eighty miles per hour with a moderate drift and brilliant St. Elmo's fire." He bragged about how many clothes he'd washed, passionately discussed bread making—his delicious, brown loaves on full display—shared the latest adventures of the dogs, talked about the flickering auroras between 1:30 and 2 AM, and recounted his many escapades on the way to the meteorological screen, and so on; elevating himself from just a night-watchman to a public hero. He was a bit unbearable at times, but after enjoying hearty porridge, canned fruit, fresh bread, butter, and tea, along with the comforting smell of countless pipes, other public heroes emerged and pushed this night-time upstart aside. Meanwhile, he started to show signs of tiredness after twelve hours of work. Soon, someone caught him taking a quick nap, a quiet signal went around, and the poor hero was jolted awake with a cheerful "Rise and shine!" where all previous grievances were settled.

Every one was at last awake and the day began in earnest. The first hint of this came from the messman and cook who commenced to make a Herculean sweep of the pint-mugs and tin plates. The former deferentially proceeded to scrape the plates, the master-cook presiding over a tub of boiling water in which he vigorously scoured knives, forks and spoons, transferring them in dripping handfuls to the cleanest part of the kitchen-table. Cooks of lyric inclination would enliven the company with the score of the latest gramophone opera, and the messman and company would often feel impelled to join in the choruses.

Everyone was finally awake, and the day kicked off in earnest. The first sign of this came from the messman and cook, who started a massive cleanup of the pint mugs and tin plates. The messman respectfully began scraping the plates while the head cook managed a tub of boiling water, vigorously scrubbing knives, forks, and spoons, transferring them in dripping handfuls to the cleanest spot on the kitchen table. Cooks with a love for music would entertain everyone with the latest gramophone opera, and the messman and others would often feel compelled to join in the choruses.

The night-watchman had sunk into log-like slumber, and the meteorologist and his merry men were making preparations to go abroad. The merry men included the ice-carrier, the magnetician, the two wardens of the dogs, the snow-shoveller and coal-carrier and the storeman. The rest subdivided themselves between the living Hut at 45 degrees F. and the outer Hut below freezing-point, taking up their endless series of jobs.

The night-watchman had fallen into a deep sleep, and the meteorologist and his crew were getting ready to head out. The crew included the ice-carrier, the magnetician, the two dog wardens, the snow shoveler, the coal carrier, and the storeman. The others split themselves between the living Hut at 45 degrees F and the outer Hut below freezing, diving into their endless list of tasks.

The merry men began to make an organized raid on the kitchen. Around and above the stove hung oddments like wolf-skin mitts, finnesko, socks, stockings and helmets, which had passed from icy rigidity through sodden limpness to a state of parchment dryness. The problem was to recover one's own property and at the same time to avoid the cook scraping the porridge saucepan and the messman scrubbing the table.

The merry men started to launch a coordinated raid on the kitchen. Hanging around and above the stove were various items like wolf-skin mitts,暖 botas, socks, stockings, and helmets, which had gone from being frozen stiff, to wet and floppy, to a brittle dryness like parchment. The challenge was to get back your own stuff while also avoiding the cook scraping the porridge pot and the messman scrubbing the table.

The urbane storeman saved the situation by inquiring of the cook: "What will you have for lunch?" Then followed a heated colloquy, the former, like a Cingalese vendor, having previously made up his mind. The argument finally crystallized down to lambs' tongues and beetroot, through herrings and tomato sauce, fresh herrings, kippered herrings, sardines and corn beef.

The sophisticated storekeeper turned things around by asking the cook, "What do you want for lunch?" This led to a lively debate, with the storekeeper, much like a Cingalese vendor, having already made his decision. Eventually, the conversation boiled down to lamb tongues and beetroot, passing through herring and tomato sauce, fresh herring, kippered herring, sardines, and corned beef.

The second question was a preliminary to more serious business; "What would you like for dinner?"

The second question was a lead-in to more important stuff: "What do you want for dinner?"

Although much trouble might have been saved by reference to the regulation programme, which was composed to provide variety in diet and to eliminate any remote chance of scurvy, most cooks adopted an attitude of surly independence, counting it no mean thing to have wheedled from the storeman a few more ounces of "glaxo," another tin of peas or an extra ration of penguin meat. All this chaffering took place in the open market-place, so to speak, and there was no lack of frank criticism from bystanders, onlookers and distant eavesdroppers. In case the cook was worsted, the messman sturdily upheld his opinions, and in case the weight of public opinion was too much for the storeman, he slipped on his felt mitts, shouldered a Venesta box and made for the tunnel which led to the store.

Although a lot of trouble could have been avoided by following the regulated program, which was designed to add variety to the diet and prevent any chance of scurvy, most cooks chose to be grumpy and independent, considering it quite an achievement to have convinced the storeman to give them a few extra ounces of "glaxo," another tin of peas, or an extra serving of penguin meat. All this haggling happened in a public marketplace, and there was no shortage of open criticism from bystanders, onlookers, and distant listeners. If the cook lost an argument, the messman confidently defended his views, and if the weight of public opinion became too much for the storeman, he would put on his felt mitts, grab a Venesta box, and head for the tunnel that led to the store.

He reaches an overhead vent admitting a cool torrent of snow, and with the inseparable box plunges ahead into darkness. An hour later his ruddy face reappears in the Hut, and a load of frosted tins is soon unceremoniously dumped on to the kitchen table. The cook in a swift survey notes the absence of penguin meat. "That'll take two hours to dig out!" is the storeman's rejoinder, and to make good his word, proceeds to pull off blouse and helmet. By careful inquiry in the outer Hut he finds an ice-axe, crowbar and hurricane lantern. The next move is to the outer veranda, where a few loose boards are soon removed, and the storeman, with a lithe twist, is out of sight.

He reaches an overhead vent blowing in a cool rush of snow, and with the inseparable box, he pushes into the darkness. An hour later, his flushed face reappears in the Hut, and a pile of frosted cans is quickly dumped onto the kitchen table. The cook glances around and notices the lack of penguin meat. "That’ll take two hours to dig out!" the storeman replies, and to back up his claim, he starts to take off his shirt and helmet. After asking around in the outer Hut, he finds an ice axe, a crowbar, and a hurricane lantern. His next step is to the outer veranda, where he swiftly removes a few loose boards, and with a quick twist, he disappears from sight.

We have pushed the tools down and, following the storeman, painfully squeezed into an Arcadia of starry mounds of snow and glistening plaques of ice, through which project a few boulders and several carcases of mutton. The storeman rummages in the snow and discloses a pile of penguins, crusted hard together in a homogeneous lump. Dislodging a couple of penguins appears an easy proposition, but we are soon disillusioned. The storeman seizes the head of one bird, wrenches hard, and off it breaks as brittle as a stalactite. The same distracting thing happens to both legs, and the only remedy is to chip laboriously an icy channel around it.

We pushed the tools down and, following the storeman, carefully squeezed into a beautiful area of snowy hills and shiny ice patches, where a few boulders and several carcasses of sheep are scattered. The storeman digs through the snow and uncovers a bunch of penguins, stuck together in a solid mass. Trying to remove a couple of penguins seems easy at first, but we quickly realize it's not. The storeman grabs the head of one bird, pulls hard, and it snaps off as easily as a stalactite. The same thing happens with both legs, and the only solution is to painstakingly carve an icy path around it.

In a crouching or lying posture, within a confined space, this means the expenditure of much patience, not to mention the exhaustion of all invective. A crowbar decides the question. One part of the channel is undermined, into this the end of the crowbar is thrust and the penguin shoots up and hits the floor of the Hut.

In a crouched or lying position, in a tight space, this requires a lot of patience, not to mention the frustration of running out of insults. A crowbar settles the matter. One side of the channel is dug out, into which the end of the crowbar is inserted, and the penguin shoots up and hits the floor of the Hut.

The storeman, plastered with snow, reappears hot and triumphant before the cook, but this dignitary is awkwardly kneading the dough of wholemeal scones, and the messman is feeding the fire with seal-blubber to ensure a "quick" oven. Every one is too busy to notice the storeman, for, like the night-watchman, his day is over and he must find another job.

The storeman, covered in snow, comes back, feeling hot and triumphant in front of the cook, who is awkwardly working the dough for wholemeal scones. Meanwhile, the messman is fueling the fire with seal blubber to make sure the oven heats up quickly. Everyone is too busy to pay attention to the storeman because, like the night-watchman, his day is done and he needs to find another job.

Jobs in the Hut were the elixir of life, and a day's cooking was no exception to the rule. It began at 7 A.M., and, with a brief intermission between lunch and afternoon tea, continued strenuously till 8.30 P.M. Cooks were broadly classified as "Crook Cooks" and "Unconventional Cooks" by the eating public. Such flattering titles as "Assistant Grand Past Master of the Crook Cooks' Association" or "Associate of the Society of Muddling Messmen" were not empty inanities; they were founded on solid fact—on actual achievement. If there were no constitutional affiliation, strong sympathy undoubtedly existed between the "Crook Cooks' Association" and "The Society of Muddling Messmen." Both contained members who had committed "championships."

Jobs in the Hut were the lifeblood, and a day's cooking was no exception. It started at 7 A.M. and, with a short break between lunch and afternoon tea, went on intensively until 8:30 P.M. Cooks were generally divided into "Crook Cooks" and "Unconventional Cooks" by the dining crowd. Titles like "Assistant Grand Past Master of the Crook Cooks' Association" or "Associate of the Society of Muddling Messmen" weren’t just empty phrases; they were based on real accomplishments. While there might not have been an official connection, there was definitely a strong camaraderie between the "Crook Cooks' Association" and "The Society of Muddling Messmen." Both groups included members who had achieved "championships."

"Championship" was a term evolved from the local dialect, applying to a slight mishap, careless accident or unintentional disaster in any department of Hut life. The fall of a dozen plates from the shelf to the floor, the fracture of a table-knife in frozen honey, the burning of the porridge or the explosion of a tin thawing in the oven brought down on the unfortunate cook a storm of derisive applause and shouts of "Championship! Championship!"

"Championship" was a term that came from the local dialect, referring to a minor mishap, careless accident, or unintentional disaster in any aspect of Hut life. The dropping of a dozen plates from the shelf to the floor, the breaking of a table knife in frozen honey, the burning of porridge, or the explosion of a tin thawing in the oven would cause a wave of mocking applause and shouts of "Championship! Championship!" to rain down on the unlucky cook.

Thawing-out tinned foods by the heroic aid of a red-hot stove was a common practice. One day a tin of baked beans was shattered in the "port" oven, and fragments of dried beans were visible on the walls and door for weeks. Our military cook would often facetiously refer to "platoon-firing in the starboard oven."

Thawing out canned food with the help of a scorching hot stove was a typical routine. One day, a can of baked beans exploded in the "port" oven, leaving bits of dried beans stuck on the walls and door for weeks. Our military cook would often jokingly call it "platoon-firing in the starboard oven."

One junior member of the "Crook Cooks' Association" had the hardihood to omit baking powder in a loaf of soda-bread, trusting that prolonged baking would repair the omission. The result was a "championship" of a very superior order. Being somewhat modest, he committed it through the trap-door to the mercy of the wind, and for a time it was lost in the straggling rubbish which tailed away to the north. Even the prowling dogs in their wolfish hunger could not overcome a certain prejudice. Of course some one found it, and the public hailed it with delight. A searching inquiry was made, but the perpetrator was never discovered. That loaf, however, like the proverbial bad penny, turned up for months. When the intricate system of snow-tunnels was being perfected, it was excavated. In the early summer, when the aeroplane was dug out of the Hangar, that loaf appeared once more, and almost the last thing we saw when leaving the Hut, nearly two years after, was this petrifaction on an icy pedestal near the Boat Harbour.

One junior member of the "Crook Cooks' Association" had the nerve to skip baking powder in a loaf of soda bread, believing that baking it longer would fix the mistake. The result was a "championship" of an exceptional kind. Being somewhat humble, he threw it through the trapdoor to let the wind take care of it, and for a while, it was lost among the scattered debris to the north. Even the wandering dogs, in their ravenous hunger, couldn't bring themselves to touch it. Naturally, someone found it, and the public loved it. An inquiry was launched, but the culprit was never found. That loaf, like the infamous bad penny, kept showing up for months. When the complex network of snow tunnels was being perfected, it was dug up. In early summer, when the airplane was finally taken out of the Hangar, that loaf showed up again, and nearly two years later, as we were leaving the Hut, the last thing we saw was that petrified loaf sitting on an icy pedestal near the Boat Harbour.

No one ever forgot the roly-poly pudding made without suet; synthetic rubber was its scientific name. And the muddling messman could never be surpassed who lost the cutter of the sausage machine and put salt-water ice in the melting-pots.

No one ever forgot the round, soft pudding made without suet; its scientific name was synthetic rubber. And the clumsy messman who lost the cutter for the sausage machine and added salt-water ice to the melting pots was impossible to outdo.

There appeared in the columns of 'The Adelie Blizzard' an article by the meteorologist descriptive of an occasion when two members of the "Crook Cooks' Association" officiated in the kitchen:

There was an article in the columns of 'The Adelie Blizzard' by the meteorologist describing an event when two members of the "Crook Cooks' Association" worked in the kitchen:

TEREBUS AND ERROR IN ERUPTION An 'Orrible Affair in One Act BY A SURVIVOR

TEREBUS AND ERROR IN ERUPTION An Horrible Affair in One Act BY A SURVIVOR

Dramatis Personae

Character List

TEREBUS | | Crook Cooks ERROR |

TEREBUS | | Crook Cooks ERROR |

Other Expedition Members

Other Expedition Team Members

Scene: Kitchen, Winter Quarters.

Kitchen, Winter Quarters.

Time: 5.30 P.M.

5:30 PM

ERROR. Now, Terebus, just bring me a nice clean pot, will you?

ERROR. Now, Terebus, can you just get me a nice clean pot?

TEREBUS [from his bunk]. Go on, do something yourself!

TEREBUS [from his bunk]. Go on, do something for yourself!

ERROR. Do something? I've done everything that has been done this afternoon.

ERROR. Do something? I've done everything that was done this afternoon.

TEREBUS. Well, you ought to feel pretty fresh.

TEREBUS. Well, you should be feeling pretty refreshed.

ERROR. And all the melting-pots are empty and I'm not going to fill them. Besides, it's not in the regulations.

ERROR. And all the melting pots are empty, and I'm not going to fill them. Besides, it's not allowed in the rules.

Voices. Who's going crook? Error!

Voices. Who's getting upset? Error!

[TEREBUS climbs from his bunk and exit for ice. ERROR attempts to extricate a pot from the nails in the shelves. Loud alarums.

[TEREBUS gets out of his bunk and heads out for ice. ERROR tries to get a pot out from the nails on the shelves. Loud alarms.]

Voices. Champ-ion-ship!

Voices. Championship!

[Alarums without. Loud cries of "Door!" Enter TEREBUS with box of ice; fills all the pots on the stove.

[Alarums outside. Loud shouts of "Door!" Enter TEREBUS with a box of ice; fills all the pots on the stove.

ERROR. Good heavens, man, you've filled up the tea water with ice.

ERROR. Good grief, dude, you've filled the tea kettle with ice.

TEREBUS [with hoarse laugh]. Never mind, they won't want so much glaxo to cool it.

TEREBUS [with a rough laugh]. Don't worry, they won't need that much glaxo to cool it down.

ERROR [who has meanwhile been mixing bread]. What shall we bake the bread in? I believe it is considered that a square tin is more suitable for ordinary ovens, but, on the other hand, Nansen in his 'Farthest North' used flat dishes.

ERROR [who has meanwhile been mixing bread]. What should we bake the bread in? I think it's generally accepted that a square tin is better for regular ovens, but on the flip side, Nansen in his 'Farthest North' used flat dishes.

TEREBUS. Use a tin. There'll be less surface exposed to the cold oven.

TEREBUS. Use a tin. There will be less surface exposed to the cold oven.

ERROR. What's all this water on the floor? I thought my feet seemed cold. Some one must have upset a bucket.

ERROR. What's all this water on the floor? I thought my feet felt cold. Someone must have knocked over a bucket.

TEREBUS. Oh, it's one of the taps turned on. Never mind, there's plenty more ice where that came from. Get your sea-boots.

TEREBUS. Oh, it's one of the taps that's running. No worries, there's plenty more ice where that came from. Put on your sea boots.

[Enter METEOROLOGICAL STAFF and others with snow-covered burberrys, mitts, etc., crowd kitchen and hang impedimenta round the stove. Great tumult.

[Enter METEOROLOGICAL STAFF and others wearing snow-covered coats, mittens, etc., crowding the kitchen and hanging their gear around the stove. Great chaos.]

TEREBUS. Here, out of the kitchen. This isn't the time to worry the cooks.

TEREBUS. Here, out of the kitchen. This isn't the time to stress the cooks.

ERROR. Take those burberrys away, please, old man. They're dripping into the soup.

ERROR. Please take those Burberrys away, old man. They're dripping into the soup.

TEREBUS. Give it some flavour at least.

TEREBUS. Add some flavor to it, at least.

[Great activity in the crater of ERROR while TEREBUS clears the kitchen. ERROR continues stirring Soup and tapioca custard on the stove. Strong smell of burning.

[Great activity in the crater of ERROR while TEREBUS cleans the kitchen. ERROR keeps stirring soup and tapioca pudding on the stove. There’s a strong smell of something burning.]

VOICES [in peculiarly joyful chorus]. Something burning!

VOICES [in a strangely happy chorus]. Something's on fire!

ERROR [aside to TEREBUS]. It's all right. It will taste all right. Say it's cloth on the stove.

ERROR [aside to TEREBUS]. It's okay. It'll taste okay. Just say it's fabric on the stove.

TEREBUS. Somebody's burberrys burning against the stove!!

TEREBUS. Someone's Burberrys are burning against the stove!!

[General rush to the stove.

[General rush to the stove.]

TEREBUS. It's all right, I've taken them away.

TEREBUS. It's fine, I've removed them.

[Interval, during which much sotto voce discussion is heard in the kitchen.

[Interval, during which a lot of quiet discussion is heard in the kitchen.

ERROR. We haven't put the spinach on to thaw and it's after six o'clock.

ERROR. We haven't taken the spinach out to thaw and it's past six o'clock.

TEREBUS. Warm it up and put it on the table with the tin-openers.

TEREBUS. Heat it up and place it on the table with the can openers.

ERROR. I'm afraid that's against the regulations. Put it in the oven and shut the door.

ERROR. I’m sorry, but that goes against the rules. Just put it in the oven and close the door.

[TEREBUS does so. Later, terrific explosion, followed by strong smell of spinach.

[TEREBUS does so. Later, a huge explosion occurs, followed by a strong smell of spinach.]

VOICES. What's the matter? Terebus in eruption!

VOICES. What's going on? Terebus is erupting!

TEREBUS [wiping spinach off his face]. Nothing wrong. Only a tin of spinach opened automatically.

TEREBUS [wiping spinach off his face]. It's nothing. Just a tin of spinach that popped open by itself.

ERROR. It's plastered all over the oven and on everything.

ERROR. It's everywhere on the oven and on everything.

TEREBUS. Don't worry, it will be served up with the baked penguin.

TEREBUS. Don't worry, it will be served with the baked penguin.

[Period of partial quiescence of TEREBUS and ERROR, which is regarded as an evil omen.

[Period of partial inactivity of TEREBUS and ERROR, which is seen as a bad sign.

ERROR [in persuasive tone]. Have you made the tea, old boy? It's nearly half-past six.

ERROR [in persuasive tone]. Have you made the tea, my friend? It's almost 6:30.

[TEREBUS takes off the lid of the tea-boiler, peers inside, making a scoop with his hand.

[TEREBUS takes off the lid of the kettle, looks inside, and uses his hand to scoop.]

ERROR. Here, don't do that. Mind your hands.

ERROR. Here, don’t do that. Watch your hands.

TEREBUS. It's all right, it's not hot.

TEREBUS. It's okay, it's not hot.

ERROR. What shall we do, then? We'll never keep them quiet if we are late with the tea.

ERROR. What should we do now? We won't be able to keep them quiet if we're late with the tea.

TEREBUS. Put the tea in now. It will be warmed up by the second course.

TEREBUS. Put the tea in now. It will be heated by the second course.

[TEREBUS puts the infusers in the pot and stirs them round.

[TEREBUS puts the infusers in the pot and stirs them around.]

ERROR. Taste it.

ERROR. Give it a try.

[BOTH taste with a dirty spoon.

[BOTH taste with a dirty spoon.

TEREBUS. Tastes like your soup—'orrible!

TEREBUS. Tastes like your soup—horrible!

ERROR. There's nothing wrong with the soup. You attend to the tea.

ERROR. There's nothing wrong with the soup. You take care of the tea.

TEREBUS. I think we'll have coffee. Pass the coffee and I'll put that in and bring it to the boil. The coffee will kill the taste of the tea.

TEREBUS. I think we should have coffee. Pass me the coffee and I'll add that in and bring it to a boil. The coffee will overpower the taste of the tea.

ERROR. Hope you make it stronger than that.

ERROR. Hope you make it better than that.

[During quiescent stage while each is thinking of a retort, 6.30 P.M. arrives, and the soup is put on the table. Interval elapses during which the victims are expected to eat the soup.

[During the quiet moment while everyone is thinking of a comeback, 6:30 PM arrives, and the soup is served. A pause occurs during which the guests are expected to eat the soup.]

VOICES [in loud chant from the table]. How did you do it, Error?

VOICES [in loud chant from the table]. How did you pull it off, Error?

TEREBUS [after a suitable period]. Any one like any more soup?

TEREBUS [after a suitable amount of time]. Does anyone want more soup?

A VOICE. Couldn't risk it, Governor. TEREBUS. Bowls up! Lick spoons!

A VOICE. Couldn't take the chance, Governor. TEREBUS. Cups up! Lick your spoons!

[Bowls are cleared away and baked penguin is put on the table.

[Bowls are cleared away and baked penguin is placed on the table.

ERROR. Cooks have got their penguin, gentlemen.

ERROR. Cooks have gotten their penguin, gentlemen.

[Suspicious glances exchanged at table. Later, monotonous chant goes up, preceded by a soft "One, two, three." "Didn't scrape the blubber off, Error."

[Suspicious glances exchanged at the table. Later, a dull chant starts, preceded by a quiet "One, two, three." "You didn't scrape the blubber off, Error."]

[Plates cleared away and scraped into dogs' bucket. ERROR takes tapioca custard from oven in two dishes.

[Plates are cleared and scraped into the dogs' bucket. ERROR takes the tapioca custard out of the oven in two dishes.]

ERROR [aside to TEREBUS]. Take some out of this one for us and don't forget to put that dish in front of the Doctor, because I spilled soda in the other.

ERROR [aside to TEREBUS]. Take some out of this one for us and don't forget to put that dish in front of the Doctor, because I spilled soda in the other.

[TEREBUS takes two large helpings out and puts rest on table as directed.

[TEREBUS takes two large servings out and puts the rest on the table as instructed.]

TEREBUS. You need not remember the cooks, gentlemen.

TEREBUS. You don’t have to remember the cooks, guys.

A VOICE. Don't want to, if I can manage it.

A VOICE. I don’t want to, if I can help it.

ERROR [aside to TEREBUS]. Put on the Algerian sweets, and then we can have ours.

ERROR [aside to TEREBUS]. Get the Algerian sweets ready, and then we can have ours.

TEREBUS [taking several handfuls]. We'll put these aside for perks.

TEREBUS [taking several handfuls]. We'll set these aside for bonuses.

[The sweets on the table, TEREBUS and ERROR retire to kitchen to have their dinner.

[The snacks on the table, TEREBUS and ERROR head to the kitchen to have their dinner.]

ERROR. Is this my pudding? It's only an ordinary share.

ERROR. Is this my dessert? It's just a standard serving.

[TEREBUS is too busy to reply, and further eruption is prevented by the temporary plugging of ERROR.

[TEREBUS is too busy to respond, and any further outburst is stopped by the temporary blocking of ERROR.]

Cooking, under the inspiration of Mrs. Beeton, became a fine art:

Cooking, inspired by Mrs. Beeton, turned into a true art form:

    On bones we leave no meat on,
    For we study Mrs. Beeton.
    We leave no meat on the bones,
    Because we're learning from Mrs. Beeton.

So said the song. On birthdays and other auspicious occasions dishes appeared which would tempt a gourmet. Puff-pastry, steam-puddings, jellies and blancmanges, original potages and consommes, seal curried and spiced, penguin delicately fried, vegetables reflavoured, trimmed and adorned were received without comment as the culinary standard rose.

So went the song. On birthdays and other special occasions, dishes popped up that would entice any food lover. Puff pastry, steamed puddings, jellies, and blancmanges, unique soups and broths, seal curried and spiced, penguin lightly fried, and veggies re-flavored, trimmed, and decorated were served without a word as the culinary standard improved.

Birthdays were always greeted with special enthusiasm. Speeches were made, toasts were drunk, the supple boards of the table creaked with good things, cook and messman vied with each other in lavish hospitality, the Hut was ornate with flags, every man was spruce in his snowiest cardigan and neck-cloth, the gramophone sang of music-hall days, the wind roared its appreciation through the stove-pipe, and rollicking merriment was supreme. On such occasions the photographer and the biologist made a genial combination.

Birthdays were always celebrated with extra excitement. Speeches were made, toasts were raised, the table creaked under a feast of delicious food, the cook and messman competed to outdo each other in generous hospitality, the Hut was decorated with flags, every man looked sharp in his cleanest cardigan and necktie, the gramophone played tunes from music-hall days, the wind praised the occasion through the stovepipe, and laughter filled the air. During these times, the photographer and the biologist made a great team.

The dark-room was the nursery of the topical song. There, by lantern or candle-stump, wit Rabelaisian, Aristophanic or Antarctic was cradled into rhyme. From there, behind the scenes, the comedian in full dress could step before the footlights into salvoes of savage applause. "A Pair of Unconventional Cooks are we, are we," and the famous refrain, "There he is, that's him," were long unrivalled in our musical annals.

The dark room was where popular songs were born. There, by lantern or candle stub, clever lyrics in the style of Rabelais, Aristophanes, or even with a polar twist were turned into rhymes. From there, backstage, the comedian in full costume could step into the spotlight to a storm of wild applause. "We're a Pair of Unconventional Cooks," and the famous line, "There he is, that's him," were unmatched in our musical history for a long time.

Celebrations were carried on into the night, but no one forgot the cook and the messman. The table was cleared by many willing hands, some brought in ice and coal or swept the floor, others scraped plates or rinsed out mugs and bowls. Soon, everything had passed through the cauldron of water, soap and soda to the drying-towels and on to the shelves. The main crowd then repaired with pipes and cigars to "Hyde Park Corner," where the storeman, our raconteur par excellence, entertained the smokers' club. A mixed concert brought the evening to the grand finale—"Auld Lang Syne."

Celebrations went on into the night, but everyone remembered the cook and the messman. Many helping hands cleared the table; some brought in ice and coal, others swept the floor, and some scraped plates or rinsed out mugs and bowls. Before long, everything had gone through the hot water, soap, and soda to the drying towels and then to the shelves. The main group then moved with pipes and cigars to "Hyde Park Corner," where the storeman, our top storyteller, entertained the smokers' club. A mixed concert wrapped up the evening with the grand finale—"Auld Lang Syne."

After events of this character, the higher shelves of the kitchen, in the interstices between thermographs, photographic plates ink bottles, and Russian stout, abounded with titbits of pie crust, blancmange, jelly, Vienna rusks, preserved figs, and other "perks." Such "perks," or perquisites, were the property of the presiding cook or night-watchman and rarely survived for more than a day.

After events like this, the upper shelves of the kitchen, in the spaces between thermometers, photo plates, ink bottles, and Russian beer, were filled with bits of pie crust, blancmange, jelly, Vienna biscuits, preserved figs, and other "perks." These "perks," or extra treats, belonged to the head cook or night-watchman and hardly lasted more than a day.

The mania for celebration became so great that reference was frequently made to the almanac. During one featureless interval, the anniversary of the First Lighting of London by Gas was observed with extraordinary eclat.

The excitement for celebration got so intense that people often referred to the almanac. During one uneventful period, the anniversary of the First Lighting of London by Gas was celebrated with remarkable flair.

The great medium of monetary exchange in the Hut was chocolate. A ration of thirty squares was distributed by the storeman every Saturday night, and for purposes of betting, games of chance, "Calcutta sweeps" on the monthly wind-velocity and general barter, chocolate held the premier place.

The main currency used in the Hut was chocolate. Every Saturday night, the storeman handed out a ration of thirty squares, and for betting purposes, games of chance, "Calcutta sweeps" based on the monthly wind speed, and general trading, chocolate was the most valued item.

At the "sweeps," the meteorologist stood with a wooden hammer behind the table, and the gaming public swarmed on the other side. Numbers ranging from "low field" and forty-five to sixty-five and "high field" were sold by auction to the highest bidder. Excitement was intense while the cartographer in clerical glasses worked out the unknown number.

At the "sweeps," the meteorologist stood with a wooden hammer behind the table, and the crowd of gamers gathered on the other side. Numbers from "low field" at forty-five to sixty-five and "high field" were auctioned off to the highest bidder. The excitement was palpable as the cartographer, wearing clerical glasses, calculated the unknown number.

As a consequence of wild speculation, there were several cases of bankruptcy, which was redeemed in the ordinary way by a sale of the debtor's effects.

As a result of reckless speculation, there were several instances of bankruptcy, which was typically resolved through the sale of the debtor's assets.

Two financiers, indifferent to the charms of chocolate, established a corner or "Bank" in the commodity. "The Bank," by barter and usurious methods, amassed a great heap of well-thumbed squares, and, when accused of rapacity, invented a scheme for the common good known as "Huntoylette." This was a game of chance similar to roulette, and for a while it completely gulfed the trusting public. In the reaction which followed, there was a rush on "The Bank," and the concern was wound up, but the promoters escaped with a large profit in candles and chocolate.

Two financiers, uninterested in the appeal of chocolate, set up a corner or "Bank" in the commodity. "The Bank," through bartering and predatory tactics, piled up a massive stash of well-worn squares, and when they were accused of greed, they came up with a scheme for the public good called "Huntoylette." This was a game of chance similar to roulette, and for a while, it completely captivated the trusting public. In the aftermath, there was a rush on "The Bank," and the operation was shut down, but the promoters walked away with a significant profit in candles and chocolate.

Throughout the winter months, work went on steadily even after dinner, and hours of leisure were easy to fill. Some wrote up their diaries, played games, or smoked and yarned; others read, developed photos, or imitated the weary cook and went to bed. The MacKellar Library, so called after the donor, was a boon to all, and the literature of polar exploration was keenly followed and discussed. Taste in literature varied, but among a throng of eighteen, the majority of whom were given to expressing their opinions in no uncertain terms—there were no rigid conventions in Adelie Land—every book had a value in accordance with a common standard.

Throughout the winter months, work continued steadily even after dinner, and it was easy to fill hours of free time. Some people wrote in their diaries, played games, or smoked and chatted; others read, developed photos, or imitated the tired cook and went to bed. The MacKellar Library, named after the donor, was a blessing for everyone, and the literature on polar exploration was eagerly followed and discussed. Tastes in literature varied, but among a group of eighteen, most were very vocal about their opinions—there were no strict rules in Adelie Land—each book was valued based on a common standard.

There was not a dissenting voice to the charm of 'Lady Betty across the Water', and the reason for this was a special one. The sudden breath of a world of warmth and colour, richness and vivacity and astute, American freshness amid the somewhat grim attractions of an Antarctic winter was too much for every one. Lady Betty, in the realm of bright images, had a host of devoted admirers. Her influence spread beyond the Hut to the plateau itself. Three men went sledging, and to shelter themselves from the rude wind fashioned an ice-cavern, which, on account of its magical hues and rare lustre, could be none other than "Aladdin's Cave." Lady Betty found her hero in a fairy grotto of the same name.

There was no one who disagreed with the charm of 'Lady Betty across the Water', and the reason for this was unique. The sudden arrival of warmth, color, richness, liveliness, and clever American freshness amidst the somewhat bleak allure of an Antarctic winter was overwhelming for everyone. Lady Betty, in the world of vibrant images, had a crowd of loyal fans. Her influence extended beyond the Hut to the plateau itself. Three men went sledding, and to protect themselves from the harsh wind, they created an ice cavern, which, due to its magical colors and rare shine, could only be "Aladdin's Cave." Lady Betty discovered her hero in a fairy grotto with the same name.

'Lorna Doone', on the other hand, was liked by many. Still there were those who thought that John Ridd was a fool, a slow, obtuse rustic, and so on, while Lorna was too divine and angelic for this life.

'Lorna Doone', on the other hand, was liked by many. Still, there were those who thought that John Ridd was a fool, a slow, dull country bumpkin, and so on, while Lorna was too extraordinary and angelic for this world.

'The War of the Carolinas' took the Hut by storm, but it was a "nine days' wonder" and left no permanent impression on the thinking community. Mostly, the story was voted delightfully funny, but very foolish and farcical after all. A few exclusive critics predicted for it a future.

'The War of the Carolinas' took the Hut by storm, but it was a "nine days' wonder" and left no lasting impact on the thinking community. Mostly, people found the story amusing but ultimately foolish and ridiculous. A few elitist critics forecasted a future for it.

Then there was 'The Trail of '98'. For power and blunt realism there was nothing like it, but the character of the hero was torn in the shreds of debate. There was general agreement on two points: that the portrayal of the desolate Alaskan wild had a touch of "home," and that the heroine was a "true sport."

Then there was 'The Trail of '98.' For its intensity and raw realism, nothing could compare, but the hero's character was a subject of heated discussion. People generally agreed on two things: that the depiction of the bleak Alaskan wilderness felt a bit like "home," and that the heroine was a "true sport."

All those who had ever hauled on the main braces, sung the topsail-halliard chanty, learned the intricate Matty Walker, the bowline-and-a-bite and a crowd of kindred knots, had a warm spot for any yarn by Jacobs. Night after night, the storeman held the audience with the humorous escapades of 'Ginger Dick', 'Sam' and 'Peter Russet'.

All those who had ever worked with the main braces, sung the topsail-halliard sea shanty, learned the complex Matty Walker knot, the bowline-and-a-bite, and a bunch of related knots, had a soft spot for any story by Jacobs. Night after night, the storeman kept the audience entertained with the funny adventures of 'Ginger Dick,' 'Sam,' and 'Peter Russet.'

And lastly, there was a more serious, if divided interest in 'Virginibus Puerisque', 'Marcus Aurelius', 'The Unveiling of Lhassa'—but the list is rather interminable.

And finally, there was a more significant, though mixed, interest in 'Virginibus Puerisque', 'Marcus Aurelius', 'The Unveiling of Lhassa'—but the list goes on and on.

The whole world is asleep except the night-watchman, and he, having made the bread, washed a tubful of clothes, kept the fire going, observed and made notes on the aurora every fifteen minutes and the weather every half-hour, and, finally, having had a bath, indulges in buttered toast and a cup of coffee.

The whole world is asleep except for the night watchman, and he, after making the bread, washing a tub full of clothes, keeping the fire going, observing and noting the aurora every fifteen minutes and the weather every half hour, and finally, after taking a bath, enjoys buttered toast and a cup of coffee.

The Hut is dark, and a shaded burner hangs by a canvas chair in the kitchen. The wind is booming in gusts, the dogs howl occasionally in the veranda, but the night-watchman and his pipe are at peace with all men. He has discarded a heavy folio for a light romance, while the hours scud by, broken only by the observations. The romance is closed, and he steals to his bunk with a hurricane lamp and finds a bundle of letters. He knows them well, but he reads them—again!

The hut is dark, and a shaded lamp hangs by a canvas chair in the kitchen. The wind is howling in gusts, the dogs occasionally bark from the porch, but the night guard and his pipe are at peace with everyone. He has put aside a heavy book for a light romance, while the hours pass, interrupted only by his thoughts. The romance is shut, and he sneaks to his bunk with a hurricane lamp and finds a pile of letters. He knows them well, but he reads them—again!

Pearly light rises in the north-east through the lessening drift, and another day has come.

Pearly light breaks in the northeast as the fog clears, and another day has arrived.





CHAPTER IX MIDWINTER AND ITS WORK;

With the advent of the fateful Ides of March, winter ii had practically set in, and work outside had a chequered career. When a few calm hours intervened between two blizzards a general rush was made to continue some long-standing job. Often all that could be done was to clear the field for action, that is, dig away large accumulations of snow. Then the furies would break loose again, and once more we would play the waiting game, meanwhile concerning ourselves with more sedentary occupations.

With the arrival of the significant Ides of March, winter had pretty much taken hold, and outdoor work had an unpredictable routine. Whenever a few calm hours came between two snowstorms, there was a mad dash to resume some ongoing tasks. Often, all we could do was clear the way for action, which meant digging out huge piles of snow. Then the storms would hit again, and we found ourselves waiting once more, focusing on more stationary activities in the meantime.

There was a familiar cry when, for some meteorological reason, the wind would relapse into fierce gusts and then suddenly stop, to be succeeded by intense stillness. "Dead calm, up with the wireless masts!" Every one hastily dashed for his burberrys, and soon a crowd of muffled figures would emerge through the veranda exit, dragging ropes, blocks, picks, and shovels. There was no time to be lost.

There was a familiar shout when, for some weather-related reason, the wind would suddenly pick up in strong gusts and then abruptly die down, leading to a heavy stillness. "Dead calm, up with the radio masts!" Everyone quickly grabbed their raincoats, and soon a crowd of bundled-up figures would rush out through the veranda, hauling ropes, pulleys, picks, and shovels. There was no time to waste.

So the erection of the wireless masts began in earnest on April 4, continued feverishly till the end of the month, suffered a long period of partial cessation during May and June, was revived in July and August, and, by September 1, two masts, each consisting of a lower-mast and top-mast, had been raised and stayed, while between them stretched the aerial. For four weeks messages were sent out, and many of them were caught by Macquarie Island. Nothing was heard in Adelie Land, although, between certain hours, regular watches were kept at the receiver. The aerial was about sixty-five feet from the ground, and it was resolved to increase its height by erecting the top-gallant masts; but before anything considerable could be done, a terrific gust of wind on October 13 broke three wire-stays, and down came the mast, broken and splintered by the fall. That is a brief resume of the fortunes of the "wireless" during the first year.

So the construction of the wireless masts kicked off seriously on April 4, continued intensely until the end of the month, faced a long pause during May and June, got going again in July and August, and by September 1, two masts, each with a lower mast and a top mast, had been erected and stabilized, with the aerial stretched between them. For four weeks, messages were sent out, many of which were picked up by Macquarie Island. Nothing was received in Adelie Land, although regular checks were performed at the receiver during certain hours. The aerial was about sixty-five feet from the ground, and it was decided to increase its height by adding top-gallant masts; however, before significant work could be done, a massive gust of wind on October 13 snapped three wire stays, and the mast came crashing down, broken and splintered by the fall. That’s a quick recap of the "wireless" adventures during the first year.

During February and March there were various other operations of more immediate importance which prevented concentration of our workers on the erection of the masts. There were many odd jobs to finish about the Hut, the Magnetograph House and Absolute Hut were "under way," the air-tractor sledge had to be efficiently housed, and all these and many other things could be done in weather during which it was out of question to hoist a mast into position. At first we were fastidious and waited for a calm, but later, as we grew more impatient, a top-mast was actually hauled up in a wind of thirty miles per hour, with gusts of higher velocity. Such work would sometimes be interrupted by a more furious outbreak, when all ropes would be secured and everything made as ship-shape as possible.

During February and March, there were several other operations of more immediate importance that kept our workers from focusing on putting up the masts. There were many small tasks to finish around the Hut, work on the Magnetograph House and Absolute Hut was "in progress," the air-tractor sledge needed to be stored properly, and all these things, along with many others, could only be done in weather that made it impossible to raise a mast into position. Initially, we were particular and waited for calm conditions, but later, as our impatience grew, we actually raised a top-mast in a wind of thirty miles per hour, with even stronger gusts. Such work would sometimes be interrupted by a more violent storm, during which all ropes would be secured and everything made as shipshape as possible.

On March 15 the following note was made: "The wind was on the cool side just after breakfast. A few loads of wireless equipment were sledged up to the rocks at the back of the Hut, and by the time several masts were carried to the same place we began to warm to the work. One of Hannam's coils of frozen rope (one hundred and twenty fathoms) had become kinked and tangled, so we dragged it up the ice-slope, straightened it out and coiled it up again. Several 'dead men' to hold the stays were sunk into ice-holes, and, during the afternoon, one mast was dragged into position by a willing crowd. Rocks were sledged to and packed around the 'dead men' in the holes to make them compact. Towards sundown snow clouds filled the northern sky and a blizzard sprang up which is now doing sixty miles per hour. We philosophically expect another week cooped up in the Hut."

On March 15, the following note was made: "The wind was cool right after breakfast. We sledged a few loads of wireless equipment up to the rocks behind the Hut, and by the time we carried several masts to the same spot, we started to get into the work. One of Hannam's coils of frozen rope (one hundred and twenty fathoms) had become kinked and tangled, so we dragged it up the ice slope, straightened it out, and coiled it again. Several 'dead men' to hold the stays were sunk into ice holes, and during the afternoon, a willing crowd helped drag one mast into position. Rocks were sledged over and packed around the 'dead men' in the holes to secure them. Towards sunset, snow clouds filled the northern sky, and a blizzard picked up, now blowing at sixty miles per hour. We calmly expect to be cooped up in the Hut for another week."

It took a long time to establish the twenty good anchorages necessary for the masts. Within a radius of eighty yards from the centre, ice-holes were dug, cairns of heavy boulders were built and rocky prominences dynamited off to secure an efficient holding for the stout "strops" of rope. April 24 was a typical day: "We spent the morning fixing up 'strops' for the wireless masts. The wind was blowing strongly in fifty- to sixty-mile gusts with drift, but most of the fellows 'stuck at it' all day. It was cold work on the hands and feet. Handling picks and shovels predisposes to frost-bite. Several charges of dynamite were fired in one hole wherein a mast will be stepped."

It took a long time to set up the twenty solid anchorages needed for the masts. Within eighty yards from the center, we dug ice-holes, built cairns of heavy boulders, and blew off rocky outcrops to create a secure hold for the strong rope "strops." April 24 was a typical day: "We spent the morning preparing 'strops' for the wireless masts. The wind was really strong, gusting at fifty to sixty miles an hour with snow blowing around, but most of the guys kept at it all day. It was cold work for our hands and feet. Using picks and shovels can lead to frostbite. We set off several charges of dynamite in one hole where a mast will be placed."

Each mast, of oregon timber, was in four sections. The lowest section was ten inches square and tapered upwards to the small royal mast at a prospective height of one hundred and twenty feet. At an early stage it was realized that we could not expect to erect more than three sections. Round the steel caps at each doubling a good deal of fitting had to be done, and Bickerton, in such occupation, spent many hours aloft throughout the year. Fumbling with bulky mitts, handling hammers and spanners, and manipulating nuts and bolts with bare hands, while suspended in a boatswain's chair in the wind, the man up the mast had a difficult and miserable task. Bickerton was the hero of all such endeavours. Hannam directed the other workers who steadied the stays, cleared or made fast the ropes, pulled and stood by the hauling tackle and so forth.

Each mast, made from Oregon timber, was in four sections. The lowest section was ten inches square and tapered up to the small royal mast at a planned height of one hundred and twenty feet. Early on, it became clear that we could only expect to erect three sections. A lot of fitting had to be done around the steel caps at each joint, and Bickerton spent many hours up high throughout the year doing this. Struggling with bulky mitts, handling hammers and wrenches, and manipulating nuts and bolts with bare hands while suspended in a bosun's chair in the wind, the person up the mast had a tough and challenging job. Bickerton was the hero of all these efforts. Hannam oversaw the other workers who steadied the stays, organized or secured the ropes, operated the hauling tackle, and so on.

One day the man on the top-mast dislodged a heavy engineering hammer which he thought secure. No warning was given, as he did not notice that it had fallen. It whizzed down and buried itself in the snow, just grazing the heads of Close and Hodgeman.

One day, the guy on the top-mast accidentally knocked loose a heavy engineering hammer that he thought was secure. He didn’t notice it had fallen and didn’t give any warning. It zipped down and buried itself in the snow, just barely missing the heads of Close and Hodgeman.

The ropes securing the aerial and running through various blocks were in constant danger of chafing during the frequent hurricanes, from their proximity to the mast and stays, or from friction on the sharp edges of the blocks. Unknown to us, this had happened to a strong, new manilla rope by which Murphy was being hauled to the top of the lower-mast. It gave way, and, but for another rope close by, which he seized to break his fall, an accident might have ensued.

The ropes holding the aerial and running through different blocks were always at risk of getting worn down during the frequent hurricanes, either from being too close to the mast and stays or from rubbing against the sharp edges of the blocks. Unbeknownst to us, this had happened to a strong, new manila rope that was used to pull Murphy up to the top of the lower mast. It snapped, and if it hadn't been for another rope nearby that he grabbed to stop his fall, there could have been a serious accident.

Frost-bites were common. There were so many occasions when one had to stand for a long time gripping a rope, pulling or maintaining a steady strain, that fingers would promptly become numb and feet unbearably cold. The usual restorative was to stamp about and beat the chest with the hands—an old sailor's trick. Attempting to climb to a block on the top-gallant mast one day, McLean had all his fingers frost-bitten at the same time.

Frostbite was common. There were many times when you had to stand for a long period gripping a rope, pulling, or keeping a steady strain, causing your fingers to quickly go numb and your feet to feel unbearably cold. The usual remedy was to walk around and punch your chest with your hands—an old sailor's trick. One day, while trying to climb to a block on the top-gallant mast, McLean ended up with frostbite in all his fingers at once.

In May the weather was atrocious, and in June building the Astronomical Hut and digging ice-shafts on the glacier absorbed a good many hands. In July, despite the enthusiasm and preparation for sledging, much was done. On August 10 the long looked-for top-mast of the southern mast became a reality:

In May, the weather was terrible, and in June, constructing the Astronomical Hut and digging ice shafts on the glacier took up a lot of manpower. In July, even with the excitement and planning for sledding, a lot was accomplished. On August 10, the long-awaited top mast of the southern mast finally became a reality:

"We were early astir—about 7 A.M.—while the pink coloration of dawn was stealing over the peaceful Barrier. For once, after months, it was perfectly still. We hurried about making preparations—hauled Bickerton up to the cross-trees and awaited the moment when we should raise the top-mast. We pulled it up half-way and Bickerton affixed a pin in its centre, above which two stays were to be attached. Suddenly, down came the wind in terrific gusts and, after securing the stays, the job had to be given up.... We were just about to have lunch when the wind ceased as suddenly as it had begun. We all sallied out once more, and, this time, completed the job, though for a while the top-mast was in imminent peril of being blown away by a sharp northerly gust."

We were up early—around 7 A.M.—as the pink light of dawn spread across the calm Barrier. For the first time in months, it was perfectly still. We rushed to get ready—hoisted Bickerton up to the cross-trees and waited for the moment to raise the top-mast. We pulled it up halfway, and Bickerton secured a pin in the center, where two stays would be attached. Suddenly, the wind picked up with powerful gusts, and after securing the stays, we had to abandon the job. We were just about to have lunch when the wind stopped as suddenly as it started. We all went back out again, and this time, we finished the job, though the top-mast was at serious risk of being blown away by a strong northerly gust.

Next day the aerial was hoisted in a wind of sixty miles per hour, but the strain was so severe on the block, upwind, that it carried away. Fortunately the insulators of the aerial were entangled by the stays in their fall to ground, otherwise some one may have been hurt, as there were a dozen men almost directly below.

The next day, the antenna was raised in winds at sixty miles per hour, but the pressure was so intense on the block upwind that it broke. Luckily, the insulators of the antenna got caught in the stays as they fell to the ground; otherwise, someone could have been injured since there were about a dozen men directly below.

Six days after this accident, August 17, the top-mast halliard of the down-wind mast frayed through, and as a stronger block was to be affixed for the aerial, some one had to climb up to wire it in position. Bickerton improvized a pair of climbing irons, and, after some preliminary practice, ascended in fine style.

Six days after this accident, on August 17, the top-mast halliard of the down-wind mast frayed, and since a stronger block needed to be attached for the aerial, someone had to climb up to secure it. Bickerton quickly fashioned a pair of climbing irons and, after some initial practice, climbed up with great skill.

Finally, by September 30, the aerial was at such a height as to give hope that long-distance messages might be despatched. There was a certain amount of suppressed excitement on the evening of that day when the engine started and gradually got up speed in the dynamo. The sharp note of the spark rose in accompanying crescendo and, when it had reached its highest pitch, Hannam struck off a message to the world at large. No response came after several nights of signalling, and, since sledging had usurped every other interest, the novelty soon wore off.

Finally, by September 30, the aerial was high enough to spark hope that long-distance messages could finally be sent. There was a bit of restrained excitement that evening when the engine started and gradually picked up speed in the dynamo. The sharp sound of the spark rose in a rising crescendo and, when it hit its peak, Hannam sent out a message to the world at large. After several nights of signaling, no response came, and since sledging took over every other interest, the novelty quickly faded.

"Atmospherics"—discharges of atmospheric electricity—and discharges from the drift-snow were heard in the wireless receiver.

"Atmospherics"—discharges of atmospheric electricity—and discharges from the drifting snow were picked up by the wireless receiver.

While messages were being sent, induction effects were noted in metallic objects around the Hut. A cook at the stove was the first to discover this phenomenon, and then every one conceived a mania for "drawing" sparks. A rather stimulating experience—the more so as it usually happened unexpectedly and accidentally—was to brush one's head against one of the numerous coils of flexible metal gas-piping festooned about the place. Sparks immediately jumped the interval with startling effect.

While messages were being sent, induction effects were observed in metallic objects around the Hut. A cook at the stove was the first to notice this phenomenon, and then everyone became obsessed with "drawing" sparks. It was quite an exciting experience—especially since it often happened unexpectedly and by chance—to brush your head against one of the many coils of flexible metal gas-piping hanging around the place. Sparks would instantly leap the gap with a startling effect.

October 13, the day when the mast blew down, was known in wireless circles as Black Sunday. All had worked keenly to make the "wireless" a success, and the final event was considered to be a public misfortune. However, the honours were to be retrieved during the following year.

October 13, the day the mast fell, was known in wireless circles as Black Sunday. Everyone had put in a lot of effort to make the "wireless" a success, and the outcome was seen as a public disaster. However, the situation was set to improve the following year.

It fell to the lot of most of the Staff that they developed an interest in terrestrial magnetism. For one thing every man had carried boulders to the great stockade surrounding the Magnetograph House. Then, too, recorders were regularly needed to assist the magnetician in the absolute Hut. There, if the temperature were not too low and the observations not too lengthy, the recorder stepped out into the blizzard with the conviction that he had learned something of value, and, when he sat down to dinner that night, it was with a genial sense of his own altruism. In his diary he would write it all up for his own edification.

Most of the staff developed an interest in Earth’s magnetism. For one thing, everyone had carried boulders to the large stockade around the Magnetograph House. Also, recorders were regularly needed to help the magnetician in the absolute Hut. There, if the temperature wasn’t too low and the observations weren’t too long, the recorder would step out into the blizzard, convinced that he had learned something valuable. When he sat down for dinner that night, he felt good about his own selflessness. In his diary, he would write it all up for his own understanding.

It would be on this wise: The Earth's magnetic force, which is the active agent in maintaining the compass-needle in the magnetic meridian** at any particular spot, acts, not as is popularly supposed, in a horizontal plane, but at a certain angle of inclination with the Earth's surface. The nearer the magnetic poles the more nearly vertical does the freely suspended needle become. At the South Magnetic Pole it assumes a vertical position with the south end downwards; at the North Magnetic Pole it stands on its other end. At the intermediate positions near the equator the whole force is exerted, swinging the needle in the horizontal plane, and in such regions ordinary ships' compasses pivoted to move freely only in a horizontal plane give the greatest satisfaction. On approaching the magnetic poles, compasses become sluggish, for the horizontal deflecting force falls off rapidly. The force, acting in a vertical direction, tending to make the needle dip, correspondingly increases, but is of no value for navigation purposes. However, in the scientific discussion of terrestrial magnetism, both the horizontal and vertical components as well as the absolute value of the total force are important, and the determination of these "elements" is the work of the magnetician. Affecting the average values of the "magnetic elements" at any one spot on the Earth's surface are regular diurnal oscillations, apparent only by the application of very delicate methods of observation: also there are sudden large irregular movements referred to as magnetic storms; the latter are always specially noticeable when unusually bright auroral phenomena are in progress.

It would be like this: The Earth's magnetic force, which is the active agent that keeps the compass needle aligned with the magnetic meridian at any specific location, operates not in a horizontal plane as many believe, but at a certain angle of inclination relative to the Earth's surface. The closer you get to the magnetic poles, the more vertical the freely suspended needle becomes. At the South Magnetic Pole, it points straight down with the south end facing downward; at the North Magnetic Pole, it stands on its other end. In areas near the equator, the force acts entirely to swing the needle in a horizontal plane, and in those regions, typical ships' compasses, which can only pivot horizontally, work best. As you get closer to the magnetic poles, compasses become slow to respond because the horizontal force that deflects them quickly diminishes. The force that pulls the needle downward increases, but that’s not helpful for navigation. Still, in the scientific study of terrestrial magnetism, both the horizontal and vertical components, as well as the total force's overall strength, are significant, and figuring these "elements" out is the job of the magnetician. Regular daily fluctuations affect the average values of the "magnetic elements" at any location on the Earth's surface, which can only be detected using very sensitive observation methods. There are also sudden large irregular movements known as magnetic storms; these are especially noticeable during bright auroral displays.

     ** The magnetic meridian is the straight line joining the North
and South Magnetic Poles and passing through the spot in question.
** The magnetic meridian is the straight line connecting the North and South Magnetic Poles and passing through the location in question.

The observations made in the "Absolute Hut", carried out at frequent intervals and on each occasion occupying two men for several hours together, are necessary to obtain standard values as a check upon the graphic record of the self-recording instruments which run day and night in the "Magnetograph House".

The observations taken in the "Absolute Hut", conducted regularly and each time taking two people several hours, are essential for getting standard values to verify the graphic record from the self-recording instruments that operate around the clock in the "Magnetograph House".

But this is another story. Three hours, sitting writing figures in a temperature of -15 degrees F., is no joke. The magnetician is not so badly off, because he is moving about, though he often has to stop and warm his fingers, handling the cold metal.

But this is a different story. Three hours spent writing numbers in a temperature of -15 degrees Fahrenheit is no laughing matter. The magnetician isn't doing too badly since he's moving around, although he often has to pause to warm up his fingers from handling the cold metal.

The Magnetograph House had by far the most formidable name. The Hut, though it symbolized our all in all, sounded very insignificant unless it were repeated with just the right intonation. The Absolute Hut had a superadded dignity. The Hangar, in passing, scarcely seemed to have a right to a capital H. The Transit House, on the and other hand, was the only dangerous rival to the first mentioned. But what's in a name?

The Magnetograph House had the most impressive name by far. The Hut, while it represented everything to us, sounded pretty insignificant unless said with the right tone. The Absolute Hut carried an added sense of dignity. The Hangar, on the other hand, hardly seemed worthy of a capital H. The Transit House was the only serious competitor to the first one mentioned. But what’s in a name?

If the Magnetograph House had been advertised, it would have been described as "two minutes from the Hut." This can easily be understood, for the magnetician after leaving home is speedily blown over a few hillocks and sastrugi, and, coming to an ice-flat about one hundred and fifty yards wide, swiftly slides over it, alighting at the snow-packed door of his house. The outside porch is just roomy enough for a man to slip off burberrys and crampons. The latter are full of steel spikes, and being capable of upsetting magnetic equilibrium, are left outside. Walking in soft finnesko, the magnetician opens an inner door, to be at once accosted by darkness, made more intense after the white glare of the snow. His eyes grow accustomed to the blackness, and he gropes his way to a large box almost concealing the feeble glimmer of a lamp. The lamp is the source of the light, projected on to small mirrors attached to the magnetic needles of three variometers. A ray of light is reflected from the mirrors for several feet on to a slit, past which revolves sensitized photographic paper folded on a drum moving by clockwork. The slightest movements of the suspended needles are greatly magnified, and, when the paper is removed and developed in a dark-room, a series of intricate curves denoting declination, horizontal intensity and vertical force, are exquisitely traced. Every day the magnetician attends to the lamp and changes papers; also at prearranged times he tests his "scale values" or takes a "quick run."

If the Magnetograph House had been advertised, it would have been described as "two minutes from the Hut." This is easy to understand, because the magnetician, after leaving home, quickly crosses a few small hills and snow ridges, and when he reaches an ice flat about one hundred and fifty yards wide, he swiftly slides over it, arriving at the snow-packed door of his house. The outside porch is just big enough for a man to take off his burberrys and crampons. The crampons, which are full of steel spikes and can disrupt magnetic equilibrium, are left outside. Wearing soft snow boots, the magnetician opens an inner door and is immediately met by darkness, which feels even more intense after the bright glare of the snow. His eyes adjust to the darkness, and he feels his way to a large box that mostly hides the weak glow of a lamp. The lamp provides light that hits small mirrors attached to the magnetic needles of three variometers. A beam of light is reflected from the mirrors several feet onto a slit, while sensitized photographic paper revolved on a drum powered by clockwork moves past it. The tiniest movements of the suspended needles are greatly amplified, and when the paper is removed and developed in a dark room, a series of intricate curves showing declination, horizontal intensity, and vertical force are beautifully traced. Every day, the magnetician tends to the lamp and changes the paper; he also tests his "scale values" or takes a "quick run" at scheduled times.

To obtain results as free as possible from the local attraction of the rocks in the neighbourhood, Webb resolved to take several sets of observations on the ice-sheet. In order to make the determinations it was necessary to excavate a cave in the glacier. This was done about three-quarters of a mile south of the Hut in working shifts of two men. A fine cavern was hewn out, and there full sets of magnetic observations were taken under ideal conditions.

To get results that were as unaffected as possible by the nearby rocks, Webb decided to take multiple sets of observations on the ice sheet. To make these measurements, it was necessary to dig a cave in the glacier. This was done about three-quarters of a mile south of the Hut, with two men working in shifts. A great cavern was carved out, and there, full sets of magnetic observations were taken under perfect conditions.

On sledging journeys the "dip" and declination were both ascertained at many stations, around and up to within less than half a degree of the South Magnetic Pole.

On sledging trips, the "dip" and declination were measured at several locations, close to and within less than half a degree of the South Magnetic Pole.

While the wind rushed by at a maddening pace and stars flashed like jewels in a black sky, a glow of pale yellow light overspread the north-east horizon—the aurora. A rim of dark, stratus cloud was often visible below the light which brightened and diffused till it curved as a low arc across the sky. It was eerie to watch the contour of the arc break, die away into a delicate pallor and reillumine in a travelling riband. Soon a long ray, as from a searchlight, flashed above one end, and then a row of vertical streamers ran out from the arc, probing upwards into the outer darkness. The streamers waxed and waned, died away to be replaced and then faded into the starlight. The arc lost its radiance, divided in patchy fragments, and all was dark once more.

While the wind rushed by at a crazy speed and stars sparkled like jewels in the black sky, a soft yellow light spread across the northeast horizon—the aurora. A band of dark stratus clouds was often visible beneath the light, which brightened and spread out until it formed a low arc across the sky. It was eerie to see the shape of the arc break, fade into a light pallor, and then light up again like a moving ribbon. Soon, a long beam, like a searchlight, shot up from one end, followed by a series of vertical streaks extending from the arc, reaching up into the outer darkness. The streaks grew brighter and dimmer, fading away only to be replaced, and then they merged back into the starlight. The arc lost its glow, broke into uneven fragments, and everything faded back into darkness once more.

This would be repeated again in a few hours and irregularly throughout the night, but with scenic changes behind the great sombre pall of the sky. North-west, northeast, and south-east it would elusively appear in nebulous blotches, flitting about to end finally in long bright strands in the zenith, crossing the path of the "milky way."

This would happen again a few hours later and randomly throughout the night, but with different scenes behind the dark, gloomy sky. It would appear in hazy patches to the northwest, northeast, and southeast, darting around before finally ending in long bright streaks at the top, crossing the path of the "Milky Way."

By the observer, who wrote down his exact observations in the meteorological log, this was called a "quiet night."

By the observer, who recorded his precise observations in the meteorological log, this was referred to as a "quiet night."

At times the light was nimble, flinging itself about in rich waves, warming to dazzling yellow-green and rose. These were the nights when "curtains" hung festooned in the heavens, alive, rippling, dancing to the lilt of lightning music. Up from the horizon they would mount, forming a vortex overhead, soundless within the silence of the ether.

Sometimes the light was quick, bouncing around in vibrant waves, shifting to bright yellow-green and pink. These were the nights when "curtains" draped across the sky, alive, rippling, moving to the rhythm of silent lightning music. They would rise from the horizon, creating a whirlpool above, silent in the stillness of the atmosphere.

A "brilliant display," we would say, and the observer would be kept busy following the track of the evanescent rays.

A "brilliant display," we would say, and the observer would be engaged in tracking the path of the fleeting rays.

Powerless, one was in the spell of an all-enfolding wonder. The vast, solitary snow-land, cold-white under the sparkling star-gems; lustrous in the radiance of the southern lights; furrowed beneath the icy sweep of the wind. We had come to probe its mystery, we had hoped to reduce it to terms of science, but there was always the "indefinable" which held aloof, yet riveted our souls.

Powerless, one was wrapped in a complete sense of wonder. The vast, lonely snowy landscape, glistening white under the sparkling stars; shining with the glow of the southern lights; marked by the icy blast of the wind. We had come to uncover its secrets, we had hoped to explain it with science, but there was always the "indefinable" that remained distant, yet captivated our souls.

The aurora was always with us, and almost without exception could be seen on a dark, driftless night. The nature of the aurora polaris has not yet been finally demonstrated, though it is generally agreed to be a discharge of electricity occurring in the upper, more rarefied atmosphere. The luminous phenomena are very similar to those seen when a current of electricity is passed through a vacuum tube.

The aurora was always with us and could almost always be seen on a dark, calm night. The exact nature of the aurora borealis hasn’t been definitively explained yet, but it's generally accepted to be a discharge of electricity happening in the upper, thinner atmosphere. The glowing effects are very similar to what you see when an electric current flows through a vacuum tube.

One receives a distinct impression of nearness, watching the shimmering edges of the "curtains" in the zenith, but all measurements indicate that they never descend nearer than a few miles above the land-surface.

One gets a clear sense of closeness when observing the shimmering edges of the "curtains" at the top, but all measurements show that they never come down closer than a few miles above the ground.

Careful records were taken to establish a relation between magnetic storms and aurorae, and a good deal of evidence was amassed to support the fact that auroral exhibitions correspond with periods of great magnetic disturbance. The displays in Adelie Land were found to be more active than those which occur in higher latitudes in the Ross Sea.

Careful records were kept to track the relationship between magnetic storms and auroras, and a lot of evidence was gathered to support the fact that auroral displays happen during times of significant magnetic disturbance. The displays in Adelie Land were found to be more active than those that occur at higher latitudes in the Ross Sea.

An occupation which helped to introduce variety in our life was the digging of ice-shafts. For the purpose of making observations upon its structure and temperature various excavations were made in the sea-ice, in the ice of the glacier, and in that of the freshwater lakes. The work was always popular. Even a whole day's labour with a pick and shovel at the bottom of an ice-hole never seemed laborious. It was all so novel.

A job that added variety to our lives was digging ice shafts. We made various excavations in the sea ice, glacier ice, and freshwater lake ice to observe their structure and temperature. This work was always well-liked. Even spending an entire day working with a pick and shovel at the bottom of an ice hole never felt tough. It was all just so new and exciting.

A calm morning in June, the sky is clear and the north ablaze with the colours of sunrise—or is it sunset? The air is delicious, and a cool waft comes down the glacier. A deep ultramarine, shading up into a soft purple hue, blends in a colour-scheme with the lilac plateau. Two men crunch along in spiked boots over snow mounds and polished sastrugi to the harbour-ice. The sea to the north is glazed with freezing spicules, and over it sweep the petrels—our only living companions of the winter. It is all an inspiration; while hewing out chunks of ice and shovelling them away is the acute pleasure of movement, exercise.

A calm June morning, the sky is clear and the north is glowing with the colors of sunrise—or is it sunset? The air feels refreshing, and a cool breeze flows down from the glacier. A deep ultramarine blends into a soft purple hue, matching the lilac plateau. Two men crunch along in spiked boots over snow mounds and polished sastrugi to the harbor ice. The sea to the north is covered in freezing spicules, and petrels sweep overhead—our only living companions this winter. It all feels inspiring; breaking off chunks of ice and shoveling them away brings a sharp joy in movement and exercise.

The men measure out an area six feet by three feet, and take a preliminary temperature of the surface-ice by inserting a thermometer in a drilled hole. Then the ice begins to fly, and it is not long before they are down one foot. Nevertheless it would surprise those acquainted only with fresh water ice to find how tough, sticky and intractable is sea-ice. It is always well to work on a definite plan, channelling in various directions, and then removing the intervening lumps by a few rough sweeps of the pick. At a depth of one foot, another temperature is taken, and some large samples of the ice laid by for the examination of their crystalline structure. This is repeated at two feet, and so on, until the whole thickness is pierced to the sea-water beneath. At three feet brine may begin to trickle into the hole, and this increases in amount until the worker is in a puddle. The leakage takes place, if not along cracks, through capillary channels, which are everywhere present in sea-ice.

The men measure out an area that's six feet by three feet and take an initial temperature of the surface ice by sticking a thermometer into a drilled hole. Then the ice starts to fly, and before long, they’re cutting down to a foot deep. However, it surprises those who are only familiar with freshwater ice to discover how tough, sticky, and difficult sea ice can be. It’s always a good idea to work according to a specific plan, channeling in different directions and then clearing away the lumps of ice with a few rough sweeps of the pick. At one foot deep, they take another temperature reading and set aside some large samples of ice to study their crystalline structure. This process is repeated at two feet deep and so on, until they’ve gone all the way through to the seawater below. At three feet deep, brine may start to trickle into the hole, and its amount increases until the worker is standing in a puddle. The leakage happens, if not along cracks, then through capillary channels, which are found everywhere in sea ice.

It is interesting to note the temperature gradually rise during the descent. At the surface the ice is chilled to the air-temperature, say -10 degrees F., and it rises in a steep gradient to approximately 28 degrees F.; close to the freezing-point of sea water. The sea-ice in the boat-harbour varied in thickness during the winter between five and seven feet.

It’s interesting to see the temperature slowly increase during the descent. At the surface, the ice is cold to the air temperature, around -10 degrees F, and it sharply rises to about 28 degrees F, which is close to the freezing point of seawater. The sea ice in the boat harbor ranged in thickness over the winter from five to seven feet.

In contrast with sea-ice, the ice of a glacier is a marvel of prismatic colour and glassy brilliance. This is more noticeable near the surface when the sun is shining. Deep down in a shaft, or in an ice-cavern, the sapphire reflection gives to the human face quite a ghastly pallor.

In contrast to sea ice, glacier ice is a stunning display of vibrant colors and shiny clarity. This is especially evident near the surface when the sun is shining. Deep down in a crevice or in an ice cavern, the sapphire reflection makes a person's face look quite pale and eerie.

During the high winds it was always easy to dispose of the fragments of ice in the earlier stages of sinking a shaft. To be rid of them, all that was necessary was to throw a shovelful vertically upwards towards the lee-side of the hole, the wind then did the rest. Away the chips would scatter, tinkling over the surface of the glacier. Of course, when two men were at work, each took it in turns to go below, and the one above, to keep warm, would impatiently pace up and down. Nevertheless, so cold would he become at times that a heated colloquy would arise between them on the subject of working overtime. When the shaft had attained depth, both were kept busy. The man at the pit's mouth lowered a bucket on a rope to receive the ice and, in hauling it up, handicapped with clumsy mitts, he had to be careful not to drop it on his companion's head.

During the strong winds, it was always easy to get rid of the ice fragments when starting to dig a shaft. To dispose of them, all you had to do was throw a shovel-full straight up towards the sheltered side of the hole, and then the wind would take care of the rest. The pieces would scatter away, tinkling across the glacier's surface. When two guys were working, they took turns going down, while the one on top would pace back and forth to stay warm. Still, it could get so cold that they’d end up heatedly debating about working overtime. Once the shaft was deep enough, both of them had their hands full. The guy at the top would lower a bucket on a rope to catch the ice, and while pulling it up, he had to be careful not to drop it on his partner’s head, especially with those bulky mitts on.

The structural composition of ice is a study in itself. To the cursory glance a piece of glacier-ice appears homogeneous, but when dissected in detail it is found to be formed of many crystalline, interlocking grains, ranging in size from a fraction of an inch to several inches in diameter. A grain-size of a half to one inch is perhaps commonest in Antarctic glacier-ice.

The structure of ice is a topic worth exploring. At first glance, a chunk of glacier ice looks uniform, but when examined closely, it's made up of many interlocking crystalline grains, varying in size from a fraction of an inch to several inches in diameter. The most common grain size in Antarctic glacier ice is probably half an inch to one inch.

The history of Antarctic glacier-ice commences with the showers of snow that fall upon the plateau. The snow particles may be blown for hundreds of miles before they finally come to rest and consolidate. The consolidated snow is called neve, the grains of which are one-twenty-fifth to one hundredth of an inch in diameter, and, en masse, present a dazzling white appearance on account of the air spaces which occupy one-third to one-half of the whole. In time, under the influence of a heavy load of accumulated layers of neve, the grains run together and the air spaces are eliminated. The final result is clear, transparent ice, of a more or less sapphire-blue colour when seen in large blocks. It contains only occasional air-bubbles, and the size of the grains is much increased.

The history of Antarctic glacier ice starts with the snow that falls on the plateau. The snowflakes can be blown for hundreds of miles before they settle and pack down. The packed snow is called neve, with grains that are about one-twenty-fifth to one-hundredth of an inch in diameter, and together they create a stunning white look because air spaces make up one-third to one-half of the total volume. Over time, under the weight of accumulated layers of neve, the grains fuse together, and the air spaces disappear. The end result is clear, transparent ice, which has a sapphire-blue color when viewed in large blocks. It contains only occasional air bubbles, and the size of the grains increases significantly.

Lake-ice, freezing from the surface downwards, is built up of long parallel prisms, like the cells of a honey-comb on a large scale. In a lakelet near the Hut this was beautifully demonstrated. In some places cracks and fissures filled with snow-dust traversed the body of the ice, and in other places long strings of beaded air-bubbles had become entangled in the process of freezing. To lie down on the clear surface and gaze "through the looking-glass" to the rocky bottom, twenty feet below, was a glimpse into "Wonderland."

Lake ice, which forms from the top down, is made up of long, parallel prisms, resembling the cells of a large honeycomb. This was beautifully shown in a small lake near the Hut. In some areas, cracks and fissures filled with snow dust crisscrossed the surface of the ice, while in other areas, long strings of tiny air bubbles became trapped during the freezing process. Lying down on the clear surface and looking "through the looking-glass" to the rocky bottom, twenty feet below, offered a glimpse into "Wonderland."

In the case of sea-ice, the simple prismatic structure is complicated owing to the presence of saline matter dissolved in the sea water. The saline tracts between the prisms produce a milky or opalescent appearance. The prisms are of fresh water ice, for in freezing the brine is rejected and forced to occupy the interstices of the prisms. Water of good drinking quality can be obtained by allowing sea water ice to thaw partially. The brine, of lower freezing-point, flows away, leaving only fresh water ice behind. In this way blocks of sea-ice exposed to the sun's rays are relieved of their salty constituents, and crumble into pellucid gravel when disturbed.

In the case of sea ice, the simple prismatic structure becomes complicated due to the presence of salt dissolved in the seawater. The salty areas between the prisms create a milky or opalescent look. The prisms are made of fresh water ice because when freezing happens, the brine gets pushed out and occupies the gaps between the prisms. You can get good drinking water by letting sea ice melt partially. The brine, which has a lower freezing point, drains away, leaving only fresh water ice behind. This way, blocks of sea ice that are exposed to sunlight lose their salty contents and break apart into clear gravel when disturbed.

A popular subject commanding general interest, apart from the devoted attention of specialists, was zoological collecting. Seals and birds were made the prey of every one, and dredging through the sea-ice in winter and spring was always a possible diversion.

A popular topic that attracted widespread interest, in addition to the focused attention of specialists, was animal collecting. Seals and birds were hunted by everyone, and dredging through the sea ice in winter and spring was always a potential pastime.

It was a splendid sight to watch the birds sailing in the high winds of Adelie Land. In winds of fifty to seventy miles per hour, when with good crampons one had to stagger warily along the ice-foot, the snow petrels and Antarctic petrels were in their element. Wheeling, swinging, sinking, planing and soaring, they were radiant with life—the wild spirits of the tempest. Even in moderate drift, when through swirling snow the vistas of sea whitened under the flail of the wind, one suddenly caught the silver flash of wings and a snow petrel glided past.

It was an amazing sight to see the birds gliding in the strong winds of Adelie Land. In winds of fifty to seventy miles per hour, when you had to carefully make your way along the ice-foot with sturdy crampons, the snow petrels and Antarctic petrels thrived. Twisting, diving, gliding, and soaring, they were full of energy—the wild spirits of the storm. Even in lighter snow, when the sea would flash white under the driving wind, you could suddenly catch a glimpse of silver wings as a snow petrel gracefully passed by.

But most memorable of all were certain winter mornings of unexpected calm, when ruddy clouds tessellated the northern sky and were mirrored in the freezing sea. Then the petrels would be en fete, flying over from the east following the line of the Barrier, winding round the icy coves, darting across the jutting points and ever onward in their long migration. In the summer they flew for weeks from the west—a never-ending string of snow, silver-grey and Antarctic petrels, and Cape pigeons. The silver-grey petrels and Cape pigeons were only abroad during that season and were accompanied by skua gulls, giant petrels, Wilson petrels, and penguins. The penguins remained in Adelie Land for the longest period—almost six months, the skua gulls and giant petrels for five months, and the rest for a shorter period—the tolerable season of midsummer.

But the most unforgettable moments were certain winter mornings of unexpected calm, when reddish clouds filled the northern sky and were reflected in the freezing sea. That’s when the petrels would be in full swing, flying in from the east along the Barrier, winding around the icy coves, darting across the jutting points, and continuing on their long migration. In the summer, they flew for weeks from the west—a never-ending line of snow, silver-grey and Antarctic petrels, and Cape pigeons. The silver-grey petrels and Cape pigeons were only around during that season, accompanied by skua gulls, giant petrels, Wilson petrels, and penguins. The penguins stayed in Adelie Land for the longest time—almost six months, the skua gulls and giant petrels for five months, and the rest for a shorter period during the pleasant midsummer season.

Birds that haunt the wide oceans all make use of the soaring principle in flight, some much more than others. The beautiful sliding sweep of the albatross is the most familiar example. With wings outspread, it is a miniature aeroplane requiring no engines, for the wind itself supplies the power. A slight movement of the tail-feathers and wing-tips controls its balance with nice precision. Birds employing this method of flight find their home in the zone of continuous steady winds which blow across the broad wastes of the southern seas.

Birds that roam the vast oceans all use the principle of gliding in flight, though some use it more than others. The graceful glide of the albatross is the most well-known example. With its wings spread wide, it acts like a small airplane that doesn’t need engines, as the wind provides all the power. A subtle movement of its tail feathers and wing tips allows it to balance with great precision. Birds that use this flying technique make their home in areas with consistent, steady winds that blow across the expansive southern seas.

Many petrels on the wing were shot during the winter. Laseron, who prepared the skins of our Adelie Land collection, determined, in the case of a number of specimens, the ratio of weight to horizontal area exposed to the wind. This subject is one which has lately exercised the curiosity of aviators. The ratios are those evolved by nature, and, as such, should be wellnigh perfect. Below is appended a table of the results obtained.

Many petrels in flight were shot during the winter. Laseron, who prepared the skins for our Adelie Land collection, calculated the ratio of weight to the surface area exposed to the wind for several specimens. This topic has recently intrigued aviators. These ratios are those developed by nature and should therefore be nearly perfect. Below is a table of the results obtained.

WEIGHT OF CERTAIN ANTARCTIC BIRDS IN RELATION TO WING AREAS

WEIGHT OF CERTAIN ANTARCTIC BIRDS IN RELATION TO WING AREAS

(Stated in pounds per square foot of wing surface)

(Stated in pounds per square foot of wing surface)

Each is the mean of several determinations by Laseron

Each is the average of several measurements by Laseron.

     Giant petrel...........  3.5
     Albatross   ...........  2.4
     Antarctic petrel.........  2.1
     Skua gull   ...........  1.6
     Snow petrel ...........  1.1
     Wilson petrel...........  0.6

     Values from a book of reference quoted for comparison

     Bat         ...........  0.1
     Sparrow     ...........  0.4
     Wild goose  ...........  1.7
     Giant petrel...........  3.5  
     Albatross   ...........  2.4  
     Antarctic petrel.........  2.1  
     Skua gull   ...........  1.6  
     Snow petrel ...........  1.1  
     Wilson petrel...........  0.6  

     Values from a reference book quoted for comparison  

     Bat         ...........  0.1  
     Sparrow     ...........  0.4  
     Wild goose  ...........  1.7  

During the winter, for a long period, no seals ventured ashore, though a few were seen swimming in the bay. The force of the wind was so formidable that even a heavy seal, exposed in the open, broadside-on, would be literally blown into the water. This fact was actually observed out on the harbour-ice. A Weddell seal made twelve attempts to land on a low projecting shelf—an easy feat under ordinary circumstances. The wind was in the region of eighty-five miles per hour, and every time the clumsy, ponderous creature secured its first hold, back it would be tumbled. Once it managed to raise itself on to the flat surface, and, after a breathing spell, commenced to shuffle towards the shelter of some pinnacles on one side of the harbour. Immediately its broad flank was turned to the wind it was rolled over, hung for a few seconds on the brink, and then splashed into the sea. On the other hand, during the spring, a few more ambitious seals won their way ashore in high winds; but they did not remain long in the piercing cold, moving uneasily from place to place in search of protecting hummocks and finally taking to the water in despair. Often a few hours of calm weather was the signal for half a dozen animals to land. The wind sooner or later sprang up and drove them back to their warmer element.

During the winter, for an extended time, no seals came ashore, although a few were spotted swimming in the bay. The wind was so powerful that even a heavy seal, exposed in the open and broadside, would literally be blown into the water. This was actually seen on the harbor ice. A Weddell seal tried twelve times to land on a low, protruding shelf—something that would normally be easy. The wind was about eighty-five miles per hour, and every time the awkward, heavy creature got a grip, it was knocked back. Once, it managed to pull itself onto the flat surface and, after resting for a bit, started shuffling toward the shelter of some pinnacles on one side of the harbor. As soon as its broad side faced the wind, it was rolled over, teetered on the edge for a few seconds, and then splashed into the sea. However, during the spring, a few more daring seals made their way ashore in high winds, but they didn't stay long in the biting cold, anxiously moving from spot to spot in search of sheltered hummocks and eventually diving back into the water in frustration. Often, a few hours of calm weather would prompt half a dozen seals to come ashore. The wind would eventually pick up again and drive them back to their warmer habitat.

Under the generic name, seal, are included the true or hair seals and the sea-bears or fur seals. Of these the fur seals are sub-polar in distribution, inhabiting the cold temperate waters of both hemispheres, but never living amongst the polar ice. The southern coast of Australia and the sub-antarctic islands were their favourite haunts, but the ruthless slaughter of the early days practically exterminated them. From Macquarie Island, for example, several hundred thousand skins were taken in a few years, and of late not a single specimen has been seen.

Under the general name "seal," we include true seals and fur seals. The fur seals are found in subpolar areas, living in the cold temperate waters of both hemispheres, but they never live among the polar ice. They preferred the southern coast of Australia and the sub-Antarctic islands as their main habitats, but the relentless hunting in the past nearly wiped them out. For instance, from Macquarie Island, hundreds of thousands of skins were taken in just a few years, and recently not a single specimen has been sighted.

Closely related to the fur seals are the much larger animals popularly known as sea-lions. These still exist in great numbers in south temperate waters. Both are distinguished from the hair seals by one obvious characteristic: their method of propulsion on land is by a "lolloping" motion, in which the front and hind flippers are used alternately. The hair seals move by a caterpillar-like shuffle, making little or no use of their flippers; and so, the terminal parts of their flippers are not bent outwards as they are in the fur seals and sea-lions.

Closely related to fur seals are the larger animals commonly known as sea lions. They can still be found in large numbers in the temperate waters of the southern hemisphere. Both are easily distinguished from hair seals by one clear feature: they move on land by using a "lolloping" motion, alternating their front and back flippers. In contrast, hair seals move with a caterpillar-like shuffle, hardly using their flippers at all; as a result, the ends of their flippers do not bend outward like those of fur seals and sea lions.

Of the hair seals there are five varieties to be recognized in the far South. The Weddell seals, with their mottled-grey coats, are the commonest. They haunt the coasts of Antarctica and are seldom found at any distance from them. Large specimens of this species reach nine and a half feet in length.

Of the hair seals, there are five types to identify in the far South. The Weddell seals, with their speckled gray coats, are the most common. They stay close to the coasts of Antarctica and are rarely found far from them. Large individuals of this species can grow up to nine and a half feet long.

The crab-eater seal, a smaller animal, lives mostly on the pack-ice. Lying on a piece of floe in the sunshine it has a glistening, silver-grey skin—another distinguishing mark being its small, handsome head and short, thin neck. Small crustaceans form its principal food.

The crab-eater seal, a smaller animal, mostly lives on the pack ice. While lying on a floe in the sun, it has a shiny, silver-grey skin—another distinguishing feature is its small, attractive head and short, thin neck. Its main diet consists of small crustaceans.

The Ross seal, another inhabitant of the pack-ice, is short and bulky, varying from a pale yellowish-green on the under side to a dark greenish-brown on the back. Its neck is ample and bloated, and when distended in excitement reminds one of a pouter-pigeon. This rare seal appears to subsist mainly on squid and jelly-fish.

The Ross seal, another resident of the pack ice, is short and chunky, ranging from a pale yellowish-green underneath to a dark greenish-brown on its back. It has a thick, swollen neck, and when it's excited, it resembles a pouter pigeon. This rare seal mainly feeds on squid and jellyfish.

The sea-leopard, the only predacious member of the seal family, has an elongated agile body and a large head with massive jaws. In general it has a mottled skin, darker towards the back. It lives on fish, penguins and seals. Early in April, Hurley and McLean were the first to obtain proof that the sea-leopard preyed on other seals. Among the broken floe-ice close beneath the ice-cliffs to the west of Winter Quarters, the wind was driving the dead body of a Weddell seal which swept past them, a few yards distant, to the open water. Then it was that a sea-leopard was observed tearing off and swallowing great pieces of flesh and blubber from the carcase.

The sea leopard, the only predatory member of the seal family, has a long, agile body and a large head with strong jaws. Its skin is usually mottled, darker on the back. It feeds on fish, penguins, and seals. In early April, Hurley and McLean were the first to provide evidence that the sea leopard hunted other seals. Among the broken ice floes just below the ice cliffs to the west of Winter Quarters, the wind was pushing a dead Weddell seal past them, just a few yards away, toward open water. That’s when they saw a sea leopard ripping off and eating big chunks of flesh and blubber from the carcass.

The last variety of hair seal, the sea elephant, varies considerably from the preceding. Reference has already been made to the species earlier in the narrative. The habitat of these monstrous animals ranges over the cold, south-temperate seas; sea elephants are but occasional visitors to the ice-bound regions. Although they have been exterminated in many other places, one of their most populous resorts at the present day is Macquarie Island.

The last type of fur seal, the sea elephant, is quite different from the ones mentioned earlier. We've talked about this species before in the story. These huge animals live in the cold, southern temperate seas and only occasionally visit the icy areas. Even though they've been wiped out in many other locations, one of their largest populations today can be found on Macquarie Island.

In the case of all the hair seals a layer of blubber several inches in thickness invests the body beneath the skin and acts as a conserver of warmth. They are largely of value for the oil produced by rendering down the blubber. The pelts are used for leather.

In all species of seals, a thick layer of blubber covers the body under the skin and helps keep them warm. They are mainly valuable for the oil obtained from melting down the blubber. The hides are used for leather.

The operation of skinning seals for specimens, in low temperatures and in the inevitable wind, was never unduly protracted. We were satisfied merely to strip off the skin, leaving much blubber still adhering to it. In this rough condition it was taken into the work-room of the Hut to be cleaned. The blubber froze, and then had the consistency of hard soap and was readily severed from the pelt. It was found that there exuded amongst the frozen blubber a thin oil which remained liquid when collected and exposed to low temperatures. This oil was used to lubricate the anemometer and other instruments exposed outside.

The process of skinning seals for specimens, in cold temperatures and unavoidable wind, was never unnecessarily prolonged. We were content to just remove the skin, leaving a lot of blubber still attached. This rough material was taken into the Hut's workroom to be cleaned. The blubber froze and then had a hard, soap-like consistency, making it easy to cut away from the pelt. It was discovered that a thin oil seeped out among the frozen blubber, which stayed liquid even when collected and subjected to low temperatures. This oil was used to lubricate the anemometer and other instruments outside.

The main part of the biological work lay in the marine collections. Hunter with the small hand-dredge brought up abundant samples of life from depths ranging to fifty fathoms. In water shallower than ten fathoms the variety of specimens was not great, including seaweeds up to eighteen or more feet in length, a couple of forms of starfish, various small mollusca, two or three varieties of fish, several sea-spiders, hydroids and lace corals, and, in great profusion, worms and small crustaceans. In deeper waters the life became much richer, so that examples of almost every known class of marine animals were represented.

The main focus of the biological research was on marine collections. Hunter used a small hand-dredge to gather plenty of samples from depths of up to fifty fathoms. In waters shallower than ten fathoms, the variety of specimens was limited, mainly consisting of seaweeds that could grow over eighteen feet long, a couple of types of starfish, various small mollusks, two or three kinds of fish, several sea spiders, hydroids, and lace corals, along with a large amount of worms and small crustaceans. In deeper waters, the diversity of life significantly increased, with representatives from nearly every known class of marine animals.

Early in June the sea bottom in depths less than ten fathoms had become so coated with ice that dredging in shallow water was suspended.

Early in June, the sea floor in depths of less than ten fathoms had become so covered with ice that dredging in shallow water was put on hold.

Floating or swimming freely were examples of pteropods, worms, crustaceans, ostracods, and jelly-fish. These were easily taken in the hand-net.

Floating or swimming freely were examples of pteropods, worms, crustaceans, ostracods, and jellyfish. These could be easily caught in the hand net.

In those regions where ice and water are intermingled, the temperature of the water varies very slightly in summer and winter, remaining approximately at freezing-point. In summer the tendency to heating is neutralized by a solution of some of the ice, and in winter the cold is absorbed in the production of a surface layer of ice. This constancy of the sea's temperature is favourable to organic life. On land there is a wide range in temperature, and only the meagre mosses and lichens, and the forms of insect life which live among them can exist, because they have developed the capacity of suspending animation during the winter. The fresh-water lakelets were found to be inhabited by low forms of life, mainly microscopic. Among these were diatoms, algae, protozoa, rotifera, and bacteria.

In areas where ice and water mix, the water temperature changes very little between summer and winter, staying close to freezing. In summer, the heat is balanced out by some of the ice melting, and in winter, the cold helps to create a layer of ice on the surface. This stable temperature of the sea is good for marine life. On land, temperatures vary greatly, and only sparse mosses and lichens, along with the insect species that live among them, can survive because they have adapted to pause their activity during the winter. The freshwater ponds were found to be home to simple forms of life, mainly microscopic organisms. These included diatoms, algae, protozoa, rotifers, and bacteria.

The last-named were investigated by McLean and were found to be manifold in distribution. Besides those from the intestines of animals and birds, cultures were successfully made from the following natural sources: lichen soil, moss soil, morainic mud, guano, ice and snow. The results may open some new problems in bacteriology.

The last ones mentioned were studied by McLean and were found to be widespread. In addition to those from the intestines of animals and birds, cultures were successfully taken from these natural sources: lichen soil, moss soil, glacial mud, guano, ice, and snow. These findings could lead to new questions in bacteriology.

Of recent years much attention has been given to the study of parasites—parasitology. Parasites may be external, on the skin; internal, in the alimentary canal; or resident, in the corpuscles of the blood. In tropical countries, where there is great promiscuity of life, one is led to expect their almost universal presence. But in polar regions, where infection and intimate co-habitation for long periods are not the rule, while the climate is not favourable to organic existence, one would be surprised to find them in any great number. The fact remains that internal parasites were found in the intestine of every animal and fish examined, and in all the birds except the Wilson petrel. External parasites were present on every species of bird and seal, though individuals were often free of them. This was so in the case of the Adelie penguins. It is a demonstration of the protective warmth of the feathers that Emperor penguins may harbour insect parasites in great numbers. It is only less wonderful than the fact that they are able to rear their young during the Antarctic winter. A large number of blood-slides were prepared and stained for examination for blood-parasites.

In recent years, there has been a lot of focus on the study of parasites—parasitology. Parasites can be external, living on the skin; internal, residing in the digestive tract; or resident, existing in the blood cells. In tropical regions, where life is very mixed and diverse, we expect to find them almost everywhere. However, in polar areas, where long-term infections and close living arrangements are rare, and the climate isn’t conducive to life, it would be surprising to encounter them in large numbers. The reality is that internal parasites were found in the intestines of every animal and fish examined, and in all the birds except the Wilson petrel. External parasites were present on every type of bird and seal, although many individuals were often free of them. This was true for the Adelie penguins. It's a testament to the protective warmth of their feathers that Emperor penguins can host large numbers of insect parasites. It's almost as remarkable as their ability to raise their young during the Antarctic winter. A significant number of blood slides were prepared and stained for the examination of blood parasites.

Searching for "fleas" amongst the feathers of birds and the hair of seals, or examining the viscera for "worms" is neither of them a pleasant occupation. To be really successful, the enthusiasm of the specialist is necessary. Hunter allowed no opportunities to pass and secured a fine collection of parasites.

Searching for "fleas" among the feathers of birds and the fur of seals, or checking the insides for "worms" is not a fun job. To be truly effective, the passion of the expert is essential. Hunter didn't miss any chances and built an impressive collection of parasites.

Amongst other work, McLean carried out monthly observations on six men, determining the colour-index and haemoglobin value of their blood over a period of ten months. The results showed a distinct and upward rise above the normal.

Among other tasks, McLean conducted monthly observations on six men, measuring the color index and hemoglobin levels in their blood over a period of ten months. The results indicated a clear and consistent increase above the normal range.

Among societies privileged to see the daily paper and to whom diversity and change are as the breath of life, the weather is apt to be tabooed as a subject of conversation. But even the most versatile may suddenly find themselves stripped of ideas, ignominiously reduced to the obvious topic. To us, instead of being a mere prelude to more serious matters, or the last resort of a feeble intellect, it was the all-engrossing theme. The man with the latest hare-brained theory of the causation of the wind was accorded a full hearing. The lightning calculator who estimated the annual tonnage of drift-snow sweeping off Adelie Land was received as a futurist and thinker. Discussion was always free, and the subject was never thrashed out. Evidence on the great topic accumulated day by day and month by month; yet there was no one without an innate hope that winter would bring calm weather or that spring-time, at least, must be propitious.

In societies lucky enough to read the daily newspaper, where diversity and change are like the air we breathe, talking about the weather often feels off-limits. But even the most adaptable people can suddenly find themselves out of ideas, embarrassingly reduced to discussing the obvious topic. For us, instead of being just a warm-up for more serious conversations or the last resort for a dull mind, it was the main focus. The person with the latest wild theory about what causes the wind got a full hearing. The statistician who calculated the annual tonnage of snow drifting off Adelie Land was treated like a visionary. Discussions were always open, and the subject was never fully exhausted. Evidence on this major topic built up day by day and month by month; yet everyone secretly hoped that winter would bring calm weather or that spring would, at least, be kind.

Meanwhile the meteorologist accepted things as he found them, supplied the daily facts of wind-mileage and direction, amount of drift, temperature and so forth, which were immediately seized by more vivacious minds and made the basis of daring speculations.

Meanwhile, the meteorologist took things as they were, providing the daily details on wind mileage and direction, amount of drift, temperature, and so on, which were quickly taken up by more lively thinkers and used as the foundation for bold speculations.

The daily facts were increased by the construction of a new instrument known as the puffometer. It was entirely a home-made contrivance, designed to measure the speed of heavy gusts of wind. A small aluminium sphere was arranged to blow out at the end of a light cord exerting tension on a calibrated spring. The pull was transferred to a lever carrying a pencil, which travelled across a disk of carbonized paper. The disk, moving by clockwork, made a complete revolution every hour. The recording parts of the instrument were enclosed in a snow-proof box in which there was a small aperture on the leeward side, through which ran the cord attachment of the sphere. This may give a rough idea of the apparatus employed to measure the momentary velocity of the cyclonic gusts. The idea is not an original one, having been previously applied for use on kites.

The daily facts were enhanced by the creation of a new instrument called the puffometer. It was entirely a homemade device designed to measure the speed of strong gusts of wind. A small aluminum sphere was set up to blow out at the end of a light cord that created tension on a calibrated spring. The pull was transferred to a lever with a pencil, which moved across a disk of carbonized paper. The disk, powered by clockwork, completed a full revolution every hour. The recording components of the instrument were housed in a snow-proof box that had a small opening on the leeward side, through which the cord attachment of the sphere ran. This gives a basic idea of the apparatus used to measure the momentary speed of cyclonic gusts. The concept isn’t original, having been previously used for kites.

It was not always possible to use the puffometer in the strongest gusts because these were often transient, occurring unexpectedly or during the night; while it took a little time to get the instrument into running order. Even in daylight, with the landscape clear of drift, it was a time-absorbing and difficult task to secure a record.

It wasn't always possible to use the puffometer in the strongest winds since they often came and went unexpectedly or during the night. Plus, getting the instrument ready took some time. Even during the day, with a clear view of the landscape, it was a time-consuming and challenging job to get a record.

Two men start from the Hut with iron crampons and a full complement of clothes and mitts. Outside they find themselves in a rushing torrent of air, pulsating with mighty gust-waves. Lowered from the estate of upright manhood, they humbly crawl, or make a series of crouching sprints between the gusts. Over the scattered boulders to the east of the Hut, across a patch of polished snow they push to the first low ridge, and there they stop for breath. Up on the side of "Annie Hill," in the local phrase, the tide sweeps by with fiendish strength, and among the jagged rocks the man clutching the puffometer-box has a few desperate falls. At last both clamber slowly to an eminence where a long steel pipe has been erected. To the top of this the puffometer is hauled by means of a pulley and line. At the same time the aluminium sphere is released, and out it floats in the wind tugging at the spring.

Two men leave the Hut wearing iron crampons and all their gear. Outside, they’re met by a strong rush of wind, filled with powerful gusts. Lowered from the peak of manhood, they struggle to crawl or make quick crouching runs between the blasts. They navigate over scattered boulders to the east of the Hut and across a slick patch of snow until they reach the first low ridge, where they take a moment to catch their breath. Up on the side of "Annie Hill," as locals call it, the wind roars past with fierce intensity, and among the sharp rocks, the man holding the puffometer box experiences a few close calls. Finally, both men laboriously climb to a high point where a long steel pipe stands. The puffometer is hoisted to the top using a pulley and rope. At the same time, the aluminum sphere is released, floating away in the wind, pulling on the spring.

The puffometer was left out for an hour at a time, and separate gusts up to one hundred and fifty and one hundred and eighty miles per hour were commonly indicated. I remember the final fate of this invention. While helping to mount it one day, the wind picked me up clear of the ground and dashed myself and the instrument on some rocks several yards away. The latter was badly damaged, but thick clothing saved me from serious injury.

The puffometer was left out for an hour at a time, and separate gusts of up to one hundred fifty and one hundred eighty miles per hour were often recorded. I recall what happened to this invention in the end. While I was helping to set it up one day, the wind lifted me off the ground and slammed both me and the instrument onto some rocks several yards away. The instrument was badly damaged, but my thick clothing protected me from serious injury.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

The wind velocity and wind direction charts for Midwinter's Day, when the steady south-by-east gale was broken after noon by a welcome lull—the wind veering the while all round the compass.

The wind speed and direction charts for Midwinter's Day, when the consistent south-by-east breeze was interrupted after noon by a welcomed calm—the wind shifting all around the compass.

The average velocity for the day 66.9 miles per hour, and the maximum of the average hourly velocities, ninety-six miles.

The average speed for the day was 66.9 miles per hour, with a maximum average hourly speed of 96 miles.

The steadiness of the temperature was a subject for debate. The stronger the wind blew, the less variation did the thermometer show. Over a period of several days there might be a range of only four or five degrees. Ordinarily, this might be expected of an insular climate, but in our case it depended upon the fact that the wind remained steady from the interior of the vast frigid continent. The air which flowed over the Hut had all passed through the same temperature-cycle. The atmosphere of the interior, where the plateau stood at an elevation of, say, eight thousand feet, might have a temperature -45 degrees F. As the air flowed northwards over Adelie Land to the sea, it would rise slowly in temperature owing to the increased barometric pressure consequent on the descending gradient of the plateau. At sea-level the temperature of the river of air would be, approximately, -20 degrees F.

The temperature stayed pretty consistent, which sparked some debate. The stronger the wind blew, the less the thermometer varied. Over several days, the temperature might only change by four or five degrees. Normally, you'd expect this in an island climate, but in our case, it was because the wind was coming steadily from the interior of the vast, icy continent. The air flowing over the Hut had all gone through the same temperature cycle. The atmosphere in the interior, where the plateau is about eight thousand feet high, could be around -45 degrees F. As the air moved north over Adelie Land toward the sea, its temperature would gradually rise due to the increased air pressure caused by the descending gradient of the plateau. At sea level, the temperature of that air would be about -20 degrees F.

Such a rise in temperature due to compression is a well-known phenomenon, referred to as the Foehn effect.

Such an increase in temperature from compression is a well-known phenomenon called the Foehn effect.

The compression of the atmosphere during the gusts affected the air temperature so considerably that, coincident with their passage, the mercury column could often be seen rising and falling through several degrees. The uniform conditions experienced during steady high winds were not only expressed by the slight variation in the temperature, but often in a remarkably even barometric curve. Thus on July 11 the wind-velocity for twenty-four hours was, throughout, seventy miles per hour; the temperature remaining within a few degrees of-21 degrees F., and the barometric curve did not show as much range as one-twentieth of an inch.

The compression of the atmosphere during the gusts significantly affected the air temperature, so much so that, as the gusts passed, the mercury column often rose and fell by several degrees. The steady high winds created uniform conditions, reflected not only in slight temperature variations but also in a remarkably consistent barometric curve. For instance, on July 11, the wind speed over a twenty-four hour period was consistently seventy miles per hour; the temperature stayed within a few degrees of -21 degrees F, and the barometric curve showed less variation than one-twentieth of an inch.

In attending to the many instruments and in gathering the voluminous meteorological data, Madigan had his hands very full. Throughout two years he carried on the work capably and thoroughly. It was difficult to keep the instruments free from the penetrating snow and in good running order. The Robinson anemometer was perhaps the greatest source of worry. Repairs and readjustments were unavoidable, as the instrument was constantly working at high pressure. In order that these might be carried out efficiently, the whole apparatus had to be carried down to the Hut. Here, Bickerton and Correll were continually in consultation with the meteorologist on the latest breakdown. Cups were blown off several times, and one was lost and replaced with difficulty. Most aggravating of all was a habit the clocks developed of stopping during the colder spells. The old-fashioned method of boiling them was found of assistance, but it was discovered that the best treatment was to put them through successive baths of benzene and alcohol.

In taking care of the various instruments and collecting a ton of meteorological data, Madigan had a lot on his plate. Over two years, he managed the work skillfully and thoroughly. Keeping the instruments free from the heavy snow and maintaining them was a challenge. The Robinson anemometer was probably the biggest headache. Repairs and adjustments were necessary since the instrument was always running at high pressure. To perform these repairs effectively, the entire setup had to be moved down to the Hut. There, Bickerton and Correll were frequently discussing the latest issues with the meteorologist. The cups blew off several times, and one was lost and was hard to replace. The most frustrating problem was that the clocks had a tendency to stop during colder weather. The old-school method of boiling them helped, but it turned out that the best solution was to run them through several baths of benzene and alcohol.

The most chronic sufferer throughout the vicissitudes of temperature was the clock belonging to Bage's tide-gauge. Every sleeper in the Hut who was sensitive to ticking knew and reviled that clock. So often was it subjected to warm, curative treatment in various resting-places that it was hunted from pillar to post. A radical operation by Correll—the insertion of an extra spring—became necessary at last. Correll, when not engaged designing electroscopes, improving sledge-meters and perfecting theodolites, was something of a specialist in clocks. His advice on the subject of refractory time-pieces was freely asked and cheerfully given. By perseverance and unlimited patience, the tide-gauge down on the harbour-ice was induced to supply a good series of unbroken records.

The clock that belonged to Bage's tide-gauge was the biggest victim of the temperature changes. Anyone in the Hut who was sensitive to ticking knew and cursed that clock. It was moved around so much for warm, healing treatment that it was chased everywhere. Eventually, Correll had to perform a major fix—adding an extra spring. When he wasn't designing electroscopes, improving sled meters, or perfecting theodolites, Correll had a knack for clocks. People often sought his advice on troublesome timepieces, and he happily shared it. Thanks to his persistence and incredible patience, the tide-gauge down on the harbor ice finally managed to provide a solid series of uninterrupted records.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

The tide-gauge

The tide gauge

The rise and fall of the tide is coincident with the movements of a perpendicular wire to which the Float is attached. The Wheel is revolved, and through wire connections (indicated above) displaces vertically the Pen. This traces a record on paper folded on the drum which is driven by clockwork. In all weathers, the box was enveloped in drift-proof canvas.

The rise and fall of the tide happens at the same time as the movement of a vertical wire the Float is attached to. The Wheel turns, and through the wire connections mentioned earlier, it moves the Pen up and down. This creates a record on paper wrapped around the drum, which is powered by clockwork. In all weather conditions, the box was covered in waterproof canvas.

Antarctica is a world of colour, brilliant and intensely pure. The chaste whiteness of the snow and the velvet blackness of the rocks belong to days of snowy nimbus enshrouding the horizon. When the sky has broken into cloudlets of fleece, their edges are painted pale orange, fading or richly glowing if the sun is low. In the high sun they are rainbow-rimmed.

Antarctica is a vibrant world, full of color that is striking and incredibly pure. The pristine whiteness of the snow and the deep blackness of the rocks belong to days when a snowy haze covers the horizon. When the sky is scattered with fluffy clouds, their edges are painted light orange, shimmering or glowing brightly when the sun is low. When the sun is high, they are edged with rainbows.

The clouds have opened into rifts and the sun is setting in the north-west. The widening spaces in the zenith are azure, and low in the north they are emerald. Scenic changes are swift. Above the mounting plateau a lofty arch of clear sky has risen, flanked by roseate clouds. Far down in the south it is tinged with indigo and ultramarine, washed with royal purple paling onwards into cold violet and greyish-blue.

The clouds have broken apart, and the sun is setting in the northwest. The expanding areas in the sky are blue, and low in the north, they’re green. The scenery is changing quickly. Above the rising plateau, a high arch of clear sky has appeared, bordered by pink clouds. Far down in the south, it has hints of dark blue and bright blue, fading into deep purple and pale violet and greyish-blue.

Soon the north is unveiled. The liquid globe of sun has departed, but his glory still remains. Down from the zenith his colours descend through greenish-blue, yellowish-green, straw-yellow, light terra-cotta to a diffuse brick-red; each reflected in the dull sheen of freezing sea. Out on the infinite horizon float icebergs in a mirage of mobile gold. The Barrier, curving to east and west, is a wall of delicate pink overlaid with a wondrous mauve—the rising plateau. A cold picture—yet it awakens the throb of inborn divinity.

Soon the north is revealed. The bright sun has set, but its glory still lingers. Its colors fade from the bright blue, to yellow-green, straw yellow, light terracotta, and finally to a muted brick red; each hue reflected in the dark sheen of the freezing sea. Icebergs float on the endless horizon, shimmering like moving gold. The Barrier, arching east and west, is a delicate pink overlaid with a stunning mauve—the rising plateau. It’s a cold scene—yet it stirs the pulse of innate divinity.

Despite contrary predictions, there were some enjoyable days in June. Occupation had to be strenuous, making the blood run hot, otherwise the wind was apt to be chill. So the Transit House was founded, and there were many volunteers to assist Bage in carrying the tons of stones which formed its permanent base. The nearest large collection of boulders was twenty yards away, on the edge of a moraine, but these after a while became exhausted. Plenty of rocks actually showed above the surface, but the majority were frozen-in, and, when of suitable size, could only be moved by a heavy crowbar. Some of the men, therefore, dislodged the rocks, while others carried them.

Despite what people said would happen, there were some great days in June. Work had to be tough to keep the blood pumping; otherwise, the breeze tended to be cold. So, the Transit House was built, and many volunteers helped Bage carry the tons of stones that made up its solid foundation. The closest big pile of boulders was twenty yards away, at the edge of a moraine, but eventually, those ran out. Lots of rocks were visible above the ground, but most were frozen in place, and the ones that were the right size could only be moved with a heavy crowbar. Some of the guys moved the rocks while others carried them.

When Bage was wondering how long the supply would last, Ninnis and Mertz came to the rescue with sledges and dog-teams. Boxes were piled on to the sledges and away the teams went, careering across the ice-flat towards the Magnetograph House close to which there were many heaps of stones, wind-swept and easily displaced. Soon a regular service was plying to the foundations, and, at the same time, the dogs were being trained. This occupation was continued, weather permitting, for several weeks before Midwinter's Day. Thus the drivers gained experience, while the animals, with a wholesome dread of the whip, became more responsive to commands. Eagerly the huskies strained at their traces with excited yelps. The heavily laden sledges would break out and start off with increasing speed over the rough ice. The drivers, running at full speed, jumped on the racing loads—Mertz in the lead shouting some quaint yodel song; Ninnis, perhaps, just behind upbraiding a laggard dog.

When Bage was wondering how long the supplies would last, Ninnis and Mertz came to the rescue with sleds and dog teams. They piled boxes onto the sleds and off the teams went, racing across the flat ice towards the Magnetograph House, near which there were many piles of stones, wind-swept and easily moved. Soon, there was a regular service going to the foundations, and at the same time, the dogs were being trained. This activity continued, weather permitting, for several weeks before Midwinter’s Day. The drivers gained experience, while the animals, with a healthy respect for the whip, became more responsive to commands. The huskies eagerly strained against their traces with excited yelps. The heavily loaded sleds would break loose and start off with increasing speed over the rough ice. The drivers, running at full speed, jumped onto the racing loads—Mertz in the lead shouting some quirky yodel song; Ninnis, perhaps just behind, scolding a slow dog.

Midwinter's Day! For once, the weather rose to the occasion and calmed during the few hours of the twilight-day. It was a jovial occasion, and we celebrated it with the uproarious delight of a community of eighteen young men unfettered by small conventions. The sun was returning, and we were glad of it. Already we were dreaming of spring and sledging, summer and sledging, the ship and home. It was the turn of the tide, and the future seemed to be sketched in firm, sure outline. While the rest explored all the ice-caves and the whole extent of our small rocky "selection," Hannam and Bickerton shouldered the domestic responsibilities. Their menu du diner to us was a marvel of gorgeous delicacies. After the toasts and speeches came a musical and dramatic programme, punctuated by choice gramophone records and rowdy student choruses. The washing-up was completed by all hands at midnight. Outside, the wind was not to be outdone; it surpassed itself with an unusual burst of ninety-five miles per hour.

Midwinter's Day! For once, the weather matched the occasion and calmed down during the few hours of the twilight-day. It was a cheerful event, and we celebrated it with the raucous joy of a community of eighteen young men free from trivial conventions. The sun was coming back, and we were happy about it. We were already dreaming of spring and sledding, summer and sledding, the ship and home. It was a turning point, and the future felt firmly outlined. While the others explored all the ice caves and the entire extent of our small rocky "selection," Hannam and Bickerton took care of the domestic duties. Their dinner menu for us was a marvel of beautiful delicacies. After the toasts and speeches, there was a musical and dramatic program, highlighted by great gramophone records and lively student choruses. Everyone finished washing up at midnight. Outside, the wind was showing off; it reached an unusual speed of ninety-five miles per hour.

   Menu du Diner

   Escoffier potage a la Reine

   Noisettes de Phoque                    |    Claret
   Haricot Verts                          |    Tintara
   Champignons en Sauce Antarctique       |

   Pingouin a la Terre Adelie             |    Burgundy
   Petits Pois a la Menthe                |    Chauvenet
   Pommes Nouvelle                        |      1898
                                          |
   Asperges au Beurre Fondu               |

   Plum Pudding Union Jack                |     Port
   Pate de Groseilles                     |     Kopke
                                          |
   Desserts                               |

   Cafe

                           ———————-0——————
   Dinner Menu

   Escoffier Queen's Soup

   Seal Loin                           |    Claret
   Green Beans                        |    Tintara
   Mushrooms in Antarctic Sauce       |

   Penguin from Adelie Land          |    Burgundy
   Minted Peas                        |    Chauvenet
   New Potatoes                      |      1898
                                      |
   Asparagus with Melted Butter       |

   Union Jack Plum Pudding           |     Port
   Currant Jelly                      |     Kopke
                                      |
   Desserts                           |

   Coffee

                           ———————-0——————

During dinner the Blizzard will render the usual accompaniment—the Tempest. For Ever and Ever etc.

During dinner, the Blizzard will bring the usual addition—the Tempest. For Ever and Ever, etc.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION] MIDWINTER'S DAY MENU AT THE MAIN BASE, ADELIE LAND, 1912

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION] MIDWINTER'S DAY MENU AT THE MAIN BASE, ADELIE LAND, 1912





CHAPTER X THE PREPARATION OF SLEDGING EQUIPMENT

The world of fashion insists on its minute vagaries in dress not always with an eye to utility and an explorer in the polar regions is a very fastidious person, expending a vast amount of care on his attire, but with the sole idea of comfort, warmth, and usefulness. The clothes he wears are many and often cumbersome, but they have gradually been perfected to meet the demands of the local weather conditions. After a sojourn in the ice-lands, he returns to civilization with a new concept of the value of dress. At last he can stand still without being reminded that his feet are chilly; he experiences the peculiar sensation of walking about in an airily light suit, in glove-tight boots, without helmet or mitts. It gives him such a delicious feeling of freedom that his energy is unbounded and life is a very pleasant and easy thing. Then it is that he can turn in retrospect to the time in exile, appreciate his altered circumstances and recall the many ingenuities which were evolved to make him master of his environment.

The fashion world is all about its tiny trends, often not focused on practicality. In contrast, an explorer in the polar regions is quite particular about his clothing, putting a lot of effort into his attire, but only to ensure comfort, warmth, and usefulness. The clothes he wears are numerous and often bulky, but they’ve been refined over time to handle the local weather. After spending time in the icy lands, he comes back to civilization with a fresh understanding of what clothing truly means. Finally, he can stand still without feeling cold in his feet; he experiences the unique feeling of walking around in a light suit, snug boots, without a helmet or mittens. It gives him such an incredible sense of freedom that his energy knows no bounds, and life feels wonderfully easy. At that point, he can look back at his time in exile, appreciate his new situation, and remember the many clever solutions he developed to adapt to his environment.

It is sufficient to say that we found the proposition of clothing one of unusual interest. Any one who was not a practised needleman and machinist was handicapped for a time, until he fell into the ways of the through-and-through and blanket-stitch, thimbles, shuttles, spools and many other things he had once affected to despise as belonging to the sphere of women's work. It was not long before he was an enthusiast in many arts attaining to a stage of independence, in which he patented new ideas and maintained them in hot opposition to the whole community of the Hut. On some fundamental points all were in agreement, and one of them was that Adelie Land was the country par excellence for the wind-proof, drift-tight burberry.

It's safe to say that we found the idea of clothing to be really interesting. Anyone who wasn't a skilled seamster or machinist struggled at first until they got used to using the through-and-through stitch and blanket stitch, thimbles, shuttles, spools, and many other tools they once claimed to look down on as feminine tasks. It didn't take long before they became passionate about various crafts, reaching a level of independence where they patented new ideas and strongly defended them against the entire community at the Hut. There were some key points everyone agreed on, and one of them was that Adelie Land was the ideal place for wind-proof, drift-tight burberry.

Outside all other garments the burberry gabardine was worn. The material was light and loosely fitting, but in wind and drift it had to be hermetically sealed, so to speak, for the snow crept in wherever there was an aperture. The trousers were of double thickness, as they were exposed to the greatest wear. Attached by large buttons, toggles or lampwick braces, they reached as high as the lower part of the chest. Below, they had lamp-wick lashings which were securely bound round the uppers of boots or finnesko. In walking, the trousers would often work off the leather boots, especially if they were cut to a tailor's length, and snow would then pour up the leg and down into the boots in a remarkably short time. To counteract this, Ninnis initiated the very satisfactory plan of sewing a short length of canvas on to the boots to increase the length of the upper.

Outside of all other clothing, the Burberry gabardine was worn. The material was light and loosely fitted, but when it was windy and snowy, it needed to be sealed up tight because snow could get in through any openings. The trousers were made of double thickness since they took the most wear. They were attached with large buttons, toggles, or lampwick braces and went up to the lower part of the chest. At the bottom, they had lamp-wick lashings that were securely bound around the tops of the boots or finnesko. While walking, the trousers would often come loose from the leather boots, especially if they were tailored too short, and snow would then quickly pour down the leg and into the boots. To solve this, Ninnis came up with a very effective idea of sewing a short piece of canvas onto the boots to make the upper part longer.

The burberry helmet and blouse were either in one piece or separate. For use round the Hut, in thick drifts, the combination of helmet and blouse was handy and time-saving. For sledging, when low temperatures and strong winds might be expected all the time, it met the conditions well; there being no necessity to worry about keeping the neck drift-tight. Under ordinary circumstances it was very convenient to have a blouse and helmet detached, as one so often could wear the former with a well-padded woollen helmet and be reduced only as a last resource to wearing the burberry helmet.

The Burberry helmet and blouse could be one piece or separate. For use around the Hut, especially in deep snow, having the combination of helmet and blouse was practical and saved time. When sledding, where low temperatures and strong winds were always expected, it worked well; there was no need to stress about keeping the neck tightly covered. Under normal circumstances, it was really convenient to have the blouse and helmet separate since you could often wear the blouse with a padded wool helmet and only resort to the Burberry helmet as a last option.

The blouse was roomy, giving great freedom of movement. Around the neck was a draw-string, which bunched in the jacket tightly over the lower part of the helmet. There was also a draw-string round the waist. It was here that we had the greatest difficulty in making the garment fit snow-tight. If simply tied, the blouse would soon slip up from below, especially if one were working with pick and shovel, carrying cases or blocks of ice. To obviate this, some of the men sewed loops or tags of lamp-wick on to the sides of the trousers, to connect with corresponding attachments on the blouse. As an additional security, others wore an outside belt which was, even if the blouse slipped up for some distance, a line of defence against the drift-snow.

The blouse was loose-fitting, allowing for a lot of movement. There was a drawstring around the neck that gathered the jacket tightly over the lower part of the helmet. There was also a drawstring at the waist. This was where we had the most trouble getting the garment to fit snugly against the snow. If just tied, the blouse would quickly ride up, especially when working with a pick and shovel or carrying ice blocks and cases. To solve this issue, some guys stitched loops or tags of lamp wick onto the sides of their trousers to connect with matching attachments on the blouse. As an extra precaution, others wore an outer belt which acted as a barrier against drifting snow, even if the blouse slid up a bit.

The burberry helmet completely enclosed the head except for the face, which remained uncovered at the bottom of a funnel stiffened by several rings of copper-wire. Lampwick, the universal polar "cord," was sewn in short strips in front of the ears and tied at the back of the head, firmly securing the helmet. Since the voyage of the 'Discovery' (1901-1904) lamp-wick had been used widely in sledging on account of its width, softness, comparative warmth and because of the fact that ordinary cord is not so easy to manipulate in cold weather. Large buttons of leather or bone were not nearly so popular as small, smooth lengths of stick engaging cross-wise with loops of cord—known as toggles, which became quite a mania with some members of the Expedition. Whetter, for instance, was known as the "Toggle King," because of the multitude of these stick-and-cord appendages which hung from every part of his clothing.

The burberry helmet completely covered the head except for the face, which was left exposed at the bottom of a funnel reinforced with several rings of copper wire. Lampwick, the universal polar "cord," was sewn in short strips in front of the ears and tied at the back of the head, securely holding the helmet in place. Since the voyage of the 'Discovery' (1901-1904), lampwick had been widely used for sledding because of its width, softness, warmth, and the fact that regular cord is harder to handle in cold weather. Large buttons made of leather or bone were nowhere near as popular as small, smooth sticks that hooked together with loops of cord—known as toggles—which became quite a craze among some Expedition members. Whetter, for example, was nicknamed the "Toggle King" because of the countless stick-and-cord accessories that dangled from every part of his clothing.

Under the burberrys thick, but light, suits of Jaeger fleece were worn. They combined trousers and a sleeveless coat, over which a woollen jersey was worn. In calm weather these with underclothing were all-sufficient, but in the average fifty-mile wind at any temperature in the neighbourhood of zero Fahrenheit, they felt distinctly porous.

Under the warm, yet lightweight, Burberry coats, they wore Jaeger fleece suits. They included trousers and a sleeveless coat, with a wool sweater on top. In calm weather, these with underclothes were enough, but in the typical fifty-mile-an-hour wind at any temperature around zero degrees Fahrenheit, they felt quite drafty.

In less windy weather the luxury of discarding burberrys, either partly or wholly, was an indulgence which gave great satisfaction.

In calmer weather, the luxury of getting rid of burberrys, either partially or completely, was a treat that brought a lot of happiness.

Finnesko were the favourite foot-gear—soft and commodious reindeer-skin fur boots. Once these were stuffed with Lapp saennegras or manilla fibre, and the feet covered with several pairs of socks, cold could be despised unless one were stationary for some time or the socks or padding became damp. Even though the padding were wet, violent exercise kept the temperature "balance" in the warm direction, especially if one were also under the stimulus of a recent hot meal.

Finnesko were the favorite footwear—soft and comfortable reindeer-skin fur boots. Once these were stuffed with Lapp saennegras or manila fiber, and the feet covered with several pairs of socks, you could ignore the cold unless you were standing still for a while or the socks or padding got wet. Even if the padding was damp, vigorous exercise kept the temperature "balance" in the warm direction, especially if you had just eaten a hot meal.

Of course, on smooth ice or polished snow in even moderate winds it was useless to try and keep one's feet in finnesko, although practice gave great agility in calmer weather. As already indicated, spiked crampons on approved models, tested on the glacier-slopes in a hurricane wind, were almost always worn encasing the finnesko. With so many coverings the feet often became uncomfortably hot, and for odd jobs about the Hut and not far abroad spiked leather boots gave most satisfaction.

Of course, it was pointless to try to stay upright on smooth ice or polished snow in even moderate winds while wearing finnesko, although practice allowed for greater agility in calmer conditions. As mentioned earlier, spiked crampons on approved models, tested on glacier slopes in hurricane winds, were almost always worn over the finnesko. With so many layers, the feet often got uncomfortably hot, so for casual tasks around the Hut and short trips nearby, spiked leather boots were the most satisfying option.

There were various coverings for the hands: felt mitts, mittens, instrument-gloves and wolfskin mitts.

There were different types of hand coverings: felt mitts, mittens, gloves for handling tools, and wolfskin mitts.

The first were used in conjunction with fingerless mittens. The wear and tear on these was greater than on any other item of clothing. It was a common sight to see them ragged, canvas-covered, patched, repatched and again repatched, to be at last reluctantly thrown away. There were two compartments in a single glove, one for the thumb and the other for the fingers. It is much easier to keep the fingers warm when in contact with one another than by having them in separate stalls.

The first were used with fingerless gloves. They experienced more wear and tear than any other piece of clothing. It was a common sight to see them tattered, canvas-covered, patched, sewn again, and eventually tossed out reluctantly. Each glove had two sections, one for the thumb and one for the fingers. It's much easier to keep the fingers warm when they’re touching each other rather than having them separated.

Instrument-gloves of wool were used for delicate manipulations, as a partial protection, since they reduced the stinging chill of cold metal at low temperatures.

Instrument gloves made of wool were used for delicate tasks, providing some protection by lessening the biting chill of cold metal in low temperatures.

Wolfskin mitts are unexcelled for use in cold windy weather. Their shaggy external hair entangles the drift-snow, which thaws, soaks the skin and refreezes until the mitt is stiff as buckram. This is their main disadvantage. These mitts or rather gauntlets were made longer in the arms than usual so as to overlap the burberry sleeves and keep the wrists warm.

Wolfskin mitts are unmatched for use in cold, windy weather. Their shaggy outer hair traps drifting snow, which melts, soaks the skin, and then refreezes until the mitt is as stiff as cardboard. This is their main downside. These mitts, or rather gauntlets, were designed to be longer in the arms than usual to overlap with the burberry sleeves and keep the wrists warm.

Lambskin mitts with the wool facing inwards were very useful and wore well for occupations like hauling on ropes and lifting cases.

Lambskin mitts with the wool on the inside were really useful and held up well for tasks like pulling ropes and lifting boxes.

Like every other movable thing, mitts had to be made fast to prevent them blowing away. So they were slung round the neck by a yoke of lamp-wick. The mittened hand could then be removed with the assurance that the outer mitt would not be far away when it was wanted, no matter how hard the wind blew.

Like everything else that could get blown away, mitts had to be secured. So they were hung around the neck with a piece of lamp wick. This way, you could take off the mittened hand and be sure the outer mitt would be nearby when you needed it, no matter how strong the wind was.

There has been much discussion as to the relative merits of fur and woollen clothing. After all the question has resolved itself into one of personal predilection. It has been claimed that furs are warmer and lighter. The warmth follows from the wind-proof quality of the hide which, unfortunately, also tends to retain moist exhalations from the body. In Adelie Land, the only furs we used were finnesko, wolfskin mitts and sleeping-bags of reindeer skins.

There has been a lot of debate about the advantages of fur versus wool clothing. Ultimately, it comes down to personal preference. Some people say that furs are warmer and lighter. The warmth comes from the windproof properties of the hide, which also tends to trap moisture from the body. In Adelie Land, the only furs we used were finnesko, wolfskin mitts, and sleeping bags made of reindeer skins.

As in every part of the equipment, modifications had to be made in the circular Willesden-drill tents. To facilitate their erection in the perpetual winds they were sewn permanently on to the five bamboo poles, instead of being thrown over the latter previously set in position. Thus the tents opened like large conical umbrellas. A rawhide loop was fixed to the middle one of the three windward legs and, when raising a tent during a high wind, it was the usual thing for a man to be inside gripping the loop to pin down the windward legs and at the same time, kicking out the two leeward legs. On hard surfaces, holes were dug to receive the ends of the poles; at other times they were pressed home into the snow by the man inside the tent.

As with every other piece of equipment, changes needed to be made to the circular Willesden-drill tents. To make them easier to set up in the constant winds, they were permanently sewn onto five bamboo poles instead of being draped over poles that had already been positioned. This way, the tents opened like large conical umbrellas. A rawhide loop was attached to the middle leg of the three facing the wind, and when raising a tent in strong winds, it was common for someone to be inside holding the loop to secure the windward legs while simultaneously kicking out the two legs on the leeward side. On hard ground, holes were dug to secure the ends of the poles; at other times, they were pushed firmly into the snow by the person inside the tent.

When pitched, the tent was held down by blocks of snow or ice, helped by spare food-bags, which were all piled round on a broad flounce. Ventilators, originally supplied with the tents, had to be dispensed with on account of the incessant drift. The door of the tent was an oval funnel of burberry material just large enough to admit a man and secured by a draw-string.

When set up, the tent was secured with blocks of snow or ice, along with spare food bags that were all piled around the bottom edge. The vents that originally came with the tents had to be removed due to the constant snowfall. The entrance of the tent was an oval opening made of burberry material, just big enough for a person to get through, and it was fastened with a drawstring.

Strips of calico and webbing were sewn over the insides of the light tents to strengthen them for sledging in the summer. For heavy weather we also had japara sail-cloth tents with Willesden canvas flounces. These gave one a feeling of greater security and were much more wind-proof, but unfortunately twice as heavy as the first-mentioned.

Strips of calico and webbing were stitched onto the insides of the light tents to make them stronger for summer sledding. For rough weather, we also had japara sailcloth tents with Willesden canvas flaps. These provided a greater sense of security and were much more windproof, but unfortunately, they were twice as heavy as the first ones.

A floor-cloth of light Willesden canvas covered the surface of snow or ice in the interior of the tent; performing when sledging the alternative office of a sail.

A light Willesden canvas floor cloth covered the snow or ice inside the tent, also serving as a sail when sledging.

In order to cut snow, neve or ice to pile on the flounce, a pick and spade had to be included in the sledging equip meet. As a rule, a strong, pointed shovel weighing about six pounds answers very well; but in Adelie Land, the surface was so often wind-swept ice, polished porcelain-snow, or hard neve that a pick was necessary to make any impression upon it. It was found that a four-pound spade, carefully handled, and a four-pound miner's pick provided against all emergencies.

To cut through snow, ice, or hard-packed snow to pile on the flounce, a pick and shovel needed to be part of the sledding gear. Typically, a sturdy, pointed shovel weighing around six pounds works perfectly; however, in Adelie Land, the surface was frequently wind-swept ice, smooth porcelain-like snow, or hard neve, making a pick essential to create any impact. It turned out that a four-pound shovel, used carefully, along with a four-pound miner's pick, was sufficient for any situation.

Our sledges were similar to those of other British Antarctic expeditions; of eleven- and twelve-foot lengths. The best were Norwegian, made of ash and hickory. Others built in Sydney, of Australian woods, were admirably suited for special work. Those made of mountain-ash had the advantage of being extremely light, but the runners wore out quickly on ice and hard neve. Sledges of powellized spotted gum were very strong and stood plenty of rough usage, but were heavier than those procured in Norway. A decking of bamboo slats secured by copper-wire to the crossbars was usually employed.

Our sledges were like those from other British Antarctic expeditions, measuring eleven to twelve feet in length. The best ones were Norwegian, crafted from ash and hickory. Others made in Sydney, using Australian woods, were perfectly suited for specific tasks. The sledges made from mountain-ash were very lightweight, but the runners wore out quickly on ice and hard snow. Sledges made from powellized spotted gum were very sturdy and could handle a lot of rough treatment, but they were heavier than those from Norway. A decking of bamboo slats, secured with copper wire to the crossbars, was usually used.

A light bamboo mast and spar were fitted to each sledge. Immediately in front of the mast came the "cooker-box," containing in respective compartments the primus and a bottle of spirit for lighting it, as well as spare prickers, openers and fillers for the kerosene tins, repair outfits and other odd articles. The cooker-boxes were of Venesta board, with hinged lids secured by chocks and overlapped by japara cloth to exclude as much drift-snow as possible. An instrument-box was secured to the sledge near the rear and just forward of a Venesta or aluminium tray on which the kerosene contained in one-gallon tins was carried. In several cases the tray was widened to receive as well a case containing a dip-circle. Rearmost of all was a wooden crosspiece to which the shaft of the sledge-meter was attached through a universal joint. On the middle section of the sledge between the cooker-box and instrument-box, sleeping-bags, food-bags, clothes-bags, tent, alpine rope, theodolite legs, and other articles, were arranged, packed and immovably stiffened by buckled straps passing from side to side.

A light bamboo mast and spar were attached to each sled. Right in front of the mast was the "cooker box," which had compartments for the primus and a bottle of spirit for lighting it, along with spare prickers, openers, and fillers for the kerosene cans, repair kits, and other miscellaneous items. The cooker boxes were made of Venesta board, with hinged lids secured by chocks and covered by japara cloth to keep out as much drift-snow as possible. An instrument box was attached to the sled near the back and just in front of a Venesta or aluminum tray that held kerosene in one-gallon cans. In some cases, the tray was widened to also hold a case for a dip circle. Furthest back was a wooden crosspiece to which the shaft of the sled meter was connected through a universal joint. In the middle section of the sled, between the cooker box and the instrument box, sleeping bags, food bags, clothing bags, a tent, alpine rope, theodolite legs, and other items were arranged, packed, and securely fastened with buckled straps that went from side to side.

Sledging harness for both men and dogs was constructed of canvas. In the former case, a wide belt of triple thickness encircled the body at the hips, sewn to braces of narrower strips passing over the shoulders, while hauling-rope was attached to the belt behind. The strength of the whole depended on the care bestowed in sewing the parts together, and, since his life might depend upon it, no one made anything else but a thorough job of his harness.

Sledding harnesses for both people and dogs were made of canvas. For people, a wide, triple-thick belt wrapped around the hips, attached to narrower straps that went over the shoulders, while the hauling rope connected to the belt at the back. The strength of the entire setup relied on how well the parts were sewn together, and since someone's life could be at stake, everyone made sure to do a thorough job on their harness.

Ninnis and Mertz ran a tailoring business for the dogs, who were brought one by one into the outer Hut to be measured for harness. After many lengths had been cut with scissors the canvas bands were put through and sewn together on the large sewing-machine and then each dog was fitted and the final alterations were made. The huskies looked quite smart in their "suits".

Ninnis and Mertz ran a tailoring business for dogs, who were brought one by one into the outer hut to be measured for harnesses. After cutting many lengths with scissors, the canvas bands were threaded through and sewn together on the large sewing machine, and then each dog was fitted with the final adjustments made. The huskies looked pretty sharp in their "suits."

Upon the primus heater, alone, did we rely for cooking the meals on sledging journeys. First used for purposes of sledging by Dr. Nansen in his journey across Greenland, the primus is only economically managed after some practice. To light a primus in a draughty tent at a low temperature calls for some forbearance before one is a thorough master of the art. A sledging cook will often make a disagreeable faux pas by extinguishing the primus in the preparation of hoosh. This is most readily done by lowering too quickly the outside cover over the rest of the cooker. Fumes of vaporizing kerosene soon fill the tent and when matches are found, the cooker pulled to pieces, the primus relighted and the choking vapours have cleared, one is apt to think that all is well. The hoosh is quite as successful as usual, but the cocoa, made from water in the annulus, has a tincture of kerosene which cannot be concealed.

We relied solely on the primus heater to cook our meals during sledging journeys. First used for sledging by Dr. Nansen on his trek across Greenland, the primus needs some practice to be managed efficiently. Lighting a primus in a drafty tent when it’s cold requires patience before becoming truly skilled at it. A sledging cook can easily make an annoying mistake by putting out the primus while making hoosh. This often happens when the outside cover is lowered too quickly over the rest of the cooker. Soon, fumes from the vaporizing kerosene fill the tent, and when matches are finally found, the cooker taken apart, the primus relit, and the choking fumes dissipated, one might think everything is fine. The hoosh comes out just as usual, but the cocoa, made from the water in the annulus, will have a noticeable hint of kerosene that can’t be hidden.

In the "Nansen Cooker," which we used, a maximum result is secured from the heat of the primus. The hot gases from the combustion of the kerosene, before they escape into the outside air, have to circulate along a tortuous path, passing from the hot interior to the colder exterior compartments, losing heat all the time. Thus a hot hoosh is preparing in the central vessel side by side with the melting of snow for cocoa or tea in the annulus. By the combination of "Nansen Cooker" and primus stove one gallon of kerosene oil properly husbanded is made to last for twelve days in the preparation of the ordinary ration for three men.

In the "Nansen Cooker" we used, we got the best results from the heat of the primus. The hot gases produced by burning the kerosene have to travel through a complicated route before they escape into the outside air, moving from the hot inside to the cooler outside compartments and losing heat along the way. This way, a hot stew is being prepared in the main vessel while snow is melted for cocoa or tea in the space around it. By using the "Nansen Cooker" with the primus stove, one gallon of kerosene can effectively last for twelve days while feeding three men.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]





Section through a Nansen Sledging Cooker mounted on the primus

The subject of food is one which requires peculiar consideration and study. It is assumed that a polar expedition must carry all its food-stuffs in that variety and quantity which may approximately satisfy normal demands. Fortunately, the advance of science has been such that necessaries like vegetables, fruit, meats and milk are now preserved so that the chances of bacterial contamination are reduced to a minimum. A cold climate is an additional security towards the same end.

The topic of food needs careful thought and study. It’s assumed that a polar expedition has to bring all the food it needs in the right variety and amount to meet normal demands. Luckily, science has advanced to the point where essentials like vegetables, fruits, meats, and milk are now preserved in a way that minimizes the risk of bacterial contamination. Cold weather also provides extra protection in this regard.

Speaking generally, while living for months in an Antarctic hut, it is a splendid thing to have more than the mere necessaries of life. Since one is cut off from the ordinary amenities of social existence, it is particularly necessary that equipment and food should be of the very best; in some measure to replace a lack which sooner or later makes itself keenly felt. Explorers, after all, are only mortal.

Speaking generally, while living for months in an Antarctic hut, it’s fantastic to have more than just the basic necessities. Since you're isolated from the usual comforts of social life, it’s essential that your gear and food are top-notch; this somewhat helps make up for the absence that eventually becomes hard to ignore. After all, explorers are only human.

Luxuries, then, are good in moderation, and mainly for their psychological effect. After a spell of routine, a celebration is the natural sequel, and if there are delicacies which in civilization are more palatable than usual, why not take them to where they will receive a still fuller and heartier appreciation? There is a corresponding rise in the "tide of life" and the ennui of the same task, in the same place, in the same wind, is not so noticeable. So we did not forget our asparagus and jugged hare.

Luxuries are great in moderation, especially for their psychological benefits. After a period of routine, a celebration is a natural next step, and if there are treats in civilization that are tastier than usual, why not enjoy them where they will be even more appreciated? There’s a corresponding boost in the “tide of life,” and the boredom of doing the same task in the same place and under the same conditions isn’t as noticeable. So, we didn’t forget our asparagus and jugged hare.

In the matter of sledging foods, one comes down to a solid basis of dietetics. But even dietetics as a science has to stand aside when actual experience speaks. Dietetics deals with proteins, carbohydrates, fats, and calories: all terms which need definition and comprehension before the value of a sledging ration can be fundamentally understood. When the subject was first introduced into table conversation at the Hut, it was regarded somewhat suspiciously as "shop." But it gradually won interest simply because it was of such vital concern.

In talking about sledging foods, we get into a solid foundation of nutrition. However, even nutrition as a science has to take a back seat when real experience comes into play. Nutrition covers proteins, carbohydrates, fats, and calories—terms that need to be defined and understood before we can truly grasp the value of a sledging diet. When this topic was first brought up in conversation at the Hut, people viewed it a bit skeptically as "work talk." But it gradually captured interest simply because it was so important.

In sledging there is undoubtedly a critical allowance which will yield the best results. Circumstances alter cases, and the correct ration under one set of conditions cannot be expected to coincide with that in another situation. Thus, the journey may be conducted under conditions of great cold or of comparative warmth, by man-hauling or auxiliary power, at sea-level or on an altitude, through regions where there is a reasonable hope of securing additions of meat by the way, or across barren tracts devoid of game. In each instance particular demands must be supplied.

In sledging, there’s definitely a key allowance that will produce the best results. Conditions change everything, and the right ration for one situation won’t necessarily work for another. For example, the trip could take place in extreme cold or comfortable warmth, through man-hauling or using extra power, at sea level or at high altitude, in areas where there’s a good chance of picking up more meat along the way, or across desolate regions with no game. In each case, specific needs must be met.

In selecting the articles of diet, idiosyncrasies of individuals should be consulted in reason, and under no consideration should anything be taken which bears the slightest stigma of contamination. It remains, then, to discriminate those foods which contribute the greatest amount of nutriment for a given weight, and which, inter se, preserve a proper dietetic balance. Variety is very desirable, provided that there is no important sacrifice in nutrient value. The proof of a wisely selected ration is to find at the end of a long sledge journey that the sole craving is for an increase in the ration. Of course, such would be the ideal result of a perfect ration, which does not exist.

When choosing foods, it's important to consider individual preferences and avoid anything that seems contaminated. The goal is to identify the foods that offer the most nutrition for their weight and that maintain a balanced diet among themselves. Variety is good, as long as it doesn't significantly reduce the nutritional value. A well-chosen diet would show that after a long sledding trip, the only desire is for a larger portion of food. Naturally, this would be the ideal outcome of a perfect diet, which doesn't really exist.

Considering that an ordinary individual in civilization may only satisfy the choice demands of his appetite by selecting from the multifarious bill of fare of a modern restaurant, it will be evident that the same person, though already on the restricted diet of an explorer, cannot be suddenly subjected to a sledging ration for any considerable period without a certain exercise of discipline.

Considering that an everyday person in society can only fulfill their appetite's demands by choosing from the diverse menu at a modern restaurant, it's clear that the same person, even if they’re already on the limited diet of an explorer, can't suddenly be put on a sledging ration for an extended time without a degree of self-discipline.

For example, the Eastern Coastal Party, sledging at fairly high temperatures over the sea-ice, noted that the full ration of hoosh produced at times a mild indigestion, they drank much liquid to satisfy an intense thirst and on returning to the Hut found their appetites inclined to tinned fruit and penguins' eggs. Bickerton's and Bage's parties, though working at a much higher altitude, had a similar experience. The former, for instance, could not at first drink the whole allowance of thick, rich cocoa without a slight nausea. The latter saved rations during the first two weeks of their journey, and only when they rose to greater heights and were in fine condition did they appreciate the ration to the full. Again, even when one becomes used to the ration, the sensation of full satisfaction does not last for more than an hour. The imagination reaches forward to the next meal, perhaps partly on account of the fact that marching is often monotonous and the scenery uninspiring. Still, even after a good evening hoosh, the subconscious self may assert itself in food-dreams. The reaction from even a short sledging trip, where food has been plentiful, is to eat a good deal, astonishing in amount to those who for the time being have lived at the Hut.

For example, the Eastern Coastal Party, sledding in fairly warm temperatures over the sea ice, found that the full ration of hoosh sometimes caused mild indigestion. They drank a lot of liquids to quench an intense thirst, and upon returning to the Hut, they craved tinned fruit and penguin eggs. Bickerton's and Bage's groups, even though they were working at a much higher altitude, had similar experiences. For instance, the former couldn’t initially drink their entire allowance of rich, thick cocoa without feeling a little nauseous. The latter saved their rations during the first two weeks of their journey and only when they reached higher altitudes and were in better condition did they fully appreciate their rations. Moreover, even after getting used to the rations, the feeling of complete satisfaction lasts for no more than an hour. People start looking forward to the next meal, maybe partly because marching can often feel monotonous and the scenery isn't inspiring. Still, even after a good evening hoosh, the subconscious can trigger food cravings in dreams. The reaction after even a short sledding trip, where food has been abundant, is to eat a surprising amount, especially for those who have been living at the Hut.

It may appear that a serious case is being made against the polar sledging ration. On the whole, it was found to be excellent and the best that experience had been able to devise. Entering the polar zones, one must not be over-fastidious, but take it as a matter of course that there will be self-denial and deprivation of small luxuries.

It might seem like there’s a strong argument against the polar sledging ration. Overall, it turned out to be excellent and the best that experience could come up with. When you enter the polar regions, you can’t be too picky; you have to accept that self-denial and giving up small luxuries are just part of the experience.

The energy exerted by man, and the requirements of tissue-building are derived from the organic compounds known as proteins,** fats and carbohydrates, though in a slight degree from other substances, most important of which are minute quantities of mineral matter.

The energy used by humans and the needs for building tissue come from organic compounds called proteins, fats, and carbohydrates, though to a lesser extent from other substances, the most important of which are small amounts of minerals.

A calorie as used in dietetics is the amount of heat required to raise the temperature of one kilogramme of water at 0 degrees C. to 1 degree C. The heat-value of food-stuffs, stated in calories, can be quickly reckoned when chemical analyses stating their protein, fat and carbohydrate contents are available. It has been ascertained that one gramme of protein or carbohydrate yields 4.1 calories, whilst the same amount of fat produces 9.3 calories. Thus the value of fat-containing foods in a sledging ration is at once apparent.

A calorie, in the context of nutrition, is the amount of heat needed to raise the temperature of one kilogram of water from 0 degrees Celsius to 1 degree Celsius. The heat value of foods, expressed in calories, can be quickly calculated when chemical analyses of their protein, fat, and carbohydrate contents are available. It has been found that one gram of protein or carbohydrate provides 4.1 calories, while the same amount of fat gives 9.3 calories. Therefore, the importance of fat-containing foods in a survival ration is clear.

     ** The proteins are complex nitrogenous compounds which are preeminent
in fulfilling the two functions of a food: to form tissue and to produce
work and heat. As examples may be quoted, myosin the chief protein of
ordinary meat or muscle, ovalbumin one of the proteins of egg-white,
casein belonging to milk and cheese, and gluten a protein-mixture in
flour.
** The proteins are complex nitrogen-containing compounds that are essential for two main functions of food: building tissue and generating energy and heat. For example, myosin is the primary protein found in regular meat or muscle, ovalbumin is a protein found in egg white, casein is present in milk and cheese, and gluten is a protein mixture found in flour.

Fats are organic non-nitrogenous substances obtained from both animal and vegetable sources, e.g. butter and olive oil.

Fats are organic substances that lack nitrogen, and they come from both animal and plant sources, like butter and olive oil.

The carbohydrates are compounds of carbon with hydrogen and oxygen in a certain proportion, e.g. cane-sugar and starch.

The carbohydrates are compounds made of carbon, hydrogen, and oxygen in a specific ratio, like cane sugar and starch.

Mineral matters are inorganic, being chlorides, carbonates or phosphates of calcium, sodium and potassium.

Mineral substances are inorganic, consisting of chlorides, carbonates, or phosphates of calcium, sodium, and potassium.

Theoretically, any of the three classes of foods mentioned might be thought to supply adequate energy, if taken in sufficient amount. Practically, however, protein and carbohydrate are essential, and it is better to have a mixture of all three. So, in concentrating foods for sledging, the largest possible proportion of fat, compatible with other considerations, is included.

Theoretically, any of the three food categories mentioned could provide enough energy if consumed in large enough quantities. However, in practice, protein and carbohydrates are essential, and it's preferable to have a mix of all three. Therefore, when preparing food for sledging, the goal is to include the largest possible amount of fat that works with other factors.

Ordinarily, a normal man consumes some four or five pounds weight of solid food per diem, of which 50 per cent., it is rather surprising to learn, is water. When sledging, one has the satisfaction of knowing that all but the smallest quantity of the food dragged is solid nutriment. The water is added when the meals are cooked. It is just in this artificial addition that the sledging ration is not perfect, though as a synthesis it satisfies the demands of dietetics. Food containing water, as cooked meat oozing with its own gravy is a more palatable thing than dried meat-powder to which boiling water has been added. In the same way, a dry, hard biscuit plus liquid is a different thing from a spongy loaf of yeast bread with its high percentage of water. One must reckon with the psychic factor in eating. When sledging, one does not look for food well served as long as the food is hot, nourishing and filling. So the usage of weeks and a wolfish appetite make hoosh a most delicious preparation; but when the days of an enforced ration are over, the desire for appetizing well-served food reasserts itself. The body refuses to be treated merely as an engine.

Typically, a normal person eats about four or five pounds of solid food each day, and surprisingly, around 50 percent of that is water. When sledding, you can take comfort in knowing that almost all of the food being carried is solid nutrition. The water gets added when the meals are cooked. This artificial addition is what makes the sledding ration imperfect, although it meets dietary needs overall. Food that contains water, like cooked meat dripping with its own juice, is much more enjoyable than dried meat powder that has boiling water mixed in. Similarly, a dry, hard biscuit with liquid is not the same as a soft loaf of yeast bread with high water content. You have to consider the psychological aspect of eating too. When sledding, you’re not concerned about how the food is presented as long as it’s hot, nutritious, and filling. After weeks of this, a hearty appetite makes “hoosh” a delicious dish; however, once the days of limited rations end, the craving for appetizing, well-prepared food comes back. The body won’t just be treated like a machine.

The daily polar sledging ration for one man has been concentrated to a figure just above two pounds in weight, For instance, in recent Antarctic expeditions, Scott, in 1903, used 34.7 ozs., Shackleton in 1908 used 34.82 ozs. and our own amounted to 34.25 ozs. Exclusive of tea, pepper and salt, Shackleton's ration and that adopted by Wild at the Western Base and ourselves in Adelie Land were identical—34 ozs. Reverting to earlier explorers, for the sake of comparisons, McClintock in 1850 brought his minimum down to 42 ozs., Nares in 1875 to 40 ozs., Greely in 1882 to 41.75 ozs., and Abruzzi in 1900 to 43.5 ozs.

The daily sledge ration for one person in the polar regions has been set to just over two pounds. For example, during recent Antarctic expeditions, Scott in 1903 used 34.7 ounces, Shackleton in 1908 used 34.82 ounces, and our team had a ration of 34.25 ounces. Excluding tea, pepper, and salt, Shackleton's ration and the ones used by Wild at the Western Base and our team in Adelie Land were the same—34 ounces. Looking back at earlier explorers for comparison, McClintock in 1850 reduced his minimum to 42 ounces, Nares in 1875 to 40 ounces, Greely in 1882 to 41.75 ounces, and Abruzzi in 1900 to 43.5 ounces.

Our allowance was made up as follows, the relative amounts in the daily sledging ration for one man being stated: plasmon biscuit, 12 ozs.; pemmican, 8 ozs.; butter, 2 ozs.; plasmon chocolate, 2 ozs.; glaxo (dried milk), 5 ozs.; sugar, 4 ozs.; cocoa, 1 oz.; tea,.25 oz. It will be instructive to make a short note on each item.

Our allowance was made up as follows, with the daily sledging ration for one person being: plasmon biscuit, 12 oz; pemmican, 8 oz; butter, 2 oz; plasmon chocolate, 2 oz; glaxo (dried milk), 5 oz; sugar, 4 oz; cocoa, 1 oz; tea, 0.25 oz. It will be useful to note a brief description of each item.

Plasmon biscuit was made of the best flour mixed with 30 per cent. of plasmon powder. Each biscuit weighed 2.25 ozs., and was made specially thick and hard to resist shaking and bumping in transit as well as the rough usage of a sledging journey. The effect of the high percentage of plasmon, apart from its nutritive value, was to impart additional toughness to the biscuit, which tested our teeth so severely that we should have preferred something less like a geological specimen and more like ordinary "hard tack," The favourite method of dealing with these biscuits was to smash them with an ice-axe or nibble them into small pieces and treat the fragments for a while to the solvent action of hot cocoa. Two important proteins were present in this food: plasmon, a trade-name for casein, the chief protein of milk, and gluten, a mixture of proteins in flour.

Plasmon biscuits were made from the finest flour mixed with 30 percent plasmon powder. Each biscuit weighed 2.25 ounces and was designed to be thick and hard to withstand shaking and bumps during transport, as well as the rough treatment of a sledging journey. The high percentage of plasmon, in addition to its nutritional benefits, also made the biscuit extra tough, testing our teeth to the point where we would have preferred something less like a geological specimen and more like regular "hard tack." The favorite way to handle these biscuits was to smash them with an ice axe or nibble them into small pieces and let the fragments soak in hot cocoa for a while. This food contained two important proteins: plasmon, a trademark for casein, the main protein in milk, and gluten, a mix of proteins found in flour.

The pemmican we used consisted of powdered dried beef (containing the important protein, myosin) and 50 per cent. of pure fat in the form of lard. The large content of fat contributes to its high caloric value, so that it is regularly included in sledging diets. Hoosh is a stodgy, porridge-like mixture of pemmican, dried biscuit and water, brought to the boil and served hot. Some men prefer it cooler and more dilute, and to this end dig up snow from the floor of the tent with their spoons, and mix it in until the hoosh is "to taste," Eating hoosh is a heightened form of bliss which no sledger can ever forget.

The pemmican we used was made of powdered dried beef (which has the important protein, myosin) and 50 percent pure fat in the form of lard. The high fat content gives it a lot of calories, so it's often included in sledging diets. Hoosh is a thick, porridge-like mix of pemmican, dried biscuits, and water, cooked until it boils and served hot. Some guys like it cooler and thinner, so they scoop up snow from the tent floor with their spoons and mix it in until the hoosh is “to taste.” Eating hoosh is a memorable treat that no sledger can forget.

Glaxo is a proprietary food preparation of dried milk, manufactured in New Zealand. It is without doubt an ideal food for any climate where concentration is desirable and asepsis cannot be neglected. The value of milk as an all-round food is well known. It contains protein as casein, fat as cream and in fine globules, carbohydrate as lactose (milk sugar) and mineral substances whose importance is becoming more recognized. At the Western Base, Wild's party invented glaxo biscuits; an unbaked mixture of flour and dried milk, which were in themselves a big inducement to go sledging. At the Hut, making milk from the dried powder required some little experience. Cold water was added to the dried powder, a paste was made and warm or hot water poured in until the milk was at the required strength. One of the professional "touches" was to aerate the milk, after mixing, by pouring it from jug to jug.

Glaxo is a specialized food product made from dried milk, produced in New Zealand. It's definitely a perfect food for any climate where high concentration is important and sanitation can't be overlooked. The benefits of milk as a versatile food are widely acknowledged. It has protein in the form of casein, fat as cream in fine droplets, carbohydrates as lactose (milk sugar), and mineral substances that are becoming increasingly recognized for their importance. At the Western Base, Wild's team created Glaxo biscuits; an unbaked mix of flour and dried milk, which were a major incentive for going sledging. At the Hut, making milk from the dried powder took a bit of experience. Cold water was added to the dried powder to create a paste, and warm or hot water was poured in until the milk reached the desired consistency. One professional tip was to aerate the milk after mixing by transferring it from one jug to another.

Butter, although it contains nearly 20 per cent. of water is a food of high heat-value and is certainly more easily digested than fat, such as dripping, with a higher melting-point. Ours was fresh Victorian butter, packed in the ordinary export boxes, and carried to the Antarctic on the open bridge of the Aurora. With a sheath-knife, the sledging cook cut off three small chunks of two ounces each from the frozen butter every day at lunch. To show how the appetite is affected by extreme cold, one feels that butter is a wholesome thing just in itself, being more inclined to eat a pound than two ounces.

Butter, even though it has nearly 20 percent water, is a high-calorie food and is definitely easier to digest than fat, like dripping, which has a higher melting point. Ours was fresh Victorian butter, packed in standard export boxes, and transported to the Antarctic on the open bridge of the Aurora. Every day at lunch, the sledging cook used a sheath knife to cut off three small chunks of two ounces each from the frozen butter. To illustrate how extreme cold affects appetite, one tends to think of butter as a nourishing food on its own, feeling more inclined to eat a pound than just two ounces.

Sugar—the carbohydrate, sucrose—has special qualities as a food since it is quickly assimilated, imparting within a few minutes fresh energy for muscular exertion. Athletes will support this; in fact, a strong solution of sugar in water is used as a stimulant in long-distance running and other feats of endurance. Wild, for instance, found as a matter of experience that chocolate was preferable to cheese as a sledging food, even though similar weights had approximately the same food-value.

Sugar—the carbohydrate, sucrose—has unique qualities as a food because it’s quickly absorbed, providing fresh energy for physical activity within minutes. Athletes can attest to this; in fact, a strong sugar solution in water is used as a booster in long-distance running and other endurance activities. For example, Wild discovered through experience that chocolate was better than cheese as food for sledding, even though similar weights had roughly the same nutritional value.

Cocoa and tea were the two sledging beverages. The cocoa was used for two meals, the first and the last in the day, and the tea for lunch. Both contain stimulating alkaloids, theobromine and caffeine, and fat is a notable constituent of cocoa. Of course, their chief nourishing value, as far as we were concerned, lay in the glaxo and sugar added.

Cocoa and tea were the two main drinks. Cocoa was consumed for breakfast and dinner, while tea was used for lunch. Both drinks contain stimulating alkaloids, theobromine and caffeine, and cocoa has a significant amount of fat. Of course, the main nutritional benefit for us came from the added milk and sugar.

Lastly, plasmon chocolate is a preparation of pure chocolate (a mixture of ground cocoa, white sugar and starch) with the addition of 10 per cent. of plasmon.

Lastly, plasmon chocolate is a mixture of pure chocolate (comprised of ground cocoa, white sugar, and starch) with 10 percent plasmon added.

As food for the dogs, there was nothing better than dried seal-steaks with the addition of a little blubber. Ordinary pemmican is readily eaten, but not appreciated by the dogs in the same way as seal meat. To save weight, the meat was dried over the stove without heating it sufficiently to cook it. By this measure, almost 50 per cent. in weight was saved.

As dog food, nothing beat dried seal steaks with a bit of blubber added. Regular pemmican was eaten, but the dogs didn't enjoy it as much as seal meat. To save weight, the meat was dried over the stove without cooking it fully. This approach saved almost 50 percent in weight.

The Hut was all agog with movement and bustle on the days when rations were being made up and packed. Starting from the earliest stage in the process, there would be two men in the outer Hut grinding plasmon biscuit into powder. One would turn away for dear life and the other smash the biscuit with a hammer on a metal slab and feed continuously into the grinder. The atmosphere would be full of the nauseous vapours of blubber arising from dishes on the stove where seal meat was drying for the dogs. Ninnis and Mertz superintended in this department, in careless moments allowing the blubber to frizzle and diffuse its aroma through the Hut.

The Hut was buzzing with activity on the days when rations were being prepared and packed. Right from the start, there were two men outside, grinding plasmon biscuits into powder. One would look away while the other smashed the biscuits with a hammer on a metal slab and continuously fed them into the grinder. The air was thick with the unpleasant fumes of blubber coming from pots on the stove where seal meat was drying for the dogs. Ninnis and Mertz oversaw this area, occasionally letting the blubber sizzle and spread its smell throughout the Hut.

Inside, spread along the eighteen-foot table would be the weighers, the bag-makers or machinists, and the packers. The first made up a compound of cocoa, glaxo and sugar—cocoa compound; mixed glaxo and sugar and stirred together, pemmican and biscuit—pemmican compound. These were weighed and run into calico bags, rapidly supplied by several machinists farther along the table. In spare moments the weighers stowed chocolate, whole biscuits, butter and tea into 190 sacks of various sizes. Lastly, the packers had strong canvas tanks, as they were called, designed to hold food for a week and a fortnight respectively. Into these the rations were carefully distributed, butter in the centre, whole biscuits near the top. Then the tanks were tightly closed, and one man operated with palm and sail-needle, sewing them up with twine. At the same time, a side-line was run in pemmican which was removed semi-frozen from the air-tight tins, and shaved into small pieces with a strong sheath-knife. Butter, too, arrived from the refrigerator-store and was subdivided into two-ounce or pound lumps.

Inside, spread across the eighteen-foot table were the weighers, bag-makers or machinists, and packers. The weighers mixed cocoa, Glaxo, and sugar to create a cocoa compound; then they combined Glaxo and sugar and stirred in pemmican and biscuits to make a pemmican compound. These mixtures were weighed and placed into calico bags, which were quickly supplied by several machinists further down the table. During downtime, the weighers packed chocolate, whole biscuits, butter, and tea into 190 sacks of various sizes. Finally, the packers had sturdy canvas tanks designed to hold food for a week and a fortnight, respectively. The rations were carefully organized into these tanks, with butter in the center and whole biscuits near the top. The tanks were then tightly sealed, and one person sewed them shut with twine using a palm and sail needle. Meanwhile, a side line was processing pemmican, which was taken semi-frozen from airtight tins and sliced into small pieces with a strong sheath knife. Butter also came from the refrigerator store and was divided into two-ounce or pound chunks.

Meanwhile, other occupations were in full swing. An amateur cobbler, his crampon on a last, studded its spiked surface with clouts, hammering away in complete disregard of the night-watchman's uneasy slumbers. The big sewing-machine raced at top-speed round the flounce of a tent, and in odd corners among the bunks were groups mending mitts, strengthening sleeping-bags and patching burberrys. The cartographer at his table beneath a shaded acetylene light drew maps and sketched, the magnetician was busy on calculations close by. The cook and messman often made their presence felt and heard. In the outer Hut, the lathe spun round, its whirr and click drowned in the noisy rasp of the grinder and the blast of the big blow-lamp. The last-named, Bickerton, "bus-driver" and air-tractor expert, had converted, with the aid of a few pieces of covering tin, into a forge. A piece of red-hot metal was lifted out and thrust into the vice; Hannam was striker and Bickerton holder. General conversation was conducted in shouts, Hannam's being easily predominant.

Meanwhile, other jobs were in full swing. An amateur cobbler, with his crampon on a last, was hammering away, adding clouts to its spiked surface, completely ignoring the uneasy slumbers of the night-watchman. The big sewing machine was racing at full speed around the flounce of a tent, and in various corners among the bunks, groups were mending mitts, reinforcing sleeping bags, and patching up burberrys. The cartographer at his table under a shaded acetylene light was drawing maps and sketching, while the magnetician was busy with calculations nearby. The cook and messman often made their presence felt and heard. In the outer hut, the lathe was spinning, its whirr and click drowned out by the noisy rasp of the grinder and the blast of the large blow-lamp. The last one, Bickerton, a "bus-driver" and air-tractor expert, had turned, with a few pieces of covering tin, into a makeshift forge. A piece of red-hot metal was lifted out and thrust into the vice; Hannam was the striker and Bickerton was the holder. General conversation was conducted in loud shouts, with Hannam's voice being the most dominant.

The sum total of sounds was sufficient for a while to make every one oblivious to the clamour of the restless wind.

The overall noise was enough for a time to make everyone unaware of the roaring, restless wind.





CHAPTER XI SPRING EXPLOITS

If the "winter calms" were a delusion, there were at least several beautifully clear, moderately calm days in June. The expectation of colder weather had been realized, and by the end of the month it was a perceptible fact that the sun had definitely turned, describing a longer arc when skimming the distant fleets of bergs along the northern horizon. Thus on June 28 the refracted image of the sun rose into visibility about eleven o'clock, heralded by a vivid green sky and damask cloud and by one o'clock had disappeared.

If the "winter calms" were just an illusion, there were at least several beautifully clear, moderately calm days in June. The anticipated colder weather had arrived, and by the end of the month, it was clear that the sun had definitely shifted, taking a longer path as it glided above the distant fleets of icebergs on the northern horizon. So, on June 28, the refraction of the sun became visible around eleven o'clock, announced by a bright green sky and rosy clouds, and by one o'clock, it was gone.

On the same day every one was abroad, advancing the wireless masts another stage and digging ice-shafts. Stillwell commenced a contoured plane-table survey of the neighbourhood of Winter Quarters. He continued this with many breaks during the next few months and eventually completed an accurate and valuable map, undeterred by the usual series of frost-bites.

On the same day, everyone was out improving the wireless masts and digging ice shafts. Stillwell started a detailed plane-table survey of the area around Winter Quarters. He kept doing this with several breaks over the next few months and eventually finished an accurate and valuable map, despite the usual round of frostbite.

There was much anticipated of July, but the wind soughed on and the temperature decreased. Just to demonstrate its resource, the wind maintained ninety-seven miles per hour for six hours on July 19, while the puff-anemometer indicated several "breaks" of one hundred and fifty miles per hour.

There was a lot of excitement for July, but the wind howled on, and the temperature dropped. To showcase its power, the wind sustained speeds of ninety-seven miles per hour for six hours on July 19, while the puff-anemometer recorded several peaks of one hundred and fifty miles per hour.

July 21 was cold, calm and clear. For the first time after many weeks the sun was mildly warm, and all felt with a spring of optimism that a new era had begun. The sea which had been kept open by the wind was immediately overspread with thin, dark ice, which in a few hours was dotted with many ice-flowers aggregates of fern-like, sprouting fronds similar to small bouquets or rosettes. Soon the surface had whitened and thickened and by next morning was firm enough to hold a man out beyond the nearest island. The wind did not allow this state of affairs to last for long, for by lunch-time it had hurried away the wide floes and raged across a foaming sea.

July 21 was cold, calm, and clear. For the first time in weeks, the sun felt pleasantly warm, and everyone sensed a wave of optimism that a new era had begun. The sea, which had been kept open by the wind, quickly became covered with thin, dark ice, which in a few hours was dotted with many ice flowers—clusters of fern-like, sprouting fronds that resembled small bouquets or rosettes. Soon, the surface had turned white and thickened, and by the next morning, it was solid enough to support a person beyond the nearest island. However, the wind didn’t let this situation last long; by lunchtime, it had swept away the large ice floes and whipped across a churning sea.

We still considered the question of sledging, and I decided that if there were the slightest prospect of accomplishing anything, several of us would start before the end of July on a short journey. The month, however, closed with nothing to commend it. The night-watchman for July 29 says:

We kept thinking about the idea of sleighing, and I decided that if there was even a small chance of achieving something, a few of us would set off on a short trip before the end of July. However, the month ended without anything promising. The night-watchman for July 29 says:

"The moon was wonderfully bright to-night, encircled by a complete halo. It appeared to hang suspended like a silver globe in the dark blue sky. The stars flash and sparkle and seem much nearer here than in Australia. At midnight the wind blew at ninety miles per hour, so that it was no easy job getting to the screen in slippery finnesko. Away in the north there was a dense cloud of spray and sea-smoke, and the wind screamed past the Hut. The 'St. Elmoscope' was buzzing merrily in the roof all the time."

"The moon was incredibly bright tonight, surrounded by a full halo. It looked like a silver globe hanging in the dark blue sky. The stars flash and sparkle, appearing much closer here than in Australia. At midnight, the wind gusted at ninety miles per hour, making it difficult to reach the screen in slippery overshoes. Far to the north, there was a thick cloud of spray and sea smoke, and the wind howled past the Hut. The 'St. Elmoscope' was buzzing happily on the roof the whole time."

Ninnis and Mertz with a team of dogs managed, on the morning of the 29th, to get several loads of forty pounds over the first steep rise of the glacier to Webb's magnetic ice-cave against a "blow" of seventy miles per hour.

Ninnis and Mertz, along with a team of dogs, managed on the morning of the 29th to haul several loads of forty pounds over the first steep slope of the glacier to Webb's magnetic ice cave, despite a wind gusting at seventy miles per hour.

August 1 was marked by a hurricane, and the celebration in the evening of Swiss Confederation Day. Mertz was the hero of the occasion as well as cook and master of ceremonies. From a mysterious box he produced all kinds of quaint conserves, and the menu soared to unknown delicacies like "Potage a la Suisse, Choucroute garnie aux saucission de Berne, Puree de foie gras trufee, and Leckerley de Bale." Hanging above the buoyant assembly were the Cross of Helvetia and the Jack of Britannia.

August 1 was marked by a hurricane and the evening celebration of Swiss Confederation Day. Mertz was the hero of the event, as well as the cook and master of ceremonies. From a mysterious box, he brought out all sorts of unique preserves, and the menu featured unknown delicacies like "Swiss Potage, Choucroute garnie with Berne sausages, Truffle foie gras puree, and Basel Leckerley." Hanging above the lively gathering were the Cross of Helvetia and the Jack of Britannia.

It was not till August 8 that there was any indication of improvement. The sun was bright, the barometer was steady, the wind fell to forty miles an hour and a fine radiant of cirrus cloud spread out fan-like from the north; the first from that direction for months.

It wasn't until August 8 that there was any sign of improvement. The sun was shining bright, the barometer was stable, the wind dropped to forty miles an hour, and a nice spread of cirrus clouds fanned out from the north; the first ones from that direction in months.

On the afternoon of August 9, Ninnis, Madigan and I set off with a team of dogs against a forty-mile wind in an attempt to push to the south. Darkness was coming on when we sighted a bamboo pole, three and a quarter miles south of the Hut, and camped. The dogs pulled well up the steep slopes, but the feet of several were cut by the sharp edges of the wind-worn ice.

On the afternoon of August 9, Ninnis, Madigan, and I headed out with a team of dogs battling a forty-mile wind as we tried to move south. It was getting dark when we spotted a bamboo pole, three and a quarter miles south of the Hut, where we set up camp. The dogs did great on the steep hills, but a few of them got cuts on their paws from the sharp edges of the wind-blown ice.

Very heavy gusts swept by in the early morning hours of the 10th. and when the time came to get out of our sleeping-bags it fell calm for a short space. We had taken down the tent and had started to move away, when back rushed the wind, strong and steady. Still we pushed on with our willing team and by a piece of good fortune reached the sledge which had been abandoned in the autumn, five and a half miles from the Hut, and of whose fate in the winter's hurricanes we had made all kind of conjectures.

Very strong gusts came through in the early morning hours of the 10th. When it was time to get out of our sleeping bags, the wind calmed down for a short while. We had taken down the tent and started to pack up when the wind came rushing back, strong and steady. Still, we pressed on with our eager team, and by some good luck, we reached the sled that had been left behind in the autumn, five and a half miles from the Hut, and we had speculated about what happened to it during the winter storms.

On its leeward side there was a ramp of very hard snow slanting down from the top of the sledge. To windward the low pedestal of ice on which the runners stood was hollowed out, and the wood of the rails and cross-bars, the leather straps, tent, floor-cloth and canvas food-tanks were all bleached and worn. The aluminium cooker, strapped on its box, was brightly polished on the weather side by the dry, drifting snow impelled by the furious winds. A thermograph, left behind in the autumn, was found to be intact and indicated a temperature of -35 degrees F.—the lowest for the eight days during which it had run. The remains of Madigan's plum-pudding of the autumn were unearthed and found in splendid condition. That evening it was thawed out over the primus and we demolished it, after a pause of over five months since having the first cut.

On its sheltered side, there was a slope of very hard snow slanting down from the top of the sled. On the windward side, the low ice pedestal where the runners rested was hollowed out, and the wood of the rails and cross-bars, along with the leather straps, tent, floor cloth, and canvas food containers were all bleached and worn. The aluminum cooker, strapped to its box, was shiny on the side facing the weather due to the dry, drifting snow blown by the fierce winds. A thermograph, left behind in the fall, was found to be intact and showed a temperature of -35 degrees F.—the lowest for the eight days it had been operating. The remains of Madigan's autumn plum pudding were uncovered and found to be in excellent condition. That evening, it was thawed out over the primus, and we devoured it after a break of over five months since the last slice.

At this spot the steepest grades of the ascent to the plateau were left behind, and it appeared to be a strategic point from which to extend our sledging efforts. The main difficulty was that of pitching camp in the prevailing winds on a surface of ice. To obviate this, the only expedient was to excavate a shelter beneath the ice itself; and there was the further consideration that all sledging parties would be able to make use of such a haven and save extra wear on their tents.

At this point, the steepest sections of the climb to the plateau were behind us, and it seemed like a key spot to continue our sledding efforts. The main challenge was setting up camp in the strong winds on an icy surface. To solve this, the best option was to dig a shelter under the ice itself; additionally, all sledding teams could use this refuge, which would help reduce wear and tear on their tents.

On the morning of August 11 Madigan and Ninnis commenced to sink a deep vertical trench, at one end of which a room was hewn out large enough to accommodate three men. The job was finished on the following day, and we struck the tent and moved to our new abode. The tent was spread over the vertical shaft which served as the entrance.

On the morning of August 11, Madigan and Ninnis started digging a deep vertical trench. At one end, they carved out a room spacious enough for three men. They completed the job the next day, and we took down the tent and moved to our new home. The tent was set up over the vertical shaft that served as the entrance.

It was a great relief to be in a strong room, with solid walls of ice, in place of the cramped tent flapping violently in the wind. Inside, the silence was profound; the blizzard was banished. Aladdin's Cave it was dubbed—a truly magical world of glassy facets and scintillating crystals.

It was such a relief to be in a strong room, with solid ice walls, instead of the cramped tent that was flapping wildly in the wind. Inside, the silence was deep; the blizzard was kept outside. It was called Aladdin's Cave—a truly magical place filled with shiny surfaces and sparkling crystals.

Shelves were chipped out at a moment's notice for primus stove, spirit bottle, matches, kerosene and other oddments. At one side a small hole was cut to communicate with a narrow fissure which provided ventilation without allowing the entrance of drift snow. Whatever daylight there was filtered through the roof and walls without hindrance. A small crevasse opened near at hand and was a natural receptacle for rubbish. The purest ice for cooking could be immediately hacked from the walls without the inconvenience of having to don one's burberrys and go outside for it. Finally, one neatly disposed of spare clothes by moistening the corner of each garment and pressing it against the wall for a few seconds, where it would remain hanging until required. The place, in fact, was simply replete with conveniences. We thoroughly enjoyed the night's rest in Aladdin's Cave, notwithstanding alarming cracks proceeding occasionally from the crevasses around.

Shelves were quickly made for the primus stove, spirit bottle, matches, kerosene, and other random items. A small hole was cut on one side to connect with a narrow crack that provided ventilation without letting in the drifting snow. Any daylight that managed to come in filtered through the roof and walls freely. A small crevasse nearby served as a natural spot for trash. The purest ice for cooking could be easily hacked off the walls without the hassle of putting on one’s coat and going outside for it. Finally, spare clothes were neatly stored by dampening the corner of each garment and pressing it against the wall for a few seconds, where they'd hang until needed. The place was truly filled with conveniences. We thoroughly enjoyed our night’s rest in Aladdin's Cave, despite the occasional alarming cracks coming from the crevasses around us.

Madigan and Ninnis dug a shelter for the dogs, which spent their time curled up so as to expose as little surface as possible to the biting wind. Their thick coats did not adhere to a snow surface, but readily became frozen down to ice, so that an ice-axe would have to be used to chip them free.

Madigan and Ninnis built a shelter for the dogs, who curled up to minimize the surface area exposed to the biting wind. Their thick coats didn’t stick to the snow but easily froze solid, requiring an ice axe to chip them free.

On August 13, though there was a steady, strong wind blowing, we continued our advance to the south. The dogs hated to face wind, but, on the whole, did better than expected. In the afternoon, when only eight miles south of Winter Quarters and at an altitude of two thousand feet, dark and lowering clouds formed overhead, and I decided to give up any idea of going farther out, for the time being. We had provisions for a few days only, and there was every indication of thick, drifting weather, during which, in the crevassed ice of that vicinity, it would not be advisable to travel.

On August 13, even with a strong, steady wind blowing, we kept making our way south. The dogs really disliked facing the wind, but overall, they handled it better than we expected. In the afternoon, just eight miles south of Winter Quarters and at an elevation of two thousand feet, dark and ominous clouds gathered above us, and I decided to abandon any thoughts of going further for now. We only had enough supplies for a few days, and everything suggested that we’d be dealing with thick, drifting weather, which wouldn’t be safe for traveling over the crevassed ice in that area.

After depoting a pick, shovel and some pemmican, we started back, thinking it might be possible to reach the Hut the same night. However, driven by a strong wind over a polished, slippery surface split into small crevasses, down a grade which steepened quickly, we required to have all our senses vigilant. Two of the dogs remained in harness and the rest were allowed to run loose ahead. These two strained every effort to catch up to their companions.

After dropping off a pick, shovel, and some pemmican, we headed back, hoping we could reach the Hut that same night. However, with a strong wind pushing us over a smooth, slippery surface that was cracked with small crevasses and down a steep slope that dipped quickly, we needed to stay alert. Two of the dogs stayed in harness while the others were let loose to run ahead. The two dogs worked hard to catch up with their teammates.

We retarded the sledge as much as possible and all went well for a few minutes. Then the wind slewed the sledge, the runners struck an irregularity in the surface and the whole capsized. This happened repeatedly, until there was nothing to do but loose the two remaining dogs and drag the sledge ourselves. The dogs were soon lost to sight, except Pavlova, who remained with us all the time. As the hours of light were short in August, darkness had come before Aladdin's Cave was reached, and it was with some relief that we saw the sledge, flag-pole and the expectant dogs suddenly loom up in front. The sleeping-bags and other gear were passed down into the Cave and the dogs were fed.

We slowed the sledge down as much as we could, and everything went smoothly for a few minutes. Then the wind shifted the sledge, the runners hit a bump in the surface, and the whole thing tipped over. This happened over and over until we had no choice but to let the last two dogs loose and pull the sledge ourselves. The dogs quickly disappeared from view, except for Pavlova, who stayed with us the whole time. Since the days were short in August, darkness fell before we reached Aladdin's Cave, and we felt a sense of relief when we suddenly spotted the sledge, the flagpole, and the eager dogs ahead of us. We passed the sleeping bags and other gear into the Cave and fed the dogs.

When the doorway was opened in the morning, August 14, a blizzard with dense drifting snow was in full progress. As it was not possible to see any distance, and as our quarters were very comfortable, we decided to wait for another day. Madigan and Ninnis went out and fed the dogs, who were all snugly curled up in beds of snow.

When the door was opened in the morning on August 14, a blizzard with heavy, drifting snow was underway. Since visibility was low and our accommodations were quite comfortable, we decided to wait another day. Madigan and Ninnis went out and fed the dogs, who were all cozily curled up in their snow beds.

The weather was no better on the 15th, but, as we were only five and a half miles from the Hut, which was more comfortable and where there was much work to be done, it seemed a shame to remain cooped up in idleness. Madigan and Ninnis were both strongly in favour of making a dash for the Hut, so we set off.

The weather was still crappy on the 15th, but since we were only five and a half miles from the Hut, which was way more comfortable and had a lot of work to get done, it felt like a waste to just sit around. Madigan and Ninnis were both really in favor of making a run for the Hut, so we headed out.

The sledge having been dug out, one man went in front to keep the course and two men brought up the rear, holding back the load. With long-spiked Swiss crampons we could hold up very well on the ice. In dense drift it was not a simple matter to steer a correct course for the Hut and it was essential not to deviate, as the rocky foreshores near which it stood extended only for a mile east and west; on either side abutting on vertical ice-cliffs. With a compelling force like a prance at our backs, it was not a nice thing to contemplate finding ourselves on the brink of a precipice.

The sled had been dug out, and one man went ahead to keep us on track while two others held back the load from behind. With long-spiked Swiss crampons, we could grip the ice pretty well. In the thick snow drift, it wasn't easy to navigate directly to the Hut, and it was crucial not to stray off course since the rocky shores it was near only stretched a mile to the east and west, with sheer ice cliffs on either side. With a strong urge pushing us from behind, it wasn’t comforting to think about possibly ending up at the edge of a cliff.

The wind, however, was steady, and we knew at what angle to steer to keep a rough course; and we were also helped by a number of small crevasses between three and five and a half miles which ran approximately north and south.

The wind was steady, and we knew the right angle to steer to maintain a rough course; we were also aided by several small crevasses that ran approximately north and south, between three and five and a half miles.

Half a mile had been covered before we remarked the absence of the dogs which had been left to follow. We had taken for granted that they would follow us, and were so fully occupied after starting that their absence had passed unnoticed. It would be difficult to locate them if we returned; the weather would improve in a few days; if they felt hungry they would come down of their own accord. So we decided to go on without them.

We had walked half a mile before we noticed that the dogs we had left behind were missing. We assumed they would follow us and had been so focused on our journey that we hadn’t realized they weren't with us. It would be hard to find them if we went back; the weather would get better in a few days, and if they got hungry, they would come down on their own. So we decided to keep going without them.

At two miles from the Hut the drift thinned out and the wind became more gusty. Between the gusts the view ahead opened out for a considerable distance, and the rocks soon showed black below the last steep fall.

At two miles from the Hut, the path became less defined and the wind picked up, getting gustier. Between the gusts, the view ahead stretched out for a long way, and the rocks quickly appeared dark below the last steep drop.

Back at the Hut it was arranged that if the dogs did not return in a reasonable time, Bage, Mertz and Hurley should go up to Aladdin's Cave in search of them.

Back at the Hut, it was decided that if the dogs didn't come back in a reasonable time, Bage, Mertz, and Hurley would head up to Aladdin's Cave to look for them.

They made a great effort to get away next morning. The sledge was hauled for one thousand one hundred yards up to the magnetic ice-cave against a bitter torrent of air rushing by at eighty-two miles an hour. Here they retreated exhausted.

They worked hard to leave the next morning. The sled was pulled for one thousand one hundred yards up to the magnetic ice cave, fighting against a fierce wind blowing at eighty-two miles an hour. They collapsed here, completely worn out.

On the 17th the wind was gauged at eighty-four miles an hour, and nothing could be done. Dense drift and ferocious wind continued until the morning of August 21, and still none of the dogs had come home.

On the 17th, the wind was measured at eighty-four miles an hour, and nothing could be done. Thick snowdrifts and fierce winds kept up until the morning of August 21, and still, none of the dogs had returned home.

Bage, Hurley and Mertz took advantage of a slight lull to start off at 6.30 A.M. As they did not return that night we presumed they were making good headway.

Bage, Hurley, and Mertz seized a brief pause to set out at 6:30 A.M. Since they didn’t come back that night, we assumed they were making solid progress.

The drift was thick and the wind high for four days, and it was not until the morning of the 25th that the weather showed clearer and more promising. At 2 P.M. Bage and his companions arrived at the Hut bringing all the dogs except Grandmother, who had died of exhaustion. Aladdin's Cave had been difficult to find in the driving snow, which had thickened after the first few miles. They actually passed close to it when Mertz, between the gusts, sighted Castor jumping about, fully alive to the approaching relief. The other dogs were found curled up in the snow, in a listless, apathetic state; apparently in the same positions when left seven days before. They had made no attempt to break into several bags of provisions lying close at hand, preferring to starve rather than expose their faces to the pelting drift. All were frozen down except Basilisk and Castor. Pavlova was in the best condition, possibly because her last meal had been an extra full one; a reward for remaining with us when the others had bolted. Grandmother was in the worst condition, and, despite all efforts at revival, died four hours after. As the poor brutes were very weak after their long fast and exposure, they were taken into the Cave and fed on warm hoosh. Everything possible was done for them, and in return the party passed a very miserable time cramped in such a small space with six dogs. The accommodation was slightly increased by enlarging the Cave.

The snow was deep and the wind was strong for four days, and it wasn’t until the morning of the 25th that the weather began to clear up and look better. At 2 P.M., Bage and his friends arrived at the Hut, bringing all the dogs except Grandmother, who had died from exhaustion. Aladdin's Cave had been hard to find in the heavy snow, which got worse after the first few miles. They actually passed close to it when Mertz, between gusts of wind, saw Castor jumping around, clearly excited about the approaching help. The other dogs were found curled up in the snow, in a lethargic, unresponsive state; they seemed to be in the same spots they were left in seven days earlier. They hadn’t even tried to get into several bags of food lying nearby, choosing to starve rather than expose their faces to the harsh snow. All were frozen in place except for Basilisk and Castor. Pavlova was in the best shape, likely because her last meal had been a big one; a reward for staying with us when the others had run off. Grandmother was in the worst shape, and despite all efforts to revive her, she died four hours later. Since the poor animals were very weak after their long fast and exposure, they were brought into the Cave and fed warm hoosh. Everything possible was done for them, and in return, the group had a very uncomfortable time crammed into such a small space with six dogs. The living space was slightly increased by enlarging the Cave.

Five days of calm weather! It could scarcely be credited, yet September came with such a spell. They gave us great opportunities, and, for once, a vision of what perfect Antarctic days might be. The sea speedily froze over and extended our territory to the north. Every day we dredged among the tide-cracks, until Hunter and Laseron had material enough to sort and bottle for weeks. Seals came up everywhere, and the dogs gorged on much-needed meat and blubber. Three large Weddells were shot near the "Eastern Barrier" on September 1, and hauled up an ice-cliff eighty feet high to the rocks above. Work on the wireless masts went on apace, and the geologist was abroad with his plane-table every day. Webb and Bage, after a protracted interval, were able to take star observations for time, in order to check the chronometers.

Five days of calm weather! It was almost unbelievable, but September brought us just that. It gave us great opportunities and, for once, a glimpse of what perfect Antarctic days could be like. The sea quickly froze over, expanding our territory to the north. Every day, we dredged in the tide-cracks until Hunter and Laseron had enough material to sort and bottle for weeks. Seals appeared everywhere, and the dogs feasted on much-needed meat and blubber. Three large Weddells were shot near the "Eastern Barrier" on September 1 and hauled up an ice-cliff eighty feet high to the rocks above. Work on the wireless masts continued at a fast pace, and the geologist was out with his plane-table every day. After a long break, Webb and Bage were finally able to take star observations to check the time and verify the chronometers.

Mertz, Ninnis, Whetter and Laseron, with a team of dogs sledged a big load of food-stuffs to Aladdin's Cave on September 1. At the Cave the dogs were let loose, but instead of running back to the Hut, lingered about and finally had to be led down the slope. On being loosed again, several rushed back to the Cave and were only brought along by force. That night, Scott and Franklin, two kindred spirits, were not present at "roll-call".

Mertz, Ninnis, Whetter, and Laseron, along with a team of dogs, sledded a large load of supplies to Aladdin's Cave on September 1. At the Cave, the dogs were set free, but instead of running back to the Hut, they hung around and eventually had to be led down the slope. When they were let loose again, several dogs rushed back to the Cave and had to be dragged along. That night, Scott and Franklin, a pair of close friends, were absent for "roll-call."

On September 3, McLean, Whetter and Close took more provisions to Aladdin's Cave. They reported light drift and wind on the highlands, while at sea-level it was clear and calm.

On September 3, McLean, Whetter, and Close brought more supplies to Aladdin's Cave. They noted light drift and wind in the highlands, while at sea level it was clear and calm.

The sea-ice was by then thick and safe. About half a mile off shore a very successful dredging was made in fifty fathoms; the bottom at this depth simply teemed with life. At first, the dredge, rope-coils, tub, picks and other necessary implements were dragged about on a sledge, but the sledge was hauled only with great difficulty and much exertion over the sticky, new sea-ice. As a substitute a portable, steel handcart was advantageously employed, although, owing to its weight, tide-cracks and rotten areas had to be crossed at a run. On one occasion a flimsy surface collapsed under it, and Hunter had a wetting before it was hauled on to firmer ice.

The sea ice was thick and safe by then. About half a mile offshore, a very successful dredging took place in fifty fathoms; the bottom at this depth was full of life. At first, the dredge, rope coils, tub, picks, and other necessary tools were dragged on a sled, but it was really hard and exhausting to pull the sled over the sticky, new sea ice. Instead, a portable steel handcart was used, although, because of its weight, they had to rush across tide cracks and weak spots. One time, a flimsy surface gave way underneath it, and Hunter got wet before it was pulled onto more solid ice.

On September 4 there was a cloud radiant from the northwest, indicative of a change in the weather. Ninnis, Mertz and Murphy transported more food-bags and kerosene to Aladdin's Cave. They found Franklin one and a half miles south of the Hut lying on the ice quite well, but there was no sign of Scott. Both dogs were seen on the 1st of the month, when they were in a locality south-east of the Hut, where crevasses were numerous. It seemed most probable that Scott had lost his life in one of them. The party visiting the Cave reported a considerable amount of snow drifting above a level of one thousand feet.

On September 4, there was a bright cloud in the northwest, signaling a change in the weather. Ninnis, Mertz, and Murphy moved more food bags and kerosene to Aladdin's Cave. They found Franklin a mile and a half south of the Hut, lying on the ice and doing fairly well, but there was no sign of Scott. Both dogs were seen on the 1st of the month in an area southeast of the Hut, where there were many crevasses. It seemed most likely that Scott had lost his life in one of them. The group visiting the Cave reported a significant amount of snow drifting above a thousand feet.

There was another day of successful dredging, and, about four o'clock, while several men were still out on the ice, whirlies with great columns of drift came steadily down the glacier, pouring over the seaward cliffs. In a few minutes the snow-clouds were round the Hut and the wind was not long in working up to eighty miles per hour. The dredging party reached the land just in time; and the sea-ice drifted away to the north. Thus ended one of the most remarkable periods of fine weather experienced by us in Adelie Land, only to be excelled in the height of summer.

There was another successful day of dredging, and around four o'clock, while several men were still out on the ice, swirling winds carried large clouds of drift steadily down the glacier, spilling over the cliffs facing the sea. In just a few minutes, snow-filled clouds surrounded the Hut, and the wind quickly picked up to eighty miles per hour. The dredging team made it back to shore just in time, as the sea ice drifted away to the north. This marked the end of one of the most extraordinary stretches of good weather we had experienced in Adelie Land, surpassed only by the peak of summer.

The possibility of such a spell being repeated fired us with the hope that after all a reasonable amount of sledging could be accomplished in the spring. Three parties were chosen to reconnoitre in different directions and to test the sledging gear. As we were far from being confident in the weather, I made it clear that no party should penetrate farther than fifty miles from the Hut, nor remain away longer than a fortnight.

The chance of that spell being repeated gave us hope that we could actually get a decent amount of sledding done in the spring. We chose three groups to scout in different directions and test the sledding equipment. Since we weren’t very confident about the weather, I made it clear that no group should go more than fifty miles from the Hut or stay away for longer than two weeks.

Webb, McLean and Stillwell, the southern reconnoitring party, were the first to set off, leaving on September 7 against a wind of fifty-six miles per hour. Between them they had only one pair of good spiked crampons, and it was a hard, five hours' drag up to Aladdin's Cave. A tent which had been spread over the entrance to keep out snow was picked up here. It had suffered punctures and small tears from crampons, and, as the next day was one of boisterous wind, the party spent it repairing the tent and endeavouring to take magnetic observations. The latter had to be abandoned owing to the instrument becoming iced up.

Webb, McLean, and Stillwell, the southern scouting team, were the first to leave, departing on September 7 against a wind of fifty-six miles per hour. They only had one good pair of spiked crampons between them, and it was a tough five-hour slog up to Aladdin's Cave. They found a tent that had been put up at the entrance to keep out the snow. It had been damaged with punctures and small tears from the crampons, and since the next day was very windy, the team spent it fixing the tent and trying to take magnetic readings. They had to give up on the readings because the instrument froze up.

Next afternoon the wind fell to the forties, and the party struggled on to the south for three miles two hundred yards and camped, as it was necessary to make a search for a small depot of pemmican tins, a pick and a shovel left by us in the vicinity in August. The drift cleared at noon on the 11th, and the bamboo pole marking the depot appeared a quarter of a mile away on the right. The pick, shovel and flag were secured and another afternoon's march against a fifty-mile wind with a temperature at -20 degrees F. brought the party three and a quarter miles further, to a point eleven and three-quarter miles south of the Hut. The wind rose to the eighties during the night, and there were many small holes in the tent which provided more ventilation than was agreeable. As the wind was too strong for travelling on the 12th, it was decided to make a cave in case of accident to the tent.

The next afternoon, the wind calmed down to the forties, and the group pushed forward south for three miles and two hundred yards before camping. They needed to search for a small stash of pemmican tins, a pick, and a shovel that they had left nearby in August. The snow cleared around noon on the 11th, and the bamboo pole marking the stash was visible a quarter of a mile to the right. They retrieved the pick, shovel, and flag, and after another afternoon march against a fifty-mile-per-hour wind with a temperature of -20 degrees F, the group moved three and a quarter miles further, reaching a point eleven and three-quarter miles south of the Hut. The wind picked up to the eighties during the night, creating several small holes in the tent that let in more air than was comfortable. Since the wind was too strong for traveling on the 12th, they decided to dig a cave in case something happened to the tent.

A tunnel was driven into the sloping surface of the ice towards a crevasse about a foot wide. It was a good ten hours' job in tough ice before the crevasse was reached. Into the fissure all the hewn ice was thrown instead of being laboriously shovelled up through the tunnel. The "Cathedral Grotto" was soon finished, the tent was struck and the party made themselves comfortable inside. The cavern was found to be a very draughty place with a crevasse along one wall, and it was difficult to keep warm in one-man sleeping-bags. The crevasse was accordingly closed with ice and snow. That evening and on several subsequent occasions McLean took blood-pressure observations.

A tunnel was dug into the sloping ice leading to a crevasse about a foot wide. It took a good ten hours of hard work in tough ice to reach the crevasse. Instead of moving the ice up through the tunnel, all the cut ice was tossed into the fissure. The "Cathedral Grotto" was quickly completed, the tent was taken down, and the group made themselves comfortable inside. They found the cave to be pretty drafty with a crevasse along one wall, making it hard to stay warm in one-man sleeping bags. They sealed the crevasse with ice and snow. That evening and on several other occasions, McLean took blood pressure measurements.

During the next three days the wind was so strong that Webb's were the only crampons in which any efficient marching could be done. The time was spent in building a high break-wind of ice-blocks, a pit being excavated on the windward side in which Webb took a full set of magnetic observations. Within the "Grotto" the instrument rapidly became coated with ice-crystals; in the open air this difficulty did not arise, but others had to be overcome. It was exceedingly cold work at -20 degrees F. in a sixty-mile wind, both for Webb and his recorder Stillwell.

During the next three days, the wind was so strong that Webb's crampons were the only ones that allowed for any efficient walking. They spent the time building a tall wall of ice blocks to break the wind, and they dug a pit on the windward side where Webb took a complete set of magnetic readings. Inside the "Grotto," the instrument quickly got coated with ice crystals; this problem didn't occur in the open air, but other challenges had to be dealt with. It was extremely cold work at -20 degrees F in a sixty-mile-per-hour wind, for both Webb and his recorder, Stillwell.

There seemed no hope of going forward, so the depot flag was hoisted and a fortnight's provisions and kerosene stowed in the lee of the break-wind. It was a furious race back to the Hut via Aladdin's Cave with a gusty, seventy-five-mile wind in the rear. McLean and Stillwell actually skied along on their short blunt crampons, while Webb did his best to brake behind.

There seemed to be no chance of moving ahead, so the depot flag was raised and two weeks' worth of supplies and kerosene were stored out of the wind. It was a wild sprint back to the Hut through Aladdin's Cave with a strong, seventy-five-mile-an-hour wind at their backs. McLean and Stillwell actually skied along on their short blunt crampons, while Webb tried his best to slow down behind them.

The second party comprised Ninnis, Mertz, and Murphy, who went to the south-east, leaving on September 11. After a hard fight to Aladdin's Cave, the wind approaching fifty miles an hour, they diverged to the south-east. On the 12th they made steady progress up the slope of the glacier, delayed by many small crevasses. The surface was so rough that the nuts on the sledge-meter soon became loose and it was necessary to stop every quarter of a mile to adjust them. The day's march was a solid five and three quarter miles against a fifty-mile wind.

The second group included Ninnis, Mertz, and Murphy, who headed southeast, leaving on September 11. After battling through to Aladdin's Cave with winds nearing fifty miles an hour, they veered to the southeast. On the 12th, they made consistent progress up the glacier slope, but were slowed down by many small crevasses. The surface was so uneven that the nuts on the sledge-meter quickly became loose, requiring them to stop every quarter mile to fix them. They managed to cover a solid five and three-quarter miles while fighting against a fifty-mile wind.

On the 13th Ninnis's record proceeds as follows:

On the 13th, Ninnis's record continues as follows:

"The sky was still clear but the wind had increased to sixty-five miles per hour, the temperature standing at -17 degrees F.

"The sky was still clear, but the wind had picked up to sixty-five miles per hour, with the temperature sitting at -17 degrees F."

"We kept on the same course; the glacier's slope being steeper. Mertz was as usual wearing leather boots and mountaineering crampons, otherwise progress would have been practically impossible; the finnesko crampons worn by Murphy and myself giving very little foothold. Travelling was very slow indeed, and when we camped at 4 P.M., two and a half miles was all that had been covered.

"We stayed on the same path; the glacier's slope was steeper. Mertz was, as usual, wearing leather boots and mountain crampons; without them, making progress would have been nearly impossible. The finnesko crampons worn by Murphy and me provided very little grip. Traveling was extremely slow, and when we set up camp at 4 PM, we had only covered two and a half miles."

"At 9.15 A.M. (September 14) the wind practically dropped, and we advanced under perfect conditions."

"At 9:15 A.M. (September 14), the wind nearly stopped, and we moved forward under ideal conditions."

They had not gone far, however, before the wind suddenly increased so that only about four and a half miles were completed in the day. That evening, curiously enough, it fell calm for a time; then there was a period of alternating violent winds and calm.

They hadn’t gone far, though, before the wind suddenly picked up, so they only managed to cover about four and a half miles that day. That evening, interestingly, it calmed down for a while; then there were stretches of fierce winds followed by stillness.

On Sunday, September 15, it was impossible for them to move, as a hurricane raged outside. The tent was very much damaged by the wind, but in that state it managed to stand up till next morning. In the meantime all three fully dressed themselves and lay in their three-man sleeping-bag ready to take to the road at a moment's notice.

On Sunday, September 15, they couldn't move at all because a hurricane was raging outside. The tent was badly damaged by the wind, but it somehow stayed up until the next morning. In the meantime, all three got fully dressed and lay in their three-person sleeping bag, ready to hit the road at a moment’s notice.

The next morning, at a distance of eighteen miles southeast of the Hut, there was nothing for it but to make for Aladdin's Cave, which was safely reached by a forced march of twelve and three-quarter miles, with a furious wind partly abeam. On the way the sledge was blown sideways on to the lids of many wide crevasses, which, fortunately for the party, were strong at that season of the year.

The next morning, eighteen miles southeast of the Hut, the only option was to head to Aladdin's Cave, which we reached safely after a tough march of twelve and three-quarter miles, against a strong wind mostly from the side. Along the way, the sledge was blown sideways onto the lids of several wide crevasses, which, luckily for the group, were sturdy at that time of year.

From the realistic reports of the two parties which had returned it was evident that Madigan and his companions, Close and Whetter who had set out on the 12th to the west were having a bad time. But it was not till the 23rd, after a week of clear skies, low temperatures and unceasing drift-free wind that we began to feel apprehensive about them.

From the realistic reports of the two parties that had returned, it was clear that Madigan and his companions, Close and Whetter, who had set out on the 12th to the west, were having a tough time. However, it wasn't until the 23rd, after a week of clear skies, low temperatures, and a constant, drift-free wind, that we started to feel worried about them.

September 24 and 25 were punctuated by several intervals of calm during which it was judged the party would have been able to travel.

September 24 and 25 had several calm periods when it was thought the group could have traveled.

On the morning of September 26 Ninnis and Mertz, with a team of dogs, set off up the hill to Aladdin's Cave to deposit some provisions and to scan the horizon for any sign of the sledgers. On the way they fell in with them descending the slopes, very worn and frost-bitten.

On the morning of September 26, Ninnis and Mertz, along with a team of dogs, started up the hill to Aladdin's Cave to drop off some supplies and look out for any signs of the sledgers. On their way, they encountered them coming down the slopes, looking very tired and frostbitten.

They had a thrilling story to tell, and, when it was known that the party had reached fifty miles to the west, everybody crowded round to listen.

They had an exciting story to share, and when word got out that the group had traveled fifty miles to the west, everyone gathered around to hear it.

The wind average at the Hut during their fortnight of absence was fifty-eight miles per hour, implying worse conditions on the plateau. Madigan gave the facts:

The average wind speed at the Hut during their two-week absence was fifty-eight miles per hour, suggesting harsher conditions on the plateau. Madigan presented the facts:

"After leaving Aladdin's Cave on the 12th we continued due south, lunching at 2 P.M. on the site of Webb's first camp. Our troubles had already begun; the wind averaging sixty miles an hour all day with a temperature at noon of -14 degrees F.

"After leaving Aladdin's Cave on the 12th, we continued straight south, having lunch at 2 PM at the spot of Webb's first camp. Our troubles had already started; the wind was averaging sixty miles an hour all day, with a temperature of -14 degrees F at noon."

"As a few tears appeared in the tent during the night, we saw that it would not be advisable to put it up next day for lunch, so we had a cold meal, crouched in the lee of the sledge. This custom was found to economize time, as we became so cold eating our fare of biscuit, chocolate and butter that we got moving again as soon as possible. The great disadvantage was that there was nothing to drink between the morning and evening meals.

"As a few tears formed in the tent during the night, we realized it wouldn't be wise to set it up again for lunch the next day, so we had a cold meal, huddled beside the sledge. This approach turned out to save time, since we got so cold eating our biscuits, chocolate, and butter that we wanted to get moving again as soon as possible. The major downside was that there was nothing to drink between breakfast and dinner."

"We sewed up the rents in the tent during the halt, having to use bare fingers in the open. About four stitches at a time were as much as one man could manage, and then the other two took their turns.

"We patched up the tears in the tent during our break, having to use our bare fingers in the open air. About four stitches at a time was all one person could handle, and then the other two took their turns."

"The next day was the only comparatively calm period of the two weeks of travelling. The wind was in the vicinity of thirty miles per hour, and, going west, we reached a spot, twenty miles 'out,' on a snow-covered surface, by nightfall.

"The next day was the only relatively calm moment during the two weeks of traveling. The wind was around thirty miles per hour, and heading west, we made it to a location, twenty miles 'out,' on a snowy surface by nightfall."

"A steady seventy-five-mile wind blew all day on the 15th at right angles to our course, accompanied by a thick, low drift. The surface was partially consolidated snow, very hard and smooth. Sometimes the sledge would grip and we could pull straight ahead. Then, suddenly, it would slide away sideways down wind and often pull us off our feet with a sudden vicious jerk. Most of the time we were dragging in a south-westerly direction to make the sledge run west, stumbling through the drift with the sledge now behind us, now sliding away to leeward, often capsizing and requiring to be laboriously righted and sometimes repacked.

A constant seventy-five-mile wind blew all day on the 15th at a right angle to our path, accompanied by a thick, low drift. The surface was partly frozen snow, very hard and smooth. Sometimes the sledge would grip, allowing us to pull straight ahead. Then, suddenly, it would slide sideways with the wind, often pulling us off our feet with a sharp jerk. Most of the time, we were dragging it in a south-westerly direction to make the sledge go west, stumbling through the drift with the sledge sometimes behind us, sometimes sliding away to the side, often tipping over and needing to be painstakingly set upright and sometimes repacked.

"After many experiments, we found the best device was to have two men on the bow-rope, about twenty feet long, and one with about ten feet of rope attached to the rear of the sledge. The man on the tail-rope, usually Whetter, found it very difficult to keep his feet, and, after a score of falls in stinging drift with incidental frost-bites on fingers and cheeks, he did not feel exactly cheerful.

"After many tests, we discovered that the best setup was to have two guys on the bow rope, which was about twenty feet long, and one guy with a rope about ten feet long attached to the back of the sled. The guy on the tail rope, usually Whetter, had a really hard time staying upright, and after a lot of falls in the biting wind with some frostbite on his fingers and cheeks, he wasn’t feeling very cheerful."

"By 4 P.M. on the 15th we had reached twenty-five miles and were exhausted. We pitched camp at an early hour, partly influenced by the fact that it was a special occasion—Close's birthday! Some port wine had been slipped in to provide against that 'emergency.' On taking the precious bottle from the instrument-box, I found that the cork was out, and, for one awful moment, thought the bottle was empty. Then I realized that the wine had frozen solid and had pushed the cork out by its expansion on solidification.

"By 4 PM on the 15th, we had covered twenty-five miles and were worn out. We set up camp early, partly because it was a special occasion—Close's birthday! Some port wine had been stashed away for that 'emergency.' When I took the precious bottle from the instrument box, I found the cork was out, and for one terrible moment, I thought the bottle was empty. Then I realized that the wine had frozen solid and pushed the cork out as it expanded while freezing."

"At last, the tent safely pitched and hoosh and cocoa finished, the moment came to drink to Close's health and happiness. The bottle had stood on the top of the cooker while the meal was being prepared, but the wine was still as solid as ever. After being shaken and held over the primus for a good half-hour it began to issue in lumps. Once the lumps were secured in mugs the rest of the thawing was easy. Finally, we toasted Close and his wife (in far Australia) in what we voted to be the finest draught it had ever been our good fortune to drink. In the morning a cairn was made of the snow-blocks which were taken from the tent-skirt, and it was surmounted with the bottle, being called 'Birthday Camp.'

"Finally, with the tent set up and the hoosh and cocoa finished, it was time to toast to Close's health and happiness. The bottle had been sitting on top of the cooker while we made the meal, but the wine was still frozen solid. After shaking it and holding it over the primus for about half an hour, it started to come out in chunks. Once we poured the chunks into mugs, the rest of the thawing was easy. We raised a toast to Close and his wife (down in Australia) with what we agreed was the best drink we had ever had. In the morning, we built a cairn with the snow blocks we took from the tent's edge and topped it off with the bottle, naming it 'Birthday Camp.'"

"During September 16 my right eyelid became frostbitten. I noticed that it was hard and refused to shut, so I rubbed vigorously to bring it round. However, it swelled and blistered badly and the eye remained closed for two days.

"On September 16, my right eyelid got frostbite. I realized it was stiff and wouldn’t close, so I rubbed it hard to get it to work properly. Instead, it swelled up and blistered badly, and my eye stayed shut for two days."

"From twenty to fifty miles 'out', the surface was neve with areas of sastrugi up to three feet in height. No crevasses were noticed. At twenty-eight miles out, we lost sight of the sea, and at forty miles an altitude of four thousand five hundred feet was reached.

"From twenty to fifty miles out, the surface was hard-packed snow with areas of sastrugi up to three feet high. No crevasses were observed. At twenty-eight miles out, we lost sight of the ocean, and at forty miles, we reached an altitude of four thousand five hundred feet."

"We turned out at 6 A.M. every morning and were on the move by 9 A.M. Lunch only took half an hour and was a most uncomfortable meal. As we sat in the lee of the sledge, the surface-drift swirled up in our faces like fine sand. We never camped before 6 P.M. and were obliged to consider five miles a good day's run.

"We woke up at 6 A.M. every morning and were on the move by 9 A.M. Lunch only took half an hour and was a really uncomfortable meal. As we sat behind the sled, the wind-blown snow swirled up in our faces like fine sand. We never set up camp before 6 P.M. and considered five miles a good day’s trek."

"Pitching camp took nearly an hour. Blocks of snow were cut and arranged in a semicircle, within which the tent was laid with its peak upwind. It sounds simple enough, but, as we had to take off crampons so as not to tread on the tent, our difficulties were enormously increased by having to move about wearing finnesko on a smooth surface in a high wind. One man crawled into the tent, and, at a given signal, the other two raised the peak while the former held on to the upwind leg and kicked the other legs into place with his feet. The others then quickly piled food-tanks and blocks of snow on to the skirt, calling out as soon as there was enough to hold it down, as the man gripping the bamboo leg inside would soon have 'deadly cold' fingers. It was always a great relief when the tent was up.

"Setting up camp took almost an hour. We cut blocks of snow and arranged them in a semicircle, inside which we placed the tent with its peak facing into the wind. It sounds straightforward, but since we had to take off our crampons to avoid damaging the tent, it became much harder to move around in the high wind while wearing finnesko on a slick surface. One person crawled into the tent, and on a signal, the other two lifted the peak while the one inside held onto the upwind leg and kicked the other legs into position with his feet. The others quickly piled food containers and snow blocks onto the skirt, calling out when there was enough weight to secure it, as the person gripping the bamboo leg inside would soon have 'deadly cold' fingers. It was always a huge relief when the tent was finally up."

"Almost every night there was some sewing to do, and it was not long before every one's fingers were in a bad state. They became, especially near the tips, as hard as wood and devoid of sensation. Manipulating toggles and buttons on one's clothing gave an immense amount of trouble, and it always seemed an interminable time before we got away in the morning. Our lowest temperature was -35 degrees F., early on September 18.

"Almost every night there was some sewing to do, and it didn't take long before everyone's fingers were in rough shape. They became, especially near the tips, as hard as wood and lost all feeling. Trying to handle toggles and buttons on our clothes was a huge hassle, and it always felt like it took forever to get out in the morning. Our lowest temperature was -35 degrees F., early on September 18."

"We were fifty miles 'out' on September 19 on a white, featureless plain. Through low drift we had seen very little of our surroundings on the march. A bamboo pole with a black flag was raised, a mound was built, and a week's provisions for three men and two gallons of kerosene were cached.

"We were fifty miles 'out' on September 19 on a flat, white plain. Through low visibility, we had seen very little of our surroundings during the march. A bamboo pole with a black flag was put up, a mound was built, and a week’s worth of supplies for three men and two gallons of kerosene were stored away."

"In the morning there was a howling eighty-mile blizzard with dense drift, and our hopes of an early start homeward were dispelled. We feared for the safety of the tent, knowing that if it had gone during that 'blow' our hopes of getting back to the Hut would have been small.

"In the morning, there was a howling eighty-mile-per-hour blizzard with heavy snow drifts, and our hopes of an early start home were dashed. We worried about the safety of the tent, realizing that if it had come down during that storm, our chances of making it back to the Hut would have been very slim."

"The wind continued all day and the next night, but, to our joy, abated on the 21st to fifty miles an hour, permitting us to travel.

"The wind blew all day and into the next night, but, to our relief, calmed down to fifty miles an hour on the 21st, allowing us to travel."

"Through a seventy-five-miler on the 22nd and a quieter day on the 23rd, we picked up our half-way mound at Birthday Camp on September 24. On the same night the long-suffering sledge-meter, much battered, gave up recording.

"After a seventy-five-mile trek on the 22nd and a quieter day on the 23rd, we reached our halfway point at Birthday Camp on September 24. That same night, the long-suffering sledge-meter, which had seen better days, finally stopped working."

"At 3 A.M. I was awakened by something striking me on the head. I looked out of the sleeping-bag and found that the tent had fallen in on us. The lashing at the apex had carried away and the poles upwind were almost flat. The cap was gone, and one side of the tent was split from top to bottom. I awakened the others, and Whetter and I got out, leaving Close inside to hang on to the bag. Luckily we had kept on our burberrys in case of accidents. For once the entrance had not to be unfastened, as there was a ready-made exit. The poles were roughly bound together with an alpine rope and anchored to a pick on the windward side. It was blowing about eighty miles an hour, but fortunately there was no drift. When daylight came the tent was found to be hopelessly ruined, and to light the primus was impossible, though the wind had abated to thirty-five miles an hour.

"At 3 A.M., something hit me on the head and woke me up. I looked out of the sleeping bag and saw that the tent had collapsed on us. The lashing at the top had come loose, and the poles on the windward side were almost flat. The cap was gone, and one side of the tent was ripped from top to bottom. I woke the others up, and Whetter and I got out, leaving Close inside to hold onto the bag. Luckily, we had kept our burberrys on just in case. This time, we didn’t have to unfasten the entrance, since there was already an exit. The poles were roughly tied together with an alpine rope and secured to a pick on the windward side. It was blowing about eighty miles an hour, but thankfully there was no drift. By daylight, the tent was completely ruined, and it was impossible to light the primus, even though the wind had dropped to thirty-five miles an hour."

"We ate some frozen food and pushed on, hoping to find Aladdin's Cave before dark, so that we should not have to spend a night without a tent. After a struggle of thirteen miles over rough ice we came, footsore and worn out, to Aladdin's Cave. Close's feet were badly blistered, and both my big toes had become frost-bitten at the fifty-mile camp, giving me a good deal of trouble on the way back.

"We had some frozen food and kept going, hoping to reach Aladdin's Cave before dark so we wouldn't have to spend the night without a tent. After trudging thirteen miles over rough ice, we arrived, sore and exhausted, at Aladdin's Cave. Close's feet were badly blistered, and both of my big toes had gotten frostbitten at the fifty-mile camp, causing me a lot of trouble on the way back."

"Never was the Cave a more luxurious place. The cooker was kept busy far into the night, while we drank and smoked and felt happy."

"Never was the Cave a more luxurious place. The cook was busy late into the night, while we drank and smoked and felt happy."

The successful conclusion of this journey in the face of the most adverse weather conditions was something upon which Madigan, Whetter and Close could well feel proud, for in its way it must be a record in the sledging world. They were indeed badly frost-bitten; Madigan's great toes having suffered most of all. Whetter's chief injury was a wound under the chin occasioned by a pair of scissors handled by Madigan to free Whetter's helmet on an occasion when it was firmly frozen to his face.

The successful completion of this journey despite the harshest weather conditions was something that Madigan, Whetter, and Close could truly be proud of, as it likely set a record in the sledding world. They were definitely badly frostbitten; Madigan's big toes were the worst off. Whetter's main injury was a cut under his chin caused by a pair of scissors that Madigan used to free Whetter's helmet when it had frozen tightly to his face.

On October 1, Mertz, Hurley and Ninnis made a gallant attempt to rescue two dogs, Basilisk and Franklin, which had remained at Aladdin's Cave on September 26, after accompanying them there with a load of provisions. At the Hut there was no drift, but during the ascent it became thicker, and the wind stronger, forcing them at last to turn back.

On October 1, Mertz, Hurley, and Ninnis made a brave attempt to rescue two dogs, Basilisk and Franklin, which had stayed at Aladdin's Cave on September 26 after they had brought a supply of provisions there. At the Hut, there was no snow accumulation, but during the climb, it got denser, and the wind got stronger, eventually forcing them to turn back.

Two days later another attempt was made by Ninnis and Mertz, and, in dense drift, after wandering about for a long time they happened on the Cave, to find that the dogs were not there, though spots were discovered where they had evidently been sleeping in the snow. Coming back disconsolately, they found that the dogs had reached the Hut not long before them. Apparently the two vagrants, hearing Ninnis and Mertz blundering about in the drift in search of the depot, had decided that it was time to return home. We concluded that the ways of these Greenland dogs were past finding out.

Two days later, Ninnis and Mertz made another attempt, and after wandering around for a long time in the thick snow, they stumbled upon the Cave, only to find that the dogs were missing. However, they did find areas where the dogs had clearly been sleeping in the snow. Feeling disheartened, they returned to discover that the dogs had made it to the Hut just shortly before they did. It seemed that the two strays, hearing Ninnis and Mertz fumbling around in the snow while searching for the supply depot, decided it was time to head back home. We concluded that the behavior of these Greenland dogs was truly unpredictable.

October came with a deluge of snow and transient hours of bright sunlight, during which the seals would make a temporary landing and retire again to the water when their endurance was exhausted. Snow petrels flew in great numbers about the rocks in the evening, seeking out their old nest-crevices. Seeing these signs of returning life, every one was in great expectation of the arrival of the penguins.

October brought a heavy snowfall and brief moments of bright sunlight, when the seals would make a quick visit to land and then head back to the water when they could no longer stay. Snow petrels flew in large numbers around the rocks in the evening, looking for their old nesting spots. Noticing these signs of life returning, everyone was eagerly anticipating the arrival of the penguins.

On the night of the 11th, Hurley, Laseron, Hunter and Correll made an innovation by presenting a small farce to an audience which had been starved of dramatic entertainment for a long time, and consequently showed tremendous appreciation.

On the night of the 11th, Hurley, Laseron, Hunter, and Correll came up with a new idea by putting on a short comedy for an audience that had been craving dramatic entertainment for a long time, and as a result, they showed great appreciation.

The first penguin came waddling up the ice-foot against a seventy-mile wind late on the afternoon of October 12. McLean brought the bird back to the Hut and the newcomer received a great ovation. Stimulated by their success on the previous night and the appearance of the first penguin, the theatrical company added to their number, and, dispensing with a rehearsal, produced an opera, "The Washerwoman's Secret" (Laseron). Part of the Hut was curtained off as a combined green-room and dressing-room; the kitchen was the stage; footlights twinkled on the floor; the acetylene limelight beamed down from the rafters, while the audience crowded on a form behind the dining-table, making tactless remarks and steadily eating chocolate.

The first penguin waddled up on the ice against a seventy-mile wind late on the afternoon of October 12. McLean brought the bird back to the Hut, and the newcomer received a huge cheer. Energized by their success the night before and the arrival of the first penguin, the theater group decided to add more performers and, skipping rehearsal, put on an opera called "The Washerwoman's Secret" (Laseron). Part of the Hut was separated off as a combined green room and dressing room; the kitchen served as the stage; footlights sparkled on the floor; the acetylene limelight shone down from the rafters, while the audience crammed onto a bench behind the dining table, making awkward comments and munching on chocolate.

The typed programmes advertised the following:

The typed programs advertised the following:

THE WASHERWOMAN'S SECRET

THE LAUNDRESS'S SECRET

(Opera in Five Acts)

(Opera in Five Acts)

DRAMATIS PERSONAE

Characters

  DR. STAKANHOISER (Tenor)       "Hoyle"             Hurley
  CHEVALIER DE TINTAIL (Fiver)   "Johnny"            Hunter
  BARON DE BRENT (Basso)         "Joe"               Laseron
  COUNT HOOPENKOFF (Barrowtone)  "Little Willie"     Correll
  MADAM FUCLOSE (Don't Sing)     "Also Joe"          Laseron
  JEMIMA FUCLOSE (Soprano)       "Dad"               McLean
  DR. STAKANHOISER'S Dog         " Monkey"           Greenland Pup
  VILLAGE IDIOT                  "Bick"              Bickerton
  ORCHESTRA                      "Stillwater Willie" StillWell
  DR. STAKANHOISER (Tenor)       "Hoyle"             Hurley  
  CHEVALIER DE TINTAIL (Fiver)   "Johnny"            Hunter  
  BARON DE BRENT (Basso)         "Joe"               Laseron  
  COUNT HOOPENKOFF (Barrowtone)  "Little Willie"     Correll  
  MADAM FUCLOSE (Don't Sing)     "Also Joe"          Laseron  
  JEMIMA FUCLOSE (Soprano)       "Dad"               McLean  
  DR. STAKANHOISER'S Dog         "Monkey"            Greenland Pup  
  VILLAGE IDIOT                  "Bick"              Bickerton  
  ORCHESTRA                      "Stillwater Willie" StillWell  

ACT I

ACT I

SCENE: Room in poorer part of Berlin: MADAM FUCLOSE in bed dying: JEMIMA at table washing clothes

SCENE: Room in a low-income area of Berlin: MADAM FUCLOSE is in bed, dying: JEMIMA is at the table washing clothes.

Song "When Sparrows Build" JEMIMA

"When Sparrows Build" by JEMIMA

       [Knock at door.  Enter Dr. STAKANHOISER.
       [Knock at the door. Enter Dr. STAKANHOISER.]

Song: "I vas a Doctor"

Song: "I Was a Doctor"

[Attends MADAM FUCLOSE, who, when dying, tells him that JEMIMA is not her daughter, but the Princess of Adeliana, whom she has rescued in Paris during the Revolution.

[Attends MADAM FUCLOSE, who, when dying, tells him that JEMIMA is not her daughter, but the Princess of Adeliana, whom she rescued in Paris during the Revolution.]

Death Scene and Chorus: "Who Killed my Mother?"

Death Scene and Chorus: "Who Killed my Mom?"

ACT II

Act 2

SCENE: Beneath JEMIMA'S window

Under JEMIMA'S window

[Enter Dr. STAKANHOISER disguised as organ grinder.

[Enter Dr. STAKANHOISER disguised as an organ grinder.]

Song: "Vurds der Likum" Dr. S.

Song: "Vurds der Likum" Dr. S.

[JEMIMA opens window and throws flour on DOCTOR.

[JEMIMA opens the window and throws flour on the DOCTOR.]

[Enter BARON DE BRENT, kicks DOCTOR out.

[Enter BARON DE BRENT, kicks DOCTOR out.]

Song: "Baron of Brent"

Song: "Baron of Brent"

[BARON makes love to JEMIMA, who laughs at him.

[BARON makes love to JEMIMA, who laughs at him.

Duet: "Wilt love me" JEMIMA and BARON

Duet: "Will you love me" JEMIMA and BARON

[Enter CHEVALIER DE TINTAIL, who denounces the BARON as already having four wives. The BARON goes off, muttering revenge.

[Enter CHEVALIER DE TINTAIL, who accuses the BARON of already having four wives. The BARON exits, grumbling about revenge.]

Song: "I'm in love with a wonderful lady" CHEVALIER

Song: "I’m in love with an amazing woman" CHEVALIER

[The CHEVALIER makes love to JEMIMA, who loves him in return.

[The CHEVALIER makes love to JEMIMA, who loves him back.]

Chorus: "Jemima"

Chorus: "Jemima"

ACT III

Act 3

SCENE: Conspirators' Chamber

SCENE: Conspirators' Room

[Enter DOCTOR, who hides behind a barrel.

[Enter DOCTOR, who is hiding behind a barrel.]

[Enter COUNT HOOPENKOFF, who amuses himself playing a piccolo.

[Enter COUNT HOOPENKOFF, who entertains himself by playing a piccolo.]

[Enter BARON. They discuss plot to kidnap Princess, which is overheard by DOCTOR.

[Enter BARON. They discuss a plan to kidnap the Princess, which is overheard by DOCTOR.]

[Enter Ghost, who frightens conspirators away.

[Enter Ghost, who scares the conspirators away.]

Chorus: "Little Willie Smith"

Chorus: "Lil Willie Smith"

ACT IV

Act 4

SCENE: JEMIMA's room

SCENE: JEMIMA's room

   [The CHEVALIER  DE TINTAIL is waiting.
   [The CHEVALIER DE TINTAIL is waiting.

Song: "I want you to see my Girl" CHEVALIER

Song: "I want you to see my Girl" CHEVALIER

          [Enter  JEMIMA.  Love scene.
[Enter JEMIMA. Romantic scene.]

[Enter DOCTOR, who discloses the plot he has heard and tells JEMIMA of her high descent. The CHEVALIER and the DOCTOR hide, and the two villains, by means of a ladder, enter the room. The heroes spring from their hiding-place and the villains are ejected.

[Enter DOCTOR, who reveals the plot he has heard and informs JEMIMA of her noble lineage. The CHEVALIER and the DOCTOR hide, and the two villains climb in through a ladder into the room. The heroes spring from their hiding place and throw out the villains.]

Chorus: "There is a Wash-House"

Chorus: "There's a Wash House"

ACT V

Act 5

SCENE: Conspirators' Chamber

SCENE: Conspirators' Room

[The BARON and COUNT enter by different doors. They accuse each other of having betrayed the plot. Duel follows in which both are killed.

[The BARON and COUNT enter from different doors. They blame each other for betraying the plan. A duel ensues in which both are killed.]

Duet: "Mort de Botheo" COUNT and BARON

Duet: "Death of Botheo" COUNT and BARON

[All the others rush in. The two lovers come together and the DOCTOR says, "God bless you, my children."

[All the others rush in. The two lovers come together and the DOCTOR says, "God bless you, my children."]

Chorus: "Auld Lang Syne" COMPANY and AUDIENCE
                         And
                   GOD SAVE THE KING
Chorus: "Auld Lang Syne" COMPANY and AUDIENCE  
                         And  
                   GOD SAVE THE KING
Played by the Society for the Prevention of the Blues.
                                       Saturday, October 12, 1912.
                                                      ADELIE HALL
Played by the Society for the Prevention of the Blues.  
                                       Saturday, October 12, 1912.  
                                                      ADELIE HALL

Admission Free. Children Half Price.

Free Admission. Kids Half Price.

October 13 was known as Black Sunday. We were all seated at dinner and the Hut was quivering in the tornado-like gusts which followed a heavy "blow" reaching a maximum hourly average of ninety-one miles. One mighty blast was followed by a crack and the sound of a heavy falling body. For a moment it was thought that something had happened to the Hut. Then the messman ran out to the trap-door and saw that the northern wireless mast had disappeared.

October 13 was called Black Sunday. We were all sitting at dinner, and the Hut was shaking in the tornado-like gusts that followed a strong wind reaching a peak of ninety-one miles per hour. One powerful blast was followed by a crack and the sound of something heavy falling. For a moment, we thought something had happened to the Hut. Then the messman ran to the trap-door and saw that the northern wireless mast was gone.

The weather showed but meagre signs of improvement, but the penguins came up in great numbers. They were in groups all along the ice-foot in the lee of rocks and icy pinnacles. They climbed up to their old resorts, and in a few days commenced to build nests of small pebbles. Skua gulls mysteriously appeared, snow petrels hovered along the rocky ridges and odd seals landed on the wind-raked harbour ice. Silver-grey and Antarctic petrels flew along the shore with occasional Cape pigeons. If the weather were indifferent to the fact, the birds did not forget that spring had come.

The weather showed only slight signs of getting better, but the penguins arrived in large numbers. They gathered in groups along the icy edges, sheltered by rocks and icy peaks. They climbed back to their usual spots, and after a few days, they started building nests out of small pebbles. Skua gulls appeared out of nowhere, snow petrels floated along the rocky ridges, and random seals made their way onto the wind-swept harbor ice. Silver-grey and Antarctic petrels flew along the shore, along with a few Cape pigeons. Even if the weather didn't seem to care, the birds remembered that spring had arrived.

A Weddell seal calved on the bay-ice on October 18. For a week the pup had a miserable time in winds ranging mostly about the seventies, with the temperature below zero Fahrenheit. At last it became so weak that it thawed a hole in the soft, sludgy ice and could not extricate itself. Both it and the mother were killed and skinned for the biological collection.

A Weddell seal gave birth on the bay ice on October 18. For a week, the pup struggled in winds mostly around seventy miles per hour, with temperatures below zero Fahrenheit. Eventually, it got so weak that it melted a hole in the soft, sludgy ice and couldn't get out. Both the pup and the mother were killed and skinned for the biological collection.

On all but the worst days a gang of men worked with picks and shovels digging out the Hangar, so that Bickerton could test the air-tractor sledge. The attack was concentrated upon a solid bank of snow and ice into which heaps of tins and rubbish had been compactly frozen. In soft snow enormous headway can be made in a short space of time, but in that species of conglomerate, progress is slow. Eventually, a cutting was made by which the machine could pass out. The rampart of snow was broken through at the northern end of the Hangar, and the sledge with its long curved runners was hauled forth triumphantly on the 25th. From that time onwards Bickerton continued to experiment and to improve the contrivance.

On all but the worst days, a group of men worked with picks and shovels digging out the Hangar so that Bickerton could test the air-tractor sledge. They focused their efforts on a solid bank of snow and ice where heaps of cans and trash had been tightly frozen. In soft snow, you can make huge progress in a short amount of time, but in that type of mixture, progress is slow. Eventually, they created a cut that allowed the machine to pass through. The snow barrier was broken through at the northern end of the Hangar, and the sledge with its long curved runners was pulled out triumphantly on the 25th. From that point on, Bickerton continued to experiment with and improve the device.

On October 21 there was a marked thaw inside the Hut. The frost along all the cracks dissolved into water and ran down the walls over pictures, on to book-shelves and bunks. The thick caking of ice on the windows dripped continually, coming away in layers at lunch-time and scattering among the diners at both ends of the table. Every available bucket and tub was in use, and small tin-gutters hooked under each window had to be emptied at frequent intervals.

On October 21, there was a noticeable thaw inside the Hut. The frost along all the cracks melted into water and ran down the walls over pictures, onto bookshelves and bunks. The thick layer of ice on the windows dripped continuously, coming off in layers at lunchtime and scattering among the diners at both ends of the table. Every available bucket and tub was in use, and small tin gutters hooked under each window had to be emptied regularly.

Stillwell came in during the afternoon bearing an albino penguin with a prettily mottled head; a curious freak of which the biologists immediately took possession. The penguins now swarmed along the foreshores, those not settling down in the rookeries wandering about in small crowds, occasionally visiting the Hut and exploring among the rocks or up the slippery glacier. Murphy was heard, at this time, to advance a theory accounting for the fact that Adelie penguins never made their nests on a scale more elaborate than a collection of stones. He submitted that anything else would be blown away. To support the contention, he stated that as soon as the female lays her egg, she places a stone on top to weight it down. The biologists kept a dignified silence during the discussion.

Stillwell walked in during the afternoon carrying an albino penguin with a nicely mottled head; a unique specimen that the biologists quickly took charge of. The penguins now filled the shorelines, those that weren't settling down in the rookeries wandering around in small groups, sometimes visiting the Hut and exploring among the rocks or up the slippery glacier. Murphy was heard at this time proposing a theory to explain why Adelie penguins never built their nests any more elaborate than a pile of stones. He claimed that anything more would just get blown away. To support his point, he noted that as soon as the female lays her egg, she places a stone on top to hold it down. The biologists maintained a dignified silence during the discussion.

On the 21st an Emperor penguin landed on the harbour ice, and, early in November, two more were captured. These imperial birds are very rare on the coasts of Adelie Land, owing to the fact that their winter breeding-grounds in Antarctica are selected in spots where climatic conditions are comparatively good.

On the 21st, an Emperor penguin landed on the harbor ice, and early in November, two more were caught. These majestic birds are quite rare on the coasts of Adelie Land because they choose winter breeding sites in Antarctica that have relatively good climate conditions.

October closed with an average wind velocity of 56.9 miles per hour. Yet the possibility of summer sledging was no longer remote. The sun was high, spells of calm were longer and more frequent, and, with the certain knowledge that we should be on the plateau in November, the sledging parties were chosen, schemes of exploration were discussed, and the last details for an extensive campaign completed.

October ended with an average wind speed of 56.9 miles per hour. Still, the chance of summer sledding was no longer far-fetched. The sun was high, periods of calm were longer and more frequent, and with the certainty that we would be on the plateau in November, the sledding teams were selected, exploration plans were discussed, and the final details for a major campaign were finished.





CHAPTER XII ACROSS KING GEORGE V LAND

    We yearned beyond the skyline.—Kipling
We longed beyond the skyline.—Kipling

October had passed without offering any opportunities for sledging, and we resolved that in defiance of all but the worst weather a start would be made in November. The 'Aurora' was due to arrive early in January 1913 and the time at our disposal for exploration was slipping away rapidly.

October had gone by without giving us any chances for sledding, and we decided that despite any bad weather, we would get going in November. The 'Aurora' was scheduled to arrive in early January 1913, and our time for exploration was running out quickly.

The investigation by sledging journeys of the coastline to the eastward was regarded as of prime importance, for our experience in the 'Aurora' when in those longitudes during the previous year was such as to give little promise of its ever being accomplished from the sea.

The exploration of the coastline to the east through sledging trips was seen as crucial, since our experience on the 'Aurora' in those longitudes the year before suggested that it was unlikely to be done from the sea.

Westward, the coast was accessible from the sea; at least for some distance in that direction. Madigan's journey in the springtime had demonstrated that, if anything, the land to the west was steeper, and consequently more windy conditions might be expected there. Further, it was judged that information concerning this region would be forthcoming from the ship, which had cruised westward after leaving Adelie Land in January 1912. The field in that direction was therefore not so promising as that to the east.

Westward, the coast was reachable by sea, at least for some distance. Madigan's trip in the spring showed that, if anything, the land to the west was steeper, which meant more windy conditions could be expected there. Additionally, it was believed that information about this area would be coming from the ship that had sailed west after leaving Adelie Land in January 1912. Therefore, the area in that direction seemed less promising than to the east.

On this account the air-tractor sledge, of somewhat doubtful utility, was detailed for use to the westward of Winter Quarters, and, as it was obvious that the engine could only be operated in moderately good weather, its final departure was postponed until December.

On this basis, the air-tractor sled, which had questionable usefulness, was assigned for use west of Winter Quarters. Since it was clear that the engine could only run in decent weather, its departure was delayed until December.

The following is a list of the parties which had been arranged and which, now fully equipped, were on the tiptoe of expectation to depart.

The following is a list of the parties that had been organized and which, now fully prepared, were eagerly waiting to leave.

(1) A Southern Party composed of Bage (leader), Webb and Hurley. The special feature of their work was to be magnetic observations in the vicinity of the South Magnetic Pole.

(1) A Southern Party made up of Bage (leader), Webb, and Hurley. The special focus of their work was to conduct magnetic observations near the South Magnetic Pole.

(2) A Southern Supporting Party, including Murphy (leader), Hunter and Laseron, who were to accompany the Southern Party as far as possible, returning to Winter Quarters by the end of November.

(2) A Southern Supporting Party, including Murphy (leader), Hunter, and Laseron, who were to join the Southern Party as far as possible, returning to Winter Quarters by the end of November.

(3) A Western Party of three men—Bickerton (leader), Hodgeman and Whetter—who were to traverse the coastal highlands west of the Hut. Their intention was to make use of the air-tractor sledge and the departure of the party was fixed for early December.

(3) A Western group of three men—Bickerton (leader), Hodgeman, and Whetter—who were set to travel the coastal highlands west of the Hut. Their plan was to use the air-tractor sledge, and the group's departure was scheduled for early December.

(4) Stillwell, in charge of a Near Eastern Party, was to map the coastline between Cape Denison and the Mertz Glacier-Tongue, dividing the work into two stages. In the first instance, Close and Hodgeman were to assist him; all three acting partly as supports to the other eastern parties working further afield. After returning to the Hut at the end of November for a further supply of stores, he was to set out again with Close and Laseron in order to complete the work.

(4) Stillwell, who was in charge of a Near Eastern team, was supposed to map the coastline between Cape Denison and the Mertz Glacier-Tongue, splitting the task into two phases. First, Close and Hodgeman were to help him; the three of them would also support the other teams working farther away. After coming back to the Hut at the end of November for more supplies, he was set to head out again with Close and Laseron to finish the job.

(5) An Eastern Coastal Party composed of Madigan (leader), McLean and Correll was to start in early November with the object of investigating the coastline beyond the Mertz Glacier.

(5) An Eastern Coastal Party made up of Madigan (leader), McLean, and Correll was set to start in early November to explore the coastline past the Mertz Glacier.

(6) Finally, a Far-Eastern Party, assisted by the dogs, was to push out rapidly overland to the southward of Madigan's party, mapping more distant sections of the coastline, beyond the limit to which the latter party would be likely to reach.

(6) Finally, a Far-Eastern Party, helped by the dogs, was set to quickly move overland to the south of Madigan's group, charting more remote parts of the coastline, beyond where that group would likely be able to go.

As the plans for the execution of such a journey had of necessity to be more provisional than in the case of the others, I determined to undertake it, accompanied by Ninnis and Mertz, both of whom had so ably acquitted themselves throughout the Expedition and, moreover, had always been in charge of the dogs.

As the plans for carrying out this journey had to be more tentative than those for the others, I decided to go for it, accompanied by Ninnis and Mertz, both of whom had performed excellently throughout the Expedition and had always been in charge of the dogs.

November opened with more moderate weather, auguring still better conditions for midsummer. Accordingly November 6 was fixed as the date of final departure for several of the parties. The evening of November 5 was made a special occasion: a farewell dinner, into which everybody entered very heartily.

November started with milder weather, suggesting even better conditions for midsummer. So, November 6 was set as the date for the final departure of several groups. The evening of November 5 was made special: a farewell dinner that everyone fully enjoyed.

On the morning of the 6th, however, we found a strong blizzard raging and the landscape blotted out by drift-snow, which did not clear until the afternoon of the following day.

On the morning of the 6th, however, we encountered a fierce blizzard, and the scenery was completely covered by blowing snow, which didn’t clear up until the afternoon of the next day.

At the first opportunity, Murphy, Hunter and Laseron (supporting the Southern Party) got away, but found the wind so strong at a level of one thousand feet on the glacier that they anchored their sledge and returned to the Hut for the night.

At the first chance, Murphy, Hunter, and Laseron (who were backing the Southern Party) set off, but they encountered such strong winds at a height of one thousand feet on the glacier that they secured their sledge and went back to the Hut for the night.

The next morning saw them off finally and, later in the day, the Near-Eastern Party (Stillwell, Close and Hodgeman) and the Eastern Coastal Party (Madigan, McLean and Correll) got under way, though there was still considerable wind.

The next morning, they finally sent them off, and later in the day, the Near-Eastern Party (Stillwell, Close, and Hodgeman) and the Eastern Coastal Party (Madigan, McLean, and Correll) began their journey, even though the wind was still quite strong.

My own party was to leave on the 9th for, assisted by the dogs, we could easily catch up to the other eastern parties, and it was our intention not to part company with them until all were some distance out on the road together.

My group was set to leave on the 9th because, with the help of the dogs, we could easily catch up to the other eastern groups. We planned to stick together until we were all a good ways down the road.

The wind increased on the 9th and the air became charged with drift, so we felt sure that those who preceded us would still be camped at Aladdin's Cave, and that the best course was to wait.

The wind picked up on the 9th, and the air felt charged with drift, so we were sure that those who came before us were still camped at Aladdin's Cave, and that the best thing to do was to wait.

At this date the penguin rookeries were full of new-laid eggs, and the popular taste inclined towards omelettes, in the production of which Mertz was a past master. I can recall the clamouring throng who pressed round for the final omelette as Mertz officiated at the stove just before we left on the 10th.

At this time, the penguin rookeries were packed with freshly laid eggs, and everyone was craving omelettes, which Mertz was an expert at making. I remember the noisy crowd that gathered around for the last omelette as Mertz cooked at the stove just before we left on the 10th.

It was a beautiful calm afternoon as the sledge mounted up the long icy slopes. The Southern Party (Bage, Webb and Hurley) were a short distance in advance, but by the help of the dogs we were soon abreast of them. Then Bickerton, who had given Bage's party a pull as far as the three-mile post, bade us good-bye and returned to the Hut where he was to remain in charge with Whetter and Hannam until the return of Murphy's party.

It was a beautiful, peaceful afternoon as the sled traveled up the long icy slopes. The Southern Party (Bage, Webb, and Hurley) were a short distance ahead, but with the help of the dogs, we quickly caught up with them. Then Bickerton, who had assisted Bage's group as far as the three-mile post, said goodbye and went back to the Hut, where he would stay in charge with Whetter and Hannam until Murphy's group returned.

At Aladdin's Cave, while some prepared supper, others selected tanks of food from the depot and packed the sledges. After the meal, the Southern Party bade us farewell and set off at a rapid rate, intending to overhaul their supporting party on the same evening at the Cathedral Grotto, eleven and three-quarter miles from the Hut. Many finishing touches had to be put to our three sledges and two teams of dogs, so that the departure was delayed till next morning.

At Aladdin's Cave, while some were getting dinner ready, others were picking out food supplies from the depot and packing the sledges. After the meal, the Southern Party said their goodbyes and left quickly, planning to catch up with their support team later that evening at the Cathedral Grotto, which is eleven and three-quarter miles from the Hut. We still had a lot of last-minute preparations for our three sledges and two dog teams, so our departure got pushed back to the next morning.

We were up betimes and a good start was made before anything came of the overcast sky which had formed during the night. The rendezvous appointed for meeting the others, in case we had not previously caught them up, was eighteen miles south-east of Aladdin's Cave. But, with a view to avoiding crevasses as much as possible, a southerly course was followed for several miles, after which it was directed well to the east. In the meantime the wind had arisen and snow commenced to fall soon after noon. In such weather it was impossible to locate the other parties, so a halt was made and the tent pitched after eight miles.

We got up early and made good progress before the overcast sky that had formed overnight started causing issues. The meeting point for catching up with the others, in case we hadn’t already met them, was eighteen miles southeast of Aladdin's Cave. To avoid crevasses as much as we could, we went south for several miles before turning east. Meanwhile, the wind picked up and snow started falling soon after noon. In these conditions, it was impossible to locate the other groups, so we stopped and set up the tent after covering eight miles.

Five days of wind and drift followed, and for the next two days we remained in camp. Then, on the afternoon of the 13th, the drift became less dense, enabling us to move forward on an approximate course to what was judged to be the vicinity of the rendezvous, where we camped again for three days.

Five days of wind and snow drift followed, and for the next two days we stayed in camp. Then, on the afternoon of the 13th, the drift lightened up, allowing us to move forward on a rough path toward what we thought was close to the meeting point, where we set up camp again for three days.

Comfortably ensconced in the sleeping-bags, we ate only a small ration of food; the savings being carefully put away for a future "rainy day." Outside, the dogs had at first an unpleasant time until they were buried in snow which sheltered them from the stinging wind. Ninnis and Mertz took turns day by day attending to their needs.

Comfortably settled in our sleeping bags, we only ate a small amount of food, saving the rest for a future "rainy day." Outside, the dogs had a rough time at first until they got buried in the snow, which protected them from the biting wind. Ninnis and Mertz alternated daily to take care of their needs.

The monotony and disappointment of delay were just becoming acute when the wind fell off, and the afternoon of November 16 turned out gloriously fine.

The boredom and frustration of waiting were starting to get intense when the wind died down, and the afternoon of November 16 turned out to be beautifully nice.

Several excursions were immediately made in the neighbourhood to seek for the whereabouts of the other parties, but all were unsuccessful. At length it occurred to us that something serious might have happened, so we left our loads and started back at a gallop for Aladdin's Cave with two empty sledges, Mertz careering ahead on skis over the sastrugi field.

Several trips were quickly taken in the area to find out where the other groups were, but none were successful. Eventually, it dawned on us that something serious might have happened, so we dropped our loads and raced back to Aladdin's Cave with two empty sledges, Mertz speeding ahead on skis over the sastrugi field.

Shortly afterwards two black specks were seen away in the north; a glance with the binoculars leaving no doubt as to the identity of the parties. We returned to the loads, and, having picked them up, made a course to the east to intercept the other men.

Shortly after, two black dots appeared in the north; a quick look through the binoculars confirmed who they were. We went back to our gear, picked it up, and headed east to catch up with the others.

It was a happy camp that evening!with the three tents pitched together, while we compared our experiences of the previous six days and made plans for the outward journey.

It was a great camp that evening, with the three tents set up close together, while we shared our experiences from the last six days and made plans for the trip ahead.

Our sledge-meter had already suffered through bumping over rough ice and sastrugi, and an exchange was made with the stronger one on Stillwell's sledge. A quantity of food was also taken over from him and the loads were finally adjusted.

Our sledge-meter had already endured bouncing over rough ice and sastrugi, and we swapped it for the stronger one on Stillwell's sledge. We also took some food from him, and the loads were finally adjusted.

The details and weights of the equipment on the three sledges belonging to my party are sufficiently interesting to be set out at length below. Most of the items were included in the impedimenta of all our parties, but slight variations were necessary to meet particular stances or to satisfy the whim of an individual.

The details and weights of the gear on the three sledges owned by my team are interesting enough to list below in detail. Most of the items were part of the equipment for all our teams, but slight changes were made to accommodate specific situations or to please individual preferences.

TOTAL LOAD

TOTAL LOAD

 The Principal Sledge, 11ft. long, 45 lb.

 Fittings for Same: Instrument-box 7 lb. 5 oz.; cooker-box, 7 lb.
 6 oz.; kerosene-tray, 3 lb.; mast-attachment, 2 lb. 8 oz.; mast, 1 lb.
 16 oz.; spar, 1 lb.  8 oz.; decking (canvas and bamboo), 3 lb. 5 oz.;
 rigging, 7.5 oz.; 5 leather straps, 5 lb.....  77 lb. 6.5 oz.

 Drill Tent, strengthened and attached to poles, also floor-cloth,
 33 lb.  Spare drill cover, 11 lb. 8 oz........ 44 lb. 8   oz.

 Sleeping-bags, 3 one-man bags............ 30 lb. 0   oz.

 Cooking gear: Nansen cooker, 11 lb. 3 oz.; 3 mugs, 1 lb. 8 oz., 2 tins,
 10 oz.; scales, 0.5 oz.; 3 spoons, 1.5 oz.; matches, 13.5 oz., and
 damp-proof tin to hold same, 3.7 oz.; "Primus" heater, full, 3 lb.
 10 oz.; "Primus" prickers, 2.5 oz.; "Primus" repair outfit, 2 oz.;
 kerosene tin openers and pourers, 4.5 oz.; spirit for "Primus" in
 tin, 5 lb. 14 oz., also a ready bottle, full, 1 lb. 5 oz.
........................... 25 lb. 14.2 oz.

 Repair Outfit: Spare copper wire, rivets, needles, thread, etc.,
 1 lb. 14.5 oz.; set of 12 tools, 15.5 oz.; requirements for repairing
 dog-harness and medically treating the dogs, 3 lb. 8 oz
........................ 6 lb. 6 oz.

  Medical Outfit: 6 "Burroughs & Wellcome" first field dressings;
 absorbent cotton wool; boric wool; pleated lint; pleated bandages,
 roll bandages; adhesive tape; liquid collodion; "tabloid" ophthalmic
 drugs for treating snow-blindness; an assortment of "tabloid" drugs
 for general treatment; canvas case containing scissors, forceps,
 artery-forceps, scalpel, surgical needles and silk, etc.
........................... 2 lb. 12.3 oz. Photographic outfit:
 A 1/4-plate, long, extension-camera in a case,
 with special stiffening board and 36 cut films, 4 lb. 4.5 oz.;
 adaptor to accommodate camera to theodolite legs, 2 oz.; a water-tight
 tin with 14 packets, each containing 12 cut films, 3 lb.10 oz.
............................8 lb. 0.5 oz.

 Surveying Requirements: A 3" transit theodolite in case, 5 lb. 14 oz.;
 legs for the same, 3 lb. 6 oz.; sledge-meter, 8 lb.; Tables from
 Nautical Almanack and book of Logarithmic Tables, 1 lb. 3 oz.;
 2 note books, 1 lb. 6 oz.; angle-books, 5 oz.; map-tube, 10 oz.;
 maps, 6.5 oz.; pencils, 1.5 oz.; dividers and rubber, 1.5 oz.;
 protractor and set-square, 0.5 oz.; prismatic compass and clinometer,
 8.5 oz.; sun-compass (Bage's), 1.5 oz......... 22 lb.  0 oz.

 Other Instruments: Zeiss prismatic binoculars X.12, 1 lb. 13.5 oz.;
 hypsometer, 2 lb. 1 oz.; 2 ordinary and 2 small minimum thermometers,
 10 oz.; specimen labels, l oz.............  4 lb. 9.5 oz.

 Rifle, 22-bore with cover and cleaner, 3 lb. 3.7 oz.; ammunition,
 1 lb. 6 oz.; sheath knife, 5.5 oz.; sharpening stone, 1.5 oz.;
 fishing line and hooks, 3.5 oz............. 4 lb. 14.7 oz.

 Waterproof Clothe-bag, 4 lb. 8 oz., containing 9 pairs of finnesko
 stuffed with saennegrass, 21 lb.; extra saennegrass, 3 lb.; 3 private
 kit-bags containing spare clothing, etc., 39 lb.; 4 extra rolls of
 lampwick for lashings, 1 lb. 3.5 oz.......... 64 lb. 3.5 oz.

 Odd gear: Pick, 4 lb. 5 oz.; 2 spades, 8 lb. 4 oz.; ice-axe, 2 lb.
 4 oz.; alpine rope (20 metros) 3 lb.; skis (1 pair), 11 lb.;
 ski-stick, 1 lb. 1 oz.; ski-boots (2 pairs), 6 lb.; attachable
 crampons for the same, 4 lb.; finnesko-crampons (3 pairs), 9 lb.;
 3 man-harnesses, 6 lb. 8 oz.; man-hauling tow-rope, 1 lb. 1 oz.;
 flags, 9.5 oz.; a water-proof bag to hold oddments, 4 lb. 8 oz.
............................ 61 lb. 8.5 oz.

 Beacons: A depot-flag and bamboo pole, 5 lb.; a special metal
 depot-beacon, mast, flag and stays, 16 lb.; 2 damp-proof tins for
 depositing records at depots, 7.5 oz.......... 21 lb. 7.5 oz.

 Other Sledges: A second sledge decked with Venesta boarding and
 fitted with straps..................  55 lb.  0  oz.
 A third sledge, 12 ft. long and strong rope lashings (spare spars
 mentioned elsewhere acting as decking)........  60 lb.  0  oz.

 Fuel: Kerosene, 6 gallons in one-gallon tins.....  60 lb.  0  oz.

 Food: Man Food: 9 weeks'  supplies for 3 men on the ration scale;
 also 25 lb. weight of special foods—'perks'..... 475 lb.  0  oz.

 Dog Food: Dried seal meat, blubber and pemmican; also the weight of
 the tin and bag-containers.............. 700 lb.  0  oz.

 Total........................ 1723 lb. 11.3 oz.
The Principal Sledge, 11 ft. long, 45 lb.

Fittings for Same: Instrument box 7 lb. 5 oz.; cooker box, 7 lb. 6 oz.; kerosene tray, 3 lb.; mast attachment, 2 lb. 8 oz.; mast, 1 lb. 16 oz.; spar, 1 lb. 8 oz.; decking (canvas and bamboo), 3 lb. 5 oz.; rigging, 7.5 oz.; 5 leather straps, 5 lb..... 77 lb. 6.5 oz.

Drill Tent, strengthened and attached to poles, also floor cloth, 33 lb. Spare drill cover, 11 lb. 8 oz........ 44 lb. 8 oz.

Sleeping bags, 3 one-man bags............ 30 lb. 0 oz.

Cooking gear: Nansen cooker, 11 lb. 3 oz.; 3 mugs, 1 lb. 8 oz.; 2 tins, 10 oz.; scales, 0.5 oz.; 3 spoons, 1.5 oz.; matches, 13.5 oz., and damp-proof tin to hold the same, 3.7 oz.; "Primus" heater, full, 3 lb. 10 oz.; "Primus" prickers, 2.5 oz.; "Primus" repair outfit, 2 oz.; kerosene tin openers and pourers, 4.5 oz.; spirit for "Primus" in tin, 5 lb. 14 oz., also a ready bottle, full, 1 lb. 5 oz.
........................... 25 lb. 14.2 oz.

Repair Outfit: Spare copper wire, rivets, needles, thread, etc., 1 lb. 14.5 oz.; set of 12 tools, 15.5 oz.; requirements for repairing dog harness and medically treating the dogs, 3 lb. 8 oz
........................ 6 lb. 6 oz.

Medical Outfit: 6 "Burroughs & Wellcome" first field dressings; absorbent cotton wool; boric wool; pleated lint; pleated bandages, roll bandages; adhesive tape; liquid collodion; "tabloid" ophthalmic drugs for treating snow blindness; an assortment of "tabloid" drugs for general treatment; canvas case containing scissors, forceps, artery-forceps, scalpel, surgical needles and silk, etc.
........................... 2 lb. 12.3 oz. Photographic outfit: A 1/4-plate, long, extension camera in a case, with special stiffening board and 36 cut films, 4 lb. 4.5 oz.; adaptor to accommodate camera to theodolite legs, 2 oz.; a water-tight tin with 14 packets, each containing 12 cut films, 3 lb. 10 oz.
............................ 8 lb. 0.5 oz.

Surveying Requirements: A 3" transit theodolite in case, 5 lb. 14 oz.; legs for the same, 3 lb. 6 oz.; sledge meter, 8 lb.; Tables from Nautical Almanack and book of Logarithmic Tables, 1 lb. 3 oz.; 2 notebooks, 1 lb. 6 oz.; angle books, 5 oz.; map tube, 10 oz.; maps, 6.5 oz.; pencils, 1.5 oz.; dividers and rubber, 1.5 oz.; protractor and set-square, 0.5 oz.; prismatic compass and clinometer, 8.5 oz.; sun compass (Bage's), 1.5 oz......... 22 lb. 0 oz.

Other Instruments: Zeiss prismatic binoculars X.12, 1 lb. 13.5 oz.; hypsometer, 2 lb. 1 oz.; 2 ordinary and 2 small minimum thermometers, 10 oz.; specimen labels, 1 oz............. 4 lb. 9.5 oz.

Rifle, 22-bore with cover and cleaner, 3 lb. 3.7 oz.; ammunition, 1 lb. 6 oz.; sheath knife, 5.5 oz.; sharpening stone, 1.5 oz.; fishing line and hooks, 3.5 oz............. 4 lb. 14.7 oz.

Waterproof cloth bag, 4 lb. 8 oz., containing 9 pairs of finnesko stuffed with saennegrass, 21 lb.; extra saennegrass, 3 lb.; 3 private kit bags containing spare clothing, etc., 39 lb.; 4 extra rolls of lampwick for lashings, 1 lb. 3.5 oz.......... 64 lb. 3.5 oz.

Odd gear: Pick, 4 lb. 5 oz.; 2 spades, 8 lb. 4 oz.; ice axe, 2 lb. 4 oz.; alpine rope (20 meters) 3 lb.; skis (1 pair), 11 lb.; ski stick, 1 lb. 1 oz.; ski boots (2 pairs), 6 lb.; attachable crampons for the same, 4 lb.; finnesko-crampons (3 pairs), 9 lb.; 3 man harnesses, 6 lb. 8 oz.; man hauling tow rope, 1 lb. 1 oz.; flags, 9.5 oz.; a waterproof bag to hold oddments, 4 lb. 8 oz.
............................ 61 lb. 8.5 oz.

Beacons: A depot flag and bamboo pole, 5 lb.; a special metal depot beacon, mast, flag and stays, 16 lb.; 2 damp-proof tins for depositing records at depots, 7.5 oz.......... 21 lb. 7.5 oz.

Other Sledges: A second sledge decked with Venesta boarding and fitted with straps.................. 55 lb. 0 oz.
A third sledge, 12 ft. long and strong rope lashings (spare spars mentioned elsewhere acting as decking)........ 60 lb. 0 oz.

Fuel: Kerosene, 6 gallons in one-gallon tins..... 60 lb. 0 oz.

Food: Man Food: 9 weeks' supplies for 3 men on the ration scale; also 25 lb. weight of special foods—'perks'..... 475 lb. 0 oz.

Dog Food: Dried seal meat, blubber and pemmican; also the weight of the tin and bag containers.................. 700 lb. 0 oz.

Total........................ 1723 lb. 11.3 oz.

Madigan's and Stillwell's parties broke trail to the east on the morning of the 17th while we were still attending to the sledges and dogs preparatory to departure. It was decided that Gadget, a rather miserable animal, who had shown herself useless as a puller thus far, should be killed. The following dogs then remained:—Basilisk, Shackleton, Ginger Bitch, Franklin, John Bull, Mary, Haldane, Pavlova, Fusilier, Jappy, Ginger, George, Johnson, Castor, Betli and Blizzard.

Madigan's and Stillwell's groups headed east on the morning of the 17th while we were still getting the sledges and dogs ready to leave. It was decided that Gadget, a pretty miserable animal who had proven to be useless as a puller so far, should be put down. The following dogs remained:—Basilisk, Shackleton, Ginger Bitch, Franklin, John Bull, Mary, Haldane, Pavlova, Fusilier, Jappy, Ginger, George, Johnson, Castor, Betli, and Blizzard.

We went in pursuit of the other six men over a surface of rough sastrugi. The dogs, who were in fine fettle, rushed the sledges along, making frantic efforts to catch up to the parties ahead, who showed as black specks across the white undulating plain.

We chased after the other six men across a rough surface of sastrugi. The dogs, excited and full of energy, pulled the sledges quickly, desperately trying to catch up to the groups ahead, which looked like dark dots against the white, wavy landscape.

At noon all lunched together, after which we separated, shaking hands warmly all round and interchanging the sledgers' "Good luck!" Our dogs drew away rapidly to the east, travelling on a slight down grade; the other two parties with their man-hauled sledges following in the same direction. The surface was splendid, the weather conditions were ideal, the pace, if anything, too rapid, for capsizes were apt to occur in racing over high sastrugi. Any doubts as to the capability of the dogs to pull the loads were dispelled; in fact, on this and on many subsequent occasions, two of us were able to sit, each one on a sledge, while the third broke trail ahead.

At noon, we all had lunch together, then we parted ways, shaking hands warmly and exchanging the sledders' "Good luck!" Our dogs quickly took off to the east, moving down a slight slope; the other two groups with their man-hauled sleds followed the same path. The surface was excellent, the weather was perfect, and the pace was, if anything, a bit too fast, as tipping over was likely when racing over tall sastrugi. Any doubts about the dogs' ability to pull the loads were gone; in fact, on this and many later occasions, two of us could sit on sledges while the third person broke trail ahead.

In sledging over wide, monotonous wastes with dogs as the motive power, it is necessary to have a forerunner, that is, somebody to go ahead and point the way, otherwise the dogs will run aimlessly about. Returning over old tracks, they will pull along steadily and keep a course. In Adelie Land we had no opportunity of verifying this, as the continuous winds soon obliterated the impression of the runners.

In crossing vast, featureless areas with dogs pulling the sled, it's important to have a leader, meaning someone to go ahead and show the way; otherwise, the dogs will wander aimlessly. When retracing old trails, they will pull along steadily and follow a path. In Adelie Land, we couldn't confirm this because the constant winds quickly erased the marks left by the sled runners.

If the weather is reasonably good and food is ample, sledging dogs enjoy their work. Their desire to pull is doubtless inborn, implanted in a long line of ancestors who have faithfully served the Esquimaux. We found that the dogs were glad to get their harnesses on and to be led away to the sledge. Really, it was often a case of the dog leading the man, for, as soon as its harness was in place, the impatient animal strained to drag whatever might be attached to the other end of the rope. Before attaching a team of dogs to a sledge, it was necessary to anchor the latter firmly, otherwise in their ardour they would make off with it before everything was ready.

If the weather is decent and there's plenty of food, sled dogs love their job. Their instinct to pull is definitely natural, passed down from generations of ancestors who have reliably served the Eskimos. We noticed that the dogs were eager to put on their harnesses and get taken to the sled. Often, it felt like the dog was leading the person, because as soon as the harness was on, the eager animal was ready to pull whatever was attached to the other end of the rope. Before hooking up a team of dogs to a sled, it was important to secure the sled firmly; otherwise, in their excitement, they would take off with it before everything was set.

There can be no question as to the value of dogs as a means of traction in the Polar regions, except when travelling continuously over very rugged country, over heavily crevassed areas, or during unusually bad weather. It is in such special stances that the superiority of man-hauling has been proved. Further, in an enterprise where human life is always at stake, it is only fair to put forward the consideration that the dogs represent a reserve of food in case of extreme emergency.

There’s no doubt about the importance of dogs for pulling sleds in the Polar regions, except when navigating extremely rough terrain, heavily crevassed areas, or during really bad weather. It's in these specific situations that the advantages of human hauling have been demonstrated. Additionally, in a venture where human lives are always at risk, it’s worth noting that the dogs can serve as a backup food source in case of dire emergencies.

We continued due eastwards until five o'clock on the afternoon of the 17th at an altitude of two thousand six hundred feet. On the crest of a ridge, which bore away in distinct outline, on our left, a fine panorama of coastal scenery was visible. Far off on the eastern horizon the Mertz Glacier Tongue discovered itself in a long wall touched in luminous bands by the south-western sun. A wide valley fell away in front, and beyond it was a deep indentation of the coastline, which would make it necessary for us to follow a more southerly course in order to round its head.

We continued heading due east until five o'clock in the afternoon of the 17th at an altitude of two thousand six hundred feet. On the crest of a ridge to our left, a beautiful view of coastal scenery was visible. Far off on the eastern horizon, the Mertz Glacier Tongue appeared as a long wall illuminated by luminous bands from the southwestern sun. A wide valley dropped away in front of us, and beyond it was a deep indentation in the coastline, which meant we would need to take a more southerly route to go around its head.

I determined to convey to the other parties my intentions, which had become more defined on seeing this view; and, in the meantime, we halted and treated ourselves to afternoon tea. This innovation in the ordinary routine was extended to a custom by saving a portion of the lunch ration for a "snack" at 5 P.M. on all days when the weather was moderately good. As latitude sights were required at midday and longitude shots at 5 P.M., the arrangement was very convenient, for, while one of us made tea, the other two took the observations.

I decided to share my intentions with the others, which had become clearer after seeing this view; and in the meantime, we took a break and enjoyed some afternoon tea. This change in our usual routine soon became a custom by saving part of the lunch ration for a "snack" at 5 P.M. on days when the weather was decent. Since we needed to take latitude readings at noon and longitude readings at 5 P.M., this arrangement was really convenient—while one of us prepared the tea, the other two took the measurements.

About 6 P.M. the two man-hauled sledges came up with us, our plans for the future were reviewed and the final instructions were given. We bade our comrades adieu and, turning to the south-east, descended quickly down a long slope leading into the valley. The sky was overcast and it was almost impossible to see the irregularities of the surface. Only a dull-white glare met the eyes, and the first indication of a hillock was to stub one's toes against it, or of a depression to fall into it. We pulled up the dogs at 7.30 P.M. after covering thirteen and a quarter miles in the day.

About 6 P.M., the two sledges being pulled by men caught up with us. We reviewed our plans for the future and gave final instructions. We said goodbye to our teammates and, turning southeast, quickly went down a long slope into the valley. The sky was cloudy, making it nearly impossible to see the uneven ground. All we could see was a dull white glare, and the first sign of a bump was stubbing our toes against it, while the only way to notice a dip was to fall into it. We stopped with the dogs at 7:30 P.M. after covering thirteen and a quarter miles for the day.

At 9.45 A.M. on November 18 everything was ready for a fresh start. The other parties could be seen rapidly bearing down on us under full sail, but our willing teams had soon dragged the three sledges over an eminence and out of their sight.

At 9:45 A.M. on November 18, everything was set for a fresh start. The other groups were quickly approaching us with their sails fully deployed, but our eager teams quickly pulled the three sledges up a hill and out of their view.

It was a lovely day; almost like a dream after the lengthy months of harassing blizzards. A venturesome skua gull appeared at lunch time, just as an observation for latitude was being taken. By the time Ninnis had unpacked the rifle the bird had flown away.

It was a beautiful day, almost like a dream after the long months of relentless blizzards. A bold skua gull showed up at lunchtime, right when they were taking a latitude reading. By the time Ninnis unpacked the rifle, the bird had already flown away.

The direction of the sastrugi was found to vary from that which obtained farther west, owing to a slight swing in the direction of the prevailing wind. The irregularities in the coastline account for this; the wind tending to flow down to sea-level by the nearest route.

The direction of the sastrugi was found to differ from that in the areas farther west, due to a slight shift in the prevailing wind's direction. The irregularities in the coastline explain this; the wind tends to flow down to sea level by the shortest route.

To the north-west, behind us, a projecting ridge of rock—Madigan Nunatak—came into sight. From the camp of the previous evening it had evidently been hidden from view by an undulation in the surface.

To the northwest, behind us, a jutting ridge of rock—Madigan Nunatak—came into view. From the campsite we had the night before, it was clearly obscured by a bump in the landscape.

During the afternoon it was noted that the surface had become very deeply eroded by the wind, troughs three feet in depth being common, into which the sledges frequently capsized. Each of us took it in turn to run ahead, jumping from one sastruga to another. As these were firm and polished by the constant wind, one often slipped with a sudden shock to the ground. Our bodies were well padded with clothing and we were beginning to get into good form, so that these habitual tumbles were taken with the best grace we could muster. I surprised myself during the afternoon, when my turn came as forerunner, by covering two and a half miles at a jog-trot without a break. The grade was slightly downhill and the sledges moved along of their own accord, accelerated by jerks from the dogs, gliding at right angles to the knife-edge crests of the snow-waves.

During the afternoon, we noticed that the surface had become really worn down by the wind, with troughs three feet deep being common, which made the sledges tip over often. We all took turns running ahead, jumping from one sastruga to another. Since these were solid and smoothed by the constant wind, it was easy to slip and fall to the ground unexpectedly. We were well bundled up in clothing and starting to get into good shape, so we took these regular falls with as much grace as we could manage. I surprised myself in the afternoon during my turn as the leader by covering two and a half miles at a jog without pausing. The terrain was slightly downhill, and the sledges moved along by themselves, getting a boost from the dogs, gliding at right angles to the sharp edges of the snow waves.

The roughness of the surface was not without its effect on the sledge-meter, which had to be repaired temporarily. It was a matter of some inconvenience that after this date its records were erroneous and approximate distances were only obtained by checking the readings against absolute observations made for latitude and longitude.

The roughness of the surface did affect the sledge-meter, which needed temporary repairs. It was a bit inconvenient that after this point, its records were inaccurate, and only rough distances could be determined by comparing the readings with precise observations for latitude and longitude.

At 5.30 P.M. a dark object stood in salient relief above the white contour of the snowy sky-line on the right. Suppressing our excitement, we pressed on eagerly, changing course so as to approach it. At nine o'clock it resolved itself into the summit of an imposing mountain rising up from a mysterious valley. Aurora Peak, as it was named, was to be a prominent landmark for several days to come.

At 5:30 P.M., a dark shape stood out sharply against the white outline of the snowy skyline on the right. Getting our excitement under control, we eagerly continued, adjusting our path to get closer to it. By nine o'clock, it turned into the peak of a majestic mountain rising from a mysterious valley. Aurora Peak, as it was called, would be a significant landmark for the next few days.

All were ready to be on the move at 8.45 A.M. on November 19. While Mertz and Ninnis built a cairn of snow, I wrote a note to be left on it in a tin, containing instructions to Stillwell in case he should happen on the locality.

All were set to leave at 8:45 A.M. on November 19. While Mertz and Ninnis built a snow cairn, I wrote a note to be left in a tin on it, with instructions for Stillwell in case he came across the area.

The weather was good and the temperatures were high, ranging at this time (one month from midsummer) between zero and 18 degrees F. When we camped for lunch the air was quite calm and the sun's rays were extremely warm.

The weather was nice and the temperatures were high, at this time (one month from midsummer) ranging between 0 and 18 degrees F. When we stopped to have lunch, the air was really calm and the sun felt very warm.

The surface became softer and smoother as the afternoon lengthened until Mertz was tempted to put on his skis. He then became forerunner for the remainder of the day.

The surface grew softer and smoother as the afternoon stretched on until Mertz felt tempted to put on his skis. He then became the forerunner for the rest of the day.

Mertz, who was skilled in the use of skis, found them of great service on this and on many future occasions. At such times he would relieve Ninnis and myself in the van. On the other hand, over deeply furrowed sastrugi or blue ice, or during a strong wind, unless it were at our backs, skiing was impossible.

Mertz, who was great at skiing, found them really useful on this and many future occasions. During those times, he would take over from Ninnis and me in the van. However, when it came to deeply furrowed sastrugi or blue ice, or in strong winds—unless the wind was at our backs—skiing was out of the question.

Owing to a steeper down grade, the sledges were now commencing to run more freely and improvised brakes were tried, all of which were ineffectual in restraining the dogs. The pace became so hot that a small obstacle would capsize the sledge, causing it to roll over and over down the slope. The dogs, frantically pulling in various directions to keep ahead of the load, became hopelessly entangled in their traces and were dragged along unresistingly until the sledge stopped of its own accord or was arrested by one of us. At length, most of the dogs were allowed to run loose, and, with a man holding on behind and a couple of dogs pulling ahead, the loads were piloted down a steep slope for several miles.

Due to a steeper downhill grade, the sledges were starting to run more freely, and makeshift brakes were attempted, all of which failed to restrain the dogs. The speed increased so much that even a small obstacle could flip the sledge, causing it to roll down the slope repeatedly. The dogs, desperately trying to pull in different directions to stay ahead of the load, became hopelessly tangled in their harnesses and were dragged along without resistance until the sledge stopped by itself or was brought to a halt by one of us. Eventually, most of the dogs were allowed to run free, and with one person holding on to the back and a couple of dogs pulling ahead, the loads were navigated down a steep slope for several miles.

The evening camp was situated at the crest of the last but steepest fall into a wide glacial valley which was clearly seen to sweep northwards past the eastern side of Aurora Peak. Looking back we could define our track winding down in the bed of a long shallow valley, while, uprising on either hand near the rim of the plateau were crevassed bluffs where the ice of the tableland streamed abruptly over the underlying crags.

The evening camp was located at the top of the last but steepest drop into a wide glacial valley that clearly stretched northward past the eastern side of Aurora Peak. Looking back, we could see our path winding down in the bed of a long, shallow valley, while steep cliffs on either side near the edge of the plateau had crevasses where the ice from the tableland suddenly flowed over the underlying rocks.

Ninnis had a touch of snow-blindness which rapidly improved under treatment. The stock cure for this very irritating and painful affection is to place first of all tiny "tabloids" of zinc sulphate and cocaine hydrochloride under the eyelids where they quickly dissolve in the tears, alleviating the smarting, "gritty" sensation which is usually described by the sufferer. He then bandages the eyes and escapes, if he is lucky, into the darkness of his sleeping-bag.

Ninnis had a bit of snow-blindness, but it quickly got better with treatment. The standard remedy for this annoying and painful condition is to put small tablets of zinc sulfate and cocaine hydrochloride under the eyelids, where they dissolve quickly in tears, easing the stinging, gritty feeling that people often describe. Then he wraps a bandage around his eyes and, if he’s lucky, escapes into the darkness of his sleeping bag.

In certain lights one is sure to be attacked more or less severely, and coloured glasses should be worn continually. Unfortunately, goggles are sometimes impracticable on account of the moisture from the breath covering the glasses with an icy film or driving snow clogging them and obscuring the view. For such contingencies narrow slots of various shapes are cut in plates or discs of wood or bone in the Esquimaux fashion. The amount of light reaching the eye can thus be reduced to the limit of moderately clear vision.

In some lighting conditions, you’re bound to be impacted more or less seriously, and colored glasses should be worn all the time. Unfortunately, goggles can be impractical because the moisture from your breath can frost over the lenses or snow can accumulate and block your view. To deal with these issues, narrow slots of different shapes are cut into wooden or bone plates, similar to how the Eskimos do it. This way, the amount of light that reaches your eyes can be minimized to a level that allows for fairly clear vision.

The morning of the 20th broke with wind and drift which persisted until after noon. Already everything had been packed up, but, as there was a steep fall in front and crevasses were not far distant, we decided not to start until the air was clear of snow.

The morning of the 20th started with wind and blowing snow that continued until after noon. Everything was already packed up, but since there was a steep drop ahead and crevasses nearby, we chose to wait until the air was clear of snow before we set out.

When at last a move was possible, it became evident that the dogs could not be trusted to pull the sledges down to the edge of the glacier. So they were tethered to ice-axes while we lowered the sledges one by one, all three checking their speed, assisted by rope brakes round the runners. Finally, the impatient dogs were brought down and harnessed in their accustomed places.

When we could finally move, it was clear that we couldn't trust the dogs to pull the sledges to the glacier's edge. So, we tied them to ice axes while we lowered the sledges one by one, all three of us controlling their speed with rope brakes around the runners. Eventually, the restless dogs were brought down and harnessed in their usual spots.

Rapid travelling now commenced over a perfectly smooth surface, sloping gently to the bed of the glacier. Mertz shot ahead on skis, and our column of dogs and sledges followed quickly in his trail.

Rapid traveling now began over a perfectly smooth surface, sloping gently to the glacier's base. Mertz sped ahead on skis, and our line of dogs and sledges quickly followed in his wake.

From this day forward our "order of procession" was as follows:—Behind the forerunner came a team of dogs dragging two sledges joined together by a short length of alpine rope. Bringing up the rear were the rest of the dogs dragging the third sledge. Each team pulled approximately equal weights; the front load being divided between two sledges. Except when taking my turn ahead, I looked after the leading team, Ninnis or Mertz, as the case might be, driving the one behind.

From this day on, our "order of procession" was as follows: Behind the forerunner came a team of dogs pulling two sledges that were connected by a short piece of alpine rope. Bringing up the rear were the other dogs pulling the third sledge. Each team pulled roughly equal weights, with the front load split between the two sledges. Except when it was my turn at the front, I looked after the leading team, whether it was Ninnis or Mertz, while driving the one behind.

We skirted Aurora Peak on its south-eastern side. The mountain rose to a height of about seventeen hundred feet on our left, its steep sides being almost completely snow-clad.

We passed by the southeastern side of Aurora Peak. The mountain rose to around seventeen hundred feet to our left, its steep sides almost entirely covered in snow.

The wide depression of the Mertz Glacier lay ahead, and on its far side the dim outline of uprising icy slopes was visible, though at the time we could not be certain as to their precise nature.

The broad dip of the Mertz Glacier was ahead, and on the other side, the faint silhouette of rising icy slopes could be seen, although we couldn't be sure of their exact characteristics at that moment.

As the sledges passed Aurora Peak, Blizzard and Ginger Bitch ran alongside. The former had hurt one of her forefeet on the previous day during the "rough-and-tumble" descending into the valley. Ginger Bitch was allowed to go free because she was daily expected to give birth to pups. As she was such a good sledge-dog we could not have afforded to leave her behind at the Hut, and later events proved that the work seemed actually to benefit her, for she was at all times the best puller and the strongest of the pack. However, in permitting both dogs to run loose that afternoon, there was an element of danger which we had not sufficiently appreciated.

As the sleds passed Aurora Peak, Blizzard and Ginger Bitch ran alongside. Blizzard had injured one of her front feet the day before while roughhousing down into the valley. Ginger Bitch was allowed to run free because she was expected to give birth to puppies any day now. Since she was such an excellent sled dog, we couldn't leave her behind at the Hut, and later events showed that working seemed to actually benefit her, as she was always the best puller and the strongest in the pack. However, by letting both dogs run loose that afternoon, we faced a risk that we didn’t fully consider.

Suddenly, without any warning, half of my dogs dropped out of sight, swinging on their harness ropes in a crevasse. Next moment I realized that the sledges were in the centre of a bridge covering a crevasse, twenty-five feet wide, along the edge of which part of the team had broken through.

Suddenly, without any warning, half of my dogs vanished from view, swinging on their harness ropes in a crevasse. The next moment, I realized that the sledges were in the middle of a bridge covering a twenty-five-foot-wide crevasse, along the edge of which part of the team had fallen through.

We spent many anxious moments before they were all hauled to the daylight and the sledge rested on solid ground. There were other crevasses about and almost immediately afterwards Ginger Bitch and Blizzard had broken through into a fissure and were frantically struggling to maintain their hold on the edge. They were speedily rescued; following which Ginger Bitch gave birth to the first of a large litter of pups. After this second accident we decided to camp.

We spent a lot of anxious moments until they were finally pulled into the daylight and the sled was on solid ground. There were other crevasses nearby, and soon afterward, Ginger Bitch and Blizzard fell into a crack and were desperately trying to hold onto the edge. They were quickly rescued; after that, Ginger Bitch gave birth to the first of a large litter of puppies. After this second accident, we decided to set up camp.

During the morning of November 21 there was a good deal of wind and drift which made travelling rather miserable. Occasionally open crevasses would break the surface of the snow.

During the morning of November 21, there was a lot of wind and drifting snow, which made traveling quite unpleasant. Occasionally, open crevasses would appear on the surface of the snow.

When the light at last improved, a nunatak was observed some fifteen miles or more to the south rising out of the glacier—Correll Nunatak. Ahead of us was a glittering line of broken ice, stretching at right angles to our path. Studded about on the icy plain were immense cauldrons, like small craters in appearance. Then an area dotted over with ice mounds approached and crevasses became correspondingly more numerous. The dogs frequently broke through them but were easily extricated in every instance.

When the light finally got better, we saw a nunatak about fifteen miles or more to the south rising out of the glacier—Correll Nunatak. In front of us was a shining line of broken ice, stretching straight across our path. Scattered across the icy plain were huge depressions that looked like small craters. Then we reached an area filled with ice mounds, and the crevasses became much more frequent. The dogs often fell into them but were easily rescued each time.

Camp was pitched for lunch in the vicinity of many gaping holes leading down into darkness, places where the bridges over large crevasses had fallen in. Mertz prepared the lunch and Ninnis and I went to photograph an open crevasse near by. Returning, we diverged on reaching the back of the tent, he passing round on one side and I on the other. The next instant I heard a bang on the ice and, swinging round, could see nothing of my companion but his head and arms. He had broken through the lid of a crevasse fifteen feet wide and was hanging on to its edge close to where the camera lay damaged on the ice. He was soon dragged into safety. Looking down into the black depths we realized how narrowly he had escaped. As the tent was found to encroach partly on the same crevasse, it may be imagined that we did not dally long over the meal.

Camp was set up for lunch near several gaping holes leading into darkness, where the bridges over large crevasses had collapsed. Mertz made lunch while Ninnis and I went to take photos of an open crevasse nearby. When we returned, we split up as we reached the back of the tent; he went around one side and I went around the other. The next moment, I heard a loud noise on the ice and, turning around, I could see nothing of my friend except his head and arms. He had fallen through the lid of a crevasse that was fifteen feet wide and was hanging on the edge close to where the camera lay broken on the ice. He was quickly pulled to safety. Looking down into the black abyss, we realized how close he had come to falling in. Since the tent was found to be partly over the same crevasse, it's safe to say we didn't linger over our meal.

In the afternoon the weather became clear and fine, but, as if to offset this, the broken surface became impassable. The region was one of serac where the glacier was puckered up, folded and crushed. After several repulses in what seemed to be promising directions, we were finally forced to camp, having ten miles to our credit.

In the afternoon, the weather turned clear and nice, but, to counter this, the rough terrain became impossible to navigate. The area was filled with serac, where the glacier was crumpled, folded, and smashed. After several setbacks while exploring what looked like promising routes, we finally had to set up camp, having only covered ten miles.

Whilst Mertz fed the dogs and prepared hoosh, Ninnis and I roped up and went off to search for a passage.

While Mertz fed the dogs and made hoosh, Ninnis and I got our gear ready and headed off to look for a passage.

All around, the glacier was pressed up into great folds, two hundred feet in height and between one quarter and a third of a mile from crest to crest. The ridges of the folds were either domes or open rifts partly choked with snow. Precipitous ice-falls and deep cauldrons were encountered everywhere. To the north the glacier flattened out; to the south it was more rugged.

All around, the glacier rose into huge folds, two hundred feet high and between a quarter and a third of a mile from peak to peak. The ridges of the folds were either dome-shaped or open cracks partially filled with snow. Steep ice falls and deep basins were found everywhere. To the north, the glacier flattened out; to the south, it was more rugged.

In this chaos we wandered for some miles until a favourable line of advance had been discovered for the march on the following day.

In this chaos, we wandered for several miles until we found a good route to take for the march the next day.

The first three miles, on the 22nd, were over a piece of very dangerous country, after which our prospects improved and we came to the border of a level plain.

The first three miles, on the 22nd, were across some really dangerous terrain, but then our situation got better and we reached the edge of a flat plain.

There Mertz slipped on his skis, went ahead and set a good pace. Although the sky had become overcast and snow fell fitfully, our progress was rapid towards the rising slopes of the land on the eastern side of the glacier. Over the last three miles of the day's journey the surface was raised in large, pimply masses surrounded by wide fissures. Into one of the fissures, bridged by snow, Ninnis's sledge fell, but fortunately jammed itself just below the surface. As it was, we had a long job getting it up again, having to unpack the sledge in the crevasse until it was light enough to be easily manipulated. Despite the delay, our day's run was sixteen and a half miles.

There Mertz put on his skis, moved ahead, and set a good pace. Even though the sky was overcast and snow was falling sporadically, we made good progress toward the rising slopes on the eastern side of the glacier. Over the last three miles of the day's journey, the surface rose in large, lumpy masses surrounded by wide cracks. Ninnis's sled fell into one of the cracks, but luckily it got stuck just below the surface. As it was, we had a long task getting it back up, having to unpack the sled in the crevasse until it was light enough to handle easily. Despite the delay, we covered sixteen and a half miles for the day.

At 8 A.M. on the 23rd everything was in readiness for a fresh start. Moderate drift and wind descended from the hills and there were yet three miles of hidden perils to be passed. With the object of making our advance less dangerous, various devices were employed.

At 8 A.M. on the 23rd, everything was set for a new beginning. A gentle breeze and some drift came down from the hills, and we still had three miles of hidden dangers to navigate. To make our progress safer, we used various methods.

First of all the towing rope of the rear sledge was secured to the back of the preceding sledge. This arrangement had to be abandoned because the dogs of Ninnis's team persisted in entangling themselves and working independently of the dogs in front. Next, all the sledges were joined together with all the dogs pulling in front. The procession was then so long that it was quite unmanageable on account of the tortuous nature of our track through the labyrinth. In the long run, it was decided that our original method was the best, provided that special precautions were taken over the more hazardous crossings.

First of all, the towing rope of the back sledge was attached to the rear of the previous sledge. This setup had to be scrapped because Ninnis's team's dogs kept getting tangled and working separately from the dogs in front. Next, all the sledges were connected together with all the dogs pulling in front. The line became so long that it was really hard to manage because of the winding path we had to navigate. Ultimately, it was agreed that our original method was the best, as long as we took extra precautions over the more dangerous crossings.

The usual procedure was, that the forerunner selected the best crossing of a crevasse, testing it with a ski-stick. The dog teams were then brought up to the spot and the forerunner went over the snow-bridge and stood on the other side, sufficiently far away to allow the first team to cross to him and to clear the crevasse. Then the second team was piloted to safety before the forerunner had resumed his position in front. This precaution was very necessary, for otherwise the dogs in the rear would make a course direct for wherever the front dogs happened to be, cutting across corners and most probably dragging their sledge sideways into a crevasse; the likeliest way to lose it altogether.

The usual procedure was that the lead person would pick the best spot to cross a crevasse, checking it with a ski pole. The dog teams would then be brought to that location, and the lead would cross the snow bridge and stand on the other side, far enough away to let the first team cross over and clear the crevasse. After that, the second team would be guided to safety before the lead resumed his place in front. This precaution was very important because otherwise, the dogs at the back would head straight for wherever the front dogs were, cutting across corners and likely pulling their sled sideways into a crevasse, which was the quickest way to lose everything.

Often enough the dogs broke through the snow-bridges on the morning of the 23rd, but only once were matters serious, when Ninnis's sledge, doubtless on account of its extra weight, again broke through a lid of snow and was securely jammed in a crevasse just below the surface.

Often enough, the dogs broke through the snow bridges on the morning of the 23rd, but only once was it serious, when Ninnis's sled, likely due to its extra weight, broke through a layer of snow and got stuck in a crevasse just below the surface.

On this occasion we were in a serious predicament, for the sledge was in such a position that an unskilful movement would have sent it hurling into the chasm below. So the unpacking of the load was a tedious and delicate operation. The freight consisted chiefly of large, soldered tins, packed tightly with dried seal meat. Each of these weighed about ninety pounds and all were most securely roped to the sledge. The sledge was got up and reloaded without the loss of a single tin, and once more we breathed freely.

On this occasion, we found ourselves in a serious situation because the sled was positioned in such a way that any wrong move could send it crashing into the abyss below. So, unpacking the load became a slow and careful task. The cargo mainly consisted of large, sealed tins packed tightly with dried seal meat. Each tin weighed about ninety pounds, and they were all securely tied to the sled. We managed to lift the sled and reload it without losing a single tin, and once again, we could breathe easily.

A valley almost free of crevasses was chosen as the upward track to the plateau. We threw in our weight hauling with the dogs, and had a long, steep drag over furrowed neve, pitching the tent after a day's journey of twelve miles.

A valley nearly clear of crevasses was chosen as the path up to the plateau. We put in our effort, pulling alongside the dogs, and had a long, steep haul over rippled snow, setting up the tent after a day's trek of twelve miles.

On waking up on November 24 I found that my watch had stopped. I had been so tired on the previous evening that I had fallen asleep without remembering to wind it. The penalty of this accident was paid in my being forced to take an extra set of observations in order to start the watch again at correct time relative to the Hut.

On waking up on November 24, I discovered that my watch had stopped. I had been so tired the night before that I fell asleep without remembering to wind it. The consequence of this mishap was having to take an extra set of observations to restart the watch at the correct time relative to the Hut.

Besides the observations for position, necessary for navigation, sets of angles were taken from time to time to fix the positions of objects of interest appearing within the field of view, while the magnetic variation was obtained at intervals. In this work Ninnis always assisted me. Mertz boiled the hypsometer when necessary to ascertain our elevation above sea-level. The meteorological conditions were carefully noted several times each day for future comparison with those of other parties and of Winter Quarters.

Besides the observations for position, which were necessary for navigation, we occasionally took sets of angles to determine the locations of interesting objects within our view, while magnetic variation was measured at intervals. Ninnis always helped me with this work. Mertz boiled the hypsometer as needed to check our elevation above sea level. We carefully recorded the weather conditions several times a day for future comparison with those of other teams and Winter Quarters.

The day's work on November 24 brought us high up on the slopes. Away to the north-west Aurora Peak was still visible, standing up like a mighty beacon pointing the way back to the Hut. Below lay the Mertz Glacier extending out to sea as a floating tongue beyond the horizon. Inland, some twenty miles to the south, it mounted up in seamed and riven "cataracts" to a smooth, broad and shallow groove which wound into the ice-cap. Ahead, on our south-east course, the ground still rose, but to the north-east the ice-sheet fell away in long wide valleys, at the extremity of some of which icebergs were visible frozen into distant sea-ice.

The day's work on November 24 took us high up the slopes. To the north-west, Aurora Peak was still visible, standing like a giant beacon guiding us back to the Hut. Below, the Mertz Glacier stretched out to sea like a floating tongue disappearing beyond the horizon. Inland, about twenty miles to the south, it rose in jagged "cataracts" to a smooth, wide, and shallow groove that wound into the ice cap. Ahead, on our south-east path, the ground continued to rise, but to the north-east, the ice sheet descended into long, wide valleys, where icebergs could be seen frozen into distant sea ice.

The tent was raised at 10 P.M. in a forty-mile wind with light drift; temperature 10 degrees F. The altitude of this camp was two thousand three hundred and fifty feet.

The tent was set up at 10 P.M. in a forty-mile wind with light snow; temperature 10 degrees F. The altitude of this camp was two thousand three hundred and fifty feet.

One of the worst features of drift overnight is that sledges and dogs become buried in snow and have to be dug out in the morning. Thus on the 25th it was 10 A.M. before we got away in a strong wind, with flying snow, across fields of sastrugi.

One of the worst things about drifting overnight is that sledges and dogs get buried in snow and have to be dug out in the morning. So on the 25th, it was 10 A.M. before we were able to leave in a strong wind, with snow flying, across fields of sastrugi.

The dogs detested the wind and, as their heads were so near the ground, they must have found the incessant stream of thick drift very tantalizing. The snow became caked over their eyes so that every few minutes they had to scrape it away with their paws or rub their faces on the ground.

The dogs hated the wind, and since their heads were so close to the ground, they must have found the constant pile of heavy snow really frustrating. The snow caked over their eyes, so every few minutes they had to scrape it off with their paws or rub their faces on the ground.

We stopped at 6 P.M. after a miserable day, covering sixteen miles in all.

We stopped at 6 PM after a tough day, covering a total of sixteen miles.

November 26 broke overcast, the light being bad for travelling and the wind still strong. Nevertheless we set out at 10 A.M. through falling snow.

November 26 started off cloudy, making visibility poor for traveling, and the wind was still strong. However, we left at 10 A.M. through the falling snow.

As the day progressed the wind subsided and Mertz was able to put on his skis over a surface which sloped gradually away to the east. The light was diffused uniformly over the irregularities of snow and ice so that depressions only a few feet away were invisible. Black objects, on the other hand, stood out with startling distinctness, and our attention was soon arrested by a hazy, dark patch which appeared in front and to the left. At first there was much doubt as to its nature, but it was soon clear that it must be a group of rocks, apparently situated at a considerable distance. They were subsequently found to be sixty miles away (Organ Pipe Cliffs, near Cape Blake).

As the day went on, the wind died down, and Mertz was able to strap on his skis over a surface that sloped gently to the east. The light spread evenly across the uneven snow and ice, making any dips just a few feet away hard to see. In contrast, black objects stood out sharply, and soon our attention was caught by a hazy, dark spot that appeared in front of us and to the left. At first, we weren’t sure what it was, but it quickly became clear that it must be a group of rocks, seemingly located quite far away. They were later found to be sixty miles off (Organ Pipe Cliffs, near Cape Blake).

Presently our course ended abruptly at the edge of a precipitous fall. We skirted round this for a while, but were ultimately forced to camp owing to the uncertainty of the light and the proximity of several large crevasses.

Right now, our journey ended suddenly at the edge of a steep drop. We navigated around this for a bit, but eventually had to set up camp because the fading light and the closeness of several large cracks made it too risky.

At 11 P.M. the sky cleared and a better idea could be gained of what lay ahead. In a line between our elevated position and the distant rocky outcrops the ice fell in a steep descent to a broad, glacial valley, undulating and in places traversed by torn masses of serac-ice. We examined the country to the east very carefully with a view to selecting a track for the journey next day and finally resolved to pass to the south of a large ice-capped island—Dixson Island, which was only about ten miles to the north-east, set within Ninnis Glacier near its western border

At 11 P.M., the sky cleared, and we could get a clearer view of what was ahead. A line from our elevated spot to the distant rocky outcrops showed the ice dropping steeply into a wide, glacial valley, rolling and sometimes crossed by broken chunks of serac-ice. We carefully looked over the area to the east to choose a route for the next day’s journey and ultimately decided to go south of a large ice-covered island—Dixson Island, which was about ten miles to the northeast, located within Ninnis Glacier near its western edge.

On the 27th Mertz and I roped up, reconnoitred for a while and returned to the sledges. We then spent several hours in advancing a mile over badly broken ground, arriving at a slope covered with sastrugi and descending steeply for one thousand feet into the bed of the glacier.

On the 27th, Mertz and I got ready, scouted for a bit, and then went back to the sledges. We spent several hours moving a mile across rough terrain, finally reaching a slope filled with sastrugi that dropped steeply for a thousand feet into the glacier's basin.

In order the more safely to negotiate this, the dogs were all let loose excepting two in each sledge. Even then the sledges were often uncontrollable, rolling over and over many times before the bottom was reached.

To navigate this more safely, all the dogs were let loose except for two on each sled. Even then, the sleds were often uncontrollable, tumbling over multiple times before finally hitting the ground.

When the dogs were re-harnessed it was found that Betli was missing and was not to be seen when we scanned the slopes in our rear with binoculars. It was expected that unless she had fallen into a crevasse she would turn up at the camp that night. However, she did not reappear, and we saw no more of her. Two other dogs, Jappy and Fusilier, had been previously killed, as neither was of any use as a puller. Blizzard, who had been always a great favourite with us, had to be shot next day.

When the dogs were re-harnessed, we realized that Betli was missing and couldn't be seen when we scanned the slopes behind us with binoculars. We thought that unless she had fallen into a crevasse, she would show up at camp that night. However, she never came back, and we didn't see her again. Two other dogs, Jappy and Fusilier, had already been killed because they were no longer useful as pullers. Blizzard, who had always been a favorite of ours, had to be put down the next day.

When it had reached the edge of the glacier, our path led over a solid ocean rising and faring in billows, two hundred and fifty feet in height; no doubt caused by the glacier in its northward movement being compressed against the southern side of Dixson Island. Still, the "caravan" made considerable progress, ending with a day's journey of sixteen miles.

When we reached the edge of the glacier, our path took us over a solid ocean rising and rolling in waves, two hundred and fifty feet high; this was likely due to the glacier pushing against the southern side of Dixson Island as it moved north. Still, the "caravan" made a lot of progress, completing a day's journey of sixteen miles.

During the small hours of November 28 the wind rose to a velocity of sixty miles per hour, but gradually diminished to a twenty-knot breeze as the day advanced. Light snow fell from a sky which was densely clouded.

During the early hours of November 28, the wind picked up to speeds of sixty miles per hour, but gradually decreased to a twenty-knot breeze as the day went on. Light snow fell from a sky that was heavily overcast.

We still pursued a devious track amid rolling waves of ice, encountering beds of soft snow through which the sledges moved slowly. By 6 P.M. pinnacles and hummocks stood around on every side, and the light was such that one could not distinguish crevasses until he was on top of them. We had to camp and be satisfied with seven miles "to the good." By this time the dogs were in good training and grew noticeably ravenous. In the evening, before they were properly tethered, Shackleton seized a one-week provision bag, ripped it open and ate a block of butter weighing more than two and a half pounds. This was a loss to us, as butter was regarded as a particular delicacy.

We continued on a tricky path through rolling waves of ice, encountering soft snow that slowed the sledges down. By 6 P.M., peaks and mounds surrounded us, and the light was such that you couldn’t see crevasses until you were right on top of them. We had to set up camp, settling for just seven miles covered. By this time, the dogs were well-trained and noticeably hungry. In the evening, before they were properly tied up, Shackleton grabbed a one-week supply bag, tore it open, and ate a block of butter weighing over two and a half pounds. This was a setback for us, as butter was considered a special treat.

The sun was shining brightly next day and it was at once evident that we were in a zone of tumbled and disrupted ice.

The sun was shining brightly the next day, and it was clear right away that we were in an area of broken and chaotic ice.

For many hours a way was won through a mighty turmoil of serac and over innumerable crevasses with varied fortune. Just before lunch my two sledges were nearly lost through the dogs swinging sharply to one side before the second sledge had cleared a rather rotten snow-bridge. I was up with the dogs at the time, and the first intimation I received of an accident was on seeing the dogs and front sledge being dragged backwards; the rear sledge was hanging vertically in a crevasse. Exerting all my strength I held back the front sledge, and in a few moments was joined by Ninnis and Mertz, who soon drove a pick and ice-axe down between the runners and ran out an anchoring rope.

For many hours, we made our way through a huge mess of ice and over countless crevasses with mixed results. Just before lunch, my two sledges almost got lost when the dogs suddenly swerved to one side before the second sledge could cross a rather weak snow-bridge. I was with the dogs at that moment, and the first sign I had of trouble was seeing the dogs and the front sledge being pulled backwards; the rear sledge was hanging straight down in a crevasse. Using all my strength, I held back the front sledge, and moments later, Ninnis and Mertz joined me. They quickly drove a pick and ice-axe between the runners and pulled out an anchoring rope.

It was a ticklish business recovering the sledge which hung suspended in the crevasse. It could not be lifted vertically as its bow was caught in a V-shaped cornice formed by an overhanging mass of snow. To add to our troubles the ground all about the place was precarious and unsafe.

It was a tricky situation getting the sledge out of the crevasse where it was stuck. We couldn't lift it straight up because its front was trapped in a V-shaped ledge created by a hanging snowdrift. To make matters worse, the ground all around was unstable and dangerous.

Mertz and Ninnis therefore lowered me down and I attached a rope to the tail-end of the sledge. The bow-rope and tail-rope were then manipulated alternately until the bow of the sledge was manoeuvred slowly through the gaping hole in the snow-lid and was finally hauled up on to level ground. No more remarkable test of the efficiency of the sledge straps and the compactness of the load could have been made.

Mertz and Ninnis lowered me down, and I fastened a rope to the back of the sled. They then took turns manipulating the front and back ropes until the front of the sled was carefully guided through the large opening in the snow and finally pulled up onto flat ground. There couldn’t have been a better test of how effective the sled straps were and how well the load was packed.

After lunch Mertz ascended a high point and was able to trace out a route which conducted us in a few hours to a better surface.

After lunch, Mertz climbed up to a high point and was able to map out a route that took us in a few hours to a smoother surface.

We were now at an elevation of from four hundred to five hundred feet above sea-level, running across a beam-wind on our right which increased during the afternoon. A rising blizzard made it necessary to camp after a day's run of ten and one-third miles.

We were now at an altitude of four hundred to five hundred feet above sea level, moving with a beam wind on our right that got stronger throughout the afternoon. A growing blizzard forced us to set up camp after a day’s journey of ten and one-third miles.

The wind blew up to seventy miles an hour during the night, but eased in strength early on November 30. At 10 A.M. we tried to make a start, but the dogs refused to face the drift. On the wind becoming gusty in the afternoon, it was once more possible to travel, and we set out.

The wind topped seventy miles an hour overnight but calmed down early on November 30. At 10 A.M. we tried to get going, but the dogs wouldn’t budge against the snow. When the wind picked up again in the afternoon, we were finally able to travel, and we hit the road.

Dense drift was still to be seen pouring over the highlands to the south-east. Above the glacier ahead whirlies, out-lined in high revolving columns of snow, "stalked about" in their wayward courses.

Dense fog was still visible rolling over the highlands to the southeast. Above the glacier ahead, whirlwinds outlined in tall swirling columns of snow were "stalking about" in their unpredictable paths.

The sledges ran through a sea of crevassed, blue ice, over ridges and past open chasms. Seven miles brought us to the "foot-hills" on the eastern border of the Ninnis Glacier, where we pitched camp.

The sleds glided over a vast expanse of cracked, blue ice, across ridges and alongside open chasms. After seven miles, we reached the "foothills" on the eastern edge of the Ninnis Glacier, where we set up camp.

The first day of December was still and hot, with brilliant sunshine. The shade temperature reached 34 degrees F. and the snow became so sticky that it was as much as we and the dogs could do to move the sledges up the slopes. As the evening lengthened and the sun sank lower the surface froze hard and our toil was lightened. At midnight we reached an altitude of nine hundred feet.

The first day of December was calm and warm, with bright sunshine. The temperature in the shade hit 34 degrees F, and the snow got so sticky that it was all we and the dogs could do to move the sledges up the hills. As the evening went on and the sun dropped lower, the surface froze solid and our work became easier. By midnight, we reached an altitude of nine hundred feet.

December 2 was another warm, bright day. The surface was atrociously bad; hard, sharp sastrugi, never less than two feet high and in many instances three feet six inches from crest to trough. The dogs were not able to exert a united pull for there were never more than half of them in action at a time.

December 2 was another warm, bright day. The surface was terrible; hard, sharp sastrugi, always at least two feet high and often three feet six inches from peak to trough. The dogs couldn't pull together because there were never more than half of them working at the same time.

Once more we were at a comparatively high altitude and a fine view presented itself to the north. One could look back to the mainland slopes descending on the western side of the Ninnis Glacier. Then the glacier, tumultuous and broken, was seen to extend far out into the frozen sea and, sweeping round to the north-east, the eye ranged over a great expanse of floe-ice dotted with bergs. To the east there was a precipitous coastline of dark rock which for a while we thought of visiting. But then it seemed likely that Madigan's party would reach as far east, so we set our faces once more to the rising plateau in the south-east.

Once again, we were at a relatively high altitude, and a stunning view opened up to the north. We could see back to the mainland slopes dropping down on the western side of the Ninnis Glacier. The glacier, chaotic and fragmented, stretched far out into the frozen sea, and sweeping around to the northeast, our gaze covered a vast area of floe-ice scattered with icebergs. To the east, there was a steep coastline of dark rock that we briefly considered visiting. But then it seemed likely that Madigan's party would reach that far east as well, so we turned our focus once more to the rising plateau in the southeast.

At midnight the sun was peering over the southern sky-line, and we halted at an elevation of one thousand five hundred and fifty feet, having covered eight and a half miles in the day. The temperature was 5 degrees F.

At midnight, the sun was rising over the southern skyline, and we stopped at an elevation of 1,550 feet, having traveled 8.5 miles that day. The temperature was 5 degrees F.

"December 3.—We were not long on the way before the sky became overcast and light snow fell. The surface was becoming flatter. Camp was pitched at 11 P.M. after eleven and two-thirds miles.

"December 3.—We weren't on the road for long before the sky turned gray and light snow started to fall. The ground was getting flatter. We set up camp at 11 P.M. after covering eleven and two-thirds miles."

"December 4.—Another day of bad light but the surface improved and good headway was made on an easterly course at an elevation of between two thousand and two thousand eight hundred feet. The crevasses were practically past. The day's march was fifteen miles.

"December 4.—Another day of poor visibility, but the surface got better and we made good progress heading east at an altitude of between two thousand and two thousand eight hundred feet. The crevasses were mostly behind us. We covered fifteen miles today."

"December 5.—A bad day; overcast, snowing and a gale of wind from the east-south-east. However, we plugged on blindly into it until 7.30 P.M. and then camped, having done eleven and a half miles.

"December 5.—A rough day; cloudy, snowing, and a strong wind from the east-southeast. Still, we pushed through it until 7:30 PM and then set up camp, having covered eleven and a half miles."

"December 6, 7 and 8.—During these days a dense blizzard raged, the wind reaching seventy miles per hour. There was nothing to do but lie in our bags and think out plans for the future. Each morning Ninnis and Mertz took it in turns to go out and feed their charges, who were snugly buried in the deep snow.

"December 6, 7, and 8.—During these days, a heavy blizzard hit, with winds reaching seventy miles per hour. There was nothing to do but lie in our sleeping bags and think about plans for the future. Each morning, Ninnis and Mertz took turns going out to feed their animals, who were comfortably buried in the deep snow."

"One day in the sleeping-bag does not come amiss after long marches, but three days on end is enough to bore any one thoroughly.

"One day in a sleeping bag is nice after long hikes, but three days straight is enough to bore anyone completely."

"Ninnis was not so badly off with a volume of Thackeray, but Mertz had come to the end of a small edition of 'Sherlock Holmes' when blizzard-bound near Aladdin's Cave, and his only diversion on these days was to recite passages from memory for our mutual benefit."

"Ninnis wasn’t doing too badly with a volume of Thackeray, but Mertz had finished a small edition of 'Sherlock Holmes' when we got stuck in a blizzard near Aladdin's Cave, and his only entertainment during those days was to recite passages from memory for both of our enjoyment."

I was troubled with an inflammation in the face just at this time, while Ninnis suffered pain owing to a "whitlow" on one of his fingers.

I had a painful inflammation on my face at that time, while Ninnis was in pain because of an infection in one of his fingers.

As usual the food ration was reduced. This caused us to have more than ordinarily vivid dreams. I happened to be awake one night when Ninnis was sledging in imagination, vociferously shouting, "Hike, hike," to the dogs; our equivalent of the usual "Mush, mush."

As usual, the food ration was cut. This made us have more intense dreams. One night, I happened to be awake when Ninnis was mentally sledding, loudly calling out, "Hike, hike," to the dogs; our version of the usual "Mush, mush."

Despite considerable wind and drift we got away at 8 A.M. on December 9. The sky was overcast and there was nothing to be seen except a soft carpet of newly fallen snow into which we sank half-way to the knees. The sledges ran deeply and heavily so that the dogs had to be assisted. Ahead Mertz glided along triumphant, for it was on such occasions that skis were of the greatest assistance to him.

Despite strong winds and drifting snow, we set off at 8 A.M. on December 9. The sky was cloudy, and all we could see was a soft blanket of fresh snow that came up to our knees. The sleds were heavy and sank deep, so the dogs needed some help. Up ahead, Mertz glided along confidently, as these were the moments when skis were most useful for him.

During the day a snow petrel circled above us for a while and then returned to the north.

During the day, a snow petrel flew around us for a bit and then headed back north.

The course was due east at an elevation of two thousand three hundred feet and the total distance we threw behind during the day was sixteen and a half miles.

The course was directly east at an elevation of two thousand three hundred feet, and the total distance we covered during the day was sixteen and a half miles.

On the 10th light wind and low drift were the order of things. Our spirits rose when the sky cleared and a slight down grade commenced.

On the 10th, there was a light wind and low drift. Our spirits lifted when the sky cleared and a gentle downhill began.

During the morning Ninnis drew our attention to what appeared to be small ice-capped islets fringing the coast, but the distance was too great for us to be sure of their exact nature. Out near the verge of the horizon a tract of frozen sea with scattered bergs could be seen.

During the morning, Ninnis pointed out what looked like small ice-covered islands along the coast, but we were too far away to determine exactly what they were. On the edge of the horizon, we could see a stretch of frozen sea with some icebergs scattered around.

Next day more features were distinguishable. The coast was seen to run in a north-easterly direction as a long peninsula ending in a sharp cape—Cape Freshfield. The north appeared to be filled with frozen sea though we could not be certain that it was not dense pack-ice. Little did we know that Madigan's party, about a week later, would be marching over the frozen sea towards Cape Freshfield in the north-east.

Next day, more details were noticeable. The coast was now seen extending in a northeast direction as a long peninsula that ended at a sharp cape—Cape Freshfield. The north seemed to be filled with frozen sea, though we couldn't be sure it wasn't dense pack-ice. Little did we know that Madigan's team, about a week later, would be marching over the frozen sea toward Cape Freshfield in the northeast.

At 10 P.M. on the 11th, at an altitude of one thousand eight hundred feet, the highland we were traversing fell away rapidly and sea-ice opened up directly in front of us. The coastal downfalls to the south-east fell in rugged masses to a vertical barrier, off the seaward face of which large, tabular bergs were grouped within environing floe.

At 10 PM on the 11th, at an altitude of 1,800 feet, the highland we were crossing dropped sharply, revealing sea ice right in front of us. The coastal cliffs to the southeast descended in jagged sections to a sheer drop, where large, flat icebergs were clustered within the surrounding floe.

Throughout December 12 a somewhat irregular course was made to the south-east and south to avoid the broken area ahead. We had had enough of crevasses and wished to be clear of serac-ice in the future.

Throughout December 12, we took a bit of a zigzag route to the southeast and south to steer clear of the damaged area ahead. We were tired of dealing with crevasses and wanted to be rid of the serac ice moving forward.

For some days Ninnis had been enduring the throbbing pain of a whitlow and had not been having sufficient sleep. He always did his share of the work and had undoubtedly borne a great deal of pain without showing it. On several nights I noticed that he sat up in his sleeping-bag for hours puffing away at a pipe or reading. At last the pain became so acute that he asked me to lance his finger. This was successfully accomplished after breakfast on the 13th and during the day he had much relief.

For several days, Ninnis had been dealing with the throbbing pain of an infection and hadn’t been getting enough sleep. He always pulled his weight in the work and clearly endured a lot of pain without complaining. I noticed on several nights that he sat up in his sleeping bag for hours, smoking a pipe or reading. Finally, the pain got so bad that he asked me to cut into his finger. I was able to do that successfully after breakfast on the 13th, and he felt a lot better throughout the day.

While Ninnis rested before we made a start, Mertz and I re-arranged the sledges and their loads. A third sledge was no longer necessary, so the one usually driven by Ninnis, which had been damaged, was discarded and all the gear was divided between the other two sledges in nearly equal amounts. When the work was completed, the rear sledge carried an extra weight of fifty pounds. As, however, both food for men and dogs were to come from it, we reckoned that this superadded load would soon diminish.

While Ninnis took a rest before we got going, Mertz and I rearranged the sledges and their loads. We no longer needed a third sledge, so we got rid of the one that Ninnis usually drove, which had been damaged, and split all the gear between the other two sledges in almost equal portions. Once we finished, the rear sledge had an extra weight of fifty pounds. However, since both food for the men and for the dogs would be coming from it, we figured that this additional load would decrease soon enough.

On we went, during the afternoon, up a steep ascent. Crevasses were so numerous that we took measures to vent them. Some were as much as a hundred feet in width, filled with snow; others were great open holes or like huge cauldrons. Close to the windward edge of some of the latter high ramps of neve with bluff faces on the windward side stood up like monoliths reaching twenty-five feet in maximum height.

On we went in the afternoon, climbing a steep slope. There were so many crevasses that we had to find ways to deal with them. Some were as wide as a hundred feet, packed with snow; others were large open holes or looked like massive cauldrons. Near the windward edge of some of those big holes, high ridges of snow with steep faces on the windy side stood like giant monoliths, reaching up to twenty-five feet at their tallest.

In the evening a field of neve was reached and we felt more placid after the anxiety of the preceding hours.

In the evening, we reached a field covered in snow and felt calmer after the anxiety of the past few hours.

During the passage of a snow-filled valley a dull, booming sound like the noise of far-distant cannon was heard. It was evidently connected with the subsidence of large areas of the surface crust. Apparently large cavities had formed beneath the snow and the weight of ourselves and the sledges caused the crust to sink and the air to be expelled.

While crossing a snow-covered valley, we heard a deep, booming sound that resembled distant cannon fire. It was clearly linked to the sinking of large sections of the surface. It seemed that significant cavities had developed beneath the snow, and the weight of us and the sledges made the crust drop and forced the air out.

The sun appeared late in the day and, as it was almost calm, the last few hours of marching were very pleasant. At midnight we camped at an altitude of one thousand nine hundred feet.

The sun showed up late in the day and, since it was nearly calm, the last few hours of marching were really nice. At midnight, we set up camp at an altitude of one thousand nine hundred feet.

A light east-south-east wind was blowing as the sledges started away eastward on the morning of December 14. The weather was sunny and the temperature registered 21 degrees F.

A gentle east-southeast wind was blowing as the sledges set off east on the morning of December 14. The weather was sunny, and the temperature was 21 degrees Fahrenheit.

Mertz and I were happy to know that Ninnis had slept well and was feeling much better.

Mertz and I were glad to hear that Ninnis had slept well and was feeling a lot better.

Our march was interrupted at noon by a latitude observation, after which Mertz went ahead on skis singing his student songs. The dogs rose to the occasion and pulled eagerly and well. Everything was for once in harmony and the time was at hand when we should turn our faces homewards.

Our march was interrupted at noon for a latitude observation, after which Mertz went ahead on skis, singing his college songs. The dogs stepped up and pulled eagerly and effectively. For once, everything was in harmony, and the time had come for us to turn our faces toward home.

Mertz was well in advance of us when I noticed him hold up his ski-stick and then go on. This was a signal for something unusual so, as I approached the vicinity, I looked out for crevasses or some other explanation of his action. As a matter of fact crevasses were not expected, since we were on a smooth surface of neve well to the southward of the broken coastal slopes. On reaching the spot where Mertz had signalled and seeing no sign of any irregularity, I jumped on to the sledge, got out the book of tables and commenced to figure out the latitude observation taken on that day. Glancing at the ground a moment after, I noticed the faint indication of a crevasse. It was but one of many hundred similar ones we had crossed and had no specially dangerous appearance, but still I turned quickly round, called out a warning word to Ninnis and then dismissed it from my thoughts.

Mertz was well ahead of us when I saw him raise his ski pole and then continue on. This was a signal for something unusual, so as I got closer, I looked out for crevasses or any other reason for his action. Actually, we didn't expect any crevasses since we were on a smooth surface of neve well to the south of the broken coastal slopes. When I reached the spot where Mertz had signaled and saw no sign of anything unusual, I jumped onto the sled, pulled out the book of tables, and started figuring out the latitude observation from that day. A moment later, as I glanced at the ground, I noticed a faint sign of a crevasse. It was just one of hundreds we had crossed and didn't seem particularly dangerous, but I quickly turned around, shouted a warning to Ninnis, and then brushed it aside.

Ninnis, who was walking along by the side of his sledge, close behind my own, heard the warning, for in my backward glance I noticed that he immediately swung the leading dogs so as to cross the crevasse squarely instead of diagonally as I had done. I then went on with my work.

Ninnis, who was walking next to his sledge, right behind mine, heard the warning. In my backward glance, I saw him immediately steer the lead dogs to cross the crevasse directly instead of at an angle like I had. I then continued with my work.

There was no sound from behind except a faint, plaintive whine from one of the dogs which I imagined was in reply to a touch from Ninnis's whip. I remember addressing myself to George, the laziest dog in my own team, saying, "You will be getting a little of that, too, George, if you are not careful."

There was no noise from behind except a faint, pitiful whine from one of the dogs, which I figured was in response to a tap from Ninnis's whip. I remember talking to George, the laziest dog on my team, saying, "You'll be getting some of that too, George, if you’re not careful."

When I next looked back, it was in response to the anxious gaze of Mertz who had turned round and halted in his tracks. Behind me, nothing met the eye but my own sledge tracks running back in the distance. Where were Ninnis and his sledge?

When I looked back again, it was because of Mertz's worried stare; he had stopped and turned around. Behind me, there was nothing but my own sled tracks stretching off into the distance. Where was Ninnis and his sled?

I hastened back along the trail thinking that a rise in the ground obscured the view. There was no such good fortune, however, for I came to a gaping hole in the surface about eleven feet wide. The lid of a crevasse had broken in; two sledge tracks led up to it on the far side but only one continued on the other side.

I hurried back along the path, thinking that a rise in the ground would block the view. However, I had no such luck, as I came across a huge hole in the ground about eleven feet wide. The cover of a crevasse had collapsed; two sled tracks led up to it on the far side, but only one continued on the other side.

Frantically waving to Mertz to bring up my sledge, upon which there was some alpine rope, I leaned over and shouted into the dark depths below. No sound came back but the moaning of a dog, caught on a shelf just visible one hundred and fifty feet below. The poor creature appeared to have broken its back, for it was attempting to sit up with the front part of its body while the hinder portion lay limp. Another dog lay motionless by its side. Close by was what appeared in the gloom to be the remains of the tent and a canvas tank containing food for three men for a fortnight.

Frantically waving to Mertz to bring up my sled, which had some alpine rope on it, I leaned over and shouted into the dark depths below. No sound came back except for the moaning of a dog, stuck on a ledge just barely visible one hundred and fifty feet down. The poor animal seemed to have broken its back, trying to sit up with the front part of its body while the back half lay limp. Another dog lay still next to it. Nearby was what looked like the remains of a tent and a canvas tank filled with food for three men for two weeks.

We broke back the edge of the neve lid and took turns leaning over secured by a rope, calling into the darkness in the hope that our companion might be still alive. For three hours we called unceasingly but no answering sound came back. The dog had ceased to moan and lay without a movement. A chill draught was blowing out of the abyss. We felt that there was little hope.

We pulled back the edge of the snow cover and took turns leaning over, secured by a rope, shouting into the darkness, hoping our friend might still be alive. For three hours we called without stopping, but no response came back. The dog had stopped whimpering and lay completely still. A cold breeze was blowing from the depths below. We sensed that there was little hope.

Why had the first sledge escaped the crevasse? It seemed that I had been fortunate, because my sledge had crossed diagonally, with a greater chance of breaking the snow-lid. The sledges were within thirty pounds of the same weight. The explanation appeared to be that Ninnis had walked by the side of his sledge, whereas I had crossed it sitting on the sledge. The whole weight of a man's body bearing on his foot is a formidable load and no doubt was sufficient to smash the arch of the roof.

Why did the first sled escape the crevasse? I seemed to have been lucky because my sled crossed at an angle, which had a better chance of breaking through the snow layer. The sleds were within thirty pounds of each other in weight. The explanation seemed to be that Ninnis had walked next to his sled, while I had crossed sitting on mine. The full weight of a person's body resting on their foot is a serious burden and likely enough to break the roof's arch.

By means of a fishing line we ascertained that it was one hundred and fifty feet sheer to the ledge on which the remains were seen; on either side the crevasse descended into blackness. It seemed so very far down there and the dogs looked so small that we got out the field glasses, but could make out nothing more by their aid.

Using a fishing line, we determined that it was one hundred and fifty feet straight down to the ledge where the remains were spotted; on either side, the crevasse dropped into darkness. It looked really deep down there, and the dogs seemed tiny, so we grabbed the field glasses, but we couldn't see anything more with them.

All our available rope was tied together but the total length was insufficient to reach the ledge and any idea of going below to investigate and to secure some of the food had to be abandoned.

All the rope we had was tied together, but it wasn't long enough to reach the ledge, so we had to give up on the idea of going down to check things out and grab some food.

Stunned by the unexpectedness of it all and having exhausted the few appliances we carried for such a contingency, we felt helpless. In such moments action is the only tolerable thing, and if there had been any expedient however hazardous which might have been tried, we should have taken all and more than the risk. Stricken dumb with the pity of it and heavy at heart, we turned our minds mechanically to what lay nearest at hand.

Stunned by how unexpected everything was and having used up the few tools we brought for this situation, we felt powerless. In moments like these, taking action is the only thing that feels bearable, and if there had been any risky option available, we would have taken it without hesitation. Overwhelmed with pity and feeling heavy-hearted, we instinctively focused on what was immediately in front of us.

There were rations on the other sledge, and we found that there was a bare one and a half weeks' food for ourselves and nothing at all for the dogs. Part of the provisions consisted of raisins and almonds which had been taken as extras or "perks," as they were usually called.

There were supplies on the other sled, and we discovered that we had only about a week and a half of food for ourselves, with nothing at all for the dogs. Some of the provisions included raisins and almonds that had been taken as extras or "perks," as they were typically referred to.

Among other losses there were both spade and ice-axe, but fortunately a spare tent-cover was saved. Mertz's burberry trousers had gone down with the sledge and the best substitute he could get was a pair of thick Jaeger woollen under-trousers from the spare clothing we possessed.

Among other losses, both the spade and the ice axe were lost, but luckily we managed to save a spare tent cover. Mertz's Burberry trousers went down with the sledge, and the best replacement he could find was a pair of thick Jaeger woolen long johns from the extra clothing we had.

Later in the afternoon Mertz and I went ahead to a higher point in order to obtain a better view of our surroundings. At a point two thousand four hundred feet above sea-level and three hundred and fifteen and three-quarter miles eastward from the Hut, a complete observation for position and magnetic azimuth was taken.

Later in the afternoon, Mertz and I moved up to a higher spot to get a better view of our surroundings. At a height of two thousand four hundred feet above sea level and three hundred fifteen and three-quarters miles east of the Hut, we took a complete measurement for our location and magnetic direction.

The coastal slopes were fearfully broken and scaured in their descent to the sea, which was frozen out to the horizon. No islands were observed or anything which could correspond with the land marked by Wilkes as existing so much farther to the north. Patches of "water sky" were visible in two places in the far distance. As we stood looking north a Wilson petrel suddenly appeared and after flitting about for a short time departed.

The coastal slopes were jagged and rough as they sloped down to the sea, which was frozen all the way to the horizon. No islands or anything that matched the land marked by Wilkes as being much farther north could be seen. Patches of "water sky" were visible in two spots far in the distance. As we stood there looking north, a Wilson petrel suddenly showed up, flitting around for a bit before it flew away.

We returned to the crevasse and packed the remaining sledge, discarding everything unnecessary so as to reduce the weight of the load. A thin soup was made by boiling up all the old food-bags which could be found. The dogs were given some worn-out fur mitts, finnesko and several spare raw hide straps, all of which they devoured.

We went back to the crevasse and loaded the last sled, throwing away anything we didn’t need to lighten the load. We made a thin soup by boiling all the old food bags we could find. The dogs were given some old fur mitts, snowshoes, and a few extra rawhide straps, all of which they gobbled up.

We still continued to call down into the crevasse at regular intervals in case our companion might not have been killed outright and, in the meantime, have become conscious. There was no reply.

We kept calling down into the crevasse at regular intervals, just in case our companion hadn't been killed immediately and had regained consciousness. There was no answer.

A weight was lowered on the fishing line as far as the dog which had earlier shown some signs of life, but there was no response. All were dead, swallowed up in an instant.

A weight was dropped on the fishing line as far as the dog that had earlier shown some signs of life, but there was no response. All were dead, consumed in an instant.

When comrades tramp the road to anywhere through a lonely blizzard-ridden land in hunger, want and weariness the interests, ties and fates of each are interwoven in a wondrous fabric of friendship and affection. The shock of Ninnis's death struck home and deeply stirred us.

When friends walk the road to anywhere through a lonely, snowy land, dealing with hunger, need, and exhaustion, their interests, connections, and destinies are woven together in an amazing bond of friendship and care. The impact of Ninnis's death hit hard and moved us deeply.

He was a fine fellow and a born soldier—and the end:—

He was a great guy and a natural soldier—and that’s it:—

    Life—give me life until the end,
    That at the very top of being,
    The battle spirit shouting in my blood,
    Out of very reddest hell of the fight
    I may be snatched and flung
    Into the everlasting lull,
    The Immortal, Incommunicable Dream.
    Life—give me life until the end,  
    That at the very peak of existence,  
    The fighting spirit roaring in my veins,  
    Out of the deepest, most intense chaos of battle  
    I may be grabbed and tossed  
    Into the everlasting calm,  
    The Immortal, Incommunicable Dream.

At 9 P.M. we stood by the side of the crevasse and I read the burial service. Then Mertz shook me by the hand with a short "Thank you!" and we turned away to harness up the dogs.

At 9 P.M., we stood next to the crevasse, and I read the burial service. Then Mertz shook my hand with a quick "Thank you!" and we turned away to get the dogs ready.





CHAPTER XIII TOIL AND TRIBULATION

The homeward track! A few days ago—only few hours ago-our hearts had beat hopefully at the prospect and there was no hint of this, the overwhelming tragedy. Our fellow, comrade, chum, in a woeful instant, buried in the bowels of the awful glacier. We could not think of it; we strove to forget it in the necessity of work, but we knew that the truth would assuredly enter our souls in the lonely days to come. It was to be a fight with Death and the great Providence would decide the issue.

The journey home! Just a few days ago—only a few hours ago—our hearts had beaten with hope at the prospect, and there was no sign of this overwhelming tragedy. Our friend, buddy, companion, in a heartbreaking moment, was trapped in the depths of that terrible glacier. We couldn’t bear to think about it; we tried to push it out of our minds with the demands of work, but we knew that the truth would inevitably weigh on our souls in the lonely days ahead. It was going to be a battle with Death, and only fate would determine the outcome.

On the outward journey we had left no depots of provisions en route, for it was our bad fortune to meet such impossible country that we had decided to make a circuit on our return to Winter Quarters sufficiently far inland to avoid the coastal irregularities. As a matter of fact, on the very day of the calamity, preparations had been made to cache most of the food within twenty-four hours, as during the last few days of the journey we were to make a dash to our "farthest east" point. Such were the plans, and now we were ranged against unexpected odds.

On the way out, we didn’t leave any supply depots along the route because, unfortunately, we encountered such challenging terrain that we decided to take a wider path back to Winter Quarters, far enough inland to avoid the irregularities of the coast. In fact, on the very day of the disaster, we had planned to store most of the food within the next twenty-four hours, as we were going to make a quick trip to our "farthest east" point in the last few days of our journey. Those were the plans, and now we were up against unexpected challenges.

With regard to the dogs, there were six very miserable animals left. The best of them had been drafted into the rear team, as it was expected that if an accident happened through the collapse of a snow-bridge the first sledge would most probably suffer. For the same reason most of the food and other indispensable articles had been carried on the rear sledge.

With respect to the dogs, there were six very unhappy animals remaining. The best of them had been assigned to the back team, as it was anticipated that if an accident occurred due to the collapse of a snow bridge, the front sled would likely take the hit. For the same reason, most of the food and other essential supplies had been loaded onto the back sled.

All the dogs which had perished were big and powerful; Basilisk, Ginger Bitch, Shackleton, Castor, Franklin and John Bull. We had fully anticipated that those at least would come back alive, at the expense of the six dogs in my sledge.

All the dogs that died were big and strong: Basilisk, Ginger Bitch, Shackleton, Castor, Franklin, and John Bull. We had completely expected that at least those would come back alive, even if it meant sacrificing the six dogs on my sled.

A silent farewell!—and we started back, aiming to reach our camping-ground on December 12 before a snowstorm intervened, as several things had been left there which would be of use to us in our straitened stances. The weather still held good and there were no signs of approaching snow or wind. So Mertz went ahead on skis, while we plodded slowly up the hills and dashed recklessly down them. During the descents I sat on the sledge and we slid over long crevassed slopes in a wild fashion, almost with a languid feeling that the next one would probably swallow us up. But we did not much care then, as it was too soon after losing our friend.

A quiet goodbye!—and we headed back, trying to get to our campsite by December 12 before a snowstorm hit, since we had left several things there that would help us in our tough situation. The weather was still nice, and there were no signs of snow or wind coming. So Mertz went ahead on skis while we slowly climbed the hills and recklessly rushed down them. During the descents, I sat on the sled and we slid over long, crevassed slopes in a wild way, almost feeling like the next one might swallow us up. But we didn’t really care at that moment; it was still too soon after losing our friend.

At 2.30 A.M. on December 15 the discarded sledge and broken spade came into sight. On reaching them, Mertz cut a runner of the broken sledge into two pieces which were used in conjunction with his skis as a framework on which to pitch the spare tent-cover; our only tent and poles having been lost. Each time the makeshift shelter was erected, these props had to be carefully lashed together at the apex, which stood four feet from the ground. Inside, there was just room for two one-man sleeping-bags on the floor. However, only one man at a time could move about and neither of us could ever rise above a sitting posture. Still, it was a shelter which protected us from the bad weather, and, with plenty of snow blocks piled around it, was wonderfully resistant to the wind.

At 2:30 A.M. on December 15, the abandoned sled and broken shovel came into view. When Mertz reached them, he cut a runner from the broken sled into two pieces, which he used along with his skis to create a framework for pitching the spare tent cover; our only tent and poles had been lost. Each time the makeshift shelter was set up, these supports had to be carefully tied together at the top, which stood four feet off the ground. Inside, there was barely enough room for two one-man sleeping bags on the floor. However, only one person could move around at a time, and neither of us could stand up straight. Still, it was a shelter that protected us from the bad weather, and with plenty of snow blocks piled around it, it was incredibly resistant to the wind.

When we retired to rest, it was not to sleep but to think out the best plan for the return journey.

When we went to bed, it wasn't to sleep but to come up with the best plan for the journey back.

It was obvious that a descent to the frozen sea would be dangerous on account of the heavily crevassed nature of the falling glacier, delay would undoubtedly be caused and our distance from the Hut would be increased. To decide definitely for the sea-ice would be to take other risks as well, since, from the altitude at which we were placed, we could not be sure that the floe-ice which covered the sea would provide a good travelling surface. In any case it was likely to be on the point of breaking up, for the season was nearing midsummer. On the other hand, there was on the sea-ice a chance of obtaining seals for food.

It was clear that going down to the frozen sea would be risky because of the heavily crevassed glacier, which would cause delays and increase our distance from the Hut. Committing to the sea ice would also involve different risks, since from our high position, we couldn’t be sure if the floe ice covering the sea would be safe for travel. In any case, it was probably about to break up, as we were approaching midsummer. On the flip side, there was a chance we could find seals for food on the sea ice.

After due consideration we resolved to follow the shorter route, returning inland over the plateau, for it was reckoned that if the weather were reasonable we might win through to Winter Quarters with one and a half weeks' rations and the six dogs which still remained, provided we ate the dogs to eke out our provisions. Fortunately neither the cooker nor the kerosene had been lost.

After careful thought, we decided to take the shorter route, heading back inland over the plateau, because it was believed that if the weather was decent, we could make it to Winter Quarters with about a week and a half's worth of rations and the six dogs we still had, as long as we ate the dogs to stretch our food supplies. Luckily, we hadn’t lost either the cooker or the kerosene.

George, the poorest of the dogs, was killed and partly fed to the others, partly kept for ourselves. The meat was roughly fried on the lid of the aluminium cooker, an operation which resulted in little more than scorching the surface. On the whole it was voted good though it had a strong, musty taste and was so stringy that it could not be properly chewed.

George, the poorest of the dogs, was killed and partly fed to the others, partly kept for ourselves. The meat was roughly fried on the lid of the aluminum pot, which ended up doing little more than burning the surface. Overall, it was considered good even though it had a strong, musty flavor and was so chewy that it couldn't be properly eaten.

As both mugs and spoons had been lost, I made two pannikins out of tins in which cartridges and matches had been packed, and Mertz carved wooden spoons out of a portion of the broken sledge. At this camp he also spliced the handle of the broken shovel which had been picked up, so as to make it temporarily serviceable.

As both mugs and spoons were lost, I made two cups from tins that had held cartridges and matches, and Mertz carved wooden spoons from a piece of the broken sled. At this camp, he also fixed the handle of the broken shovel we found, so it could be used for a while.

It was midsummer, and therefore we found it easier to drag the sledge over the snow at night when the surface was frozen hard. Camp was not finally broken until 6 P.M., when the long and painful return journey commenced.

It was midsummer, so we found it easier to pull the sled over the snow at night when the surface was frozen solid. Camp wasn't fully packed up until 6 PM, when the long and difficult journey back began.

For fourteen miles the way led up rising snow slopes to the north-west until an elevation of two thousand five hundred feet had been reached. After that, variable grades and flat country were met. Though the sledge was light, the dogs required helping and progress was slow. The midnight sun shone low in the south, and we tramped on through the morning hours, anxious to reduce the miles which lay ahead.

For fourteen miles, the path went up snowy slopes to the northwest until we reached an elevation of two thousand five hundred feet. After that, we encountered uneven grades and flat ground. Even though the sled was light, the dogs needed help, and our progress was slow. The midnight sun hung low in the south as we trudged on through the morning hours, eager to cover the miles that lay ahead.

Early on December 16 the sky became rapidly overcast. The snowy land and the snowy sky merged to form an enclosed trap, as it seemed to us, while showers of snow fell. There were no shadows to create contrast; it was impossible to distinguish even the detail of the ground underfoot. We stumbled over unseen ridges of the hard neve, our gaze straining forward. The air was so still that advantage was taken of the calm to light the primus and melt some snow in the lee of the sledge. The water, to which were added a few drops of primus alcohol, helped to assuage our thirst.

Early on December 16, the sky quickly turned cloudy. The snowy ground and the snowy sky seemed to blend into an enclosed trap while snowflakes fell around us. There were no shadows to provide contrast; it was impossible to even see the details of the ground beneath our feet. We stumbled over hidden bumps in the hard snow, our eyes straining to see ahead. The air was so still that we took advantage of the calm to light the primus stove and melt some snow behind the sledge. The water, with a few drops of primus alcohol added, helped quench our thirst.

The erection of the makeshift tent was a long and tedious operation, and so, on our return marches, we never again took any refreshment during the day's work excepting on this occasion.

The setup of the makeshift tent was a long and tedious process, so on our return trips, we never had any refreshments during the day's work except for this one time.

At 6 A.M., having done twenty miles and ascended to an elevation of about two thousand five hundred feet, we pitched camp.

At 6 A.M., after covering twenty miles and climbing to an elevation of about two thousand five hundred feet, we set up camp.

There was very little sleep for me that day for I had an unusually bad attack of snow-blindness. During the time that we rested in the bags Mertz treated one of my eyes three times, the other twice with zinc sulphate and cocaine.

There was barely any sleep for me that day because I had a particularly bad case of snow blindness. While we rested in the bags, Mertz treated one of my eyes three times and the other one twice with zinc sulfate and cocaine.

On account of the smallness of the tent a great deal of time was absorbed in preparations for "turning in" and for getting away from each camp. Thus, although we rose before 6 P.M. on December 16, the start was not made until 8.30 P.M., notwithstanding the fact that the meal was of the "sketchiest" character.

Due to the small size of the tent, a lot of time was spent preparing for "turning in" and getting ready to leave each camp. So, even though we got up before 6 PM on December 16, we didn't actually leave until 8:30 PM, despite the meal being very minimal.

On that night ours was a mournful procession; the sky thickly clouded, snow falling, I with one eye bandaged and the dog Johnson broken down and strapped on top of the load on the sledge. There was scarcely a sound; only the rustle of the thick, soft snow as we pushed on, weary but full of hope. The dogs dumbly pressed forward in their harness, forlorn but eager to follow. Their weight now told little upon the sledge, the work mainly falling upon ourselves. Mertz was tempted to try hauling on skis, but came to the conclusion that it did not pay and thenceforth never again used them.

On that night, we moved sadly through the snow; the sky was heavy with clouds, snow falling all around. I had one eye bandaged, and the dog Johnson was worn out and tied on top of the load on the sled. There was hardly any noise; just the soft rustle of the thick snow as we continued on, tired but hopeful. The dogs quietly trudged forward in their harnesses, looking sad but still eager to follow. Their weight barely affected the sled, as most of the work fell on us. Mertz thought about trying to pull on skis, but decided it wasn't worth it and never used them again after that.

Close to the Magnetic Pole as we were, the compass was of little use, and to steer a straight course to the west without ever seeing anything of the surroundings was a difficult task. The only check upon the correctness of the bearing was the direction in which trended the old hard winter sastrugi, channelled out along a line running almost north and south. The newly fallen snow obliterated these, and frequent halts had to be called in order to investigate the buried surface.

Close to the Magnetic Pole as we were, the compass was pretty much useless, and navigating straight west without being able to see anything around us was a tough job. The only way to confirm our direction was by looking at the old, hard winter sastrugi, which ran almost north and south. The fresh snow covered these, so we often had to stop to check the hidden surface.

At 2 A.M. on the 17th we had only covered eleven miles when we stopped to camp. Then Mertz shot and cut up Johnson while I prepared the supper.

At 2 A.M. on the 17th, we had only traveled eleven miles when we stopped to set up camp. While I made dinner, Mertz shot and butchered Johnson.

Johnson had always been a very faithful, hard-working and willing beast, with rather droll ways of his own, and we were sorry that his end should come so soon. He could never be accused of being a handsome dog, in fact he was generally disreputable and dirty.

Johnson had always been a very loyal, hard-working, and eager dog, with his own quirky personality, and we were sad that his time had to come so soon. He could never be called a good-looking dog; in fact, he was usually pretty scruffy and dirty.

All the dogs were miserable and thin when they reached the stage of extreme exhaustion. Their meat was tough, stringy and without a vestige of fat. For a change we sometimes chopped it up finely, mixed it with a little pemmican, and brought all to the boil in a large pot of water. We were exceedingly hungry, but there was nothing to satisfy our appetites. Only a few ounces were used of the stock of ordinary food, to which was added a portion of dog's meat, never large, for each animal yielded so very little, and the major part was fed to the surviving dogs. They crunched the bones and ate the skin, until nothing remained.

All the dogs were miserable and thin by the time they reached the point of extreme exhaustion. Their meat was tough, stringy, and devoid of any fat. Occasionally, we chopped it up finely, mixed it with a bit of pemmican, and boiled it all in a large pot of water. We were incredibly hungry, but there was nothing to satisfy our appetites. Only a few ounces of the regular food stock were used, with a small amount of dog meat added, since each animal produced so little, and most of it was given to the surviving dogs. They crunched the bones and ate the skin until nothing was left.

A fresh start was made at 7.30 P.M. and a wretched, trying night was spent, when we marched without a break for twelve and a half hours. Overhead there was a dense pall of nimbus from which snow fell at intervals. None of the dogs except Ginger gave any help with the load, and Mary was so worn out that she had to be carried on the sledge. Poor Mary had been a splendid dog, but we had to kill her at the camp in the morning.

A new journey started at 7:30 PM, and a tough, exhausting night followed as we marched nonstop for twelve and a half hours. Above us, there was a thick layer of clouds from which snow fell occasionally. None of the dogs except Ginger helped with the load, and Mary was so exhausted that she had to be carried on the sled. Poor Mary had been an amazing dog, but we had to put her down at the camp in the morning.

After a run of eighteen and a half miles we halted at 8 A.M. on December 18.

After running eighteen and a half miles, we stopped at 8 A.M. on December 18.

At 5.30 P.M. a light south-easter blew and snow fell from an overcast sky. Soon after a start was made, it became apparent that a descent was commencing. In this locality the country had been swept by wind, for none of the recent snow settled on the surface. The sastrugi were high and hard, and over them we bumped, slipping and falling in the uncertain light. We could not endure this kind of travelling for long and resolved to camp shortly after midnight, intending to go on when the day had advanced further and the light was stronger.

At 5:30 PM, a gentle southeast wind picked up and snow began to fall from a cloudy sky. Soon after we started, it was clear that we were beginning a descent. In this area, the wind had blown through recently, so none of the new snow had settled on the ground. The sastrugi were tall and firm, and we jolted over them, slipping and falling in the dim light. We couldn't handle this kind of travel for much longer and decided to set up camp shortly after midnight, planning to continue once the sun was higher and the light was better.

"December 19.—Up at noon and tried a few more miles in the snow-glare. Later in the afternoon the sky began to break and we picked our way with less difficulty. Camped at 5 P.M., having done only twelve miles one thousand and fifty yards since the morning of December 18.

"December 19.—Got up at noon and tried to cover a few more miles in the snowy glare. Later in the afternoon, the sky started to clear up, and we made our way with less trouble. We set up camp at 5 P.M., having traveled only twelve miles and one thousand fifty yards since the morning of December 18."

"Up at 8 P.M. again, almost calm and sun shining. Still continuing a westerly course we dropped several hundred feet, marching over rough, slippery fields of sastrugi."

"Up at 8 P.M. again, almost calm and the sun shining. Still heading west, we dropped several hundred feet, crossing rough, slippery fields of sastrugi."

In the early morning hours of the 20th the surface changed to ice and occasional crevasses appeared. It was clear that we had arrived at the head of the Ninnis Glacier above the zone of serac we had traversed on the outward journey. It was very satisfactory to know this; to be certain that some landmark had been seen and recognized.

In the early morning hours of the 20th, the surface turned to ice and occasional crevasses showed up. It was obvious that we had reached the head of the Ninnis Glacier, above the zone of seracs we had crossed on the way out. It was really satisfying to know this; to be sure that we had seen and recognized some landmark.

Soon after this discovery we came near losing Haldane, the big grey wolf, in a crevasse. Miserably thin from starvation the wretched dogs no longer filled their harness. As we pulled up Haldane, after he had broken into a deep, sheer-walled crevasse, his harness slipped off just as he reached the top. It was just possible to seize hold of his hair at that moment and to land him safely, otherwise we should have lost many days' rations.

Soon after this discovery, we almost lost Haldane, the big grey wolf, in a crevasse. Miserably thin from starvation, the poor dogs no longer filled their harness. As we pulled Haldane up after he had fallen into a deep, sheer-walled crevasse, his harness slipped off just as he reached the top. It was just possible to grab hold of his fur at that moment and get him to safety; otherwise, we would have lost many days' worth of rations.

He took to the harness once more but soon became uncertain in his footsteps, staggered along and then tottered and fell. Poor brutes! that was the way they all gave in—pulling till they dropped.

He put the harness on again but quickly became unsure of his steps, stumbled, and then wobbled and fell. Poor creatures! That was how they all surrendered—pulling until they collapsed.

We camped at 4 A.M., thinking that a rest would revive Haldane. Inside the tent some snow was thawed, and we drank the water with an addition of a little primus spirit. A temperature reading showed-1 degree F.

We set up camp at 4 A.M., hoping that some rest would refresh Haldane. Inside the tent, we melted some snow and drank the water mixed with a bit of primus spirit. The temperature reading was -1 degree F.

Outside, the hungry huskies moaned unceasingly until we could bear to hear them no longer. The tent was struck and we set off once more.

Outside, the hungry huskies howled continuously until we couldn't stand the noise anymore. The tent was taken down, and we set off again.

Haldane was strapped on the sledge as he could not walk. He had not eaten the food we had given him, because his jaws seemed too weak to bite. He had just nursed it between his paws and licked it.

Haldane was strapped to the sled since he couldn't walk. He hadn’t eaten the food we offered him because his jaw seemed too weak to chew. He just held it between his paws and licked it.

Before the dogs became as weak as this, great care had to be taken in tethering them at each camp so as to prevent them from gnawing the wood of the sledge, the straps or, in fact, anything at all. Every time we were ready for a fresh start they seemed to regain their old strength, for they struggled and fought to seize any scraps, however useless, left on the ground.

Before the dogs got as weak as this, we had to be very careful when tying them up at each camp to keep them from chewing on the sled's wood, the straps, or really anything at all. Every time we were about to head out again, they seemed to get their old strength back, as they fought and struggled to grab any scraps, no matter how useless, left on the ground.

The day's march was completed at 10.30 A.M. and fourteen and a half miles lay behind.

The day's journey was finished at 10:30 A.M., having covered fourteen and a half miles.

"We were up again at 11.20 P.M. Sky clear; fifteen-mile breeze from the south-south-east and the temperature 3 degrees F. By midnight there was a thirty-mile wind and low, flying drift.

"We were up again at 11:20 PM. The sky was clear; a fifteen-mile-per-hour breeze was coming from the south-southeast, and the temperature was 3 degrees F. By midnight, the wind had picked up to thirty miles per hour, and there was low, flying snow."

"December 21.—The night-march was a miserable one. The only thing which helped to relieve it was that for a moment Dixson Island was miraged up in the north, and we felt that we had met an old friend, which means a lot in this icy desolation. The surface was furrowed by hard, sharp sastrugi.

"December 21.—The night march was a miserable experience. The only thing that made it a bit better was seeing a mirage of Dixson Island up in the north for a moment; it felt like meeting an old friend, which means a lot in this icy desolation. The surface was marked by hard, sharp sastrugi."

"We camped at 9 A.M. after only eleven miles. Haldane was finished off before we retired.

"We set up camp at 9 A.M. after just eleven miles. Haldane was wiped out before we went to sleep."

"We were up again at 9 P.M., and when a start was made at 11 P.M. there was a strong south-south-east wind blowing, with low drift; temperature, zero Fahr.

"We were up again at 9 PM, and when we started at 11 PM, there was a strong south-southeast wind blowing, with low drift; temperature, zero degrees Fahrenheit."

"December 22.—The surface of hard, polished sastrugi caused many falls. The track was undulating, rising in one case several hundred feet and finally falling in a long slope.

"December 22.—The surface of hard, shiny sastrugi caused a lot of falls. The path was uneven, rising in one spot by several hundred feet and then descending in a long slope."

"Pavlova gave in late in the march and was taken on the sledge.

"Pavlova conceded towards the end of the march and was carried on the sled."

"Camped at 6.40 A.M. in a forty-mile wind with low drift. Distance marched was twelve miles one thousand four hundred yards.

"Set up camp at 6:40 A.M. in a strong wind of forty miles an hour with light drifting snow. The distance covered was twelve miles and one thousand four hundred yards."

"Before turning in, we effected sundry repairs. Mertz re-spliced the handle of the shovel which had broken apart and I riveted the broken spindle of the sledge-meter. The mechanism of the latter had frozen during the previous day's halt, and, on being started, its spindle had broken off short. It was a long and tedious job tapping at the steed with a toy hammer, but the rivet held miraculously for the rest of the journey.

"Before going to bed, we made various repairs. Mertz re-attached the handle of the shovel that had come apart, and I fixed the broken spindle on the sledge-meter. The mechanism had frozen during our stop the day before, and when we tried to use it again, the spindle broke off completely. It was a long and tedious job tapping at the machine with a small hammer, but the rivet miraculously held for the rest of the journey."

"Up at 11.30 P.M., a moderate breeze blowing, overcast sky, light snow falling."

"Up at 11:30 PM, a gentle breeze blowing, cloudy sky, light snow falling."

On December 28 an uphill march commenced which was rendered very heavy by the depth of the soft snow. Pavlova had to be carried on the sledge.

On December 28, an uphill march started, which was made really tough by the deep, soft snow. Pavlova had to be carried on the sled.

Suddenly, gaping crevasses appeared dimly through the falling snow which surrounded us like a blanket. There was nothing to do but camp, though it was only 4.30 A.M., and we had covered but five miles one thousand two hundred and thirty yards.

Suddenly, huge cracks showed faintly through the falling snow that wrapped around us like a blanket. There was nothing to do but set up camp, even though it was only 4:30 A.M., and we had only gone five miles and one thousand two hundred thirty yards.

Pavlova was killed and we made a very acceptable soup from her bones. In view of the dark outlook, our ration of food had to be still further cut down. We had no proper sleep, hunger gnawing at us all the time, and the question of food was for ever in our thoughts. Dozing in the fur bags, we dreamed of gorgeous "spreads" and dinner-parties at home. Tramping along through the snow, we racked our brains thinking of how to make the most of the meagre quantity of dogs' meat at hand.

Pavlova was killed, and we made a decent soup from her bones. Given the grim situation, we had to cut our food rations even more. We couldn’t sleep properly, hunger gnawing at us constantly, and food was always on our minds. As we dozed in the fur bags, we dreamed of lavish meals and dinner parties back home. Marching through the snow, we racked our brains trying to figure out how to make the most of the small amount of dog meat we had.

The supply of kerosene for the primus stove promised to be ample, for none of it had been lost in the accident. We found that it was worth while spending some time in boiling the dogs' meat thoroughly. Thus a tasty soup was prepared as well as a supply of edible meat in which the muscular tissue and the gristle were reduced to the consistency of a jelly. The paws took longest of all to cook, but, treated to lengthy stewing, they became quite digestible.

The supply of kerosene for the primus stove was more than enough since none was lost in the accident. We found it worthwhile to spend time boiling the dogs' meat thoroughly. This way, we prepared a delicious soup and a supply of meat where the muscle and cartilage turned into a jelly-like texture. The paws took the longest to cook, but after a good long stew, they became quite easy to eat.

On December 24 we were up at 8 A.M. just as the sun commenced to gleam through clouds. The light was rather bad, and snow fell as the track zigzagged about among many crevasses; but suddenly the sun broke forth. The sledge was crossing a surface of deep snow which soon became so sticky that the load would scarcely move. At last a halt was made after four miles, and we waited for the evening, when the surface was expected to harden.

On December 24, we got up at 8 A.M. just as the sun started to shine through the clouds. The light was pretty poor, and snow was falling as the path zigzagged around many crevasses; but then the sun suddenly came out. The sled was going over a deep snow surface that quickly became so sticky that the load could barely move. Finally, we stopped after four miles and waited for the evening when the surface was expected to harden.

A small prion visited us but went off in a moment. It is very remarkable how far some Antarctic sea-birds may wander inland, apparently at such a great distance from anything which should interest them. We were then more than one hundred miles south of the open sea. As the bird flew away, we watched it until it disappeared in the north, wishing that we too had wings to cross the interminable plateau ahead.

A small prion stopped by for a moment but then flew away. It's amazing how far some Antarctic seabirds can travel inland, seemingly so far from anything that would attract them. We were more than a hundred miles south of the open sea. As the bird flew off, we watched it until it vanished in the north, wishing we also had wings to cross the endless plateau in front of us.

Lying in the sleeping-bag that day I dreamt that I visited a confectioner's shop. All the wares that were displayed measured feet in diameter. I purchased an enormous delicacy just as one would buy a bun under ordinary stances. I remember paying the money over the counter, but something happened before I received what I had chosen. When I realized the omission I was out in the street, and, being greatly disappointed, went back to the shop, but found the door shut and "early closing" written on it.

Lying in the sleeping bag that day, I dreamed I visited a candy shop. All the treats on display were huge, measuring feet in diameter. I bought a massive dessert just like someone would buy a bun on a normal day. I remember handing over the cash at the counter, but something happened before I got what I had picked. When I noticed the mistake, I was outside on the street, and feeling very disappointed, I went back to the shop, only to find the door locked with "early closing" written on it.

Though a good daily average had been maintained on the march whenever conditions were at all favourable, the continuance of bad weather and the undoubtedly weaker state in which we found ourselves made it imperative to dispense with all but the barest necessities. Thus the theodolite was the only instrument retained, and the camera, photographic films (exposed and unexposed), hypsometer, thermometers, rifle, ammunition and other sundries were all thrown away. The frame of the tent was made lighter by constructing two poles, each four feet high, from the telescopic theodolite legs, the heavier pieces of sledge-runner being discarded.

Though we had kept a decent daily average during the march whenever conditions allowed, the ongoing bad weather and our undoubtedly weaker state made it necessary to stick to just the absolute essentials. So, we kept only the theodolite and got rid of the camera, photographic films (both used and unused), hypsometer, thermometers, rifle, ammunition, and other extra items. We made the tent's frame lighter by using two poles, each four feet tall, made from the legs of the telescopic theodolite, and we discarded the heavier parts of the sledge-runner.

We were up at 11 P.M. on December 24, but so much time was absorbed in making a dog-stew for Christmas that it was not till 2.80 A.M. that we got under way. We wished each other happier Christmases in the future, and divided two scraps of biscuit which I found in my spare kit-bag; relics of better days.

We were up at 11 P.M. on December 24, but we spent so much time making a dog stew for Christmas that we didn’t get going until 2:30 A.M. We wished each other happier Christmases in the future and shared two leftover biscuits I found in my spare kit bag; leftovers from better days.

The surface was a moderately good one of undulating, hard sastrugi, and, as the course had been altered to north-west, the southerly wind helped us along. The sun shone brightly, and only for the wind and the low drift we might have felt tolerably comfortable. On our right, down within the shallow depression of the Ninnis Glacier, the low outline of Dixson Island, forty miles to the north, could be seen miraged up on the horizon.

The surface was a fairly decent one of rolling, hard sastrugi, and, since the route had shifted to the northwest, the south wind was pushing us along. The sun was shining brightly, and if it weren't for the wind and the light drift, we might have felt pretty comfortable. To our right, down in the shallow dip of the Ninnis Glacier, the faint outline of Dixson Island, forty miles to the north, could be seen miraged on the horizon.

The tent was raised at 9.30 A.M. after a run of eleven miles one hundred and seventy-six yards. An ounce each of butter was served out from our small stock to give a festive touch to the dog-stew.

The tent was set up at 9:30 A.M. after a run of eleven miles and one hundred seventy-six yards. An ounce of butter was distributed from our small supply to add a festive touch to the dog stew.

At noon I took an observation for latitude, and, after taking a bearing on to Dixson Island, computed that the distance in an air-line to Winter Quarters was one hundred and sixty miles.

At noon, I measured the latitude and, after taking a direction toward Dixson Island, calculated that the straight-line distance to Winter Quarters was one hundred sixty miles.

"December 26.—Got away at 2 A.M.; the surface undulating and hummocky with occasional beds of soft snow. Sun shining, wind ranged between thirty and forty miles per hour with much low drift; cold; camped about noon having done ten miles five hundred and twenty-eight yards.

"December 26.—Left at 2 A.M.; the ground was uneven and bumpy with occasional patches of soft snow. The sun was out, and the wind was blowing between thirty and forty miles per hour with a lot of low drifting; it was cold; we set up camp around noon after traveling ten miles and five hundred twenty-eight yards."

"We have reached the western side of the Ninnis Glacier. Ahead are rising slopes, but we look forward to assistance from the wind in the ascent.

"We've made it to the western side of the Ninnis Glacier. Up ahead are some steep slopes, but we're counting on the wind to help us as we climb."

"I was again troubled with a touch of snow-blindness, but it responded to the usual treatment.

"I was once again bothered by a slight case of snow blindness, but it reacted to the usual treatment."

"At 11 P.M. we were at it again,but what with preparing dog-stew, packing up within the limited area of the tent and experimenting with a sail, it was five hours before the march commenced.

"At 11 PM we were at it again, but with making dog stew, packing up in the tight space of the tent, and trying out a sail, it took five hours before we started the march."

"The sail was the tent-cover, attached to the top of one ski lashed vertically as a mast and secured below to the other ski, lashed across the sledge as a boom."

"The sail was the tent cover, attached to the top of one ski tied vertically as a mast and secured below to the other ski, tied across the sledge as a boom."

A start was made at 4 A.M. on the 27th in a thirty-mile wind accompanied by low drift. The surface was smooth but grew unexpectedly soft at intervals, while the ascent soon began to tell on us. Though the work was laborious, notwithstanding some aid from the sail, the bright sunlight kept up our spirits, and, whenever a halt was called for a few minutes' spell, the conversation invariably turned upon the subject of food and what we should do on arrival on board the 'Aurora'.

A start was made at 4 A.M. on the 27th in a thirty-mile wind with low drifting snow. The surface was smooth but unexpectedly got soft at times, and the climb started to wear us out. Although the work was tough, even with some help from the sail, the bright sunlight lifted our spirits. Whenever we took a break, the conversation always shifted to food and what we would do when we got back on the 'Aurora'.

At noon the sledge-meter showed nine miles one thousand four hundred yards, and we agreed to halt and pitch camp.

At noon, the sled meter displayed nine miles and one thousand four hundred yards, and we decided to stop and set up camp.

The wind had fallen off considerably, and in the brilliant sunshine it was comparatively warm in the tent. The addition of the heat from the primus stove, kept burning for an unusually long time during the preparation of the meat, caused a thaw of drift-snow which became lodged on the lee side of the tent. Thus we had frequently to put up with an unwelcome drip. Moisture came from the floor also, as there was no floor-cloth, and the sleeping-bags were soon very wet and soggy. As soon as the cooking was finished, the tent cooled off and the wet walls froze and became stiff with icy cakes.

The wind had died down a lot, and in the bright sunshine, it was relatively warm inside the tent. The heat from the primus stove, which burned for an unusually long time while we cooked the meat, caused some of the drifting snow to melt, forming puddles that collected on the sheltered side of the tent. As a result, we often had to deal with an annoying drip. Moisture also came from the ground since there was no floor mat, and the sleeping bags quickly became very damp and soggy. Once the cooking was done, the tent cooled down, and the wet walls froze, turning into stiff icy sheets.

At this time we were eating largely of the dogs' meat, to which was added one or two ounces of chocolate or raisins, three or four ounces of pemmican and biscuit mixed together, and, as a beverage, very dilute cocoa. The total weight of solid food consumed by each man per day was approximately fourteen ounces. Our small supply of butter and glaxo was saved for emergency, while a few tea-bags which remained were boiled over and over again.

At that time, we mostly ate dog meat, along with a couple of ounces of chocolate or raisins, three or four ounces of pemmican mixed with biscuits, and very diluted cocoa as a drink. Each person ate about fourteen ounces of solid food per day. We saved our limited supply of butter and Glaxo for emergencies, while the few tea bags we had left were boiled repeatedly.

The march commenced on December 28 at 3 A.M. in a thirty-mile wind accompanied by light drift. Overhead there was a wild sky which augured badly for the next few days. It was cold work raising the sail, and we were glad to be marching.

The march started on December 28 at 3 A.M. in a thirty-mile-an-hour wind with a light snow drift. The sky above was wild, which didn't look good for the days to come. It was tough work putting up the sail, and we were relieved to be on the move.

Our faithful retainer Ginger could walk no longer and was strapped on the sledge. She was the last of the dogs and had been some sort of a help until a few days before. We were sad when it came to finishing her off.

Our loyal dog Ginger couldn't walk anymore and was strapped onto the sled. She was the last of the dogs and had been somewhat helpful until a few days ago. We felt sad when it came time to put her down.

On account of the steep up grade and the weight of Ginger on the sledge, we camped at 7.15 A.M. after only four miles one thousand two hundred and thirty yards.

Due to the steep incline and Ginger's weight on the sled, we set up camp at 7:15 A.M. after traveling just four miles and one thousand two hundred thirty yards.

We had breakfast off Ginger's skull and brain. I can never forget the occasion. As there was nothing available to divide it, the skull was boiled whole. Then the right and left halves were drawn for by the old and well-established sledging practice of "shut-eye," after which we took it in turns eating to the middle line, passing the skull from one to the other. The brain was afterwards scooped out with a wooden spoon.

We had breakfast using Ginger's skull and brain. I can never forget that moment. Since there was nothing to cut it with, the skull was boiled whole. Then the right and left halves were chosen using the old sledging practice of "shut-eye," after which we took turns eating to the middle line, passing the skull back and forth. The brain was later scooped out with a wooden spoon.

On sledging journeys it is usual to apportion all food-stuffs in as nearly even halves as possible. Then one man turns away and another, pointing to a heap, asks "Whose?" The reply from the one not looking is "Yours" or "Mine" as the case may be. Thus an impartial and satisfactory division of the rations is made.

On sledging trips, it's common to divide all food supplies as evenly as possible. Then one person turns away, and another, pointing to a pile, asks, "Whose is this?" The person who isn't looking replies, "Yours" or "Mine," depending on the situation. This way, they achieve a fair and satisfactory distribution of the rations.

After the meal I went on cooking more meat so as to have a supply in readiness for eating. It was not till 2 P.M. that the second lot was finished. The task was very trying, for I had to sit up on the floor of the tent for hours in a cramped position, continually attending to the cooker, while Mertz in his Sleeping-bag was just accommodated within the limited space which remained. The tent was too small either to lie down during the operation or to sit up comfortably on a sleeping-bag.

After the meal, I continued cooking more meat to have some ready to eat. It wasn't until 2 P.M. that the second batch was done. The task was very exhausting because I had to sit on the tent floor for hours in a cramped position, constantly attending to the cooker, while Mertz was squeezed into the little space left in his sleeping bag. The tent was too small to either lie down during the process or sit up comfortably in a sleeping bag.

At 9.30 P.M. Mertz rose to take a turn at the cooking, and at 11 P.M. I joined him at "breakfast."

At 9:30 PM, Mertz got up to take his shift at cooking, and at 11 PM, I joined him for "breakfast."

At this time a kind of daily cycle was noted in the weather. It was always calmest between 4 P.M. and 6 P.M. During the evening hours the wind increased until it reached a maximum between four and six o'clock next morning, after which it fell off gradually.

At this time, a sort of daily weather cycle was observed. It was always calmest between 4 PM and 6 PM. During the evening, the wind picked up until it peaked between four and six the next morning, after which it gradually decreased.

We were away at 2.30 A.M. on the 29th in a thirty-mile wind which raised a light drift. The sail was found to be of great assistance over a surface which rose in terraces of fifty to one hundred feet in height, occurring every one to one and a half miles. This march lasted for six hours, during which we covered seven miles five hundred and twenty-eight yards.

We left at 2:30 A.M. on the 29th in a thirty-mile wind that created a light drift. The sail proved to be very helpful over a terrain that rose in terraces of fifty to one hundred feet high, appearing every one to one and a half miles. This journey lasted six hours, during which we covered seven miles and five hundred twenty-eight yards.

On December 30 the ascent continued and the wind was still in the "thirties." After several hours we overtopped the last terrace and stood on flat ground—the crest of a ridge.

On December 30, the climb went on and the wind was still in the "thirties." After a few hours, we reached the top of the last terrace and stood on flat ground—at the crest of a ridge.

Tramping over the plateau, where reigns the desolation of the outer worlds, in solitude at once ominous and weird, one is free to roam in imagination through the wide realm of human experience to the bounds of the great Beyond. One is in the midst of infinities—the infinity of the dazzling white plateau, the infinity of the dome above, the infinity of the time past since these things had birth, and the infinity of the time to come before they shall have fulfilled the Purpose for which they were created. We, in the midst of the illimitable, could feel with Marcus Aurelius that "Of life, the time is a point."

Tramping across the plateau, where the emptiness of the outer worlds dominates, in a solitude that is both foreboding and strange, one is free to wander in imagination through the vast landscape of human experience all the way to the edges of the unknown. One finds oneself surrounded by infinities—the infinite expanse of the bright white plateau, the infinite sky above, the infinite time that has passed since these things came into existence, and the infinite time that lies ahead before they fulfill the Purpose for which they were created. We, amidst the limitless, could resonate with Marcus Aurelius' thought that "In life, time is just a moment."

By 9 A.M. we had accomplished a splendid march of fifteen miles three hundred and fifty yards, but the satisfaction we should have felt at making such an inroad on the huge task before us was damped by the fact that I suddenly became aware that Mertz was not as cheerful as usual. I was at a loss to know the reason, for he was always such a bright and companionable fellow.

By 9 A.M. we had successfully completed an impressive march of fifteen miles and three hundred fifty yards, but the satisfaction we should have felt for making significant progress on the daunting task ahead was overshadowed by the realization that Mertz was not as cheerful as he usually was. I couldn’t figure out why, since he was always such a lively and friendly guy.

At 10.15 P.M. the sky had become overcast, snow was falling and a strong wind was blowing. We decided to wait for better conditions.

At 10:15 PM, the sky was cloudy, snow was coming down, and a strong wind was blowing. We decided to wait for better conditions.

On New Year's Eve at 5.30 A.M. the wind was not so strong, so we got up and prepared for the start.

On New Year's Eve at 5:30 AM, the wind wasn't as strong, so we got up and got ready to leave.

Mertz said that he felt the dogs' meat was not doing him much good and suggested that we should give it up for a time and eat a small ration of the ordinary sledging food, of which we had still some days' supply carefully husbanded. I agreed to do this and we made our first experiment on that day. The ration tasted very sweet compared with dogs' meat and was so scanty in amount that it left one painfully empty.

Mertz said he felt that eating dog meat wasn’t really helping him and suggested we should stop for a while and stick to a small portion of the regular sledging food, which we still had a few days’ worth of, carefully saved. I agreed, and that day we tried it out for the first time. The ration tasted really sweet compared to the dog meat, and it was so small that it left us feeling painfully empty.

The light was so atrocious for marching that, after stumbling along for two and a half miles, we were obliged to give up the attempt and camp, spending the day in sleeping-bags.

The light was so bad for marching that, after tripping along for two and a half miles, we had to give up and set up camp, spending the day in sleeping bags.

In the evening at 9.30 P.M. the sun appeared for a brief moment and the wind subsided. Another stage was therefore attempted but at considerable cost, for we staggered along in the bewildering light, continually falling over unseen sastrugi. The surface was undulating with a tendency to down grades. Two sets of sastrugi were found crossing one another, and, in the absence of the sun, we could not be sure of the course, so the camp was pitched niter five miles.

In the evening at 9:30 P.M., the sun came out for a quick moment, and the wind calmed down. We tried to move forward again, but it was challenging and exhausting as we stumbled through the confusing light, constantly tripping over hidden sastrugi. The ground was uneven, sloping downward. We encountered two sets of sastrugi crossing each other, and without the sun to guide us, we were unsure of our direction, so we set up camp after covering five miles.

"January 1, 1913.—Outside, an overcast sky and falling snow. Mertz was not up to his usual form and we decided not to attempt blundering along in the bad light, believing that the rest would be advantageous to him.

"January 1, 1913.—Outside, the sky was gray and snow was falling. Mertz wasn’t feeling his best, so we decided not to try to stumble our way through the poor visibility, thinking that taking a break would be good for him."

"He did not complain at all except of the dampness of his sleeping-bag, though when I questioned him particularly he admitted that he had pains in the abdomen. As I had a continuous gnawing sensation in the stomach, I took it that he had the same, possibly more acute.

"He didn't complain at all except about the dampness of his sleeping bag, but when I asked him specifically, he admitted that he had pains in his abdomen. Since I had a constant gnawing sensation in my stomach, I figured he was feeling the same, maybe even worse."

"After New Year's Day he expressed a dislike to biscuit, which seemed rather strange. Then he suddenly had a desire for glaxo and our small store was made over to him, I taking a considerable ration of the dogs' meat in exchange.

"After New Year's Day, he mentioned that he didn't like biscuits, which seemed pretty odd. Then he suddenly wanted some Glaxo, and we dedicated our small stash to him, with me taking quite a bit of the dog's meat in return."

"It was no use, however, for when we tried to cover a few more miles the exertion told very heavily on him, and it was plain that he was in a more serious condition than myself.

"It was no use, though, because when we tried to cover a few more miles, the effort weighed down on him, and it was clear that he was in a more serious condition than I was."

"January 2.—The same abominable weather. We eat only a few ounces of chocolate each day.

"January 2.—The same awful weather. We only eat a few ounces of chocolate each day."

"January 3.—In the evening the sky broke and the sun looked through the clouds. We were not long in packing up and getting on the way. The night was chilly and Mertz got frost-bitten fingers, so camp was pitched after four miles one thousand two hundred and thirty yards.

"January 3.—In the evening the sky cleared up, and the sun peeked through the clouds. We quickly packed up and hit the road. The night was cold, and Mertz got frostbite on his fingers, so we set up camp after four miles and one thousand two hundred and thirty yards."

"January 4.—The sun was shining and we had intended rising at 10 A.M., but Mertz was not well and thought that the rest would be good for him. I spent the time improving some of the gear, mending Mertz's clothing and cooking a quantity of the meat.

"January 4.—The sun was shining, and we planned to get up at 10 A.M., but Mertz wasn’t feeling well and thought some extra rest would be beneficial. I used the time to fix some of the gear, repair Mertz’s clothes, and cook up a lot of the meat."

"January 5.—The sky was overcast, snow was falling, and there was a strong wind. Mertz suggested that as the conditions were so bad we should delay another day.

"January 5.—The sky was cloudy, snow was coming down, and there was a strong wind. Mertz suggested that since the conditions were so bad, we should hold off for another day."

"Lying in the damp bags was wretched and was not doing either of us any good, but what was to be done? Outside, the conditions were abominable. My companion was evidently weaker than I, and it was apparently quite true that he was not making much of the dogs' meat.

"Lying in the damp bags was miserable and wasn't helping either of us, but what could we do? Outside, the conditions were terrible. My companion was clearly weaker than I was, and it seemed true that he wasn't getting much sustenance from the dogs' meat."

"January 6.—A better day but the sky remained overcast. Mertz agreed to try another stage."

"January 6.—A better day, but the sky was still cloudy. Mertz agreed to try another stage."

The grade was slightly downhill and the wind well behind. Unfortunately the surface was slippery and irregular and falls were frequent. These told very much upon my companion until, after consistently demurring, he at last consented to ride on the sledge. With the wind blowing behind us, it required no great exertion to bring the load along, though it would often pull up suddenly against sastrugi. After we had covered two and a half miles, Mertz became so cold through inaction in the wind that there was nothing to do but pitch the tent.

The slope was a bit downhill, and the wind was behind us. Unfortunately, the surface was slippery and uneven, which caused frequent falls. This really wore on my companion until, after repeatedly refusing, he finally agreed to ride on the sledge. With the wind at our back, it didn't take much effort to pull the load, although it often came to a sudden stop because of the sastrugi. After we had covered two and a half miles, Mertz got so cold from not moving in the wind that we had no choice but to set up the tent.

Mertz appeared to be depressed and, after the short meal, sank back into his bag without saying much. Occasionally, during the day, I would ask him how he felt, or we would return to the old subject of food. It was agreed that on our arrival on board the 'Aurora' Mertz was to make penguin omelettes, for we had never forgotten the excellence of those we had eaten just before leaving the Hut.

Mertz seemed really down, and after the quick meal, he settled back into his bag without saying much. Every now and then throughout the day, I'd check in to see how he was feeling, or we’d go back to our usual topic of food. We decided that when we got on the 'Aurora,' Mertz would make penguin omelettes because we had never forgotten how great they were when we had them right before leaving the Hut.

Reviewing the situation, I found that we were one hundred miles south-east of Winter Quarters where food and plenty awaited us. At the time we had still ordinary rations for several days. How short a distance it would seem to the vigorous, but what a lengthy journey for the weak and famished!

Reviewing the situation, I found that we were one hundred miles southeast of Winter Quarters where food and plenty awaited us. At the time, we still had regular rations for several days. How short a distance it would seem to the strong, but what a long journey for the weak and starving!

The skin was peeling off our bodies and a very poor substitute remained which burst readily and rubbed raw in many places. One day, I remember, Mertz ejaculated, "Just a moment," and, reaching over, lifted from my ear a perfect skin-cast. I was able to do the same for him. As we never took off our clothes, the peelings of hair and skin from our bodies worked down into our under-trousers and socks, and regular clearances were made.

The skin was peeling off our bodies, leaving a really poor substitute that burst easily and rubbed raw in many spots. One day, I remember, Mertz said, "Just a moment," and, reaching over, lifted a perfect skin-cast from my ear. I was able to do the same for him. Since we never took off our clothes, the remnants of hair and skin from our bodies ended up in our underwear and socks, and we had to clean them out regularly.

During the evening of the 6th I made the following note in my diary:

During the evening of the 6th, I wrote the following note in my diary:

"A long and wearisome night. If only I could get on; but I must stop with Xavier. He does not appear to be improving and both our chances are going now."

"A long and exhausting night. If only I could move on; but I have to stay with Xavier. He doesn't seem to be getting any better, and both our chances are fading now."

"January 7.—Up at 8 A.M., it having been arranged last night that we would go on to-day at all costs, sledge-sailing, with Xavier in his bag on the sledge." It was a sad blow to me to find that Mertz was in a weak state and required helping in and out of his bag. He needed rest for a few hours at least before he could think of travelling. "I have to turn in again to kill time and also to keep warm, for I feel the cold very much now."

"January 7.—Up at 8 A.M., since we arranged last night that we would go today no matter what, sledge-sailing, with Xavier in his bag on the sledge." It was disappointing to discover that Mertz was in poor condition and needed help getting in and out of his bag. He needed to rest for at least a few hours before he could even consider traveling. "I guess I’ll go back to bed to pass the time and to stay warm, because I'm really feeling the cold now."

"At 10 A.M. I get up to dress Xavier and prepare food, but find him in a kind of fit." Coming round a few minutes later, he exchanged a few words and did not seem to realize that anything had happened. "... Obviously we can't go on to-day. It is a good day though the light is bad, the sun just gleaming through the clouds. This is terrible; I don't mind for myself but for others. I pray to God to help us."

"At 10 A.M., I wake up to get Xavier dressed and make some food, but I find him having some sort of fit." After a few minutes, he comes to, shares a few words, and doesn’t seem to understand that anything happened. "... Clearly we can't continue today. It's a nice day even though the light isn't great; the sun is barely shining through the clouds. This is awful; I don’t mind for myself, but for others. I pray to God for help."

"I cook some thick cocoa for Xavier and give him beef-tea; he is better after noon, but very low—I have to lift him up to drink."

"I make some thick cocoa for Xavier and give him beef tea; he feels a bit better after noon, but he's still very weak—I have to help him up to drink."

During the afternoon he had several more fits, then became delirious and talked incoherently until midnight, when he appeared to fall off into a peaceful slumber. So I toggled up the sleeping-bag and retired worn out into my own. After a couple of hours, having felt no movement from my companion, I stretched out an arm and found that he was stiff.

During the afternoon, he had several more episodes, then became delirious and talked nonsense until midnight, when he seemed to drift off into a peaceful sleep. So I zipped up the sleeping bag and crawled into my own, exhausted. After a couple of hours, not feeling any movement from my companion, I reached out an arm and discovered that he was stiff.

My comrade had been accepted into "the peace that passeth all understanding." It was my fervent hope that he had been received where sterling qualities and a high mind reap their due reward. In his life we loved him; he was a man of character, generous and of noble parts.

My friend had found "the peace that surpasses all understanding." I truly hoped he had been welcomed to a place where outstanding qualities and a strong mind are justly rewarded. In his life, we loved him; he was a man of character, generous, and of noble actions.

For hours I lay in the bag, rolling over in my mind all that lay behind and the chance of the future. I seemed to stand alone on the wide shores of the world—and what a short step to enter the unknown future!

For hours I lay in the bag, thinking about everything that happened in the past and the possibilities of the future. I felt like I was standing alone on the vast shores of the world—and it felt like just a small step to dive into the unknown future!

My physical condition was such that I felt I might collapse in a moment. The gnawing in the stomach had developed there a permanent weakness, so that it was not possible to hold myself up in certain positions. Several of my toes commenced to blacken and fester near the tips and the nails worked loose.

My physical condition was such that I felt like I might collapse at any moment. The gnawing in my stomach had created a constant weakness, making it impossible to support myself in certain positions. Several of my toes started to blacken and fester near the tips, and the nails became loose.

Outside, the bowl of chaos was brimming with drift-snow and I wondered how I would manage to break and pitch camp single-handed. There appeared to be little hope of reaching the Hut. It was easy to sleep on in the bag, and the weather was cruel outside. But inaction is hard to brook, and I thought of Service's lines:

Outside, the scene was chaotic with blowing snow, and I wondered how I would set up camp all by myself. It seemed unlikely that I would make it to the Hut. It was tempting to stay curled up in my sleeping bag, especially with the harsh weather outside. But sitting still was tough to handle, and I thought of Service's lines:

    Buck up, do your damndest and fight,
    It's the plugging away that will win you the day.
    Stay strong, give it your all, and keep fighting,
    It's the persistence that will lead you to victory.

If I failed to reach the Hut it would be something done to reach some prominent point likely to catch the eye of a search party, where a cairn might be erected and our diaries cached. And so I commenced to modify the sledge and camping gear to meet fresh requirements.

If I couldn’t get to the Hut, it would be necessary to find a noticeable spot that would attract the attention of a search party, where a pile of stones could be built and our diaries hidden away. So, I started to adapt the sledge and camping gear to fit new needs.

The sky remained clouded, but the wind fell off to a calm which lasted for several hours. I took the opportunity to set to work on the sledge, sawing it in halves with a pocket tool. A mast was made out of one of the rails of the discarded half of the sledge and a spar was cut from the other rail. The sledge-meter, very much battered, was still serviceable. Lastly, the load was cut down to a minimum by the elimination of all but the barest necessities.

The sky was overcast, but the wind calmed down for several hours. I took the chance to work on the sled, sawing it in half with a pocket tool. I made a mast from one of the rails of the discarded half of the sled and cut a spar from the other rail. The sledge-meter, although quite damaged, was still usable. Finally, I reduced the load to the bare essentials by getting rid of everything else.

Late on the evening of the 8th I took the body of Mertz, wrapped up in his sleeping-bag, outside the tent, piled snow blocks around it and raised a rough cross made of the two half-runners of the sledge.

Late on the evening of the 8th, I took Mertz's body, wrapped in his sleeping bag, outside the tent, piled snow blocks around it, and raised a rough cross made from the two half-runners of the sled.

On January 9 the weather was overcast and fairly thick drift was flying in a wind reaching about fifty miles an hour. As certain matters still required attention and my chances of re-erecting the tent were rather doubtful, if I had decided to move on, the start was delayed.

On January 9, the weather was cloudy, and there was a significant amount of snow being blown around in winds of about fifty miles per hour. Since some things still needed to be taken care of and my chances of setting up the tent again were pretty uncertain, I decided to postpone my departure.

"I read the Burial Service over Xavier this afternoon. As there is little chance of my reaching human aid alive. I greatly regret inability at the moment to set out the detail of coastline met with for three hundred miles travelled and observations of glacier and ice-formations, etc.; the most of which latter are, of course, committed to my head.

"I read the Burial Service over Xavier this afternoon. Since there's a slim chance I'll make it to safety alive, I regret that I can't share the details of the coastline I encountered over the three hundred miles traveled, along with my observations of glaciers and ice formations, etc.; most of which, of course, are stuck in my head."

"The approximate location of the camp is latitude 68 degrees 2' S., longitude 145 degrees 9' E. This is dead reckoning, as the theodolite legs have been out of action for some time, splinted together to form tent-props. I believe the truth lies nearer latitude 67 degrees 57' S., longitude 145 degrees 20' E., as the wind must have drifted us to the north."

"The camp's approximate location is latitude 68 degrees 2' S., longitude 145 degrees 9' E. This is based on dead reckoning, since the theodolite legs have been out of service for a while and are being used as tent props. I think the real coordinates are closer to latitude 67 degrees 57' S., longitude 145 degrees 20' E., since the wind has likely pushed us northward."

During the afternoon I cut up Mertz's burberry jacket and roughly sewed it to a large canvas clothes-bag, making a sail which could be readily set or furled, so as to save delay in starting out or in camping.

During the afternoon, I cut up Mertz's burberry jacket and roughly sewed it to a large canvas bag, creating a sail that could be easily set up or taken down to save time when getting started or setting up camp.

January 10 was an impossible day for travelling on account of thick drift and high wind. I spent part of the time in reckoning up the amount of food remaining and in cooking the rest of the dogs' meat; the last device enabling me to leave behind some of the kerosene, of which there was still a good supply. Late in the afternoon the wind fell and the sun peered amongst the clouds just as I was in the middle of a long job riveting and lashing the broken shovel.

January 10 was a terrible day for traveling because of heavy snow and strong winds. I spent part of the time calculating how much food we had left and cooking the remaining dog meat, which allowed me to save some of the kerosene we still had a good amount of. Late in the afternoon, the wind calmed down, and the sun broke through the clouds just as I was in the middle of a lengthy task of repairing and securing the broken shovel.

It was on January 11—a beautiful, calm day of sunshine—that I set out over a good surface with a slight down grade. From the start my feet felt lumpy and sore. They had become so painful after a mile of walking that I decided to make an examination of them on the spot, sitting in the sun on the sledge. The sight of my feet gave me quite a shock, for the thickened skin of the soles had separated in each case as a complete layer, and abundant watery fluid had escaped into the socks. The new skin underneath was very much abraded and raw.

It was January 11—a beautiful, calm day with sunshine—when I started out on a decent surface with a slight downhill slope. From the beginning, my feet felt lumpy and sore. They became so painful after a mile of walking that I decided to take a look at them right there, sitting in the sun on the sled. The sight of my feet really shocked me; the thickened skin on the soles had completely peeled away, and a lot of watery fluid had soaked into my socks. The new skin underneath was really abraded and raw.

I did what appeared to be the best thing under the stances: smeared the new skin with lanoline, of which there was a good store, and with bandages bound the skin soles back in place, as they were comfortable and soft in contact with the raw surfaces. Outside the bandages I wore six pairs of thick woollen socks, fur boots and a crampon over-shoe of soft leather. Then I removed most of my clothing and bathed in the glorious heat of the sun. A tingling sensation seemed to spread throughout my whole body, and I felt stronger and better.

I did what seemed to be the best thing at the time: I slathered the new skin with lanolin, of which I had plenty, and used bandages to hold the skin soles back in place since they were comfortable and soft against the raw surfaces. On top of the bandages, I wore six pairs of thick wool socks, fur boots, and a soft leather crampon over-shoe. Then, I took off most of my clothes and soaked in the glorious heat of the sun. A tingling sensation spread throughout my entire body, and I felt stronger and better.

When the day commenced with ideal weather I thought I would cover a long distance, but at 5.30 P.M., after six and a quarter miles, I felt nerve-worn and had to camp, "so worn that had it not been a delightful evening, I should not have found strength to erect the tent."

When the day started with perfect weather, I thought I could travel a long way, but at 5:30 PM, after six and a quarter miles, I felt exhausted and had to set up camp, "so tired that if it hadn't been a lovely evening, I wouldn't have had the energy to put up the tent."

Though the medical outfit was limited, there were a fair number of bandages and on camping I devoted much time to tending raw patches all over the body, festering fingers and inflamed nostrils.

Though the medical supplies were limited, there were a decent number of bandages, and while camping, I spent a lot of time taking care of raw spots all over the body, infected fingers, and swollen nostrils.

High wind and much drift put travelling out of the question on January 12, and in any case my feet needed a rest.

High winds and heavy drifting made traveling impossible on January 12, and besides, my feet needed a break.

"January 13.—The wind subsided and the snow cleared off at noon. The afternoon was beautifully fine. Descended hard ice-slopes over many crevasses—almost all descent—but surface cut my feet up; at 8 P.M. camped, having done five and three-quarter miles—painful feet—on camping find feet worse than ever; things look bad but shall persevere. It is now 11 P.M. and the glacier is firing off like artillery—appears to send up great jets of imprisoned air."

"January 13.—The wind died down and the snow cleared by noon. The afternoon was beautifully clear. I descended steep ice slopes over many crevasses—almost all downhill—but the surface hurt my feet; at 8 P.M. I set up camp after walking five and three-quarter miles—my feet are in pain—camping feels worse than ever; things look grim but I’ll keep going. It’s now 11 P.M. and the glacier is rumbling like artillery—looks like it’s sending up huge bursts of trapped air."

During the march Aurora Peak showed up to the west, about twenty miles away, across the Mertz Glacier. I felt happy at thus fixing my position, and at the sight of the far plateau which led onwards to Winter Quarters.

During the march, Aurora Peak appeared to the west, about twenty miles away, across the Mertz Glacier. I felt happy to see my position clearly and at the sight of the distant plateau that stretched towards Winter Quarters.

The glacier was the next obstacle to advance. To the south-west it descended from the plateau in immense broken folds. Pressing northward it was torn into the jumbled crush of serac-ice, sparkling beneath an unclouded sun. The idea of diverging to the west and rounding the ice-falls occurred to me, but the detours involved other difficulties, so I strove to pick out the best track across the valley.

The glacier was the next hurdle to overcome. To the southwest, it sloped down from the plateau in huge, twisted folds. As it pushed northward, it broke apart into a chaotic jumble of serac ice, glinting under a clear sun. I considered going west to navigate around the ice falls, but the detours came with their own challenges, so I tried to find the best route across the valley.

A high wind which blew on the morning of the 14th diminished in strength by noon and allowed me to get away. The sun was so warm that the puckered ice underfoot was covered with a film of water and in some places small trickles ran away to disappear into crevasses.

A strong wind that blew on the morning of the 14th died down by noon, letting me leave. The sun was so warm that the uneven ice beneath my feet was covered with a layer of water, and in some spots, small streams flowed away, disappearing into crevasses.

Though the course was downhill to the Mertz Glacier, the sledge required a good deal of pulling owing to the wet runners. At 9 P.M., after travelling five miles, I pitched camp in the bed of the glacier.

Though the path was downhill to the Mertz Glacier, the sled needed a lot of pulling due to the wet runners. At 9 P.M., after covering five miles, I set up camp in the glacier’s bed.

Between 9.30 P.M. and 11 P.M. the "cannonading" heard on the previous night recommenced. The sounds, resembling the explosions of heavy guns, usually started higher up the glacier and ended down towards the sea. When I first heard them, I put my head outside the tent to see what was going on. The reports came at random from every direction, but there was no visible evidence as to how they were produced. Without a doubt they had something to do with the re-freezing and splitting of the ice owing to the evening chill; but the sounds seemed far too loud to be explained by this cause alone.

Between 9:30 PM and 11 PM, the "cannonading" we heard the night before started up again. The noises, which sounded like explosions from heavy artillery, usually began higher up on the glacier and ended down by the sea. When I first heard them, I stuck my head out of the tent to see what was happening. The loud bangs came randomly from every direction, but there was no clear explanation for how they were being made. There was no doubt they were linked to the ice refreezing and cracking due to the evening chill, but the sounds seemed way too loud to be explained by that alone.

January 15—the date on which all the summer sledging parties were due at the Hut! It was overcast and snowing early in the day, and in a few hours the sun broke out and shone warmly. The travelling was so heavy over a soft snowy surface, partly melting, that I gave up, after one mile, and camped.

January 15—the day when all the summer sledding groups were expected at the Hut! It was cloudy and snowing early on, but after a few hours, the sun came out and warmed things up. The snow was so soft and partly melting that traveling was really tough, so I decided to stop after just one mile and set up camp.

At 7 P.M. the surface had not improved, the sky was thickly obscured and snow fell. At 10 P.M. the snow was coming down heavily, and, since there were many crevasses in the vicinity, I resolved to wait.

At 7 PM, the conditions hadn't improved; the sky was heavily overcast, and snow was falling. By 10 PM, the snow was coming down hard, and with numerous crevasses nearby, I decided to wait.

On the 16th at 2 A.M. the snow was as thick as ever, but at 5 A.M. the atmosphere lightened and the sun appeared.

On the 16th at 2 A.M., the snow was as thick as ever, but by 5 A.M., the atmosphere brightened and the sun came out.

Without delay I broke camp. A favourable breeze sprang up, and with sail set I managed to proceed through the snowy "deluge" in short stages. The snow clung in lumps to the runners, which had to be scraped frequently. I passed some broken ridges and sank into several holes leading down to crevasses out of which it was possible to scramble easily.

Without wasting any time, I packed up camp. A nice breeze picked up, and with my sail set, I was able to move through the snowy "deluge" in short bursts. The snow stuck in clumps to the sled runners, which I had to scrape off regularly. I went past some broken ridges and fell into a few holes that led down to crevasses, which were easy to climb out of.

After laboriously toiling up one long slope, I was just catching my breath at the top and the sledge was running easily when I noticed that the surface beneath my feet fell away steeply in front. I suddenly realized that I was on the brink of a great blue hole like a quarry. The sledge was following of its own accord and was rapidly gaining speed, so I turned and, exerting every effort, was just able to hold it back by means of the hauling-line from the edge of the abyss. I should think that there must have been an interval of quite a minute during which I held my ground without being able to make it budge. Then it slowly came my way, and the imminent danger was past.

After hard work climbing a long slope, I was finally catching my breath at the top, and the sledge was gliding smoothly when I noticed that the ground beneath my feet dropped steeply in front of me. I suddenly realized I was on the edge of a massive blue hole, like a quarry. The sledge was moving on its own and picking up speed, so I turned and, putting in all my effort, was just able to hold it back with the hauling line from the edge of the drop. I think there must have been almost a full minute where I held my position without being able to move it. Then it slowly began to come back my way, and the immediate danger was over.

The day's march was an extremely hard five miles. Before turning in I had an extra supper of jelly soup, made by boiling down some of the dogs' sinews, strengthened with a little pemmican. The acute enjoyment of eating under these circumstances compensates in a slight measure for the suffering of starvation.

The day's hike was a really tough five miles. Before going to bed, I had an extra dinner of jelly soup, made by boiling down some of the dogs' tendons, enriched with a bit of pemmican. The intense pleasure of eating in these conditions somewhat makes up for the pain of hunger.

January 17 was another day of overcast weather and falling snow. Delay meant a reduction in the ration which was low enough already, so there was nothing to do but go on.

January 17 was another gloomy day with falling snow. The delay meant a further cut in the already low rations, so there was nothing to do but keep moving forward.

When I got away at 8 A.M. I found that the pulling was easier than it had been on the previous day. Nevertheless I covered only two miles and had to consider myself fortunate in not winding up the whole story then and there. This is what happened, following the account in my diary.

When I left at 8 A.M., I found that the pulling was easier than it had been the day before. Still, I only covered two miles and had to count myself lucky for not ending the whole journey right then and there. This is what happened, according to my diary.

"Going up a long, fairly steep slope, deeply covered with soft snow, broke through lid of crevasse but caught myself at thighs, got out, turned fifty yards to the north, then attempted to cross trend of crevasse, there being no indication of it; a few moments later found myself dangling fourteen feet below on end of rope in crevasse—sledge creeping to mouth—had time to say to myself, 'so this is the end,' expecting the sledge every moment to crash on my head and all to go to the unseen bottom—then thought of the food uneaten on the sledge; but as the sledge pulled up without letting me down, thought of Providence giving me another chance." The chance was very small considering my weak condition. The width of the crevasse was about six feet, so I hung freely in space, turning slowly round.

"Climbing up a long, fairly steep slope that was covered in soft snow, I broke through the surface of a crevasse but managed to catch myself at my thighs. I pulled myself out, turned fifty yards to the north, and tried to cross the crevasse’s trend without any sign of it. A few moments later, I found myself dangling fourteen feet below, hanging by a rope in the crevasse—my sledge creeping toward the edge. I had time to think, 'So this is the end,' expecting the sledge to crash down on me any second and for everything to fall into the unseen depths below. Then I thought about the food I hadn’t eaten on the sledge; but as the sledge came up without letting me down, I considered it a second chance from Providence." The chance was very slim given my weak condition. The crevasse was about six feet wide, so I hung freely in space, slowly turning around.

A great effort brought a knot in the rope within my grasp, and, after a moment's rest, I was able to draw myself up and reach another, and, at length, hauled myself on to the overhanging snow-lid into which the rope had cut. Then, when I was carefully climbing out on to the surface, a further section of the lid gave way, precipitating me once more to the full length of the rope.

A strong effort created a knot in the rope I was holding, and after a moment to catch my breath, I managed to pull myself up and grab onto another part. Eventually, I hoisted myself up onto the overhanging snow that the rope had cut into. Then, as I was cautiously climbing onto the surface, another part of the lid collapsed, sending me crashing down again to the full length of the rope.

Exhausted, weak and chilled (for my hands were bare and pounds of snow had got inside my clothing) I hung with the firm conviction that all was over except the passing. Below was a black chasm; it would be but the work of a moment to slip from the harness, then all the pain and toil would be over. It was a rare situation, a rare temptation—a chance to quit small things for great—to pass from the petty exploration of a planet to the contemplation of vaster worlds beyond. But there was all eternity for the last and, at its longest, the present would be but short. I felt better for the thought.

Exhausted, weak, and cold (my hands were bare, and snow had gotten inside my clothes), I hung there, convinced that everything was over except for the end. Below me was a dark abyss; it would only take a moment to slip out of the harness, and then all the pain and struggle would be over. It was a rare situation, a rare temptation—a chance to trade small things for something greater—to move from the minor exploration of a planet to the consideration of vaster worlds beyond. But there was all of eternity for the latter, and at its longest, the present would be just a brief moment. I felt better thinking about that.

My strength was fast ebbing; in a few minutes it would be too late. It was the occasion for a supreme attempt. New power seemed to come as I addressed myself to one last tremendous effort. The struggle occupied some time, but by a miracle I rose slowly to the surface. This time I emerged feet first, still holding on to the rope, and pushed myself out, extended at full length, on the snow—on solid ground. Then came the reaction, and I could do nothing for quite an hour.

My strength was quickly fading; in just a few minutes, it would be too late. This was the moment for one last major push. I felt a surge of energy as I prepared for one final, incredible effort. The struggle took some time, but by some miracle, I slowly made it to the surface. This time, I came up feet first, still gripping the rope, and pushed myself out, lying flat on the snow—on solid ground. Then the aftermath hit me, and I couldn't move for almost an hour.

The tent was erected in slow stages and I then had a little food. Later on I lay in the sleeping-bag, thinking things over. It was a time when the mood of the Persian philosopher appealed to me:

The tent was set up gradually, and then I had a quick snack. Later, I lay in the sleeping bag, reflecting on things. It was a moment when the perspective of the Persian philosopher resonated with me:

    Unborn To-morrow and dead Yesterday,
    Why fret about them if To-day be sweet?
    Unborn tomorrow and dead yesterday,  
    Why worry about them if today is sweet?

I was confronted with this problem: whether it was better to enjoy life for a few days, sleeping and eating my fill until the provisions gave out, or to "plug on" again in hunger with the prospect of plunging at any moment into eternity without the great luxury and pleasure of food. And then an idea presented itself which greatly improved my prospects. It was to construct a ladder from alpine rope; one end of which was to be secured to the bow of the sledge and the other to be carried over my left shoulder and loosely attached to the sledge harness. Thus, if I fell into a crevasse again, it would be easy for me, even though weakened by starvation, to scramble out again by the ladder, provided the sledge was not also engulphed.

I faced a dilemma: should I enjoy life for a few days, eating and sleeping as much as I wanted until the supplies ran out, or "keep going" in hunger with the fear of slipping into eternity at any moment without the comfort and delight of food? Then an idea came to me that greatly improved my chances. I thought about making a ladder from alpine rope; one end would be tied to the front of the sledge, and I would carry the other end over my left shoulder, loosely connecting it to the sledge harness. This way, if I fell into a crevasse again, it would be easier for me, even though weak from starvation, to climb out using the ladder, as long as the sledge wasn’t also swallowed up.

Notwithstanding the possibilities of the rope ladder, I could not sleep properly at all; my nerves had been so overtaxed. All night considerable wind and drift continued.

Not withstanding the options the rope ladder offered, I couldn't sleep at all; my nerves had been so stretched. The wind and drifting continued all night long.

On the 19th it was overcast and light snow was falling. I resolved "to go ahead and leave the rest to Providence."

On the 19th, it was cloudy and light snow was falling. I decided "to go ahead and leave the rest to fate."

As they wallowed through the deep snow my feet and legs kept breaking through into space. Then I went right under, but the sledge was held back and the ladder "proved trumps." A few minutes later I was down again, but I emerged again without much exertion, half-smothered with snow. Faintness overcame me and I stopped to camp, though only a short distance had been covered.

As they trudged through the deep snow, my feet and legs kept sinking into it. Then I went all the way under, but the sledge got stuck, and the ladder was a lifesaver. A few minutes later I went under again, but I managed to get out easily, half-buried in snow. I felt faint and decided to stop and rest, even though I hadn't gone very far.

All around me was a leaden glare, the snow clouds "corralling" me in. The sun had not shown up for some days and I was eager to see it once more, not only that it might show up the landscape, but for its cheerful influence and life-giving energy. A few days previously my condition had been improving, but now it was going back.

All around me was a heavy grayness, the snow clouds "trapping" me in. The sun hadn't appeared for several days, and I was looking forward to seeing it again, not just to light up the landscape, but for its uplifting effect and life-giving warmth. A few days before, I had been getting better, but now I was slipping back.

During the night of the 18th loud booming noises, sharp cracks and muffled growls issued form the neighbouring crevasses and kept waking me up. At times one could feel a vibration accompanying the growling sounds, and I concluded that the ice was in rapid motion.

During the night of the 18th, loud booming noises, sharp cracks, and muffled growls came from the nearby crevasses and kept waking me up. Sometimes, I could feel a vibration along with the growling sounds, and I figured that the ice was moving quickly.

The sun at last appeared on the 19th, and I was off by 8.30 A.M. The whole surface was a network of crevasses, some very wide. Along one after another of these I dragged the sledge until a spot was reached where the snow-bridge looked to be firm. Here I plunged across, risking the consequences.

The sun finally came out on the 19th, and I was on my way by 8:30 A.M. The entire surface was covered in crevasses, some quite wide. I dragged the sledge along one after another of these until I found a place where the snow bridge seemed solid. I went for it, taking the risk.

After three hours' marching nothing serious had happened and I found myself on safer ground with a "pimply" surface visible ahead, close under the slopes of the highlands. Once on this I became over-reliant, and in consequence sank several times into narrow fissures.

After three hours of marching, nothing serious had happened, and I found myself on safer ground with a "pimply" surface visible ahead, just below the slopes of the highlands. Once on this terrain, I became over-confident and ended up sinking several times into narrow cracks.

At 1 P.M. the Mertz Glacier was at last crossed and I had reached the rising hills on its western side. Overlooking the camp, five hundred feet above the glacier, were beetling, crevassed crags, but I could trace out a good road, free from pitfalls, leading to the plateau, at an elevation of three thousand feet.

At 1 P.M., I finally crossed the Mertz Glacier and reached the rising hills on its western side. Overlooking the camp, five hundred feet above the glacier, were steep, cracked cliffs, but I could see a good path, clear of hazards, leading to the plateau, which was three thousand feet high.

To lighten my load for the climb I threw away alpine rope, finnesko crampons, sundry pairs of worn crampons and socks, while I rubbed a composition on the sledge-runners which prevented them from sticking to wet snow.

To make my climb easier, I got rid of alpine rope, finner shoes, a bunch of old crampons and socks, while I applied a mix to the sledge runners that kept them from freezing to wet snow.

January 20 was a wretched day; overcast, with wind and light drift. In desperation I got away at 2 P.M. in a wind which proved to be of considerable assistance. I could see nothing of my surroundings; one thing was certain, and that was that the ascent had commenced and every foot took me upward. The day's work amounted to about two and a half miles.

January 20 was a terrible day; it was cloudy, windy, and there was light snow drifting. In my desperation, I left at 2 P.M. in a wind that turned out to be quite helpful. I couldn’t see anything around me; one thing was clear, and that was that I had started my ascent, and every step took me higher. The day's journey covered about two and a half miles.

On the 21st the sun shone brightly and there was a good following wind. Through deep snow I zigzagged up for three miles before deciding to camp.

On the 21st, the sun was shining brightly and there was a nice tailwind. I zigzagged through deep snow for three miles before deciding to set up camp.

Wind and drift prevailed early on the 22nd but fell away towards noon, and I was then favoured with a glorious sunny day. Away to the north was a splendid view of the open sea; it looked so beautiful and friendly that I longed to be down near it. Six miles had been covered during the day, but I felt very weak towards the end on account of the heavy pulling.

Wind and currents were strong early on the 22nd but calmed down around noon, and then I was treated to a beautiful sunny day. To the north, there was a stunning view of the open sea; it looked so inviting and friendly that I wished I could be closer to it. I had covered six miles during the day, but I felt really weak by the end because of the hard work.

During the early hours of the 23rd the sun was visible, but about 8 A.M. the clouds sagged low, the wind rose and everything became blotted out in a swirl of driving snow.

During the early hours of the 23rd, the sun was visible, but around 8 A.M., the clouds hung low, the wind picked up, and everything was obscured in a whirlwind of driving snow.

I wandered on through it for several hours, the sledge capsizing at times owing to the strength of the wind. It was not possible to keep an accurate course, for even the wind changed direction as the day wore on. Underfoot there was soft snow which I found comfortable for my sore feet, but which made the sledge drag heavily at times.

I wandered through it for several hours, with the sled tipping over at times because of the strong wind. It was impossible to maintain a steady course, as even the wind shifted direction throughout the day. The soft snow underfoot was comfortable for my sore feet, but it also made the sled drag heavily at times.

When camp was pitched at 4 P.M. I reckoned that the distance covered in a straight line had been three and a half miles.

When we set up camp at 4 P.M., I estimated that we had covered a straight-line distance of about three and a half miles.

Erecting the tent single-handed in the high wind was a task which required much patience and some skill. The poles were erected first and then the tent was gathered up in the proper form and taken to the windward side of the legs where it was weighted down. The flounce on the windward side was got into position and piled up with snow blocks. Other blocks of snow had previously been placed in a ring round the legs in readiness to be tumbled on to the rest of the flounce when the tent was quickly slipped over the apex of the poles. In very windy weather it was often as much as two hours after halting before I would be cosy within the shelter of the tent.

Setting up the tent alone in the strong wind was a job that needed a lot of patience and some skill. The poles were put up first, then the tent was gathered into the right shape and taken to the windward side of the poles where it was weighed down. The flap on the windward side was positioned and stacked with snow blocks. Other snow blocks had already been arranged in a ring around the poles, ready to be tossed onto the rest of the flap when the tent was quickly slipped over the top of the poles. In really windy conditions, it would often take as long as two hours after stopping before I could get comfortably settled into the shelter of the tent.

High wind and dense driving snow persisted throughout the 24th and I made five and a half miles, sitting on the sledge most of the time with the sail up.

High winds and heavy snow continued throughout the 24th, and I made it five and a half miles, sitting on the sled most of the time with the sail up.

The blizzard continued on the 25th, but after the trying experience of the previous two days, I did not feel well enough to go on. Outside, the snow fell in "torrents," piled up round the tent and pressed in until it was no bigger than a coffin, of which it reminded me.

The blizzard carried on through the 25th, but after the tough experience of the last two days, I didn’t feel well enough to continue. Outside, the snow fell in "torrents," stacking up around the tent and pressing in until it was no bigger than a coffin, which it reminded me of.

I passed most of the day doctoring myself, attending to raw and inflamed places. Tufts of my beard and hair came out, and the snowy floor of the tent was strewn with it at every camp.

I spent most of the day taking care of myself, treating sore and inflamed spots. Clumps of my beard and hair fell out, and the white floor of the tent was covered with it at every camp.

"January 26.—I went on again in dense, driving snow. There was no need of the sail. The wind, which was behind, caught the sledge and bundled it along so that, though over a soft surface of snow, the travelling was rapid. The snow was in large, rounded grains, and beat on the tent like hail. Altogether nine miles were covered.

"January 26.—I continued on through heavy, blowing snow. The sail wasn’t necessary. The wind, coming from behind, pushed the sled along quickly, making the journey speedy even on the soft snow. The snow consisted of large, rounded grains and hit the tent like hail. In total, we covered nine miles."

"January 27.—Blizzard-bound again. The previous day's exertions were too much for me to undertake the same again without a long rest.

"January 27.—Stuck in a blizzard again. Yesterday's activities wore me out, so I can't do the same thing again without a long break."

"January 28,—In the morning the wind had moderated very much but the sky remained overcast and snow continued to fall. It was a long job digging the tent out. Soon after the start the sun gleamed and the weather improved. The three-thousand-foot crest of the plateau had been crossed and I was bearing down rapidly on Commonwealth Bay, the vicinity of which showed up as a darker patch on the clouds of the north-west horizon.

"January 28,—In the morning, the wind had calmed down a lot, but the sky stayed cloudy and snow kept falling. It took a long time to dig the tent out. Soon after we began, the sun peeked through and the weather got better. I had crossed the three-thousand-foot peak of the plateau and was quickly heading toward Commonwealth Bay, which appeared as a darker area on the clouds of the north-west horizon."

"The evening was fine and I really began to feel that Winter Quarters were approaching. To increase my excitement Madigan Nunatak came into view for a time in the clear, evening light. Distance covered, over eight miles."

"The evening was nice, and I really started to feel that Winter Quarters were getting closer. To boost my excitement, Madigan Nunatak appeared for a moment in the clear evening light. Distance covered: over eight miles."

The calm of the previous evening was broken again, and I started on the morning of January 29 in considerable drift and a fairly strong wind. After going five miles I had miraculous good fortune.

The peace of the previous evening was interrupted once more, and I began the morning of January 29 with a significant drift and a pretty strong wind. After traveling five miles, I had incredible luck.

I was travelling along on an even down grade and was wondering how long the two pounds of food which remained would last, when something dark loomed through the drift a short distance away to the right. All sorts of possibilities fled through my mind as I headed the sledge for it. The unexpected happened—it was a cairn of snow erected by McLean, Hodgeman and Hurley, who had been out searching for us. On the top of the mound was a bag of food, left on the chance that it might be picked up, while in a tin was a note stating the bearing and distance of the mound from Aladdin's Cave (E. 30 degrees S., distance twenty-three miles), that the Ship had arrived at the Hut and was waiting, that Amundsen had reached the Pole, and that Scott was remaining another year in Antarctica.

I was traveling downhill and wondering how long the two pounds of food I had left would last when I saw something dark appear through the snow a short distance to my right. A million thoughts raced through my mind as I steered the sled toward it. What I found was unexpected—it was a snow cairn built by McLean, Hodgeman, and Hurley, who had been out looking for us. On top of the mound was a bag of food, left there in case someone found it, and inside a tin was a note stating the direction and distance of the mound from Aladdin's Cave (E. 30 degrees S., twenty-three miles away), that the Ship had arrived at the Hut and was waiting, that Amundsen had reached the Pole, and that Scott was staying in Antarctica for another year.

It was rather a singular fact that the search party only left this mound at eight o'clock on the morning of that very day (January 29). It was about 2 P.M. when I found it. Thus, during the night of the 28th, our camps had been only about five miles apart.

It was quite unusual that the search party only left this mound at 8 a.m. on that same day (January 29). I found it around 2 p.m. So, during the night of the 28th, our camps were only about five miles apart.

With plenty of food, I speedily felt stimulated and revived, and anticipated reaching the Hut in a day or two, for there was then not more than twenty-three miles to cover. Alas, however, there was to be another delay. I was without crampons—they had been thrown away on the western side of Mertz Glacier—and in the strong wind was not able to stand up on the slippery ice of the coastal slopes. The result was that I sat on the sledge and ran along with the wind, nibbling at the food as I went. The sledge made so much leeway that near the end of the day, after fourteen miles, I reckoned that I had been carried to the east of Aladdin's Cave. The course was therefore changed to the west, but the wind came down almost broadside-on to the sledge, and it was swept away. The only thing to do was to camp.

With plenty of food, I quickly felt energized and looked forward to reaching the Hut in a day or two, since there were only about twenty-three miles left to travel. Unfortunately, there was going to be another delay. I didn't have any crampons—they had been discarded on the west side of Mertz Glacier—and in the strong wind, I couldn’t keep my balance on the slippery ice of the coastal slopes. As a result, I sat on the sled and let the wind push me along while munching on my food. The sled drifted so much that by the end of the day, after fourteen miles, I figured I had been blown east of Aladdin's Cave. So, I changed direction to head west, but the wind came in almost sideways to the sled, and it was swept away. The only option was to set up camp.

On the 30th I cut up the box of the theodolite and into two pieces of wood stuck as many screws and tacks as I could procure from the sledge-meter. In the repair-bag there were still a few ice-nails which at this time were of great use. Late in the day the wind fell off, and I started westward over the ice-slopes with the pieces of nail-studded wood lashed to my feet.

On the 30th, I broke down the theodolite box and attached as many screws and tacks as I could find from the sledge-meter to two pieces of wood. In the repair bag, there were still a few ice nails that were really helpful at this point. Later in the day, the wind died down, and I headed west over the icy slopes with the nailed-up wooden pieces strapped to my feet.

After six miles these improvised crampons broke up, and the increasing wind got me into difficulties. Finally, the sledge slipped sideways into a narrow crevasse and was caught by the boom (which crossed from side to side at the lower part of the mast). I was not strong enough for the job of extricating it straight away, and by the time I had got it safely on the ice, the wind had increased still more. So I pitched camp.

After six miles, these makeshift crampons fell apart, and the stronger wind made things tough for me. Eventually, the sled slipped sideways into a narrow crevasse and got caught by the boom (which crossed from side to side at the lower part of the mast). I wasn't strong enough to pull it out right away, and by the time I managed to get it safely on the ice, the wind had picked up even more. So, I set up camp.

The blizzard was in full career on January 31 and I spent all day and until late at night trying to make the crampons serviceable, but without success.

The blizzard was in full swing on January 31, and I spent all day and into the late night trying to fix the crampons, but I had no luck.

On February 1 the wind and drift subsided late in the afternoon, and I clearly saw to the west the beacon which marked Aladdin's Cave.

On February 1, the wind and snow finally calmed down in the late afternoon, and I could clearly see the beacon to the west that marked Aladdin's Cave.

At 7 P.M. I reached this haven within the ice, and never again was I to have the ordeal of pitching the tent. Inside the cave were three oranges and a pineapple which had been brought from the Ship. It was wonderful once more to be in the land of such things!

At 7 P.M. I arrived at this refuge in the ice, and I would never have to face the challenge of setting up the tent again. Inside the cave were three oranges and a pineapple that had come from the ship. It felt amazing to be back in a place with such things!

I waited to mend one of the crampons and then started off for the Hut; but a blizzard had commenced. To descend the five miles of steep icy slopes with my miserable crampons, in the weak state in which I found myself, would only have been as a last resort. So I camped in the comfortable cave and hoped for better weather next day.

I waited to fix one of the crampons and then set off for the Hut; however, a blizzard had started. Going down the five miles of steep, icy slopes with my worn-out crampons, especially given how weak I felt, would only have been a last resort. So, I set up camp in the cozy cave and hoped for better weather the next day.

The high wind, rising to a hurricane at times, continued for a whole week with dense drift until the 8th. I spent the long hours making crampons of a new pattern, eating and sleeping. Eventually I became so anxious that I used to sit outside the cave for long spells, watching for a lull in the wind.

The strong winds, sometimes reaching hurricane strength, lasted for an entire week with heavy drifting snow until the 8th. I spent the long hours creating a new type of crampons, eating, and sleeping. Eventually, I became so anxious that I would sit outside the cave for long periods, waiting for a break in the wind.

At length I resolved to go down in the blizzard, sitting on the sledge as long as possible, blown along by the wind. I was making preparations for a start when the wind suddenly decreased and my opportunity had come.

At last, I decided to head down into the blizzard, sitting on the sled for as long as I could, carried along by the wind. I was getting ready to start when the wind suddenly died down, and my chance had arrived.

In a couple of hours I was within one mile and a half of the Hut. There was no sign of the Ship lying in the offing, but I comforted myself with the thought that she might be still at the anchorage and have swung inshore so as to be hidden by the ice-cliffs, or on the other hand that Captain Davis might have been along the coast to the east searching there.

In a couple of hours, I was about a mile and a half from the Hut. There was no sign of the Ship in the distance, but I reassured myself that she might still be anchored and moved inshore, hidden by the ice cliffs, or maybe Captain Davis had gone along the coast to the east searching there.

But even as I gazed about seeking for a clue, a speck on the north-west horizon caught my eye and my hopes went down. It looked like a distant ship; it might well have been the 'Aurora'. Well, what matter! the long journey was at an end-a terrible chapter of my life was finished!

But even as I looked around for a clue, a dot on the north-west horizon caught my eye and my hopes dropped. It looked like a distant ship; it could have been the 'Aurora'. Well, what does it matter! The long journey was finally over—a terrible chapter of my life was finished!

Then the rocks around Winter Quarters began to come into view, part of the basin of the boat harbour appeared, and lo! there were human figures! They almost seemed unreal—I was in a dream—but after a brief moment one of them saw me and waved an arm, I replied, there was a commotion and they all ran towards the Hut. Then they were lost, for the crest of the first steep slope hid them. It almost seemed to me that they had run away to hide.

Then the rocks around Winter Quarters started to come into view, part of the boat harbor appeared, and suddenly! there were people! They almost seemed unreal—I felt like I was dreaming—but after a moment, one of them noticed me and waved an arm. I waved back, and there was a commotion as they all ran towards the Hut. Then they disappeared, as the top of the first steep slope blocked my view. It almost felt like they had run away to hide.

Minutes passed, and I slowly went along with the sledge. Then a head rose over the brow of the hill and there was Bickerton, breathless after a long run. I expect he considered for a while which one of us it was. Soon we had shaken hands and he knew all in a few brief words, and I learned that the Ship had left earlier in the day. Madigan, McLean, Bage and Hodgeman arrived, and then a new-comer—Jeffryes. Five men had remained behind to make a search for our party, and Jeffryes was a new wireless operator brought down by Captain Davis.

Minutes went by as I slowly moved alongside the sled. Then a figure popped up over the hill, and it was Bickerton, out of breath from a long run. I guess he paused for a moment to figure out which one of us it was. Soon we shook hands, and he filled me in on everything in just a few short sentences, telling me that the Ship had left earlier that day. Madigan, McLean, Bage, and Hodgeman arrived next, followed by a newcomer—Jeffryes. Five men had stayed behind to search for our group, and Jeffryes was a new wireless operator brought in by Captain Davis.

We were soon at the Hut where I found that full preparations had been made for wintering a second year. The weather was calm and the Ship was no distance away so I decided to recall her by wireless. The masts at the Hut had been re-erected during the summer, and on board the 'Aurora' Hannam was provided with a wireless receiving set. Jeffryes had arranged with Hannam to call up at 8, 9 and 10 P.M. for several evenings while the 'Aurora' was "within range" in case there were any news of my party. A message recalling the Ship was therefore sent off and repeated at frequent intervals till past midnight.

We soon arrived at the Hut, where I discovered that everything was set up for spending a second winter. The weather was calm, and the Ship was nearby, so I decided to call her back using the wireless. The masts at the Hut had been put back up during the summer, and on board the 'Aurora,' Hannam had a wireless receiver. Jeffryes had coordinated with Hannam to check in at 8, 9, and 10 P.M. for several nights while the 'Aurora' was "within range" in case there were any updates about my group. A message to recall the Ship was sent and repeated often until after midnight.

Next morning there was a forty-mile wind when we went outside, but away across Commonwealth Bay to the west the 'Aurora' could be seen close to the face of the ice-cliffs. She had returned in response to the call and was steaming up and down, waiting for the wind to moderate.

Next morning, there was a strong forty-mile-an-hour wind when we went outside, but over across Commonwealth Bay to the west, we could see the 'Aurora' near the ice cliffs. She had come back in response to the call and was moving up and down, waiting for the wind to calm down.

We immediately set to work getting all the records, instruments and personal gear ready to be taken down to the boat harbour in anticipation of calm weather during the day.

We quickly got to work gathering all the records, tools, and personal gear to take down to the boat harbor, hoping for calm weather throughout the day.

The wind chose to continue and towards evening was in the sixties, while the barometer fell. During the afternoon Hodgeman went across to the western ridge and saw that the Ship was still in the Bay. The sea was so heavy that the motor-boat could never have lived through it.

The wind decided to keep blowing and by evening it was in the sixties, while the barometer dropped. In the afternoon, Hodgeman crossed over to the western ridge and noticed that the Ship was still in the Bay. The sea was so rough that the motorboat would never have survived it.

That night Jeffryes sent another message, which we learned afterwards was not received, in which Captain Davis was given the option of remaining until calm weather supervened or of leaving at once for the Western Base. I felt that the decision should be left to him, as he could appreciate exactly the situation of the Western Base and what the Ship could be expected to do amid the ice at that season of the year. The time was already past when, according to my written instructions left for him on arrival at Commonwealth Bay, the 'Aurora' should sail west to relieve Wild and his party.

That night, Jeffryes sent another message, which we later found out was not received, giving Captain Davis the choice to stay until the weather improved or to leave immediately for the Western Base. I thought the decision should be his since he understood the situation at the Western Base and what the Ship could realistically accomplish in the ice during that time of year. It was already past the point when, according to my written instructions left for him upon arriving at Commonwealth Bay, the 'Aurora' was supposed to head west to help Wild and his team.

On the morning of the 10th there was no sign of the Ship and evidently Captain Davis had decided to wait no longer, knowing that further delay would endanger the chances of picking up the eight men who had elected to winter on the shelf-ice one thousand five hundred miles to the west. At such a critical moment determination, fearless and swift, was necessary, and, in coming to his momentous decision, Captain Davis acted well and for the best interests of the Expedition.

On the morning of the 10th, there was no sign of the ship, and it was clear that Captain Davis had chosen not to wait any longer. He understood that any further delay would jeopardize the chances of rescuing the eight men who had chosen to spend the winter on the shelf ice, one thousand five hundred miles to the west. At such a crucial time, determination, bravery, and speed were essential, and in making his important decision, Captain Davis acted wisely and in the best interest of the expedition.

A long voyage lay before the 'Aurora' through many miles of ice-strewn sea, swept by intermittent blizzards and shrouded now in midnight darkness. We still fostered the hope that the vessel's coal-supply would be sufficient for her to return to Adelie Land and make an attempt to pick us up. But it was not to be.

A long journey was ahead of the 'Aurora' through many miles of icy ocean, battered by occasional snowstorms and now cloaked in midnight darkness. We still held onto the hope that the ship's coal supply would be enough for her to head back to Adelie Land and try to rescue us. But that wasn’t meant to happen.

The long Antarctic winter was fast approaching and we turned to meet it with resolution, knowing that if the 'Aurora' failed us in early March, that the early summer of the same year would bring relief.

The long Antarctic winter was quickly coming, and we prepared to face it with determination, knowing that if the 'Aurora' let us down in early March, the early summer of that same year would bring us relief.





CHAPTER XIV THE QUEST OF THE SOUTH MAGNETIC POLE

Dr. R. BAGE

    Send me your strongest, those who never fail.
    I'm the Blizzard, King of the Southern Trail!
                                       Sledging song.
    Send me your best, the ones who never fail.  
    I'm the Blizzard, King of the Southern Trail!  
                                       Sledging song.

On the afternoon of November 10, at Aladdin's Cave, after a convivial hoosh, Webb, Hurley and I said good-bye to Dr. Mawson's party and made off south for the eleven and three-quarter mile cave where our Supporting Party, Murphy, Hunter and Laseron, were waiting for us. At 7 P.M. we started almost at a run over the smooth ice, to the accompaniment of hearty cheers from Dr. Mawson, Ninnis, and Mertz; two of whom we were never to see again.

On the afternoon of November 10, at Aladdin's Cave, after a friendly gathering, Webb, Hurley, and I said goodbye to Dr. Mawson's group and headed south towards the eleven and three-quarter mile cave where our Supporting Party, Murphy, Hunter, and Laseron, were waiting for us. At 7 PM, we took off almost running over the smooth ice, accompanied by loud cheers from Dr. Mawson, Ninnis, and Mertz; two of whom we would never see again.

Half a mile of this easy going, and we were on snow for the first time with a loaded sledge. Uphill snow, too, and the wind rising, so it was no small relief when we finally made the Cathedral Grotto at 11.30 P.M., and found Murphy's tent pitched alongside it. The wind by this time was about forty-five miles per hour and, it being nearly dusk, the crevasses—a five-mile belt—had been fairly difficult to negotiate.

Half a mile of this easy-going, and we were on snow for the first time with a loaded sled. Uphill snow, too, and the wind picking up, so it was a huge relief when we finally reached the Cathedral Grotto at 11:30 PM and found Murphy's tent set up right next to it. By this time, the wind was blowing at about forty-five miles per hour and, with it being almost dusk, the crevasses—a five-mile stretch—had been pretty challenging to navigate.

We soon had the cave clear of snow, had a good meal and then slept the sleep of the just, feeling well content with the first day's work—eleven and a half miles from home at an altitude of one thousand nine hundred feet. We were off at last on a search for the Magnetic Pole.

We quickly cleared the cave of snow, had a nice meal, and then slept soundly, feeling really satisfied with the first day's efforts—eleven and a half miles from home at an altitude of one thousand nine hundred feet. We were finally off on a quest to find the Magnetic Pole.

On the morrow some time was spent in rearranging the loads. Finally, both parties moved off south into heavy wind and fairly thick drift. What with the ground rising steadily, the pressure of the wind and our lack of condition, two and a quarter hours of solid work realized only two and a quarter miles; so we decided to camp.

On the next day, we spent some time reorganizing the loads. Eventually, both groups headed south into strong winds and pretty thick snowdrifts. With the ground steadily rising, the force of the wind, and us not being in great shape, we managed to cover only two and a quarter miles in two and a quarter hours of hard work; so we decided to set up camp.

All the night it blew hard, between seventy and eighty miles per hour, and next day it was still blowing and drifting heavily. Our tent was a good deal smaller than Murphy's, and, as Webb and Hurley are both six-footers, we always had to put all gear outside when the sleeping-bags were down. This is really a good thing when the weather is bad, as one is not tempted to stay in the bag all the time.

All night it blew hard, between seventy and eighty miles per hour, and the next day it was still blowing and drifting heavily. Our tent was a lot smaller than Murphy's, and since Webb and Hurley are both six feet tall, we always had to put all our gear outside when the sleeping bags were laid out. This is actually a good thing when the weather is bad, as it prevents you from just staying in the bag all the time.

Early in the afternoon as we were all feeling hungry and had been in bags long enough to feel cold, although the weather was quite warm (10 degrees F.), we rolled bags, and, when our frozen burberrys were once fairly on, quite enjoyed ourselves. After a boil-up and a few minutes' "run" round in the drift and wind, we did some stitching on our light drill tent, which was making very heavy weather of it, although pitched close under the lee of Murphy's strong japara tent. A little reading, some shouted unintelligible conversation with the other tent, another boil-up, and, last but not least, a smoke, found us quite ready for another sleep.

Early in the afternoon, as we were all getting hungry and had been in our bags long enough to feel cold, even though the weather was fairly warm (10 degrees F.), we rolled ourselves up in the bags. Once we had our frozen burberrys on, we started to enjoy ourselves. After a quick boil-up and a few minutes of running around in the wind and drift, we did some stitching on our lightweight drill tent, which was struggling, even though it was pitched right under the protection of Murphy's sturdy japara tent. A bit of reading, some loud but unclear conversations with the other tent, another boil-up, and finally, a smoke, left us all ready for another nap.

Next day (November 13), the wind having dropped to thirty-five miles per hour, we set out about 11 A.M. in light drift. The sky was still overcast, so the light was very trying. In the worst fogs at home one can at any rate see something of the ground on which one is treading; in Adelie Land, even when the air was clear of snow, it was easy to bump against a four-foot sastruga without seeing it. It always reminded me most of a fog at sea: a ship creeping "o'er the hueless, viewless deep."

The next day (November 13), with the wind dropping to thirty-five miles per hour, we headed out around 11 A.M. in light snow. The sky was still cloudy, making the light really challenging. Even in the worst fogs back home, you can at least see some of the ground underneath you; in Adelie Land, even when the air was clear of snow, it was easy to bump into a four-foot sastruga without noticing it. It always reminded me of being in fog at sea: a ship moving "o'er the hueless, viewless deep."

When 6 P.M. arrived we had only covered five and a half miles, but were all thoroughly exhausted and glad to camp. Lunch had been rather barbarously served in the lee of the sledge. First came plasmon biscuit, broken with the ice-axe into pieces small enough to go into the mouth through the funnel of a burberry helmet; then followed two ounces of chocolate, frozen rather too hard to have a definite taste; and finally a luscious morsel—two ounces of butter, lovingly thawed-out in the mouth to get the full flavour. Lunches like these in wind and drift are uncomfortable enough for every one to be eager to start again as soon as possible.

When 6 P.M. came, we had only managed to cover five and a half miles, but we were all completely worn out and happy to set up camp. Lunch had been served in a pretty rough manner, sheltered behind the sledge. First, we had plasmon biscuits, which were broken into small pieces with the ice axe so we could fit them into our mouths through the funnel of our burberry helmets; then we had two ounces of chocolate, which was frozen too hard to taste properly; and finally, a delightful treat—two ounces of butter, lovingly thawed in our mouths to enjoy the full flavor. Lunches like this during wind and snow are uncomfortable enough that everyone is eager to get moving again as soon as possible.

By nine o'clock that night the wind had increased to a full gale. We were in camp all the 14th and the 15th, the wind rising to eighty-five miles per hour with very heavy drift during the small hours of the 15th. This was its maximum, and by the afternoon it was down to about seventy miles per hour with a clear sky and light drift. We donned our burberrys (I should like to give Hurley's "Ode to a Frozen Burberry") and dug out our sledges, both of which were completely buried in a ramp forty yards long; the shovel projecting nine inches above the surface.

By nine o'clock that night, the wind had picked up to a full gale. We stayed in camp all day on the 14th and 15th, with the wind reaching eighty-five miles per hour and heavy snow drifting during the early hours of the 15th. This was the peak, and by the afternoon, it dropped to around seventy miles per hour with a clear sky and light drifting. We put on our burberrys (I’d like to share Hurley’s "Ode to a Frozen Burberry") and dug out our sledges, both of which were completely buried under a snowbank that was forty yards long, with the shovel sticking nine inches above the surface.

While we were engaged on this work, I overheard the following conversation being shouted in the Supporting Party's tent:

While we were working on this, I overheard the following conversation being shouted in the Supporting Party's tent:

FIRST VOICE. I'm hungry. Who will go out and get the food-bag?

FIRST VOICE. I'm hungry. Who's going to go out and get the food bag?

SLEEPY VOICE. The food-weights ** are in the cooker.

SLEEPY VOICE. The food weights ** are in the cooker.

FIRST VOICE. No they're not.

No, they're not.

SLEEPY VOICE. Saw them there yesterday, must be somewhere in the tent.

SLEEPY VOICE. I saw them there yesterday; they must be somewhere in the tent.

FIRST VOICE. No they're not... I ate them last night.

FIRST VOICE. No, they’re not... I had them last night.

     ** Until amounts were known by experience, rations were weighed by a
small balance whose various weights were small calico bags filled with
chocolate.
     ** Until amounts were known through experience, rations were weighed using a small scale with different weights made from small fabric bags filled with chocolate.

The exercise, a good hoosh and above all the clear sky made us take a less morbid view of the fact that we were six days out from the Hut and only nineteen and a half miles away.

The exercise, a good effort, and especially the clear sky helped us see the situation in a less gloomy way, considering we were six days out from the Hut and only nineteen and a half miles away.

Early on the 16th we could hear above the roar of the wind the drift still hissing against the tent, but it had diminished by nine o'clock breakfast.

Early on the 16th, we could hear above the roar of the wind the snow still hissing against the tent, but it had lessened by nine o'clock breakfast.

By common consent it was agreed that our loads were too heavy for the conditions under which we were working. I accordingly decided to drop one hundred-pound bag. We had already saved nearly one week's food for three men and had not yet worked up our full sledging appetites. The bag was raised to the top of a six-foot snow mound, a thermograph being placed alongside. As we now seemed to be on plateau snow, I thought it wise to leave behind my heavy boots and Swiss crampons.

By mutual agreement, we all felt that our loads were too heavy for the conditions we were dealing with. I decided to drop one hundred-pound bag. We had already saved almost a week's worth of food for three men and hadn't completely worked up our sledding appetites yet. The bag was placed on top of a six-foot snow mound, with a thermograph next to it. Since it appeared we were now on plateau snow, I figured it would be a good idea to leave behind my heavy boots and Swiss crampons.

By 4 P.M. the wind had decreased to a light breeze. Work was very slow on a steeper up grade, and at six o'clock clouds came up quickly from the south-east and snow began to fall, so we camped at 7.30 P.M. thoroughly tired out. At twenty-four and a half miles the altitude was three thousand two hundred feet.

By 4 PM, the wind had calmed down to a light breeze. Progress was really slow on the steeper incline, and by six o'clock, clouds rolled in quickly from the southeast and it started to snow, so we set up camp at 7:30 PM, completely exhausted. After covering twenty-four and a half miles, we reached an altitude of three thousand two hundred feet.

The snow was a false alarm. It ceased at 9 P.M. and the wind subsided to a dead calm!!

The snow turned out to be nothing. It stopped at 9 P.M., and the wind died down to complete stillness!!

Good headway was being made against a strong breeze next day, when it was noticed that two gallons of kerosene were missing off the supporters' sledge. While Murphy and Laseron went back two miles to recover them, Webb secured a magnetic declination and I took sun observations for time and azimuth.

Good progress was being made against a strong breeze the next day when it was noticed that two gallons of kerosene were missing from the supporters' sledge. While Murphy and Laseron went back two miles to get them, Webb took a magnetic declination and I took sun observations for time and direction.

We were off early on the 18th and for the first time were able to appreciate the "scenery." Glorious sunshine overhead and all around brilliant snow, dappled by livid shadows; very different from the smooth, soft, white mantle usually attributed to the surface of Antarctica by those in the homeland. Here and there, indeed, were smooth patches which we called bowling-greens, but hard and slippery as polished marble, with much the same translucent appearance. Practically all the country, however, was a jumbled mass of small, hard sastrugi, averaging perhaps a foot in height, with an occasional gnarled old veteran twice as high. To either side the snow rolled away for miles. In front, we made our first acquaintance with the accursed next ridge, which is always ahead of you on the plateau. Generally we passed from one ridge to another so gradually that we could never say for certain just when we had topped one; still the next ridge was always there.

We set off early on the 18th, and for the first time, we could truly appreciate the "scenery." The sun was shining brightly overhead, and all around us was brilliant snow, dappled with deep shadows; it was very different from the smooth, soft, white cover that people back home often imagine when they think of Antarctica. Here and there were smooth patches we called bowling greens, but they were hard and slippery like polished marble, with a similar translucent look. Most of the landscape, however, was a chaotic mix of small, hard sastrugi, averaging about a foot high, with the occasional gnarled old veteran towering twice as high. On either side, the snow stretched for miles. In front of us, we encountered the dreaded next ridge, which always seems to be waiting for you on the plateau. Typically, we transitioned from one ridge to another so gradually that we could never really tell exactly when we had topped one; still, the next ridge was always right there.

The weather had lately been colder with the increased altitude. The temperature in daily range varied from -10 degrees F. to 9 degrees F. It was so hot in the sun, on the 18th, that lunching inside the tent was unbearable. We preferred its shadow outside in the breeze.

The weather had recently become colder as we climbed higher. The daily temperature ranged from -10 degrees F to 9 degrees F. It was so hot in the sun on the 18th that having lunch inside the tent was unbearable. We preferred the shade outside in the breeze.

Wearing a minimum of clothes, we marched along gaily during the afternoon. The country changed in a wonderful manner, the sastrugi gradually becoming smaller and finally disappearing. The surface was so soft that a bamboo would easily penetrate it for a foot. Evidently it was fairly old and laid down in calm weather, for excavations showed that it became more compact without any hard wind-swept layers marking successive snowfalls.

Wearing very few clothes, we happily marched along in the afternoon. The landscape transformed beautifully, the sastrugi gradually getting smaller and eventually vanishing. The surface was so soft that a bamboo pole could easily push into it by a foot. Clearly, it was quite old and formed in calm weather, as the excavations revealed it became denser without any hard, wind-blown layers indicating recent snowfalls.

It was proved that we were commencing a descent of one thousand five hundred feet down the north side of a valley feeding the Mertz Glacier. In order to explain the surface, smooth and unruffled by any wind, the question arose as to whether it is possible that there is a cushion of dead air more or less permanently over the north side of this depression.

It was confirmed that we were starting a drop of one thousand five hundred feet down the north side of a valley that feeds the Mertz Glacier. To understand the surface, which was smooth and undisturbed by any wind, the question came up about whether it's possible that there's a layer of still air that's more or less permanently over the north side of this dip.

On the soft surface we were able to dispense with crampons. Hitherto, it had been impossible to haul over a slippery surface in finnesko. Now we felt as light as air and were vastly cheered when some one calculated that the six of us were saving I don't know how many thousand foot-pounds of work every mile. With a run of twelve miles we were forty-two miles from Winter Quarters.

On the soft ground, we could do without crampons. Until now, it had been impossible to move over a slippery surface in thin shoes. Now we felt light as a feather and were really encouraged when someone estimated that the six of us were saving, I don’t know how many thousand foot-pounds of effort every mile. After covering twelve miles, we were forty-two miles away from Winter Quarters.

Another splendid day on the 19th. We had lunch in a curious cup-shaped hollow, estimated to be two miles wide and one hundred and fifty feet deep. Webb obtained here an approximate dip of 88 degrees 44',** a very promising increase from the Hut (87 degrees 27').

Another amazing day on the 19th. We had lunch in a strange cup-shaped hollow, about two miles wide and one hundred and fifty feet deep. Webb got an approximate dip of 88 degrees 44', which is a significant increase from the Hut (87 degrees 27').

     ** At the South Magnetic Pole the dip is 90 degrees.
     ** At the South Magnetic Pole, the angle of dip is 90 degrees.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Map showing track of the southern sledging party from the Main Base

Map showing the route of the southern sledding team from the Main Base

Snow-blindness had now begun to make itself felt for the first time. I for one had my first experience of it that afternoon. During the halt at lunch I put on yellow goggles in place of the smoked ones I had been wearing, and in a quarter of an hour the change of colour had 'settled' my eyes for the time being.

Snow blindness was starting to affect me for the first time. I had my first experience with it that afternoon. During our lunch break, I switched from my smoked goggles to yellow ones, and in about fifteen minutes, the change in color had adjusted my eyes for the moment.

The afternoon was very hot. The thermometer stood at 10 degrees F. at 4 P.M., but the still air made it almost insupportable. By the time the load was hauled up out of the basin, we were streaming with perspiration.

The afternoon was really hot. The thermometer read 10 degrees F. at 4 P.M., but the completely still air made it almost unbearable. By the time we got the load hauled up out of the basin, we were dripping with sweat.

Before halting, we sighted a dark, distant ridge, thirty miles away, and the course was corrected by its bearing. Our extravagant hopes of finding a permanently calm region had been dwindling for the last few miles, as a hard bottom, a few inches under the surface, had become evident. They were finally dispelled by a south-west wind springing up during the night.

Before stopping, we spotted a dark ridge in the distance, thirty miles away, and adjusted our course based on its position. Our high hopes of discovering a permanently calm area had been fading over the past few miles, as a hard bottom a few inches below the surface had become clear. They were completely dashed when a southwest wind picked up during the night.

As every one was beginning to feel the hard work after another oppressive afternoon on the 20th, we decided to have an easy march next day and to build our first depot. Of course we had hoped to have been farther out before sending back the supporting party, but the weather had settled the question.

As everyone was starting to feel the fatigue after another tough afternoon on the 20th, we decided to take it easy the next day and build our first depot. We had, of course, hoped to be farther out before sending back the support team, but the weather made that decision for us.

On the 21st, taking things as easily as a thirty-five mile wind would permit, we pulled on, up and down small undulations till 4 P.M. when we encountered a small rise, with the next ridge a considerable distance ahead. The depot was to be built here.

On the 21st, taking things as easily as a thirty-five mile wind would allow, we continued on, going up and down small hills until 4 P.M. when we came across a slight rise, with the next ridge quite a way ahead. The depot was going to be built here.

Webb at once proceeded to take full magnetic declination, time and azimuth observations, Laseron recording for him. Murphy put in a miserable hour over the primus melting snow. He was rather snow-blind and his eyes must have contributed a good deal of water to the pot. The water was poured into food-bags filled with snow, which were buried, encircled by wire slings, in holes. Here they froze, making excellent holdfasts for the depot flag. Depot flags had been exercising our ingenuity for months before the start, ordinary forms being destroyed by the wind in a few hours. Webb had finally built the perfect flag of the wind-vane type: a V of pieces of blackened Venesta board with light struts at the back and a piece of aeroplane tubing at the apex which slipped over the bamboo pole. The pole, of two bamboos, stood sixteen feet from the ground and was provided with two sets of flexible steel stays. Close by, Hurley and Hunter had built a snow mound ten feet in diameter and ten feet in height, finished off with a capping of snow blocks wrapped in black bunting.

Webb immediately began taking full magnetic declination, time, and azimuth observations, with Laseron recording for him. Murphy spent a frustrating hour using the primus stove to melt snow. He was somewhat snow-blind, and his eyes probably added quite a bit of water to the pot. The water was poured into food bags filled with snow, which were buried and secured with wire slings in deep holes. Here they froze, making great holdfasts for the depot flag. Depot flags had been a challenge for months before the start, as regular ones were destroyed by the wind in just a few hours. Webb finally created the ideal flag in the wind-vane style: a V shape made of pieces of blackened Venesta board with light struts at the back and a piece of airplane tubing at the top that slid over the bamboo pole. The pole, made of two bamboo pieces, stood sixteen feet above the ground and was equipped with two sets of flexible steel stays. Nearby, Hurley and Hunter built a snow mound ten feet in diameter and ten feet tall, topped off with snow blocks wrapped in black bunting.

Next day it was blowing a little harder and the sky was overcast, snow falling all day. What bad light means can be gathered from the fact that Laseron on crawling out of the tent in the morning raised an alarm that our tent had been blown away in the night. It turned out that our tent was hidden by a mound which he could not see, though only about ten yards from it.

The next day, the wind picked up a bit more, and the sky was overcast with snow falling all day. The poor visibility was evident when Laseron crawled out of the tent in the morning and sounded an alarm, thinking our tent had been blown away during the night. It turned out that our tent was just hidden behind a mound he couldn’t see, even though it was only about ten yards away.

I had been given the option of relieving the supporting party of any of their gear I coveted and I used it freely. The sledgemeter was the first thing commandeered, ours, made by Correll, having developed some slight complaint in its interior. Their cooker, being in good condition, was also taken. We all cast longing eyes at the roomy wind-proof tent but finally decided that it was too heavy—forty pounds as against our own of twenty-six pounds, including tent and poles.

I was given the chance to take any gear from the supporting party that I wanted, and I took full advantage of it. The sledgemeter was the first thing I claimed; it was ours, made by Correll, but it had a minor issue inside. Their cooker, which was in good shape, was also taken. We all eyed the spacious windproof tent with envy, but ultimately decided it was too heavy—forty pounds compared to our own, which weighed twenty-six pounds, including the tent and poles.

At 7 P.M. we said good-bye to our supporters, Hurley exposed the last plate of his big reflex camera, which they carried back to the Hut, and a few minutes later Webb, Hurley, and I were standing alone watching three black specks disappearing in the drift; a stiff wind helping them along in great style. We were left to our own resources now, for better or for worse. "Weird" is how I described my feelings in the diary.

At 7 P.M., we said goodbye to our supporters. Hurley took the last shot with his big reflex camera, which they carried back to the Hut. A few minutes later, Webb, Hurley, and I were standing by ourselves, watching three black dots fade away in the snow, with a strong wind pushing them along quickly. We were now on our own, for better or worse. I described my feelings in the diary as "weird."

The same night it blew a hurricane and only dropped to sixty miles per hour during the 23rd, compelling us to remain in camp. Not an ideal birthday for Webb, but we made the most of it. I quote from my diary: "Turned out and rolled bags at 3 P.M. for lunch, for which we opened a wee tin of bacon ration brought for the occasion. Had some extra lumps of sugar (collared from the eleven-mile cave) in our tea. After the wine had been round (i.e. after a special second cup of tea), I gave Eric a pair of stockings from Murphy, and then 'Hoyle' and I smoked a cigar each which Webb produced. Dinner at 7 was also a special affair as we had the remains of the bacon ration in the hoosh, with great effect. Also an extra strong brew of cocoa boiled quite smooth. Burberrys on and a stroll outside in the wind for a yard or two to get up a circulation; then into bag where I am smoking a plebeian pipe which is very tame after the glories of the day, especially as I suspect my tobacco of being a bit damp."

That night, a hurricane hit, and the winds only dropped to sixty miles per hour on the 23rd, forcing us to stay in camp. Not the best birthday for Webb, but we made the most of it. I wrote in my diary: "We got up and rolled our sleeping bags at 3 P.M. for lunch, where we opened a small tin of bacon ration brought for the occasion. We had some extra sugar (stolen from the eleven-mile cave) in our tea. After the wine went around (i.e., after a special second cup of tea), I gave Eric a pair of stockings from Murphy, and then 'Hoyle' and I each smoked a cigar that Webb provided. Dinner at 7 was also special because we added the leftover bacon ration to the hoosh, which was great. We also had an extra strong brew of cocoa boiled just right. We put our Burberrys on and took a quick stroll outside in the wind to get our circulation going, then headed back to our bags where I’m smoking a regular pipe that feels quite dull after the excitement of the day, especially since I think my tobacco is a bit damp."

Such was the first of the two "auspicious occasions" we had on the journey.

Such was the first of the two "lucky moments" we had on the journey.

After going carefully through the gear, we discarded a pickaxe, one pair of big spiked boots and some odd clothing. We also decided, as the probability of leisure was not great, to leave our reading matter behind. It was with regret that I added my little 'Virginibus Puerisque' to the small pile of "rejects." The load now amounted to seven hundred and forty-eight pounds in all. Not many days after, the floor-cloth (eight pounds) was left behind, as the japara sail afforded ample protection from damp in the low temperatures of the plateau.

After carefully going through our gear, we got rid of a pickaxe, a pair of large spiked boots, and some random clothing. We also decided to leave our reading materials behind since we probably wouldn't have much free time. With a heavy heart, I added my little 'Virginibus Puerisque' to the small pile of things we were tossing out. The total weight was now seven hundred and forty-eight pounds. A few days later, we also left behind the floor-cloth (eight pounds) because the japara sail provided enough protection from the dampness in the chilly temperatures of the plateau.

The dip-circle, which was to yield the most important result of our journey, was housed after much thought on a conveniently shaped kerosene tray between the tins of oil. Four light leather straps, buckled tightly, made a solid mass of tray, oil tins, and dip-circle; very safe, and easy to undo.

The dip-circle, which was meant to provide the most significant outcome of our trip, was carefully placed on a conveniently shaped kerosene tray between the oil cans. Four light leather straps, secured tightly, formed a stable unit of the tray, oil cans, and dip-circle; it was very secure and easy to remove.

My orders were to proceed inland, due south, taking magnetic, geographical, meteorological, and such other observations as were possible, returning to the Hut not later than January 15. Dr. Mawson had left it to my discretion, in the event of any great change occurring in the declination, to go either true or magnetic south.

My orders were to head inland, due south, making as many magnetic, geographical, meteorological, and other observations as possible, and to return to the Hut by January 15 at the latest. Dr. Mawson had given me the choice, in case of any significant change in the declination, to go either true south or magnetic south.

At the Hut and up to about sixty miles south of it, the declination had proved fairly constant, but now at the Southern Cross Depot, as we had christened the sixty-seven-mile camp, the compass, from pointing a little to the east of south, had travelled to 40 degrees east of south, so that it became obvious that there was considerable magnetic disturbance in the country over which we were travelling. Whether we went south or south-east seemed unlikely to affect the value of geographical and other information we might gather, while Webb was of the opinion that the best magnetic results would be obtained by marching directly towards the Magnetic Pole, particularly if there were disturbances over the intervening area. For these reasons the course was maintained magnetic south.

At the Hut and up to about sixty miles south of it, the declination had been pretty consistent, but now at the Southern Cross Depot, which we named the sixty-seven-mile camp, the compass, which had been pointing slightly east of south, had moved to 40 degrees east of south. It was clear that there was significant magnetic interference in the area we were traveling through. Whether we headed south or southeast didn't seem likely to change the geographical and other data we might collect, while Webb believed that the best magnetic results would come from heading straight toward the Magnetic Pole, especially if there were disturbances along the way. For these reasons, we stuck to a course of magnetic south.

At 11 A.M. on Sunday, November 24, we moved off to the south-east in a wind of fifty miles an hour. The light was bad, and steering had to be done by sastrugi and wind. However, momentary glimpses of the sun served to check the course. The lunch camp was five miles from the depot, and a good mound with a top of black bunting was left there. At almost every halt, thus far on our journey, the snow cut for pitching the tent had been gathered up into a mound which, in addition to forming a landmark, could often be used as a back-mark for checking the course. Our depot thus had a mound four miles on the southern and five miles on the northern side of it. It was not marked as well as I had hoped, but under the circumstances we could not do better. Moreover, at intervals during the day, some very distinctive snow ramps had appeared in the valley, some five miles to the north-east, and their position was fixed relative to the course.

At 11 A.M. on Sunday, November 24, we headed southeast in a wind of fifty miles an hour. The visibility was poor, so we had to steer by the sastrugi and the wind. However, brief glimpses of the sun helped us stay on course. The lunch stop was five miles from the depot, and we left behind a solid mound topped with black bunting. At nearly every break so far on our journey, the snow we used to set up the tent had been piled into a mound that not only served as a landmark but could also be used as a back marker for checking our route. Therefore, our depot had a mound four miles to the south and five miles to the north of it. It wasn't marked as well as I had hoped, but given the situation, we couldn’t do better. Additionally, throughout the day, some very distinctive snow ramps appeared in the valley about five miles to the northeast, and we noted their position in relation to our path.

Our hopes for a good afternoon were disappointed, as the wind and drift came up again as strong as ever. The surface, too, grew worse; nothing but sastrugi eighteen inches to thirty inches high and very close together. We were marching a little to the east of the wind, and the sledge was continually blown sideways, making considerable leeway. By 8.30 P.M. it was blowing sixty miles per hour, so we halted, thoroughly tired out, having hauled our one-third of a ton eight and three-quarter miles.

Our hopes for a nice afternoon were dashed as the wind picked up again, just as strong as before. The surface also worsened; we encountered nothing but sastrugi that were eighteen to thirty inches high and very close together. We were marching a bit to the east of the wind, and the sledge kept getting blown sideways, losing a lot of ground. By 8:30 PM, it was blowing at sixty miles per hour, so we stopped, completely exhausted, after hauling our one-third of a ton for eight and three-quarter miles.

When it is blowing hard, the end of the day's march is not the end of the day's work. As soon as a camping spot has been chosen, the sledge is pulled round head to wind. The straps round the load are loosened carefully, the shovel and tent removed and the straps retightened. One man starts breaking out chunks of snow, experimenting until he finds a place where large pieces come away readily. Lumps of forty pounds are the handiest and quickest, but often only smaller ones can be obtained. These are arranged in a circle round the tent-site, while the man with the tent places it on the ground pointing upwind, the bottom of the poles being just where the middle windward leg will be, and makes a hole for that leg.

When it's really windy, the end of the day’s hike doesn’t mean the day’s work is done. Once a camping spot is picked, the sled is turned to face the wind. The straps around the load are carefully loosened, the shovel and tent are taken out, and the straps are tightened again. One person begins digging out chunks of snow, trying to find a spot where larger pieces come off easily. Forty-pound chunks are the easiest and fastest to handle, but often only smaller ones can be found. These are arranged in a circle around the tent site, while the person with the tent sets it down facing the wind, making sure the bottom of the poles is right where the middle windward leg will go, and digs a hole for that leg.

When everything is ready, all three catch hold of the tent, one man crawling half into it, gripping hard the leather loop on the windward leg. The others sort out and grip their two side legs. "All ready? Up!" It almost takes one's breath away, the roar and the flap! The side legs are quickly separated as the tent rises, and before it can blow over, the leeward legs are more or less in position, taking the strain. The centre man is throwing all his weight on to the leather loop, while the other two outside each holds down his windward pole with one hand and with the other pulls blocks of snow on to the skirt to windward. Once this is done, the rest is simple: cutting holes in just the right positions for the other legs, pulling out the skirt and making it snug all round. Then in goes the floor-cloth, and, by the time that is spread out properly, the primus and cooker are passed in. The cooker is dissected and the two water vessels passed out to be filled with snow. The cook will have hard work to get the primus started if he does not shield the spirit flame from the wind, which blows through the tent, by putting the whole lamp inside the big cooker lid.

When everything is set, all three grab the tent, with one guy crawling halfway in and holding tightly onto the leather loop on the windward leg. The others sort out and grip their two side legs. "All set? Lift!" It nearly takes your breath away, the noise and the flapping! The side legs are quickly pulled apart as the tent goes up, and before it can blow away, the leeward legs get into position, taking the strain. The man in the center is putting all his weight on the leather loop, while the other two outside each hold down their windward pole with one hand and use the other to pile blocks of snow onto the skirt on the windward side. Once that's done, the rest is easy: cutting holes in the right spots for the other legs, pulling out the skirt, and making it snug all around. Then they put in the floor cloth, and by the time that's spread out properly, the primus and cooker are handed inside. The cooker is taken apart, and the two water containers are passed out to be filled with snow. The cook will have a tough time getting the primus started unless he shields the spirit flame from the wind blowing through the tent by placing the whole lamp inside the big cooker lid.

In come the pots filled with lumps of snow. The food tank is placed just outside the entrance, and the proper food-bags for the meal are passed in to the cook, the tank being retied to keep out drift. The cooker will now be going at full pressure, and the cook is ready to receive the gear. Sleeping-bags, "computation bag," hypsometer, "meat block" (a three-inch-square paper pad on which meteorological notes were taken); clothes-bag opened, three ditty-bags passed in and bag retied; a final temperature taken and aneroid read; sledge anchored securely by tow-rope to the ice-axe, and a final look round to see all gear is safely strapped down and snow-tight.

In come the pots filled with snow. The food tank is placed just outside the entrance, and the proper food bags for the meal are handed to the cook, the tank being tied up again to keep out the drifting snow. The cooker is now running at full pressure, and the cook is ready to receive the equipment. Sleeping bags, "computation bag," hypsometer, "meat block" (a three-inch-square paper pad for taking meteorological notes); clothes bag opened, three ditty bags passed in and bag retied; a final temperature is taken and aneroid read; sledge anchored securely by tow rope to the ice axe, and a final check to ensure all gear is safely strapped down and snow-tight.

In calm weather, camping is a very different thing. On a fine day, half an hour after the halt would usually find us carefully scraping the last of the hoosh out of our pannikins, ready for the cocoa.

In nice weather, camping is a completely different experience. On a beautiful day, half an hour after stopping would usually have us carefully scraping the last bits of the meal out of our pannikins, all set for the cocoa.

At the seventy-six-mile camp we tried the experiment of a break-wind. The tent was so small and light that it was necessary to protect it in the heavy winds. Hurley and I took about three-quarters of an hour to build the first one, but later we improved, getting into the knack of hewing snow with a sharp-pointed shovel.

At the seventy-six-mile camp, we experimented with a windbreak. The tent was so small and light that we needed to shield it from the strong winds. Hurley and I spent about forty-five minutes building the first one, but we got better at it, learning how to cut snow effectively with a sharp shovel.

That night in bag I wrote: "The result of the breakwind is that for once we have the wind bluffed. It is blowing seventy-five miles per hour—a full hurricane—but all the viciousness is taken out of the flapping and there will be no damage done to the tent by morning."

That night in my bag I wrote: "The outcome of the windstorm is that for once we’ve outsmarted the wind. It’s blowing at seventy-five miles per hour—a full hurricane—but all the fury is gone from the flapping, and there won’t be any damage to the tent by morning."

The wind was too strong for travelling early in the day (November 25). While outside we suddenly observed two snow petrels. It was hard to realize that they had actually flown seventy-six miles inland to a height of two thousand four hundred and fifty feet. I dashed inside for the fishingline; Hurley got out the camera. They were a beautiful sight, hovering with outspread wings just above the snow, tipping it with their feet now and then, to poise without a flutter in a sixty-five-mile gale. Hurley secured a couple of "snaps" at the expense of badly frost-bitten hands. Just as I arrived with the line hooked and baited, the birds flew away to the north-east; our visions of fresh meat went with them. The line was always ready after this.

The wind was too strong for traveling early in the day (November 25). While we were outside, we suddenly spotted two snow petrels. It was hard to believe they had actually flown seventy-six miles inland to an elevation of two thousand four hundred and fifty feet. I rushed inside for the fishing line, while Hurley grabbed the camera. They were a stunning sight, hovering with their wings spread just above the snow, occasionally touching it with their feet, staying perfectly still in a sixty-five-mile gale. Hurley managed to take a couple of photos, even though his hands got badly frostbitten. Just as I came back with the line all setup and baited, the birds flew off to the northeast; our hopes of fresh meat flew away with them. After that, the line was always ready.

Towards evening the wind dropped suddenly to twenty miles per hour. Our camp was stationed on the southern side of the large valley we had entered on the 18th, and we could identify the ridge crossed on that date, blue and dim, forty miles away to the north. To the north-east could be seen a distinct dip in the skyline, indicating the bed of the valley, on whose northern side the dip met the higher skyline in a steep bluff, twenty-five miles off. This bluff under the glasses was of heavily crevassed, blue ice.

Towards evening, the wind suddenly dropped to twenty miles per hour. Our camp was set up on the southern side of the large valley we entered on the 18th, and we could see the ridge we crossed that day, blue and faint, forty miles to the north. To the northeast, there was a clear dip in the skyline, showing the bottom of the valley, where the dip met a steep bluff on the northern side, twenty-five miles away. Through the binoculars, this bluff appeared to be heavily crevassed, blue ice.

The wind did not rise again much until 10 P.M., when we had moved on seven and a half miles, rising about three hundred feet over several ridges and practically losing our view to the north.

The wind didn’t pick up again until 10 P.M., after we had covered seven and a half miles, gaining about three hundred feet over several ridges and mostly losing our view to the north.

A steady breeze on the 26th, and, on the whole, good light, allowed us to make twelve miles.

A steady breeze on the 26th, along with generally good light, helped us cover twelve miles.

Each day, now, Webb took an approximate magnetic dip and declination in the lee of the break-wind. This was necessary in order to get some idea of local disturbances. Also, it gave us some vague idea as to the direction in which lay the South Magnetic Pole. For instance, at the eighty-three-and-three-quarter-mile camp, the needle showed the Pole to be 18 degrees east of true south, while at our lunch camp that day, six miles farther on, it was given as 50 degrees east of south. The dip was so great that our prismatic compass would not set closer than about 15 degrees, but the long compass needle of the dip-circle, though of course sluggish, continued to give excellent results.

Each day now, Webb took an approximate magnetic dip and declination in the shelter of the windbreak. This was necessary to understand local disturbances. It also gave us a rough idea of where the South Magnetic Pole was located. For example, at the eighty-three-and-three-quarter-mile camp, the needle indicated the Pole was 18 degrees east of true south, while at our lunch camp that day, six miles farther, it showed 50 degrees east of south. The dip was so significant that our prismatic compass couldn't set closer than about 15 degrees, but the long needle of the dip-circle compass, although slow to respond, continued to provide excellent results.

Under these conditions it is obvious that the magnetic needle is quite useless for steering purposes. The sun compass proved itself a more than efficient substitute. On a snowfield there is usually a total absence of landmarks of any kind, so the direction of wind, sastrugi, or perhaps a low cloud is found with the sun-compass, frequently checked, and the course kept accordingly. On camping we would generally carefully note the direction in which the sledge was left, in case the next day proved overcast. Thus we would march in the morning by the wind's direction till the sun, gleaming through the clouds for a few moments, enabled us to use the compass again.

Under these conditions, it's clear that the magnetic needle is pretty useless for navigation. The sun compass turned out to be a much more effective alternative. In a snowfield, there are usually no landmarks at all, so we rely on the direction of the wind, sastrugi, or maybe a low cloud, using the sun compass for frequent checks and keeping our course accordingly. When we camped, we would usually take careful note of the direction where the sledge was left, just in case the next day turned out cloudy. This way, we would travel in the morning by following the wind's direction until the sun peeked through the clouds for a brief moment, allowing us to use the compass again.

Sastrugi, only six inches high, seen on the 26th, showed the effects of wind-erosion exquisitely. In an individual case the windward end of a sastruga might be completely undercut for six or nine inches, leaving a hard crust, sometimes only one-eighth of an inch in thickness and a couple of inches wide. This would sag downwards under its own weight in a fine curve till the tip rested on the snow beneath. It is marvellous how such a delicate structure can withstand the heavy wind.

Sastrugi, just six inches tall, observed on the 26th, displayed the effects of wind erosion beautifully. In some cases, the windward end of a sastruga could be completely undercut by six or nine inches, creating a hard crust that is sometimes only one-eighth of an inch thick and a couple of inches wide. This would droop down under its own weight in a gentle curve until the tip touched the snow below. It's amazing how such a fragile structure can endure the strong wind.

November 27 proved a very hard day. The wind kept up sixty miles per hour all the time, so that, after taking four hours to do four and three-quarter miles, we were all thoroughly exhausted. It was not a great run, but the century was hoisted—one hundred and three-quarter miles by sledge-meter; altitude two thousand nine hundred feet. There was a mild celebration that night over a square of butter-scotch and half an ounce of chocolate, besides the regular hoosh and cocoa.

November 27 turned out to be a really tough day. The wind was blowing at sixty miles per hour the entire time, which meant that after four hours, we had only covered four and three-quarter miles. We were all completely wiped out. It wasn't a huge distance, but we managed to log one hundred and three-quarter miles on the sledge-meter; we were at an altitude of two thousand nine hundred feet. That night, we had a small celebration with a square of butterscotch and half an ounce of chocolate, along with our usual hoosh and cocoa.

Next day the light was very bad and the wind fifty miles per hour. Observations were therefore made inside the tent. Webb, Hurley and the instrument occupied all available space, while I spent three hours digging a shaft eight feet deep in the snow, taking temperatures every foot. It appeared that the mean annual temperature of the snow was approximately -16 degrees F.

The next day, the visibility was poor and the wind was blowing at fifty miles per hour. So, the observations were done inside the tent. Webb, Hurley, and the equipment took up all the available space, while I spent three hours digging a shaft eight feet deep in the snow, recording temperatures every foot. It seemed that the average annual temperature of the snow was around -16 degrees F.

The dip was 88 degrees 54'; certainly rather too large a rise from 88 degrees 20' of twenty miles back. The declination had actually changed about 80 degrees in the last ten miles. This one-hundred-mile station was badly disturbed. From the evidence, it is possible that a subsidiary "pole" or area of almost vertical dip may exist close by this spot to the west or south-west.

The dip was 88 degrees 54'; that's quite a jump from 88 degrees 20' from twenty miles ago. The declination had actually changed about 80 degrees in the last ten miles. This one-hundred-mile station was really messed up. From the evidence, it seems likely that there might be a nearby "pole" or area with almost vertical dip to the west or southwest.

Going straight up wind into a "blow" which varied from forty to fifty miles per hour, we were able to make eight miles after the previous day's rest. At lunch a hole was dug five feet square and two feet deep. It served three purposes. First, it gave a good shelter for a longitude observation; secondly, with the mast, yard and floor-cloth we converted it into a shelter snug enough to house the primus and to lunch comfortably; and thirdly, a mound was left as a back-mark which was picked up on the return journey.

Going directly into a strong wind blowing at about forty to fifty miles per hour, we managed to cover eight miles after resting the day before. At lunchtime, we dug a hole that was five feet square and two feet deep. This served three purposes. First, it provided a good shelter for taking a longitude reading; second, with the mast, yard, and floor cloth, we turned it into a cozy spot to keep the primus and enjoy our lunch comfortably; and third, we left a mound as a marker to find our way back on the return trip.

By experience we found that a warm lunch and a rest enabled one to "peg" along a good deal farther than would otherwise be possible.

By experience, we found that a warm lunch and a break allowed us to keep going much further than we would have otherwise.

The "scenery" in the afternoon became if possible more desolate—very few new sastrugi, the surface appearing generally old and pitted. In some places it was rotten and blown away, disclosing coarse granulated substrata. At the top of one ridge the snow merged into neve split into small crevasses, nine inches wide and four or five yards apart. The camp was pitched, here, at 11 P.M. The latitude was 68 degrees 32' S., and we saw the midnight sun for the first time that summer, about one-quarter of its rim remaining above the horizon.

The "scenery" in the afternoon became even more desolate—very few new sastrugi, and the surface looked generally old and pitted. In some areas, it was worn away and blown out, revealing coarse, granular layers underneath. At the top of one ridge, the snow turned into neve, breaking into small crevasses that were nine inches wide and four or five yards apart. The camp was set up here at 11 P.M. The latitude was 68 degrees 32' S., and we saw the midnight sun for the first time that summer, with about a quarter of its rim still above the horizon.

A full hurricane came up and kept between fifty and sixty miles per hour all day on the 30th. Before moving off, Webb found that the magnetic needle had "waltzed" back 60 degrees since the one-hundred-mile camp, now pointing 80 degrees east of south. Still, to allow the needle to makeup its mind, we steered into the wind at 2 P.M., losing the neve and meeting very rough country. By 6 P.M., with four miles to our credit, we were nearly played out. It was being discussed whether we should go on when the discovery was made that the theodolite legs were missing; probably having slipped out in one of the numerous capsizes of the sledge.

A full hurricane hit, blowing between fifty and sixty miles per hour all day on the 30th. Before leaving, Webb noticed that the magnetic needle had shifted back 60 degrees since the one-hundred-mile camp and was now pointing 80 degrees east of south. To give the needle time to stabilize, we steered into the wind at 2 P.M., losing the neve and encountering very rough terrain. By 6 P.M., after covering four miles, we were nearly exhausted. We were discussing whether to continue when we discovered that the theodolite legs were missing; they probably fell out during one of the many times the sledge tipped over.

The solemn rites of "shut-eye" determined that Webb was to stay and make camp while Hurley and I retraced our steps. It was no easy matter to follow the trail, for on hard snow the sledge runners leave no mark, and we had to watch for the holes of the crampon-spikes. About two and a half miles back, the legs were found, and there only remained a hard "plug" against the wind to camp and hoosh.

The serious rituals of "shut-eye" decided that Webb would stay and set up camp while Hurley and I went back the way we came. It wasn't easy to follow the trail because the sledge runners leave no mark on hard snow, so we had to keep an eye out for the holes made by the crampon spikes. About two and a half miles back, we found the legs, and all that was left was a tough push against the wind to get to camp and eat.

While we were lying half-toggled into the sleeping-bags, writing our diaries, Hurley spent some time alternately imprecating the wind and invoking it for a calm next day. As he said, once behind a break-wind one could safely defy it, but on the march one is much more humble.

While we were half-buried in our sleeping bags, writing in our diaries, Hurley spent some time cursing the wind and also asking for a calm day tomorrow. As he put it, once you’re sheltered from the wind, you can easily challenge it, but while you’re on the move, you have to be a lot more respectful.

Whether it was in honour of Queen Alexandra's birthday, or whether Hurley's pious efforts of the evening before had taken effect, December 1 turned out a good day. By noon, the wind had dropped sufficiently for us to hoist the Jack and Commonwealth Ensign for the occasion.

Whether it was to celebrate Queen Alexandra's birthday or because of Hurley's dedicated efforts the night before, December 1 turned out to be a great day. By noon, the wind had calmed down enough for us to raise the Jack and Commonwealth Ensign for the occasion.

After four miles of battling, there came into sight a distinct ridge, ten miles to the west and south—quite the most definitely rising ground observed since leaving the coast. In one place was a patch of immense crevasses, easily visible to the naked eye; in another, due south, were black shadows, and towards these the course was pointed.

After four miles of struggling, a clear ridge came into view, ten miles to the west and south—definitely the most noticeable elevation seen since leaving the coast. In one area, there was a patch of huge crevasses, easily seen with the naked eye; in another direction, due south, there were dark shadows, and the path was headed toward them.

At a point more than one hundred and twenty-five miles from the sea, a skua gull paid an afternoon call, alighting a few yards from the track. I immediately commenced to stalk it with a fishing-line, this time all ready and baited with pemmican. However, it was quite contemptuous, flying off to the south-south-east as far as we could follow it. Was it taking a short cut to the Ross Sea?

At a spot over one hundred twenty-five miles from the sea, a skua gull dropped by one afternoon, landing just a few yards from the path. I quickly started to stalk it with a fishing line, fully prepared and baited with pemmican. However, it ignored me completely, flying off to the south-southeast as far as we could track it. Was it taking a shortcut to the Ross Sea?

December 2 saw us through "Dead-Beat Gully" to a rise, in sight of the shadows towards which we had been steering. Two miles away they appeared like the edge of the moon seen through a large telescope. The shadows were due to large mounds of snow on the south side of a steep escarpment. Three main prominences were cross-connected with regular lines of hillocks, giving the impression of a subdivided town-site. The low evening sun threw everything up in the most wonderful relief.

December 2 took us through "Dead-Beat Gully" to a rise, where we could see the shadows we had been aiming for. Two miles away, they looked like the edge of the moon seen through a big telescope. The shadows were caused by large snow mounds on the south side of a steep cliff. Three main peaks were connected by regular lines of small hills, creating the impression of a divided town. The low evening sun highlighted everything in an amazing way.

On the morning of the 3rd we were in a valley running west-north-west and east-south-east. The southern side rose steeply and from it projected three large mounds, about two hundred feet from the bottom of the valley, into which they fell just like tailings-heaps from a mine. They were christened "The Nodules."

On the morning of the 3rd, we were in a valley that ran northwest and southeast. The southern side rose sharply, and from it jutted out three large mounds, about two hundred feet up from the bottom of the valley, which looked just like piles of tailings from a mine. They were named "The Nodules."

Going due south uphill over neve we found ourselves in a regular network of crevasses. They were about ten feet wide and well bridged. Most noticeable were "hedges" of ice up to six feet in height on either side of the crevasses which ran southward. It was now nearly calm and in every crack and chink in the snow-bridges beautiful fern-like ice-crystals were seen. These must have been just forming, as a very light puff of wind was seen to destroy many of them.

Going straight south uphill over the snow, we found ourselves in a real network of cracks. They were about ten feet wide and well-connected. Most striking were "hedges" of ice up to six feet tall on either side of the cracks that stretched southward. It was nearly calm now, and in every crack and crevice in the snow-bridges, we saw beautiful fern-like ice crystals. They must have just been forming, as a light breeze was enough to blow many of them away.

We spent three hours exploring the locality. On nearing the top of the ridge, roped together, we found that the crevasses were becoming much wider, while the "hedges" were disappearing. The centre "nodule" was found to be immediately north or to the leeward of the intersection of two crevasses, each about forty feet wide. The bridge of one crevasse had dropped some thirty feet for a length of eighty yards. Doubtless, an eddy from this hole accounts for the deposit of snow and, by accretions, for the erection of the nodule. Webb went down at the end of the alpine rope and found the bridge below quite solid.

We spent three hours exploring the area. As we got near the top of the ridge, roped together, we noticed that the crevasses were getting much wider, while the "hedges" were disappearing. The center "nodule" was found immediately north or downwind of where two crevasses intersected, each about forty feet wide. The bridge of one crevasse had dropped about thirty feet along a stretch of eighty yards. Surely, an eddy from this hole explains the snow deposit and, through accumulation, the formation of the nodule. Webb went down at the end of the alpine rope and found the bridge below to be quite solid.

For about half a mile the summit of the slope was practically level, three hundred feet above the bed of the valley. The surface was still of neve, intersected by canals forty, sixty and eighty feet wide, in which the snow-bridge was generally four or five feet from the brink.

For about half a mile, the top of the slope was mostly flat, three hundred feet above the valley floor. The surface was still made of neve, crossed by channels that were forty, sixty, and eighty feet wide, where the snow bridge was usually four or five feet from the edge.

On the south-west horizon, perhaps twenty miles away, was a salient crest streaked by three dark vertical bars; evidently another crevassed area.

On the southwest horizon, about twenty miles away, was a prominent ridge marked by three dark vertical stripes; clearly another area with crevasses.

Returning to the sledge, we toggled-on and worked it up over the top of the ridge, much regretting that time would not allow us to examine the other two large "nodules." Hurley was in the lead, lengthening his line by thirty feet of alpine rope, but even then all three of us and the sledge were often on the lid of a crevasse. Luckily, the lids were fairly sound, and none of us went in beyond the waist. Finally, the trail emerged on to ordinary sastrugi once more, where a halt was made for lunch. We were all glad to have seen the place, but I think none of us has any wish to see another like it.

Returning to the sled, we turned it on and dragged it over the ridge, wishing we had more time to check out the other two large "nodules." Hurley was in the lead, extending his line by thirty feet of alpine rope, but even then, all three of us and the sled were often right on the edge of a crevasse. Fortunately, the surfaces were pretty solid, and none of us fell in past our waists. Eventually, the path led us back to regular sastrugi, where we stopped for lunch. We were all glad to have seen the place, but I think none of us wanted to see another one like it.

That night, after following the magnetic needle towards the south-east, we were fairly on the plateau at one hundred and forty miles, with an altitude of four thousand four hundred feet. The dip, however, had steadily decreased, standing now at 88 degrees 30'. There was some consolation in the hope that a big, sudden rise was stored up for us somewhere along the way ahead.

That night, after tracking the compass needle southeast, we were pretty much on the plateau at one hundred and forty miles, at an elevation of four thousand four hundred feet. However, the dip had steadily decreased, now sitting at 88 degrees 30'. There was some comfort in the hope that a big, sudden rise was waiting for us somewhere along the way.

December 4 and 5 were fine days, giving only twenty-two miles, as we met with a rough surface; a large quantity of very hard, razor-backed sastrugi, generally about two feet high, like groined vaulting inverted, on a small scale. Sledge and sledge-meter both had a very rough passage. The sledge, for instance, balances itself on the top of a sastruga for a moment, with an ominous bend in the runners, crashes down the slope and jams its bow into the next one, from which it has to be lifted clear.

December 4 and 5 were nice days, covering only twenty-two miles because we encountered a tough surface; there was a lot of very hard, razor-sharp sastrugi, usually about two feet high, resembling inverted groined vaulting on a smaller scale. Both the sledge and sledge-meter had a very rough trip. The sledge, for example, balances on top of a sastruga for a moment, bending the runners ominously, then crashes down the slope and gets its bow stuck in the next one, which has to be lifted clear.

During this run the needle again misbehaved itself, changing its direction some 85 degrees in ten miles, but by the night of the 5th we were getting past the disturbed locality and the dip had increased considerably.

During this run, the needle acted up again, shifting its direction by about 85 degrees in ten miles, but by the night of the 5th, we were moving past the disturbed area, and the dip had increased significantly.

For the first time on the trip the wind veered round to the south-east. Snow had fallen overnight (December 5) and had drifted in long ramps diagonally across the sastrugi. In two and a half hours we covered two and a quarter miles, blindly blundering in an uncertain light among crests and troughs and through piles of soft, new snow. Then we stopped; Webb filling in the afternoon with a full set of dip observations.

For the first time on the trip, the wind shifted to the southeast. Snow had fallen overnight (December 5) and had drifted into long ramps diagonally across the sastrugi. In two and a half hours, we covered two and a quarter miles, stumbling blindly in uncertain light among the peaks and valleys and through heaps of soft, fresh snow. Then we stopped; Webb spent the afternoon taking a full set of dip observations.

That night the break-wind played its one possible trick. Waking on the 8th, we found that the heavy snowfall, with only a moderate wind, had drifted us up. Of course Hurley and I, who slept on the 'outsides,' had known it most of the night. Before we could extricate ourselves from the bags Webb had to turn out from the middle to dig away the drift which was weighing down the walls of the tent on top of us.

That night, the wind played its only trick. When we woke up on the 8th, we found that the heavy snowfall, along with a light wind, had drifted around us. Of course, Hurley and I, who were sleeping on the outside, had felt it most of the night. Before we could get out of our sleeping bags, Webb had to climb out from the middle to dig away the snow that was pressing down on the walls of the tent above us.

It was hopeless weather for travelling. In the afternoon a snow cave was dug, seven feet deep and enlarged to seven feet square at the bottom. The whole was covered with mast, yard and sail. It was very snug from the outward aspect, but we soon found that there were two objections to the "Sarcophagus," as it was named. There was very little light except a ghastly blue half-tone filtering through the snow, and the place was not over warm, surrounded by walls at a much lower temperature than that of the surface.

It was awful weather for traveling. In the afternoon, a snow cave was dug, seven feet deep and widened to seven feet square at the bottom. It was covered with mast, yard, and sail. From the outside, it looked cozy, but we quickly discovered two major drawbacks to the "Sarcophagus," as we named it. There was hardly any light, just a creepy blue glow filtering through the snow, and it wasn't very warm inside, surrounded by walls that were much colder than the surface.

Webb commenced a declination "quick-run," consisting of half-hourly observations of the direction in which the compass was pointing. In ordinary latitudes, during the day, the compass needle moves over a few minutes of arc, but here, being so close to the Magnetic Pole, its movement is greatly magnified, the range being about 5 degrees on this occasion. Webb carried on readings till midnight, and at 4 A.M., December 9, I turned out, being relieved at 8 A.M. by Hurley, who carried on until the twenty-four hours were completed. This observation should be especially valuable when it is compared with continuous magnetic records obtained at the same time at Winter Quarters and by the Scott expedition at McMurdo Sound.

Webb started a "quick-run" to track the compass's direction every half hour. Normally, in typical latitudes during the day, the compass needle shifts just a few minutes of arc. However, since we were so close to the Magnetic Pole, its movement was significantly increased, showing a range of about 5 degrees this time. Webb continued taking readings until midnight, and at 4 A.M. on December 9, I got up, with Hurley taking over at 8 A.M. to continue until the 24-hour period was completed. This observation will be particularly valuable when compared with the continuous magnetic records collected simultaneously at Winter Quarters and by the Scott expedition at McMurdo Sound.

It was not till 1.30 P.M. on December 10 that the sixty-mile wind had subsided sufficiently for us to get away. Every yard of our quota of seven miles was hard going. A fine example of a typical old sastruga was passed on the way. In order to secure a photograph of it, Hurley had to waste eighteen films before he could persuade one to pull into place correctly. The film-packs had been carefully kept in an airtight tin, but the cold was too much for them. The tags which should pull each film round from the back to the front of the pack usually tore away with a small piece of film. In fact, out of one hundred and twenty films only forty-five exposures were made.

It wasn't until 1:30 PM on December 10 that the sixty-mile-an-hour wind calmed down enough for us to leave. Every yard of our seven-mile quota was tough going. We passed a great example of a typical old sastruga on the way. To get a photograph of it, Hurley had to waste eighteen film rolls before he finally got one to come out right. The film packs had been carefully stored in an airtight container, but the cold was too harsh for them. The tags that were supposed to pull each film from the back to the front of the pack often ripped off with a small piece of film. In fact, out of one hundred and twenty films, only forty-five exposures were successfully taken.

On the 11th a good deal of "piecrust" cut down the day's march to eight and a half miles. Sledge runners are usually supported by this surface, but one's feet break through in a most annoying and tiring manner. The drift eased off for a few hours and we managed to dry some of our gear. At the Sarcophagus, things which had all been wet enough before became saturated with drift which turned to ice. Felt mitts are perhaps the worst in this respect, and it is no exaggeration to say that you could easily brain a man with one after it had been worn in drift for a couple of days.

On the 11th, a lot of "piecrust" really cut down our distance to just eight and a half miles for the day. Normally, sledge runners glide over this surface, but your feet can suddenly sink in, which is really annoying and tiring. The snow settled for a few hours, so we were able to dry out some of our gear. At the Sarcophagus, everything that had been wet before got soaked again by the drifting snow, turning into ice. Felt mitts are probably the worst in this situation, and it's no exaggeration to say you could easily knock someone out with one after wearing it in the drift for a couple of days.

That night I decided that one more day must see us at our depot. Allowing three days' grace for contingencies, there were thirty-one days for us to attain our farthest southerly point and back to the Hut.

That night, I decided we needed one more day to reach our depot. With three days as a buffer for any unexpected issues, we had thirty-one days to get to our farthest southern point and return to the Hut.

On the 12th we planned to reach a spot for the depot, two hundred miles out, and by 11.30 P.M. came on a fine site at one hundred and ninety-nine and three-quarter miles; altitude four thousand eight hundred and fifty feet, latitude 69 degrees 83.1' south; longitude 140 degrees 20' east. Everything possible was left behind, the sledge-decking being even cut away, until only three light bamboo slats remained. A pile, including ten days' food and one gallon of kerosene, was placed on a small mound to prevent it being drifted over. A few yards distant rose a solid nine-foot cairn surmounted by a black canvas-and-wire flag, six feet higher, well stayed with steel wire.

On the 12th, we aimed to reach a spot for the depot, two hundred miles out, and by 11:30 PM, we found a great location at one hundred and ninety-nine and three-quarter miles; elevation four thousand eight hundred and fifty feet, latitude 69 degrees 83.1' south; longitude 140 degrees 20' east. We left behind everything we could, even cutting away the sledge-decking until only three light bamboo slats were left. We placed a pile, which included ten days' worth of food and one gallon of kerosene, on a small mound to keep it from being covered by drifting snow. A few yards away, there was a solid nine-foot cairn topped with a black canvas-and-wire flag that was six feet higher, securely fastened with steel wire.

I took on food for seventeen days, three days more than I intended to be out, partly so that we could keep on longer if we found we could make very fast time, and also as a safeguard against thick weather when returning to the depot.

I packed enough food for seventeen days, three days more than I planned to be out, partly so we could stay longer if we realized we were making really good time, and also as a backup in case we encountered bad weather on the way back to the depot.

Late in the evening we set off against a stiff breeze. The sledge ran lightly for three and a half miles, and we camped. The depot showed up well in the north-west as a bright golden spot in the low midnight sun.

Late in the evening, we headed out into a strong breeze. The sled moved smoothly for three and a half miles, and then we set up camp. The depot stood out clearly in the northwest as a bright golden dot in the low midnight sun.

Next day the piecrust was so bad that, despite the lessened load, we only covered twelve miles. The surface was smoothly polished, and we either crashed through it from four inches to a foot or else slipped and came down heavily on knees, elbow, or head. New finnesko were largely responsible for such an accident.

The next day, the piecrust was so bad that, even with a lighter load, we only managed to cover twelve miles. The surface was slick and smooth, and we either crashed through it, dropping from four inches to a foot, or slipped and landed hard on our knees, elbows, or heads. The new finnesko were mostly to blame for these accidents.

At 11 P.M. a remarkable ramp, five chains long, was passed. On its windward side was a tangled cluster of large sastrugi. They made one imagine that the wind, infuriated at finding a block of snow impeding its progress, had run amok with a giant gouge, endeavouring to pare it down. Every now and then, the gouge, missing its aim, had taken great lateral scoops from the surface, leaving trenches two and three feet deep.

At 11 P.M., we passed a notable ramp that was five chains long. On the windward side, there was a messy cluster of large sastrugi. It made you think that the wind, frustrated by a block of snow blocking its path, had gone wild with a giant scoop, trying to shave it down. Every now and then, the scoop, missing its target, had taken out big chunks from the surface, leaving trenches that were two or three feet deep.

In bags that night we had a talk (not the first by any means) over our prospects. Up to the one hundred-and-seventy-four-mile camp, four hundred miles seemed dimly possible, but now we saw we would be lucky to reach three hundred miles. Moreover, the dip at this spot was 89 degrees 11', practically what it had been ever since one hundred and fifty miles. Sixty-five miles for nothing! How far for the other forty-nine minutes which were needed for a vertical dip and the South Magnetic Pole? This problem was insoluble, so each toggled himself into his bag in a rather depressed state of mind.

In our sleeping bags that night, we had a discussion (definitely not the first one) about our prospects. Up until the one hundred seventy-four mile camp, four hundred miles seemed somewhat possible, but now we realized we’d be lucky to hit three hundred miles. Plus, the dip at this point was 89 degrees 11’, pretty much what it had been for the last one hundred fifty miles. Sixty-five miles for nothing! How far for the other forty-nine minutes we needed to reach a vertical dip and the South Magnetic Pole? This question was impossible to solve, so each of us climbed into our bags feeling a bit down.

December 16 was a glorious day; only a fifteen-mile wind, and for ten miles an improved surface. There was no drift, consequently opportunity was taken to turn the sleeping bags inside out. They needed it, too. The upper parts were not so bad as they had been propped open occasionally, but the lower halves were coated with solid ice. For the first time for weeks we did not wear burberrys, as the weather was so warm. Fourteen miles was the total work, the previous day's being twelve.

December 16 was an amazing day; there was only a fifteen-mile wind, and for ten miles, the surface was better. There was no drift, so we took the opportunity to turn the sleeping bags inside out. They really needed it, too. The tops weren’t as bad since they had been propped open sometimes, but the bottoms were covered in solid ice. For the first time in weeks, we didn’t wear our burberrys because the weather was so warm. We covered fourteen miles in total, compared to twelve the day before.

All three of us were having trouble with snow-blindness; the "zinc and cocaine" tabloids being in great demand.

All three of us were struggling with snow-blindness; the "zinc and cocaine" tabloids were highly sought after.

Latitude 70 degrees south was passed on the 17th and we were another fourteen miles to the good. The dip was on the increase 89 degrees 25' and the declination swung to 40 degrees east of the magnetic meridian. At two hundred and fifty-six miles the altitude was five thousand five hundred feet.

Latitude 70 degrees south was reached on the 17th, and we were another fourteen miles ahead. The dip increased to 89 degrees 25', and the declination shifted to 40 degrees east of the magnetic meridian. At two hundred and fifty-six miles, the altitude was five thousand five hundred feet.

The temperature was getting lower; the minimum being -21 degrees F. on the night of the 17th, rising to a maximum of 3 degrees F. on the following day.

The temperature was dropping; the lowest point was -21 degrees F. on the night of the 17th, then rising to a high of 3 degrees F. the next day.

There was dead calm and a regular heat wave on December 19. As the sun rose higher and higher, the tent became absolutely oppressive. The rime coating the walls inside thawed and water actually trickled into our finnesko. Usually we awoke to find them frozen hard, just as we had shaped them on the previous night, but on this particular morning they were pathetically limp and wet. The temperature inside the tent was 66 degrees F., heated, of course, by the sun's rays which raised our black bulb thermometer to 105 degrees F. We were not used to this sort of thing and struggled out hurriedly for a breath of fresh air.

There was a dead calm and a regular heat wave on December 19. As the sun rose higher and higher, the tent became completely oppressive. The frost on the walls inside melted, and water actually dripped into our shoes. Usually, we woke up to find them frozen solid, just as we had shaped them the night before, but on this particular morning they were sadly limp and wet. The temperature inside the tent was 66 degrees F., heated, of course, by the sun's rays which pushed our black bulb thermometer up to 105 degrees F. We weren’t used to this kind of weather and rushed out quickly for a breath of fresh air.

Once into harness, we began to feel the effects of exertion. By degrees we got rid of our clothing, but unfortunately soon came to bedrock in that respect, as the underclothing was sewn on and immovable. At lunch time, with the thermometer at -2 degrees F. in the shade, we reluctantly dressed knowing how soon we would cool off. About 9 P.M. clouds moved over rapidly from the south-east and the landscape faded into the blank, shadowless nothing of an overcast day. The camp was pitched at two hundred and eighty-three miles amidst a jumble of ramps and sastrugi. The dip had seen fit to rise to 89 degrees 35'.

Once we got started, we began to feel the strain of the effort. Little by little, we took off our clothes, but unfortunately, we soon reached a point where we couldn't remove anything else since our undergarments were stitched on and stuck. At lunchtime, with the thermometer reading -2 degrees F. in the shade, we reluctantly put our clothes back on, knowing we would start to feel cold again soon. Around 9 PM, clouds rapidly moved in from the southeast, and the landscape disappeared into the blank, shadowless void of an overcast day. The camp was set up at two hundred and eighty-three miles, surrounded by a mix of ramps and sastrugi. The dip had decided to rise to 89 degrees 35'.

In the morning the wind was doing thirty miles per hour, which certainly seemed to be the normal thing. It fell to a nice sailing breeze, but, at the time, we were not very appreciative of anything as the course was uphill. Again, it was to be the last day's run, so we were "all out" when the halt came after a good fifteen miles—the longest day's march on the outward journey. Nevertheless, Webb unpacked the theodolite after hoosh and took an altitude of the sun at midnight.

In the morning, the wind was blowing at thirty miles per hour, which definitely felt normal. It settled into a nice sailing breeze, but we weren’t really in the mood to appreciate anything since we were heading uphill. Once again, it was our last day of traveling, so we were exhausted when we finally stopped after a good fifteen miles—the longest trek of the entire outward journey. Still, after a break, Webb unpacked the theodolite and took a sun altitude measurement at midnight.

On December 21 the load on the sledge was stripped down to tent, dip-circle, theodolite, cooker and a little food. For two and a half miles we went south-east over rising ground until the sledge-meter showed three hundred and one miles.

On December 21, the load on the sledge was reduced to a tent, dip-circle, theodolite, cooker, and a bit of food. We traveled southeast for two and a half miles over rising ground until the sledge-meter showed three hundred and one miles.

While Hurley and I pitched the tent, Webb built a breakwind for his instrument fifty yards away. Then followed a long set of magnetic observations. About 5 P.M. the magnetic work was interrupted; the theodolite replacing the dip-circle on the legs, while I took a longitude shot. I was seeing double, being slightly snow-blind, and had some difficulty in choosing the correct combination from the assortment of suns and cross-wires visible in the telescope. Setting the vertical and horizontal wires simultaneously on the sun was beyond me; Webb taking the observations for the true meridian, which also checked my longitude shot.

While Hurley and I set up the tent, Webb built a windbreak for his instrument fifty yards away. Then we did a long series of magnetic observations. Around 5 P.M., we paused the magnetic work; the theodolite replaced the dip-circle on the legs while I took a longitude reading. I was seeing double because I was a bit snow-blind, making it hard to pick the right alignment from the mix of suns and crosshairs visible in the telescope. I couldn't manage to set the vertical and horizontal wires on the sun at the same time, so Webb took the readings for the true meridian, which also confirmed my longitude shot.

Magnetic work under these conditions is an extremely uncomfortable operation. Even a light wind will eddy round the break-wind, and it is wind which makes low temperatures formidable. Nearly all the work has to be done with bare fingers or thin instrument-gloves, and the time taken is far greater than in temperate climates, owing to the fingers constantly "going" and because of the necessity of continually freeing the instrument from the condensed moisture of the breath. Considering that the temperature was -12 degrees F. when he had finished his four hours' work, it may be imagined that Webb was ready for his hot tea. The dip proved to be 89 degrees 43.5', that is, sixteen and a half minutes from the vertical. The altitude was just over five thousand nine hundred feet, in latitude 70 degrees 36.5' south and longitude 148 degrees 10' east.

Magnetic work in these conditions is an incredibly uncomfortable task. Even a light breeze will swirl around the windbreak, and it's the wind that makes low temperatures so challenging. Most of the work has to be done with bare fingers or thin gloves, and the time required is much longer than in milder climates, due to the fingers constantly going numb and the need to frequently wipe the instrument free of the moisture from one's breath. Given that the temperature was -12 degrees F. when he finished his four hours of work, it's easy to see why Webb was eager for his hot tea. The dip measured 89 degrees 43.5', which is sixteen and a half minutes from vertical. The altitude was just over five thousand nine hundred feet, at latitude 70 degrees 36.5' south and longitude 148 degrees 10' east.

After lunch the Union Jack and the Commonwealth Ensign were hoisted and three cheers given for the King—willing but rather lonesome away out there! We searched the horizon with glasses but could see nothing save snow, undulating in endless sastrugi. To the south-east the horizon was limited by our old enemy, "the next ridge," some two miles away. We wondered what could be beyond, although we knew it was only the same featureless repetition, since one hundred and seventy-five miles on the same course would bring us to the spot where David, Mawson and Mackay had stood in 1909.

After lunch, the Union Jack and the Commonwealth Ensign were raised, and we cheered for the King—who was willing but felt a bit lonely out there! We scanned the horizon with binoculars but saw nothing but snow, rolling in endless sastrugi. To the southeast, the horizon was blocked by our old adversary, "the next ridge," which was about two miles away. We wondered what lay beyond, even though we knew it was just more of the same featureless landscape, since traveling one hundred and seventy-five miles in the same direction would take us to the spot where David, Mawson, and Mackay stood in 1909.

After Hurley had taken a photograph of the camp, the tent was struck and the sledge repacked. At last the sail was rigged, we gave a final glance back and turned on the homeward trail.

After Hurley took a picture of the camp, they took down the tent and repacked the sled. Finally, the sail was set up, we took one last look back, and headed home.

My diary of that night sums up: "We have now been exactly six weeks on the tramp and somehow feel rather sad at turning back, even though it has not been quite a Sunday school picnic all along. It is a great disappointment not to see a dip of 90°, but the time is too short with this 'climate.' It was higher than we expected to get, after the unsatisfactory dips obtained near the two-hundred-mile depot. The rate of increase since that spot has been fairly uniform and indicates that 90 degrees might be reached in another fifty to sixty miles, if the same rate held, and that means at least another week. It's no good thinking about it for 'orders are orders.' We'll have our work cut out to get back as it is. Twenty-five days till we are overdue. Certainly we have twenty-three days' food, eight days' with us, ten days' at two hundred miles, and five days' at sixty-seven miles, so with luck we should not go hungry, but Webb wants to get five more full sets of dips if possible on the way back, and this means two and a half days."

My diary from that night sums up: "We’ve now been exactly six weeks on this journey, and somehow we feel pretty sad about turning back, even though it hasn’t been exactly a walk in the park. It’s a huge letdown not to see a dip of 90°, but the time is too short given this 'climate.' We reached a height higher than we thought we would, after the disappointing dips near the two-hundred-mile mark. The rate of increase since that point has been pretty consistent and suggests that we might hit 90 degrees in another fifty to sixty miles if the same rate continues, which means at least another week. No point in dwelling on it since 'orders are orders.' We’ve got our work cut out for us just to get back. Twenty-five days until we’re overdue. We definitely have twenty-three days' worth of food—eight days with us, ten days at two hundred miles, and five days at sixty-seven miles—so with a bit of luck, we shouldn’t go hungry. But Webb wants to get five more complete sets of dips if possible on the way back, and that means two and a half days."

That night the minimum thermometer registered its lowest at -25 degrees F. It was December 21 and Midsummer Day, so we concluded that the spot would be a very chilly one in the winter.

That night, the lowest temperature recorded by the minimum thermometer was -25 degrees F. It was December 21, Midsummer Day, so we figured that the place would be really cold in the winter.

At this juncture we were very short of finnesko. The new ones we had worn since the two-hundred-mile camp had moulted badly and were now almost "bald." The stitching wears through as soon as the hair comes off and frequent mending is necessary.

At this point, we were really low on finnesko. The new ones we had worn since the two-hundred-mile camp had worn out badly and were now almost "bald." The stitching wears through as soon as the hair comes off, and frequent repairs are necessary.

We rose earlier than usual on the 22nd, so as to get more advantage from the wind, which each evening had always tended to die down somewhat. With forty-two square feet of sail, the twenty-mile wind was too much for us, the sledge capsizing on the smallest pretext. Instead of hanging the yard from the top of the mast, we placed it across the load, reversing the sail and hooking the clews over the top of the mast. Three or four pieces of lampwick at intervals served as reefing-points by which the area of the sail could be quickly cut down by bunching the upper part as much as was necessary.

We got up earlier than usual on the 22nd to take better advantage of the wind, which always tended to die down a bit by evening. With forty-two square feet of sail, a twenty-mile wind was too strong for us, and the sled would flip over at the slightest provocation. Instead of hanging the yard from the top of the mast, we laid it across the load, flipped the sail, and hooked the clews over the top of the mast. A few pieces of lampwick at intervals acted as reefing points, allowing us to quickly reduce the sail area by bunching up the upper part as needed.

During the day we frequently saw our tracks in patches of snow left during a previous snowfall, but they were much eroded, although only three days old. After sledging in Adelie Land it is hard to realize that on certain parts of the Ross Barrier tracks a year old may remain visible.

During the day, we often noticed our tracks in the patches of snow left from an earlier snowfall, but they were quite worn down, even though they were only three days old. After sledding in Adelie Land, it’s hard to believe that in some areas of the Ross Barrier, tracks that are a year old can still be seen.

After passing the two-hundred-and-eighty-three-mile mound, the sledge-meter became very sickly. Spoke after spoke had parted and we saw that nothing we could do would make it last very much longer. As we intended in one place to make a cross-country run of seventy miles, so as to cut off the detour to the "Nodules," the meter was carried on the sledge. We had now the mounds to check distances.

After passing the 283-mile mark, the sledge-meter started acting up. Spoke after spoke broke, and we realized that there was nothing we could do to keep it running for much longer. Since we planned to make a cross-country trip of 70 miles to avoid the detour to the "Nodules," we carried the meter on the sledge. We now had the mounds to measure distances.

On December 23 we were lucky enough to catch sight of the two-hundred-and-sixty-nine-mile mound and later the one at two hundred and sixty-one miles, though there was a good deal of drift. The day's run was twenty and a half miles.

On December 23, we were fortunate enough to see the 269-mile mound and later the one at 261 miles, even though there was quite a bit of drift. We traveled twenty and a half miles that day.

A thing which helped us unexpectedly was that, now with the wind behind, we found it unnecessary to wear the stiff, heavy, frozen, burberry trousers. Thick pyjama trousers took their place in all except the worst weather.

A surprising thing that helped us was that, now with the wind at our backs, we found we didn't need to wear the stiff, heavy, frozen Burberry trousers. Thick pajama pants replaced them in all but the worst weather.

At our old two-hundred-and-forty-nine-mile camp, Webb took a complete set of magnetic observations and another time-shot for watch-rate. It was late when these were over, so we did only two and a half miles more, halting for Christmas Eve, well content with a run of fourteen miles in addition to a set of observations.

At our old 249-mile camp, Webb took a full set of magnetic observations and another time shot for watch rate. It was late when these wrapped up, so we only did another two and a half miles, stopping for Christmas Eve, feeling satisfied with a total of fourteen miles plus a set of observations.

On Christmas Day the country was very rough, making sailing difficult. Still, eighteen and a half miles were left behind. The wind was practically along the sastrugi and the course was diagonal to both. As the sledge strikes each sastruga, it skids northwards along it to the discomfort of the wheelers and the disgust of the leader.

On Christmas Day, the weather was really bad, making it hard to sail. Still, they managed to cover eighteen and a half miles. The wind was mostly blowing along the sastrugi, and their path was at an angle to both. Every time the sledge hit a sastruga, it slid northward along it, which annoyed the wheelers and frustrated the leader.

For Christmas dinner that night we had to content ourselves with revising the menu for the meal which was to celebrate the two-hundred-mile depot. But now it was all pretty well mapped out, having been matured in its finer details for several days on the march. Hors d'oeuvre, soup, meat, pudding, sweets and wine were all designed, and estimates were out. Would we pick up the depot soon enough to justify an "auspicious occasion"?

For Christmas dinner that night, we had to settle for going over the menu for the meal that was meant to celebrate the two-hundred-mile depot. But now it was mostly planned out, having been fine-tuned over several days on the march. Appetizers, soup, main course, dessert, treats, and wine were all planned, and estimates were prepared. Would we reach the depot in time to make it a "special occasion"?

Next day the wind was due south at thirty miles per hour. Dodging big ramps and overturning on sastrugi, at the same time dragging well upwind of the course to save leeway, twelve miles went by without the two-hundred-and-fifteen-mile mound coming into sight. Finally, a search with the glasses through falling snow revealed it a good two miles back. As we particularly wanted some photos of the ramps at this camp, we made across to it and had lunch there, Hurley exposing the last of the films.

The next day, the wind was coming from the south at thirty miles per hour. While we navigated around large ramps and over uneven snow, we also stayed a bit upwind of our intended path to avoid drifting. After covering twelve miles, we still hadn’t spotted the two-hundred-and-fifteen-mile mound. Eventually, after scanning the area with binoculars through the falling snow, we finally saw it about two miles behind us. Since we really wanted some photos of the ramps at this camp, we headed over there and had lunch, with Hurley using the last of the film.

At two hundred and nine miles "Lot's Wife" appeared—a tall, thin mound which Hurley had erected during a lunch-camp on the way out.

At two hundred and nine miles, "Lot's Wife" came into view—a tall, thin mound that Hurley had built during a lunch stop on the way out.

On the 27th, with a thirty-five-mile wind and a good deal of drift, we did not see the two-hundred-and-three-mile mound until we almost ran into it. By three o'clock the great event occurred—the depot was found! We determined to hold the Christmas feast. After a cup of tea and a bit of biscuit, the rest of the lunch ration was put aside.

On the 27th, with a thirty-five-mile wind and a lot of drifting snow, we didn't spot the two-hundred-and-three-mile mound until we were almost on top of it. By three o'clock, the big moment happened—the depot was discovered! We decided to celebrate Christmas with a feast. After having a cup of tea and a biscuit, we set aside the rest of the lunch ration.

Webb set up his instrument in the lee of the big mound and commenced a set of observations; I sorted out gear from the depot and rearranged the sledge load; Hurley was busy in the tent concocting all kinds of dishes. As the tableware was limited to three mugs and the Nansen cooker, we had to come in to deal with each course the moment it was ready. Aiming at a really high-class meal, Hurley had started by actually cleaning out the cooker.

Webb set up his instrument sheltered from the wind by the large mound and started a series of observations; I organized equipment from the storage and rearranged the sledge load; Hurley was busy in the tent whipping up all sorts of dishes. Since we only had three mugs and the Nansen cooker, we had to come in and serve each course as soon as it was ready. Wanting to create a top-notch meal, Hurley even cleaned out the cooker first.

The absence of reindeer-hair and other oddments made everything taste quite strange, though the basis was still the same old ration with a few remaining "perks." After the "raisin gliders," soup and a good stiff hoosh, Webb finished his observations while I recorded for him. It is wonderful what sledging does for the appetite. For the first week of the journey, the unaccustomed ration was too much for us; but now when Hurley announced "Pudding!" we were all still ravenous. It was a fine example of ye goode olde English plum-pudding, made from biscuit grated with the Bonsa-saw, fat picked out of the pemmican, raisins and glaxo-and-sugar, all boiled in an old food-bag.

The lack of reindeer fur and other unusual ingredients made everything taste really weird, but the base was still the same old food with a few leftover "perks." After the "raisin gliders," soup, and a strong hoosh, Webb finished his observations while I recorded for him. It’s amazing what sledding does for your appetite. During the first week of the trip, the unfamiliar rations were too much for us; but now when Hurley announced "Pudding!" we were all still starving. It was a great example of the classic English plum pudding, made from biscuits grated with the Bonsa-saw, fat taken from the pemmican, raisins, and glaxo-and-sugar, all boiled in an old food bag.

This pudding was so filling that we could hardly struggle through a savoury, "Angels on runners," and cocoa. There was a general recovery when the "wine" was produced, made from stewed raisins and primus alcohol; and "The King" was toasted with much gusto. At the first sip, to say the least, we were disappointed. The rule of "no heel taps" nearly settled us, and quite a long interval and cigars, saved up for the occasion by Webb, were necessary before we could get courage enough to drink to the Other Sledging Parties and Our Supporting Party.

This pudding was so filling that we could barely manage a savory "Angels on runners" and cocoa. Everyone perked up when the "wine" was brought out, made from stewed raisins and primus alcohol; and we toasted "The King" with a lot of enthusiasm. However, we were quite disappointed after the first sip. The rule of "no heel taps" almost did us in, and we needed a significant break along with cigars, which Webb had saved for the occasion, before we could muster the courage to toast to the Other Sledging Parties and Our Supporting Party.

The sun was low in the south when, cigars out and conversation lagging, we finally toggled in for the finest sleep of the whole journey.

The sun was setting in the south when, cigars out and the conversation slowing down, we finally settled in for the best sleep of the entire trip.

The cook, under a doubtful inspiration, broke forth, later on, into a Christmas Carol:

The cook, feeling unsure of his inspiration, later started singing a Christmas carol:

    I've dined in many places but never such as these-
    It's like the Gates of Heaven when you find you've lost the keys.
    I've dined with kings and emperors, perhaps you scarce believe;
    And even they do funny things when round comes Christmas Eve.
    I've feasted with iguanas on a lonely desert isle;
    Once in the shade of a wattle by a maiden's winsome smile.
    I've "grubbed" at a threepenny hash-house, I've been at a
      counter-lunch,
    Reclined at a clap-up cafe where only the "swankers" munch.
    In short, I've dined from Horn to Cape and up Alaska-way
    But the finest, funniest dinner of all was on that Xmas Day.
    I've eaten in many places, but none quite like these—
    It feels like the Gates of Heaven when you realize you've lost the keys.
    I've dined with kings and emperors, though you might find that hard to believe;
    Even they act a little silly when Christmas Eve arrives.
    I've shared meals with iguanas on a deserted island;
    Once under the shade of a tree, enchanted by a lovely girl’s smile.
    I've eaten at a cheap diner, and I've grabbed a quick bite at a counter,
    Relaxed at a trendy café where only the posh folks hang out.
    In short, I've eaten from one end of the world to the other and up into Alaska,
    But the most memorable and hilarious dinner of all was on that Christmas Day.

For the first ten miles on the afternoon of the 28th, the sail was reefed down to prevent the sledge overrunning us on smooth patches. Not far past the one-hundred-and-ninety-mile mound, which was missed in the drift, we picked up some of the outward tracks—a bas-relief of three footsteps and a yard of sledge-meter track, raised half an inch and undercut by the wind. It was not very much, but quite a comfort when one is navigating in blinding weather.

For the first ten miles on the afternoon of the 28th, we reduced the sail to stop the sledge from catching up with us on the smooth parts. Not long after passing the one-hundred-and-ninety-mile mound, which we missed in the drift, we found some of the outward tracks—a clear imprint of three footsteps and a yard-long sledge track, raised half an inch and shaped by the wind. It wasn’t much, but it was a nice relief when you’re trying to navigate in such terrible visibility.

At 11.30 P.M. we had marched twenty-one miles, and both light and surface were improving, so I proposed making a long run of it. Hurley and Webb eagerly agreed, and we had a preparatory hoosh. Ten miles scudded by monotonously without a sign of the mounds around the one-hundred-and-seventy-mile camp. As we were in the vicinity of a point where we had determined to diverge from our outward track, a course was laid direct for the one-hundred-and-thirteen-mile mark. The sledge-meter, which had been affixed, made its presence evident from time to time by ringing like a cash register, as still another broken spoke struck the forks. We would halt for a moment and extract the remains. Out of the original thirty-six wire spokes, only twelve wire and one wooden one remained. At 11.30 A.M. on December 29, a halt was called and the sledge-meter was then lying over on its side with a helpless expression. It indicated twenty-two miles, making, so we thought, a total of forty-three miles in the twenty-two and a quarter hours since leaving the depot. Observations for position next day proved that in its dying effort it exaggerated the truth; the total run being 41.6 miles.

At 11:30 PM, we had marched twenty-one miles, and both the light and the surface were getting better, so I suggested that we push on for a longer stretch. Hurley and Webb eagerly agreed, and we had a quick prep meeting. Ten miles flew by monotonously without a hint of the mounds near the one-hundred-and-seventy-mile camp. As we approached the point where we planned to divert from our outbound route, we set a direct course for the one-hundred-and-thirteen-mile mark. The sledge-meter, which had been attached, occasionally made its presence known with a sound like a cash register as yet another broken spoke hit the forks. We would stop for a moment to remove the remains. Out of the original thirty-six wire spokes, only twelve wire ones and one wooden one were left. At 11:30 AM on December 29, we called a halt, and the sledge-meter was lying on its side with a look of defeat. It read twenty-two miles, which we thought meant a total of forty-three miles in the twenty-two and a quarter hours since we left the depot. However, position observations the next day showed that in its final act, it had overstated the distance; the actual total was 41.6 miles.

We were now well ahead of schedule time, there being four and a half days' surplus food; above what was probably required to reach the sixty-seven-and-a-half-mile depot. It was decided to hold three days of this and to use one and a half days food as a bonus during the coming week, as long as we were ahead of our necessary distance. The sledging ration is quite enough to live on, but for the whole of the journey we had felt that we could have done more distance on a slightly larger ration. This may be partly explained by our comparatively high altitude.

We were now well ahead of schedule, with four and a half days' worth of extra food beyond what was probably needed to reach the sixty-seven-and-a-half-mile depot. We decided to save three days' worth and use one and a half days' worth as a bonus during the upcoming week, as long as we were ahead of our required distance. The sledging rations are sufficient to live on, but throughout the journey, we felt that we could have covered more distance with a slightly larger ration. This might be partly due to our relatively high altitude.

Next morning the sledge-meter was cut away and stuck in the snow. It looked very forlorn sitting askew in its forks, with a pair of worn-out finnesko hanging over it.

Next morning, the sledge-meter was cut loose and left in the snow. It looked really sad, leaning awkwardly in its supports, with a pair of old, worn-out snowshoes draped over it.

After twelve miles with a favourable wind, Webb took more observations; Hurley and I recording by turns. There were several small holes in the tent which needed mending, and I experimented with adhesive plaster from the medical kit with great success. Heated over a fusee and pressed hard down between the bottoms of mugs, held outside and inside, the patches adhered well and made a permanent job.

After twelve miles with a good wind, Webb took more observations; Hurley and I took turns recording. There were a few small holes in the tent that needed fixing, and I tried using adhesive plaster from the medical kit with great success. Heated over a fusee and pressed firmly between the bottoms of mugs, held outside and inside, the patches stuck well and created a permanent repair.

Early on December 31, 1912, snow was falling. The light gave Hurley an attack of snow-blindness and a miserable day. Crampons were worn to give some security to the foothold on the uneven track. The position, after a trudge of fifteen miles, was estimated at five miles east of the one-hundred-and-twenty-three-mile mound.

Early on December 31, 1912, snow was falling. The bright light caused Hurley to suffer from snow blindness, making it a miserable day. They wore crampons to get better traction on the uneven path. After slogging through fifteen miles, their location was estimated to be five miles east of the one-hundred-and-twenty-three-mile mound.

On New Year's Day, 1913, the wind was fresher and the surface improved. Estimation placed us to the north of one hundred and thirteen miles, but we were not hopeful in the light falling snow of seeing a mound. Soon, however, the snow ceased, and Webb made out a hillock two miles ahead. It was identified as the one at one hundred and nine miles.

On New Year's Day, 1913, the wind was stronger and the surface was better. We estimated we were north of one hundred and thirteen miles, but with the light snowfall, we didn't expect to see a mound. Soon, though, the snow stopped, and Webb spotted a hillock two miles ahead. It was recognized as the one at one hundred and nine miles.

It had been my turn to be snowblind. I was so bad that the only thing to do was to camp or ride on the sledge. The trail changed here to straight downwind, so Webb and Hurley undertook the job, hauling the sledge with me as a passenger for three and a half miles to the one-hundred-and-five-mile mound. It must have been a trying finish to a run of twenty miles.

It was my turn to be snowblind. I was in such bad shape that the only choice was to either camp or ride on the sled. The trail shifted to straight downwind, so Webb and Hurley took on the task, pulling the sled with me as a passenger for three and a half miles to the one-hundred-and-five-mile mound. It must have been a tough end to a twenty-mile run.

In spite of the spell, which was a sleepless one, I was no better in the morning and again had to ride. The others pulled away for five miles with a good helping wind, but in a provoking light. The camp was made where the one-hundred-mile mound was judged to be. We spent longer over lunch, hoping that the clouds would clear. At last we moved on, or rather I was moved on. After two miles the surface became heavier. My eyes were better now on account of the rest and a snow "poultice" Webb had invented. I harnessed-in for five miles over light, unpacked snow, with piecrust underneath. The day's work was twelve miles.

Despite the sleepless night, I was still no better in the morning and had to ride again. The others took off for five miles with a strong tailwind, but in frustratingly light conditions. We set up camp where we thought the one-hundred-mile marker was. We lingered over lunch, hoping the clouds would clear. Finally, we moved on, or rather, I was prompted to move on. After two miles, the ground became tougher. My eyes felt better thanks to the rest and a snow "poultice" that Webb had come up with. I powered through five miles over light, unpacked snow with a crust underneath. I logged twelve miles for the day.

The snow-clouds broke at noon on January 3, and a reliable latitude was obtained. It agreed with our reckoning. Persevering over the same trying surface as on the previous day, we sighted the ninety-mile-mound in the rear as a rift broke in the sky. We must have passed a few hundred yards from it.

The snow clouds cleared at noon on January 3, and we got an accurate latitude. It matched what we had estimated. Pushing through the same challenging terrain as the day before, we caught sight of the ninety-mile mound behind us as a gap opened in the sky. We must have passed just a few hundred yards from it.

We were still eleven miles from the depot, so at breakfast on the 4th the rations were reduced by one-half to give plenty of time to locate our goal. On the 4th the sky was clear, but surface drift prevented us from seeing any mounds till, in the afternoon, the ramps near the sixty-seven-mile depot were discovered in fitful glimpses. They bore too much to the north, so we altered course correspondingly to the west, camping in rising wind and drift, with great hopes for the morrow.

We were still eleven miles from the depot, so at breakfast on the 4th, the rations were cut in half to allow us plenty of time to find our destination. On the 4th, the sky was clear, but surface drift made it hard to see any mounds until, in the afternoon, we caught brief glimpses of the ramps near the sixty-seven-mile depot. They were positioned too far north, so we changed our course slightly to the west, setting up camp in increasing wind and drift, with high hopes for the next day.

A densely overcast sky on the 5th; light snow falling! We moved on two miles, but not being able to see one hundred yards, camped again; then walking as far as seemed safe in various directions. One could do nothing but wait for clear weather. The clouds lightened at 6 P.M. and again at 9 P.M., when altitudes of the sun were secured, putting us four miles south of the depot.

A thick, cloudy sky on the 5th; light snow was falling! We traveled two miles, but with visibility under a hundred yards, we set up camp again. Then we walked as far as felt safe in different directions. We had no choice but to wait for clearer weather. The clouds cleared a bit at 6 P.M. and again at 9 P.M., allowing us to get the sun's altitudes, confirming we were four miles south of the depot.

With only one chronometer watch, one has to rely entirely on dead reckoning for longitude, the rate of a single watch being very variable. The longitude obtained on this occasion from our latest known rate moved us several miles to the east of the depot, so I concluded that our distances since the camp at ninety miles had been overestimated, and that we were probably to the south-east of it. Accordingly, we shifted four miles to the north-west, but by this time it had again clouded over and nothing could be seen.

With just one chronometer watch, you have to depend entirely on dead reckoning for longitude, since the accuracy of a single watch can vary a lot. The longitude we figured out this time based on our latest known rate placed us several miles east of the depot, so I decided that our distance since the camp at ninety miles had probably been overestimated, and we were likely southeast of it. So, we moved four miles northwest, but by then it had clouded over again and we couldn't see anything.

On the 6th the sky was still overcast, but a lucky peep at noon aligned us on the exact latitude of the depot. We walked east and west, but it snowed persistently and everything was invisible.

On the 6th, the sky was still cloudy, but a lucky glimpse at noon showed us we were right on the latitude of the depot. We walked east and west, but it kept snowing, and everything was obscured.

It is weary work waiting in the tent for weather to improve. During this time Hurley amused himself and us by composing a Christmas carol on the Christmas dinner; a fragment from which has already appeared. I whiled away a whole afternoon, cutting up the remains of two cigars which had refused to draw. Sliced up with a pair of scissors and mixed with a few of Hurley's cigarettes, they made very good smoking tobacco.

It’s tiring to wait in the tent for the weather to get better. In the meantime, Hurley entertained himself and us by writing a Christmas carol about our Christmas dinner; a part of it has already been shared. I spent an entire afternoon cutting up the remains of two cigars that wouldn’t smoke properly. Chopped up with scissors and mixed with a few of Hurley’s cigarettes, they made some decent smoking tobacco.

On the 7th the sky was immovable, and we trekked four miles due east, camped once more and walked about without finding our goal.

On the 7th, the sky was still, and we hiked four miles straight east, set up camp again, and wandered around without finding what we were looking for.

I now decided that if the weather did not improve by the morning, we should have to dash for the north. It was a risk, but matters were coming to a serious pass. On broaching the subject to Webb and Hurley, they unconditionally agreed with me.

I decided that if the weather didn't get better by morning, we would have to hurry north. It was a gamble, but things were getting critical. When I brought it up to Webb and Hurley, they completely agreed with me.

At 3 A.M. the sky cleared rapidly and we turned out and saw the ramps plainly to the east. Webb set up the theodolite while Hurley and I paced out a half-mile base-line to find out the intervening distance. Just as we got to the end of it, however, the clouds came over again and the ramps faded.

At 3 A.M., the sky cleared quickly, and we stepped outside to see the ramps clearly to the east. Webb set up the theodolite while Hurley and I measured out a half-mile baseline to determine the distance in between. Just as we reached the end of it, though, the clouds rolled back in, and the ramps disappeared.

There was only one thing for it now, and that was to make a break for the coast. Of food, there was one full day's ration with enough pemmican for half a hoosh, six lumps of sugar and nine raisins, rather the worse for wear, oil for two days, and, last but not least, a pint of alcohol. After four days on half-rations we felt fairly fit, thanks no doubt to the good meals of the previous week.

There was only one thing to do now, and that was to head for the coast. As for food, we had a full day's worth of rations, enough pemmican for half a hoosh, six pieces of sugar, and nine somewhat damaged raisins, oil for two days, and, last but not least, a pint of alcohol. After four days on half-rations, we felt pretty good, thanks to the decent meals we had the week before.

There were sixty-seven miles to go, and in case we did not happen on the narrow descent to the Hut, the food was apportioned to last for five days. Everything unessential was stripped off the sledge, including dip-circle, thermometers, hypsometer, camera, spare clothing and most of the medical and repair kits.

There were sixty-seven miles left to travel, and in case we didn’t find the narrow path down to the Hut, the food was divided to last for five days. Everything non-essential was taken off the sled, including the dip-circle, thermometers, hypsometer, camera, extra clothing, and most of the medical and repair supplies.

At 7 A.M. we set off on the final stage of the journey. The sky was densely overcast and snow was falling, but there was a strong wind almost behind. We would march for an hour by my wrist-watch, halt for five minutes and on again till all agreed that we had covered ten miles; when it was lunch time. Each man's share of this consisted of one-third of a biscuit, one-third of an ounce of butter and a drink made of a spoonful of glaxo-and-sugar and one of absolute alcohol, mixed in a mug of lukewarm water. We could not afford oil enough to do much more than thaw the water, but the alcohol warmed us splendidly, enabling us to get a good rest.

At 7 A.M., we set off on the last leg of the journey. The sky was heavily overcast, and snow was falling, but a strong wind was mostly at our backs. We would walk for an hour by my watch, take a five-minute break, and then keep going until everyone agreed we had covered ten miles, which would be lunchtime. Each person’s meal consisted of one-third of a biscuit, one-third of an ounce of butter, and a drink made from a spoonful of Glaxo and sugar mixed with a spoonful of pure alcohol in a mug of lukewarm water. We couldn’t spare enough oil to do much more than warm the water, but the alcohol heated us up nicely, allowing us to get a decent rest.

After an hour's spell we started again, luckily seeing just enough of the sun to check the course. The wind grew stronger in the afternoon and several times dense fog-banks drove down on us. Meeting one steep rise, we sidled round it for what seemed hours, but my chief memory of that afternoon was of the clouds of the northern horizon. They were a deep bluish-grey colour—a typical "water-sky"—but I have never seen clouds moving so fast. It was like trying to steer by one particular phase in a kaleidoscope. When all were satisfied that twenty miles had been covered we camped.

After an hour, we set off again, lucky to catch just enough sunlight to check our direction. The wind picked up in the afternoon, and several times thick fog rolled in on us. When we faced a steep incline, we circled around it for what felt like hours, but my strongest memory from that afternoon was of the clouds on the northern horizon. They were a deep bluish-grey—a classic "water-sky"—but I had never seen clouds moving so quickly. It was like trying to navigate by a single image in a kaleidoscope. Once everyone agreed that we had covered twenty miles, we set up camp.

Dinner consisted of a very watery hoosh, followed up by a mug of alcohol and water. We were all very thankful for the forethought of Dr. Mawson in providing absolute alcohol for lighting the primus, instead of methylated spirit.

Dinner was a really watery stew, followed by a mug of alcohol and water. We were all very grateful for Dr. Mawson's thoughtfulness in providing pure alcohol for lighting the primus instead of methylated spirits.

Breakfast on the 9th was of about the same consistency as dinner on the night before, except that cocoa replaced the alcohol. In fact, breakfast was possibly even more watery, as I was in charge of the food-bag and surreptitiously decided to make the rations last six days instead of five.

Breakfast on the 9th was pretty much the same as dinner the night before, except cocoa took the place of the alcohol. In fact, breakfast might have been even more soupy since I was in charge of the food bag and secretly decided to stretch the rations to last six days instead of five.

This was the worst day's march of the journey. The wind was booming along at sixty miles per hour with dense drift and falling snow. What made it worse was that it came from the south-east, forcing us to pull partly across it. I was the upwind wheeler and had to hitch on to the side of the sledge to reduce the leeway as much as possible. The sledge was being continually jammed into big, old, invisible sastrugi and we fell about in the wind until crampons became absolutely necessary.

This was the toughest day of our journey. The wind was howling at sixty miles per hour, with heavy drifts and falling snow. To make matters worse, it was coming from the southeast, forcing us to tackle it at an angle. I was positioned as the upwind wheel and had to attach myself to the side of the sled to minimize the drift as much as I could. The sled kept getting stuck on large, hidden sastrugi, and we were tossed around in the wind until we absolutely needed crampons.

At 4 P.M. we were disgusted to find that the wind had veered to south-by-east. So for possibly several hours we had been doing Heaven only knows how many times the amount of work necessary, and for any time up to four hours might have been marching three points off our course. Being blown straight downwind, the sledge made rapid progress, and about 6 P.M. a halt was called for lunch. This was over almost as soon as it was begun, but we had a good rest, sheltering ourselves with the floor-cloth from the wind which blew through the tent.

At 4 P.M., we were frustrated to discover that the wind had shifted to south-by-east. So for possibly several hours, we had been working way harder than necessary, and for up to four hours, we might have been off course by three points. Being blown straight downwind, the sled moved quickly, and around 6 P.M., we paused for lunch. This was over almost as soon as it started, but we got a nice rest, using the floor cloth to shield ourselves from the wind that was coming through the tent.

Off again, we "plugged" away until midnight when we were much surprised to find the usual snow surface merging into blue ice. The tent was pitched on the latter, snow being procured from the bridge of a crevasse as we had no pick: even the ice-axe having been left behind.

Off again, we "plugged" away until midnight when we were surprised to find the usual snow surface turning into blue ice. The tent was set up on the ice, and we got snow from the edge of a crevasse since we didn’t have a pick; we had even left the ice axe behind.

Turning out on the morning of the 10th, we were delighted to find the sky clearing and the wind moderating. And then, far away on the northern horizon a beautiful line of blue sea dotted with bergs!

Turning out on the morning of the 10th, we were thrilled to see the sky clearing and the wind calming down. And then, way off on the northern horizon, a stunning stretch of blue sea sprinkled with icebergs!

We now officially considered ourselves to be twenty-seven miles from the Hut. As we should not have met blue ice on the proper course till we were only thirteen miles out, it was thought that we had edged a long way to the east the day before. When a start was made, we manoeuvred to the west in looking for a crossing-place at each crevasse.

We now officially considered ourselves to be twenty-seven miles from the Hut. Since we wouldn’t have seen blue ice on the right course until we were only thirteen miles away, we figured we had drifted quite a bit to the east the day before. When we got started, we moved west, searching for a crossing at each crevasse.

It was not long before the bergs on the horizon were noticeably enlarging, and at last we realized that in reality it was only a few miles to them. Suddenly the grade increased, the ice becoming much lacerated; and we had some trouble getting the sledge along. Hurley was snow-blind and had one eye covered. He looked very comical feeling his way over the crevasses, but he probably did not feel over-humorous.

It wasn't long before the icebergs on the horizon started getting noticeably bigger, and we finally realized that they were only a few miles away. Suddenly, the slope steepened, and the ice became really torn up; we had some difficulty moving the sleigh along. Hurley was snow-blind with one eye covered. He looked quite funny trying to find his way over the cracks in the ice, but he probably didn't feel very amused.

I was in the lead, and suddenly coming over a ridge above a steep ice-fall, I caught sight of the Mackellar Islets and the old "Piano" berg. Just at the same instant the spur of ice on which I was standing collapsed, and down I went into a crevasse. The others quickly had me out, and, as soon as I was in the upper air, I gave them the news: "There are the Islands!" Being twenty feet farther back on the rope they had not yet seen them.

I was in the lead, and suddenly, as I climbed over a ridge above a steep ice fall, I spotted the Mackellar Islets and the old "Piano" iceberg. At that exact moment, the ice ledge I was standing on collapsed, and I fell into a crevasse. The others quickly pulled me out, and as soon as I was back in the open air, I told them, "There are the Islands!" Since they were twenty feet further back on the rope, they hadn't seen them yet.

We were now able to place ourselves about three miles west of Aladdin's Cave. The last camp must have been thirteen miles from the Hut, and we had really done twenty-seven miles each day instead of our conservative twenty.

We were now positioned about three miles west of Aladdin's Cave. The last campsite must have been thirteen miles from the Hut, and we had actually covered twenty-seven miles each day instead of our more cautious estimate of twenty.

We tried to work along to the east, but the ice was too much broken, so the camp was made on a patch of snow. In view of our good fortune, I produced that evening's ration of hoosh in addition to our usual lunch. Even this meagre spree went against Hurley's feelings, for, being snow-blind, he had not been able to see the islands and positively would not believe that we were nearly home.

We attempted to head east, but the ice was too broken up, so we set up camp on a patch of snow. Considering our good luck, I made the evening's ration of hoosh in addition to our usual lunch. Even this small indulgence upset Hurley, as he was snow-blind and couldn't see the islands, and he absolutely refused to believe that we were almost home.

After lunch it was necessary to retrace our way upwind to get out of the rough country. About midnight, Webb recognized Aladdin's Cave. Hurley and I had a competition as to who should see it first, for I was also getting a little blind again. We had a dead-heat at one hundred and fifty yards.

After lunch, we had to make our way back against the wind to escape the tough terrain. Around midnight, Webb spotted Aladdin's Cave. Hurley and I raced to see it first since I was starting to lose my sight again. We ended up tying at one hundred and fifty yards.

The first thing to arrest our attention was a tin of dog biscuits. These kept things going till we dug out a food tank from which was rapidly extracted a week's supply of chocolate. After that we proceeded in a happier frame of mind to open up the cave and have a meal.

The first thing that caught our attention was a tin of dog biscuits. These kept us going until we found a food tank, from which we quickly pulled out a week's supply of chocolate. After that, we moved on in a better mood to open up the cave and have a meal.

The journey of more than six hundred miles was now practically over. After a carousal lasting till 5 P.M. on the 11th, we went down hill, arriving just after dinner and finding all well.

The journey of over six hundred miles was almost complete. After a celebration that lasted until 5 PM on the 11th, we headed downhill, arriving just after dinner and finding everything well.

We three had never thought the Hut quite such a fine place, nor have we ever since.

We three had never considered the Hut such a great place, and we still don't.





CHAPTER XV EASTWARD OVER THE SEA-ICE

by C. T. MADIGAN

    Harnessed and girt in his canvas bands,
    Toggled and roped to his load;
    With helmeted head and bemittened hands,
    This for his spur and his goad:

  "Out in the derelict fastnesses bare
    Some whit of truth may be won."
    Be it a will o' the wisp, he will fare
    Forth to the rising sun.

                             The Sledge Horse
    Harnessed and strapped in his canvas gear,  
    Tied down and secured to his load;  
    With a helmeted head and gloved hands,  
    This is his spur and his goad:  

  "Out in the empty wilderness,  
    Some hint of truth might be found."  
    Whether it's just a will-o'-the-wisp, he will go  
    Out toward the rising sun.  

                             The Sledge Horse

The Eastern Coastal party consisted of Dr. A. L. McLean, P. E. Correll and myself. For weeks all preparations had been made; the decking put on the sledge, runners polished, cooker- and instrument-boxes attached, mast erected, spar and sail rigged, instruments and clothing collected, tent strengthened—all the impedimenta of a sledge journey arranged and rearranged, and still the blizzard raged on. Would we never get away? November arrived, and still the wind kept up daily averages of over fifty miles per hour, with scarce a day without drifting snow.

The Eastern Coastal team included Dr. A. L. McLean, P. E. Correll, and me. For weeks, we had prepared everything; we put the decking on the sled, polished the runners, attached the cooker and instrument boxes, set up the mast, rigged the spar and sail, gathered our instruments and clothing, and reinforced the tent—all the gear for a sled journey was organized and reorganized, yet the blizzard continued to blow. Would we ever leave? November came, and the wind remained relentless, averaging over fifty miles per hour daily, with hardly a day free of drifting snow.

At last it was decided that a start must soon be made even though it ended in failure, so that we received orders to set out on November 6, or the first possible day after it.

At last, it was decided that we needed to make a start soon, even if it ended in failure, so we were ordered to set out on November 6, or the first possible day after that.

Friday November 8 broke, a clear driftless day, and Murphy's party left early in the morning. By noon, Stillwell's party (Stillwell, Hodgeman and Close), and we, were ready to start. The former were bound on a short journey to the near east and were to support us until we parted company.

Friday, November 8, started as a clear day with no wind, and Murphy's party left early in the morning. By noon, Stillwell's party (Stillwell, Hodgeman, and Close), along with us, was ready to set out. The former were headed on a short trip to the east and were going to help us until we split up.

All was bustle and excitement. Every one turned out to see us off. Breaking an empty sauce-bottle over the bow of our sledge, we christened it the M.H.S. Championship (Man-Hauled Sledge). The name was no boastful prevision of mighty deeds, as, at the Hut, a "Championship" was understood to mean some careless action usually occasioning damage to property, while our party included several noted "champions."

All was busy and exciting. Everyone came out to see us off. We smashed an empty sauce bottle on the front of our sled and named it the M.H.S. Championship (Man-Hauled Sledge). The name wasn’t a boastful prediction of great feats, since at the Hut, a "Championship" meant some reckless act that usually caused damage to property, and our group included several well-known "champions."

Mertz harnessed a dog-team to the sledge and helped us up the first steep slope. With hearty handshakes and a generous cheer from the other fellows, we started off and were at last away, after many months of hibernation in the Hut, to chance the hurricanes and drifting snow and to push towards the unknown regions to the east.

Mertz hooked up a dog team to the sled and assisted us up the first steep hill. With warm handshakes and a big cheer from the other guys, we set off and were finally on our way, after months of being cooped up in the Hut, to face the hurricanes and drifting snow and to head towards the unknown areas to the east.

At the steepest part of the rise we dismissed our helpers and said good-bye. McLean and Correll joined me on the sledge and we continued on to Aladdin's Cave.

At the steepest part of the climb, we let our helpers go and said goodbye. McLean and Correll hopped on the sled with me, and we moved on to Aladdin's Cave.

As we mounted the glacier the wind increased, carrying surface drift which obscured the view to within one hundred yards. It was this which made us pass the Cave on the eastern side and pull up on a well-known patch of snow in a depression to the south of our goal. It was not long before a momentary clearing of the drift showed Aladdin's Cave with its piles of food-tanks, kerosene, dog biscuit and pemmican, and, to our dismay, a burberry-clad figure moving about among the accumulation. Murphy's party were in possession when we expected them to be on the way south to another cave—the Cathedral Grotto—eleven and three-quarter miles from the Hut. Of course the rising wind and drift had stopped them.

As we climbed the glacier, the wind picked up, blowing in surface drift that limited our visibility to just a hundred yards. This led us to skip the Cave on the eastern side and stop at a familiar patch of snow in a depression south of our destination. It wasn't long before a brief clearing in the drift revealed Aladdin's Cave, with its stacks of food supplies, kerosene, dog biscuits, and pemmican. To our surprise, we saw a figure dressed in a Burberry coat moving around the piles. Murphy's team was there when we expected them to be heading south to another cave—the Cathedral Grotto—about eleven and three-quarter miles from the Hut. Naturally, the increasing wind and drift had delayed them.

It was then 5 P.M., so we did not wait to discuss the evident proposition as to which of the three parties should occupy the Cave, but climbed down into it at once and boiled up hoosh and tea. Borrowing tobacco from the supporting parties, we reclined at ease, and then in that hazy atmosphere so dear to smokers, its limpid blue enhanced by the pale azure of the ice, we introduced the subject of occupation as if it were a sudden afterthought.

It was then 5 PM, so we didn't waste time debating which of the three groups should take the Cave. Instead, we climbed down into it right away and cooked some hoosh and tea. After borrowing tobacco from the other groups, we relaxed comfortably, and in that smoky haze that smokers love, its clear blue deepened by the pale blue of the ice, we casually brought up the topic of who would occupy the space, as if it had just come to mind.

It was soon decided to enlarge the Cave to accommodate five men, the other four consenting to squeeze into Stillwell's big tent. McLean volunteered to join Stillwell's party in the tent, while Correll and I were to stay in the Cave with Murphy and company.

It was quickly decided to expand the Cave to fit five men, while the other four agreed to crowd into Stillwell's large tent. McLean offered to join Stillwell's group in the tent, while Correll and I would stay in the Cave with Murphy and the others.

I went outside and selected ten weeks' provisions from the pile of food-tanks and piled them beside the sledge. McLean attended to the thermograph which Bage and I had installed in the autumn. Meanwhile, in a fifty-mile wind, Stillwell and his men erected the tent. Hunter and Laseron started with picks and shovels to enlarge the Cave, and, working in relays, we had soon expanded it to eight feet by seven feet.

I went outside and grabbed ten weeks' worth of supplies from the pile of food containers and stacked them next to the sled. McLean took care of the thermograph that Bage and I had set up in the fall. Meanwhile, in a fifty-mile-per-hour wind, Stillwell and his crew set up the tent. Hunter and Laseron began using picks and shovels to enlarge the Cave, and by working in shifts, we quickly expanded it to eight feet by seven feet.

The men from the tent came down to "high dinner" at eight o'clock. They reported weather conditions unimproved and the temperature -3 degrees F.

The guys from the tent came down for "high dinner" at eight o'clock. They said the weather hadn't improved and the temperature was -3 degrees F.

Early next morning I dug my way out and found that the surface drift had increased with a wind of fifty-five miles per hour. It was obviously impossible to start.

Early the next morning, I dug my way out and discovered that the snow on the surface had deepened with a wind blowing at fifty-five miles per hour. It was clear that starting out was impossible.

After breakfast it was arranged that those outside should have their meals separately, digging down at intervals to let us know the state of the weather. It was not pleasant for us, congested as we were in the Cave, to have visitors sliding down through the opening with a small avalanche of snow in their train. Further, to increase their own discomfort, they arrived covered in snow, and what they were unable to shake off thawed and wet them, subsequently freezing again to the consistency of a starched collar.

After breakfast, it was decided that those outside would have their meals separately, checking in periodically to update us on the weather. It was uncomfortable for us, packed as we were in the Cave, to have visitors sliding down through the opening with a little avalanche of snow following them. To make things worse for them, they showed up covered in snow, and whatever they couldn’t shake off melted and soaked them, later freezing again to feel as stiff as a starched collar.

The opening was, therefore, kept partly closed with a food-tank. The result was that a good deal of snow came in, while the hole diminished in size. For a man to try to crawl out in stiff burberrys appeared as futile as for a porcupine to try to go backwards up a canvas hose.

The opening was, therefore, partially closed with a food tank. As a result, a lot of snow blew in, while the hole got smaller. For a man to attempt to crawl out in stiff outerwear seemed as pointless as a porcupine trying to back up through a canvas hose.

The day passed slowly in our impatience. We took turns at reading 'The Virginian', warmed by a primus stove which in a land of plenty we could afford to keep going. Later in the afternoon the smokers found that a match would not strike, and the primus went out. Then the man reading said that he felt unwell and could not see the words. Soon several others commented on feeling "queer," and two in the sleeping-bags had fallen into a drowsy slumber. On this evidence even the famous Watson would have "dropped to it," but it was some time before it dawned on us that the oxygen had given out. Then there was a rush for shovels. The snow, ice and food-tank were tightly wedged, at the mouth of the entrance, and it took some exertion to perforate through to the outside air with an ice-axe. At once every one speedily recovered. Later, another party had a worse experience, not forgetting to leave a warning note behind them. We should have done the same.

The day dragged on as we grew impatient. We took turns reading 'The Virginian,' warmed by a Primus stove that we could afford to keep running in this land of plenty. Later in the afternoon, the smokers discovered that their matches wouldn’t strike, and the Primus went out. Then the guy reading said he felt unwell and couldn’t see the words. Soon, several others mentioned feeling "off," and two people in the sleeping bags had dropped into a drowsy sleep. Based on that, even the famous Watson would have "dropped to it," but it took us a while to realize that the oxygen had run out. Then there was a mad scramble for shovels. The snow, ice, and food tank were tightly wedged at the entrance, and it took some effort to break through to the outside air with an ice axe. Immediately, everyone started to feel better. Later on, another group had an even worse experience, making sure to leave a warning note behind. We should have done the same.

The weather was no better by the evening, and during the night the minimum thermometer registered -12 degrees F.

The weather was still bad by the evening, and overnight the lowest temperature recorded was -12 degrees F.

At six o'clock on Sunday morning, November 10, McLean dug down to us with the news that the wind had abated to thirty miles per hour with light surface drift.

At six o'clock on Sunday morning, November 10, McLean reached us with the news that the wind had slowed to thirty miles per hour with a light surface drift.

We hurried through breakfast, rolled up the bags and started packing the sledge. Three 100-lb. food-tanks, one 50-lb. bag opened for ready use, and four gallons of kerosene were selected. Stillwell took for us a 50-lb. food-tank, a 56-lb. tin of wholemeal biscuits, and a gallon of kerosene. With the 850 lbs. of food, 45 lbs. of kerosene, three sleeping-bags of 10 lbs. each, a tent of 40 lbs., 86 lbs. of clothing and personal gear for three men, a cooker, primus, pick, shovel, ice-axe, alpine rope, dip-circle, theodolite, tripod, smaller instruments such as aneroid, barometer and thermometer, tools, medical outfit and sledge-fittings, our total load amounted to nearly 800 lbs., and Stillwell's was about the same.

We rushed through breakfast, packed up the bags, and started loading the sled. We chose three 100-lb. food containers, one 50-lb. bag for easy access, and four gallons of kerosene. Stillwell took a 50-lb. food container, a 56-lb. tin of wholemeal biscuits, and a gallon of kerosene for us. With 850 lbs. of food, 45 lbs. of kerosene, three sleeping bags at 10 lbs. each, a 40-lb. tent, 86 lbs. of clothing and personal gear for three men, a stove, primus, pick, shovel, ice axe, alpine rope, dip circle, theodolite, tripod, and smaller instruments like aneroid, barometer, and thermometer, along with tools, medical supplies, and sled fittings, our total load came to nearly 800 lbs., and Stillwell's was about the same.

All were ready at 9 A.M., and, shaking hands with Murphy's party, who set off due south, we steered with Stillwell to the south-east. The preliminary instructions were to proceed south-east from the Cave to a distance of eighteen miles and there await the arrival of Dr. Mawson and his party, who were to overtake us with their dogteams.

All were ready by 9 A.M., and after shaking hands with Murphy's group, who headed south, we set off with Stillwell toward the southeast. The initial instructions were to head southeast from the Cave for eighteen miles and wait for Dr. Mawson and his team, who were supposed to catch up with us using their dog teams.

The first few miles gave a gradual rise of one hundred feet per mile, so that, with a heavy load against wind and drift, travelling was very slow. The wind now dropped to almost calm, and the drift cleared. In the afternoon progress was hampered by crevasses, which were very frequent, running east and west and from one to twenty feet in width. The wider ones were covered with firm snow-bridges; the snow in places having formed into granular and even solid ice. What caused most delay were the detours of several hundreds of yards which had to be made to find a safe crossing over a long, wide crevasse. At 6.30 P.M. we pitched camp, having only made five miles from the Cave.

The first few miles had a gradual climb of a hundred feet per mile, so traveling was really slow with a heavy load against the wind and snowdrift. The wind then calmed down almost completely, and the snow drift cleared up. In the afternoon, our progress was slowed by crevasses, which were very common, running east to west and ranging from one to twenty feet wide. The larger ones were covered with solid snow bridges; in some places, the snow had turned into granular and even solid ice. The main delays came from having to take detours of several hundred yards to find a safe way across a long, wide crevasse. At 6:30 PM, we set up camp, having only covered five miles from the Cave.

We got away at 9 A.M. the next morning. Throughout the whole journey we thought over the same mysterious problem as confronted many another sledger: Where did the time go to in the mornings? Despite all our efforts we could not cut down the interval from "rise and shine" to the start below two hours.

We left at 9 A.M. the next morning. During the whole trip, we pondered the same mysterious question that many other sledders had faced: Where did the time disappear to in the mornings? No matter how hard we tried, we couldn't reduce the gap from "rise and shine" to the start to less than two hours.

Early that day we had our first experience of the treacherous crevasse. Correll went down a fissure about three feet wide. I had jumped across it, thinking the bridge looked thin, but Correll stepped on it and went through. He dropped vertically down the full length of his harness—six feet. McLean and I soon had him out. The icy walls fell sheer for about sixty feet, where snow could be seen in the blue depths. Our respect for crevasses rapidly increased after this, and we took greater precautions, shuddering to think of the light-hearted way we had trudged over the wider ones.

Early that day, we had our first encounter with the dangerous crevasse. Correll went down a crack about three feet wide. I had jumped across it, thinking the bridge looked flimsy, but Correll stepped on it and fell through. He dropped straight down the full length of his harness—six feet. McLean and I quickly pulled him out. The icy walls dropped straight down for about sixty feet, where we could see snow in the blue depths. Our respect for crevasses grew rapidly after this, and we became more cautious, shuddering at the thought of how carelessly we had crossed the wider ones.

At twelve miles, blue, wind-swept ice gave place to an almost flat snow surface. Meanwhile the sky had rapidly clouded over, and the outlook was threatening. The light became worse, and the sastrugi indistinguishable. Such a phenomenon always occurs on what we came to call a "snow-blind day." On these days the sky is covered with a white, even pall of cloud, and cloud and plateau seem as one. One walks into a deep trench or a sastruga two feet high without noticing it. The world seems one huge, white void, and the only difference between it and the pitch-dark night is that the one is white and the other black.

At twelve miles, blue, wind-swept ice gave way to a nearly flat snow surface. Meanwhile, the sky quickly clouded over, and the outlook looked grim. The light got worse, and the sastrugi became indistinguishable. This phenomenon always happens on what we came to call a "snow-blind day." On these days, the sky is covered with a uniform, white layer of clouds, and the cloud and snow plateau blend together. You can walk into a deep trench or a sastruga that's two feet high without realizing it. The world feels like one giant, white void, and the only difference between it and pitch-dark night is that one is white and the other is black.

Light snow commenced at 2.30 P.M., the wind rising to forty-five miles per hour with heavy drift. Thirteen miles out we pitched camp.

Light snow started at 2:30 PM, with the wind picking up to forty-five miles per hour and strong drifts. We set up camp thirteen miles out.

This, the first "snow-blind day" claimed McLean for its victim. By the time we were under cover of the tent, his eyes were very sore, aching with a throbbing pain. At his request I placed a zinc-cocaine tablet in each eye. He spent the rest of the day in the darkness of his sleeping-bag and had his eyes bandaged all next day. Up till then we had not worn goggles, but were careful afterwards to use them on the trying, overcast days.

This, the first "snow-blind day," left McLean as its victim. By the time we got under the tent, his eyes were really sore, aching with a pounding pain. At his request, I put a zinc-cocaine tablet in each eye. He spent the rest of the day in the darkness of his sleeping bag and had his eyes bandaged all the next day. Until then, we hadn’t worn goggles, but we made sure to use them on the tough, overcast days afterwards.

For four and a half days the weather was too bad to travel. On the 14th the wind increased and became steady at sixty miles per hour, accompanied by dense drifting snow. We found it very monotonous lying in the tent. As always happens during heavy drifts, the temperature outside was high, on this day averaging about 12 degrees F.; inside the tent it was above freezing-point, and the accompanying thaw was most unpleasant.

For four and a half days, the weather was too bad to travel. On the 14th, the wind picked up and steadied at sixty miles per hour, along with heavy drifting snow. We found it really boring lying in the tent. As always happens during heavy snow, the temperature outside was pretty high, averaging about 12 degrees F. that day; inside the tent, it was above freezing, and the melting snow was really uncomfortable.

Stillwell's party had pitched their tent about ten paces to the leeward side of ours, of which stratagem they continually reminded us. Going outside for food to supply our two small meals per day was an operation fraught with much discomfort to all. This is what used to happen. The man on whom the duty fell had to insinuate himself into a bundle of wet burberrys, and, as soon as he was outside, they froze stiff. When, after a while, he signified his intention of coming in, the other two would collect everything to one end of the tent and roll up the floor-cloth. Plastered with snow, he entered, and, despite every precaution, in removing burberrys and brushing himself he would scatter snow about and increase the general wetness. On these excursions we would visit Stillwell's tent and be hospitably, if somewhat gingerly, admitted; the inmates drawing back and pulling away their sleeping-bags as from one with a fell disease. As a supporting party they were good company, among other things, supplying us with tobacco ad libitum. When we parted, five days after, we missed them very much.

Stillwell's group had set up their tent about ten steps downwind from ours, a fact they never let us forget. Going outside to fetch food for our two small meals each day was a task filled with discomfort for everyone involved. Here’s how it went down: the person on duty had to wriggle into a bunch of wet rain gear, and as soon as he stepped outside, it would freeze solid. When he finally indicated that he was ready to come back in, the other two would gather everything to one side of the tent and roll up the floor cloth. Covered in snow, he would come in, and despite all precautions, while taking off the rain gear and brushing himself off, he would spread snow around and make the tent even wetter. During these outings, we would visit Stillwell's tent and were cautiously welcomed; the members would pull back and distance themselves from their sleeping bags as if we had some contagious disease. As a supporting group, they were good company and generously supplied us with as much tobacco as we wanted. When we finally left after five days, we really missed them.

During the night the wind blew harder than ever—that terrible wind, laden with snow, that blows for ever across the vast, mysterious plateau, the "wind that shrills all night in a waste land, where no one comes or hath come since the making of the world." In the early hours of the morning it reached eighty miles per hour.

During the night, the wind blew harder than ever— that fierce wind, heavy with snow, that constantly sweeps across the vast, mysterious plateau, the "wind that howls all night in a wasteland, where no one comes or has come since the world began." By early morning, it hit eighty miles per hour.

Not till 9 next morning did the sky clear and the drift diminish. Considering that it had taken us eight days to do thirteen miles, we decided to move on the 16th at any cost.

Not until 9 the next morning did the sky clear and the snow drift lessen. Considering that it had taken us eight days to cover thirteen miles, we decided to move on the 16th no matter what.

Our library consisted of 'An Anthology of Australian Verse', Thackeray's 'Vanity Fair' and 'Hints to Travellers' in two volumes. McLean spent much of the time reading the Anthology and I started 'Vanity Fair'. The latter beguiled many weary hours in that tent during the journey. I read a good deal aloud and McLean read it afterwards. Correll used to pass the days of confinement arranging rations and costs for cycling tours and designing wonderful stoves and cooking utensils, all on the sledging, "cut down weight" principle.

Our library included 'An Anthology of Australian Verse,' Thackeray's 'Vanity Fair,' and 'Hints to Travellers' in two volumes. McLean spent a lot of time reading the Anthology, while I started on 'Vanity Fair.' The latter made many tiring hours in that tent much more enjoyable during the journey. I read a good amount aloud, and McLean read it afterwards. Correll spent his days of confinement organizing rations and expenses for cycling tours and coming up with fantastic stoves and cooking utensils, all based on the "cut down weight" principle for sledging.

On the 16th we were off at 9 A.M. with a blue sky above and a "beam" wind of thirty-five miles per hour. Up a gentle slope over small sastrugi the going was heavy. We went back to help Stillwell's party occasionally, as we were moving a little faster.

On the 16th, we left at 9 A.M. with a clear blue sky and a strong wind blowing at thirty-five miles per hour. The journey uphill over small sastrugi was tough. We sometimes went back to assist Stillwell's group since we were moving a bit faster.

Just after lunch I saw a small black spot on the horizon to the south. Was it a man? How could Dr. Mawson have got there? We stopped and saw that Stillwell had noticed it too. Field-glasses showed it to be a man approaching, about one and a half miles away. We left our sledges in a body to meet him, imagining all kinds of wonderful things such as the possibility of it being a member of Wild's party—we did not know where Wild had been landed. All the theories vanished when the figure assumed the well-known form of Dr. Mawson. He had made a little more south than we, and his sledges were just out of sight, about two miles away.

Just after lunch, I spotted a small black dot on the horizon to the south. Was it a person? How could Dr. Mawson have gotten there? We paused and noticed that Stillwell had seen it too. Using binoculars, we confirmed it was a man coming toward us, about one and a half miles away. We left our sledges behind as a group to meet him, imagining all sorts of exciting possibilities, like the chance that it might be a member of Wild's party—we had no idea where Wild had been dropped off. All our theories disappeared when the figure turned out to be the familiar shape of Dr. Mawson. He had traveled a little further south than we had, and his sledges were just out of sight, about two miles away.

Soon Mertz and Ninnis came into view with a dog-team, which was harnessed on to one sledge. All hands pulled the other sledge, and we came up fifteen minutes later with Dr. Mawson's camp at eighteen and a quarter miles. In the good Australian way we sat round a large pot of tea and after several cups put up our two tents.

Soon, Mertz and Ninnis appeared with a dog team, which was hitched to one sledge. Everyone helped pull the other sledge, and we reached Dr. Mawson's camp after fifteen minutes, covering eighteen and a quarter miles. In true Australian fashion, we gathered around a big pot of tea, and after several cups, we set up our two tents.

It was a happy evening with the three tents grouped together and the dogs securely picketed on the great plateau, forming the only spot on the limitless plain. Every one was excited at the prospect of the weeks ahead; the mystery and charm of the "unknown" had taken a strange hold on us.

It was a great evening with the three tents set up together and the dogs tied up safely on the large flat area, which was the only spot on the endless plain. Everyone was thrilled about the upcoming weeks; the mystery and allure of the "unknown" had captivated us in a unique way.

Ninnis and Mertz came into our tent for a short talk before turning in. Mertz sang the old German student song:

Ninnis and Mertz came into our tent for a quick chat before going to bed. Mertz sang the old German student song:

    Studio auf einer Reis'
    Immer sich zu helfen weis
    Immer fort durch's Dick und Dunn
    Schlendert es durch's Leben hin.
    Studio auf einer Reis'  
    Always knows how to help itself  
    Always moving through thick and thin  
    It strolls through life.  

We were nearly all University graduates. We knew that this would be our last evening together till all were safely back at the Hut. No thought was farther from our minds than that it was the last evening we would ever spend with two companions, who had been our dear comrades for just a year.

We were mostly University graduates. We realized this would be our last night together until everyone was safely back at the Hut. The idea that it was the last evening we would ever spend with two friends, who had been our cherished companions for just a year, was the farthest thought from our minds.

Before turning into sleeping-bags, a messenger brought me dispatches from the general's tent—a letter on the plateau. This proved to be the instructions to the Eastern Coastal Party. Arriving back at the Hut by January 15, we were to ascertain as much as possible of the coast lying east of the Mertz Glacier, investigating its broad features and carrying out the following scientific work: magnetic, biological and geological observations, the character, especially the nature and size of the grains of ice or snow surfaces, details of sastrugi, topographical features, heights and distances, and meteorology.

Before we turned in for the night, a messenger brought me updates from the general's tent—a letter about the plateau. This turned out to be the instructions for the Eastern Coastal Party. By January 15, we were to return to the Hut and gather as much information as possible about the coast east of the Mertz Glacier, examining its major features and conducting the following scientific work: magnetic, biological and geological observations, the characteristics, especially the type and size of ice or snow grains on surfaces, details of sastrugi, topographical features, elevations and distances, and meteorology.

On Sunday, November 17, we moved on together to the east with the wind at fifteen miles an hour, the temperature being 9 degrees F. The sun shone strongly soon after the start, and with four miles to our credit a tent was run up at 1 P.M., and all lunched together on tea, biscuit, butter and chocolate. Up to this time we had had only three al fresco lunches, but, as the weather seemed to be much milder and the benefit of tea and a rest by the way were so great, we decided to use the tent in future, and did so throughout the journey.

On Sunday, November 17, we headed east together with the wind blowing at fifteen miles per hour and the temperature at 9 degrees F. The sun was shining brightly soon after we started, and after covering four miles, we set up a tent at 1 P.M. and all had lunch together with tea, biscuits, butter, and chocolate. Up to that point, we had only had three outdoor lunches, but since the weather seemed to be much milder and the advantages of having tea and a break along the way were so beneficial, we decided to use the tent moving forward, and we did for the rest of the journey.

In the afternoon, Dr. Mawson's party forged ahead, the dogs romping along on a downhill grade. We took the bit in our teeth as we saw them sitting on their sledges, growing smaller and smaller in front of us. We came up with them again as they had waited to exchange a few more words at a point on the track where a long extent of coast to the east came into view.

In the afternoon, Dr. Mawson's team moved forward, the dogs playfully running downhill. We decided to push ahead as we watched them sitting on their sleds, getting smaller in front of us. We caught up with them again since they had paused to swap a few more words at a spot on the track where a long stretch of coast to the east was visible.

Here we bade a final adieu to Dr. Mawson, Mertz and Ninnis. The surface was on the down grade towards the east, and with a cheer and farewell wave they started off, Mertz walking rapidly ahead, followed by Ninnis and Dr. Mawson with their sledges and teams. They were soon lost to view behind the rolling undulations.

Here we said a final goodbye to Dr. Mawson, Mertz, and Ninnis. The ground sloped down towards the east, and with cheers and farewell waves, they set off, Mertz walking quickly ahead, followed by Ninnis and Dr. Mawson with their sleds and teams. They quickly disappeared from sight behind the rolling hills.

A mile farther on we pitched camp at 8 P.M. in a slight depression just out of sight of the sea. Every one slept soundly after a good day's pulling.

A mile further on, we set up camp at 8 PM in a slight dip just out of view of the sea. Everyone slept soundly after a good day's effort.

November 18 was a bright dazzling day, the sky dotted with fleecy alto-cumulus. At 6 A.M. we were out to find Stillwell's party moving in their tent. There was a rush for shovels to fill the cookers with snow and a race to boil hoosh.

November 18 was a bright, sunny day, with the sky filled with fluffy alto-cumulus clouds. At 6 A.M., we went out to see Stillwell's group packing up their tent. Everyone rushed to grab shovels to fill the cookers with snow and raced to boil up some hoosh.

At this camp we tallied up the provisions, with the intention of taking what we might require from Stillwell and proceeding independently of him, as he was likely to leave us any day. There were fifty-nine days to go until January 15, 1913, the latest date of arrival back at the Hut, for which eight weeks' rations were considered to be sufficient. There were seven weeks' food on the sledge, so Stillwell handed over another fifty-pound bag as well as an odd five pounds of wholemeal biscuit. The total amount of kerosene was five gallons, with a bottle of methylated spirit.

At this camp, we took stock of our supplies, planning to grab what we’d need from Stillwell and move on without him since he might leave us any day now. There were fifty-nine days left until January 15, 1913, the latest date we needed to be back at the Hut, and eight weeks' worth of food was considered enough. We had seven weeks' worth of food on the sled, so Stillwell gave us an extra fifty-pound bag and five pounds of wholemeal biscuits. We had a total of five gallons of kerosene and a bottle of methylated spirits.

Shortly after eight o'clock we caught sight of Dr. Mawson's camp, and set sail to make up the interval. This we did literally as there was a light westerly breeze—the only west wind we encountered during the whole journey.

Shortly after eight o'clock, we spotted Dr. Mawson's camp and decided to sail to cover the distance. We did this literally since there was a light westerly breeze—the only west wind we experienced throughout the entire journey.

The sledge was provided with a bamboo mast, seven feet high, stepped behind the cooker-box and stayed fore and aft with wire. The yard was a bamboo of six feet, slung from the top of the mast, its height being varied by altering the length of the slings. The bamboo was threaded through canvas leads in the floor-cloth which provided a spread of thirty square feet of sail. It was often such an ample area that it had to be reefed from below.

The sled had a seven-foot bamboo mast set behind the cooker box and secured with wire at the front and back. The yard was a six-foot bamboo piece hung from the top of the mast, and its height could be adjusted by changing the length of the slings. The bamboo was threaded through canvas straps on the floor cloth, creating a sail area of thirty square feet. Sometimes, this area was so large that it had to be reefed from below.

With the grade sloping gently down and the wind freshening, the pace became so hot that the sledge often overran us. A spurious "Epic of the East" (see 'Adelie Blizzard') records it:

With the slope gently going down and the wind picking up, the pace became so intense that the sledge often got ahead of us. A fake "Epic of the East" (see 'Adelie Blizzard') documents it:

        Crowd on the sail-
     Let her speed full and free "on the run"
   Over knife-edge and glaze, marble polish and pulverized chalk
   The finnesko glide in the race, and there's no time for talk.
       Up hill, down dale,
     It's all in the game and the fun.
        Crowd on the sail-
     Let her go fast and free "on the run"
   Over sharp edges and shine, smooth as marble and powdered chalk
   The fins glide in the race, and there's no time for conversation.
       Up hill, down valley,
     It's all part of the game and the fun.

We rapidly neared Dr. Mawson's camp, but when we were within a few miles of it, the other party started in a south-easterly direction and were soon lost to sight. Our course was due east.

We quickly approached Dr. Mawson's camp, but when we were just a few miles away, the other group headed off to the southeast and soon disappeared from view. We continued on a due east path.

At thirty-three and a half miles the sea was in sight, some fine flat-topped bergs floating in the nearest bay. Suddenly a dark, rocky nunatak sprang into view on our left. It was a sudden contrast after ten days of unchanging whiteness, and we felt very anxious to visit this new find. As it was in Stillwell's limited territory we left it to him.

At thirty-three and a half miles, the sea came into view, with some nice flat-topped icebergs floating in the closest bay. Suddenly, a dark, rocky nunatak appeared on our left. It was a sharp contrast after ten days of nothing but whiteness, and we were eager to explore this new discovery. Since it was within Stillwell's restricted area, we decided to leave it to him.

According to the rhymester it was:

According to the poet, it was:

        A rock by the way-
      A spot in the circle of white-
    A grey, craggy spur plunging stark through the deep-splintered ice.
    A trifle! you say, but a glow of warm land may suffice
        To brighten a day
      Prolonged to a midsummer night.
        A rock by the way-
      A spot in the circle of white-
    A grey, craggy spur poking sharply through the deeply fractured ice.
    Just a little thing! you say, but a hint of warm land might be enough
        To brighten a day
      Extended to a midsummer night.

After leaving Aladdin's Cave, our sledge-meter had worked quite satisfactorily. Just before noon, the casting attaching the recording-dial to the forks broke—the first of a series of break-downs. Correll bound it up with copper wire and splints borrowed from the medical outfit.

After leaving Aladdin's Cave, our sledge-meter had performed pretty well. Just before noon, the piece connecting the recording dial to the forks broke—the first of several malfunctions. Correll fixed it up with copper wire and splints taken from the medical kit.

The wind died away and the sail was of little use. In addition to this, we met with a slight up grade on the eastern side of the depression, our rate diminishing accordingly. At 7 P.M. the tent was pitched in dead calm, after a day's run of fifteen miles with a full load of almost eight hundred pounds—a record which remained unbroken with us till near the end of the outward journey. Looking back, the nunatak and bergs were still visible.

The wind died down, and the sail wasn't much help. On top of that, we encountered a slight incline on the east side of the dip, which slowed us down. At 7 P.M., we set up camp in complete stillness after traveling fifteen miles with a heavy load of nearly eight hundred pounds— a record we wouldn't break until close to the end of our trip out. Looking back, the nunatak and icebergs were still visible.

Both parties were under way at 8 A.M. next day (November 19) on a calm and sunny morning. The course by sun-compass was set due east.

Both sides started their journey at 8 A.M. the next day (November 19) on a calm and sunny morning. They navigated due east using a sun compass.

At noon I took a latitude "shot" with the three-inch Cary theodolite. This little instrument proved very satisfactory and was easily handled in the cold. In latitude 67 degrees 15' south, forty-six and a half miles east of the Hut, we were once more on level country with a high rise to the north-east and another shallow gully in front.

At noon, I took a latitude measurement with the three-inch Cary theodolite. This small instrument worked really well and was easy to use in the cold. At latitude 67 degrees 15' south, forty-six and a half miles east of the Hut, we were once again on flat land with a high rise to the northeast and another shallow gully in front.

A fog which had been moving along the sea-front in an opaque wall drifted over the land and enveloped us. Beautiful crystals of ice in the form of rosettes and small fern-fronds were deposited on the cordage of the sail and mast. One moment the mists would clear, and the next, we could not see more than a few hundred yards.

A fog that had been creeping along the shore in a solid wall rolled over the land and surrounded us. Gorgeous ice crystals shaped like rosettes and tiny fern fronds settled on the ropes of the sail and mast. One moment the mist would lift, and the next, we could barely see more than a few hundred yards.

We now parted with Stillwell, Hodgeman and Close, who turned off to a rising knoll—Mount Hunt—visible in the north-east, and disappeared in the fog.

We now said our goodbyes to Stillwell, Hodgeman, and Close, who headed towards a rising hill—Mount Hunt—visible in the northeast, and vanished into the fog.

After the halt at noon the sastrugi became much larger and softer. The fog cleared at 2 P.M. and the sun came out and shone very fiercely. A very inquisitive skua gull—the first sign of life we had seen thus far—flew around the tent and settled on the snow near by. In the calm, the heat was excessive and great thirst attacked us all the afternoon, which I attempted to assuage at every halt by holding snow in my hands and licking the drops of water off my knuckles—a cold and unsatisfactory expedient. We travelled without burberrys—at that time quite a novel sensation—wearing only fleece suits and light woollen undergarments. Correll pulled for the greater part of the afternoon in underclothing alone.

After the break at noon, the sastrugi got much bigger and softer. The fog lifted at 2 PM, and the sun came out shining intensely. A curious skua gull—the first sign of life we'd seen so far—flew around the tent and landed on the snow nearby. In the calm, the heat was oppressively high, and we were all extremely thirsty throughout the afternoon. I tried to quench my thirst during every break by holding snow in my hands and licking the water off my knuckles—this was a cold and unsatisfactory solution. We traveled without our burberrys—at that time quite a new experience—wearing only fleece suits and light woolen undergarments. Correll pulled for most of the afternoon in just his underclothes.

At forty-nine and a half miles a new and wonderful panorama opened before us. The sea lay just below, sweeping as a narrow gulf into the great, flat plain of debouching glacier-tongue which ebbed away north into the foggy horizon. A small ice-capped island was set like a pearl in the amethyst water. To the east, the glacier seemed to fuse with the blue line of the hinterland. Southward, the snowy slope rose quickly, and the far distance was unseen.

At forty-nine and a half miles, a new and amazing view opened up in front of us. The sea lay just below, curving like a narrow bay into the vast, flat area formed by melting glacier tongues that faded away into the foggy horizon to the north. A small ice-covered island looked like a pearl in the purple water. To the east, the glacier appeared to blend with the blue outline of the distant land. To the south, the snowy slope climbed steeply, and the far distance was hidden from view.

We marched for three-quarters of a mile to where a steep down grade commenced. Here I made a sketch and took a round of angles to all prominent features, and the conspicuous, jutting, seaward points of the glacier. McLean and Correll were busy making a snow cairn, six feet high, to serve as a back-sight for angles to be taken at a higher eminence southward.

We walked for about three-quarters of a mile to where a steep slope started. Here, I made a sketch and took a series of angles to all the notable features and the prominent, jutting points of the glacier facing the sea. McLean and Correll were busy building a six-foot-high snow cairn to use as a reference point for angles to be measured from a higher location to the south.

We set out for the latter, and after going one and a half miles it was late enough to camp. During the day we had all got very sunburnt, and our faces were flushed and smarting painfully. After the long winter at the Hut the skin had become more delicate than usual.

We headed for the latter destination, and after walking one and a half miles it was late enough to set up camp. Throughout the day, we all got pretty sunburned, and our faces were red and stinging painfully. After the long winter at the Hut, our skin had become more sensitive than usual.

Under a clear sky, the wind came down during the night at forty-five miles per hour, lashing surface drift against the walls of the tent. It was not till ten o'clock that the sledge started, breaking a heavy trail in snow which became more and more like brittle piecrust. There was at first a slight descent, and then we strained up the eminence to the south over high sastrugi running almost north and south. Capsizes became frequent, and to extricate the heavy sledge from some of the deep furrows it was necessary to unload the food-bags. The drift running over the ground was troublesome when we sat down for a rest, but, in marching, our heads were just clear of it.

Under a clear sky, the wind picked up during the night at forty-five miles per hour, whipping surface snow against the sides of the tent. It wasn't until ten o'clock that the sledges set out, carving a heavy path through the snow that was becoming increasingly brittle, like pie crust. At first, there was a slight downhill, but then we strained up the hill to the south over tall sastrugi running almost north and south. Capsizing happened often, and to free the heavy sledge from some of the deep grooves, we had to unload the food bags. The drifting snow on the ground was annoying when we stopped to take a break, but while marching, our heads stayed just above it.

It was a long laborious day, and the four miles indicated by the inexorable sledge-meter seemed a miserable result. However, near the top of the hill there was a rich reward. A small nunatak slanted like a steel-blue shadow on the side of a white peak to the south-west. There was great excitement, and the sledge slid along its tracks with new life. It was rock without a doubt, and there was no one to dispute it with us. While speculating wildly as to its distance, we came unexpectedly to the summit of the hill.

It had been a long, exhausting day, and the four miles marked by the unyielding sledge meter felt like a disappointing outcome. However, close to the top of the hill, there was a rewarding sight. A small nunatak leaned like a steel-blue shadow against a white peak to the southwest. There was a buzz of excitement, and the sledge moved along its tracks with renewed energy. It was definitely rock, and there was no one to argue otherwise. As we wildly speculated about its distance, we suddenly reached the top of the hill.

The wind had subsided, the sky was clear and the sun stood low in the south-west. Our view had widened to a noble outlook. The sea, a delicate turquoise-blue, lay in the foreground of the low, white, northern ice-cliffs. Away to the east was the dim suggestion of land across the bed of the glacier, about which circled the southerly highlands of the plateau, buried at times in the haze of distance. Due south, twenty miles away, projecting from the glacier, was another island of rock. The nunatak first seen, not many miles to the south-west, was a snowy mountain streaked with sprouting rock, rising solitary in an indentation of the land. We honoured our Ship by calling it Aurora Peak, while our camp stood on what was thenceforth to be Mount Murchison.

The wind had calmed down, the sky was clear, and the sun was low in the southwest. Our view had opened up to a magnificent landscape. The sea, a soft turquoise-blue, spread out in front of the low, white northern ice cliffs. To the east, there was a faint outline of land beyond the glacier bed, surrounded at times by the haze of the distant southern highlands of the plateau. Straight south, twenty miles away, jutted another rocky island from the glacier. The nunatak we first spotted, not too far to the southwest, was a snowy mountain streaked with exposed rock, standing alone in a dip in the land. We honored our ship by naming it Aurora Peak, while our camp was established on what would henceforth be called Mount Murchison.

It was obvious that this was the place for our first depot. I had decided, too, to make it the first magnetic station and the point from which to visit and explore Aurora Peak. None of us made any demur over a short halt. Correll had strained his back during the day from pulling too hard, and was troubled with a bleeding nose. My face was very sore from sunburn, with one eye swollen and almost closed, and McLean's eyes had not yet recovered from their first attack of snow-blindness.

It was clear that this was the spot for our first depot. I had also decided to turn it into the first magnetic station and the base for visiting and exploring Aurora Peak. None of us objected to a quick stop. Correll had strained his back earlier from overexertion and was dealing with a bleeding nose. My face was very sore from sunburn, with one eye nearly swollen shut, and McLean's eyes hadn't yet healed from their first bout of snow blindness.

November 21 was a day in camp. Most of the morning I spent trying, with Correll's help, to get the declination needle to set. Its pivot had been destroyed in transit and Correll had replaced it by a gramophone needle, which was found too insensitive. There was nothing to do but use the three-inch theodolite, which, setting to one degree, would give a good result, with a mean of thirty-two settings, for a region with such variable magnetic declination. A latitude "shot" was made at noon, and in the afternoon I took a set of dip determinations. These, with a panoramic sketch from the camp, a round of angles to conspicuous points and an observation at 5.30 P.M. for time and azimuth completed the day's work. Correll did the recording.

November 21 was a day spent in camp. Most of the morning, I worked with Correll to get the declination needle to set. Its pivot had been broken during transport, and Correll replaced it with a gramophone needle, but that turned out to be too sensitive. We had no choice but to use the three-inch theodolite, which, when set to one degree, would produce a reliable result with an average of thirty-two settings for an area with such fluctuating magnetic declination. A latitude measurement was taken at noon, and in the afternoon, I conducted a series of dip measurements. These, along with a panoramic sketch from the camp, a set of angles to notable points, and a time and azimuth observation at 5:30 PM, completed the day's tasks. Correll handled the recording.

Meanwhile, McLean had built an eight-feet snow mound, erected a depot flag upon it and taken several photographs.

Meanwhile, McLean had built an eight-foot snow mound, put a depot flag on it, and taken several photos.

The next day was devoted to an excursion to Aurora Peak. The weather was, to our surprise, quite clear and calm. Armed with the paraphernalia for a day's tour, we set off down the slope. Correll put the primus stove and the inner pot of the cooker in the ready food-bag, McLean slung on his camera and the aneroid barometer, while I took my ruck-sack with the rations, as well as field-glasses and an ice-axe. In case of crevasses, we attached ourselves to an alpine rope in long procession. According to the "Epic" it was something like this:

The next day was set aside for a trip to Aurora Peak. The weather was surprisingly clear and calm. Loaded up for a day of adventure, we started making our way down the slope. Correll packed the primus stove and the inner pot of the cooker into the food bag, McLean grabbed his camera and an aneroid barometer, while I took my backpack filled with supplies, along with binoculars and an ice axe. To be safe from any crevasses, we tied ourselves to an alpine rope in a long line. According to the "Epic," it went something like this:

    We saddled up, adventure-bent;
    Locked up the house—I mean the tent-
    Took "grub" enough for three young men
    With appetite to equal ten.
    A day's outing across the vale.
    Aurora Peak! What ho! All hail!

    We waltzed a'down the silvered slope,
    Connected by an Alpine rope;
    "Madi" in front with ice-axe armed,
    For fear that we should feel alarmed.
    Glad was the hour, and—what a lark!
    Explorers three? "Save the mark!"
    We got ready, all set for adventure;  
    Locked up the house—I mean the tent—  
    Brought enough food for three young guys  
    With appetites to match ten.  
    A day trip across the valley.  
    Aurora Peak! Cheers to that!  

    We danced down the shiny slope,  
    Tied together with an Alpine rope;  
    "Madi" in front with an ice axe ready,  
    In case we got a little unsteady.  
    What a great time it was—and what a blast!  
    Three explorers? You bet!

The mystery of the nunatak was about to be solved. Apparently it rose from the level of the glacier, as our descent showed its eastern flank more clearly outlined. It was three miles to the bottom of the gully, and the aneroid barometer registered one thousand one hundred and ninety feet. The surface was soft and yielding to finnesko crampons, which sank through in places till the snow gripped the knees.

The mystery of the nunatak was about to be revealed. It seemed to rise from the glacier's level, as our descent made its eastern side clearer. It was three miles down to the bottom of the gully, and the aneroid barometer showed one thousand one hundred and ninety feet. The surface was soft and giving under the finnesko crampons, which sometimes sank in until the snow hugged our knees.

Ascending on the other side we crossed a small crevasse and the peak towered above us. The northern side terminated in a perpendicular face of ice, below which a deep basin had been "scalloped" away; evidently kept clear by eddies of wind. In it lay broken fragments of the overhanging cliff. The rock was a wide, outcropping band curving steeply to the summit on the eastern aspect.

Ascending on the other side, we crossed a small crevasse, and the peak loomed above us. The northern side dropped off into a vertical ice wall, below which a deep basin had been carved away, clearly cleared by gusts of wind. In it were broken pieces of the overhanging cliff. The rock was a broad, exposed band that curved steeply to the summit on the eastern side.

After a stiff climb we hurried eagerly to the rock as if it were a mine of inexhaustible treasure. The boulders were all weathered a bright red and were much pitted where ferruginous minerals were leached out. The rock was a highly quartzose gneiss, with black bands of schist running through it. Moss and lichens were plentiful, and McLean collected specimens.

After a tough climb, we rushed excitedly to the rock like it was a source of endless treasure. The boulders were all a bright red from weathering and were heavily pitted where iron minerals had washed away. The rock was a highly quartz-rich gneiss, with black bands of schist running through it. Moss and lichens were abundant, and McLean gathered samples.

The rocky strip was eighty feet wide and three hundred feet high, so, making a cache of the primus, provisions and burberrys, we followed it up till it became so steep that it was necessary to change to the snow. This was in the form of hard neve with patches of ice. I went first, cutting steps with the ice-axe, and the others followed on the rope. The last ten of more than one hundred steps were in an almost vertical face, which gave a somewhat precarious foothold.

The rocky ledge was eighty feet wide and three hundred feet high, so we made a stash of the primus stove, supplies, and jackets, then followed it up until it got so steep we had to switch to the snow. The snow was hard neve with spots of ice. I went first, cutting steps with the ice axe, and the others followed on the rope. The last ten of over a hundred steps were on nearly vertical ground, which made for a pretty shaky foothold.

At 11.30 A.M. we stood on the summit at an altitude of one thousand seven hundred and fifty feet, while across the valley to the north-east rose Mount Murchison, one hundred and fourteen feet higher. The top of the ridge was quite a knife-edge, with barely space for standing. It ran mainly north and south, dipping in the centre, to curve away sharply westward to a higher eminence. At the bend was an inaccessible patch of rock. The surrounding view was much the same at that on Mount Murchison.

At 11:30 A.M., we stood at the summit, which was 1,750 feet high, while across the valley to the northeast loomed Mount Murchison, 114 feet taller. The ridge's top was like a knife-edge, with barely enough space to stand. It mostly ran north and south, dipping in the middle and sharply curving westward to a higher peak. At the curve was a section of rock that was hard to access. The view around us looked pretty much the same as the one from Mount Murchison.

The Union Jack and the Australian flag were erected on a bamboo, and photographs taken. At the same time, low, threatening clouds rapidly emerged from the southeast, covering the sun and creating the "snow-blind" light. This was rather alarming as the climb had been difficult enough under a clear sky, and the descent was certainly much more difficult. So we hastily ate some chocolate and discussed the best way down.

The Union Jack and the Australian flag were raised on a bamboo pole, and photos were taken. At the same time, dark, ominous clouds quickly rolled in from the southeast, blocking the sun and creating a blinding light. This was pretty concerning since the climb had already been tough under a clear sky, and the descent was definitely going to be harder. So, we quickly ate some chocolate and talked about the best way to get down.

Prospecting to the north, in search of a long snow ramp which appeared to run away in that direction, we scrambled down to the edge of a wide snowy crevasse full of blue chinks.

Prospecting to the north, looking for a long snow ramp that seemed to stretch in that direction, we scrambled down to the edge of a wide snowy crevasse filled with blue chinks.

Turning back, we considered the chances of sliding down a steep scoured hollow to the west and finally decided to descend by the track we had cut.

Turning back, we thought about the possibility of sliding down a steep, eroded hollow to the west and ultimately decided to go down the path we had created.

McLean started off first down the steps and was out of sight in a few moments. When the rope tightened, Correll followed him and then I came last. It was very ticklish work feeling for the steps below with one's feet, and, as we signalled to one another in turn after moving a step, it took more than an hour to reach a safe position on the rocks. With every step I drove my axe into the ice, so that if the others had fallen there would still have been a last chance.

McLean was the first to head down the steps and disappeared in a few moments. When the rope pulled tight, Correll followed him, and then I came last. It was really tricky trying to find the steps below with my feet, and as we signaled to each other after taking a step, it took over an hour to get to a safe spot on the rocks. With every step, I drove my axe into the ice, so if the others had slipped, there would still be a last chance to catch them.

There was no time to be wasted; light snow was falling with the prospect of becoming thicker. In the gully the snowfall became heavy, limiting the view to within a few hundred yards. We advanced up the hill in what seemed to be the steepest direction, but circled half-way round it before finding out that the course was wrong. Aimlessly trying to place the broad flat summit I came across tracks in the snow, which were then carefully followed and led to the tent. The wind was rising outside and the hoosh in steaming mugs was eaten with extra relish in our snug retreat.

There was no time to waste; light snow was falling and it looked like it would get heavier. In the gully, the snowfall got heavy, reducing visibility to just a few hundred yards. We made our way up the hill in what felt like the steepest direction, but we ended up circling halfway around before realizing we were off course. While I was trying to locate the broad, flat summit, I stumbled upon some tracks in the snow, which I carefully followed to the tent. The wind was picking up outside and the steam rising from our mugs was enjoyed even more in our cozy retreat.

Specimens were labelled to be deposed and provisions were arranged for the rest of the journey. It was evident that we had superfluous clothing, and so the weight of the kit-bags was scrupulously cut down. By the time we crawled into sleeping-bags, everything dispensable was piled alongside the depot-flag.

Specimens were tagged for deposit, and arrangements were made for the rest of the trip. It was clear that we had too much clothing, so we carefully reduced the weight of the gear bags. By the time we settled into our sleeping bags, everything unnecessary was stacked next to the depot flag.

We slept the sleep of the weary and did not hear the flapping tent nor the hissing drift. At 6 A.M. the wind was doing forty miles per hour and the air was filled with snow. It must have been a new climate, for by noon the sun had unexpectedly broken through, the wind was becoming gusty and the drift trailed like scud over the surface.

We slept soundly and didn’t notice the tent flapping or the snow blowing. At 6 A.M., the wind was blowing at forty miles per hour, and the air was thick with snow. It had to be a new climate, because by noon, the sun surprisingly came out, the wind started to gust, and the snow drift was moving across the surface like scud.

With six weeks' food we set off on a new trail after lunch. The way to the eastern glacier—Mertz Glacier—issued through the mouth of the gully, which ran in an easterly direction between Aurora Peak and Mount Murchison. On Mount Murchison ice-falls and crevasses began a short distance east of our first line of descent, but yet I thought a slight deviation to the east of south would bring us safely into the valley, and, at the same time, cut off a mile. Alas! it proved to be one of those "best-laid schemes."

With six weeks' worth of food, we set out on a new trail after lunch. The route to the eastern glacier—Mertz Glacier—emerged from the mouth of the gully, which ran eastward between Aurora Peak and Mount Murchison. On Mount Murchison, ice falls and crevasses began just a short distance east of our initial descent, but I thought a slight detour to the east of south would lead us safely into the valley and also save us a mile. Unfortunately, it turned out to be one of those "best-laid plans."

The load commenced to glide so quickly as we were leaving the crest of the mountain that Correll and McLean unhitched from the hauling line and attached themselves by the alpine rope to the rear of the sledge, braking its progress. I remained harnessed in front keeping the direction. For two miles we were going downhill at a running pace and then the slope became suddenly steeper and the sledge overtook me. I had expected crevasses, in view of which I did not like all the loose rope behind me. Looking round, I shouted to the others to hold back the sledge, proceeding a few steps while doing so. The bow of the sledge was almost at my feet, when—whizz! I was dropping down through space. The length of the hauling rope was twenty-four feet, and I was at the end of it. I cannot say that "my past life flashed before me." I just had time to think "Now for the jerk—will my harness hold?" when there was a wrench, and I was hanging breathless over the blue depth. Then the most anxious moment came—I continued to descend. A glance showed me that the crevasse was only four feet wide, so the sledge could not follow me, and I knew with a thankful heart that I was safe. I only descended about two feet more, and then stopped. I knew my companions had pulled up the sledge and would be anchoring it with the ice-axe.

The load started to slide so quickly as we were leaving the top of the mountain that Correll and McLean unhitched from the hauling line and secured themselves to the back of the sledge with the alpine rope to slow it down. I stayed harnessed in front, maintaining our direction. For two miles, we went downhill at a fast pace, and then the slope suddenly got steeper, causing the sledge to catch up with me. I had expected crevasses, and I didn’t like the loose rope trailing behind me. Looking back, I shouted to the others to hold back the sledge while taking a few steps back myself. The front of the sledge was almost at my feet when—whoosh! I started falling through the air. The hauling rope was twenty-four feet long, and I was at the end of it. I can't say that "my life flashed before my eyes." I just had time to think, "Here comes the jerk—will my harness hold?" when there was a jolt, and I found myself hanging breathlessly over the blue abyss. Then came the most nerve-wracking moment—I kept falling. A quick look showed me that the crevasse was only four feet wide, so the sledge couldn’t follow me, and I felt relieved knowing I was safe. I fell about two feet more before coming to a stop. I knew my companions had pulled up the sledge and were securing it with the ice-axe.

I had a few moments in which to take in my surroundings. Opposite to me was a vertical wall of ice, and below a beautiful blue, darkening to black in that unseen chasm. On either hand the rift of the crevasse extended, and above was the small hole in the snow bridge through which I had shot.

I had a few moments to take in my surroundings. In front of me was a vertical wall of ice, and below was a beautiful blue that faded to black in that unseen chasm. On either side, the rift of the crevasse stretched out, and above was the small hole in the snow bridge I had shot through.

Soon I heard McLean calling, "Are you all right?" And I answered in what he and Correll thought an alarmingly distant voice. They started enlarging the hole to pull me out, until lumps of snow began to fall and I had to yell for mercy. Then I felt they were hauling, and slowly I rose to daylight.

Soon I heard McLean calling, "Are you okay?" And I answered in what he and Correll thought was a shockingly distant voice. They started making the hole bigger to pull me out until chunks of snow began to fall, and I had to yell for help. Then I felt them pulling, and gradually I rose into the daylight.

The crevasse ran westward along the gully, forcing us to make a detour through a maze of smaller cracks. We had to retreat up the hill in one place, throwing off half the load and carrying it on in relays. There was a blistering sun and the work was hard. At last the sledge came to a clear run and tobogganed into the snow-filled valley, turning eastward towards its outlet.

The crevasse stretched westward along the gully, making us take a detour through a maze of smaller cracks. At one point, we had to go back up the hill, unloading half our gear and transporting it in relays. The sun was blazing, and the work was tough. Finally, the sled hit a clear path and slid into the snow-filled valley, turning east toward its exit.

At the evening camp the sledge-meter indicated that our distance eastward of the Hut was sixty miles, one thousand two hundred yards. The northern face of the gully was very broken and great sentinel pillars of ice stood out among the yawning caves, some of them leaning like the tower of Pisa, others having fallen and rolled in shattered blocks. Filling the vision to the south-west was Aurora Peak, in crisp silhouette against a glorious radiant of cirrus cloud.

At the evening camp, the sledge-meter showed that we were sixty miles and one thousand two hundred yards east of the Hut. The northern side of the gully was quite rugged, with massive ice pillars standing out among the deep caves—some leaning like the Leaning Tower of Pisa, while others had collapsed and scattered into broken chunks. To the southwest, Aurora Peak rose in a sharp silhouette against a stunning backdrop of cirrus clouds.

Reviewing the day through our peaceful smoke-rings, I was rather comforted by the fact that the fall into the crevasse had thoroughly tested my harness. Correll expressed himself as perfectly satisfied with his test. McLean seemed to feel somewhat out of it, being the only one without a crevasse experience; which happy state he maintained until the end, apparently somewhat to his disappointment.

Looking back on the day as we blew peaceful smoke rings, I felt pretty reassured by the fact that the fall into the crevasse had really put my harness to the test. Correll said he was completely happy with his test. McLean seemed a bit disconnected, being the only one who hadn't experienced a crevasse; he stayed in that blissful state until the end, which seemed to disappoint him a little.

On the 24th we broke camp at 9 A.M., continuing down the gully towards the glacier. A lofty wall of rocks, set within a frame of ice, was observed on our left, one mile away. To it we diverged and found it to be gneiss similar to that of Aurora Peak. Several photos were taken.

On the 24th, we packed up camp at 9 A.M. and continued down the gully towards the glacier. On our left, about a mile away, we noticed a tall rock wall surrounded by ice. We veered towards it and discovered it was gneiss, similar to that of Aurora Peak. We took several photos.

The land was at our back and the margin of the glacier had been crossed. Only too soon we were in the midst of terribly crevassed ground, through which one could only thread a slow and zig-zag course. The blue ice was riven in every direction by gaping quarries and rose smooth and slippery on the ridges which broke the surface into long waves. Shod with crampons, the rear of the sledge secured by a tail-rope, we had a trying afternoon guiding the load along the narrow ridges of ice with precipices on either hand. Fortunately the wind was not above twenty miles per hour. As the frivolous "Epic" had it:

The land was behind us, and we had crossed the edge of the glacier. Before long, we found ourselves on extremely cracked ground, where we could only move slowly and in a zig-zag pattern. The blue ice was split in every direction by large gaps and rose smooth and slippery on the ridges that made the surface look like long waves. Wearing crampons and with the back of the sled secured by a tail rope, we faced a tough afternoon maneuvering the load along the narrow ice ridges, with sheer drops on either side. Luckily, the wind was only about twenty miles per hour. As the light-hearted "Epic" put it:

    Odds fish! the solid sea is sorely rent,
    And all around we're pent
    With quarries, chasms, pits, depressions vast,
    Their snow-lids overcast.

    A devious track, all curved and serpentine
    Round snow-lids superfine.
    On jutting brinks and precipices sheer
    Precariously we steer.
    Wow! The solid sea is really torn apart,
    And all around we're trapped
    With quarries, chasms, pits, and huge depressions,
    Their snowy tops all covered.

    A winding path, all curved and twisty
    Around the fine snowy tops.
    On jutting edges and steep cliffs
    We dangerously navigate.

We pushed on to find a place in which to camp, as there was scarcely safe standing-room for a primus stove. At seventy miles the broken ice gave way to a level expanse of hard sastrugi dotted all over with small mounds of ice about four feet high. After hoosh, a friendly little Wilson petrel came flying from the northern sea to our tent. We considered it to be a good omen.

We continued searching for a spot to camp since there was hardly enough safe space for a primus stove. After seventy miles, the broken ice turned into a flat area of hard sastrugi sprinkled with small ice mounds about four feet high. After our meal, a playful little Wilson petrel flew in from the northern sea to our tent. We took it as a good sign.

Next day the icy mounds disappeared, to be replaced by a fine, flat surface, and the day's march amounted to eleven and a quarter miles.

The next day, the icy mounds were gone, replaced by a smooth, flat surface, and the day’s journey totaled eleven and a quarter miles.

At 11 A.M. four snow petrels visited us, circling round in great curiosity. It is a cheerful thing to see these birds amid the lone, inhospitable ice.

At 11 A.M., four snow petrels came to see us, circling around with great curiosity. It’s a delightful sight to see these birds in the lonely, harsh ice.

We were taking in the surroundings from our position off the land scanning the far coast to the south for rock and turning round to admire the bold contours of Aurora Peak and Mount Murchison at our back. Occasionally there were areas of rubbly snow, blue ice and crevasses completely filled with snow, of prodigious dimensions, two hundred to three hundred yards wide and running as far as the eye could travel. The snow filling them was perfectly firm, but, almost always along the windward edge, probing with an ice-axe would disclose a fissure. This part of the Mertz Glacier was apparently afloat.

We were taking in the scenery from our spot off the land, scanning the distant southern coast for rocks while turning around to admire the striking shapes of Aurora Peak and Mount Murchison behind us. Every now and then, we came across patches of rocky snow, blue ice, and crevasses completely packed with snow, some reaching an impressive two hundred to three hundred yards wide and stretching as far as we could see. The snow filling them was solid, but almost always along the windward edge, poking with an ice axe would reveal a crack. This part of the Mertz Glacier seemed to be floating.

The lucky Wilson petrel came again in the evening. At this stage the daily temperatures ranged between 10 degrees F. and near freezing-point. The greater part of November 26 was passed in the tent, within another zone of crevasses. The overcast sky made the light so bad that it became dangerous to go ahead. At 5.30 P.M. we started, and managed to do five and a half miles before 8 P.M.

The lucky Wilson petrel returned in the evening. At this point, the daily temperatures ranged from 10 degrees Fahrenheit to just below freezing. Most of November 26 was spent in the tent, surrounded by another area of crevasses. The cloudy sky made visibility so poor that it became unsafe to move forward. At 5:30 PM, we set out and managed to cover five and a half miles before 8 PM.

It was rather an eventful day, when across the undulating sastrugi there appeared a series of shallow valleys running eastward. As the valleys approached closer, the ground sloped down to meet them, their sides becoming steeper, buckled and broken. Proceeding ahead on an easterly course, our march came to an abrupt termination on an ice-bluff.

It was quite an eventful day when a series of shallow valleys appeared across the uneven sastrugi, stretching eastward. As the valleys got closer, the ground sloped down to meet them, with their sides becoming steeper, uneven, and fractured. Continuing on an easterly path, our march came to a sudden stop at an ice bluff.

In front lay a perfectly flat snow-covered plain—the sea-ice. In point of fact we had arrived at the eastern side of the Mertz Glacier and were about fifteen miles north of the mainland. Old sea-ice, deeply covered in snow, lay ahead for miles, and the hazy, blue coast sank below the horizon in the south-east, running for a time parallel to the course we were about to take. It was some time before we realized all this, but at noon on the following day there came the first reminder of the proximity of sea-water.

In front stretched a perfectly flat snow-covered plain—the sea ice. In fact, we had reached the eastern side of the Mertz Glacier and were about fifteen miles north of the mainland. Old sea ice, heavily blanketed in snow, extended for miles ahead, and the hazy blue coast dipped below the horizon to the southeast, running parallel to the path we were about to take for a while. It took us some time to understand all this, but at noon the next day, we received the first hint of the nearby sea water.

An Adelie penguin, skiing on its breast from the north, surprised us suddenly by a loud croak at the rear of the sledge. As astonished as we were, it stopped and stared, and then in sudden terror made off. But before starting on its long trek to the land, it had to be captured and photographed.

An Adelie penguin, sliding on its belly from the north, surprised us unexpectedly with a loud croak at the back of the sledge. As shocked as we were, it stopped and stared, and then in a sudden panic, took off. But before it began its long journey to land, it needed to be caught and photographed.

To the south the coast was marked by two faces of rock and a short, dark spur protruding from beneath the ice-cap. As our friendly penguin had made off in that direction, we elected to call the place Penguin Point, intending to touch there on the return journey. During the afternoon magnetic dips and a round of angles to the prominences of the mainland were taken.

To the south, the coast was defined by two rock formations and a small, dark ridge sticking out from under the ice cap. Since our friendly penguin had headed that way, we decided to name the spot Penguin Point, planning to stop there on our way back. In the afternoon, we took magnetic dips and measured angles to the landmarks on the mainland.

The next evidence on the sea-ice question came in the shape of a line of broken slabs of ice to the north, sticking out of the snow like the ruins of an ancient graveyard. At one hundred and fifteen miles the line was so close that we left the sledge to investigate it, finding a depression ten feet deep, through which wound a glistening riband of sea-water. It reminded one of a creek in flat, Australian country, and the illusion was sustained by a dark skua gull—in its slow flight much like a crow. It was a fissure in old thick sea-ice.

The next evidence about the sea-ice issue appeared as a line of broken ice slabs to the north, protruding from the snow like the remains of an ancient graveyard. At one hundred and fifteen miles, the line was so close that we left the sled to check it out, discovering a depression ten feet deep, through which a glistening ribbon of seawater flowed. It reminded one of a creek in flat, Australian terrain, and the illusion was supported by a dark skua gull—its slow flight resembling that of a crow. It was a crack in old, thick sea-ice.

Sunday, and the first day of December, brought good weather and a clear view of the mainland. A bay opened to the east of Penguin Point, from which the coast trended to the south-east. Across a crack in the sea-ice we could just distinguish a low indented line like the glacier-tongue, we had already crossed. It might have been a long promontory of land for all we knew. Behind it was a continuous ice-blink and on our left, to the north, a deep blue "water sky." It seemed worth while continuing on an easterly course approximately parallel with the coast.

Sunday, the first day of December, brought nice weather and a clear view of the mainland. A bay opened to the east of Penguin Point, where the coast curved to the southeast. Across a gap in the sea ice, we could just make out a low, jagged line like the glacier tongue we had already crossed. For all we knew, it could have been a long stretch of land. Behind it was a continuous shimmer of ice, and to our left, to the north, was a deep blue "water sky." It seemed worthwhile to continue on an easterly course, roughly parallel to the coast.

We were faced by another glacier-tongue; a fact which remained unproven for a week at least. From the sea-ice on to the glacier—the Ninnis Glacier—there was a gentle rise to a prominent knoll of one hundred and seventy feet. Here our distance from the Hut amounted to one hundred and fifty-two miles, and the spot was reckoned a good situation for the last depot.

We encountered another glacier tongue; a fact that stayed unverified for at least a week. From the sea ice to the glacier—the Ninnis Glacier—there was a gentle incline up to a notable knoll of one hundred and seventy feet. At this point, we were one hundred and fifty-two miles away from the Hut, and this location was considered a good place for the final supply depot.

In taking magnetic observations, it was interesting to find that the "dip" amounted to 87 degrees 44', while the declination, which had varied towards the west, swung at this our most northerly station a few degrees to the east. We were curving round the South Magnetic Pole. Many points on the coast were fixed from an adjoining hill to which Correll and I trudged through sandy snow, while McLean stayed behind erecting the depot-mound, placing a food-bag, kerosene tin, black cloth and miner's pick on the top.

While making magnetic observations, it was interesting to find that the "dip" was at 87 degrees 44', and the declination, which had shifted toward the west, swung a few degrees to the east at our northernmost location. We were circling the South Magnetic Pole. We marked many points along the coast from a nearby hill, which Correll and I hiked to through sandy snow, while McLean stayed behind to build the depot mound, placing a food bag, a kerosene tin, a black cloth, and a miner's pick on top.

With four weeks' provisions we made a new start to cross the Ninnis Glacier on December 3, changing course to E. 30 degrees N., in great wonderment as to what lay ahead. In this new land interest never flagged. One never could foresee what the morrow would bring forth.

With four weeks' worth of supplies, we set off again to cross the Ninnis Glacier on December 3, adjusting our course to E. 30 degrees N., filled with excitement about what was ahead. In this new land, our interest never faded. You could never predict what tomorrow would hold.

Across rolling "downs" of soft, billowy snow we floundered for twenty-four miles, on the two following days. Not a wind-ripple could be seen. We were evidently in a region of comparative calms, which was a remarkable thing, considering that the windiest spot in the world was less than two hundred miles away.

Across rolling hills of soft, fluffy snow, we struggled for twenty-four miles over the next two days. Not a single wind ripple was visible. We were clearly in a relatively calm area, which was quite remarkable given that the windiest place in the world was less than two hundred miles away.

After several sunny days McLean and I had very badly cracked lips. It had been often remarked at the Hut that the standard of humour greatly depreciated during the winter and this caused McLean and me many a physical pang while sledging, as we would laugh at the least provocation and open all the cracks in our lips. Eating hard plasmon biscuits was a painful pleasure. Correll, who was immune from this affliction, tanned to the rich hue of the "nut-brown maiden."

After several sunny days, McLean and I had really chapped lips. People at the Hut often commented that the humor took a dive during the winter, and this led to many physical discomforts for McLean and me while sledding, as we'd laugh at the slightest thing and split our lips open even more. Eating hard plasmon biscuits was a painful treat. Correll, who didn't have this problem, tanned to a rich shade like "nut-brown maiden."

On December 5, at the top of a rise, we were suddenly confronted with a new vision—"Thalassa!" was our cry, "the sea!" but a very different sea from that which brought such joy to the hearts of the wandering Greeks. Unfolded to the horizon was a plain of pack-ice, thickly studded with bergs and intersected by black leads of open water. In the north-east was a patch of open sea and above it, round to the north, lowering banks of steel-blue cloud. We had come to the eastern side of Ninnis Glacier.

On December 5, at the top of a rise, we were suddenly faced with a new sight—“Thalassa!” we shouted, “the sea!” but it was a very different sea from the one that brought such joy to the hearts of wandering Greeks. Stretching to the horizon was a plain of pack ice, heavily dotted with icebergs and crossed by dark channels of open water. In the northeast was a patch of open sea and above it, to the north, brooding banks of steel-blue cloud. We had arrived at the eastern side of Ninnis Glacier.

At this point any analogy which could possibly have been found with Wilkes's coastline ceased. It seems probable that he charted as land the limits of the pack-ice in 1840.

At this point, any comparison that might have been made with Wilkes's coastline ended. It's likely that he mapped the edges of the pack-ice as land in 1840.

The excitement of exploring this new realm was to be deferred. Even as we raised the tent, the wind commenced to whistle and the air became surcharged with snow. Three skua gulls squatted a few yards away, squawking at our approach, and a few snow petrels sailed by in the gathering blizzard.

The excitement of exploring this new area would have to wait. As we set up the tent, the wind started to whistle and the air filled with snow. Three skua gulls sat a few yards away, squawking at us as we got closer, and a few snow petrels flew by in the growing blizzard.

Through the 6th, 7th and 8th and most of the 9th it raged, during which time we came definitely to the conclusion that as social entertainers we were complete failures. We exhausted all the reserve topics of conversation, discussed our Universities, sports, friends and homes. We each described the scenery we liked best; notable always for the sunny weather and perfect calm. McLean sailed again in Sydney Harbour, Correll cycled and ran his races, I wandered in the South Australian hills or rowed in the "eights," while the snow swished round the tent and the wind roared over the wastes of ice.

Through the 6th, 7th, 8th, and most of the 9th, it went on, during which time we came to the clear conclusion that as social entertainers we were complete failures. We ran out of all the backup topics for conversation, talked about our universities, sports, friends, and homes. We each described the scenery we liked best; always noted for the sunny weather and perfect calm. McLean sailed again in Sydney Harbour, Correll cycled and competed in races, I strolled through the South Australian hills or rowed in the "eights," while the snow swirled around the tent and the wind roared over the icy wasteland.

Avoiding a few crevasses on the drop to sea-level on December 10, the sledge was manoeuvred over a tide-crack between glacier and sea-ice. The latter was traversed by frequent pressure-ridges; hummocks and broken pinnacles being numerous.

Avoiding a few cracks on the way down to sea level on December 10, the sled was maneuvered over a gap between the glacier and the sea ice. The sea ice was covered with frequent pressure ridges, and there were many hummocks and broken peaks.

The next six days out on the broken sea-ice were full of incident. The weather was gloriously sunny till the 13th, during which time the sledge had to be dragged through a forest of pinnacles and over areas of soft, sticky slush which made the runners execrable for hours. Ponds of open water, by which basked a few Weddell seals, became a familiar sight. We tried to maintain a south-easterly course for the coast, but miles were wasted in the tortuous maze of ice—"a wildering Theban ruin of hummock and serrac."

The next six days on the broken sea-ice were eventful. The weather was beautifully sunny until the 13th, during which we had to drag the sled through a forest of ice pinnacles and over areas of soft, sticky slush that made the runners miserable for hours. Ponds of open water, where a few Weddell seals lounged, became a common sight. We tried to keep heading southeast toward the coast, but we wasted miles navigating the twisted maze of ice—"a bewildering Theban ruin of hummock and serrac."

The sledge-meter broke down and gave the ingenious Correll a proposition which he ably solved. McLean and I had a chronic weakness of the eyes from the continual glare. Looking at the other two fellows with their long protruding goggles made me think of Banquo's ghost: "Thou hast no speculation in those eyes that thou dost glare with."

The sledge-meter broke down and presented the clever Correll with a challenge that he handled skillfully. McLean and I suffered from persistent eye strain due to the constant brightness. Seeing the other two guys with their oversized goggles reminded me of Banquo's ghost: "You have no thoughts behind those eyes that you're glaring with."

I had noticed that some of the tide-cracks had opened widely and, when a blizzard blew on December 13, the thought was a skeleton in my brain cupboard.

I noticed that some of the tide cracks had opened up a lot, and when a blizzard hit on December 13, that thought felt like a skeleton hiding in the back of my mind.

On the 15th an Emperor penguin was seen sunning himself by a pool of water, so we decided to kill the bird and carry some meat in case of emergency. McLean found the stomach full of fish and myriads of cestodes in the intestines.

On the 15th, an Emperor penguin was spotted basking by a pool of water, so we decided to take it down and bring some meat just in case of an emergency. McLean found its stomach packed with fish and numerous cestodes in the intestines.

By dint of hard toil over cracks, ridges and jagged, broken blocks, we came, by diverging to the south-west, to the junction between shifting pack and fast bay-ice, and even there, we afterwards shuddered to find, it was at least forty-five miles, as the penguin skis, to the land.

By working hard over cracks, ridges, and jagged, broken blocks, we made our way, heading southwest, to the point where the shifting pack ice meets the solid bay ice. We later realized with a shudder that it was at least forty-five miles, in penguin terms, to the land.

It was a fine flat surface on which the sledge ran, and the miles commenced to fly by, comparatively speaking. Except for an occasional deep rift, whose bottom plumbed to the sea-water, the going was excellent. Each day the broken ice on our left receded, the mainland to the south grew closer and traces of rock became discernible on the low, fractured cliffs.

It was a smooth, flat surface where the sled was running, and the miles started to pass quickly, relatively speaking. Aside from an occasional deep crack that reached down to the seawater, the travel was great. Each day, the broken ice on our left moved further away, the mainland to the south got closer, and signs of rock became visible on the low, jagged cliffs.

On December 17 a huge rocky bluff—Horn Bluff—stood out from the shore. It had a ram-shaped bow like a Dreadnought battleship and, adjoining it, there were smaller outcrops of rock on the seaward ice-cliffs. On its eastern side was a wide bay with a well-defined cape—Cape Freshfield—at the eastern extremity about thirty miles away.

On December 17, a massive rocky cliff—Horn Bluff—jutted out from the shore. It had a ram-shaped bow like a modern battleship, and next to it were smaller rock formations on the icy cliffs facing the sea. On the eastern side, there was a large bay with a clearly defined cape—Cape Freshfield—at the eastern tip, about thirty miles away.

The Bluff was a place worth exploring. At a distance of more than fifteen miles, the spot suggested all kinds of possibilities, and in council we argued that it was useless to go much farther east, as to touch at the land would mean a detour on the homeward track and time would have to be allowed for that.

The Bluff was a spot worth checking out. More than fifteen miles away, it hinted at all sorts of possibilities, and during our discussion, we debated that it was pointless to go much farther east since getting to the land would mean a detour on our way home, and we needed to account for that time.

At a point two hundred and seventy miles from the Hut, in latitude 68 degrees 18' S., longitude 150 degrees 12' E., we erected our "farthest east" camp on December 18, after a day's tramp of eighteen miles. Here, magnetic "dips" and other observations were made throughout the morning of the 19th. It was densely overcast, with sago snow falling, but by 3 P.M. of the same day the clouds had magically cleared and the first stage of the homeward journey had commenced.

At a point two hundred seventy miles from the Hut, at latitude 68 degrees 18' S. and longitude 150 degrees 12' E., we set up our "farthest east" camp on December 18, after walking eighteen miles that day. Here, we took magnetic "dips" and other measurements throughout the morning of the 19th. It was heavily overcast, with sago snow falling, but by 3 P.M. that same day, the clouds had suddenly cleared, and the first leg of the journey home had begun.





CHAPTER XVI HORN BLUFF AND PENGUIN POINT

by C. T. MADIGAN

       What thrill of grandeur ours
    When first we viewed the column'd fell!
    What idle, lilting verse can tell
       Of giant fluted towers,
    O'er-canopied with immemorial snow
    And riven by a glacier's azure flow?
       What a thrilling sense of grandeur we felt  
    When we first saw the towering columns!  
    What playful, whimsical words can capture  
       The massive fluted towers,  
    Overlooked by ancient snow  
    And split by a glacier's blue stream?  

As we neared Horn Bluff, on the first stage of our homeward march, the upper layers of snow were observed to disappear, and the underlying ice became thinner; in corrugated sapphire plains with blue reaches of sparkling water. Cracks bridged with flimsy snow continually let one through into the water. McLean and I both soaked our feet and once I was immersed to the thighs, having to stop and put on dry socks and finnesko. It was a chilly process allowing the trousers to dry on me.

As we got closer to Horn Bluff, during the first leg of our journey home, the top layers of snow started to melt away, revealing thinner ice underneath; we saw rippled sapphire plains with blue patches of shimmering water. Cracks covered with thin snow often let us slip into the water. Both McLean and I ended up with soaked feet, and at one point, I was soaked up to my thighs, forcing me to stop and put on dry socks and finnesko. It was a cold process trying to dry my trousers while wearing them.

The mountain, pushing out as a great promontory from the coast amid the fast sea-ice, towered up higher as our sledge approached its foot. A great shadow was cast on the ice, and, when more than a mile away, we left the warm sunshine.

The mountain jutted out like a massive promontory from the coast among the thick sea ice, rising even higher as we got closer to its base. It cast a huge shadow on the ice, and from over a mile away, we stepped out of the warm sunshine.

Awed and amazed, we beheld the lone vastness of it all and were mute. Rising out of the flat wilderness over which we had travelled was a mammoth vertical barrier of rock rearing its head to the skies above. The whole face for five miles was one magnificent series of organ-pipes. The deep shade was heightened by the icy glare beyond it. Here was indeed a Cathedral of Nature, where the "still, small voice" spoke amid an ineffable calm.

Awed and amazed, we looked at the vastness of it all and were speechless. Rising out of the flat landscape we had traveled through was a massive vertical wall of rock lifting its peak to the sky. The entire face for five miles was a stunning series of organ-like formations. The deep shade contrasted with the icy glare beyond it. Here was truly a Cathedral of Nature, where the "still, small voice" spoke in an indescribable calm.

Far up the face of the cliff snow petrels fluttered like white butterflies. It was stirring to think that these majestic heights had gazed out across the wastes of snow and ice for countless ages, and never before had the voices of human beings echoed in the great stillness nor human eyes surveyed the wondrous scene.

Far up the side of the cliff, snow petrels flitted around like white butterflies. It was moving to realize that these magnificent heights had looked out over the endless snow and ice for countless ages, and never before had human voices echoed in the deep silence nor had human eyes witnessed the incredible view.

From the base of the organ-pipes sloped a mass of debris; broken blocks of rock of every size tumbling steeply to the splintered hummocks of the sea-ice.

From the base of the organ-pipes sloped a pile of rubble; broken rocks of all sizes tumbling steeply to the shattered mounds of sea ice.

Standing out from the top of this talus-slope were several white "beacons," up to which we scrambled when the tent was pitched. This was a tedious task as the stones were ready to slide down at the least touch, and often we were carried down several yards by a general movement. Wearing soft finnesko, we ran the risk of getting a crushed foot among the large boulders. Amongst the rubble were beds of clay, and streams of thaw-water trickled down to the surface of a frozen lake.

Standing out from the top of this rocky slope were several white "beacons," which we climbed to once the tent was set up. This was a tiring task since the stones were ready to slide down with the slightest touch, and often we were swept down several yards by the shifting ground. Wearing soft winter boots, we risked getting our feet crushed among the large boulders. Among the rubble were patches of clay, and streams of melting water trickled down to the surface of a frozen lake.

After rising two hundred feet, we stood beneath the beacons which loomed above to a height of one hundred and twenty-eight feet. The organ-pipes were basaltic** in character but, to my great joy, I found the beacons were of sedimentary rock. After a casual examination, the details were left till the morrow.

After climbing two hundred feet, we found ourselves beneath the beacons that towered above us at a height of one hundred and twenty-eight feet. The organ-pipes were made of basalt, but to my delight, I discovered that the beacons were made of sedimentary rock. After a quick look, I decided to leave the details for tomorrow.

     ** To be exact the igneous rook was a very thick sill of dolerite,
     ** To be exact, the igneous rock was a very thick layer of dolerite,

That night we had a small celebration on raisins, chocolate and apple-rings, besides the ordinary fare of hoosh, biscuit and cocoa. Several times we were awakened by the crash of falling stones. Snow petrels had been seen coming home to their nests in the beacons, which were weathered out into small caves and crannies. From the camp we could hear their harsh cries.

That night we had a little celebration with raisins, chocolate, and apple rings, in addition to the usual hoosh, biscuits, and cocoa. Several times, we were jolted awake by the sound of falling stones. Snow petrels were spotted returning to their nests in the beacons, which had eroded into small caves and crevices. From the camp, we could hear their harsh calls.

The scene in the morning sun was a brilliant one. The great columnar rampart ran almost north and south and the tent was on its eastern side. So what was in dark shadow on the day before was now radiantly illumined.

The scene in the morning sun was stunning. The massive column-like rampart stretched almost north and south, and the tent was located on its eastern side. What had been in dark shadow the day before was now brightly lit up.

Correll remained behind on the sea-ice with a theodolite to take heights of the various strata. McLean and I, armed with aneroid, glasses, ruck-sack, geological hammer (ice-axe) and camera, set out for the foot of the talus-slope.

Correll stayed back on the sea ice with a theodolite to measure the heights of the different layers. McLean and I, equipped with an aneroid, binoculars, a backpack, a geological hammer (ice axe), and a camera, headed out towards the base of the talus slope.

The beacons were found to be part of a horizontal, stratified series of sandstones underlying the igneous rock. There were bands of coarse gravel and fine examples of stream-bedding interspersed with seams of carbonaceous shale and poor coal. Among the debris were several pieces of sandstone marked by black, fossilized plant-remains. The summits of the beacons were platforms of very hard rock, baked by the volcanic overflow. The columns, roughly hexagonal and weathered to a dull-red, stood above in sheer perpendicular lines of six hundred and sixty feet in altitude.

The beacons were discovered to be part of a layered series of sandstones below the volcanic rock. There were sections of coarse gravel and fine examples of stream beds mixed with layers of carbon-rich shale and low-quality coal. Among the debris were several pieces of sandstone marked by black, fossilized plant remains. The tops of the beacons were made of very hard rock, hardened by volcanic activity. The columns, roughly hexagonal and weathered to a dull red, rose straight up in sheer vertical lines, reaching six hundred and sixty feet high.

After taking a dozen photographs of geological and general interest and stuffing the sack and our pockets with specimens, we picked a track down the shelving talus to a lake of fresh water which was covered with a superficial crust of ice beneath which the water ran. The surface was easily broken and we fetched the aluminium cover of the cooker, filling it with three gallons of water, thus saving kerosene for almost a day.

After taking a dozen photos of geological features and interesting stuff and filling our bags and pockets with samples, we found a path down the sloping rock debris to a freshwater lake that had a thin layer of ice on top while the water flowed underneath. The surface easily cracked, so we grabbed the aluminum cover from the cooker and filled it with three gallons of water, saving us kerosene for nearly a day.

After McLean had collected samples of soil, lichens, algae and moss, and all the treasures had been labelled, we lunched and harnessed-up once more for the homeward trail.

After McLean had gathered samples of soil, lichens, algae, and moss, and all the treasures had been labeled, we had lunch and geared up once again for the journey home.

For four miles we ran parallel to the one-thousand-foot wall of Horn Bluff meeting several boulders stranded on the ice, as well as the fragile shell of a tiny sea-urchin. The promontory was domed with snow and ice, more than one thousand two hundred feet above sea-level. From it streamed a blue glacier overflowing through a rift in the face. Five miles on our way, the sledge passed from frictionless ice to rippled snow and with a march of seven miles, following lunch, we pitched camp.

For four miles, we ran alongside the one-thousand-foot wall of Horn Bluff, coming across several boulders stuck in the ice, as well as the delicate shell of a small sea urchin. The promontory was covered in snow and ice, soaring over one thousand two hundred feet above sea level. A blue glacier flowed down through a gap in the wall. After five miles, the sled transitioned from smooth ice to bumpy snow, and after marching seven miles following lunch, we set up camp.

Every one was tired that night, and our prayer to the Sleep Merchant in the book of Australian verse was for:

Every one was exhausted that night, and our prayer to the Sleep Merchant in the book of Australian poetry was for:

    Twenty gallons of balmy sleep,
    Dreamless, and deep, and mild,
    Of the excellent brand you used to keep
    When I was a little child.
    Twenty gallons of soothing sleep,
    Dreamless, deep, and gentle,
    Of the great stuff you used to have
    When I was a little kid.

For three days, December 22, 23 and 24, the wind soughed at thirty miles per hour and the sky was a compact nimbus, unveiling the sun at rare moments. Through a mist of snow we steered on a north-west course towards the one-hundred-and-fifty-two mile depot. The wind was from the south-east true, and this information, with hints from the sun-compass, gave us the direction. With the sail set, on a flat surface, among ghostly bergs and over narrow leads we ran for forty-seven miles with scarce a clear view of what lay around. The bergs had long ramps of snow leading close up to their summits on the windward side and in many cases the intervals between these ramps and the bergs were occupied by deep moats.

For three days, December 22, 23, and 24, the wind howled at thirty miles per hour, and the sky was a thick blanket of clouds, revealing the sun only occasionally. Through a haze of snow, we headed northwest towards the one-hundred-and-fifty-two-mile depot. The wind was coming from the southeast, and this information, along with clues from the sun-compass, helped us find our direction. With the sail up, on a flat surface, among ghostly icebergs and across narrow gaps, we traveled for forty-seven miles with hardly a clear view of our surroundings. The icebergs had long slopes of snow leading up to their peaks on the windward side, and in many cases, the spaces between these slopes and the icebergs were filled with deep moats.

One day we were making four knots an hour under all canvas through thick drift. Suddenly, after a gradual ascent, I was on the edge of a moat, thirty feet deep. I shouted to the others and, just in time, the sledge was slewed round on the very brink.

One day we were traveling at four knots an hour under all the sails through thick ice. Suddenly, after a slow climb, I found myself on the edge of a thirty-foot deep moat. I yelled to the others and, just in time, the sled was turned around right at the edge.

We pushed on blindly:

We kept going blindly:

    The toil of it none may share;
    By yourself must the way be won
    Through fervid or frozen air
    Till the overland journey's done.
    No one can share the struggle;
    You alone must find the way
    Through hot or icy air
    Until the long journey is complete.

Christmas Day! The day that ever reminds one of the sweet story of old, the lessons of childhood, the joys of Santa Claus—the day on which the thoughts of the wildest wanderer turn to home and peace and love. All the world was cheerful; the sun was bright, the air was calm. It was the hometrail, provisions were in plenty, the sledge was light and our hearts lighter.

Christmas Day! The day that always brings to mind the sweet story from the past, the lessons of childhood, the joys of Santa Claus—the day when even the most restless wanderer thinks of home, peace, and love. Everyone was cheerful; the sun was shining, and the air was calm. It was the way back home, supplies were plentiful, the sled was light, and our hearts were even lighter.

The eastern edge of Ninnis Glacier was near, and, leaving the sea-ice, we were soon straining up the first slope, backed by a line of ridges trending north-east and south-west, with shallow valleys intervening. On the wind-swept crests there were a few crevasses well packed with snow.

The eastern edge of Ninnis Glacier was close, and after leaving the sea ice, we were quickly making our way up the first slope, supported by a series of ridges running northeast to southwest, with shallow valleys in between. On the wind-swept peaks, there were a few crevasses filled with packed snow.

It was a day's work of twelve miles and we felt ready for Christmas dinner. McLean was cook and had put some apple-rings to soak in the cooker after the boil-up at lunch. Beyond this and the fact that he took some penguin-meat into the tent, he kept his plans in the deepest mystery. Correll and I were kept outside making things snug and taking the meteorological observations, until the word came to enter. When at last we scrambled in, a delicious smell diffused through the tent, and there was a sound of frying inside the cooker-pot. We were presented with a menu which read:

It was a day's work of twelve miles, and we were ready for Christmas dinner. McLean was the cook and had put some apple rings to soak in the cooker after boiling them at lunch. Other than this and the fact that he took some penguin meat into the tent, he kept his plans a total mystery. Correll and I were kept outside, making things cozy and taking the weather observations until we got the signal to come in. When we finally scrambled inside, a delicious smell filled the tent, and we could hear frying sounds coming from the cooker pot. We were presented with a menu that read:

              "Peace on earth, good will to men."

   Xmas 1912                               KING GEORGE V. LAND
                                 200 miles east of Winter Quarters.

                          MENU DU DINER
                           Hors d'oeuvre
  Biscuit de plasmon                  Ration du lard glace
              "Peace on earth, goodwill to everyone."

   Xmas 1912                               KING GEORGE V. LAND
                                 200 miles east of Winter Quarters.

                          DINNER MENU
                           Appetizers
  Plasmon Biscuit                  Glazed Bacon Ration
                              Entree
  Monsieur l'Empereur Pingouin fricasse

                         Piece de Resistance
  Pemmican naturel a l'Antarctique

                              Dessert
  Hotch-potch de pommes et de raisins
  Chocolat au sucre glaxone
  Liqueur bien ancienne de l'Ecosse

                Cigarettes                      Tabac
                              Entree
  Emperor Penguin Fricassee

                         Piece de Resistance
  Natural Pemmican from Antarctica

                              Dessert
  Apple and Raisin Stew
  Chocolate with Glaxone Sugar
  Well-Aged Scotch Liqueur

                Cigarettes                      Tobacco

The hors d'oeuvre of bacon ration was a welcome surprise. McLean had carried the tin unknown to us up till this moment. The penguin, fried in lumps of fat taken from the pemmican, and a little butter, was delicious. In the same pot the hoosh was boiled and for once we noted an added piquancy. Next followed the plum-pudding—dense mixture of powdered biscuit, glaxo, sugar, raisins and apple-rings, surpassing the finest, flaming, holly-decked, Christmas creation.

The bacon ration appetizer was a nice surprise. McLean had brought the tin without us knowing until now. The fried penguin, cooked in bits of fat from the pemmican and a bit of butter, was tasty. In the same pot, the hoosh was boiled, and for once, it had a little extra flavor. Next came the plum pudding—a rich mix of crushed biscuits, glaxo, sugar, raisins, and apple rings, better than the best, festive, holly-decorated Christmas dessert.

Then came the toasts. McLean produced the whisky from the medical kit and served it out, much diluted, in three mugs. There was not three ounces in all, but it flavoured the water.

Then came the toasts. McLean pulled out the whisky from the medical kit and poured it, mostly diluted, into three mugs. There wasn't even three ounces total, but it flavored the water.

I was asked to call "The King." McLean proposed "The Other Sledgers" in a noble speech, wishing them every success; and then there were a few drops left to drink to "Ourselves," whom Correll eulogized to our complete satisfaction. We then drew on the meagre supply of cigarettes and lay on our bags, feeling as comfortable as the daintiest epicure after a twelve-course dinner, drinking his coffee and smoking his cigar.

I was asked to call "The King." McLean suggested "The Other Sledgers" in a heartfelt speech, wishing them all the best; and then we had a few sips left to toast "Ourselves," which Correll praised to our total satisfaction. We then pulled out the limited supply of cigarettes and lay on our bags, feeling as content as the pickiest foodie after a fancy twelve-course meal, sipping his coffee and smoking his cigar.

We talked till twelve o'clock, and then went outside to look at the midnight sun, shining brightly just above the southern horizon. Turning in, we were once more at home in our dreams.

We talked until midnight, and then went outside to check out the midnight sun, shining brightly just above the southern horizon. As we turned in, we were once again at home in our dreams.

By a latitude shot at noon on Boxing Day, I found that our position was not as far north as expected. The following wind had been probably slightly east of south-east and too much westing had been made. From a tangle of broken ridges whose surface was often granular, half-consolidated ice, the end of the day opened up a lilac plain of sea-ice ahead. We were once more on the western side of Ninnis Glacier and the familiar coast of Penguin Point, partly hidden by an iceberg, sprang into view. The depot hill to the north-west could be recognized, twenty miles away, across a wide bay. By hooch-time we had found a secure path to the sea-ice, one hundred and eighty feet below.

By taking a latitude measurement at noon on Boxing Day, I discovered that we weren't as far north as we had thought. The following wind was probably a bit east of southeast, and we had drifted too far west. After navigating through a jumble of broken ridges covered in often granular, half-frozen ice, the end of the day revealed a lilac expanse of sea ice ahead. We were once again on the western side of Ninnis Glacier, and the familiar coastline of Penguin Point, partially obscured by an iceberg, came into view. The depot hill to the northwest was recognizable, twenty miles away across a wide bay. By hooch time, we had found a safe route down to the sea ice, which was one hundred and eighty feet below.

The wind sprang up opportunely on the morning of the 27th, and the sun was serene in a blue sky. Up went the sail and with a feather-weight load we strode off for the depot eighteen miles distant. Three wide rifts in the sea-ice exercised our ingenuity during the day's march, but by the time the sun was in the south-west the sledge was sawing through the sandy snow of the depot hill. It was unfortunate that the food of this depot had been cached so far out of our westerly course, as the time expended in recovering it might have been profitably given to a survey of the mainland east of Penguin Point. At 6.20 P.M., after eighteen and a quarter miles, the food-bag was sighted on the mound, and that night the dinner at our one-hundred-and-fifty-two-mile depot was marked by some special innovations.

The wind picked up conveniently on the morning of the 27th, and the sun was shining brightly in a clear blue sky. We raised the sail and, with a lightweight load, set off for the depot eighteen miles away. We faced three wide cracks in the sea-ice during the day's journey, but by the time the sun was in the southwest, the sled was making its way through the soft snow of the depot hill. It was unfortunate that the food at this depot was stored so far off our westward path, as the time spent retrieving it could have been better used for surveying the mainland east of Penguin Point. At 6:20 PM, after eighteen and a quarter miles, we spotted the food bag on the mound, and that night, dinner at our one-hundred-and-fifty-two-mile depot featured some special additions.

Penguin Point, thirty miles away, bore W. 15 degrees S., and next day we made a bid for it by a march of sixteen miles. There was eleven days' ration on the sledge to take us to Mount Murchison, ninety miles away; consequently the circuitous route to the land was held to be a safe "proposition."

Penguin Point, thirty miles away, was located at W. 15 degrees S., and the next day we aimed for it by marching sixteen miles. There were eleven days' worth of rations on the sled to get us to Mount Murchison, which was ninety miles away; therefore, the roundabout route to the land was considered a safe "proposition."

Many rock faces became visible, and I was able to fix numerous prominent points with the theodolite.

Many rock faces became visible, and I was able to identify several prominent points using the theodolite.

At three miles off the coast, the surface became broken by ridges, small bergs and high, narrow cupolas of ice surrounded by deep moats. One of these was very striking. It rose out of a wind-raked hollow to a height of fifty feet; just the shape of an ancient Athenian helmet. McLean took a photograph.

At three miles from the coast, the surface was disturbed by ridges, small icebergs, and tall, narrow dome-shaped ice structures surrounded by deep channels. One of these was particularly impressive. It stood tall at fifty feet, rising from a wind-swept depression and resembling an ancient Athenian helmet. McLean took a photo.

As at Horn Bluff, the ice became thinner and freer of snow as we drew near the Point. The rocky wall under which the tent was raised proved to be three hundred feet high, jutting out from beneath the slopes of ice. From here the coast ran almost south on one side and north-west on the other. On either hand there were dark faces corniced with snow.

As we approached the Point, the ice became thinner and less snowy, just like at Horn Bluff. The rocky wall where the tent was set up was three hundred feet high, sticking out from beneath the ice slopes. From this spot, the coast extended almost directly south on one side and northwest on the other. On either side, there were dark cliffs topped with snow.

The next day was devoted to exploration. Adelie penguins waddled about the tide-crack over which we crossed to examine the rock, which was of coarse-grained granite, presenting great, vertical faces. Hundreds of snow petrels flew about and some stray skua gulls were seen.

The next day was all about exploration. Adelie penguins waddled around the tide-crack that we crossed to look at the rock, which was made of coarse-grained granite and had steep, vertical faces. Hundreds of snow petrels were flying around, and we spotted a few stray skua gulls.

Near the camp, on thick ice, were several large blocks of granite which had floated out from the shore and lay each in its pool of thaw-water, covered with serpulae and lace coral.

Near the camp, on thick ice, were several large blocks of granite that had floated out from the shore and lay in their own pools of melted water, covered with serpulae and lace coral.

Correll, our Izaak Walton, had brought a fishing-line and some penguin-meat. He stopped near the camp fishing while McLean and I continued down the coast, examining the outcrops. The type of granite remained unchanged in the numerous exposures.

Correll, our Izaak Walton, had brought a fishing line and some penguin meat. He stopped near the camp to fish while McLean and I continued down the coast, checking out the rock formations. The type of granite stayed the same in the various exposures.

I had noticed a continuous rustling sound for some time and found at length that it was caused by little streams of ice-crystals running down the steep slopes in cascades, finally pouring out in piles on the sea-ice. The partial thaw in the sunlight causes the semi-solid ice to break up into separate grains. Sometimes whole areas of the surface, in delicate equilibrium, would suddenly flow rapidly away.

I had been hearing a constant rustling sound for a while and finally discovered it was due to tiny streams of ice crystals cascading down the steep slopes, eventually spilling out in piles onto the sea ice. The partial melting in the sunlight causes the semi-solid ice to break apart into individual grains. Sometimes entire sections of the surface, perfectly balanced, would suddenly flow away quickly.

For three miles we walked, and as the next four miles of visible coast presented no extensive outcrops, we turned back for lunch.

For three miles we walked, and since the next four miles of visible coastline showed no significant outcrops, we turned back for lunch.

During the afternoon, on the summit of the Point, it was found that an uneven rocky area, about a quarter of a mile wide, ran backwards to the ice-falls of the plateau. The surface was very broken and weathered, covered in patches by abundant lichens and mosses. Fossicking round in the gravel, Correll happened on some tiny insect-like mites living amongst the moss or on the moist under side of slabs of stone. This set us all insect-hunting. Alcohol was brought in a small bottle from the tent, and into this they were swept in myriads with a camel's-hair brush. From the vantage-point of a high rock in the neighbourhood the long tongue of Mertz Glacier could be seen running away to the north.

During the afternoon, at the top of the Point, we discovered that an uneven rocky area, about a quarter of a mile wide, extended back toward the icefalls of the plateau. The surface was very rough and weathered, covered in patches with abundant lichens and mosses. While sifting through the gravel, Correll found some tiny insect-like mites living among the moss or on the damp underside of stone slabs. This got us all excited about insect hunting. We brought a small bottle of alcohol from the tent, and with a camel's-hair brush, we swept them in by the thousands. From a high rock nearby, we could see the long tongue of the Mertz Glacier stretching off to the north.

At 8.30 A.M., on New Year's Eve, we set off for another line of rocks about four miles away to the west. There were two masses forming an angle in the ice-front and consisting of two main ridges rising to a height of two hundred and fifty feet, running back into the ice-cap for a mile, and divided by a small glacier.

At 8:30 A.M. on New Year's Eve, we headed out to another line of rocks about four miles to the west. There were two formations creating an angle in the ice front, made up of two main ridges that rose to a height of 250 feet, extending back into the ice cap for a mile, and separated by a small glacier.

This region was soon found to be a perfect menagerie of life. Seals lay about dozing peacefully by the narrow lanes of water. Adelie penguins strutted in procession up and down the little glacier. To reach his rookery, a penguin would leap four feet on to a ledge of the ice-foot, painfully pad up the glassy slope and then awkwardly scale the rocks until he came to a level of one hundred and fifty feet. Here he took over the care of a chick or an egg, while the other bird went to fish. Skua gulls flew about, continually molesting the rookeries. One area of the rocks was covered by a luxuriant growth of green moss covering guano and littered skeletons—the site of a deserted rookery.

This area quickly turned out to be a vibrant hub of life. Seals lounged peacefully by the narrow waterways. Adelie penguins marched back and forth on the small glacier. To reach their nesting spot, a penguin would jump four feet onto the ice ledge, struggle up the slick slope, and then clumsily climb the rocks until he reached a height of one hundred and fifty feet. There, he would take care of a chick or an egg while the other penguin went fishing. Skua gulls flew around, constantly annoying the nesting birds. One section of the rocks was covered in a rich growth of green moss over guano and scattered skeletons—the remains of an abandoned nesting site.

Correll and I went up to where the ridges converged, selecting numerous specimens of rock and mineral and finding thousands of small red mites in the moist gravel. Down on the southern ridge we happened on a Wilson petrel with feathered nestlings. At this point McLean came along from the west with the news of silver-grey petrels and Cape pigeons nesting in hundreds. He had secured two of each species and several eggs. This was indeed a discovery, as the eggs of the former birds had never before been found. Quite close to us were many snow petrels in all kinds of unexpected crevices. The light was too dull for photographing, but, while I took magnetic "dips" on the following morning, McLean visited the silver-grey petrels and Cape pigeons and secured a few "snaps."

Correll and I hiked up to where the ridges came together, picking up various rock and mineral samples and discovering thousands of tiny red mites in the damp gravel. Down on the southern ridge, we found a Wilson petrel with feathered chicks. At that moment, McLean arrived from the west with news about silver-grey petrels and Cape pigeons nesting in the hundreds. He had collected two of each species and several eggs. This was definitely a significant find, as the eggs of the former birds had never been discovered before. Close by, there were many snow petrels in all sorts of surprising crevices. The light was too dim for photography, but while I was taking magnetic "dips" the next morning, McLean visited the silver-grey petrels and Cape pigeons and managed to get a few "snaps."

The last thing we did before leaving the mainland was to kill two penguins and cut off their breasts and this meat was, later, to serve us in good stead.

The last thing we did before leaving the mainland was kill two penguins and cut off their breasts, and this meat would later be very useful to us.

Crossing the Mertz Glacier at any time would have been an unpleasant undertaking, but to go straight to Mount Murchison (the site of our first depot on the outward journey) from Penguin Point meant spanning it in a long oblique line. It was preferable to travel quickly and safely over the sea-ice on a north-westerly course, which, plotted on the chart, intersected our old one-hundred-mile camp on the eastern margin of the glacier; then to cross by the route we already knew.

Crossing the Mertz Glacier at any time would have been an unpleasant task, but going directly to Mount Murchison (the location of our first supply depot on the way out) from Penguin Point meant traversing it in a long diagonal line. It was better to move quickly and safely over the sea ice on a northwest course, which, when plotted on the map, cut through our old one-hundred-mile campsite on the eastern edge of the glacier; then to cross by the route we already knew.

By January 2 we had thrown Penguin Point five miles behind, and a spell of unsettled weather commenced; in front lay a stretch of fourteen miles over a good surface. The wind was behind us, blowing between thirty and forty miles per hour, and from an overcast sky light snow was falling. Fortunately there were fleeting glimpses of the sun, by which the course could be adjusted. Towards evening the snow had thickened, but thanks to the splendid assistance afforded by a sail, the white jutting spurs of the edge of Mertz Glacier were dimly visible.

By January 2, we had left Penguin Point five miles behind us, and a period of unstable weather began; ahead of us was a stretch of fourteen miles of good terrain. The wind was at our backs, blowing between thirty and forty miles per hour, and light snow was falling from an overcast sky. Luckily, there were brief glimpses of the sun that helped us adjust our course. By evening, the snow had become heavier, but thanks to the excellent help from a sail, the white peaks at the edge of Mertz Glacier were faintly visible.

A blizzard took possession of the next day till 7 P.M., when we all sallied out and found the identical gully in which was the one-hundred-mile camp of the outward journey. The light was still bad and the sky overcast, so the start was postponed till next morning.

A blizzard hung around until 7 P.M. the next day, when we all headed out and found the exact gully where we had set up the hundred-mile camp on the way there. The visibility was still poor and the sky was gray, so we decided to wait until the next morning to begin.

There was food for five days on a slightly reduced ration and the depot on Mount Murchison was forty miles away.

There was enough food for five days on a slightly smaller ration, and the supply depot on Mount Murchison was forty miles away.

Once we had left the sea-ice and stood on the glacier, Aurora Peak with its black crest showed through the glasses. Once there, the crevasses we most dreaded would be over and the depot easily found.

Once we had left the sea ice and stood on the glacier, we could see Aurora Peak with its dark peak through the binoculars. Once we got there, the crevasses we feared the most would be behind us, and we would easily find the supply depot.

A good fourteen and a quarter miles slipped by on January 4—a fine day. On January 5 the "plot began to thicken." The clouds hung above like a blanket, sprinkling light snow. The light was atrocious, and a few open rents gave warning of the western zone of pitfalls. All the while there was a shifting spectral chaos of whiteness which seemed to benumb the faculties and destroy one's sense of reality. We decided to wait for a change in the weather.

A good fourteen and a quarter miles passed on January 4—a great day. On January 5, the "plot started to thicken." The clouds were draped above like a blanket, lightly snowing. The visibility was terrible, and a few gaps signaled the dangerous western area ahead. Throughout it all, there was a swirling, ghostly chaos of white that seemed to dull the senses and distort reality. We decided to wait for the weather to change.

During the night the snow ceased, and by lunch time on the 6th the sledge-meter recorded ten miles. The strange thing was that the firm sastrugi present on the outward journey were now covered inches in snow, which became deeper as we marched westward.

During the night, the snow stopped, and by lunchtime on the 6th, the sledge meter showed ten miles. The odd thing was that the solid sastrugi we had encountered on the way out were now buried under inches of snow, which got deeper as we headed west.

It was now a frequent occurrence for one of us to pitch forward with his feet down a hidden crevasse, sometimes going through to the waist. The travelling was most nerve-racking. When a foot went through the crust of snow, it was impossible to tell on which side of the crevasse one happened to be, or in what direction it ran. The only thing to do was to go ahead and trust in Providence.

It had become common for one of us to suddenly fall forward with his feet down a concealed crevice, sometimes getting stuck up to his waist. Traveling like this was really stressful. When a foot broke through the snow's surface, it was impossible to know which side of the crevice you were on or how it was shaped. The only option was to keep moving forward and trust that things would work out.

At last we landed the sledge on a narrow ridge of hard snow, surrounded by blue, gaping pits in a pallid eternity of white. It was only when the tent was pitched that a wide quarry was noticed a few yards away from the door.

At last we landed the sled on a narrow ridge of hard snow, surrounded by blue, gaping holes in an endless stretch of white. It was only after we set up the tent that we spotted a large pit just a few yards from the door.

It was now fourteen miles to the top of Mount Murchison and we had only two more days' rations and one and a half pounds of penguin-meat.

It was now fourteen miles to the top of Mount Murchison, and we had just two more days’ worth of supplies and one and a half pounds of penguin meat.

On January 7th the light was worse than ever and snow fell. It was only six miles across the broken country between us and the gully between Mt. Murchison and Aurora Peak, where one could travel with some surety. A sharp look-out was kept, and towards 11 P.M. a rim of clear sky overtopped the southern horizon. We knew the sun would curve round into it at midnight, so all was made ready for marching.

On January 7th, the visibility was worse than ever, and snow was falling. It was only six miles across the rugged terrain between us and the gully between Mt. Murchison and Aurora Peak, where we could travel with some certainty. We kept a sharp lookout, and around 11 P.M., a band of clear sky appeared on the southern horizon. We knew the sun would rise into it at midnight, so everything was prepared for our march.

When the sun's disc emerged into the rift there was light; but dim, cold and fleeting. The smallest irregularity on the surface threw a shadow hundreds of yards long. The plain around was a bluish-grey checquer-board of light and shade; ahead, sharp and clear against the leaden sky, stood beautiful Aurora Peak, swathed in lustrous gold—the chariot of the goddess herself. The awful splendour of the scene tended to depress one and make the task more trying. I have never felt more nervous than I did in that ghostly light in the tense silence, surrounded by the hidden horror of fathomless depths. All was covered with a uniform layer of snow, growing deeper and heavier at every step. I was ahead and went through eight times in about four miles. The danger lay in getting the sledge and one, two, or all of us on a weak snow-bridge at the same time. As long as the sledge did not go down we were comparatively safe.

When the sun finally broke through the gap, there was light, but it was dim, cold, and fleeting. The slightest bump on the surface cast a shadow hundreds of yards long. The plain around us was a bluish-gray checkerboard of light and shadow; ahead, sharp and clear against the gray sky, stood beautiful Aurora Peak, wrapped in shining gold—the chariot of the goddess herself. The overwhelming beauty of the scene felt depressing and made the task even harder. I’ve never felt more anxious than I did in that eerie light in the tense silence, surrounded by the hidden terror of endless depths. Everything was covered with a uniform layer of snow, getting deeper and heavier with every step. I was leading and stumbled through eight times in about four miles. The danger was in getting the sledge and one, two, or all of us on a weak snow-bridge at the same time. As long as the sledge didn’t go down, we were relatively safe.

At 1.30 A.M. the sun was obscured and the light waned to dead white. Still we went on, as the entrance of the gully between Aurora Peak and Mount Murchison was near at hand and we had a mind to get over the danger-zone before a snowstorm commenced.

At 1:30 A.M., the sun was hidden, and the light faded to a dull white. Still, we pushed on, as the entrance to the gully between Aurora Peak and Mount Murchison was close, and we wanted to get through the danger zone before a snowstorm started.

By 5.30 A.M. we breathed freely on "terra firma," even though one sunk through a foot of snow to feel it. It had taken six hours to do the last five and three-quarter miles, and, being tired out with the strain on muscles and nerves, we raised the tent, had a meal, and then slept till noon on the 8th. It was eight miles to the depot, five miles up the gully and three miles to the summit of Mount Murchison; and no one doubted for a moment that it could not be done in a single day's march.

By 5:30 A.M., we were finally back on solid ground, even if it meant sinking a foot into the snow to get there. The last five and three-quarters miles took us six hours to cover, and feeling exhausted from the physical and mental strain, we set up the tent, had a meal, and then slept until noon on the 8th. It was eight miles to the depot: five miles up the gully and three miles to the top of Mount Murchison. Everyone was confident it could be done in one day's trek without a doubt.

Advancing up the gully after lunch, we found that the surface became softer, and we were soon sinking to the knees at every step. The runners, too, sank till the decking rested on the snow, and it was as much as we could do to shift the sledge, with a series of jerks at every step. At 6 P.M. matters became desperate. We resolved to make a depot of everything unnecessary, and to relay it up the mountain afterwards.

Advancing up the gully after lunch, we found that the ground got softer, and we were soon sinking to our knees with every step. The runners also sank until the decking rested on the snow, and it was a struggle to move the sledge, jerking it forward with each step. By 6 P.M., things had gotten dire. We decided to set aside everything we didn’t need and carry it up the mountain later.

The sledge-meter, clogged with snow and almost submerged, was taken off and stood up on end to mark a depot, whilst a pile was made of the dip-circle, theodolite and tripod, pick, alpine rope, ice-axe, all the mineral and biological specimens and excess clothing.

The sledge-meter, packed with snow and nearly buried, was removed and stood upright to mark a supply point, while a stack was created with the dip-circle, theodolite and tripod, pick, alpine rope, ice axe, all the mineral and biological samples, and extra clothing.

Even thus lightened, we could scarcely move the sledge, struggling on, sinking to the thighs in the flocculent deluge. Snow now began to fall so thickly that it was impossible to see ahead.

Even with that weight off, we could barely move the sled, pushing forward, sinking up to our thighs in the fluffy snow. The snow started to fall so heavily that we couldn’t see anything ahead.

At 7 P.M. we finished up the last scraps of pemmican and cocoa. Biscuit, sugar and glaxo had given out at the noon meal. There still remained one and a half pounds of penguin meat, several infusions of tea and plenty of kerosene for the primus.

At 7 P.M., we finished off the last bits of pemmican and cocoa. The biscuit, sugar, and glaxo ran out at lunchtime. There was still one and a half pounds of penguin meat left, several cups of tea, and plenty of kerosene for the primus.

We staggered on till 10.30 P.M., when the weather became so dense that the sides of the gully were invisible. Tired out, we camped and had some tea. In eight hours we had only made four and a half miles, and there was still the worst part to come.

We trudged on until 10:30 PM, when the weather got so thick that we couldn’t see the sides of the gully. Exhausted, we set up camp and had some tea. In eight hours, we had only covered four and a half miles, and the hardest part was still ahead.

In our exhausted state we slept till 11 P.M. of January 9, awaking to find the sky densely overcast and a light fog in the air. During a rift which opened for a few minutes there was a short glimpse of the rock on Aurora Peak. Shredding half the penguin-meat, we boiled it up and found the stew and broth excellent.

In our tired state, we slept until 11 P.M. on January 9, waking up to find the sky heavily clouded and a light fog in the air. During a brief moment when the clouds parted, we caught a quick glimpse of the rock on Aurora Peak. After shredding half the penguin meat, we boiled it and found the stew and broth to be excellent.

At 1.30 A.M. we started to struggle up the gully once more, wading along in a most helpless fashion, with breathing spells every ten yards or less. Snow began to fall in such volume that at last it was impossible to keep our direction with any certainty. The only thing to do was to throw up the tent as a shelter and wait. This we did till 4.30 A.M.; but there must have been a cloud-burst, for the heavy flakes toppled on to the tent like tropical rain. We got into sleeping-bags, and tried to be patient and to forget that we were hungry.

At 1:30 A.M., we started to struggle up the gully again, trudging along in a completely helpless way, taking breaks to catch our breath every ten yards or so. Snow began to fall heavily, making it impossible to keep our bearings. The only option was to set up the tent for shelter and wait it out. We did this until 4:30 A.M.; it felt like a cloudburst, as the thick flakes slammed onto the tent like tropical rain. We crawled into our sleeping bags, trying to be patient and forget our hunger.

Apparently, during our seven weeks' absence, the local precipitation had been almost continual, and snow now lay over this region in stupendous amount. Even when one sank three feet, it was not on to the firm sastrugi over which we had travelled out of the valley on the outward journey, for these lay still deeper. It was hoped that the "snowdump" did not continue over the fifty miles to the Hut, but we argued that on the windy plateau this could scarcely be possible.

Apparently, during our seven weeks away, it had been almost non-stop precipitation, and there was now a huge amount of snow covering this area. Even when we sank three feet, it wasn’t on the solid sastrugi we had crossed out of the valley on the way there, since those lay even deeper. We hoped that the "snowdump" didn’t extend the fifty miles to the Hut, but we reasoned that on the windy plateau, that was unlikely.

It was evident that without any more food, through this bottomless, yielding snow, we could never haul the sledge up to the depot, a rise of one thousand two hundred feet in three miles. One of us must go up and bring food back, and I decided to do so as soon as the weather cleared.

It was clear that without more food, we could never pull the sled up through this endless, soft snow, a climb of one thousand two hundred feet over three miles. One of us had to go up and get food, and I decided to do that as soon as the weather improved.

We found the wait for clearer weather long and trying with empty stomachs. As the tobacco-supply still held out, McLean and I found great solace in our pipes. All through the rest of the day and till 5 P.M. of the next, January 10, there was not a rift in the opaque wall of flakes. Then to our intense relief the snow stopped, the clouds rolled to the north, and, in swift transformation—a cloudless sky with bright sunshine! With the rest of the penguin-meat—a bare half-pound—we had another thin broth. Somewhat fortified, I took the food-bag and shovel, and left the tent at 5.30 A.M.

We found the wait for better weather long and exhausting with empty stomachs. Since we still had some tobacco, McLean and I took comfort in our pipes. The entire day passed and by 5 PM the next day, January 10, there was still no break in the thick wall of snowflakes. Then, to our great relief, the snow stopped, the clouds moved north, and in a quick change—we had a clear sky with bright sunshine! With the remaining penguin meat—just half a pound—we made another thin broth. Feeling a bit stronger, I grabbed the food bag and shovel, and left the tent at 5:30 AM.

Often sinking to the thighs, I felt faint at the first exertion. The tent scarcely seemed to recede as I toiled onwards towards the first steep slope. The heavy mantle of snow had so altered the contours of the side of the gully that I was not sure of the direction of the top of the mountain.

Often sinking to my thighs, I felt dizzy from the first effort. The tent barely seemed to get any smaller as I worked my way toward the first steep slope. The thick layer of snow had changed the shape of the gully's side so much that I couldn't tell which way the top of the mountain was.

Resting every hundred yards, I floundered on hour after hour, until, on arriving at a high point, I saw a little shining mound standing up on a higher point, a good mile to the east. After seven hours' wading I reached it and found that it was the depot.

Resting every hundred yards, I struggled on hour after hour, until, when I finally reached a high point, I saw a small shining mound up on a higher point, about a mile to the east. After seven hours of wading, I got to it and discovered that it was the depot.

Two feet of the original eight-foot mound projected above the surface, with the bamboo pole and a wire-and-canvas flag rising another eighteen inches. On this, a high isolated mountain summit, six feet of snow had actually accumulated. How thankful I was that I had brought a shovel!

Two feet of the original eight-foot mound stuck out above the surface, with the bamboo pole and a wire-and-canvas flag rising another eighteen inches. On this isolated mountain peak, six feet of snow had actually piled up. How grateful I was that I had brought a shovel!

At seven feet I "bottomed" on the hard snow, without result. Then, running a tunnel in the most probable direction, I struck with the shovel the kerosene tin which was on the top of the food-bag. On opening the bag, the first items to appear were sugar, butter and biscuits; the next quarter of an hour I shall not forget!

At seven feet, I hit the hard snow without any luck. Then, digging a tunnel in the most likely direction, I hit the kerosene can that was on top of the food bag with my shovel. When I opened the bag, the first things I saw were sugar, butter, and biscuits; I won't forget the next fifteen minutes!

I made a swag of five days' provisions, and, taking a direct route, attacked the three miles downhill in lengths of one hundred and fifty yards. Coming in sight of the tent, I called to my companions to thaw some water for a drink. So slow was progress that I could speak to them a quarter of an hour before reaching the tent. I had been away eleven and a half hours, covering about seven miles in all.

I packed five days' worth of supplies and took a straight path down the three miles, tackling it in hundred and fifty-yard stretches. As I spotted the tent, I shouted to my friends to heat some water for a drink. I was moving so slowly that I could talk to them a good fifteen minutes before I actually reached the tent. I had been gone for eleven and a half hours, covering about seven miles in total.

McLean and Correll were getting anxious about me. They said that they had felt the cold and were unable to sleep. Soon I had produced the pemmican and biscuit, and a scalding hoosh was made. The other two had had only a mug of penguin broth each in three days, and I had only broken my fast a few hours before them.

McLean and Correll were starting to worry about me. They said they were feeling cold and couldn’t sleep. Soon, I had prepared the pemmican and biscuit, and we made a hot stew. The other two had only each had a mug of penguin broth in three days, and I had just ended my fast a few hours before them.

After the meal, McLean and Correll started back to the cache, two miles down the gully, to select some of the geological and biological specimens and to fetch a few articles of clothing. The instruments, the greater part of the collection of rocks, crampons, sledge-meter and other odds and ends were all left behind. Coming back with the loads slung like swags they found that by walking in their old footsteps they made fair progress.

After the meal, McLean and Correll headed back to the cache, two miles down the gully, to pick up some geological and biological samples and grab a few pieces of clothing. They left behind the instruments, most of the rock collection, crampons, sledge-meter, and other miscellaneous items. On their way back with their loads slung over their shoulders, they realized that retracing their old footsteps helped them make good progress.

By 8 P.M. all had rested, every unnecessary fitting had been stripped off the sledge and the climb to the depot commenced. I went ahead in my old trail, Correll also making use of it; while McLean broke a track for himself. The work was slow and heavy; nearly six hours were spent doing those three miles.

By 8 PM, everyone was rested, and all unnecessary gear had been removed from the sled, so we began the climb to the depot. I followed my old path, and Correll used it too, while McLean made his own trail. The work was slow and exhausting; we spent nearly six hours covering those three miles.

It was a lovely evening; the yellow sun drifting through orange cloudlets behind Aurora Peak. We were in a more appreciative mood than on the last midnight march, exulting in the knowledge of ten days' provisions at hand and fifty-three miles to go to reach the Hut.

It was a beautiful evening; the yellow sun gliding through orange clouds behind Aurora Peak. We felt more grateful than during the last midnight hike, celebrating the fact that we had ten days' worth of supplies and fifty-three miles left to reach the Hut.

In the manner of the climate, a few wisps of misty rack came sailing from the south-east, the wind rose, snow commenced to fall and a blizzard held sway for almost three days. It was just as well that we had found that depot when we did.

In line with the weather, a few thin clouds drifted in from the southeast, the wind picked up, snow started to fall, and a blizzard took over for almost three days. We were fortunate to have found that depot when we did.

The fifty-three miles to the Hut melted away in the pleasures of anticipation. The first two miles, on the morning of January 14, gave us some strenuous work, but they were luxurious in comparison with what we expected; soon, however, the surface rapidly and permanently improved. A forty-mile wind from the south-east was a distinct help, and by the end of the day we had come in sight of the nunatak first seen after leaving the Hut (Madigan Nunatak).

The fifty-three miles to the Hut flew by with excitement. The first two miles on the morning of January 14 were pretty tough, but they felt easy compared to what we expected; soon enough, the surface got a lot better. A strong forty-mile wind from the southeast really helped, and by the end of the day, we spotted the nunatak we first saw after leaving the Hut (Madigan Nunatak).

In two days forty miles lay behind. Down the blue ice-slopes in slippery finnesko, and Aladdin's Cave hove in sight. We tumbled in, to be assailed by a wonderful odour which brought back orchards, shops, people—a breath of civilization. In the centre of the floor was a pile of oranges surmounted by two luscious pineapples. The Ship was in! There was a bundle of letters—Bage was back from the south—Wild had been landed one thousand five hundred miles to the west—Amundsen had reached the Pole! Scott was remaining in the Antarctic for another year. How we shouted and read all together!

In just two days, we covered forty miles. We glided down the blue ice slopes in slippery boots, and then we caught sight of Aladdin's Cave. We rushed in, greeted by a wonderful scent that reminded us of orchards, shops, and people—a hint of civilization. In the middle of the floor was a pile of oranges topped with two juicy pineapples. The Ship had arrived! There was a stack of letters—Bage was back from the south—Wild had been dropped off one thousand five hundred miles to the west—Amundsen had reached the Pole! Scott was staying in Antarctica for another year. We cheered and read everything together!





CHAPTER XVII WITH STILLWELL'S AND BICKERTON'S PARTIES

Leaving Madigan's party on November 19, when forty-six miles from the Hut, Stillwell, Hodgeman and Close of the Near-Eastern Party diverged towards a dome-shaped mountain—Mount Hunt. A broad valley lay between their position on the falling plateau and this eminence to the north-east. Looking across, one would think that the depression was slight, but the party found by aneroid that their descent was one thousand five hundred feet into a gully filled with soft, deep snow. After skimming the polished sastrugi of the uplands, the sledge ran heavily in the yielding drifts. Then a gale of wind rose behind them just as the ascent on the other side commenced, and was a valuable aid in the pull to the summit.

Leaving Madigan's party on November 19, when they were forty-six miles from the Hut, Stillwell, Hodgeman, and Close from the Near-Eastern Party veered towards a dome-shaped mountain—Mount Hunt. A wide valley lay between their location on the descending plateau and this peak to the northeast. At first glance, one might think the dip was minor, but the group discovered through an aneroid that they had dropped one thousand five hundred feet into a gully filled with soft, deep snow. After gliding over the smooth sastrugi of the uplands, the sled struggled in the soft drifts. Then a strong wind picked up behind them just as they started the climb on the other side, becoming a helpful boost as they pulled toward the summit.

From the highest point or cap of what proved to be a promontory, a wide seascape dotted with bergs was unfolded to the north. To the west the eastern cape of Commonwealth Bay was visible, and sweeping away to the north-east was the Mertz Glacier with sheer, jutting headlands succeeding one another into the distance. True bearings to these points were obtained from the camp, and, subsequently, with the help of an observation secured on the 'Aurora' during the previous year, the trend of the glacier-tongue was determined. Hodgeman made a series of illustrative sketches.

From the highest point of what turned out to be a promontory, a vast view of the sea dotted with icebergs unfolded to the north. To the west, the eastern tip of Commonwealth Bay was visible, and stretching away to the northeast was the Mertz Glacier, with steep, jutting headlands following one after another into the distance. Accurate bearings to these points were taken from the camp, and later, with the help of an observation made on the 'Aurora' the previous year, the direction of the glacier's tongue was established. Hodgeman created a series of illustrative sketches.

On November 21 the party commenced the return journey, moving directly towards Madigan Nunatak to the south-west. This nunatak had been sighted for the first time on the outward march, and there was much speculation as to what the rock would prove to be. A gradual descent for seven miles brought them on to a plain, almost at sea-level, continuous with the valley they had crossed on the 19th further to the east. On the far side of the plain a climb was commenced over some ice-spurs, and then a broad field of crevasses was encountered, some of which attained a width of fifty yards. Delayed by these and by unfavourable weather, they did not reach Madigan Nunatak until the evening of November 20.

On November 21, the group started their journey back, heading directly towards Madigan Nunatak to the southwest. This nunatak had been spotted for the first time on their outward journey, and there was a lot of curiosity about what the rock would be like. A steady decline for seven miles took them onto a plain, nearly at sea level, connected to the valley they had crossed on the 19th further east. On the other side of the plain, they began to climb over some ice ridges, and then they came across a wide area of crevasses, some as wide as fifty yards. Held up by these obstacles and bad weather, they didn’t reach Madigan Nunatak until the evening of November 20.

The outcrop—a jagged crest of rock—was found to be one hundred and sixty yards long and thirty yards wide, placed at an altitude of two thousand four hundred feet above sea-level. It is composed of grey quartzose gneiss.

The outcrop—a jagged ridge of rock—was found to be one hundred sixty yards long and thirty yards wide, sitting at an elevation of two thousand four hundred feet above sea level. It's made up of grey quartzite gneiss.

There were no signs of recent glaciation or of ice-striae, though the rock was much weathered, and all the cracks and joint-planes were filled with disintegrating material. The weathering was excessive and peculiar in contrast with that observed on fresh exposures near the Hut and at other localities near sea-level.

There were no signs of recent glaciers or ice marks, although the rock was significantly weathered, and all the cracks and joint planes were filled with crumbling material. The weathering was unusually intense and stood out when compared to what was seen on fresh surfaces near the Hut and at other locations close to sea level.

After collecting specimens and placing a small depot of food on the highest point, the party continued their way to the Hut, reaching it on November 27.

After gathering samples and leaving a small stash of food at the highest point, the group continued their journey to the Hut, arriving on November 27.

At Winter Quarters noticeable changes had taken place. The harbour ice had broken back for several hundred yards and was rotten and ready to blow out in the first strong wind; marked thawing had occurred everywhere, and many islands of rock emerged from the snow; the ice-foot was diminishing; penguins, seals, and flying birds made the place, for once, alive and busy.

At Winter Quarters, there were clear changes. The harbor ice had melted back several hundred yards and was weak and ready to break apart with the first strong wind; there was significant thawing everywhere, and many rocky islands appeared from the snow; the ice-foot was shrinking; penguins, seals, and flying birds made the place, for once, lively and bustling.

Bickerton, Whetter and Hannam carried on the routine of work; Whetter as meteorologist and Hannam as magnetician, while Bickerton was busied with the air-tractor and in preparations for sledging. Thousands of penguins' eggs had been gathered for the return voyage of the 'Aurora', or in case of detention for a second winter.

Bickerton, Whetter, and Hannam continued their regular work; Whetter as the meteorologist and Hannam as the magnetician, while Bickerton focused on the air-tractor and getting ready for sledging. Thousands of penguin eggs had been collected for the return trip of the 'Aurora', or in case they had to stay another winter.

Murphy, Hunter and Laseron arrived from the south on the same day as Stillwell, Hodgeman and Close came in from the east. The former party had plodded for sixty-seven miles through a dense haze of drift. They had kept a course roughly by the wind and the direction of sastrugi. The unvarying white light of thick overcast days had been so severe that all were suffering from snow-blindness. When, at length, they passed over the endless billows of snow on to the downfalls near the coast, the weather cleared and they were relieved to see once more the Mecca of all sledging parties—Aladdin's Cave.

Murphy, Hunter, and Laseron arrived from the south on the same day that Stillwell, Hodgeman, and Close came in from the east. The first group had trudged for sixty-seven miles through a thick haze of drifting snow. They had maintained their course roughly by the wind and the direction of the sastrugi. The constant white light of the overcast days had been so harsh that everyone was suffering from snow-blindness. When they finally moved over the endless waves of snow to the downfalls near the coast, the weather cleared, and they were relieved to see once again the Mecca of all sledging parties—Aladdin's Cave.

A redistribution of parties and duties was made. Hodgeman joined Whetter and Bickerton in preparation for the air-tractor sledge's trip to the west. Hunter took up the position of meteorologist and devoted all his spare time to biological investigations amongst the immigrant life of summer. Hannam continued to act as magnetician and general "handy man." Murphy, who was also to be in charge during the summer, returned to his stores, making preparations for departure. Hourly meteorological observations kept every one vigilant at the Hut.

A reorganization of roles and responsibilities was carried out. Hodgeman teamed up with Whetter and Bickerton to prepare for the air-tractor sledge's journey to the west. Hunter took on the role of meteorologist and spent all his free time researching the biological diversity of the summer's immigrant life. Hannam continued his work as the magnetician and general "handy man." Murphy, who was also set to be in charge over the summer, went back to his supplies to make preparations for departure. Hourly weather observations kept everyone alert at the Hut.

In pursuance of a plan to examine in detail the coast immediately east of Commonwealth Bay, Stillwell set out with Laseron and Close on December 9. The weather was threatening at the start, and they had the usual struggle with wind and drift to "make" Aladdin's Cave.

In line with a plan to closely study the coast just east of Commonwealth Bay, Stillwell set out with Laseron and Close on December 9. The weather was looking grim at the beginning, and they faced the usual battle with wind and drift to reach Aladdin's Cave.

Forewarned on the first journey of the dangers of bad ventilation, they cleared the entrance to the cave of obstacles so that a ready exit could be made, if, as was expected, the opening became sealed with snow-drift. This did happen during the night, and, though everything seemed all right the next morning, the whole party was overpowered during breakfast by foul air, the presence of which was not suspected.

Forewarned on their first journey about the dangers of poor ventilation, they cleared the entrance to the cave of any obstacles so that they could quickly escape if, as expected, the opening got blocked by snow. This did happen overnight, and although everything seemed fine the next morning, the whole group was overwhelmed by bad air during breakfast, which they hadn't suspected at all.

Hoosh was cooked and about to be served, when Stillwell, who was in charge of the primus, collapsed. Close immediately seized an ice-axe, stood up, thrust its point through the choked entrance, and fell down, overcome. Laseron became powerless at the same time. An hour and a half later—so it was reckoned—the party revived and cleared the opening. The hole made by the ice-axe had been sufficient to save their lives. For a day they were too weak and exhausted to travel, so the tent was pitched and the night spent outside the Cave.

Hoosh was cooked and ready to be served when Stillwell, who was in charge of the stove, collapsed. Close quickly grabbed an ice axe, stood up, shoved the point through the blocked entrance, and then fell, overcome. Laseron also became powerless at that moment. About an hour and a half later—so it was said—the group revived and cleared the opening. The hole made by the ice axe had been enough to save their lives. For a day, they were too weak and exhausted to travel, so they set up the tent and spent the night outside the Cave.

On December 11 they steered due south for a while and then eastward for three days to Madigan Nunatak; delayed for twenty-four hours by a blizzard.

On December 11, they headed straight south for a bit and then east for three days to Madigan Nunatak, held up for twenty-four hours by a snowstorm.

Stillwell goes on to describe: "Part of the 15th was spent in making observations, taking photographs and collecting specimens of rocks and lichens. Breaking camp, we set out on a northerly course for the coast down gently falling snowfields. Gradually there opened up a beautiful vista of sea, dotted with floes and rocky islets (many of which were ice-capped). On December 16 camp was pitched near the coast on a stretch of firm, unbroken ice, which enabled one to venture close enough to the edge to discover an islet connected by a snow-ramp with the icy barrier. Lying farther off the shore was a thick fringe of islets, among and beyond which drifted a large quantity of heavy floe. The separate floes stood some ten or fifteen feet above the water-level, and the lengths of several exceeded a quarter of a mile. Every accessible rock was covered with rookeries of Adelie penguins; the first chicks were just hatched."

Stillwell describes: "Part of the 15th was spent making observations, taking photos, and collecting rock and lichen samples. After breaking camp, we headed north towards the coast down gently sloping snowfields. Gradually, a stunning view of the sea opened up, dotted with ice floes and rocky islets (many of which were capped with ice). On December 16, we set up camp near the coast on a stretch of solid, unbroken ice, which allowed us to get close enough to the edge to spot an islet linked by a snow ramp to the icy barrier. Off the shore was a dense line of islets, among and beyond which drifted a large number of heavy ice floes. The separate floes were about ten to fifteen feet above the water level, and several were over a quarter of a mile long. Every accessible rock was covered with nesting Adelie penguins; the first chicks had just hatched."

A theodolite traverse was run to fix the position of each islet. The traverse-line was carried close to the ice-cliff, so that the number of islets hidden from view was as few as possible. Snow mounds were built at intervals and the intervening distances measured by the sledge-meter.

A theodolite traverse was conducted to determine the position of each islet. The traverse line was run near the ice cliff, ensuring that as few islets as possible were obscured from view. Snow mounds were created at intervals, and the distances between them were measured using a sledge meter.

The party travelled west for seven and a quarter miles round a promontory—Cape Gray—until the Winter Quarters were sighted across Commonwealth Bay. They then turned eastward over the higher slopes, meeting the coast some three miles to the east of the place where they had first encountered it. The surface was for the most part covered with snow, while crevasses were frequent and treacherous.

The group traveled west for seven and a quarter miles around a point—Cape Gray—until they spotted the Winter Quarters across Commonwealth Bay. They then turned east over the higher slopes, reaching the coast about three miles east of where they had first encountered it. The surface was mostly covered in snow, and crevasses were common and dangerous.

In the midst of the survey the sledge-meter broke down, and, as the party were wholly dependent upon it for laying out base-lines, repairs had to be made.

In the middle of the survey, the sledge-meter broke down, and since the team was entirely reliant on it for setting up base lines, repairs needed to be made.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Map showing the remarkable distribution of islets fringing the coast of Adelie Land in the vicinity of Cape Gray

Map showing the impressive spread of islets along the coast of Adelie Land near Cape Gray.

On the 27th another accessible rocky projection was seen. Over it and the many islands in the vicinity hovered flocks of snow petrels and occasional Antarctic and Wilson petrels. Masses of Adelie penguins and chicks constituted the main population, and skua gulls with eggs were also observed. The rock was of garnet gneiss, traversed by black dykes of pyroxene granulite.

On the 27th, we spotted another accessible rocky outcrop. Flocks of snow petrels, along with occasional Antarctic and Wilson petrels, were flying over it and the many nearby islands. Large groups of Adelie penguins and their chicks made up the main population, and we also saw skua gulls with eggs. The rock was composed of garnet gneiss, crossed by black dykes of pyroxene granulite.

A great discovery was made on December 29. On the abrupt, northern face of some rocks connected to the ice-cap of the mainland by a causeway of ice a large colony of sea-birds had nested. Cape pigeons, the rare silver-grey and snow petrels were all present. Amongst these Laseron made a collection of many eggs and birds.

A significant discovery was made on December 29. On the steep northern side of some rocks linked to the mainland ice-cap by an ice causeway, a large colony of seabirds had settled. Cape pigeons, the rare silver-grey petrels, and snow petrels were all there. Among these, Laseron collected various eggs and birds.

The traverse-line was then carried back to Madigan Nunatak along a series of connecting mounds. After being held up for three and a half days in a blizzard from December 31 to January 4, the party were home once more late on January 5, 1913.

The traverse line was then taken back to Madigan Nunatak along a series of connecting mounds. After being stuck for three and a half days in a blizzard from December 31 to January 4, the group was home once again late on January 5, 1913.

Returning to the fortunes of the air-tractor sledge, which was to start west early in December. Bickerton has a short story to tell, inadequate to the months of work which were expended on that converted aeroplane. Its career was mostly associated with misfortune, dating from a serious fall when in flight at Adelaide, through the southern voyage of the 'Aurora', buffeted by destructive seas, to a capacious snow shelter in Adelie Land—the Hangar—where for the greater part of the year it remained helpless and drift-bound.

Returning to the story of the air-tractor sledge, which was set to head west in early December. Bickerton has a brief tale to share, one that hardly matches the months of effort that went into converting that airplane. Its journey was mostly marked by bad luck, starting with a severe fall while flying in Adelaide, going through the southern voyage of the 'Aurora', battered by rough seas, to a spacious snow shelter in Adelie Land—the Hangar—where it stayed mostly stranded and unable to move for the bulk of the year.

Bickerton takes up the story:

Bickerton shares the story:

I had always imagined that the air-tractor sledge would be most handicapped by the low temperature; but the wind was far more formidable. It is obvious that a machine which depends on the surrounding air for its medium of traction could not be tested in the winds of an Adelie Land winter. One might just as well try the capabilities of a small motor-launch in the rapids at Niagara. Consequently we had to wait until the high summer.

I always thought the air-tractor sledge would struggle the most with the low temperatures, but the wind was even more challenging. It's clear that a machine relying on the surrounding air for traction can't be tested in the winter winds of Adelie Land. It would be like trying to see how a small motorboat performs in the rapids at Niagara. So, we had to wait until high summer.

With hopes postponed to an indefinite future, another difficulty arose. As it was found that the wind would not allow the sea-ice to form, breaking up the floe as quickly as it appeared, the only remaining field for manoeuvres was over the highlands to the south; under conditions quite different from those for which it was suited. We knew that for the first three miles there was a rise of some one thousand four hundred feet, and in places the gradient was one in three and a half. I thought the machine would negotiate this, but it was obviously unsafe to make the venture without providing against a headlong rush downhill, if, for any reason, power should fail.

With hopes pushed to an uncertain future, another challenge emerged. It became clear that the wind wouldn't let the sea-ice form, breaking up the floe as quickly as it formed. The only remaining option for maneuvering was over the highlands to the south, under conditions that were quite different from what we had prepared for. We knew that for the first three miles, there was a rise of about one thousand four hundred feet, and at some points, the slope was one in three and a half. I believed the machine could handle this, but it was obviously risky to attempt it without precautions against a sudden rush downhill if, for any reason, the power failed.

Suggestions were not lacking, and after much consideration the following device was adopted:

Suggestions were plentiful, and after careful thought, the following device was chosen:

A hand rock-drill, somewhat over an inch in diameter, was turned up in the lathe, cut with one-eighth-inch pitched, square threads and pointed at the lower end. This actuated through an internal threaded brass bush held in an iron standard; the latter being bolted to the after-end of a runner over a hole bushed for the reception of the drill. Two sets of these were got ready; one for each runner.

A hand rock drill, just over an inch in diameter, was shaped on the lathe, featuring one-eighth-inch pitched, square threads and pointed at the bottom. It was operated through an internally threaded brass bushing secured in an iron stand; the stand was bolted to the back end of a runner above a hole fitted for the drill. Two sets of these were prepared, one for each runner.

The standards were made from spare caps belonging to the wireless masts. The timely fracture of one of the vices supplied me with sufficient ready-cut thread of the required pitch for one brake. Cranked handles were fitted, and the points, which came in contact with the ice, were hardened and tempered. When protruded to their fullest extent, the spikes extended four inches below the runners.

The standards were created using extra caps from the wireless masts. The timely breakage of one of the vices provided me with enough pre-cut thread of the right pitch for one brake. I attached cranked handles, and the points that touched the ice were hardened and tempered. When fully extended, the spikes went four inches below the runners.

The whole contrivance was not very elegant, but impressed one with its strength and reliability. To work the handles, two men had to sit one on each runner. As the latter were narrow and the available framework, by which to hold on and steady oneself, rather limited, the office of brakesman promised to be one with acrobatic possibilities.

The whole setup wasn’t very stylish, but it made an impression with its strength and reliability. To operate the handles, two men had to sit on each runner. Since the runners were narrow and there wasn’t much framework to hold on to for balance, the job of brakesman seemed to involve a lot of acrobatics.

To start the engine it was necessary to have a calm and, preferably, sunny day; the engine and oil-tank had been painted black to absorb the sun's heat. On a windy day with sun and an air temperature of 30 degrees F., it was only with considerable difficulty that the engine could be turned—chiefly owing to the thickness of the lubricating oil. But on a calm day with the temperature lower -20 degrees F. for example—the engine would swing well enough to permit starting, after an hour or two of steady sun. If there were no sun even in the absence of wind, starting would be out of the question, unless the atmospheric temperature were high or the engine were warmed with a blow-lamp.

To start the engine, it was essential to have a calm and preferably sunny day; the engine and oil tank had been painted black to soak up the sun's heat. On a windy day with sunshine and an air temperature of 30°F, it was pretty difficult to crank the engine—mainly because of the thickness of the lubricating oil. But on a calm day with a lower temperature—like -20°F, for instance—the engine would turn over enough to allow for starting after an hour or two of steady sunlight. If there was no sun, even without wind, starting the engine would be impossible unless the temperature was high or the engine was warmed up with a blowtorch.

It was not till November 15 that the right combination of conditions came. That day was calm and sunny, and the engine needed no more stimulus than it would have received in a "decent" climate.

It wasn’t until November 15 that the perfect combination of conditions arrived. That day was calm and sunny, and the engine required no more encouragement than it would have in a “normal” climate.

Hannam, Whetter and I were the only inhabitants of the Hut at the time. Having ascertained that the oil and air pumps were working satisfactorily, we fitted the wheels and air-rudder, and made a number of satisfactory trials in the vicinity of the Hut.

Hannam, Whetter, and I were the only people living in the Hut at that time. After making sure that the oil and air pumps were functioning properly, we attached the wheels and air-rudder, and conducted several successful tests around the Hut.

The wheels were soon discarded as useless; reliance being placed on the long runners. Then the brakes were tested for the first time by driving for a short distance uphill to the south and glissading down the slope back to the Hut. With a man in charge of each brake, the machine, when in full career down the slope, was soon brought to a standstill. The experiment was repeated from a higher position on the slope, with the same result. The machine was then taken above the steepest part of the slope (one in three and a half) and, on slipping back, was brought to rest with ease. The surface was hard, polished blue ice. The air-rudder, by the way, was efficient at speeds exceeding fifteen miles per hour.

The wheels were quickly thrown away as they proved useless; they relied on the long runners instead. Then the brakes were tested for the first time by driving a short distance uphill to the south and then sliding back down to the Hut. With one person in charge of each brake, the machine was quickly brought to a stop when it was going full speed down the slope. The test was repeated from a higher spot on the slope, with the same successful outcome. The machine was then taken above the steepest part of the slope (one in three and a half) and, when it slid back, it was stopped easily. The surface was hard, polished blue ice. By the way, the air-rudder worked well at speeds over fifteen miles per hour.

On the 20th we had a calm morning, so Whetter and I set out for Aladdin's Cave to depot twenty gallons of benzene and six gallons of oil. The engine was not running well, one cylinder occasionally "missing." But, in spite of this and a head wind of fifteen miles per hour, we covered the distance between the one-mile and the two-mile flags in three minutes. This was on ice, and the gradient was about one in fifteen. We went no farther that day, and it was lucky that we did so, for, soon after our return to the Hut, it was blowing more than sixty miles per hour.

On the 20th, we had a calm morning, so Whetter and I headed out to Aladdin's Cave to drop off twenty gallons of benzene and six gallons of oil. The engine wasn't running smoothly, with one cylinder occasionally "missing." But despite that and a headwind of fifteen miles per hour, we made it the distance between the one-mile and two-mile flags in three minutes. This was on ice, and the slope was about one in fifteen. We didn’t go any farther that day, and it was a good thing we didn’t because, shortly after we got back to the Hut, the wind picked up to over sixty miles per hour.

On December 2 Hodgeman joined us in a very successful trip to Aladdin's Cave with nine 8-gallon tins of benzene on a sledge; weighing in all seven hundred pounds.

On December 2, Hodgeman joined us on a very successful trip to Aladdin's Cave with nine 8-gallon cans of benzene on a sled, weighing a total of seven hundred pounds.

After having such a good series of results with the machine, the start of the real journey was fixed for December 3. At 3 P.M. it fell calm, and we left at 4 P.M., amid an inspiriting demonstration of goodwill from the six other men. Arms were still waving violently as we crept noisily over the brow of the hill and the Hut disappeared from sight.

After getting such great results with the machine, the real journey was set to begin on December 3. It became calm at 3 P.M., and we left at 4 P.M., amidst an uplifting display of support from the six other men. Arms were still waving enthusiastically as we quietly made our way over the top of the hill and the Hut faded from view.

On the two steepest portions it was necessary to walk, but, these past, the machine went well with a load of three men and four hundred pounds, reaching Aladdin's Cave in an hour by a route free of small crevasses, which I had discovered on the previous day. Here we loaded up with three 100-lb. food-bags, twelve gallons of oil (one hundred and thirty pounds), and seven hundred pounds of benzene. Altogether, there was enough fuel and lubricating oil to run the engine at full speed for twenty hours as well as full rations for three men for six weeks.

On the two steepest sections, we had to walk, but once we got past those, the machine handled a load of three men and four hundred pounds effortlessly, reaching Aladdin's Cave in an hour via a path clear of small crevasses that I had found the day before. Here, we loaded three 100-pound food bags, twelve gallons of oil (totaling one hundred and thirty pounds), and seven hundred pounds of benzene. In total, we had enough fuel and oil to run the engine at full speed for twenty hours and enough rations for three men for six weeks.

After a few minutes spent in disposing the loads, our procession of machine, four sledges (in tow) and three men moved off. The going was slow, too slow—about three miles an hour on ice. This would probably mean no movement at all on snow which might soon be expected. But something was wrong. The cylinder which had been missing fire a few days before, but which had since been cleaned and put in order, was now missing fire again, and the speed, proportionately, had dropped too much.

After a few minutes of organizing the loads, our convoy of machinery, four sleds (in tow), and three men set off. The pace was slow, too slow—about three miles per hour on ice. This would likely mean no movement at all on snow, which we might encounter soon. But something was off. The cylinder that had been misfiring a few days earlier, which had since been cleaned and fixed, was misfiring again, and the speed had dropped significantly.

I made sure that the oil was circulating, and cleaned the sparking-plug, but the trouble was not remedied. A careful examination showed no sufficient cause, so it was assumed to be internal. To undertake anything big was out of the question, so we dropped thirty-two gallons of benzene and a spare propeller. Another mile went by and we came to snow, where forty gallons of benzene, twelve gallons of oil and a sledge were abandoned. The speed was now six miles an hour and we did two miles in very bad form. As it was now 11 P.M. and the wind was beginning to rise, we camped, feeling none too pleased with the first day's results.

I made sure the oil was circulating and cleaned the spark plug, but the problem didn’t get fixed. A careful check didn’t reveal any obvious issues, so we figured it was something internal. Tackling anything major was out of the question, so we jettisoned thirty-two gallons of benzene and a spare propeller. After another mile, we hit snow, where we left behind forty gallons of benzene, twelve gallons of oil, and a sled. Our speed was now six miles an hour, and we covered two miles in really bad shape. Since it was now 11 P.M. and the wind was starting to pick up, we set up camp, feeling pretty disappointed with how the first day went.

While in the sleeping-bag I tried to think out some rapid way of discovering what was wrong with the engine. The only conclusion to which I could come was that it would be best to proceed to the cave at eleven and three-quarter miles—Cathedral Grotto—and there remove the faulty cylinder, if the weather seemed likely to be favourable; if it did not, to go on independently with our man-hauled sledge.

While in the sleeping bag, I tried to figure out a quick way to find out what was wrong with the engine. The only conclusion I could reach was that it would be best to head to the cave at eleven and three-quarter miles—Cathedral Grotto—and there take out the faulty cylinder, if the weather looked promising; if not, I would continue on my own with our man-hauled sled.

On December 4 the wind was still blowing about twenty miles per hour when we set to work on the machine. I poured some oil straight into the crank-case to make sure that there was sufficient, and we also tested and improved the ignition. At four o'clock the wind dropped, and in an hour the engine was started. While moving along, the idle cylinder was ejecting oil, and this, together with the fact that it had no compression, made me hope that broken piston-rings were the source of the trouble. It would only take two hours to remove three cylinders, take one ring from each of the two sound ones for the faulty one, and all might yet be well!

On December 4, the wind was still blowing at about twenty miles per hour when we started working on the machine. I poured some oil directly into the crankcase to ensure there was enough, and we also tested and improved the ignition. At four o'clock, the wind calmed down, and within an hour, the engine was started. As we moved along, the idle cylinder was spitting out oil, and the fact that it had no compression made me think that broken piston rings were causing the issue. It would only take two hours to remove three cylinders, take one ring from each of the two good ones for the faulty one, and everything might still turn out okay!

These thoughts were brought to a sudden close by the engine, without any warning, pulling up with such a jerk that the propeller was smashed. On moving the latter, something fell into the oil in the crank-case and fizzled, while the propeller could only be swung through an angle of about 30°. We did not wait to examine any further, but fixed up the man-hauling sledge, which had so far been carried by the air-tractor sledge, and cached all except absolute necessities.

These thoughts were abruptly interrupted by the engine, which suddenly stopped with such a jolt that the propeller broke. As we moved it, something fell into the oil in the crank-case and sizzled, while the propeller could only be turned through an angle of about 30°. We didn’t stick around to check further, but instead set up the man-hauling sled that had been carried by the air-tractor sled, and stored everything except for the essentials.

We were sorry to leave the machine, though we had never dared to expect a great deal from it in the face of the unsuitable conditions found to prevail in Adelie Land. However, the present situation was disappointing.

We were sad to leave the machine, even though we never really expected much from it given the tough conditions in Adelie Land. Still, the current situation was disappointing.

Having stuffed up the exhaust-pipes to keep out the drift, we turned our backs to the aero-sledge and made for the eleven-and-three-quarter-mile cave, arriving there at 8 P.M. There was a cheering note from Bage in the "Grotto", wishing us good luck.

Having blocked the exhaust pipes to keep out the snow, we turned away from the aero-sledge and headed for the eleven-and-three-quarter-mile cave, getting there at 8 PM. Bage in the "Grotto" sent us a cheerful message wishing us good luck.

To avoid crevasses we steered first of all to the southwest on the morning of the 5th, which was clear and bright. After six miles the sastrugi became hard and compact, so the course was changed to due west. Shortly afterwards, a piece of rock ** which we took to be a meteorite, was found on the surface of the snow. It measured approximately five inches by three inches by three and a half inches and was covered with a black scale which in places had blistered; three or four small pieces of this scale were lying within three inches of the main piece. Most of the surface was rounded, except one face which looked as if it had been fractured. It was lying on the snow, in a slight depression, about two and a half inches below the mean surface, and there was nothing to indicate that there had been any violent impact.

To avoid crevasses, we headed southwest first thing in the morning on the 5th, which was clear and bright. After six miles, the sastrugi became hard and compact, so we changed our course to due west. Shortly after, we found a piece of rock ** that we believed was a meteorite lying on the surface of the snow. It measured about five inches by three inches by three and a half inches and was covered with a black scale that had blistered in some areas; three or four small pieces of this scale were found within three inches of the main piece. Most of the surface was rounded, except for one side that looked fractured. It was resting on the snow in a slight dip, about two and a half inches below the average surface, and there was no sign of any violent impact.

     ** This has since been examined by Professor E. Skeats and
Stillwell, who report it to be an interesting form of meteorite,
containing amongst other minerals, plagioclase felspar. This is, we
believe, the first occasion on which a meteorite has been found in the
Antarctic regions.—ED.
     ** This has since been analyzed by Professor E. Skeats and Stillwell, who report that it is an intriguing type of meteorite, containing several minerals, including plagioclase feldspar. We believe this is the first time a meteorite has been discovered in the Antarctic regions.—ED.

At eight o'clock that night we had done twelve miles, losing sight of the sea at a height of about three thousand feet. All felt pleased and looked forward to getting over a ridge ahead, which, from an altitude of four thousand feet, ran in pencilled outline to the western point of Commonwealth Bay.

At eight o'clock that night, we had covered twelve miles, leaving the sea behind at an elevation of around three thousand feet. Everyone felt good and eagerly anticipated crossing a ridge ahead, which, from four thousand feet up, extended in a faint line to the western edge of Commonwealth Bay.

On December 6 it was drifting hard, and part of the morning was spent theorizing on our prospects in an optimistic vein. This humour gradually wore off as the thick drift continued, with a fifty-mile wind, for three days.

On December 6, it was blowing hard, and we spent part of the morning speculating about our prospects in a hopeful mood. This optimism gradually faded as the heavy snow drift continued, along with a fifty-mile-per-hour wind, for three days.

At 5 P.M. on December 8 a move was made. The drift was what our Hut-standard reckoned to be "moderate," but the wind had fallen to thirty miles an hour and had veered to the east; so the sail was hoisted. The going was difficult over a soft surface, and after five hours, by which time the drift had perceptibly thickened, we had done eight miles.

At 5 PM on December 8, we made a move. The drift was what our Hut-standard considered "moderate," but the wind had dropped to thirty miles an hour and shifted to the east, so we hoisted the sail. The ground was tough going over a soft surface, and after five hours, by which point the drift had noticeably thickened, we covered eight miles.

The thirst each one of us developed in those earlier days was prodigious. When filling the cooker with snow it was hard to refrain from packing it "up to the knocker" in order to obtain a sufficient supply of water.

The thirst we all experienced back in those days was incredible. When we filled the cooker with snow, it was tough to resist packing it "up to the knocker" to get enough water.

The next day it blew harder and drifted thicker. Above the loud flapping of the tent and the incessant sizzling of the drift we discussed our situation. We were one week "out" and had travelled thirty-one miles. Future progress depended entirely on the weather—unfortunately. We were beginning to learn that though the season was "meteorologically" called summer, it was hardly recognizable as such.

The next day, the wind picked up even more and the snow piled up thicker. Amidst the loud flapping of the tent and the constant hiss of the drifting snow, we talked about our situation. We were one week in and had covered thirty-one miles. Our ability to move forward was completely dependent on the weather—unfortunately. We were starting to realize that, even though the season was technically called summer, it barely looked like it.

December 10 was Whetter's birthday. It was heralded by an extra strong wind and the usual liberal allowance of drift. I was cook, and made some modifications in the meal. Hodgeman (who was the previous cook) used to make hoosh as thick as a biscuit, so we had some thin stuff for a change —two mugs each. Then really strong tea; we boiled it for some time to make sure of the strength and added some leaves which had already done good service.

December 10 was Whetter's birthday. It arrived with a powerful wind and the usual amount of drift. I was the cook and decided to tweak the meal a bit. Hodgeman, who was the previous cook, used to make the hoosh as thick as a biscuit, so we had some thinner stuff for a change—two mugs each. Then we had really strong tea; we boiled it for a while to ensure it was strong enough and added some leaves that had already been used before.

Several times fault had been found with the way the tent was pitched. I had not yet tried my hand at being the "man inside" during this operation. One day, while every one was grumbling, I said I would take the responsibility at the next camp; the proposal being received with grunts of assent. When the job was finished and the poles appeared to be spread taut, I found myself alone in what seemed to me a cathedral. Feeling pleased, I called for the others to come in, and arranged myself in a corner with an "I-told-you-so" expression on my face, ready to receive their congratulations. Hodgeman came in first. He is not a large man, though he somehow gives one the impression that he is, but after he had made himself comfortable the place seemed smaller. When half-way through the "spout," coming in, he gave a grunt which I took to be one of appreciation. Then Whetter came in. He is of a candid disposition: "Ho, ho, laddie, what the dickens have you done with the tent?"

Several times, people had criticized how the tent was set up. I hadn’t yet tried being the one inside while this was happening. One day, while everyone was complaining, I said I would take charge at the next camp; the suggestion was met with grunts of approval. Once the job was done and the poles looked tight, I found myself alone in what felt like a cathedral. Feeling proud, I called for the others to come in and positioned myself in a corner with an "I-told-you-so" look on my face, ready for their praise. Hodgeman was the first to enter. He isn’t a tall guy, though he somehow gives the impression that he is, but once he settled in, the space felt smaller. As he was coming through the entrance, he let out a grunt that I took to mean he liked it. Then Whetter walked in. He’s pretty straightforward: "Ho, ho, buddy, what on earth have you done with the tent?"

I tried to explain their mistake. But it was no good. When we were all inside, I couldn't help seeing that the tent was much smaller than it had ever been before, and we had to huddle together most uncomfortably. And there were three days like this.

I tried to explain their mistake. But it didn’t help. Once we were all inside, I couldn't help but notice that the tent was way smaller than it had ever been before, and we had to squeeze together very uncomfortably. And it was like this for three days.

At nine o'clock one morning Hodgeman woke me with, "What about getting a move on?" The wind had dropped to forty miles an hour, and through a tiny hole in the tent the ground could be seen. Amid a thinning fog of drift, the disc of the sun was just visible.

At nine o'clock one morning, Hodgeman woke me up saying, "What about getting a move on?" The wind had calmed to forty miles an hour, and through a small hole in the tent, I could see the ground. Through a fading fog of drift, the sun was just barely visible.

We made a start and then plodded on steadily till midnight over a soft and uncomfortable surface. Shortly after that hour I looked at the sledge-meter and found that it had ceased working; the sprocket had been knocked off. Repair was out of the question, as every joint was soldered up; so without more ado we dropped it. In future we were to estimate our speed, having already had some good experience in this way.

We got going and then kept moving steadily until midnight over a soft and uncomfortable surface. Shortly after that time, I checked the sledge-meter and realized it had stopped working; the sprocket had come off. Repairing it was impossible since every joint was soldered shut, so without hesitation, we abandoned it. From then on, we would estimate our speed since we already had some good experience doing that.

No sooner had Friday December 13 come on the scene than a catastrophe overtook us. The superstitious might have blamed Fate, but on this occasion there was no room for doubt; the fault was mine. The sail was up and, while braking the load upwind, I slipped and fell, allowing the sledge to collide with a large sastruga. The bow struck the solid snow with such force that it was smashed.

No sooner had Friday, December 13, arrived than disaster struck. The superstitious might have blamed Fate, but this time there was no doubt; it was my fault. The sail was up and, while trying to slow the load upwind, I slipped and fell, causing the sledge to hit a large sastruga. The bow hit the hard snow so forcefully that it broke.

Next day a new bow was manufactured from a spare bamboo which had been brought as a depot pole. It took some time splitting and bending this into position and then lashing it with raw hide. But the finished article fully justified the means, and, in spite of severe treatment, the makeshift stood for the rest of the journey.

Next day, a new bow was made from a spare bamboo that had been brought as a depot pole. It took some time to split and shape it into position, then lash it with rawhide. But the finished product fully justified the effort, and despite being treated roughly, the makeshift bow held up for the rest of the journey.

While on the march on December 16, the wind dropped and the drift ceased for the first time since December 5; for eleven days it had been heavy or moderate. Before we got into harness on the same day, a Wilson petrel flew above us. This little touch of life, together with the bright sun, light wind and lack of drift enabled us to start away in better spirits than had been our wont.

While we were marching on December 16, the wind calmed down and the snow stopped drifting for the first time since December 5; it had been heavy or moderate for eleven days. Before we got ready to go that day, a Wilson's petrel flew overhead. This small sign of life, along with the bright sun, gentle wind, and absence of drift, allowed us to set off in better spirits than we usually had.

The next four days passed in excellent weather. The surface was mainly hard and the clusters of large sastrugi could generally be avoided. Patches of softer "piecrust" were met but only lasted for two or three miles. Making up for lost time, we did a few miles short of one hundred in five days.

The next four days went by with great weather. The ground was mostly hard, and we were usually able to dodge the big sastrugi. We encountered some softer "piecrust" areas, but they only lasted a couple of miles. Making up for the time we lost, we covered just under a hundred miles in five days.

Unfortunately there was always drift at midday, so that it was impossible to get a latitude "shot" with a sextant and artificial horizon.

Unfortunately, there was always drift at noon, making it impossible to take a latitude reading with a sextant and artificial horizon.

On December 19 camp was pitched at 1 A.M. before a glorious view; an horizon of sea from west to north-east and white fields of massive bergs. In the extreme west there was something which very closely resembled pack-ice.

On December 19, camp was set up at 1 A.M. in front of a stunning view; a horizon of ocean stretching from west to northeast and vast fields of massive icebergs. In the far west, there was something that looked a lot like pack ice.

On the 20th the surface was softer and the snow more recent, but the wind was behind us and for part of the day the track led downhill into a peculiar saucer-shaped depression which, on our first entry, looked like a valley closed at the far end, while when we came to the middle it resolved itself once more into a saucer.

On the 20th, the ground was softer and the snow was fresher, but the wind was at our backs. For part of the day, the path went downhill into a strange saucer-shaped dip that, when we first entered, seemed like a valley closing off at the far end. However, when we reached the center, it transformed again into a saucer shape.

Camping here, I managed to get a good time-shot, so that, provided we occupied this camp on the return journey, I reckoned that I could get the watch-rate and fix the approximate longitude of the pack-ice, which for two days had been clearly within view.

Camping here, I was able to get an accurate time reading, so if we stayed at this camp on the way back, I figured I could determine the watch rate and establish the approximate longitude of the pack ice, which had been clearly visible for two days.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Adelie Land: Showing tracks of the Western Sledging Party from the Main Base.

Adelie Land: Displaying the trails of the Western Sledging Party originating from the Main Base.

December 21 marked the end of the good weather, for drift and wind came on apace lasting four days, the wind attaining about eighty miles an hour. Sleeping-bags and tent-cloth were soon in a wretched state, sodden with moisture. Christmas Day was not very enjoyable in cramped quarters, the tent having encroached on us owing to drift settling around it. Still, by the evening, it was clear enough to break camp and we made a spurt of thirteen miles.

December 21 marked the end of the nice weather, as snow and wind came in quickly and lasted for four days, with winds reaching about eighty miles an hour. Our sleeping bags and tent fabric quickly became a mess, soaked with moisture. Christmas Day wasn't very enjoyable in our cramped space, with the tent having shrunk around us due to the snow piling up. However, by the evening, it cleared up enough for us to break camp, and we managed to cover thirteen miles.

From the next camp there was a good view to the northwest, the pack extending beyond the limit of vision. The land trended to the west-north-west and we could see it at a distance of fifty miles from our altitude.

From the next camp, we had a great view to the northwest, with the pack going beyond what we could see. The land stretched to the west-northwest, and we could see it up to fifty miles away from our height.

All things considered, I thought it right to turn back at this stage. In twenty-six days we had done one hundred and fifty-eight miles, and ninety-seven miles of that distance had been covered on the only five consecutive good days. We waited some time until the sun appeared, when I was able to get an observation while Hodgeman made a sketch of the view.

All things considered, I thought it was best to turn back at this point. In twenty-six days, we had traveled one hundred and fifty-eight miles, and ninety-seven of those miles had been covered in just five consecutive good days. We waited a while until the sun came out, and I was able to take a reading while Hodgeman sketched the view.

By December 30 we reoccupied the camp of the 20th, sixteen miles on the return journey. A time-shot was successful, and observations were also taken for magnetic declination.

By December 30, we returned to the camp of the 20th, sixteen miles into our journey back. A time shot was successful, and we also took observations for magnetic declination.

As the weather was fine, Hodgeman and Whetter went to investigate two odd-looking pyramids about five miles away. These turned out to be high snow-ramps, two hundred yards long, on the lee side of open crevasses.

As the weather was nice, Hodgeman and Whetter went to check out two strange-looking pyramids about five miles away. These turned out to be high snow ramps, two hundred yards long, on the sheltered side of open crevasses.

The last day of 1912 was calm and "snow-blind"—the first of this particular variety we had experienced without drift. A New Year pudding was made of soaked biscuit, cocoa, milk, sugar, butter, and a few remaining raisins, and it was, of course, an immense success.

The last day of 1912 was quiet and "snow-blind"—the first of this specific kind we had experienced without any drifting snow. A New Year pudding was made from soaked biscuits, cocoa, milk, sugar, butter, and a few leftover raisins, and it was, of course, a huge success.

On January 1 and the two succeeding days the drift was so thick that we had to lie up and amuse ourselves discussing various matters of individual interest. Hodgeman gave us a lecture on architecture, explaining the beauties of certain well-known buildings. Whetter would describe some delicate surgical operation, while I talked about machinery. I also worked up the time-shots, and the hours passed quickly. If only our sleeping-bags had been drier we might have enjoyed ourselves at intervals.

On January 1 and the next two days, the snowstorm was so severe that we had to stay put and keep ourselves entertained by discussing different topics we each found interesting. Hodgeman gave us a talk about architecture, highlighting the beauty of some famous buildings. Whetter described some intricate surgical procedure, while I chatted about machinery. I also worked on the time-shots, and the hours flew by. If only our sleeping bags had been drier, we might have enjoyed ourselves more often.

The evening of the 4th found us camped ten miles nearer home, beside a large crevasse and with a closer view of the bay seen on December 20. This time we were greatly excited to see rocks outcropping near the water-line, and an investigation of them was resolved upon for the following day.

The evening of the 4th found us camped ten miles closer to home, next to a large crevasse and with a better view of the bay seen on December 20. This time we were really excited to see rocks coming out of the ground near the waterline, and we decided to investigate them the next day.

The morning broke overcast and ghostly white. Although only ten yards away from it, we could not see the huge crevasse in our vicinity. Thus our expedition to the rocks had to be abandoned.

The morning was cloudy and eerie white. Even though it was just ten yards away, we couldn’t see the massive crevasse nearby. So, we had to call off our trip to the rocks.

After a week's travelling, during which obscured skies and intermittent drift were the rule, we were once more in the neighbourhood of Madigan's spring depot, forty-five miles west of Aladdin's Cave. It had been passed without our seeing any signs of it on the outward journey, and, as we never relied on finding it, we did not mind about missing it again.

After a week of travel, during which cloudy skies and random drifts were the norm, we were finally near Madigan's spring depot, forty-five miles west of Aladdin's Cave. We had passed it without noticing any signs on the way there, and since we never expected to find it, we didn't mind missing it again.

Thick drift and a fifty-mile wind on January 12 kept us confined for thirty-six hours. It was clear enough after noon on the 13th, and five miles were covered in four hours through thick surface drift. What the course was we did not care as we steered by the sastrugi. If ever a man had any "homing instinct" it would surely show itself on such an occasion as this.

Thick snow drift and a fifty-mile wind on January 12 kept us stuck for thirty-six hours. It cleared up after noon on the 13th, and we covered five miles in four hours through deep snow. We didn’t really care which direction we were heading as we navigated by the sastrugi. If anyone had a "homing instinct," it definitely would have come out in a situation like this.

Travelling in driving snow used to have a curious effect on me. I always imagined that we were just coming to an avenue of trees running at right angles to our course. What produced this idea I have not the slightest suspicion, but while it lasted, the impression was very strong.

Travelling in heavy snow used to have a strange effect on me. I always imagined that we were about to reach a row of trees crossing our path. I have no idea what made me think this, but while it lasted, the feeling was really intense.

To avoid the drift, which was thickest by day, travelling had for some time been conducted at night. On the evening of the 14th, during a clear spell, a ridge rose up behind, and, in front, a wide bay was visible with its far eastern point rising in mirage. This was taken to be Commonwealth Bay, but the fact could not be verified as the drift came on thickly once more. The day's march was twelve miles by concerted reckoning.

To avoid the drift, which was heaviest during the day, travel had been happening at night for a while. On the evening of the 14th, during a clear period, a ridge appeared behind us, and in front, a wide bay was visible with its far eastern point rising in a mirage. This was believed to be Commonwealth Bay, but that couldn’t be confirmed as the drift quickly became thick again. The day's journey was twelve miles by our combined calculations.

Next day we went three miles to the north to see if any recognizable bergs would come in sight, but were stopped by crevasses. The eastward course was therefore resumed.

The next day, we traveled three miles north to see if we could spot any familiar icebergs, but we were blocked by crevasses. So, we continued our journey eastward.

After continuing for about a mile Hodgeman told us to stop, flung down his harness and dashed back to the sledge, rummaging in the instrument-box till he found the glasses. "Yes, it's the aeroplane," he said.

After going for about a mile, Hodgeman told us to stop, dumped his harness, and rushed back to the sled, searching through the instrument box until he found the glasses. "Yeah, it's the airplane," he said.

This remark took us by surprise as we had not expected it for eight miles at least. It was about midnight—the time when mirage was at a maximum. Consequently, all agreed that the machine was about twelve miles away, and we went on our way rejoicing, steering towards the Cathedral Grotto which was two miles south of the aero-sledge. After three miles we camped, and, it being my birthday, the two events were celebrated by "blowing in" the whisky belonging to the medical outfit.

This comment caught us off guard since we hadn’t anticipated it for at least eight miles. It was around midnight—the moment when mirages are at their strongest. So, everyone agreed that the machine was about twelve miles away, and we continued on our journey feeling good, heading towards the Cathedral Grotto, which was two miles south of the aero-sledge. After three miles, we set up camp, and since it was my birthday, we celebrated both occasions by sharing the whisky from the medical supplies.

On the 16th the weather was thick, and we marched east for ten miles, passing a tea-leaf, which it was afterwards found must have come downwind from the Grotto. For eight hours nothing could be done in thick drift, and then, on breaking camp, we actually came to a flag which had been planted by Ninnis in the spring, thirteen miles south-east of Aladdin's Cave. The distance to the air-tractor had been over-estimated, and the Grotto must have been passed quite close.

On the 16th, the weather was foggy, and we marched east for ten miles, passing a tea-leaf that was later found to have come from the Grotto thanks to the wind. For eight hours, we couldn't do anything in the thick fog, and then, when we broke camp, we actually found a flag that Ninnis had planted in the spring, thirteen miles southeast of Aladdin's Cave. The distance to the air-tractor had been overestimated, and we must have passed really close to the Grotto.

We made off down the hill, running over the crevasses at a great pace. Aladdin's Cave with its medley of boxes, tins, picks and shovels, gladdened our eyes at 10 P.M. on the 17th. Conspicuous for its colour was an orange, stuck on a pick, which told us at once that the Ship was in.

We raced down the hill, jumping over the gaps quickly. Aladdin's Cave, filled with a mix of boxes, cans, picks, and shovels, brightened our spirits at 10 PM on the 17th. An orange, stuck on a pick, stood out with its color and immediately let us know that the Ship had arrived.





CHAPTER XVIII THE SHIP'S STORY

by Captain J. K. Davis

    By sport of bitter weather
      We're warty, strained, and scarred
    From the kentledge on the kelson
      To the slings upon the yard.
                                 KIPLING.
    By the harshness of the weather
      We're rough, worn, and marked
    From the heavy weight on the hull
      To the ropes on the mast.
                                 KIPLING.

Dr. Mawson's plans, as laid before the Royal Geographical Society in 1911, provided for an extensive oceanographical campaign in the immense stretch of ocean to the southward of Australia. Very little was known of the sea-floor in this area, there being but a few odd soundings only, beyond a moderate distance from the Australian coast. Even the great Challenger expedition had scarcely touched upon it; and so our Expedition had a splendid field for investigation.

Dr. Mawson's plans, presented to the Royal Geographical Society in 1911, included a large oceanographic campaign in the vast waters south of Australia. Very little was known about the seabed in this area, with only a few random soundings taken beyond a reasonable distance from the Australian coast. Even the great Challenger expedition barely explored it; therefore, our Expedition had an excellent opportunity for research.

The first discovery made in this connexion on board the 'Aurora' was the fact that deep-water work is more intricate than books would make it appear. Although text-books had been carefully studied on the subject, it was found that most of them passed over the practical side of the work in a few words, insufficient to give us much help in carrying out difficult operations with the vessel rolling and tumbling about in the heavy seas of the Southern Ocean.

The first discovery made in this connection on board the 'Aurora' was that deep-water work is more complicated than books suggest. Even though textbooks had been studied thoroughly on the topic, it turned out that most of them only briefly covered the practical aspects of the job, which wasn’t enough to help us with challenging tasks while the ship was rolling and tumbling in the rough waters of the Southern Ocean.

So it was only after a good deal of hard work and many disappointments that the experience was gained which enabled us, during the later stages of the Expedition, to do useful and successful work.

So it was only after a lot of hard work and many setbacks that we gained the experience that allowed us, during the later stages of the Expedition, to do meaningful and successful work.

Before passing on to the operations of the 'Aurora' during the winter of 1912, I shall briefly refer to the equipment provided for oceanographical work.

Before moving on to the activities of the 'Aurora' during the winter of 1912, I will briefly mention the equipment available for oceanographic work.

The Lucas Automatic Sounding Machine was situated on the port side of the forecastle head. It was suitable for depths up to six thousand fathoms, being fitted with a grooved wheel so as to be driven by a rope belt from a steam-winch or other engine. The wire was wound in by means of a small horizontal steam-engine which had been specially designed for the 'Scotia', of the Scottish Antarctic Expedition (1902) and was kindly lent to us by Dr. W. S. Bruce.

The Lucas Automatic Sounding Machine was located on the left side of the forecastle head. It could handle depths of up to six thousand fathoms and had a grooved wheel that was powered by a rope belt from a steam-winch or another engine. The wire was reeled in using a small horizontal steam engine, which was specifically designed for the 'Scotia' of the Scottish Antarctic Expedition (1902) and was generously loaned to us by Dr. W. S. Bruce.

The wire as it is paid out passes over a measuring wheel, the revolutions of which record on a dial the number of fathoms out. A spring brake, which is capable of stopping the reel instantly, is kept out of action by the tension of the wire, but when the sinker strikes the bottom, the loss of tension allows the brake to spring back and stop the reel. The depth can then be read off on the dial.

The wire, as it's being released, goes over a measuring wheel that tracks the number of fathoms paid out on a dial. A spring brake, which can instantly stop the reel, remains inactive due to the tension in the wire. However, when the sinker hits the bottom, the loss of tension allows the brake to engage and stop the reel. The depth can then be read on the dial.

A hollow iron tube called a driver is attached to a piece of hemp line spliced into the outer end of the sounding wire. This driver bears one or two weights to the bottom and detaches them on striking it; a specimen of the bottom being recovered in the hollow part of the tube which is fitted with valves to prevent water from running through it on the way up. Immediately the driver and weight strike the bottom, the reel automatically stops paying out wire.

A hollow iron tube called a driver is connected to a piece of hemp rope spliced into the outer end of the sounding wire. This driver carries one or two weights to the bottom and releases them upon impact; a sample of the bottom is collected in the hollow part of the tube, which has valves to stop water from flowing through it on the way up. As soon as the driver and weight hit the bottom, the reel automatically stops releasing wire.

To obtain a deep-sea sounding on the 'Aurora', the vessel was stopped, turned so as to bring the wind on the port-bow and kept as nearly stationary as possible; the engines being used to balance any drift of the vessel due to wind or sea.

To take a deep-sea measurement on the 'Aurora', the ship was stopped, turned to have the wind coming from the port side, and kept as still as possible; the engines were used to counteract any movement of the ship caused by the wind or waves.

The difficulties of sounding in the Southern Ocean were much increased by the almost constant, heavy swell. The breaking strain of the wire being only two hundred and forty pounds and the load it had to carry to the bottom weighing nearly fifty-six pounds in air, it could easily be understood that the sudden strain imposed by the violent rolling of the vessel often resulted in the parting of the wire. We soon learnt to handle both vessel and sounding machine in such a way as to entail the least possible strain on the wire.

The challenges of taking soundings in the Southern Ocean were significantly heightened by the almost constant, heavy swell. With the breaking strength of the wire being only two hundred and forty pounds and the load it had to carry to the bottom weighing nearly fifty-six pounds in air, it became clear that the sudden strain from the vessel's violent rolling often caused the wire to break. We quickly learned to manage both the vessel and the sounding machine in a way that minimized the strain on the wire as much as possible.

Of all the operations conducted on board the 'Aurora', deep-sea trawling was the one about which we had most to learn. Dr. W. S. Bruce gave me most valuable advice on the subject before we left England. Later, this was supplemented by a cruise in Australian waters on the 'Endeavour', of the Commonwealth Fisheries Investigation. Here I was able to observe various trawling operations in progress, subsequently applying the information gained to our own requirements on the 'Aurora'.

Of all the activities carried out on the 'Aurora', deep-sea trawling was the one we needed to learn the most about. Dr. W. S. Bruce provided me with valuable advice on the topic before we left England. Later, this was enhanced by a cruise in Australian waters on the 'Endeavour', part of the Commonwealth Fisheries Investigation. During this time, I was able to observe various trawling operations in action and then apply the knowledge I gained to our own needs on the 'Aurora'.

A short description of our trawling arrangements may be useful to those who are engaged in this work on board a vessel not specially designed for it.

A brief overview of our trawling setup might be helpful for those working on a vessel that isn't specifically built for this task.

We were provided with three thousand fathoms of tapered steel wire (varying from one and three-quarters to one and a half inches in circumference and weighing roughly a ton to the thousand fathoms in air); this was kept on a large iron reel (A) mounted on standards and controlled by a friction-brake. This reel was situated on the starboard side of the main deck, the wire being wound on to it by means of a chain-drive from the forward cargo-winch.

We were given three thousand fathoms of tapered steel wire (ranging from one and three-quarters to one and a half inches in circumference and weighing about a ton per thousand fathoms in air); this was stored on a large iron reel (A) mounted on supports and operated with a friction brake. This reel was located on the starboard side of the main deck, with the wire being wound onto it using a chain drive from the forward cargo winch.

For heaving in, our steam-windlass was fitted with a specially constructed drum (B), which absorbed the crushing strain and then allowed the slack wire to be wound on the reel (A), which was driven as nearly as possible at the same speed; the windlass usually heaving at the rate of four hundred and fifty fathoms per hour.

For hauling in, our steam-windlass was equipped with a specially designed drum (B), which absorbed the heavy strain and then let the loose wire be wound onto the reel (A), which was operated to keep up with the same speed; the windlass typically hauled at a rate of four hundred and fifty fathoms per hour.

A wooden derrick (D), provided with topping lift and guys, was mounted on the foremast by means of a band and goose-neck. At the outer end of the derrick, the dynamometer and a fourteen-inch block were attached. The maximum strain which could be supported was ten tons. In paying out, the wire was led from the head of the derrick to a snatch-block on the quarter (E), constructed so as to admit of its disengagement from the wire when it was necessary to heave in. This block kept the wire clear of the propeller and allowed us to have the vessel moving slow or fast as required, while the trawl was being paid out. The positions of the various parts of the trawling gear are shown in the plan on the opposite page.

A wooden derrick (D), equipped with a topping lift and stays, was installed on the foremast using a band and goose-neck. At the end of the derrick, a dynamometer and a fourteen-inch block were attached. The maximum load it could handle was ten tons. When letting out the line, the wire was routed from the top of the derrick to a snatch block on the quarter (E), designed to easily detach from the wire when we needed to reel it in. This block kept the wire away from the propeller and allowed us to move the vessel at the desired speed while the trawl was being let out. The positions of the different parts of the trawling gear are shown in the plan on the opposite page.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Plan illustrating the arrangements for deep-sea trawling on board the 'Aurora'.

Plan illustrating the arrangements for deep-sea trawling on the 'Aurora'.

Before trawling in deep water the vessel was stopped and a sounding obtained; then the derrick was hoisted, the wire rove through the various blocks, the trawl shackled on, and the men distributed at their stations. When all was ready, the engines were put at half-speed (three knots), a course was given to the helmsman and the trawl lowered into the water. When it was flowing nicely just astern, the order, "Slack away," was given; the wire being paid out evenly by means of the friction-brakes. In one thousand five hundred fathoms of water, after the two-thousand-fathom mark had passed out, the order was given, "Hold on and make fast." Speed was now reduced to one and a half knots and the wire watched until it gave a decided indication of the trawl dragging over the bottom. The strain was now taken by the windlass-barrel, controlled by a screw-brake, backed if necessary by a number of turns round the forward bitts. A slow drag over the bottom was generally continued for one hour. The engines were then stopped, and the order came, "Stand by to heave away." This was quickly followed by "Knock out," which meant the disengaging of the after-block from the wire and allowed the vessel to swing round head-on to the wire. "Vast heaving" indicated the appearance of the net at the surface, and, when the mouth of the net was well above the bulwarks the derrick was topped up vertically, the lower part of the net dragged inboard and the cod-end untied, the catch being thus allowed to empty itself on deck. The contents of the haul supplied the biologists with the work of sorting and bottling for the next twelve hours or more.

Before fishing in deep water, the boat was stopped and a depth was measured; then the derrick was raised, the wire threaded through the various pulleys, the trawl attached, and the crew assigned to their stations. Once everything was ready, the engines were set to half-speed (three knots), a course was given to the helmsman, and the trawl was lowered into the water. When it was flowing nicely just behind the boat, the order, "Slack away," was given; the wire was released evenly using the friction brakes. In one thousand five hundred fathoms of water, after passing the two-thousand-fathom mark, the order was given, "Hold on and make fast." Speed was reduced to one and a half knots, and the wire was monitored until it showed a clear indication of the trawl dragging along the bottom. The strain was taken by the windlass barrel, controlled by a screw brake, supplemented as needed by several wraps around the forward posts. A slow drag along the bottom was typically maintained for an hour. The engines were then stopped, and the order came, "Stand by to heave away." This was quickly followed by "Knock out," which meant disconnecting the back block from the wire and allowing the boat to turn to face the wire. "Vast heaving" indicated the appearance of the net at the surface, and when the mouth of the net was well above the sides of the boat, the derrick was raised vertically, the lower part of the net was pulled inboard, and the cod-end was untied, allowing the catch to empty onto the deck. The contents of the haul provided the biologists with work sorting and bottling for the next twelve hours or more.

The form of trawl used on board the 'Aurora' was known as a Monagasque trawl, of a type employed by the Prince of Monaco. As will be seen from the sketch, it is of simple construction and possesses the advantage of having both sides similar so that it is immaterial which lands on the bottom.

The type of trawl used on the 'Aurora' was called a Monagasque trawl, similar to one used by the Prince of Monaco. As the sketch shows, it has a simple design and the benefit of having both sides identical, so it doesn't matter which side lands on the bottom.

The winter cruise in the Sub-Antarctic began on May 18, 1912, after we had refitted in Sydney and taken on board all the oceanographic apparatus, during the previous month. Leaving Port Jackson, we proceeded to Port Kembla, N.S.W., and took in four hundred and eleven tons of coal.

The winter cruise in the Sub-Antarctic started on May 18, 1912, after we had refitted in Sydney and loaded all the oceanographic equipment in the previous month. Leaving Port Jackson, we headed to Port Kembla, N.S.W., where we took on four hundred and eleven tons of coal.

The following was the personnel of the ship's officers on this and the two following cruises: Chief Officer, F. D. Fletcher; Chief Engineer, F. J. Gillies; Second Officer, P. Gray; Third Officer, C. P. de la Motte.

The personnel of the ship's officers on this and the next two cruises were as follows: Chief Officer, F. D. Fletcher; Chief Engineer, F. J. Gillies; Second Officer, P. Gray; Third Officer, C. P. de la Motte.

During the first dredging cruise, Mr. E. R. Waite, from the Canterbury Museum, Christchurch, was in charge of the biological work.

During the first dredging cruise, Mr. E. R. Waite from the Canterbury Museum in Christchurch was in charge of the biological work.

My plan was to go through Bass Strait and then to sail towards the Royal Company Islands as given on the French chart, before heading for Macquarie Island. From thence we should steam across to the Auckland Islands. At both the latter places Mr. Waite would be able to secure specimens. It was not expected that the weather would permit of much trawling, but we anticipated some good soundings. As a matter of fact, sub-antarctic weather in the winter may be predicted with some certainty: strong winds, heavy seas, much fog and general gloom.

My plan was to navigate through Bass Strait and then head towards the Royal Company Islands as shown on the French chart, before making our way to Macquarie Island. From there, we would steam over to the Auckland Islands. At both of these locations, Mr. Waite would be able to collect specimens. We didn’t expect the weather to allow for much trawling, but we hoped to get some good soundings. In reality, sub-Antarctic weather in the winter can be predicted fairly accurately: strong winds, rough seas, lots of fog, and overall gloom.

We had a fine run through Bass Strait with a light south-east breeze, arriving off King's Island at noon on May 28. The trawling gear was got ready for the following day, but the sea was too high and the ship continued south towards the position of the Royal Company Islands.

We had a good run through Bass Strait with a light southeast breeze, reaching King's Island at noon on May 28. We prepared the trawling gear for the next day, but the sea was too rough, so the ship continued south towards the Royal Company Islands.

On June 1 we were in latitude 53 degrees south, longitude 152 degrees east, and had been cruising about fruitlessly in heavy weather for days waiting for an opportunity to dredge. After being at sea for a whole fortnight we had only three soundings to our credit, and it was, therefore, resolved to make for Macquarie Island.

On June 1, we were at 53 degrees south latitude and 152 degrees east longitude, and we had been cruising around in rough weather for days, waiting for a chance to dredge. After spending two weeks at sea, we had only three soundings to show for it, so we decided to head to Macquarie Island.

On the 7th we reached the island and anchored at North-East Bay in twelve fathoms, about one mile from land.

On the 7th, we arrived at the island and anchored in North-East Bay in twelve fathoms, about a mile from shore.

After a stiff pull ashore, next day, we landed and found the party all well. They had built a comfortable hut and were enjoying life as far as possible, despite the constant gales and continuous days of fog.

After a tough pull to shore, the next day we arrived and found the group all safe and sound. They had built a cozy hut and were making the best of things, despite the persistent winds and endless days of fog.

We then climbed up the hill to the wireless station, where everything was in splendid order. Two small huts had been erected, one for the engine and the other for the receiving apparatus. Sandell and Sawyer, the two operators, were to be congratulated on the efficient way the station had been kept going under very considerable difficulty. In addition to the routine work with Hobart and Wellington they had occasionally communicated with stations over two thousand miles distant.

We then hiked up the hill to the wireless station, where everything was in great shape. Two small huts had been set up, one for the engine and the other for the receiving equipment. Sandell and Sawyer, the two operators, deserved praise for the way they had efficiently kept the station running despite significant challenges. Besides their regular work with Hobart and Wellington, they had occasionally communicated with stations over two thousand miles away.

I was able to send the following message to Professor David: "'Aurora' arrived Macquarie Island; all well, June 7; constant gales and high seas have prevented dredging so far. Royal Company Islands not found in the position indicated on the chart."

I was able to send the following message to Professor David: "'Aurora' arrived at Macquarie Island; everything is fine, June 7; strong winds and rough seas have stopped us from dredging so far. The Royal Company Islands weren't found where the chart indicated."

We were able to land some stores for the use of the land party under Ainsworth. Meteorological, biological and geological work were all in progress and the scientific records should be of great value. Up to the date of our arrival, no wireless messages had been received from Adelie Land. As Dr. Mawson was in ignorance of its exact location, the position of the Western Base under Wild was given to Ainsworth to forward to Adelie Land in case communication should be established.

We managed to secure some stores for the land party under Ainsworth. Weather, biology, and geology work were all ongoing, and the scientific records should be really valuable. By the time we arrived, no wireless messages had come from Adelie Land. Since Dr. Mawson didn't know its exact location, the position of the Western Base under Wild was given to Ainsworth to send to Adelie Land if communication was established.

After Mr. Waite had obtained several birds, it was decided to move down to Lusitania Bay to secure some Royal penguins and a sea-elephant. Two days later, the 'Aurora' anchored in the bay, three-quarters of a mile from the beach, in sixteen fathoms; the weather was very misty. Mr. Waite and Mr. Haines, the taxidermist, were rowed ashore.

After Mr. Waite had collected several birds, it was decided to head down to Lusitania Bay to catch some Royal penguins and a sea elephant. Two days later, the 'Aurora' dropped anchor in the bay, three-quarters of a mile from the beach, in sixteen fathoms; the weather was quite foggy. Mr. Waite and Mr. Haines, the taxidermist, were rowed to shore.

The island, above a height of three hundred feet from sea-level, was shrouded in mist throughout the day, and, before dark, all signs of the land had disappeared. The mist did not clear until 6 P.M. on the 15th.

The island, rising more than three hundred feet above sea level, was covered in fog all day, and by nightfall, all traces of land had vanished. The fog didn't lift until 6 PM on the 15th.

We stayed for a whole fortnight at Macquarie Island, during which time the highest velocity of the wind recorded on shore was thirty-five miles per hour, although, during the winter, gales are almost of daily occurrence. On June 22, the date of departure, a course was set for the Auckland Islands, which lie in the track of homeward-bound vessels from Australia via Cape Horn.

We stayed for two whole weeks at Macquarie Island, during which the highest wind speed recorded on shore was thirty-five miles per hour, even though strong winds happen almost every day during the winter. On June 22, the day we left, we set course for the Auckland Islands, which are on the route home for ships coming from Australia via Cape Horn.

The group was discovered in 1806 by Captain Bristow of the 'Ocean', owned by Samuel Enderby. It comprises one main island and several smaller ones, separated by narrow channels. There are two spacious harbours; a northern, now called Port Ross, and a southern, Carnley Harbour. The islands are situated about one hundred and eighty miles south of Stewart Island (New Zealand).

The group was found in 1806 by Captain Bristow of the 'Ocean', owned by Samuel Enderby. It includes one main island and several smaller ones, divided by narrow channels. There are two large harbors: a northern one, now called Port Ross, and a southern one, Carnley Harbour. The islands are located about one hundred eighty miles south of Stewart Island (New Zealand).

After a run of three hundred and forty miles on a northeast course, we entered Carnley Harbour and anchored off Flagstaff Point. A breeze blew strong from the west-northwest. Next day, June 25, we stood up to Figure of Eight Island and found good holding for the anchor in nine and a half fathoms.

After traveling three hundred and forty miles on a northeast route, we arrived at Carnley Harbour and anchored near Flagstaff Point. A strong breeze was blowing from the west-northwest. The next day, June 25, we headed toward Figure of Eight Island and found good anchorage in nine and a half fathoms.

The eastern entrance to Carnley Harbour is formed by two bluff points, about two miles apart; its upper extremity terminating in a lagoon. The site of Musgrave's house ("Epigwaith") is on the east side of this lagoon. Here he spent twenty months after the wreck of the 'Grafton'.

The eastern entrance to Carnley Harbour is formed by two cliff points, about two miles apart; its upper end leading to a lagoon. Musgrave's house ("Epigwaith") is located on the east side of this lagoon. He spent twenty months here after the wreck of the 'Grafton'.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Auckland Island (from the Admiralty Chart) showing the track of the 'Aurora'

Auckland Island (from the Admiralty Chart) showing the route of the 'Aurora'

We set off in the motor-launch on the 26th to visit Camp Cove, where we found the two huts maintained by the New Zealand Government for the benefit of castaways. In the larger hut there were potatoes, biscuits, tinned meats and matches. The smaller hut was empty but on the outside were carved many names of shipwrecked mariners. The 'Amakura' had visited the depot in November 1911. The various depots established on the island by the New Zealand Government are visited every six months.

We left on the motorboat on the 26th to check out Camp Cove, where we found the two huts that the New Zealand Government keeps for castaways. In the bigger hut, we found potatoes, biscuits, canned meats, and matches. The smaller hut was empty, but there were many names of shipwrecked sailors carved on the outside. The 'Amakura' had visited the depot in November 1911. The different depots set up on the island by the New Zealand Government are visited every six months.

While in Carnley Harbour we were able to make several hauls with the small dredge.

While in Carnley Harbour, we managed to make several catches with the small dredge.

After passing up the eastern coast of the main island we entered Port Ross and anchored west of Shoe Island. On June 30 the depot on Erebus Cove was visited, where three white sheds contain the usual necessaries for unfortunate castaways. The New Zealand Government steamer, 'Hinemoa', while on a scientific expedition to the Sub-Antarctic in 1907, rescued the sixteen survivors of the barque 'Dundonald', two thousand two hundred and three tons, which had been wrecked on Disappointment Island. The captain and ten men had been drowned and the chief officer had died from the effects of exposure and starvation.

After traveling along the eastern coast of the main island, we entered Port Ross and anchored west of Shoe Island. On June 30, we visited the depot at Erebus Cove, where three white sheds hold the usual supplies for unfortunate castaways. The New Zealand Government steamer, 'Hinemoa', while on a scientific expedition to the Sub-Antarctic in 1907, rescued the sixteen survivors of the barque 'Dundonald', which weighed two thousand two hundred and three tons and had wrecked on Disappointment Island. The captain and ten men had drowned, and the chief officer had died from exposure and starvation.

On July 2 we went to Observation Point, finding there a flat stone commemorating the visit of the German Scientific Expedition of 1874.

On July 2, we went to Observation Point and found a flat stone that marks the visit of the German Scientific Expedition of 1874.

The biologist found various kinds of petrels on Shoe Island, where the turf was riddled in all directions by their burrows.

The biologist discovered different types of petrels on Shoe Island, where the ground was crisscrossed in every direction by their burrows.

At Rose Island, close by, there are some fine basaltic columns, eighty feet high, weathered out into deep caverns along their base.

At Rose Island, nearby, there are impressive basalt columns, eighty feet tall, worn down to form deep caves at their base.

In Sandy Bay, Enderby Island, there was an extensive depot. Among the stores I found a Venesta case marked s.y. 'Nimrod', which contained dried vegetables and evidently formed part of the stores which were sold on the return of the British Antarctic Expedition of 1907.

In Sandy Bay, Enderby Island, there was a large supply depot. Among the supplies, I found a Venesta case labeled s.y. 'Nimrod', which held dried vegetables and clearly was part of the supplies sold after the British Antarctic Expedition of 1907.

After leaving the Auckland Islands for New Zealand, we were fortunate in having fairly good weather. Five soundings were taken, and, on July 9, the trawl was put over in three hundred and forty-five fathoms. The net unfortunately fouled on a rocky bottom and so we gained nothing but experience in the operation.

After leaving the Auckland Islands for New Zealand, we were lucky to have pretty good weather. We took five depth measurements, and on July 9, we dropped the trawl at three hundred and forty-five fathoms. Unfortunately, the net got stuck on a rocky bottom, so we didn’t get anything except experience with the operation.

The 'Aurora' arrived at Port Lyttleton on July 11 and we received a very kind welcome from the people of Christchurch. Mr. J. J. Kinsey, well known in connexion with various British Antarctic expeditions, gave us valuable assistance during our stay. We were back again in Melbourne on the 17th of the month.

The 'Aurora' reached Port Lyttleton on July 11, and we were warmly welcomed by the people of Christchurch. Mr. J. J. Kinsey, who is well-known for his involvement in various British Antarctic expeditions, provided us with valuable support during our visit. We returned to Melbourne on the 17th of the month.

While the first oceanographical cruise of the 'Aurora' did not prove very fruitful in results, chiefly on account of the stormy weather, it provided the necessary training for officers and men in the handling of the deep-sea gear, and we were able to realize later how much we had learnt on our first cruise.

While the first oceanographic cruise of the 'Aurora' didn't yield many results, mainly due to the rough weather, it was essential training for the crew in using the deep-sea equipment, and we later saw how much we had learned on that first trip.

The ship, after undergoing a thorough overhaul at the State dockyard at Williamstown, Victoria, undertook a second deep-sea cruise.

The ship, after a complete makeover at the state dockyard in Williamstown, Victoria, set out on its second deep-sea voyage.

Leaving Hobart on November 12, 1912, she laid her course to the southward in order to obtain soundings for a complete section of the sea-floor, as nearly as possible on the meridian of Hobart. Our time was limited to one month, during which a visit to Macquarie Island for the purpose of landing stores and mail had to be made. Professor T. Flynn of Hobart University accompanied the vessel in charge of the biological work.

Leaving Hobart on November 12, 1912, she headed south to gather soundings for a complete section of the sea floor, as close as possible to the meridian of Hobart. We had one month to work, during which we needed to stop at Macquarie Island to land supplies and mail. Professor T. Flynn from Hobart University joined the ship to oversee the biological research.

An interesting discovery was made two hundred miles south of Tasmania. Here it was proved that a rocky ridge rose like a huge mountain from depths of more than two thousand fathoms to within five hundred and forty fathoms of the surface. A great number of soundings were taken in the vicinity of this rise, subsequently named the Mill Rise, until a heavy gale drove us far from its situation.

An interesting discovery was made two hundred miles south of Tasmania. Here, it was shown that a rocky ridge rose like a giant mountain from depths of more than two thousand fathoms to within five hundred and forty fathoms of the surface. Many soundings were taken near this rise, which was later named the Mill Rise, until a fierce gale pushed us far away from its location.

On November 21 we were not far from Macquarie Island and, at 7 P.M., sounded in one thousand four hundred and fifty fathoms. As the weather was remarkably fine for these latitudes we decided to lower the trawl. Before dark it was being towed slowly towards the east with one thousand nine hundred fathoms of wire out.

On November 21, we were close to Macquarie Island, and at 7 P.M., we took soundings in one thousand four hundred and fifty fathoms. Since the weather was unusually nice for this area, we decided to lower the trawl. Before nightfall, it was being towed slowly to the east with one thousand nine hundred fathoms of wire out.

We spent an anxious night hoping that the weather would remain fine long enough to permit us to get the gear on board again. We had been driving before a light westerly wind, when the trawl caught on the bottom and stopped the vessel.

We spent a tense night hoping that the weather would stay nice long enough for us to get the gear back on board. We had been sailing with a gentle west breeze when the trawl snagged on the bottom and brought the boat to a halt.

A very heavy strain was imposed on the wire as the vessel rose in the swell; the dynamometer registering up to seven tons. I decided to wait for daylight before attempting to heave in the trawl. At 3 A.M. we cast the wire off the after-block and started to heave away; it was two hours before the trawl cleared the bottom and the strain was reduced.

A very heavy strain was put on the wire as the vessel rose in the waves; the dynamometer registered up to seven tons. I decided to wait for daylight before trying to pull in the trawl. At 3 A.M., we released the wire from the after-block and started to pull; it took two hours before the trawl cleared the bottom and the strain decreased.

At 8 A.M. the trawl was once more on board, the frames being bent and twisted and the net badly torn. On sounding, the depth was found to be only six hundred and thirty-six fathoms, so that we had evidently put over the trawl on to the edge of a steep rise and then drifted across it.

At 8 A.M., the trawl was back on board, with the frames bent and twisted and the net badly torn. When we took a depth reading, we found it was only six hundred and thirty-six fathoms, indicating that we had clearly lowered the trawl onto the edge of a steep rise and then drifted across it.

In view of our position—only thirty miles from Macquarie Island—this accident might have been expected. But opportunities of trawling had been so few that risks had to be taken when the weather quieted down for a few hours. Our only consolation on this occasion was that we recovered the gear.

Considering our location—just thirty miles from Macquarie Island—this accident was somewhat predictable. However, we had such limited opportunities for trawling that we had to take risks whenever the weather calmed down for a bit. Our only comfort this time was that we managed to recover the gear.

The following evening, at 7.30, the anchor was dropped in North-East Bay, Macquarie Island, and we were immediately boarded by our land party who were all well. They had become very clever boatmen during their stay, using a small dinghy to make coastal journeys.

The next evening, at 7:30, the anchor was dropped in North-East Bay, Macquarie Island, and our land party boarded us right away, all in good health. They had become skilled boatmen during their time there, using a small dinghy for coastal trips.

On November 24 we left the anchorage at 9 A.M. and spent the day in its vicinity. More than one hundred soundings were taken, which Blake, the geological surveyor, was to plot on the chart of the island which he had almost completed.

On November 24, we left the anchorage at 9 A.M. and spent the day nearby. We took more than one hundred soundings, which Blake, the geological surveyor, was supposed to plot on the chart of the island that he had almost finished.

Some idea of the steepness of the submarine mountain of which Macquarie Island forms the crest may be gathered from a sounding, taken ten and a half miles east of the island, which gave two thousand seven hundred and forty-five fathoms and no bottom. In other words, if the sea were to dry up, there would be a lofty mountain rising from the plain of the ocean's bed to a height of nearly eighteen thousand feet.

Some sense of how steep the underwater mountain, of which Macquarie Island is the peak, can be understood from a sounding taken ten and a half miles east of the island, which measured two thousand seven hundred and forty-five fathoms with no bottom detected. In other words, if the sea were to evaporate, there would be a tall mountain rising from the ocean floor to a height of nearly eighteen thousand feet.

A great deal of work still required to be done off Macquarie Island, but, as the uneven and rocky nature of the bottom prevented dredging, I decided to sail on the 25th, continuing the voyage towards the Auckland Islands.

A lot of work still needed to be done off Macquarie Island, but since the uneven and rocky seabed made dredging impossible, I decided to set sail on the 25th, continuing the journey toward the Auckland Islands.

Several people had expressed belief in a submarine ridge connecting Macquarie Island with the Auckland group. Three soundings which we obtained on this voyage did not support the suggestion, ranging as they did from one thousand eight hundred and fifty-five to two thousand four hundred and thirty fathoms, eighty-five miles south-west of the Auckland group. We were the more glad to obtain these soundings, as, during the winter cruise, in the same waters, the weather had forced us to abandon the attempt.

Several people believed there was a submarine ridge connecting Macquarie Island with the Auckland group. However, the three soundings we took on this trip didn’t support that idea, ranging from one thousand eight hundred and fifty-five to two thousand four hundred and thirty fathoms, eighty-five miles southwest of the Auckland group. We were especially pleased to get these soundings since bad weather during the winter cruise in the same waters had forced us to give up on the attempt.

On November 28 we took several soundings on the eastern side of the Auckland Islands, but did not prolong our stay as we wished to investigate the ridge south of Tasmania—the Mill Rise. The course was therefore directed westward with a view to outlining the eastern edge of this submarine elevation.

On November 28, we took several depth measurements on the eastern side of the Auckland Islands, but we didn't stay long because we wanted to check out the ridge south of Tasmania—the Mill Rise. So, we headed west to map out the eastern edge of this underwater elevation.

The first sounding to indicate that we were once more approaching the Mill Rise was in one thousand and seventy-six fathoms. Continuing west we secured the next record in one thousand three hundred fathoms, limiting the southern extremity of the ridge which extends northward for nearly one hundred miles. From this sounding the water shoaled quickly as we steered north. Thus, on the same day, we were in eight hundred and thirty-five fathoms at noon, in seven hundred and thirty-five fathoms at 3.40 P.M. and in seven hundred and ten fathoms at 7.30 P.M. After the last sounding we lowered the rock-gripper. On the first trial, however, it failed to shut and, on the second, only a little fine sand was recovered. As it was blowing hard most of the time, we were very fortunate in being able to do this piece of work.

The first sign that we were getting close to the Mill Rise again was at one thousand and seventy-six fathoms. As we continued west, we recorded the next reading at one thousand three hundred fathoms, which marked the southern end of the ridge that stretches north for almost one hundred miles. From this point, the water got shallower quickly as we headed north. So, on the same day, we found ourselves in eight hundred and thirty-five fathoms at noon, in seven hundred and thirty-five fathoms at 3:40 PM, and in seven hundred and ten fathoms at 7:30 PM. After the last sounding, we lowered the rock-gripper. On the first attempt, it failed to close, and on the second, we only got a little fine sand. Since it was blowing hard most of the time, we were very lucky to manage this task.

An inspection of the chart reveals the fact that the main direction of the shallowest water is in a north-west and south-east direction, but the number of soundings obtained was too small to give more than a general outline. Later, we were able to add to these on the voyage southward to relieve the Antarctic Bases.

An inspection of the chart shows that the main direction of the shallowest water runs northwest to southeast, but the number of soundings we collected was too small to provide more than a general outline. Later, we were able to gather more information on our trip south to support the Antarctic Bases.

The weather was so bad and the sea so heavy that we were unable to obtain soundings on December 9, and, as dredging under such conditions was out of the question, I decided to steer for the east coast of Tasmania, where dredging might be possible under the lee of the land. The constant gales were very disheartening, the last having continued for four days with only short intervals of moderate weather.

The weather was terrible and the sea was rough, so we couldn't take measurements on December 9. Dredging was impossible in those conditions, so I decided to head toward the east coast of Tasmania, where dredging might be feasible with the protection of the land. The relentless strong winds were really discouraging, with the last one lasting four days and only brief breaks of mild weather.

On December 12 and 13, in calmer water, some thirty miles off the east coast of Tasmania, trawlings were made successfully in one thousand three hundred fathoms and seventy-five fathoms respectively. From the deeper trawling were obtained a large octopus and several interesting fish.

On December 12 and 13, in calmer waters, about thirty miles off the east coast of Tasmania, trawling was successfully done at one thousand three hundred fathoms and seventy-five fathoms respectively. From the deeper trawling, a large octopus and several interesting fish were caught.

Just before noon on December 14 we arrived in Hobart and immediately began preparations for the voyage to the Antarctic.

Just before noon on December 14, we arrived in Hobart and immediately started getting ready for the trip to Antarctica.

On December 24, 1912, preparations for sailing were complete. For ten days every one connected with the 'Aurora' had been working at high pressure, and Christmas Day, our last day ashore, was to be celebrated as a well-earned holiday.

On December 24, 1912, everything was ready for sailing. For ten days, everyone involved with the 'Aurora' had been working hard, and Christmas Day, our final day on land, was set to be a well-deserved holiday.

There was on board a good supply of coal, five hundred and twenty-one tons, and a very heavy mail of letters and packages for the members of the Expedition who had been isolated in the far South for more than twelve months. We were to take thirty-five sheep on board as well as twenty-one dogs, presented by Captain Amundsen upon his return from his South Polar expedition. Captain James Davis, of Hobart, of long whaling experience, was to accompany us to give an expert opinion upon such whales as we might meet. Mr. Van Waterschoot van der Gracht, who had had previous experience in the Antarctic, joined as marine artist, and Mr. S. N. Jeffryes as wireless operator. With C. C. Eitel, Secretary of the Expedition, the whole party on board numbered twenty-eight.

There was a good supply of coal on board, five hundred and twenty-one tons, along with a heavy load of letters and packages for the members of the Expedition who had been isolated in the far South for over a year. We were set to take thirty-five sheep on board, as well as twenty-one dogs gifted by Captain Amundsen on his return from his South Polar expedition. Captain James Davis from Hobart, who had extensive whaling experience, was joining us to provide expert insight on any whales we might encounter. Mr. Van Waterschoot van der Gracht, who had previous experience in the Antarctic, came on as a marine artist, and Mr. S. N. Jeffryes was onboard as the wireless operator. With C. C. Eitel, the Secretary of the Expedition, the entire crew on board totaled twenty-eight.

A very pleasant Christmas was spent ashore. The ship's company of twenty-three men met for dinner, and we did not forget to wish a "Merry Christmas" to our leader and his twenty-six comrades who were holding their celebration amid the icy solitudes of Antarctica. I was glad, on this festive occasion, to be able to congratulate officers and men on their willing and loyal service during the previous twelve months; every one had done his best to advance the objects of the Expedition.

A very enjoyable Christmas was spent on land. The crew of twenty-three men gathered for dinner, and we made sure to wish a "Merry Christmas" to our leader and his twenty-six teammates who were celebrating in the frozen expanses of Antarctica. I was happy, on this festive occasion, to congratulate the officers and men on their dedicated and loyal service over the past year; everyone had done their best to help achieve the goals of the Expedition.

The attractions of Hobart, at this season, are so numerous, and Tasmanian hospitality so boundless, that it gives me great pleasure to place on record that every man was at his post on the 'Aurora' at 10 A.M. on Boxing Day.

The attractions of Hobart at this time of year are plentiful, and Tasmanian hospitality is endless, so I’m happy to report that everyone was at their station on the 'Aurora' at 10 A.M. on Boxing Day.

As we drew away from the wharf amid the cheers of those who had come to wish us God-speed, the weather was perfect and the scene on the Derwent bright and cheering. Captain James Davis acted as pilot.

As we pulled away from the dock with the cheers of those who came to wish us well, the weather was perfect and the view on the Derwent was bright and uplifting. Captain James Davis served as our pilot.

At 11.30 A.M. we had embarked the twenty-one dogs, which were brought off from the Quarantine Station, and were steaming down Storm Bay. Outside there was a heavy swell, and the wind was freshening from the west. The course was laid south 50 degrees west, true.

At 11:30 A.M., we loaded the twenty-one dogs that were brought from the Quarantine Station, and we were heading down Storm Bay. Outside, the sea was rough, and the wind was picking up from the west. The course was set at south 50 degrees west, true.

For the next two days there was a westerly gale with a very high sea, and the dogs and sheep had a bad time, as a good deal of water came aboard. Two of the sheep had to be killed. By the afternoon of the 29th it had moderated, and a sounding was secured.

For the next two days, there was a strong westerly wind with very rough seas, and the dogs and sheep struggled since a lot of water came on board. Two of the sheep had to be put down. By the afternoon of the 29th, the weather calmed down, and they were able to take a sound reading.

This storm was followed by another from the west-northwest. The 'Aurora' weathered it splendidly, although one sea came over everything and flooded the cabins, while part of the rail of the forecastle head was carried away on the morning of the 31st. At this time we were in the vicinity of the reputed position of the Royal Company Islands. A sounding was taken with great difficulty, finding two thousand and twenty fathoms and a mud bottom.

This storm was followed by another coming from the west-northwest. The 'Aurora' handled it beautifully, although one wave came over everything and flooded the cabins, while part of the railing on the forecastle was taken away on the morning of the 31st. At that time, we were near the believed location of the Royal Company Islands. Taking a sounding was quite challenging, but it revealed two thousand and twenty fathoms and a muddy bottom.

January 4, 1918, was a fine day, with a fresh westerly breeze and a high sea. Occasionally there were snow squalls. At night the wireless operator was able to hear H.M.S. 'Drake' at Hobart, and also the station at Macquarie Island; the ship having been fitted to receive wireless signals before sailing.

January 4, 1918, was a beautiful day, with a cool westerly breeze and rough seas. Every now and then, there were snow squalls. At night, the wireless operator could pick up H.M.S. 'Drake' in Hobart, as well as the station on Macquarie Island; the ship had been equipped to receive wireless signals before it set sail.

Next day the sun was bright and there was only a moderate westerly swell. Large bunches of kelp were frequently seen drifting on the surface. "Blue Billys"** flew in great numbers about the ship. Two soundings were obtained in one thousand nine hundred fathoms.

Next day, the sun was bright and there was only a mild westerly swell. Large clumps of kelp were often seen floating on the surface. "Blue Billys" flew around the ship in large numbers. Two measurements were taken in one thousand nine hundred fathoms.

     ** Prion Banksii.
** Prion Banksii.

On the 8th a heavy swell came from the south-east. During the morning a sounding realized two thousand two hundred and seventy fathoms and the sample of mud contained a small, black manganese nodule. At 8 P.M. a floating cask was sighted and taken aboard after much difficulty. It turned out to be a ship's oil cask, empty, giving no clue from whence it came.

On the 8th, a strong swell came in from the southeast. In the morning, a sounding measured two thousand two hundred and seventy fathoms, and the mud sample had a small, black manganese nodule in it. At 8 PM, we spotted a floating barrel, which was brought aboard after quite a bit of trouble. It turned out to be an empty ship's oil barrel, offering no hint of where it had come from.

The first ice was observed about 6 P.M. on the 10th. The water was still deep—more than two thousand fathoms.

The first ice was seen around 6 P.M. on the 10th. The water was still deep—over two thousand fathoms.

By noon on January 11 loose pack came into view, with a strong blink of heavier pack to the south. The course was changed to south-west. At 7 P.M. the ship was steaming west in clear water, a few bergs being in sight and a marked ice-blink to the south. Several whales appeared which Captain James Davis reported were "blue whales" (finners or rorquals).

By noon on January 11, loose pack ice was visible, with a strong indication of heavier pack ice to the south. The course was changed to the southwest. At 7 P.M., the ship was moving west through clear water, with a few icebergs in sight and a noticeable ice blink to the south. Several whales showed up, which Captain James Davis reported as "blue whales" (finners or rorquals).

After we had been steering westward until almost midnight, the course was altered to south-west in the hope of encountering the shelf-ice barrier (met in 1912) well to the east of the Main Base station. On the 12th we sailed over the position of the ice-tongue in 1912 without seeing a trace of it, coming up with heavy broken floe at 10 A.M.

After we had been heading west until almost midnight, we changed our course to southwest in hopes of finding the shelf-ice barrier (which we encountered in 1912) well east of the Main Base station. On the 12th, we sailed over where the ice tongue was located in 1912 without seeing any signs of it, and at 10 A.M. we encountered heavy broken ice floes.

For four hours the 'Aurora' pushed through massive floes and "bergy bits," issuing into open water with the blink of ice-covered land to the south. At nine o'clock Adelie Land was plainly visible, and a course was set for the Main Base. In squally weather we reached the Mackellar Islets at midnight, and by 2 A.M. on the 13th dropped anchor in Commonwealth Bay under the ice-cliffs in twenty fathoms.

For four hours, the 'Aurora' moved through huge ice blocks and small icebergs, breaking into open water with a glimpse of ice-covered land to the south. By nine o'clock, Adelie Land was clearly visible, and we set a course for the Main Base. In stormy weather, we arrived at the Mackellar Islets at midnight, and by 2 A.M. on the 13th, we dropped anchor in Commonwealth Bay beneath the ice cliffs in twenty fathoms of water.

At 6 A.M. Fletcher, the chief officer, reported that a heavy gust of wind had struck the ship and caused the chain to carry away the lashing of the heavy relieving-tackle. The chain then ran over the windlass, and, before anything could be done, the pointer to which the end of the chain was attached had been torn from the bolts, and our best ground-tackle was lost overboard. It was an exasperating accident.

At 6 A.M., Fletcher, the chief officer, reported that a strong gust of wind hit the ship and caused the chain to break free from the heavy relieving tackle. The chain then ran over the windlass, and before anyone could react, the pointer that the end of the chain was attached to was ripped off the bolts, resulting in the loss of our best ground tackle overboard. It was a frustrating accident.

At seven o'clock the port anchor was dropped in ten fathoms, about eight hundred yards west of the first anchorage, with ninety fathoms of chain. The wind shifted suddenly to the north, and the 'Aurora' swung inshore until her stern was within one hundred yards of the cliffs; but the depth at this distance proved to be seventeen fathoms. After a few northerly puffs, the wind shifted to the south-east and then died away.

At seven o'clock, the port anchor was dropped in ten fathoms, about eight hundred yards west of the first anchorage, with ninety fathoms of chain. The wind suddenly shifted to the north, causing the 'Aurora' to swing inshore until her stern was within one hundred yards of the cliffs; however, the depth at that distance turned out to be seventeen fathoms. After a few bursts of northerly wind, it shifted to the southeast and then faded away.

At 2.30 P.M. the launch was hoisted over and the mail was taken ashore, with sundry specimens of Australian fruit as "refreshment" for the shore-party. The boat harbour was reached before any one ashore had seen the 'Aurora'. At the landing-place we were greeted most warmly by nine wild-looking men; some with beards bleached by the weather. They all looked healthy and in very fair condition, after the severe winter, as they danced about in joyous excitement.

At 2:30 PM, the launch was lifted out of the water and the mail was brought ashore, along with various samples of Australian fruit to serve as "refreshments" for the landing party. We reached the boat harbor before anyone on land noticed the 'Aurora.' At the landing site, we were warmly welcomed by nine rugged-looking men, some with beards faded by the sun and weather. They all appeared healthy and in good shape after the harsh winter, as they energetically celebrated.

We learned that five sledging parties had left the Hut: Bage, Webb and Hurley had returned from the south, Stillwell, Close and Laseron from the east, and the others were still out. In Dr. Mawson's instructions, all parties were to be back at the Hut by January 15, 1913.

We found out that five sledging teams had left the Hut: Bage, Webb, and Hurley had returned from the south, Stillwell, Close, and Laseron from the east, and the others were still out. According to Dr. Mawson's instructions, all teams were supposed to be back at the Hut by January 15, 1913.

The launch made some trips to and from the ship with specimens during the afternoon. I returned on board and had a look at the cable. The weather was fine, but changes were apt to occur without much warning. At midnight it was blowing a gale from the south-east, and the chain was holding well. The launch was hoisted up in the davits and communication with the shore was suspended until 8 A.M. on January 15.

The launch made several trips to and from the ship with samples during the afternoon. I boarded again and checked the cable. The weather was nice, but changes could happen quickly and without much notice. By midnight, there was a strong wind coming from the southeast, and the anchor was holding tight. The launch was lifted up in the davits, and communication with the shore was stopped until 8 A.M. on January 15.

The lull was of two hours' duration, during which Murphy came aboard and furnished me with some particulars about the sledging parties still away.

The pause lasted for two hours, during which Murphy came on board and gave me some details about the sledding teams that were still out.

Dr. Mawson, with Ninnis and Mertz, had gone to the south-east. They were well provisioned and had taken eighteen dogs for transport purposes. Bickerton, Hodgeman and Whetter had been out forty-three days to the west and had food for forty days only. Madigan, McLean and Correll had been away for seventy days in an easterly direction.

Dr. Mawson, along with Ninnis and Mertz, had headed southeast. They were well-stocked with supplies and had brought eighteen dogs for transportation. Bickerton, Hodgeman, and Whetter had been out for forty-three days to the west and only had enough food for another forty days. Madigan, McLean, and Correll had been away for seventy days heading east.

Dr. Mawson had left a letter for me with instructions to take charge if he failed to return to time, that is not later than January 15, 1913.

Dr. Mawson had left a letter for me with instructions to take charge if he didn’t return on time, meaning not later than January 15, 1913.

On January 16 a party was observed from the ship coming in over the slope. There was much speculation as to its personnel since, at a distance, the three figures could not be recognized. The launch took us ashore and we greeted Madigan, McLean and Correll who had returned from a very successful expedition along the eastern coast over sea-ice.

On January 16, we saw a group arriving on the slope from the ship. There was a lot of guesswork about who they were because, from far away, we couldn't identify the three figures. The launch took us to shore, where we met Madigan, McLean, and Correll, who had just come back from a very successful trip along the eastern coast over sea ice.

Madigan and Bage came on board during the forenoon of the 17th and we had a long consultation about the position of affairs owing to the non-return of two parties. It was decided to re-erect the wireless mast and stay it well while the ship was waiting, so that, in case of any party being left at the Main Base, the wireless station would be in working order.**

Madigan and Bage boarded in the morning on the 17th, and we had an extensive discussion about the situation due to the non-return of two groups. We decided to set up the wireless mast again and secure it properly while the ship was waiting, so that if any group was left at the Main Base, the wireless station would be operational.

     ** It should be borne in mind that during the summer months (November,
December, January and part of February) wireless communication with the
outside world is impossible owing to continuous daylight reducing the
effective range. In summer the range was only a few hundred miles, and
the effective working distance for all times of the day probably not
above one hundred miles.
     ** It’s important to remember that during the summer months (November, December, January, and part of February), wireless communication with the outside world is impossible due to constant daylight, which shortens the effective range. In summer, the range was only a few hundred miles, and the effective working distance throughout the day was likely no more than one hundred miles.

At one o'clock on the morning of January 18, de la Motte, the officer on watch, reported that a party could be seen descending the glacier. This proved to be Bickerton, Hodgeman and Whetter returning from their trip along the west coast. Thus Dr. Mawson's party was the only one which had not yet returned.

At 1:00 AM on January 18, de la Motte, the officer on watch, reported that a group was seen coming down the glacier. This turned out to be Bickerton, Hodgeman, and Whetter coming back from their trip along the west coast. So, Dr. Mawson's party was the only one that still hadn't returned.

All day work on the wireless mast went along very satisfactorily, while Captain James Davis and Chief Officer Fletcher spent their time in the launch dragging for the cable lost on the morning of our arrival. The launch returned at 10.30 P.M. and Captain Davis reported that the grapnel had been buoyed until operations could be resumed.

All day, work on the wireless mast went smoothly, while Captain James Davis and Chief Officer Fletcher spent their time in the launch looking for the cable lost on the morning we arrived. The launch came back at 10:30 PM, and Captain Davis reported that the grapnel had been marked so operations could continue later.

On January 19 we tried to recover the chain, and to this end the 'Aurora' was taken over to the position where the grapnels had been buoyed and was anchored. All efforts to secure the chain were unsuccessful. At 7 P.M. we decided to return to our former position, having a hard job to raise the anchor, which appeared to have dragged under a big rock. Finally it broke away and came up in a mass of kelp, and with the stock "adrift." The latter was secured and we steamed back, "letting go" in eleven fathoms with ninety fathoms of chain.

On January 19, we attempted to recover the chain, and to do this, the 'Aurora' was moved to the spot where the grapnels had been marked and was anchored there. All our efforts to secure the chain were unsuccessful. At 7 PM, we decided to go back to our original position, which was a tough task since the anchor seemed to be stuck under a large rock. Eventually, it broke free and came up tangled in kelp, with the stock "adrift." We secured the latter and headed back, "dropping" the anchor in eleven fathoms with ninety fathoms of chain.

When Dr. Mawson's party was a week overdue, I considered that the time had arrived to issue a provisional notice to the members of the Expedition at Commonwealth Bay concerning the establishment of a relief party to operate from the Main Base.

When Dr. Mawson's team was a week late, I thought it was time to send a provisional notice to the members of the Expedition at Commonwealth Bay about setting up a relief party to operate from the Main Base.

A party of four left the Hut on the 20th, keeping a sharp look-out to the south-east for any signs of the missing party. They travelled as far as the air-tractor sledge which had been abandoned ten miles to the south, bringing it back to the Hut.

A group of four left the Hut on the 20th, watching closely to the south-east for any signs of the missing party. They went as far as the air-tractor sledge that had been left behind ten miles to the south, bringing it back to the Hut.

I decided to remain at Commonwealth Bay until January 30. If the leader's party had not returned by that day, a search party was to proceed eastward while the 'Aurora' sailed for Wild's Base. From the reports of the gales which prevailed during the month of March in 1912, and considering the short daylight there was at that time, I felt that it would be risking the lives of all on board to return to the Main Base after relieving Wild's party. I resolved, therefore, to wait as long as possible. As a result of a consultation with Madigan and Bage, I had a provisional notice drafted, to be posted up in the Hut on January 22.

I decided to stay at Commonwealth Bay until January 30. If the leader's party hadn’t returned by then, a search team would head east while the 'Aurora' sailed to Wild's Base. Given the strong winds that hit in March 1912 and the limited daylight at that time, I believed it would endanger everyone on board to go back to the Main Base after helping Wild's group. So, I decided to wait as long as possible. After discussing with Madigan and Bage, I had a temporary notice created to put up in the Hut on January 22.

This notice was to the effect that the non-arrival of the leader's party rendered it necessary to prepare for the establishment of a relief expedition at Winter Quarters and appointed Bage, Bickerton, Hodgeman, Jeffryes and McLean as members, under the command of Madigan; to remain in Antarctica for another year if necessary.

This notice stated that since the leader's party hadn't arrived, it was necessary to get ready for a relief expedition at Winter Quarters. Bage, Bickerton, Hodgeman, Jeffryes, and McLean were appointed as members, under Madigan's command, to stay in Antarctica for another year if needed.

On the same evening I went ashore to inspect the wireless mast, which was practically complete. The work had been done thoroughly and, provided the mast itself did not buckle, the stays were likely to hold. Hannam, Bickerton and Jeffryes were busy placing the engine and instruments in position.

On the same evening, I went ashore to check out the wireless mast, which was almost finished. The work had been done well, and as long as the mast didn’t bend, the stays should hold. Hannam, Bickerton, and Jeffryes were busy setting up the engine and instruments.

I then went up the slope for about a mile. The Winter Quarters looked like a heap of stones; boundless ice rose up to the southern skyline; the dark water to the north was broken by an occasional berg or the ice-covered islands. This wonderful region of ice and sea looks beautiful on a fine day. But what a terrible, vast solitude, constantly swept by icy winds and drift, stretches away to the south! A party will go out to-morrow to visit the depot at the top of the slope. This is the seventh day we have been waiting and hoping to welcome the absentees!

I then walked up the slope for about a mile. The Winter Quarters looked like a pile of stones; endless ice stretched to the southern horizon; the dark water to the north was interrupted by an occasional iceberg or the ice-covered islands. This stunning region of ice and sea looks amazing on a clear day. But what a terrible, vast solitude, constantly battered by icy winds and drift, spreads out to the south! A group will head out tomorrow to visit the depot at the top of the slope. This is the seventh day we have been waiting and hoping to welcome back the people who are missing!

On the 23rd the breeze was very strong in the forenoon, but the wind moderated about 4 P.M., when the launch was able to leave for the shore. We could see a search party (Hodgeman, Stillwell, and Correll) marching against a strong south-east wind on their way to examine the depot at Aladdin's Cave and its vicinity.

On the 23rd, the breeze was really strong in the morning, but the wind calmed down around 4 PM, allowing the launch to head for the shore. We could see a search party (Hodgeman, Stillwell, and Correll) making their way against a strong southeast wind to check out the depot at Aladdin's Cave and the surrounding area.

Though there was a moderate south-easter blowing, communication with the land went on during the day. I went ashore early, but the search party did not return until noon. They had remained at Aladdin's Cave overnight and marched farther south next morning, approaching a line of dense drift, without seeing anything.

Though there was a light southeast wind blowing, communication with the land continued throughout the day. I went ashore early, but the search party didn't come back until noon. They had stayed at Aladdin's Cave overnight and moved farther south the next morning, getting close to a line of thick drift without spotting anything.

It was arranged that another party of three men should start next morning (January 25) and, going in a southeasterly direction, make a search for five days, laying a depot at their farthest point. Hodgeman, Hurley and McLean made preparations to set out. I left instructions that a flag should be flown on the wireless mast if Dr. Mawson returned.

It was decided that another group of three men would leave the next morning (January 25) and head southeast to search for five days, setting up a supply depot at their farthest point. Hodgeman, Hurley, and McLean prepared to depart. I instructed them to raise a flag on the wireless mast if Dr. Mawson came back.

I now went through the supplies of provisions and coal which were to be landed for the use of the Relief Party. I intended to try and have everything on shore by January 29, taking advantage of any short interval of fair weather to send a boatload to the landing-place.

I now went through the supplies of food and coal that were meant for the Relief Party. I planned to try and get everything on shore by January 29, taking advantage of any brief moments of good weather to send a boatload to the landing spot.

On the 25th there was a hard south-east gale blowing until the afternoon, when it moderated sufficiently to send off the launch with thirteen bags of coal, Gillies being in charge. The boat harbour was reached in safety, the wind freshening to a gale before 6 P.M.

On the 25th, there was a strong southeast wind blowing until the afternoon, when it calmed down enough to send off the launch with thirteen bags of coal, with Gillies in charge. They safely reached the boat harbor, but the wind picked up again to a gale before 6 P.M.

Terrific gusts followed in rapid succession and, without warning, the cable parted sixty fathoms from the anchor at 9 P.M. Having cleared the reefs to leeward, we managed to get in the rest of the chain and then stood along the coast to the north-west. By keeping about three miles from the shore, we seemed to be beyond the reach of the more violent gusts, but a short sea holding the ship broadside to the wind during the squalls, rendered it difficult to maintain a fixed course.

Terrific gusts came in quick succession and, without warning, the cable snapped sixty fathoms from the anchor at 9 PM. After clearing the reefs to the leeward, we got the rest of the chain in and then headed along the coast to the northwest. By staying about three miles from shore, we seemed to be out of reach of the stronger gusts, but a short sea kept the ship broadside to the wind during the squalls, making it hard to maintain a steady course.

With reefs and bergs around, the increasing darkness about midnight made our position unpleasant. The engines had to be stopped and the ship allowed to drift with the wind, owing to a bearing becoming hot, but in a quarter of an hour they were moving once more.

With reefs and icebergs nearby, the growing darkness around midnight made our situation uncomfortable. We had to stop the engines and let the ship drift with the wind because one of the bearings was overheating, but after about fifteen minutes, we were moving again.

Early on January 26 the 'Aurora' was about half-way between Winter Quarters and the western point of Commonwealth Bay, when the wind suddenly ceased, and then came away light from the north-west. We could see that a south-east gale was still raging close inshore. Over the sea, towards the north, dark clouds were scudding with great rapidity along the horizon: the scene of a violent disturbance.

Early on January 26, the 'Aurora' was roughly halfway between Winter Quarters and the western point of Commonwealth Bay when the wind suddenly died down, then picked up lightly from the northwest. We could see that a southeast gale was still blowing hard close to the shore. Dark clouds were rapidly racing along the horizon to the north, indicating a violent disturbance.

We returned towards our late anchorage. On reaching it, the south-east wind had moderated considerably, and we let go our spare anchor and what had been saved of the chain.

We headed back to our earlier anchorage. When we got there, the southeast wind had calmed down a lot, so we lowered our spare anchor and what was left of the chain.

To the north, violent gusts appeared to be travelling in various directions, but, to our astonishment, these gusts, after approaching our position at a great rate, appeared to curve upwards; the water close to the ship was disturbed, and nothing else. This curious phenomenon lasted for about an hour and then the wind came with a rush from the south-east, testing the anchor-chain in the more furious squalls.

To the north, strong gusts seemed to be moving in different directions, but, to our surprise, these gusts, after rushing toward our position, seemed to curve upward; the water near the ship was agitated, and that was it. This strange phenomenon lasted for about an hour and then the wind suddenly came from the southeast, putting the anchor chain to the test in the more intense squalls.

The gale was in its third day on the 27th, and there was a "hurricane sky" during the morning. The wind would die away, only to blow more fiercely than before. The suddenness with which the changes occurred may be gathered from the following extracts from my journal:

The storm had been raging for three days on the 27th, and there was a "hurricane sky" in the morning. The wind would die down, only to pick up again even stronger than before. The abruptness of these shifts can be understood through these excerpts from my journal:

"January 27. 6 A.M. A whole gale blowing from the south-east.

"January 27. 6 A.M. A strong wind is blowing from the southeast."

"9 A.M. Light airs from north to east. Launch taking coal ashore.

"9 A.M. Light winds coming from the north to east. Launch is delivering coal ashore."

"11 A.M. Last cargo of coal had just left ship when the wind freshened from the south-east. The launch had just got inside the boat harbour when a terrific gust struck the vessel and our chain parted. We were blown out to sea while heaving in thirty fathoms of chain which remained.

"11 A.M. The last cargo of coal had just left the ship when the wind picked up from the southeast. The launch had just entered the boat harbor when a strong gust hit the vessel and our chain broke. We were blown out to sea while pulling in the thirty fathoms of chain that was left."

"4 P.M. We have been steaming backwards and forwards until the wind died away. The launch has just come off and taken another load of stores to the boat harbour.

"4 P.M. We have been moving back and forth until the wind died down. The launch just left and took another load of supplies to the boat harbor."

"7 P.M. The weather is moderating with rising barometer. Nearly everything required by the Relief Party is now ashore. Two or three trips will take the remainder.

"7 P.M. The weather is getting better with the barometer going up. Almost everything the Relief Party needs is now on land. A couple more trips will bring the rest."

"We shall steam about for a few hours, and make the anchorage early to-morrow morning."

"We'll cruise around for a few hours and reach the anchorage early tomorrow morning."

Next morning a kedge-anchor (about five hundred-weights) was lowered with the remainder of the chain. For a time this held the ship, but a gust of wind from the southeast caused it to drag. It was, therefore, hauled up and, on coming to the surface, was seen to have lost a fluke.

Next morning, a kedge-anchor (about five hundred pounds) was lowered with the rest of the chain. For a while, this kept the ship in place, but a sudden gust of wind from the southeast made it drag. So, it was pulled up, and when it surfaced, it was noticed that it had lost a fluke.

All equipment, coal and food were now on shore for the use of the Relief Party. I had given them everything that could be spared from the provisions set apart for the use of the ship's company. Next day I purposed to cruise along the coast to the east, if the weather were clear.

All the equipment, coal, and food were now on land for the Relief Party's use. I had given them everything that could be spared from the supplies set aside for the ship's crew. The next day, I planned to cruise along the coast to the east, provided the weather was clear.

January 29 was fine, so we steamed off at 6.30 A.M. As no flag was seen on the wireless mast, we knew that Dr. Mawson had not returned. A course was kept two or three miles from the ice-cliffs beyond the fringe of rocky islets.

January 29 was nice, so we set off at 6:30 A.M. Since there was no flag visible on the wireless mast, we realized that Dr. Mawson hadn’t come back. We maintained a course two or three miles away from the ice cliffs, just past the edge of the rocky islets.

At 4 A.M. on the 30th we were alongside the Mertz Glacier and reached the head of the bay at the confluence of glacier with land-ice. Mount Murchison was only dimly visible, but the weather was clear along the glacier-tongue. Signals were fired and a big kite flown at a height of about five hundred feet to attract attention on shore in case the missing party were near.

At 4 A.M. on the 30th, we were next to the Mertz Glacier and got to the end of the bay where the glacier meets the land ice. Mount Murchison was only faintly visible, but the weather was clear along the glacier tongue. We fired signals and flew a big kite about five hundred feet in the air to get attention on shore in case the missing group was nearby.

"1.30 P.M. We are now about half a mile from the head of the inlet. From the appearance of the country (heavily crevassed) approach to the sea by a sledging-party would be extremely difficult. There is no floe-ice at the foot of the cliff.

"1:30 P.M. We are currently about half a mile from the start of the inlet. Based on the look of the land (heavily crevassed), getting to the sea with a sledding team would be really tough. There’s no floe ice at the base of the cliff."

"10.30 P.M. We are approaching the end of the glacier-tongue around which there is a collection of pack. There is some drift ahead and it is difficult to see far. We have passed the eastern limit of coast to be searched.

"10:30 PM. We're nearing the end of the glacier tongue, where there's a cluster of pack ice. There's some drift ahead, making it hard to see very far. We've passed the eastern boundary of the coast we needed to search."

"10.35 P.M. The glacier-tongue is trending to the east and a line of heavy pack extends to the north, with many large bergs. No sign of flag or signal on the end of the barrier.

"10:35 PM. The glacier tongue is moving east and a stretch of thick pack ice goes north, with many large icebergs. There's no sign of a flag or signal at the end of the barrier."

"January 31. We left the glacier-tongue at 8 A.M. and steered back to Winter Quarters.

"January 31. We left the glacier tongue at 8 A.M. and headed back to Winter Quarters."

"At noon we could see Madigan Nunatak, a rocky patch, high up on the slope.

"At noon, we could see Madigan Nunatak, a rocky area high up on the slope."

"4.15 P.M. Sighted the large grounded berg, fifteen miles from the Main Base.

"4:15 PM. Spotted the large grounded iceberg, fifteen miles from the Main Base."

"9 P.M. Off Main Base. There is no flag to be seen on the wireless mast!

"9 P.M. Off Main Base. There’s no flag on the wireless mast!"

"Dr. Mawson's party is now sixteen days overdue; there must be something seriously amiss. But from our examination of the line of coast as far as 64 degrees 45' south, 146 degrees 19' east, there does not appear to be any probability of finding traces along the shore line at the base of vertical ice-cliffs."

"Dr. Mawson's party is now sixteen days late; something must be seriously wrong. However, from our inspection of the coastline up to 64 degrees 45' south, 146 degrees 19' east, it doesn’t seem likely that we’ll find any signs along the shoreline at the base of the vertical ice cliffs."

No communication with the shore was possible until the wind, which had again risen, had moderated. We could just stand off and on until a favourable opportunity occurred. Once the returning ten members of the Expedition were embarked it was imperative to hasten towards Wild's Base.

No communication with the shore was possible until the wind, which had picked up again, calmed down. We could only drift back and forth until a good opportunity came along. Once the returning ten members of the Expedition were on board, it was crucial to head towards Wild's Base as quickly as possible.

A week's gale in Commonwealth Bay! The seven days which followed I do not think any of us will forget. From February 1 to 7 it blew a continuous heavy gale, interrupted only when the wind increased to a full hurricane ** (eighty miles an hour).

A week of strong winds in Commonwealth Bay! I don’t think any of us will forget the seven days that followed. From February 1 to 7, there was a constant heavy gale, only interrupted when the wind picked up to a full hurricane ** (eighty miles an hour).

     ** * The maximum wind-velocity recorded at this time by the anemometer
on shore was approximately eighty miles an hour.
     ** * The highest wind speed recorded by the anemometer on the shore at this time was around eighty miles per hour.

We endeavoured to maintain a position under the cliffs where the sea had not room to become heavy. This entailed a constant struggle, as, with a full head of steam during the squalls, the vessel drove steadily seaward to where the rising waves broke on board and rendered steering more perplexing. Then, when it had moderated to a mere "howl," we would crawl back, only to be driven out again by the next squall. The blinding spray which was swept out in front of the squalls froze solidly on board and lent additional difficulty to the operation of "wearing ship."

We tried to keep our position under the cliffs where the sea wasn’t too rough. This was a constant battle because, with a full head of steam during the storms, the ship pushed steadily out to sea, where the waves crashed on board and made steering even harder. Then, when the winds died down to a mere "howl," we would slowly inch our way back, only to be pushed out again by the next squall. The blinding spray that got whipped up in front of the storms froze solid on board and made it even tougher to "wear ship."

It was on this occasion that we realized what a fine old vessel the 'Aurora' was, and, as we slowly moved back to shelter, could appreciate how efficiently our engine-room staff under Gillies were carrying out their duties. The ordinary steaming speed was six knots, yet for the whole of this week, without a hitch, the ship was being driven at an equivalent of ten knots. The fact of having this reserve power undoubtedly saved us from disaster.

It was during this time that we recognized what a great old ship the 'Aurora' was, and as we gradually returned to safety, we could see how effectively our engine-room crew under Gillies was performing their tasks. The normal cruising speed was six knots, yet for the entire week, the ship was running at an equivalent of ten knots without any issues. Having this extra power definitely helped us avoid disaster.

A typical entry from my diary reads:

A typical entry from my diary says:

"February 6. Just as the sun was showing over the ice-slopes this morning (4 A.M.) the wind became very violent with the most terrific squalls I have ever experienced. Vessel absolutely unmanageable, driving out to sea. I was expecting the masts to go overboard every minute. This was the worst, I think, lasting about two hours. At 6 A.M., still blowing very hard but squalls less violent, gradually made shelter during the morning...."

"February 6. As the sun was rising over the icy slopes this morning (4 A.M.), the wind picked up and turned incredibly violent with the worst squalls I've ever experienced. The ship was completely unmanageable, being pushed out to sea. I thought the masts would go overboard at any moment. This was definitely the worst stretch, lasting about two hours. By 6 A.M., it was still blowing really hard, but the squalls were less fierce, and we slowly found shelter throughout the morning...."

On February 8 the weather improved after 1 A.M. The gusts were less violent and the lulls were of longer duration. At 9 A.M. there was only a gentle breeze. We steamed in towards the boat harbour and signalled for the launch to come off with the ten members of the shore-party. The latter had been instructed to remain at the Hut until the vessel was ready to sail. Here, while the gale had been in full career, they had helped to secure enough seal and penguin-meat to keep the Relief Party and their dogs for another year.

On February 8, the weather got better after 1 A.M. The winds were less intense, and the calm periods lasted longer. By 9 A.M., there was just a light breeze. We headed toward the boat harbor and signaled for the launch to come over with the ten members of the shore party. They had been told to stay at the Hut until the ship was ready to leave. During the storm, they helped gather enough seal and penguin meat to keep the Relief Party and their dogs fed for another year.

The good-byes were brief while the launch discharged the men and their belongings. Instructions were handed over to Madigan directing him to follow the course believed to have been taken by Dr. Mawson and to make an exhaustive search, commencing as soon as the 'Aurora' left Commonwealth Bay. Madigan gave me a letter containing a report of the work done by the party which had left on the 25th.

The goodbyes were quick as the launch unloaded the men and their stuff. Instructions were given to Madigan telling him to follow the route that Dr. Mawson was thought to have taken and to conduct a thorough search, starting as soon as the 'Aurora' left Commonwealth Bay. Madigan handed me a letter with a report on the work done by the team that had left on the 25th.

It appears that they had been confined in Aladdin's Cave for twenty-four hours by dense drift and then, in moderate drift, made four miles to the south-east. Here they camped and were not able to move for thirty-six hours in a high wind with thick snow.

It seems they were stuck in Aladdin's Cave for twenty-four hours due to heavy snow and then, with lighter snow, traveled four miles to the southeast. They set up camp here and couldn’t move for thirty-six hours because of strong winds and heavy snow.

On the 28th the drift decreased in amount and, though it was only possible to see a few hundred yards and crevasses were frequent, they kept a course of east 30 degrees south for six miles. A snow-mound was built and on top of it were placed provisions and a note giving the bearing and distance from Aladdin's Cave.

On the 28th, the drift lessened, and even though visibility was only a few hundred yards and crevasses were common, they maintained a course of east 30 degrees south for six miles. They built a snow mound and placed provisions and a note on top, indicating the bearing and distance from Aladdin's Cave.

In the afternoon the wind subsided and it became clear. Eight miles on the same course brought them to their farthest camp, twenty-three miles from the Hut. A mound of eleven feet was erected here, provisions and a note being left and some black bunting wound among the snow-blocks. The depot was on a ridge and, with glasses, several miles could be swept to the south-east.

In the afternoon, the wind calmed down and it became clear. After eight miles on the same route, they reached their farthest camp, which was twenty-three miles from the Hut. They set up an eleven-foot mound here, leaving behind supplies, a note, and some black bunting twisted among the snow blocks. The depot was situated on a ridge, and through binoculars, they could see several miles to the southeast.

The party consisted of McLean, Hodgeman and Hurley.

The party included McLean, Hodgeman, and Hurley.

De la Motte and Hannam took the Relief Party ashore in the launch and, as soon as they had returned—at 11.30 A.M.—we steamed out of the bay. The weather had calmed and there were light airs and a smooth sea.

De la Motte and Hannam took the Relief Party to shore in the launch, and as soon as they got back—at 11:30 A.M.—we headed out of the bay. The weather had settled down, and there were gentle breezes and calm waters.

The members of the Relief Party were as follows: C. T. Madigan (leader), R. Bage, F. H. Bickerton, A. J. Hodgeman, Dr. A. L. McLean and S. N. Jeffryes (wireless operator). The remaining ten members of the Main Base Party returned to Australia: J. H. Close, P. E. Correll, W. H. Hannam, J. G. Hunter, J. F. Hurley, C. F. Laseron, H. D. Murphy, F. L. Stillwell, E. N. Webb and Dr. L. A. Whetter.

The members of the Relief Party were: C. T. Madigan (leader), R. Bage, F. H. Bickerton, A. J. Hodgeman, Dr. A. L. McLean, and S. N. Jeffryes (wireless operator). The other ten members of the Main Base Party went back to Australia: J. H. Close, P. E. Correll, W. H. Hannam, J. G. Hunter, J. F. Hurley, C. F. Laseron, H. D. Murphy, F. L. Stillwell, E. N. Webb, and Dr. L. A. Whetter.

Throughout the afternoon we steered north-west and at 8.30 P.M. were approaching heavy pack. Just then Hannam received a wireless message from the Main Base informing us that Dr. Mawson had reached the Hut alone, his two comrades having perished, and instructing me to return at once and pick up all hands. We turned round and steered back immediately.

Throughout the afternoon we headed northwest, and at 8:30 PM we were getting close to dense pack ice. At that moment, Hannam received a wireless message from the Main Base letting us know that Dr. Mawson had made it to the Hut alone, as his two companions had died, and it instructed me to turn back right away and pick up everyone. We immediately turned around and headed back.

At 8 A.M. on February 9 the ship entered Commonwealth Bay steaming against a strong southerly breeze with some snow. We were right up near the anchorage about noon and the Pilot Jack could be seen flying from the wireless mast. Instructions were signalled for, but our efforts were unobserved. We then steamed to and fro across the bay. At 6 P.M. it was blowing a hard gale and showed signs of becoming worse.

At 8 A.M. on February 9, the ship entered Commonwealth Bay, battling a strong southern breeze with some snow. By noon, we were close to the anchorage, and the Pilot Jack was visible flying from the wireless mast. We signaled for instructions, but our attempts went unnoticed. We then cruised back and forth across the bay. By 6 P.M., there was a strong gale blowing, and it looked like it would get worse.

At 6 P.M. the wind was growing in strength and the barometer was falling. Not having received any reply to my signal for instructions, I felt it was necessary to decide whether I was justified in remaining any longer.

At 6 P.M., the wind was picking up, and the barometer was dropping. Not having gotten a response to my call for instructions, I felt it was necessary to decide whether I could justify staying any longer.

After considering the position in all its bearings I decided to sail westward without further delay and for the following reasons:

After thinking about the situation from all angles, I decided to head west without wasting any more time, and here are the reasons:

1. Dr. Mawson and his companions were in safety, comfortably housed and fully equipped for another winter.

1. Dr. Mawson and his companions were safe, comfortably settled in, and fully prepared for another winter.

2. Any further delay was seriously endangering our chance of being able to relieve Wild's party that year. The navigation of the fifteen hundred miles to the Shackleton Ice-Shelf was becoming, daily, more dangerous on account of the shortness of daylight and the conditions of the ice.

2. Any additional delay was putting our chances of rescuing Wild's group that year in serious jeopardy. Navigating the fifteen hundred miles to the Shackleton Ice-Shelf was getting riskier every day due to the limited daylight and the state of the ice.

3. The only vessel which had wintered in the vicinity of the Western Base (the 'Gauss') had been frozen in as early in the season as February 22, spending more than twelve months in the ice. The 'Aurora' was not provisioned for a winter in the ice.

3. The only ship that had spent the winter near the Western Base (the 'Gauss') got trapped in the ice as early as February 22, remaining frozen for over twelve months. The 'Aurora' wasn't stocked for a winter in the ice.

4. It had been ascertained from the records at the Main Base that gales were often protracted at the close of the short summer season. We had just experienced one such gale, lasting seven days.

4. Records from the Main Base showed that storms often lasted for a long time at the end of the brief summer season. We had just gone through one of those storms, which lasted for seven days.

5. As a seaman, I had realized the difficulties encountered in approaching and getting away from the Western Base in 1912. It was then three weeks later in the year.

5. As a sailor, I had come to understand the challenges faced in getting to and leaving the Western Base in 1912. It was then three weeks later in the year.

I felt convinced that in leaving the Main Base, without further delay, I was acting as Dr. Mawson would have wished, if I had been able to acquaint him with the position of the Western Party.

I was sure that by leaving the Main Base without any more delays, I was doing what Dr. Mawson would have wanted, if I had been able to tell him about the situation of the Western Party.

At 6.30 P.M. we steamed out of the bay, the wind moderating as the ship got well out to sea. At midnight there was a moderate breeze from the south, with some snow.

At 6:30 PM, we sailed out of the bay, and the wind calmed down as the ship moved farther out to sea. By midnight, there was a gentle breeze coming from the south, along with some snow.

On February 10 heavy pack was met, about fifty miles north of Commonwealth Bay. After coasting along its margin for a while, we pushed among the floes and, after three hours, reached a patch of fairly open water about 1 P.M.

On February 10, we encountered thick pack ice, roughly fifty miles north of Commonwealth Bay. After following its edge for a bit, we navigated through the floes and, after three hours, arrived at a section of relatively open water around 1 P.M.

One hour later a large ice-formation was sighted, which tallied with that met on January 3 of the previous year (1912) and which, on this occasion, was no longer in its original position. We came to the conclusion that the whole must have drifted about fifty miles to the north-west during the intervening year. The face of this huge berg, along which the 'Aurora' coasted, was about forty miles in length.

One hour later, we spotted a large ice formation that matched the one we encountered on January 3 of the previous year (1912), but this time it was not in its original spot. We concluded that it must have drifted about fifty miles to the northwest over the past year. The side of this massive iceberg, which the 'Aurora' sailed along, was about forty miles long.

Hannam heard fragments of a message from Dr. Mawson during the evening. The words, "crevasse," "Ninnis," "Mertz," "broken" and "cable" were picked up.

Hannam heard snippets of a message from Dr. Mawson during the evening. The words, "crevasse," "Ninnis," "Mertz," "broken," and "cable" were caught.

Good progress was made on the 11th against a high westerly sea. The sun set in a clear sky and the barometer was slowly rising. Our position was evidently north of the pack and, if unimpeded by ice, there was a chance of the ship arriving at her destination in time.

Good progress was made on the 11th against a strong westward sea. The sun set in a clear sky and the barometer was slowly rising. Our position was clearly north of the ice pack, and if there were no ice in the way, there was a chance the ship would reach its destination on time.

Poor headway was made for nearly three days against an adverse wind and sea. Then, late on the 14th, a breeze sprang up from the east-south-east and, under all sail, the 'Aurora' made seven knots.

Poor progress was made for almost three days against a strong wind and rough seas. Then, late on the 14th, a breeze picked up from the east-southeast, and with all sails set, the 'Aurora' reached seven knots.

Next morning we were driving along before an easterly gale in thick snow, and at noon the day's run was one hundred and eighty miles.

Next morning, we were driving with an east wind in heavy snow, and by noon, we had covered one hundred eighty miles.

The journal describes the following week:

The journal talks about the upcoming week:

"February 16. The weather cleared up this morning and the sun came out, enabling us to fix our position.

"February 16. The weather cleared this morning and the sun came out, allowing us to determine our location."

"We are doing about eight knots under topsails and foresail. The sky looked threatening this evening but improved considerably before midnight.

"We're going about eight knots with the topsails and foresail. The sky looked dark this evening but got a lot better before midnight."

"February 17. There were frequent snow squalls today, making it difficult to see. Only a few scattered pieces of ice were about.

"February 17. There were a lot of snow squalls today, making it hard to see. Just a few scattered pieces of ice were around."

"February 18. Bright, clear weather to-day enabled us to get good observations. There are a great many 'blue whales' round the ship, and the many bergs in sight are suggestive of heavy pack to the south. A great many petrels and Cape pigeons have been seen.

"February 18. The bright, clear weather today allowed us to take good observations. There are a lot of 'blue whales' around the ship, and the many icebergs in sight suggest heavy pack ice to the south. We've seen a lot of petrels and Cape pigeons."

"February 19. The ship was brought up this morning at 8.45 by a line of heavy pack extending across the course. The weather was misty, but cleared up before noon. We have been obliged to steer a northerly course along the edge of the pack.

"February 19. The ship was brought up this morning at 8:45 by a line of heavy ice extending across our path. The weather was foggy, but it cleared up before noon. We had to navigate a northern course along the edge of the ice."

"The margin of this pack is some sixty miles farther north than that which we followed in 1912.

"The edge of this pack is about sixty miles further north than the one we followed in 1912."

"At midnight we were steering north-north-west; many bergs in sight and a line of pack to port.

"At midnight, we were heading north-northwest; there were many icebergs in sight and a line of pack ice to our left."

"February 20. At daylight we were able to steer southwest, being at noon about twenty miles north of Termination Ice-Tongue. Pushing through the looser edge of pack for a couple of hours we saw the loom of the ice-tongue to the southward. The pack becoming closer, we turned back to the north in order to try and push through farther west, where the sky looked more promising.

"February 20. At dawn, we managed to head southwest, and by noon we were about twenty miles north of Termination Ice-Tongue. After navigating through the looser edge of the pack for a couple of hours, we spotted the ice-tongue rising up to the south. As the pack tightened, we turned back north to attempt to push further west, where the sky appeared more promising."

"At dark we were in a patch of clear water, with ice all around. It began to snow and, as the wind remained a light easterly, the ship was allowed to drift until daylight.

"At night, we were in a spot of clear water, surrounded by ice. It started to snow, and since the wind was a gentle easterly, we let the ship drift until morning."

"February 21. The morning was very foggy up till 11 A.M. We steered west until noon and then entered the pack; there was a promising sky towards the south. Fair progress was made through the ice, which became looser as we advanced to the south. At 8 P.M. we passed through leads by moonlight, having a favourable run throughout the night.

"February 21. The morning was really foggy until 11 A.M. We headed west until noon and then entered the pack; the sky looked promising to the south. We made good progress through the ice, which got looser as we moved south. At 8 P.M., we navigated through openings by moonlight, having a smooth run throughout the night."

"February 22. At 4 A.M. the wind freshened from the south-east with some snow; the floes were getting heavier and the advent of a blizzard was not hailed with joy. About noon the ship approached open water and the snow ceased.

"February 22. At 4 A.M. the wind picked up from the southeast with some snow; the ice floes were getting thicker and the arrival of a blizzard was not welcomed. Around noon, the ship neared open water and the snowfall stopped."

"We were now on the confines of the sea of bergs where navigation had proved so dangerous in 1912.

"We were now on the edge of the sea of icebergs where navigation had been so dangerous in 1912."

"At 8 P.M. the driving snow and growing darkness made it impossible to see any distance ahead. The next seven hours were the most anxious I have ever spent at sea. Although the wind blew hard from the south-east, we passed through the sea of bergs without mishap, guided and protected by a Higher Power.

"At 8 P.M., the heavy snow and increasing darkness made it impossible to see far ahead. The next seven hours were the most anxious I've ever spent at sea. Even though the wind was blowing strong from the southeast, we navigated through the sea of icebergs without any issues, guided and protected by a Higher Power."

"February 23. At 4 A.M. the loom of an ice-tongue was sighted and we were soon standing in to follow this feature until we reached the Shackleton Shelf.

"February 23. At 4 A.M. we spotted the edge of an ice tongue and quickly moved in to track this feature until we reached the Shackleton Shelf."

"At 8 A.M. we found that we were some miles south of our reckoning.

"At 8 A.M. we discovered that we were a few miles south of where we thought we were."

"At 11 A.M. we sighted a depot-flag on the slope. Soon after the ship was up to the fast floe at the head of the bay, the ice being nearly a mile farther north than on the previous year. In fact, the ice-conditions as a whole had changed considerably.

"At 11 A.M., we spotted a depot flag on the slope. Shortly after, the ship reached the fast ice at the head of the bay, with the ice being almost a mile farther north than the previous year. In fact, the overall ice conditions had changed significantly."

"At noon we reached the Base and found the party all well."

"At noon we arrived at the Base and found everyone in good health."

Wild and his comrades were as glad to see the 'Aurora' as we were to see them. They had commenced to lay in a stock of seal-meat fearing that they might have to pass another winter on the glacier.

Wild and his friends were just as happy to see the 'Aurora' as we were to see them. They had started to stock up on seal meat, worried that they might have to spend another winter on the glacier.

All the afternoon every one was busy getting baggage on board and watering ship. The weather was good and I had intended to sail on the same evening by moonlight, following the glacier-tongue northward in clear water for sixty miles.

All afternoon, everyone was busy loading luggage onto the ship and watering it. The weather was nice, and I planned to set sail that evening by moonlight, following the glacier's edge northward in clear water for sixty miles.

As we turned northward, "all well" on board, I felt truly thankful that Wild's party had been relieved and anxiety on their account was now at an end. The party included F. Wild (leader), G. Dovers, C. T. Harrisson, C. A. Hoadley, Dr. S. E. Jones, A. L. Kennedy, M. H. Moyes and A. D. Watson.

As we headed north, with everything good on board, I felt genuinely grateful that Wild's team had been relieved and my worries about them were finally over. The team included F. Wild (leader), G. Dovers, C. T. Harrisson, C. A. Hoadley, Dr. S. E. Jones, A. L. Kennedy, M. H. Moyes, and A. D. Watson.

Early on the 24th there was a fresh easterly breeze, while the ship steamed among fields of bergs, for the most part of glacier-ice. It is marvellous how a vessel can pass through such an accumulation in the dark and come off with only a few bumps!

Early on the 24th, there was a fresh easterly breeze while the ship navigated through fields of icebergs, mostly made of glacier ice. It's amazing how a vessel can move through such a collection in the dark and only come away with a few minor bumps!

Pack consisting of heavy broken floe-ice was entered at four o'clock on the same day, and at 8 A.M. on the 25th we were clear of it, steering once more among bergs, many of which were earth-stained. The day was remarkably fine with light winds and a smooth sea.

Pack made up of thick broken floe ice was entered at four o'clock on the same day, and at 8 A.M. on the 25th we were out of it, navigating once again among icebergs, many of which were marked with dirt. The day was unusually nice with gentle winds and a calm sea.

After we had passed through three hundred miles of berg-strewn ocean, large masses of ice, water-worn in most instances, were still numerous, and on February 27, though our position was north of the 80th parallel, they were just beginning to diminish in numbers. At noon on that day a sounding was made in two thousand two hundred and thirty fathoms.

After we had traveled through three hundred miles of ocean filled with icebergs, large chunks of ice, usually worn down by the water, were still common. On February 27, even though we were north of the 80th parallel, they were just starting to decrease in number. At noon that day, we took a measurement at two thousand two hundred and thirty fathoms.

Any hope we may have had of steaming to the east with the object of attempting to relieve the seven men at Adelie Land had to be definitely abandoned on account of the small supply of coal which remained.

Any hope we had of sailing east to try to rescue the seven men at Adelie Land had to be completely given up because of the small amount of coal we had left.

There was now a clear run of two thousand miles through the zone of westerly gales and high seas, and on March 14 we reached Port Esperance. Mr. Eitel, Secretary of the Expedition, landed here and caught the steamer Dover to Hobart. We heard of the disaster to Captain Scott and it was learned that wireless messages had been received from Dr. Mawson, which had been forwarded on to Australia through the Macquarie Island party.

There was now a straight path of two thousand miles through the area of westward gales and rough seas, and on March 14 we arrived at Port Esperance. Mr. Eitel, the Secretary of the Expedition, got off here and took the steamer Dover to Hobart. We learned about the tragedy that befell Captain Scott, and it was reported that wireless messages had been received from Dr. Mawson, which were sent on to Australia via the Macquarie Island team.





CHAPTER XIX THE WESTERN BASE—ESTABLISHMENT AND EARLY ADVENTURES

by F. Wild

At 7 A.M. on February 21, 1912, the 'Aurora' steamed away to the north leaving us on the Shackleton Ice-Shelf, while cheers and hearty good wishes were exchanged with the ship's company. On the sea-ice, that day, there stood with me my comrades—the Western Party; G. Dovers, C. T. Harrisson, C. A. Hoadley, S. E. Jones, A. L. Kennedy, M. H. Moyes and A. D. Watson.

At 7 A.M. on February 21, 1912, the 'Aurora' headed north, leaving us on the Shackleton Ice-Shelf, as cheers and well wishes were exchanged with the crew. On the sea ice that day, I was with my friends—the Western Party: G. Dovers, C. T. Harrisson, C. A. Hoadley, S. E. Jones, A. L. Kennedy, M. H. Moyes, and A. D. Watson.

We proceeded to the top of the cliff, where the remainder of the stores and gear were hauled up. Tents were then erected and the work of hut-building at once commenced. The site selected for our home was six hundred and forty yards inland from the spot where the stores were landed, and, as the edge of the glacier was very badly broken, I was anxious to get a supply of food, clothing and fuel moved back from the edge to safety as soon as possible.

We made our way to the top of the cliff, where the rest of the supplies and equipment were pulled up. Then, we set up tents, and immediately started building huts. The place we chose for our home was six hundred and forty yards inland from where the supplies were unloaded, and since the edge of the glacier was really unstable, I wanted to move food, clothing, and fuel back to safety from the edge as soon as we could.

Of the twenty-eight Greenland dogs that had reached Antarctica in the 'Aurora', nineteen were landed in Adelie Land and nine with us. So far, none of these had been broken in for sledging, and all were in poor condition. Their quarters on the ship had been very cramped, and many times they had been thoroughly soaked in salt water, besides enduring several blizzards in Antarctic waters.

Of the twenty-eight Greenland dogs that made it to Antarctica on the 'Aurora', nineteen were brought to Adelie Land and nine were with us. So far, none of them had been trained for sledding, and all were not in great shape. Their space on the ship had been pretty cramped, and they had been soaked in salt water many times, plus they had to endure several storms in Antarctic waters.

Harrisson, Hoadley, Kennedy and Jones "turned the first sod" in the foundations of the hut, while Dovers, Moyes, Watson and I sledged along supplies of timber and stores. Inward from the brink of the precipice, which was one hundred feet in height, the surface was fairly good for sledges, but, owing to crevasses and pressure-ridges, the course was devious and mostly uphill.

Harrisson, Hoadley, Kennedy, and Jones "turned the first sod" for the hut's foundation, while Dovers, Moyes, Watson, and I hauled in supplies of timber and other materials. Moving inward from the edge of the cliff, which was a hundred feet high, the ground was decent for sledges, but because of crevasses and pressure ridges, the path was winding and mostly uphill.

Until the building was completed, the day's work commenced at 6 A.M., and, with only half an hour for a midday meal, continued until 7 P.M. Fortunately, the weather was propitious during the seven days when the carpenters and joiners ruled the situation; the temperature ranging from -12 degrees F. to 25 degrees F., while a moderate blizzard interrupted one day. The chief trouble was that the blizzard deposited six feet of snow around the stack of stores and coal at the landing-place, thereby adding considerably to our labour. As evidence of the force of the wind, the floe was broken and driven out past the foot of the "flying-fox," tearing away the lower anchor and breaking the sheer-legs on the glacier.

Until the building was finished, workdays started at 6 A.M., and, with only half an hour for lunch, went on until 7 P.M. Luckily, the weather was favorable during the seven days when the carpenters and joiners were in charge; temperatures ranged from -12 degrees F. to 25 degrees F., and a light blizzard interrupted one day. The main issue was that the blizzard dumped six feet of snow around the stack of supplies and coal at the landing spot, which significantly increased our workload. As a sign of the wind's power, the ice floe was broken and pushed out past the base of the "flying-fox," ripping off the lower anchor and damaging the sheer-legs on the glacier.

An average day's work on the stores consisted in bringing thirteen loads over a total distance of nine and a half miles. First of all, the cases had to be dug out of the snow-drifts, and loading and unloading the sledges was scarcely less arduous.

An average day's work in the stores involved hauling thirteen loads over a total distance of nine and a half miles. First, the cases had to be dug out of the snow drifts, and loading and unloading the sledges was almost just as tough.

On February 27, while working on the roof, Harrisson made an addition to our geographical knowledge. Well to the north of the mainland, and bearing a little north of east, he could trace the outline of land. Subsequently this was proved to be an island, thirty-two miles distant, and seventeen miles north of the mainland. It was twenty miles long and fifteen miles wide, being entirely ice-covered. Later on, it was charted as Masson Island.

On February 27, while working on the roof, Harrisson expanded our geographical knowledge. Far to the north of the mainland, slightly north of east, he could see the outline of land. Later, it was confirmed to be an island, thirty-two miles away and seventeen miles north of the mainland. It measured twenty miles long and fifteen miles wide, completely covered in ice. Eventually, it was mapped as Masson Island.

On the 28th, the hut was fit for habitation, the stove was installed, and meals were cooked and eaten in moderate comfort. The interior of the house was twenty feet square, but its area was reduced by a lobby entrance, three feet by five feet, a dark-room three feet by six feet situated on one side, and my cabin six feet six inches square in one corner. The others slept in seven bunks which were ranged at intervals round the walls. Of the remaining space, a large portion was commodiously occupied by the stove and table.

On the 28th, the hut was ready for living, the stove was set up, and meals were prepared and enjoyed in decent comfort. The house's interior was twenty feet square, but the usable area was smaller because of a lobby entrance that was three feet by five feet, a darkroom that was three feet by six feet located on one side, and my cabin that measured six feet six inches square in one corner. The others slept in seven bunks lined up at intervals around the walls. A large part of the remaining space was comfortably taken up by the stove and table.

On three sides, the roof projected five feet beyond the walls and formed a veranda which was boarded up, making an excellent store-room and work-room. This was a splendid idea of Dr. Mawson's, enabling us to work during the severest storms when there was no room in the hut, and incidentally supplying extra insulation and rendering the inside much warmer. The main walls and roof were double and covered with weather-proof felt. Daylight was admitted through four plate-glass skylights in the roof.

On three sides, the roof extended five feet beyond the walls and created a veranda that was enclosed, turning it into a great storage and workspace. This was a brilliant idea from Dr. Mawson, allowing us to work during the most intense storms when there wasn’t enough space in the hut, and it also added extra insulation, making the inside much warmer. The main walls and roof were double-layered and covered with weatherproof felt. Daylight came in through four plate-glass skylights in the roof.

A blizzard effectually prevented outdoor work on February 29, and all hands were employed in the hut, lining the roof and walls and fixing shelves for cooking and other utensils.

A blizzard effectively stopped all outdoor work on February 29, so everyone was inside the hut, putting up insulation on the roof and walls and setting up shelves for cooking and other utensils.

An attack was made on the transport of stores next day. As a result of twelve hours' work, five and a half tons of coal were dragged up and stowed under the veranda. It was Hoadley's birthday, and the cook made a special feature of the dinner. With extra dainties like figs, cake and a bottle of wine, we felt that the occasion was fitly celebrated. On March 2, more stores were amassed round the house; Hoadley, Harrisson and I doing odd jobs inside, opening cans, sorting out stores, fitting bunks, shelves and the acetylene gas plant.

The next day, an attack was launched on the supply transport. After twelve hours of work, we managed to haul up and store five and a half tons of coal under the porch. It was Hoadley's birthday, and the cook made a big deal out of dinner. With special treats like figs, cake, and a bottle of wine, we felt the occasion was celebrated properly. On March 2, we gathered more supplies around the house, while Hoadley, Harrisson, and I tackled various tasks inside, opening cans, sorting supplies, and setting up bunks, shelves, and the acetylene gas equipment.

While undoing some packages of small boards, Hoadley found that a space had been arranged in the centre of one of the bundles, and a box of cigars inserted by some of the men originally employed upon the construction of the hut in Melbourne. Enclosed was a letter of hearty good wishes.

While unpacking some packages of small boards, Hoadley discovered that a space had been made in the center of one of the bundles, and a box of cigars had been placed there by some of the workers originally involved in building the hut in Melbourne. A letter containing warm wishes was enclosed.

During the afternoon, Dovers and Kennedy lowered a small sledge down to the floe and brought up a seal and three Adelie penguins. These served for a while as fresh food for ourselves and the dogs.

During the afternoon, Dovers and Kennedy lowered a small sledge down to the ice and brought up a seal and three Adelie penguins. These served for a while as fresh food for us and the dogs.

Sunday March 3 was the finest day we had up till then experienced, and, since the work was now sufficiently advanced to make us comparatively comfortable and safe, I determined to make a proper Sunday of it. All hands were called at 8.30 A.M. instead of 6 A.M. After breakfast a few necessary jobs were done and at noon a short service was held. When lunch was over, the skis were unpacked, and all went for a run to the east in the direction of Masson Island.

Sunday, March 3, was the best day we had experienced so far, and since the work was now advanced enough to make us relatively comfortable and safe, I decided to observe it as a proper Sunday. Everyone was called at 8:30 A.M. instead of 6 A.M. After breakfast, we took care of a few necessary tasks, and at noon, we held a short service. Once lunch was over, we unpacked the skis and all went for a run to the east toward Masson Island.

The glacier's surface was excellent for travelling, but I soon found that it would be dangerous to walk about alone without skis, as there were a number of crevasses near the hut, some of considerable size; I opened one twenty-five feet wide. They were all well bridged and would support a man on skis quite easily.

The glacier's surface was great for traveling, but I quickly realized it would be risky to wander around alone without skis because there were several crevasses close to the hut, some quite large; I discovered one that was twenty-five feet wide. They were all well bridged and could easily support a person on skis.

A heavy gale, with falling snow and blinding drift, came on early the next day and continued for forty-eight hours; our worst blizzard up to that time. The temperature, below zero before the storm, rose with the wind to 30 degrees F. Inside, all were employed preparing for a sledging trip I intended to make to the mainland before the winter set in. We were greatly handicapped by the want of a sewing machine.** When unpacked, the one which had been brought was found to be without shuttles, spools and needles. Large canvas bags, made to contain two weeks' provisions for a sledging unit of three men, were in the equipment, but the smaller bags of calico for the different articles of food had to be sewn by hand. Several hundred of these were required, and altogether the time consumed in making them was considerable.

A strong wind, with falling snow and blinding snowdrifts, hit early the next day and lasted for forty-eight hours; it was our worst blizzard up to that point. The temperature, which was below zero before the storm, rose with the wind to 30 degrees F. Inside, everyone was busy getting ready for a sledging trip I planned to take to the mainland before winter arrived. We were really limited by the lack of a sewing machine. When we unpacked it, we found that the one that had been brought was missing shuttles, spools, and needles. Large canvas bags, designed to hold two weeks' worth of supplies for a sledging team of three men, were in the equipment, but the smaller calico bags for the different food items had to be sewn by hand. We needed several hundred of these, and all in all, it took a lot of time to make them.

     ** By accident the small sewing machine belonging to Wild's party
was landed at the Main Base—ED.
     ** By chance, the small sewing machine that belonged to Wild's group ended up at the Main Base—ED.

Emerging on the morning of the 6th. after the blizzard had blown itself out, we found that snow-drifts to a depth of twelve feet had collected around the hut. For entrance and exit, a shaft had to be dug and a ladder made. The stores, stacked in heaps close by, were completely covered, and another blizzard swooping down on the 7th made things still worse. This "blow," persisting till the morning of the 9th, was very heavy, the wind frequently attaining velocities judged to reach ninety miles per hour, accompanied by drift so thick that it was impossible to go outside for anything.

Emerging on the morning of the 6th, after the blizzard had finally calmed down, we discovered that snowdrifts piled up to twelve feet around the hut. To get in and out, we had to dig a shaft and make a ladder. The supplies, stacked nearby, were completely buried, and another blizzard hit on the 7th, making everything even worse. This "blow," which lasted until the morning of the 9th, was extremely intense, with winds reaching speeds estimated at ninety miles per hour, and the snowdrift was so dense that it was impossible to go outside for anything.

Beyond the erection of the wireless masts, everything was now ready for the sledging journey. On the day when the wind abated, a party set to work digging holes for the masts and stay-posts. The former were to be fifty-two feet high, four and a half feet being buried in the ice. Unfortunately, a strong breeze with thick drift sprang up just as hoisting operations had started, and in a few minutes the holes were filled up and the workers had to run for shelter. Meanwhile, four men had succeeded in rescuing all the buried stores, some being stowed alongside the hut, and the remainder stacked up again on a new level.

Beyond the installation of the wireless masts, everything was now set for the sledging journey. On the day when the wind died down, a team began digging holes for the masts and stay-posts. The masts were supposed to be fifty-two feet tall, with four and a half feet buried in the ice. Unfortunately, a strong gust of wind picked up with heavy snow just as the hoisting operations began, and within minutes the holes were filled in, forcing the workers to seek shelter. Meanwhile, four men managed to retrieve all the buried supplies; some were stored next to the hut, while the rest were stacked again at a new height.

On came another severe blizzard, which continued with only a few minutes' interval until the evening of the 12th. During the short lull, Jones, Dovers and Hoadley took a sledge for a load of ice from a pressure-ridge rather less than two hundred yards from the hut. While they were absent, the wind freshened again, and they had great difficulty in finding a way to the entrance.

On came another intense blizzard, which carried on with only a few minutes' break until the evening of the 12th. During the brief pause, Jones, Dovers, and Hoadley took a sled to collect ice from a pressure ridge that was just under two hundred yards from the hut. While they were gone, the wind picked up again, and they had a tough time finding their way back to the entrance.

It was very disappointing to be delayed in this manner, but there was consolation in the fact that we were better off in the hut than on the glacier, and that there was plenty of work inside. The interior was thus put in order much earlier than it would otherwise have been.

It was really disappointing to be delayed like this, but we were comforted by the fact that we were better off in the hut than on the glacier, and there was plenty of work to do inside. As a result, we got the interior organized much sooner than we would have otherwise.

In erecting the hut, it was found that a case of nuts and bolts was missing, and many places in the frame had in consequence to be secured with nails. For a while I was rather doubtful how the building would stand a really heavy blow. There was, however, no need for uneasiness, as the first two blizzards drifted snow to such a depth in our immediate vicinity that, even with the wind at hurricane force, there was scarcely a tremor in the building.

In putting up the hut, we discovered that we were missing a box of nuts and bolts, so we had to use nails to secure many parts of the frame instead. For a bit, I was unsure how well the building would hold up in a severe storm. However, there was no reason to worry, as the first two blizzards piled snow up so high around us that, even with the wind blowing at hurricane strength, there was barely any shaking in the structure.

The morning of Wednesday March 13 was calm and overcast. Breakfast was served at six o'clock. We then set to work and cleared away the snow from the masts and stay-posts, so that by 8.30 A.M. both masts were in position. Before the job was over, a singular sight was witnessed. A large section of the glacier—many thousands of tons—calved off into the sea. The tremendous waves raised by the fall of this mass smashed into fragments all the floe left in the bay. With the sea-ice went the snow-slopes which were the natural roadway down. A perpendicular cliff, sixty to one hundred feet above the water, was all that remained, and our opportunities of obtaining seals and penguins in the future were cut off. Of course, too, the old landing-place no longer existed.

The morning of Wednesday, March 13, was calm and cloudy. Breakfast was served at six o'clock. We then got to work and cleared the snow off the masts and stay-posts, so by 8:30 A.M., both masts were in place. Before we finished, we saw something unusual. A massive section of the glacier—many thousands of tons—calved off into the sea. The huge waves created by the fall of this mass shattered all the floes left in the bay. Along with the sea ice went the snow slopes that had been our natural pathway down. A sheer cliff, sixty to one hundred feet high above the water, was all that remained, and our chances of hunting seals and penguins in the future were gone. Naturally, the old landing spot was no longer there either.

The whole of the sledging provisions and gear were brought out, weighed and packed on the sledges; the total weight being one thousand two hundred and thirty-three pounds. Dovers, Harrisson, Hoadley, Jones, Moyes and myself were to constitute the party.

The entire supply of sledding provisions and gear was taken out, weighed, and loaded onto the sledges; the total weight was one thousand two hundred thirty-three pounds. Dovers, Harrisson, Hoadley, Jones, Moyes, and I were going to be the team.

It was necessary for two men to remain behind at the base to keep the meteorological records, to wind chronometers, to feed the dogs and to bring up the remainder of the stores from the edge of the ice-cliff. Kennedy, the magnetician, had to stay, as two term days** were due in the next month. It was essential that we should have a medical man with us, so Jones was included in the sledging party; the others drawing lots to decide who should remain with Kennedy. The unlucky one was Watson.

It was necessary for two men to stay at the base to keep the weather records, wind the clocks, take care of the dogs, and bring up the rest of the supplies from the edge of the ice cliff. Kennedy, the magnetician, had to stay because two term days were coming up next month. We needed a doctor with us, so we included Jones in the sledding party; the others drew lots to decide who would stay with Kennedy. The unlucky one was Watson.

     ** Days set apart by previous arrangement for magnetic "quick runs."
     ** Days scheduled in advance for magnetic "quick runs."

To the south of the Base, seventeen miles distant at the nearest point, the mainland was visible, entirely ice-clad, running almost due east and west. It appeared to rise rapidly to about three thousand feet, and then to ascend more gradually as the great plateau of the Antarctic continent. It was my intention to travel inland beyond the lower ice-falls, which extended in an irregular line of riven bluffs all along the coast, and then to lay a depot or depots which might be useful on the next season's journeys. Another reason for making the journey was to give the party some experience in sledging work. The combined weight of both sledges and effects was one thousand two hundred and thirty-three pounds, and the total amount of food carried was four hundred and sixty pounds.

To the south of the Base, seventeen miles away at its closest point, the mainland was visible, completely covered in ice, stretching almost directly east and west. It seemed to rise sharply to about three thousand feet and then gradually ascend as part of the vast plateau of the Antarctic continent. I planned to travel inland past the lower ice falls, which formed an uneven line of jagged cliffs along the coast, and then set up a supply depot or depots that could be useful for the next season's expeditions. Another reason for making the journey was to give the team some hands-on experience with sledging. The combined weight of both sledges and gear was one thousand two hundred and thirty-three pounds, and the total amount of food carried was four hundred and sixty pounds.

While the sledges were being loaded, ten skua gulls paid us a visit, and, as roast skua is a very pleasant change of food, Jones shot six of them.

While the sledges were being loaded, ten skua gulls came by, and since roast skua is a nice change of food, Jones shot six of them.

At 1 P.M. we left the hut, making an east-south-east course to clear a pressure-ridge; altering the course once more to south-east. The coast in this direction looked accessible, whereas a line running due south would have brought us to some unpromising ice-falls by a shorter route.

At 1 PM, we left the hut, heading southeast to get around a pressure ridge, then changed our course again to the southeast. The coast in that direction seemed more accessible, while going straight south would have taken us to some uninviting icefalls more quickly.

The surface was very good and almost free from crevasses; only one, into which Jones fell to his middle, being seen during the afternoon's march. Not wishing to do too much the first day, especially after the "soft" days we had been forced to spend in the hut during the spell of bad weather, I made two short halts in the afternoon and camped at 5 P.M., having done seven and half miles.

The surface was in great condition and nearly free of crevasses; only one, which Jones fell into up to his waist, was spotted during the afternoon's hike. Not wanting to overdo it on the first day, especially after the "soft" days we had to spend in the hut during the bad weather, I took two brief breaks in the afternoon and set up camp at 5 PM, having covered seven and a half miles.

On the 11th we rose at 5 A.M., and at 7 A.M. we were on the march. For the two hours after starting, the surface was tolerable and then changed for the worse; the remainder of the day's work being principally over a hard crust, which was just too brittle to bear the weight of a man, letting him through to a soft substratum, six or eight inches deep in the snow. Only those who have travelled in country like this can properly realize how wearisome it is.

On the 11th, we got up at 5 A.M., and by 7 A.M., we were on the move. For the first two hours, the ground was decent, but then it got worse; the rest of the day's journey was mainly over a hard crust that was just brittle enough to collapse under a person's weight, causing them to sink into a soft layer that was six or eight inches deep in snow. Only those who have traveled in this kind of terrain can truly understand how exhausting it is.

At 9 A.M. the course was altered to south, as there appeared to be a fairly good track up the hills. The surface of the glacier rose and fell in long undulations which became wider and more marked as the land approached. By the time we camped, they were three-quarters of a mile from crest to crest, with a drop of thirty feet from crest to trough. Despite the heavy trudging we covered more than thirteen miles.

At 9 A.M., we changed our course to south, as there seemed to be a decent path up the hills. The glacier's surface went up and down in long waves that became broader and more pronounced as we got closer to the land. By the time we set up camp, the distance from peak to peak was three-quarters of a mile, with a drop of thirty feet from peak to valley. Despite the strenuous walking, we covered more than thirteen miles.

I made the marching hours 7 A.M. to 5 P.M., so that there was time to get the evening meal before darkness set in; soon after 6 P.M.

I scheduled the marching hours from 7 A.M. to 5 P.M., so there was enough time to have dinner before it got dark; shortly after 6 P.M.

The march commenced about seven o'clock on March 15, the thermometer registering -8 degrees F., while a light southerly breeze made it feel much colder. The exercise soon warmed us up and, when the breeze died away, the remainder of the day was perfectly calm.

The march started around seven o'clock on March 15, with the temperature at -8 degrees F. A light southerly breeze made it feel even colder. The activity quickly warmed us up, and when the breeze stopped, the rest of the day was completely calm.

A surface of "pie-crust" cut down the mileage in the forenoon. At 11 A.M. we encountered many crevasses, from two to five feet wide, with clean-cut sides and shaky bridges. Hoadley went down to his head in one, and we all got our legs in others.

A "pie-crust" surface reduced our travel distance in the morning. By 11 A.M., we came across several crevasses, ranging from two to five feet wide, with sharp edges and unstable bridges. Hoadley fell in one up to his head, and we all had our legs stuck in others.

It became evident after lunch that the land was nearing rapidly, its lower slopes obscuring the higher land behind. The crevasses also became wider, so I lengthened the harness with an alpine rope to allow more room and to prevent more than two men from being over a chasm at the same time. At 4 P.M. we were confronted with one sixty feet wide. Crevasses over thirty feet in width usually have very solid bridges and may be considered safe, but this one had badly broken edges and one hundred yards on the right the lid had collapsed. So instead of marching steadily across, we went over singly on the alpine rope and hauled the sledges along in their turn, when all had crossed in safety. Immediately after passing this obstacle the grade became steeper, and, between three and five o'clock, we rose two hundred feet, traversing several large patches of neve.

It became clear after lunch that the land was getting closer quickly, with the lower slopes hiding the higher ground behind. The crevasses also widened, so I extended the harness with an alpine rope to create more space and to ensure that no more than two guys were over a chasm at the same time. At 4 P.M., we faced one that was sixty feet wide. Crevasses wider than thirty feet usually have solid bridges and are considered safe, but this one had jagged edges and a hundred yards to the right where the lid had collapsed. So instead of crossing steadily, we went over one by one on the alpine rope and pulled the sledges along as each person crossed safely. Right after getting past this obstacle, the slope got steeper, and between three and five o’clock, we climbed two hundred feet, navigating several large patches of neve.

That night the tent stood on a field of snow covering the lower slopes of the hills. On either hand were magnificent examples of ice-falls, but ahead the way seemed open.

That night the tent was set up on a snowy field covering the lower hills. On either side were stunning ice falls, but ahead the path looked clear.

With the exception of a preliminary stiffness, every one felt well after the toil of the first few days.

Aside from a bit of initial stiffness, everyone felt fine after the hard work of the first few days.

In bright sunlight next morning all went to examine the ice-falls to the east, which were two miles away. Roping up, we made an ascent half-way to the top which rose five hundred feet and commanded a grand panorama of glacier and coast. Soon the wind freshened and drift began to fly. When we regained the tents a gale was blowing, with heavy drift, so there was nothing to do but make ourselves as comfortable as possible inside.

In the bright sunlight the next morning, everyone went to check out the ice falls to the east, which were two miles away. We roped up and climbed halfway to the top, which was five hundred feet high and offered an amazing view of the glacier and coast. Soon the wind picked up, and snow started to blow around. By the time we got back to the tents, a strong gale was blowing with heavy snowfall, so we just had to make ourselves as comfortable as we could inside.

All through Saturday night the gale raged and up till 11.30 A.M. on Sunday March 16. On turning out, we found that the tents and sledges were covered deeply in snow, and we dug continuously for more than two hours before we were able to pack up and get away. Both sledges ran easily for nearly a mile over neve, when the gradient increased to one in ten, forcing us to relay. It was found necessary to change our finnesko for spiked boots. Relaying regularly, we gradually mounted six hundred feet over neve and massive sastrugi. With a steep slope in front, a halt was made for the night. The sunset was a picture of prismatic colours reflected over the undulating ice-sheet and the tumbling cascades of the glacier.

All through Saturday night, the storm howled, and it continued until 11:30 A.M. on Sunday, March 16. When we got up, we discovered that the tents and sledges were buried deep in snow, and we dug for over two hours before we could pack up and leave. Both sledges moved smoothly for nearly a mile over the hard snow, but then the slope steepened to a one in ten gradient, forcing us to relay. We needed to switch our finnesko for spiked boots. By relaying regularly, we slowly climbed six hundred feet over the hard snow and large sastrugi. With a steep slope ahead, we stopped for the night. The sunset was a stunning display of prismatic colors reflecting off the rolling ice sheet and the rushing waterfalls of the glacier.

On the evening of March 18 the altitude of our camp was one thousand four hundred and ten feet, and the slope was covered with sastrugi ridges, three to four feet in height. Travelling over these on the following day we had frequent capsizes.

On the evening of March 18, our camp was at an elevation of one thousand four hundred and ten feet, and the slope was covered with sastrugi ridges, three to four feet high. While traveling over these the next day, we often tipped over.

The outlook to the south was a series of irregular terraces, varying from half a mile to two miles in breadth and twenty to two hundred feet in height. These were furrowed by small valleys and traversed by ridges, but there was not a sign of rock anywhere.

The view to the south was a series of uneven terraces, ranging from half a mile to two miles wide and twenty to two hundred feet high. These were marked by small valleys and crossed by ridges, but there was no sign of rock anywhere.

The temperature varied from 4 degrees to 14 degrees F. during the day, and the minimum recorded at night was -11 degrees F.

The temperature ranged from 4 degrees to 14 degrees F during the day, and the lowest recorded at night was -11 degrees F.

Another nine miles of slow ascent brought us to two thousand feet, followed by a rise of two hundred and twenty feet in seven and three-quarter miles on March 21. Hauling over high broken sastrugi was laborious enough to make every one glad when the day was over. The rations were found sufficient, but the plasmon biscuits were so hard that they had to be broken with a geological hammer.

Another nine miles of slow uphill walking took us to two thousand feet, followed by an increase of two hundred and twenty feet over seven and three-quarter miles on March 21. Climbing over rough, broken sastrugi was tough enough that everyone was relieved when the day ended. The food rations were adequate, but the plasmon biscuits were so hard that we had to break them with a geological hammer.

There now swept down on us a blizzard** which lasted for a whole week, on the evening of March 21. According to my diary, the record is as follows:

There was a blizzard that hit us, and it lasted an entire week, starting on the evening of March 21. According to my diary, the record is as follows:

"Friday, March 22. Snowing heavily all day, easterly wind: impossible to travel as nothing can be seen more than ten to twelve yards away. Temperature high, 7 degrees to 18 degrees F.

"Friday, March 22. It snowed heavily all day with an easterly wind: travel was impossible as visibility was limited to only ten to twelve yards. The temperature ranged from 7 to 18 degrees F."

     ** It is a singular fact that this blizzard occurred on the same date
as that during which Captain Scott and his party lost their lives.
     ** It's a unique fact that this blizzard happened on the same date that Captain Scott and his team lost their lives.

"Saturday, March 23. Blowing hard at turn-out time, so did not breakfast until 8.30. Dovers is cook in my tent this week. He got his clothes filled up with snow while bringing in the cooker, food-bag, etc. The wind increased to a fierce gale during the day, and all the loose snow which fell yesterday was shifted.

"Saturday, March 23. It was really windy at breakfast time, so we didn’t eat until 8:30. Dovers is the cook in my tent this week. He got his clothes soaked with snow while bringing in the cooker, food bag, etc. The wind picked up to a strong gale during the day, and all the loose snow that fell yesterday got blown around."

"About 5 P.M. the snow was partially blown away from the skirt or ground cloth, and the tent bulged in a good deal. I got into burberries and went out to secure it; it was useless to shovel on snow as it was blown off immediately. I therefore dragged the food-bags off the sledge and dumped them on. The wind and drift were so strong that I had several times to get in the lee of the tent to recover my breath and to clear the mask of snow from my face.

"Around 5 P.M., the snow was mostly blown off the ground cloth, and the tent was bulging quite a bit. I put on my burberries and went out to secure it; shoveling snow was pointless since it just got blown off right away. So, I dragged the food bags off the sled and dumped them on. The wind and drift were so intense that I had to take shelter on the side of the tent several times to catch my breath and clear the snow off my face."

"We are now rather crowded through the tent bulging in so much, and having cooker and food-bag inside.

"We're now pretty cramped in the tent, which is bulging from all the stuff inside, including the cooker and food bag."

"Sunday, March 24. Had a very bad night. The wind was chopping about from south-east to north and blowing a hurricane. One side of the tent was pressed in past the centre, and I had to turn out and support it with bag lashings. Then the ventilator was blown in and we had a pile of snow two feet high over the sleeping-bags; this kept us warm, but it was impossible to prevent some of it getting into the bags, and now we are very wet and the bags like sponges. There were quite two hundredweights of snow on us; all of which came through a hole three inches wide.

"Sunday, March 24. Had a really rough night. The wind was whipping around from southeast to north and blowing like a hurricane. One side of the tent was pushed in past the center, so I had to get up and brace it with some bag straps. Then the ventilator got blown in, and we ended up with a two-foot-high pile of snow over the sleeping bags; it kept us warm, but we couldn't stop some of it from getting inside the bags, and now we're really wet with our bags feeling like sponges. There was about two hundred pounds of snow on us, all of which came through a three-inch-wide hole."

"According to report from the other tent they are worse off than we are; they say they have four feet of snow in the tent. All this is due to the change of wind, making the ventilator to windward instead of leeward.

"According to the report from the other tent, they’re worse off than we are; they say they have four feet of snow in the tent. This is all because of the change in the wind, causing the ventilator to face into the wind instead of away from it."

"March 25, 26 and 27. Blizzard still continues, less wind but more snowfall.

"March 25, 26, and 27. The blizzard is still going on, with less wind but more snow falling."

"Thursday, March 28. Heavy falling snow and drift, south-east wind. At noon, the wind eased down and snow ceased falling, so we slipped into our burberry over-suits and climbed out to dig for the sledges.

"Thursday, March 28. Heavy snow falling and drifting, southeast wind. At noon, the wind calmed down and the snow stopped, so we put on our burberry over-suits and went outside to search for the sledges."

"Nothing could be seen except about two feet of the tops of the tents, which meant that there was a deposit of five feet of freshly fallen snow. The upper two feet was soft and powdery, offering no resistance; under that it was still soft, so that we sank to our thighs every step and frequently to the waist. By 4.30 P.M. both sledges were rescued, and it was ascertained that no gear had been lost. We all found that the week of idleness and confinement had weakened us, and at first were only able to take short spells at the digging. The sky and barometer promise fine weather to-morrow, but what awful work it will be pulling!"

"All we could see was about two feet of the tops of the tents, which meant there was a good five feet of freshly fallen snow. The top two feet was soft and powdery, offering no resistance; beneath that, it was still soft, so we sank to our thighs with every step and often to our waists. By 4:30 P.M., both sledges were rescued, and we confirmed that no gear had been lost. We all noticed that the week of inactivity and confinement had weakened us, and at first, we could only manage short bursts of digging. The sky and barometer look promising for nice weather tomorrow, but it’s going to be really tough work pulling!"

At 5.30 A.M. on March 29 the weather was bright and calm. As a strong wind had blown throughout the night, a harder surface was expected. Outside, we were surprised to find a fresh wind and thick, low drift; owing to the tents being snowed up so high, the threshing of the drift was not audible. To my disgust the surface was as soft as ever. It appeared that the only resort was to leave the provisions for the depot on the nearest ridge and return to the Base. The temperature was -20 degrees F., and, while digging out the tents, Dovers had his nose frost-bitten.

At 5:30 A.M. on March 29, the weather was bright and calm. Since a strong wind had blown all night, we expected a harder surface. Outside, we were surprised to find a fresh wind and thick, low snowdrifts; because the tents were buried so high in snow, we couldn't hear the wind whipping the drifts. To my disappointment, the surface was just as soft as before. It seemed the only option was to leave the supplies at the nearest ridge and head back to the Base. The temperature was -20 degrees F, and while we were digging out the tents, Dovers got his nose frostbitten.

It took six of us well over an hour to drag the necessary food half a mile up a rise of less than one hundred feet; the load, sledge included, not being five hundred pounds. Nearly all the time we were sinking thigh-deep, and the sledge itself was going down so far that the instrument-box was pushing a mass of snow in front of it. Arriving on the ridge, Moyes found that his foot was frozen and he had to go back to camp, as there was too much wind to bring it round in the open.

It took six of us well over an hour to haul the necessary food half a mile up a hill that was less than a hundred feet high; the total weight, including the sled, was only about five hundred pounds. Most of the time, we were sinking thigh-deep in snow, and the sled itself was sinking so much that the instrument box was pushing a pile of snow in front of it. When we finally got to the ridge, Moyes discovered that his foot was frozen, so he had to return to camp since the wind was too strong to treat it properly outside.

Sufficient food and oil were left at this depot for three men for six weeks; also a minimum thermometer.

Sufficient food and oil were left at this depot for three men for six weeks; there was also a minimum thermometer.

In a fresh breeze and flying drift we were off at 10 A.M. next day. At first we were ambitious and moved away with two sledges, sinking from two to three feet all the time. Forty yards was as much as we could do without a rest, and by lunch time nine hundred yards was the total. Now the course was downhill, and the two sledges were pulled together, creeping along with painful slowness, as walking was the hardest work imaginable. After one of the most strenuous days I have ever experienced, we camped; the sledge-meter recorded one mile four hundred and fifty yards.

In a fresh breeze and drifting snow, we set off at 10 A.M. the next day. At first, we were ambitious and moved out with two sledges, sinking two to three feet into the snow the whole time. Forty yards was all we could manage without a break, and by lunch, we had covered nine hundred yards in total. Now the path was downhill, and the two sledges were pulled together, creeping along at a painfully slow pace, as walking was the hardest work imaginable. After one of the most exhausting days I’ve ever had, we set up camp; the sledge meter recorded one mile four hundred and fifty yards.

A spell of two days' blizzard cooped us up once more, but improved the surface slightly. Still, it was dreadfully soft, and, but for the falling gradient, we would not have made what we did; five miles six hundred and ten yards, on April 2. On that and the following day it was fortunate that the road chosen was free of crevasses.

A two-day blizzard trapped us again, but slightly improved the surface. It was still incredibly soft, and without the downhill slope, we wouldn't have covered as much distance—five miles and six hundred ten yards on April 2. On that day and the next, we were lucky that the path we picked had no crevasses.

At the foot of the hills I had decided to reduce the rations but, as the track had grown firm once more, and we were only twenty-five miles from the hut, with a week's food, I thought it would be safe to use the full allowance.

At the base of the hills, I decided to cut back on the rations, but since the path had solidified again and we were just twenty-five miles from the hut, with enough food for a week, I figured it would be fine to use the full amount.

Soon after leaving the hills (April 4), a direct course to the hut was made. There was no mark by which to steer, except a "water-sky" to the north, the hinterland being clouded over. During the afternoon, the sun occasionally gleamed through a tract of cirro-stratus cloud and there was a very fine parhelion: signs of an approaching blizzard. At 4.30 P.M. we had done seventeen and a half miles, and, as all hands were fresh and willing, I decided to have a meal and go on again, considering that the moon was full and there were only six miles to be done.

Soon after leaving the hills (April 4), we headed straight for the hut. There was no landmark to guide us, except for a “water-sky” to the north, while the inland was overcast. In the afternoon, the sun occasionally peeked through a patch of cirrostratus clouds, and we noticed a faint parhelion—a sign of an impending blizzard. By 4:30 PM, we had covered seventeen and a half miles, and since everyone was feeling fresh and motivated, I decided to pause for a meal and continue on, considering the moon was full and we only had six miles left to go.

After supper the march was continued till 8.30 P.M., by which time we were due for a rest. I had begun to think that we had passed the hut.

After dinner, the march continued until 8:30 PM, by which time we were ready for a break. I had started to wonder if we had already passed the hut.

April 5 was far from being a Good Friday for us. At 2 A.M. a fresh breeze rose and rapidly increased to a heavy gale. At 10 A.M. Hoadley and I had to go out to secure the tent; the weather-side bulged in more than half the width of the tent and was held by a solid load of drift, but the other sides were flapping so much that almost all the snow had been shaken off the skirt. Though only five yards away from it we could not see the other tent. At noon Hoadley again went out to attend to the tent and entirely lost himself within six feet of it. He immediately started to yell and I guessed what was the matter at once. Dovers and I shouted our best, and Hoadley groped his way in with a mask of snow over his face. He told us that the wind which was then blowing a good eighty miles an hour, knocked him down immediately he was outside, and, when he struggled to his feet again, he could see nothing and had no idea in what direction lay the tent.

April 5 was definitely not a Good Friday for us. At 2 A.M., a fresh breeze picked up and quickly turned into a strong gale. By 10 A.M., Hoadley and I had to head out to secure the tent; the side facing the weather was bulging in more than half the width of the tent and was weighed down by a solid load of drift, but the other sides were flapping so much that almost all the snow had been shaken off the bottom. Even though we were only five yards away, we couldn't see the other tent. At noon, Hoadley went out again to check on the tent and completely lost his way within six feet of it. He immediately started yelling, and I figured out what was wrong right away. Dovers and I shouted as loud as we could, and Hoadley felt his way in with a mask of snow covering his face. He told us that the wind, which was blowing at around eighty miles an hour, knocked him down as soon as he stepped outside, and when he got back on his feet, he couldn't see anything and had no idea which direction the tent was in.

The space inside was now so limited by the combined pressure of wind and snow that we did not light the primus, eating lumps of frozen pemmican for the evening meal.

The space inside was now so restricted by the combined pressure of wind and snow that we didn't light the primus, eating chunks of frozen pemmican for dinner.

The blizzard continued with unabated violence until eleven o'clock next morning, when it moderated within an hour to half a gale. We turned out and had a good hot meal. Then we looked to see how the others had fared and found that their tent had collapsed. Getting at once into wind-proof clothing, we rushed out and were horrified to see Harrisson in his bag on the snow. He quickly assured us that he was all right. After carrying him, bag and all, into our tent, he emerged quite undamaged, but very hungry.

The blizzard raged on with relentless intensity until eleven o'clock the next morning, when it calmed down to a strong wind an hour later. We got up and had a hearty hot meal. Then we checked on the others and discovered that their tent had fallen in. Quickly putting on our windproof gear, we rushed outside and were shocked to see Harrisson in his sleeping bag on the snow. He quickly reassured us that he was fine. After we carried him, bag and all, into our tent, he came out completely unharmed but very hungry.

Jones and Moyes now had to be rescued; they were in a most uncomfortable position under the fallen tent. It appears that the tent had blown down on the previous morning at ten o'clock, and for thirty-six hours they had had nothing to eat. We did not take long to dig them out.

Jones and Moyes needed to be rescued; they were stuck in a very uncomfortable spot under the collapsed tent. It seems the tent had come down the morning before at ten o'clock, and for thirty-six hours, they hadn’t eaten anything. We didn’t take long to dig them out.

The wind dropped to a moderate breeze, and, through the falling snow, I could make out a "water-sky" to the west. The three unfortunates said that they felt fit to travel, so we got under way. The surface was soft and the pulling very heavy, and I soon saw that the strain was largely due to the weakness of the three who had been without food. Calling a halt, I asked Jones if it would do to go on; he assured me that they could manage to go on with an effort, and the march was resumed.

The wind calmed down to a gentle breeze, and through the falling snow, I could see a "water-sky" to the west. The three unfortunate ones said they felt up to traveling, so we set off. The ground was soft and the pulling was really heavy, and I quickly realized that the strain was mostly because the three of them were weak from not eating. I called for a break and asked Jones if we should keep going; he assured me that they could push through with some effort, and we continued our march.

Not long after, Dovers sighted the wireless mast, and a quarter of an hour later we were safely in the hut, much to the surprise of Kennedy and Watson, who did not expect us to be travelling in such weather, and greatly to our own relief. According to the sledge-meter, the last camp had only been two miles one hundred yards from home, and if anything had been visible on the night of April 4, we could have got in easily.

Not long after, Dovers spotted the wireless mast, and fifteen minutes later we were safely in the hut, much to the surprise of Kennedy and Watson, who didn’t expect us to be traveling in such weather, and greatly to our own relief. According to the sledge-meter, the last camp had only been two miles one hundred yards from home, and if anything had been visible on the night of April 4, we could have made it back easily.

I was very pleased with the way all the party had shaped. They had worked splendidly and were always cheerful, although conditions had been exceptionally trying during this journey. No one was any the worse for the hardships, except for a few blistered fingers from frost-bites. The party lost weight at the average of two and a half pounds; Harrisson was the greatest loser, being reduced six pounds. Out of the twenty-five days we were away, it was only possible to sledge on twelve days. The total distance covered, including relay work, was nearly one hundred and twenty-two miles, and the greatest elevation reached on the southern mainland was two thousand six hundred feet above sea-level.

I was really happy with how the whole group performed. They worked great together and stayed upbeat, even though the conditions were really tough during this trip. No one was seriously affected by the challenges, except for a few blistered fingers from frostbite. The group lost an average of two and a half pounds; Harrisson lost the most, shedding six pounds. Out of the twenty-five days we were gone, we could only use the sled for twelve days. The total distance covered, including relay work, was almost one hundred and twenty-two miles, and the highest point reached on the southern mainland was two thousand six hundred feet above sea level.

Kennedy and Watson had been very busy during our absence. In a few days they had trained five of the dogs to pull in harness, and transported the remainder of the stores from the landing-place, arranging them in piles round the hut. The weather at the Base had been quite as bad as that experienced by us on the land slopes.

Kennedy and Watson had been super busy while we were away. In just a few days, they trained five of the dogs to pull in harness and moved the rest of the supplies from the landing area, stacking them in piles around the hut. The weather at the Base had been just as terrible as what we faced on the land slopes.

In the first blizzard both wireless masts were broken down. Watson and Kennedy managed to repair and re-erect one of the masts, but it was only thirty-seven feet in height. Any final hopes of hearing wireless signals were dispelled by the discovery that the case containing the detector and several other parts necessary for a receiving-station were missing.

In the first blizzard, both wireless masts were damaged. Watson and Kennedy were able to fix and set up one of the masts again, but it was only thirty-seven feet tall. Any remaining hopes of receiving wireless signals ended when they discovered that the case holding the detector and several other parts needed for a receiving station was missing.

Watson had fitted up a splendid dark-room, as well as plenty of shelves and racks for cooking utensils.

Watson had set up a fantastic darkroom, along with plenty of shelves and racks for kitchen tools.

Kennedy was able to secure a series of observations on one of his term days, but, before the next one, the tent he was using was blown to ribbons.

Kennedy managed to gather a series of observations on one of his term days, but before the next one, the tent he was using got torn to shreds.





CHAPTER XX THE WESTERN BASE—WINTER AND SPRING

On Easter Sunday, April 7, 1912, a furious blizzard kept us close prisoners. To meet the occasion, Dovers prepared a special dinner, the principal item being roast mutton, from one of the six carcases landed with the stores. Divine service was held in the forenoon.

On Easter Sunday, April 7, 1912, a fierce blizzard kept us confined indoors. To mark the occasion, Dovers made a special dinner, the main dish being roast mutton from one of the six carcasses brought in with the supplies. A church service was held in the morning.

The blizzard raged with such force all Sunday and Monday that I dared not let any one go out to feed the dogs, although we found, later, that a fast of three days did not hurt them at all.

The blizzard raged with such intensity all Sunday and Monday that I didn't dare let anyone go out to feed the dogs, even though we later found that a three-day fast didn’t harm them at all.

I now thought it time to establish a winter routine. Each member had his particular duties to perform, in addition to general work, in which all hands were engaged. Harrisson took charge of the lamps and checked consumption of oil. Hoadley had the care of the provisions, making out lists showing the amount the cook might use of each article of food, besides opening cases and stowing a good assortment on convenient shelves in the veranda. Jones and Kennedy worked the acetylene plant. In connexion with this, I should mention that several parts were missing, including T-pieces for joints and connexions for burners. However Jones, in addition to his ability as a surgeon, showed himself to be an excellent plumber, brazier and tinsmith, and the Hut was well lighted all the time we occupied it. Moyes's duties as meteorologist took him out at all hours. Watson looked after the dogs, while Dovers relieved other members when they were cooks. The duty of cook was taken for a week at a time by every one except myself. A night watch was kept by each in turn. The watchman went on duty at 9 P.M., usually taking advantage of this night to have a bath and wash his clothes. He prepared breakfast, calling all hands at 8.30 A.M. for this meal at nine o'clock. The cook for the week was exempt from all other work. In the case of Kennedy, whose magnetic work was done principally at night, arrangements were made to assist him with the cooking.

I thought it was time to set up a winter routine. Each person had specific tasks to handle, in addition to the general work that everyone helped with. Harrisson was in charge of the lamps and monitored the oil usage. Hoadley managed the supplies, creating lists that showed how much of each food item the cook could use, as well as opening boxes and organizing a selection on convenient shelves in the veranda. Jones and Kennedy operated the acetylene plant. I should mention that several parts were missing, including T-pieces for joints and connections for burners. However, Jones, aside from being a skilled surgeon, proved himself to be an excellent plumber, brazier, and tinsmith, so the Hut was well lit the entire time we were there. Moyes's responsibilities as the meteorologist took him out at all hours. Watson took care of the dogs, while Dovers filled in for other people when they were cooking. Each person took on the cooking duty for a week at a time, except for me. Each person also took turns as the night watchman. The watchman started duty at 9 P.M., often using the night to take a bath and wash their clothes. He prepared breakfast, waking everyone up at 8:30 A.M. for a meal at nine o'clock. The cook of the week was exempt from all other tasks. For Kennedy, whose magnetic work mostly took place at night, arrangements were made to help him with the cooking.

Work commenced during the winter months at ten o'clock and, unless anything special had to be done, finished at 1 P.M., when lunch was served. The afternoon was usually devoted to sport and recreation.

Work started during the winter months at 10:00 AM and, unless there was something special to take care of, ended at 1:00 PM, when lunch was served. The afternoon was typically spent on sports and leisure activities.

The frequent blizzards and heavy snowfall had by this time buried the Hut so deeply that only the top of the pointed roof was visible and all the outside stores were covered.

The frequent blizzards and heavy snowfall had, by this time, buried the Hut so deeply that only the tip of the pointed roof was visible, and all the outdoor supplies were covered.

My diary for April 9 says:

My diary for April 9 says:

"The blizzard" (which had commenced on the evening of the 6th) "played itself out during the night and we got to work immediately after breakfast. There was still a fresh breeze and low drift, but this gradually died away.

"The blizzard" (which had started on the evening of the 6th) "calmed down during the night and we got to work right after breakfast. There was still a light breeze and some drifting snow, but this slowly faded away.

"We were an hour digging an exit from the Hut. The day has been occupied in cutting a tunnel entrance, forty feet long, through the drift, so that driving snow cannot penetrate, and we shall be able to get out with less trouble.

"We spent an hour digging our way out of the Hut. The day was spent cutting a forty-foot-long tunnel entrance through the drift, so that the blowing snow can’t get in, making it easier for us to get out."

"As we get time I intend to excavate caverns in the huge drifts packed round the house and stow all our stores inside; also a good supply of ice for use during blizzards.

"As we find the time, I plan to dig out caves in the large snow drifts around the house and store all our supplies inside; also, we'll stock up on ice for use during blizzards."

"I had intended to make a trip to Masson Island before the winter properly set in, but with the weather behaving as it does, I don't think it would be wise."

"I was planning to take a trip to Masson Island before winter fully arrived, but with the way the weather is acting, I don’t think it would be a good idea."

The 10th, 11th and 12th being fine, good progress was made in digging out store-rooms on either side of the tunnel, but a blizzard on the 13th and 14th stopped us again.

The 10th, 11th, and 12th were great, and we made good progress digging out store-rooms on both sides of the tunnel, but a blizzard on the 13th and 14th halted us again.

On going to feed the dogs during the afternoon of the 14th, Watson found that Nansen was dead; this left us with seven, as Crippen had already died. Of the remainder, only four were of any value; Sweep and the two bitches, Tiger and Tich, refusing to do anything in harness, and, as there was less than sufficient food for them, the two latter had to be shot. Sweep would have shared the same fate but he disappeared, probably falling down a crevasse or over the edge of the glacier.

On the afternoon of the 14th, when Watson went to feed the dogs, he found that Nansen was dead. This left us with seven, since Crippen had already died. Of the others, only four were any good; Sweep and the two female dogs, Tiger and Tich, wouldn’t work in harness. With not enough food for them, the latter two had to be shot. Sweep would’ve met the same fate, but he disappeared, likely falling into a crevasse or off the edge of the glacier.

Until the end of April almost all our time was spent in making store-rooms and in searching for buried stores; sometimes a shaft would have to be sunk eight to twelve feet. Bamboo poles stuck in the snow marked the positions of the different stacks. The one marking the carbide was blown away, and it was two days before Dovers finally unearthed it. By the 30th, caves roomy enough to contain everything were completed, all being connected by the tunnel. We were now self-contained, and everything was accessible and immune from the periodic blizzards.

Until the end of April, we spent almost all our time creating storage rooms and searching for buried supplies; sometimes we had to dig a shaft eight to twelve feet deep. Bamboo poles stuck in the snow marked the locations of the various stacks. The marker for the carbide was blown away, and it took Dovers two days to finally find it. By the 30th, we had finished caves spacious enough to hold everything, all connected by a tunnel. We were now self-sufficient, with everything easily accessible and safe from the occasional blizzards.

The entrance, by the way, was a trap-door built over the tunnel and raised well above the outside surface to prevent it being drifted over. From below it was approached by a ladder, but the end of the tunnel was left open, so that in fine weather we could run sledges in and out with loads of ice. With each blizzard the entrance was completely choked, and it gave two men a day's work to clear it out once more.

The entrance was a trapdoor built over the tunnel and raised well above the ground to stop it from getting covered by snow. You accessed it from below using a ladder, but the end of the tunnel was left open, so during nice weather, we could easily slide sledges in and out loaded with ice. Each blizzard would completely block the entrance, and it would take two men a whole day to clear it out again.

On April 16 Kennedy had a term day. A fresh breeze was blowing and the temperature was -20 degrees F. Some of his observations had to be taken in the open and the remainder in a tent. The series took three hours to complete and by that time he was thoroughly chilled through, his feet and fingers were frost-bitten and his language had grown more incisive than usual.

On April 16, Kennedy had a term day. A cool breeze was blowing, and the temperature was -20 degrees F. Some of his observations had to be done outside, and the rest in a tent. The series took three hours to finish, and by that time, he was completely frozen, his feet and fingers were frostbitten, and his language had become sharper than usual.

Between the 10th and the 19th we made a search for penguins and seals. Hoadley and Moyes staying behind, the rest of us with tents and equipment journeyed along the edge of the glacier to the south, without seeing the smallest sign of life. The edge of the shelf-ice was very much fissured, many of the breaches giving no sign of their presence, in consequence of which several falls were sustained. It should be remarked that the Shackleton Shelf-Ice runs mainly in a southerly direction from the Winter Quarters, joining the mainland at a point, afterwards named Junction Corner. The map of Queen Mary Land illustrates this at a glance.

Between the 10th and the 19th, we searched for penguins and seals. Hoadley and Moyes stayed behind while the rest of us, with our tents and equipment, traveled along the edge of the glacier to the south, without spotting the smallest sign of life. The edge of the shelf ice was heavily cracked, with many crevasses that were not evident, which caused several falls. It’s worth noting that the Shackleton Shelf Ice mainly stretches south from the Winter Quarters, connecting with the mainland at a location later called Junction Corner. The map of Queen Mary Land makes this clear at a glance.

From the 25th to the 29th, Kennedy, Harrisson and Jones were employed building an igloo to be used as a magnetic observatory. On the afternoon of the 30th, the magnetician invited every one to a tea-party in the igloo to celebrate the opening. He had the place very nicely decorated with flags, and after the reception and the formal inspection of the instruments, we were served with quite a good tea. The outside temperature was -33 degrees F. and it was not much higher inside the igloo. As a result, no one extended his visit beyond the bounds of politeness.

From the 25th to the 29th, Kennedy, Harrison, and Jones worked on building an igloo to use as a magnetic observatory. On the afternoon of the 30th, the magnetician invited everyone to a tea party in the igloo to celebrate the opening. He had the place beautifully decorated with flags, and after the reception and the formal inspection of the instruments, we enjoyed quite a nice tea. The outside temperature was -33 degrees Fahrenheit, and it wasn’t much warmer inside the igloo. As a result, no one stayed longer than what was polite.

On May 1, Harrisson, Hoadley and Watson went away south towards the land at the head of the bay, which curved round to Junction Corner, to examine icebergs, take photographs and to search for seals. They took the four dogs with them and, as the load was a light one—three hundred and forty-two pounds—the dogs pulled it easily.

On May 1, Harrisson, Hoadley, and Watson headed south toward the land at the head of the bay, which curved around to Junction Corner, to check out the icebergs, take photos, and look for seals. They brought the four dogs along, and since the load was light—three hundred and forty-two pounds—the dogs handled it easily.

I went with the others to the north, hoping that we might find a portion of the glacier low enough to give access to the sea-ice. There were several spots where the ice-cliffs were not more than forty to fifty feet high, but no convenient ramps led down from the cliffs. In any case neither penguins nor seals were to be had in the vicinity. A great, flat sheet of frozen sea stretched away to the north for quite thirty miles.

I went with the others up north, hoping to find a section of the glacier low enough to reach the sea ice. There were several places where the ice cliffs were only about forty to fifty feet high, but there were no easy slopes leading down from the cliffs. In any case, there weren't any penguins or seals around. A vast, flat sheet of frozen sea extended north for at least thirty miles.

May 2 was fine, but the 3rd and 4th were windy once more and we had to remain indoors. Saturday, the 4th, was clean-up day, when the verandas, tunnel and cave were swept and tidied, the stove cleaned, the hut and darkroom scrubbed and the windows cleared. The last was a job which was generally detested. During the week, the windows in the roof collected a coat of ice, from an inch to three inches thick, by condensation of moisture. Chipping this off was a most tedious piece of work, while in the process one's clothes became filled with ice.

May 2 was nice, but the 3rd and 4th were windy again, so we had to stay indoors. Saturday, the 4th, was clean-up day, when we swept and tidied the verandas, tunnel, and cave, cleaned the stove, scrubbed the hut and darkroom, and cleared the windows. The last task was usually hated. Throughout the week, the windows in the roof collected a layer of ice, ranging from an inch to three inches thick, due to moisture condensation. Chipping this off was really tedious, and during the process, our clothes ended up covered in ice.

One Sunday, Harrisson, Hoadley and Watson returned from their short trip; they had missed the strong winds which had been blowing at the Base, although less than twenty miles away. Some very fine old icebergs were discovered which were of interest to the two geologists and made good subjects for Harrisson's sketches. Watson had had a nasty fall while crossing a patch of rough ice, his nose being rather badly cut in the accident.

One Sunday, Harrisson, Hoadley, and Watson came back from their short trip; they had avoided the strong winds that had been blowing at the Base, even though it was less than twenty miles away. They discovered some really impressive old icebergs that intrigued the two geologists and were great subjects for Harrisson's sketches. Watson took a bad fall while crossing a rough patch of ice, and his nose got pretty badly cut in the accident.

On May 7 another blizzard stopped all outside work. Moyes ventured as far as the meteorological screen at noon and got lost, but luckily only for a short time. The barometer behaved very strangely during the blow, rising abruptly during a little more than an hour, and then slowly falling once more. For a few hours on the 8th there was a lull and the store of ice was replenished, but the 9th and 10th were again spent indoors, repairing and refitting tents, poles and other sledging gear during the working hours, and reading or playing chess and bridge in the leisure time. Harrisson carved an excellent set of chessmen, distinguishing the "black" ones by a stain of permanganate of potash.

On May 7, another blizzard halted all outside work. Moyes made it to the meteorological screen around noon and got lost, but thankfully it was only for a short while. The barometer acted very strangely during the storm, spiking up sharply for a little over an hour before slowly dropping again. For a few hours on the 8th, there was a break, and the ice supply was restocked. However, the 9th and 10th were once again spent indoors, repairing and refitting tents, poles, and other sledging gear during work hours, and reading or playing chess and bridge during downtime. Harrisson carved a fantastic set of chess pieces, marking the "black" ones with a stain of permanganate of potash.

Bridge was the favourite game all through the winter, and a continuous record of the scores was kept. Two medals were struck: a neat little thing for the highest scorer and a huge affair as large as a plate, slung on a piece of three-and-a-half-inch rope, with "Jonah" inscribed on it, to be worn by the player at the foot of the list.

Bridge was the favorite game all winter, and a constant record of the scores was kept. Two medals were made: a small one for the highest scorer and a huge one as big as a plate, hanging on a piece of three-and-a-half-inch rope, with "Jonah" engraved on it, to be worn by the player at the bottom of the list.

Divine service was held every Sunday, Moyes and I taking it in turn. There was only one hymn book amongst the party, which made it necessary to write out copies of the hymns each week.

Divine service was held every Sunday, with Moyes and me taking turns. There was only one hymn book among the group, which meant we had to write out copies of the hymns each week.

The sleeping-bags used on the first sledging journey had been hung up near the roof. They were now taken down to be thoroughly overhauled. As a consequence of their severe soaking, they had shrunk considerably and required enlarging. Dovers's bag, besides contracting a good deal, had lost much hair and was cut up to patch the others. He received a spare one to replace it.

The sleeping bags used on the first sledding trip had been hung up near the roof. They were now taken down to be completely checked. Because of their heavy soaking, they had shrunk quite a bit and needed to be sized up. Dovers's bag, in addition to shrinking a lot, had lost a lot of insulation and was cut up to patch the others. He got a spare one to replace it.

May 15 was a beautiful bright morning and I went over to an icy cape two miles southward, with Harrisson, Hoadley, Dovers and Watson, to find a road down to the sea-ice. Here, we had good fortune at last, for, by following down a crevasse which opened out at sea-level into a magnificent cave, we walked straight out on to the level plain. Along the edge of the glacier there was not even a seal's blow-hole. Watson took some photos of the cave and cliff.

May 15 was a beautiful, sunny morning, and I headed over to an icy cape two miles to the south with Harrisson, Hoadley, Dovers, and Watson to find a path down to the sea ice. Finally, we had some luck, as we followed a crevasse that opened up at sea level into a stunning cave, allowing us to walk right out onto the flat plain. There wasn't even a seal's blowhole along the edge of the glacier. Watson took some photos of the cave and cliff.

It was Kennedy's term night; the work keeping him in the igloo from 10 P.M. until 2.30 A.M. He had had some difficulty in finding a means of warming the observatory—an urgent necessity, since he found it impossible to manipulate delicate magnetic instruments for three or four hours with the temperature from -25 degrees F. to -30 degrees F. The trouble was to make a non-magnetic lamp and the problem was finally solved by using one of the aluminium cooking pots; converting it into a blubber stove. The stove smoked a great deal and the white walls were soon besmirched with a layer of soot.

It was Kennedy's shift at the observatory, working from 10 P.M. until 2:30 A.M. He struggled to find a way to heat the observatory—an urgent need, because it was impossible to use sensitive magnetic instruments for three or four hours when temperatures ranged from -25 degrees F to -30 degrees F. The challenge was to create a non-magnetic lamp, which he eventually solved by using one of the aluminum cooking pots and turning it into a blubber stove. The stove produced a lot of smoke, and soon the white walls were covered in a layer of soot.

The 17th, 18th and 19th were all calm but dull. One day I laid out a ten-hole golf course and with some homemade balls and hockey sticks for clubs played a game, not devoid of interest and excitement.

The 17th, 18th, and 19th were all calm but boring. One day, I set up a ten-hole golf course and, using some homemade balls and hockey sticks as clubs, played a game that was quite interesting and exciting.

During a blizzard which descended on the evening of the 20th, Zip and Sweep disappeared and on the 21st, a search on the glacier having been in vain, Dovers and Hoadley made their way down to the floe. They found Zip well and hearty in spite of having had a drop of at least forty feet off the glacier. A further search for Sweep proved fruitless. We were forced to conclude that he was either killed by falling over the precipice or he had gone far away hunting for penguins.

During a blizzard that hit on the evening of the 20th, Zip and Sweep went missing. On the 21st, after a fruitless search on the glacier, Dovers and Hoadley headed down to the floe. They found Zip safe and sound, despite having fallen at least forty feet off the glacier. Unfortunately, a further search for Sweep didn’t yield any results. We had to accept that he was either killed by falling over the edge or had wandered off in search of penguins.

The regular blizzard immured us on May 22, 23 and 24; the wind at times of terrific force, approaching one hundred miles per hour. It was impossible to secure meteorological observations or to feed the dogs until noon on the 24th. Moyes and I went out during a slight cessation and, with the aid of a rope from the trap-door, managed to find the dogs, and gave them some biscuits. The drift was then so thick that six feet was as far as one could see.

The regular blizzard trapped us on May 22, 23, and 24; the wind sometimes reached nearly one hundred miles per hour. It was impossible to take weather measurements or feed the dogs until noon on the 24th. Moyes and I went out during a brief break in the storm, and with the help of a rope from the trap-door, we managed to find the dogs and gave them some biscuits. The snow was so thick that you could only see about six feet ahead.

We did not forget Empire Day and duly "spliced the mainbrace." The most bigoted teetotaller could not call us an intemperate party. On each Saturday night, one drink per man was served out, the popular toast being "Sweethearts and Wives." The only other convivial meetings of our small symposium were on the birthdays of each member, Midwinter's Day and King's Birthday.

We didn't forget Empire Day and appropriately "spliced the mainbrace." Even the most strict teetotaler couldn't label us an excessive drinking group. Every Saturday night, we each had one drink, with the popular toast being "Sweethearts and Wives." The only other social gatherings of our small group were on each member's birthday, Midwinter's Day, and King's Birthday.

On the 25th we were able to make an inventory of a whole series of damages effected outside. The dogs' shelter had entirely carried away; a short mast which had been erected some weeks previously as a holdfast for sledges was snapped off short and the sledges buried, and, worst of all, Kennedy's igloo had parted with its roof, the interior being filled with snow, underneath which the instruments were buried. The dogs were, however, all quite well and lively. It was fortunate for them that the temperature always rose during the blizzards. At this period, when on fine days it was usual to experience -25 degrees to-37 degrees F., the temperature rose in the snowstorms to 25 degrees or even 30 degrees F.

On the 25th, we managed to take stock of a whole series of damages outside. The dogs' shelter was completely

Monday the 27th was beautifully clear. The tunnel entrance was opened and some of the party brought in ice while others undid the rope lashings which had been placed over the hut. This was so compactly covered in snow that the lashings were not required and I wanted to make a rope ladder to enable us to get down to the sea-ice and also to be used by Watson and Hoadley, who were about to dig a shaft in the glacier to examine the structure of the ice.

Monday the 27th was beautifully clear. The tunnel entrance was opened, and some of the group brought in ice while others untied the rope lashings that had been placed over the hut. It was so completely covered in snow that the lashings weren't necessary, and I wanted to make a rope ladder to help us get down to the sea ice and also for Watson and Hoadley, who were about to dig a shaft in the glacier to check out the structure of the ice.

Fine weather continued until June 2. During this time we were occupied in digging a road from the glacier down to the sea-ice in the forenoons and hunting for seals or skiing in the afternoons. Kennedy and Harrisson rebuilt the magnetic igloo. A seal-hole was eventually found near the foot of the glacier and this was enlarged to enable the seals to come up.

Fine weather continued until June 2. During this time, we spent our mornings digging a path from the glacier down to the sea ice and hunting for seals or skiing in the afternoons. Kennedy and Harrisson rebuilt the magnetic igloo. Eventually, we found a seal hole near the foot of the glacier and enlarged it to allow the seals to come up.

At the end of May, daylight lasted from 9 A.M. until 3 P.M., and the sunrise and sunset were a marvel of exquisite colour. The nightly displays of aurora australis were not very brilliant as the moon was nearing the full.

At the end of May, daylight lasted from 9 A.M. to 3 P.M., and the sunrise and sunset were stunning displays of vibrant colors. The nighttime shows of the aurora australis weren't very bright since the moon was close to being full.

On the days of blizzards, there was usually sufficient work to be found to keep us all employed. Thus on June 2, Watson and I were making a ladder, Jones was contriving a harpoon for seals, Hoadley was opening cases and stowing stores in the veranda, Dovers cleaning tools, Moyes repairing a thermograph and writing up the meteorological log, Harrisson cooking and Kennedy sleeping after a night-watch.

On blizzard days, there was usually enough work to keep everyone busy. So, on June 2, Watson and I were building a ladder, Jones was making a harpoon for seals, Hoadley was unpacking boxes and organizing supplies on the porch, Dovers was cleaning tools, Moyes was fixing a thermograph and updating the weather log, Harrisson was cooking, and Kennedy was sleeping after his night shift.

Between June 4 and 22 there was a remarkably fine spell. It was not calm all the time, as drift flew for a few days, limiting the horizon to a few hundred yards. An igloo was built as a shelter for those sinking the geological shaft, and seal-hunting was a daily recreation. On June 9, Dovers and Watson found a Weddell seal two and a half miles to the west on the sea-ice. They killed the animal but did not cut it up as there were sores on the skin. Jones went over with them afterwards and pronounced the sores to be wounds received from some other animal, so the meat was considered innocuous and fifty pounds were brought in, being very welcome after tinned foods. Jones took culture tubes with him and made smears for bacteria. The tubes were placed in an incubator and several kinds of organisms grew, very similar to those which infect wounds in ordinary climates.

Between June 4 and 22, the weather was exceptionally nice. It wasn’t calm all the time, as there were days of drifting snow that reduced visibility to just a few hundred yards. They built an igloo for shelter while working on the geological shaft, and seal hunting became a daily pastime. On June 9, Dovers and Watson discovered a Weddell seal two and a half miles to the west on the sea ice. They killed the seal but didn’t break it down because of sores on its skin. Jones went with them afterward and confirmed that the sores were wounds from another animal, so they deemed the meat safe to eat and brought back fifty pounds, which was a welcome change from canned food. Jones took culture tubes with him and prepared smears for bacteria. The tubes were placed in an incubator, and several types of organisms grew, resembling those that infect wounds in regular climates.

The snowstorms had by this time built up huge drifts under the lee of the ice-cliffs, some of them more than fifty feet in height and reaching almost to the top of the ice-shelf. An exhilarating sport was to ski down these ramps. The majority of them were very steep and irregular and it was seldom that any of us escaped without a fall at one time or another. Several of the party were thrown from thirty to forty feet, and, frequently enough, over twenty feet, without being hurt. The only accident serious enough to disable any one happened to Kennedy on June 19, when he twisted his knee and was laid up for a week.

The snowstorms had created massive snowdrifts by this time, piled up against the ice cliffs, some of them over fifty feet high and almost reaching the top of the ice shelf. Skiing down these slopes was an exhilarating sport. Most of them were very steep and uneven, so it was rare for any of us to avoid a fall at some point. Several members of the group were thrown from thirty to forty feet, and often over twenty feet, without getting hurt. The only serious accident that left anyone unable to continue occurred on June 19, when Kennedy twisted his knee and had to rest for a week.

There were many fine displays of the aurora in June, the best being observed on the evening of the 18th. Curtains and streamers were showing from four o'clock in the afternoon. Shortly after midnight, Kennedy, who was taking magnetic observations, called me to see the most remarkable exhibition I have so far seen. There was a double curtain 30 degrees wide unfolded from the eastern horizon through the zenith, with waves shimmering along it so rapidly that they travelled the whole length of the curtain in two seconds. The colouring was brilliant and evanescent. When the waves reached the end of the curtain they spread out to the north and rolled in a voluminous billow slowly back to the east. Kennedy's instruments showed that a very great magnetic disturbance was in progress during the auroral displays, and particularly on this occasion.

There were many beautiful displays of the aurora in June, with the best one happening on the evening of the 18th. Curtains and streamers started to appear at four o'clock in the afternoon. Shortly after midnight, Kennedy, who was taking magnetic observations, called me to check out the most amazing sight I’ve seen so far. There was a double curtain 30 degrees wide stretching from the eastern horizon all the way through the zenith, with waves shimmering along it so quickly that they traveled the entire length of the curtain in just two seconds. The colors were bright and fleeting. When the waves reached the end of the curtain, they spread out to the north and rolled back to the east in large billows. Kennedy's instruments indicated that a significant magnetic disturbance was occurring during the auroral displays, especially during this event.

Hoadley and Watson set up a line of bamboos, a quarter of a mile apart and three miles long, on the 20th, and from thence onwards took measurements for snowfall every fortnight.

Hoadley and Watson set up a line of bamboos, a quarter mile apart and three miles long, on the 20th, and from then on took measurements for snowfall every two weeks.

On Midwinter's Day the temperature ranged from -38 degrees F. to -25 degrees F. and daylight lasted from 10 A.M. until 4 P.M. We proclaimed a universal holiday throughout Queen Mary Land. Being Saturday, there were a few necessary jobs to be done, but all were finished by 11 A.M. The morning was fine and several of us went down to the floe for skiing, but after twelve o'clock the sky became overcast and the light was dimmed. A strong breeze brought along a trail of drift, and at 6 P.M. a heavy blizzard was in full career. Inside, the hut was decorated with flags and a savoury dinner was in the throes of preparation. To make the repast still more appetising, Harrisson, Hoadley and Dovers devised some very pretty and clever menus. Speeches, toasts and a gramophone concert made the evening pass quickly and enjoyably.

On Midwinter's Day, the temperature was between -38°F and -25°F, and daylight lasted from 10 A.M. to 4 P.M. We declared a universal holiday across Queen Mary Land. Since it was Saturday, there were a few necessary tasks to complete, but we finished everything by 11 A.M. The morning was nice, and several of us went down to the ice for skiing, but after noon, the sky became overcast and the light faded. A strong breeze brought in some drifting snow, and by 6 P.M., a heavy blizzard was in full swing. Inside, the hut was decorated with flags, and a delicious dinner was being prepared. To make the meal even more appealing, Harrisson, Hoadley, and Dovers came up with some really nice and creative menus. Speeches, toasts, and a gramophone concert made the evening pass quickly and enjoyably.

From this time dated our preparations for spring sledging, which I hoped would commence about August 15. Jones made some experiments with "glaxo," of which we had a generous supply. His aim was to make biscuits which would be suitable for sledging, and, after several failures, he succeeded in compressing with a steel die a firm biscuit of glaxo and butter mixed, three ounces of which was the equivalent in theoretical food value to four and a half ounces of plasmon biscuit; thereby affording a pleasant variety in the usual ration.

From this time onward, we started getting ready for spring sledding, which I hoped would begin around August 15. Jones experimented with "glaxo," which we had plenty of. His goal was to create biscuits that would be good for sledding. After several failed attempts, he managed to compress a solid biscuit made of glaxo and butter using a steel die. Three ounces of this biscuit had the same theoretical food value as four and a half ounces of plasmon biscuit, providing a nice change from the usual rations.

July came in quietly, though it was dull and cloudy, and we were able to get out on the first two days for work and exercise. On the 2nd a very fine effect was caused by the sun shining through myriads of fog-crystals which a light northerly breeze had brought down from the sea. The sun, which was barely clear of the horizon, was itself a deep red, on either side and above it was a red mock sun and a rainbow-tinted halo connected the three mock suns.

July arrived quietly, even though it was gloomy and overcast, allowing us to go out for work and exercise on the first two days. On the 2nd, a beautiful effect was created by the sun shining through countless fog crystals brought down from the sea by a light northern breeze. The sun, which was barely above the horizon, appeared deep red, while beside it and above were red mock suns, and a rainbow-colored halo linked all three mock suns.

On the 5th and 6th the wind blew a terrific hurricane (judged to reach a velocity of one hundred miles per hour) and, had we not known that nothing short of an earthquake could move the hut, we should have been very uneasy.

On the 5th and 6th, the wind howled like a fierce hurricane (estimated to hit speeds of one hundred miles per hour), and if we hadn’t known that only an earthquake could shift the hut, we would have been quite anxious.

All were now busy making food-bags, opening and breaking up pemmican and emergency rations, grinding biscuits, attending to personal gear and doing odd jobs many and various.

All were now busy making food bags, opening and breaking up pemmican and emergency rations, grinding biscuits, taking care of personal gear, and doing all sorts of odd jobs.

In addition to recreations like chess, cards and dominoes, a competition was started for each member to write a poem and short article, humorous or otherwise, connected with the Expedition. These were all read by the authors after dinner one evening and caused considerable amusement. One man even preferred to sing his poem. These literary efforts were incorporated in a small publication known as "The Glacier Tongue."

In addition to activities like chess, cards, and dominoes, a competition was launched for each member to write a poem and a short article, whether humorous or serious, related to the Expedition. Everyone read their work after dinner one evening, and it brought a lot of amusement. One guy even chose to sing his poem. These literary contributions were included in a small publication called "The Glacier Tongue."

Watson and Hoadley put in a good deal of time digging their shaft in the glacier. As a roofed shelter had been built over the top, they were able to work in all but the very worst weather. While the rest of us were fitting sledges on the 17th and 18th, they succeeded in getting down to a level of twenty-one feet below the surface of the shelf-ice.

Watson and Hoadley spent a lot of time digging their shaft in the glacier. Since a roofed shelter was built over the top, they could work in all but the worst weather. While the rest of us were getting the sledges ready on the 17th and 18th, they managed to reach a depth of twenty-one feet below the surface of the shelf ice.

Sandow, the leader of the dogs, disappeared on the 18th. Zip, who had been missed for two days, returned, but Sandow never came back, being killed, doubtless, by a fall of snow from the cliffs. All along the edge of the ice-shelf were snow cornices, some weighing hundreds of tons; and these often broke away, collapsing with a thunderous sound. On July 31, Harrisson and Watson had a narrow escape. After finishing their day's work, they climbed down to the floe by a huge cornice and sloping ramp. A few seconds later, the cornice fell and an immense mass of hard snow crashed down, cracking the sea-ice for more than a hundred yards around.

Sandow, the leader of the dogs, vanished on the 18th. Zip, who had been missing for two days, came back, but Sandow never returned, likely killed by a snow avalanche from the cliffs. All along the edge of the ice shelf were snow cornices, some weighing hundreds of tons, and these often broke off, collapsing with a thunderous sound. On July 31, Harrisson and Watson had a close call. After finishing their day's work, they climbed down to the floe by a massive cornice and sloping ramp. A few seconds later, the cornice collapsed, and a huge mass of hard snow fell, cracking the sea ice for over a hundred yards around.

July had been an inclement month with three really fine and eight tolerable days. In comparison with June's, which was -14.5 degrees F., the mean temperature of July was high at -1.5 degrees F. and the early half of August was little better.

July had been a harsh month with three really nice days and eight okay ones. Compared to June's mean temperature of -14.5 degrees F., July's was much higher at -1.5 degrees F., and the early part of August wasn't much better.

Sunday August 11 was rather an eventful day. Dovers and I went out in the wind to attend to the dogs and clear the chimney and, upon our return, found the others just recovering from rather an exciting accident. Jones had been charging the acetylene generators and by some means one of them caught fire. For a while there was the danger of a general conflagration and explosion, as the gas-tank was floating in kerosene. Throwing water over everything would have made matters worse, so blankets were used to smother the flames. As this failed to extinguish them, the whole plant was pulled down and carried into the tunnel, where the fire was at last put out. The damage amounted to two blankets singed and dirtied, Jones's face scorched and hair singed, and Kennedy, one finger jammed. It was a fortunate escape from a calamity.

Sunday, August 11 was quite an eventful day. Dovers and I went out in the wind to tend to the dogs and clear the chimney, and when we got back, we found the others just recovering from a pretty exciting accident. Jones had been charging the acetylene generators and somehow one of them caught fire. For a while, there was a risk of a major fire and explosion since the gas tank was floating in kerosene. Throwing water on everything would have made things worse, so they used blankets to smother the flames. When that didn't work, the whole setup was taken down and moved into the tunnel, where the fire was finally extinguished. The damage included two blankets that were singed and dirty, Jones's face scorched and hair singed, and Kennedy with one jammed finger. It was a lucky escape from a disaster.

A large capsized berg had been noticed for some time, eleven miles to the north. On the 14th, Harrisson, Dovers, Hoadley and Watson took three days' provisions and equipment and went off to examine it. A brief account is extracted from Harrisson's diary:

A large overturned iceberg had been spotted for a while, eleven miles to the north. On the 14th, Harrisson, Dovers, Hoadley, and Watson packed three days' worth of supplies and gear and set off to check it out. Here’s a short excerpt from Harrisson's diary:

"It was a particularly fine, mild morning; we made good progress, three dogs dragging the loaded sledge over the smooth floe without difficulty, requiring assistance only when crossing banks of soft snow. One and a half miles from 'The Steps,' we saw the footprints of a penguin.

"It was a really nice, mild morning; we made good progress, with three dogs pulling the loaded sled over the smooth ice without any trouble, only needing help when crossing soft patches of snow. One and a half miles from 'The Steps,' we spotted the footprints of a penguin."

"Following the cliffs of the shelf-ice for six and three quarter miles, we sighted a Weddell seal sleeping on a drift of snow. Killing the animal, cutting off the meat and burying it in the drift delayed us for about one hour. Continuing our journey under a fine bluff, over floe-ice much cracked by tide-pressure, we crossed a small bay cutting wedge-like into the glacier and camped on its far side.

"After following the cliffs of the ice shelf for six and three-quarter miles, we spotted a Weddell seal resting on a snowdrift. It took us about an hour to kill the seal, cut off the meat, and bury it in the snow. We then resumed our journey beneath a nice bluff, over floe ice that was heavily cracked from the tide pressure, and crossed a small bay that jutted into the glacier before setting up camp on the other side."

"After our midday meal we walked to the berg three miles away. When seen on June 28, this berg was tilted to the north-east, but the opposite end, apparently in contact with the ice-cliffs, had lifted higher than the glacier-shelf itself. From a distance it could be seen that the sides, for half their height, were wave-worn and smooth. Three or four acres of environing floe were buckled, ploughed up and in places heaped twenty feet high, while several large fragments of the broken floe were poised aloft on the old 'water-line' of the berg.

"After our lunch, we walked to the icebergs three miles away. On June 28, this iceberg was tilted to the northeast, but the other end, which seemed to be touching the ice cliffs, was lifted higher than the glacier shelf itself. From a distance, we could see that the sides were wave-worn and smooth for about half their height. Three or four acres of surrounding ice floe were crumpled, turned over, and in some places stacked twenty feet high, while several large chunks of the broken floe were resting on the old 'water line' of the iceberg."

"However, on this visit, we found that the berg had turned completely over towards the cliffs and was now floating on its side surrounded by large separate chunks; all locked fast in the floe. In what had been the bottom of the berg Hoadley and Watson made an interesting find of stones and pebbles—the first found in this dead land!

"However, on this trip, we discovered that the iceberg had completely flipped over toward the cliffs and was now floating on its side, surrounded by large separate chunks; all stuck fast in the ice. In what used to be the bottom of the iceberg, Hoadley and Watson made an interesting find of stones and pebbles—the first found in this barren land!"

"Leaving them collecting, I climbed the pitted wave-worn ice, brittle and badly cracked on the higher part. The highest point was fifty feet above the level of the top of the shelf-ice. There was no sign of open water to the north, but a few seals were observed sleeping under the cliffs."

"Leaving them to gather, I climbed the worn, pitted ice, which was brittle and badly cracked at the top. The highest point was fifty feet above the level of the shelf ice. There was no sign of open water to the north, but I spotted a few seals resting under the cliffs."

Next morning the weather thickened and the wind arose, so a start was made for the Base. All that day the party groped along in the comparative shelter of the cliff-face until forced to camp. It was not till the next afternoon in moderate drift that a pair of skis which had been left at the foot of 'The Steps' were located and the hut reached once again.

Next morning, the weather got worse and the wind picked up, so they set off for the Base. All day, the group moved along in the relative shelter of the cliff until they had to set up camp. It wasn't until the next afternoon, with a light snowfall, that they found a pair of skis that had been left at the bottom of 'The Steps' and made it back to the hut.

After lunch on August 11, while we were excavating some buried kerosene, Jones sighted a group of seven Emperor penguins two miles away over the western floe. Taking a sledge and camera we made after them. A mile off, they saw us and advanced with their usual stately bows. It seemed an awful shame to kill them, but we were sorely in need of fresh meat. The four we secured averaged seventy pounds in weight and were a heavy load up the steep rise to the glacier; but our reward came at dinner-time.

After lunch on August 11, while we were digging up some buried kerosene, Jones spotted a group of seven Emperor penguins two miles away on the western ice floe. We grabbed a sled and a camera and went after them. A mile away, they noticed us and approached with their characteristic dignified bows. It felt terrible to think about killing them, but we really needed some fresh meat. The four we caught averaged seventy pounds each and were a heavy load to carry up the steep slope to the glacier; but our reward came at dinner time.

With several fine days to give us confidence, everything was made ready for the sledge journey on August 20. The party was to consist of six men and three dogs, the object of the journey being to lay out a food-depot to the east in view of the long summer journey we were to make in that direction. Hoadley and Kennedy were to remain at the Base, the former to finish the geological shaft and the latter for magnetic work. There remained also a good deal to do preparing stores for later sledge journeys.

With several nice days to boost our confidence, everything was set for the sledge journey on August 20. The team would consist of six men and three dogs, with the goal of establishing a food depot to the east in anticipation of the long summer journey we planned to take in that direction. Hoadley and Kennedy would stay at the Base, with Hoadley finishing the geological shaft and Kennedy handling magnetic work. There was still a lot to do to get supplies ready for upcoming sledge journeys.

The load was to be one thousand four hundred and forty pounds distributed over three sledges; two hundred pounds heavier than on the March Journey, but as the dogs pulled one sledge, the actual weight per man was less.

The load was supposed to be one thousand four hundred and forty pounds distributed over three sledges; two hundred pounds heavier than on the March Journey, but since the dogs pulled one sledge, the actual weight per person was less.

The rations were almost precisely the same as those used by Shackleton during his Expedition, and the daily allowance was exactly the same—thirty-four ounces per man per day. For his one ounce of oatmeal, the same weighs of ground biscuit was substituted; the food value being the same. On the second depot journey and the main summer journeys, a three-ounce glaxo biscuit was used in place of four and a half ounces of plasmon biscuit. Instead of taking cheese and chocolate as the luncheon ration, I took chocolate alone, as on Shackleton's southern journey it was found more satisfactory than the cheese, though the food value was practically the same.

The rations were almost exactly the same as those used by Shackleton during his expedition, and the daily allowance was identical—thirty-four ounces per person per day. For his one ounce of oatmeal, the same weight of ground biscuit was used; the nutritional value remained the same. On the second depot journey and the main summer trips, a three-ounce Glaxo biscuit replaced four and a half ounces of Plasmon biscuit. Instead of taking cheese and chocolate as the lunch ration, I opted for chocolate alone, as it was found to be more satisfactory than cheese on Shackleton's southern journey, even though the nutritional value was practically the same.

The sledging equipment and clothing were identical with that used by Shackleton. Jaeger fleece combination suits were included in the outfit but, though excellent garments for work at the Base, they were much too heavy for sledging. We therefore wore Jaeger underclothing and burberry wind clothing as overalls.

The sledging gear and clothing were the same as those used by Shackleton. Jaeger fleece suits were part of the outfit, but while they were great for work at the Base, they were way too heavy for sledging. So, we wore Jaeger underwear and Burberry windbreakers as our outer layer.

The weather was not propitious for a start until Thursday, August 22. We turned out at 5.30 A.M., had breakfast, packed up and left the Hut at seven o'clock.

The weather wasn't favorable for a start until Thursday, August 22. We got up at 5:30 A.M., had breakfast, packed up, and left the Hut at seven o'clock.

After two good days' work under a magnificently clear sky, with the temperature often as low as -34 degrees F., we sighted two small nunataks among a cluster of pressure-ridges, eight miles to the south. It was the first land, in the sense of rocks, seen for more than seven months. We hoped to visit the outcrops—Gillies Nunataks—on our return.

After two great days of work under a brilliantly clear sky, with temperatures often dropping to -34 degrees F., we spotted two small nunataks among a group of pressure ridges, eight miles to the south. It was the first land, in terms of rocks, we had seen in over seven months. We planned to check out the outcrops—Gillies Nunataks—on our way back.

The course next day was due east and parallel to the mainland, then ten miles distant. To the north was Masson Island, while at about the same distance and ahead was a smaller island, entirely ice-covered like the former—Henderson Island.

The course the next day was straight east and parallel to the mainland, which was ten miles away. To the north was Masson Island, and at roughly the same distance ahead was a smaller island, completely covered in ice like the first one—Henderson Island.

A blizzard of three days' duration kept us in camp between August 27 and 30. Jones, Moyes and I had a three-man sleeping-bag, and the temperature being high, 11 degrees to 15 degrees F., we were very warm, but thoroughly tired of lying down for so long. Harrisson, Dovers and Watson had single bags and therefore less room in the other tent.

A blizzard that lasted three days kept us in camp from August 27 to 30. Jones, Moyes, and I had a three-person sleeping bag, and with the temperature being relatively warm, between 11 and 15 degrees F, we stayed cozy, but we were really tired of lying down for so long. Harrisson, Dovers, and Watson had individual sleeping bags, so they had less space in the other tent.

The last day of August was beautifully bright: temperature -12 degrees to -15 degrees F. We passed Henderson Island in the forenoon, and, hauling up a rise to the south of it, had a good view of the surroundings. On the right, the land ran back to form a large bay, seventeen miles wide. This was later named the Bay of Winds, as a "blow" was always encountered while crossing it.

The last day of August was stunningly bright: temperatures between -12 and -15 degrees F. We passed Henderson Island in the morning, and as we climbed a rise to the south of it, we had a great view of the area. To the right, the land extended back to create a large bay that was seventeen miles wide. This was later called the Bay of Winds, as there was always a strong wind when crossing it.

In the centre of the bay was a nunatak, which from its shape at once received the name of the Alligator. In front, apparently fifteen miles off, was another nunatak, the Hippo, and four definite outcrops—Delay Point and Avalanche Rocks—could be seen along the mainland. The sight of this bare rock was very pleasing, as we had begun to think we were going to find nothing but ice-sheathed land. Dovers took a round of angles to all the prominent points.

In the middle of the bay was a nunatak that instantly got the name Alligator due to its shape. In front, about fifteen miles away, was another nunatak, the Hippo, and we could see four distinct outcrops—Delay Point and Avalanche Rocks—along the coastline. The sight of this bare rock was very refreshing, as we had started to think we would only encounter ice-covered land. Dovers took measurements of angles to all the prominent points.

The Hippo was twenty-two miles away, so deceptive is distance in these latitudes; and in one and a half days, over very heavy sastrugi, we were in its vicinity. The sledges could not be brought very near the rock as it was surrounded by massive ridges of pressure-ice.

The Hippo was twenty-two miles away, but distance can be tricky in this area; and in one and a half days, battling through some tough sastrugi, we managed to get close. We couldn’t bring the sledges too close to the rock because it was surrounded by huge ridges of pressure ice.

We climbed to the top of the nunatak which was four hundred and twenty feet high, four hundred yards long and two hundred yards wide. It was composed of gneissic granite and schists. Dovers took angles from an eminence, Watson collected geological specimens and Harrisson sketched until his fingers were frost-bitten. Moss and lichens were found and a dead snow petrel—a young one—showing that the birds must breed in the vicinity.

We climbed to the top of the nunatak, which was 420 feet high, 400 yards long, and 200 yards wide. It was made up of gneissic granite and schists. Dovers took measurements from a high point, Watson collected geological samples, and Harrisson sketched until his fingers were frostbitten. We found moss and lichens, along with a young dead snow petrel, indicating that the birds likely breed nearby.

To the south, the glacier shelf appeared to be very little broken, but to the north it was terribly torn and twisted. At each end of the nunatak there was a very fine bergschrund.** Twenty miles to the east there appeared to be an uncovered rocky islet; the mainland turning to the southward twelve miles away. During the night the minimum thermometer registered -47 degrees F.

To the south, the glacier shelf looked mostly intact, but to the north it was severely damaged and twisted. At each end of the nunatak, there was a nice bergschrund. Twenty miles to the east, there seemed to be a bare rocky islet, with the mainland bending to the south about twelve miles away. During the night, the lowest temperature recorded was -47 degrees F.

     ** The term not used in the usual sense.  Referring to a wide,
imposing crevasse caused by the division of the ice as it presses past
the nunatak.—ED.
     ** The term isn't used in the usual way. It refers to a large, impressive crevasse created by the separation of the ice as it moves past the nunatak. —ED.

An attempt to get away next morning was frustrated by a strong gale. We were two hundred yards from the shelter of the Hippo and were forced to turn back, since it was difficult to keep one's feet, while the sledges were blown sideways over the neve surface.

An attempt to leave the next morning was stopped by a strong wind. We were two hundred yards from the shelter of the Hippo and had to turn back because it was hard to stay on our feet, while the sledges were pushed sideways over the snow surface.

I resolved to leave the depot in this place and return to the Base, for our sleeping-bags were getting very wet and none of the party were having sufficient sleep. We were eighty-four miles from the hut; I had hoped to do one hundred miles, but we could make up for that by starting the summer journey a few days earlier. One sledge was left here as well as six weeks' allowance of food for three men, except tea, of which there was sufficient for fifty days, seventy days oil and seventy-eight days' biscuit. The sledge was placed on end in a hole three feet deep and a mound built up around it, six feet high; a bamboo and flag being lashed to the top.

I decided to leave the depot here and head back to the Base because our sleeping bags were getting really wet and no one in the group was getting enough sleep. We were eighty-four miles away from the hut; I had hoped to cover a hundred miles, but we could make up for that by starting the summer journey a few days earlier. One sledge was left here along with six weeks' worth of food for three people, except for tea, which was enough for fifty days, plus seventy days' worth of oil and seventy-eight days' worth of biscuits. The sledge was stood up in a three-foot-deep hole with a six-foot-high mound built around it, and a bamboo pole and flag were secured to the top.

On September 4 we were homeward bound, heading first to the mainland leaving Delay Point on our left, to examine some of the outcrops of rock. Reaching the coast about 3 P.M., camp was shortly afterwards pitched in a most beautiful spot. A wall of solid rock rose sheer for over four hundred feet and was crowned by an ice-cap half the thickness. Grand ice-falls surged down on either side.

On September 4, we were on our way home, first heading to the mainland and passing Delay Point on our left to check out some rock formations. We reached the coast around 3 P.M. and quickly set up camp in a stunning location. A solid rock wall rose straight up for over four hundred feet and was topped by an ice cap that was half as thick. Impressive ice falls cascaded down on both sides.

The tents were erected in what appeared to be a sheltered hollow, a quarter of a mile from Avalanche Rocks. One tent was up and we were setting the other in position when the wind suddenly veered right round to the east and flattened out both tents. It was almost as humorous as annoying. They were soon raised up once more, facing the other way.

The tents were set up in what looked like a sheltered dip, about a quarter of a mile from Avalanche Rocks. We had one tent up and were positioning the other when the wind suddenly shifted to the east and knocked both tents down. It was almost as funny as it was frustrating. They were quickly put back up again, facing the opposite direction.

While preparing for bed, a tremendous avalanche came down. The noise was awful and seemed so close that we all turned to the door and started out. The fastening of the entrance was knotted, the people from the other tent were yelling to us to come out, so we dragged up the bottom of the tent and dived beneath it.

While getting ready for bed, a huge avalanche came crashing down. The sound was terrible and felt so close that we all rushed to the door and started to go out. The latch on the entrance was tangled, and the people from the other tent were shouting for us to come out, so we pulled up the bottom of the tent and crawled underneath it.

The cliff was entirely hidden by a cloud of snow, and, though the crashing had now almost ceased, we stood ready to run, Dovers thoughtfully seizing a food-bag. However, none of the blocks had come within a hundred yards of us, and as it was now blowing hard, all hands elected to remain where they were.

The cliff was completely obscured by a cloud of snow, and, even though the crashing sounds had nearly stopped, we were prepared to run, with Dovers carefully grabbing a food bag. However, none of the blocks had come within a hundred yards of us, and since it was now blowing hard, everyone decided to stay put.

Several more avalanches, which had broken away near the edge of the mainland, disturbed our sleep through the night, but they were not quite so alarming as the first one. A strong breeze was blowing at daybreak; still the weather was not too bad for travelling, and so I called the party. Moyes and I lashed up our bags, passed them out and strapped them on the sledge; Jones, in the meantime, starting the cooker. Suddenly a terrific squall struck the front of our tent, the poles burst through the apex, and the material split from top to bottom.

Several more avalanches, which had broken away near the edge of the mainland, kept us awake through the night, but they weren’t as alarming as the first one. A strong breeze was blowing at daybreak; still, the weather wasn't too bad for traveling, so I called the group together. Moyes and I packed up our bags, handed them out, and strapped them onto the sled; meanwhile, Jones was getting the cooker started. Suddenly, a massive squall hit the front of our tent, the poles shot through the peak, and the fabric ripped from top to bottom.

Moyes and I were both knocked down. When we found our feet again, we went to the aid of the other men, whose tent had survived the gust. The wind rushed by more madly than ever, and the only thing to do was to pull away the poles and allow the tent to collapse.

Moyes and I were both knocked down. When we got back on our feet, we went to help the other guys, whose tent had managed to stay up. The wind howled more wildly than before, and the only option was to take down the poles and let the tent fall.

Looking around for a lee where it could be raised, we found the only available shelter to be a crevasse three hundred yards to windward, but the wind was now so strong that it was impossible to convey the gear even to such a short distance. All were frequently upset and blown along the surface twenty or thirty yards, and, even with an ice-axe, one could not always hold his own. The only resort was to dig a shelter.

Looking around for a protected spot where we could set up, we discovered that the only available shelter was a crevasse three hundred yards upwind, but the wind was now so strong that it was impossible to move the gear even that short distance. Things were constantly getting knocked over and blown along the surface twenty or thirty yards, and even with an ice axe, it was tough to stay in one place. The only option was to dig a shelter.

Setting to work, we excavated a hole three feet deep, twelve feet long and six feet wide; the snow being so compact that the job occupied three hours. The sledges and tent-poles were placed across the hole, the good tent being laid on top and weighted down with snow and blocks of ice. All this sounds very easy, but it was a slow and difficult task. Many of the gusts must have exceeded one hundred miles per hour, since one of them lifted Harrisson who was standing beside me, clean over my head and threw him nearly twenty feet. Everything movable was stowed in the hole, and at noon we had a meal and retired into sleeping-bags. At three o'clock a weighty avalanche descended, its fearful crash resounding above the roar of the wind. I have never found anything which gave me a more uncomfortable feeling than those avalanches.

Getting started, we dug a hole three feet deep, twelve feet long, and six feet wide; the snow was so packed that it took us three hours to finish. We laid the sledges and tent poles across the hole, then placed the good tent on top and weighed it down with snow and blocks of ice. It all sounds simple, but it was a slow and challenging job. Many of the gusts must have been over one hundred miles per hour, since one of them lifted Harrisson, who was next to me, right over my head and threw him nearly twenty feet. Everything movable was stored in the hole, and at noon we had a meal and crawled into our sleeping bags. At three o'clock a massive avalanche came down, its terrifying crash echoing above the sound of the wind. I've never experienced anything that made me feel more uneasy than those avalanches.

The gale continued on September 6, and we still remained packed in the trench. If the latter had been deeper and it had been possible to sit upright, we should have been quite comfortable. To make matters worse, several more avalanches came down, and all of them sounded horribly close.

The strong winds kept blowing on September 6, and we were still crammed in the trench. If it had been deeper and we could sit up straight, we would have been pretty comfortable. To make things worse, several more avalanches tumbled down, and they all sounded alarmingly close.

We were confined in our burrow for five days, the wind continuing to blow with merciless force. Through being closed up so much, the temperature of the hole rose above freezing-point, consequently our sleeping-bags and clothes became very wet.

We were stuck in our burrow for five days, with the wind continuing to blow with relentless force. Being cooped up like this caused the temperature in the hole to rise above freezing, which made our sleeping bags and clothes quite damp.

On Sunday September 8, Moyes went out to feed the dogs and to bring in some biscuit. He found a strong gusty wind with falling snow, and drift so thick that he could not see five yards. We had a cold lunch with nothing to drink, so that the primus should not raise the temperature. In the evening we sang hymns and between us managed to remember the words of at least a dozen.

On Sunday, September 8, Moyes went out to feed the dogs and to bring in some biscuits. He encountered a strong, gusty wind with falling snow, and the drifts were so thick that he couldn’t see five yards ahead. We had a cold lunch with nothing to drink, so the primus wouldn’t raise the temperature. In the evening, we sang hymns and managed to remember the words of at least a dozen between us.

The long confinement was over on the 10th; the sky was blue and the sun brilliant, though the wind still pulsated with racking gusts. As soon as we were on the ice, away from the land, two men had to hold on to the rear of each sledge, and even then capsizes often occurred. The sledge would turn and slide broadside-on to leeward, tearing the runners badly on the rough ice. Still, by 9.30 A.M. the surface changed to snow and the travelling improved. That night we camped with twenty miles one hundred yards on the meter.

The long confinement ended on the 10th; the sky was blue and the sun was shining brightly, although the wind still blew with strong gusts. As soon as we got on the ice, away from the shore, two men had to hang on to the back of each sled, and even then, we often flipped over. The sled would turn and slide sideways into the wind, damaging the runners on the rough ice. Still, by 9:30 A.M., the surface changed to snow, making travel easier. That night, we set up camp after covering twenty miles and one hundred yards on the meter.

There was a cold blizzard on the 11th with a temperature of -30 degrees F. Confined in the tents, we found our sleeping-bags still sodden and uncomfortable.

There was a cold blizzard on the 11th with a temperature of -30 degrees F. Confined in the tents, we found our sleeping bags still damp and uncomfortable.

With a strong beam wind and in moderate drift big marches were made for two days, during which the compass and sastrugi determined our course.

With a strong wind and moderate drift, we made significant progress for two days, during which the compass and sastrugi (sharp ribs of hardened snow) guided our direction.

My diary of September 14 runs as follows:

My diary entry for September 14 is as follows:

"On the march at 7 A.M.; by noon we had done twelve miles one thousand five hundred yards. Lunch was hurried, as we were all anxious to get to the hut to-night, especially we in the three-man bag, as it got so wet while we were living underground that we have had very little sleep and plenty of shivering for the last four nights. Last night I had no sleep at all. By some means, in the afternoon, we got on the wrong course. Either the compass was affected or a mistake had been made in some of the bearings, as instead of reaching home by 5 P.M. we were travelling till 8 P.M. and have done thirty-two miles one thousand one hundred yards. Light loads, good surface and a fair wind account for the good travelling, the sail doing almost all the work on the man-hauled sledge.

"On the march at 7 A.M.; by noon we had covered twelve miles one thousand five hundred yards. Lunch was quick since we were all eager to reach the hut tonight, especially those of us in the three-man bag, as it got so wet while we were underground that we've barely slept and have been shivering for the last four nights. Last night, I didn’t sleep at all. For some reason, in the afternoon, we lost our way. Either the compass was off or there was a mistake in some of the bearings because instead of getting home by 5 P.M., we ended up traveling until 8 P.M. and covered thirty-two miles one thousand one hundred yards. Light loads, good terrain, and a steady wind made for good traveling, with the sail doing almost all the work on the man-hauled sledge."

"The last two hours we were in the dark, except for a young moon, amongst a lot of crevasses and pressure-ridges which none of us could recognize. At one time, we found ourselves on a slope within a dozen yards of the edge of the glacier; this decided me to camp. Awfully disappointing; anticipating another wretched night. Temperature-35 degrees F."

"The last two hours, we were in the dark, except for a young moon, surrounded by crevasses and pressure ridges that none of us could identify. At one point, we ended up on a slope just a dozen yards from the edge of the glacier; this made me decide to set up camp. Really disappointing; I was dreading another miserable night. Temperature -35 degrees F."

Next day we reached home. The last camp had been four and a half miles north of the hut. I found that we had gone wrong through using 149 degrees as the bearing of Masson Island from the Base, when it should have been 139 degrees. I believe it was my own mistake, as I gave the bearing to Dovers and he is very careful.

The next day we got home. The last campsite had been four and a half miles north of the cabin. I realized we had messed up by using 149 degrees as the bearing to Masson Island from the Base when it should have been 139 degrees. I think it was my fault, as I provided the bearing to Dovers, and he’s usually very careful.

Before having a meal, we were all weighed and found the average loss to be eight pounds. In the evening, Moyes and I weighed ourselves again; he had gained seven pounds and I five and three-quarter pounds.

Before having a meal, we were all weighed, and the average loss turned out to be eight pounds. In the evening, Moyes and I weighed ourselves again; he had gained seven pounds, and I had gained five and three-quarter pounds.

Comparing notes with Hoadley and Kennedy, I found that the weather at the Base had been similar to that experienced on the sledging journey.

Comparing notes with Hoadley and Kennedy, I found that the weather at the Base had been similar to what we experienced on the sledding journey.

It was now arranged that Jones was to take charge of the main western journey in the summer. While looking for a landing-place in the 'Aurora', we had noted to the west an expanse of old, fast floe, extending for at least fifty miles. The idea was for Jones and party to march along this floe and lay a depot on the land as far west as was possible in four weeks. The party included Dovers, Harrisson, Hoadley and Moyes. They were to be assisted by the dogs.

It was decided that Jones would lead the main western journey in the summer. While searching for a landing spot on the 'Aurora', we had observed to the west an area of old, solid ice that stretched for at least fifty miles. The plan was for Jones and his team to march along this ice and set up a supply point on land as far west as possible within four weeks. The team included Dovers, Harrisson, Hoadley, and Moyes. They would be helped by the dogs.

It was my intention to take Kennedy and Watson up to the depot we had left on the hills in March, bringing back the minimum thermometer and probably some of the food. Watson was slightly lame at the time, as he had bruised his foot on the last trip.

It was my plan to take Kennedy and Watson up to the depot we had left on the hills in March, bringing back the minimum thermometer and probably some of the food. Watson was a little lame at the time because he had hurt his foot on the last trip.

Until Jones made a start on September 26, there were ten days of almost continuous wind and drift. The equinox may have accounted for this prolonged period of atrocious weather. No time, however, was wasted indoors. Weighing and bagging food, repairing tents, poles, cookers and other gear damaged on the last journey and sewing and mending clothes gave every man plenty of employment.

Until Jones set out on September 26, there were ten days of nearly nonstop wind and bad weather. The equinox might have caused this extended stretch of terrible conditions. However, no time was wasted inside. Weighing and bagging food, fixing tents, poles, cookers, and other equipment damaged on the last trip, as well as sewing and mending clothes, kept every man busy.

At 6 A.M. on the 26th, Jones reported that there was only a little low drift and that the wind was dying away. All hands were therefore called and breakfast served.

At 6 A.M. on the 26th, Jones reported that there was just a bit of low drift and that the wind was fading. So, everyone was called together and breakfast was served.

Watson, Kennedy and I assisted the others down to the sea-ice by a long sloping snow-drift and saw them off to a good start in a south-westerly direction. We found that the heavy sledge used for carrying ice had been blown more then five hundred yards to the edge of the glacier, capsized among the rough pressure-slabs and broken. Two heavy boxes which were on the sledge had disappeared altogether.

Watson, Kennedy, and I helped the others down to the sea ice via a long, sloping snow drift and saw them off to a good start heading southwest. We discovered that the heavy sled used for carrying ice had been blown more than five hundred yards to the glacier's edge, tipped over among the rough pressure slabs and damaged. Two heavy boxes that were on the sled were completely missing.

The rest of the day was devoted to clearing stores out of the tunnels. It was evident to us that with the advent of warmer weather, the roof of the caves or grottoes (by the way, the hut received the name of "The Grottoes") would sink, and so it was advisable to repack the cases outside rather than dig them out of the deep snow. By 6 P.M. nearly two hundred boxes were passed up through the trap-door and the caverns were all empty.

The rest of the day was spent clearing out the supplies from the tunnels. It was clear to us that with warmer weather coming, the ceilings of the caves or grottoes (by the way, the hut was called "The Grottoes") would collapse, so it made more sense to repack the boxes outside instead of digging them out from the deep snow. By 6 P.M., nearly two hundred boxes had been passed up through the trap-door, and the caverns were completely empty.

After two days of blizzard, Watson, Kennedy and I broke trail with loads of one hundred and seventy pounds per man. Right from the start the surface was so soft that pulling became very severe. On the first day, September 29, we managed to travel more than nine miles, but during the next six days the snow became deeper and more impassable, and only nineteen miles were covered. Crevasses were mostly invisible, and on the slope upwards to the ice-cap more troublesome than usual. The weather kept up its invariable wind and drift. Finally, after making laborious headway to two thousand feet, Kennedy strained his Achilles tendon and I decided to return to "The Grottoes."

After two days of a blizzard, Watson, Kennedy, and I began our trek with loads of one hundred seventy pounds each. From the start, the ground was so soft that pulling became extremely tough. On the first day, September 29, we managed to cover over nine miles, but in the following six days, the snow got deeper and more impassable, and we only covered nineteen miles. The crevasses were mostly hidden, and the slope leading up to the ice cap was more troublesome than usual. The weather continued with its constant wind and drifting snow. Eventually, after pushing our way to two thousand feet, Kennedy strained his Achilles tendon, and I decided to head back to "The Grottoes."

At 2 P.M. on October 8, the mast was sighted and we climbed down into the Hut, finding it very cold, empty and dark. The sun had shone powerfully that day and Kennedy and Watson had a touch of snow-blindness.

At 2 PM on October 8, we spotted the mast and went down into the Hut, where it was really cold, empty, and dark. The sun had been shining intensely that day, and Kennedy and Watson were dealing with a bit of snow-blindness.

Two weeks went by and there was no sign of the western depot party. In fact, out of sixteen days, there were thirteen of thick drift and high wind, so that our sympathies went out to the men in tents with soaking bags, waiting patiently for a rift in the driving wall of snow. On October 23 they had been away for four weeks; provisions for that time having been taken. I had no doubt that they would be on reduced rations, and, if the worst came, they could eat the dogs.

Two weeks passed, and there was no sign of the western depot team. In fact, out of sixteen days, thirteen were filled with heavy snow drift and strong winds, so we felt for the guys in tents with wet sleeping bags, patiently waiting for a break in the relentless wall of snow. On October 23, they had been away for four weeks; supplies were meant to last that long. I was sure they were on limited rations, and if things got really bad, they could eat the dogs.

During a lull on October 24, I went to the masthead with the field-glasses but saw nothing of the party. On that day we weighed out provisions and made ready to go in search of them. It was my intention to go on the outward track for a week. I wrote instructions to Jones to hoist a large flag on the mast, and to burn flares each night at 10 P.M. if he should return while I was away.

During a break on October 24, I went up to the mast with the binoculars but didn't see any sign of the group. That day, we prepared supplies and got ready to search for them. I planned to follow the same route for a week. I wrote instructions to Jones to raise a big flag on the mast and to light flares each night at 10 PM if he returned while I was gone.

There was a fresh gale with blinding drift early on the following morning; so we postponed the start. At 4 P.M. the wind subsided to a strong breeze and I again went up the mast to sweep the horizon. Westward from an icy cape to the south a gale was still blowing and a heavy cloud of drift, fifty to sixty feet high, obscured everything.

There was a strong wind with blinding snow early the next morning, so we delayed our departure. By 4 P.M., the wind had calmed down to a strong breeze, and I climbed up the mast again to check the view. To the west, from an icy cape to the south, the storm was still raging, and a dense cloud of snow, about fifty to sixty feet high, covered everything.

An hour later Watson saw three Adelie penguins approaching across the floe and we went down to meet them, bringing them in for the larder. Four Antarctic petrels flew above our heads: a sign of returning summer which was very cheering.

An hour later, Watson saw three Adélie penguins coming over the ice, and we went down to greet them, bringing them in for the food storage. Four Antarctic petrels flew overhead: a sign of the returning summer, which was very uplifting.

The previous night had promised a fine day and we were not disappointed on October 26. A sledge was packed with fourteen days' provisions for eight men and we started away on a search expedition at 10 A.M.

The night before had promised a beautiful day, and we weren’t let down on October 26. A sled was loaded with two weeks' worth of supplies for eight men, and we set off on a search expedition at 10 A.M.

After doing a little over nine miles we camped at 5.30 P.M. Before retiring to bag, I had a last look round and was delighted to see Jones and his party about a mile to the south. It was now getting dark and we were within two hundred yards of them before being seen, and, as they were to windward, they could not hear our shouts. It was splendid to find them all looking well. They were anxious to get back to "The Grottoes," considering there was only one serviceable tent between them. Kennedy and I offered to change with any of them but, being too eager for warm blankets and a good bed, they trudged on, arriving at the Base at midnight.

After walking a little over nine miles, we set up camp at 5:30 PM. Before heading to bed, I took one last look around and was happy to see Jones and his group about a mile to the south. It was starting to get dark, and we were only two hundred yards away from them before they noticed us. Since the wind was blowing towards us, they couldn't hear our calls. It was great to see them all looking good. They were eager to get back to "The Grottoes," especially since they only had one usable tent among them. Kennedy and I offered to switch places with any of them, but they were too keen on warm blankets and a comfy bed, so they continued on and reached the Base at midnight.

Briefly told, their story was that they were stopped in their westerly march, when forty-five miles had been covered, by a badly broken glacier—Helen Glacier—on the far side of which there was open sea. There was only one thing to do and that was to set out for the mainland by a course so circuitous that they were brought a long way eastward, back towards "The Grottoes." They had very rough travelling, bad weather, and were beset with many difficulties in mounting on to the land-ice, where the depot had to be placed. Their distance from the Base at this point was only twenty-eight miles and the altitude was one thousand feet above sea-level. On the ice-cap they were delayed by a blizzard and for seventeen days—an unexampled time—they were unable to move from camp. One tent collapsed and the occupants, Jones, Dovers and Hoadley, had to dig a hole in the snow and lower the tent into it.

In short, their story was that they were halted in their westward journey after covering forty-five miles by a badly fractured glacier—Helen Glacier—beyond which lay open sea. They had no choice but to head for the mainland by a route so winding that it took them far eastward, back toward "The Grottoes." They faced tough travel, terrible weather, and numerous challenges while trying to climb onto the land-ice where the supply depot needed to be set up. At this point, they were only twenty-eight miles from the Base and at an elevation of one thousand feet above sea level. On the ice-cap, a blizzard held them up, and for seventeen days—an unprecedented duration—they were stuck at camp. One tent collapsed, forcing the occupants, Jones, Dovers, and Hoadley, to dig a hole in the snow and lower the tent into it.

These are a few snatches from Jones's diary:

These are a few excerpts from Jones's diary:

"The next sixteen days (following Wednesday, October 9) were spent at this camp.... Harrisson and Moyes occupied one tent and Dovers, Hoadley and myself the other.

"The next sixteen days (after Wednesday, October 9) were spent at this camp.... Harrisson and Moyes shared one tent while Dovers, Hoadley, and I took the other."

"On Saturday, the third day of the blizzard, the wind which had been blowing steadily from the east-south-east veered almost to east and the tents commenced to flog terrifically. This change must have occurred early in the night, for we awoke at 5 A.M. to find clouds of snow blowing under the skirt on one side: the heavy pile on the flounce having been cut away by the wind. As it would have been impossible to do anything outside, we pulled the tent poles together and allowed the tent to collapse. The rest of the day was spent in confined quarters, eating dry rations and melting snow in our mugs by the warmth of our bodies.... Although Harrisson and Moyes were no more than twenty feet from us, the noise of the gale and the flogging of our tents rendered communication impossible.

"On Saturday, the third day of the blizzard, the wind that had been blowing steadily from the east-southeast shifted almost to the east, and the tents started to flap violently. This change must have happened early in the night because we woke up at 5 A.M. to find clouds of snow blowing under one side of the tent; the heavy build-up on the edge had been blown away by the wind. Since it was impossible to do anything outside, we pulled the tent poles together and let the tent collapse. The rest of the day was spent in cramped quarters, eating dry food and melting snow in our mugs using our body heat. Although Harrisson and Moyes were only about twenty feet away, the noise of the wind and the flapping of our tents made communication impossible."

"The terrible flapping at last caused one of the seams of our tent to tear; we sewed it as well as we were able and hoped that it would hold till daylight.

"The awful flapping finally made one of the seams of our tent rip; we patched it up as best we could and hoped it would last until morning."

"On Monday morning, the same seam again parted and we decided to let the tent down again, spending the day in a half-reclining position....

"On Monday morning, the same seam came apart again, and we decided to take the tent down once more, spending the day mostly lying down...."

"At 6.30 P.M. the gale eased and, during a comparative lull, Moyes came out to feed the dogs. Noticing our position, he helped us to re-erect the tent and Dovers then went out and piled snow over the torn seam. Moyes said that Harrisson and he had been fairly comfortable, although the cap of their tent was slowly tearing with the pressure of the wind and snow on the weather panels....

"At 6:30 PM, the storm calmed down a bit, and during a brief break, Moyes came out to feed the dogs. Seeing where we were, he helped us set the tent back up, and then Dovers went outside to pile snow over the ripped seam. Moyes mentioned that he and Harrisson had been fairly comfortable, even though the top of their tent was gradually tearing from the wind and snow pressing against the weather panels...."

"On Friday, the 18th, Swiss, one of the dogs, returned very thin after six days' absence from the camp.

"On Friday, the 18th, Swiss, one of the dogs, came back very skinny after being gone from the camp for six days."

"On the following Monday the blizzard moderated somewhat and we proceeded to make our quarters more roomy by digging out the floor and undercutting the sides, thus lowering the level about eighteen inches.

"On the following Monday, the blizzard eased up a bit, and we started to make our space roomier by digging out the floor and undercutting the sides, which lowered the level by about eighteen inches."

"Our tent now looks as if it were half blown over. To relieve the tremendous strain on the cap, we lowered the feet of the two lee poles on to the new floor. The tent now offered very little resistance to the wind. We were able to communicate with Harrisson and Moyes and they said they were all right."

"Our tent now looks like it's half blown over. To ease the intense pressure on the cap, we lowered the feet of the two lee poles onto the new floor. The tent now provided very little resistance to the wind. We could talk to Harrisson and Moyes, and they said they were fine."

When the snow and wind at last held up, they immediately made down to the sea-ice and back towards home, and, when they met us, had done nineteen miles. All were stiff next day, and no wonder; a march of twenty-eight miles after lying low for seventeen days is a very strenuous day's work.

When the snow and wind finally stopped, they quickly headed for the sea ice and back home, and when they joined us, they had covered nineteen miles. Everyone was sore the next day, and it’s no surprise; marching twenty-eight miles after being on the ground for seventeen days is an exhausting day’s work.

Preparations were made on October 28 for the main eastern summer journey, the object of which was to survey as much coast-line as possible and at the same time to carry on geological work, surveying and magnetics. The party was to consist of Kennedy, Watson and myself.

Preparations were made on October 28 for the main eastern summer trip, the goal of which was to survey as much coastline as possible while also conducting geological work, surveying, and magnetics. The group would include Kennedy, Watson, and me.

Jones, Dovers and Hoadley were to start on the main western journey on November 2. I arranged that Harrisson and Moyes should remain at the Hut, the latter to carry on meteorological work, and Harrisson biology and sketching. Later, Harrisson proposed to accompany me as far as the Hippo depot, bringing the dogs and providing a supporting party. At first I did not like the idea, as he would have to travel one hundred miles alone, but he showed me that he could erect a tent by himself and, as summer and better weather were in sight, I agreed that he should come.

Jones, Dovers, and Hoadley were set to begin their main journey west on November 2. I arranged for Harrisson and Moyes to stay at the Hut, with Moyes handling the weather observations and Harrisson focusing on biology and sketching. Later, Harrisson suggested that he join me as far as the Hippo depot, bringing the dogs and forming a support crew. At first, I was hesitant about this since he would be traveling a hundred miles alone, but he demonstrated that he could set up a tent by himself, and with summer and better weather approaching, I agreed to let him come.

Each party was taking fourteen weeks' provisions, and I had an additional four weeks' supply for Harrisson and the dogs. My total load came to nine hundred and seventy pounds; the dogs pulling four hundred pounds with the assistance of one man and three of us dragging five hundred and seventy pounds.

Each group was carrying supplies for fourteen weeks, and I had an extra four weeks' worth for Harrisson and the dogs. My total load weighed nine hundred seventy pounds; the dogs were pulling four hundred pounds with help from one person, while the three of us were dragging five hundred seventy pounds.





CHAPTER XXI THE WESTERN BASE—BLOCKED ON THE SHELF-ICE

by F. Wild

We started away on the main eastern journey with a spurt of eleven miles on a calm and cloudless day, intending to follow our former track over the shelf-ice to the Hippo Nunatak. The surface varied; soft patches putting a steady brake on the ardour of the first, fresh hours of marching.

We set off on the main eastern journey with a burst of eleven miles on a clear and sunny day, planning to retrace our previous route over the shelf ice to the Hippo Nunatak. The surface varied; soft spots slowing down the enthusiasm of our initial hours of marching.

In the afternoon, it was only necessary to wear a shirt, singlet, heavy pyjama trousers, finnesko and socks, and even then one perspired freely. The temperature stood at 17 degrees F. The dogs pulled their load well, requiring help only over loose snow.

In the afternoon, all that was needed was a shirt, tank top, warm pajama pants, slippers, and socks, and even then, it was easy to sweat. The temperature was 17 degrees Fahrenheit. The dogs pulled their load effectively, needing assistance only in loose snow.

The evening of Friday November 1, 1912, saw us past Masson Island and about ten miles from the mainland. All day there had been a chill easterly breeze, the temperature being well below zero. The sky was hazy with cirro-stratus and a fine halo "ringed" the sun.

The evening of Friday, November 1, 1912, found us past Masson Island and about ten miles away from the mainland. There had been a chilly easterly breeze all day, with the temperature well below freezing. The sky was hazy with cirrostratus clouds, and a fine halo surrounded the sun.

Looking out from the tent in the morning we saw that the clouds were dense and lowering, but the breezes were light and variable until 5 P.M., when an east-north-east wind arose, bringing snow in its train. Travelling through foggy drift, we could just ascertain that the Bay of Winds had opened up on the right. The day's march was a good one of sixteen miles thirty-five yards.

Looking out from the tent in the morning, we saw that the clouds were thick and low, but the breezes were light and changeable until 5 P.M., when an east-north-east wind picked up, bringing snow with it. As we traveled through the foggy snow, we could barely see that the Bay of Winds had opened up on our right. We made a solid journey of sixteen miles and thirty-five yards that day.

The Bay of Winds did not belie its name. Throughout November 3 the wind veered about in gusts and after lunch settled down to a hard south-easter.

The Bay of Winds lived up to its name. On November 3, the wind shifted in gusts, and after lunch, it settled into a strong southeast breeze.

We had made a good start; more than sixty-two miles in a little over four days. The camp was half-way across the Bay of Winds, with the Alligator Nunatak six miles off on the "starboard bow" and the Rock of the Avalanches seventeen miles straight ahead. Passing glimpses were caught of the Hippo twenty-four miles distant.

We had made a solid start; over sixty-two miles in just a little more than four days. The camp was halfway across the Bay of Winds, with the Alligator Nunatak six miles off to the right and the Rock of the Avalanches seventeen miles straight ahead. We caught fleeting glimpses of the Hippo, which was twenty-four miles away.

On November 5, after a day's blizzard, there was much accumulated snow to shovel away from tents and sledges. Finding the hauling very arduous, we headed in for the land to find a better surface, passing the Alligator Nunatak close on its southern side.

On November 5, after a day of heavy snowfall, there was a lot of snow to shovel off the tents and sledges. Finding the hauling really tough, we made our way to the land in search of a better surface, passing the Alligator Nunatak closely on its southern side.

At noon on the 6th, the sledges were running parallel to the Rock of the Avalanches, three miles away, and soon afterwards we came to a large boulder; one of four in a line from the rock-cliffs, from which they had been evidently transported, as they were composed of the same gneiss.

At noon on the 6th, the sledges were traveling alongside the Rock of the Avalanches, three miles away, and shortly after that, we arrived at a large boulder; one of four lined up from the rock cliffs, from which they had clearly been moved, as they were made of the same gneiss.

The Hippo was close at hand at four o'clock and, on nearing the shattered ice about the depot, we released the dogs and pulled the sledge ourselves. On being freed, they galloped over to the rock and were absent for over an hour. When they returned, Amundsen's head was daubed with egg-yolk, as we thought. This was most probable as scores of snow petrels were flying about the rocks.

The Hippo was nearby at four o'clock, and as we approached the broken ice around the depot, we let the dogs go and pulled the sled ourselves. As soon as they were freed, they raced over to the rock and were gone for more than an hour. When they came back, Amundsen's head was smeared with what we assumed was egg yolk. This seemed likely since there were lots of snow petrels flying around the rocks.

A nasty shock was awaiting us at the depot. The sledge, which had been left on end, two feet buried in hard snow and with a mound six feet high built round it, had been blown completely away. The stays, secured to foodbags, were both broken; one food-bag weighing sixty-eight pounds having been lifted ten feet. This was a very serious loss as the total load to be carried now amounted to one thousand one hundred and eighty pounds, which was too great a weight to be supported by one sledge.

A nasty surprise awaited us at the depot. The sledge, which had been left upright, two feet buried in hard snow with a six-foot high mound built around it, had been completely blown away. The stays, attached to the food bags, were both broken; one food bag weighing sixty-eight pounds had been lifted ten feet. This was a significant loss because the total load to be carried now added up to one thousand one hundred eighty pounds, which was too heavy for one sledge to handle.

It appeared, then, that the only thing to do was to include Harrisson in the party, so that we could have his sledge. This would facilitate our progress considerably, but against that was the fact that Moyes would be left alone at the Base under the belief that Harrisson had perished.

It seemed that the only option was to include Harrisson in the group so we could use his sledge. This would greatly improve our progress, but on the downside, Moyes would be left alone at the Base thinking that Harrisson had died.

A gale was blowing on the 7th, but as we were partly under the lee of the Hippo, it was only felt in gusts. A visit was made to the Nunatak; Harrisson to examine the birds, Watson for geology and photography, while I climbed to the summit with the field-glasses to look for the missing sledge. Kennedy remained at the camp to take a series of magnetic observations.

A strong wind was blowing on the 7th, but since we were mostly sheltered by the Hippo, we only felt it in bursts. We made a trip to the Nunatak; Harrisson went to check out the birds, Watson focused on geology and photography, while I climbed to the top with the binoculars to search for the missing sledge. Kennedy stayed at the camp to take a series of magnetic readings.

There were hundreds of snow petrels pairing off, but no eggs were seen in any of the nest-crevices. They were so tame that it was quite easy to catch them, but they had a habit of ejecting their partially digested food, a yellow oily mess, straight at one. This was the stuff we had thought was egg-yolk on Amundsen's head the previous night.

There were hundreds of snow petrels forming pairs, but no eggs were found in any of the nest crevices. They were so tame that it was really easy to catch them, but they had a tendency to spit out their partially digested food, a yellow gooey mess, right at you. This was what we had mistakenly believed was egg yolk on Amundsen's head the night before.

Upon returning to camp, the search for the sledge was continued. After prospecting with a spade in possible snow-drifts and crevasse-lids, we walked out fanwise, in the direction of the prevailing wind, but with no result. I decided, therefore, to take Harrisson with me. I was extremely sorry for Moyes, but it could not be helped.

Upon returning to camp, we continued the search for the sled. After digging around in possible snow drifts and crevasse covers, we spread out in a fan shape, moving with the direction of the prevailing wind, but didn't find anything. I decided to take Harrisson with me. I felt really sorry for Moyes, but there was nothing that could be done.

On the way back towards the land to the south, we found that the surface had improved in the morning's gale. Camp was finally pitched on a slope close to the high land.

On the way back to the land to the south, we noticed that the surface had improved after the morning's storm. Camp was finally set up on a slope near the high ground.

The coast, from the Base to this spot—Delay Point—runs almost due east and west and with no deep indentations except the Bay of Winds. To the west, the slope from the inland plateau is fairly gradual and therefore not badly broken, but still farther west it is much steeper, coming down from two thousand feet in a very short distance, over tumbling ice-fields and frozen cascades. Several outcrops of dark rock lay to the east, one of them only two miles away.

The coast, from the Base to this point—Delay Point—runs almost directly east and west with no significant indentations except for the Bay of Winds. To the west, the slope from the inland plateau is relatively gentle and therefore not too rugged, but further west it gets much steeper, dropping from two thousand feet in a very short distance over tumbling ice fields and frozen cascades. Several outcrops of dark rock are to the east, one of them just two miles away.

The wind-velocity fluctuated between sixty and eighty miles per hour, keeping us securely penned. Harrisson and Kennedy, after battling their way to our tent for a meal, used the second primus and cooker, brought for Harrisson, in their own tent. All we could do was to smoke and listen to the fierce squalls and lashing drift. I had brought nothing to read on the trip, making up the weight in tobacco. Watson had Palgrave's 'Golden Lyrics', Kennedy, an engineer's hand-book, and Harrisson, a portion of the 'Reign of Mary Tudor'. There was a tiny pack of patience cards, but they were in the instrument-box on the sledge and none of us cared to face the gale to get them.

The wind speed varied between sixty and eighty miles per hour, keeping us stuck inside. Harrisson and Kennedy, after fighting their way to our tent for a meal, used the second stove and cooker brought for Harrisson in their own tent. All we could do was smoke and listen to the intense squalls and driving snow. I hadn't brought anything to read on the trip, opting instead to pack extra tobacco. Watson had Palgrave's 'Golden Lyrics,' Kennedy had an engineer's handbook, and Harrisson had part of the 'Reign of Mary Tudor.' There were a few patience cards, but they were in the instrument box on the sled, and none of us wanted to brave the storm to retrieve them.

The wind, on the 10th, saw fit to moderate to half a gale; the drift creeping low and thick over the ground; the land visible above it. Donning burberrys, we made an excursion to the rocks ahead. Two miles and a climb of six hundred feet were rather exhausting in the strong wind. There were about eighty acres of rock exposed on the edge of the ice-cap, mainly composed of mica schists and some granite; the whole extensively weathered. A line of moraine ran from the rocks away in an east-north-east direction.

The wind, on the 10th, calmed down to about half a gale; the snow drift was creeping low and thick across the ground, making the land visible above it. Putting on our raincoats, we took a trip to the rocks ahead. The two-mile trek and a climb of six hundred feet were pretty tiring in the strong wind. There were about eighty acres of rock visible at the edge of the ice cap, mostly made up of mica schists and some granite, and the entire area was heavily weathered. A line of moraine extended from the rocks out towards the east-northeast.

Most of the next day was broken by a heavy gale and, since the prospect ahead was nothing but bare, rough ice, we passed the day in making everything ready for a start and repaired a torn tent. The rent was made by Amundsen, who dragged up the ice-axe to which he was tethered and, in running round the tent, drove the point of the axe through it, narrowly missing Kennedy's head inside.

Most of the next day was interrupted by a strong gale, and since all we could see ahead was just bare, rough ice, we spent the day getting everything ready to leave and fixing a torn tent. The tear was caused by Amundsen, who dragged the ice axe he was tied to and, while running around the tent, accidentally drove the point of the axe through it, barely missing Kennedy's head inside.

Tuesday November 12 was an interesting day. The greater part of the track was over rippled, level ice, thrown into many billows, through devious pressure-hummocks and between the inevitable crevasses. The coast was a kaleidoscope of sable rocks, blue cascades, and fissured ice-falls. Fifteen miles ahead stood an island twenty miles long, rising in bare peaks and dark knolls. This was eventually named David Island.

Tuesday, November 12, was an interesting day. Most of the track was over rippled, flat ice, thrown into many waves, through winding pressure ridges and between the unavoidable crevasses. The coast was a mix of black rocks, blue waterfalls, and cracked ice falls. Fifteen miles ahead was an island twenty miles long, rising in bare peaks and dark hills. This was eventually named David Island.

The dogs were working very well and, if only a little additional food could be procured for them, I knew they could be kept alive. Zip broke loose one night and ate one of my socks which was hanging on the sledge to dry; it probably tasted of seal blubber from the boots. Switzerland, too, was rather a bother, eating his harness whenever he had a chance.

The dogs were performing really well, and if I could just get a bit more food for them, I knew I could keep them alive. One night, Zip broke free and ate one of my socks that was drying on the sled; it probably tasted like seal blubber from my boots. Switzerland was also a bit of a headache, chewing on his harness whenever he got the chance.

On the 14th, a depot was formed, consisting of one week's provisions and oil; the bags being buried and a mound erected with a flag on top. Kennedy took a round of angles to determine its position.

On the 14th, a storage site was set up, containing a week's worth of supplies and oil; the bags were buried, and a mound was built with a flag on top. Kennedy took a survey of angles to figure out its location.

At the end of two snowy days, after we had avoided many ugly crevasses, our course in an east-south-east line pointed to a narrow strait between David Island and the mainland. On the southern side of the former, there was a heaped line of pressure-ice, caused by the flow from a narrow bay being stopped by the Island. After lunch, on the 16th, there was an hour's good travelling and then we suddenly pulled into a half-mile of broken surface—the confluence of the slowly moving land-ice and of the more rapidly moving ice from a valley on our right, from which issued Reid Glacier. It was impossible to steer the dogs through it with a load, so we lightened the loads on both sledges and then made several journeys backwards and forwards over the more broken areas, allowing the dogs to run loose. The crevasses ran tortuously in every direction and falls into them were not uncommon. One large lid fell in just as a sledge had cleared it, leaving a hole twelve feet wide, and at least a hundred feet deep. Once over this zone, the sledges were worked along the slope leading to the mainland where we were continually worried by their slipping sideways.

At the end of two snowy days, after avoiding many deep cracks in the ice, we headed in a southeast direction toward a narrow strait between David Island and the mainland. On the southern side of the island, there was a piled-up line of pressure ice, created by the flow from a narrow bay that was blocked by the island. After lunch on the 16th, we had an hour of decent travel, then suddenly found ourselves in half a mile of broken surface—the meeting point of the slowly moving land ice and the faster-moving ice from a valley to our right, where Reid Glacier flowed. It was impossible to guide the dogs through with the load, so we lightened the loads on both sledges and made several trips back and forth over the rougher areas, letting the dogs run free. The crevasses twisted in every direction, and falling into them happened often. One large crack opened up just as a sledge had passed, creating a hole that was twelve feet wide and at least a hundred feet deep. Once we got past this area, we moved the sledges along the slope leading to the mainland, where we were constantly worried about them slipping sideways.

Ahead was a vast sea of crushed ice, tossed and piled in every direction. On the northern horizon rose what we concluded to be a flat-topped, castellated berg. Ten days later, it resolved itself into a tract of heavy pressure ridges.

Ahead was a huge expanse of crushed ice, scattered and piled up in every direction. On the northern horizon, we saw what we figured was a flat-topped, castle-like iceberg. Ten days later, it turned into an area of thick pressure ridges.

Camping after nine and a half miles, we were surprised, on moving east in the morning, to sight clearly the point—Cape Gerlache—of a peninsula running inland to the southwest. A glacier from the hinterland, pushing out from its valley, had broken up the shelf-ice on which we were travelling to such an extent that nothing without wings could cross it. Our object was to map in the coastline as far east as possible, and the problem, now, was whether to go north or south. From our position the former looked the best, the tumbled shelf-ice appearing to smooth out sufficiently, about ten miles away, to afford a passage east, while, to the south, we scanned the Denman Glacier, as it was named, rolling in magnificent cascades, twelve miles in breadth, from a height of more than three thousand feet. To get round the head of this ice-stream would mean travelling inland for at least thirty miles.

Camping after nine and a half miles, we were surprised, the next morning, to clearly see the point—Cape Gerlache—of a peninsula that extended inland to the southwest. A glacier from the interior, pushing out from its valley, had broken up the shelf ice we were traveling on to the point where nothing without wings could cross it. Our goal was to map the coastline as far east as possible, and the question now was whether to go north or south. From our position, north seemed like the better option, as the jumbled shelf ice appeared to flatten out enough, about ten miles ahead, to allow for a passage east, while to the south, we observed the Denman Glacier, as it was called, flowing in magnificent cascades, twelve miles wide, from a height of over three thousand feet. To get around the end of this ice stream would mean traveling inland for at least thirty miles.

So north we went, getting back to our old surface over a heavy "cross sea," honeycombed with pits and chasms; many of them with no visible bottom. There was half a mile to safety, but the area had to be crossed five times; the load on the twelve-foot sledge being so much, that half the weight was taken off and the empty sledges brought back for the other half. Last of all came the dogs' sledge. Kennedy remarked during the afternoon that he felt like a fly walking on wire-netting.

So north we went, returning to our old surface over a rough "cross sea," full of pits and deep gaps; many of them with no clear bottom. We had half a mile to safety, but we had to cross the area five times; the weight on the twelve-foot sledge was so heavy that we took off half the load and brought back the empty sledges for the other half. Finally, the dogs' sledge came last. During the afternoon, Kennedy commented that he felt like a fly walking on wire mesh.

The camp was pitched in a line of pressure, with wide crevasses and "hell-holes" within a few yards on every side. Altogether the day's march had been a miserable four miles. On several occasions, during the night, while in this disturbed area, sounds of movement were distinctly heard; cracks like rifle shots and others similar to distant heavy guns, accompanied by a weird, moaning noise as of the glacier moving over rocks.

The camp was set up in a line of pressure, with wide cracks and "hell-holes" just a few yards away on every side. Overall, the day's march had been a tough four miles. Several times during the night, while in this unstable area, sounds of movement were clearly heard; cracks like rifle shots and others similar to distant heavy artillery, along with a strange, moaning noise as the glacier shifted over the rocks.

November 18 was a fine, bright day: temperature 8 degrees to 20 degrees F. Until lunch, the course was mainly north for more than five miles. Then I went with Watson to trace out a road through a difficult area in front. At this point, there broke on us a most rugged and wonderful vision of ice-scenery.

November 18 was a nice, sunny day: temperature 8 to 20 degrees F. Until lunch, the route headed mostly north for over five miles. Then I teamed up with Watson to map out a road through a challenging area ahead. At that moment, we were greeted with an incredible and stunning view of icy landscapes.

The Denman Glacier moving much more rapidly than the Shackleton Shelf, tore through the latter and, in doing so, shattered both its own sides and also a considerable area of the larger ice-sheet. At the actual point of contact was what might be referred to as gigantic bergschrund: an enormous chasm over one thousand feet wide and from three hundred feet to four hundred feet deep, in the bottom of which crevasses appeared to go down for ever. The sides were splintered and crumpled, glittering in the sunlight with a million sparklets of light. Towering above were titanic blocks of carven ice. The whole was the wildest, maddest and yet the grandest thing imaginable.

The Denman Glacier was moving much faster

The turmoil continued to the north, so I resolved to reconnoitre westward and see if a passage were visible from the crest of David Island.

The chaos carried on to the north, so I decided to scout westward and check if a path was visible from the top of David Island.

The excursion was postponed till next day, when Kennedy, Watson and I roped up and commenced to thread a tangled belt of crevasses. The island was three and a half miles from the camp, exposing a bare ridge and a jutting bluff, nine hundred feet high—Watson Bluff. At the Bluff the rock was almost all gneiss, very much worn by the action of ice. The face to the summit was so steep and coarsely weathered that we took risks in climbing it. Moss and lichens grew luxuriantly and scores of snow petrels hovered around, but no eggs were seen.

The trip was pushed back to the next day, when Kennedy, Watson, and I geared up and started to navigate a messy area full of crevasses. The island was three and a half miles from our camp, showing a bare ridge and a prominent bluff, nine hundred feet high—Watson Bluff. At the Bluff, the rock was mostly gneiss, heavily worn down by the ice. The slope to the top was so steep and rough that we were taking risks while climbing. Moss and lichens thrived there, and lots of snow petrels flew around, but we didn't see any eggs.

Owing to an overcast sky, the view was not a great deal more enlightening than that which we had had from below. The Denman Glacier swept down for forty miles from over three thousand feet above sea-level. For twenty miles to the east torn ice-masses lay distorted in confusion, and beyond that, probably sixty miles distant, were several large stretches of bare rock-like islands.

Due to the cloudy sky, the view wasn’t much more revealing than what we had seen from below. The Denman Glacier extended for forty miles from over three thousand feet above sea level. To the east, for twenty miles, fragmented ice masses were scattered chaotically, and beyond that, likely sixty miles away, there were several large patches of bare rock that looked like islands.

On November 20, a strong north-east wind blew, with falling snow. Nothing could be seen but a white blanket, above, below and all around; so, with sudden death lurking in the bottomless crevasses on every hand, we stayed in camp.

On November 20, a strong northeast wind blew, bringing falling snow. All we could see was a white blanket above, below, and all around us; so, with the threat of sudden death lurking in the deep crevasses all around, we stayed in camp.

A blizzard of great violence blew for two days and the tent occupied by Kennedy and myself threatened to collapse. We stowed all our gear in the sleeping-bags or in a hole from which snow had been dug for cooking. By the second day we had become extremely tired of lying down. One consolation was that our lips, which were very sore from exposure to the sun and wind, had now a chance of healing.

A fierce blizzard raged for two days, and the tent that Kennedy and I were in was on the verge of collapsing. We packed all our gear into the sleeping bags or in a dugout where we had been cooking. By the second day, we were really tired of lying down. One small comfort was that our lips, which were very chapped from the sun and wind, finally had a chance to heal.

Next afternoon, the gale moderated sufficiently for us to go once more to David Island, in clearer weather, to see the outlook from the bluff. This time the sun was shining on the mainland and on the extension of the glacier past the bluff to the north. The distant southern slopes were seamed with a pattern of crevasses up to a height of three thousand feet. To the north, although the way was certainly impassable for twelve miles, it appeared to become smoother beyond that limit. We decided to try and cross in that direction.

The next afternoon, the storm calmed down enough for us to head back to David Island, under clearer skies, to check out the view from the bluff. This time, the sun was shining on the mainland and the glacier stretching north past the bluff. The distant southern slopes were marked with a pattern of crevasses reaching up to three thousand feet. To the north, even though the path was definitely blocked for twelve miles, it seemed to get smoother beyond that point. We decided to attempt crossing in that direction.

We persevered on the 24th over many lines of pressure-ice and then camped near an especially rough patch. Watson had the worst fall on that day, going down ten feet vertically into a crevasse before his harness stopped him. After supper, we went to locate a trail ahead, and were greatly surprised to find salt water in some of the cracks. It meant that in two days our descent had been considerable, since the great bergschrund farther south was well over three hundred feet in depth and no water had appeared in its depths.

We pushed through on the 24th over a lot of pressure ice and then set up camp near a particularly rough area. Watson had the worst fall that day, dropping ten feet straight down into a crevasse before his harness caught him. After dinner, we went to find a trail ahead and were really surprised to see salt water in some of the cracks. This indicated that we had descended quite a bit in two days, since the big bergschrund further south was well over three hundred feet deep and there hadn’t been any water visible down there.

A few extracts from the diary recall a situation which daily became more serious and involved:

A few excerpts from the diary remember a situation that grew more serious and complicated every day:

"Monday, November 25. A beautiful day so far as the weather and scenery are concerned but a very hard one. We have been amongst 'Pressure,' with a capital P, all day, hauling up and lowering the sledges with an alpine rope and twisting and turning in all directions, with waves and hills, monuments, statues, and fairy palaces all around us, from a few feet to over three hundred feet in height. It is impossible to see more than a few hundred yards ahead at any time, so we go on for a bit, then climb a peak or mound, choose a route and struggle on for another short stage.

"Monday, November 25. It's been a beautiful day in terms of the weather and scenery, but it has been really tough. We've been dealing with 'Pressure,' with a capital P, all day, hauling up and lowering the sledges with an alpine rope and twisting and turning in all directions, surrounded by waves and hills, monuments, statues, and fairy palaces all around us, ranging from a few feet to over three hundred feet high. It's impossible to see more than a few hundred yards ahead at any time, so we move forward a bit, then climb a peak or mound, choose a route, and push on for another short stretch."

"We have all suffered from the sun to-day; Kennedy has caught it worst, his lips, cheeks, nose and forehead are all blistered. He has auburn hair and the tender skin which frequently goes with it....

"We have all been affected by the sun today; Kennedy has it the worst, with his lips, cheeks, nose, and forehead all blistered. He has reddish-brown hair and the delicate skin that often comes with it...."

"Tuesday, November 26. Another very hard day's work. The first half-mile took three hours to cover; in several places we had to cut roads with ice-axes and shovels and also to build a bridge across a water-lead. At 1 P.M. we had done just one mile. I never saw or dreamt of anything so gloriously beautiful as some of the stuff we have come through this morning. After lunch the country changed entirely. In place of the confused jumble and crush we have had, we got on to neve slopes; huge billows, half a mile to a mile from crest to crest, meshed with crevasses...

"Tuesday, November 26. Another really tough day at work. The first half-mile took three hours to finish; in several spots, we had to clear paths with ice axes and shovels and also build a bridge over a waterway. By 1 P.M., we had only managed to cover one mile. I’ve never seen or imagined anything as stunningly beautiful as some of the scenery we passed through this morning. After lunch, the landscape changed completely. Instead of the chaotic mess we dealt with earlier, we moved onto snow slopes; massive waves, half a mile to a mile apart from peak to peak, interspersed with crevasses..."

"We all had falls into these during the day: Harrisson dropping fifteen feet. I received rather a nasty squeeze through falling into a hole whilst going downhill, the sledge running on to me before I could get clear, and pinning me down. So far as we can see, the same kind of country continues, and one cannot help thinking about having to return through this infernal mess. The day's distance—only one thousand and fifty yards.

"We all took some falls during the day: Harrisson fell fifteen feet. I had a bad squeeze when I fell into a hole while going downhill, and the sledge ran over me before I could get out of the way, pinning me down. From what we can see, the same kind of terrain continues, and we can’t help but dread having to go back through this terrible mess. The day's distance—only one thousand and fifty yards."

"Wednesday, November 27. When I wrote last night about coming back, I little thought it would be so soon. We turn back to-morrow for the simple reason that we cannot go on any farther.

"Wednesday, November 27. When I wrote last night about coming back, I hardly thought it would be so soon. We're turning back tomorrow for the straightforward reason that we can’t go any further."

"In the morning, for nearly a mile along a valley running south-east, the travelling was almost good; then our troubles commenced again.

"In the morning, for almost a mile along a valley heading southeast, the journey was pretty decent; then our problems started up again."

"Several times we had to resort to hand-hauling with the alpine rope through acres of pitfalls. The bridges of those which were covered were generally very rotten, except the wide ones. Just before lunch we had a very stiff uphill pull and then a drop into a large basin, three-quarters of a mile in diameter.

"Several times we had to rely on manually hauling with the alpine rope through acres of hazards. The bridges that were covered were mostly pretty unstable, except for the wider ones. Just before lunch, we faced a tough uphill climb and then dropped into a large basin that was about three-quarters of a mile across."

"The afternoon was spent in vain searching for a road.... On every side are huge waves split in every direction by crevasses up to two hundred feet in width. The general trend of the main crevasses is north and south....

"The afternoon was wasted looking for a road.... All around are enormous waves broken apart by cracks as wide as two hundred feet. The main cracks mostly run north and south...."

"I have, therefore, decided to go back and if possible follow the road we came by, then proceed south on to the inland ice-cap and find out the source of this chaos. If we are able to get round it and proceed east, so much the better; but at any rate, we shall be doing something and getting somewhere. We could push through farther east from here, but it would be by lowering the gear piecemeal into chasms fifty to one hundred feet deep, and hauling it up on the other side; each crevasse taking at least two hours to negotiate. For such slow progress I don't feel justified in risking the lives of the party."

"I've decided to go back and, if possible, follow the route we took before. Then, we'll head south toward the inland ice cap to figure out where all this chaos is coming from. If we can get around it and move east, that would be even better; but either way, we'll be making progress. We could push further east from here, but that would mean lowering our gear into crevasses that are fifty to one hundred feet deep and pulling it up on the other side, with each crevasse taking at least two hours to get through. I don’t think it’s worth risking the lives of the team for such slow progress."

Snow fell for four days, at times thickly, unaccompanied by wind. It was useless to stir in our precarious position. Being a little in hand in the ration of biscuits, we fed the dogs on our food, their own having run out. I was anxious to keep them alive until we were out of the pressure-ice.

Snow fell for four days, sometimes heavily, without any wind. It was pointless to move in our unstable situation. Since we had a little extra in our biscuit rations, we fed the dogs with our food because they had run out. I was worried about keeping them alive until we made it out of the pressure ice.

From this, our turning-point out on the shelf-ice, the trail lay over eighteen inches of soft snow on December 3, our former tracks, of course, having been entirely obliterated. The bridged crevasses were now entirely hidden and many weak lids were found.

From this turning point on the shelf ice, the path stretched over eighteen inches of soft snow on December 3, with our previous tracks completely erased. The bridged crevasses were now completely concealed, and many weak lids were discovered.

At 9 A.M. Harrisson, Watson and I roped up to mark a course over a very bad place, leaving Kennedy with the dogs. We had only gone about one hundred yards when I got a very heavy jerk on the rope and, on looking round, found that Watson had disappeared. He weighs two hundred pounds in his clothes and the crevasse into which he had fallen was fifteen feet wide. He had broken through on the far side and the rope, cutting through the bridge, stopped in the middle so that he could not reach the sides to help himself in any way. Kennedy brought another rope over and threw it down to Watson and we were then able to haul him up, but it was twenty minutes before he was out. He reappeared smiling, and, except for a bruise on the shin and the loss of a glove, was no worse for the fall.

At 9 A.M., Harrisson, Watson, and I tied ourselves to a rope to mark a course over a really bad area, leaving Kennedy with the dogs. We had only gone about one hundred yards when I felt a heavy jerk on the rope. When I looked back, I realized Watson had disappeared. He weighs two hundred pounds in his clothes, and the crevasse he fell into was fifteen feet wide. He had broken through on the other side, and the rope, cutting through the bridge, stopped in the middle, making it impossible for him to reach the sides for help. Kennedy brought over another rope and threw it down to Watson, and we were finally able to pull him up, but it took twenty minutes before he was out. He came back smiling, and aside from a bruise on his shin and a lost glove, he was fine after the fall.

At 2.30 P.M. we were all dead-beat, camping with one mile one thousand seven hundred yards on the meter. One-third of this distance was relay work and, in several places, standing pulls with the alpine rope. The course was a series of Z's, S's, and hairpin turns, the longest straight stretch one hundred and fifty yards, and the whole knee-deep in soft snow, the sledges sinking to the cross-bars.

At 2:30 P.M., we were all exhausted, having covered one mile and one thousand seven hundred yards on the meter. A third of this distance involved relay work, and in several spots, we had to pull with the alpine rope. The route consisted of a series of Z's, S's, and hairpin turns, with the longest straight stretch being one hundred fifty yards, and the whole thing knee-deep in soft snow, causing the sledges to sink down to the cross-bars.

The 4th was a repetition of the previous day—a terribly hard two and a half miles. We all had "hangman's drops" into crevasses. One snow-bridge, ten feet wide, fell in as the meter following the twelve-foot sledge was going over behind it.

The 4th was just like the day before—a really tough two and a half miles. We all had "hangman's drops" into crevasses. One snowbridge, ten feet wide, collapsed just as the meter following the twelve-foot sled was crossing behind it.

The 5th was a day of wind, scurrying snow and bad light. Harrisson went out to feed the dogs in the morning and broke through the lid of a crevasse, but fortunately caught the side and climbed out.

The 5th was a day of wind, blowing snow, and poor visibility. Harrisson went out to feed the dogs in the morning and fell through the lid of a crevasse, but luckily he grabbed the side and climbed out.

The diary again:

The journal again:

"Friday, December 6. Still bad light and a little snowfall, but we were off at ten o'clock. I was leading and fell into at least a dozen crevasses, but had to be hauled out of one only. At 1.30 P.M. we arrived at the open lead we had crossed on the outward journey and found the same place. There had been much movement since then and we had to make a bridge, cutting away projections in some places and filling up the sea-water channels with snow and ice. Then Harrisson crossed with the aid of two bamboo poles, and hauled me over on a sledge. Harrisson and I on one side and Kennedy and Watson on the other then hauled the sledges backwards and forwards, lightly loaded one way and empty the other, until all was across. The shelf-ice is without doubt afloat, if the presence of sea-water and diatomaceous stains on the ice is of any account. We camped to-night in the same place as on the evening of November 25, so with luck we should be out of this mess to-morrow. Switzerland had to be killed as I cannot afford any more biscuit. Amundsen ate his flesh without hesitation, but Zip refused it."

"Friday, December 6. The light was still bad with a little snowfall, but we left at ten o'clock. I was leading and fell into at least a dozen crevasses, but only needed to be pulled out of one. At 1:30 P.M., we reached the open lead we had crossed on the way out and found the same spot. There had been a lot of movement since then, so we had to build a bridge by cutting away some projections and filling in the sea-water channels with snow and ice. Then Harrisson crossed with the help of two bamboo poles and pulled me over on a sled. Harrisson and I were on one side while Kennedy and Watson were on the other, and we pulled the sleds back and forth, lightly loaded one way and empty the other, until everything was across. The shelf-ice is definitely floating, considering the presence of sea-water and diatom stains on the ice. We camped tonight at the same place as the evening of November 25, so with a bit of luck, we should be out of this mess tomorrow. I had to eat the Swiss biscuit stash since I can't afford any more. Amundsen ate his meat without hesitation, but Zip refused to."

Sure enough, two days sufficed to bring us under the bluff on David Island. As the tents were being pitched, a skua gull flew down. I snared him with a line, using dog's flesh for bait and we had stewed skua for dinner. It was excellent.

Sure enough, two days were enough to get us under the bluff on David Island. While we were setting up the tents, a skua gull swooped down. I caught it with a line, using dog meat for bait, and we had stewed skua for dinner. It was delicious.

While I was cooking the others climbed up the rocks and brought back eight snow petrels and five eggs, with the news that many more birds were nesting. After supper we all went out and secured sixty eggs and fifty-eight birds. It seemed a fearful crime to kill these beautiful, pure white creatures, but it meant fourteen days' life for the dogs end longer marches for us.

While I was cooking, the others climbed up the rocks and brought back eight snow petrels and five eggs, along with the news that many more birds were nesting. After dinner, we all went out and collected sixty eggs and fifty-eight birds. It felt like a terrible crime to kill these beautiful, pure white creatures, but it meant fourteen days of life for the dogs and longer treks for us.

Fresh breeze, light snow and a bad light on the 9th; we remained in camp. Two more skuas were snared for the evening's dinner. The snow petrels' eggs were almost as large as hens' eggs and very good to eat when fresh. Many of them had been under the birds rather too long, but although they did not look so nice, there was little difference in the taste. I was very glad to get this fresh food, as we had lived on tinned meat most of the year and there was always the danger of scurvy.

Fresh breeze, light snow, and poor visibility on the 9th; we stayed in camp. Two more skuas were caught for dinner. The snow petrels' eggs were nearly the size of chicken eggs and really tasty when fresh. Many of them had been under the birds for a bit too long, but even though they didn't look as appealing, there was hardly any difference in taste. I was really glad to have this fresh food, as we had been surviving on canned meat for most of the year and there was always the risk of scurvy.

The light was too changeable to make a satisfactory start until the evening of December 11, when we managed to dodge through four and a half miles of broken ice, reaching the mainland close to our position on November 16, and camping for lunch at midnight. In front was a clear mile on a peninsula and then the way led across Robinson Bay, seven miles wide, fed by the Northcliffe Glacier.

The light was too unpredictable to make a good start until the evening of December 11, when we finally managed to navigate through four and a half miles of broken ice, reaching the mainland near where we were on November 16, and stopping for lunch at midnight. Ahead was a clear mile on a peninsula, and then the route took us across Robinson Bay, seven miles wide, fed by the Northcliffe Glacier.

Another night march was commenced at 8 P.M. The day had been cloudless and the sun very warm, softening the surface, but at the time of starting it was hardening rapidly. Crossing the peninsula we resolved to head across Robinson Bay as the glacier's surface was still torn up. We ended with a fine march of twelve miles one thousand two hundred yards.

Another night march started at 8 P.M. The day had been clear with a very warm sun, which softened the surface, but by the time we set off, it was hardening quickly. As we crossed the peninsula, we decided to go straight across Robinson Bay since the glacier's surface was still rough. We finished with a great march of twelve miles and one thousand two hundred yards.

The fine weather continued and we managed to cross three and a half miles of heavy sastrugi, pressure-ridges and crevasses, attaining the first slopes of the mainland at 10 P.M. on December 14. The discovery of two nunataks springing out of the piedmont glacier to the south, lured us on.

The good weather lasted, and we were able to cross three and a half miles of tough sastrugi, pressure ridges, and crevasses, reaching the first slopes of the mainland at 10 P.M. on December 14. The sight of two nunataks rising from the piedmont glacier to the south motivated us to keep going.

The first rock—Possession Nunataks—loomed ahead, two hundred feet above, up a slope of half a mile. Here a depot of provisions and spare gear was made, sufficient to take us back to the Hippo. The rock was found by Watson to be gneiss, rich in mica, felspar and garnets. We lunched in this place and resumed our march at midnight.

The first rock—Possession Nunataks—towered in front of us, two hundred feet above, up a slope that stretched half a mile. Here, we set up a storage area for supplies and extra gear, enough to get us back to the Hippo. Watson discovered that the rock was gneiss, rich in mica, feldspar, and garnets. We had lunch in this spot and continued our journey at midnight.

The second nunatak was on the course; a sharp peak in the south, hidden by the contour of the uprising ridges. In four miles we steadily ascended eight hundred feet. While we were engaged pitching camp, a Cape pigeon flew overhead.

The second nunatak was on our route; a sharp peak to the south, concealed by the shape of the rising ridges. In four miles, we gradually climbed eight hundred feet. As we were setting up camp, a Cape pigeon flew overhead.

There were advantages in travelling at night. The surface was firmer, our eyes were relieved from the intense glare and our faces no longer blistered. On the other hand, there were disadvantages. The skirt of the tent used to get very wet through the snow thawing on it in the midday sun, and froze solid when packed up; the floor-cloths and sleeping-bags, also, never had a chance of drying and set to the same icy hardness. When we had mounted higher I intended to return to work by day.

There were perks to traveling at night. The ground was more solid, our eyes got a break from the harsh glare, and our faces didn't get burned. But there were also downsides. The bottom of the tent would get really wet from the snow melting on it in the midday sun, then freeze solid when we packed it up; the floor coverings and sleeping bags never got a chance to dry out and became just as icy. Once we climbed higher, I planned to go back to working during the day.

It was not till the altitude was three thousand feet that we came in sight of the far peak to the south. We were then pulling again in daylight. The ice-falls of the Denman Glacier on the left were still seen descending from the plateau, while down on the plain we saw that the zone of disrupted ice, into which the short and intricate track of our northern attempt had been won, extended for quite thirty miles.

It wasn't until we reached three thousand feet that we finally spotted the distant peak to the south. At that point, we were rowing again in daylight. The ice falls of the Denman Glacier on the left were still visible as they flowed down from the plateau, and down on the plain, we noticed that the area of broken ice—which our complicated and brief route from the north had managed to navigate—stretched for about thirty miles.

The surface then softened in a most amazing fashion and hauling became a slow, dogged strain with frequent spells. A little over four miles was the most we could do on the 18th, and on the 19th the loads were dragging in a deluge of dry, flour-like snow. A long halt was made at lunch to repair a badly torn tent.

The surface then softened in a really surprising way, and pulling became a slow, exhausting effort with regular breaks. Just over four miles was the best we could manage on the 18th, and on the 19th, the loads were heavy in a downpour of dry, powdery snow. We took a long break at lunch to fix a badly torn tent.

The peak ahead was named Mount Barr-Smith. It was fronted by a steep rise which we determined to climb next day. On the eastern margin of the Denman Glacier were several nunataks and higher, rising ground.

The peak ahead was called Mount Barr-Smith. It was preceded by a steep slope that we decided to climb the next day. On the eastern edge of the Denman Glacier were several nunataks and higher ground.

Following a twenty-four hours' blizzard, the sky was overcast, with the usual dim light filtering through a mist of snow. We set off to scale the mountain, taking the dip-circle with us. The horizon was so obscured that it was useless to take a round of angles. Fifteen miles south of Mount Barr-Smith, and a little higher there was another peak, to be subsequently called Mount Strathcona; also several intervening outcrops. Not a distinct range of mountains as we had hoped. The Denman Glacier sweeps round these projecting rocks from the south-west, and the general flow of the ice-sheet is thereby concentrated within the neck bounded by the two peaks and the higher land to the east. Propelled by the immense forces of the hinterland, this stream of ice is squeezed down through a steep valley at an accelerated speed, and, meeting the slower moving Shackleton Shelf, rends it from top to bottom and presses onward. Thus chaos, icequake, and ruin.

After a twenty-four-hour blizzard, the sky was overcast, with the usual dim light filtering through a mist of snow. We set off to climb the mountain, taking the dip-circle with us. The horizon was so obscured that taking a round of angles was pointless. Fifteen miles south of Mount Barr-Smith, and a little higher, there was another peak, which would later be named Mount Strathcona; there were also several intervening outcrops. It wasn't a distinct range of mountains as we had hoped. The Denman Glacier sweeps around these jutting rocks from the southwest, and the overall flow of the ice sheet is concentrated within the neck bounded by the two peaks and the higher land to the east. Driven by the immense forces from the hinterland, this stream of ice is forced down through a steep valley at an accelerated speed and, upon meeting the slower-moving Shackleton Shelf, tears it apart from top to bottom and continues onward. Thus chaos, icequake, and destruction.

Our tramp to Mount Barr-Smith was through eighteen inches of soft snow, in many places a full two feet deep. Hard enough for walking, we knew from experience what it was like for sledging. There was only sufficient food for another week and the surface was so abominably heavy that in that time, not allowing for blizzards, it would have been impossible to travel as far as we could see from the summit of Mount Barr-Smith, while four miles a day was the most that could have been done. Our attempt to make east by rounding the Denman Glacier to the south had been foiled, but by turning back at that point, we stood a chance of saving our two remaining dogs, who had worked so well that they really deserved to live.

Our hike to Mount Barr-Smith was through eighteen inches of soft snow, with some spots reaching a full two feet deep. Walking was tough enough; we knew from experience how challenging it was to pull sleds. We only had enough food for another week, and the snow was so heavy that, even without considering potential blizzards, it would have been impossible to travel as far as we could see from the top of Mount Barr-Smith. The most we could manage was about four miles a day. Our plan to head east by going around the Denman Glacier to the south didn’t work out, but by turning back at that point, we had a chance to save our two remaining dogs, who had worked so hard that they truly deserved to survive.

Sunday December 22 broke with a fresh breeze and surface drift; overhead a clear sky. We went back to Mount Barr-Smith, Kennedy taking an observation for latitude, Watson making a geological survey and collecting specimens, Harrisson sketching. The rocks at the summit were granites, gneisses and schists. The latitude worked out at 67 degrees 10.4' S., and we were a little more than one hundred and twenty miles in an air-line from the hut.

Sunday, December 22, started with a refreshing breeze and surface drift; the sky above was clear. We returned to Mount Barr-Smith, with Kennedy taking a latitude observation, Watson doing a geological survey and collecting samples, and Harrisson sketching. The rocks at the summit consisted of granites, gneisses, and schists. The latitude calculated out to 67 degrees 10.4' S., and we were just over one hundred and twenty miles in a straight line from the hut.

In the next two days, downhill, we "bullocked" through eleven miles, reaching a point where the depot at Possession Nunataks was only sixteen miles away. The surface snow was very sticky in places, clogging the runners badly, so that they had to be scraped every half-mile. Stewed skua was the feature of our Christmas Eve supper.

In the next two days, we pushed through eleven miles downhill, getting to a spot where the depot at Possession Nunataks was just sixteen miles ahead. The snow on the surface was really sticky in some areas, making the runners get stuck badly, so we had to scrape them off every half-mile. Stewed skua was the highlight of our Christmas Eve dinner.

From the diary:

From the journal:

"Christmas Day, Wednesday. Turned out and got away at 8 A.M., doing nine miles before lunch down a steep descent. The sun was very hot, and after lunch the surface became sticky, but at 5 P.M. we reached the depot, having done fifteen miles one hundred yards and descended two thousand three hundred feet.

"Christmas Day, Wednesday. We set out and left at 8 A.M., covering nine miles before lunch down a steep hill. The sun was blazing, and after lunch the ground got sticky, but by 5 P.M. we arrived at the depot, having traveled fifteen miles and one hundred yards and descended two thousand three hundred feet."

"I am afraid I shall have to go back to travelling by night, as the snow is so very soft down here during the day; not soft in the same way as the freshly fallen powdery stuff we had on the hills, but half-thawed and wet, freezing at night into a splendid surface for the runners. The shade temperature at 5.30 P.M. to-day was 29 degrees F., and a thermometer laid in the sun on the dark rocks went up to 87 degrees F.

"I’m afraid I’ll have to go back to traveling at night since the snow down here is really soft during the day; not soft like the fresh powder we had on the hills, but half-thawed and wet, freezing at night into a perfect surface for the runners. The shade temperature at 5:30 PM today was 29°F, while a thermometer laid in the sun on the dark rocks reached 87°F."

"Some time ago, a plum-pudding was found in one of our food-bags, put there, I believe, by Moyes. We ate it to-night in addition to the ordinary ration, and, with a small taste of spirits from the medical store, managed to get up quite a festive feeling. After dinner the Union Jack and Australian Ensign were hoisted on the rocks and I formally took possession of the land in the name of the Expedition, for King George V. and the Australian Commonwealth."

"Not long ago, we discovered a plum pudding in one of our food bags, placed there, I think, by Moyes. We enjoyed it tonight along with our regular rations, and with a little taste of spirits from the medical supplies, we managed to create a pretty festive atmosphere. After dinner, we raised the Union Jack and Australian Ensign on the rocks, and I officially took possession of the land on behalf of the Expedition, for King George V and the Australian Commonwealth."

Queen Mary Land is the name which, by gracious sanction, was eventually affixed to that area of new land.

Queen Mary Land is the name that was eventually given to that area of new land, with gracious approval.

Night marches commenced at 1 A.M. on December 27. The sail was hoisted for the first time and the fresh breeze was of great assistance. We were once more down on the low peninsula and on its highest point, two hundred feet above the shelf-ice, Kennedy took a round of angles.

Night marches started at 1 A.M. on December 27. The sail was raised for the first time, and the fresh breeze was a big help. We were back on the low peninsula, and at its highest point, two hundred feet above the shelf ice, Kennedy took a round of angles.

Along the margin of the shelf the crevasses were innumerable and, as the sun was hot and the snow soft and mushy, we pitched camp about six miles from the bluff on David Island.

Along the edge of the shelf, there were countless cracks, and since the sun was intense and the snow was soft and slushy, we set up camp about six miles from the bluff on David Island.

At 6 A.M. on the 28th we rounded the bluff and camped under its leeward face. After lunch there was a hunt for snow petrels. Fifty-six were caught and the eggs, which all contained chicks, were given to the dogs.

At 6 A.M. on the 28th, we rounded the bluff and set up camp on its sheltered side. After lunch, we went searching for snow petrels. We caught fifty-six of them, and since all the eggs had chicks in them, we gave them to the dogs.

It was my intention to touch at all the rocks on the mainland on the way home, as time and weather permitted. Under a light easterly breeze we scudded along with sail set and passed close to several outcrops. Watson examined them, finding gneiss and granite principally, one type being an exceptionally coarse granite, very much weathered. A mile of bad crevasses caused some delay; one of the dogs having a fall of twelve feet into one abyss.

It was my plan to visit all the rocks on the mainland on the way home, as long as time and weather allowed. With a light easterly breeze, we sailed along quickly and passed close to several outcrops. Watson checked them out, mostly finding gneiss and granite, including one type that was an especially coarse granite that had weathered quite a bit. A mile of rough crevasses caused some delays, with one of the dogs falling twelve feet into one of the gaps.

Next day, the Hippo hove in sight and we found the depoted food in good condition. The course had been over high pressure-waves and in some places we had to diverge on account of crevasses and—fresh water! Many of the hollows contained water from thawed snow, and in others there was a treacherous crust which hid a slushy pool. The march of eighteen miles landed us just north of the Avalanche Rocks.

Next day, the Hippo came into view and we found the stored food in good shape. The journey had crossed some high-pressure waves, and in some areas, we had to detour because of cracks and—fresh water! Many of the depressions held water from melted snow, and in others, there was a dangerous crust that concealed a muddy pool. The trek of eighteen miles brought us just north of the Avalanche Rocks.

While we were erecting the tents there were several snow-slips, and Watson, Kennedy and I walked landwards after supper to try for a "snap" of one in the act of falling, but they refused to oblige us. It was found that one or more avalanches had thrown blocks of ice, weighing at least twenty tons, two hundred yards past the hole in which we spent five days on the depot journey. They had, therefore, travelled six hundred yards from the cliff.

While we were setting up the tents, there were a few snow slides, and Watson, Kennedy, and I headed inland after dinner to try to get a picture of one as it was falling, but they didn’t cooperate. It turned out that one or more avalanches had thrown blocks of ice, weighing at least twenty tons, two hundred yards past the spot where we spent five days during the depot journey. They had, therefore, traveled six hundred yards from the cliff.

The Alligator Nunatak was explored on January 2, 1913. It was found to be half a mile long, four hundred feet high and four hundred and fifty feet in width, and, like most of the rock we had seen, mainly gneiss.

The Alligator Nunatak was explored on January 2, 1913. It was discovered to be half a mile long, four hundred feet high, and four hundred and fifty feet wide, and, like most of the rock we had seen, mainly gneiss.

There was half a gale blowing on the 4th and though the wind was abeam, the sail was reefed and we moved quickly. The dogs ran loose, their feet being very sore from pulling on rough, nobbly ice. The day's run was the record up to that time—twenty-two miles. Our camp was in the vicinity of two small nunataks discovered in August 1912. We reckoned to be at the Base in two days and wondered how poor Moyes was faring.

There was a strong wind on the 4th, and even though the wind was coming from the side, we had the sail trimmed down and moved fast. The dogs were running free, but their paws were really sore from pulling on the rough, bumpy ice. We set a record for the day—twenty-two miles. Our campsite was near two small nunataks that were found back in August 1912. We figured we’d reach the Base in two days and wondered how poor Moyes was doing.

Early on the 5th, the last piece of broken country fell behind, and one sledge being rigged with full sail, the second sledge was taken in tow. Both dogs had bleeding feet and were released, running alongside. During the halt for lunch a sail was raised on the dogs' sledge, using tent poles as a mast, a floor-cloth for a sail, an ice-axe for an upper yard and a bamboo for a lower yard. Getting under way we found that the lighter sledge overran ours; so we cast off and Harrisson took the light sledge, the sail working so well that he rode on top of the load most of the time. Later in the afternoon the wind increased so much that the dogs' sledge was dismasted and taken in tow once more, the sail on the forward sledge being ample for our purpose.

Early on the 5th, the last piece of rough terrain fell behind, and one sledge was rigged with a full sail while the second sledge was taken in tow. Both dogs had bleeding paws, so they were released to run alongside. During our lunch break, we set up a sail on the dogs' sledge, using tent poles as a mast, a floor cloth as a sail, an ice axe as an upper yard, and a bamboo pole as a lower yard. Once we got moving, we noticed that the lighter sledge was pulling ahead of ours, so we let it go, and Harrisson took the lighter sledge. The sail worked so well that he spent most of the time riding on top of the load. Later in the afternoon, the wind picked up so much that the dogs' sledge lost its mast and was taken in tow again, while the sail on the forward sledge was more than enough for our needs.

At 4 P.M. we had done twenty miles, and, everybody feeling fresh, I decided to try and reach "The Grottoes," fifteen miles away. The wind increasing to a gale with hurtling drift, the sail was reefed, and even then was more than enough to push along both sledges. Two of us made fast behind and maintained a continual brake to stop them running away. At 9 P.M. the gale became so strong that we struck sail and camped. Altogether, the day's run was thirty-five miles.

At 4 P.M., we had covered twenty miles, and since everyone felt energetic, I decided to go for "The Grottoes," which was another fifteen miles away. The wind picked up to a gale with blowing snow, so we reefed the sail, and even then it was still more than enough to move both sledges. Two of us secured ourselves behind and kept a steady brake to prevent them from racing off. By 9 P.M., the gale had gotten so fierce that we took down the sail and set up camp. Overall, we traveled thirty-five miles that day.

An hour's march next morning, and, through the glasses, we saw the mast and soon afterwards the hut. Just before reaching home, we struck up a song, and in a few seconds Moyes came running out. When he saw there were four of us, he stood on his head.

An hour's walk the next morning, and, through the binoculars, we spotted the mast and soon after the cabin. Just before getting home, we started singing, and in a few seconds, Moyes came running out. When he saw there were four of us, he stood on his head.

As we expected, Moyes had never thought of Harrisson coming with me and had quite given him up as dead. When a month had elapsed—the time for which Harrisson had food—Moyes packed a sledge with provisions for Harrisson, himself and the dogs and went out for six days. Then, recognizing the futility of searching for any one in that white waste of nothingness, he returned. He looked well, after his lonely nine weeks, but said that it was the worst time he had ever had in his life. Moyes reported that the Western party were delayed in starting by bad weather until November 7.

As we expected, Moyes had never considered that Harrisson would come with me and had pretty much given him up for dead. When a month passed—the amount of time Harrisson had food—Moyes loaded up a sled with supplies for Harrisson, himself, and the dogs and set out for six days. Then, realizing it was pointless to look for anyone in that endless white wasteland, he came back. He looked good after his lonely nine weeks but said it was the worst time he had ever experienced in his life. Moyes mentioned that the Western party was delayed in starting due to bad weather until November 7.

The total distance sledged during our main summer eastern journey was two hundred and thirty-seven miles, including thirty-two of relay work, but none of the many reconnoitring miles. Out of seventy days, there were twenty-eight on which the weather was adverse. On the spring depot journey the travelling had been so easy that I fully expected to go four hundred or five hundred miles eastward in the summer. It was therefore, a great disappointment to be blocked as we were.

The total distance traveled during our main summer eastern journey was two hundred and thirty-seven miles, including thirty-two miles of relay work, but none of the many scouting miles. Out of seventy days, there were twenty-eight when the weather was bad. On the spring depot journey, the travel had been so easy that I fully expected to go four hundred or five hundred miles east in the summer. So, it was a huge disappointment to be blocked as we were.





CHAPTER XXII THE WESTERN BASE—LINKING UP WITH KAISER WILHELM II LAND

by Dr. S. E. Jones

On our return from the Western Depot journey towards the end of October 1912, we found preparations completed for the long western trip, towards Gaussberg in Kaiser Wilhelm II Land, which was discovered by the German Antarctic Expedition of 1902. The departure was delayed for several days, but came at last on November 7, Moyes bidding us adieu and wishing us good luck.

On our way back from the Western Depot trip at the end of October 1912, we found everything ready for the long journey west to Gaussberg in Kaiser Wilhelm II Land, discovered by the German Antarctic Expedition in 1902. Our departure was pushed back by a few days, but we finally left on November 7, with Moyes saying goodbye and wishing us good luck.

The party consisted of Dovers (surveyor), Hoadley (geologist), and myself (surgeon). We were hauling one sledge with rations for nine weeks. Our course, which was almost due south lay over the glacier shelf practically parallel to the sea-cliffs. The surface was good, and we covered eleven miles by nightfall, reaching a point some two or three miles from the rising land slopes. As the high land was approached closer, the surface of the glacier-shelf, which farther north was practically level, became undulating and broken by pressure-ridges and crevasses. These, however, offered no obstacle to sledging.

The team included Dovers (the surveyor), Hoadley (the geologist), and me (the surgeon). We were dragging one sled with supplies for nine weeks. Our route, which was nearly due south, went over the glacier shelf, almost parallel to the sea cliffs. The surface was good, and we covered eleven miles by nightfall, getting within two or three miles of the rising land slopes. As we got closer to the high land, the surface of the glacier shelf, which further north was almost flat, became uneven and marked by pressure ridges and crevasses. However, these didn’t pose any obstacle to sledging.

Proceeding in the morning and finding that an ascent of the slopes ahead was rendered impracticable by wide patches of ice, we turned more to the west and steered for Junction Corner. Upon our arrival there, it was discovered that several bergs lay frozen within the floe close to where the seaward wall of the glacier-shelf joined that of the land ice-sheet. Some of these bergs were old and rotten, but one seemed to have broken away quite recently.

Proceeding in the morning and finding that climbing the slopes ahead was impossible due to large patches of ice, we turned more to the west and headed toward Junction Corner. When we arrived, we discovered that several icebergs were frozen within the floe, right by where the seaward wall of the glacier shelf met the land ice sheet. Some of these icebergs were old and deteriorating, but one looked like it had recently broken away.

From the same place we could see several black points ahead; our course was altered towards them, almost due westward, about halt a mile from the sea-cliffs. They proved to be rocks, six in number, forming a moraine. As it was then half-past five, we camped in order that Hoadley might examine them. There had been a halo visible all day, with mock suns in the evening.

From the same spot, we could see several dark dots in the distance; we changed our direction towards them, almost directly west, about half a mile from the sea cliffs. They turned out to be rocks, six in total, forming a moraine. Since it was around 5:30 PM, we set up camp so Hoadley could investigate them. There had been a halo visible all day, with sun dogs appearing in the evening.

In the morning a high wind was blowing. Everything went well for a little over a mile, when we found ourselves running across a steep slope. The wind having increased and being abeam, the sledge was driven to leeward when on a smooth surface, and when amongst soft sastrugi, which occurred in patches, was capsized. Accordingly camp was pitched.

In the morning, strong winds were blowing. Everything went smoothly for just over a mile until we found ourselves running across a steep slope. The wind increased and hit us from the side, causing the sled to be pushed off course on a smooth surface, and when we hit some soft sastrugi that appeared in patches, it tipped over. So, we set up camp.

The next day being less boisterous, a start was made at 9 A.M. There was still a strong beam wind, however, which carried the sledge downhill, with the result that for one forward step two had to be taken to the right. We were more fortunate in the afternoon and reached the depot laid on the earlier journey at 5.30 A.M. From this position we had a fine view of the Helen Glacier running out of a bay which opened up ahead.

The next day was calmer, and we set out at 9 A.M. However, there was still a strong beam wind that pushed the sledge downhill, so for every step we took forward, we had to take two steps to the right. We had better luck in the afternoon and reached the depot established during the earlier journey by 5:30 A.M. From this spot, we enjoyed a great view of the Helen Glacier flowing out of a bay that opened up ahead.

Having picked up the depot next morning, we were disappointed to find that we should have to commence relay work. There were then two sledges with rations for thirteen weeks; the total weight amounting to one thousand two hundred pounds. By making an even division between the two sledges the work was rendered easy but slow. When we camped at 6 P.M., five and a half miles had been covered. The surface was good, but a strong beam wind hindered us while approaching the head of Depot Bay. The ice-cap to the west appeared to be very broken, and it seemed inevitable that we should have to ascend to a considerable altitude towards the south-west to find a good travelling surface.

After picking up the supplies the next morning, we were disappointed to learn that we had to start relay work. There were two sledges loaded with rations for thirteen weeks, weighing a total of twelve hundred pounds. By evenly dividing the load between the two sledges, the work became easier but slower. When we camped at 6 P.M., we had covered five and a half miles. The surface was good, but a strong headwind slowed us down as we approached the top of Depot Bay. The ice cap to the west looked really broken, and it seemed unavoidable that we would have to climb to a significant height towards the south-west to find a better traveling surface.

In the morning we were delayed by heavy wind, but left camp at ten o'clock after spending an hour digging out the sledges and tent. At lunch time the sun became quite obscured and each of us had many falls stumbling over the invisible sastrugi. At five o'clock the weather became so thick that camp was pitched. Hoadley complained of snow-blindness and all were suffering with cracked lips; there was consequently a big demand for hazeline cream in the evening.

In the morning, we were held up by strong winds, but we finally left camp at ten o'clock after an hour of digging out the sleds and tent. By lunchtime, the sun was completely hidden, and each of us took many spills tripping over the unseen sastrugi. At five o'clock, the weather got so bad that we set up camp. Hoadley was complaining about snow blindness, and everyone was dealing with cracked lips, so there was a huge need for hazeline cream in the evening.

On Wednesday November 13, we started early, and, finding a good firm track over a gently rising plateau, made fair progress. At three o'clock a gale sprang up suddenly; and fortunately the sledges were only a quarter of a mile apart as we were relaying them in stages up the rising plateau. The tent was pitched hurriedly, though with difficulty, on account of the high wind and drift. The distance for the day was four miles one thousand five hundred yards, the last mile and a half being downhill into a valley at the head of the bay. The morainic boulders visible from the camp at the depot were now obscured behind a point to the west of Depot Bay.

On Wednesday, November 13, we started early and made good progress over a solid, gently rising plateau. At three o'clock, a strong wind suddenly picked up; luckily, the sledges were only a quarter of a mile apart since we were moving them up the plateau in stages. We quickly set up the tent, though it was challenging due to the strong wind and snow drift. We covered a distance of four miles and one thousand five hundred yards, with the last mile and a half going downhill into a valley at the head of the bay. The morainic boulders visible from the camp at the depot were now hidden behind a point to the west of Depot Bay.

The next sixty hours were spent in sleeping-bags, a heavy snowstorm making it impossible to move. Owing to the comparatively high temperature, 20 degrees to 26 degrees F., the snow melted readily on the lee side of the tent, and, the water running through, things became uncomfortably wet inside. At midday of the 16th, however, we were able to go out, and, after spending two and a half hours digging out the tent and sledges, we made a start, travelling two and three-quarter miles on a south-westerly course.

The next sixty hours were spent in sleeping bags, with a heavy snowstorm making it impossible to move. Because of the relatively high temperature, 20 to 26 degrees F, the snow melted easily on the sheltered side of the tent, and with water running through, everything got uncomfortably wet inside. However, at midday on the 16th, we were able to go outside, and after spending two and a half hours digging out the tent and sledges, we set off, traveling two and three-quarter miles on a south-west course.

During the morning of the 17th a slight descent was negotiated, but in the afternoon came the ascent of the slopes on the western side of Depot Bay. The ice-cap here was very badly crevassed, and spiked boots had to be worn in hauling the sledges up the steep neve slopes. In the latter part of the afternoon a course was made more to the west, and about the same time the south-east wind freshened and we travelled for a couple of hours through thick drift. The night's camp was situated approximately at the eastern edge of the Helen Glacier. The portion of the ice-cap which contributes to the glacier below is marked off from the general icy surface on either side by a series of falls and cascades. These appeared quite impassable near sea-level, but we hoped to find a smooth passage at an altitude of about one thousand feet.

On the morning of the 17th, we went down a slight slope, but in the afternoon, we climbed the hills on the western side of Depot Bay. The ice cap here was really badly crevassed, so we had to wear spiked boots to haul the sledges up the steep neve slopes. Later in the afternoon, we headed more west, and around the same time, the southeast wind picked up, and we traveled for a couple of hours through thick snow drift. We set up camp for the night roughly at the eastern edge of the Helen Glacier. The part of the ice cap that feeds the glacier below is separated from the general icy surface on both sides by a series of drops and waterfalls. These looked almost impossible to cross near sea level, but we hoped to find a smooth path at around one thousand feet up.

A start was made at 7 A.M. The surface consisted of ice and neve and was badly broken by pressure-mounds, ten to twenty feet high, and by numerous crevasses old and recent; many with sunken or fallen bridges. While crossing a narrow crevasse, about forty feet of the bridge collapsed lengthwise under the leading man, letting him fall to the full extent of his harness rope. Hoadley and myself had passed over the same spot, unsuspecting and unroped, a few minutes previously, while looking for a safe track. We were now nearing the approximate western edge of the Helen Glacier, and the broken condition of the ice evidently indicated considerable movement. Later in the morning a more southerly course was kept over an improving surface.

A start was made at 7 A.M. The surface was made up of ice and snow and was badly damaged by pressure mounds, ten to twenty feet high, and by various crevasses, both old and new; many had sunken or fallen bridges. While crossing a narrow crevasse, about forty feet of the bridge collapsed under the leading man, causing him to fall to the full length of his harness rope. Hoadley and I had passed over the same spot just a few minutes earlier, unaware and without ropes, while searching for a safe path. We were now approaching the approximate western edge of the Helen Glacier, and the broken state of the ice clearly indicated significant movement. Later in the morning, we took a more southerly route over an improving surface.

At midday Dovers took observations of the sun and found the latitude to be 66 degrees 47' S. Owing to the heat of the sun the fat in the pemmican had been melting in the food-bags, so after lunch the provisions were repacked and the pemmican was put in the centre of the large tanks. In the afternoon we hoisted the sail, and by evening had done four miles. From our camp the eye could range across the Helen Glacier eastward to the shelf-ice of "The Grottoes." Far away in the north-west was a wide expanse of open water, while a multitude of bergs lay scattered along the coast to the west of the Helen Glacier.

At noon, Dovers took measurements of the sun and determined the latitude to be 66 degrees 47' S. Because of the sun's heat, the fat in the pemmican had been melting in the food bags, so after lunch, the supplies were reorganized and the pemmican was placed in the center of the large containers. In the afternoon, we raised the sail, and by evening, we had traveled four miles. From our camp, we could see across the Helen Glacier to the east, extending to the shelf ice of "The Grottoes." Far off to the northwest was a wide stretch of open water, while numerous icebergs were scattered along the coast to the west of the Helen Glacier.

The next day was gloriously bright, with a breeze just strong enough to make hauling pleasant. Erecting a sail, we made an attempt to haul both sledges, but found that they were too heavy. It was soon discovered that a considerable detour would have to be made to cross the broken ice on the western edge of the Helen Glacier. By keeping to the saddles and valleys as much as possible and working to the south, we were able to avoid the rougher country, but at 4 P.M. we arrived at what at first appeared an impasse.

The next day was beautifully sunny, with a breeze just strong enough to make hauling enjoyable. We set up a sail and tried to haul both sledges, but they were too heavy. It quickly became clear that we would need to take a significant detour to get over the broken ice on the western edge of the Helen Glacier. By sticking to the saddles and valleys as much as we could and heading south, we managed to avoid the rougher terrain, but by 4 P.M. we found ourselves at what initially seemed like a dead end.

At this point three great crevassed ridges united to form the ice-falls on the western side of the glacier. The point of confluence was the only place that appeared to offer any hope of a passage, and, as we did not want to retrace our steps, we decided to attempt it. The whole surface was a network of huge crevasses, some open, the majority from fifty to one hundred feet or more in width. After many devious turns, a patch of snow between two large abysses was reached. As the ice in front seemed even more broken than that behind, camp was pitched. After tea a search was made for a way out, and it was found that by travelling along a narrow, knife-edge ridge of ice and neve, with an open crevasse on each side, a good surface could be reached within a mile of the camp. This ridge had a gradient of one in ten, and, unfortunately, also sloped down towards one of the open crevasses.

At this point, three massive, crevassed ridges came together to create the ice falls on the western side of the glacier. The place where they met seemed like the only spot that offered any chance of getting through, and since we didn't want to backtrack, we decided to give it a try. The entire surface was a maze of huge crevasses, some wide open, most between fifty and a hundred feet or more across. After many winding turns, we reached a patch of snow between two large chasms. Since the ice in front looked even more broken than what we had just come from, we set up camp. After tea, we searched for an escape route and discovered that by moving along a narrow, knife-edge ridge of ice and neve, with an open crevasse on either side, we could reach a solid surface within a mile of the camp. This ridge had a slope of one in ten, and unfortunately, it also slanted down towards one of the open crevasses.

During the next four days a heavy blizzard raged. There was a tremendous snowfall accompanied by a gale of wind, and, after the second day, the snow was piled four feet high round the tent, completely burying the sledges and by its pressure greatly reducing the space inside the tent. On the 23rd, the fourth day, we dug out the floor, lowering the level of the tent about two feet, and this made things more comfortable. While digging, a crack in the ice was disclosed running across the floor, and from this came a considerable draught. By midday the weather had improved sufficiently to allow us to move.

During the next four days, a heavy blizzard hit us. There was a massive snowfall with strong winds, and by the second day, the snow piled up four feet high around the tent, completely covering the sledges and significantly reducing the space inside the tent. On the 23rd, the fourth day, we dug out the floor, lowering the level of the tent by about two feet, which made things more comfortable. While digging, we discovered a crack in the ice running across the floor, causing a noticeable draft. By midday, the weather had improved enough for us to move.

The sledge and tent were excavated from beneath a great mass of soft snow; the new level of the snow's surface being four to five feet above that on which the camp had been made four days earlier. The wind having fallen, we went ahead with the sledges. While crossing the ridge of ice which led into the valley below, one man hauled the sledges while the other two prevented them from sliding sideways downhill into the open crevasse. That afternoon we noticed very fine iridescent colouring in cirro-cumulus clouds as they crossed the sun.

The sled and tent were dug out from under a large pile of soft snow; the new snow surface level was about four to five feet higher than where the camp had been set up four days earlier. With the wind calming down, we moved forward with the sleds. As we crossed the ice ridge leading into the valley below, one person pulled the sleds while the other two kept them from sliding sideways into the open crevasse. That afternoon, we saw beautiful iridescent colors in cirro-cumulus clouds as they passed in front of the sun.

The next day gave us a pleasant surprise, there being a strong breeze dead aft, while the travelling surface ahead looked distinctly favourable. Sail was hoisted and the two sledges were coupled together. The course for a short distance was downhill, and we had to run to keep up with the sledges. The slopes on the far side of the valley we had entered on the previous afternoon were not so formidable as they had looked, for by lunch time six and a half miles had been covered. The surface was good, with occasional long undulations. After lunch a turn to the north was made for a short distance in order to come in touch with the coastline. Then the march west was resumed by travelling parallel to the shore at a distance of five to ten miles. At halting-time the extreme western edge of Helen Glacier was passed, and below lay young floe-ice, studded with numerous bergs.

The next day brought us a nice surprise with a strong breeze coming from behind, and the traveling surface ahead looked really good. We raised the sails and joined the two sledges together. For a little while, the route went downhill, and we had to hurry to keep up with the sledges. The slopes on the far side of the valley we entered the day before weren’t as daunting as they seemed; by lunchtime, we had covered six and a half miles. The surface was decent, with some long bumps. After lunch, we made a quick turn north to get closer to the coastline. Then we continued our march west, traveling parallel to the shore about five to ten miles away. When we stopped for the night, we had passed the extreme western edge of Helen Glacier, and below us was young floe-ice, dotted with numerous icebergs.

In the morning, Dovers called attention to what appeared to be an ice-covered island lying to the north-north-west, thirty to forty miles away. We watched this carefully during the day, but found its form to be constant. Through binoculars, icy patches and bluff points at the eastern and western ends were distinguishable.**

In the morning, Dovers pointed out what seemed to be an ice-covered island located to the north-northwest, thirty to forty miles away. We observed it closely throughout the day, but its shape remained the same. Using binoculars, we could make out icy patches and bluff points at the eastern and western ends.

     ** This was examined in detail from the 'Aurora' in January 1913 and
found to be an island, which was named Drygalski Island, for it is
evidently the ice-covered "high-land" observed by Professor Drygalski
(German Expedition, 1902) from his balloon.—ED.
     ** This was examined in detail from the 'Aurora' in January 1913 and found to be an island, which was named Drygalski Island, as it is clearly the ice-covered "high-land" noted by Professor Drygalski (German Expedition, 1902) from his balloon.—ED.

As soon as camp was struck the march was resumed direct for what every one thought was a rocky outcrop, though nearer approach proved it to be merely the shady face of an open crevasse. The same course was maintained and the ridge of ice that runs down to the western point of Depot Bay was soon close at hand. From its crest we could see a group of about a dozen rocky islands, the most distant being five miles off the coast. All were surrounded by floe. Descending steeply from the ridge into a valley which ran out to the sea-cliffs, we pitched camp for lunch.

As soon as we packed up the camp, we continued marching straight toward what everyone thought was a rocky outcrop, but as we got closer, it turned out to be just the shady side of an open crevasse. We kept the same course, and soon we were near the ice ridge that extends down to the western point of Depot Bay. From the top, we could see about a dozen rocky islands, the furthest one being five miles off the coast. All of them were surrounded by ice floes. We descended steeply from the ridge into a valley that led to the sea cliffs and set up camp for lunch.

The meal completed, Hoadley and I descended to the edge of the glacier in order to see if there were a passable route to the sea-ice. Crossing wide areas of badly crevassed ice and neve during a descent of nine hundred feet, we reached the sea-front about one and a half miles from the camp. Below us there was a chaos of bergs and smaller debris, resulting from the disintegration of the land-ice, which were frozen into the floe and connected to one another by huge ramparts of snow. Following a path downward with great difficulty, we approached a small berg which was discovered to be rapidly thawing under the action of the heat absorbed by a pile of stones and mud. The trickling of the falling water made a pleasant relief in the otherwise intense silence. As it seemed impossible to haul sledges through this jumble of ice and snow, Hoadley suggested that he should walk across the floe and make a brief geological examination of at least the largest islet. I therefore returned to the camp and helped Dovers take observations for longitude and magnetic variation.

Once we finished our meal, Hoadley and I headed down to the edge of the glacier to see if there was a way to reach the sea ice. After crossing large areas of rough, crevassed ice and neve during a descent of nine hundred feet, we arrived at the sea front about a mile and a half from the camp. Below us, there was a chaotic mix of icebergs and smaller debris from the melting land ice, all frozen into the floe and connected by large snow mounds. We managed to find a difficult path downwards and got close to a small iceberg that was melting quickly due to heat being trapped by a pile of stones and mud. The sound of trickling water provided a nice contrast to the otherwise intense silence. Since it seemed impossible to drag sledges through this mess of ice and snow, Hoadley proposed that he would walk across the floe and do a quick geological survey of at least the biggest islet. So, I went back to the camp and assisted Dovers with taking measurements for longitude and magnetic variation.

Hoadley returned at 9 P.M. and reported that he had seen an immense rookery of Emperor penguins near the largest islet, besides Adelie penguins, silver-grey, Wilson and Antarctic petrels and skua gulls. He also said that he thought it possible to take a sledge, lightly laden, through the drifts below the brink of the glacier.

Hoadley came back at 9 PM and said he had spotted a huge colony of Emperor penguins near the biggest islet, along with Adelie penguins, silver-grey petrels, Wilson's petrels, and skua gulls. He also mentioned that he thought it might be feasible to take a lightly loaded sled through the drifts below the edge of the glacier.

Accordingly in the morning the eleven-foot sledge was packed with necessaries for a week's stay, although we intended to remain only for a day in order to take photographs and search for specimens. Erecting a depot flag to mark the big sledge, we broke camp at midday and soon reached the sea-front. Our track then wound among the snow-drifts until it emerged from the broken ice which was observed to border the land ice-sheet for miles. The travelling became unexpectedly good for a time over highly polished, green sea-ice, and thence on to snow, amid a field of numerous small bergs. Many of these showed a marked degree of ablation, and, in places, blocks of ice perched on eminences had weathered into most grotesque forms. There were numerous streams of thaw-water running from mud-covered bergs. Perspiring in the heat, we more than once stopped to slake our thirst.

Accordingly, in the morning, we packed the eleven-foot sled with essentials for a week's stay, even though we planned to only be there for a day to take photos and look for specimens. We set up a depot flag to mark the big sled, broke camp at midday, and soon reached the sea front. Our path twisted through the snowdrifts until we got to the broken ice that stretched along the land ice sheet for miles. For a while, the travel turned out to be unexpectedly good on the smooth, green sea ice, and then onto the snow, surrounded by a field of numerous small icebergs. Many of these showed significant wear, and in some areas, chunks of ice sitting on high spots had weathered into the most bizarre shapes. There were lots of streams of meltwater running from mud-covered icebergs. Sweating in the heat, we stopped more than once to quench our thirst.

Approaching the largest rock—Haswell Island, as it was called later—we saw more distinctly the immense numbers of Emperor penguins covering several acres of floe. The birds extended in rows even on to the lower slopes of several bergs. The sound of their cries coming across the ice reminded one of the noise from a distant sports' ground during a well-contested game. We camped at 5 P.M. on a snow-drift at the southern end of the island. A large rookery of Adelie penguins on a long, low rock, about a mile distant, soon made itself evident.

As we got closer to the largest rock—later known as Haswell Island—we saw more clearly the huge number of Emperor penguins spread across several acres of ice. The birds formed lines that extended even onto the lower slopes of some icebergs. The sound of their calls echoed across the ice, reminiscent of the noise from a distant sports field during an intense match. We set up camp at 5 PM on a snowdrift at the southern end of the island. A large colony of Adelie penguins on a long, low rock, about a mile away, quickly became noticeable.

Although the stay was intended to occupy only about twenty-four hours, we were compelled to remain five days on the island on account of a snowstorm which continued for practically the whole of the time. This did not prevent us from leaving the tent and wandering about; Hoadley keen on the geology and Dovers surveying whenever the light was good enough. The temperature of the rock was well above freezing-point where it was exposed, and snow melted almost as soon as it fell. Our sleeping-bags and gear soon became very wet, but we rejoiced in one compensation, and that was a change in diet. It was agreed that five Adelie penguins or ten Cape pigeons' eggs made a good tasty entree to the monotonous ration.

Although the stay was meant to last only about twenty-four hours, we ended up stuck on the island for five days due to a snowstorm that lasted nearly the entire time. This didn’t stop us from leaving the tent and exploring; Hoadley was really into the geology, and Dovers was surveying whenever the light was good enough. The temperature of the rock was well above freezing where it was exposed, and the snow melted almost as soon as it fell. Our sleeping bags and gear quickly got very wet, but we were happy about one thing: a change in our diet. We agreed that five Adelie penguins or ten Cape pigeon eggs made for a delicious addition to our boring rations.

The camp was situated on the largest of a group of about twelve small islets, lying within five or six miles of the coast, on the lower slopes of which several outcrops of rock could be observed. Haswell Island was found to be roughly diamond-shaped; three-quarters of a mile in length, the same in width, and about three hundred feet on the highest point. It was surrounded by one season's floe, raised in pressure-ridges on the eastern side. On the northern, southern, and especially the eastern face, the rock was steep; on the western aspect, there was a more gentle slope down to the floe, the rock being almost concealed by big snow-drifts. There were signs of previous glaciation in the form of erratics and many examples of polishing and grooving. The rock was very rotten, and in many places, especially about the penguin rookeries, there were collections of soil. Two deep gorges cut through the island from north-west to south-east, in both of which there were small ponds of fresh water.

The camp was set on the largest of a group of about twelve small islets, located around five or six miles from the coast. The lower slopes had several rocky outcrops. Haswell Island was roughly diamond-shaped, measuring three-quarters of a mile in length and width, and about three hundred feet high at its peak. It was surrounded by seasonal sea ice, forming pressure ridges on the eastern side. The northern, southern, and especially eastern edges were steep, while the western side had a gentler slope down to the ice, almost hidden by large snow drifts. There were signs of past glaciation, such as erratics and numerous examples of polishing and grooving. The rock was very fragile, and in many areas, especially around the penguin rookeries, there were patches of soil. Two deep gorges ran through the island from northwest to southeast, where small ponds of fresh water could be found.

The most marked feature was the wonderful abundance of bird life, for almost all the birds frequenting the shores of the continent were found nesting there. Adelie penguins were in greatest numbers. Besides the large rookery on one of the smaller islets, there were numerous rookeries of fifty to one hundred birds each on Haswell Island. In most cases the penguins made their nests on the rock itself, but, failing this, had actually settled on snow-drifts, where they presented a peculiar sight, as the heat of their bodies having caused them to sink in the snow, their heads alone were visible above the surface. One bird was observed carrying an egg on the dorsal surface of his feet as the Emperor penguins do. Feathers were scattered broadcast around each rookery. These result from the numerous fights which occur and are also partly derived from the bare patch of skin at the lower part of the abdomen which provides the necessary heat for incubation when the bird is sitting. Most of the birds had two eggs in a well-advanced stage of incubation, and it was a difficult task to find a sufficient number fresh enough for culinary purposes. Attached to each rookery was a pair of skua gulls, who swooped down and quickly flew off with any eggs left for a moment untended.

The standout feature was the incredible variety of bird life, as nearly all the birds along the continent’s shores were nesting there. Adelie penguins were the most numerous. In addition to the large rookery on one of the smaller islets, there were several rookeries with fifty to one hundred birds each on Haswell Island. Most of the time, the penguins built their nests directly on the rocks, but when that wasn’t possible, they surprisingly settled on snow-drifts, where they looked quite unusual since their bodies sunk into the snow, leaving only their heads visible above the surface. One bird was seen carrying an egg on the top of its feet, just like Emperor penguins do. Feathers were scattered around each rookery, a result of the many fights that happen and also partly from the bare patch of skin on the lower abdomen, which provides the heat needed for incubation while the bird is sitting. Most of the birds were sitting on two eggs that were well into the incubation stage, making it hard to find enough fresh ones for cooking. Each rookery had a pair of skua gulls nearby that swooped down to quickly grab any eggs left unattended for a moment.

The Emperor penguins had their rookery on the floe, about a mile from the island. The birds covered four to five acres, but there were undoubted signs that a much larger area had been occupied. We estimated the numbers to be seven thousand five hundred, the great majority being young birds. These were well grown, most of them standing as high as the shoulders of the adults. They were all very fat, covered by a grey down, slightly darker on the dorsal than on the ventral surface, with dark tails and a black, straight beak. The eyes were surrounded by a ring of grey plumage, and this again by a black band which extended over the skull to the root of the beak. Thus the markings on the young do not correspond with those of the adults. A few of the larger chicks had commenced to moult, the change of plumage being observed on the flippers.

The Emperor penguins had their breeding ground on the ice floe, about a mile from the island. The birds covered four to five acres, but there were clear signs that a much larger area had been used. We estimated the population to be seven thousand five hundred, mostly young birds. These were well grown, with most of them standing as high as the adults' shoulders. They were all very plump, covered in grey down, slightly darker on their backs than on their bellies, with dark tails and straight black beaks. Their eyes were surrounded by a ring of grey feathers, which was bordered by a black band extending over the head to the base of the beak. So, the markings on the young birds differ from those of the adults. A few of the larger chicks had started to shed their feathers, with the change in plumage noticeable on their flippers.

Daily we watched large numbers of adults departing from and returning to the rookery. The direction in which they travelled was north, towards open water, estimated to be twenty miles distant. Although more than once the adults' return to the rookery was carefully noted, we never saw the young birds being fed, old birds as they entered the rookery quietly going to sleep.

Daily, we observed many adults leaving and coming back to the rookery. They traveled north, toward open water, which was about twenty miles away. Even though we paid close attention to when the adults returned to the rookery, we never saw the young birds being fed; the older birds just quietly went to sleep as they entered the rookery.

Hoadley, on his first visit to the island, had seen Antarctic petrels flying about, and a search revealed a large rookery of these on the eastern side. The nesting-place of this species of petrel had never before been discovered, and so we were all elated at the great find. About three hundred birds were found sitting in the gullies and clefts, as close together as they could crowd. They made no attempt to form nests, merely laying their eggs on the shallow dirt. Each bird had one egg about the same size as that of a domestic fowl. Incubation was far advanced, and some difficulty was experienced in blowing the specimens with a blow-pipe improvised from a quill. Neither the Antarctic nor any other petrels offered any resistance when disturbed on their nests, except by the expectoration of large quantities of a pink or green, oily fluid.

Hoadley, during his first trip to the island, noticed Antarctic petrels flying around, and a search uncovered a large rookery of these birds on the eastern side. This nesting site for the species had never been discovered before, so we were all thrilled about the significant find. About three hundred birds were found sitting in the gullies and crevices, packed closely together. They didn’t try to build nests; instead, they just laid their eggs on the shallow dirt. Each bird had one egg, roughly the same size as a chicken egg. Incubation was well advanced, and we faced some challenges in blowing the specimens with a blowpipe we made from a quill. Neither the Antarctic nor any other petrels resisted when disturbed at their nests, except by spitting out large amounts of a pink or green, oily fluid.

The Cape pigeons had just commenced laying when we arrived at the island. On the first day only two eggs were found, but, on the fourth day after our arrival, forty were collected. These birds make a small shallow nest with chips of stone.

The Cape pigeons had just started laying eggs when we got to the island. On the first day, we only found two eggs, but by the fourth day after we arrived, we collected forty. These birds build a small, shallow nest using bits of stone.

The silver-grey or Southern Fulmar petrels were present in large numbers, especially about the steep north-eastern side of the island. Though they were mated, laying had scarcely commenced, as we found only two eggs. They made small grottoes in the snow-drifts, and many pairs were seen billing and cooing in such shelters.

The silver-grey or Southern Fulmar petrels were abundant, particularly on the steep northeastern side of the island. Although they were paired up, nesting had barely started, as we found only two eggs. They created small nests in the snowdrifts, and many couples were seen cuddling and cooing in these shelters.

The small Wilson petrels were found living in communities under slabs of rock, and Hoadley one afternoon thought he heard some young birds crying.

The small Wilson petrels were found living in groups under slabs of rock, and one afternoon Hoadley thought he heard some young birds calling.

Skua gulls were present in considerable force, notably near the penguin rookeries. They were breeding at the time, laying their eggs on the soil near the summit of the island. The neighbourhood of a nest was always betrayed by the behaviour of these birds who, when we intruded on them, came swooping down as if to attack us.

Skua gulls were plentiful, especially around the penguin nesting sites. They were in the breeding season, laying their eggs on the ground near the top of the island. You could always tell if there was a nest nearby by the way these birds acted; when we got too close, they would dive down as if they were going to attack us.

Although many snow petrels were seen flying about, we found only one with an egg. The nests were located in independent rocky niches but never in rookeries.

Although many snow petrels were seen flying around, we found only one with an egg. The nests were located in separate rocky niches but never in rookeries.

Vegetable life existed in the form of algae, in the pools, lichens on oversell rocks and mosses which grew luxuriantly, chiefly in the Adelie penguin rookeries.

Vegetable life existed as algae in the pools, lichens on rock surfaces, and mosses that grew abundantly, mainly in the Adelie penguin colonies.

Weddell seals were plentiful about the island near the tide-cracks; two of them with calves.

Weddell seals were abundant around the island near the tide cracks; two of them had pups.

Though the continuous bad weather made photography impossible, Hoadley was able to make a thorough geological examination of the locality. On December 2 the clouds cleared sufficiently for photography, and after securing some snapshots we prepared to move on the next day. Dovers built a small cairn on the summit of the island and took angles to the outlying rocks.

Though the ongoing bad weather made photography impossible, Hoadley managed to conduct a thorough geological survey of the area. On December 2, the clouds cleared enough for photography, and after taking some snapshots, we got ready to move on the next day. Dovers built a small cairn at the top of the island and took measurements to the surrounding rocks.

On the 3rd we packed our specimens and left for the mainland at 9.30 A.M., arriving at the land ice-cliffs at 2 P.M. The snow surface was soft, even slushy in places, and the heat amongst the bergs along the coast of the mainland was very oppressive. After we had dug out the second sledge and re-arranged the loads, the hour was too late for sledging, so Dovers took another observation in order to obtain the rate of the half-chronometer watch. While on the island, we had examined the coast to the west with glasses and concluded that the only way to get westward was to ascend to a considerable altitude on the ice-cap, which, as far as the eye could reach, descended to the sea-level in long cascades and falls. We had expected to place a depot somewhere near Haswell Island, but such procedure was now deemed inadvisable in view of its distance from what would probably be our direct return route.

On the 3rd, we packed our specimens and left for the mainland at 9:30 A.M., arriving at the icy cliffs by 2 P.M. The snow was soft and even slushy in places, and the heat among the icebergs along the mainland coast was really oppressive. After digging out the second sled and rearranging the loads, it was too late to go sledding, so Dovers took another reading to calculate the rate of the half-chronometer watch. While on the island, we had looked at the coast to the west through binoculars and concluded that the only way to head west was to climb to a high point on the ice cap, which, as far as we could see, sloped down to sea level in long cascades and waterfalls. We had hoped to set up a depot near Haswell Island, but that plan was now seen as unwise because of its distance from what would likely be our main return route.

A start was made next day against an opposing wind, the sledges being relayed up a steep hillside. Later on, however, a turn was made more to the west, and it was then possible to haul both sledges at the same time. The surface was soft, so that after every halt the runners had to be cleared. The distance for the day was five and a half miles, and the night's camp was at an altitude of about one thousand five hundred feet, located just above the broken coastal ice.

The next day, we started against a headwind, with the sledges being sent up a steep hill one at a time. However, later on, we turned more west, which allowed us to pull both sledges together. The ground was soft, so we had to clear the sled runners after every stop. We covered five and a half miles for the day, and we set up camp at around one thousand five hundred feet, just above the fractured coastal ice.

During December 5 and 6 a snowstorm raged and confined us to our tent. The high temperature caused the falling snow to melt as it touched the tent, and, when the temperature fell, the cloth became thickly coated with ice.

During December 5 and 6, a snowstorm hit us hard and trapped us in our tent. The warm temperature made the snow melt as it landed on the tent, and when the temperature dropped, the fabric got heavily coated in ice.

On the 7th the march was resumed, by skirting a small valley at an approximate altitude of two thousand feet. The ice-cap ahead descended in abrupt falls to the floe. Having a fair wind and a smooth surface, we made good headway. In the afternoon we ran into a plexus of crevasses, and the surface was traversed by high ridges. The snowbridges in many cases were weak and several gave way while the sledge was crossing them. A chasm about fifty feet deep and one hundred feet long was passed, evidently portion of a crevasse, one side of which had been raised. Later in the afternoon the surface became impassable and a detour to the south was rendered necessary. This difficulty arose near the head of the valley, in which situation the ice-cap fell in a series of precipitous terraces for about one thousand feet.

On the 7th, we resumed our march, skirting a small valley that was about two thousand feet high. The ice cap ahead dropped sharply to the floe. With a good wind and a smooth surface, we made great progress. In the afternoon, we encountered a network of crevasses, and the surface was marked by high ridges. Many of the snow bridges were weak, and several collapsed while the sledge was crossing them. We passed a chasm that was about fifty feet deep and one hundred feet long, clearly a part of a crevasse, one side of which had been raised. Later in the afternoon, the surface became impassable, and we had to make a detour to the south. This difficulty arose near the head of the valley, where the ice cap descended in a series of steep terraces for about one thousand feet.

At midday on the 8th we were compelled to continue the detour over a badly crevassed surface, ascending most of the time. On that night, camp was pitched again amongst crevasses. The sledge-meter showed only two miles one thousand one hundred yards for the afternoon, relaying having been necessary.

At noon on the 8th, we had to take a detour over a rough, crevassed terrain, mostly climbing. That night, we set up camp again among the crevasses. The sledge-meter recorded only two miles and one thousand one hundred yards for the afternoon, as we had to relay.

The sledges slipped along in the morning with a fresh breeze in their favour. The sky was covered with rapidly scudding, cirro-cumulus clouds which, by midday, quite obscured the sun, making surrounding objects and even the snow at our feet indistinguishable. After continuing for four and a half miles, we were forced to camp. In the afternoon a heavy snowstorm commenced and persisted throughout the following day.

The sledges moved smoothly in the morning with a nice breeze at their backs. The sky was filled with quickly moving cirro-cumulus clouds that, by midday, completely blocked the sun, making everything around us and even the snow at our feet hard to see. After going four and a half miles, we had to set up camp. In the afternoon, a heavy snowstorm began and lasted through the next day.

Though snow was still falling on the morning of the 11th, camp was broken at 10 A.M., and we moved off rapidly with a strong wind. During the morning the surface was gently undulating, but it mounted in a gradual ascent until nightfall. In the latter part of the afternoon the sun was clouded over, and steering had to be done by the aid of the wind. To the north we had a fine view of Drygalski's "High Land" (Drygalski Island), perceiving a distinct seaward ice-cliff of considerable height.

Though snow was still falling on the morning of the 11th, we packed up camp at 10 A.M. and set off quickly with a strong wind. During the morning, the surface was gently rolling, but it gradually sloped upward until nightfall. In the late afternoon, the sun was obscured by clouds, so we had to navigate using the wind. To the north, we had a clear view of Drygalski's "High Land" (Drygalski Island), seeing a noticeable ice cliff that was quite tall extending towards the sea.

As there were no prominences on the ice-cap that could be used for surveying marks, Dovers had considerable difficulty in keeping a reckoning of our course. The trouble was overcome by building snow-mounds and taking back-angles to them with the prismatic compass. At this juncture we were about ten miles from the shore and could see open water some thirty miles to the north. Frozen fast within the floe were great numbers of bergs.

As there were no noticeable features on the ice cap to use as survey markers, Dovers had a tough time keeping track of our course. We solved the problem by making snow mounds and taking back-angles to them with the prismatic compass. At this point, we were about ten miles from the shore and could see open water about thirty miles to the north. Immense icebergs were stuck fast in the floe.

We started off early on December 12 with the aid of a fair breeze over a good surface, so that both sledges were easily hauled along together. The course was almost due west, parallel to the coast. Open water came within a few miles of the ice-cliffs, and, farther north, a heavy belt of pack was observed. When the sun sank lower, the bergs on the northern horizon were refracted up to such a degree that they appeared to be hanging from the sky.

We set off early on December 12 with a nice breeze and a smooth surface, allowing both sledges to be pulled along together without difficulty. We traveled almost due west, alongside the coast. Open water was just a few miles from the ice cliffs, and further north, we saw a thick area of pack ice. As the sun lowered in the sky, the icebergs on the northern horizon were bent in such a way that they looked like they were floating in the sky.

The aid rendered by the sail under the influence of a fair breeze was well shown on the following day. In four hours, on a good surface, both sledges were transported seven miles. When we moved off, the wind was blowing at ten to fifteen miles an hour. By 10 A.M. the sky became overcast and the wind freshened. Camp was pitched for lunch at 11 A.M., as we hoped that the weather would clear again later, but the wind increased and snow began to fall heavily in the afternoon, so we did not stir. The storm continued throughout the following day and it was impossible to march until the 15th.

The help from the sail with a nice breeze was really clear the next day. In four hours, on a smooth surface, both sledges traveled seven miles. When we set off, the wind was blowing at ten to fifteen miles per hour. By 10 A.M., the sky got cloudy and the wind picked up. We set up camp for lunch at 11 A.M., hoping the weather would clear up later, but the wind got stronger and heavy snow started falling in the afternoon, so we stayed put. The storm went on throughout the next day, and we couldn’t march until the 15th.

Continuing the ascent on the 16th out of a valley we had crossed on the previous day, we halted on the top of a ridge within view of German "territory"—a small, dark object bearing due west, evidently bare rock and presumably Gaussberg. The course was altered accordingly towards this object and everything went smoothly for ten miles. Then followed an area where the ice fell steeply in waves to the sea, crossed by crevasses which averaged fifty feet in width. The snow-bridges were deeply concave, and the lower side of each chasm was raised into a ridge five to ten feet high. Making fast the alpine rope on to the sledges, one of us went ahead to test the bridge, and then the sledges, one at a time, were rushed down into the trough and up on the other side. After crossing ten or more crevasses in this fashion, we were forced to camp by the approach of a rapidly moving fog driven before a strong westerly wind. While camp was being prepared, it was discovered that a tin of kerosene on the front sledge had been punctured causing the loss of a gallon of fuel. Fortunately, we were well within our allowance, so the accident was not serious. Soon after tea our attention was drawn to a pattering on the tent like rain, caused by a fall of sago snow.

Continuing our climb on the 16th after crossing a valley the day before, we stopped at the top of a ridge where we could see German "territory"—a small, dark shape to the west that clearly looked like bare rock, presumably Gaussberg. We changed our course toward this object and everything went smoothly for ten miles. Then we encountered an area where the ice dropped steeply in waves down to the sea, with crevasses that were around fifty feet wide. The snow bridges were deeply concave, and the lower edges of each crevice were raised into ridges five to ten feet high. We secured the alpine rope to the sledges, and one of us went ahead to check the bridge before rushing the sledges down into the trough and back up on the other side. After crossing ten or more crevasses this way, we had to set up camp because a thick fog was rapidly approaching, pushed by a strong westerly wind. While we were getting the camp ready, we noticed that a tin of kerosene on the front sledge had been punctured, resulting in the loss of a gallon of fuel. Fortunately, we were still within our allowance, so it wasn't a serious issue. Shortly after tea, we heard a pattering on the tent that sounded like rain, which turned out to be sago snow falling.

In the morning the weather was clearer, and we saw that it was impossible to reach Gaussberg by a direct route. The ice ahead was cleft and split in all directions, and, in places, vertical faces stood up to a height of one hundred feet. The floe was littered with hundreds of bergs, and in several localities there were black spots which resembled small rocks, but it was impossible to approach close enough to be certain. Retracing the way out of the broken ice, we steered in a south-westerly direction, just above the line of serac and crevassed ice. The coast here trended to the south-west, forming the eastern side of Drygalski's Posadowsky Bay. The going was heavy, the surface being covered by a layer of frost-crystals deposited during the night. A fog came up again early in the afternoon and had quite surrounded us at camping time. During the day there were fine clouds of ice-crystals in the air, and at 8 P.M. a fog-bow was seen in the east.

In the morning, the weather was clearer, and we realized that there was no way to reach Gaussberg directly. The ice ahead was cracked and fractured in all directions, with vertical faces rising up to a height of one hundred feet in some places. The ice floe was scattered with hundreds of bergs, and in several areas, there were black spots that looked like small rocks, but it was impossible to get close enough to be sure. Backtracking through the broken ice, we headed southwest, just above the line of seracs and crevassed ice. The coastline here curving to the southwest formed the eastern side of Drygalski's Posadowsky Bay. The terrain was tough to navigate, covered with a layer of frost crystals that had formed overnight. A fog rolled in again early in the afternoon and completely surrounded us by the time we set up camp. Throughout the day, there were fine clouds of ice crystals in the air, and at 8 P.M., we spotted a fog bow in the east.

Turning out in the morning we saw Gaussberg peeping over a ridge to the west, but were still prevented from steering directly towards it by the broken surface. When we had advanced ten miles, a heavy fog brought us to a halt at 5 P.M.

Turning out in the morning, we saw Gaussberg peeking over a ridge to the west, but we were still unable to head straight towards it because of the rough terrain. After we had gone ten miles, a thick fog stopped us at 5 PM.

On Friday the 20th, in spite of a sticky surface, thirteen miles was covered on a west-south-west course. The ice-cap continued to be undulating but free of crevasses. The altitude was between two thousand five hundred and three thousand feet.

On Friday the 20th, despite a sticky surface, we traveled thirteen miles on a west-south-west route. The ice-cap remained bumpy but was clear of crevasses. The elevation ranged from two thousand five hundred to three thousand feet.

In the morning, after travelling two miles, we came in sight of Gaussberg again and steered directly towards it. The surface was good with a downward grade. At five and a quarter miles a depot was made of the small sledge and most of the food, in expectation of a clear run to the mountain. Not far ahead, however, were two broken-backed ridges intersecting the course, and a detour had to be made to the south to cross them higher up.

In the morning, after traveling two miles, we spotted Gaussberg again and headed straight towards it. The terrain was decent with a downward slope. At five and a quarter miles, we set down the small sled and most of the food, hoping for a clear path to the mountain. Not too far ahead, though, there were two broken ridges crossing our route, so we had to take a detour south to get over them higher up.

Midsummer's day, December 22, was spent in the tent, a move being impossible on account of the high wind. In the afternoon we walked ahead a short distance and reconnoitred six or seven crumpled ridges. Though the barometer had been falling ominously for twenty-four hours, the bad weather did not continue.

Midsummer's day, December 22, was spent in the tent since moving was impossible because of the strong wind. In the afternoon, we walked a short distance ahead and surveyed six or seven crumpled ridges. Even though the barometer had been dropping ominously for twenty-four hours, the bad weather didn’t persist.

Gaussberg was reached in the afternoon, after our track had passed through seventeen miles of dangerous country. For the first few miles the surface consisted of a series of steep, buckled ice-ridges; later, it was snow-covered, but at times literally cut into a network of crevasses.

Gaussberg was reached in the afternoon, after our path had gone through seventeen miles of treacherous terrain. For the first few miles, the surface was made up of steep, jagged ice ridges; later, it became snow-covered, but at times was literally crisscrossed by a network of crevasses.

The only approach to Gaussberg from the plateau is from the south. To the east and west there are magnificent ice-falls, the debris from which litters the floe for miles around.

The only way to get to Gaussberg from the plateau is from the south. To the east and west, there are stunning ice falls, and the debris from them spreads across the floe for miles.

December 24 and Christmas Day were devoted to examining the mountain. Dovers made a long series of observations for longitude, latitude and magnetic variation, while Hoadley examined the rocks and took photographs.

December 24 and Christmas Day were spent exploring the mountain. Dovers made extensive observations for longitude, latitude, and magnetic variation, while Hoadley studied the rocks and took photos.

On the southern side, the ice-cap abuts against this extinct volcano at an elevation of about four hundred feet above sea-level; the summit of the mountain rises another eight hundred feet. On the north, the rock descends to the floe. Gaussberg is pyramidal in shape, falling steeply, from a ridge at the summit. The sides are covered with a loose rubble of volcanic fragments, square yards of which commence to slide at the slightest disturbance. This renders climbing difficult and accounts for the large numbers of isolated blocks fringing the base.

On the southern side, the ice cap meets this extinct volcano at around four hundred feet above sea level; the mountain's peak rises another eight hundred feet. To the north, the rock slopes down to the ice floe. Gaussberg is pyramid-shaped and steeply drops from a ridge at the top. The sides are covered with loose volcanic rubble, which can start sliding with even the smallest disturbance. This makes climbing tough and explains the many isolated blocks scattered around the base.

At the summit two cairns were found, the bamboo poles which had previously marked them having blown over. Further examination revealed many other bamboos which had been used as marks, but no other record of the visit of the German expedition, ten years before, was met. Bird life was not plentiful, being limited to a few skuas, Wilson petrels and snow petrels; the latter nesting under slabs of rock. There were large quantities of moss where thaw-water had been running.

At the summit, two cairns were found, with the bamboo poles that had previously marked them blown over. A closer look revealed many other bamboos that had been used as markers, but no other records of the German expedition's visit from ten years ago were found. Birdlife was sparse, limited to a few skuas, Wilson's petrels, and snow petrels, the latter nesting under rocks. There were large amounts of moss where meltwater had been flowing.

The ice and snow near the mountain showed evidences of marked thawing, and we had difficulty in finding a favourable spot for our camp.

The ice and snow near the mountain showed clear signs of melting, and we had a hard time finding a good spot for our camp.

Christmas Day was gloriously fine, with just sufficient wind to counteract the heat of the sun. At midday the Christmas "hamper" was opened, and it was not long before the only sign of the plum-pudding was the tin. In the afternoon we ascended the mountain and left a record in a cairn at the top. By the route followed, Gaussberg was two hundred and fifteen miles from "The Grottoes" but relay work had made the actual distance covered three hundred miles.

Christmas Day was beautifully clear, with just enough wind to balance the sun's warmth. At noon, we opened the Christmas "hamper," and it didn't take long for the only trace of the plum pudding to be the tin it came in. In the afternoon, we climbed the mountain and left a mark in a stone pile at the top. By the path we took, Gaussberg was two hundred and fifteen miles from "The Grottoes," but the relay work made the actual distance traveled three hundred miles.

We had been away from home seven weeks, and, though there was sufficient food for an outward journey of another week, there was no indication that the country would change. Further, from the summit of Gaussberg one could see almost as far as could be marched in a week. Accordingly it was decided to commence our return on the 26th, making a course almost due east, thus cutting out numerous detours which had to be taken on the outward journey.

We had been away from home for seven weeks, and while there was enough food for another week of travel, there was no sign that the landscape would change. Furthermore, from the top of Gaussberg, you could see almost as far as we could march in a week. So, we decided to start our return on the 26th, heading almost straight east, which would eliminate many of the detours we had to take on the way out.

We left the mountain on December 26, pursuing a course to the south of our outward track so as to avoid some crevassed ridges. Ascending steadily against a continuous headwind, we picked up the second sledge at midday on the 28th.

We left the mountain on December 26, heading south of our original route to avoid some crevassed ridges. Climbing steadily into a constant headwind, we picked up the second sled at noon on the 28th.

Next day all the gear was transferred to one sledge and a course made direct to the Helen Glacier; the other sledge being abandoned.

Next day, all the gear was moved to one sled, and a path was set straight to the Helen Glacier; the other sled was left behind.

On December 31, after a day's blizzard, the surface was found to be covered with sastrugi of soft snow eighteen inches to two feet in depth. In crossing a wide crevasse, the sledge became bogged in the soft snow of a drift which had a deceptive appearance of solidity. It took us ten minutes to extricate ourselves, and, after this, crevasses were negotiated at a run.

On December 31, after a day of heavy snowstorm, the ground was found to be covered with soft sastrugi of snow, eighteen inches to two feet deep. When we tried to cross a wide crevasse, the sled got stuck in a soft snow drift that looked solid. It took us ten minutes to free ourselves, and after that, we approached crevasses at a run.

A violent blizzard raged during the following day—the first of the New Year 1913. This proved to be a blessing, for it made the surface more crisp and firm. In the morning the sun was obscured and nothing was visible but the snow at our feet, so that steering was very difficult. In the afternoon the sun broke through, a strong westerly wind sprang up and we moved along at a good pace, covering more than thirteen miles before camping.

A fierce blizzard hit on the first day of the New Year 1913. This turned out to be a blessing, as it made the ground more solid and firm. In the morning, the sun was hidden and all we could see was the snow at our feet, which made navigating really challenging. In the afternoon, the sun came out, a strong westerly wind picked up, and we moved quickly, covering over thirteen miles before setting up camp.

On January 3 the track bordered on the edge of the plateau, the surface being almost level, rising gently towards the south.

On January 3, the track ran along the edge of the plateau, the surface being nearly flat, sloping gently toward the south.

After a violent blizzard of three days' duration, which confined us in the tent, we continued on the same course for four days, averaging about eleven miles each day. The surface was good, but a strong south-easter blew practically all the time and reduced our speed considerably.

After a violent blizzard lasting three days that kept us trapped in the tent, we continued on the same route for four days, averaging about eleven miles each day. The ground was decent, but a strong southeast wind blew almost constantly, which slowed us down significantly.

At 10 A.M. on January 9, a fog-bank was observed in the east. This rapidly approached, and in fifteen minutes was quite close. There was now a splendid display of rings and arcs, caused apparently by minute ice-crystals which filled the air without obscuring the sun or sky. First an arc of prismatic colours appeared in the east, and in a few seconds the sky seemed literally to be covered with other arcs. At first they seemed to be scattered indiscriminately, but after a short time several arcs joined and we could discern a symmetrical arrangement. The sun was surrounded by a ring, the lower portion of which was broken by an inverted arc; two other arcs were visible on either side. A large ring appeared encircling the zenith, intersecting the first and passing through the sun. Two pairs of arcs were also seen, one pair in each ring. Excepting the arcs and ring about the zenith, which was grayish-white against the blue sky, the arcs showed prismatic colouring. The display lasted ten minutes and ended with the disappearance of the ice-crystals.

At 10 A.M. on January 9, a thick fog was seen in the east. It quickly moved closer, and in fifteen minutes it was right nearby. There was an amazing display of rings and arcs, likely caused by tiny ice crystals that filled the air without blocking the sun or the sky. First, an arc of rainbow colors appeared in the east, and within seconds, it looked like the sky was completely covered with other arcs. Initially, they seemed scattered randomly, but shortly after, several arcs connected, and we could see a more organized pattern. The sun was surrounded by a ring, with the lower part broken by an inverted arc; two other arcs were visible on either side. A large ring appeared around the zenith, crossing over the first and going through the sun. Two pairs of arcs were also observed, one pair in each ring. Other than the arcs and ring near the zenith, which was grayish-white against the blue sky, the other arcs displayed rainbow colors. The display lasted ten minutes and ended with the ice crystals disappearing.

[ILLUSTRATION IN TEXT]

[ILLUSTRATION IN TEXT]

The diagram shows the arrangement of the arcs:

The diagram shows how the arcs are arranged:

S = Sun. Z = Zenith.

S = Sun. Z = Zenith.

At A, B, C, mock suns could be seen.

At A, B, C, you could see fake suns.

From our camp on the night of January 10, broken country could be seen ahead. To the north, open water was visible, and to the north-east the Shackleton Shelf, so that we were nearing home at last. Here, a heavy snowstorm delayed us for two and a half days, and it was not till the afternoon of January 13 that we were able to move ahead.

From our camp on the night of January 10, we could see rough terrain ahead. To the north, there was open water, and to the northeast, the Shackleton Shelf, meaning we were finally close to home. However, a heavy snowstorm held us up for two and a half days, and it wasn't until the afternoon of January 13 that we could move forward.

The next day was dull, the sun being quite obscured; and the only check upon the steering was the south-easterly wind. At midday the thermometer registered 35 degrees F. in the shade, and the surface became quite sticky. After tea we walked ahead for a couple of hundred yards to the summit of a ridge where the full extent of the Helen Glacier was laid before us. It was evident that our position was some miles north of the true course, but, considering the absence of steering marks and the constant overcast weather, we considered ourselves lucky in being so close to it.

The next day was boring; the sun was mostly hidden, and the only thing affecting our direction was the southeast wind. At midday, the thermometer showed 35 degrees F. in the shade, and the ground became pretty sticky. After tea, we walked ahead for a couple of hundred yards to the top of a ridge where we could see the entire Helen Glacier. It was clear that we were a few miles north of the actual route, but with no steering markers and the ongoing cloudy weather, we felt fortunate to be that close.

The bad weather continued and snow fell during the following day. On the 16th the light was better, and we pushed into a strong wind which freshened to the force of a moderate gale before we had travelled two miles. Approaching a steep ascent we were compelled to camp. The morning brought an improvement, and the crossing of the Helen Glacier was commenced a mile or two above the outward course.

The bad weather kept going, and it snowed the next day. On the 16th, the light improved, and we battled a strong wind that picked up to a moderate gale before we had gone two miles. As we neared a steep hill, we had to set up camp. The next morning was better, and we started crossing the Helen Glacier about a mile or two above our previous route.

At midday on January 18, over treacherous ice, in the face of strong winds, we were making good headway towards Junction Corner. Almost daily for a fortnight a Wilson petrel had visited us, the only form of life seen on the return journey.

At noon on January 18, we were making good progress toward Junction Corner despite the dangerous ice and strong winds. Almost every day for two weeks, a Wilson petrel had come to visit us, the only sign of life we saw on the way back.

On the 19th we were not able to move until 8.80 P.M., when the wind, which had been blowing with the force of a gale, subsided. During the afternoon a magnificent view of the Helen Glacier was obtained, and in the west we could see Haswell Island and Drygalski Island.

On the 19th, we couldn't leave until 8:80 PM, when the wind, which had been blowing strongly like a gale, calmed down. In the afternoon, we got a stunning view of the Helen Glacier, and to the west, we could see Haswell Island and Drygalski Island.

Continuing on the same course, throughout the following day, we picked up the hut with the binoculars at 5 P.M. There now came a quick descent to Junction Corner.

Continuing on the same path, the next day, we spotted the hut with the binoculars at 5 PM. Then we quickly descended to Junction Corner.

On the lower levels there was clear evidence of thawing having occurred. The firm surface of snow which had been present on the outward journey was now converted into rough ice, over which we walked painfully in finnesko. Neve and ice surfaces were covered with sharp spicules, and the sides and bridges of crevasses were unmistakably thawed.

On the lower levels, there was clear evidence that thawing had taken place. The solid layer of snow that had been there on our way out was now turned into rough ice, which we trudged over painfully in our boots. The snow and ice surfaces were covered with sharp spikes, and the edges and ledges of crevasses were clearly thawed.

Leaving Junction Corner at 6 A.M., we steered a course for the hut, running parallel to the edge of the glacier. At 3 P.M. the mast was sighted, and, later, the hut itself. When within half a mile of "The Grottoes" we saw three figures on the floe and guessed that the eastern party had returned. In a few minutes greetings were heartily exchanged and they had welcomed us home.

Leaving Junction Corner at 6 A.M., we headed towards the hut, moving alongside the glacier's edge. At 3 P.M. we spotted the mast, and later, the hut itself. When we got within half a mile of "The Grottoes," we noticed three figures on the ice and figured the eastern party had come back. In just a few minutes, we warmly exchanged greetings, and they welcomed us home.

Instructions had been given that the Western Base should be in readiness to embark on the 'Aurora' not later than January 30, 1913.

Instructions had been issued that the Western Base should be ready to board the 'Aurora' no later than January 30, 1913.

When Wild's party had arrived, preparations for departure were immediately made. Geological and biological collections were packed, stores were sorted out and cases containing personal gear were sledged to the edge of the glacier.

When Wild's group arrived, they quickly started getting ready to leave. They packed up geological and biological collections, sorted through supplies, and sledged personal gear cases to the edge of the glacier.

Harrisson contrived a winch for sounding and fishing. Fourteen-gauge copper wire was wound on it and, through a crack in the sea-ice a quarter of a mile from the glacier, bottom was reached in two hundred and sixty fathoms. As the water was too deep for dredging, Harrisson manufactured cage-traps and secured some fish, a squid, and other specimens.

Harrisson designed a winch for measuring depths and fishing. Fourteen-gauge copper wire was wrapped around it, and through a crack in the sea ice a quarter of a mile from the glacier, they reached the bottom at two hundred and sixty fathoms. Since the water was too deep for dredging, Harrisson created cage traps and caught some fish, a squid, and other samples.

At this time there was abundant evidence of life. Skua gulls frequently flew about the hut, as well as Cape pigeons, Antarctic, snow, Wilson, giant and silver-grey petrels. Out on the sea-ice, there were Adelie and Emperor penguins; the latter moulting. Hundreds of seals were seen with glasses on the edge of the floe, ten miles to the north.

At this time, there was plenty of evidence of life. Skua gulls often flew around the hut, along with Cape pigeons, Antarctic petrels, snow petrels, Wilson's petrels, giant petrels, and silver-grey petrels. Out on the sea ice, there were Adelie and Emperor penguins, the latter of which were molting. Hundreds of seals were spotted lounging on the edge of the floe, ten miles to the north.

On the whole, January was a very fine month. Some of the days seemed really hot; the shade temperature on one occasion reaching 37 degrees F., and, in several instances, 33 degrees F. It was quite a common thing for a man to work outside in loose, light garments; in fact, with nothing more than a singlet on the upper part of the body.

Overall, January was a really nice month. Some days felt pretty hot; the shaded temperature once hit 37 degrees F., and there were several times it reached 33 degrees F. It was quite normal for someone to work outside in loose, light clothing; in fact, many people wore just a tank top on their upper body.

On January 26, while Kennedy took observations, Wild and the others went for a walk towards the open water. The surface was very rough and broken by leads, along which Weddell seals lay in great numbers. Three miles of ice were found to have drifted out, reducing the northern expanse to seven miles.

On January 26, while Kennedy was taking measurements, Wild and the others went for a walk toward the open water. The surface was really rough and broken by leads, where a lot of Weddell seals were lying. They found that three miles of ice had drifted away, reducing the northern area to seven miles.

In view of the possibility of the 'Aurora' not relieving them, the party went through their food-supplies, finding that these were sufficient for another year, with the exception of meat. With regard to coal, two tons of briquettes remained, which, augmented by good stock of seal-blubber, would provide sufficient fuel.

In light of the chance that the 'Aurora' might not reach them, the group went through their food supplies, discovering they had enough for another year, except for meat. As for coal, there were two tons of briquettes left, which, combined with a good supply of seal blubber, would provide enough fuel.

Laying in a store of seals' flesh and blubber now became the principal work, and every fine day saw a party out with a sledge. Unfortunately, the nearest crack on the sea-ice was nearly two miles away, so that the return journey, with a heavily laden sledge, was long and tedious. Two holes were dug in the glacier near the hut, one for blubber and the other for meat.

Laying in a supply of seals' flesh and blubber became the main task, and every nice day saw a group heading out with a sled. Unfortunately, the closest opening in the sea ice was almost two miles away, making the return trip with a heavily loaded sled long and tiring. Two holes were dug in the glacier near the hut, one for blubber and the other for meat.

On January 31 six miles of sea-ice still remained, and, if the ship had arrived to time, a good deal of sledging would have been required to transport all the gear aboard.

On January 31, six miles of sea ice still remained, and if the ship had arrived on time, a lot of sledging would have been needed to transport all the gear aboard.

In February, the weather altered for the worse, and there was not a single fine day until the 20th. A strong east-southeast wind with falling snow prevailed. As the days were shortening rapidly, all were beginning to feel anxious about the 'Aurora'.

In February, the weather took a turn for the worse, and there wasn't a single nice day until the 20th. A strong east-southeast wind with falling snow was dominating. As the days were getting shorter quickly, everyone was starting to feel anxious about the 'Aurora'.

Wild erected a flagstaff on the highest ice-pinnacle near "The Grottoes" and flew a large flag on it whenever the wind moderated. On the 16th, a lamp-screen and reflector were fitted at the mast-head and each night a hurricane lamp was placed there, which could be seen eight miles with the naked eye.

Wild set up a flagpole on the tallest ice peak near "The Grottoes" and raised a big flag on it whenever the wind calmed down. On the 16th, a lampshade and reflector were installed at the top of the mast, and each night a hurricane lamp was placed there, visible from eight miles away to the naked eye.

On the 20th Dovers and Wild made a large signboard, taking it out to a prominent point on the glacier, three and a half miles to the north. It was lashed to a bamboo pole with a flag flying on it. The open water was then only three miles distant.

On the 20th, Dovers and Wild created a large signboard and brought it to a noticeable spot on the glacier, three and a half miles to the north. It was tied to a bamboo pole with a flag waving on it. The open water was just three miles away.

Wild writes:

Wild posts:

"The 22nd February was the anniversary of the day the 'Aurora' left us, but the weather was very different. A heavy blizzard was raging, the wind's velocity ranging up to eighty miles per hour. As it was Saturday, we kept the usual routine, scrubbing out and cleaning up the hut. We could not help speculating as to whether we should have to do it for another whole year. But every one had great faith in 'good old Davis,' and nobody was at all downhearted.

"The 22nd of February marked the anniversary of the day the 'Aurora' departed, but the weather was completely different. A severe blizzard was raging, with wind speeds reaching up to eighty miles per hour. Since it was Saturday, we stuck to our usual routine of scrubbing and cleaning the hut. We couldn’t help but wonder if we’d have to keep doing this for another entire year. But everyone had strong faith in 'good old Davis,' and no one was really feeling down."

"When we 'turned out' on Sunday there was still a strong wind and drift, but this died away to a light breeze before breakfast was over, and the sun came out. I had a look round with the glasses and saw that the ice had broken away beyond a limit of one and a half miles. As there was a sledge, which Harrisson had been using for sounding, within a few yards of the water's edge, Jones and I went off to bring it in. We had gone less than half a mile when we saw what at first appeared to be a penguin, standing on some pack-ice in the distance, but which we soon saw was the mast-head of the 'Aurora'.

"When we headed out on Sunday, the wind was still strong and there was some drifting snow, but that calmed down to a light breeze before we finished breakfast, and then the sun came out. I took a look around with the binoculars and saw that the ice had broken up about a mile and a half out. Since there was a sled that Harrisson had been using for sounding just a few yards from the water's edge, Jones and I went to bring it in. We had gone less than half a mile when we spotted what at first seemed to be a penguin standing on some pack ice in the distance, but we quickly realized it was actually the mast of the 'Aurora'."

"It was evident that she could not be alongside for some time, so Jones went back to the hut to tell the others to bring down a load of gear, and I went on to meet the ship. Before the 'Aurora' had reached the fast ice, all the party were down with two sledge loads, having covered the mile and a half in record time.

"It was clear that she wouldn't be able to join us for a while, so Jones went back to the hut to tell the others to bring down some gear, and I continued on to meet the ship. By the time the 'Aurora' reached the fast ice, everyone had arrived with two sled loads, having covered the mile and a half in record time."

"We were all anxious, of course, for news, and the first we received was the sad account of the deaths of Ninnis and Mertz; then of the wonderful march made by Dr. Mawson.

"We were all anxious, of course, for news, and the first we got was the sad report of the deaths of Ninnis and Mertz; then about the incredible journey made by Dr. Mawson."

"Before closing, I should like to pay a tribute to the good-fellowship, unfailing industry, enthusiasm and unswerving loyalty which characterized my comrades. During the whole of the Expedition, whether carrying out monotonous routine work at the Base or under the trying conditions of sledging, all duties were performed with never-failing good temper and perseverance.

"Before wrapping up, I want to acknowledge the camaraderie, constant hard work, enthusiasm, and unwavering loyalty shown by my teammates. Throughout the entire Expedition, whether doing repetitive tasks at the Base or facing the challenging conditions of sledding, everyone executed their duties with consistent good humor and determination."

"Should it ever be my lot to venture on a like expedition I hope to have some, if not all, of the same party with me. But whether we meet again or not, I shall always think of every man of them with the greatest affection and respect."

"If I ever get the chance to go on a similar adventure, I hope to have some, if not all, of the same group with me. But whether we meet again or not, I will always remember each one of them with the deepest affection and respect."





CHAPTER XXIII A SECOND WINTER

During the first busy year in Adelie Land, when the Hut was full of life and work, there were few moments for reflection. Yet, over the speculative pipe at home after a successful day's labour on the wireless masts, or out on the turbulent plateau when the hour of hoosh brought the strenuous day to a close, more than one man was heard to say, "One year in this country is enough for me." Still, in the early days, no one could predict what would happen, and therefore a change in the perverse climate was always considered probable. So great was the emulation, and so keen were all to extend our geographical boundaries, that the year sped away almost before the meagre opportunity came. With the cheery support of numbers, we did not find it a difficult matter "to drive dull care away."

During the first hectic year in Adelie Land, when the Hut was buzzing with activity, there were few chances to pause and reflect. Yet, after a successful day working on the wireless masts, whether gathered around a speculative drink at home or on the windy plateau when it was time for hoosh, more than one person would say, "One year in this place is enough for me." Still, in those early days, no one could foresee what would happen next, and so a change in the unpredictable weather always seemed likely. Everyone was so eager to push our boundaries that the year flew by almost before we had the chance to take stock. With the cheerful support of our team, we found it easy to chase away any gloom.

Now there were only seven of us; we knew what was ahead; the weather had already given ample proof of the early approach of winter; the field of work which once stretched to the west, east and south had no longer the mystery of the "unknown"; the Ship had gone and there was scant hope of relief in March.

Now there were only seven of us; we knew what was coming; the weather had already shown clear signs that winter was arriving early; the area we once worked in to the west, east, and south no longer held the mystery of the "unknown"; the Ship was gone, and there was little hope of help in March.

Against all this. There remained the Hut—a proven shelter from the wind; and, most vital of all, there was abundant food for another year. Every avenue of scientific work was not yet closed. Even the routine of meteorological and magnetic work was adding in no slight degree to the sum of human knowledge. Our short mile of rocks still held some geological secrets, and there were biological discoveries yet to make. A wireless telegraphic station had at last been established, and we could confidently expect communication with the outside world at an early date. These were some of the obvious assurances which no one had the heart to think about at first; and then there was always our comradeship, most enduring of all.

Against all this, there was the Hut—a reliable shelter from the wind; and, most importantly, there was plenty of food for another year. Not every path of scientific research was closed off yet. Even the routine work in meteorology and magnetism was contributing significantly to human knowledge. Our short stretch of rocks still held some geological secrets, and there were biological discoveries waiting to be made. A wireless telegraphic station had finally been set up, and we could expect communication with the outside world soon. These were some of the clear reassurances that no one wanted to think about at first; and then there was always our camaraderie, the most enduring of all.

February, during 1912, was a tolerable month with a fair proportion of sunny, moderately calm days. A year later, the first eight days of this month were signalized by the blizzard in which the 'Aurora' had such a perilous experience. While the winter began in 1912 with the advent of March, now in 1913 it came on definitely in early February. Autumn was a term which applied to a few brilliant days which would suddenly intervene in the dense rack of drift-snow.

February 1912 was an okay month with a decent amount of sunny, fairly calm days. A year later, the first eight days of this month were marked by the blizzard where the 'Aurora' had such a dangerous experience. While winter started in 1912 with the arrival of March, in 1913 it definitely began in early February. Autumn referred to a few bright days that would suddenly break through the thick blanket of snow drifts.

We set to work to make the Hut, if anything, safer and snugger. Bage put finishing touches to the break-wind of rock and cases, and with Hodgeman and McLean nailed battens of wood over a large sheet of canvas which had been stretched across the windward side of the roof, overlapping rolls of black paper, scraps of canvas and bagging, which were also battened down to make the eastern and western faces more air-tight.

We got to work to make the Hut safer and cozier. Bage added the finishing touches to the windbreak made of rocks and crates, and with Hodgeman and McLean, nailed wooden battens over a large piece of canvas that had been stretched across the windward side of the roof. They also secured overlapping rolls of black paper, scraps of canvas, and bags to make the eastern and western sides more airtight.

Before the Ship left us, the remaining coal briquettes had been dug out of a bed of ice and carefully piled on a high point of the rocks. Round them all the spare timber and broken cases were gathered to provide sufficient fuel for the ensuing winter. The penguins' eggs, which had been stored in boxes, were stacked together on the windward side of the Hut, and a choice selection of steaks of seal and penguin for our own use were at the storeman's disposal in the veranda.

Before the ship left us, the leftover coal briquettes were dug out of a bed of ice and carefully piled on a high point of the rocks. Surrounding them, all the spare timber and broken crates were gathered to provide enough fuel for the upcoming winter. The penguin eggs, which had been stored in boxes, were stacked together on the windward side of the hut, and a select variety of seal and penguin steaks for our use were available to the storeman on the veranda.

Madigan, in addition to his meteorological duties, took charge of the new sledging-dogs which had been presented by Captain Amundsen. A good many seals had been already killed, and a big cache of meat and blubber was made alongside the Hut to last throughout the winter.

Madigan, along with his weather duties, was in charge of the new sled dogs that Captain Amundsen had given them. Several seals had already been hunted, and there was a large supply of meat and blubber stored next to the Hut to last through the winter.

Bickerton found many odd jobs to occupy his time in connexion with the petrol-engine and the wireless installations. He was also busied with the anemometer, which had broken down and needed a strong start for its second year of usefulness.

Bickerton took on various odd jobs to keep himself occupied with the petrol engine and the wireless setups. He was also busy with the anemometer, which had broken down and needed a solid reboot for its second year of functionality.

Bage, following the parting instructions of Webb, became the owner of the Magnetograph House and the Absolute Hut, continuing to keep the magnetic records. As storeman, Bage looked after the food-supplies. The canvas coverings had made the veranda drift-tight, so the storeman could arrange his tins and cases on the shelves with some degree of comfort, and the daily task of shovelling out snow was now at an end. Further, Hodgeman and he built an annex out of spare timber to connect the entrance veranda with the store. This replaced the old snow-tunnel which had melted away, and, when completed and padded outside with old mattresses, was facetiously styled the "North-West Passage." The only thing which later arose to disturb the composure of the storeman was the admission of the dogs to a compartment in the veranda on the eastern side. His constant care then became a heap of mutton carcases which the dogs in passing or during the occasional escapades from their shelter were always eager to attack.

Bage, following Webb's parting instructions, became the owner of the Magnetograph House and the Absolute Hut, continuing to maintain the magnetic records. As the storeman, Bage took care of the food supplies. The canvas coverings had made the veranda drift-proof, allowing the storeman to arrange his cans and boxes on the shelves with some comfort, and the daily chore of shoveling out snow was now over. Additionally, Hodgeman and he built an extension out of spare wood to connect the entrance veranda with the store. This replaced the old snow tunnel that had melted away and, when finished and padded outside with old mattresses, was humorously called the "North-West Passage." The only issue that later disturbed the storeman's peace was the dogs being allowed into a part of the veranda on the eastern side. His constant worry then became a pile of mutton carcasses that the dogs were always eager to attack, whether they were passing by or during the occasional escape from their shelter.

Hodgeman helped to change the appearance of the living-hut by cutting the table in two and, since there was now plenty of room, by putting in more shelves for a larder on which the storeman displayed his inviting wares to the cook, who could think of nothing original for the next meal.

Hodgeman helped to change the look of the living-hut by cutting the table in half and, since there was now plenty of space, adding more shelves for a pantry where the storeman showcased his tempting goods for the cook, who couldn't think of anything new for the next meal.

McLean undertook the duties of ice-cutting and coal-carrying throughout the year, kept the biological log and assisted in general observations. He also sent off sealed messages in bottles, regularly, on the chance of their being picked up on the high seas, thereby giving some indication of the direction of currents.

McLean took on the tasks of ice-cutting and carrying coal all year round, kept the biological log, and helped with general observations. He also regularly sent sealed messages in bottles, hoping they would be found at sea, which would provide some indication of the currents' direction.

Jeffryes was occupied regularly every night listening attentively for wireless signals and calling at intervals. The continuous winds soon caused many of the wire stays of the main wireless mast to become slack, and these Jeffryes pulled taut on his daily rounds.

Jeffryes spent every night focused on listening for wireless signals and making calls at different times. The constant winds quickly made many of the wire stays of the main wireless mast loose, and Jeffryes tightened them during his daily rounds.

Looking back and forward, we could not but feel that the sledging programme of the previous summer had been so comprehensive that the broad features of the land were ascertained over a wide radius; beyond what we, with our weakened resources of the second year, could reach. The various observations we were carrying on were adding to the value of the scientific results, but we could not help feeling disappointed that our lot was not cast in a new and more clement region.

Looking back and ahead, we couldn't help but feel that last summer's sledging program had been so thorough that the main features of the land were identified over a large area; beyond what we, with our reduced resources in the second year, could access. The different observations we were conducting were enhancing the value of the scientific results, but we couldn't shake the disappointment that we weren't assigned to a new and more favorable region.

It was to be a dreary and difficult time for the five men who had volunteered to remain behind in order to make a thorough search for myself and comrades. They were men whom I had learned to appreciate during the first year, and I now saw their sterling characters in a new light. To Jeffryes all was fresh, and we envied him the novelties of a new world, rough and inhospitable though it was. As for me, it was sufficient to feel that

It was going to be a tough and challenging time for the five men who had volunteered to stay behind to conduct a thorough search for me and my comrades. They were men I had come to appreciate over the first year, and now I saw their true characters in a new way. Everything was new for Jeffryes, and we envied him the excitement of experiencing a new world, no matter how rough and unfriendly it was. As for me, it was enough to feel that

  ...He that tossed thee down into the Field,
     He knows about it all—He knows, He knows.
  ...The one who threw you down into the field,  
     He knows everything about it—all of it—He knows, He knows.

On the night of February 15, Jeffryes suddenly surprised us with the exciting intelligence that he had heard Macquarie Island send a coded weather report to Hobart. The engine was immediately set going, but though repeated attempts were made, no answer could be elicited. Each night darkness was more pronounced and signals became more distinct, until, on the 20th, our call reached Sawyer at Macquarie Island, who immediately responded by saying "Good evening." The insulation of a Leyden jar broke down at this point, and nothing more could be done until it was remedied.

On the night of February 15, Jeffryes suddenly surprised us with the exciting news that he had heard Macquarie Island send a coded weather report to Hobart. The engine was immediately started, but despite repeated attempts, we couldn't get a response. Each night, the darkness deepened and the signals got clearer, until, on the 20th, our call made it to Sawyer at Macquarie Island, who promptly replied, "Good evening." At that point, the insulation of a Leyden jar broke down, and nothing more could be done until it was fixed.

At last, on February 21, signals were exchanged, and by the 23rd a message had been dispatched to Lord Denman, Governor-General of the Commonwealth, acquainting him with our situation and the loss of our comrades and, through him, one to his Majesty the King requesting his royal permission to name a tract of newly discovered country to the east, "King George V Land." Special messages were also sent to the relatives of Lieutenant B. E. S. Ninnis and Dr. X. Mertz.

At last, on February 21, signals were exchanged, and by the 23rd, a message had been sent to Lord Denman, Governor-General of the Commonwealth, informing him of our situation and the loss of our comrades. Through him, we also sent a message to His Majesty the King, requesting royal permission to name a newly discovered area to the east "King George V Land." Special messages were also sent to the families of Lieutenant B. E. S. Ninnis and Dr. X. Mertz.

The first news received from the outside world was the bare statement that Captain Scott and four of his companions had perished on their journey to the South Pole. It was some time before we knew the tragic details which came home, direct and poignant, to us in Adelie Land.

The first news we got from the outside world was the simple fact that Captain Scott and four of his companions had died on their journey to the South Pole. It took a while before we learned the heartbreaking details that reached us, direct and emotional, in Adelie Land.

To Professor David a fuller account of our own calamity was sent and, following this, many kind messages of sympathy and congratulation were received from all over the world. On February 26 Lord Denman sent an acknowledgment of our message to him, expressing his sorrow at the loss of our two companions; and on March 7 his Majesty the King added his gracious sympathy, with permission to affix the name, King George V Land, to that part of the Antarctic continent lying between Adelie Land and Oates Land.

To Professor David, a detailed report of our tragedy was sent, and after that, we received many kind messages of sympathy and congratulations from all over the world. On February 26, Lord Denman acknowledged our message, conveying his sadness over the loss of our two companions. Then, on March 7, His Majesty the King expressed his gracious sympathy and permitted us to name the part of the Antarctic continent between Adelie Land and Oates Land as King George V Land.

On February 23 there was a spell of dead calm; heavy nimbus clouds and fog lowering over sea and plateau. Fluffy grains of sago snow fell most of the day, covering the dark rocks and the blue glacier. A heaving swell came in from the north, and many seals landed within the boat harbour, where a high tide lapped over the ice-foot. The bergs and islands showed pale and shadowy as the snow ceased or the fog lifted. Then the wind arose and blew hard from the east-south-east for a day, swinging round with added force to its old quarter—south-by-east.

On February 23, there was a complete stillness; thick clouds and fog hung low over the sea and plateau. Fluffy bits of sago snow fell throughout the day, covering the dark rocks and the blue glacier. A rolling swell came in from the north, and many seals made their way ashore within the boat harbor, where high tide washed over the ice edge. The icebergs and islands appeared pale and shadowy as the snow stopped or the fog lifted. Then the wind picked up, blowing strongly from the east-southeast for a day, before shifting with even more force back to its original direction—south-by-east.

March began in earnest with much snow and monotonous days of wind. By contrast, a few hours of sunny calm were appreciated to the full. The face of the landscape changed; the rocky crevices filling flush with the low mounds of snow which trailed along and off the ridges.

March kicked off in full force with plenty of snow and endless windy days. On the other hand, a few hours of sunny stillness were truly valued. The scenery transformed; the rocky cracks filled up smoothly with the low piles of snow that drifted along and off the ridges.

On March 16 every one was relieved to hear that the 'Aurora' had arrived safely in Hobart, and that Wild and his party were all well. But the news brought disappointment too, for we had always a lingering ray of hope that there might be sufficient coal to bring the vessel back to Adelie Land. Later on we learned that on account of the shortage of funds the Ship was to be laid up at Hobart until the following summer. In the meantime, Professors David and Masson were making every effort to raise the necessary money. In this they were assisted by Captain Davis, who went to London to obtain additional donations.

On March 16, everyone was relieved to hear that the 'Aurora' had arrived safely in Hobart and that Wild and his team were all okay. But the news also brought disappointment because we always held onto a slim hope that there might be enough coal to bring the ship back to Adelie Land. Later, we found out that due to a lack of funds, the ship would be docked in Hobart until the next summer. In the meantime, Professors David and Masson were doing everything they could to raise the necessary money. They were supported by Captain Davis, who went to London to get additional donations.

It was now a common thing for those of us who had gone to bed before midnight to wake up in the morning and find that quite a budget of wireless messages had been received. It took the place of a morning paper and we made the most of the intelligence, discussing it from every possible point of view. Jeffryes and Bickerton worked every night from 8 P.M. until 1 A.M., calling at short intervals and listening attentively at the receiver. In fact, notes were kept of the intensity of the signals, the presence of local atmospheric electrical discharges—"static"—or intermittent sounds due to discharges from snow particles—St. Elmo's fire—and, lastly, of interference in the signals transmitted. The latter phenomenon should lead to interesting deductions, for we had frequent evidence to show that the wireless waves were greatly impeded or completely abolished during times of auroral activity.

It was now common for those of us who went to bed before midnight to wake up in the morning and find that quite a lot of wireless messages had been received. This took the place of a morning paper, and we made the most of the information, discussing it from every possible angle. Jeffryes and Bickerton worked every night from 8 P.M. until 1 A.M., calling at short intervals and listening closely to the receiver. In fact, notes were kept on the intensity of the signals, the presence of local atmospheric electrical discharges—"static"—or intermittent sounds caused by discharges from snow particles—St. Elmo's fire—and, finally, interference in the transmitted signals. The latter phenomenon could lead to interesting conclusions, as we often had evidence showing that the wireless waves were significantly hindered or completely blocked during periods of auroral activity.

Listening at the wireless receiver must have been very tedious and nerve-racking work, as so many adventitious sounds had to be neglected. There was, first of all, the noise of the wind as it swept by the Hut; then there was the occasional crackling of "St. Elmo's fire"; the dogs in the veranda shelter were not always remarkable for their quietness; while within the Hut it was impossible to avoid slight sounds which were often sufficient to interrupt the sequence of a message. At times, when the aurora was visible, signals would often die away, and the only alternative was to wait until they recurred, meanwhile keeping up calls at regular intervals in case the ether was not "blocked." So Jeffryes would sometimes spend the whole evening trying to transmit a single message, or, conversely, trying to receive one. By experience it was found easier to transmit and receive wireless messages between certain hours in the evening, while not infrequently, during the winter months, a whole week would go by and nothing could be done. During such a period auroral displays were usually of nightly occurrence. Then a "freak night" would come along and business would be brisk at both terminals.

Listening at the radio receiver must have been really boring and stressful, since so many random sounds had to be ignored. First, there was the wind noise sweeping past the Hut; then there was the occasional crackling of "St. Elmo's fire"; the dogs on the veranda weren't always very quiet; and inside the Hut, there were little noises that often interrupted the flow of a message. Sometimes, when the aurora was visible, signals would drop out, and the only option was to wait for them to come back, while keeping up calls at regular intervals in case the ether wasn’t "blocked." So, Jeffryes would sometimes spend the whole evening trying to send a single message or, on the flip side, trying to receive one. Through experience, it was found easier to send and receive radio messages during certain hours in the evening, and it wasn't uncommon during the winter months for an entire week to go by without being able to do anything. During such times, auroral displays usually occurred nightly. Then a "freak night" would come along and things would get busy at both ends.

It was often possible for Jeffryes to "hear" Wellington, Sydney, Melbourne and Hobart, and once he managed to communicate directly with the last-named. Then there were numerous ships passing along the southern shores of Australia or in the vicinity of New Zealand whose "calls" were audible on "good nights." The warships were at times particularly distinct, and occasionally the "chatter in the ether" was so confusing that Sawyer, at Macquarie Island, would signal that he was "jammed."

It was often possible for Jeffryes to "hear" Wellington, Sydney, Melbourne, and Hobart, and once he even managed to communicate directly with Hobart. There were also many ships passing along the southern shores of Australia or nearby New Zealand whose "calls" could be heard on "good nights." The warships were sometimes especially clear, and occasionally the "chatter in the ether" became so chaotic that Sawyer, at Macquarie Island, would signal that he was "jammed."

The "wireless" gave us another interest in life, and plenty of outside occupation when the stays became loose or an accident occurred. It served to relieve some of the tedium of that second year:

The "wireless" gave us another interest in life and plenty of outside activity when the stays got loose or something happened. It helped break up some of the boredom of that second year:

    Day after day the same
    Only a little worse.
    Day after day the same  
    Just a bit worse.

On March 13 there was a tremendous fall of snow, and worst "pea-souper" we had had during the previous year. Next day everything was deluged, and right up the glacier there were two-foot drifts, despite a sixty-mile wind.

On March 13, there was a huge snowfall, the worst "pea-souper" we had seen in the past year. The next day everything was flooded, and up the glacier there were two-foot drifts, even with a sixty-mile wind.

It was very interesting to follow the changes which occurred from day to day. First of all, under the flail of the incessant wind, a crust would form on the surface of the snow of the type we knew as "piecrust," when out sledging. It was never strong enough to bear a man, but the sledge-runners would clear it fairly well if the load were not too heavy. Next day the crust would be etched, and small flakes and pellets would be carried away until the snow was like fleece. Assuming that the wind kept up (which it always did) long, shallow concavities would now be scooped out as the "lobules" of the fleece were carried away piecemeal. These concavities became deeper, hour by hour and day by day, becoming at last the troughs between the crests of the snow-waves or sastrugi. All this time the surface would be gradually hardening and, if the sun chanced to shine for even a few hours every day, a shining glaze would gradually form on the long, bevelled mounds. It was never a wise thing to walk on these polished areas in finnesko and this fact was always learnt by experience.

It was really fascinating to watch the changes that happened day by day. First, with the constant wind blowing, a crust would form on the snow surface, which we called "piecrust" when we were sledding. It was never strong enough to support a person, but the sledge runners would slide over it fairly well if the load wasn't too heavy. The next day, the crust would be etched, and small flakes and pellets would be blown away until the snow looked like fleece. Assuming the wind kept up (which it always did), long, shallow dips would start to appear as the “lobules” of the fleece were carried off bit by bit. These dips got deeper hour by hour and day by day, eventually becoming the troughs between the peaks of the snow drifts or sastrugi. During all this time, the surface would gradually harden, and if the sun happened to shine for even a few hours each day, a shiny glaze would slowly form on the long, sloped mounds. It was never a smart idea to walk on these polished areas in finnesko, and that was a lesson learned through experience.

Above the Hut, where the icy slopes fell quickly to the sea, the snow would lie for a few days at the very most, but, lower down, where the glacier ran almost level for a short distance to the harbour ice, the drifts would lie for months at the mercy of the wind, furrowed and cut into miniature canyons; wearing away in fragments until the blue ice showed once more, clear and wind-swept.

Above the Hut, where the icy slopes dropped sharply to the sea, the snow would stick around for only a few days at most. But further down, where the glacier ran almost flat for a short stretch to the harbor ice, the snowdrifts would last for months, shaped and carved by the wind into tiny canyons; eroding in chunks until the blue ice became visible again, clear and wind-blown.

Towards the end of March the wind gave a few exhibitions of its power, which did not augur well for the maximum periods of the winter. A few diary jottings are enough to show this:

Towards the end of March, the wind showed its strength a few times, which didn’t promise good things for the last parts of winter. A few notes from the diary are enough to illustrate this:

"March 23. During the previous night the wind steadily rose to an eighty-mile 'touch' and upwards. It was one of those days when it is a perpetual worry to be outside.

"March 23. Last night, the wind consistently picked up to an eighty-mile 'touch' and more. It was one of those days when being outside was a constant source of worry."

"March 24. Doing at least seventy miles per hour during the morning. About 8 P.M. there was a temporary lull and a rise of.15 in the barometer. Now, 9.30 P.M., it is going 'big guns.' The drift is fairly thick and snow is probably falling.

"March 24. Traveling at least seventy miles an hour in the morning. Around 8 P.M., there was a brief break and a rise of .15 in the barometer. Now, at 9:30 P.M., it's really coming down. The snowfall is pretty heavy, and snow is likely falling."

"March 25. Much the same as yesterday.

"March 25. Pretty much the same as yesterday."

"March 28. In a seventy-five-mile wind, Hodgeman had several fingers frost-bitten this morning while attending to the anemograph.

"March 28. In a seventy-five-mile wind, Hodgeman had several fingers frostbitten this morning while checking the anemograph."

"March 29. It was quite sunny when we opened the trap-door, though it blew about sixty miles per hour with light drift.

"March 29. It was really sunny when we opened the trapdoor, even though it was blowing about sixty miles per hour with a light drift."

"March 30. The wind is doing itself full justice. About 8 P.M. it ranged between ninety-five and one hundred miles per hour, and now the whole hut is tremulous and the stove-pipe vibrates so that the two large pots on the stove rattle."

"March 30. The wind is really showing its strength. Around 8 P.M., it hit speeds between ninety-five and one hundred miles per hour, and now the whole hut is shaking, making the stove-pipe vibrate so much that the two big pots on the stove rattle."

At the beginning of April, McLean laid the foundations of The Adelie Blizzard which recorded our life for the next seven months. It was a monthly publication, and contributions were invited from all on every subject but the wind. Anything from light doggerel to heavy blank verse was welcomed, and original articles, letters to the Editor, plays, reviews on books and serial stories were accepted within the limits of our supply of foolscap paper and type-writer ribbons.

At the start of April, McLean created The Adelie Blizzard, which documented our lives for the next seven months. It was a monthly publication, and everyone was encouraged to contribute on any topic except the wind. Anything from light poetry to serious blank verse was welcome, along with original articles, letters to the editor, plays, book reviews, and serialized stories, all within the limits of our supply of legal-sized paper and typewriter ribbons.

     _____________________________________________________
   /                                                      \
  /             THE ADELIE BLIZZARD                         \
  |                                                          |
  |                                                          |
  |  / Registered at the General Plateau Office          \
  |/                                                       \ |
  | /  for transmission by wind as a newspaper           \   |
  | /                                                      \ |
  |    -o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-                       |
  |                                                          |
  |                                                          |
  |                ——CONTENTS——                          |
  |                     o-o-o-o-                             |
  |                                                          |
  |  Editorial.............................. Page  1        |
  |  Southern Sledging Song.................   "   2        |
  |  A Phantasm of the Snow.................   "   3        |
  |  The Romance of Exploration                              |
  |     First Crossing of Greenland (Nansen).  "   8        |
  |  Ode to Tobacco..........................  "  10        |
  |  Punch, the dinner epilogue..............  "  11        |
  |  To the Editor...........................  "  12        |
  |  Scott's British Antarctic Expedition....  "  13        |
  |  Statics and Antarctics..................  "  14        |
  |  Wireless—the realization...............  "  16        |
  |  Birth's, Deaths and Marriages...........  "  17        |
  |  The Evolution of Women..................  "  18        |
  |  A Concise Narrative.....................  "  21        |
  |  The Daylight Proposition................  "  23        |
  |  Meteorological and Magnetic Notes.......  "  24        |
  |  Calendar Rhymes.........................  "  25        |
  |  Answers to Correspondents...............  "  26        |
  |                                                          |
  |               o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-                       |
  |                                                          |
  |  VOL-I—No. I                        April, 1913         |
  |                                                          |
  |__________________________________________________________|
     _____________________________________________________
   /                                                      \
  /             THE ADELIE BLIZZARD                         \
  |                                                          |
  |                                                          |
  |  / Registered at the General Plateau Office          \
  |/                                                       \ |
  | /  for transmission by wind as a newspaper           \   |
  | /                                                      \ |
  |    -o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-                       |
  |                                                          |
  |                                                          |
  |                ——CONTENTS——                          |
  |                     o-o-o-o-                             |
  |                                                          |
  |  Editorial.............................. Page  1        |
  |  Southern Sledging Song.................   "   2        |
  |  A Phantasm of the Snow.................   "   3        |
  |  The Romance of Exploration                              |
  |     First Crossing of Greenland (Nansen).  "   8        |
  |  Ode to Tobacco..........................  "  10        |
  |  Punch, the dinner epilogue..............  "  11        |
  |  To the Editor...........................  "  12        |
  |  Scott's British Antarctic Expedition....  "  13        |
  |  Statics and Antarctics..................  "  14        |
  |  Wireless—the realization...............  "  16        |
  |  Birth's, Deaths and Marriages...........  "  17        |
  |  The Evolution of Women..................  "  18        |
  |  A Concise Narrative.....................  "  21        |
  |  The Daylight Proposition................  "  23        |
  |  Meteorological and Magnetic Notes.......  "  24        |
  |  Calendar Rhymes.........................  "  25        |
  |  Answers to Correspondents...............  "  26        |
  |                                                          |
  |               o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-o-                       |
  |                                                          |
  |  VOL-I—No. I                        April, 1913         |
  |                                                          |
  |__________________________________________________________|

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

It was the first Antarctic publication which could boast a real cable column of news of the day. Extracts from the April number were read after dinner one evening and excited much amusement. An "Ode to Tobacco" was very popular, and seemed to voice the enthusiasm of our small community, while "The Evolution of Women" introduced us to a once-familiar subject. The Editor was later admitted by wireless to the Journalists' Association (Sydney).

It was the first Antarctic publication that could proudly feature a real cable news column. Excerpts from the April issue were read after dinner one night and created a lot of laughter. An "Ode to Tobacco" was very popular, capturing the enthusiasm of our small community, while "The Evolution of Women" brought back a once-familiar topic. The Editor was later accepted via wireless into the Journalists' Association (Sydney).

Many have asked the question, "What did you do to fill in the time during the second year?"

Many have asked, "What did you do to pass the time during the second year?"

The duties of cook and night-watchman came to each man once every week, and meteorological and magnetic observations went on daily. Then we were able to devote a good deal of time to working up the scientific work accomplished during the sledging journeys. The wireless watches kept two men well occupied, and in spare moments the chief recreation was reading. There was a fine supply of illustrated journals and periodicals which had arrived by the 'Aurora', and with papers like the 'Daily Graphic', 'Illustrated London News', 'Sphere' and 'Punch', we tried to make up the arrears of a year in exile. The "Encyclopaedia Britannica" was a great boon, being always "the last word" in the settlement of a debated point. Chess and cards were played on several occasions. Again, whenever the weather gave the smallest opportunity, there were jobs outside, digging for cases, attending to the wireless mast and, in the spring, geological collecting and dredging. If the air was clear of drift, and the wind not over fifty miles per hour, one could spend a pleasant hour or more walking along the shore watching the birds and noting the changes in "scenery" which were always occurring along our short "selection" of rocks. During 1912 we had been able to study all the typical features of our novel and beautiful environment, but 1913 was the period of "intensive cultivation" and we would have gladly forgone much of it. Divine service was usually held on Sunday mornings, but in place of it we sometimes sang hymns during the evening, or arranged a programme of sacred selections on the gramophone. There was a great loss in our singing volume after the previous year, which Hodgeman endeavoured to remedy by striking up an accompaniment on the organ.

The responsibilities of cooking and night watchman rotated among the men once a week, and we took daily meteorological and magnetic observations. This allowed us to spend a lot of time analyzing the scientific work done during our sledging trips. The wireless watches kept two men busy, and during our free time, reading was our main form of entertainment. We had a great collection of illustrated magazines and periodicals that had arrived with the 'Aurora', and with publications like the 'Daily Graphic', 'Illustrated London News', 'Sphere', and 'Punch', we tried to catch up on a year’s worth of missing information. The "Encyclopaedia Britannica" was incredibly helpful, always being the go-to resource for settling any debates. We played chess and cards on several occasions. Whenever the weather allowed, we had outdoor tasks like digging for crates, maintaining the wireless mast, and come springtime, geology collecting and dredging. If the air was free of snow and the wind wasn’t over fifty miles per hour, we could enjoy nice walks along the shore, watching the birds and noting the constant changes in the "landscape" of our small stretch of rocks. In 1912, we had studied all the typical features of our unique and beautiful environment, but 1913 was the time for "intensive cultivation," and we would have gladly sacrificed much of it. Sunday mornings usually included a divine service, but instead, we sometimes sang hymns in the evening or played a selection of spiritual songs on the gramophone. We experienced a significant loss in our singing volume compared to the previous year, which Hodgeman tried to fix by playing along on the organ.

Cooking reached its acme, according to our standard, and each man became remarkable for some particular dish. Bage was the exponent of steam puddings of every variety, and Madigan could always be relied upon for an unfailing batch of puff-pastry. Bickerton once started out with the object of cooking a ginger pudding, and in an unguarded moment used mixed spices instead of ginger. The result was rather appetizing, and "mixed-spice pudding" was added to an original list. McLean specialized in yeast waffles, having acquired the art of tossing pancakes. Jeffryes had come on the scene with a limited experience, but his first milk scones gained him a reputation which he managed to make good. Hodgeman fell back on the cookery book before embarking on the task of preparing dinner, but the end-product, so to speak, which might be invariably expected for "sweets" was tapioca pudding. Penguin meat had always been in favour. Now special care was devoted to seal meat, and, after a while, mainly owing to the rather copious use of onion powder, no one could say for certain which was which.

Cooking reached its peak, by our standards, and each guy became known for a specific dish. Bage was the master of all kinds of steam puddings, and Madigan was always reliable for a perfect batch of puff pastry. Bickerton once set out to make a ginger pudding, but in an unguarded moment, he used mixed spices instead of ginger. The result was surprisingly tasty, and "mixed-spice pudding" was added to the original list. McLean focused on yeast waffles, having learned the art of tossing pancakes. Jeffryes joined us with limited experience, but his first milk scones earned him a reputation that he upheld. Hodgeman referred to the cooking book before starting dinner, but the go-to "sweets" that could always be expected were tapioca pudding. Penguin meat had always been popular. Now, special attention was given to seal meat, and after a while, mainly due to the heavy use of onion powder, nobody could reliably tell which was which.

During the previous year, yeast had been cultivated successfully from Russian stout. The experiments were continued, and all available information was gathered from cookery books and the Encyclopaedia. Russian stout, barley wine, apple rings, sugar, flour and mould from potatoes were used in several mixtures and eventually fermentation was started. Bread-making was the next difficulty, and various instructions were tried in succession. The method of "trial and error" was at last responsible for the first light spongy loaf, and then every night-watchman cultivated the art and baked for the ensuing day.

During the past year, they successfully cultivated yeast from Russian stout. The experiments continued, and all available information was collected from cookbooks and the encyclopedia. They used Russian stout, barley wine, apple rings, sugar, flour, and potato mold in various mixtures, and eventually, fermentation began. The next challenge was making bread, and they tried different methods one after the other. The "trial and error" approach finally led to the creation of the first light and spongy loaf, and then every night-watchman practiced the art and baked for the next day.

On April 8 the snow had gathered deeply everywhere and we had some exercise on skis. Several of the morainic areas were no longer visible, and it was possible to run between the rocks for a considerable distance. A fresh breeze came up during the afternoon and provided a splendid impetus for some good slides. During the short calm, twenty-six seals landed on the harbour-ice.

On April 8, the snow had piled up deeply everywhere, and we got some exercise on skis. Many of the morainic areas were not visible anymore, and it was possible to ski between the rocks for quite a distance. A fresh breeze picked up in the afternoon, giving us a great boost for some fun slides. During the brief calm, twenty-six seals came ashore on the harbor ice.

On the morning of the same day Mary gave birth to five pups in the Transit House. The place was full of cracks, through which snow and wind were always driving, and so we were not surprised when four of them were found to have died. The survivor was named "Hoyle" (a cognomen for our old friend Hurley) and his doings gave us a new fund of entertainment.

On the morning of the same day, Mary gave birth to five puppies in the Transit House. The place was full of cracks, letting in snow and wind all the time, so we weren't surprised when four of them were found dead. The lone survivor was named "Hoyle" (a nickname for our old friend Hurley), and what he got up to provided us with a new source of entertainment.

The other dogs had been penned in the veranda and in tolerable weather were brought outside to be fed. Carrying an axe, Madigan usually went down to the boat harbour, followed by the expectant pack, to where there were several seal carcases. These lay immovably frozen to the ice, and were cut about and hacked so that the meat in section reminded one of the grain of a log of red gum, and it was certainly quite as hard. When Madigan commenced to chop, the dogs would range themselves on the lee side and "field" the flying chips.

The other dogs were kept on the veranda, and when the weather was decent, they were taken outside to be fed. Madigan usually carried an axe and went down to the boat harbor, followed by the eager pack, to where there were several seal carcasses. These were frozen solid to the ice and were cut and chopped in a way that the meat looked like the grain of a log of red gum, and it was just as tough. When Madigan started to chop, the dogs would line up on the sheltered side and catch the flying chips.

On April 16 the last penguin was seen on a ledge overhanging an icy cove to the east. Apparently its moulting time had not expired, but it was certainly a very miserable bird, smothered in small icicles and snow and partly exposed to a sixty-five mile wind with the temperature close to -10 degrees F. Petrels were often seen flying along the foreshores and no wind appeared to daunt them. It was certainly a remarkable thing to witness a snow-petrel, small, light and fragile, making headway over the sea in the face of an eighty-mile hurricane, fluttering down through the spindrift to pick up a morsel of food which it had detected. Close to the western cliffs there was a trail of brash-ice where many birds were often observed feeding on Euphausia (crustaceans) in weather when it scarcely seemed possible for any living creature to be abroad.

On April 16, the last penguin was spotted on a ledge above an icy cove to the east. It seemed that its moulting season wasn't over, but it looked like a very miserable bird, covered in small icicles and snow, and partially exposed to a sixty-five mile per hour wind with the temperature hovering around -10 degrees F. Petrels were frequently seen flying along the shorelines, and no wind seemed to intimidate them. It was truly something to see a snow-petrel, small, light, and delicate, making progress over the sea against an eighty-mile hurricane, fluttering down through the spindrift to grab a morsel of food it had sensed. Near the western cliffs, there was a patch of brash ice where many birds were often seen feeding on Euphausia (small crustaceans), in weather that hardly seemed bearable for any living creature to be out and about.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

The meteorological chart for April 12, 1913, compiled by the Commonwealth Meteorological Bureau

The weather chart for April 12, 1913, created by the Commonwealth Meteorological Bureau

Mr. Hunt appends the following explanation: "A very intense cyclone passing south of Macquarie Island, where the barometer fell on the 11th from 29.49 at 9 A.M. to 29.13 at 6 P.M., and the next day to 28.34 at 9 A.M. and 27.91 at 6 P.M. At Adelie Land the barometer was not greatly affected, but rose in sympathy with the passage of the 'low' from 28.70 to 28.90 during the twenty-four hours. The influence of this cyclone was very wide and probably embraced both Adelie Land and Tasmania."

Mr. Hunt adds the following explanation: "A very strong cyclone passed south of Macquarie Island, where the barometer dropped on the 11th from 29.49 at 9 A.M. to 29.13 at 6 P.M., and the next day to 28.34 at 9 A.M. and 27.91 at 6 P.M. In Adelie Land, the barometer wasn’t significantly affected but rose in response to the passing ‘low’ from 28.70 to 28.90 over the course of twenty-four hours. The impact of this cyclone was extensive and likely included both Adelie Land and Tasmania."

Throughout April news by wireless came in slowly and spasmodically, and Jeffryes was becoming resigned to the eccentricities of the place. As an example of the unfavourable conditions which sometimes prevailed: on April 14 the wind was steady, in the nineties, with light drift and, at times, the aurora would illumine the north-west sky. Still, during "quiet" intervals, two messages came through and were acknowledged.

Throughout April, news by wireless arrived slowly and inconsistently, and Jeffryes was starting to accept the quirks of the place. For instance, on April 14, the wind was steady, in the nineties, with light drift, and at times, the aurora lit up the north-west sky. Still, during "quiet" moments, two messages came through and were confirmed.

A coded weather report, which had priority over all other messages, was sent out each night, and it is surprising how often Jeffryes managed to transmit this important intelligence. On evenings when receiving was an impossibility, owing to a continual stream of St. Elmo's fire, the three code words for the barometric reading, the velocity and direction of the wind were signalled repeatedly and, on the following night, perhaps, Macquarie Island would acknowledge them. Of course we had to use new signs for the higher wind velocities, as no provision had been made for them in our meteorological code-book. The reports from Macquarie Island and Adelie Land were communicated to Mr. Hunt of the Commonwealth Weather Bureau and to Mr. Bates of the Dominion Meteorological Office, who plotted them out for their daily weather forecasts.

A coded weather report, which took priority over all other messages, was sent out each night, and it's amazing how often Jeffryes was able to transmit this crucial information. On nights when it was impossible to receive due to a constant stream of St. Elmo's fire, the three code words for the barometric pressure, the speed, and direction of the wind were signaled repeatedly, and maybe the next night, Macquarie Island would acknowledge them. Of course, we had to come up with new signs for the higher wind speeds, since our meteorological codebook hadn’t accounted for them. The reports from Macquarie Island and Adelie Land were sent to Mr. Hunt at the Commonwealth Weather Bureau and Mr. Bates at the Dominion Meteorological Office, who used them to create their daily weather forecasts.

It was very gratifying to learn that the Macquarie Island party to a man had consented to remain at their lonely post and from Ainsworth, their leader, I received a brief report of the work which had been accomplished by each member. We all could appreciate the sacrifice they were making. Then, too, an account was received of the great sledging efforts which had been made by Wild and his men to the west. But it was not till the end of the year that their adventurous story was related to us in detail.

It was really rewarding to find out that every single member of the Macquarie Island team had agreed to stay at their remote post. From Ainsworth, their leader, I got a short report on the work each member had completed. We all recognized the sacrifices they were making. Additionally, we received a report on the impressive sledging efforts made by Wild and his team to the west. However, we didn't hear the full details of their adventurous story until the end of the year.

On the 23rd Lassie, one of the dogs, was badly wounded in a fight and had to be shot. Quarrels amongst the dogs had to be quelled immediately, otherwise they would probably mean the death of some unfortunate animal which happened to be thrown down amongst the pack. Whenever a dog was down, it was the way of these brutes to attack him irrespective of whether they were friends or foes.

On the 23rd, Lassie, one of the dogs, was seriously injured in a fight and had to be put down. Arguments among the dogs had to be stopped right away; otherwise, it could result in the death of some poor animal that got caught up in the pack. Whenever a dog went down, these animals would instinctively attack him, regardless of whether they were allies or enemies.

Among our dogs there were several groups whose members always consorted together. Thus, George and Lassie were friends and, when the latter was killed, George, who was naturally a miserable, downtrodden creature, became a kind of pariah, morose and solitary and at war with all except Peary and Fix, with whom he and Lassie had been associated in fights against the rest. The other dogs lived together in some kind of harmony, Jack and Amundsen standing out as particular chums, while the "pups," as we called them—D'Urville, Ross and Wilkes ("Monkey")—were a trio born in Adelie Land and, therefore, comrades in misfortune. Hoyle, as a pup, was treated benevolently by all the others, and entered the fellowship of the other three when he grew up. Among the rest, Mikkel stood out as a good fighter, Colonel as the biggest dog and ringleader against the Peary-Fix faction, Fram as a nervous intractable animal, and Mary as the sole representative of the sex.

Among our dogs, there were several groups that always hung out together. George and Lassie were friends, and when Lassie was killed, George, who was naturally a miserable and downtrodden creature, became somewhat of a pariah, gloomy and alone, at odds with everyone except Peary and Fix, with whom he and Lassie had teamed up in fights against the others. The other dogs lived together in some sort of harmony, with Jack and Amundsen being particularly close friends, while the "pups," as we called them—D'Urville, Ross, and Wilkes ("Monkey")—were a trio born in Adelie Land and were therefore comrades in misfortune. Hoyle, as a pup, was treated kindly by all the others and joined the group of the other three when he grew up. Among the rest, Mikkel was notable as a good fighter, Colonel as the biggest dog and the leader against the Peary-Fix faction, Fram as a nervous and stubborn animal, and Mary as the only female.

It was remarkable that Peary, Fix and George in their hatred of the others, who were penned up in the dog shelter during bad weather, would absent themselves for days on a snow ramp near the Magnetograph House, where they were partly protected from the wind by rocks. George, from being a mere associate of Peary and Fix, became more amiable as the year went by, and at times it was quite pathetic to see his attempts at friendliness.

It was striking how Peary, Fix, and George, in their animosity toward the others who were stuck in the dog shelter during bad weather, would stay away for days on a snow ramp near the Magnetograph House, where they were somewhat shielded from the wind by rocks. Over the year, George shifted from being just an associate of Peary and Fix to becoming more friendly, and at times it was quite touching to witness his efforts to be sociable.

We became very fond of the dogs despite their habit of howling at night and their wolfish ferocity. They always gave one a welcome, in drift or sunshine, and though ruled by the law of force, they had a few domestic traits to make them civilized.

We grew really attached to the dogs, even with their tendency to howl at night and their wild fierceness. They always greeted us warmly, no matter the weather, and although they operated under the law of strength, they had a few friendly behaviors that made them feel more like family.

May was a dreaded month because it had been the period of worst wind and drift during 1912. On this occasion the wind velocities over four weeks were not so high and constant, though the snowfall was just as persistent. On the 17th and 18th, however, there was an unexpected "jump" to the nineties. The average over the first twenty-four hours was eighty-three, and on the 18th it attained 93.7 miles per hour. One terrific rise between 6.30 and 7.30 on the night of the 17th was shown as one hundred and three miles on the anemometer—the record up to that time.

May was a month everyone dreaded because it had been the worst for wind and snow drift in 1912. This time, the wind speeds over four weeks weren't as high and consistent, but the snowfall was just as relentless. However, on the 17th and 18th, there was an unexpected spike into the nineties. The average for the first twenty-four hours was eighty-three, and on the 18th, it reached 93.7 miles per hour. One massive jump between 6:30 and 7:30 on the evening of the 17th showed a record one hundred and three miles per hour on the anemometer—marking the highest reading up to that point.

Madigan was thrown over and had a hard fall on his arm, smashing a bottle of the special ink which was used for the anemograph pen. Bage related how he had sailed across the Magnetic Flat by sitting down and raising his arms in the air. He was accompanied by Fix, Peary and George, who were blown along the slippery surface for yards. McLean had a "lively time" cutting ice and bringing in the big blocks. Often he would slide away with a large piece, and "pull up" on a snow patch twenty yards to leeward.

Madigan was thrown over and took a hard fall on his arm, breaking a bottle of the special ink used for the anemograph pen. Bage shared how he had sailed across the Magnetic Flat by sitting down and raising his arms in the air. He was joined by Fix, Peary, and George, who got blown along the slick surface for yards. McLean had a "lively time" cutting ice and bringing in the big blocks. Often, he would slide away with a large piece and "pull up" on a snow patch twenty yards downwind.

On the 22nd there were hours of gusts which came down like thunderbolts, making us apprehensive for the safety of the wireless masts; we had grown to trust the stability of the Hut. Every one who went outside came back with a few experiences. Jeffryes was roughly handled through not wearing crampons, and several cases of kerosene, firmly stacked on the break-wind, were dislodged and thrown several yards.

On the 22nd, there were hours of strong gusts that came down like thunder, making us worry about the safety of the wireless masts; we had come to rely on the stability of the Hut. Everyone who went outside returned with some stories. Jeffryes had a rough time because he wasn't wearing crampons, and several cases of kerosene, stacked securely against the windbreak, were knocked loose and thrown several yards.

Empire Day was celebrated in Adelie Land with a small display. At 2.30 P.M. the Union Jack was hoisted to the topmast and three cheers were given for the King. The wind blew at fifty miles an hour with light drift, temperature -3 degrees F. Empire greetings were sent to the Colonial Secretary, London, and to Mr Fisher, Prime Minister of Australia. These were warmly reciprocated a few days afterwards.

Empire Day was celebrated in Adelie Land with a small event. At 2:30 PM, the Union Jack was raised to the top of the mast, and three cheers were given for the King. The wind was blowing at fifty miles an hour with a light drift, and the temperature was -3 degrees F. Empire greetings were sent to the Colonial Secretary in London and to Mr. Fisher, the Prime Minister of Australia. These were warmly returned a few days later.

Preceded by a day of whirlies on the 7th and random gusts on the same evening, the wind made a determined attack next morning and carried away the top and part of the middle section of the main wireless mast. It was a very unexpected event, lulled as we were into security by the fact that May, the worst month, had passed. On examination it was found that two of the topmast wire stays had chafed through, whilst another had parted. At first it seemed a hopeless task to re-erect the mast, but gradually ways and means were discussed, and we waited for the first calm day to put the theories into execution.

Following a day of whirling winds on the 7th and random gusts that evening, the wind launched a serious assault the next morning, tearing away the top and part of the middle section of the main wireless mast. It was a completely unexpected event, especially since we felt secure with May, the worst month, behind us. Upon inspection, we discovered that two of the topmast wire stays had worn through, while another had snapped. Initially, it seemed impossible to re-erect the mast, but gradually we discussed different strategies, and we waited for the first calm day to put our plans into action.

Meanwhile, it was suggested that if a heavy kite were made and induced to fly in the continuous winds, the aerial thus provided would be sufficient to receive wireless messages. To this end, Bage and Bickerton set to work, and the first invention was a Venesta-box kite which was tried in a steady seventy-mile wind. Despite its weight,—at least ten pounds —the kite rose immediately, steadied by guys on either side, and then suddenly descended with a crash on to the glacier ice. After the third fall the kite was too battered to be of any further use. Another device, in which an empty carbide tin was employed, and still another, making use of an old propeller, shared the same fate.

Meanwhile, it was suggested that if a heavy kite were built and flown in the steady winds, the lift it provided would be enough to receive wireless messages. To achieve this, Bage and Bickerton got to work, and their first invention was a Venesta-box kite which was tested in a strong seventy-mile wind. Despite its weight—at least ten pounds—the kite took off immediately, stabilized by lines on either side, and then abruptly crashed down onto the glacier ice. After the third fall, the kite was too damaged to be used anymore. Another design, using an empty carbide can, and yet another that utilized an old propeller, met the same fate.

On the evening of the 19th a perfect coloured corona, three degrees in diameter, was observed encircling the moon in a sky which lit up at intervals with dancing auroral curtains. Coronae or "glories," which closely invest the luminary, are due to diffraction owing to immense numbers of very minute water or ice particles floating in the air between the observer and the source of light. The larger the particles the smaller the corona, so that by a measurement of the diameter of a corona the size of the particles can be calculated. Earlier in the year, a double corona had been seen when the moon was shining through cirro-cumulus clouds. Haloes, on the other hand, are wide circles (or arcs of circles) in the sky surrounding the sun or moon, and arising from light-refraction in myriads of tiny ice-crystals suspended in the atmosphere. They were very commonly noted in Adelie Land where the conditions were so ideal for their production.

On the evening of the 19th, a perfect colored halo, three degrees in diameter, was seen around the moon in a sky that lit up occasionally with shimmering auroras. Halos, or "glories," which closely surround the light source, are caused by diffraction from countless tiny water or ice particles floating in the air between the observer and the light. The larger the particles, the smaller the halo, so measuring the size of a halo can help calculate the size of the particles. Earlier in the year, a double halo was observed when the moon was shining through cirro-cumulus clouds. Halos, on the other hand, are wide circles (or arcs) in the sky around the sun or moon, created by light refraction in countless tiny ice crystals suspended in the atmosphere. They were frequently observed in Adelie Land, where the conditions were perfect for their formation.

Midwinter's Day 1913! we had reached a turning-point in the season. The Astronomer Royal told us that at eight o'clock on June 22 the sun commenced to return, and every one took note of the fact. The sky was overcast, the air surcharged with drifting snow, and the wind was forty miles an hour—a representative day as far as the climate was concerned. The cook made a special effort and the menu bore the following foreword:

Midwinter's Day 1913! We had reached a turning point in the season. The Astronomer Royal informed us that at eight o'clock on June 22, the sun began to return, and everyone paid attention to this. The sky was cloudy, the air thick with blowing snow, and the wind was blowing at forty miles an hour—a typical day for the climate. The cook made a special effort, and the menu had the following note:

    Now is the winter of our discontent
    Made glorious summer....
    Now is the winter of our unhappiness  
    Made glorious summer....

On July 6 the wind moderated, and we set about repairing once more the fortunes of the "wireless." The shattered topmast used to sway about in the heavy winds, threatening to bring down the rest of the mast. Bickerton, therefore, climbed up with a saw and cut it almost through above the doubling. All hands then pulled hard, and the upper part cracked off, the lower section being easily removed from the cross-trees. The mast now looked "shipshape" and ready for future improvements.

On July 6, the wind calmed down, and we got back to fixing the "wireless." The broken topmast used to sway in the strong winds, risking the collapse of the entire mast. So, Bickerton climbed up with a saw and cut it nearly all the way through above the doubling. Everyone then pulled hard, and the upper part snapped off, while the lower section was easily taken out from the cross-trees. The mast now looked "shipshape" and ready for future upgrades.

It was decided to use as a topmast the mast which had been formerly employed to support the northern half of the aerial. So on the 29th this was lowered and removed to the veranda to be fitted for erection.

It was decided to use the mast that had previously supported the northern half of the aerial as a topmast. So on the 29th, it was lowered and taken to the veranda to be prepared for installation.

Almost a fortnight now elapsed, during which the weather was "impossible." In fact, the wind was frightful throughout the whole month of July, surpassing all its previous records and wearing out our much-tried patience. All that one could do was to work on and try grimly to ignore it. On July 2 we noted: "Thick as a wall outside with an eighty-five miler." And so it commenced and continued for a day, subsiding slowly through the seventies to the fifties and then suddenly redoubling in strength, rose to a climax about midnight on the 5th—one hundred and sixteen miles an hour! For eight hours it maintained an average of one hundred and seven miles an hour, and the timbers of the Hut seemed to be jarred and wrenched as the wind throbbed in its mightier gusts. These were the highest wind-velocities recorded during our two years' residence in Adelie Land and are probably the highest sustained velocities ever reported from a meteorological station.

Almost two weeks went by, during which the weather was "terrible." In fact, the wind was fierce throughout all of July, breaking all previous records and testing our already strained patience. All we could do was keep working and try hard to ignore it. On July 2, we noted: "Visibility is as thick as a wall outside with an eighty-five-mile-per-hour wind." And so it began and continued for a day, gradually easing from the seventies to the fifties, then suddenly picking up again, peaking around midnight on the 5th at one hundred and sixteen miles per hour! For eight hours, it averaged one hundred and seven miles per hour, and the structure of the Hut felt jolted and strained as the wind roared with its stronger gusts. These were the highest wind speeds recorded during our two years in Adelie Land and are likely the highest sustained winds ever reported from a meteorological station.

With the exception of a few Antarctic and snow petrels flying over the sea on the calmer days, no life had been seen round the Hut during June. So it was with some surprise that we sighted a Weddell seal on July 9 attempting to land on the harbour-ice in a seventy-five-mile wind. Several times it clambered over the edge and on turning broadside to the wind was actually tumbled back into the water. Eventually it struggled into the lee of some icy hummocks, but only remained there for a few minutes, deciding that the water was much warmer.

Except for a few Antarctic and snow petrels flying over the sea on calmer days, we hadn't seen any life around the Hut during June. So we were surprised to spot a Weddell seal on July 9 trying to land on the harbor ice in a 75-mile-per-hour wind. It tried several times to climb over the edge, and each time it turned sideways to the wind, it got knocked back into the water. Eventually, it managed to get to a sheltered spot behind some icy hummocks, but it only stayed there for a few minutes before deciding the water was a lot warmer.

On the 11th there was an exceptionally low barometer at 27.794 inches. At the same time the wind ran riot once more—two hundred and ninety-eight miles in three hours. The highest barometric reading was recorded on September 3, 30.4 inches, and the comparison indicates a wide range for a station at sea-level.

On the 11th, the barometer dropped to an unusually low 27.794 inches. Meanwhile, the wind picked up fiercely again—blowing at two hundred ninety-eight miles in three hours. The highest barometric reading was on September 3, at 30.4 inches, and this comparison shows a significant range for a station at sea level.

To show how quickly conditions would change, it was almost calm next morning, and all hands were in readiness to advance the wireless mast another stage. Previously there had been three masts, one high one in three lengths, and two smaller ones of one length each, between which the aerial stretched; the "lead-in" wires being connected to the middle of the aerial. This is known as an "umbrella aerial." Since we were without one short mast it was resolved to erect a "directive" [capital gamma gjc]-shaped aerial. The mainmast was to be in two instead of three lengths, and we wondered if the aerial would be high enough. In any case, it was so calm early on the 11th that we ventured to erect the topmast and had hauled it half-way, when the wind swooped down from the plateau, and there was just time to make fast the stays and the hauling rope and to leave things "snug" for the next spell of bad weather.

To illustrate how quickly things could change, it was almost calm the next morning, and everyone was ready to raise the wireless mast another stage. Previously, there had been three masts: one tall one made of three sections and two smaller ones of one section each, between which the aerial was stretched; the "lead-in" wires were connected to the middle of the aerial. This is known as an "umbrella aerial." Since we didn't have one short mast, it was decided to set up a "directive" [capital gamma gjc]-shaped aerial. The main mast was going to be in two sections instead of three, and we wondered if the aerial would be tall enough. In any case, it was so calm early on the 11th that we decided to put up the top mast and had pulled it halfway up when the wind suddenly swept down from the plateau. We just had enough time to secure the stays and the hauling rope and to leave everything "snug" for the next round of bad weather.

In eight days another opportunity came, and this time the topmast was hoisted, wedged and securely stayed. Bickerton had fixed a long bolt through the middle of the topmast and just above it three additional wire stays were to be placed. Another fine day and we reckoned to finish the work.

In eight days, another opportunity arrived, and this time the topmast was raised, wedged, and securely secured. Bickerton had installed a long bolt through the center of the topmast, and just above it, three extra wire stays were to be added. With another nice day, we figured we could complete the job.

From July 26 onwards the sky was cloudless for a week, and each day the northern sun would rise a fraction of a degree higher. The wind was very constant and of high velocity.

From July 26 onward, the sky was clear for a week, and each day the northern sun rose a bit higher. The wind was steady and strong.

It was a grand sight to witness the sea in a hurricane on a driftless, clear day. Crouched under a rock on Azimuth Hill, and looking across to the west along the curving brink of the cliffs, one could watch the water close inshore blacken under the lash of the wind, whiten into foam farther off, and then disappear into the hurrying clouds of spray and sea-smoke. Over the Mackellar Islets and the "Pianoforte Berg" columns of spray would shoot up like geysers, and fly away in the mad race to the north.

It was an incredible sight to see the ocean during a hurricane on a calm, clear day. Crouched under a rock on Azimuth Hill, looking west along the curved edge of the cliffs, you could see the water near the shore turn black under the force of the wind, turn white with foam further out, and then vanish into the swirling clouds of spray and sea mist. Over the Mackellar Islets and the "Pianoforte Berg," columns of spray would shoot up like geysers and rush away in the wild sprint to the north.

Early in July Jeffryes became ill, and for some weeks his symptoms were such as to give every one much anxiety. His work on the wireless had been assiduous at all times, and there is no doubt that the continual and acute strain of sending and receiving messages under unprecedented conditions was such that he eventually had a "nervous breakdown." Unfortunately the weather was so atrocious, and the conditions under which we were placed so peculiarly difficult, that nothing could be done to brighten his prospects. McLean considered that as the spring returned and it became possible to take more exercise outside, the nervous exhaustion would pass off. In the meantime Jeffryes took a complete rest, and slowly improved as the months went by, and our hopes of relief came nearer. It was a great misfortune for our comrade, especially as it was his first experience of such a climate, and he had applied himself to work with enthusiasm and perhaps in an over-conscientious spirit.

Early in July, Jeffryes fell ill, and for weeks, his symptoms worried everyone a lot. He had always worked hard on the wireless, and it's clear that the constant and intense pressure of sending and receiving messages under such unprecedented conditions led to his "nervous breakdown." Unfortunately, the weather was terrible, and the situation we were in was uniquely challenging, so there was nothing we could do to improve his situation. McLean believed that as spring returned and it became possible to get more exercise outside, the nervous exhaustion would fade. In the meantime, Jeffryes took complete rest and slowly got better as the months passed, and our hopes for relief grew. It was a significant misfortune for our friend, especially since it was his first time experiencing such a climate, and he had thrown himself into work with enthusiasm, maybe a bit too seriously.

July concluded its stormy career with the astonishing wind-average of 63.6 miles an hour. We were all relieved to see Friday, August 1, appear on the modest calendar, which it was the particular pleasure of each night-watchman to change. More light filtered day by day through the ice on the kitchen window, midwinter lay behind, and we were ready to hail the first signs of returning spring.

July ended its stormy run with an incredible wind average of 63.6 miles per hour. We were all relieved to see Friday, August 1, show up on the plain calendar, which each night-watchman took particular pleasure in changing. More light came through the kitchen window's ice day by day, midwinter was behind us, and we were ready to welcome the first signs of spring returning.





CHAPTER XXIV NEARING THE END

    Seven men from all the world, back to town again,
    Seven men from out of hell.
                                 Kipling
    Seven men from all over the world, back in town again,  
    Seven men from out of hell.  
                                 Kipling

It is wonderful how quickly the weeks seemed to pass. Situated as we were, Time became quite an object of study to us and its imperceptible drift was almost a reality, considering that each day was another step towards liberty—freedom from the tyranny of the wind. In a sense, the endless surge of the blizzard was a slow form of torture, and the subtle effect it had on the mind was measurable in the delight with which one greeted a calm, fine morning, or noted some insignificant fact which bespoke the approach of a milder season. Thus in August, although the weather was colder, there were the merest signs of thawing along the edges of the snow packed against the rocky faces which looked towards the sun; Weddell seals came back to the land, and the petrels would at times appear in large flocks; all of which are very commonplace events which any one might have expected, but at the time they had more than their face value.

It’s amazing how quickly the weeks seemed to fly by. Given our situation, time became a real focus for us, and its slow passage felt almost tangible, since each day brought us a step closer to freedom—freedom from the relentless wind. In a way, the constant assault of the blizzard was a kind of slow torture, and the gradual impact it had on our minds was evident in the joy we felt when a calm, beautiful morning arrived, or when we noticed some small sign that hinted at a warmer season ahead. So in August, even though it was colder, there were the slightest signs of melting at the edges of the snow packed against the sun-facing rocky surfaces; Weddell seals returned to the shore, and petrels sometimes appeared in large flocks; all of which were pretty ordinary occurrences that anyone might expect, but at that moment they carried more significance than usual.

August 5 was undoubtedly a great day from our very provincial point of view. On the 4th there had been a dense drift, during which the Hut was buttressed round with soft snow which rose above the eaves and half filled the entrance-veranda. The only way in which the night-watchman could keep the hourly observations was to dig his way out frequently with a shovel. In the early morning hours of the 5th the wind abated and veered right round from south through east to north-east, from which quarter it remained as a fresh breeze with falling snow. By 7 A.M. the air was still, and outside there was a dead world of whiteness; flocculent heaps of down rolling up to where glimpses of rock streaked black near the skyline of the ridges, striated masses of livid cloud overhead, and to the horizon the dark berg-strewn sea, over which the snow birds fluttered.

August 5 was definitely an amazing day from our very local perspective. On the 4th, there had been a heavy snowfall, which covered the Hut with soft snow that rose above the eaves and partially filled the entrance porch. The only way the night-watchman could keep up with the hourly observations was by frequently digging his way out with a shovel. In the early morning hours of the 5th, the wind died down and shifted all the way from south through east to northeast, coming in as a fresh breeze with falling snow. By 7 A.M., the air was calm, and outside was a lifeless world of white; fluffy piles of snow rolling up to where you could see dark rock streaked near the ridges' skyline, striated masses of pale cloud above, and on the horizon, the dark sea dotted with icebergs, over which the snowbirds flitted.

We did not linger over the scenery, but set to work to hoist to the head of the mainmast the aerial, which had been hurriedly put together. The job occupied till lunch-time, and then a jury-mast was fixed to the southern supporting mast, and by dusk the aerial hung in position. Bickerton was the leading spirit in the work and subsequently steadied the mainmast with eighteen wire stays, in the determination to make it stable enough to weather the worst hurricane. The attempt was so successful that in an ordinary fifty-mile "blow" the mast vibrated slightly, and in higher winds exhibited the smallest degree of movement.

We didn’t take our time enjoying the scenery but got right to work on raising the makeshift aerial to the top of the mainmast. We spent the time until lunch on it, and then we attached a jury-mast to the southern support mast, getting the aerial secured by dusk. Bickerton was the driving force behind the efforts and later reinforced the mainmast with eighteen wire stays, determined to make it sturdy enough to withstand even the fiercest hurricane. The attempt worked so well that in a typical fifty-mile gust, the mast only vibrated slightly, and in stronger winds, it showed almost no movement at all.

At eight o'clock that night, Jeffryes, who felt so benefited by his rest that he was eager to commence operating once more, had soon "attuned" his instrument to Macquarie Island, and in a few minutes communication was reestablished.

At eight o'clock that night, Jeffryes, who felt so refreshed from his rest that he was eager to start working again, quickly "tuned" his instrument to Macquarie Island, and within a few minutes, communication was back online.

We learned from the Governor-General, Lord Denman, that her Majesty the Queen was "graciously pleased to consent to the name 'Queen Mary Land' being given to newly discovered land." The message referred to the tract of Antarctic coast which had been discovered and mapped by Wild and his party to the west.

We learned from the Governor-General, Lord Denman, that Her Majesty the Queen was "graciously pleased to agree to the name 'Queen Mary Land' being given to newly discovered land." The message referred to the stretch of Antarctic coast that had been discovered and mapped by Wild and his team to the west.

On August 6 Macquarie Island signalled that they had run short of provisions. The message was rather a paradox: " Food done, but otherwise all right." However, on August 11, we were reassured to hear that the 'Tutanekai', a New Zealand Government steamer, had been commissioned to relieve the party, and that Sawyer through ill-health had been obliged to return to Australia. A sealing-ship, the 'Rachel Cohen', after battling for almost the whole month of July against gales, in an endeavour to reach the island, with stores for our party and the sealers, had returned damaged to port.

On August 6, Macquarie Island reported that they were running low on supplies. The message was somewhat ironic: "Food is gone, but otherwise we're doing fine." However, on August 11, we felt reassured to learn that the 'Tutanekai', a New Zealand Government steamer, had been sent to help the group, and that Sawyer had to return to Australia due to health issues. A sealing ship, the 'Rachel Cohen', after struggling for almost the entire month of July against strong winds in an attempt to reach the island with supplies for our group and the sealers, had returned to port damaged.

Marvellous to relate we had two calm days in succession, and on the 6th the snow lay so deeply round the Hut that progression without skis was a laborious flounder. The dogs plunged about in great glee, rolling in the snow and "playing off" their surplus energy after being penned for a long spell in the shelter.

Amazing to say, we had two peaceful days in a row, and on the 6th, the snow was so deep around the Hut that moving without skis was a tough struggle. The dogs were joyfully bouncing around, rolling in the snow and releasing their pent-up energy after being cooped up in the shelter for a long time.

On skis one could push up the first slopes of the glacier for a long distance. Soft snow had settled two feet thick even on the steep icy downfalls. The sea to the north was frozen into large cakes between which ran a network of dark water "leads." With glasses we could make out in the near distance five seals and two tall solitary figures which were doubtless Emperor penguins. During the whole day nimbus clouds had hung heavily from the sky, and snow had fallen in grains and star-like crystals. Gradually the nimbus lightened, a rift appeared overhead, and,the edges of the billowy cumulus were burnished in the light of the low sun. The sea-horizon came sharply into sight through fading mist. Bergs and islands, from being ghostly images, rose into sharp-featured reality. The masts and Hut, with a dark riband of smoke floating from the chimney, lay just below, and two of the men were walking out to the harbour-ice where a seal had just landed, while round them scampered the dogs in high spirits. That was sufficient to set us sliding downhill, ploughing deep furrows through the soft drift and reaching the Hut in quick time.

On skis, you could glide up the first slopes of the glacier for a long way. Soft snow had settled two feet thick even on the steep icy drops. The sea to the north was frozen into large chunks, with a network of dark water "leads" running between them. With binoculars, we could see in the near distance five seals and two tall, solitary figures that were definitely Emperor penguins. Throughout the day, thick clouds had hung heavily in the sky, and snow had fallen in grains and star-like crystals. Gradually, the clouds lightened, a gap appeared overhead, and the edges of the fluffy cumulus were glowing in the light of the low sun. The horizon of the sea became clear through the fading mist. Icebergs and islands, once ghostly images, emerged into sharp reality. The masts and the Hut, with a dark plume of smoke drifting from the chimney, lay just below, and two of the men were walking out to the harbor ice where a seal had just landed, while the dogs joyfully scampered around them. That was enough to prompt us to slide downhill, carving deep trails through the soft snow and reaching the Hut quickly.

During August we were able to do more work outside, thus enlarging our sphere of interest. Bage, who had been busy up till August 8 with his daily magnetograph records, ran short of bromide papers and now had to be contented with taking "quick runs" at intervals, especially when the aurora was active. His astronomical observations had been very disappointing owing to the continuous wind and drift. Still, in September, which was marked by periods of fine weather, a few good star observations were possible. Shafts were sunk in the sea-ice and up on the glacier, just above the zone where the ice was loaded with stones and debris—the lower moraine. The glacier shaft was dug to a depth of twenty-four feet, and several erratics were met with embedded in the ice. In this particular part the crystalline structure of the ice resembled that of a gneiss, showing that it had flowed under pressure. I was able to make measurements of ablation on the glacier, to take observations of the temperature and salinity of the sea-water, and to estimate the forward movement of the seaward cliffs of the ice-cap.

During August, we were able to spend more time working outside, which expanded our area of focus. Bage, who had been busy with his daily magnetograph records until August 8, ran out of bromide paper and had to settle for taking "quick runs" at intervals, especially when the aurora was active. His astronomical observations were quite disappointing due to the constant wind and drifting. However, in September, which featured some nice weather, a few good star observations became possible. We dug shafts in the sea-ice and on the glacier, right above the area where the ice was filled with stones and debris—the lower moraine. The glacier shaft reached a depth of twenty-four feet, and we encountered several erratics embedded in the ice. In this area, the crystalline structure of the ice resembled that of gneiss, indicating it had flowed under pressure. I was able to take measurements of ablation on the glacier, observe the temperature and salinity of the seawater, and estimate the forward movement of the seaward cliffs of the ice cap.

Geological collecting now became quite a popular diversion. With a slight smattering of "gneiss," "felspar," "weathered limestone," "garnets," and "glacial markings" the amateurs went off and made many finds on the moraines, and the specimens were cached in heaps, to be later brought home by the dogs, some of which were receiving their first lessons in sledge-pulling.

Geological collecting became a popular hobby. With a little knowledge of "gneiss," "felspar," "weathered limestone," "garnets," and "glacial markings," amateur collectors ventured out and made many discoveries on the moraines. They piled up their specimens to be brought home later by the dogs, some of which were learning to pull sleds for the first time.

Rather belated, but none the less welcome, our midwinter wireless greetings arrived on August 17 from many friends who could only imagine how much they were appreciated, and from various members of the Expedition who had spent the previous year in Adelie Land and who knew the meaning of an Antarctic winter. A few evenings later, Macquarie Islanders had their reward in the arrival of the 'Tutanekai' from New Zealand with supplies of food, and, piecing together a few fragments of evidence "dropped in the ether," we judged that they were having a night of revelry.

A bit late, but still appreciated, our midwinter wireless greetings arrived on August 17 from many friends who could only imagine how much they meant to us, and from various members of the Expedition who had spent the past year in Adelie Land and understood what an Antarctic winter feels like. A few nights later, Macquarie Islanders were rewarded with the arrival of the 'Tutanekai' from New Zealand with food supplies, and by piecing together a few bits of information "floating in the ether," we guessed that they were having a night of celebration.

The wind was in a fierce humour on the morning of August 16, mounting to one hundred and five miles per hour between 9 and 10 A.M., and carrying with it a very dense drift.

The wind was in a fierce mood on the morning of August 16, reaching up to one hundred and five miles per hour between 9 and 10 A.M., and bringing with it a very thick drift.

We were now in a position to sit down and generalize about the wind. It is a tiresome thing to have it as the recurring insistent theme of our story, but to have had it as the continual obstacle to our activity, the opposing barrier to the simplest task, was even more tedious.

We were now able to sit down and generalize about the wind. It's a frustrating thing to have it as the constant, nagging theme of our story, but having it as the ongoing obstacle to our actions, the barrier to the simplest tasks, was even more tedious.

A river, rather a torrent, of air rushes from the hinterland northward year after year, replenished from a source which never fails. We had reason to believe that it was local in character, as apparently a gulf of open water about one hundred miles in width—the D'Urville Sea—exists to the north of Adelie Land. Thus, far back in the interior—back to the South Geographical Pole itself—across one thousand six hundred miles of lofty plateau—is a zone of high barometric pressure, while to the north lies the D'Urville Sea and beyond it the Southern Ocean—a zone of low pressure. As if through a contracted outlet, thereby increasing the velocity of the flow, the wind sweeps down over Adelie Land to equalize the great air-pressure system. And so, in winter, the chilling of the plateau leads to the development of a higher barometric pressure and, as the open water to the north persists, to higher winds. In summer the suns shines on the Pole for six months, the uplands of the continent are warmed and the northern zone of low pressure pushes southward. So, in Adelie Land, short spells of calm weather may be expected over a period of barely three months around the summer solstice. This explanation is intentionally popular. The meteorological problem is one which can only be fully discussed when all the manifold observations have been gathered together, from other contemporary Antarctic expeditions, from our two stations on the Antarctic continent, and from Macquarie Island; all taken in conjunction with weather conditions around Australia and New Zealand. Then, when all the evidence is arrayed and compared, some general truths of particular value to science and, maybe, to commerce, should emerge.

A stream of air, more like a torrent, rushes from the interior northward year after year, coming from a source that never runs dry. We have reason to think it’s a local phenomenon because there seems to be a stretch of open water about one hundred miles wide—the D'Urville Sea—north of Adelie Land. Thus, deep in the interior—going all the way back to the South Geographical Pole—across one thousand six hundred miles of high plateau, there’s a zone of high barometric pressure, while to the north lies the D'Urville Sea and beyond that, the Southern Ocean—a zone of low pressure. As if through a narrow opening, increasing the speed of the flow, the wind rushes down over Adelie Land to balance the larger air-pressure system. So in winter, the cooling of the plateau results in higher barometric pressure and, since the open water to the north remains, stronger winds. In summer, the sun shines on the Pole for six months, warming the uplands of the continent, and the northern low-pressure area pushes southward. As a result, in Adelie Land, brief periods of calm weather can be expected over a span of just three months around the summer solstice. This explanation is deliberately simplified. The weather issue is one that can only be fully addressed when all the various observations have been collected from other current Antarctic expeditions, from our two stations on the Antarctic continent, and from Macquarie Island; all considered alongside the weather conditions in Australia and New Zealand. Then, once all the data is organized and compared, some general insights of particular importance to science and possibly commerce should come to light.

Of one thing we were certain, and that was that Adelie Land was the windiest place in the world. To state the fact more accurately: such wind-velocities as prevail at sea-level in Adelie Land are known in other parts of the world only at great elevations in the atmosphere. The average wind-velocity for our first year proved to be approximately fifty miles per hour. The bare figures convey more when they are compared with the following average annual wind-velocities quoted from a book of reference: Europe, 10.3 miles per hour; United States, 9.5 miles per hour; Southern Asia, 6.5 miles per hour; West Indies, 6.2 miles per hour.

One thing we were sure of was that Adelie Land was the windiest place on Earth. To be more precise, the wind speeds that occur at sea level in Adelie Land are typically only found at high altitudes in other parts of the world. The average wind speed during our first year turned out to be about fifty miles per hour. These numbers carry more weight when compared to the following average annual wind speeds taken from a reference book: Europe, 10.3 miles per hour; United States, 9.5 miles per hour; Southern Asia, 6.5 miles per hour; West Indies, 6.2 miles per hour.

Reference has already been made to the fact that often the high winds ceased abruptly for a short interval. Many times during 1913 we had opportunities of judging this phenomenon and, as an example, may be quoted September 6.

Reference has already been made to the fact that often the high winds would suddenly stop for a brief period. Many times during 1913, we had chances to observe this phenomenon, and as an example, September 6 can be mentioned.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

A diagrammatic sketch illustrating the meteorological conditions at the main base, noon, September 6, 1913

A diagram showing the weather conditions at the main base at noon on September 6, 1913.

On that day a south-by-east hurricane fell off and the drift cleared suddenly from about the Hut at 11.20 A.M. On the hills to the south there was a dense grey wall of flying snow. Whirlies tracked about at intervals and overhead a fine cumulus cloud formed, revolving rapidly. Over the recently frozen sea there was an easterly breeze, while about the Hut itself there were light northerly airs. Later in the day the zone of southern wind and drift crept down and once more overwhelmed us. Evidently the "eye" of a cyclonic storm had passed over.

On that day, a south-by-east hurricane suddenly blew in, and the blizzard cleared up around the Hut at 11:20 A.M. To the south, there was a thick gray wall of flying snow. Whirlwinds moved around intermittently, and a fine cumulus cloud formed above, spinning quickly. There was an easterly breeze over the recently frozen sea, while there were light northern winds around the Hut itself. Later in the day, the area of southern wind and snow moved in again and once more engulfed us. Clearly, the "eye" of a cyclonic storm had passed over.

During September the sea was frozen over for more than two weeks, and the meteorological conditions varied from their normal phase. It appeared as if we were situated on the battlefield, so to speak, of opposing forces. The pacific influence of the "north" would hold sway for a few hours, a whole day, or even for a few days. Then the vast energies of the "south" would rise to bursting-point and a "through blizzard" would be the result.

During September, the sea was frozen for over two weeks, and the weather conditions were different from what we usually expect. It felt like we were on a battlefield, so to speak, between opposing forces. The calm influence of the "north" would prevail for a few hours, a whole day, or even a few days. Then, the massive energy from the "south" would surge to a breaking point, resulting in a blizzard.

On September 11, although there was a wind of seventy miles per hour, the sea-ice which had become very solid during a few days of low temperature was not dispersed. Next day we found it possible to walk in safety to the Mackellar Islets. On the way rushes of southerly wind accompanied by a misty drift followed behind us. Then a calm intervened, and the sun momentarily appeared and shone warmly. Suddenly from the north-west came breezy puffs which settled into a light wind as we went north. On the way home we could not see the mainland for clouds of drift, and, when approaching the mouth of the boat-harbour, these clouds were observed to roll down the lower slopes of the glacier and, reaching the shore, rise into the air in columns. They then sailed away northward at a higher altitude, almost obscuring the sun with a fine fog. On the same night the "south" had gained the mastery, and the wind blew with its accustomed strength.

On September 11, even with winds reaching seventy miles per hour, the sea ice, which had solidified in just a few days of cold weather, remained intact. The next day, we found it safe to walk to the Mackellar Islets. As we made our way, gusts of southern wind accompanied by a misty haze followed behind us. Then, a stillness settled in, and the sun briefly appeared, shining warmly. Suddenly, gentle breezes from the northwest picked up and turned into a light wind as we headed north. On our way back, we couldn’t see the mainland due to drifting clouds, and as we neared the boat harbor, we observed these clouds rolling down the lower slopes of the glacier, rising into the air in columns upon reaching the shore. They then drifted away to the north at a higher altitude, nearly blocking out the sun with a thin fog. That same night, the "south" regained control, and the wind blew with its usual intensity.

Again, on September 24, McLean had a unique experience. He was digging ice in a fifty-mile wind with moderate drift close to the Hut and, on finishing his work, walked down to the harbour-ice to see if there were any birds about. He was suddenly surprised to leave the wind and drift behind and to walk out into an area of calm. The water lapped alongside the ice-foot, blue in the brilliant sunlight. Away to the west a few miles distant a fierce wind was blowing snow like fine spume over the brink of the cliffs. Towards the north-west one could plainly see the junction between calm water and foam-crested waves. To the south the drift drove off the hills, passed the Hut, and then gyrated upwards and thinned away seawards at an altitude of several hundred feet.

Again, on September 24, McLean had a unique experience. He was digging ice in a fifty-mile wind with moderate drift near the Hut and, after finishing his work, walked down to the harbor ice to check for any birds. He was suddenly surprised to leave the wind and drift behind and step into a calm spot. The water lapped against the ice-foot, blue in the bright sunlight. A few miles to the west, a fierce wind was blowing snow like fine spray over the edge of the cliffs. To the northwest, you could clearly see where the calm water met the foam-topped waves. To the south, the drift swept off the hills, passed the Hut, and then spiraled upwards, thinning out to sea at an altitude of several hundred feet.

The wind average for September was 36.8 miles per hour, as against 53.7 for September of the previous year. There were nine "pleasant" days, that is, days on which it was possible to walk about outside and enjoy oneself. On the 27th there was a very severe blizzard. The wind was from the south-east: the first occasion on which it had blown from any direction but south-by-east at a high velocity. The drift was extremely dense, the roof of the Hut being invisible at a distance of six feet. Enormous ramps of snow formed in the vicinity, burying most of the cases and the air-tractor sledge completely. The anemograph screen was blown over and smashed beyond all repair. So said the Meteorological Notes in the October number of the 'Adelie Blizzard'.

The average wind speed for September was 36.8 miles per hour, compared to 53.7 for September of the previous year. There were nine "pleasant" days, which means days when it was nice enough to be outside and enjoy the fresh air. On the 27th, there was a very intense blizzard. The wind blew from the southeast, which was the first time it had come from any direction other than south-by-east at such a strong speed. The snowfall was incredibly thick, making the roof of the Hut impossible to see from six feet away. Huge snowbanks formed nearby, completely burying most of the cases and the air-tractor sledge. The anemograph screen was blown over and completely destroyed. So reported the Meteorological Notes in the October issue of the 'Adelie Blizzard'.

Speaking of temperature in general, it was found that the mean-temperature for the first year was just above zero; a very low temperature for a station situated near the Circle. The continual flow of cold air from the elevated interior of the continent accounts for this. If Adelie Land were a region of calms or of northerly winds, the average temperature would be very much higher. On the other hand, the temperature at sea-level was never depressed below-28 degrees F., though with a high wind we found that uncomfortable enough, even in burberrys. During the spring sledging in 1912 the lowest temperature recorded was -35 degrees F. and it was hard to keep warm in sleeping-bags. The wind made all the difference to one's resistance.

Speaking of temperature in general, it was found that the average temperature for the first year was just above freezing; a really low temp for a location near the Antarctic Circle. The constant flow of cold air from the high interior of the continent explains this. If Adelie Land experienced calm weather or northerly winds, the average temperature would be much higher. On the other hand, the temperature at sea level never dropped below -28 degrees F., though with a strong wind, that was uncomfortable enough, even in heavy clothing. During the spring sledding in 1912, the lowest recorded temperature was -35 degrees F., and it was tough to stay warm in sleeping bags. The wind made a huge difference in how much we could handle.

There was an unusually heavy snowfall during 1913. When the air was heavily charged with moisture, as in midsummer, the falls would consist of small (sago) or larger (tapioca) rounded pellets. Occasionally one would see beautiful complicated patterns in the form of hexagonal flakes. When low temperatures were the rule, small, plain, hexagonal stars or spicules fell. Often throughout a single snowfall many types would be precipitated. Thus, in September, in one instance, the fall commenced with fluffy balls and then passed to tapioca snow, sago snow, six-rayed stars and spicules.

There was an unusually heavy snowfall in 1913. When the air was really humid, like in midsummer, the snow would consist of small (sago) or larger (tapioca) round pellets. Sometimes, you would see beautiful, intricate patterns in the shape of hexagonal flakes. When the temperatures were low, small, simple hexagonal stars or spicules would fall. Often during a single snowfall, many types would come down. For example, in September, one time it started with fluffy balls and then switched to tapioca snow, sago snow, six-rayed stars, and spicules.

Wireless communication was still maintained, though September was found to be such a "disturbed" month—possibly owing to the brilliant aurorae—that not a great many messages were exchanged. Jeffryes was not in the best of health, so that Bickerton took over the operating work. Though at first signals could only be received slowly, Bickerton gradually improved with practice and was able to "keep up his end" until November 20, when daylight became continuous. One great advantage, which by itself justified the existence of the wireless plant, was the fact that time-signals were successfully received from Melbourne Observatory by way of Macquarie Island, and Bage was thus able to improve on his earlier determinations and to establish a fundamental longitude.

Wireless communication was still active, but September turned out to be such a "troubled" month—possibly due to the bright auroras—that not many messages were sent. Jeffryes wasn't in great health, so Bickerton took over the operating duties. At first, he could only receive signals slowly, but with practice, Bickerton gradually got better and was able to "keep up his end" until November 20, when daylight became constant. One major benefit, which alone justified having the wireless system, was that time-signals were successfully received from the Melbourne Observatory via Macquarie Island, allowing Bage to improve his earlier calculations and establish a fundamental longitude.

During this same happy month of September, whose first day marked the event of "One hundred days to the coming of the Ship" there was a great revival in biological work. Hodgeman made several varieties of bag-traps which were lowered over the edge of the harbour-ice, and many large "worms" and crustaceans were caught and preserved.

During this same cheerful month of September, with the first day marking "One hundred days to the arrival of the Ship," there was a significant resurgence in biological research. Hodgeman created several types of bag traps that were lowered over the edge of the harbor ice, and many large "worms" and crustaceans were caught and preserved.

On September 14 Bickerton started to construct a hand-dredge, which was ready for use by the next evening. It was a lovely, cloudless day on the 16th and the sea-ice, after more than two weeks, still spread to the north in a firm, unbroken sheet. We went out on skis to reconnoitre, and found that the nearest "lead" was too far away to make dredging a safe proposition. So we were contented to kill a seal and bring it home before lunch, continuing to sink the ice-shaft above the moraine for the rest of the day.

On September 14, Bickerton started building a hand-dredge, which was ready to use by the next evening. It was a beautiful, clear day on the 16th, and the sea ice, after more than two weeks, still stretched to the north in a solid, unbroken sheet. We went out on skis to scout around and found that the nearest "lead" was too far away to make dredging a safe option. So, we happily killed a seal and brought it home before lunch, continuing to dig the ice shaft above the moraine for the rest of the day.

The wind rose to the "seventies" on September 17, and the sea-ice was scattered to the north. On the 19th—a fine day—there were many detached pieces of floe which drifted in with a northerly breeze, and on one of these, floating in an ice-girt cove to the west, a sea-leopard was observed sunning himself. He was a big, vicious-looking brute, and we determined to secure him if possible. The first thing was to dispatch him before he escaped from the floe. This Madigan did in three shots from a Winchester rifle. A long steel-shod sledge was then dragged from the Hut and used to bridge the interval between the ice-foot and the floe. After the specimen had been flayed, the skin and a good supply of dogs' meat were hauled across and sledged home. On the 30th another sea-leopard came swimming in near the harbour's entrance, apparently on the look-out for seals or penguins. Including the one seen during 1912, only three of these animals were observed during our two years' sojourn in Adelie Land.

The wind picked up to the "seventies" on September 17, and the sea ice was scattered to the north. On the 19th—a beautiful day—there were many detached pieces of floe drifting in with a northern breeze, and on one of these, floating in an ice-bound cove to the west, a sea leopard was spotted sunning itself. He was a big, fierce-looking creature, and we decided to capture him if we could. The first thing was to take him down before he escaped from the floe. Madigan managed to do this in three shots with a Winchester rifle. A long, steel-shod sled was then pulled from the Hut to bridge the gap between the ice edge and the floe. After the specimen was skinned, we hauled the skin and a good amount of dog food back across and sledged it home. On the 30th, another sea leopard was seen swimming near the harbor entrance, seemingly looking for seals or penguins. Including the one spotted in 1912, we only saw three of these animals during our two-year stay in Adelie Land.

Dredgings in depths up to five fathoms were done inside the boat harbour and just off its entrance on five separate occasions between September 22 and the end of the month. Many "worms," crustaceans, pteropods, asteroids, gastropods and hydroids were obtained, and McLean and I had many interesting hours classifying the specimens. The former preserved and labelled them, establishing a small laboratory in the loft above the "dining-room." The only disadvantage of this arrangement was that various "foreign bodies" would occasionally come tumbling through the interspaces between the flooring boards of the loft while a meal was in progress.

Dredging was done in depths of up to five fathoms inside the boat harbor and just off its entrance on five separate occasions between September 22 and the end of the month. We collected many "worms," crustaceans, pteropods, asteroids, gastropods, and hydroids, and McLean and I spent a lot of interesting hours classifying the specimens. He preserved and labeled them, setting up a small lab in the loft above the "dining room." The only downside to this setup was that various "foreign bodies" would occasionally fall through the gaps between the floorboards of the loft while we were eating.

Some Antarctic petrels were shot and examined for external and internal parasites. Fish were caught in two traps made by Hodgeman and myself in October, but unfortunately the larger of the two was lost during a blizzard. However, on October 11 a haul of fifty-two fish was made with hand-lines off the boat harbour, and we had a pleasant change in the menu for dinner. They were of the type known as Notothenia, to which reference has already been made.

Some Antarctic petrels were shot and checked for external and internal parasites. Fish were caught in two traps made by Hodgeman and me in October, but unfortunately, the larger one was lost during a blizzard. However, on October 11, we caught fifty-two fish using hand-lines off the boat harbor, giving us a nice change in our dinner menu. They were of the type known as Notothenia, which has already been mentioned.

By October 13, when a stray silver-grey petrel appeared, every one was on the qui vive for the coming of the penguins. In 1912 they had arrived on October 12, and as there was much floating ice on the northern horizon, we wondered if their migration to land had been impeded.

By October 13, when a stray silver-grey petrel showed up, everyone was on high alert for the arrival of the penguins. In 1912, they had come on October 12, and with all the floating ice on the northern horizon, we wondered if their journey to land had been blocked.

The winds were very high for the ensuing two days, and on the 17th the horizon was clearer and more "water sky" was visible. Before lunch on that day there was not a living thing along the steep, overhanging ice-foot, but by the late afternoon thirteen birds had effected a landing, and those who were not resting after their long swim were hopping about making a survey of the nearest rookeries. One always has a "soft spot" for these game little creatures—there is something irresistibly human about them—and, situated as we were, the wind seemed of little account now that the foreshores were to be populated by the penguins—our harbingers of summer and the good times to be. Three days later, at the call of the season, a skua gull came flapping over the Hut.

The winds were really strong for the next two days, and on the 17th, the horizon was clearer, showing more of the "water sky." Before lunch that day, there wasn’t a single living thing along the steep, overhanging ice ledge, but by late afternoon, thirteen birds had landed, and those that weren’t resting after their long swim were hopping around, checking out the nearest rookeries. You can't help but have a "soft spot" for these brave little creatures—there’s something irresistibly human about them—and being where we were, the wind didn't seem to matter now that the shores were about to be filled with penguins—our sign of summer and the good times to come. Three days later, with the season calling, a skua gull came flapping over the Hut.

It was rather a singular circumstance that on the evening of the 17th, coincident with the disappearance of the ice on the horizon, wireless signals suddenly came through very strongly in the twilight at 9.30 P.M., and for many succeeding nights continued at the same intensity. On the other hand, during September, when the sea was either firmly frozen or strewn thickly with floe-ice, communication was very fitful and uncertain. The fact is therefore suggested that wireless waves are for some reason more readily transmitted across a surface of water than across ice.

It was quite unusual that on the evening of the 17th, right when the ice disappeared from the horizon, wireless signals suddenly came through very clearly at twilight at 9:30 PM, and for many nights after that, they continued at the same strength. On the other hand, in September, when the sea was either completely frozen or covered in thick floe-ice, communication was very intermittent and unreliable. This suggests that wireless waves somehow transmit more easily over water than over ice.

The weather during the rest of October and for the first weeks of November took on a phase of heavy snowfalls which we knew were inevitable before summer could be really established. The winds were very often in the "eighties" and every four or five days a calm might be expected.

The weather for the rest of October and the first weeks of November turned into heavy snowfalls, which we knew were unavoidable before summer could truly settle in. The winds were often in the "eighties," and we could expect a calm every four or five days.

The penguins had a tempestuous time building their nests, and resuming once more the quaint routine of their rookery life. In the hurricanes they usually ceased work and crouched behind rocks until the worst was over. A great number of birds were observed to have small wounds on the body which had bled and discoloured their feathers. In one case a penguin had escaped, presumably from a sea-leopard, with several serious wounds, and had staggered up to a rookery, dying there from loss of blood. Almost immediately the frozen carcase was mutilated and torn by skua gulls.

The penguins had a rough time building their nests and getting back into the usual routine of their colony life. During the storms, they usually stopped working and huddled behind rocks until it was safe again. Many birds were seen with small injuries on their bodies that had bled and stained their feathers. In one instance, a penguin had managed to escape, likely from a sea leopard, but had several serious wounds and staggered up to a colony, dying there from blood loss. Almost right away, the frozen body was ripped apart by skua gulls.

On October 31 the good news was received that the 'Aurora' would leave Australia on November 15. There were a great number of things to be packed, including the lathe, the motor and dynamos, the air-tractor engine, the wireless "set" and magnetic and meteorological instruments. Outside the Hut, many cases of kerosene and provisions, which might be required for the Ship, had been buried to a depth of twelve feet in places during the southeast hurricane in September. So we set to work in great spirits to prepare for the future.

On October 31, we got the great news that the 'Aurora' would leave Australia on November 15. There was a lot to pack, including the lathe, the motor and dynamos, the air-tractor engine, the wireless "set," and magnetic and meteorological instruments. Outside the Hut, many cases of kerosene and supplies, which might be needed for the Ship, had been buried to a depth of twelve feet in some spots during the southeast hurricane in September. So we got to work in high spirits to get ready for the future.

McLean was busy collecting biological specimens, managing to secure a large number of parasites from penguins, skua gulls, giant petrels, snow petrels, Wilson petrels, seals and an Emperor penguin, which came up on the harbour-ice. On several beautiful days, with a sea-breeze wafting in from the north, large purple and brown jelly-fish came floating to the ice-foot. Many were caught in a hand-net and preserved in formalin. In his shooting excursions McLean happened on a small rocky ravine to the east where, hovering among nests of snow and Wilson petrels, a small bluish-grey bird,* not unlike Prion Banksii, was discovered. Four specimens were shot, and, later, several old nests were found containing the unhatched eggs of previous years.

McLean was busy collecting biological specimens and managed to gather a large number of parasites from penguins, skua gulls, giant petrels, snow petrels, Wilson petrels, seals, and an Emperor penguin that appeared on the harbor ice. On several beautiful days, with a sea breeze blowing in from the north, large purple and brown jellyfish floated to the ice edge. Many were caught in a hand net and preserved in formalin. During his shooting trips, McLean stumbled upon a small rocky ravine to the east where, hovering among the nests of snow and Wilson petrels, he discovered a small bluish-grey bird, not unlike Prion Banksii. Four specimens were shot, and later, several old nests were found containing the unhatched eggs from previous years.

     ** On arrival in Australia this bird proved to be new to science.
     ** On arriving in Australia, this bird was discovered to be new to science.

On the highest point of Azimuth Hill, overlooking the sea, a Memorial Cross was raised to our two lost comrades.

On the highest point of Azimuth Hill, overlooking the sea, a Memorial Cross was erected for our two lost friends.

A calm evening in November! At ten o'clock a natural picture in shining colours is painted on the canvas of sea and sky. The northern dome is a blush of rose deepening to a warm terra-cotta along the horizon, and the water reflects it upward to the gaze. Tiny Wilson petrels flit by like swallows; seals shove their dark forms above the placid surface; the shore is lined with penguins squatting in grotesque repose. The south is pallid with light—the circling sun. Adelie Land is at peace!

A calm evening in November! At ten o'clock, a beautiful scene in bright colors unfolds on the canvas of the sea and sky. The northern sky is a blush of pink that deepens to a warm terra-cotta along the horizon, and the water mirrors it back for us to see. Little Wilson petrels dart by like swallows; seals raise their dark shapes above the calm surface; the shore is lined with penguins sitting in odd positions. The south is pale with light—the setting sun. Adelie Land is at peace!

For some time Madigan, Hodgeman and I had been prepared to set out on a short sledging journey to visit Mount Murchison and to recover if possible the instruments cached by the Eastern Coastal and the Southern Parties. It was not until November 23 that the weather "broke" definitely, and we started up the old glacier "trail" assisted by a good team of dogs.

For a while, Madigan, Hodgeman, and I had been ready to head out on a brief sledding trip to visit Mount Murchison and, if we could, retrieve the instruments left behind by the Eastern Coastal and Southern Parties. It wasn't until November 23 that the weather finally improved, and we began our trek up the old glacier trail with the help of a solid team of dogs.

Aladdin's Cave was much the same as we had left it in the previous February, except that a fine crop of delicate ice-crystals had formed on its walls. We carried with us a small home-made wireless receiving set, and arrangements were made with Bickerton and Bage to call at certain hours. As an "aerial" a couple of lengths of copper wire were run out on the surface of the ice. At the first "call" Madigan heard the signals strongly and distinctly, but beyond five and a half miles nothing more was received.

Aladdin's Cave looked pretty much the same as we left it last February, except a beautiful layer of delicate ice crystals had formed on the walls. We brought along a small homemade wireless receiver, and we set up plans with Bickerton and Bage to check in at specific times. For an "aerial," we laid out a couple of lengths of copper wire on the ice surface. At the first "call," Madigan picked up the signals loud and clear, but we couldn’t get anything beyond five and a half miles.

Resuming the journey on the following day, we made a direct course for Madigan Nunatak and then steered southeast for Mount Murchison, pitching camp at its summit on the night of November 28.

Resuming our journey the next day, we headed straight for Madigan Nunatak and then turned southeast toward Mount Murchison, setting up camp at its summit on the night of November 28.

On the 29th Madigan and Hodgeman made a descent into the valley, on whose southern side rose Aurora Peak. The former slid away on skis and had a fine run to the bottom, while Hodgeman followed on the sledge drawn by Monkey and D'Urville, braking with an ice-axe driven into the snow between the cross-bars. Their object was to find the depot of instruments and rocks which the Eastern Coastal Party were forced to abandon when fifty-three miles from home. They were unsuccessful in the search, as an enormous amount of snow had fallen on the old surface during the interval of almost a year. Indeed, on the knoll crowning Mount Murchison, where a ten-foot flagpole had been left, snow had accumulated so that less than a foot of the top of the pole was showing. Nine feet of hard compressed snow scarcely marked by one's footsteps—the contribution of one year! To such a high isolated spot drift-snow would not reach, so that the annual snowfall must greatly exceed the residuum found by us, for the effect of the prevailing winds would be to reduce it greatly.

On the 29th, Madigan and Hodgeman went down into the valley, where Aurora Peak rose on the southern side. Madigan glided down on skis and had a great run to the bottom, while Hodgeman followed on a sled pulled by Monkey and D'Urville, using an ice axe braked into the snow between the crossbars. Their goal was to locate the stash of instruments and rocks that the Eastern Coastal Party had to leave behind fifty-three miles from home. They didn’t succeed in their search since a huge amount of snow had fallen on the old surface during the nearly year-long gap. In fact, on the knoll at the top of Mount Murchison, where a ten-foot flagpole had been left, snow had built up so much that less than a foot of the pole’s top was visible. Nine feet of hard, compressed snow barely marked by footsteps—that was the result of just one year! In such a high, isolated spot, drift-snow wouldn’t reach, so the total snowfall must have been much greater than what we found, since the effect of the prevailing winds would significantly reduce it.

On the third day after leaving Mount Murchison for the Southern Party's depot, sixty-seven miles south of Winter Quarters, driving snow commenced, and a blizzard kept us in camp for seven days. When the drift at last moderated we were forced to make direct for the Hut, as the time when the Ship was expected to arrive had passed.

On the third day after leaving Mount Murchison for the Southern Party's depot, sixty-seven miles south of Winter Quarters, it started snowing heavily, and a blizzard kept us stuck in camp for seven days. When the snow finally let up, we had to head straight for the Hut since the time when the Ship was supposed to arrive had already passed.

Descending the long blue slopes of the glacier just before midnight on December 12, we became aware of a faint black bar on the seaward horizon. Soon a black speck had moved to the windward side of the bar—and it could be nothing but the smoke of the 'Aurora'. The moment of which we had dreamt for months had assuredly come. The Ship was in sight!

Descending the long blue slopes of the glacier just before midnight on December 12, we noticed a faint black line on the horizon facing the sea. Soon, a small black dot appeared on the side of the line where the wind was coming from—and it had to be the smoke of the 'Aurora'. The moment we had dreamed about for months had finally arrived. The ship was in sight!

There were wild cheers down at the Hut when they heard the news. They could not believe us and immediately rushed up with glasses to the nearest ridge to get the evidence of their own senses. The masts, the funnel and the staunch hull rose out of the ocean as we watched on the hills through the early hours of a superb morning. The sun was streaming warmly over the plateau and a cool land breeze had sprung up from the south, as the 'Aurora' rounded the Mackellar Islets and steamed up to her old anchorage. We picked out familiar figures on the bridge and poop, and made a bonfire of kerosene, benzine and lubricating oil in a rocky crevice in their honour.

There were wild cheers at the Hut when they heard the news. They couldn’t believe us and immediately rushed up with glasses to the nearest ridge to see for themselves. The masts, the funnel, and the sturdy hull emerged from the ocean as we watched from the hills during the early hours of a beautiful morning. The sun was shining warmly over the plateau, and a cool breeze had picked up from the south, as the 'Aurora' rounded the Mackellar Islets and steamed back to her old anchorage. We identified familiar figures on the bridge and deck, and we lit a bonfire of kerosene, gasoline, and oil in a rocky crevice in their honor.

The indescribable moment was when Davis came ashore in the whale-boat, manned by two of the Macquarie Islanders (Hamilton and Blake), Hurley and Hunter. They rushed into the Hut, and we tried to tell the story of a year in a few minutes.

The unforgettable moment was when Davis arrived on land in the whale-boat, crewed by two of the Macquarie Islanders (Hamilton and Blake), along with Hurley and Hunter. They burst into the Hut, and we attempted to share the story of a year in just a few minutes.

On the Ship we greeted Gillies, Gray, de la Motte, Ainsworth, Sandell and Correll. It was splendid to know that the world contained so many people, and to see these men who had stuck to the Expedition through "thick and thin." Then came the fusillade of letters, magazines and "mysterious" parcels and boxes. At dinner we sat down reunited in the freshly painted ward-room, striving to collect our bewildered thoughts at the sight of a white tablecloth, Australian mutton, fresh vegetables, fruit and cigars.

On the ship, we welcomed Gillies, Gray, de la Motte, Ainsworth, Sandell, and Correll. It was amazing to realize that the world had so many people and to see these guys who had stuck with the Expedition through thick and thin. Then came the flurry of letters, magazines, and "mysterious" packages and boxes. At dinner, we sat down together in the freshly painted wardroom, trying to gather our confused thoughts while looking at a white tablecloth, Australian lamb, fresh veggies, fruit, and cigars.

The two long years were over—for the moment they were to be effaced in the glorious present. We were to live in a land where drift and wind were unknown, where rain fell in mild, refreshing showers, where the sky was blue for long weeks, and where the memories of the past were to fade into a dream—a nightmare?

The two long years were finally over—for now, they were to be erased in the amazing present. We were going to live in a place where drift and wind didn’t exist, where rain came in gentle, refreshing showers, where the sky stayed blue for weeks, and where memories of the past would fade into a dream—a nightmare?





CHAPTER XXV LIFE ON MACQUARIE ISLAND

By G. F. Ainsworth

Left on an island in mid-ocean!

Left on an island in the middle of the ocean!

It suggests the romances of youthful days—Crusoe, Sindbad and all their glorious company. Still, when this narrative is completed, imagination will be seen to have played a small part. In fact, it is a plain tale of our experiences, descriptive of a place where we spent nearly two years and of the work accomplished during our stay.

It brings to mind the adventures of our younger days—Crusoe, Sindbad, and all their incredible friends. However, once this story is wrapped up, it will become clear that imagination had a minor role. In reality, it's a straightforward account of our experiences, describing a place where we spent nearly two years and the work we accomplished during that time.

The island was discovered in 1810 by Captain Hasselborough of the ship 'Perseverance', which had been dispatched by Campbell and Sons, of Sydney, under his command to look for islands inhabited by fur seals. Macquarie Islands, named by Hasselborough after the Governor of New South Wales, were found to be swarming with these valuable animals, and for two years after their discovery was made known, many vessels visited the place, landing gangs of men to procure skins and returning at frequent intervals to carry the proceeds of their labours to the markets of the world.

The island was discovered in 1810 by Captain Hasselborough of the ship 'Perseverance', which had been sent by Campbell and Sons from Sydney to look for islands populated by fur seals. Macquarie Islands, named by Hasselborough after the Governor of New South Wales, were found to be teeming with these valuable animals. For two years after the discovery was announced, many ships visited the area, landing crews to collect skins and returning frequently to bring the results of their work to markets around the world.

The slaughter of the seals was so great that the animals were almost exterminated within a few years. One ship is known to have left Macquarie Island with a cargo of 35,000 skins during the first year of operations. High prices were obtained for them in London and China, and many American, British and Sydney firms were engaged in the enterprise.

The seal slaughter was so excessive that the population was nearly wiped out within just a few years. One ship reportedly left Macquarie Island with 35,000 skins during its first year of operations. They fetched high prices in London and China, and many American, British, and Sydney companies were involved in the business.

The value of a skin is determined by the condition of the fur, which is often damaged by the animals fighting amongst themselves. Furthermore, at a certain season of the year, the seals moult, and if taken within a certain time of this natural process, the skin is almost valueless. These facts were ignored by the sealers, who killed without discrimination.

The value of a skin depends on the condition of the fur, which is often damaged when the animals fight each other. Additionally, during a certain season, seals shed their fur, and if captured during this natural process, the skin is nearly worthless. The sealers overlooked these facts and hunted indiscriminately.

Again, both male and female, old and young were ruthlessly slaughtered, with the obvious result—the extermination of the species. If supervision had been exercised and restrictions imposed, there is no doubt that the island would still have been used by the fur seal as a breeding-ground. During our stay none were seen, but Mr. Bauer, who acts as sealing herdsman and who had visited the island in that capacity each summer for eleven years, stated that he had seen odd ones at infrequent intervals.

Again, both men and women, old and young, were brutally killed, leading to the obvious outcome—the extinction of the species. If there had been oversight and regulations in place, there is no doubt the island would still have been used by the fur seals as a breeding ground. During our time there, none were seen, but Mr. Bauer, who works as the sealing herdsman and has visited the island each summer for eleven years, stated that he had spotted a few at rare intervals.

Associated as the island has been since the year 1812 with sealing and oil ventures, it follows that a history has been gradually developed; somewhat traditional, though many occurrences to which we shall refer are well authenticated.

Associated with sealing and oil ventures since 1812, the island has gradually developed a history; it's somewhat traditional, although many events we will mention are well-documented.

It might be supposed from the foregoing, that a good deal is known about the place, but such is not the case, except in a general sense. Several scientific men from New Zealand, recognizing the importance of the island as a link between Australasia and Antarctica, visited it at different times within the past twenty years, only remaining long enough to make a cursory examination of the eastern side. They had to depend on the courtesy of the sealing ships' captains for a passage, and the stormy conditions which are ever prevalent made their stay too brief for any exhaustive work.

It may seem from the earlier discussion that a lot is known about the place, but that’s not true, at least not in detail. Several scientists from New Zealand have recognized the island's significance as a connection between Australasia and Antarctica and visited it at various times over the last twenty years, but they only stayed long enough to take a quick look at the eastern side. They relied on the kindness of the sealing ship captains for transportation, and the consistently stormy weather limited their time there, making it impossible to conduct any thorough research.

A Russian Antarctic expedition, under Bellingshausen's command, called there in 1821 and stayed for two days, collecting a few bird and animal specimens. They referred to the island as being "half-cooled down," in a short but interesting account of their visit, and remarked upon the large number of sea-elephants lying on the shores.

A Russian Antarctic expedition, led by Bellingshausen, visited there in 1821 and stayed for two days, gathering a few bird and animal samples. They described the island as "half-cooled down" in a brief but fascinating account of their visit and noted the large number of sea elephants resting on the shores.

In 1840 the ship 'Peacock', one of the exploring vessels of the American Expedition under Wilkes, landed several men after much difficulty on the south-west of the island, but they remained only a few hours, returning to their ship after securing some specimens of birds. Expressing astonishment at the "myriad of birds", they remarked, "Macquarie Islands offer no inducement for a visit, and as far as our examination showed, have no suitable place for landing with a boat."

In 1840, the ship 'Peacock', part of the American Expedition led by Wilkes, managed to land several crew members on the southwest side of the island after a lot of trouble. They stayed for only a few hours and returned to their ship with some bird samples. They were amazed by the “myriad of birds” and noted, “Macquarie Islands offer no reason for a visit, and based on our examination, there isn't a suitable spot for landing with a boat.”

The next call of an Antarctic expedition was made by Captain Scott in the 'Discovery' in November 1901. He, with several naturalists, landed on the eastern side to collect specimens, but remained only a few hours. He refers to the penguins, kelp-weed and tussock grass; certainly three characteristic features.

The next call for an Antarctic expedition was made by Captain Scott on the 'Discovery' in November 1901. He, along with several naturalists, landed on the eastern side to collect specimens but only stayed for a few hours. He mentions the penguins, kelp, and tussock grass; definitely three distinctive features.

Captain Davis, during his search for charted sub-antarctic islands, when connected with Sir Ernest Shackleton's expedition, called there in the 'Nimrod' in 1909. He landed a party of men who secured several sea-elephants and some penguins.

Captain Davis, while looking for mapped sub-antarctic islands and linked up with Sir Ernest Shackleton's expedition, stopped there on the 'Nimrod' in 1909. He sent a group of men ashore who captured several sea elephants and some penguins.

It will thus be seen that very little had been done which was scientifically important or generally interesting. Sealers came and went as a matter of business, and probably the arduous nature of their work and the rugged topography of the island combined to prevent the more curious from exploring far afield.

It can be seen that not much was accomplished that was scientifically significant or broadly interesting. Sealers came and went as part of their business, and likely the tough nature of their work and the rough landscape of the island kept the more inquisitive individuals from exploring too far.

Captain Scott was desirous of establishing a base on Macquarie Island in 1910, but circumstances compelled him to abandon the idea. And so it came that we five men of Dr. Mawson's Expedition were landed on December 22, 1911, with a programme of work outlined by our leader. H. Hamilton was biologist, L. R. Blake surveyor and geologist, C. A. Sandell and A. J. Sawyer were wireless operators, the former being also a mechanic, and I was appointed meteorologist and leader of the party.

Captain Scott wanted to set up a base on Macquarie Island in 1910, but circumstances forced him to drop the plan. So, on December 22, 1911, we five men from Dr. Mawson's Expedition were landed with a work plan laid out by our leader. H. Hamilton was the biologist, L. R. Blake was the surveyor and geologist, C. A. Sandell and A. J. Sawyer were the wireless operators, with the former also being a mechanic, and I was appointed as the meteorologist and leader of the group.

We stood on the beach in the dusk, watching the boat's party struggle back to the 'Aurora', which lay at anchor one and a half miles from the north-west shore. Having received a soaking landing in the surf and being tired out with the exertions of the day, we started back to our temporary shelter. We had not gone very far when a mysterious sound, followed by a shaking of the earth, made us glance at each other and exclaim, "An earthquake!" The occurrence gave rise to a discussion which carried us to bed.

We stood on the beach at dusk, watching the party from the boat struggle back to the 'Aurora', which was anchored a mile and a half from the northwest shore. After getting soaked landing in the waves and feeling exhausted from the day's activities, we started back to our temporary shelter. We hadn't gone far when a strange sound, followed by a shaking of the ground, made us look at each other and shout, "An earthquake!" This led to a conversation that lasted until we went to bed.

Seeing that we were to spend a long time on the island, the question of building a hut was the first consideration. Through the kindness of Mr. Bauer, who had just left the island in the s.s. 'Toroa', we were able to live for the time being in the sealers' hut.

Seeing that we were going to be on the island for a while, the first thing we needed to think about was building a hut. Thanks to Mr. Bauer, who had just left the island on the s.s. 'Toroa', we were able to stay temporarily in the sealers' hut.

It was urgent to get the wireless station into working order as soon as possible. The masts and operating-hut had been erected during the stay of the 'Aurora', but there yet remained the building of the engine-hut and the installation of the machinery and instruments, as well as the construction and erection of the aerial. Accordingly we proceeded with the living-hut and the job on Wireless Hill at the same time, working on the hill most of the day and at the hut in the evening.

It was crucial to get the wireless station up and running as soon as possible. The masts and operating hut had been set up while the 'Aurora' was there, but we still needed to build the engine hut and install the machinery and instruments, along with constructing and putting up the aerial. So, we worked on the living hut and the project on Wireless Hill simultaneously, spending most of the day on the hill and working at the hut in the evening.

Wireless Hill rose to three hundred and fifty feet in height, and formed part of a peninsula running in a northeasterly direction from the main island. It had been chosen by Mr. Hannam of the Adelie Land party because of its open northerly aspect, and because "wireless" waves would probably have a good "set-off," southward to the Main Base in Antarctica.

Wireless Hill rose to three hundred and fifty feet tall and was part of a peninsula extending northeast from the main island. Mr. Hannam of the Adelie Land party selected it for its open northern view and because "wireless" signals would likely have a strong connection southward to the Main Base in Antarctica.

Just a few yards from the base of the hill on its southwestern side was a huge rock, upon the easterly side of which we decided to build our dwelling. The timbers for the hut had been cut and fitted in Hobart, so all that remained for us was to put them together.

Just a few yards from the bottom of the hill on its southwestern side was a huge rock, on the east side of which we decided to build our home. The wood for the hut had been cut and prepared in Hobart, so all we had to do was assemble it.

After working at high pressure until December 30, we were able to establish ourselves in a home. The doorway faced to the east, and the rock protected the small place from the strong westerly weather which is invariable in these latitudes. The dimensions were twenty feet by thirteen feet, the front wall being nine feet six inches high, sloping to seven feet six inches at the back. All the timbers were of oregon and deal, and particular attention was paid to bracing and strengthening the building, which rested on piles just clear of the sandy surface. The inside was lined and ceiled, and the roof of galvanized iron was set flush with the front wall, fascia boards along the front and sides being designed to keep the fine snow from blowing under the corrugations and lodging on the ceiling. "George V Villa" was fixed upon as the name, but the hut was never at any time referred to as the villa, and in future will always be known as the Shack.

After working at a high pace until December 30, we finally managed to settle into a home. The doorway faced east, and the rock shielded the small space from the harsh westerly weather that's typical in these regions. The dimensions were twenty feet by thirteen feet, with the front wall standing nine feet six inches high, sloping down to seven feet six inches at the back. All the wood used was Oregon pine and deal, and we paid special attention to bracing and reinforcing the construction, which was built on piles above the sandy ground. The interior was lined and ceilinged, and the roof made of galvanized iron was flush with the front wall, with fascia boards along the front and sides designed to prevent fine snow from blowing under the corrugations and settling on the ceiling. We decided on the name "George V Villa," but the hut was never referred to as the villa and will henceforth always be known as the Shack.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Plan of Hut—Macquarie Island

Hut Plan—Macquarie Island

Twelve live sheep had been landed, and these had been driven on to Wireless Hill so as to be accessible. We decided to kill one for Christmas, so on December 24 Sandell and I, leaving the others at work on the Shack, started out.

Twelve live sheep had been brought over, and we moved them up to Wireless Hill to make them easy to access. We decided to kill one for Christmas, so on December 24, Sandell and I, leaving the others to work on the Shack, set out.

The hillsides are deeply ravined and the slopes covered with a dense growth of tussock, which renders progress uncertain and laborious. Our experience was a foretaste of many to come. We found the sheep huddled together in a deep gully on the eastern side, and drove them round to the front of the hill, where one was caught, killed and dressed.

The hillsides are deeply cut, and the slopes are covered with thick tussock grass, making it hard and exhausting to move forward. What we experienced was just a preview of many more challenges ahead. We found the sheep gathered in a deep gully on the east side and herded them to the front of the hill, where we caught one, killed it, and prepared it for cooking.

Christmas Day dawned fine and sunny, and we decided to make some attempt at a dinner. Blake produced a plum pudding, and this, together with roast mutton and several kinds of vegetables, washed down with a little claret, constituted our first Christmas dinner.

Christmas Day started off bright and sunny, and we decided to try to put together a dinner. Blake brought out a plum pudding, and this, along with roasted mutton and various vegetables, enjoyed with a bit of claret, made up our first Christmas dinner.

The sealing schooner, Clyde, had been wrecked without loss of life on November 14, 1911, on the east coast, and was now lying on the beach nearly half a mile away. A two-hundred-gallon tank had been saved from the wreck and we managed on Christmas morning, after two hours of carrying and trundling, to place it at the end of the Shack. This was a valuable find, ensuring in the future a constant, convenient supply of rain water. Further, we made use of the timber of the wreck for building, and the broken pieces strewn about were stored up as firewood.

The sealing schooner, Clyde, was wrecked without any loss of life on November 14, 1911, on the east coast and was now lying on the beach nearly half a mile away. A two-hundred-gallon tank had been salvaged from the wreck, and on Christmas morning, after two hours of carrying and rolling, we set it up at the end of the Shack. This was a valuable find, ensuring a constant, convenient supply of rainwater in the future. Additionally, we used the timber from the wreck for building, and the broken pieces scattered around were stored as firewood.

On the 26th we all went to the wireless station, and, as Sandell had the aerial made, we pulled it into position. In the afternoon I unpacked all my instruments and started them off so as to make sure that all were working correctly. I did not intend to record any observations till January 1, 1912, and therefore did not erect the meteorological screen until the 28th.

On the 26th, we all headed to the radio station, and since Sandell had made the antenna, we set it up. In the afternoon, I unpacked all my instruments and got them started to ensure everything was functioning properly. I didn't plan to take any readings until January 1, 1912, so I didn't set up the weather screen until the 28th.

On moving into our abode domestic arrangements were made. With regard to cooking, each man took duty for a week, during which he was able to write up his work and to wash and mend clothes. To Hamilton and Sandell, who had had previous experience, frequent appeals were made as to methods of cooking various dishes, but by degrees each one asserted his independence. There were several cookery books for reference and each week saw the appearance of some new pudding, in each instance prefaced by the boast: "This is going to be the best pudding ever turned out on the island!" The promise was not always made good.

Once we settled into our home, we organized our daily tasks. For cooking, each person took a week-long turn, during which they could also catch up on work and handle laundry repairs. We often turned to Hamilton and Sandell, who had more experience, for advice on how to prepare different dishes, but gradually everyone began to assert their own independence. We had several cookbooks to refer to, and each week brought a new pudding, always introduced with the claim: "This is going to be the best pudding ever made on the island!" The results didn’t always live up to the hype.

We had a good deal of difficulty at first in making bread and several batches were very "heavy" failures. This difficulty, however, was soon overcome and, after the first few months, the cooking standard was high and well maintained. Our stove was very small and only two loaves of bread could be cooked at once. It frequently happened, therefore, that the others, which would go on rising in the tins, overflowed; a matter which could only be set right by experience.

We initially had a lot of trouble making bread, and several batches turned out to be really dense failures. However, we quickly got the hang of it, and after the first few months, our cooking skills improved significantly. Our stove was quite small, so we could only bake two loaves of bread at a time. As a result, the other loaves would often keep rising in the pans and overflow, which we could only fix through experience.

On New Year's Day, 1912, we carried timber in relays from the wreck to the top of Wireless Hill, so that the building of the engine-hut could be started. The next few days were occupied in getting food-stuffs, medicines, stationery, clothing and other necessaries over to the Shack from the landing-place on the beach. Blake and Hamilton unpacked their instruments and appliances, fitting up a small laboratory and photographic dark-room in one corner of the hut.

On New Year's Day, 1912, we transported lumber in shifts from the wreck to the top of Wireless Hill, so that we could start building the engine hut. The next few days were spent bringing food, medicines, stationery, clothing, and other essentials over to the Shack from the landing spot on the beach. Blake and Hamilton unpacked their instruments and equipment, setting up a small lab and a photography darkroom in one corner of the hut.

Some kind Hobart friend had sent four fowls to me on the day of sailing, requesting me to take them to Macquarie island. They were housed in one of the meteorological screens, but on the third day from Hobart a heavy sea broke on board, upset the temporary fowl-house and crushed the rooster's head. The three hens were landed safely and appeared to be thoroughly reconciled to their strange surroundings, though the presence of so many large birds soaring about overhead had a terrifying effect on them for several days. They did not appear to pick up much food amongst the grass, but scratched away industriously all the same. I must say that they were very friendly and gave the place quite a homely aspect. One of them was christened "Ma" on account of her maternal and somewhat fussy disposition.

Some kind friend from Hobart sent me four chickens on the day we set sail, asking me to take them to Macquarie Island. They were kept in one of the meteorological screens, but on the third day out from Hobart, a heavy wave hit the ship and knocked over their makeshift coop, crushing the rooster’s head. The three hens were safely landed and seemed to adapt well to their new surroundings, although the sight of so many large birds flying overhead scared them for several days. They didn't seem to find much food in the grass, but they kept scratching around anyway. I have to say, they were quite friendly and made the place feel more like home. One of them was named "Ma" because of her motherly and somewhat fussy nature.

On the first Sunday in the new year all except myself went along the coast towards West Point. The party reported immense numbers of sea-elephants, especially young ones. They also saw many wekas and three ducks, shooting nine of the former for the kitchen.

On the first Sunday of the new year, everyone except me headed down the coast toward West Point. The group reported seeing huge amounts of sea elephants, especially the young ones. They also spotted a lot of wekas and three ducks, shooting nine of the former for the kitchen.

The wekas or Maori hens are small, flightless birds, averaging when full grown about two and three-quarter pounds. They were introduced twenty-five years ago by Mr. Elder, of New Zealand, a former lessee of the island, and multiplied so fast that they are now very numerous. They live among the tussocks, and subsist for the most part upon the larvae of the kelp-fly, small fish and other marine life which they catch under the stones along the rocky shores at low tide. They are exceedingly inquisitive and pugnacious and may easily be caught by hand.

The wekas, also known as Maori hens, are small, flightless birds that typically weigh about two and three-quarter pounds when fully grown. They were brought to the island twenty-five years ago by Mr. Elder, a former lessee from New Zealand, and they multiplied so rapidly that there are now many of them. They live among the tussocks and mainly feed on the larvae of kelp flies, small fish, and other marine life that they catch under stones along the rocky shores at low tide. They are very curious and aggressive, making them easy to catch by hand.

Usually, when disturbed, they will pop under a rock, and on being seized immediately commence to squeak. This is sufficient to bring every weka within a quarter of a mile hurrying to the spot, and, in a few minutes, heads may be seen poking out of the grass in every direction. The man holding the bird then crouches down, preferably just on the border of the tussock, holding the protesting bird in one hand. Soon there will be a rustle, then a rush, and another furious weka will attack the decoy. The newcomer is grabbed and, if the birds are plentiful, five or six of them may be taken in one spot.

Usually, when they’re disturbed, they’ll dart under a rock, and as soon as they get grabbed, they start squeaking right away. This is enough to bring every weka within a quarter of a mile rushing to the scene, and in just a few minutes, you can see heads popping out of the grass in all directions. The person holding the bird then crouches down, ideally just at the edge of the tussock, keeping the squawking bird in one hand. Soon, there will be some rustling, then a rush, and another furious weka will attack the decoy. The new arrival gets caught, and if there are plenty of birds around, you might catch five or six in one spot.

Their call is peculiarly plaintive and wild and may be heard night and day. Though we saw and caught innumerable young ones of all sizes, we were never able to find the nests of these Maori hens.

Their call is uniquely mournful and wild and can be heard day and night. Although we saw and caught countless young ones of various sizes, we were never able to locate the nests of these Maori hens.

A depot of stores had been laid by the 'Aurora' at Caroline Cove, twenty miles from the Shack at the south end of the island, and it was deemed advisable to lay several more intermediate food-depots along the east coast.

A supply depot had been set up by the 'Aurora' at Caroline Cove, twenty miles from the Shack at the southern end of the island, and it was considered wise to establish several more food depots along the east coast.

The sealers had a motor-launch which they kindly placed at our disposal, and a supply of stores was put on board for transport. At 8 A.M., January 9, Sandell, Blake, Sawyer and Hamilton started out accompanied by two sealers who offered to point out the positions of several old huts along the coast. These huts had been built by sealing gangs many years ago and were in a sad state of disrepair.

The sealers had a motorboat that they generously made available to us, and we loaded it with supplies for transport. At 8 A.M. on January 9, Sandell, Blake, Sawyer, and Hamilton set out, joined by two sealers who offered to show us the locations of several old huts along the coast. These huts, built by sealing crews many years earlier, were in really poor condition.

The first call was made at Sandy Bay, about five miles from the Shack. Stores were landed and placed in the hut, and the party proceeded to Lusitania Bay, eleven miles farther on, where they stayed for the night. At this place (named after an old sealing craft, the 'Lusitania') there were two huts, one being a work-hut and the other a living-hut. They had not been used for sixteen years and, as a result, were found to be much dilapidated. In the locality is a large King penguin rookery, the only one on the island, and two dozen eggs were obtained on this visit, some fresh and some otherwise.

The first call was made at Sandy Bay, about five miles from the Shack. Supplies were unloaded and put in the hut, and the group moved on to Lusitania Bay, eleven miles further, where they spent the night. This place (named after an old sealing ship, the 'Lusitania') had two huts: one for work and the other for living. They hadn't been used for sixteen years, so they were found to be quite rundown. In the area is a large King penguin rookery, the only one on the island, and two dozen eggs were collected on this visit, some fresh and some not.

As the next morning was squally, it was decided that the stores should be deposited in the hut at the south end; a distance of five miles across country. Through bog and tussock it took the party four hours to accomplish this journey. The hut was found in the same condition as the others and a rather miserable night was spent. A short distance from this spot is situated the largest penguin rookery on the island. On returning to the launch, the six men had a quick run of three hours back to the north end.

As the next morning was stormy, it was decided that the supplies should be stored in the hut at the south end, which was five miles away overland. The group took four hours to make the trip through bog and tussock. They found the hut in the same state as the others and spent a pretty miserable night there. Not far from this spot is the largest penguin rookery on the island. On the way back to the launch, the six men made a quick three-hour run back to the north end.

During the absence of the party I had been busy erecting a stand for the anemo-biagraph. Ordinarily, such an instrument is kept in a house, the upper section only being exposed through the roof. The Shack was in a position too sheltered for my purpose, so I built a place for the anemo-biagraph behind a low rock well out on the isthmus.

While the group was away, I spent my time building a stand for the anemo-biagraph. Usually, this kind of instrument is stored indoors, with only the top part sticking out through the roof. The Shack was located in a spot that was too sheltered for my needs, so I created a place for the anemo-biagraph behind a low rock far out on the isthmus.

Sandell and Sawyer reported on the 16th that the wireless station was ready for testing. Therefore, on the following day, the three of us erected a small set on the farthest point of the peninsula—North Head. The set had been made in order to test the large station. Sawyer then returned to the operating-hut and received signals sent from North Head by Sandell, who in return received Sawyer's signals, thus showing that so far everything was satisfactory. It was thought, after the tests, that the "earth" was not by any means good and Sawyer erected a counterpoise, which, however, failed to give anything like the "earth" results. More "earths" (connexions by wire with the ground) were now put in from day to day, and on the 27th Sawyer noted an improvement. Successful tests were again made on the 30th. The wireless men now expected communication with Australia.

Sandell and Sawyer reported on the 16th that the wireless station was ready for testing. So, the next day, the three of us set up a small station at the furthest point of the peninsula—North Head. The station was built to test the large facility. Sawyer then went back to the operating hut and received signals sent from North Head by Sandell, who, in turn, received signals from Sawyer, confirming that everything was working well so far. After the tests, it was determined that the "earth" connection wasn't very good, so Sawyer set up a counterpoise, which, however, didn’t give any significant improvement in the "earth" results. More "earths" (connections by wire to the ground) were added day by day, and on the 27th, Sawyer noticed an improvement. Successful tests were conducted again on the 30th. The wireless team was now hopeful for communication with Australia.

Blake and Hamilton were soon making inroads, each on his own particular sphere of work. On the 17th a baseline was laid down on the plateau, and Blake was able to commence his survey of the island. He had already made some geological investigations in the vicinity of North Head and West Point, as well as for a short distance along the east coast. Hamilton had visited nearly all the penguin rookeries in the vicinity, and already had several fine specimens. Marine collecting occupied part of his time and plant life promised to provide an interesting field.

Blake and Hamilton were soon making progress, each in his specific area of work. On the 17th, a baseline was established on the plateau, allowing Blake to start his survey of the island. He had already conducted some geological studies near North Head and West Point, as well as a short distance along the east coast. Hamilton had visited almost all the penguin rookeries nearby and had already gathered several great specimens. Part of his time was spent on marine collecting, and plant life looked like it would offer an intriguing opportunity.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

The north end of Macquarie Island

The north end of Macquarie Island

From the intermediate position that Macquarie Island occupies relative to Australasia and the Antarctic continent, it was highly important that its biology should be fully determined. Investigation of the marine and terrestrial fauna and flora shows several facts indicating the part this island has played in the supposed connexion of the great land masses of the southern hemispheres. It is an established fact that the flora of New Zealand has strong sub-antarctic and South American affinities and the problem is to account for this distribution. Many forms of plant and animal life are circumaustral, being found in all suitable sub-antarctic situations. To account for this fact two theories have been advanced, namely, the Relict theory (Dahl, Schenck and others) and the Antarctic theory.

From the mid-point that Macquarie Island holds between Australasia and the Antarctic continent, it was crucial to completely understand its biology. Research into the marine and land animals and plants reveals several facts highlighting the role this island has played in the supposed connection between the major landmasses of the southern hemispheres. It's widely recognized that New Zealand’s plant life has strong sub-Antarctic and South American connections, and the challenge is to explain this distribution. Many species of plants and animals are circumaustral, appearing in all suitable sub-Antarctic environments. To explain this phenomenon, two theories have been proposed, namely, the Relict theory (Dahl, Schenck, and others) and the Antarctic theory.

The first theory supposes that the inhabitants of the sub-antarctic islands are the remnants of groups of animals developed in some northern land-mass, and driven south by more highly developed forms. Again, that these sub-antarctic islands have always been separated from continents, and that the distribution of life on the former must have proceeded over wide stretches of sea.

The first theory suggests that the inhabitants of the sub-Antarctic islands are the remnants of animal groups that originated in some northern landmass and were pushed south by more advanced species. It also proposes that these sub-Antarctic islands have always been isolated from continents, and that the distribution of life there must have occurred over vast stretches of ocean.

The Antarctic theory accounts for the distribution and similarity of sub-antarctic fauna and flora by establishing a connexion between the sub-antarctic islands and the Antarctic continent. At the same period, the Antarctic continent was assumed to be connected by land with South America, South Africa and Australia, and the similar life forms now found in these continents were driven northward by a subsequent colder period. This theory is strengthened by several facts, chief of which are, (1) the existence of an Antarctic continent, and (2) the comparatively shallow waters between it, South Africa, Australia and South America.

The Antarctic theory explains how sub-Antarctic plants and animals are distributed and similar by linking the sub-Antarctic islands to the Antarctic continent. At that time, it was believed that the Antarctic continent was connected by land to South America, South Africa, and Australia, and that similar species found on these continents were pushed northward during a later cooler period. This theory is supported by several key facts, primarily (1) the existence of an Antarctic continent, and (2) the relatively shallow waters between it, South Africa, Australia, and South America.

Whichever theory is adopted, it is evident that our scientific opportunities were unique.

Whichever theory we choose, it's clear that our scientific opportunities were one-of-a-kind.

On the 28th, Sandell, Sawyer and I decided to climb on to the main ridge or plateau of the island. We had already discovered that the easiest way to get on to the hills was to follow up one of the many ravines or gullies which run down to the sea. This necessitates walking in water most of the way, but one soon gets accustomed to wet feet on Macquarie Island.

On the 28th, Sandell, Sawyer, and I decided to hike up to the main ridge or plateau of the island. We had already found that the easiest way to access the hills was to follow one of the many ravines or gullies that lead down to the sea. This requires walking in water for most of the way, but you quickly get used to having wet feet on Macquarie Island.

The slopes rise in a series of terraces which are generally soggy and covered with tussock (pleurophyllum) and with scattered cushions of Azorella. The summit of the ridge is a barren waste, over which loose rocks are scattered in every direction, while a wavy effect due to the action of wind is plainly visible over the surface of the ground. The steep, descending sides are very soft and sodden, supporting a scanty growth of vegetation, including the small burr known as the "biddy-bid."

The slopes rise in a series of terraces that are usually wet and covered with tussock (pleurophyllum) and scattered patches of Azorella. The top of the ridge is a barren area, with loose rocks strewn everywhere, while a wavy pattern from the wind’s action is clearly visible on the ground’s surface. The steep, descending sides are very soft and soggy, supporting a sparse growth of plants, including the small burr called the "biddy-bid."

Hundreds of tarns and lakes are visible along the plateau-like ridge which extends throughout the length of the island. Several of the lakes are half a mile long and very deep. The tarns are, for the most part, shallow with hard stony bottoms. The water is beautifully fresh and apparently contains no life.

Hundreds of ponds and lakes can be seen along the flat ridge that runs the entire length of the island. Some of the lakes are half a mile long and quite deep. The ponds are mostly shallow with rocky bottoms. The water is crystal clear and seems to have no living organisms in it.

Skua gulls were plentiful and washed themselves, with a great flapping of wings, in the shallow waters at the edge of the lakes. They paid particular attention to our dog "Mac," swooping down and attempting to strike her with their wings. A yelp at intervals came from Mac if they were successful, though the former, if she were quick enough, would spring at the bird and retaliate by getting a mouthful of feathers.

Skua gulls were abundant and cleaning themselves, flapping their wings vigorously in the shallow waters by the lakes. They especially targeted our dog "Mac," diving down and trying to hit her with their wings. Mac would yelp now and then if they succeeded, but if she was fast enough, she'd jump at the bird and snap up a mouthful of feathers in return.

We eventually came out on to a point about seven hundred feet high, overlooking the west coast, and it could be seen that the space between the base of the hills and the ocean was occupied by a plain which sloped very gradually to the beach. Here and there across its surface were huge mounds of earth and rock and, occasionally, a small lakelet fringed with a dense growth of tussock and Maori cabbage.

We finally reached a viewpoint about seven hundred feet high, overlooking the west coast, where we could see that the area between the bottom of the hills and the ocean was filled with a flat plain that gradually sloped down to the beach. Scattered across its surface were large mounds of earth and rock, and now and then, there was a small pond bordered by thick growths of tussock and Maori cabbage.

A descent was made to explore the place. A fairly large volume of water flowed rapidly downward by several deep gullies and, coming to the terrace, cut narrow, sinuous channels which were soon lost to view in the tussocks. Examination of the watercourses revealed that this tract was simply a raised beach covered with sodden peat and carrying a rather coarse vegetation. The ground was decidedly springy and shook to our tread; moreover, one sank down over the ankles at each step. Occasionally a more insecure area was encountered, where one of us would go down to the thighs in the boggy ground.

A descent was made to check out the area. A pretty large amount of water flowed quickly down through several deep gullies and, reaching the terrace, carved narrow, winding channels that soon disappeared into the tussocks. Looking at the watercourses showed that this land was basically an elevated beach covered with wet peat and had a rather coarse plant life. The ground was definitely springy and wobbled under our feet; plus, each step caused us to sink down to our ankles. Sometimes, we came across a more unstable spot, where one of us would sink down to our thighs in the muddy ground.

As the shore approached we came to thick tussock and Maori cabbage, and the travelling became much rougher. A group of earthy mounds and rock was sighted some distance away and we decided to reach them and have our lunch. A nearer view showed us a large opening in one of these prominences and we scrambled up to examine it.

As we got closer to the shore, we encountered thick tussock and Maori cabbage, making the journey a lot bumpier. We saw a group of earthy mounds and rocks in the distance and decided to head over to them for lunch. When we got closer, we noticed a large opening in one of the mounds and climbed up to check it out.

Inside there was a small cave, high in front but sloping sharply towards the back for a distance of thirty-five feet. The roof and walls were blackened by smoke, and spikes and nails driven into crevices were evidences that the place had once been occupied. Eagle Cave it is called and its story was afterwards related to us.

Inside, there was a small cave, high in the front but sloping sharply toward the back for about thirty-five feet. The roof and walls were blackened by smoke, and spikes and nails driven into the crevices showed that the place had once been occupied. It’s called Eagle Cave, and its story was later shared with us.

Between thirty and forty years ago the schooner 'Eagle', in attempting to make the island, had been caught in a gale and wrecked on the rock-bound western coast. As far as can be learned, there were nine men and a woman on board, all of whom were saved. They lived in this cave for almost two years, subsisting upon what they could catch. Decayed tussock grass, a foot in depth, now covers the floor, showing that some attempt had been made to improve the comfort of the place, while bones lying strewn about in all directions indicate that gulls, penguins and cormorants must have supplied a good deal of their food. It is presumed that some of them made a journey to North Head periodically to look out for relief, as a well-defined track to that point is still visible in places.

Between thirty and forty years ago, the schooner 'Eagle' tried to reach the island but got caught in a storm and crashed on the rocky western coast. From what we know, there were nine men and one woman on board, and they all survived. They lived in this cave for nearly two years, surviving on whatever they could catch. The floor is now covered with a foot of decayed tussock grass, indicating that they tried to make the place more comfortable, while bones scattered around show that gulls, penguins, and cormorants must have provided a lot of their food. It’s thought that some of them regularly traveled to North Head to look for help, as a well-defined path to that point can still be seen in some areas.

The tale, however, has its tragic side, for the woman died on the very day when the rescuing ship called at the island. She was buried on the isthmus, not far from our Shack. One would think that death was rather a relief from such an existence as this unfortunate woman must have endured, but, at the same time, it seems hard that she did not live to participate in the joy of deliverance.

The story, however, has its tragic side, as the woman died on the very day the rescue ship arrived at the island. She was buried on the isthmus, not far from our Shack. One might think that death could be seen as a relief from the life this unfortunate woman must have endured, but at the same time, it's heartbreaking that she didn’t get to experience the joy of being rescued.

We ate our lunch and had a smoke, after which we decided to walk homewards along "Feather Bed" terrace. A few minutes after leaving the cave, Sawyer and Sandell caught three young ducks, which they carried back, intending to rear them, but they died several days later. A weary tramp brought us, thoroughly tired, to the Shack, where Hamilton had an excellent meal awaiting us.

We had our lunch and smoked a cigarette, then decided to walk home along "Feather Bed" terrace. A few minutes after leaving the cave, Sawyer and Sandell caught three ducklings, which they brought back, planning to raise them, but they sadly died a few days later. A tired trek brought us, completely worn out, to the Shack, where Hamilton had a fantastic meal ready for us.

The weather during January was rather trying. Precipitation in the form of either rain, hail, sleet or snow occurred on twenty-six days, sometimes all forms being experienced on the same day. As a result, the supply of water was well maintained; in fact, the amount caught exceeded the consumption and we finished the month with the tank almost full. Gales were experienced on eight days, the maximum wind-force being forty-two miles an hour. The sky was mostly heavily clouded or absolutely overcast and on many days the sun was not seen. Fog hung about the hills almost continuously, and driving mist accompanied the northerly winds.

The weather in January was quite challenging. We had rain, hail, sleet, or snow on twenty-six days, and sometimes all these conditions happened in a single day. Because of this, our water supply was well maintained; in fact, we collected more than we used, and by the end of the month, the tank was nearly full. Strong winds occurred on eight days, with the highest gusts reaching forty-two miles per hour. The sky was mostly heavily clouded or completely overcast, and there were many days when we didn’t see the sun. Fog lingered around the hills almost constantly, and the northern winds brought a driving mist.

January 24 was a glorious day, calm and sunny, with a maximum temperature of 51.3 degrees F. The habit of former days induced Sandell and myself to have a dip in the surf, but as the temperature of the water was about 42 degrees F., we stayed in as many seconds. The mean temperature for the month was 44.9 degrees F.; the minimum being 35.5 degrees F.

January 24 was a beautiful day, calm and sunny, with a high of 51.3 degrees F. Sandell and I felt inclined to take a dip in the surf, but since the water temperature was around 42 degrees F., we only stayed in for a few seconds. The average temperature for the month was 44.9 degrees F., with a low of 35.5 degrees F.

My first view of the island when the 'Aurora' arrived in December 1911 left rather an agreeable impression. The day of our approach was marked by fine calm weather and the dark-green tussock-clad hillsides were rather attractive. On the other hand, one was immediately struck with the entire absence of trees, the steep precipices, cliffs and the exceedingly rugged nature of the coastline.

My first look at the island when the 'Aurora' arrived in December 1911 left a pretty good impression. The day we got close was characterized by nice, calm weather, and the dark-green hills covered in tussocks were quite appealing. However, it was impossible not to notice the total lack of trees, the steep cliffs, and the extremely rugged coastline.

Closer scrutiny shows that the tussock grass radiates closely from a semi-decayed mass of leaf-sheaths, with the blades of grass shooting upwards and outwards as high as three or four feet. Scattered through it are patches of Stilbocarpa polaris, locally known as Maori cabbage. It is of a more vivid green than the tussock and is edible, though somewhat stringy and insipid. Our sheep ate it readily, even nibbling the roots after the plant had been cropped down.

Closer inspection reveals that the tussock grass grows out from a partially decayed mass of leaf sheaths, with the blades of grass reaching up and out to heights of three to four feet. Scattered throughout are patches of Stilbocarpa polaris, commonly referred to as Maori cabbage. This plant is a brighter green than the tussock and is edible, though it can be a bit stringy and bland. Our sheep readily ate it, even nibbling on the roots after the plant had been trimmed down.

There were several Victoria penguin colonies round about the rocky faces of the hills in the vicinity of the Shack, and their hubbub and cackling uproar were something to remember. The rearing of the young appeared to be rather a busy process. The young ones look like bundles of down and seem to grow at a remarkable rate, while the attempt of the parent to shelter the usual two chicks is a very ludicrous thing to watch.

There were several colonies of Victoria penguins around the rocky hills near the Shack, and their noise and chaos were quite memorable. Raising the young seemed to be a hectic process. The chicks looked like little bundles of fluff and grew at an impressive rate, while watching the parents try to keep their usual two chicks sheltered was very amusing.

The material for the nest made by these birds seems to depend almost entirely on its immediate surroundings. The rookery is established on a broken rocky face close to the water's edge and the nests are made under rocks, in niches and passages, as well as amongst the tussock growing on the rocks. Those under the rocks are constructed of small stones and a few blades of grass, while those in the passages and fissures are usually depressions in soft mud. Amongst the tussock a hole is first made in the soft earth and then neatly lined with blades of grass.

The materials for the nests built by these birds seem to rely almost entirely on their immediate surroundings. The rookery is situated on a jagged rocky face near the water’s edge, and the nests are located under rocks, in crevices and openings, as well as among the tussock growing on the rocks. Nests under the rocks are made of small stones and a few blades of grass, while those in the openings and cracks are typically shallow depressions filled with soft mud. Among the tussock, a hole is first dug into the soft earth and then neatly lined with blades of grass.

The birds lay two or three eggs of a white or greenish-white colour, but I have never seen three chicks hatched. The eggs are edible, and we used many dozens of them during our stay.

The birds lay two or three eggs that are white or greenish-white, but I’ve never seen three chicks hatch. The eggs are edible, and we used many dozens of them during our time there.

The period of incubation is about five weeks, and male and female take turns at sitting. A young one is fed by placing its beak within that of the parent bird where the food—mainly crustaceans—is taken as it regurgitates from the stomach of the latter.

The incubation period is about five weeks, and both the male and female take turns sitting on the eggs. The young ones are fed by having their beaks placed inside the parent's beak, where food—mostly crustaceans—is provided as it is regurgitated from the parent's stomach.

Although the smallest species on the island, the Victoria penguins are the most spiteful, and a scramble through the rookery invites many pecks and much disturbance. They have a black head and back, white breast and yellow crest, the feathers of which spread out laterally. During the moulting season they sit in the rookery or perched on surrounding rocks, living apparently on their fat, which is found to have disappeared when at last they take to the sea. They come and go with remarkable regularity, being first seen about the middle of October, and leaving during the first week of May. The same rookeries are occupied year after year, and the departure of the birds adds to the general desolation during the winter months.

Although the smallest species on the island, the Victoria penguins are the most aggressive, and walking through the rookery invites many pecks and a lot of disturbance. They have a black head and back, a white belly, and a yellow crest that fans out sideways. During the molting season, they sit in the rookery or perched on nearby rocks, seemingly living off their fat, which is gone by the time they finally head to the sea. They come and go with impressive regularity, first appearing around the middle of October and leaving during the first week of May. The same rookeries are occupied year after year, and the birds’ departure adds to the overall desolation during the winter months.

Their destination on leaving the land is still a mystery. Although they are never seen, it is conjectured that they spend the winter at sea. Their natural enemy in the waters round Macquarie Island is the sea-leopard, and the stomachs of all specimens of this animal taken by us during the penguin season contained feathers.

Their destination upon leaving the land remains a mystery. Although they're never spotted, it's believed that they spend the winter at sea. Their natural enemy in the waters around Macquarie Island is the sea leopard, and we found feathers in the stomachs of all specimens of this animal that we captured during the penguin season.

The presence of numerous bones just at the rear of the Shack pointed to the fact that here must have been at one time the site of a King penguin rookery. As many of our potatoes and onions were sprouting in the bags, I determined to dig a portion of this area and plant the most "progressive" of these vegetables. The sandy soil did not appear to contain much nutriment, but I thought that something might be gained by giving it a trial.

The many bones behind the Shack indicated that this area might have once been a King penguin rookery. Since many of our potatoes and onions were sprouting in their bags, I decided to dig up part of this area and plant the most "promising" of those vegetables. The sandy soil didn’t seem to have much nutrition, but I figured it was worth a shot.

On the night of February 2, Sawyer reported that he had heard the Wellington wireless operator calling Suva station, but, as no further signals were heard from anywhere, he was inclined to the idea that it was the experience of a "freak night." In explanation of this term, I may say that it is used in reference to nights on which the atmospheric conditions are abnormally favourable for wireless work.

On the night of February 2, Sawyer mentioned that he had heard the Wellington radio operator trying to reach Suva station, but since he didn't hear any more signals from anywhere else, he thought it was just a "freak night." To explain this term, it refers to nights when atmospheric conditions are unusually good for radio communication.

The news was particularly encouraging, and for the next few days we were on the tip-toe of expectation.

The news was really positive, and for the next few days we were on edge with anticipation.

In the early morning of the 5th a howling gale sprang up and, increasing in force as the day wore on, rendered work impossible. A tremendous sea worked up, and the ocean for a distance of a mile from shore was simply a seething boil of foam. Huge waves dashed on shore, running yards beyond the usual marks, and threatening to sweep across the isthmus. Masses of tangled kelp, torn from the outlying rocks, washed backwards and forwards in the surf or were carried high up among the tussocks. The configuration of the shingly beach changed while one looked at it. The tops of the waves could be seen flying over Anchor Rock, seventy feet high, and spray was blowing right across the isthmus.

In the early morning of the 5th, a howling wind picked up and grew stronger as the day went on, making it impossible to work. A massive sea developed, and the ocean for a mile out from the shore was just a boiling mass of foam. Huge waves crashed onto the shore, reaching far beyond the usual limits and threatening to wash over the isthmus. Clumps of tangled kelp, ripped from the distant rocks, were tossed back and forth in the surf or carried high among the grasses. The shape of the pebbly beach changed visibly. The tops of the waves could be seen flying over Anchor Rock, which was seventy feet tall, with spray blowing right across the isthmus.

On the advice of the sealers we had shifted our stores farther back from the beach and it was just as well we did so, as the waves reached to within a few feet of the nearest box. Meanwhile I began to wonder how our benzine and lubricating oil were faring. Both had been stacked in cases among the tussock and rocks, well back from the waters of Aerial Cove on the western side of Wireless Hill.

On the sealers' advice, we moved our supplies further from the beach, which turned out to be a good decision since the waves came just a few feet from the nearest box. In the meantime, I started to worry about how our benzene and lubricating oil were doing. Both had been piled in cases among the grass and rocks, safely away from the waters of Aerial Cove on the west side of Wireless Hill.

Accordingly, Hamilton, Sandell and I went round in that direction the following morning, while Sawyer made his way up to the wireless station to see if there were any damages there. We worked along round the cliff-front through a cave rejoicing in the name of "Catch Me," from the fact that the waves rushed into it, frequently catching and thoroughly wetting any unfortunate taken off his guard. A massive rock, evidently broken from the roof, lay right across its centre, while on either side of the obstruction were masses of greasy decaying kelp. We were "caught" and floundered about in the kelp while the water surged around us. Arriving at the Cove, we found that several cases were missing. One was discovered buried in kelp, and a little later we came upon a tin battered almost out of recognition. The loss was not serious, but the precaution was taken to shift the oil still farther back.

So, the next morning, Hamilton, Sandell, and I headed in that direction while Sawyer went up to the wireless station to check for any damage. We walked along the cliff front through a cave jokingly called "Catch Me" because the waves would rush in and often catch and soak anyone who wasn’t paying attention. A huge rock, clearly fallen from the roof, lay right in the middle, with piles of slimy, decaying kelp on either side. We got "caught" and struggled in the kelp while the water surged around us. When we got to the Cove, we discovered several cases were missing. One was found buried in kelp, and shortly after, we came across a tin that was nearly unrecognizable. The loss wasn’t significant, but we decided to move the oil further back as a precaution.

While we were engaged on this task, Sawyer appeared on the front of the hill above and signalled to us that the aerial had been blown down. The three-inch rope keeping the aerial taut had broken off close to the bridle and torn the halyard with it. It meant that some one would have to climb the mast to pass a rope through the block, and the wind was at this time too strong for anything to be done.

While we were working on this task, Sawyer showed up on the top of the hill and signaled to us that the aerial had fallen down. The three-inch rope that was keeping the aerial tight had snapped close to the bridle and taken the halyard with it. This meant that someone would need to climb the mast to thread a rope through the block, but the wind was too strong at that moment to do anything.

On February 7, Blake and Hamilton, who had been making preparations for several days past, set out for Sandy Bay, intending to do some work in that locality. Their blankets, sleeping-bag, instruments and other gear made rather heavy swags, but they shouldered them in true Murrumbidgee style and tramped away.

On February 7, Blake and Hamilton, who had been getting ready for the past few days, headed out to Sandy Bay to do some work there. Their blankets, sleeping bag, instruments, and other gear made for pretty heavy packs, but they carried them in true Murrumbidgee style and set off.

Sandell, Sawyer and I went up Wireless Hill to fix the aerial. Sandell, the lightest of the three, was being hoisted up the first section of the mast with some one-and-a-half-inch rope when the hauling-line gave way. Fortunately, he had a strap securing him to the mast, otherwise his fall would have been from twenty feet. This was the only rope we had, so we had to think of some other means of reaching the top. After a short discussion, I suggested that decking-spikes should be secured from the wreck of the Clyde and driven into the mast at intervals. The idea was followed with great success, and Sandell was able to run the halyard through the block at the top (ninety feet). The aerial was then hauled into position, the stay-wires were tightened, an extra "dead man" was put in and the station was once more ready for work.

Sandell, Sawyer, and I went up Wireless Hill to fix the aerial. Sandell, the lightest of the three, was being lifted up the first section of the mast with some one-and-a-half-inch rope when the hauling line snapped. Luckily, he had a strap securing him to the mast; otherwise, he would have fallen from twenty feet. This was the only rope we had, so we had to come up with another way to reach the top. After a brief discussion, I suggested that we get decking spikes from the wreck of the Clyde and drive them into the mast at intervals. The idea worked really well, and Sandell was able to run the halyard through the block at the top (ninety feet). The aerial was then lifted into position, the stay wires were tightened, an extra "dead man" was added, and the station was ready for work again.

Hamilton returned from Sandy Bay on the 11th laden with botanical trophies and four specimens of a small land bird which we had never before seen. He and Blake, who remained behind, had fixed up the hut there so that it afforded decent shelter.

Hamilton returned from Sandy Bay on the 11th loaded with botanical treasures and four specimens of a small land bird that we had never seen before. He and Blake, who stayed behind, had set up the hut there so that it provided decent shelter.

On the night of the 13th what we had long expected happened. Wireless communication was established for the first time, with a ship—s.s. 'Ulimaroa'. Sandell and Sawyer were complimented on their success.

On the night of the 13th, what we had been anticipating for a long time finally occurred. Wireless communication was successfully established for the first time with a ship—the s.s. 'Ulimaroa'. Sandell and Sawyer received praise for their achievement.

On the following night communication was held with Sydney, s.s. 'Westralia', s.s. 'Ulimaroa' and H.M.S. 'Drake'; the latter very courteously sending us time-signals. We heard that a wireless station had just been established in Melbourne, and that the Hobart station would be working in about one month. It was with the latter station that we expected to do most of our business. There was great joy in the camp now that this stage of practical efficiency was reached and because we were no longer isolated from the world.

On the next night, we communicated with Sydney, the s.s. 'Westralia', the s.s. 'Ulimaroa', and H.M.S. 'Drake', which kindly sent us time signals. We learned that a wireless station had just been set up in Melbourne, and the Hobart station would be operational in about a month. We anticipated doing most of our business with the Hobart station. There was a lot of excitement in the camp now that we had reached this level of practical efficiency and were no longer cut off from the world.

Blake came back from Sandy Bay on the 16th with news that he had almost finished the survey of that section. Foggy or misty weather gave him a good deal of trouble in getting sights with the theodolite, and it became part of his future programme to devote the "impossible" days to plotting data, writing up field-notes, and making geological collections.

Blake returned from Sandy Bay on the 16th with news that he had nearly completed the survey of that area. Foggy or misty weather caused him quite a bit of trouble while taking readings with the theodolite, and he decided to dedicate the "impossible" days to plotting data, writing up field notes, and making geological collections.

The afternoon of the 17th was fine, and I went along the beach towards West Point and found it very rough travelling. Hundreds of sea elephants, mostly of the season's young, lay about in the tussock or amongst the rocks. The young, silver-grey in colour, looked very sleek and fat. The adults consorted in groups of from eight to ten, packed closely and fast asleep. They seemed to fairly luxuriate in a soft, swampy place and were packed like sardines in some of the wallows.

The afternoon of the 17th was nice, and I walked along the beach towards West Point, but it was tough going. Hundreds of sea elephants, mainly this season's young, were scattered around in the grass or among the rocks. The young ones, silver-gray in color, looked really sleek and fat. The adults hung out in groups of eight to ten, tightly packed and fast asleep. They seemed to really enjoy lounging in a soft, marshy spot and were crammed together like sardines in some of the depressions.

Large numbers of skua gulls, creating a dreadful din, drew my attention to a spot amongst the rocks, and, on nearing it, I found them squabbling around the carcase of a xiphoid whale, about sixteen feet long, which had been cast up apparently only a few hours before.

A large group of skua gulls, making an awful racket, caught my attention to a place among the rocks. As I got closer, I discovered them fighting over the carcass of a swordfish whale, about sixteen feet long, that had apparently been washed up only a few hours earlier.

The skuas, as they are commonly called, are large brown birds which resort to the island in great numbers for the purpose of breeding. They stay longer than any other migrant, being absent only three months during the depth of winter. Returning early in August, they do not start nesting until the beginning of October. The nests, nicely made of grass and plant leaves, are generally built on the terraces and slopes amongst the hills. The ideal site, however, is a pleurophyllum flat adjoining a penguin rookery. Two or three eggs of a brown or greenish-brown colour with darker spots or blotches are laid about the end of October, and, from this time till the chicks are reared, the parent exhibits much annoyance at the presence of any person in the vicinity. They utter shrill cries and swoop down continuously in an attempt to strike the invader with their wings. Several of our party received black eyes as a result of attacks by skuas.

The skuas, as they’re commonly known, are large brown birds that come to the island in huge numbers to breed. They stay longer than any other migratory birds, only leaving for three months in the heart of winter. They return early in August but don’t start nesting until early October. The nests, well-made from grass and plant leaves, are usually built on terraces and slopes among the hills. However, the best spot is a pleurophyllum flat next to a penguin rookery. By the end of October, they lay two or three eggs that are brown or greenish-brown with darker spots or blotches, and from that point until the chicks are raised, the parents are very protective and annoyed by anyone nearby. They make loud cries and dive at anyone they see as a threat, trying to hit them with their wings. Several members of our group ended up with black eyes from skua attacks.

The young grow rather quickly, and not much time elapses before they leave the nest to stagger round and hide amongst the vegetation. The parents fly down and disgorge food, which is immediately devoured by the young ones. The skuas are bare-faced robbers and most rapacious, harassing the penguins in particular. They steal the eggs and young of the latter and devour a great number of prions—small birds which live in holes in the ground. The skuas are web-footed, but are very rarely seen in the water.

The young grow up quickly, and it doesn't take long before they leave the nest to wander around and hide among the plants. The parents come down and regurgitate food, which is quickly eaten by the chicks. The skuas are bold thieves and quite greedy, especially bothering the penguins. They steal their eggs and chicks and eat a lot of prions—small birds that live in burrows. Although skuas have webbed feet, they're hardly ever found in the water.

Towards the end of the month, Blake spent two days at Sandy Bay and then returned to work up his results.

Towards the end of the month, Blake spent two days at Sandy Bay and then went back to analyze his results.

Hamilton, in order to get into close touch with another species of penguin, stayed several days at "The Nuggets," two and a half miles down the eastern coast. A creek flows into the sea at this point, and many Royal penguin rookeries are established along its course.

Hamilton, to connect more closely with another type of penguin, spent several days at "The Nuggets," located two and a half miles down the eastern coast. A creek empties into the sea here, and several Royal penguin rookeries are set up along its path.

Meanwhile, many improvements had been effected in the interior of the Shack. Shelves lined the walls wherever it was convenient to have them, and many perishable foodstuffs had been brought inside. Comfort, after all, is but a relative matter, and, as far as we were concerned, it was sufficient.

Meanwhile, many upgrades had been made to the interior of the Shack. Shelves lined the walls wherever it was convenient, and a lot of perishable food had been brought inside. Comfort, after all, is a relative concept, and for us, it was enough.

Our clothing was all that could be desired, with the exception, perhaps, of the boots. In the equipment were included one pair of sea-boots, one pair of raw hide kneeboots and two pairs of rawhide hunting boots. The latter were not heavy enough, and soon showed the effect of travelling from a water-logged surface to one of rock and vice versa. In fact, our boots were very rarely dry on Macquarie Island.

Our clothing was just what we needed, except maybe for the boots. The gear included one pair of sea boots, one pair of rawhide knee-high boots, and two pairs of rawhide hunting boots. The hunting boots weren’t sturdy enough and quickly started to wear out from transitioning between the wet ground and rocky surfaces. In fact, our boots were hardly ever dry on Macquarie Island.

An event of some moment occurred on the 28th. The fowls, in order to justify our confidence in them and as a return for our constant care, commenced to lay and, strange to say, all began to lay at the same time. Ma, who was greatly concerned during the turn of affairs, suffered from prolonged attacks of cackling.

An important event took place on the 28th. The hens, to prove they were worth our trust and as a way to repay our ongoing care, started laying eggs, and oddly enough, they all began at the same time. Mom, who was very worried about what was happening, had long episodes of cackling.

During the opening days of March, Blake and Hamilton were engaged in field work down the island. They went as far as "The Brothers," a rocky promontory about two miles south of Sandy Bay. Wekas were so plentiful that they lived almost entirely on them. Blake, on returning to the Shack, had a badly blistered heel which kept him indoors for a few days. Hamilton, who had secured a goodly number of specimens, had to attend immediately to their preservation.

During the first days of March, Blake and Hamilton were out in the field on the island. They traveled all the way to "The Brothers," a rocky point about two miles south of Sandy Bay. Wekas were so abundant that they relied almost entirely on them for food. When Blake returned to the Shack, he had a badly blistered heel that kept him inside for a few days. Hamilton, having collected a good number of specimens, had to focus right away on preserving them.

There were many rats on the island and we frequently heard them scuttling about on the ceiling of the Shack and slithering down between the lining and the wall. Hitherto they had contented themselves by doing this, but on the night of the 7th several of them flopped one after another into the hut, awakening the inmates. On getting out to investigate I found a hole through the lining, about seven feet from the floor, and two or three were rustling about on the shelves. After much shifting of boxes and searching behind tins, the intruders were killed.

There were a lot of rats on the island, and we often heard them scurrying around on the ceiling of the Shack and sliding down between the lining and the wall. Until then, they had been fine with just that, but on the night of the 7th, several of them jumped into the hut one after the other, waking everyone up. When I got up to check it out, I found a hole in the lining, about seven feet from the floor, and two or three were rustling around on the shelves. After moving boxes around and searching behind cans, we managed to kill the intruders.

On March 10 our station held communication with Suva at a distance of two thousand four hundred miles; a remarkable performance for a one-and-a-half-kilowatt wireless set.

On March 10, our station communicated with Suva, which is two thousand four hundred miles away; a remarkable feat for a one-and-a-half-kilowatt wireless system.

Hamilton and I set out for West Point and Eagle Cave on the 11th with the object of examining the flora of the locality and, incidentally, to shoot ducks which frequent the pools on the "Feather Bed" terrace. The weather was dull and misty and the walk very uncomfortable. We made our way across this treacherous tract, often sinking kneedeep. As we neared the first pool a duck rose and immediately paid the penalty. Although we saw at least two hundred, only one was shot, owing to the fact that there is no cover about and the ducks are too easily scared.

Hamilton and I headed out for West Point and Eagle Cave on the 11th to check out the local plants and, along the way, to shoot some ducks that hang around the pools on the "Feather Bed" terrace. The weather was gray and foggy, making our walk pretty uncomfortable. We navigated through this tricky area, often sinking up to our knees. As we got close to the first pool, a duck took off and immediately paid the price. Even though we spotted at least two hundred ducks, we only managed to shoot one, since there was no cover around and the ducks were easily frightened.

Close to Eagle Cave Hamilton gathered some plant specimens and, after lunching, we set off home. Light, steady rain set in about 3 P.M. and wet us thoroughly. We travelled back along the coast, finding it fearfully rough but not so tiring as walking on the terrace.

Close to Eagle Cave, Hamilton collected some plant samples, and after having lunch, we headed home. A light, steady rain started up around 3 P.M. and soaked us completely. We traveled back along the coast, which was incredibly rough but less tiring than walking on the terrace.

Heavy snow fell during the night of the 11th. Among other things we learnt by wireless that Amundsen had returned to Hobart with the news that he had reached the South Pole.

Heavy snow fell during the night of the 11th. Among other things, we learned through the radio that Amundsen had returned to Hobart with the news that he had reached the South Pole.

Blake had just recovered from his blistered heel when he had the misfortune to meet with a slight accident. He and Hamilton were engaged cutting a track through the tussock from the Shack to the beach, when the spade wielded by Hamilton struck Blake's foot, cutting through the boot and inflicting a wound on the great toe. It was treated antiseptically and bound up; Blake being laid up for a few days.

Blake had just gotten over his blistered heel when he unfortunately had a minor accident. He and Hamilton were busy cutting a path through the tussock from the Shack to the beach when Hamilton's spade accidentally hit Blake's foot, cutting through his boot and injuring his big toe. It was treated with antiseptic and wrapped up, causing Blake to be laid up for a few days.

Cooking was still on the up grade. Everybody, as his turn arrived, embarked on something new. Blake turned out a magnificent meat pudding during his week, and Sawyer manufactured a salmon kedgeree. Sandell's treacle pudding and Hamilton's soda rolls and date pudding were all equally good, while I fairly surpassed myself with a roly-poly and some pancakes.

Cooking was still improving. Everyone, when it was their turn, tried something new. Blake made an amazing meat pudding during his week, and Sawyer created a salmon kedgeree. Sandell's treacle pudding and Hamilton's soda rolls and date pudding were all just as good, while I really outdid myself with a roly-poly and some pancakes.

Hitherto, Sawyer and Sandell had been coming down to the Shack each night after finishing the wireless work, but on account of the bad weather they determined to sleep up there and, with that end in view, each built a bunk for himself; Sawyer, in the operating-hut, had ample room for the improvement, but Sandell had more difficulty in the engine-hut, finding it necessary to add a small structure to the original one.

So far, Sawyer and Sandell had been heading to the Shack every night after finishing their wireless work, but due to the bad weather, they decided to sleep up there. With that in mind, each of them built a bunk for himself; Sawyer had enough space in the operating hut for his setup, but Sandell faced more challenges in the engine hut and had to add a small extension to the original one.

Good wireless work was now being done, and almost every ship trading to eastern Australian ports gave us a "call up." Much difficulty was experienced with the mast's stays, which frequently required tightening on account of the "deadmen" working loose in the yielding peaty soil. There were seven stays required for each mast, and Sandell spent much time in attending to them.

Good wireless work was happening now, and almost every ship trading to eastern Australian ports contacted us. We faced a lot of challenges with the mast stays, which often needed tightening because the "deadmen" were becoming loose in the soft, peaty soil. Each mast needed seven stays, and Sandell spent a lot of time taking care of them.

Hamilton had found, some weeks previously, several nests of the sooty albatross along the cliff-front on the eastern side of Wireless Hill, and on the 21st he visited them for the purpose of photographing the young in the nest. They were still in the downy stage, and vomited vigorously on being approached.

Hamilton had discovered several nests of the sooty albatross along the cliff-front on the eastern side of Wireless Hill a few weeks earlier, and on the 21st, he went to photograph the young birds in the nests. They were still covered in downy feathers and vomited vigorously when he got close.

These birds build their nests on ledges along the face of a steep cliff and always betray the whereabouts of their nesting-place by wheeling and soaring around the vicinity. When sitting, the bird utters piercing calls for its mate and is thereby easily located. They make a nest of grass, generally at the root of a tussock growing on the cliff-front, and when the building is in progress the two birds sit side by side entwining their necks, rubbing beaks and at intervals uttering their harsh cries. One can approach and catch them quite easily, either at this time or when sitting. The female lays one large white egg, which has a peculiar and rather disagreeable odour. They have beautiful slaty or bluish-gray plumage with a dark soot-black head, while encircling the eye is a white ring which stands out conspicuously from the dark feathers surrounding it. Like most other sea-birds they have the rather revolting habit of vomiting quantities of partly digested food and fluid when an attempt is made to get close to them. In this respect old and young are alike. Their food is procured at sea, and consists of the small forms of marine life.

These birds build their nests on ledges along a steep cliff and always give away the location of their nesting site by flying and soaring around the area. When resting, the bird makes sharp calls for its mate, making them easy to find. They construct a nest out of grass, usually at the base of a tussock growing on the cliff. While they’re building, the two birds sit close together, intertwining their necks, rubbing beaks, and occasionally making their harsh calls. You can get pretty close and catch them easily, either during this time or when they're sitting. The female lays one large white egg, which has a strange and somewhat unpleasant smell. They have beautiful slate or bluish-gray feathers with a dark black head, and there’s a white ring around their eye that stands out against the dark feathers. Like many other seabirds, they have the rather unpleasant habit of vomiting up partially digested food and liquid if you try to approach them. This behavior is the same for both adults and chicks. They catch their food at sea, which consists of small marine creatures.

Sandell and Hamilton went round to Aerial Cove on the 25th to collect shells and to search for the missing lubricating oil. When coming home, after a successful day, they discovered a cave quite close to Catch Me. A lantern was secured from the Shack and they went back to examine it. It penetrated for a considerable distance and opened out on the hill side about eighty feet above sea-level. Many rocks hung down from overhead, and altogether it appeared a very unsafe place. Blake went along later and collected specimens from its floor.

Sandell and Hamilton visited Aerial Cove on the 25th to gather shells and look for the missing lubricating oil. On their way back home after a successful day, they found a cave close to Catch Me. They grabbed a lantern from the Shack and returned to explore it. The cave extended for a long way and opened up on the hillside about eighty feet above sea level. Lots of rocks were hanging from above, making it seem like a pretty unsafe spot. Blake went by later and collected samples from the cave floor.

We built a kind of annex to the Shack out of the cases of provisions; each case being numbered and a list being drawn out setting forth the contents of the case. This list was nailed on to the wall inside, and besides being convenient for procuring the provisions, gave the cook, in a coup-d'oeil, exact information and afforded him a glorious scope.

We created a sort of extension to the Shack using the supply cases; each case was numbered, and we made a list detailing the contents of each one. This list was nailed to the wall inside, and not only did it make it easy to grab what we needed, but it also provided the cook with a quick overview and great opportunities.

With regard to the coal-supply, our allowance at Macquarie Island had been reduced by one-half, on account of the large amount of wreckage lying on the beach. The weekly cook limited himself to three briquettes, and these he supplemented with sea elephant blubber and wood, which he gathered and cut up for use.

Regarding the coal supply, our allocation at Macquarie Island was cut by half due to the significant amount of wreckage on the beach. The weekly cook restricted himself to three briquettes, which he supplemented with sea elephant blubber and wood that he collected and chopped for use.

Each man commenced his cooking week on Saturday morning, and continued until the following Friday night, when, after having cleared up, washed the towels and cleaned the stove, he retired. The incoming cook, who for half an hour had been prowling about keenly observant of "overlooked" dirty "things" and betraying every sign of impatience to make a start, proceeded at once to set a batch of bread, sufficient for one week, which was baked early on Saturday morning. Five loaves had to be baked, and as only two could be dealt with at a time, the chance of producing at least one doughy loaf was reasonably high until every one became a master baker.

Each man started his cooking week on Saturday morning and continued until the following Friday night when, after cleaning up, washing the towels, and cleaning the stove, he would turn in for the night. The new cook, who had been eagerly scouting around for any "overlooked" dirty items and showing clear signs of impatience to get going, immediately set about making a week's worth of bread, which would be baked early on Saturday morning. Five loaves needed to be baked, and since only two could be handled at a time, there was a decent chance of producing at least one doughy loaf until everyone became a skilled baker.

For a time we had been rather hard put to it in the matter of having baths, but the disability had been overcome by means of sawing a cask in two; an expedient which answered very well. The bath was also used as a wash-tub, each man taking charge as his cooking week came round. The clothes were dried inside the Shack along a number of strings arranged at the back of the stove. Darning and mending took a little time, and our experiences in this direction were such as to demonstrate the wisdom of putting in "a stitch in time."

For a while, we struggled to take baths, but we solved the problem by cutting a cask in half; this worked out pretty well. The bath was also used as a wash tub, with each person responsible for it during their cooking week. We dried our clothes inside the Shack on several strings set up behind the stove. Darning and mending took some time, and our experiences showed the importance of addressing issues promptly.

In going over to the meteorological screen one morning I saw a giant petrel flapping about in the tussock, gorged to such an extent that it could not rise. I killed the loathsome bird with the rib-bone of a sea elephant, and Hamilton made a fine specimen of it later on.

One morning, when I checked the weather screen, I noticed a giant petrel struggling in the tussock, so stuffed that it couldn't take off. I killed the disgusting bird with a rib from a sea elephant, and Hamilton later prepared a great specimen of it.

These birds, properly called giant petrels, are usually known as "nellies" or "stinkers"; the latter title being thoroughly justified on account of the disagreeable smell which comes from them. As may be inferred from the name, they are the largest of all the petrels, and measure about seven feet from tip to tip when on the wing. The colour ranges through various shades from almost pure white to a dark greyish-brown; some even appearing almost black. Very large and ungainly when on the ground, they become most graceful when in the air, and soar about without the slightest effort even on the stormiest days. I have seen them flying into a forty-mile wind with absolute ease, never moving a wing, but occasionally adjusting their balance. They are gross scavengers, and eat apparently for the sake of eating. A carcase on the rocks or beach attracts them in large numbers, and very soon they can be seen pulling and tearing at it until thoroughly gorged, when they waddle away into the water and sit there wholly unable to rise till digestion takes place. If disturbed, they immediately disgorge and fly off. They nest on the ground and lay one large white egg. When sitting, they are reluctant to leave the nest and will squat there, vomiting evil-smelling, partly digested food and fluid at any intruder. The young, even in the downy stage, have the same habit.

These birds, officially known as giant petrels, are commonly referred to as "nellies" or "stinkers"; the latter name is well-deserved due to the unpleasant odor they produce. As suggested by their name, they are the largest of all petrels, measuring about seven feet across from tip to tip when flying. Their coloration varies from nearly pure white to a dark greyish-brown, with some appearing almost black. They look large and clumsy on land, but in the air, they become quite graceful, soaring effortlessly even on the windiest days. I've seen them fly into a forty-mile wind with ease, hardly moving a wing and just adjusting their balance from time to time. They are voracious scavengers, eating simply for the sake of eating. A carcass on the rocks or beach draws them in large numbers, and soon they are pulling and tearing at it until they are completely stuffed, at which point they waddle into the water and sit there, unable to take off until they've digested their meal. If disturbed, they quickly disgorge and fly away. They nest on the ground and lay one large white egg. When sitting on their nest, they are hesitant to leave and will stay put, vomiting foul-smelling, partly digested food and fluid at any intruder. Even the young, in their downy stage, exhibit the same behavior.

When mating they go on with a queer kind of performance, which consists of running around each other on the shore with wings outspread as if displaying their charms, finally flying off or waddling into the water.

When they mate, they put on a strange show, running around each other on the shore with their wings spread, as if showing off their beauty, before finally flying away or waddling into the water.

The persistently windy weather during March had an effect on everything exposed to its force. Sandell discovered on the 29th that the rope holding the wireless aerial had cut through, leaving only one strand, which now bore all the strain. It was just a matter of days before it would part, and, with a view to preventing a repetition of February's happening, we went up to lower the aerial, but the frayed portion of the rope would not pass through the block, so we had to leave it as it was and wait for the inevitable.

The constantly windy weather in March affected everything it touched. On the 29th, Sandell found that the rope holding the wireless aerial had worn down to just one strand, which was now taking all the strain. It was only a matter of days before it would break, so to avoid a repeat of what happened in February, we went up to lower the aerial. However, the frayed part of the rope wouldn’t go through the block, so we had to leave it as is and wait for the inevitable.

Exceptionally low tides at the end of the month gave Hamilton a fine opportunity of collecting marine specimens, and he secured amongst many other things some striking anemones. Some difficulty was experienced in preserving them, as they lost colour and shrivelled up. But a special line of treatment was attended by fairly successful results. They were put in shallow dishes into which sea-water was poured. Very soon they attached themselves to the bottom and began to expand, finally opening out to the fullest extent. With a view to narcotizing them while in this condition, menthol was applied to the water but did not seem to have much effect. Chloral hydrate was found to give the best results. It killed them all, but, before dying, they elongated and detached themselves from the bottom of the dish; after which they were taken out and placed in formalin for preservation.

Exceptionally low tides at the end of the month gave Hamilton a great chance to collect marine specimens, and he gathered several striking anemones among other things. He faced some challenges in keeping them alive, as they lost color and shriveled up. However, a specific treatment was fairly successful. He placed them in shallow dishes filled with sea water. They quickly attached themselves to the bottom and began to expand, eventually opening up fully. To sedate them while in this state, he added menthol to the water, but it didn’t seem to work well. Chloral hydrate turned out to be the most effective. It ended up killing them all, but before dying, they stretched out and detached from the bottom of the dish; afterward, they were removed and placed in formalin for preservation.

Blake had very little opportunity of doing much survey work during the month, as he was hampered by a sore foot and the weather was wretched. He therefore spent most of his time plotting data, making geological investigations and collecting and naming specimens.

Blake had very few chances to do much surveying during the month because he was held back by a sore foot and the weather was terrible. So, he spent most of his time plotting data, conducting geological investigations, and collecting and naming specimens.

He and Hamilton had so far confined their attention to the northern half of the island, and had resolved to complete the study of this area before tackling the southern half.

He and Hamilton had so far focused their attention on the northern half of the island and had decided to finish studying this area before moving on to the southern half.

The weather throughout the month was rather severe, and only two days were really appreciated. Precipitation occurred on twenty-five days, but the worst feature was the continuity of strong winds, which however did not reach gale-force on more than three occasions. Much snow and hail fell, the former accompanying winds with a southerly component, while with the north-westers came the depressing mist or misty rain which is such a characteristic of the place. Temperatures, as might have been expected, were beginning to go down, and we experienced several very cold days. The average temperature for March was 41.8 degrees, while the highest was 46.9 degrees and the lowest 35.3 degrees F. on the 24th.

The weather this month was quite harsh, with only two days truly enjoyable. It rained on twenty-five days, but the most challenging aspect was the constant strong winds, which only hit gale-force on three occasions. There was a lot of snow and hail; the snow came with southerly winds, while the northwesterly winds brought the dreary mist or drizzle that’s typical for the area. As expected, temperatures were dropping, and we had several very cold days. The average temperature for March was 41.8 degrees, with a high of 46.9 degrees and a low of 35.3 degrees F. on the 24th.

At 10 P.M. on April 1 the rope supporting the aerial parted. Sawyer and Sandell were on duty at the time, but of course suspended operations immediately. As before, the halyard also carried away and Sandell henceforth resolved to shackle one end of the aerial to the mast, using a short length of chain instead of the rope. The wreck of the Clyde was once more our standby, providing a suitable length of chain and four shackles. After completing this job, they had very little subsequent trouble with the aerial.

At 10 PM on April 1, the rope holding the aerial broke. Sawyer and Sandell were on duty at the time, but they immediately stopped operations. As before, the halyard also came loose, so Sandell decided to secure one end of the aerial to the mast using a short piece of chain instead of the rope. The wreck of the Clyde was again our backup, supplying a suitable length of chain and four shackles. After finishing this task, they had very little trouble with the aerial going forward.

Hamilton and Sawyer caught several three-pound fish on April 2, and Sandell served them in good style. They were good eating, but, unfortunately, were very much worm-infested. These parasitical worms are about an inch and a half long and taper to a point at each end. They penetrate right through the flesh and are plainly noticeable after the fish is cooked. One has to dodge the worms as the meal proceeds: either that or persuade oneself that they do not matter.

Hamilton and Sawyer caught a few three-pound fish on April 2, and Sandell served them up nicely. They were tasty, but unfortunately, they were heavily infested with worms. These parasitic worms are about an inch and a half long and come to a point at both ends. They penetrate the flesh and are quite noticeable after the fish is cooked. You have to dodge the worms while eating, or just convince yourself that they’re not a big deal.

The flowing contours of the land in the vicinity of "The Nuggets" suggested glacial action to Blake, and on the 4th, while making geological investigations in that locality, he lit upon a well-defined basal moraine. Needless to say he was very interested in the discovery, and brought home a number of polished, striated boulders as convincing evidence of his theory.

The smooth curves of the land around "The Nuggets" made Blake think of glacial activity, and on the 4th, while he was doing geological research in that area, he came across a clearly defined basal moraine. Of course, he was really interested in this discovery and brought back several polished, striated boulders as solid proof of his theory.

It was rather disappointing to find that the vegetables we had planted were making little progress. They would shoot up at first very strongly, like the "seed which fell on stony ground," but, as soon as a gale arose, the tops turned black and shortly afterwards withered away. It was apparently an effect of the salt spray which, in rough weather, used to blow across the isthmus. Hamilton planted some willows and other cuttings, which shared the same fate.

It was quite disappointing to see that the vegetables we planted weren't making much progress. They initially shot up strong, like the “seed that fell on rocky ground,” but as soon as a storm hit, the tops turned black and quickly withered away. It seemed to be caused by the salt spray that blew across the isthmus during rough weather. Hamilton planted some willows and other cuttings, but they met the same fate.

The winter had now arrived in real earnest, and the months which followed were punctuated by a succession of gales, while we came to recognize that it was an exceptional day when the hills were not shrouded in mist. The only thing to do was to brace oneself up for the ordeal and to put a good foot forward.

The winter had now truly arrived, and the months that followed were marked by a series of storms, while we recognized that it was an unusual day when the hills weren't covered in mist. The only option was to prepare ourselves for the challenge and to make a good effort.





CHAPTER XXVI A LAND OF STORM AND MIST

by G. F. Ainsworth

A Heavy north-west gale was experienced on April 12, the wind attaining a force of over fifty miles an hour.

A strong northwest gale hit on April 12, with wind speeds reaching over fifty miles per hour.

As usual, a tremendous sea worked up very quickly, and sheets of spray shredded across the isthmus. About 2 P.M. the wind shifted to west and later to south-west; these changes being accompanied by fierce hail and squalls of snow. During the night the wind moderated, heavy snow fell and, when morning dawned, all the pools were frozen over and the island was draped in white. It was the heaviest fall we had so far experienced.

As usual, a huge sea picked up quickly, and sheets of spray blew across the isthmus. Around 2 PM, the wind shifted to the west and then to the southwest; these changes brought fierce hail and snow squalls. During the night, the wind calmed down, heavy snow fell, and by morning, all the pools were frozen over and the island was covered in white. It was the heaviest snowfall we had experienced so far.

On the 15th Hamilton and I shot several gulls for specimens.

On the 15th, Hamilton and I shot several seagulls for specimens.

The Dominican or black-backed gulls are very numerous and remain on the island all the year round. They are rather pretty, being snow-white, except on the upper part of the wings and back. Ordinarily their food is obtained from the water, but at Macquarie Island they live almost entirely upon the carcases left by the sealers, and are usually seen defending their rights against skuas and giant petrels. They build nests of tussock on rocks close to the water or maybe on the ground. Three eggs, much like those of the skua in colour, but with a greener tint and smaller, are laid, but generally only two are hatched. The young leave the nest early and hide amongst the rocks, whither the old ones come to feed them.

The Dominican or black-backed gulls are very common and stay on the island year-round. They are quite beautiful, being snow-white except for the tops of their wings and backs. Usually, they find their food in the water, but on Macquarie Island, they mostly eat the carcasses left by sealers and can often be seen defending their territory against skuas and giant petrels. They build nests out of tussock on rocks near the water or sometimes on the ground. They lay three eggs that look similar to skua eggs but are smaller and have a greener tint, although usually only two hatch. The young leave the nest early and hide among the rocks, where the parents come to feed them.

We now considered it advisable to prepare for the winter, and with that end in view papered the inside of the Shack in various places. As the cold winds were particularly searching, all faulty joints in the lining were pasted over with any kind of paper we could find. A leak down the outside of the stove-pipe was remedied, after a good deal of trouble, by soldering a collar round the pipe where it passed through the roof. Firing was an important consideration, so each man now brought home several loads of driftwood every day, until we had enough to keep us going for some months. There was a complete boot-mending outfit which was put to a good deal of use, for the weathered rocks cut the soles of our boots and knocked out the hobnails. Our supply of the last-named did not last long, and several of the party used strips of hoop-iron in their stead.

We thought it was a good idea to get ready for winter, so we covered the inside of the Shack with different kinds of paper. Since the cold winds were really intense, we patched up all the weak spots in the lining with whatever paper we could find. After a lot of effort, we fixed a leak on the outside of the stovepipe by soldering a collar around it where it went through the roof. Firewood was a big priority, so each person started bringing home several loads of driftwood every day until we had enough to last us for a few months. We had a complete boot-mending kit that got a lot of use because the rough rocks wore down the soles of our boots and knocked out the hobnails. Our supply of hobnails ran out quickly, and some members of the group used strips of hoop iron instead.

Blake found it necessary to make a kind of work-desk in his section, and accordingly had a thorough rearrangement. He shifted his bunk up to a height of about five and a half feet, very close to the ceiling; a fact which necessitated some wriggling and squirming on his part to get into the sleeping-bag. There was a fine open space left underneath, and he managed to fix up his table very neatly.

Blake felt it was essential to create a workspace in his section, so he completely rearranged everything. He lifted his bunk to about five and a half feet off the ground, almost touching the ceiling; this required some twisting and squirming to get into his sleeping bag. He left a nice open space underneath and managed to set up his table quite neatly.

Although they had intended to leave the work on the southern half of the island until the spring, Hamilton and Blake set out for Lusitania Bay on April 28 to make a short reconnoitring trip. It was thought advisable to spend a few days down there, to improve the hut and generally speaking to have a look-round. Both men had already visited the place and depoted some provisions there. At 8 A.M. they started off, carrying their blankets, sleeping-bags and a few other articles. Their proposal was to go along the coast as far as Sandy Bay and from thence along the hill-tops for the remaining ten miles.

Although they had planned to leave the work on the southern half of the island until spring, Hamilton and Blake set out for Lusitania Bay on April 28 for a quick scouting trip. They thought it would be a good idea to spend a few days there to improve the hut and take a general look around. Both men had visited the area before and had stored some supplies there. They started at 8 A.M., carrying their blankets, sleeping bags, and a few other items. Their plan was to travel along the coast to Sandy Bay and then along the hilltops for the remaining ten miles.

Hail and snow-squalls succeeded each other at frequent intervals, and by the time they reached Sandy Bay, all hope of proceeding along the hill-tops was dissipated. They therefore kept near the coast. The going was frightfully rough and the weather was very bad, so on making Green Valley they camped in a small cave for the night. The floor was covered with tussock, and, by searching amongst the rocks, enough pieces of wreckage were found to keep the fire going. On the whole they passed a fairly comfortable night. Mac proved a bit troublesome by persisting in her attempts to curl up on or between the sleeping-bags, and by finally eating the jam which had been saved for breakfast. The weather was quite as bad next morning, but, after a meal of dry biscuit and cocoa, they pushed on, taking four and a half hours to do the six miles. The next day was spent making the hut weather-proof and fixing up a couple of bunks. The provisions which had been cached were in good order and abundance of firewood lay around, in the shape of old barrel-staves. Just close to the living-hut was a works-hut containing boilers and digestors which years ago had been used for procuring penguin oil, while there was a rookery a few yards away from which the victims had come.

Hail and snow squalls alternated frequently, and by the time they arrived at Sandy Bay, all hope of continuing along the hills was gone. So, they stayed close to the coast. The terrain was extremely rough and the weather was terrible, so when they reached Green Valley, they camped in a small cave for the night. The floor was covered with tussock grass, and by searching among the rocks, they found enough pieces of wreckage to keep the fire going. Overall, they had a fairly comfortable night. Mac was a bit of a hassle, constantly trying to curl up on or between the sleeping bags and eventually eating the jam that had been saved for breakfast. The weather was just as bad the next morning, but after a meal of dry biscuits and cocoa, they set out, taking four and a half hours to cover the six miles. The next day was spent making the hut weatherproof and setting up a couple of bunks. The supplies they had stored away were in good shape, and there was plenty of firewood around, in the form of old barrel staves. Close to the living hut was a works hut that contained boilers and digesters which had been used years ago to extract penguin oil, along with a rookery just a few yards away from where the penguins had come from.

This rookery was the resort of King penguins, the largest of the four species which are to be found on the island. They are magnificently coloured birds, being bluish-grey on the back while the head is greenish-black and on each side of the neck there is a brilliant yellow band, shading to a greenish-yellow on the upper part of the breast, and gradually merging into the glossy white of the lower part of the body. They attain to a height of about three feet and weigh thirty pounds approximately. The site of their rookery is a stony flat about a hundred yards from the water, and here are collected between five and six thousand—all that remain on the island.

This rookery was home to King penguins, the largest of the four species found on the island. They are stunning birds, with bluish-grey backs, greenish-black heads, and a bright yellow band on each side of their necks that fades to a greenish-yellow on the upper part of their breasts, eventually blending into the glossy white of their lower bodies. They grow to about three feet tall and weigh around thirty pounds. The rookery is located on a stony flat about a hundred yards from the water, where between five and six thousand of them gather—every King penguin that remains on the island.

They make no nest, the single egg laid being supported on the feet, and kept in position and incubated in a kind of skin pouch which conceals it from view. One would never guess the egg was there, for, on being disturbed, the bird shuffles along, carrying it in the manner described. The egg is large, tapering very much at one end and resembling a pear in shape. They lay during December and January, and the young are hatched in about six weeks. A peculiar feature about the young birds is that the parents feed them for two seasons. They are covered with a coarse, greyish-brown furry growth, and a year-old chick looks bigger than the old bird. This furry growth is lost during the second year and the adult plumage replaces it. The young utter a peculiar sound, something between a squeak and a whistle. It is probable that the King penguins were never so numerous as the Royal or Victoria penguins, but the fact remains that they have not yet recovered from the wholesale slaughter to which they must have been subjected over sixteen years ago.

They don’t build nests; instead, they rest their single egg on their feet and keep it in a kind of skin pouch that hides it from sight. You would never guess the egg is there because when disturbed, the bird shuffles along while carrying it like that. The egg is large, pointed at one end, and has a pear-like shape. They lay eggs in December and January, and the chicks hatch in about six weeks. A unique thing about the young birds is that the parents feed them for two seasons. They’re covered in a coarse, greyish-brown fur, and a one-year-old chick looks bigger than the adult. This fur is lost in the second year, making way for adult feathers. The young make a strange sound, somewhere between a squeak and a whistle. It’s likely that King penguins were never as numerous as Royal or Victoria penguins, but they still haven’t bounced back from the large-scale hunting they faced more than sixteen years ago.

Down on a strip of shingly beach the birds parade, when not in the rookery or at sea getting food. Their proceedings strike one as being extraordinarily human, while the dignity and gravity of the participants are beyond description. On one occasion, a large number marching along the beach were seen to halt suddenly and talk excitedly. Three birds then left the main body, consulted together for a short time, and then separated. The other birds immediately separated into three companies, and each company stood behind one of the three already mentioned, who were now some distance apart. The individuals of each party then talked among themselves for several minutes, after which two parties joined forces and marched off, leaving the third party staring after them.

On a stretch of pebbly beach, the birds show off when they’re not in their nesting area or out at sea looking for food. Their behavior seems surprisingly human, and the seriousness and poise of the participants are indescribable. One time, a large group walking along the beach suddenly stopped and started chatting excitedly. Three birds then broke away from the main group, conferred for a brief moment, and then went their separate ways. The other birds immediately divided into three groups, each one standing behind one of the three mentioned before, who were now a good distance apart. The members of each group then talked among themselves for several minutes, after which two groups united and marched off, leaving the third group watching them go.

I have lost myself for the time being amongst the penguins and shall now return to Blake and Hamilton, who climbed on to the hill-tops the following morning to spy out the land. The island is generally speaking higher, and all the more elevated peaks are on the southern half.

I have temporarily lost myself among the penguins and will now return to Blake and Hamilton, who climbed to the hilltops the next morning to survey the land. Generally speaking, the island is higher, with the most elevated peaks located in the southern half.

They saw numerous rabbits, of which many were black, and Mac had the day of her life amongst them. These animals were introduced to the island about twenty-five years ago, and have gradually withdrawn to the lonelier southern part, though occasionally odd ones are seen about the northern end. They are very tame and live in holes amongst the rocks or make burrows in the gully banks and broken hill sides.

They spotted a lot of rabbits, many of which were black, and Mac had the best day of her life with them. These animals were brought to the island about twenty-five years ago, and they've slowly moved to the quieter southern area, though you can still see a few wandering around the northern end. They're very friendly and live in holes among the rocks or dig burrows in the gully banks and along the rugged hillsides.

Many lakes, frozen over, were seen, several of which were fairly large. Altogether, the topography is similar to that of the northern end.

Many lakes were noticed, frozen over, and several of them were quite large. Overall, the landscape looks a lot like that of the northern end.

In an endeavour to improve the evening fare, a sweet broth consisting of biscuit, milk, jam and sugar was tried but it was not a success; Hamilton remarking that "even Blake had only one helping." On the following morning they started for the Shack and chose the route on the hilltops, as the ground was frozen hard; and, though there were frequent snow-drifts into which they floundered occasionally, the surface for travelling was much better than along the coast.

In an effort to enhance the evening meal, they tried a sweet broth made of biscuits, milk, jam, and sugar, but it didn't go over well; Hamilton noted that "even Blake had only one serving." The next morning, they set out for the Shack and took the route along the hilltops since the ground was frozen solid. Although they occasionally stumbled into snowdrifts, the surface was overall much better for traveling than along the coast.

Hamilton slipped and hurt his ankle on the trip, and the boots of both were just about worn out. They apprehended no difficulty in completing their prospective work. Blake pointed out that the chart of the island shows Lusitania Bay as being rather a large indentation, whereas in reality it is almost a straight stretch of coast.

Hamilton slipped and hurt his ankle on the trip, and both of their boots were nearly worn out. They didn’t expect any trouble finishing their planned work. Blake pointed out that the chart of the island shows Lusitania Bay as a pretty big indentation, while in reality, it’s almost a straight stretch of coast.

An earthquake shock was felt at 9.15 P.M. on the 27th. I was sitting in the Shack writing up records at the time, and it seemed as if somebody had struck the south-west end of the place a severe blow with a bag of sand. Immediately afterwards a crashing sound, apparently some distance away on the eastern side, indicated that some rocks on the cliff-front had been dislodged.

An earthquake was felt at 9:15 PM on the 27th. I was sitting in the Shack writing up records when it happened, and it felt like someone had hit the southwest end of the place hard with a bag of sand. Right after that, I heard a crashing sound, coming from some distance away on the eastern side, which suggested that some rocks on the cliff front had been knocked loose.

Much rough weather was experienced during the month, and it rained, hailed and snowed on twenty-five days. The wind attained moderate to fresh gale-force on six days, and fog and mist were almost invariable. The lowest temperature recorded was 32.7 degrees F.

Much bad weather was experienced during the month, with rain, hail, and snow occurring on twenty-five days. The wind reached moderate to fresh gale-force on six days, and fog and mist were almost constant. The lowest temperature recorded was 32.7 degrees F.

The average relative humidity for the four months ending April 30 was 93 per cent., leading to copious condensation on the instruments exposed to the air. It was necessary, therefore, constantly to attend and frequently clean the thermographs, hygrometers and the wireless plant. In the case of the latter, loss of power occurred in the form of "brush discharge," and Sawyer had to take great care in order to guard against this accident. He shellacked the condensers and other exposed parts and found the proceeding rather effective. I noticed that the drifting snow and misty rain managed to get down the opening leading to the liquid surface of the anemobiagraph, thus altering the zero of the recording apparatus. When this happened the instrument had to be dismantled and set right.

The average relative humidity for the four months ending April 30 was 93 percent, causing a lot of condensation on the instruments exposed to the air. This meant we had to constantly monitor and frequently clean the thermographs, hygrometers, and the wireless equipment. In the case of the latter, power loss occurred due to "brush discharge," so Sawyer had to be very careful to prevent this issue. He shellacked the condensers and other exposed parts and found this method to be quite effective. I noticed that the drifting snow and misty rain managed to enter the opening leading to the liquid surface of the anemobiagraph, which altered the zero point of the recording device. When this happened, the instrument had to be taken apart and fixed.

We found it necessary to use sea elephant blubber in the stove in order to warm the Shack, and a very small piece put on the fire at intervals always ensured a good heat. Sea elephants had become scarce, so, in order to lay in a supply of fuel for the next few weeks, we went round to Aerial Cove on the 3rd and killed the largest animal we could find, afterwards carrying the blubber round to the Shack. We came through Catch Me and had the same old experience. Hamilton examined the contents of the stomach of the sea elephant and found gravel, stones, cuttlefish, beaks and "worms" in abundance.

We found it necessary to use sea elephant blubber in the stove to warm the Shack, and a small piece added to the fire at intervals always ensured good heat. Sea elephants had become hard to find, so to stock up on fuel for the next few weeks, we went to Aerial Cove on the 3rd and killed the largest one we could find, then carried the blubber back to the Shack. We passed through Catch Me and had the same old experience. Hamilton checked the stomach contents of the sea elephant and found plenty of gravel, stones, cuttlefish, beaks, and "worms."

A violent north-west gale during the early morning hours of the 4th reached a maximum velocity of fifty-two miles an hour at 5.20 A.M., but at 8 A.M. it began to weaken rapidly and an hour later had shifted to west-south-west, coming from that point as a moderate gale for the rest of the day. As was usual with winds having any southerly component, snow and squalls of soft hail were experienced. With the exception of the wind-vane, which was blown a few yards into the tussock, nothing was damaged.

A strong northwest wind during the early morning hours of the 4th hit its peak at fifty-two miles per hour at 5:20 A.M. By 8 A.M., it started to die down quickly, and an hour later, it shifted to west-southwest, blowing from that direction as a moderate gale for the rest of the day. As is common with winds that have any southern element, there were snow showers and bursts of soft hail. Aside from the wind vane, which was blown a few yards into the grass, nothing was damaged.

In the afternoon Blake and I had a trip down to the moraine which he had found a few days previously. After a heavy one and a half hours' walk, the last half-mile of which was along a creek bed, with water ankle-deep all the way, we reached the spot: the site of one of the large penguin rookeries up on the hills at the back of "The Nuggets." The sun showed between squalls, and Blake took some interesting photographs of rocks showing striae and other glacial characteristics. We battled with one enormous boulder for some time before getting it into a suitable position for the camera, and afterwards walked right through the glacial area. The U-shaped character of the valleys was very pronounced, while boulder-clay obtruded itself everywhere on our notice.

In the afternoon, Blake and I went to the moraine he had discovered a few days earlier. After a challenging hour and a half walk, the last half-mile of which was along a creek bed with ankle-deep water the whole way, we arrived at the location: the site of one of the large penguin rookeries up on the hills behind "The Nuggets." The sun peeked out between rain showers, and Blake took some fascinating photos of rocks displaying striae and other glacial features. We struggled with one massive boulder for a while before finally positioning it for the camera, and then we walked straight through the glacial area. The U-shaped valleys were very obvious, and boulder clay was everywhere we looked.

Hobart wireless station was by this time in working order, a fact which greatly facilitated wireless business. Sandell took the engine to pieces early in the month and gave it, as well as the fittings, a thorough overhaul and cleaning. We received a message on the 7th, saying that the 'Aurora' was leaving Hobart on the 13th for a sub-antarctic cruise and would call at the island. At the same time I was requested to send a list of articles required. I found, after going through the stock and consulting each member, that we needed nothing but strong boots, cartridges, dungaree trousers, coarse salt, cigarettes and fresh vegetables.

The Hobart wireless station was up and running by this time, which made handling wireless communications much easier. Sandell disassembled the engine early in the month and gave it and the fittings a thorough cleaning and overhaul. We got a message on the 7th saying that the 'Aurora' would leave Hobart on the 13th for a sub-antarctic cruise and would stop at the island. At the same time, I was asked to send a list of items we needed. After checking the inventory and consulting with each team member, I found that we only needed strong boots, cartridges, dungaree trousers, coarse salt, cigarettes, and fresh vegetables.

A persistent area of high pressure affected the weather conditions of the island to the extent of shrouding us in fog from the 6th to the 10th inclusive, and we did not catch a glimpse of the sun during that period. The average daily temperature-range during this time was only 2.3 degrees. Such conditions have a rather depressing effect on the spirits, but the cheering news we received on the 7th made some amends for the lack of sunshine.

A constant high-pressure system impacted the weather on the island, covering us in fog from the 6th to the 10th, and we didn’t see the sun at all during that time. The average daily temperature range was just 2.3 degrees. These conditions can be pretty discouraging, but the good news we got on the 7th helped make up for the absence of sunlight.

The sun appeared at last on the 11th and shone strongly, so Blake and I went up to Wireless Hill to take some "shots" with the theodolite. I noticed four of our sheep on the front of the hill, and, as there should have been nine, Sandell and I, after finishing with Blake, walked out to North Head to see if the others were all right. We found them on the north-east side of the hill and drove them up to the rest of the flock.

The sun finally came out on the 11th and shone brightly, so Blake and I went up to Wireless Hill to take some "shots" with the theodolite. I noticed four of our sheep on the front of the hill, and since there should have been nine, Sandell and I, after finishing with Blake, walked out to North Head to check on the others. We found them on the northeast side of the hill and brought them back to join the rest of the flock.

From the hill-top we could see Hamilton engaged in skinning a large sea leopard on the coast, so we climbed down to render any necessary assistance. It was a beautifully marked animal, about eleven feet long, and made a fine specimen.

From the hilltop, we spotted Hamilton working on skinning a large sea leopard on the coast, so we headed down to offer any help he needed. It was a beautifully marked animal, about eleven feet long, and made for a great specimen.

Sea leopards frequent Macquarie Island in great numbers from the late winter to the early summer, and may be seen lying about, sleeping close to the water and apparently always very tired. They do not give birth to the young there, and from observations I concluded that they were born at sea. We had taken female specimens on several occasions, apparently within a few hours of parturition, and as none had been seen with newly born young, and no islands lay within several hundred miles, it was presumed that the birth took place in the water. Until the young one is weaned, its habitat is evidently in the water as we never saw an adult suckling its offspring.

Sea leopards come to Macquarie Island in large numbers from late winter to early summer, and you can often see them lounging around, resting close to the water and looking really tired. They don’t give birth to their young there, and from what I observed, I concluded that they are born at sea. We had collected female specimens on several occasions, seemingly just hours after giving birth, and since none had been spotted with newborns and there were no islands within hundreds of miles, it was assumed that the birth happened in the water. Until the young one is weaned, it’s clear that its habitat is in the water, as we never saw an adult nursing its offspring.

Sea leopards—long, lithe creatures with a reptilian cast of head—are remarkably quick in the water. If one is disturbed on shore it opens its mouth very wide, revealing a wicked-looking row of teeth in each jaw; the canine teeth or tusks being very long and slightly curved.

Sea leopards—long, slender creatures with a reptilian appearance—are incredibly fast in the water. If one is startled on land, it opens its mouth wide, showing off a menacing set of teeth in both jaws; the canine teeth or tusks are especially long and slightly curved.

Unlike sea elephants and seals they are solitary animals, and should several of them be found on a small gravelly patch of beach they are seen to be as far as possible from one another. We have never seen them attempt to fight on the shore, but the gaping wounds and scars with which they are frequently covered indicate that they treat each other very severely in the water. They live on penguins, gulls, shags and fish.

Unlike sea elephants and seals, they are solitary animals. If several of them are found on a small gravelly beach, they stay as far apart from each other as possible. We've never seen them try to fight on the shore, but the gaping wounds and scars that frequently cover them show that they are pretty brutal with each other in the water. They feed on penguins, gulls, shags, and fish.

I saw several shags on one occasion very busy fishing, and between diving intervals they would sit on the water. Suddenly one disappeared under the water and the rest flew off; but in a few seconds the one which had disappeared was thrown into the air and caught by a sea leopard, who played in this fashion with the maimed bird for several minutes before devouring it.

I saw a bunch of cormorants once, actively fishing, and during their breaks, they would just sit on the water. Suddenly, one of them went under the water, and the others took off; but a few seconds later, the one that had disappeared was thrown into the air and caught by a leopard seal, who toyed with the injured bird for several minutes before eating it.

A few days previously we had received a request from Mr. D. C. Bates, the New Zealand Meteorologist, for a daily weather report, and from the 12th onwards a message was sent nightly to Wellington, a distance of about eleven hundred miles. In acknowledging these reports, subsequently, the office referred to their immediate value in the issue of daily forecasts, and expressed indebtedness to the Expedition.

A few days earlier, we got a request from Mr. D. C. Bates, the New Zealand Meteorologist, for a daily weather report. Starting from the 12th, we sent a message every night to Wellington, which is about eleven hundred miles away. When acknowledging these reports later on, the office mentioned their immediate value for daily forecasts and expressed gratitude to the Expedition.

The two species of penguins which leave the island during the winter months had disappeared, and silence now reigned where formerly were busy, noisy colonies. The departure of the migrants made the place seem lonelier and, during the depths of winter when snow covers the ground and the birds and animals are few in number, a more dreary spot would be difficult to find.

The two species of penguins that left the island during the winter months were gone, and silence now filled the space where busy, noisy colonies once thrived. The absence of the migrants made the place feel emptier, and during the harsh winter, when snow blankets the ground and birds and animals are scarce, it would be hard to find a more depressing location.

The weather conditions were now rather severe, and as Sawyer and Sandell worked from 8 P.M. till 2 or 3 A.M. every night and slept at the wireless station, they were exempted from the necessity of coming down to get breakfast during their cooking weeks. They now rested till about noon, and arrived at the Shack every day in time for lunch. Hamilton, Blake and I, each outside his own cooking week, took it in turns to prepare breakfast.

The weather was pretty harsh, and since Sawyer and Sandell worked from 8 P.M. to 2 or 3 A.M. every night and slept at the wireless station, they didn’t have to go down for breakfast during their cooking weeks. They now rested until around noon and made it to the Shack just in time for lunch every day. Hamilton, Blake, and I, each outside our own cooking week, took turns making breakfast.

Blake's fieldwork at the north end, more particularly in the vicinity of West Point and North Head, was just about finished. West Point proved to be an area of gabbro, a coarse-grained eruptive rock representative of basic rocks, while North Head was composed of basic agglomerate, and volcanic bombs were numerous.

Blake's fieldwork at the north end, especially around West Point and North Head, was nearly complete. West Point turned out to be an area of gabbro, a coarse-grained volcanic rock typical of basic rocks, while North Head was made up of basic agglomerate, and there were many volcanic bombs.

Hamilton had got together a good collection of bird specimens, and was now in quest of skeletons.

Hamilton had gathered a solid collection of bird specimens and was now on the hunt for skeletons.

On the night of the 13th we witnessed a rather pretty auroral manifestation. It assumed the appearance of a Noah's ark cloud, that is, stretching from opposite points on the horizon and appearing to converge at each one of these points. The light was a pale yellow, no other tint being visible. In addition, a nebulous glow appeared at intervals in the south.

On the night of the 13th, we saw a really beautiful display of the northern lights. It looked like a cloud shaped like Noah's ark, stretching from opposite sides of the horizon and seeming to meet at each end. The light was a pale yellow, and no other colors were visible. Also, a hazy glow appeared at times in the south.

We heard on the 16th that the 'Aurora' had sailed on that day from Hobart and would arrive at Macquarie Island in about three weeks; oceanographical work being carried out on the trip down. This was indeed cheerful news, and we began to look forward to her arrival.

We heard on the 16th that the 'Aurora' had sailed that day from Hobart and would arrive at Macquarie Island in about three weeks, with oceanographic work being done on the way. This was great news, and we started to look forward to her arrival.

A fresh west-south-west gale during the early morning hours of the 17th was accompanied by soft hail and snow-squalls, and the temperature at 9 A.M. was 31.2 degrees F. The ground was covered with snow and all the pools were frozen over, but at 9 P.M. there was a rapid shift of the wind to the north-west and the snow almost disappeared. Soft hail, generally a little larger than tapioca and of the same shape, frequently fell. These little pellets are formed of compressed snow and are commonly supposed to be frozen cloud-particles mixed with raindrops compacted by a high wind.

A strong west-southwest wind blew in the early morning hours of the 17th, bringing with it light hail and snow squalls, with a temperature of 31.2 degrees F at 9 A.M. The ground was blanketed in snow, and all the pools were frozen over. However, by 9 P.M., the wind shifted quickly to the northwest, and the snow nearly vanished. Soft hail, usually slightly larger than tapioca and shaped the same way, fell frequently. These small pellets are made of compressed snow and are generally thought to be frozen cloud particles mixed with raindrops that get packed together by strong winds.

On the following night, Blake and I went up to wireless Hill to take star observations. It was very dark and the hill-front was slippery, frequent falls being the rule. Just after setting up the instrument, the wind freshened to such an extent that it was impossible to do anything, so we descended very wet and muddy to the Shack, having had a rough passage. The reason for this was that I fell on the lantern and extinguished the light.

On the next night, Blake and I went up to Wireless Hill to look at the stars. It was really dark and the hill was slippery, so we kept taking tumbles. Right after we set up the equipment, the wind picked up so much that we couldn't get anything done, so we went back down to the Shack, soaked and muddy, after a tough trek. The reason for this was that I tripped on the lantern and put out the light.

We were supplied with two hurricane lamps which do not by any means deserve their title as they blow out in even a moderately strong wind. Sandell made a lantern for his own use, declaring that it was impossible for any wind to blow it out. I firmly believed him, as it was a little binnacle lamp placed inside a small oatmeal tin into which a cleaned photographic plate had been fixed and with holes punched in the bottom and top of the tin for ventilation. It was thus a lamp with two covers, and frequent demonstrations of its ability to survive heavy blows were made by the inventor.

We were given two hurricane lamps that really don't live up to their name since they go out in even a moderate wind. Sandell built a lantern for himself, claiming it was impossible for any wind to extinguish it. I totally believed him because it was a small binnacle lamp inside a cleaned-out oatmeal tin, with a photographic plate fixed in and holes punched in the bottom and top of the tin for ventilation. It was basically a lamp with two covers, and the inventor often demonstrated how it could withstand heavy winds.

During the next three days a forty-mile wind accompanied by snow, hail and sleet was experienced and the maximum temperature on the 25th did not reach freezing-point, the ground being firmly frozen and snow-covered. During the evening of the last-named date the wind shifted to north-west, and by noon on the 26th no snow remained, except on the hills.

Over the next three days, a forty-mile-per-hour wind brought snow, hail, and sleet, and the highest temperature on the 25th didn’t even reach freezing. The ground was completely frozen and covered in snow. On the evening of that same day, the wind changed to the northwest, and by noon on the 26th, all the snow had melted away, except on the hills.

In anticipation of the 'Aurora's arrival, Blake and Hamilton collected some stores together in the hope that Captain Davis would transport them down to Lusitania Bay, thus obviating the necessity of carrying them down on foot. As Blake reckoned that he would remain there fully three months and Hamilton about two months, it was thought that such another opportunity might not present itself.

In preparation for the 'Aurora's arrival, Blake and Hamilton gathered some supplies, hoping that Captain Davis would take them to Lusitania Bay, which would save them from having to carry them on foot. Since Blake estimated that he would stay there for about three months and Hamilton for around two months, they figured this opportunity might not come again.

Through the courtesy of the naval officials, H.M.S. Drake sent us time-signals twice a week, and though we had so far heard no sound from Adelie Land, there was a possibility that they could receive messages from us. Sawyer therefore sent out time-signals as a matter of routine.

Through the kindness of the naval officials, H.M.S. Drake sent us time signals twice a week, and even though we hadn’t heard anything from Adelie Land yet, there was a chance they could get messages from us. Sawyer therefore sent out time signals as a standard practice.

Hamilton made a trip to the west coast on the 28th and returned with thirteen wekas. Sawyer did not care for these birds, but each of the others could account for one at a meal. They seem to be better eating if plucked like a fowl and roasted, but the plucking takes too long and we generally skinned and boiled them. It is advisable to hang them for several days before cooking as it certainly makes them tender.

Hamilton traveled to the west coast on the 28th and came back with thirteen wekas. Sawyer wasn’t fond of these birds, but each of the others could handle one for a meal. They seem to taste better if you pluck them like a chicken and roast them, but plucking takes too long, so we usually skinned and boiled them instead. It’s a good idea to hang them for a few days before cooking, as it definitely makes them more tender.

Rough, stormy weather prevailed during the greater part of the month and the wind reached the force of a gale on nine days. Much snow, soft hail and sleet fell and some very cold days were experienced. The average temperature was 40 degrees, the maximum being 44.7 degrees and the minimum 27.8 degrees F.

Rough, stormy weather dominated most of the month, with the wind hitting gale force on nine days. There was a lot of snow, soft hail, and sleet, along with some very cold days. The average temperature was 40 degrees, peaking at 44.7 degrees and dipping to a low of 27.8 degrees F.

A heavy snowfall occurred during the early morning hours of June 3, and the temperature was below freezing-point all day. In the afternoon we had rather an enjoyable time tobogganing down a steep talus-slope on the east coast. A considerable struggle was necessary in order to get the sledge to the top, but the lightning slide to the bottom more than compensated for the labour.

A heavy snowfall happened during the early morning of June 3, and the temperature stayed below freezing all day. In the afternoon, we had a great time tobogganing down a steep slope on the east coast. It took a lot of effort to get the sled to the top, but the thrilling ride down made all the hard work worth it.

We made wireless inquiries concerning the 'Aurora' at night, and were informed by Hobart that a search for the Royal Company Islands was included in her programme. It was therefore presumed that she was engaged in prosecuting this search and would probably not reach us for some days.

We made wireless inquiries about the 'Aurora' at night and were informed by Hobart that a search for the Royal Company Islands was part of her agenda. It was assumed that she was busy with this search and would likely not arrive for a few days.

Hamilton killed a very fine sea leopard on the 5th and the skin, apart from being unscarred, was handsomely marked. It should make a splendid specimen. The stomach contained more than the usual number of worms and one specimen of tape-worm, seven inches long and three-eighths of an inch wide, was preserved.

Hamilton killed a great sea leopard on the 5th, and its skin, aside from being unblemished, was beautifully patterned. It should make an excellent specimen. The stomach had more than the usual amount of worms, and one tape-worm specimen, seven inches long and three-eighths of an inch wide, was preserved.

Everything was going along in the usual placid manner on the 7th, when, as we were just taking our seats for lunch, some one rushed in with the information that the 'Aurora' was in sight. There was a scramble to various points of vantage and she was soon observed coming up the east coast very slowly. At 2.30 P.M. she dropped anchor in North-East Bay, but, as it was blowing strongly and a nasty sea was running, no boat was launched, though one may imagine how anxiously we watched for some movement in that direction. As soon as it became dark a message was "Morsed" to us to the effect that a boat would bring mails and goods ashore in the morning if the weather moderated, and with that we had to be content. Needless to say, business ashore was for the time being paralysed, but a message was sent to the Secretary in Hobart advising him of the Ship's arrival.

Everything was going along smoothly on the 7th when, just as we were getting ready for lunch, someone rushed in with the news that the 'Aurora' was in sight. Everyone scrambled to get to the best spots to see her, and she was soon spotted slowly making her way up the east coast. At 2:30 PM, she dropped anchor in North-East Bay, but since it was windy and the sea was rough, no boat was launched, even though we anxiously watched for any sign of movement in that direction. Once it got dark, we received a message via Morse code saying that a boat would bring mail and supplies ashore in the morning if the weather improved, and we had to be satisfied with that. Naturally, business on land was put on hold for the time being, but a message was sent to the Secretary in Hobart to inform him of the ship's arrival.

True to his intimation of the previous night, Captain Davis brought a boat ashore at 9.30 A.M. and with him came several visitors who were to be our guests for some days. They were Mr. E. R. Waite, Curator of the Canterbury Museum and his taxidermist, and Mr. Primmer, a cinematographer. Conspicuous in the boat was a well-laden mail bag and no time was lost in distributing the contents. Letters, papers, and magazines were received by every member of the party, and all the news was "good." Some stores were brought along and, after getting these ashore, we took the visitors across to the Shack and invited them to make themselves at home.

True to his hint from the night before, Captain Davis brought a boat ashore at 9:30 A.M. Along with him came several guests who would be with us for a few days. They included Mr. E. R. Waite, the Curator of the Canterbury Museum, his taxidermist, and Mr. Primmer, a cinematographer. Prominently in the boat was a heavy mail bag, and we quickly got to distributing its contents. Every member of the party received letters, papers, and magazines, all of which had "good" news. Some supplies were also brought, and after getting those ashore, we took the visitors over to the Shack and invited them to make themselves at home.

Captain Davis also came along to the Shack and afterwards looked over the wireless station. He returned to the ship just after lunch, and Sandell, Sawyer and Blake took the opportunity of going on board. Hamilton, in the meantime, piloted the visitors on a short trip round to Aerial Cove, introducing them to Catch Me, where they were duly baptized. They afterwards climbed up Wireless Hill and had a look at the station, returning to the Shack much impressed with the rough nature of the country.

Captain Davis also joined the group at the Shack and later checked out the wireless station. He went back to the ship just after lunch, and Sandell, Sawyer, and Blake took the chance to board. Meanwhile, Hamilton took the visitors on a quick trip to Aerial Cove, introducing them to Catch Me, where they were officially welcomed. They then hiked up Wireless Hill to see the station, returning to the Shack really impressed by how rugged the land was.

Blake went off to the ship again, taking the stores which had been got ready for transport to Lusitania Bay, as the captain had agreed to land them when he visited there in a few days' time.

Blake headed back to the ship, bringing the supplies that had been prepared for transport to Lusitania Bay, since the captain had agreed to drop them off during his visit there in a few days.

Amongst the cases which were landed was one containing the recording apparatus for the tide-gauge. The other parts of this instrument had been left on the island in December, but for some reason the clock and charts had gone astray and were not found till the vessel was being unloaded in Adelie Land. Some thermometers and a Robinson anemometer had also been overcarried and, when they came to light, the latter was immediately placed in commission.

Among the cases that were unloaded was one with the recording equipment for the tide gauge. The other parts of this instrument had been left on the island in December, but for some reason, the clock and charts had gotten lost and were only found when the ship was being unloaded in Adelie Land. Some thermometers and a Robinson anemometer had also been misplaced, and when they were discovered, the anemometer was put into use right away.

Captain Davis sent a boat ashore on the morning of the 12th with an invitation to come on board and lunch. I accordingly went out to the vessel and, after lunching, had a thorough look over her, mentally contrasting her spick-and-span appearance at the time with what it had been when I left her in December. I went ashore again in the afternoon and assisted the visitors to get their loads down to the boat, as they were returning to the ship, which was leaving next morning on a sounding trip down the island.

Captain Davis sent a boat to shore on the morning of the 12th with an invitation to come aboard for lunch. I went out to the ship, and after having lunch, I took a good look around her, mentally comparing her spotless condition now to how she had looked when I left in December. I went back to shore in the afternoon and helped the visitors bring their things down to the boat since they were returning to the ship, which was leaving the next morning for a sounding trip down the island.

On the 14th we started to carry the stores across to the Shack on our backs. We soon realized that seventy or eighty pounds was not a light load over a half-mile stretch of rough, shingly beach, but succeeded in transporting the onions, apples and potatoes before finishing for the night. The other articles were brought over during the next two afternoons.

On the 14th, we began carrying supplies over to the Shack on our backs. We quickly understood that seventy or eighty pounds was a heavy load over a half-mile stretch of rough, pebbly beach, but we managed to transport the onions, apples, and potatoes before calling it a night. The other items were brought over during the next two afternoons.

The tide-gauge pipe, weighing about six hundredweights, and the box for the housing of the recording gear had been landed in December round in Aerial Cove, where a site had been chosen for the erection of the gauge. Experience showed me that the place was unsuitable, so I took Hamilton, Sandell and Sawyer round to the cove on the 15th and we decided, as we had no boat, that it was impossible to carry the pipe round to the east coast.

The tide-gauge pipe, weighing around six hundred pounds, along with the box for the recording gear, was delivered in December at Aerial Cove, where we planned to set up the gauge. From my experience, I realized that the location wasn’t suitable, so on the 15th, I took Hamilton, Sandell, and Sawyer to the cove, and we agreed that without a boat, it was impossible to transport the pipe over to the east coast.

I had been making some tidal observations on an upright, fixed in a comparatively quiet spot on the east coast, and it was here that I contemplated erecting the gauge. Two snow-gauges, eight inches each in diameter, were amongst the meteorological equipment and it appeared that if these two were soldered together a suitable pipe could be made. Further, the pipe was to be protected from the violence of the seas by planks fixed round it. Sandell agreed with the idea and forthwith set about soldering the two together and making a suitable float, the one supplied being too wide. All that now remained was to erect the gauge.

I had been taking some tidal measurements at a vertical post located in a relatively calm area on the east coast, and it was here that I thought about setting up the gauge. There were two snow gauges, each eight inches in diameter, among the weather instruments, and it seemed like if these two were joined together, we could create a suitable pipe. Additionally, the pipe needed to be protected from rough sea conditions with wooden planks secured around it. Sandell agreed with the plan and immediately got to work soldering the two together and creating an appropriate float, as the one we had was too wide. All that was left to do was install the gauge.

The two following afternoons were devoted to stowing the new stores. We carried everything across and stacked them at the south-west end of the Shack. Unfortunately, the boots which we had ordered did not come, but Captain Davis let us have five pairs of light bluchers out of the ship's stores, and we reckoned that these with extra soles and a few hobnails would hold out till August or September, when a sealing vessel was expected.

The next two afternoons were spent organizing the new supplies. We moved everything over and piled it up at the southwest end of the Shack. Unfortunately, the boots we ordered didn’t arrive, but Captain Davis gave us five pairs of light bluchers from the ship's supplies. We figured these, along with some extra soles and a few hobnails, would last until August or September when a sealing ship was expected.

The 'Aurora' returned from the south of the island on the 19th and reported having had a rough experience in the north-east to south gale which blew on the two previous days. The wind came out of the north-east very suddenly on the 17th, and some very strong squalls were experienced. A calm prevailed for several hours in the evening, but a south-east gale then sprang up and blew all day on the 18th, gradually working into the south and dying away during the night.

The 'Aurora' came back from the south side of the island on the 19th and reported having a tough time with the northeast to south gale that hit the last two days. The wind shifted out of the northeast unexpectedly on the 17th, bringing some really strong gusts. There was a calm for several hours in the evening, but then a southeast gale picked up and blew all day on the 18th, slowly shifting to the south and dying down overnight.

Early on the 20th the 'Aurora' steamed out of the bay, bound north as we thought, but she returned again in the evening, and we signalled to know if anything were wrong. They replied, "All well, but weather very bad outside." She lay at anchor in the bay all next day as it was snowing and blowing very hard from the south-west, but at 8.45 A.M. on the 22nd she disappeared in the north and we did not see her again for some months. A few hours after her departure the wind increased in force, and a continuous gale raged for the next five days.

Early on the 20th, the 'Aurora' steamed out of the bay, seemingly heading north, but she came back in the evening. We signaled to ask if there was a problem. They replied, "All good, but the weather is terrible outside." She stayed anchored in the bay all the next day because it was snowing and blowing hard from the southwest. However, at 8:45 A.M. on the 22nd, she vanished to the north, and we didn't see her again for several months. A few hours after she left, the wind picked up, and a continuous gale raged for the next five days.

Sandell and I now made a start at erecting the tide-gauge, and after the lapse of five days got the instrument into position. We could work on it only at low tide, for much rock had to be chipped away and numerous wire stays fixed. The work was therefore of a disagreeable character. Its appearance when finished did not by any means suggest the amount of trouble we experienced in setting it up, but the fact that it stood the heavy seas for the following eighteen months without suffering material damage was a sufficient guarantee that the work had been well done.

Sandell and I got started on setting up the tide gauge, and after five days, we finally got the instrument in place. We could only work on it at low tide because we had to chip away a lot of rock and install several wire stays. This made the work pretty unpleasant. Once it was finished, it didn't really look like the amount of trouble we went through to set it up, but the fact that it withstood heavy seas for the next eighteen months without significant damage showed that we had done a good job.

A tremendous sea was running on the 25th as a result of the previous two days' "blow" and a heavy gale still persisting. Spray was scudding across the isthmus, and the sea for a mile from the shore was just a seething cauldron. The wind moderated somewhat on the 26th, but strong squalls were experienced at intervals throughout the day, and on the 27th a strong wind from the south-west brought rather heavy snow.

A huge sea was crashing on the 25th due to the intense storms from the previous two days, and a strong gale was still going. Spray was whipping across the isthmus, and the water for a mile from the shore looked like a boiling cauldron. The wind calmed down a bit on the 26th, but there were still strong gusts throughout the day, and on the 27th, a powerful wind from the south-west brought quite a bit of snow.

On the following day a westerly gale sprang up which shifted suddenly to south-south-west and south-west in the evening and was accompanied by fierce hail and snow-squalls throughout the night. Without moderating to any extent the gale continued to blow on the 29th and passed through west to west-north-west, finally lasting till the end of the month.

On the next day, a strong westerly wind picked up, suddenly shifting to south-southwest and southwest in the evening, bringing along heavy hail and snow squalls throughout the night. Without letting up, the wind continued to blow on the 29th, shifting through west to west-northwest, and continued until the end of the month.

Something in the nature of a "tidal" wave occurred during the night of the 28th, for, on rising the following morning, I was considerably astonished to see that the sea-water had been almost across the isthmus. To effect this, a rise of twenty or twenty-five feet above mean sea-level must have taken place and such a rise appeared abnormally high. Our coal heap, which we had hitherto regarded as perfectly safe from the sea, was submerged, as shown by the kelp and sand lying on top of it, and the fact that seven or eight briquettes were found fifteen feet away from the heap.

Something like a "tidal" wave happened during the night of the 28th because when I got up the next morning, I was really surprised to see that the sea water had nearly covered the isthmus. To do that, the water must have risen about twenty or twenty-five feet above mean sea level, which seemed unusually high. Our coal pile, which we had thought was completely safe from the sea, was underwater, as indicated by the kelp and sand on top of it, and the fact that seven or eight briquettes were found fifteen feet away from the pile.

Nothing at the wireless station was damaged and work went on as usual. The wind used to make a terrific noise in the aerial wires, but this did not affect the transmission of messages. The howling of the wind round the operating-hut interfered with the receiving, at times making it extremely difficult to hear signals; particularly on nights not favourable for wireless work.

Nothing at the wireless station was damaged, and work continued as usual. The wind used to make a loud noise in the aerial wires, but this didn’t affect the transmission of messages. The howling wind around the operating hut sometimes interfered with receiving, making it really difficult to hear signals, especially on nights that weren't good for wireless work.

Hamilton was at this time concentrating his attention on shags or cormorants. This species of cormorant is peculiar to the island, being found nowhere else. They are blue-black, with a white breast, and on the head they have a small black crest. At the top of the beak are golden lobes, while the skin immediately round the eye is pale blue. They remain on the shores of the island all the year and nest on the rocks in or very close to the water. They form rookeries and build nests of grass, laying three eggs about the end of November. The period of incubation is six weeks. They live entirely on fish, and, on that account, neither the birds nor the eggs are palatable. They are very stupid, staring curiously till one gets almost within reach of them, when they flap heavily into the water. They are easily caught when sitting on the nest, but a shag rookery, like most other rookeries, is by no means a pleasant place in which to linger.

Hamilton was at this time focusing on shags, or cormorants. This type of cormorant is unique to the island and can’t be found anywhere else. They are blue-black with a white chest, and they have a small black crest on their heads. The top of their beaks has golden lobes, and the skin around their eyes is pale blue. They stay around the island’s shores all year and nest on the rocks right by the water. They create rookeries and build nests out of grass, laying three eggs around late November. The incubation period lasts six weeks. They eat only fish, which makes the birds and their eggs unappetizing. They are quite dim-witted, staring curiously until someone gets almost close enough to touch them, then they flap heavily into the water. They are easy to catch when they’re on the nest, but a shag rookery, like most rookeries, is definitely not a pleasant place to hang around.

I had the satisfaction of getting the first record from the tide-gauge on the first day of July, but the clock worked erratically, requiring some attention.

I was pleased to get the first reading from the tide gauge on the first day of July, but the clock was acting up and needed some fixing.

Hamilton had a lobster-pot set some distance from the shore and anchored to a float, but unfortunately the pot was lost in the rough seas at the end of June. He had a couple of fish-traps also, but, in view of this disaster, he decided to set these in Aerial Cove, where the water was quieter. Having a couple of sea leopard heads which required macerating, he baited the trap with them and lowered it into the water, securing it to the rock with a steel wire.

Hamilton had a lobster trap set some distance from the shore and tied to a float, but sadly, the trap was lost in the rough seas at the end of June. He also had a few fish traps, but due to this setback, he decided to place them in Aerial Cove, where the water was calmer. He had a couple of sea leopard heads that needed to be broken down, so he baited the trap with them and lowered it into the water, securing it to the rock with a steel wire.

Taking advantage of a bright sun on the following day, Blake and Hamilton went to "The Nuggets" and took some geological and biological photographs, which on being developed turned out well. They had occasion to enter one of the unoccupied huts down there and found a wild cat a little more than half grown, which they caught and carried home with them. He was of the usual tabby colour and by no means fierce, quickly yielding to the coaxing treatment of his captors. He made himself quite at home in the Shack, and we looked forward to a display of his prowess as a rat-catcher.

Taking advantage of the bright sun the next day, Blake and Hamilton went to "The Nuggets" and took some geological and biological photos, which turned out well once developed. They had the chance to go into one of the empty huts there and found a wild cat that was just over half grown, which they caught and brought home with them. He was the typical tabby color and wasn’t fierce at all, quickly responding to the coaxing of his captors. He settled in comfortably in the Shack, and we looked forward to seeing his skills as a rat-catcher.

A bright display of the aurora occurred on the night of July 4, the ribbons and streamers of light being well defined and occasionally slightly coloured. We could establish no connexion between this extraordinary outburst and the fact that it occurred on American Independence night, but it was certainly the most energetic manifestation of the phenomenon we had so far witnessed. Many "glows" had been seen, and also a few displays of the arch-shaped form, but none had shown much activity or rapid movement.

A vivid display of the aurora happened on the night of July 4, with well-defined ribbons and streamers of light, occasionally showing slight colors. We couldn't find any link between this remarkable display and its timing on American Independence night, but it was definitely the most intense manifestation of the phenomenon we had seen up to that point. Many "glows" had been observed, and there were a few arch-shaped displays, but none had displayed much activity or quick movement.

The operator was requested by the Pennant Hills high-power wireless station at Sydney to listen for signals tapped out during the daytime, and Sawyer spent a couple of hours on certain mornings assisting in these tests, which were attended with some success. We occasionally received press news from land stations or from ships passing across the Tasman Sea, but it was only a brief summary of the cable news: enough to whet one's curiosity, rarely ever satisfying it.

The operator was asked by the Pennant Hills high-power wireless station in Sydney to listen for signals sent during the day, and Sawyer spent a couple of hours on some mornings helping with these tests, which had some success. We occasionally got press news from land stations or from ships crossing the Tasman Sea, but it was only a short summary of the cable news: just enough to spark curiosity, but rarely satisfying it.

Very cold, rough weather was experienced on the 6th and 7th and a temperature of 26 degrees F. occurred on the latter date, while the maximum did not reach freezing-point. Much snow and soft hail fell, and the ground set hard. The weather interfered to some extent with the tide-gauge clock, and it became so unsatisfactory that I took it to pieces on the 9th and gave it a thorough cleaning, after which it had a new lease of life.

Very cold, harsh weather was felt on the 6th and 7th, with a temperature of 26 degrees F. on the latter date, and the high never reached freezing. A lot of snow and soft hail fell, and the ground froze solid. The weather disrupted the tide-gauge clock somewhat, and it became so unreliable that I took it apart on the 9th and gave it a complete cleaning, after which it worked like new.

We received a message on the 11th saying that the 'Aurora' had arrived in Dunedin, "all well," but had experienced a very rough voyage which greatly interfered with the dredging and sounding programme.

We got a message on the 11th saying that the 'Aurora' had arrived in Dunedin, "all good," but had a really rough journey that seriously messed up the dredging and sounding plan.

Our tank water gave out for the first time on the 12th. The precipitation for a fortnight had been in the form of dry powdery snow and soft hail, the wind blowing it off the roof before it had a chance to thaw, thus robbing us of our usual water-supply. For a while we had to use swamp water, which contained a good many insects of various kinds and had a distinctly peaty flavour. Finding good water running from the hill-tops down a deep gully on the east coast, three-quarters of a mile away, we carried drinking water from there, using the other for washing up.

Our tank water ran out for the first time on the 12th. The precipitation over the past two weeks had been dry, powdery snow and soft hail, with the wind blowing it off the roof before it could melt, leaving us without our usual water supply. For a while, we had to use swamp water, which was filled with various insects and had a distinctly peaty taste. We found some good water flowing from the hilltops down a deep gully on the east coast, three-quarters of a mile away, so we carried drinking water from there while using the other water for washing up.

The 13th was a most delightful day—bright sun, very little wind and fresh exhilarating air. Blake and Hamilton went out early on a photographing excursion, and, later on, the latter shot and skinned a white giant petrel.

The 13th was a really lovely day—bright sunshine, hardly any wind, and refreshing, invigorating air. Blake and Hamilton went out early for a photography trip, and later on, Hamilton shot and skinned a white giant petrel.

During the third week of July a very low tide exposed rocks, ordinarily submerged, and Hamilton was occupied all the week in collecting marine organisms, worms and plants and then preserving, bottling and labelling them.

During the third week of July, a very low tide revealed rocks that are usually underwater, and Hamilton spent the entire week collecting marine organisms, worms, and plants, then preserving, bottling, and labeling them.

A most peculiar sight was witnessed on the 17th. Aerial Cove is a favourite nesting-place for shags, and they may be seen in twos and threes flying round in that direction almost any time during the day; but on this particular day a kind of wholesale exodus from the cove took place, and large flocks of them followed each other for a couple of hours. They congregated on the rocks along the east coast, or settled in the water in scores; the latter fact suggesting that the probable reason for this extraordinary behaviour was the presence of unusual shoals of fish.

A very strange sight was seen on the 17th. Aerial Cove is a favorite nesting spot for shags, and you can usually see them flying around in pairs or small groups throughout the day. But on this particular day, there was a mass exodus from the cove, with large flocks of them following each other for a couple of hours. They gathered on the rocks along the east coast or settled in the water in large numbers; this suggests that the likely reason for this unusual behavior was the presence of unusual schools of fish.

We used to relax and have a game of cards occasionally, while our small organ became a medium of much enjoyment. All the members except one played well enough to enjoy themselves and to give pleasure to the others. There was a distinct predilection in favour of "ragtime" and I must say I liked to hear that music at frequent intervals. Any one who plays a musical instrument knows that the mood of the player is generally reflected in the character of the music, particularly when he sits down and plays in a casual way.

We would chill and play cards every now and then, while our little organ provided a lot of fun. Everyone except one person played well enough to have a good time and entertain the others. There was a clear preference for "ragtime," and I have to say I enjoyed hearing that type of music frequently. Anyone who plays a musical instrument knows that the player's mood usually shows in the music, especially when they sit down and play casually.

The pursuit and killing of a sheep had now become something in the nature of an experience, and when Sandell and I went hunting for one on the 20th, we realized it before we reached home. The flock was very timid, and when disturbed on North Head invariably came past the wireless station close to the engine-hut. Sandell concealed himself there with a gun, while I went out to startle the animals. They did not fail to do their part, but Sandell missed and the shot frightened them. He then rushed out and fired another shot as they were running, managing to hit one, which immediately dropped behind and ran to the edge of the cliff. We did not want to shoot the sheep at this moment, as it would have fallen about two hundred feet, so we cautiously approached to drive it away. The poor creature simply took a leap out into space and landed on the talus below, down which it rolled to the water's edge. We scrambled down and skinned it, having to carry the carcase along the rocks at the base of the cliffs, and getting many duckings on the way.

The chase and killing of a sheep had become quite an experience, and when Sandell and I went hunting for one on the 20th, we realized that before we even got home. The flock was very skittish, and when spooked on North Head, they always came past the radio station close to the engine hut. Sandell hid there with a gun while I went out to scare the animals. They did their part, but Sandell missed, and the shot scared them off. He then ran out and fired another shot as they were running, managing to hit one, which immediately fell behind and made a dash for the edge of the cliff. We didn't want to shoot the sheep then, as it would have dropped about two hundred feet, so we carefully approached to drive it away. The poor thing simply jumped into the air and landed on the rocky slope below, rolling down to the water's edge. We scrambled down and skinned it, having to drag the carcass along the rocks at the base of the cliffs, and getting soaked many times along the way.

On July 26 I went round to Aerial Cove with Hamilton to have a look at the fish-trap, but it had disappeared, the wire having broken, apparently through the continual friction against rock. He had previously caught some fish in it, and it was rather a misfortune to lose it so soon.

On July 26, I went to Aerial Cove with Hamilton to check out the fish trap, but it was gone. The wire had apparently broken from constantly rubbing against the rocks. He had caught some fish in it before, so it was quite a bummer to lose it so quickly.

During the last week of the month we all had our hair cut. On arrival at the island, several of us had it shorn very closely with the clippers and had not trimmed it since then, growth being very slow. We had a proper hair-cutting outfit and either Blake, Hamilton or Sandell acted as barber.

During the last week of the month, we all got our hair cut. When we arrived on the island, several of us had it cut really short with clippers and hadn't trimmed it since, as it grows really slowly. We had a proper hair-cutting kit, and either Blake, Hamilton, or Sandell took turns as the barber.

Blake was an expert with the needle and did some really neat mending, while with the aid of some woollen thread and a mug he darned holes in his socks most artistically. He was the authority on how, when and where to place a patch or on the only method of washing clothes. The appearance of his articles when washed, compared with mine, made me wonder.

Blake was really good with a needle and did some impressive mending. With some wool thread and a mug, he darned holes in his socks in a very artistic way. He was the go-to expert on how, when, and where to place a patch, as well as the best way to wash clothes. The way his clothes looked after washing, compared to mine, had me questioning a lot.

Hamilton was busy, about this time, dredging in swamp pools and securing specimens of the rockhopper or gentoo penguin.

Hamilton was busy around this time, digging in swamp pools and collecting specimens of the rockhopper or gentoo penguin.

The small gentoo penguins, like the King penguins, do not migrate and are few in numbers. They form diminutive colonies, which are always established on mounds amongst the tussock, or on the hill sides not far from the water. Their eggs, which are globular in shape, are about the best of the penguin eggs for eating, and if their nests are robbed the birds will generally lay again, although I think they could not lay more than four eggs. They build their nests of grass and plant leaves, and occasionally have been known to establish a fresh rookery after their first one has been robbed. They are more timid than any other species of penguin, and leave the nests in a body when one ventures into the rookery. The skuas take advantage of this peculiarity to the length of waiting about till a chance presents itself, when they swoop down, pick up an egg with their beak and fly off. The penguin makes a great fuss on returning to find that the eggs are gone, but generally finishes up by sitting on the empty nest. We have frequently put ten or a dozen eggs into one nest and watched the proprietress on her return look about very doubtfully and then squat down and try to tuck the whole lot under herself with her beak.

The small gentoo penguins, like the King penguins, do not migrate and are low in numbers. They create small colonies, which are always built on mounds among the tussock or on hillsides near the water. Their eggs, which are round in shape, are considered some of the best penguin eggs for eating, and if their nests are raided, the birds will usually lay again, although I don't think they can lay more than four eggs. They construct their nests from grass and plant leaves, and occasionally, they have been known to start a new rookery after their first one has been robbed. They are more timid than other species of penguins and leave their nests as a group when someone enters the rookery. Skua birds take advantage of this tendency by patiently waiting for an opportunity, then swooping down, grabbing an egg with their beak, and flying off. The penguin makes a big fuss upon returning to find that the eggs are missing, but usually ends up sitting on the empty nest. We have often put ten or a dozen eggs into one nest and watched the owner return, looking around very hesitantly before squatting down and trying to tuck the entire lot under herself with her beak.

Weather conditions were rough enough during July, but occasionally a fairly quiet day would occur. High winds were experienced on ten days, the greatest hourly average for any twenty-four hours being thirty-two miles, but no day averaged less than ten miles. Precipitation occurred on twenty-one days, mostly in the form of snow and soft hail. The mean temperature was 37.7 degrees, with extremes of 43.3 degrees and 26 degrees F. The average percentage of cloud was 78; somewhat less than usual and due to the greater frequency of south-west winds, which almost always bring a broken sky.

Weather conditions were pretty rough in July, but there were a few days that were relatively calm. High winds were recorded on ten days, with the highest hourly average for any twenty-four hours reaching thirty-two miles per hour, but no day had an average below ten miles per hour. Precipitation happened on twenty-one days, mostly as snow and soft hail. The average temperature was 37.7 degrees Fahrenheit, with highs of 43.3 degrees and lows of 26 degrees. The average cloud cover was 78%, slightly lower than normal, thanks to the more frequent south-west winds, which often bring partly cloudy skies.

Now that our life was one of smooth routine I devoted a good deal of time to reducing the meteorological observations. Hourly pressure and temperature readings as well as descriptive remarks, averages and other details required to be summarized, and this occupied a considerable amount of time, so I made a practice of spending a couple of hours each day on the work, whenever possible, hoping thereby to pick up the "leeway." I did not take too kindly to inactive writing in the Shack, but the weather conditions were such that I was glad to stay indoors, though that meant enduring the inevitable cold feet. The floor of the Shack was never warm, and of course there were no carpets.

Now that our life had settled into a smooth routine, I spent a lot of time compiling the weather observations. I had to summarize hourly pressure and temperature readings, along with descriptive notes, averages, and other details, which took a significant amount of time. So, I made it a habit to spend a couple of hours each day on this work whenever I could, hoping to catch up on the "leeway." I wasn’t fond of doing passive writing in the Shack, but the weather was such that I was happy to stay inside, even if it meant dealing with the inevitable cold feet. The floor of the Shack was never warm, and, of course, there were no carpets.

Mac developed a great animosity against the rats and thoroughly enjoyed rooting them out on all occasions. The only explanation of their presence on the island is that they had arrived in the ships which were wrecked along the coasts. They got into the Shack several times, and we simply brought in Mac and shifted things about till she caught them.

Mac developed a strong dislike for the rats and took great pleasure in hunting them down whenever he could. The only reason for their presence on the island is that they must have come from the ships that wrecked along the coast. They got into the Shack several times, and we just brought in Mac and rearranged things until he caught them.

Rough weather occurred during the first week of August, and with occasional temporary weakenings a gale blew throughout, reaching fifty miles an hour at different times. Snow, hail and sleet fell every day, and on the 3rd the temperature was below freezing-point all day. The Shack, which always shook a little in exceptionally heavy gales, now vibrated a good deal in a forty-mile wind, no doubt feeling the effects of the beating it had undergone.

Rough weather hit during the first week of August, and despite some temporary breaks, a gale blew steadily, reaching speeds of fifty miles an hour at different times. Snow, hail, and sleet fell every day, and on the 3rd, the temperature stayed below freezing all day. The Shack, which always trembled a bit in particularly strong gales, now shook significantly in a forty-mile wind, clearly feeling the impact of the pounding it had taken.

Blake found a cave running through North Head and went round, on the 5th, to examine it. He proved it to be about sixty yards from opening to opening, and to widen out very much inside; the roof being about fifteen feet above the floor.

Blake discovered a cave at North Head and went around on the 5th to check it out. He found it to be about sixty yards from one opening to the other and much wider inside, with the ceiling about fifteen feet above the floor.

Hamilton and Sandell went along the coast on the 6th and brought home a dozen Maori hens for the pot. Hamilton secured some spiders, parasites on birds and many beetles under the moss and stones on the site of a penguin rookery, besides shooting a few terns.

Hamilton and Sandell traveled along the coast on the 6th and brought back a dozen Maori hens for dinner. Hamilton collected some spiders, bird parasites, and various beetles from under the moss and stones at a penguin nesting site, and he also shot a few terns.

The tern is a very pretty bird with light grey plumage, a black head and red beak and feet. We found no nests on the island, though the fact that the birds remain throughout the year implies that they breed there. They fly very fast while not appearing to do so, but their movements are by no means graceful. They flit about over the water close to the shore, every now and then dipping down picking up morsels and keeping up a constant, shrill squeaking.

The tern is a really beautiful bird with light grey feathers, a black head, and a red beak and feet. We didn't see any nests on the island, but the fact that the birds stay there year-round suggests they breed there. They fly super fast without it looking like they are, but their movements aren't particularly graceful. They zip around over the water near the shore, occasionally dipping down to grab snacks while making a constant, shrill squeaking sound.

The sea was so high on the 7th that it reached the weight of the tide-gauge and, lifting it up, unshipped the recording gear, as the steel wire flew off the wheel before the latter could take up the slack. I deemed it advisable to use stout cord instead of wire in the future and made a protective slot for the weight. I had blocked up the seaward side of the pipe with rocks, but found that these caused a deposit of silt so I had to get into the water at low tide and shift them all out again to clean away the accumulation of sand.

The sea was so high on the 7th that it lifted the weight of the tide gauge, knocking off the recording equipment as the steel wire unwound from the wheel before it could take up the slack. I decided it would be better to use thick cord instead of wire moving forward and created a protective slot for the weight. I had blocked the seaward side of the pipe with rocks, but found that these created a buildup of silt, so I had to go into the water at low tide and remove them all again to clear the sand accumulation.

Very heavy snow fell during the afternoon, the flakes being the size of half a crown. A fresh north-north-west wind dropped to a calm at 4 P.M. and almost immediately it began to snow, the island being quite white by 5.30 P.M.

Very heavy snow fell during the afternoon, with flakes as big as half a crown. A fresh north-northwest wind calmed down at 4 P.M., and almost immediately it started to snow, covering the island in white by 5:30 P.M.

Bright sunny intervals alternated with light snow-squalls on the 10th, and the temperature was below freezing-point all day. It was pleasant to be out of doors, and I walked along to the west coast to see if there were any signs of activity amongst the sea elephants.

Bright sunny spells alternated with light snow showers on the 10th, and the temperature stayed below freezing all day. It was nice to be outside, so I walked to the west coast to check for any signs of activity among the sea elephants.

An unmistakable sign of the near approach of the breeding season was the presence of an enormous old bull, almost too fat to move, lying on the beach. Very few small ones were seen, as, on the arrival of the adult males and females for the breeding season, the young ones leave for a while, presumably in order to get fat for the moulting period, or because they are afraid of the bulls, who are particularly savage at this time. The full-grown bulls attain to a length of twenty feet, and have a fleshy proboscis about eight or ten inches in length hanging over the mouth, suggesting the trunk of an elephant. It is from this fact that they derive the name of sea elephant.

An obvious sign that the breeding season was approaching was the sight of a huge old bull, nearly too fat to move, lying on the beach. Very few younger ones were seen because, when the adult males and females arrive for breeding, the young tend to leave for a while, likely to put on weight for the moulting period or because they’re scared of the bulls, who are especially aggressive at this time. Fully grown bulls can reach a length of twenty feet and have a fleshy trunk around eight to ten inches long hanging over their mouths, resembling an elephant's trunk. This is why they are called sea elephants.

There is a considerable disparity in size between the adult male and female, the latter very rarely exceeding eleven feet, though we have seen a few twelve and thirteen feet long. The females have no snout development and some of them facially very much resemble a bull terrier. The adults are called bulls and cows, while, curiously enough, in the sealers' phrase, the offspring are referred to as pups. The places where large numbers of them gather together during the breeding season are known as rookeries! "Rookery" appears to me to be inapplicable to a herd of sea elephants, though "pup" supplies a more apt description of the young.

There is a significant size difference between adult males and females, with females rarely exceeding eleven feet, although we've seen a few that are twelve and thirteen feet long. Females don’t have developed snouts and some of them look quite a bit like a bull terrier. Adults are called bulls and cows, while interestingly, the offspring are referred to as pups by sealers. The locations where large groups come together during the breeding season are known as rookeries! I think "rookery" doesn’t really fit a herd of sea elephants, but "pup" is a more suitable term for the young.

The pups, born during September or early October, are covered with a long, black, wavy fur, which they lose when about two months old, and in its place comes a growth of silver-grey hair, which changes later into the ordinary brown colour of the full-grown animal.

The puppies, born in September or early October, have long, wavy black fur that they shed when they're around two months old. In its place, they grow silver-grey hair, which eventually turns into the typical brown color of the adult animal.

The old males and females leave the island about the end of January, and are not seen again (except a few stray ones) till August in the case of the males, and until September in the case of the females.

The older males and females leave the island around the end of January and aren’t seen again (aside from a few stragglers) until August for the males and until September for the females.

The fact that the bulls arrive first leads one to the conclusion that their feeding-grounds must lie at a considerable distance and, in the journey therefrom, the males, being the stronger, should arrive before the females, who are heavy with young and probably make a somewhat leisurely progress, feeding by the way.

The fact that the bulls arrive first suggests that their feeding grounds must be quite far away. Since the males are stronger, they should get there before the females, who are likely slowed down by being pregnant and take their time, grazing along the way.

The rookeries vary in size, containing from half a dozen to four or five hundred cows; in the last case, of course, being an aggregation of smaller rookeries, each with its proprietor, in the shape of an old bull, lying in or somewhere near the centre. The normal rookery, as far as I could judge, seemed to be one that contained about forty cows, but once the nucleus was formed, it was hard to say how many cows would be there before the season ended, as females keep arriving for a period of about three weeks.

The rookeries vary in size, holding anywhere from six to four or five hundred cows; in the latter case, it's usually a combination of smaller rookeries, each managed by an old bull resting in or near the center. From what I could tell, the typical rookery seemed to have around forty cows, but once the main group was established, it was tough to predict how many cows would be there by the end of the season, as females continue to arrive over a span of about three weeks.

The young vary in length from three and a half to four and a half feet, are born within a few days of arrival and suckled for about a month, becoming enormously fat. The cow, who has not eaten during the whole of this time and has become very thin, then leaves the pup, but remains in the rookery for about two days, after which she escapes to sea, remaining there till the beginning of January, when she returns to the island to moult. The pups when weaned get such rough usage in the rookery that they soon make off into the tussock and sleep for about a month, living on their fat and acquiring a new coat. The noise in one of the large rookeries is something to remember—the barking of the pups, the whimpering and yelping of the mothers and the roaring of the bulls.

The young range in length from three and a half to four and a half feet, are born within a few days of arrival, and are nursed for about a month, rapidly gaining weight. The mother, who hasn’t eaten during this entire time and has become very thin, then leaves the pup but stays in the rookery for about two days before heading back to the sea, where she stays until early January, when she returns to the island to shed her fur. Once weaned, the pups endure such rough treatment in the rookery that they quickly venture into the tussock to rest for about a month, living off their fat and growing a new coat. The noise in one of the large rookeries is unforgettable—the barking of the pups, the whimpering and yelping of the mothers, and the roaring of the bulls.

Another feature in connexion with the rookery is the presence of what may be called unattached bulls, which lie around at a little distance from the cows, and well apart, forming a regular ring through which any cow wishing to desert her pup or leave the rookery before the proper time has very little chance of passing, as one of these grips her firmly with his powerful flipper and stays her progress. The lord of the harem, in the meantime, hastens to the scene of the disturbance, whereupon the other bull decamps.

Another aspect related to the rookery is the presence of what can be called unattached bulls, which lounge a bit away from the cows, creating a regular circle. This makes it hard for any cow wanting to abandon her pup or leave the rookery early to get through, as one of these bulls will grab her firmly with his strong flipper and halt her movement. Meanwhile, the dominant male rushes to the source of the commotion, prompting the other bull to leave.

The sea immediately in the vicinity of a large rookery is generally swarming with unattached bulls, who may be seen with their heads out of the water eyeing each other and keeping a bright look out for escaping cows. Now and again one may see a bull in the water gripping a cow with his flipper, despite her struggles, and roaring at a couple of others who show up menacingly quite close to him.

The water around a big breeding ground is usually filled with lone bulls, who can be spotted with their heads above the surface, watching each other and keeping a sharp lookout for any cows trying to escape. Occasionally, you'll see a bull in the water holding onto a cow with his flipper, ignoring her attempts to break free, and roaring at a couple of other bulls that are swimming dangerously close to him.

It may be remarked that towards the end of the season changes in the proprietorship of a rookery are rather rapid, as continuous raids are made by individuals from the outside. The need of continuous vigilance and the results of many encounters eventually lead to the defeat and discomfiture of the once proud proprietor.

It can be noted that towards the end of the season, changes in who owns a rookery happen quite quickly, as there are constant attacks from outsiders. The need for ongoing watchfulness and the outcome of many battles ultimately result in the downfall and embarrassment of the once-dominant owner.

I have never seen two bulls fight without first indulging in the usual preliminaries, that is, roaring and advancing a few yards and repeating the performance till within striking distance. Then both animals rear high up, supporting themselves on the lower part of the body, and lunge savagely with their whole weight each at his opponent's head or neck, tearing the thick skin with their teeth and causing the blood to flow copiously. Several lunges of this kind generally finish the battle, whereupon the beaten one drops to his flippers and makes all haste towards the water, glancing fearfully behind him on the way. We have seen bulls with their snouts partly torn off and otherwise injured, but worse injuries must occur in the rare, desperate battles which sometimes take place between two very much enraged animals.

I've never seen two bulls fight without going through the usual warm-up, which involves roaring and advancing a few yards, then repeating the process until they're close enough to hit each other. Then both bulls rear up on their hind legs and lunge fiercely with all their weight at each other’s heads or necks, tearing through the thick skin with their teeth and making blood flow heavily. A few lunges like this usually end the fight, and the loser drops to the ground and hurriedly makes his way to the water, looking back nervously as he goes. We've seen bulls with their snouts partly torn off and other injuries, but worse injuries must happen in the rare, intense battles that sometimes occur between two extremely furious animals.

When a bull in the centre of a rookery has occasion to rush at an interloper, he does so without regard to anything in his way, going over cows and pups alike and very often crushing some of the latter to death. Again, it seems as if all the outlying bulls recognize the noise of the rookery bull, because each time he roars they all lift up their heads and take notice, whereas others who have just been roaring have not the slightest regard paid to them, except perhaps by one immediately concerned.

When a bull in the middle of a rookery needs to charge at an intruder, he does it without any concern for what's in his path, trampling over cows and pups alike and often killing some of the pups in the process. It also seems like all the surrounding bulls respond to the sound of the rookery bull because every time he bellows, they all raise their heads and pay attention, while others who have just roared hardly get acknowledged, except maybe by one directly involved.

The bull, during the breeding season, will on provocation attack a man, and it is surprising how quickly the former covers the ground. But on the whole he is an inoffensive animal. It is, of course, impossible to venture into a rookery, as the cows are very savage when they have the pups with them, but one can approach within a few yards of its outskirts without danger. Their food consists of cuttlefish, crabs and fish, and it is probable that they frequent the ocean where this food is plentiful, when they are absent from the island.

The bull, during the breeding season, will attack a person if provoked, and it's surprising how quickly it can cover the ground. However, for the most part, it is a harmless animal. Of course, you can't go into a rookery, as the cows are very aggressive when they have their pups with them, but you can get within a few yards of the edge without any danger. Their diet includes cuttlefish, crabs, and fish, and it's likely that they stay in the ocean where this food is abundant when they’re not on the island.

It has been stated that these animals are nearly extinct, but a visit to Macquarie Island during the breeding season would be enough to convince anybody to the contrary. There are thousands of them, and though about seven hundred are killed during a season, the increase in numbers each year, on Macquarie Island alone, must be very great.

It has been said that these animals are almost extinct, but a trip to Macquarie Island during the breeding season would be enough to change anyone's mind. There are thousands of them, and even though about seven hundred are killed each season, the increase in their numbers every year, just on Macquarie Island, must be quite significant.

The skuas were now returning to the island and their numbers and corresponding clamour were daily increasing. They were the noisiest and most quarrelsome birds we had, but their advent, we hoped, marked the return of less rigorous weather.

The skuas were now coming back to the island, and their numbers and loudness were increasing every day. They were the loudest and most argumentative birds we had, but we hoped their arrival signaled the return of milder weather.

Blake left for Lusitania Bay on the 17th, intending to spend several months there in order to survey and geologically examine the southern end, so we gave him a send-off dinner. He had a very rough trip to the place, having to spend two nights in a cave about six miles from his destination, as a result of getting lost in a dense fog.

Blake left for Lusitania Bay on the 17th, planning to spend several months there to survey and study the geology of the southern end, so we threw him a farewell dinner. He had a really tough journey to the place, having to spend two nights in a cave about six miles from his destination after getting lost in thick fog.

Hamilton made a wire fish-trap to replace the one which he had lost, and succeeded in getting a few fish on lowering it for the first time. He discovered parasitical mites all over them on the outside, and the flesh contained many worms.

Hamilton made a wire fish trap to replace the one he had lost, and he managed to catch a few fish the first time he lowered it. He found parasitic mites all over them on the outside, and the flesh had many worms in it.

A heavy north-north-west gale was experienced on the 26th, but the weather during the last three days of August was very quiet, either calms or light winds prevailing, and we took the opportunity to do some work on Wireless Hill. All the wire stays were tightened, and various ropes which appeared to require attention were renewed, while, as a final improvement, the aerial was hauled as tight as we could make it.

A strong north-northwest storm hit on the 26th, but the weather during the last three days of August was really calm, with either no wind or just light breezes. We took this chance to do some work on Wireless Hill. All the guy wires were tightened, and we replaced various ropes that needed fixing. As a final touch, we pulled the aerial as tight as possible.

We heard on July 31 that the 'Rachel Cohen', a sealing-vessel, had sailed for Macquarie Island and was bringing a few articles for us, so there was something to which we could look forward in the immediate future.

We heard on July 31 that the 'Rachel Cohen', a sealing vessel, had set sail for Macquarie Island and was bringing us a few items, so there was something to look forward to in the near future.

The most remarkable feature of the month's weather was the wind, as gales blew on eleven days, and on seven other days the velocity reached twenty-five miles per hour. Precipitation occurred on twenty-seven days, and the average percentage of cloud was eighty-four. The mean temperature was 38.1 degrees with extremes of 45.3 degrees and 26 degrees F. A prolonged display of auroral light occurred on the night of the 17th, though no colours other than the light lemon-yellow of the arch and streamers could be seen.

The most notable aspect of the month's weather was the wind, with strong gusts hitting on eleven days, and on seven other days, the speed reached twenty-five miles per hour. It rained on twenty-seven days, and the average cloud cover was eighty-four percent. The average temperature was 38.1 degrees, with highs of 45.3 degrees and lows of 26 degrees F. There was an extended display of northern lights on the night of the 17th, although the only color visible was the light lemon-yellow of the arch and streamers.

Bull elephants were now arriving in great numbers, and these monsters could be seen lying everywhere on the isthmus, both up in the tussock, on the beaches, and among the heaps of kelp. Now and again one would lazily lift a flipper to scratch itself or heave its great bulk into a more comfortable position.

Bull elephants were now arriving in large numbers, and these giant creatures could be seen lying everywhere on the isthmus, both up in the grass, on the beaches, and among the piles of kelp. Occasionally, one would lazily lift a flipper to scratch itself or move its massive body into a more comfortable position.

The island is the habitat of two kinds of night-birds, one kind—a species of petrel (Lesson's)—being much larger than the other, both living in holes in the ground. They fly about in the darkness, their cries resembling those made by a beaten puppy. The smaller bird (apparently indigenous and a new species) was occasionally seen flying over the water during the day, but the larger ones come out almost exclusively at night. A light attracts them and Hamilton, with the aid of a lantern and a butterfly-net, tried to catch some. Others swooped about, well out of range, shrieking the while in an uncanny way. Numbers of them were secured afterwards by being dug out of their holes, Mac being just as keen to locate them as Hamilton was to secure them. They cannot see well during the day, and seem to have almost lost the use of their feet. They lay two small, white, thin-shelled eggs at the end of their burrow; and in certain parts of the island, where the burrows are numerous, the sound made by hundreds of them at once, during the nesting season, somewhat resembles that made by a high-power Marconi wireless set at close range.

The island is home to two types of night birds, one of which—a species of petrel (Lesson's)—is much larger than the other, and both live in burrows in the ground. They fly around in the dark, making sounds that resemble the whines of a puppy. The smaller bird (which seems to be native and a new species) was occasionally spotted flying over the water during the day, but the larger ones mostly come out at night. A light draws them in, and Hamilton, using a lantern and a butterfly net, tried to catch some. Others flew around, just out of reach, shrieking in an eerie manner. Many of them were later caught by digging them out of their burrows, with Mac just as eager to find them as Hamilton was to catch them. They don't see well during the day and seem to have nearly lost the use of their feet. They lay two small, thin-shelled white eggs at the end of their burrow; and in certain areas of the island, where the burrows are plentiful, the noise made by hundreds of them at once during nesting season is somewhat similar to the sound of a high-power Marconi wireless set at close range.

Before Blake left Lusitania Bay, I promised to see that the hut on Sandy Bay was re-stocked with provisions by the middle of the month, so, on the 8th, Hamilton, Sandell and I carried a supply of stores down there, leaving a note which informed him that we expected the 'Rachel Cohen' to arrive any day, and asking him to return to the Shack. On the way down we came upon a vast quantity of wreckage piled up on the beach, midway between "The Nuggets" and Sandy Bay. This was all that remained of the sealing schooner, 'Jessie Nichol', which had been wrecked on December 21, 1910. Three men were drowned, their bodies being interred among the tussock, each marked by a life belt and a small board on which the name was roughly carved.

Before Blake left Lusitania Bay, I promised to make sure the hut on Sandy Bay was stocked with supplies by the middle of the month. So, on the 8th, Hamilton, Sandell, and I brought a load of supplies down there. We left a note informing him that we expected the 'Rachel Cohen' to arrive any day and asking him to come back to the Shack. On the way down, we came across a huge amount of wreckage piled up on the beach, halfway between "The Nuggets" and Sandy Bay. This was all that remained of the sealing schooner, 'Jessie Nichol', which had been wrecked on December 21, 1910. Three men drowned, and their bodies were buried among the tussock, each marked by a life belt and a small board with their names roughly carved.

On our homeward trip we caught some wekas for the pot and duly arrived at the Shack, tired, wet and hungry.

On our way home, we caught some wekas for dinner and finally arrived at the Shack, tired, wet, and hungry.

Next day, while sitting in the Shack reducing records, I heard a yell from Hamilton to the effect that the 'Rachel Cohen' was in sight, and about an hour later she dropped anchor in North-East Bay.

Next day, while sitting in the Shack going through records, I heard a shout from Hamilton saying that the 'Rachel Cohen' was in sight, and about an hour later she dropped anchor in North-East Bay.

The sea was fairly smooth and no time was lost in bringing a boat ashore with the mails, of which each man received a share. A gang of sealers was landed with a view to obtaining sea elephant and penguin oil. I had wirelessed asking for a dinghy to be sent down, which would enable Hamilton to do more marine work; and it now came to hand. Further, we received an additional supply of photographic material and some rubber tubing for the anemometer, but the much needed boots did not arrive.

The sea was pretty calm, and we quickly brought a boat ashore with the mail, which everyone got a portion of. A group of sealers was landed to collect sea elephant and penguin oil. I had sent a wireless request for a dinghy, which would help Hamilton do more marine work, and it just arrived. Additionally, we received more photographic supplies and some rubber tubing for the anemometer, but the much-needed boots didn’t arrive.

On the 18th a strong southerly gale sprang up and compelled the 'Rachel Cohen' to seek safety in flight; so she slipped her cable and put to sea. She had not yet landed all the sealers' stores and was forced to hang about the island till the weather moderated sufficiently for her to return to an anchorage.

On the 18th, a strong southerly gale kicked up, forcing the 'Rachel Cohen' to escape for safety; she let go of her moorings and set sail. She hadn't finished unloading all the sealers' supplies and had to linger around the island until the weather calmed down enough for her to go back to anchor.

The gentoo penguins, which had been observed at the beginning of the month building their nests, commenced to lay, and the first ten eggs were collected by us on September 18. Many sea elephant rookeries were now well-formed as the cows began to arrive about the 11th and were soon landing in large numbers. The first pups were heard on the 20th, and Bauer and I walked along to the rookery from which the barking came and had a look at the newcomers. There were only four, none of which was more than a few hours old, but they yapped their displeasure, and the mothers made frantic lunges at us when we approached to get a close view of them.

The gentoo penguins, which had been seen at the start of the month building their nests, started to lay eggs, and we collected the first ten eggs on September 18. Many sea elephant rookeries were now well-established as the females began arriving around the 11th and soon landed in large numbers. The first pups were heard on the 20th, and Bauer and I walked over to the rookery from which the barking came to check out the newcomers. There were only four, none more than a few hours old, but they yapped in annoyance, and the mothers lunged at us frantically when we got close to take a better look at them.

The sealers always gave the animals time to form their rookeries and then killed the bulls for oil. A well-conditioned full-grown animal yields about half a tun of oil, and as the commodity when refined has a market value of from L20 to L25 per tun, it will be seen that the industry is a profitable one. The cows being small never have a very thick coating of blubber, but I have seen bulls with blubber to a depth of eight inches, and some of them yield nearly two thousand pounds, though I should estimate the average yield at about one thousand one hundred pounds. The sealers in the early days used to obtain the oil by cutting the blubber up into very small pieces and melting it down in "try " pots. These pots, many of which may be still seen about the island, were made of very thick iron and the fuel used was the refuse taken from the pot itself. In the present method steam digestors are used, and the oil from the melted blubber is drawn off, after steam has been passing for twelve hours. Coal is brought down by the sealing-vessel to be used as fuel. The "elephant season" lasts only about three months, and within about four weeks of its conclusion, the "penguin season" begins; the same gang of men being employed as a rule. The most difficult operation in connexion with both of these industries is undoubtedly the loading and unloading of the vessel. If auxiliary power were used, the ship could then steam to within half a mile of the shore, but as it is, a sailing-vessel has to anchor about two miles off and the oil is towed in rafts over that distance.

The sealers always allowed the animals time to create their rookeries before they killed the bulls for oil. A healthy, adult seal produces about half a ton of oil, and since the refined product sells for between £20 to £25 per ton, it's clear that the industry is quite profitable. The smaller cows don't have a thick layer of blubber, but I've seen bulls with blubber up to eight inches deep, and some yield nearly two thousand pounds, though I would estimate the average yield at around one thousand one hundred pounds. In the early days, sealers obtained the oil by chopping the blubber into very small pieces and melting it down in "try" pots. Many of these pots, made of very thick iron, can still be seen around the island, and they used the leftover material from the pot itself as fuel. Nowadays, steam digesters are used, and the oil from the melted blubber is extracted after steam has been running for twelve hours. Coal is brought by the sealing vessel to be used as fuel. The "elephant season" lasts only about three months, and about four weeks after it ends, the "penguin season" kicks off, usually with the same crew of men. The most challenging part of both of these industries is definitely loading and unloading the vessel. If auxiliary power were utilized, the ship could steam within half a mile of the shore, but as it stands, a sailing vessel has to anchor about two miles out, and the oil is towed in rafts that distance.

We heard sounds from Adelie Land wireless station for the first time on September 25, 1912, but the signals were very faint and all that we could receive was: "Please inform Pennant Hills." Sawyer called them repeatedly for several hours, but heard no acknowledgment. Every effort was made to get in touch with them from this time forward, Sawyer remaining at the instrument until daylight every morning.

We first picked up sounds from the Adelie Land wireless station on September 25, 1912, but the signals were really weak, and all we could get was: "Please inform Pennant Hills." Sawyer kept trying to reach them for several hours but received no response. From that point on, we made every effort to contact them, with Sawyer staying at the equipment until daylight every morning.

The Royal penguins returned to the island on the 27th and immediately commenced to make their way to the rookeries. They had been absent since April and were very fat after their long migration.

The Royal penguins came back to the island on the 27th and immediately started heading to the rookeries. They had been gone since April and were quite plump after their long migration.

On the 28th Blake and Hamilton started out in the dinghy for Lusitania Bay. They had already made a step and sprit, and, with a calico sail hoisted, the frail craft ran before a light breeze. Having a fair wind they made good headway along the coast, dropping in at a gentoo penguin rookery en route, and collecting about two hundred and twenty eggs. Mac was a passenger and was a very sick dog all the trip.

On the 28th, Blake and Hamilton set off in the dinghy for Lusitania Bay. They had already prepared a step and sprit, and with a calico sail raised, the lightweight boat sailed smoothly in a light breeze. With a favorable wind, they made good progress along the coast, stopping at a gentoo penguin rookery along the way and collecting about two hundred and twenty eggs. Mac was along for the ride and spent the entire trip feeling very sick.

Shortly after their departure, the 'Rachel Cohen', which had been blown away on the 18th, reappeared and again anchored. The captain reported having seen numerous icebergs, some of which were very large, about thirty miles to the eastward of the island. The sealers immediately commenced to get away the rest of their stores and coal and also to put some oil aboard the vessel, but on the following day the wind increased to such an extent that, in attempting to reach the ship with a raft of oil, they were blown down the coast and had to beach the boat several miles away.

Shortly after they left, the 'Rachel Cohen', which had been blown off course on the 18th, reappeared and anchored again. The captain reported seeing numerous icebergs, some of which were quite large, about thirty miles east of the island. The sealers immediately started to unload the rest of their supplies and coal and also began putting some oil aboard the ship. However, the next day the wind picked up significantly, and while they tried to reach the ship with a raft of oil, they were blown down the coast and had to beach the boat several miles away.

On the night of the 29th Adelie Land wireless station was again heard tapping out a message apparently with the hope that some station would receive it. All we got was: "Having a hell of a time waiting for calm weather to put up more masts." Sawyer again repeatedly called, but they evidently could not hear him as no reply was received, and the above message was repeated time after time.

On the night of the 29th, the Adelie Land wireless station was once again heard sending out a message, seemingly hoping that some station would pick it up. All we got was: "Having a tough time waiting for calm weather to put up more masts." Sawyer tried calling several times, but it was clear they couldn't hear him since there was no response, and the message above was sent over and over.

The weather during September was not quite so rough as that of the previous two or three months, but misty days were very frequent. Gales were experienced on six days and strong winds on nine days, but several quiet periods occurred. The average temperature was 38.6 degrees, with extremes of 44.7 degrees and 26 degrees F.

The weather in September wasn't as harsh as the previous two or three months, but there were a lot of foggy days. There were strong winds on six days and really gusty winds on nine days, although there were also several calm periods. The average temperature was 38.6 degrees, with highs of 44.7 degrees and lows of 26 degrees F.

October was ushered in by a strong gale and rather heavy rain-squalls. The 'Rachel Cohen' had a severe buffeting, though she was lying on the lee side of the island.

October arrived with a strong wind and heavy rain showers. The 'Rachel Cohen' took a heavy beating, even though she was anchored on the protected side of the island.

Just about three-quarters of a mile to the west of the Shack were two large sea elephant rookeries, very close to each other, and on the 3rd Sandell and I went along to see what was happening there. We found about two hundred and fifty cows in the nearer one, and, as closely as we could count, about five hundred in the adjacent colony. The babel of sounds made one feel thankful that these noisy creatures were some distance from the Shack. Nearly all the cows had pups, some of which had reached a fair size, while others were only a few hours old. We saw several dead ones, crushed out almost flat, and some skuas were busily engaged gorging themselves on the carcases. These birds are indeed professional plunderers, and will venture almost anywhere in pursuit of food.

Just about three-quarters of a mile west of the Shack, there were two large sea elephant rookeries, really close to each other. On the 3rd, Sandell and I went to check out what was going on there. We found around two hundred and fifty cows in the closer rookery and, as best as we could count, about five hundred in the nearby colony. The chaotic noise made us grateful these loud creatures were some distance from the Shack. Almost all the cows had pups, some of which were quite big, while others were only a few hours old. We saw several dead ones, flattened almost completely, and some skuas were eagerly feeding on the carcasses. These birds are true scavengers and will go nearly anywhere in search of food.

During the evening we again heard Adelie Land station working, and the burden of their message to an apparently chance audience was: "We do not seem able to get Macquarie Island, all is well, though bad weather has so far prevented any attempt at sledging."

During the evening, we once again heard the Adelie Land station broadcasting, and their message to what seemed like a random audience was: "We haven't been able to reach Macquarie Island; everything is fine, but bad weather has so far stopped any attempts at sledging."

Sawyer again called them at regular intervals for the rest of the night, but, as before, got no response.

Sawyer kept calling them at regular intervals for the rest of the night, but, like before, he didn't get any response.

Hamilton and Blake were busy at Lusitania Bay during the first two weeks of October securing sea elephant specimens and collecting eggs. They visited Caroline Cove where is established a giant petrel rookery containing about four hundred birds, and gathered a large number of eggs—purely specimens, as they are no use otherwise.

Hamilton and Blake were busy at Lusitania Bay during the first two weeks of October collecting sea elephant specimens and gathering eggs. They visited Caroline Cove, where a giant petrel rookery is located, home to around four hundred birds, and collected a substantial number of eggs—just for specimens, since they have no other purpose.

The 'Rachel Cohen' finally left us on the 8th, expecting to pay another visit in December for the purpose of taking off the sea elephant oil procured by the sealers. Sandell and I visited the gentoo penguin colony in Aerial Cove during the afternoon, for the purpose of getting a few eggs. We found plenty there and collected as many as we required. On returning to the empty nests, the birds would first of all peer round to assure themselves that the eggs were really missing, and then throw their heads back, swaying them from side to side to the accompaniment of loud, discordant cries.

The 'Rachel Cohen' finally left us on the 8th, planning to return in December to collect the sea elephant oil gathered by the sealers. Sandell and I visited the gentoo penguin colony in Aerial Cove in the afternoon to get a few eggs. We found plenty there and took as many as we needed. When we returned to the empty nests, the birds would first look around to make sure the eggs were really gone, and then tilt their heads back, swinging them side to side while making loud, discordant cries.

Several of us started out on the 10th to visit the west coast for the purpose of getting some wekas and, incidentally, to make any observations possible. We saw thousands of sea elephants along the coast and passed many rookeries of various sizes. There were a large number of wekas about, but after shooting fourteen we were satisfied with our bag.

Several of us set out on the 10th to visit the west coast to catch some wekas and, along the way, make any observations we could. We spotted thousands of sea elephants along the coast and passed many rookeries of different sizes. There were plenty of wekas around, but after shooting fourteen, we were satisfied with our haul.

A westerly gale during the night proved too much for the aerial, and down it came. Blake and Hamilton were away, so Sawyer, Sandell and I went up, and after much battling and frequent use of the "handy billy" succeeded in fixing things. We also re-tightened the wire stays and thoroughly overhauled the ropes. Snow and sleet fell all the time, making the task most disagreeable.

A westward storm last night was too strong for the aerial, and it crashed down. Blake and Hamilton were gone, so Sawyer, Sandell, and I headed up. After a lot of struggle and frequent use of the "handy billy," we managed to get everything fixed. We also tightened the wire stays and completely checked the ropes. Snow and sleet were falling the whole time, making the task really unpleasant.

About the middle of the month the Royal penguins commenced to lay, and on the 17th Sandell and I went to their rookeries at "The Nuggets" and collected about fifteen dozen eggs, which we buried in a hole in the bank of the creek for preservation. This species of penguin is the one which is killed for oil, not because it is any fatter than the others, but because it lives in such large colonies. There is one rookery of these birds on the south end of the island which covers an area of sixteen and a half acres, whilst at "The Nuggets" there are numbers of them scattered along the banks of a creek which reaches the sea, aggregating ten acres. At the latter place are situated the oil works belonging to the sealers.

About the middle of the month, the Royal penguins started to lay eggs, and on the 17th, Sandell and I went to their rookeries at "The Nuggets" and collected about fifteen dozen eggs, which we buried in a hole in the bank of the creek to keep them safe. This type of penguin is hunted for oil, not because it’s any fatter than the others, but because it lives in such large groups. There’s one rookery of these birds at the south end of the island that covers an area of sixteen and a half acres, while at "The Nuggets," there are many of them scattered along the banks of a creek that leads to the sea, totaling ten acres. The oil works belonging to the sealers are located at the latter site.

From careful observation I should say that the number of birds killed during the season would not total one hundred and fifty thousand. The method of killing—by blows from a heavy club—is about as humane as any that could be adopted, and the yearly increase in numbers in the only rookeries that are being worked is certainly greater than the decrease due to the depredations of the sealers. Apart from this, there are acres of rookeries on the island from which not a single bird is taken, and they go on year after year adding thousands upon thousands to their already vast numbers.

From careful observation, I’d say the number of birds killed during the season wouldn’t reach one hundred and fifty thousand. The way they’re killed—by getting hit with a heavy club—is about as humane as any method could be, and the yearly growth in numbers in the only rookeries being harvested is definitely greater than the decline caused by the sealers. On top of that, there are acres of rookeries on the island where not a single bird is taken, and they continue to grow year after year, adding thousands upon thousands to their already huge populations.

This species resembles the others in habits, and I shall not describe them at any length. They are of the same colour as the Victoria penguins, but have a more orderly crest. Their rookeries are always on or very close to a running stream which forms the highway along which they travel to and fro. There is no policeman on duty, but a well-ordered procession is somehow arranged whereby those going up keep to one side and those coming down keep to the other. Once they are in the rookery, however, different conditions obtain. Here are fights, squabbles and riots, arising from various causes, the chief of which appears to be a disposition on the part of some birds to loiter about. During the nesting time much disorder prevails, and fights, in which beaks and flippers are energetically used, may be seen in progress at various places throughout the rookery. The nests are made of small stones, and occasionally, a bone or two from the skeleton of some long-dead relative forms part of the bulwarks. The attempt on the part of some birds to steal stones from surrounding nests is about the most fruitful cause of a riot, and the thief generally gets soundly thrashed, besides which all have a peck at him as he makes his way with as much haste as possible from the danger-zone. As the season advances, these rookeries become covered with filthy slush, but it seems to make no difference to the eggs, as the chicks appear in due course. When the moulting process is in full swing the rookeries are very crowded, and feathers and slush then become mixed together, making the place anything but fragrant.

This species behaves like the others, so I won’t go into too much detail. They share the same color as the Victoria penguins but have a more organized crest. Their nests are always located on or very near a flowing stream that serves as the main route they use to travel back and forth. There’s no one to direct traffic, but somehow they manage to form a well-organized line where those heading up stay on one side and those coming down stay on the other. However, once they’re in the nesting area, things change. Here, there are fights, arguments, and chaos, mainly caused by some birds that tend to hang around too much. During the nesting season, disorder reigns, and you can see aggressive encounters where beaks and flippers are used vigorously in various spots across the rookery. The nests are built from small stones, and sometimes you might find a bone or two from some long-dead relative mixed in. One of the most common triggers for chaos is when some birds try to steal stones from nearby nests. The thief usually gets a serious beating, and everyone takes a shot at him as he hurriedly escapes from the trouble. As the season goes on, these nesting areas become covered with disgusting slush, but it doesn’t seem to affect the eggs, as the chicks eventually appear. When molting is in full swing, the rookeries are extremely crowded, and feathers and slush get mixed together, creating a pretty unpleasant smell.

A fifty-four mile gale from the west-north-west blew down on us on the 20th, but shortly after noon it weakened, and, towards evening, with the shifting of the wind to southwest, came squalls of sleet and snow and a drop in temperature. Hamilton returned from Lusitania Bay in the dinghy on the 21st, but Blake stopped there as he had not yet finished his work in that locality. The dinghy was well laden with specimens of various kinds and, on the way up, some wood and pickets were left at Green Valley for future requirements.

A fifty-four mile-per-hour gale from the west-northwest hit us on the 20th, but soon after noon it died down, and by evening, as the wind shifted to the southwest, we experienced squalls of sleet and snow along with a temperature drop. Hamilton came back from Lusitania Bay in the dinghy on the 21st, but Blake stayed there since he hadn't finished his work in that area. The dinghy was heavily loaded with specimens of different types, and on the way up, some wood and pickets were dropped off at Green Valley for future needs.

On the 25th Sandell and I visited the west coast, but, instead of going the usual way, we walked down the east coast and went up the creek at "The Nuggets" with a view to having a look at the penguin colonies along its course, finally crossing over the hills and getting into another creek, which we followed all the way down to the west coast. Along this creek were numerous waterfalls, one of which was quite sixty feet in height with wind-blown spray frozen white on the rocks on either side. We came across several giant petrel rookeries, and were treated to a display of the "stinker's" ability to make himself objectionable. A pair of sooty albatrosses were seen nesting on the front of a rocky steep, but on climbing up we found that they had not yet laid. After catching some wekas and taking a few photographs we returned to the Shack.

On the 25th, Sandell and I visited the west coast, but instead of taking the usual route, we walked down the east coast and headed up the creek at "The Nuggets" to check out the penguin colonies along the way. We eventually crossed over the hills and entered another creek, which we followed all the way down to the west coast. Along this creek were several waterfalls, one of which was about sixty feet tall, with wind-blown spray frozen white on the rocks on either side. We stumbled upon several giant petrel rookeries and witnessed the "stinker's" knack for being unpleasant. A pair of sooty albatrosses were nesting on the face of a steep rocky area, but when we climbed up, we found they hadn't laid any eggs yet. After catching some wekas and snapping a few photos, we headed back to the Shack.

On the last day of the month several of us crossed the hills to the west coast in search of plants and birds' eggs. We secured a number of plant specimens—a further sign of the arrival of spring—including two which bore a very small flower, and were most successful in obtaining skuas', giant petrels' and sooty albatrosses' eggs.

On the last day of the month, several of us hiked over the hills to the west coast looking for plants and birds' eggs. We collected a number of plant specimens—a clear sign that spring had arrived—including two with very small flowers, and we were quite successful in finding eggs from skuas, giant petrels, and sooty albatrosses.

During the evening I received a message from Captain Davis stating that the 'Aurora' would visit us in about three weeks' time and inquiring if we needed any supplies. This was entirely unexpected, as we thought that no more would be seen of the Ship until she came to take us home at the end of March 1913.

During the evening, I got a message from Captain Davis saying that the 'Aurora' would be stopping by in about three weeks and asking if we needed any supplies. This was a total surprise since we thought we wouldn't see the ship again until she came to take us home at the end of March 1913.

Earthquake shocks were felt at 1.55 A.M. and 9.35 A.M. on October 28, but did no damage other than to bring down some loose rock. Auroral displays were rather frequent but not very pronounced, and in most cases could only be classed as "glows."

Earthquake tremors were felt at 1:55 A.M. and 9:35 A.M. on October 28, but caused no damage other than knocking down some loose rocks. Auroral displays occurred fairly often but weren't very striking, and in most instances could only be described as "glows."

A bright sunny morning on the 3rd induced Hamilton and me to make a photographic excursion along the coast. Hitherto only still-life photos had been taken, but with the sunlight we were then having, any work was possible, so we determined to have some "shots" at the sea elephants. They were rather difficult subjects, strange to say, but we spent some time amongst them and did famously, till a snow-squall made us suspend operations.

A bright sunny morning on the 3rd motivated Hamilton and me to take a photography trip along the coast. Up until then, we had only taken still-life photos, but with the sunlight we had that day, any kind of photography was possible. So, we decided to try to get some "shots" of the sea elephants. They were surprisingly tricky subjects, but we spent a good amount of time with them and did really well until a snow squall forced us to stop.

We heard the discordant but mournful cry of a sooty albatross coming from the cliff-front, so Hamilton climbed up and, after scrambling about for a while, succeeded in finding a nest, which contained one egg. This led him to look along the cliffs fronting the east coast, and on the following morning he found several nests and caught two birds, both of which were taken by hand while on the nest. They had beautiful plumage and made very fine specimens.

We heard the jarring yet sad call of a sooty albatross coming from the cliff edge, so Hamilton climbed up and after a bit of searching, managed to find a nest that had one egg in it. This prompted him to check along the cliffs facing the east coast, and the next morning he discovered several nests and caught two birds, both of which he grabbed by hand while they were on the nest. They had stunning feathers and made great specimens.

Blake returned from Lusitania Bay during the afternoon of the 4th and reported that he required only four or five days to complete the survey. The configuration of the island at the southern end is vastly different to that shown in the published charts, and this became more apparent as Blake's figures were plotted.

Blake came back from Lusitania Bay in the afternoon of the 4th and said that he needed just four or five days to finish the survey. The shape of the island at the southern end is very different from what’s shown in the published charts, and this became clearer as Blake's data was plotted.

The news that Piastre had won the Melbourne Cup was flashed about all over the southern ocean during the evening, and we picked it up; but as this was the first we had heard of the animal, nobody seemed much interested. It certainly gave a turn to the conversation, and quite a sporting tone permeated the discussions of the ensuing two or three days.

The news that Piastre had won the Melbourne Cup spread quickly across the southern ocean that evening, and we heard about it; but since it was the first time we had learned of the horse, nobody seemed very interested. It definitely changed the conversation, and a sporty vibe took over the discussions in the next couple of days.

The subjects of discussion were usually those of environment, and most of our talk centred round sea elephants, sea-leopards, penguins, temperatures, wind, wireless telegraphy, fish, aurorae, exploration, ships, Queensland and New Zealand. Sea elephants and penguins do offer scope for a considerable amount of conversation, as one observes them under such different circumstances, and they are so odd that something remarkable is always associated with the sight of them. The weather, being practically the bete noire of our existence, came in for a good deal of abuse. Wireless telegraphy is a mighty interesting subject at all times, and we passed many hours of our stay in discussing its future. All the members were, allegedly, fishermen of some calibre, and when I have said that, anybody with a knowledge of the man who claims ability as an angler will know what all the others, in turn, had to receive with restrained and respectful admiration. The advantages of settlement in Queensland were so apparent to at least one member of the party that he simply could not understand why thousands were not annually killed in the rush to get to this, "the greatest of all the Australian States." Good old silky oak!

The topics we discussed were mostly about the environment, and most of our conversation focused on sea elephants, sea leopards, penguins, temperatures, wind, wireless telegraphy, fish, auroras, exploration, ships, Queensland, and New Zealand. Sea elephants and penguins provide plenty to talk about since we see them in such different situations, and they're so strange that there's always something interesting connected to seeing them. Weather, being practically the bane of our existence, received a lot of criticism. Wireless telegraphy is an incredibly engaging topic at any time, and we spent many hours during our stay discussing its future. Everyone claimed to be a fisherman of some sort, and once I say that, anyone familiar with someone who boasts about their fishing skills knows what the rest of us had to regard with restrained and respectful admiration. The benefits of settling in Queensland were so clear to at least one member of the group that he just couldn’t understand why thousands weren’t rushing every year to get to this "greatest of all the Australian States." Good old silky oak!

The scenery of New Zealand was almost as well known to us as to anybody who has lived in the country all his life, and three of us had never been there. We have sat round the Shack sometimes and only the roar of a sea elephant outside reminded us that we were not, as we imagined, at a Maori "tangi." The wages to be earned there, the delights of travelling, the legislators, Rotorua, kauri pine, and the moon they've got in Auckland—we've heard of all these and marvelled at them. "Kapai te Maori!"

The scenery of New Zealand was almost as familiar to us as it is to anyone who has lived there their whole life, and three of us had never been. We often sat around the Shack, and only the roar of a sea elephant outside reminded us that we weren’t, as we thought, at a Maori "tangi." We’ve heard about the wages to be made there, the joys of traveling, the lawmakers, Rotorua, kauri pine, and the moon they have in Auckland—and we’ve marveled at all of it. "Kapai te Maori!"

Blake and Hamilton went to Sandy Bay in the dinghy on the 6th in order to complete some work. They improved the hut there, to the extent of making a fire-place and laying barrel-staves on the floor, afterwards bringing a boat-load of timber from the 'Jessie Nichol' wreck and rigging up a board bunk sufficiently large to accommodate both of them.

Blake and Hamilton went to Sandy Bay in the small boat on the 6th to get some work done. They fixed up the hut there by adding a fireplace and laying barrel staves on the floor. Later, they brought a boatload of timber from the wreck of the 'Jessie Nichol' and set up a board bunk big enough for both of them.

While walking down to the 'Clyde' wreck for some wood on the 7th I saw a strange bird on the beach, and, returning to the Shack for the gun, I got him at the second shot. He was a land bird and had evidently been blown out of his course, as none of his kind had been seen before on the island.

While walking down to the 'Clyde' wreck for some wood on the 7th, I saw a strange bird on the beach. After going back to the Shack for the gun, I managed to shoot it on my second attempt. It was a land bird and had clearly been blown off course since none of its kind had been seen on the island before.

On getting up on the following morning I found poor old Ma lying dead, and the feathers which lay about indicated that she had been the victim of a savage assault, but whether at the teeth of a dog or the beak of a skua I was unable to determine. This was most unfortunate, as the hens had all started to lay again two days previously; but apart from this she was a funny old creature and one could almost hold a conversation with her, so we regretted her loss. However, to make amends for this disaster the Victoria penguins started to lay on the same day, and as several of their rookeries were only a few minutes' walk from the Shack, the position was much the same as if we owned a poultry farm.

When I got up the next morning, I found poor old Ma lying dead, and the feathers scattered around said she had been attacked violently, but I couldn't tell if it was a dog or a skua that did it. This was really unfortunate since the hens had just started laying again two days before; but besides that, she was a quirky old bird and you could almost have a chat with her, so we felt her loss. On the bright side, the Victoria penguins began laying that same day, and since several of their rookeries were just a few minutes' walk from the Shack, it felt like we owned a poultry farm.

Hamilton returned from Sandy Bay on the 17th and immediately set about collecting shags' eggs. He visited Aerial Cove for the purpose but did not get enough, and was compelled to go to West Point, where he gathered twenty-four dozen for specimens. He now had a collection of eggs of all birds which nest on the island, with the exception of the weka and the tern.

Hamilton came back from Sandy Bay on the 17th and immediately started collecting shags' eggs. He went to Aerial Cove for this but didn’t find enough, so he had to head to West Point, where he managed to gather twenty-four dozen for specimens. He now had a collection of eggs from all the birds that nest on the island, except for the weka and the tern.

At 6.30 P.M. on November 22 the 'Aurora' steamed into North-East Bay and dropped anchor. Hamilton, Blake and Sawyer launched the dinghy and pulled out to receive the mails, which they brought ashore for distribution. All on board were well and Captain Davis sent word to say he would land in the morning, bringing our goods and some visitors—Professor Flynn of Hobart and Mr. Denny.

At 6:30 PM on November 22, the 'Aurora' arrived in North-East Bay and dropped anchor. Hamilton, Blake, and Sawyer launched the dinghy and went out to collect the mail, which they brought ashore for distribution. Everyone on board was doing well, and Captain Davis sent a message saying he would come ashore in the morning, bringing our supplies and some visitors—Professor Flynn from Hobart and Mr. Denny.

The 'Aurora' next day steamed round North Head and took a series of soundings between the main island and the Judge and Clerk. These latter islets lie about eight miles to the north of North Head, and are merely rocks about eighty feet high upon which thousands of shags and other birds have established rookeries. On the following morning we said good-bye to the Ship, which weighed anchor and steamed away, leaving us once more to our own devices.

The 'Aurora' the next day went around North Head and took a series of soundings between the main island and the Judge and Clerk. These smaller islands are about eight miles north of North Head and are just rocks around eighty feet high where thousands of cormorants and other birds have made their nests. The next morning, we said goodbye to the Ship, which weighed anchor and left, leaving us to our own devices again.

All the flowering plants were now showing their extremely modest blooms, and the tussock looked like a field of wheat, each stem having a decided ear. The gentoo penguins, as well as the giant petrels, had hatched their eggs, and the parent birds were shouldering full responsibilities.

All the flowering plants were now displaying their very subtle blooms, and the tussock resembled a wheat field, with each stem having a distinct ear. The gentoo penguins, along with the giant petrels, had hatched their eggs, and the parent birds were taking on full responsibilities.

Blake and Hamilton were now prepared for another visit to the southern end. Blake had almost completed the chart of the island, and the difference between it and the published chart was very striking. In the latter case the south end was shown as being six miles wide, whereas it is in reality only a little more than two miles across, and the width of the island is nowhere more than three and a half miles. About twenty miles from the southern end lie two islets known as the Bishop and Clerk. The former, which is the larger, is covered with a growth of tussock, while the latter is mainly bare rock.

Blake and Hamilton were now ready for another trip to the southern end. Blake had nearly finished the chart of the island, and the differences compared to the published chart were very noticeable. The published chart shows the south end as being six miles wide, but in reality, it's just a little over two miles across, and the island's width is never more than three and a half miles. About twenty miles from the southern end are two small islands called the Bishop and Clerk. The Bishop, the larger of the two, is covered in tussock grass, while the Clerk is mostly bare rock.

A distinct rise in temperature was noticeable during November and the mean worked out at 41.6 degrees, while the extremes were 49 degrees and 82 degrees F. Strong winds were recorded on thirteen days and six short-lived gales occurred. We had less precipitation than during any previous month, as thirteen dry days were experienced. The average cloudiness was 93 per cent.; largely due to the frequent foggy or misty weather.

A noticeable increase in temperature was observed in November, with an average of 41.6 degrees, while the highs reached 49 degrees and the lows dropped to 82 degrees F. Strong winds were noted on thirteen days, and we experienced six brief gales. We had less rainfall than in any previous month, with thirteen dry days recorded. The average cloud cover was 93 percent, mainly due to the frequent foggy or misty conditions.

On December 2, at 10 A.M., Blake and I packed our sleeping-bags and blankets and started for Sandy Bay. The swags weighed only thirty-five pounds each and we made a rather quick trip.

On December 2, at 10 A.M., Blake and I packed our sleeping bags and blankets and headed to Sandy Bay. The kits weighed just thirty-five pounds each, so we made good time on our trip.

After repairing the dilapidated shack, we sallied out for the purpose of catching our evening meal, and with the aid of Mac soon succeeded in getting eight wekas. A sea elephant was then killed, and the blubber, heart and tongue taken; the first-named for use as fuel and the others for food. We cleaned the wekas and put them in the pot, cooking the whole lot together, a proceeding which enabled us to forgo cooking a breakfast in the morning. The beach was swarming with young sea elephants and many could be seen playing about in a small, shallow lagoon.

After fixing up the run-down shack, we headed out to catch our dinner, and with Mac's help, we managed to catch eight wekas. We also hunted a sea elephant and took its blubber, heart, and tongue; we used the blubber as fuel and the other parts for food. We cleaned the wekas and cooked them all together in one pot, which saved us from having to make breakfast in the morning. The beach was filled with young sea elephants, and many of them were playing in a small, shallow lagoon.

Just south of the hut there is a sandy spit and one of the only stretches of beach on the island, where thousands of penguins from the adjacent rookeries were congregated, amongst them being three King penguins, which were easily distinguishable on account of their great size.

Just south of the hut, there’s a sandy spit and one of the few beach stretches on the island, where thousands of penguins from the nearby rookeries gathered. Among them were three King penguins, which were easy to spot because of their large size.

Feeling a little weary, I sought the hut about 9 P.M. and turned into the sleeping-bag, which was placed on a board bottom covered with tussock, which was by no means uncomfortable. The old place smoked so much that we decided to let the fire die down, and as soon as the smoke had cleared away, the imperfections of the hut became apparent; rays of moonlight streaming through countless openings in the walls and roof.

Feeling a bit tired, I headed to the hut around 9 P.M. and got into the sleeping bag that was on a board bottom covered with tussock, which wasn't uncomfortable at all. The old place was so smoky that we decided to let the fire die down, and once the smoke cleared, the flaws of the hut became obvious; moonlight was streaming in through countless gaps in the walls and roof.

We rose at 6.30 A.M. While Blake lit the fire, I went out to fill the billy at a small stream running out of the hills about sixty yards away. After breakfast we set out for Green Valley, but had not gone very far when it began to blow very hard from the south, straight in our faces, and we scrambled on towards our destination amidst squalls of snow, hail and sleet. Eventually we reached the valley and had a somewhat meagre lunch in a small cave. The title "cave" rather dignifies this hole in the rock, but it was the only friendly spot in a most inhospitable locality, and we were inclined to be generous,

We got up at 6:30 A.M. While Blake started the fire, I went out to fill the kettle at a small stream that was about sixty yards away in the hills. After breakfast, we headed out for Green Valley, but we hadn’t gone very far when the wind started blowing really hard from the south, right in our faces, and we pushed on toward our destination through snow, hail, and sleet. Eventually, we made it to the valley and had a pretty basic lunch in a small cave. Calling it a "cave" is a bit generous for this hole in the rock, but it was the only decent spot in such an unfriendly area, and we were feeling generous.

On the whole, the length of coast we had traversed was found to be as rough as any on the island. There is not a stretch of one hundred yards anywhere that can be termed "good going." In many places we found that the steep cliffs approached very close to the water, and the mournful cry of the sooty albatross could be heard coming from points high on the face of the cliffs, while the wekas were so tame that one could almost walk up and catch them.

Overall, the stretch of coastline we covered was just as rough as any on the island. There's not a single stretch of a hundred yards that could be considered "easy walking." In many areas, the steep cliffs came right up to the water's edge, and we could hear the haunting call of the sooty albatross from high up on the cliffs, while the wekas were so accustomed to humans that you could almost walk right up and catch them.

A large creek whose banks are overhung with a coarse growth of fern makes its way out of the hills and runs into Sandy Bay. Just a little to the south of this creek Blake discovered a terminal moraine about two hundred yards in length and fifty feet wide. It rests on sandstone about fifteen feet above the present sea-level and the boulders consist of polished and sub-angular blocks of sandstone and porphyry of various sizes. It evidently belongs to the valley or to a later stage of glaciation. The rocks along the coast are all a volcanic series, and basic dykes are visible in many places.

A large creek with banks covered in thick ferns flows down from the hills and into Sandy Bay. Just a little south of this creek, Blake found a terminal moraine that is about two hundred yards long and fifty feet wide. It sits on sandstone about fifteen feet above the current sea level, and the boulders are a mix of polished and jagged sandstone and porphyry in various sizes. It clearly belongs to the valley or a later phase of glaciation. The rocks along the coast are all part of a volcanic series, and you can see basic dykes in many spots.

We arose at 7 A.M. next day and breakfasted on porridge, weka, fried heart, "hard-tack" and cocoa. Leaving the hut shortly afterwards we climbed on to the hills and travelled south for several miles in order to fix the position of some lakes and creeks. There was one lake in the vicinity about half a mile long and to all appearances very deep. It lay between two steep hills, and the grassy bank at one end and the small sloping approach at the other gave it an artificial appearance, while the water was beautifully clear and perfectly fresh. At the sloping end, dozens of skuas were busily engaged washing themselves and the flapping of their wings in the water made a remarkable noise, audible at a considerable distance on the hill-tops. On returning to the hut at Sandy Bay several rabbits secured by Mac were cleaned and put on to boil.

We got up at 7 A.M. the next day and had porridge, weka, fried heart, hardtack, and cocoa for breakfast. Shortly after leaving the hut, we climbed up into the hills and traveled south for several miles to pinpoint some lakes and creeks. There was one lake nearby, about half a mile long and seemingly very deep. It was situated between two steep hills, and the grassy shore on one end and the small sloping entry on the other gave it an unnatural look, while the water was beautifully clear and completely fresh. At the sloping end, dozens of skuas were busy washing themselves, and the sound of their wings flapping in the water was quite loud, carrying a good distance on the hilltops. When we returned to the hut at Sandy Bay, several rabbits caught by Mac were cleaned and put on to boil.

Next morning a dense mist shrouded the island till about 11 A.M., but the weather becoming fine and bright, we started for the west coast about noon. During our progress along the bed of a creek, Blake discovered what was believed to be a glacial deposit containing fossil bones, and considerable time was spent in examining this and attempting to extract whole specimens, thereby making it too late to proceed to the west. On returning to the hut we decided to pack the swags. We reached home just in time for tea, finding that nothing unusual had occurred during our four days' absence.

The next morning, a thick fog covered the island until around 11 A.M., but as the weather cleared up and became bright, we set off for the west coast around noon. While making our way along the creek bed, Blake found what was thought to be a glacial deposit filled with fossil bones, and we spent quite a bit of time examining it and trying to extract whole specimens, which made it too late to continue west. When we got back to the hut, we decided to pack our gear. We got home just in time for tea, finding that nothing unusual had happened during our four days away.

Hamilton and Blake went out fishing in the dinghy on the 9th and made a remarkable haul of fish, sixty in number, ranging in size from a few ounces to twelve and a half pounds. They were all of the same species, somewhat resembling rock cod, but as usual they were covered with external parasites, and their flesh was full of worm-cysts. Hamilton preserved a number of them and the rest were cooked, but we did not relish them very much and the one meal was enough.

Hamilton and Blake went fishing in the dinghy on the 9th and had an impressive catch of sixty fish, ranging in size from a few ounces to twelve and a half pounds. They were all the same species, somewhat like rock cod, but as usual, they were covered in external parasites, and their flesh was full of worm cysts. Hamilton preserved some of them, and the rest were cooked, but we didn't enjoy them very much, and one meal was enough.

On December 11 we had a hard gale all day, the anemometer recording "bursts" of over fifty miles an hour frequently, while the average exceeded forty miles an hour throughout. Twelve months ago on that day we had made our first landing on the island from the 'Aurora', but vastly different weather conditions prevailed at the time.

On December 11, we faced a strong gale all day, with the anemometer frequently showing "bursts" of over fifty miles an hour, while the average was over forty miles an hour throughout the day. A year ago on that same day, we had made our first landing on the island from the 'Aurora', but the weather conditions were completely different then.

Christmas Day was now very close at hand, and as Blake and Hamilton were going to celebrate at the other end of the island, whence they had gone on the 10th, Sawyer, Sandell and I arranged a little "spread" for ourselves. Sawyer produced a cake which he had received in the recent mail, and some friend had forwarded a plum pudding to Sandell, so on Christmas Day these, with a boiled ham, some walnuts, mince rolls and a bottle of stout were spread on the table, which had been decorated with tussock stuck in sea elephants' tusks. The highest temperature registered on the island during our stay—51.8 degrees F.—was recorded on Christmas Day, and the sun seemed so warm that Sandell and I ventured into the sea for a dip, but the temperature of the water was not high enough to make it an agreeable experience.

Christmas Day was just around the corner, and since Blake and Hamilton were heading to the other side of the island to celebrate, where they had gone on the 10th, Sawyer, Sandell, and I planned a little feast for ourselves. Sawyer brought out a cake he had received in the recent mail, and a friend had sent Sandell a plum pudding, so on Christmas Day we spread these, along with a boiled ham, some walnuts, mince rolls, and a bottle of stout on the table, which we decorated with tussock stuck in sea elephants' tusks. The highest temperature recorded on the island during our stay—51.8 degrees F.—was noted on Christmas Day, and the sun felt so warm that Sandell and I decided to take a dip in the sea, but the water wasn't warm enough to make it a pleasant experience.

During the evening of the 26th we received a message saying that the 'Aurora' had left Hobart on her trip south to bring back the two parties from Antarctica, but no mention of picking us up on the return journey was made.

During the evening of the 26th, we got a message saying that the 'Aurora' had left Hobart on her trip south to bring back the two teams from Antarctica, but there was no mention of picking us up on the way back.

The King penguins and "night birds" had laid by this time, and Hamilton added more eggs to his collection. He found for the first time a colony of mutton birds near the south end. He also came upon a mollymawk rookery on the south-western point of the island, and managed to take one of the birds by hand.

The King penguins and "night birds" had laid their eggs by then, and Hamilton added more to his collection. He discovered a colony of mutton birds for the first time near the southern end. He also found a mollymawk rookery on the southwestern tip of the island and managed to catch one of the birds by hand.

Blake and he had an accident in the dinghy on the 29th, fortunately attended by no serious results. They had gone from Lusitania Bay to the south end, and, while attempting to land through the surf, the boat struck a rock and capsized, throwing them into the water. They had many things in the boat but lost only two billies, two pannikins, a sounding line and Hamilton's hat, knife and pipe. Their blankets floated ashore in a few minutes, and the oars came floating in later in the day. After the capsize Hamilton managed to reach the boat and turn her over, and Blake made for a kelp-hung rock, but, after pulling himself up on to it, was immediately washed off and had to swim ashore. The boat was afterwards found to be stove-in in two places, though the breaks were easily patched up subsequently.

Blake and he had an accident in the dinghy on the 29th, but luckily, there were no serious consequences. They had traveled from Lusitania Bay to the south end, and while trying to land through the surf, the boat hit a rock and capsized, throwing them into the water. They had a lot of gear in the boat but only lost two billies, two pannikins, a sounding line, and Hamilton's hat, knife, and pipe. Their blankets floated ashore within a few minutes, and the oars came in later that day. After the capsize, Hamilton managed to get to the boat and turned it over, while Blake headed for a kelp-covered rock, but as soon as he pulled himself up onto it, he was instantly washed off and had to swim to shore. The boat was later found to be damaged in two spots, but the breaks were easy to fix afterwards.

New Year's Eve came and with keen anticipations we welcomed the advent of 1913.

New Year's Eve arrived, and with eager anticipation, we welcomed the start of 1913.





CHAPTER XXVII THROUGH ANOTHER YEAR

by G. F. Ainsworth

We had now thrown a year behind and the work we set out to accomplish was almost finished; so it was with pleasurable feelings that we took up the burden of completion, looking forward to the arrival of April 1913 which should bring us final relief and the prospects of civilisation. I shall deal with the first three months of the year as one period, since almost all the field-work, except photography, had been done, and, after the return of Blake and Hamilton from Lusitania Bay on January 8, our life was one of routine; much time being devoted to packing and labelling specimens in anticipation of departure.

We had now completed a year, and the work we set out to do was almost finished; so we happily took on the final tasks, eagerly looking forward to April 1913, which would bring us much-needed relief and the promise of civilization. I will discuss the first three months of the year as one period, since almost all the fieldwork, except for photography, had been completed, and after Blake and Hamilton returned from Lusitania Bay on January 8, our life became routine, with a lot of time spent packing and labeling specimens in preparation for our departure.

The first business of the year was to overhaul the wireless station, and on the 6th, Sawyer, Sandell and I spent the day laying in a supply of benzine from Aerial Cove, changing worn ropes, tightening stay-wires, straightening the southern masts and finally hauling the aerial taut. These duties necessitated much use of the "handy billy," and one has but to form an acquaintance with this desirable "person" to thoroughly appreciate his value.

The first task of the year was to upgrade the wireless station, and on the 6th, Sawyer, Sandell, and I spent the day getting a supply of benzene from Aerial Cove, replacing worn ropes, tightening stay wires, straightening the southern masts, and finally tightening the aerial. These tasks required a lot of use of the "handy billy," and once you get to know this handy "guy," you really appreciate what he can do.

Blake and Hamilton returned on January 8 and reported that their work was finished at the southern end. Thenceforth they intended to devote their time to finishing what remained to be done at the northern end and in adding to their collections. Blake, for instance, resolved to finish his chart of the island, and, if time permitted, to make a topographical survey of the locality, as it was of great geological interest. Hamilton made the discovery that a number of bird specimens he had packed away were mildewed, and as a result he was compelled to overhaul the whole lot and attend to them. He found another colony of mutton birds on North Head, the existence of which was quite unexpected till he dug one out of a burrow thought to contain "night-birds."

Blake and Hamilton returned on January 8 and reported that they had finished their work at the southern end. From that point on, they planned to focus on completing the tasks at the northern end and expanding their collections. Blake, for example, decided to finish his map of the island and, if time allowed, conduct a topographical survey of the area since it was of significant geological interest. Hamilton discovered that several bird specimens he had packed away were moldy, so he had to go through everything and take care of them. He also found another colony of mutton birds on North Head, which was quite unexpected until he dug one out of a burrow he thought contained "night-birds."

About the middle of January I endeavoured to do a little meteorological work with the aid of some box-kites manufactured by Sandell. But though a number of them were induced to fly, we had no success in getting them up with the instruments attached. They all had a habit of suddenly losing equilibrium and then indulging in a series of rapid dives and plunges which usually ended in total wreckage.

About mid-January, I tried to do some weather observations using a few box kites made by Sandell. Although several of them managed to fly, we didn't succeed in getting them airborne with the instruments attached. They all tended to suddenly lose balance and then went into a series of quick dives and drops that usually resulted in complete destruction.

The 'Rachel Cohen' again visited the island on January 26, but this time she anchored off "The Nuggets," whither the sealers had gone to live during the penguin season. We could see the ship lying about a mile offshore, and walked down to get our mails and anything else she had brought along for us. I received a letter from the Secretary of the Expedition saying that he had made arrangements for us to return by the 'Rachel Cohen' early in April, and the news caused a little excitement, being the only definite information we had had concerning relief.

The 'Rachel Cohen' visited the island again on January 26, but this time she anchored off "The Nuggets," where the sealers had gone to stay during the penguin season. We could see the ship about a mile offshore, so we walked down to collect our mail and anything else she had brought for us. I received a letter from the Secretary of the Expedition saying he had arranged for us to return on the 'Rachel Cohen' early in April, and the news created a bit of excitement, as it was the only definite information we had about getting relief.

The end of the first month found Blake and Hamilton both very busy in making suitable boxes for specimens. Many of the larger birds could not be packed in ordinary cases, so Hamilton had to make specially large ones to accommodate them, and Blake's rock specimens being very heavy, extra strong boxes had to be made, always keeping in view the fact that each was to weigh not more than eighty pounds, so as to ensure convenient handling.

The end of the first month found Blake and Hamilton both very busy creating appropriate boxes for specimens. Many of the larger birds couldn't be packed in standard cases, so Hamilton had to build extra-large ones to fit them. Additionally, because Blake's rock specimens were quite heavy, they had to make extra-strong boxes, always keeping in mind that each one should not weigh more than eighty pounds to ensure easy handling.

After a silence of about four months, we again heard Adelie Land on February 3, but the same old trouble existed, that is, they could not hear us. Sawyer called them again and again, getting no reply, but we reckoned that conditions would improve in a few weeks, as the hours of darkness increased.

After about four months of silence, we finally heard from Adelie Land on February 3, but the same old problem was still there—they couldn't hear us. Sawyer kept calling them over and over, but got no response. However, we figured that things would get better in a few weeks as the nights got longer.

Hamilton and I made a trip to the hill-tops on the 4th for the purpose of taking a series of plant and earth temperatures which were of interest biologically, and while there I took the opportunity of obtaining temperatures in all the lakes we saw. Hamilton also took some panoramic photographs from the various eminences and all of them turned out well.

Hamilton and I went up to the hilltops on the 4th to take a series of plant and soil temperature readings that were of biological interest. While we were there, I also took the chance to record temperatures in all the lakes we saw. Hamilton took some panoramic photos from various high points, and they all came out great.

During the evening Adelie Land sent out a message saying that Dr. Mawson had not yet returned to the Base from his sledging trip and Sawyer received it without difficulty, but though he "pounded away" in return for a considerable time, he was not heard, as no reply or acknowledgment was made.

During the evening, Adelie Land sent a message saying that Dr. Mawson had not returned to the Base from his sledding trip. Sawyer received it easily, but even though he "pounded away" in response for quite a while, he received no reply or acknowledgment.

The 'Rachel Cohen' remained till the 5th, when a northerly gale arose and drove her away. As she had a good cargo of oil on board no one expected her to return. We had sent our mail on board several days previously as experience had shown us that the sailing date of ships visiting the island was very uncertain.

The 'Rachel Cohen' stayed until the 5th, when a strong north wind came up and forced her to leave. Since she had a solid cargo of oil on board, no one thought she would come back. We had sent our mail on board several days earlier because experience had taught us that the sailing dates of ships coming to the island were very unpredictable.

Sandell met with a slight though painful accident on the 7th. He was starting the engine, when it "backfired" and the handle flying off with great force struck him on the face, inflicting a couple of nasty cuts, loosening several teeth, and lacerating the inside of his cheek. A black eye appeared in a day or two and his face swelled considerably, but nothing serious supervened. In a few days the swelling had subsided and any anxiety we felt was at an end.

Sandell had a minor but painful accident on the 7th. He was starting the engine when it backfired, and the handle flew off with considerable force, hitting him in the face. It caused a couple of nasty cuts, loosened several teeth, and cut the inside of his cheek. A black eye showed up a day or two later, and his face swelled up quite a bit, but nothing serious happened afterward. After a few days, the swelling went down, and our worries were over.

We now had only two sheep left, and on the 8th Blake and I went to kill one. Mac accompanied us. Seeing the sheep running away, she immediately set off after them, notwithstanding our threats, yells and curses. They disappeared over a spur, but shortly afterwards Mac returned, and, being severely thrashed, immediately left for home. We looked for the sheep during the rest of the day but could find no trace of them, and though we searched for many days it was not till five weeks had elapsed that we discovered them on a small "landing" about half-way down the face of the cliff. They had apparently rushed over the edge and, rolling down, had finally come to a stop on the ledge where they were found later, alive and well.

We only had two sheep left, and on the 8th, Blake and I went to catch one. Mac came with us. When she saw the sheep running away, she immediately chased after them, ignoring our threats, shouts, and curses. They disappeared over a slope, but a short while later, Mac came back, and after getting a serious scolding, she headed home. We looked for the sheep for the rest of the day but couldn't find any sign of them. Even though we searched for many days, it wasn't until five weeks later that we found them on a small ledge about halfway down the cliff. They had apparently jumped over the edge, rolled down, and ended up on the ledge where we eventually found them, alive and well.

On the 8th Adelie Land was heard by us calling the 'Aurora' to return at once and pick up the rest of the party, stating also that Lieutenant Ninnis and Dr. Mertz were dead. All of us were shocked at the grievous intelligence and every effort was made by Sawyer to call up Adelie Land, but without success.

On the 8th, we heard from Adelie Land urging the 'Aurora' to come back immediately and pick up the remaining members of the team, also mentioning that Lieutenant Ninnis and Dr. Mertz had died. We were all stunned by this tragic news, and Sawyer did everything possible to get in touch with Adelie Land, but it was unsuccessful.

On the following day we received news from Australia of the disaster to Captain Scott's party.

On the next day, we got news from Australia about the disaster that struck Captain Scott's party.

Blake, who was now geologizing and doing topographical work, discovered several lignite seams in the hills on the east coast; he had finished his chart of the island. The mainland is simply a range of mountains which have been at some remote period partly submerged. The land meets the sea in steep cliffs and bold headlands, whose general height is from five hundred to seven hundred feet, with many peaks ranging from nine hundred and fifty to one thousand four hundred and twenty feet, the latter being the height of Mount Hamilton, which rears up just at the back of Lusitania Bay. Evidence of extreme glaciation is everywhere apparent, and numerous tarns and lakes are scattered amongst the hills, the tops of which are barren, wind-swept and weather-worn. The hill sides are deeply scored by ravines, down which tumble small streams, forming cascades at intervals on their hurried journey towards the ocean. Some of these streams do not reach the sea immediately, but disappear in the loose shingly beaches of peaty swamps. The west coast is particularly rugged, and throughout its length is strewn wreckage of various kinds, some of which is now one hundred yards from the water's edge. Very few stretches of what may be called "beach" occur on the island; the foreshores consisting for the most part of huge water-worn boulders or loose gravel and shingle, across which progress is slow and difficult.

Blake, who was now studying geology and doing topographical work, discovered several lignite seams in the hills on the east coast; he had completed his chart of the island. The mainland is essentially a mountain range that was partly submerged at some distant time. The land meets the sea with steep cliffs and bold headlands, generally ranging from five hundred to seven hundred feet high, with many peaks between nine hundred fifty and one thousand four hundred twenty feet, the latter being the height of Mount Hamilton, which rises just behind Lusitania Bay. Signs of intense glaciation are visible everywhere, and many tarns and lakes dot the hills, whose summits are barren, wind-swept, and weathered. The hillsides are deeply etched by ravines, down which small streams tumble, creating cascades at intervals on their rush towards the ocean. Some of these streams do not reach the sea right away but vanish into the loose, shingly beaches of peaty swamps. The west coast is especially rugged, and throughout its length, there’s a mix of wreckage of various kinds, some now one hundred yards from the water's edge. Very few areas that could be called "beach" exist on the island; the foreshores mostly consist of large water-worn boulders or loose gravel and shingle, making progress slow and difficult.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

A Section across Macquarie Island through Mt. Elder

A section across Macquarie Island through Mt. Elder

Apparently the ground shelves very rapidly under the water, as a sounding of over two thousand fathoms was obtained by the 'Aurora' at a distance of eight miles from the east coast. The trend of the island is about eleven degrees from true north; the axis lying north by east to south by west. At either end are the island-groups already referred to, and their connexion with the mainland may be traced by the sunken rocks indicated by the breaking seas on the line of reef.

Apparently, the sea floor drops off quickly, as the 'Aurora' measured over two thousand fathoms just eight miles from the east coast. The island trends about eleven degrees from true north; its axis runs north by east to south by west. At each end are the island groups mentioned earlier, and their connection to the mainland can be traced by the submerged rocks shown by the breaking waves along the reef.

A very severe storm about the middle of the month worked up a tremendous sea, which was responsible for piling hundreds of tons of kelp on the shore, and for several days tangled masses could be seen drifting about like small floating islands.

A really severe storm around the middle of the month created huge waves, which led to hundreds of tons of kelp being washed up on the shore, and for several days, tangled clumps could be seen drifting around like small floating islands.

On the 20th an event occurred to which we had long looked forward, and which was now eagerly welcomed. Communication was established with the Main Base in Adelie Land by wireless! A message was received from Dr. Mawson confirming the deaths of Ninnis and Mertz, and stating that the 'Aurora' had not picked up the whole party. Sawyer had a short talk with Jeffryes, the Adelie Land operator, and among other scraps of news told him we were all well.

On the 20th, something we had been anticipating for a long time finally happened, and it was received with excitement. We established wireless communication with the Main Base in Adelie Land! We received a message from Dr. Mawson confirming that Ninnis and Mertz had died and mentioned that the 'Aurora' hadn’t picked up the entire party. Sawyer had a brief conversation with Jeffryes, the Adelie Land operator, and shared some news, telling him that we were all doing well.

Hamilton killed a sea elephant on the 22nd. The animal was a little over seventeen feet long and thirteen and a half feet in girth just at the back of the flippers, while the total weight was more than four tons. It took Hamilton about a day to complete the skinning, and, during the process, the huge brute had to be twice turned over, but such is the value of the nautical handy-billy that two men managed it rather easily. When the skin had been removed, five of us dragged it to the sealers' blubber-shed, where it was salted, spread out, and left to cure.

Hamilton killed a sea elephant on the 22nd. The animal was just over seventeen feet long and thirteen and a half feet in girth right behind the flippers, with a total weight of over four tons. It took Hamilton about a day to finish skinning it, and during that time, the massive animal had to be flipped over twice, but thanks to the nautical handy-billy, two men handled it quite easily. Once the skin was off, five of us dragged it to the sealers' blubber shed, where it was salted, laid out, and left to cure.

We had communication with Adelie Land again on the 26th, and messages were sent and received by both stations. Dr. Mawson wirelessed to the effect that the 'Aurora' would, after picking up Wild's party, make an attempt to return to Adelie Land if conditions were at all favourable.

We communicated with Adelie Land again on the 26th, and both stations sent and received messages. Dr. Mawson radioed that the 'Aurora' would, after picking up Wild's team, try to return to Adelie Land if the conditions were favorable.

Finding that provisions were running rather short on the last day of February, we reduced ourselves to an allowance of one pound of sugar per week each, which was weighed out every Thursday. Altogether there were only forty-five pounds remaining. Thenceforth it was the custom for each to bring his sugar-tin to the table every meal. The arrangement had its drawbacks, inasmuch as no sugar was available for cooking unless a levy were made. Thus puddings became rareties, because most of us preferred to use the sugar in tea or coffee.

Finding that supplies were getting low on the last day of February, we limited ourselves to one pound of sugar per week each, which was weighed out every Thursday. Overall, there were only forty-five pounds left. From then on, it was the routine for everyone to bring their sugar tin to the table at every meal. This system had its downsides, since no sugar was available for cooking unless a portion was taken. As a result, puddings became rare because most of us preferred to use the sugar in tea or coffee.

March came blustering in, accompanied by a sixty-four-mile gale which did damage to the extent of blowing down our annexe, tearing the tarpaulin off the stores at the back and ripping the spouting off the Shack. A high sea arose and the conformation of the beach on the north-western side of the isthmus was completely changed. Numbers of sea elephants' tusks and bones were revealed, which had remained buried in the shingle probably for many years, and heaps of kelp were piled up where before there had been clean, stony beach. Kelp is a very tough weed, but after being washed up and exposed to the air for a few days, begins to decay, giving forth a most disagreeable smell.

March arrived with a strong wind, bringing a sixty-four-mile gale that caused significant damage by blowing down our annex, tearing the tarpaulin off the supplies at the back, and ripping the spouting off the Shack. High waves formed, and the shape of the beach on the northwestern side of the isthmus was completely altered. Many sea elephant tusks and bones were uncovered, having been buried in the gravel for probably many years, and piles of kelp were heaped up where there used to be a clean, rocky beach. Kelp is a really tough weed, but after being washed ashore and exposed to the air for a few days, it starts to decay, producing a very unpleasant smell.

At this time we caught numerous small fish amongst the rocks at the water's edge with a hand line about four feet long. It was simply a matter of dropping in the line, watching the victim trifle with destiny and hauling him in at the precise moment.

At this time, we caught a lot of small fish among the rocks at the water's edge using a hand line that was about four feet long. It was just a matter of dropping in the line, watching the fish play with their fate, and pulling them in at the right moment.

Wireless business was now being done nightly with Adelie Land, and on the 7th I received a message from Dr. Mawson saying that the party would in all probability be down there for another season, and stating the necessity for keeping Macquarie Island station going till the end of the year. This message I read out to the men, and gave them a week in which to view the matter. The alternatives were to return in April or to remain till the end of the year.

Wireless business was now happening every night with Adelie Land, and on the 7th, I got a message from Dr. Mawson saying that the team would likely be down there for another season, and emphasizing the need to keep the Macquarie Island station running until the end of the year. I read this message to the guys and gave them a week to think it over. The options were to return in April or to stay until the end of the year.

I went through the whole of the stores on the 10th, and found that the only commodities upon which we would have to draw sparingly were milk, sugar, kerosene, meats and coal. The flour would last till May, but the butter allowance would have to be reduced to three pounds per week.

I checked all the stores on the 10th and found that the only items we need to use carefully are milk, sugar, kerosene, meat, and coal. The flour will last until May, but we’ll need to cut the butter allowance to three pounds a week.

It was on the 12th that we found the lost sheep, but as we had some wekas, sufficient to last us for several days, I did not kill one till the 15th. On that day four of us went down towards the ledge where they were standing, and shot one, which immediately toppled off and rolled down some distance into the tussock, the other one leaping after it without hesitation. While Blake and Hamilton skinned the dead sheep, Sandell and I caught the other and tethered it at the bottom of the hill amongst a patch of Maori cabbage, as we thought it would probably get lost if left to roam loose. However, on going to the spot next day, the sheep was nearly dead, having got tangled up in the rope. So we let it go free, only to lose the animal a day or two later, for it fell into a bog and perished.

It was on the 12th that we found the lost sheep, but since we had enough wekas to last us several days, I didn’t kill one until the 15th. On that day, four of us went down to the ledge where they were standing and shot one, which instantly toppled over and rolled down into the tussock, with the other one jumping after it without hesitation. While Blake and Hamilton skinned the dead sheep, Sandell and I caught the other and tied it up at the bottom of the hill among some Maori cabbage, thinking it would probably get lost if left to wander freely. However, when we returned to that spot the next day, the sheep was nearly dead, having gotten tangled in the rope. So we set it free, only to lose it a day or two later when it fell into a bog and died.

On March 22 a lunar eclipse occurred, contact lasting a little over three hours from 9.45 P.M. till within a few minutes of 1 A.M. on the 23rd. The period of total eclipse was quite a lengthy one, and during the time it lasted the darkness was intense. Cloud interfered for a while with our observations in the total stage. No coronal effect was noted, though a pulsating nebulous area appeared in front of the moon just before contact.

On March 22, a lunar eclipse took place, lasting just over three hours from 9:45 P.M. until a few minutes before 1 A.M. on the 23rd. The total eclipse phase was quite long, and during that time, the darkness was really intense. Clouds obstructed our observations for a bit during the total stage. No coronal effect was observed, although a pulsating, hazy area appeared in front of the moon just before contact.

A message came on the 27th saying that the 'Rachel Cohen' was sailing for Macquarie Island on May 2, and would bring supplies as well as take back the men who wished to be relieved, and this was forwarded in turn to Dr. Mawson.

A message arrived on the 27th stating that the 'Rachel Cohen' was set to sail for Macquarie Island on May 2, bringing supplies and taking back the men who wanted to be relieved. This information was then passed on to Dr. Mawson.

He replied, saying that the 'Aurora' would pick us up about the middle of November and convey us to Antarctica, thence returning to Australia; but if any member wished to return by the 'Rachel Cohen' he could do so, though notification would have to be given, in order to allow of substitutes being appointed. All the members of the party elected to stay, and I asked each man to give an outline of the work he intended to pursue during the extended period.

He replied that the 'Aurora' would pick us up around mid-November and take us to Antarctica, then return to Australia; however, if any member wanted to go back on the 'Rachel Cohen,' they could do so, but they would need to notify us so substitutes could be arranged. Everyone in the group chose to stay, and I asked each person to outline the work they planned to focus on during the extended period.

During March strong winds were recorded on fourteen days, reaching gale-force on six occasions. The gale at the beginning of the month was the strongest we had experienced, the velocity at 5.40 A.M. on the 1st reaching sixty-four miles per hour. Precipitation occurred on twenty-six days and the average amount of cloud was 85 per cent. A bright auroral display took place on the 6th, lasting from 11.20 till 11.45 P.M. It assumed the usual arch-form stretching from the south-east to south-west, and streamers and shafts of light could be observed pulsating upwards towards the zenith.

During March, strong winds were recorded on fourteen days, hitting gale-force on six occasions. The gale at the start of the month was the strongest we had experienced, with a speed of sixty-four miles per hour recorded at 5:40 A.M. on the 1st. Rain fell on twenty-six days, and the average cloud cover was 85 percent. A bright aurora occurred on the 6th, lasting from 11:20 to 11:45 P.M. It formed the usual arch shape stretching from the southeast to the southwest, with streamers and beams of light seen pulsing upward toward the zenith.

We now started on what might be called the second stage of our existence on the island. In the preceding pages I have endeavoured to give some idea of what happened during what was to have been our full period; but unforeseen circumstances compelled us to extend our stay for eight months more, until the 'Aurora' came to relieve us in November. As the routine was similar in a good many respects to that which we had just gone through, I shall now refer to only the more salient features of our life.

We now began what could be considered the second phase of our time on the island. In the previous sections, I tried to provide an overview of what occurred during what was supposed to be our complete period; however, unexpected situations forced us to prolong our stay for another eight months until the 'Aurora' arrived to take us back in November. Because the daily routine was quite similar in many ways to what we had just experienced, I will now focus on only the most significant aspects of our life.

The loyalty of my fellows was undoubted, and though any of them could have returned if he had felt so inclined, I am proud to say that they all decided to see it through. When one has looked forward hopefully to better social conditions, more comfortable surroundings and reunion with friends, it gives him a slight shock to find that the door has been slammed, so to speak, for another twelve months. Nevertheless, we all found that a strain of philosophy smoothed out the rough realities, and in a short time were facing the situation with composure, if not actual contentment.

The loyalty of my friends was unquestionable, and even though any of them could have left if they wanted to, I'm proud to say they all chose to stick it out. When you've been looking forward to better social conditions, more comfortable surroundings, and reuniting with friends, it’s a bit of a jolt to realize that the door has effectively been shut for another year. Still, we all discovered that a bit of a philosophical perspective helped ease the harsh realities, and before long, we were facing the situation with calm, if not complete satisfaction.

We decided now to effect a few improvements round about our abode, and all set to work carrying gravel from the beach to put down in front of the Shack, installing a sink-system to carry any waste water, fixing the leaking roof and finally closing up the space between the lining and the wall to keep out the rats.

We decided to make some improvements around our home, so we all got to work carrying gravel from the beach to lay down in front of the Shack, installing a sink system to manage the waste water, fixing the leaking roof, and finally sealing up the gap between the lining and the wall to keep out the rats.

We expected the 'Rachel Cohen' to leave Hobart with our stores on May 2, and reckoned that the voyage would occupy two weeks. Thus, it would be six weeks before she arrived. I was therefore compelled on the 10th to reduce the sugar allowance to half a pound per week. We were now taking it in turns to go once a week and get some wekas, and it was always possible to secure about a dozen, which provided sufficient meat for three dinners. Breakfast consisted generally of fish, which we caught, or sea elephant in some form, whilst we had tinned fish for lunch.

We expected the 'Rachel Cohen' to leave Hobart with our supplies on May 2, and thought the voyage would take about two weeks. So, she would arrive in six weeks. Because of this, I had to cut the sugar allowance to half a pound per week on the 10th. We were now taking turns going out once a week to catch some wekas, and we could usually get about a dozen, which was enough meat for three dinners. Breakfast usually consisted of fish that we caught or sea elephant in some form, while we had tinned fish for lunch.

Sandell installed a telephone service between the Shack and the wireless station about the middle of April, the parts all being made by himself; and it was certainly an ingenious and valuable contrivance. I, in particular, learned to appreciate the convenience of it as time went on. The buzzer was fixed on the wall close to the head of my bunk and I could be called any time during the night from the wireless station, thus rendering it possible to reply to communications without loss of time. Further, during the winter nights, when auroral observations had to be made, I could retire if nothing showed during the early part of the night, leaving it to Sandell, who worked till 2 or 3 A.M. to call me if any manifestation occurred.

Sandell set up a phone line between the Shack and the wireless station around mid-April, making all the parts himself. It was definitely an clever and useful device. I especially came to appreciate how convenient it was as time went on. The buzzer was mounted on the wall near my bunk, so I could be contacted at any hour during the night from the wireless station, allowing me to respond to messages without delay. Additionally, during the winter nights when we needed to make auroral observations, I could go to bed if nothing was happening early on, trusting Sandell, who worked until 2 or 3 A.M., to call me if something occurred.

We had heavy gales from the 12th to the 17th inclusive, the force of the wind during the period frequently exceeding fifty miles per hour, and, on the first-mentioned date, the barometer fell to 27.8 inches. The usual terrific seas accompanied the outburst.

We had strong winds from the 12th to the 17th, with speeds often over fifty miles per hour. On the first day mentioned, the barometer dropped to 27.8 inches. The usual huge waves came with this storm.

Finding that there were only eight blocks of coal left, I reduced the weekly allowance to one. We had a good supply of tapioca, but neither rice nor sago, and as the sealers had some of the latter two, but none of the former, we made an exchange to the extent of twelve pounds of tapioca for eight pounds of rice and some sago. Only fifteen pounds of butter remained on the 20th, and I divided this equally, as it was now one of the luxuries, and each man could use his own discretion in eating it. As it was nearing the end of April, and no further word concerning the movements of the 'Rachel Cohen' had been received, I wirelessed asking to be immediately advised of the exact date of the vessel's departure. A reply came that the ship would definitely reach us within two months. I answered, saying we could wait two months, but certainly no longer.

Finding that there were only eight blocks of coal left, I cut the weekly allowance to one. We had a good supply of tapioca, but we were out of rice and sago. The sealers had some of those two, but none of the tapioca, so we made a trade: twelve pounds of tapioca for eight pounds of rice and some sago. By the 20th, we had only fifteen pounds of butter left, and I divided it equally, as it had become a luxury, allowing each man to use his own discretion in how to eat it. As we were approaching the end of April and hadn't received any updates about the movements of the 'Rachel Cohen,' I sent a wireless message asking to be informed of the exact date the vessel would depart. A response came back saying the ship would definitely reach us within two months. I replied that we could wait two months, but certainly no longer.

With a view to varying the menu a little, Blake and I took Mac up on the hills on April 26 to get some rabbits and, after tramping for about six hours, we returned with seven. In our wanderings we visited the penguin rookeries at "The Nuggets," and one solitary bird sat in the centre of the vast area which had so lately been a scene of much noise and contention.

To mix up the menu a bit, Blake and I took Mac up into the hills on April 26 to hunt for some rabbits. After walking around for about six hours, we came back with seven. During our trek, we checked out the penguin rookeries at "The Nuggets," where one lonely bird was sitting in the middle of the vast space that had recently been filled with noise and activity.

On May 1 I took an inventory of the stores and found that they would last for two months if economically used. Of course, I placed confidence in the statement that the 'Rachel Cohen' would reach the island within that time.

On May 1, I checked the supplies and found they would last for two months if used carefully. Of course, I trusted the statement that the 'Rachel Cohen' would arrive on the island during that time.

With the coming of May wintry conditions set in, and at the end of the first week the migrants had deserted our uninviting island. Life with us went on much the same as usual, but the weather was rather more severe than that during the previous year, and we were confined to the Shack a good deal.

With the arrival of May, wintery weather came in, and by the end of the first week, the migrants had left our unappealing island. Life with us continued pretty much as usual, but the weather was harsher than the previous year, and we spent a lot of time stuck in the Shack.

The sealers who were still on the island had shifted back to the Hut at the north end so that they were very close to us and frequently came over with their dog in the evenings to have a yarn. The majority of them were men who had "knocked about" the world and had known many rough, adventurous years. One of them in particular was rather fluent, and we were often entertained from his endless repertoire of stories.

The sealers who were still on the island had moved back to the Hut at the north end, so they were really close to us and often came over with their dog in the evenings to chat. Most of them were guys who had traveled around the world and had experienced many tough, adventurous years. One of them, in particular, was quite talkative, and we were often entertained by his endless collection of stories.

On the 23rd, finding that there were seventy-seven and a half pounds of flour remaining, and ascertaining that the sealers could let us have twenty-five pounds, if we ran short, I increased the allowance for bread to twelve and a half pounds per week, and this, when made up, gave each man two and three-quarter pounds of bread. Our supply of oatmeal was very low, but in order to make it last we now started using a mixture of oatmeal and sago for breakfast; of course, without any milk or sugar.

On the 23rd, I found that we had seventy-seven and a half pounds of flour left, and I confirmed that the sealers could provide us with twenty-five pounds if we needed more. I raised the bread allowance to twelve and a half pounds per week, which meant each man would get two and three-quarter pounds of bread. Our oatmeal supply was really low, so to make it last, we started mixing oatmeal with sago for breakfast, of course without any milk or sugar.

Just about this time Mac gave birth to six pups and could not help us in obtaining food. She had done valuable service in this connexion, and the loss in the foraging strength of the party was severely felt for several weeks. She was particularly deadly in hunting rabbits and wekas, and though the first-named were very scarce within a few miles of the Shack, she always managed to unearth one or two somewhere. Hut-slippers were made out of the rabbit skins and they were found to be a great boon, one being able to sit down for a while without his feet "going."

Just around this time, Mac gave birth to six pups and couldn’t help us find food. She had been really valuable in this regard, and the loss of her foraging ability was felt severely for several weeks. She was particularly good at hunting rabbits and wekas, and although rabbits were pretty hard to find within a few miles of the Shack, she always managed to dig up one or two somewhere. We made hut-slippers from the rabbit skins, and they turned out to be a huge help, allowing us to sit down for a while without our feet going numb.

June arrived and with it much rough, cold weather. A boat was expected to come to our relief, at the very latest, by the 30th. We had a very chilly period during the middle of the month, and it was only by hand-feeding the "jacket" of the wireless motor that any work could be done by the station, as the tank outside was almost frozen solid.

June came, bringing cold and harsh weather. A boat was expected to arrive and help us by the 30th at the latest. We had a particularly chilly stretch in the middle of the month, and the station could only function by hand-feeding the “jacket” of the wireless motor since the tank outside was nearly frozen solid.

The tide-gauge clock broke down towards the end of the month, and though I tried for days to get it going I was not successful. One of the springs had rusted very badly as a result of the frequent "duckings" the clock had experienced, and had become practically useless.

The tide-gauge clock stopped working near the end of the month, and even though I spent days trying to fix it, I wasn’t successful. One of the springs had rusted badly due to the constant “duckings” the clock had gone through, and it had become almost useless.

We had ascertained that the 'Rachel Cohen' was still in Hobart, so on the 23rd I wirelessed asking when the boat was to sail. The reply came that the 'Rachel Cohen' was leaving Hobart on Thursday, June 26.

We had confirmed that the 'Rachel Cohen' was still in Hobart, so on the 23rd I sent a wireless message asking when the boat would sail. The response was that the 'Rachel Cohen' was leaving Hobart on Thursday, June 26.

Our supply of kerosene oil was exhausted by the end of the month, despite the fact that the rule of "lights out at 10 P.M." had been observed for some time. Thus we were obliged to use sea elephant oil in slush lamps. At first we simply filled a tin with the oil and passed a rag through a cork floating on the top, but a little ingenuity soon resulted in the production of a lamp with three burners and a handle. This was made by Sandell out of an old tea-pot and one, two or three burners could be lit as occasion demanded. During meal times the whole three burners were used, but, as the oil smoked and smelt somewhat, we generally blew out two as soon as the meal was finished. This was the "general" lamp, but each man had, as well, one of his own invention. Mine was scornfully referred to as the "house-boat," since it consisted of a jam tin, which held the oil, standing in a herring tin which caught the overflow.

Our supply of kerosene was gone by the end of the month, even though we had been following the "lights out at 10 P.M." rule for a while. So, we had to use sea elephant oil in our slush lamps. At first, we just filled a tin with the oil and used a rag through a cork floating on top, but with a bit of creativity, we quickly made a lamp with three burners and a handle. Sandell created this from an old tea pot, and we could light one, two, or all three burners as needed. During meal times, we used all three burners, but since the oil smoked and had a bit of an odor, we usually blew out two of them as soon as we finished eating. This was the "general" lamp, but everyone also had their own version. Mine was mockingly called the "house-boat," as it was just a jam tin holding the oil, sitting in a herring tin to catch any overflow.

At the end of June, Blake and I surveyed all the penguin rookeries round about "The Nuggets" and, allowing a bird to the square foot, found that there must have been about half a million birds in the area. The sealers kill birds from these rookeries to the number of about one hundred and thirty thousand yearly, so that it would seem reasonable to suppose that, despite this fact, there must be an annual increase of about one hundred thousand birds.

At the end of June, Blake and I checked out all the penguin colonies around "The Nuggets" and, estimating about one bird per square foot, found there were roughly half a million birds in the area. The sealers kill about one hundred thirty thousand birds from these colonies each year, so it seems reasonable to assume that, despite this, there's an annual increase of about one hundred thousand birds.

The end of the month arrived and, on making inquiries, we found that there was no news of the 'Rachel Cohen' having left Hobart. We had enough flour to last a fortnight, and could not get any from the sealers as they possessed only three weeks' supply themselves. However, on July 8, Bauer came across and offered to let us have some wheatmeal biscuits as they had a couple of hundredweights, so I readily accepted twenty pounds of them. We now had soup twice a day, and managed to make it fairly thick by adding sago and a few lentils. Cornflour and hot water flavoured with cocoa made a makeshift blanc-mange, and this, with sago and tapioca, constituted our efforts towards dessert.

The end of the month came, and when we asked around, we found out there was still no news of the 'Rachel Cohen' leaving Hobart. We had enough flour to last us two weeks, but we couldn't get any from the sealers since they only had a three-week supply for themselves. However, on July 8, Bauer came by and offered us some wheatmeal biscuits as they had a couple of hundredweights, so I gladly accepted twenty pounds of them. Now we had soup twice a day and managed to make it fairly thick by adding sago and a few lentils. Cornflour mixed with hot water and flavored with cocoa made a makeshift blanc-mange, and this, along with sago and tapioca, made up our attempts at dessert.

On the 12th I received a message stating that the 'Rachel Cohen' had sailed on July 7; news which was joyfully received. We expected her to appear in ten or twelve days.

On the 12th, I got a message saying that the 'Rachel Cohen' had set sail on July 7; news that was received with joy. We expected her to show up in ten to twelve days.

On the 18th we used the last ounce of flour in a small batch of bread, having fully expected the ship to arrive before we had finished it. Next day Bauer lent us ten pounds of oatmeal and showed us how to make oatmeal cakes. We tried some and they were a complete success, though they consisted largely of tapioca, and, according to the respective amounts used, should rather have been called tapioca cakes.

On the 18th, we used the last bit of flour to make a small batch of bread, fully expecting the ship to arrive before we finished it. The next day, Bauer lent us ten pounds of oatmeal and taught us how to make oatmeal cakes. We tried them, and they turned out great, even though they were mostly tapioca, and based on the amounts we used, they should have been called tapioca cakes instead.

When the 22nd arrived and no ship showed up, I went across to see what the sealers thought of the matter, and found that they all were of opinion that she had been blown away to the eastward of the island, and might take a considerable time to "make" back.

When the 22nd came and no ship appeared, I crossed over to see what the sealers thought about it and found that they all believed she had been blown off to the east side of the island and might take quite a while to "make" it back.

On this date we came to the end of our meats, which I had been dealing out in a very sparing manner, just to provide a change from sea elephant and weka. We had now to subsist upon what we managed to catch. There were still thirty-five tins of soup, of which only two tins a day were used, so that there was sufficient for a few weeks. But we found ourselves running short of some commodity each day, and after the 23rd reckoned to be without bread and biscuit.

On this date, we ran out of our meat supply, which I had been distributing very sparingly just to have a change from sea elephant and weka. Now we had to rely on what we could catch. There were still thirty-five cans of soup, of which we only used two cans a day, so there was enough to last a few weeks. However, we found ourselves short of some item every day, and after the 23rd, we figured we would be without bread and biscuits.

At this juncture many heavy blows were experienced, and on the 24th a fifty-mile gale accompanied by a tremendous sea beat down on us, giving the 'Rachel Cohen' a very poor chance of "making" the island. Our last tin of fruit was eaten; twelve tins having lasted us since March 31, and I also shared the remaining ten biscuits amongst the men on the 24th. We were short of bread, flour, biscuits, meats, fish, jam, sugar and milk, but had twenty tins of French beans, thirty tins of cornflour, some tapioca, and thirty tins of soup, as well as tea, coffee and cocoa in abundance. We had not been able to catch any fish for some days as the weather had been too rough, and, further, they appeared to leave the coasts during the very cold weather.

At this point, we faced many tough challenges, and on the 24th, a fifty-mile gale with huge waves hit us, making it very unlikely for the 'Rachel Cohen' to reach the island. We finished our last tin of fruit; twelve tins had lasted us since March 31, and I also split the remaining ten biscuits among the men on the 24th. We were low on bread, flour, biscuits, meat, fish, jam, sugar, and milk, but we had twenty tins of French beans, thirty tins of cornflour, some tapioca, and thirty tins of soup, along with plenty of tea, coffee, and cocoa. We hadn't been able to catch any fish for several days because the weather was too rough, and additionally, the fish seemed to leave the coasts during the very cold weather.

Sea elephants were very scarce, and we invariably had to walk some distance in order to get one; each man taking it in turn to go out with a companion and carry home enough meat for our requirements. We were now eating sea elephant meat three times a day (all the penguins having migrated) and our appetites were very keen. The routine work was carried on, though a great deal of time was occupied in getting food.

Sea elephants were really hard to find, so we always had to walk quite a distance to get one; each man took turns going out with a buddy to bring back enough meat for our needs. We were now eating sea elephant meat three times a day (since all the penguins had migrated) and our appetites were strong. The regular work continued, although a lot of time was spent on gathering food.

Bauer very generously offered to share his biscuits with us, but we fellows, while appreciating the spirit which prompted the offer, unanimously declined to accept them. We now concluded that something had happened to the ship, as at the end of July she had been twenty-four days out.

Bauer kindly offered to share his biscuits with us, but we guys, while appreciating the thought behind the offer, all decided to decline. We now figured that something had happened to the ship, as she had been out for twenty-four days by the end of July.

On August 3 we had a sixty-three-mile gale and between 1 and 2 A.M. the velocity of the wind frequently exceeded fifty miles per hour. Needless to say there was a mountainous sea running, and the Rachel Cohen, if she had been anywhere in the vicinity, would have had a perilous time.

On August 3, we experienced a sixty-three-mile gale, and between 1 and 2 A.M., the wind speed often topped fifty miles per hour. It goes without saying that the sea was extremely rough, and the Rachel Cohen, if she had been anywhere nearby, would have faced a dangerous situation.

A message came to me on August 6 from the Secretary of the Expedition, saying that the 'Rachel Cohen' had returned to New Zealand badly damaged, and that he was endeavouring to send us relief as soon as possible. I replied, telling him that our food-supply was done, but that otherwise we were all right and no uneasiness need be felt, though we wished to be relieved as soon as possible.

A message reached me on August 6 from the Secretary of the Expedition, saying that the 'Rachel Cohen' had come back to New Zealand badly damaged, and that he was trying to send us help as soon as he could. I responded, letting him know that our food supply was exhausted, but that otherwise we were okay and there was no need for worry, although we did want to be relieved as soon as possible.

Splendid news came along on the 9th to the effect that the New Zealand Government's steamer 'Tutanekai' would tranship our stores from the 'Rachel Cohen' on the 15th and sail direct for the island.

Great news arrived on the 9th that the New Zealand Government's steamer 'Tutanekai' would transfer our supplies from the 'Rachel Cohen' on the 15th and head straight for the island.

Sawyer now became ill and desired me to make arrangements for his return. I accordingly wired to the Secretary, who replied asking if we could manage without an operator. After consulting Sandell, I answered that Sandell and I together could manage to run the wireless station.

Sawyer got sick and asked me to arrange for his return. I then sent a message to the Secretary, who replied asking if we could handle things without an operator. After talking to Sandell, I responded that Sandell and I could manage the wireless station together.

Everybody now looked forward eagerly to the arrival of the 'Tutanekai', but things went on as before. We found ourselves with nothing but sea elephant meat and sago, with a pound-tin of French beans once a week and two ounces of oatmeal every morning.

Everybody was now eagerly anticipating the arrival of the 'Tutanekai', but life continued as usual. We were left with nothing but sea elephant meat and sago, a pound can of French beans once a week, and two ounces of oatmeal every morning.

We heard that the Tutanekai did not leave as expected on the 15th, but sailed on the afternoon of the 17th, and was coming straight to Macquarie Island. She was equipped with a wireless telegraphy outfit, which enabled us on the 18th to get in touch with her; the operator on board stating that they would reach us early on the morning of the 20th.

We heard that the Tutanekai didn’t leave as planned on the 15th, but departed on the afternoon of the 17th, heading directly to Macquarie Island. She had a wireless telegraph system, which allowed us to contact her on the 18th; the operator on board said they would arrive early on the morning of the 20th.

On the evening of the 19th we gave Sawyer a send-off dinner; surely the poorest thing of its kind, as far as eatables were concerned, that has ever been tendered to any one. The fare consisted of sea elephant's tongue "straight," after which a bottle of claret was cracked and we drank heartily to his future prosperity.

On the evening of the 19th, we threw Sawyer a farewell dinner; it was probably the most inadequate dinner ever served to someone. The food was just sea elephant's tongue "straight," and afterward, we opened a bottle of claret and toasted to his future success.

At 7.30 A.M. on the 20th the 'Tutanekai' was observed coming up the east coast, and as we had "elephanted" at 6 A.M. we were ready to face the day. I went across to the sealers' hut and accompanied Bauer in the launch to the ship, which lay at anchor about a mile from the shore. We scrambled on board, where I met Captain Bollons. He received me most courteously, and, after discussing several matters, suggested landing the stores straight away. I got into the launch to return to the shore, but the wind had freshened and was soon blowing a fresh gale. Still, Bauer thought we should have no difficulty and we pushed off from the ship. The engine of the launch failed after we had gone a few yards, the boat was blown rapidly down the coast, and we were eventually thrown out into the surf at "The Nuggets." The Captain, who witnessed our plight, sent his launch in pursuit of us, but its engines also failed. It now became necessary for the crew of the whale-boat to go to the assistance of the launch. However, they could do nothing against the wind, and, in the end, the ship herself got up anchor, gave the two boats a line and towed them back to the former anchorage. The work of unloading now commenced, though a fairly heavy surf was running. But the whaleboat of the 'Tutanekai' was so dexterously handled by the boatswain that most of our stores were landed during the day.

At 7:30 A.M. on the 20th, we saw the 'Tutanekai' coming up the east coast, and since we had started our day at 6 A.M., we were ready to tackle whatever came next. I headed over to the sealers' hut and joined Bauer in the launch to get to the ship, which was anchored about a mile from shore. We scrambled onboard, where I met Captain Bollons. He greeted me warmly, and after discussing a few things, suggested we unload the supplies right away. I got back into the launch to head to the shore, but the wind had picked up and soon turned into a strong gale. Still, Bauer felt we wouldn't have any issues and we pushed off from the ship. The launch's engine failed just after we had gone a few yards, the boat was quickly blown down the coast, and we ultimately ended up in the surf at "The Nuggets." The Captain, who saw us struggle, sent his launch after us, but its engine also failed. It became necessary for the crew of the whale-boat to help out the launch. However, they couldn’t make any headway against the wind, and eventually, the ship itself weighed anchor, gave both boats a line, and towed them back to their original spot. Unloading began now, despite a significant surf. Fortunately, the whale-boat from the 'Tutanekai' was skillfully operated by the boatswain, allowing most of our supplies to be brought ashore during the day.

Sawyer went on board the 'Tutanekai' in the afternoon, thus severing his connexion with the Expedition, after having been with us on the island since December 1911. On the following morning, some sheep, coal and flour were landed, and, with a whistled good-bye, the 'Tutanekai' started north on her visit to other islands.

Sawyer boarded the 'Tutanekai' in the afternoon, ending his connection with the Expedition after being with us on the island since December 1911. The next morning, some sheep, coal, and flour were unloaded, and with a whistled goodbye, the 'Tutanekai' headed north on her trip to other islands.

Our short period of stress was over and we all felt glad. From that time onwards we ate no more elephant meat "straight." A sheep was killed just as the 'Tutanekai' left, and we had roast mutton, scones, butter, jam, fruit and rice for tea. It was a rare treat.

Our brief time of stress was behind us, and we all felt relieved. From then on, we stopped eating elephant meat "straight." A sheep was slaughtered just as the 'Tutanekai' was leaving, and we had roast lamb, scones, butter, jam, fruit, and rice for tea. It was a special treat.

All the stores were now brought up from the landing-place, and as I had put up several extra shelves some weeks previously, plenty of room was found for all the perishable commodities inside the Shack.

All the supplies were now brought up from the dock, and since I had added several extra shelves a few weeks earlier, there was plenty of space inside the Shack for all the perishable goods.

The beginning of September found me fairly busy. In addition to the meteorological work, the results of which were always kept reduced and entered up, I had to work on Wireless Hill during the evening and make auroral observations on any night during which there was a display, attending to the stores and taking the week of cooking as it came along.

The start of September had me pretty busy. Besides the meteorological work, which was always organized and recorded, I had to work on Wireless Hill in the evenings and make auroral observations whenever there was a display, managing the supplies and handling the week’s cooking as it came.

Blake and Hamilton went down the island for several days on September 3, since they had some special observations to make in the vicinity of Sandy Bay.

Blake and Hamilton went to the island for a few days on September 3, since they had some specific observations to make near Sandy Bay.

The sea elephant season was now in progress, and many rookeries were well formed by the middle of the month. The skuas had returned, and on the 19th the advance-guard of the Royal penguins arrived. The gentoos had established themselves in their old "claims," and since the 12th we had been using their eggs for cooking.

The sea elephant season was now underway, and by the middle of the month, many rookeries were well established. The skuas had returned, and on the 19th, the first group of Royal penguins showed up. The gentoos had settled into their old spots, and since the 12th, we had been using their eggs for cooking.

Early in September time-signals were received from Melbourne, and these were transmitted through to Adelie Land. This practice was kept up throughout the month and in many cases the signals were acknowledged.

Early in September, time signals were received from Melbourne, and these were transmitted to Adelie Land. This practice continued throughout the month, and in many cases, the signals were acknowledged.

Blake and Hamilton returned to the Shack on the 24th, but left again on the 30th, as they had some more photographic work to do in the vicinity of Green Valley and Sandy Bay.

Blake and Hamilton came back to the Shack on the 24th, but left again on the 30th because they had more photography to do near Green Valley and Sandy Bay.

Blake made a special trip to Sandy Bay on October 30 to bring back some geological specimens and other things he had left there, but on reaching the spot found that the old hut had been burned to the ground, apparently only a few hours before, since it was still smouldering. Many articles were destroyed, among which were two sleeping-bags, a sextant, gun, blankets, photographic plates, bird specimens and articles of clothing. It was presumed that rats had originated the fire from wax matches which had been left lying on a small shelf.

Blake took a special trip to Sandy Bay on October 30 to collect some geological samples and other items he had left behind, but when he arrived, he found that the old hut had burned down, apparently just a few hours earlier, since it was still smoldering. Many items were lost, including two sleeping bags, a sextant, a gun, blankets, photographic plates, bird specimens, and clothing. It was believed that rats had started the fire by playing with wax matches that had been left on a small shelf.

On November 9 we heard that the 'Aurora' would leave Hobart on the 19th for Antarctica, picking us up on the way and landing three men on the island to continue the wireless and meteorological work.

On November 9, we learned that the 'Aurora' would depart from Hobart on the 19th for Antarctica, picking us up along the way and dropping off three men on the island to continue the wireless and meteorological work.

We sighted the 'Rachel Cohen' bearing down on the island on November 18, and at 5.15 P.M. she came to an anchorage in North-East Bay. She brought down the remainder of our coal and some salt for Hamilton for the preservation of specimens.

We saw the 'Rachel Cohen' approaching the island on November 18, and at 5:15 PM, she anchored in North-East Bay. She brought the rest of our coal and some salt for Hamilton to preserve specimens.

On the next night it was learned that the 'Aurora' had left Hobart on her way South, expecting to reach us about the 28th, as some sounding and dredging were being done en route.

On the following night, it was discovered that the 'Aurora' had departed from Hobart on her way south, expecting to arrive around the 28th, as some soundings and dredging were being conducted along the way.

Everybody now became very busy making preparations for departure. Time passed very quickly, and November 28 dawned fine and bright. The 'Rachel Cohen', which had been lying in the bay loading oil, had her full complement on board by 10 A.M., and shortly afterwards we trooped across to say good-bye to Bauer and the other sealers, who were all returning to Hobart. It was something of a coincidence that they took their departure on the very day our ship was to arrive. Their many acts of kindness towards us will ever be recalled by the members of the party, and we look upon our harmonious neighbourly association together with feelings of great pleasure.

Everyone got really busy preparing for departure. Time flew by, and November 28 arrived clear and bright. The 'Rachel Cohen', which had been in the bay loading oil, had all her crew on board by 10 A.M., and shortly after, we went over to say goodbye to Bauer and the other sealers, who were all heading back to Hobart. It was quite a coincidence that they were leaving on the exact day our ship was arriving. We will always remember their many acts of kindness, and we look back on our friendly relationship with great pleasure.

A keen look-out was then kept for signs of our own ship, but it was not until 8 P.M. that Blake, who was up on the hill side, called out, "Here she comes," and we climbed up to take in the goodly sight. Just visible, away in the north-west, there was a line of thin smoke, and in about half an hour the 'Aurora' dropped anchor in Hasselborough Bay.

A close watch was then maintained for any signs of our ship, but it wasn't until 8 PM that Blake, who was up on the hillside, shouted, "Here she comes," and we climbed up to see the wonderful sight. Just barely visible in the northwest, there was a thin line of smoke, and in about half an hour, the 'Aurora' dropped anchor in Hasselborough Bay.





CHAPTER XXVIII THE HOMEWARD CRUISE

    We bring no store of ingots,
    Of spice or precious stones;
    But what we have we gathered
    With sweat and aching bones.
                          KIPLING.
    We don’t carry a stash of gold bars,  
    spices, or precious gems;  
    But what we have we’ve earned  
    through hard work and sore muscles.  
                          KIPLING.

As we sat in the wardroom of the 'Aurora' exchanging the news of months long gone by, we heard from Captain Davis the story of his fair-weather trip from Hobart. The ship had left Australian waters on November 19, and, from the outset, the weather was quite ideal. Nothing of note occurred on the run to Macquarie Island, where a party of three men were landed and Ainsworth and his loyal comrades picked up. The former party, sent by the Australian Government, were to maintain wireless communication with Hobart and to send meteorological reports to the Commonwealth Weather Bureau. A week was spent at the island and all the collections were embarked, while Correll was enabled to secure some good colour photographs and Hurley to make valuable additions to his cinematograph film.

As we sat in the wardroom of the 'Aurora' sharing news from months past, Captain Davis told us about his pleasant trip from Hobart. The ship had left Australian waters on November 19, and from the very start, the weather was perfect. Nothing significant happened on the journey to Macquarie Island, where a group of three men was disembarked, and Ainsworth and his loyal crew were picked up. The former group, sent by the Australian Government, was there to maintain wireless communication with Hobart and to send weather reports to the Commonwealth Weather Bureau. They spent a week on the island, and all collections were loaded onto the ship, while Correll managed to take some good color photos and Hurley made valuable additions to his film.

The 'Aurora' had passed through the "fifties" without meeting the usual gales, sighting the first ice in latitude 63 degrees 33' S., longitude 150 degrees 29' E. She stopped to take a sounding every twenty-four hours, adding to the large number already accumulated during her cruises over the vast basin of the Southern Ocean.

The 'Aurora' had moved through the "fifties" without encountering the typical storms, spotting the first ice at latitude 63 degrees 33' S., longitude 150 degrees 29' E. She paused to take a depth measurement every twenty-four hours, contributing to the significant amount already gathered during her voyages across the expansive Southern Ocean.

All spoke of the clear and beautiful days amid the floating ice and of the wonderful coloured sunsets; especially the photographers. The pack was so loosely disposed, that the ship made a straight course for Commonwealth Bay, steaming up to Cape Denison on the morning of December 14 to find us all eager to renew our claim on the big world up North.

All talked about the clear and beautiful days among the floating ice and the stunning colored sunsets; especially the photographers. The ice was so loosely packed that the ship went straight to Commonwealth Bay, heading up to Cape Denison on the morning of December 14, eager to reestablish our connection with the big world up North.

There was a twenty-five-knot wind and a small sea when we pulled off in the whale-boat to the ship, but, as if conspiring to give us for once a gala-day, the wind fell off, the bay became blue and placid and the sun beat down in full thawing strength on the boundless ice and snow. The Adelians, if that may be used as a distinctive title, sat on the warm deck and read letters and papers in voracious haste, with snatches of the latest intelligence from the Macquarie Islanders and the ship's officers. No one could erase that day from the tablets of his memory.

There was a twenty-five-knot wind and a small sea when we set off in the whale-boat to the ship, but, as if the universe decided to treat us to a special day, the wind calmed down, the bay turned blue and tranquil, and the sun shone down with full warmth on the endless ice and snow. The Adelians, if that’s an appropriate name, sat on the warm deck, eagerly reading letters and papers, catching up on the latest updates from the Macquarie Islanders and the ship's officers. No one could forget that day.

Late in the afternoon the motor-launch went ashore, and the first of the cargo was sent off. The weather remained serene and calm, and for the next six days, with the exception of a "sixty-miler" for a few hours and a land breeze overnight, there was nothing to disturb the embarkation of our bulky impedimenta which almost filled the outer Hut. Other work went on apace. The skua gulls, snow and Wilson petrels were laying their eggs, and Hamilton went ashore to secure specimens and to add to our already considerable collection of bird skins. Hunter had a fish-trap lowered from the forecastle, used a hand dredge from the ship, and did tow-netting occasionally from the launch in its journeys to and from the land. Hurley and Correll had bright sunshine to ensure good photographic results. Bage and Hodgeman looked after the transport of stores from the Hut, and Gillies, Bickerton and Madigan ran the motor-launch. McLean, who was now in possession of an incubator and culture tubes, grew bacteria from various sources—seals and birds, soils, ice and snow. Ainsworth, Blake and Sandell, making their first acquaintance with Adelie Land, were most often to be seen quarrying ice on the glacier or pulling loaded sledges down to the harbour.

Late in the afternoon, the motorboat went ashore, and the first cargo was dispatched. The weather stayed calm and peaceful, and for the next six days, except for a "sixty-miler" for a few hours and a land breeze overnight, nothing interrupted the loading of our bulky gear, which nearly filled the outer Hut. Other work continued at a steady pace. The skuas, snow petrels, and Wilson's petrels were laying their eggs, and Hamilton went ashore to collect specimens and expand our already significant collection of bird skins. Hunter had a fish trap lowered from the bow, used a hand dredge from the ship, and occasionally did tow-netting from the launch during its trips to and from the land. Hurley and Correll enjoyed bright sunshine, ensuring great photographic results. Bage and Hodgeman managed the transport of supplies from the Hut, and Gillies, Bickerton, and Madigan operated the motorboat. McLean, who now had an incubator and culture tubes, grew bacteria from various sources—seals and birds, soil, ice, and snow. Ainsworth, Blake, and Sandell, experiencing Adelie Land for the first time, were most often seen extracting ice from the glacier or hauling loaded sledges down to the harbor.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Mackellar Islets

Mackellar Islands

On the 18th a party of us went off to the Mackellar Islets in the motor-launch, taking a tent and provisions, intending to spend two days there surveying and making scientific observations.

On the 18th, a group of us set off to the Mackellar Islets in the motorboat, bringing along a tent and supplies, planning to spend two days there taking measurements and making scientific observations.

These islets, over thirty in number, are clustered mainly in a group about two miles off shore. The group is encircled by rocky "outposts," and there are several "links" to the southern mainland. Under a brilliant sun, across the pale blue water, heaving in a slow northerly swell, the motor-launch threaded her way between the granite knobs, capped with solid spray. The waves had undermined the white canopies so that they stood immobile, perched on the dark, kelp-fringed rocks, casting their pallid reflections in the turquoise sea. Steaming into a natural harbour, bordered by a low ice-foot on which scores of Weddell seals lay in listless slumber, we landed on the largest islet—a succession of salt-encrusted ridges covered by straggling penguin rookeries. The place just teemed with the sporadic life of an Antarctic summer.

These islets, more than thirty in total, are mostly grouped about two miles offshore. The group is surrounded by rocky "outposts," and there are several "links" to the southern mainland. Under a bright sun, across the pale blue water, gently rolling in a slow northern swell, the motor launch made its way between the granite knobs, topped with solid spray. The waves had eroded the white canopies so that they stood still, perched on the dark, kelp-covered rocks, casting their pale reflections in the turquoise sea. As we steamed into a natural harbor, bordered by a low ice foot on which scores of Weddell seals lay in relaxed slumber, we landed on the largest islet—a series of salt-encrusted ridges dotted with scattered penguin rookeries. The place was filled with the sporadic life of an Antarctic summer.

It was calculated that the Adelie penguins exceeded one hundred and fifty thousand in number over an area of approximately one hundred acres. Near the landing-place there were at least sixty seals and snow petrels; skua gulls and Wilson petrels soon betrayed their nests to the biologists.

It was estimated that the Adelie penguins numbered more than one hundred and fifty thousand across an area of about one hundred acres. Close to the landing site, there were at least sixty seals and snow petrels; skua gulls and Wilson petrels quickly revealed their nests to the biologists.

The islets are flat, and afford evidence that at one time the continental ice-cap has ridden over them. The rock is a hard grey gneiss. A rough plane-table map of the group was made by Hodgeman and myself.

The islets are flat and show that at one time the continental ice cap passed over them. The rock is a tough gray gneiss. A rough map of the group was created by Hodgeman and me.

Our scheme of local exploration was now continued to the west. For two years we had looked curiously at a patch of rocks protruding beneath the ice-cap eight miles away, within Commonwealth Bay. It had been inaccessible to sledging parties, and so we reserved Cape Hunter, as it was ultimately called, for the coming of the Ship.

Our local exploration plan was now extended to the west. For two years, we had been curious about a patch of rocks sticking out from beneath the ice cap eight miles away, in Commonwealth Bay. It had been unreachable for sledging teams, so we saved Cape Hunter, as it was eventually named, for the arrival of the Ship.

The anchor was raised on the forenoon of the 22nd, and by midday the 'Aurora' steamed at half-speed along the ramparts of the glacier, stopping about four miles from the Cape, after sounding in four hundred and twenty-four fathoms. Through field-glasses much had already been seen; enough to arouse an intense interest.

The anchor was lifted in the morning on the 22nd, and by noon the 'Aurora' was moving at half-speed along the glacier's edges, stopping about four miles from the Cape after taking soundings in four hundred and twenty-four fathoms. Through binoculars, a lot had already been observed; enough to spark a strong interest.

One could not but respond to the idea that here was a new world, flawless and unblemished, into which no human being had ever pried. Here were open secrets to be read for the first time. It was not with the cold eye of science alone that we gazed at these rocks—a tiny spur of the great unseen continent; but it was with an indefinable wonder.

One couldn't help but react to the notion that this was a new world, perfect and untouched, where no human had ever ventured. Here were hidden secrets to discover for the first time. We didn’t look at these rocks—just a small part of the vast, hidden continent—only with the detached view of science, but with a sense of awe that was hard to define.

In perfect weather a small party set off in the launch towards a large grounded berg which appeared to lie under the ice-cliffs. Approaching it closely, after covering two miles, we could see that it was still more than a mile to the rocks.

In perfect weather, a small group headed out in the boat toward a large grounded iceberg that seemed to be resting beneath the ice cliffs. As we got closer, after traveling two miles, we could see that there was still over a mile to the rocks.

Penguins soon began to splash around; Wilson petrels came glancing overhead and we could descry great flocks of Antarctic petrels wheeling over cliff and sea. Reefs buried in frothing surge showed their glistening mantles, and the boat swerved to avoid floating streamers of brash-ice.

Penguins quickly started splashing around; Wilson’s petrels flew overhead, and we could see large flocks of Antarctic petrels circling over the cliffs and sea. Reefs hidden in frothy waves revealed their shining surfaces, and the boat swerved to steer clear of floating chunks of brash ice.

The rocky cliffs, about eighty feet in height at the highest point, were formed of vertically lying slate rocks—a very uniform series of phyllite and sericite-schist. At their base lay great clinging blocks of ice deeply excavated by the restless swell. One island was separated from the parent mass by a channel cut sheer to the deep blue water. Behind the main rocks and indenting the ice-cliff was a curving bay into which we steered, finding at its head a beautiful cove fringed with a heavy undermined ice-foot and swarming with Adelie penguins. Overhanging the water was a cavern hollowed out of a bridge of ice thrown from the glacier to the western limit of the rock outcrop.

The rocky cliffs, about eighty feet high at their tallest point, were made up of vertically layered slate rocks—a very consistent sequence of phyllite and sericite-schist. At their base were large blocks of ice that clung on, deeply carved by the restless waves. One island was separated from the main land by a channel that plunged straight down to the deep blue water. Behind the main rocks, indenting the ice cliff, was a curved bay where we steered, discovering at its end a beautiful cove lined with a heavy undermined ice ledge swarming with Adelie penguins. Overhanging the water was a cave carved out of a bridge of ice extending from the glacier to the western edge of the rock formation.

Hurley had before him a picture in perfect proportion. The steel-blue water, paled by an icy reflection, a margin of brown rocks on which the penguins leapt through the splashing surf, a curving canopy of ice-foot and, filling the background, the cavern with pendent icicles along its cornice.

Hurley had in front of him a perfectly balanced scene. The steel-blue water, dimmed by a cold reflection, a border of brown rocks where the penguins jumped through the splashing waves, an arched canopy of ice, and in the background, the cave with hanging icicles along its edge.

The swell was so great that an anchor had to be thrown from the stern to keep the launch off shore, and two men remained on board to see that no damage was done.

The waves were so big that an anchor had to be dropped from the back to keep the boat from drifting ashore, and two men stayed on board to make sure nothing got damaged.

At last we were free to roam and explore. Over the first ridge of rocks we walked suddenly into the home of the Antarctic petrels! There had always been much speculation as to where these birds nested. Jones' party at our western base had the previous summer at Haswell Island happened upon the first rookery of Antarctic petrels ever discovered. Here was another spot in the great wilderness peopled by their thousands. Every available nook and crevice was occupied along a wide slope which shelved away until it met the vertical cliffs falling to the ocean. One could sit down among the soft, mild birds who were fearless at the approach of man. They rested in pairs close to their eggs laid on the bare rock or among fragments of slate loosely arranged to resemble a rest. Many eggs were collected, and the birds, losing confidence in us, rose into the air in flocks, gaining in feathered volume as they circled in fear above this domain of rock and snow which had been theirs for generations.

At last, we were free to roam and explore. As we walked over the first ridge of rocks, we unexpectedly found ourselves in the home of the Antarctic petrels! There had always been a lot of speculation about where these birds nested. Last summer, Jones' party at our western base stumbled upon the first rookery of Antarctic petrels ever discovered at Haswell Island. Here was another location in the vast wilderness populated by thousands of them. Every nook and cranny along a wide slope was occupied until it met the steep cliffs dropping down to the ocean. You could sit down among the soft, gentle birds who were unafraid of our presence. They rested in pairs close to their eggs laid on the bare rock or among loose fragments of slate arranged to create a resting place. Many eggs were collected, and as the birds started to lose confidence in us, they took to the air in flocks, their numbers growing as they circled in fear above this rocky and snowy domain that had belonged to them for generations.

In adjoining rookeries the Adelie penguins, with their fat, downy cheeks, were very plentiful and fiercer than usual. Skuas, snow and Wilson petrels were all in their accustomed haunts. Down on the low ice-foot at the mouth of a rocky ravine, a few seals had effected a landing. Algae, mosses and lichens made quite a display in moist localities.

In nearby nesting areas, the Adelie penguins, with their plump, fluffy cheeks, were abundant and more aggressive than usual. Skuas, snow petrels, and Wilson's petrels were all in their usual spots. At the low ice edge at the entrance of a rocky ravine, a few seals had come ashore. Algae, mosses, and lichens created a vibrant display in damp areas.

Before leaving for the ship, we "boiled the billy" on a platform of slate near the cove where the launch was anchored and had a small picnic, entertained by the penguins playing about in the surf or scaling the ice-foot to join the birds which were laboriously climbing to the rookeries on the ridge. The afternoon was so peaceful and the calm hot weather such a novelty to us that we pushed off reluctantly to the 'Aurora' after an eventful day.

Before leaving for the ship, we made some tea on a slate platform near the cove where the launch was anchored and had a small picnic, entertained by the penguins playing in the surf or climbing the ice-foot to join the birds that were laboriously making their way to the rookeries on the ridge. The afternoon was so peaceful, and the calm, warm weather was such a novelty for us that we reluctantly headed off to the 'Aurora' after a busy day.

Those on board had had a busy time dredging, and their results were just as successful as ours. A haul was made in two hundred and fifty fathoms of ascidians, sponges, crinoids, holothurians, fish and other forms of life in such quantity that Hunter and Hamilton were occupied in sorting the specimens until five o'clock next morning. Meanwhile the 'Aurora' had returned to her old anchorage close to Cape Denison.

Those onboard had been busy dredging, and their results were just as successful as ours. They brought up a haul from two hundred and fifty fathoms that included ascidians, sponges, crinoids, holothurians, fish, and other forms of life in such large quantities that Hunter and Hamilton were busy sorting the specimens until five o'clock the next morning. Meanwhile, the 'Aurora' had returned to her old anchorage near Cape Denison.

The sky banked up from the south with nimbus, and early on the 23rd a strong breeze ruffled the water. There were a few things to be brought off from the shore, while Ainsworth, Sandell and Correll were still at the Hut, so that, as the weather conditions pointed to a coming blizzard, I decided to "cut the painter" with the land.

The sky filled with dark clouds from the south, and early on the 23rd, a strong breeze stirred the water. There were a few things to take off the shore while Ainsworth, Sandell, and Correll were still at the Hut, so, since the weather suggested a blizzard was coming, I decided to "cut the painter" with the land.

An hour later the motor-launch, with Madigan and Bickerton, sped away for the last load through falling snow and a rising sea. Hodgeman had battened down the windows of the Hut, the chimney was stuffed with bagging, the veranda-entrance closed with boards, and, inside, an invitation was left for future visitors to occupy and make themselves at home. After the remainder of the dogs and some miscellaneous gear had been shipped, the launch put off and came alongside in a squally wind through thick showers of snow. Willing hands soon unloaded the boat and slung it in the davits. Every one was at last safe on board, and in future all our operations were to be conducted from the ship.

An hour later, the motorboat, with Madigan and Bickerton, took off for the last load through falling snow and rough seas. Hodgeman had secured the windows of the Hut, stuffed the chimney with cloth, closed the veranda entrance with boards, and inside, left an invitation for future visitors to settle in and make themselves comfortable. After the last of the dogs and some random gear were loaded, the boat set off and pulled alongside in a gusty wind with heavy snowfall. Ready hands quickly unloaded the boat and hoisted it in the davits. Everyone was finally on board, and from now on, all our activities were to be managed from the ship.

During the night the wind rose and the barometer fell, while the air was filled with drifting snow. On the 24th—Christmas Eve—the velocity of the wind gradually increased to the seventies until at noon it blew with the strength of a hurricane. Chief Officer Blair, stationed with a few men under the fo'c'sle-head, kept an anxious eye on the anchor chain and windlass.

During the night, the wind picked up and the barometer dropped, while the air was filled with falling snow. On the 24th—Christmas Eve—the wind's speed gradually increased to the seventies until noon when it blew with hurricane force. Chief Officer Blair, along with a few men under the fo'c'sle-head, kept a worried eye on the anchor chain and windlass.

About lunch time the anchor was found to be dragging and we commenced to drift before the hurricane. All view of the land and lurking dangers in the form of reefs and islets were cut off by driving snow.

About lunchtime, we realized the anchor was dragging, and we started to drift ahead of the hurricane. The driving snow blocked all visibility of the land and hidden dangers like reefs and small islands.

The wind twanged the rigging to a burring drone that rose to a shriek in the shuddering gusts. The crests of the waves were cut off and sprayed in fine spindrift. With full steam on we felt our way out, we hoped to the open sea; meanwhile the chain cable and damaged anchor were slowly being hauled in. The ship's chances looked very small indeed, but, owing to the good seamanship of Captain Davis and a certain amount of luck, disaster was averted. Soon we were in a bounding sea. Each time we were lifted on a huge roller the motor-launch, swinging in the davits, would rise and then descend with a crash on the water, to be violently bumped against the bulwarks. Everything possible was done to save the launch, but our efforts proved fruitless. As it was being converted into a battering ram against the ship itself it had to be cut away, and was soon swept astern and we saw no more of it.

The wind plucked at the rigging, creating a low hum that climbed to a scream in the shuddering gusts. The tops of the waves were chopped off and sprayed into fine mist. With full steam ahead, we navigated our way out, hoping to reach the open sea; meanwhile, the chain cable and damaged anchor were slowly being pulled in. The ship’s chances seemed pretty slim, but thanks to the skilled seamanship of Captain Davis and a bit of luck, we avoided disaster. Soon we were in choppy waters. Each time we were lifted by a massive wave, the motor-launch, swinging in the davits, would rise and then fall with a crash on the water, violently slamming against the sides. We did everything we could to save the launch, but our efforts were in vain. As it turned into a battering ram against the ship itself, it had to be cut loose, and it was quickly swept away behind us, never to be seen again.

Most unexpectedly there came a lull in the wind, so that it was almost calm, though the ship still laboured in the seas. A clearance in the atmosphere was also noticeable for Cape Hunter became discernible to the west, towards which we were rapidly drifting. This sight of the coast was a great satisfaction to us, for we then knew our approximate position ** and the direction of the wind, which had veered considerably.

Most unexpectedly, there was a break in the wind, making it almost calm, even though the ship still struggled against the waves. We also noticed a clearing in the sky as Cape Hunter came into view to the west, and we were quickly drifting toward it. Seeing the coastline was a great relief for us because it confirmed our approximate location and revealed that the wind had shifted significantly.

     ** It should be borne in mind that compasses are unreliable in the
vicinity of the magnetic pole.
     ** Keep in mind that compasses can be unreliable near the magnetic pole.

The lull lasted scarcely five minutes when the wind came back from a somewhat different quarter, north of east, as violent as ever. The "eye" of the storm had passed over us, and the gale continued steady for several days. That night the struggle with the elements was kept up by officers and crew, assisted by members of the shore party who took the lee-wheel or stood by in case of emergency.

The calm lasted hardly five minutes before the wind returned from a slightly different direction, north of east, just as intense as before. The "eye" of the storm had moved past us, and the strong wind continued steadily for several days. That night, the fight against the elements continued with the officers and crew, along with members of the shore party who took the lee-wheel or stood by in case of an emergency.

"December 25. Christmas Day on the high seas off Adelie Land, everything wet and fairly miserable; incipient mal de mer, wind 55-60; snowing! When Davis came down to breakfast and wished us a Merry Christmas, with a smile at the irony of it, the ward-room was swaying about in a most bewildering fashion."

"December 25. Christmas Day on the high seas near Adelie Land, everything was wet and pretty miserable; starting to feel seasick, wind 55-60; snowing! When Davis came down to breakfast and wished us a Merry Christmas, smiling at the irony of it all, the ward-room was swaying in a very confusing way."

Towards evening, after the 'Aurora' had battled for hours slowly to the east, the sea went down somewhat and some drifting ice was sighted. We continued under full steam, pushing forward to gain the shelter of the Mertz glacier-tongue. It was now discovered that the fluke of the anchor had broken off short, so great had been the strain imposed upon it during the height of the hurricane.

Towards evening, after the 'Aurora' had struggled for hours making its way east, the sea calmed down a bit and some drifting ice was spotted. We continued at full speed, pushing ahead to reach the safety of the Mertz glacier-tongue. It was then discovered that the anchor’s fluke had snapped off completely, so intense had been the pressure on it during the peak of the hurricane.

On Boxing Day the ship was in calmer water heading in a more southerly direction so as to come up with the land. Fog, fine snow and an overcast sky made a gloomy combination, but during the afternoon the fog lightened sufficiently for us to perceive the mainland—a ghostly cliff shrouded in diaphanous blink. By 10 P.M. the Mertz glacier was visible on the port bow, and to starboard there was an enormous tilted berg which appeared to be magnified in the dim light.

On Boxing Day, the ship was in calmer waters heading more south to reach the land. Fog, light snow, and a cloudy sky created a gloomy atmosphere, but in the afternoon the fog cleared up enough for us to see the mainland—a ghostly cliff wrapped in thin mist. By 10 P.M., the Mertz glacier was visible off the port side, and on the starboard side, there was a massive tilted iceberg that looked larger in the dim light.

Allowing a day for the weather to become clearer and more settled, we got out the trawl on the 28th and did a dredging in three hundred fathoms close to the glacier-tongue. Besides rocks and mud there were abundant crinoids, holothurians, corals, crustaceans and "shells." In addition, several pieces of fossilized wood and coaly matter were discovered scattered through the "catch."

Allowing a day for the weather to improve and become more stable, we brought out the trawl on the 28th and did some dredging at three hundred fathoms near the glacier's edge. Along with rocks and mud, we found plenty of crinoids, holothurians, corals, crustaceans, and shells. Additionally, we discovered several pieces of fossilized wood and coal-like material mixed in with the catch.

Bage, under Davis's direction, took temperatures and collected water samples at fifty, seventy-five, one hundred, two hundred and three hundred fathoms, using the Lucas sounding-machine on the fo'c'sle. The temperature gradient from the surface downwards appeared to give some indication of the depth of ice submerged in the glacier-tongue alongside which we were lying.

Bage, following Davis's instructions, measured temperatures and gathered water samples at fifty, seventy-five, one hundred, two hundred, and three hundred fathoms, using the Lucas sounding machine on the forecastle. The temperature gradient from the surface downward seemed to suggest the depth of ice submerged in the glacier tongue next to which we were anchored.

On the 29th a cold south-easter blew off the ice-cliffs and the sun was trying to pierce a gauzy alto-stratus. The 'Aurora' steamed north-east, it being our intention to round the northern limit of the Mertz Glacier. Gradually a distant line of pack, which had been visible for some time, closed in and the ship ran into a cul-de-sac. Gray, who was up in the crow's-nest, reported that the ice was very heavy, so we put about.

On the 29th, a cold southeast wind blew off the ice cliffs, and the sun was trying to break through a thin layer of alto-stratus clouds. The 'Aurora' headed northeast, with plans to round the northern edge of the Mertz Glacier. Gradually, a distant line of pack ice, which had been visible for a while, closed in, and the ship found itself in a dead end. Gray, who was up in the crow's nest, reported that the ice was quite thick, so we turned around.

Proceeding southward once more, we glided along within a stone's throw of the great wall of ice whose chiselled headlands stood in profile for miles. There was leisure to observe various features of this great formation, and to make some valuable photographic records when the low south-western sun emerged into a wide rift. Hunter trailed the tow-net for surface plankton while the ship was going at half-speed.

Heading south again, we sailed close to the massive wall of ice, its sharply defined headlands visible for miles. We took our time to examine different aspects of this impressive formation and managed to capture some great photographs when the low southwestern sun broke through a wide gap. Hunter dragged the tow-net for surface plankton while the ship moved at half-speed.

At ten o'clock the ship had come up with the land, and her course was turned sharply to the north-west towards a flotilla of bergs lying to the east of the Way Archipelago, which we intended to visit.

At ten o'clock, the ship reached the land, and we sharply turned our course to the northwest toward a group of icebergs east of the Way Archipelago, which we planned to visit.

On December 30, 1913, the 'Aurora' lay within a cordon of floating ice about one mile distant from the nearest islet of a group scattered along the coast off Cape Gray.

On December 30, 1913, the 'Aurora' was surrounded by a ring of floating ice about a mile away from the closest islet in a group spread along the coast near Cape Gray.

Immediately after breakfast a party of eight men set off in the launch to investigate Stillwell Island. The weather was gloriously sunny and every one was eager at the prospect of fresh discoveries. Cape Hunter had been the home of the Antarctic petrels, and on this occasion we were singularly fortunate in finding a resort of the Southern Fulmar or silver-grey petrels. During the previous summer, two of the eastern sledging parties had for the first time observed the breeding habits of these birds among isolated rocks outcropping on the edge of the coast. But here there was a stronghold of hundreds of petrels, sitting with their eggs in niches among the boulders or ensconced in bowers excavated beneath the snow which lay deep over some parts of the island.

Right after breakfast, a group of eight men set off in the boat to check out Stillwell Island. The weather was beautifully sunny, and everyone was excited about the chance for new discoveries. Cape Hunter had been home to Antarctic petrels, and this time we were particularly lucky to find a gathering of Southern Fulmars, or silver-grey petrels. During the last summer, two of the eastern sledging teams had, for the first time, noticed the breeding habits of these birds among the isolated rocks along the coast. However, here there was a stronghold of hundreds of petrels, sitting with their eggs in niches among the boulders or tucked away in nests dug out beneath the deep snow covering parts of the island.

The rock was a gneiss which varied in character from that which had been examined at Cape Denison and in other localities. All the scientific treasures were exhausted by midday, and the whale-boat was well laden when we rowed back to the ship.

The rock was a gneiss that was different from what had been studied at Cape Denison and in other places. By midday, we had collected all the scientific treasures, and the whale-boat was heavily loaded as we rowed back to the ship.

Throughout a warm summer afternoon the 'Aurora' threaded her way between majestic bergs and steamed west across the wide span of Commonwealth Bay, some fifteen miles off the land. At eleven o'clock the sky was perfectly clear and the sun hung like a luminous ball over the southern plateau. The rocks near the Hut were just visible. Close to the "Pianoforte Berg" and the Mackellar Islets tall jets of fine spray were seen to shoot upward from schools of finner whales. All around us and for miles shoreward, the ocean was calm and blue; but close to the mainland there was a dark curving line of ruffled water, while through glasses one could see trails of serpentine drift flowing down the slopes of the glacier. Doubtless, it was blowing at the Hut; and the thought was enough to make us thankful that we were on our good ship leaving Adelie Land for ever.

Throughout a warm summer afternoon, the 'Aurora' navigated her way between impressive icebergs and headed west across the vast expanse of Commonwealth Bay, about fifteen miles from the shore. At eleven o'clock, the sky was completely clear and the sun hung like a glowing orb over the southern plateau. The rocks near the Hut were barely visible. Close to the "Pianoforte Berg" and the Mackellar Islets, tall jets of fine spray were seen shooting upward from schools of fin whales. All around us and for miles toward the shore, the ocean was calm and blue; but near the mainland, there was a dark curved line of choppy water, and through binoculars, one could see trails of swirling drift flowing down the glacier slopes. It was surely windy at the Hut; and just the thought of it made us grateful to be on our reliable ship leaving Adelie Land for good.

On the morning of December 31, 1913, Cape Alden was abeam, and a strong wind swept down from the highlands. Bordering the coast there was a linear group of islets and outcropping rocks at which we had hoped to touch. The wind continued to blow so hard that the idea was abandoned and our course was directed towards the north-west to clear a submerged reef which had been discovered in January 1912.

On the morning of December 31, 1913, Cape Alden was off to the side, and a strong wind was blowing down from the highlands. Along the coast, there was a line of small islands and rocky outcrops where we had hoped to stop. However, the wind continued to blow so fiercely that we scrapped that idea and changed our course to the northwest to avoid a submerged reef that had been discovered in January 1912.

The wind and sea arose during the night, causing the ship to roll in a reckless fashion. Yet the celebration of New Year's Eve was not marred, and lusty choruses came up from the ward-room till long after midnight. Next morning at breakfast our ranks had noticeably thinned through the liveliness of the ship, but it is wonderful how large an assembly we mustered for the New Year's dinner, and how cheerfully the toast was drunk to "The best year we have ever had!"

The wind and waves picked up during the night, making the ship roll wildly. Still, the New Year's Eve celebration wasn't spoiled, and lively singing filled the ward-room well past midnight. The next morning at breakfast, we were noticeably fewer due to the ship's roughness, but it was impressive how many people showed up for the New Year's dinner, and how happily we raised our glasses to "The best year we've ever had!"

On January 2, 1914, fast ice and the mainland were sighted. The course was changed to the south-west so as to bring the ship within a girdle of loose ice disposed in big solid chunks and small pinnacled floes. A sounding realized two hundred fathoms some ten miles off the coast, which stretched like a lofty bank of yellow sand along the southern horizon. On previous occasions we had not been able to see so much of the coastline in this longitude owing to the compactness of the ice, and so we were able to definitely chart a longer tract at the western limit of Adelie Land.

On January 2, 1914, we spotted fast ice and the mainland. We changed our course to the southwest to navigate through a band of loose ice made up of large solid chunks and small pinnacled floes. We took a sounding that measured two hundred fathoms about ten miles off the coast, which looked like a high bank of yellow sand along the southern horizon. Previously, we hadn’t been able to see much of the coastline in this area due to the thick ice, so we were able to map out a longer stretch along the western edge of Adelie Land.

The ice became so thick and heavy as the 'Aurora' pressed southward that she was forced at last to put about and steer for more open water. On the way, a sounding was made in two hundred and fifty fathoms, but a dredging was unsuccessful owing to the fact that insufficient cable was paid out in going from two hundred and fifty fathoms to deeper water.

The ice got so thick and heavy as the 'Aurora' headed south that she finally had to turn around and seek more open water. Along the way, they took a sound reading at two hundred and fifty fathoms, but the dredging didn't work because not enough cable was let out when moving from two hundred and fifty fathoms to deeper water.

Our north-westerly course ran among a great number of very long tabular bergs, which suggested the possibility of a neighbouring glacier-tongue as their origin.

Our north-western route took us among a lot of very long flat-topped icebergs, which hinted that there might be a neighboring glacier as their source.

At ten o'clock on the evening of the 2nd, a mountain of ice with a high encircling bastion passed to starboard. It rose to a peak, flanked by fragments toppling in snowy ruin. The pyramidal summit was tinged the palest lilac in the waning light; the mighty pallid walls were streaked and blotched with deep azure; the green swell sucked and thundered in the wave-worn caverns. Chaste snow-birds swam through the pure air, and the whole scene was sacred.

At ten o'clock on the evening of the 2nd, a massive iceberg with a tall, surrounding wall drifted by on the right. It reached a peak, with pieces crumbling down in snowy chaos. The pyramid-shaped top had the faintest lilac hue in the fading light; the huge white walls were marked with deep blue streaks and patches; the green waves crashed and roared in the weathered caves below. Pure white seabirds glided through the clear air, making the entire scene feel sacred.

A tropical day in the pack-ice! Sunday January 4 was clear and perfectly still, and the sun shone powerfully. On the previous day we had entered a wide field of ice which had become so close and heavy that the ship took till late in the evening to reach its northern fringe.

A tropical day in the pack ice! Sunday, January 4, was clear and completely calm, and the sun shone brightly. The day before, we had entered a vast expanse of ice that had become so dense and thick that it took the ship until late in the evening to reach its northern edge.

From January 5 onwards for two weeks we steamed steadily towards the west, repeatedly changing course to double great sheets of pack which streamed away to the north, pushing through them in other places where the welcome "water-sky showed strong" ahead, making "southing" for days following the trend of the ice, then grappling with it in the hope of winning through to the land and at last returning to the western track along the margin of brash which breaks the first swell of the Southern Ocean.

From January 5 onwards, for two weeks, we moved steadily west, constantly changing our course to navigate around large areas of pack ice that drifted north. In some places, we pushed through where the inviting "water-sky" appeared strong ahead, heading south for days while following the ice’s trend, then wrestling with it in hopes of reaching land and finally returning to our western route along the edge of the loose ice that softens the first waves of the Southern Ocean.

The weather was mostly overcast with random showers of light snow and mild variable winds on all but two days, when there was a "blow" of forty miles per hour and a considerable sea in which the ship seemed more active than usual.

The weather was mostly cloudy with occasional light snow showers and mild, changing winds on all but two days, when there was a wind of forty miles per hour and a significant sea that made the ship seem more lively than usual.

Many soundings were taken, and their value lay in broadly [...] Of course, too, we were supplementing the ship's previous work in these latitudes.

Many soundings were taken, and their value lay in broadly [...] Of course, we were also adding to the ship's earlier work in these areas.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Section Illustrating The Moat In The Antarctic Continental Shelf

Section Illustrating The Moat In The Antarctic Continental Shelf



One successful dredging in eighteen hundred fathoms brought up some large erratics and coaly matter, besides a great variety of animal life. It was instructive to find that the erratics were coated with a film of manganese oxide derived from the sea-water. Several tow-nettings were taken with large nets automatically closing at any desired depth through the medium of a "messenger." Small crustaceans were plentiful on the surface, but they were if anything more numerous at depths of fifty to one hundred fathoms. Amongst the latter were some strongly phosphorescent forms. The flying birds were "logged" daily by the biologists. Emperor and Adelie penguins were occasionally seen, among the floes as well as sea-leopards, crab-eater and Weddell seals.

One successful dredging at eighteen hundred fathoms brought up some large boulders and coal-like material, along with a wide variety of marine life. It was fascinating to discover that the boulders were covered in a layer of manganese oxide from the seawater. Several tow-netting samples were collected using large nets that automatically closed at any desired depth with the help of a "messenger." Small crustaceans were abundant at the surface, but they were even more plentiful at depths of fifty to one hundred fathoms. Among those were some brightly glowing forms. The flying birds were recorded daily by the biologists. Emperor and Adelie penguins were occasionally spotted among the ice, along with sea leopards, crab-eater seals, and Weddell seals.

Friday January 16 deserves mention as being a day full of incident. In the morning a thin, cold fog hung along the pack whose edge determined our course. Many petrels flew around, and on the brash-ice there were dark swarms of terns—small birds with black-capped heads, dove-grey backs and silvery-white breasts. They were very nervous of the ship, rising in great numbers when it had approached within a few hundred yards. One startled bird would fly up, followed by several more; then a whole covey would disturb the rest of the flock. Hamilton managed to shoot two of them from the fo'c'sle, and, after much manoeuvring, we secured one with a long hand-net.

Friday, January 16, was definitely a day worth mentioning. In the morning, a thin, cold fog hung over the pack ice that guided our path. Many petrels flew around, and there were dark swarms of terns on the brash ice—small birds with black-capped heads, dove-grey backs, and silvery-white breasts. They were quite sensitive to the ship, taking off in large numbers whenever we got within a few hundred yards. One startled bird would rise, followed by several more, and then a whole group would disturb the rest of the flock. Hamilton managed to shoot two of them from the bow, and after some careful maneuvering, we caught one with a long hand-net.

Soon after, there was a cry of "killer whales!" from the stern. Schools of them were travelling from the west to the east along the edge of the pack. The water was calm and leaden, and every few seconds a big black triangular fin would project from the surface, there would be a momentary glimpse of a dark yellow-blotched back and then all would disappear.

Soon after, someone shouted, "killer whales!" from the back of the boat. Groups of them were moving from the west to the east along the edge of the ice. The water was calm and heavy, and every few seconds, a big black triangular fin would break the surface, followed by a quick glimpse of a dark yellow-blotched back, and then they would vanish.

We pushed into the pack to "ice ship," as the water-supply was running low. Just as the 'Aurora' was leaving the open water, a school of finner whales went by, blowing high jets of spray in sudden blasts, wallowing for a few seconds on the surface, and diving in swirls of foam. These finners or rorquals are enormous mammals, and on one occasion we were followed by one for several hours. It swam along with the ship, diving regularly underneath from one side to another, and we wondered what would happen if it had chosen to charge the vessel or to investigate the propeller.

We moved into the group to "ice ship," as our water supply was running low. Just as the 'Aurora' was leaving the open water, a school of fin whales swam by, sending up high jets of spray in sudden bursts, floating for a few seconds on the surface, then diving in swirls of foam. These fin whales, or rorquals, are massive creatures, and once, one followed us for several hours. It swam alongside the ship, regularly diving underneath from one side to the other, and we wondered what would happen if it decided to charge at the vessel or check out the propeller.

Close to a big floe to which the ship was secured, two crab-eater seals were shot and hauled aboard to be skinned and investigated by the biologists and bacteriologist. When the scientists had finished their work, the meat and blubber were cut up for the dogs, while the choicer steaks were taken to the cook's galley.

Close to a large ice floe where the ship was anchored, two crab-eater seals were shot and brought on board to be skinned and examined by the biologists and bacteriologist. Once the scientists completed their work, the meat and blubber were chopped up for the dogs, while the best steaks were sent to the cook's kitchen.

After lunch every one started to "ice ship" in earnest. The sky had cleared and the sun was warm and brilliant by the time a party had landed on the snow-covered floe with baskets, picks and shovels. When the baskets had been filled, they were hoisted by hand-power on to a derrick which had been fixed to the mizen mast, swung inboard and then shovelled into a melting tank alongside the engine-room. The melter was a small tank through which ran a coil of steam pipes. The ice came up in such quantity that it was not melted in time to keep up with the demand, so a large heap was made on the deck.

After lunch, everyone started to "ice ship" for real. The sky had cleared up, and the sun was warm and bright by the time a group landed on the snow-covered floe with baskets, picks, and shovels. Once the baskets were filled, they were lifted by hand onto a derrick attached to the mizen mast, swung inboard, and then shoveled into a melting tank next to the engine room. The melter was a small tank with a coil of steam pipes running through it. The ice came in so quickly that it couldn't be melted fast enough to meet the demand, so they ended up making a big pile of it on the deck.

Later in the afternoon it was found that holes chipped in the sea-ice to a depth of six or eight inches filled quickly with fresh water, and soon a gang of men had started a service with buckets and dippers between these pools and the main hatch where the water was poured through funnels into the ship's tanks. The bulwarks on the port side of the main hatch had been taken down, and a long plank stretched across to the floe. At nine o'clock work was stopped and we once more resumed our western cruise.

Later in the afternoon, it was discovered that holes chipped in the sea ice to a depth of six or eight inches quickly filled with fresh water. Soon, a group of men began a service using buckets and dippers to transfer this water from the pools to the main hatch, where it was poured through funnels into the ship's tanks. The guardrails on the left side of the main hatch had been removed, and a long plank stretched across to the ice floe. At nine o'clock, work stopped, and we resumed our journey westward.

It was found that as the region of Queen Mary Land approached, heavy pack extended to the north. While skirting this obstacle, we disclosed by soundings a steep rise in the ocean's floor from a depth of about fifteen hundred fathoms to within seven hundred fathoms of the surface, south of which there was deep water. It was named "Bruce Rise" in recognition of the oceanographical work of the Scottish Expedition in Antarctic seas.

It was discovered that as we got closer to Queen Mary Land, thick sea ice stretched northward. While navigating around this obstacle, soundings revealed a steep rise in the ocean floor from a depth of about 1,500 fathoms to within 700 fathoms of the surface, with deep water to the south of it. It was named "Bruce Rise" to honor the oceanographic work of the Scottish Expedition in Antarctic waters.

On the 17th, in latitude 62 degrees 21' S., longitude 95 degrees 9' E., the course ran due south for more than seven hours. For the two ensuing days the ship was able to steer approximately south-west through slackening ice, until on the 19th at midday we were in latitude 64 degrees 59' S., longitude 90 degrees 8' E. At length it appeared that land was approaching, after a westward run of more than twelve hundred miles. Attempts to reach the charted position of Totten's Land, North's Land, Budd Land and Knox Land had been successively abandoned when it became evident that the pack occupied a more northerly situation than that of the two previous years, and was in most instances thick and impenetrable.

On the 17th, at latitude 62 degrees 21' S., longitude 95 degrees 9' E., the course headed straight south for over seven hours. For the next two days, the ship was able to navigate roughly southwest through less dense ice, until on the 19th at noon we found ourselves at latitude 64 degrees 59' S., longitude 90 degrees 8' E. Eventually, it seemed that land was getting closer after traveling more than twelve hundred miles westward. Attempts to reach the mapped locations of Totten's Land, North's Land, Budd Land, and Knox Land were successively given up when it became clear that the ice pack was situated farther north than in the previous two years and was, in most cases, thick and impossible to penetrate.

At 10 P.M. on the 19th, the ice fields still remaining loose and navigable, a dark line of open water was observed ahead. From the crow's-nest it was seen to the south stretching east and west within the belt of pack-ice—the Davis Sea. We had broken through the pack less than twenty-five miles north of where the 'Gauss' (German Expedition, 1902) had wintered.

At 10 PM on the 19th, with the ice fields still loose and navigable, we spotted a dark line of open water ahead. From the crow's-nest, it was seen stretching east and west to the south within the pack-ice area—the Davis Sea. We had broken through the pack less than twenty-five miles north of where the 'Gauss' (German Expedition, 1902) had wintered.

All next day the 'Aurora' steamed into the eye of an easterly wind towards a low white island, the higher positions of which had been seen by the German Expedition of 1902, and charted as Drygalski's High Land. Dr. Jones' party had, the year before, obtained a distant view of it and regarded it as an island, which proved to be correct, so we named it Drygalski Island. To the south there was the dim outline of the mainland. Soundings varied between two hundred and three hundred fathoms.

All the next day, the 'Aurora' moved toward a low white island against an easterly wind. The German Expedition of 1902 had spotted the higher points of this island and marked it as Drygalski's High Land. Dr. Jones' team had gotten a distant view of it the year before and believed it to be an island, which turned out to be true, so we named it Drygalski Island. To the south, there was a faint outline of the mainland. The depth varied between two hundred and three hundred fathoms.

On January 21, Drygalski Island was close at hand, and a series of soundings which showed from sixty to seventy fathoms of water deepening towards the mainland proved beyond doubt that it was an island. In shape it is like a flattened dome about nine miles in diameter and twelve hundred feet in height, bounded by perpendicular cliffs of ice, and with no visible evidence of outcropping rock.

On January 21, Drygalski Island was nearby, and a series of depth measurements showed between sixty to seventy fathoms of water getting deeper as we approached the mainland, confirming that it was an island. It has the shape of a flattened dome, about nine miles in diameter and twelve hundred feet high, surrounded by steep ice cliffs, with no visible signs of exposed rock.

The dredge was lowered in sixty fathoms, and a rich assortment of life was captured for the biologists—Hunter and Hamilton. A course was then made to the south amidst a sea of great bergs; the water deepening to about four hundred fathoms.

The dredge was lowered to sixty fathoms, and a diverse collection of life was captured for the biologists—Hunter and Hamilton. They then headed south through a sea of massive icebergs, with the water deepening to about four hundred fathoms.

During the evening the crevassed slopes of the mainland rose clear to the south, and many islets were observed near the coast, frozen in a wide expanse of bay-ice. Haswell Island, visited by Jones, Dovers and Hoadley of the Western Party, was sighted, and the ship was able to approach within eight miles of it; at ten o'clock coming up to flat bay-ice, where she anchored for the night. Before we retired to bunk, a Ross seal was discovered and shot, three-quarters of a mile away.

During the evening, the jagged slopes of the mainland rose clearly to the south, and many small islands were spotted near the coast, trapped in a broad expanse of bay ice. Haswell Island, visited by Jones, Dovers, and Hoadley from the Western Party, was seen, and the ship managed to get within eight miles of it; at ten o'clock, we reached some flat bay ice, where we anchored for the night. Before we went to bed, a Ross seal was found and shot, three-quarters of a mile away.

Next day, January 22, an unexpected find was made of five more of this rare species of seal. Many Emperor penguins were also secured. It would have been interesting to visit the great rookery of Emperor penguins on Haswell Island, but, as the ship could only approach to within eight miles of it, I did not think it advisable to allow a party to go so far.

Next day, January 22, an unexpected discovery was made of five more of this rare seal species. Many Emperor penguins were also captured. It would have been fascinating to visit the large colony of Emperor penguins on Haswell Island, but since the ship could only get within eight miles of it, I didn't think it was wise to let a group go that far.

On the night of the 22nd, the 'Aurora' was headed northeast for the Shackleton Ice-Shelf. In the early hours of the 28rd a strong gale sprang up and rapidly increased in violence. A pall of nimbus overspread the sky, and blinding snow commenced to fall.

On the night of the 22nd, the 'Aurora' was on its way northeast to the Shackleton Ice Shelf. Early on the 28th, a fierce gale arose and quickly grew stronger. A layer of dark clouds covered the sky, and heavy snow began to fall.

We had become used to blizzards, but on this occasion several factors made us somewhat apprehensive. The ship was at least twenty-five miles from shelter on an open sea, littered with bergs and fragments of ice. The wind was very strong; the maximum velocity exceeding seventy miles per hour, and the dense driving snow during the midnight hours of semi-darkness reduced our chances of navigating with any certainty.

We were used to blizzards, but this time several factors made us feel uneasy. The ship was at least twenty-five miles from safety on a wide-open sea filled with icebergs and chunks of ice. The wind was really strong, with maximum speeds over seventy miles per hour, and the heavy snow during the midnight hours of dim light made it hard to navigate with any certainty.

The night of the 23rd had a touch of terror. The wind was so powerful that, with a full head of steam and steering a few points off the eye of the wind, the ship could just hold her own. But when heavy gusts swooped down and the propeller raced on the crest of a mountainous wave, Davis found it impossible to keep steerage-way.

The night of the 23rd was pretty terrifying. The wind was so strong that, with full power and steering slightly off from directly into the wind, the ship could barely maintain control. But when heavy gusts hit and the propeller sped along the top of a huge wave, Davis found it impossible to steer properly.

Drift and spray lash the faces of officer and helmsman, and through the grey gloom misty bergs glide by on either hand. A long slow struggle brings us to a passage between two huge masses of ice. There is a shock as the vessel bumps and grinds along a great wall. The engine stops, starts again, and stops once more. The yards on the foremast are swung into the wind, the giant seas are broken by the stolid barriers of ice, the engine commences to throb with its old rhythm, and the ship slowly creeps out to meet the next peril. It comes with the onset of a "bergy-bit" which smashes the martingale as it plunges into a deep trough. The chain stay parts, dragging loose in the water, while a great strain is put by the foremast on the bowsprit.

Drift and spray hit the faces of the officer and helmsman, and through the gray gloom, misty icebergs float by on either side. A long, slow struggle takes us to a passage between two massive chunks of ice. There's a jolt as the ship bumps and grinds against a large wall. The engine stops, starts again, and then stops once more. The yards on the foremast are adjusted into the wind, the giant waves are broken by the solid barriers of ice, the engine begins to thrum with its familiar rhythm, and the ship slowly moves out to face the next danger. It arrives with the onset of a "bergy-bit," which smashes the martingale as it dives into a deep trough. The chain stay snaps, trailing loose in the water, while a great strain is placed on the bowsprit by the foremast.

Early on the 24th the ship was put about and ran with the wind, while all hands assembled on the fo'c'sle. The crew, under the direction of Blair, had the ticklish job of replacing the chain stay by two heavy blocks, the lower of which was hooked on to the lug which secured the end of the stay, and the upper to the bowsprit. The running ropes connecting the blocks were tightened up by winding the hauling line round the capstan. When the boatswain and two sailors had finished the wet and chilly task of getting the tackle into position, the rest put their weight on to the capstan bars and the strain on the bowsprit was relieved. The fo'c'sle, plunging and swaying in the great waves, was encased in frozen spray, and along all the ropes and stays were continuous cylinders of ice. The 'Aurora' then resumed her easterly course against the blizzard.

Early on the 24th, the ship turned around and sailed with the wind, while everyone gathered on the forecastle. The crew, led by Blair, had the tricky job of replacing the chain stay with two heavy blocks, with the lower one hooked onto the lug securing the end of the stay and the upper one attached to the bowsprit. They tightened the running ropes connecting the blocks by winding the hauling line around the capstan. Once the boatswain and two sailors finished the wet and cold task of positioning the tackle, the rest put their weight on the capstan bars to relieve the strain on the bowsprit. The forecastle, plunging and swaying in the massive waves, was covered in frozen spray, and there were continuous cylinders of ice along all the ropes and stays. The 'Aurora' then continued her easterly course against the blizzard.

Saturday January 24 was a day of high wind, rough seas, watery decks, lively meals and general discomfort. At 11.30 P.M. the waves had perceptibly decreased, and it was surmised that we were approaching the berg, about thirty miles in length, which lay to the west of the Shackleton Ice-Shelf.

Saturday, January 24 was a day of strong winds, rough seas, wet decks, chaotic meals, and overall discomfort. By 11:30 P.M., the waves had noticeably calmed down, and we guessed that we were getting close to the iceberg, which was about thirty miles long, located to the west of the Shackleton Ice Shelf.

At 6 A.M. on the 25th the sun managed to glimmer through the low rack flying from the east, lighting up the carven face of an ice-cliff along which the 'Aurora' was coasting. Up and down we steamed until the afternoon of the 26th, when the wind lulled away to nothing, and the grey, even pall of cloud rose and broke into fleecy alto-cumulus.

At 6 A.M. on the 25th, the sun started to shine through the low clouds coming from the east, illuminating the carved face of an ice cliff as the 'Aurora' coasted along. We steamed back and forth until the afternoon of the 26th, when the wind calmed to nothing, and the dull gray cloud cover began to lift and turn into fluffy alto-cumulus clouds.

At the southern extremity of the long berg, fast bay-ice extended up to the land and for twenty miles across to the shelf on which the Winter Quarters of the Western Party had been situated. Further progress to the south was blocked, so our course was directed to the north along the western border of the berg.

At the southern tip of the long ice shelf, solid bay-ice stretched all the way to the land and for twenty miles across to the shelf where the Winter Quarters of the Western Party were located. We couldn't go any further south, so we headed north along the western edge of the ice shelf.

When not engaged in sounding, dredging, or tow-netting members of the land party found endless diversion in trimming coal. Big inroads had been made in the supply of more than five hundred tons, and it now became necessary to shift many tons of it from the holds aft to the bunkers where it was accessible to the firemen. The work was good exercise, and every one enjoyed the shift below, "trucking"and "heaving." Another undoubted advantage, in the opinion of each worker, was that he could at least demand a wash from Chief Engineer Gillies, who at other times was forced to be thrifty with hot fresh water.

When they weren't busy sounding, dredging, or using the tow-net, members of the land party found endless entertainment in sorting coal. They had made significant progress in using up more than five hundred tons, and it was now necessary to move many tons from the holds at the back to the bunkers where it was accessible to the firemen. The work provided good exercise, and everyone enjoyed the effort down below, "trucking" and "heaving." Another clear advantage, according to each worker, was that they could at least ask Chief Engineer Gillies for a wash, which he usually had to be stingy with when it came to hot fresh water.

After supper on the 28th it was evident that we had reached a point where the shelf-ice veered away to the eastward and a wide tract of adhering sea-ice barred the way. The floe was exceedingly heavy and covered with a deep layer of soft snow. Emperor and Adelie penguins, crab-eater and Weddell seals were recognized through glasses along its edge. As there was a light obscuring fog and dusk was approaching, the 'Aurora' "hung up" for the night.

After dinner on the 28th, it was clear that we had arrived at a place where the shelf ice turned eastward, and a broad area of attached sea ice blocked our path. The ice floe was very thick and had a deep layer of soft snow on it. We spotted emperor and Adelie penguins, as well as crab-eater and Weddell seals along its edge through binoculars. Since there was a light fog and twilight was setting in, the 'Aurora' anchored for the night.

On January 29 the ship, after a preliminary trawling had been done in three hundred and twenty fathoms, pushed into the floe and was made fast with an ice-anchor. Emperor penguins were so plentiful in the neighbourhood that many specimens were secured for skins.

On January 29, the ship, after doing some initial trawling in three hundred and twenty fathoms, moved into the ice and was secured with an ice anchor. Emperor penguins were so abundant in the area that many specimens were collected for their skins.

A sea-leopard was seen chasing a crab-eater seal quite close to the bow of the ship. The latter, after several narrow escapes, took refuge on an ice-foot projecting from the edge of the floe.

A sea leopard was spotted chasing a crab-eater seal just off the front of the ship. The seal, after several close calls, found safety on an ice ledge jutting out from the edge of the floe.

Advantage was taken of a clearing in the weather to walk over the sea-ice to a berg two and a half miles away, from the summit of which it was hoped that some sign of land might be apparent. Away in the distance, perhaps five miles further on, could be seen an immense congregation of Emperor Penguins—evidently another rookery. No certain land was visible.

We took advantage of a break in the weather to walk over the sea ice to a berg two and a half miles away, hoping to see some sign of land from the top. In the distance, maybe five miles further on, we spotted a huge group of Emperor Penguins—clearly another breeding ground. No definite land was in sight.

The cruise was now continued to the north-west in order to skirt a collection of bergs and floe, with the ultimate object of proceeding in an easterly direction towards Termination Ice-Tongue at the northern limit of the Shackleton Shelf-Ice.

The cruise was now heading northwest to avoid a group of icebergs and floes, with the goal of ultimately moving east toward the Termination Ice-Tongue at the northern edge of the Shackleton Shelf Ice.

A glance at the map which illustrates the work done by the Western Party affords the best idea of the great ice-formation which stretches away to the north of Queen Mary Land. It is very similar in character to the well-known Ross Barrier over which lay part of Scott's and Amundsen's journeys to the South Pole. Its height is remarkably uniform, ranging from sixty to one hundred feet above the water-level. When allowance has been made for average specific gravity, its average total thickness should approximate to six hundred feet. From east to west the formation was proved to be as much as two hundred miles, with one hundred and eighty miles between its northern and southern limits.

A look at the map showing the work done by the Western Party gives the best idea of the massive ice formation that extends north of Queen Mary Land. It's very similar to the famous Ross Barrier, which was part of Scott's and Amundsen's journeys to the South Pole. Its height is strikingly consistent, ranging from sixty to one hundred feet above the water level. Considering average specific gravity, its overall thickness should be around six hundred feet. The formation stretches as much as two hundred miles from east to west, with one hundred and eighty miles between its northern and southern boundaries.

This vast block of ice originates fundamentally from the glacial flow over the southern hinterland. Every year an additional layer of consolidated snow is added to its surface by the frequent blizzards. These annual additions are clearly marked in the section exposed on the dazzling white face near the brink of the ice-cliff. There is a limit, however, to the increase in thickness, for the whole mass is ever moving slowly to the north, driven by the irresistible pressure of the land-ice behind it. Thus the northern face crumbles down into brash or floats away as part of a berg severed from the main body of the shelf-ice.

This huge block of ice mainly comes from the glacial flow over the southern region. Each year, a new layer of compacted snow is added to its surface by frequent blizzards. These yearly additions are clearly visible in the section exposed on the bright white face near the edge of the ice cliff. However, there is a limit to how thick it can get, as the entire mass is constantly moving slowly northward, pushed by the relentless pressure of the land ice behind it. As a result, the northern face breaks down into small chunks or drifts away as part of an iceberg that has broken away from the main section of the shelf ice.

On the morning of January 30 we had the unique experience of witnessing this crumbling action at work—a cataclysm of snow, ice and water! The ship was steaming along within three hundred yards of a cliff, when some loose drifts slid off from its edge, followed by a slice of the face extending for many hundreds of feet and weighing perhaps one million tons. It plunged into the sea with a deep booming roar and then rose majestically, shedding great masses of snow, to roll onwards exposing its blue, swaying bulk shivering into lumpy masses which pushed towards the ship in an ever-widening field of ice. It was a grand scene enacted in the subdued limelight of an overcast day.

On the morning of January 30, we had the amazing experience of seeing this crumbling action in action—a huge mix of snow, ice, and water! The ship was cruising about three hundred yards from a cliff when some loose drifts slid off the edge, followed by a massive chunk of the cliff itself, extending for hundreds of feet and weighing maybe a million tons. It crashed into the sea with a deep booming sound and then rose majestically, shedding large amounts of snow, rolling forward to reveal its blue, swaying form, which broke into lumpy pieces that pushed toward the ship in an ever-expanding field of ice. It was an impressive scene played out in the soft light of an overcast day.

During the afternoon the 'Aurora' changed her north-westerly course round to north-east, winding through a wonderful sea of bergs grounded in about one hundred and twenty fathoms of water. At times we would pass through narrow lanes between towering walls and emerge into a straight wide avenue along which these mountains of ice were ranged. Several were rather remarkable; one for its exquisite series of stratification lines, another for its facade in stucco, and a third for its overhanging cornice fringed with slender icicles.

During the afternoon, the 'Aurora' shifted its course from northwest to northeast, navigating through a stunning sea of icebergs resting in about one hundred and twenty fathoms of water. At times, we would glide through narrow passages between towering walls and emerge into a broad, open avenue lined with these ice mountains. Some were quite impressive; one showed off beautiful layers of striations, another had a stucco-like facade, and a third featured an overhanging ledge adorned with delicate icicles.

On January 31 a trawling was made in one hundred and twelve fathoms. Half a ton of life emptied on the deck gave the biologists occupation for several days. Included in the catch were a large number of monstrous gelatinous ascidians or "sea-squirts." Fragments of coal were once more found; an indication that coaly strata must be very widely distributed in the Antarctic.

On January 31, a trawl was conducted at a depth of one hundred and twelve fathoms. Half a ton of marine life spilled onto the deck, keeping the biologists busy for several days. Among the catch were many large, grotesque gelatinous ascidians, also known as "sea-squirts." Fragments of coal were discovered again, suggesting that coal-rich layers are likely widespread in Antarctica.

The pack was dense and in massive array at the extremity of Termination Ice-Tongue. Davis drove the ship through some of it and entered an open lead which ran like a dark streak away to the east amid ice which grew heavier and more marked by the stress of pressure.

The pack was thick and arranged in a huge mass at the edge of Termination Ice-Tongue. Davis steered the ship through part of it and entered an open lead that stretched like a dark line to the east among ice that became denser and more defined by the pressure.

Our time was now limited and it seemed to me that there was little chance of reaching open water by forcing a passage either to the east or north. We therefore turned on our tracks and broke south-west back into the Davis Sea, intending to steam westward to the spot where we had so easily entered two weeks previously.

Our time was now limited, and it seemed to me that there was little chance of reaching open water by forcing a way either to the east or north. So, we turned around and made our way southwest back into the Davis Sea, planning to head west to the spot where we had so easily entered two weeks before.

On February 4 the pack to the north was beginning to thin out and to look navigable. Several short-cuts were taken across projecting "capes," and then on February 5 the 'Aurora' entered a zone of bergs and broken floe. No one slept well during that night as the ship bumped and ground into the ice which crashed and grated along her stout sides. Davis was on watch for long hours, directing in the crow's nest or down on the bridge, and throughout the next day we pushed on northwards towards the goal which now meant so much to us—Australia—Home!

On February 4, the ice pack to the north was starting to thin out and seemed passable. We took several shortcuts across jutting "capes," and then on February 5, the 'Aurora' sailed into a field of icebergs and broken floes. Nobody got much sleep that night as the ship bumped and scraped against the ice, which crashed and grinded against her sturdy sides. Davis was on watch for long hours, directing from the crow's nest or down on the bridge, and throughout the next day we continued moving north towards a goal that now meant so much to us—Australia—Home!

At four o'clock the sun was glittering on the great ocean outside the pack-ice. Many of us climbed up in the rigging to see the fair sight—a prevision of blue skies and the calm delights of a land of eternal summer. Our work was finished, and the good ship was rising at last to the long swell of the southern seas.

At four o'clock, the sun was shining brightly on the vast ocean beyond the ice. Many of us climbed up into the rigging to take in the beautiful view—a glimpse of blue skies and the peaceful joys of a land with endless summer. Our work was done, and the ship was finally rising to the gentle roll of the southern seas.

On February 12, in latitude 55 degrees S, a strong south-wester drove behind, and, with all sails set, the 'Aurora' made eight knots an hour. The last iceberg was seen far away on the eastern horizon. Albatrosses followed in our wake, accompanied by their smaller satellites—Cape hens, priors, Lesson's and Wilson petrels.

On February 12, at latitude 55 degrees S, a strong southwest wind pushed us along, and with all sails up, the 'Aurora' was sailing at eight knots an hour. The last iceberg was spotted far off on the eastern horizon. Albatrosses flew behind us, along with their smaller companions—Cape hens, priors, Lesson's petrels, and Wilson's petrels.

Before leaving the ice, Sandell and Bickerton had fixed an aerial between the fore and mizen masts, while the former installed a wireless receiving-apparatus within the narrow limits of his cabin. There was no space on the ship to set up the motor-engine, dynamos and other instruments necessary for transmitting messages over a long distance.

Before leaving the ice, Sandell and Bickerton had set up an aerial between the fore and mizen masts, while Sandell installed a wireless receiver in the tight confines of his cabin. There simply wasn't enough space on the ship to install the motor engine, dynamos, and other equipment needed to send messages over long distances.

As the nights began to darken, Sandell listened eagerly for distant signals, until on February 16, in latitude 47 degrees S, the "calls" of three ships in the vicinity of the Great Australian Bight were recognized. After this date news was picked up every night, and all the items were posted on a morning bulletin pinned up in the ward-room.

As the nights got darker, Sandell listened intently for distant signals, and on February 16, at latitude 47 degrees S, he picked up the "calls" of three ships near the Great Australian Bight. From that point on, news was received every night, and all the updates were posted on a morning bulletin pinned up in the ward-room.

The first real touch of civilization came unexpectedly early on the morning of February 21. A full-rigged ship on the southern horizon! It might have been an iceberg, the sails flashed so white in the morning sun. But onward it came with a strong south-wester, overhauled and passed us, signalling "'Archibald Russell', fifty-four days out from Buenos Ayres, bound for Cape Borda." It was too magical to believe.

The first real sign of civilization showed up unexpectedly on the morning of February 21. A fully-rigged ship appeared on the southern horizon! It could have been an iceberg, the sails shone so white in the morning sun. But it kept coming with a strong southwest wind, overtook us, and signaled, "'Archibald Russell', fifty-four days out from Buenos Aires, headed for Cape Borda." It felt too magical to be real.

On February 26 we gazed on distant cliffs of rock and earth—Kangaroo Island—and the tiny cluster of dwellings round the lighthouse at Cape Borda. Then we entered St. Vincent's Gulf on a clear, hot day, marvelling at the sandy-blue water, the long, flat mainland with its clumps of trees and the smoke of many steamers.

On February 26, we looked out at the far-off cliffs of rock and dirt—Kangaroo Island—and the small collection of homes around the lighthouse at Cape Borda. Then we entered St. Vincent's Gulf on a clear, hot day, amazed by the sandy-blue water, the long, flat mainland dotted with trees, and the smoke from numerous steamers.

The welcome home—the voices of innumerable strangers—the hand-grips of many friend—it chokes one—it cannot be uttered!

The welcome home—the voices of countless strangers—the handshakes of many friends—it overwhelms you—it’s hard to express!





APPENDIX I

 THE STAFF

 The Ship's Officers

 J. K. Davis               Master of S. Y. 'Aurora' and Second-in
                             Command of the Expedition.
 J. H. Blair               First Officer during the later stages of
                             the Expedition.
 P. Gray                   Second Officer.
 C. P. de la Motte         Third Officer.
 F. J. Gillies             Chief Engineer.
 THE STAFF

 The Ship's Officers

 J. K. Davis               Captain of S. Y. 'Aurora' and Second-in
                             Command of the Expedition.
 J. H. Blair               First Officer during the later stages of
                             the Expedition.
 P. Gray                   Second Officer.
 C. P. de la Motte         Third Officer.
 F. J. Gillies             Chief Engineer.
 Macquarie Island Party

 G. F. Ainsworth           Leader: Meteorologist.
 L. R. Blake               Geologist and Cartographer.
 H. Hamilton               Biologist.
 C. A. Sandell             Wireless Operator and Mechanic.
 A. J. Sawyer              Wireless Operator.
Macquarie Island Party

G. F. Ainsworth           Leader: Meteorologist.  
L. R. Blake               Geologist and Cartographer.  
H. Hamilton               Biologist.  
C. A. Sandell             Radio Operator and Mechanic.  
A. J. Sawyer              Radio Operator.  
 Main Base Party

 Dr. D. Mawson             Commander of the Expedition.
 Lieut. R. Bage            Astronomer, Assistant Magnetician and
                             Recorder of Tides.
 C. T. Madigan             Meteorologist.
 Lieut. B. E. S. Ninnis    In charge of Greenland dogs.
 Dr. X. Mertz              In charge of Greenland dogs.
 Dr. A. L. McLean          Chief Medical Officer, Bacteriologist.
 F. H. Bickerton           In charge of air-tractor sledge.
 A. J. Hodgeman            Cartographer and Sketch Artist.
 J. F. Hurley              Official Photographer.
 E. N. Webb                Chief Magnetician.
 P. E. Correll             Mechanic and Assistant Physicist.
 J. G. Hunter              Biologist.
 C. F. Laseron             Taxidermist and Biological Collector.
 F. L. Stillwell           Geologist.
 H. D. Murphy              In charge of Expedition stores.
 W. H. Hannam              Wireless Operator and Mechanic.
 J. H. Close               Assistant Collector.
 Dr. L. A. Whetter         Surgeon.
Main Base Party

Dr. D. Mawson             Commander of the Expedition.  
Lieut. R. Bage            Astronomer, Assistant Magnetician and  
                             Recorder of Tides.  
C. T. Madigan             Meteorologist.  
Lieut. B. E. S. Ninnis    In charge of Greenland dogs.  
Dr. X. Mertz              In charge of Greenland dogs.  
Dr. A. L. McLean          Chief Medical Officer, Bacteriologist.  
F. H. Bickerton           In charge of air-tractor sledge.  
A. J. Hodgeman            Cartographer and Sketch Artist.  
J. F. Hurley              Official Photographer.  
E. N. Webb                Chief Magnetician.  
P. E. Correll             Mechanic and Assistant Physicist.  
J. G. Hunter              Biologist.  
C. F. Laseron             Taxidermist and Biological Collector.  
F. L. Stillwell           Geologist.  
H. D. Murphy              In charge of Expedition stores.  
W. H. Hannam              Wireless Operator and Mechanic.  
J. H. Close               Assistant Collector.  
Dr. L. A. Whetter         Surgeon.  
 Western Base Party

 F. Wild                   Leader.
 A. D. Watson              Geologist.
 Dr. S. E. Jones           Medical Officer.
 C. T. Harrisson           Biologist.
 M. H. Moyes               Meteorologist.
 A. L. Kennedy             Magnetician.
 C. A. Hoadley             Geologist.
 G. Dovers                 Cartographer.

 In addition to these were the following gentlemen who accompanied
 the Expedition for a portion of the time only or who joined later.

 S. N. Jeffryes            Wireless Operator, who relieved
                             W. H. Hannam during 1913.
 E. R. Waite               (Curator, Canterbury Museum, Christchurch),
                             Biologist, first Sub-Antarctic cruise of
                             'Aurora'.
 Professor T. T. Flynn     (Hobart University), Biologist, second
                              Sub-Antarctic cruise of 'Aurora'.
 J. van Waterschoot        Marine Artist, second Antarctic cruise of
   van der Gracht             'Aurora'.
 Captain James Davis       Whaling authority, second Antarctic cruise
                              of 'Aurora'.
 C. C. Eitel               Secretary, second Antarctic cruise of 'Aurora'.
 N. C. Toucher, and later  Served in the capacity of Chief Officer
    F. D. Fletcher           on the 'Aurora' during the earlier voyages.
Western Base Party

F. Wild                   Leader.  
A. D. Watson              Geologist.  
Dr. S. E. Jones           Medical Officer.  
C. T. Harrisson           Biologist.  
M. H. Moyes               Meteorologist.  
A. L. Kennedy             Magnetician.  
C. A. Hoadley             Geologist.  
G. Dovers                 Cartographer.  

In addition to these, the following gentlemen accompanied the Expedition for a portion of the time or joined later.  

S. N. Jeffryes            Wireless Operator, who took over  
                            from W. H. Hannam in 1913.  
E. R. Waite               (Curator, Canterbury Museum, Christchurch),  
                            Biologist, first Sub-Antarctic cruise of  
                            'Aurora'.  
Professor T. T. Flynn     (Hobart University), Biologist, second  
                            Sub-Antarctic cruise of 'Aurora'.  
J. van Waterschoot        Marine Artist, second Antarctic cruise of  
   van der Gracht             'Aurora'.  
Captain James Davis       Whaling expert, second Antarctic cruise  
                            of 'Aurora'.  
C. C. Eitel               Secretary, second Antarctic cruise of  
                            'Aurora'.  
N. C. Toucher, and later  Served as Chief Officer on the 'Aurora'  
    F. D. Fletcher           during the earlier voyages.  
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

 Signatures of members of the land parties in Antarctica and at
 Macquarie Island
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

 Signatures of members of the land parties in Antarctica and at Macquarie Island
 [Accounts of the members of the expedition, in alphabetical order.]

 G. F. AINSWORTH, thirty** years of age, single, was born in Sydney,
 New South Wales.  His services were loaned to the expedition by the
 Commonwealth Meteorological Bureau, Melbourne.  For a period of two
 years he acted as leader of the Macquarie Island Party, carrying out
 the duties of Meteorologist.  In the summer of 1913-1914 he visited
 the Antarctic during the final cruise of the 'Aurora'.
[Accounts of the members of the expedition, in alphabetical order.]

G. F. AINSWORTH, 30 years old, single, was born in Sydney, New South Wales. His services were provided to the expedition by the Commonwealth Meteorological Bureau in Melbourne. For two years, he served as the leader of the Macquarie Island Party, performing the duties of Meteorologist. In the summer of 1913-1914, he traveled to the Antarctic during the final voyage of the 'Aurora'.
      ** The ages refer to the date of joining the Expedition and are but
 approximate.

 R. BAGE, twenty-three years of age, single, was a graduate in
 Engineering of Melbourne University and a lieutenant in the Royal
 Australian Engineers.  A member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land)
 and leader of the Southern Sledging Party, he remained in the
 Antarctic for two years.  During the first year he was in charge of
 chronometers, astronomical observations and tidal records, and
 throughout the second year continued the magnetic work and looked
 after stores.

 F. H. BICKERTON, F.R.G.S., twenty-two years of age, single, was born
 at Oxford, England.  Had studied engineering: joined the Expedition
 as Electrical Engineer and Motor Expert.  A member of the Main Base
 Party and leader of the Western Sledging Party, he remained in the
 Antarctic for two years, during which time he was in charge of the
 air-tractor sledge, and was engineer to the wireless station.  For
 a time, during the second year, he was in complete charge of the
 wireless plant.

 J. H. BLAIR, twenty-four years of age, single, was born in Scotland.
 For five years he served with the Loch Line of Glasgow as apprentice
 and third mate.  As second mate he joined A. Currie and Company, of
 Melbourne, in the Australian-Indian trade, reaching the rank of first
 mate, in which capacity he acted during the final Antarctic cruise of
 the 'Aurora' in the summer of 1913-14.

 L. R. BLAKE, twenty-one years of age, single, was born in England,
 but had lived for many years in Queensland previous to joining the
 Expedition.  Before accompanying the Macquarie Island Party as
 Geologist and Cartographer, he obtained leave from the Geological
 Survey Department, Brisbane.  He visited the Antarctic during the
 final cruise of the 'Aurora' in the summer of 1913-1914.

 J. H. Close, F.R.G.S., forty years of age, married, was born in
 Sydney, New South Wales.  During the South African War he saw active
 service in Rhodesia, and at the time of the Expedition's departure was
 a teacher of physical culture at Sydney.  A member of the Main Base
 Party (Adelie Land) and of several sledging parties, he spent two
 summers and one winter in the Antarctic.

 P. E. CORRELL, nineteen years of age, single, was a student in
 Science of the Adelaide University.  He joined the Expedition
 as Mechanician and Assistant Physicist.  He was a member of the Main
 Base Party accompanying the Eastern Coastal Party during their
 sledging journey.  He spent three summers and one winter in the
 Antarctic, acting as colour photographer during the final cruise of
 the 'Aurora'.

 J. E. DAVIS, twenty-eight years of age, single, was master of the
 'Aurora' and Second-in-Command of the Expedition.  Born in Ireland and
 educated in England, he served his apprenticeship on the Liverpool
 owned sailing-ship, 'Celtic Chief', obtaining his certificate
 as second mate before joining the barque 'Westland' trading between
 England and New Zealand.  His next post was that of second officer on
 the training ship 'Port Jackson', following which he joined Sir Ernest
 Shackleton's Expedition (1907-1909) as chief officer of the 'Nimrod',
 acting subsequently as master.  Throughout the whole period of the
 Australasian Antarctic Expedition (1911-1914) Captain J. K. Davis
 commanded the 'Aurora' during five cruises.

 G. DOVERS, twenty-one years of age, single, of Sydney, New South Wales,
 was completing his term for Licensed Surveyor in the service of the
 Commonwealth Government when he joined the Expedition.  He was in
 the Antarctic for two summers and one winter, being stationed with the
 Western Party (Queen Mary Land).  A member of several sledging parties,
 he acted as Cartographer to the party which reached Gaussberg.

 F. J. GILLIES, thirty-five years of age, single, was born at Cardiff,
 Wales.  He served his apprenticeship as an engineer on the steamers of
 John Shearman and Company and P. Baker and Company of Cardiff.  For
 six years previous to joining the Expedition he was in the Indian trade.
 Throughout the five cruises of the 'Aurora' between 1911 and 1914  F. J.
 Gillies was Chief Engineer.

 P. GRAY, twenty-two years of age, single, was born and educated in
 England.  He served on the 'Worcester' as cadet captain for eighteen
 months and as apprentice on the 'Archibald Russell', of Glasgow, and
 in the New Zealand Shipping Company.  In 1909 he entered the Peninsula
 and Oriental Company and reached the rank of third officer, joining
 the Australasian Antarctic Expedition as second officer of the 'Aurora'.
 Throughout five cruises, from 1911 to 1914, he served in this capacity.

 H. HAMILTON, twenty-six years of age, single, was born at Napier, New
 Zealand.  Graduate of the Otago University.  Besides being employed on
 the New Zealand Geological Survey, he acted as Entomological Collector
 to the Dominion Museum at Wellington.  A member of the Macquarie
 Island Party, of which he was the Biologist for two years, H. Hamilton
 visited the Antarctic during the final cruise of the 'Aurora' in the
 summer of 1913-1914.

 W. H. HANNAM, twenty-six years of age, single, was of Sydney, New
 South Wales, and joined the Expedition in charge of the arrangements
 for a wireless telegraphic system.  He was in the Antarctic at the
 Main Base (Adelie Land) for two summers and a winter, and was
 successful in transmitting wireless messages for a short time during
 1912 through Macquarie Island to Australia, assistant magnetician for
 a time.

 C. T. HARRISSON, forty-three years of age, married, was born in
 Hobart, Tasmania.  For many years previous to joining the Expedition
 he had done illustrative and artistic work and had been engaged on a
 survey and in botanical and other scientific observations on the west
 coast of Tasmania.  Stationed with the Western Base (Queen Mary Land)
 he acted as Biologist and Artist, accompanying F. Wild on his main
 eastern journey and several other sledging parties.

 C. A. HOADLEY, twenty-four years of age, single, was a graduate in
 Mining Engineering of Melbourne University.  A member of F. Wild's
 Western Party (Queen Mary Land), he took part in several sledging
 journeys and was Geologist of the party who explored westwards to
 Gaussberg.

 A. J. HODGEMAN, twenty-six years of age, single, was born at
 Adelaide, South Australia.  For four years he was an articled
 architect, and for five years a draughtsman in the Works and Buildings
 Department, Adelaide.  A member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land),
 he took part in several sledging journeys, and throughout two years
 in the Antarctic acted in the capacity of Cartographer and Sketch
 Artist, as well as that of Assistant Meteorologist.

 J. G. HUNTER, twenty-three years of age, single, was a graduate in
 Science of Sydney University, New South Wales.  A member of the Main
 Base Party (Adelie Land) he carried on the work of Biologist during
 two summers and one winter; and in the same capacity accompanied
 the 'Aurora' in her final summer cruise 1911-1914.

 J. F. HURLEY, twenty-four years of age, single, was of Sydney, New
 South Wales.  He had been the recipient of many amateur and professional
 awards for photographic work before joining the Expedition.  At the
 Main Base he obtained excellent photographic and cinematographic records
 and was one of the three members of the Southern Sledging Party.  He
 was also present on the final cruise of the 'Aurora'.

 S. N. JEFFRYES, twenty-seven years of age, single, of Towoomba,
 Queensland, was a qualified operator of the Australasian Wireless
 Company.  During the second year (1913) he took W. H. Hannam's place
 in charge of the wireless plant, wintering at the Main Base (Adelie
 Land).

 S. E. JONES, twenty-four years of age, single, was a graduate in
 Medicine of Sydney University, New South Wales.  A member and Medical
 Officer of F. Wild's Western Base (Queen Mary Land), he took part in
 several sledging journeys during 1912 and was leader of the party who
 explored westward to Gaussberg.

 A. L. KENNEDY, twenty-two years of age, single, was a student in
 Science of Adelaide University, South Australia.  Receiving special
 tuition, he acted as Magnetician at the Western Base (Queen Mary
 Land) during the year 1912.  He was a member of several sledging
 parties and accompanied F. Wild on his main eastern journey as
 Cartographer.

 C. F. LASERON, twenty-five years of age, single, had gained a
 Diploma in Geology at the Technical College, Sydney, New South Wales,
 and for some years was Collector to the Technological Museum.  At the
 Main Base (Adelie Land), during 1912, he acted as Taxidermist and
 general Collector, taking part, as well, in sledging journeys to the
 south and east of Winter Quarters.

 C. T. MADIGAN, twenty-three years of age, single, was a graduate in
 Science (Mining Engineering) of Adelaide University, South Australia.
 Through the courtesy of the Trustees of the Rhodes Scholarship, the
 necessary leave to accompany the Expedition was granted just as he
 was on the eve of continuing his studies at Oxford University.  A
 member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land) he acted as Meteorologist
 for two years, and during the second year (1913) was also in charge of
 the Greenland dogs.  An important journey in the spring and one to
 the east in the summer were made under his leadership, and the Party,
 left in Adelie Land in 1913, was to have been under his charge, but
 for my return.

 D. MAWSON, thirty years of age, single, was the Organiser and Leader
 of the Australasian Antarctic Expedition and was, previous to it, a
 member of Sir Ernest Shackleton's Antarctic Expedition of 1907-1909,
 being one of the party under Professor David which reached the South
 Magnetic Pole.  A graduate in Science and Engineering of Sydney and
 Adelaide Universities, he had filled for some time the post of
 Lecturer in Mineralogy and Petrology at the Adelaide University.
 The only survivor of a party sledging to the east from the Main Base
 in the summer of 1912-1913.

 A. L. McLEAN, twenty-six years of age, single, was a graduate in Arts
 and Medicine of Sydney University; New South Wales.  He acted as
 Chief Medical Officer at the Main Base (Adelie Land) and carried out
 observations in Bacteriology and Physiology during the first year.
 In 1913 (the second year) he was Biologist, Ice-Carrier and Editor of
 the 'Adelie Blizzard'.  He took part in a sledging journey along the
 eastern coast in the summer of 1912-1913.

 X. MERTZ, twenty-eight years of age, single, of Basle, Switzerland,
 was a graduate in Law of the Universities of Leipzig and Berne.  Prior
 to joining the Expedition he had gained the Ski-running Championship
 of Switzerland and was an experienced mountaineer.  At the Main Base
 (Adelie Land) he was assisted by B. E. S. Ninnis in the care of
 the Greenland dogs.  On January 7, 1913, during a sledging journey,
 he lost his life, one hundred miles south-east of Winter Quarters.

 C. P. DE LA MOTTE, nineteen years of age, single, of Bulli, New
 South Wales, had early training at sea on the barque 'Northern Chief'
 of New Zealand, obtaining his certificate as second mate in March
 1911.  During the eight months prior to joining the Expedition he
 served as fourth officer on the S.S. 'Warrimoo' of the Union Steamship
 Company of New Zealand.  Throughout the five cruises of the 'Aurora'
 between 1911 and 1914, C. P. de la Motte was third officer with the
 Ship's party.

 M. H. MOYES, twenty-five years of age, single, of Koolunga, South
 Australia, was a graduate in Science of Adelaide University.  With the
 Western Base Party (Queen Mary Land) he acted as Meteorologist and
 took part in several sledging journeys in the autumn and spring of
 1912.  During the summer of 1912-1913, through an unavoidable
 accident, he was left to carry on work alone at Winter Quarters for
 a period of nine weeks.

 H. D. MURPHY, thirty-two years of age, single, of Melbourne,
 one-time Scholar in History of Oxford University.  At the outset he
 was to have been leader of a third Antarctic Base which was eventually
 amalgamated with the Main Base (Adelie Land).  Here he had charge of
 the stores and during the early summer of 1912 was leader of the
 Southern Supporting Party.

 B. E. S. NINNIS, twenty-three years of age, single, was educated at
 Dulwich, England, and entered His Majesty's Army, having a commission
 as Lieutenant in the Royal Fusiliers prior to joining the Expedition
 in London.  At the Main Base (Adelie Land) he was assisted by X. Mertz
 in the care of the Greenland dogs.  On December 14, 1912, while on a
 sledging journey, he lost his life by falling into a crevasse three
 hundred miles east of Winter Quarters.

 C. A. SANDELL, twenty-five years of age, single, of Surrey, England,
 studied electrical engineering for some years and then came to
 Australia in 1909 and entered the Commonwealth Branch of Telephony.
 Having a practical knowledge of wireless telegraphy he joined the
 Expedition as a Wireless Operator and Mechanic and was stationed with
 the Macquarie Island Party for two years.  After the departure of A.
 J. Sawyer in August 1913, he was in complete charge of the wireless
 station.  C. A. Sandell visited the Antarctic during the final
 cruise of the 'Aurora' in the summer of 1913-1914.

 A. J. SAWYER, twenty-six years of age, single, was born in New
 Zealand.  Having had considerable experience in wireless telegraphy,
 he joined the Expedition as an operator from the Australasian Wireless
 Company.  At the Macquarie Island Station he was chief wireless until
 August 1913, when on account of illness he returned to New Zealand.

 F. L. STILLWELL, twenty-three years of age, single, was a graduate
 in Science of Melbourne University, Victoria.  A member of the Main
 Base Party (Adelie Land) he acted as Geologist.  F. L. Stillwell
 was leader of two sledging parties who did detail work for about sixty
 miles along the coast eastward of Winter Quarters.

 A. D. WATSON, twenty-four years of age, single, was a graduate in
 Science of Sydney University, New South Wales.  A member of the
 Western Base Party (Queen Mary Land) he acted as Geologist.  A. D.
 Watson took part in several sledging journeys, accompanying F. Wild
 in his main eastern trip during the summer of 1912-1913.

 E. N. WEBB, twenty-two years of age, single, was an Associate of
 Civil Engineering of Canterbury University College, and, for the
 five months previous to joining the Expedition, carried out magnetic
 observations under the Carnegie Institute of Washington, U.S.A.  At
 the Main Base (Adelie Land) E. N. Webb was Chief Magnetician,
 accompanying the Southern Sledging Party.

 L. A. WHETTER, twenty-nine years of age, single.  He graduated at
 Otago University, New Zealand, and joined the Expedition as Surgeon,
 acting in that capacity at the Main Base (Adelie Land) during 1912.
 He accompanied a sledging party which explored to the westward of
 Winter Quarters.

 F. WILD, thirty-eight years of age, single, was Leader of the Western
 Base Party (Queen Mary Land).  He joined the Merchant Service in
 1889 and the Navy in 1900, served on an extended sledge journey
 during the National Antarctic Expedition (Capt. R. F. Scott) of
 1901-1904, and was one of the Southern Party of Sir Ernest
 Shackleton's Expedition from 1907-1909.  During the Australasian
 Expedition he opened up a new tract of country—Queen Mary Land.

 I desire to make special mention of the Ship's Party who faced the
 rigorous conditions of Antarctica and the stormy Southern Ocean,
 during five separate voyages, with a cheerfulness and devotion to duty
 which will always stand to their lasting credit.  In regions of heavy
 pack-ice and sudden blizzard winds, Captain Davis piloted the Ship
 safely through many situations of extreme danger.  In a report to me
 on the work of the Ship he writes an appreciative note:—

 "I wish to draw particular attention to the loyal way in which the
 officers and men of the 'Aurora' supported me.  Messrs. Toucher,
 Fletcher, Blair, Gray, de la Motte, and Gillies, in their respective
 positions, carried out the duties assigned to them with ability and
 cheerfulness, often under very trying conditions.

 "Mr. Gillies not only looked after the engines but assisted
 materially in the deep-sea work by the invention of a new form of
 sounding driver which was used successfully during the various
 cruises of the 'Aurora'.

 "The Chief Officer was in charge of the stores and equipment of the
 Expedition on board the vessel, in addition to his ordinary executive
 duties.  Messrs. Toucher, Fletcher and Blair served in this capacity
 on different voyages.

 "Mr. P. Gray, as Second and Navigating Officer, and Mr. C. P. de
 la Motte, as Third Officer, acted capably and thoroughly throughout
 the Expedition."
 APPENDIX II

 Scientific Work
      ** The ages indicate the date of joining the Expedition and are only approximate. 

 R. BAGE, 23 years old, single, was an Engineering graduate from Melbourne University and a lieutenant in the Royal Australian Engineers. He was a member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land) and led the Southern Sledging Party, spending two years in Antarctica. In his first year, he oversaw chronometers, astronomical observations, and tidal records, and in the second year, he continued the magnetic work and managed the stores.

 F. H. BICKERTON, F.R.G.S., 22 years old, single, was born in Oxford, England. He studied engineering and joined the Expedition as an Electrical Engineer and Motor Expert. A member of the Main Base Party and leader of the Western Sledging Party, he stayed in Antarctica for two years, during which he managed the air-tractor sledge and served as the engineer for the wireless station. He was in full charge of the wireless plant for a time during the second year.

 J. H. BLAIR, 24 years old, single, was born in Scotland. He served five years with the Loch Line of Glasgow as an apprentice and third mate. Joining A. Currie and Company in Melbourne as a second mate in the Australian-Indian trade, he reached the rank of first mate and acted in that role during the final Antarctic cruise of the 'Aurora' in the summer of 1913-14.

 L. R. BLAKE, 21 years old, single, was born in England but lived in Queensland for many years before joining the Expedition. Before going with the Macquarie Island Party as a Geologist and Cartographer, he took leave from the Geological Survey Department, Brisbane. He visited Antarctica during the final cruise of the 'Aurora' in the summer of 1913-1914.

 J. H. Close, F.R.G.S., 40 years old, married, was born in Sydney, New South Wales. He served actively in Rhodesia during the South African War and was a physical culture teacher in Sydney when the Expedition departed. A member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land) and several sledging parties, he spent two summers and one winter in Antarctica.

 P. E. CORRELL, 19 years old, single, was a Science student at Adelaide University. He joined the Expedition as a Mechanician and Assistant Physicist. He was part of the Main Base Party accompanying the Eastern Coastal Party during their sledging journey and spent three summers and one winter in Antarctica, serving as a color photographer during the final cruise of the 'Aurora'.

 J. E. DAVIS, 28 years old, single, was the master of the 'Aurora' and second-in-command of the Expedition. Born in Ireland and educated in England, he completed his apprenticeship on the Liverpool-owned sailing ship, 'Celtic Chief', obtaining his certificate as second mate before joining the barque 'Westland' trading between England and New Zealand. His next role was second officer on the training ship 'Port Jackson', after which he joined Sir Ernest Shackleton's Expedition (1907-1909) as chief officer of the 'Nimrod', later serving as master. Captain J. K. Davis commanded the 'Aurora' throughout the entire Australasian Antarctic Expedition (1911-1914) during five cruises.

 G. DOVERS, 21 years old, single, from Sydney, New South Wales, was completing his term for Licensed Surveyor in the Commonwealth Government's service when he joined the Expedition. He spent two summers and one winter in Antarctica with the Western Party (Queen Mary Land). As a member of several sledging parties, he served as Cartographer for the party that reached Gaussberg.

 F. J. GILLIES, 35 years old, single, was born in Cardiff, Wales. He apprenticed as an engineer on steamers of John Shearman and Company and P. Baker and Company in Cardiff. For six years before joining the Expedition, he was involved in the Indian trade. F. J. Gillies served as Chief Engineer during the five cruises of the 'Aurora' from 1911 to 1914.

 P. GRAY, 22 years old, single, was born and educated in England. He served as cadet captain for eighteen months on the 'Worcester' and as an apprentice on the 'Archibald Russell' of Glasgow and with the New Zealand Shipping Company. In 1909, he joined the Peninsula and Oriental Company, reaching the rank of third officer before joining the Australasian Antarctic Expedition as the second officer of the 'Aurora'. He served in this role throughout five cruises from 1911 to 1914.

 H. HAMILTON, 26 years old, single, was born in Napier, New Zealand. He graduated from Otago University and worked for the New Zealand Geological Survey while serving as an Entomological Collector for the Dominion Museum in Wellington. A member of the Macquarie Island Party, he was the Biologist for two years and visited Antarctica during the final cruise of the 'Aurora' in the summer of 1913-1914.

 W. H. HANNAM, 26 years old, single, was from Sydney, New South Wales, and joined the Expedition to manage the wireless telegraphic system. He was based at the Main Base (Adelie Land) for two summers and a winter, successfully transmitting wireless messages for a brief time in 1912 from Macquarie Island to Australia and served as an assistant magnetician for a period.

 C. T. HARRISON, 43 years old, married, was born in Hobart, Tasmania. Before joining the Expedition, he had worked in illustrative and artistic roles and had engaged in surveys and various scientific observations along the west coast of Tasmania. Stationed with the Western Base (Queen Mary Land), he acted as Biologist and Artist, accompanying F. Wild on his main eastern journey and several other sledging parties.

 C. A. HOADLEY, 24 years old, single, was a Mining Engineering graduate from Melbourne University. As a member of F. Wild's Western Party (Queen Mary Land), he joined several sledging journeys and served as Geologist for the party that explored westwards to Gaussberg.

 A. J. HODGEMAN, 26 years old, single, was born in Adelaide, South Australia. He trained as an articled architect for four years and worked as a draughtsman in the Works and Buildings Department of Adelaide for five years. A member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land), he participated in several sledging journeys and acted as Cartographer and Sketch Artist and as Assistant Meteorologist during his two years in Antarctica.

 J. G. HUNTER, 23 years old, single, was a Science graduate from Sydney University, New South Wales. As a member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land), he served as Biologist during two summers and one winter; and accompanied the 'Aurora' in its final summer cruise from 1911-1914 in the same role.

 J. F. HURLEY, 24 years old, single, was from Sydney, New South Wales. Before joining the Expedition, he received numerous amateur and professional awards for his photography. At the Main Base, he achieved excellent photographic and cinematographic records and was one of three members of the Southern Sledging Party. He was also present during the final cruise of the 'Aurora'.

 S. N. JEFFRYES, 27 years old, single, from Toowoomba, Queensland, was a qualified operator for the Australasian Wireless Company. In the second year (1913), he took over W. H. Hannam's position in charge of the wireless plant, wintering at the Main Base (Adelie Land).

 S. E. JONES, 24 years old, single, was a Medicine graduate from Sydney University, New South Wales. A member and Medical Officer for F. Wild's Western Base (Queen Mary Land), he participated in several sledging journeys in 1912 and led the party that explored westward to Gaussberg.

 A. L. KENNEDY, 22 years old, single, was a Science student at Adelaide University, South Australia. With specialized training, he served as Magnetician at the Western Base (Queen Mary Land) during 1912. He joined several sledging parties and accompanied F. Wild on his main eastern journey as Cartographer.

 C. F. LASERON, 25 years old, single, obtained a Diploma in Geology from the Technical College in Sydney, New South Wales, and worked as Collector for the Technological Museum for several years. At the Main Base (Adelie Land) in 1912, he acted as Taxidermist and general Collector, and also joined sledging journeys to the south and east of Winter Quarters.

 C. T. MADIGAN, 23 years old, single, was a Mining Engineering graduate from Adelaide University, South Australia. With the Trustees of the Rhodes Scholarship's approval, he was granted leave to accompany the Expedition just before he was set to continue his studies at Oxford University. As a member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land), he served as Meteorologist for two years and was in charge of the Greenland dogs during the second year (1913). He led an important spring journey and one to the east in the summer, while the Party left in Adelie Land in 1913 was supposed to be under his charge, were it not for my return.

 D. MAWSON, 30 years old, single, was the Organizer and Leader of the Australasian Antarctic Expedition and was previously a part of Sir Ernest Shackleton's Antarctic Expedition from 1907-1909, among the party led by Professor David that reached the South Magnetic Pole. A graduate in Science and Engineering from Sydney and Adelaide Universities, he had been a Lecturer in Mineralogy and Petrology at Adelaide University for some time. He was the only survivor from a party that sledged east from the Main Base in the summer of 1912-1913.

 A. L. McLEAN, 26 years old, single, was a graduate in Arts and Medicine from Sydney University, New South Wales. He served as Chief Medical Officer at the Main Base (Adelie Land) where he conducted observations in Bacteriology and Physiology during the first year. In 1913 (the second year), he was the Biologist, Ice-Carrier, and Editor of the 'Adelie Blizzard', participating in a sledging journey along the eastern coast in the summer of 1912-1913.

 X. MERTZ, 28 years old, single, from Basle, Switzerland, was a Law graduate from the Universities of Leipzig and Berne. Prior to joining the Expedition, he had won the Ski-running Championship in Switzerland and was an experienced mountaineer. At the Main Base (Adelie Land), he was assisted by B. E. S. Ninnis in caring for the Greenland dogs. On January 7, 1913, during a sledging journey, he lost his life, a hundred miles southeast of Winter Quarters.

 C. P. DE LA MOTTE, 19 years old, single, from Bulli, New South Wales, had early maritime training on the barque 'Northern Chief' from New Zealand, obtaining his certificate as second mate in March 1911. For the eight months before joining the Expedition, he served as fourth officer on the S.S. 'Warrimoo' of the Union Steamship Company of New Zealand. Throughout the five cruises of the 'Aurora' from 1911 to 1914, C. P. de la Motte was the third officer in the Ship's party.

 M. H. MOYES, 25 years old, single, from Koolunga, South Australia, was a Science graduate from Adelaide University. He was part of the Western Base Party (Queen Mary Land), where he served as Meteorologist and took part in various sledging journeys in the autumn and spring of 1912. During the summer of 2012-2013, he was left to continue work alone at Winter Quarters for nine weeks due to an unavoidable accident.

 H. D. MURPHY, 32 years old, single, from Melbourne, was once a History Scholar at Oxford University. Initially, he was to lead a third Antarctic Base that eventually merged with the Main Base (Adelie Land). There, he managed the stores and was the leader of the Southern Supporting Party during the early summer of 1912.

 B. E. S. NINNIS, 23 years old, single, was educated at Dulwich, England, and entered His Majesty's Army, holding a commission as Lieutenant in the Royal Fusiliers before joining the Expedition in London. At the Main Base (Adelie Land), he was assisted by X. Mertz in the care of the Greenland dogs. On December 14, 1912, while on a sledging journey, he fell to his death in a crevasse three hundred miles east of Winter Quarters.

 C. A. SANDELL, 25 years old, single, from Surrey, England, studied electrical engineering for several years before coming to Australia in 1909 and joining the Commonwealth Branch of Telephony. With practical knowledge in wireless telegraphy, he joined the Expedition as a Wireless Operator and Mechanic, stationed with the Macquarie Island Party for two years. After A. J. Sawyer's departure in August 1913, he took full charge of the wireless station. C. A. Sandell visited Antarctica during the final cruise of the 'Aurora' in the summer of 1913-1914.

 A. J. SAWYER, 26 years old, single, was born in New Zealand. He joined the Expedition as a wireless operator from the Australasian Wireless Company, leveraging his significant experience in wireless telegraphy. He served as the chief wireless operator at the Macquarie Island Station until August 1913, when he returned to New Zealand due to illness.

 F. L. STILLWELL, 23 years old, single, was a Science graduate from Melbourne University, Victoria. As a member of the Main Base Party (Adelie Land), he served as Geologist. F. L. Stillwell led two sledging parties that conducted detailed work about sixty miles along the eastern coast of Winter Quarters.

 A. D. WATSON, 24 years old, single, was a Science graduate from Sydney University, New South Wales. A member of the Western Base Party (Queen Mary Land), he served as Geologist and participated in various sledging journeys, accompanying F. Wild on his main eastern trip during the summer of 1912-1913.

 E. N. WEBB, 22 years old, single, held an Associate degree in Civil Engineering from Canterbury University College and, for the five months prior to joining the Expedition, conducted magnetic observations under the Carnegie Institute of Washington, U.S.A. At the Main Base (Adelie Land), E. N. Webb served as Chief Magnetician, accompanying the Southern Sledging Party.

 L. A. WHETTER, 29 years old, single, graduated from Otago University, New Zealand, and joined the Expedition as Surgeon, serving in that role at the Main Base (Adelie Land) during 1912. He participated in a sledging party that explored to the west of Winter Quarters.

 F. WILD, 38 years old, single, was the Leader of the Western Base Party (Queen Mary Land). He began his career in the Merchant Service in 1889 and joined the Navy in 1900, participating in a lengthy sledge journey during Captain R. F. Scott's National Antarctic Expedition from 1901-1904, and being part of the Southern Party of Sir Ernest Shackleton's Expedition from 1907-1909. During the Australasian Expedition, he explored a new tract of land—Queen Mary Land.

 I want to especially recognize the Ship's Party who bravely faced the harsh conditions of Antarctica and the stormy Southern Ocean during five separate voyages with resilience and dedication that will always be remembered. In areas with heavy pack ice and sudden blizzard winds, Captain Davis skillfully navigated the Ship through numerous perilous situations. In a report to me about the Ship's work, he wrote positively: 

 "I want to highlight the loyal support the officers and crew of the 'Aurora' provided me. Messrs. Toucher, Fletcher, Blair, Gray, de la Motte, and Gillies, in their respective roles, performed their duties with competence and positivity, often under challenging conditions. 

 "Mr. Gillies not only managed the engines but also significantly assisted in deep-sea work through the invention of a new kind of sounding driver, used successfully during various cruises of the 'Aurora'. 

 "The Chief Officer managed the stores and equipment for the Expedition on board, in addition to his usual executive responsibilities. Messrs. Toucher, Fletcher, and Blair served in this role during different voyages. 

 "Mr. P. Gray, as Second and Navigating Officer, and Mr. C. P. de la Motte, as Third Officer, performed their duties well and thoroughly throughout the Expedition."  
 APPENDIX II  

 Scientific Work
 It should be remarked that there is no intention of furnishing
 anything more than a suggestion of the general trend of the scientific
 observations of the Expedition.  The brief statement made below
 indicates the broad lines on which the work was conducted and in some
 cases the ground which was actually covered.  It may thus give the
 general reader a clue to the nature of the scientific volumes which
 will serve to record permanently the results amassed during a period
 of more than two years.
It should be noted that this is not meant to provide anything more than a general overview of the scientific observations from the Expedition. The brief statement below highlights the main areas in which the work was carried out and, in some instances, the actual locations that were explored. This may give the average reader an idea of the scientific volumes that will permanently document the results collected over more than two years.
 Terrestrial Magnetism

 1.  Field Work.

 (a) Dip determinations were made at Macquarie Island, on the eastern
 and southern journeys from the Main Base (Adelie Land) and on a
 short journey from the Western Base (Queen Mary Land).

 (b) Declination by theodolite observations was determined at
 Macquarie Island and at intervals on all sledging journeys in the
 Antarctic.

 (c) Rough observations of magnetic variation were made daily on the
 'Aurora' during her five cruises.

 2.  Station Work.

 (a) Regular magnetograph records were kept at the Main Base (Adelie Land)
 for a period of eighteen months.  A system of term days for quick runs
 was also followed; Melbourne, Christchurch, and other stations co
 operating.  In connexion with the magnetograph work, Webb conducted
 regular, absolute observations throughout the year 1912.  Bage continued
 the magnetograph records for a further six months in 1913, observed
 term days, and took absolute observations.

 (b) At the Western Base (Queen Mary Land) Kennedy kept term days in
 the winter, using a magnetometer and dip-circle.
Terrestrial Magnetism

 1.  Field Work.

 (a) We determined the dip at Macquarie Island during the eastern and southern trips from the Main Base (Adelie Land) and on a short trip from the Western Base (Queen Mary Land).

 (b) We assessed the declination using theodolite observations at Macquarie Island and at intervals during all sledging trips in Antarctica.

 (c) We made daily rough observations of magnetic variation on the 'Aurora' during her five voyages.

 2.  Station Work.

 (a) We kept regular magnetograph records at the Main Base (Adelie Land) for eighteen months. We also followed a system of term days for quick runs, collaborating with Melbourne, Christchurch, and other stations. In relation to the magnetograph work, Webb carried out regular absolute observations throughout 1912. Bage continued the magnetograph records for another six months in 1913, observed term days, and took absolute observations.

 (b) At the Western Base (Queen Mary Land), Kennedy maintained term days during the winter, using a magnetometer and dip-circle.
 Biology

 1.  Station Collections.

 (a) At Macquarie Island, Hamilton worked for two years amongst a rich
 fauna and a scanty but interesting flora.  Amongst other discoveries
 a finch indigenous to Macquarie Island was found.

 (b) In Adelie Land, Hunter, assisted by Laseron, secured a large
 biological collection, notwithstanding the continuous bad weather.
 Dredgings from depths down to fifty fathoms were made during the
 winter.  The eggs of practically all the flying birds known along
 Antarctic shores were obtained, including those of the silver-grey
 petrel and the Antarctic petrel, which were not previously known;
 also a variety of prion, of an unrecorded species, together with its
 eggs.

 (c) At the Western Base (Queen Mary Land) eggs of the Antarctic and
 other petrels were found, and a large rookery of Emperor penguins was
 located; the second on record.  Harrisson, working under difficulties,
 succeeded in trapping some interesting fish on the bottom in two
 hundred and fifty fathoms of water.

 2.  Ship Collections.

 (a) A collection made by Mr. E. R. Waite, Curator of the Canterbury
 Museum, on the first Sub-Antarctic cruise.

 (b) A collection made by Professor T. T. Flynn, of Hobart, on the
 second Sub-Antarctic cruise.

 (c) A collection made by Hunter, assisted by Hamilton, in Antarctic
 waters during the summer of 1913-1914.  This comprised deep-sea
 dredgings at eleven stations in depths down to one thousand eight
 hundred fathoms and regular tow-nettings, frequently serial, to
 depths of two hundred fathoms.  Six specimens of the rare Ross seal
 were secured.  A large collection of external and internal parasites
 was made from birds, seals and fish.
Biology

1. Station Collections.

(a) At Macquarie Island, Hamilton spent two years exploring a diverse range of wildlife and a sparse but fascinating range of plants. Among other findings, a finch native to Macquarie Island was discovered.

(b) In Adelie Land, Hunter, with help from Laseron, gathered a significant biological collection despite the constant bad weather. Dredgings were taken from depths of up to fifty fathoms during the winter. Eggs from nearly all the flying birds known along the Antarctic coasts were collected, including those of the silver-grey petrel and the Antarctic petrel, which had not been previously documented; as well as a variety of prion of an unrecorded species, along with its eggs.

(c) At the Western Base (Queen Mary Land), eggs from Antarctic and other petrels were found, and a large rookery of Emperor penguins was discovered; the second ever recorded. Harrisson, working under challenging conditions, managed to catch some interesting fish from the seabed at two hundred and fifty fathoms deep.

2. Ship Collections.

(a) A collection made by Mr. E. R. Waite, Curator of the Canterbury Museum, during the first Sub-Antarctic cruise.

(b) A collection made by Professor T. T. Flynn, of Hobart, during the second Sub-Antarctic cruise.

(c) A collection made by Hunter, with assistance from Hamilton, in Antarctic waters during the summer of 1913-1914. This included deep-sea dredgings from eleven stations at depths of up to one thousand eight hundred fathoms and regular tow-nettings, often serial, to depths of two hundred fathoms. Six specimens of the rare Ross seal were collected. A large collection of external and internal parasites was gathered from birds, seals, and fish.
 Geology

 (a) A geological examination of Macquarie Island was made by Blake.
 The older rocks were found to be all igneous.  The Island has been
 overridden in comparatively recent times by an ice-cap travelling
 from west to east.

 (b) Geological collections at the Main Base.  In Adelie Land the rocky
 outcrops are metamorphic sediments and gneisses.  In King George V
 Land there is a formation similar to the Beacon sandstones and dolerites
 of the Ross Sea, with which carbonaceous shales and coaly strata are
 associated.

 (c) Stillwell met with a great range of minerals and rocks in the
 terminal moraine near Winter Quarters, Adelie Land.  Amongst them was
 red sandstone in abundance, suggesting that the Beacon sandstone
 formation extends also throughout Adelie Land but is hidden by the
 ice-cap.  A solitary stony meteorite was found by a sledging party
 lying on the ice of the plateau.

 (d) In the collections made by Watson and Hoadley at the Western
 Base (Queen Mary Land) gneisses and schists were ascertained to be
 the predominant types.

 (e) A collection of erratics was brought up by the deep-sea trawl in
 the course of dredgings in Antarctic waters.
Geology

(a) Blake conducted a geological examination of Macquarie Island. The older rocks found were all igneous. The Island has been covered in relatively recent times by an ice cap moving from west to east.

(b) Geological collections at the Main Base. In Adelie Land, the rocky outcrops are metamorphic sediments and gneisses. In King George V Land, there is a formation similar to the Beacon sandstones and dolerites of the Ross Sea, which are associated with carbonaceous shales and coaly layers.

(c) Stillwell encountered a wide range of minerals and rocks in the terminal moraine near Winter Quarters, Adelie Land. Among them was an abundant amount of red sandstone, suggesting that the Beacon sandstone formation also extends throughout Adelie Land but is covered by the ice cap. A single stony meteorite was found by a sledging party lying on the ice of the plateau.

(d) In the collections made by Watson and Hoadley at the Western Base (Queen Mary Land), gneisses and schists were found to be the predominant types.

(e) A collection of erratics was brought up by the deep-sea trawl during dredging in Antarctic waters.
 Glaciology

 (a) Observations of the pack-ice, coastal glaciers and shelf-ice from
 the 'Aurora' during her three Antarctic cruises.

 (b) Observations of the niveous and glacial features met with on the
 sledging journeys from both Antarctic bases.
Glaciology

(a) Observations of the pack ice, coastal glaciers, and shelf ice from the 'Aurora' during her three Antarctic trips.

(b) Observations of the snowy and glacial features encountered on the sledding journeys from both Antarctic bases.
 Meteorology

 (a) Two years' observations at Macquarie Island by Ainsworth

 (b) Two years' observations in Adelie Land by Madigan.

 (c) One year's observations in Queen Mary Land by Moyes.

 (d) Observations by the Ship on each of her five voyages.

 (e) Observations during the many sledging journeys from both
       Antarctic Bases.
Meteorology

(a) Two years of observations at Macquarie Island by Ainsworth

(b) Two years of observations in Adelie Land by Madigan.

(c) One year of observations in Queen Mary Land by Moyes.

(d) Observations made by the Ship on each of her five voyages.

(e) Observations during the various sledging journeys from both Antarctic Bases.
 Bacteriology, etc.

 In Adelie Land, McLean carried out many months of steady work in
 Bacteriology, Haematology and Physiology.
Bacteriology, etc.

In Adelie Land, McLean spent several months doing consistent work in Bacteriology, Hematology, and Physiology.
 Tides

 Self-recording instruments were run at Macquarie Island by Ainsworth
 and at Adelie Land by Bage.
Tides

Self-recording instruments were operated at Macquarie Island by Ainsworth and at Adelie Land by Bage.
 Wireless and Auroral  Observations

 A very close watch was kept upon auroral phenomena with interesting
 results, especially in their relation to the "permeability" of the
 ether to wireless waves.

Wireless and Auroral Observations

A very close watch was kept on auroral phenomena with interesting results, especially regarding the "permeability" of the ether to wireless waves.
 Geographical Results

 1.  The successful navigation by the 'Aurora' of the Antarctic pack
 ice in a fresh sphere of action, where the conditions were practically
 unknown, resulting in the discovery of new lands and islands.

 2.  Journeys were made over the sea-ice and on the coastal and upland
 plateau in regions hitherto unsurveyed.  At the Main Base (Adelie
 Land) the journeys aggregated two thousand four hundred miles, and at
 the Western Base (Queen Mary Land) the aggregate was eight hundred
 miles.  These figures do not include depot journeys, the journeys of
 supporting parties, or the many miles of relay work.  The land was
 mapped in through 33 degrees of longitude, 27 degrees of which were
 covered by sledging parties.

 3.  The employment of wireless telegraphy in the fixation of a
 fundamental meridian in Adelie Land.

 4.  The mapping of Macquarie Island.
Geographical Results

1. The successful navigation of the 'Aurora' through the Antarctic pack ice in a new area, where conditions were mostly unknown, led to the discovery of new lands and islands.

2. Journeys were made over the sea ice and on the coastal and upland plateau in regions that had never been surveyed before. At the Main Base (Adelie Land), the journeys totaled two thousand four hundred miles, and at the Western Base (Queen Mary Land), the total was eight hundred miles. These figures do not include depot journeys, journeys of supporting parties, or the many miles of relay work. The land was mapped across 33 degrees of longitude, with 27 degrees covered by sledging parties.

3. The use of wireless telegraphy to establish a fundamental meridian in Adelie Land.

4. The mapping of Macquarie Island.
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATIONS]

 A Section of the Antarctic Plateau from the Coast to a Point Three
 Hundred Miles Inland, along the Route followed by the Southern
 Sledging Party (Adelie Land)

 A Section across the Antarctic Continent through the South Magnetic
 Pole from the D'Urville Sea to the Ross Sea; Compiled from Observations
 made by the British Antarctic Expedition (1907-1909) and by the
 Australian Antarctic Expedition (1911-1914)
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATIONS]

 A Section of the Antarctic Plateau from the Coast to a Point Three
 Hundred Miles Inland, along the Route followed by the Southern
 Sledging Party (Adelie Land)

 A Section across the Antarctic Continent through the South Magnetic
 Pole from the D'Urville Sea to the Ross Sea; Compiled from Observations
 made by the British Antarctic Expedition (1907-1909) and by the
 Australian Antarctic Expedition (1911-1914)
 Oceanography

 1.  By soundings the fringe of the Antarctic Continent as well as the
 Continental Shelf has been indicated through 55 degrees of longitude.

 2.  The configuration of the floor of the ocean southward of Australia
 and between Macquarie Island and the Auckland Islands has been broadly
 ascertained.

 3.  Much has been done in the matter of sea-water temperatures and
 salinities.
Oceanography

1. By soundings, the edge of the Antarctic Continent and the Continental Shelf has been mapped out through 55 degrees of longitude.

2. The layout of the ocean floor south of Australia and between Macquarie Island and the Auckland Islands has been generally determined.

3. A lot of work has been done regarding sea-water temperatures and salinities.
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATIONS]

 A Section of the Floor of the Southern Ocean between Tasmania
 and King George V Land

 A Section of the Floor of the Southern Ocean between Western
 Australia and Queen Mary Land
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATIONS]

 A Section of the Floor of the Southern Ocean between Tasmania
 and King George V Land

 A Section of the Floor of the Southern Ocean between Western
 Australia and Queen Mary Land
 APPENDIX Ill

 An Historical Summary**
APPENDIX III

A Historical Summary
      ** For this compilation reference has been largely made to Dr. H. R.
 Mill's "The Siege of the South Pole."  Several doubtful voyages
 during the early part of the nineteenth century have been omitted.

 1775.  James Cook circumnavigated the Globe in high southern
 latitudes, discovering the sub-antarctic island of South Georgia.
 He was the first to cross the Antarctic Circle.

 1819.  William Smith, the master of a merchant vessel trading between
 Montevideo and Valparaiso, discovered the South Shetland Islands.

 1819.  Fabian Gottlieb von Bellingshausen, despatched in command of an
 Expedition by the Emperor, Alexander I of Russia, with instructions
 to supplement the voyage of Captain Cook, circumnavigated the
 Antarctic continent in high southern latitudes.  The first discovery
 of land south of the Antarctic Circle was made, namely, Peter I Island
 and Alexander I Land (also an island), in the American Quadrant of
 Antarctica.

 1820.  Nathaniel Palmer, master of an American sealing-vessel, sighted
 new land to the south of the South Shetland Islands.  It seems clear
 that he was the first to view what is now known as the Palmer
 Archipelago (1820-21).

 1823.  James Weddell, a British sealer, sailing southward of the
 Atlantic Ocean, reached 74 degrees 15' south latitude in the American
 Quadrant, establishing a "farthest south" record.

 1830.  John Biscoe, a whaling master of the British firm of Enderby
 Brothers, sailed on a voyage circumnavigating the Antarctic Regions.
 Enderby Land was discovered south of the West Indian Ocean in the
 African Quadrant of Antarctica.  This was apparently a part of the
 Antarctic continent.  New land was also met with to the south of
 America and charted as Graham's Land, Biscoe Island and Adelaide
 Island.

 Kemp, a sailing master of Enderby Brothers, extended Biscoe's
 discoveries shortly after by the report of land east of, and
 adjacent to, Enderby Land.

 Neither of these discoveries has yet been proved, though Enderby Land
 (Biscoe) undoubtedly exists.

 1839.  John Balleny, another of Enderby's whaling captains, discovered
 the Balleny Islands within the Antarctic Circle, in the Australian
 Quadrant of Antarctica, and gave a vague description of an appearance
 of land to the westward.  This has been charted on maps, without
 adequate evidence, as Sabrina Land.
      ** For this compilation, references have mainly been made to Dr. H. R. Mill's "The Siege of the South Pole." Several questionable voyages from the early nineteenth century have been left out.

 1775. James Cook sailed around the globe in the high southern latitudes, discovering the sub-Antarctic island of South Georgia. He was the first to cross the Antarctic Circle.

 1819. William Smith, the captain of a merchant ship trading between Montevideo and Valparaiso, found the South Shetland Islands.

 1819. Fabian Gottlieb von Bellingshausen, sent on an expedition by Emperor Alexander I of Russia with instructions to build on Captain Cook's voyage, circumnavigated the Antarctic continent in the high southern latitudes. This led to the first discovery of land south of the Antarctic Circle, specifically Peter I Island and Alexander I Land (also an island), in the American Quadrant of Antarctica.

 1820. Nathaniel Palmer, captain of an American sealing vessel, spotted new land south of the South Shetland Islands. It appears he was the first to see what is now known as the Palmer Archipelago (1820-21).

 1823. James Weddell, a British sealer, sailing south in the Atlantic Ocean, reached 74 degrees 15' south latitude in the American Quadrant, setting a record for the "farthest south."

 1830. John Biscoe, a whaling captain from the British firm Enderby Brothers, embarked on a voyage circling the Antarctic Regions. He discovered Enderby Land south of the West Indian Ocean in the African Quadrant of Antarctica. This was likely part of the Antarctic continent. He also encountered new land south of America, which he charted as Graham's Land, Biscoe Island, and Adelaide Island.

 Kemp, a captain from Enderby Brothers, expanded Biscoe's discoveries shortly after by reporting land east of and next to Enderby Land.

 Neither of these discoveries has been confirmed yet, though Enderby Land (Biscoe) definitely exists.

 1839. John Balleny, another of Enderby's whaling captains, discovered the Balleny Islands within the Antarctic Circle, in the Australian Quadrant of Antarctica, and provided a vague description of what appeared to be land to the west. This has been marked on maps as Sabrina Land, despite insufficient evidence.
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

 Antarctic Land Discoveries Preceding 1838

 Note.  This and the two following maps of the series illustrate land
 discoveries only.  In cases where the existence of land once reported
 has since been disproved no record at all is shown
 [TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

 Antarctic Land Discoveries Before 1838

 Note. This and the next two maps in the series show only land discoveries. If the existence of any land that was previously reported has since been proven false, no record is displayed.
 1837.  Jules Sebastian Cesar Dumont D'Urville, was despatched by King
 Louis Philippe of France for the prosecution of scientific researches
 on a voyage round the World.  His cruise in the Antarctic resulted in
 the charting of Joinville Island and Louis Philippe Land to the south
 of America (American Quadrant) and the discovery of a portion of the
 Antarctic continent, named Adelie Land, southward of Australia
 (Australian Quadrant).

 1838.  Charles Wilkes, United States Navy, in accordance with a bill
 passed by Congress, set out on an exploring expedition to circumnavigate
 the World.  His programme included the investigation of the area of
 the Antarctic to the south of Australia—the Australian Quadrant.
 The squadron composing this American expedition first visited the
 Antarctic regions in the American Quadrant, and then proceeded eastward
 round to the Australian Quadrant from which, after a long cruise, they
 returned, reporting land at frequent intervals in the vicinity of the
 Antarctic Circle between longitudes 157 degrees 46' E. and 106 degrees
 19' E.  He shares with D'Urville the full honour of the discovery of
 Adelie Land.  Some of the supposed landfalls known to be non-existent.

 1839.  James Clark Ross proceeded south in charge of a scientific
 expedition fitted out by the Admiralty at the instance of the British
 Association for the Advancement of Science and approved of by the Royal
 Society.  His aim was to circumnavigate the Antarctic regions and to
 investigate the Weddell Sea.  The geographical results were fruitful;
 the Ross Sea, the Admiralty Range and the Great Ice Barrier were
 discovered and some eight hundred miles of Antarctic coastline were
 broadly delineated.

 1844.  T. E. L. Moore was detailed by the Admiralty to supplement
 the magnetic work of Ross and to explore to the southward of Africa
 and of the Indian Ocean, but no additions were made to geographical
 knowledge.

 1872.  Eduard Dallmann, whilst engaged in whaling with a German
 steamer to the southward of America, added some details to the map of
 the Palmer Archipelago but did not go further south than 64 degrees
 45' S. Iatitude.

 1874.  The 'Challenger' scientific expedition, under the command of
 George Strong Nares, in the course of their voyage from the Cape to
 Australia during the circumnavigation of the World penetrated within
 the Antarctic Circle in longitude 78 degrees 22' E.

 1892.  A fleet of four Scottish whalers cruised through the north
 western part of the Weddell Sea.  Scientific observations were made
 by W. S. Bruce and others, but no geographical discoveries were
 recorded.

 1892.  C. A. Larsen, master of a Hamburg whaler, added important
 details to the geography of the American Quadrant of Antarctica on
 the western side of the Weddell Sea.

 1894.  Evensen, master of another Hamburg whaler, brought back further
 information of the American Quadrant on the Pacific Ocean side.

 1895.  H.  J.  Bull organized a whaling venture and with Leonard
 Kristensen, master of the ship, revisited the Ross Sea area where
 a landing was made at Cape Adare (Australian Quadrant).  This was the
 first occasion on which any human being had set foot on the Antarctic
 continent.

 [TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

 Antarctic land Discoveries Preceding 1896    (A. J. Hodgeman)
1837. Jules Sebastian Cesar Dumont D'Urville was sent by King Louis Philippe of France to conduct scientific research on a voyage around the world. His journey in the Antarctic led to the mapping of Joinville Island and Louis Philippe Land south of America (American Quadrant) and the discovery of a part of the Antarctic continent, named Adelie Land, south of Australia (Australian Quadrant).

1838. Charles Wilkes, from the United States Navy, set off on an exploratory expedition to sail around the world, following a bill passed by Congress. His plan included exploring the Antarctic area south of Australia—the Australian Quadrant. This American expedition first visited the Antarctic regions in the American Quadrant and then traveled eastward around to the Australian Quadrant. After a lengthy cruise, they returned, reporting land sightings at regular intervals near the Antarctic Circle between longitudes 157 degrees 46' E. and 106 degrees 19' E. He shares the full honor of discovering Adelie Land with D'Urville, although some of the supposed landfalls were later found to be non-existent.

1839. James Clark Ross led a scientific expedition organized by the Admiralty at the request of the British Association for the Advancement of Science, with approval from the Royal Society. His goal was to navigate the Antarctic regions and explore the Weddell Sea. The geographical findings were significant; Ross Sea, the Admiralty Range, and the Great Ice Barrier were discovered, and about eight hundred miles of Antarctic coastline were broadly mapped.

1844. T. E. L. Moore was assigned by the Admiralty to support Ross's magnetic work and explore southward of Africa and the Indian Ocean, but no new geographical knowledge was gained.

1872. Eduard Dallmann, while whaling with a German steamer south of America, added more details to the map of the Palmer Archipelago but did not go further south than 64 degrees 45' S. latitude.

1874. The 'Challenger' scientific expedition, led by George Strong Nares, penetrated within the Antarctic Circle at longitude 78 degrees 22' E during their journey from the Cape to Australia while circumnavigating the world.

1892. A fleet of four Scottish whalers cruised through the northwestern part of the Weddell Sea. Scientific observations were made by W. S. Bruce and others, but no geographical discoveries were recorded.

1892. C. A. Larsen, captain of a Hamburg whaler, contributed important details to the geography of the American Quadrant of Antarctica on the western side of the Weddell Sea.

1894. Evensen, captain of another Hamburg whaler, provided further information about the American Quadrant on the Pacific Ocean side.

1895. H. J. Bull organized a whaling venture and, with Leonard Kristensen, the ship's captain, revisited the Ross Sea area, where they landed at Cape Adare (Australian Quadrant). This marked the first time any human had set foot on the Antarctic continent.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

Antarctic land Discoveries Preceding 1896 (A. J. Hodgeman)
 1897.  Adrien de Gerlache sailed from Belgium on a scientific exploring
 expedition to the American Quadrant.  Important additions were made to
 the map, but the ship became frozen into the pack-ice and drifted about
 for a whole year south of the Antarctic Circle.  The members of this
 expedition were the first to experience an Antarctic winter.  Antarctic
 exploration now entered upon a new era.

 1898.  Carstens Egeberg Borchgrevink led an expedition, fitted out by
 Sir George Newnes; its objective being the Ross Sea area.  Further
 details were added to the map, but the most notable fact was that the
 expedition wintered at Cape Adare, on the mainland itself.  The Great
 Ross Barrier was determined to be thirty miles south of the position
 assigned by Ross in 1839.

 1898.  Chun of Leipsig, in charge of the 'Valdivia' Expedition, carried
 out oceanographical researches far to the south, in the vicinity of
 Enderby Land (African Quadrant), though he did not come within sight
 of the continent.

 1901.  Robert Falcon Scott, in command of the 'Discovery' Expedition,
 organised by the Royal Geographical Society and Royal Society with
 the co-operation of the Admiralty, in accordance with a scheme of
 international endeavour, passed two winters at the southern extremity
 of the Ross Sea and carried out many successful sledging journeys.
 Their main geographical achievements were: the discovery of King
 Edward VII Land; several hundred miles of new land on a "farthest
 south" sledging journey to latitude 82 degrees 17' S.; the discovery
 of the Antarctic plateau; additional details and original contributions
 to the geography of the lands and islands of the Ross Sea.

 1901.  A German national expedition, led by Erich von Drygalski, set
 out for the region south of the Indian Ocean.  After a small party
 had been stationed on Kerguelen Island, the main party proceeded
 south close to the tracks of the Challenger.  They came within sight
 of Antarctic shores but were frozen into the pack-ice for a whole
 year.  Kaiser Wilhelm II Land was discovered close to the junction
 between the Australian and African Quadrants.

 1901.  A Swedish national expedition, planned and led by Otto
 Nordenskjold, wintered for two years on Snow Hill Island in the
 American Quadrant, and did much valuable scientific work.

 1902.  William Speirs Bruce organized and led a Scottish expedition to
 the Weddell Sea, southward of the Atlantic Ocean.  The party effected
 notable oceanographic researches and wintered at the South Orkney
 Islands, but were foiled in their attempt to penetrate the pack-ice.
 During the second season, conditions were more favourable and the ship
 reached Coats Land in 74 degrees 1' S. Iatitude.

 1903.  Jean Charcot organized and led a French expedition to the
 American Quadrant and there added many details to the existing chart.

 1907.  Ernest Henry Shackleton organized and led a British
 expedition with the main object of reaching the South Geographical
 Pole.  His party wintered at Cape Royds, McMurdo Sound, and two main
 sledging parties set out in the early summer.  E. H. Shackleton's
 party ascended the Antarctic plateau and penetrated to within ninety
 seven geographical miles of the South Pole, discovering new land beyond
 Scott's "farthest south."  T. W. Edgeworth David's party reached the
 South Magnetic Polar Area, filling in many details of the western coast
 of McMurdo Sound.

 1908.  Jean Charcot organized and led a second French expedition to
 extend the work accomplished in 1903 in the American Quadrant.  He was
 successful in discovering new land still further to the south.
 Loubet, Fallieres and Charcot Lands, towards and beyond Alexander I
 Land, were added to the map of Antarctica.

 1910.  Roald Amundsen organized an expedition for scientific research
 in the vicinity of the North Pole but changed his plans, eventually
 heading for the South Pole.  The expedition wintered on the Ross
 Barrier near King Edward VII Land, from which point he set out and
 attained the South Geographical Pole, mapping in new land on the way.
 Another party visited King Edward VII Land.

 1910.  Robert Falcon Scott led a second Antarctic expedition, the main
 object of which was to reach the South Geographical Pole.  The
 principal party wintered near his old winter quarters at Hut Point,
 McMurdo Sound.  A second party was landed at Cape Adare.  Scott
 reached the Pole soon after the Norwegian Amundsen, but he and his
 party perished on the return journey.  Other parties added details to
 the map of Victoria Land.  Oates Land was sighted from the ship to the
 westward of Cape Adare in the Australian Quadrant.

 1910.  A Japanese expedition sailed to the Ross Sea, but on account of
 the lateness of the season was forced to turn back without landing.
 The winter was spent at Sydney, New South Wales.  Next year a summer
 visit was made to the South, but no additional land discoveries were
 made.

 1911.  A German expedition, led by Wilhelm Filchner, proceeded to the
 Weddell Sea; the South Pole being its objective.  The party
 succeeded in reaching further south in that region than any previous
 navigators and discovered new land, to be named Prince Luitpold Land.
 They were driven northwards amongst the pack in a blizzard and spent
 the winter frozen in south of Coats Land.

 [TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

         A Map of the Antarctic Regions as Known at the Present Day
             1915
1897. Adrien de Gerlache set sail from Belgium on a scientific exploration trip to the American Quadrant. Important additions were made to the map, but the ship got trapped in the pack ice and drifted around for an entire year south of the Antarctic Circle. The members of this expedition were the first to experience an Antarctic winter. Antarctic exploration entered a new era.

1898. Carstens Egeberg Borchgrevink led an expedition, funded by Sir George Newnes, aimed at the Ross Sea area. More details were added to the map, but the most significant result was that the expedition wintered at Cape Adare, on the mainland itself. The Great Ross Barrier was found to be thirty miles south of where Ross had placed it in 1839.

1898. Chun of Leipzig, in charge of the 'Valdivia' Expedition, conducted oceanographic research far to the south, near Enderby Land (African Quadrant), although he did not sight the continent.

1901. Robert Falcon Scott commanded the 'Discovery' Expedition, organized by the Royal Geographical Society and Royal Society with the support of the Admiralty as part of an international effort, and spent two winters at the southern tip of the Ross Sea while undertaking many successful sledging journeys. Their primary geographical achievements included the discovery of King Edward VII Land, several hundred miles of new land during a “farthest south” sledging journey to latitude 82 degrees 17' S, the discovery of the Antarctic plateau, and additional details and original contributions to the geography of the lands and islands of the Ross Sea.

1901. A German national expedition, led by Erich von Drygalski, headed for the region south of the Indian Ocean. After a small group was stationed on Kerguelen Island, the main party went south, closely following the tracks of the Challenger. They spotted Antarctic shores but got trapped in the pack ice for a year. Kaiser Wilhelm II Land was discovered near the junction of the Australian and African Quadrants.

1901. A Swedish national expedition, planned and led by Otto Nordenskjold, wintered for two years on Snow Hill Island in the American Quadrant, where they conducted valuable scientific research.

1902. William Speirs Bruce organized and led a Scottish expedition to the Weddell Sea, south of the Atlantic Ocean. The party conducted significant oceanographic research and wintered at the South Orkney Islands, but their attempt to penetrate the pack ice was unsuccessful. During the second season, conditions improved, allowing the ship to reach Coats Land at latitude 74 degrees 1' S.

1903. Jean Charcot planned and led a French expedition to the American Quadrant, contributing many details to the existing chart.

1907. Ernest Henry Shackleton organized and led a British expedition primarily aimed at reaching the South Geographical Pole. His party wintered at Cape Royds, McMurdo Sound, and two main sledging parties set out in early summer. Shackleton’s group ascended the Antarctic plateau and got within ninety-seven geographical miles of the South Pole, discovering new land beyond Scott's “farthest south.” T. W. Edgeworth David's party reached the South Magnetic Polar Area, filling in many details of the western coast of McMurdo Sound.

1908. Jean Charcot organized and led a second French expedition to extend the work done in 1903 in the American Quadrant. He successfully discovered new land even further south. Loubet, Fallières, and Charcot Lands, towards and beyond Alexander I Land, were added to the map of Antarctica.

1910. Roald Amundsen organized an expedition for scientific research near the North Pole but changed his plans and headed for the South Pole instead. The expedition spent the winter on the Ross Barrier near King Edward VII Land, from where he set out and reached the South Geographical Pole, mapping new land along the way. Another party visited King Edward VII Land.

1910. Robert Falcon Scott led a second Antarctic expedition, primarily aimed at reaching the South Geographical Pole. The main party wintered near his previous winter quarters at Hut Point, McMurdo Sound, while a second party was landed at Cape Adare. Scott reached the Pole soon after the Norwegian Amundsen, but he and his team perished on the way back. Other parties contributed further details to the map of Victoria Land. Oates Land was sighted from the ship west of Cape Adare in the Australian Quadrant.

1910. A Japanese expedition sailed to the Ross Sea but, due to the late season, was forced to turn back without landing. They spent the winter in Sydney, New South Wales. The following year they made a summer visit to the South, but no new land discoveries were made.

1911. A German expedition, led by Wilhelm Filchner, journeyed to the Weddell Sea, aiming for the South Pole. The party succeeded in going further south in that region than any previous navigators and discovered new land, named Prince Luitpold Land. They were pushed northwards into the pack in a blizzard and spent the winter frozen south of Coats Land.

[TEXT ILLUSTRATION]

         A Map of the Antarctic Regions as Known at the Present Day
             1915
 APPENDIX IV

 Glossary

 Oceanography.  The study of the ocean, including the shape and
 character of its bed, the temperature and salinity of the water at
 various depths, the force and set of its currents, and the nature of
 the creatures and plants which haunt its successive zones.

 Neve.  [n,e acute, v, e acute] The compacted snow of a snow-field;
 a stage in the transition between soft, loose snow and glacier-ice.

 Sastrugi.  The waves caused by continuous winds blowing across the
 surface of an expanse of snow.  These waves vary in size according to
 the force and continuity of the wind and the compactness of the snow.
 The word is of Russian derivation (from zastruga [sing.], zastrugi
 [pl.] ), denoting snow-waves or the irregularities on the surface of
 roughly-planed wood.

 Ice-foot.  A sheath of ice adhering along the shores of polar lands.
 The formation may be composed of attached remnants of floe-ice,
 frozen sea-spray and drift-snow.

 Nunatak.  An island-like outcrop of rock projecting through a sheet of
 enveloping land-ice.

 Shelf-ice.  A thick, floating, fresh water ice-formation pushing out
 from the land and continuous with an extensive glacier.  Narrow
 prolongations or peninsulas of the shelf-ice may be referred to as
 ice-tongues or glacier-tongues.

 Barrier is a term which has been rather loosely applied in the
 literature of Antarctic Exploration.  Formerly it was used to
 describe a formation, which is mainly shelf-ice, known as the Great
 Ross Barrier.  Confusion arose when "Barrier" came to be applied to
 the seaward ice-cliff (resting on rock) of an extensive sheet of
 land-ice and when it was also employed to designate a line of
 consolidated pack-ice.  Spelt with a small "b" the term is a
 convenient one, so long as it carries its ordinary meaning; it seems
 unnecessary to give it a technical connotation.

 Blizzard.  A high wind at a low temperature, accompanied by drifting,
 not necessarily falling snow.

 Floe or Floe-ice.  The comparatively flat, frozen surface of the sea
 intersected by cracks and leads (channels of open water).

 Pack or Pack-ice is a field of loose ice originating in the main from
 broken floe, to which may be added material from the disintegration
 of bergs, and bergs themselves.

 Brash or Brash-ice.  Small, floating fragments of ice—the debris of
 larger pieces—usually observed bordering a tract of pack-ice.

 Bergschrund has been "freely rendered" in the description of the
 great cleft between the lower part of the Denman Glacier and the
 Shackleton Shelf-Ice (Queen Mary Land).  In a typical glacier, "the
 upper portion is hidden by neve and often by freshly fallen snow
 and is smooth and unbroken.  During the summer, when little snow
 falls, the body of the glacier moves away from the snow-field and a
 gaping crevasse of great depth is usually established, called a
 'Bergschrund', which is sometimes taken as the upper limit of the
 glacier" ("Encyclopaedia Britannica").

 Sub-Antarctica.  A general term used to denote the area of ocean,
 containing islands and encircling the Antarctic continent, between the
 vicinity of the 50th parallel of south latitude and the confines of
 the ice-covered sea.

 Seracs are wedged masses of icy pinnacles which are produced in the
 surface of a glacier by dragging strains which operate on crevassed
 areas.  A field of such pinnacles, jammed together in broken
 confusion, is called serac-ice

 The following colloquial words or phrases occurring in the narrative
 were largely determined by general usage:
 To depot = to cache or to place a stock of provisions in a depot;
 drift = drift-snow;
 fifty-mile wind = a wind of fifty miles an hour;
 burberry = "Burberry gabardine" or specially prepared wind-proof
             clothing;
 whirly (pi. whirlies) = whirlwind carrying drift-snow and pursuing a
              devious track;
 night-watchman = night-watch;
 glaxo = "Glaxo" (a powder of dried milk);
 primus = primus stove used during sledging;
 hoosh = pemmican and plasmon biscuit "porridge";
 tanks = canvas bags for holding sledging provisions;
 boil-up = sledging meal;
 ramp = bank of snow slanting away obliquely on the leeward side of an
           obstacle;
 radiant = an appearance noted in clouds (especially cirro-stratus)
               which seem to radiate from a point on the horizon

 The following appended list may be of biological interest:

      Birds                                 Aves

 Emperor penguin                          Aptenodytes forsteri
 King penguin                             Aptenodytes patagonica
 Adelie penguin                           Pygoscelis adeliae
 Royal penguin                            Catarrhactes schlegeli
 Victoria penguin                         Catarrhactes pachyrynchus
 Gentoo or Rockhopper penguin             Pygoscelis papua

 Wandering albatross                      Diomedea exulans
 Mollymawk or Black-browed albatross      Diomedea melanophrys
 Sooty albatross                          Phoebetria fuliginosa
 Giant petrel or nelly                    Ossifraga gigantea
 MacCormick's skua gull                   Megalestris maccormicki
 Southern skua gull                       Megalestris antarctica
 Antarctic petrel                         Thalassoeca antarctica
 Silver-grey petrel or southern fulmar    Priocella glacialoides
 Cape pigeon                              Daption capensis
 Snow petrel                              Pagodroma nivea
 Lesson's petrel                          Oestrelata lessoni
 Wilson petrel                            Oceanites oceanicus
 Storm petrel                             Fregetta melanogaster
 Cape hen                                 Majaqueus oequinoctialis
 Small prion or whale bird                Prion banksii
 Crested tern                             Sterna sp.
 Southern black-backed or Dominican gull  Larus dominicanus
 Macquarie Island shag                    Phalacrocorax traversi
 Mutton bird                              Puffinus griseus
 Maori hen or "weka"                    Ocydromus scotti
APPENDIX IV

Glossary

Oceanography. The study of the ocean, including the shape and characteristics of its floor, the water's temperature and salinity at various depths, the direction and strength of its currents, and the types of creatures and plants that inhabit its different zones.

Neve. [n, e acute, v, e acute] The compacted snow found in a snowfield; a stage in the transition from soft, loose snow to glacier ice.

Sastrugi. The ridges created by strong, continuous winds blowing across a snowy surface. These ridges can vary in size based on wind strength and duration, as well as the compactness of the snow. The term comes from Russian (from zastruga [sing.], zastrugi [pl.]), meaning snow waves or surface irregularities of roughly-planed wood.

Ice-foot. A layer of ice that clings to the shores of polar regions. This formation may consist of fragments of floe ice, frozen sea spray, and drift snow.

Nunatak. A rocky outcrop that rises like an island above a layer of surrounding land ice.

Shelf-ice. A thick layer of fresh-water ice that floats and extends out from land, merging with a large glacier. Narrow extensions or peninsulas of shelf-ice can be called ice tongues or glacier tongues.

Barrier is a term that has been used somewhat loosely in the literature of Antarctic Exploration. It was originally used to describe a mainly shelf-ice formation known as the Great Ross Barrier. Confusion arose when "Barrier" was also applied to the seaward ice cliff (supported by rock) of a large land-ice sheet and to describe a line of consolidated pack-ice. Written with a lowercase "b," the term is convenient as long as it retains its general meaning without needing a technical definition.

Blizzard. A strong wind at a low temperature, accompanied by drifting snow, which may not necessarily be falling.

Floe or Floe-ice. The relatively flat, frozen surface of the sea, marked by cracks and leads (channels of open water).

Pack or Pack-ice is a field of loose ice primarily made up of broken floes, which may also include material from the breaking apart of icebergs and the icebergs themselves.

Brash or Brash-ice. Small, floating ice fragments—debris from larger pieces—often seen at the edges of pack ice.

Bergschrund has been "freely rendered" in the description of the significant gap between the lower part of the Denman Glacier and the Shackleton Shelf-Ice (Queen Mary Land). In a typical glacier, "the upper section is covered by neve and often freshly fallen snow, appearing smooth and unbroken. In the summer, when there’s little snowfall, the glacier's mass pulls away from the snowfield, creating a deep crevasse called a ‘Bergschrund,’ which is sometimes considered the glacier's upper limit" ("Encyclopaedia Britannica").

Sub-Antarctica. A general term referring to the ocean area containing islands that surround the Antarctic continent, located between approximately the 50th parallel south and the edges of the ice-covered sea.

Seracs are jagged masses of ice pinnacles formed in a glacier's surface due to stress on crevassed areas. A field of such tightly packed pinnacles, jumbled together, is called serac-ice.

The following colloquial words or phrases occurring in the narrative were largely determined by general usage:
To depot = to store or cache provisions in a depot; drift = drift-snow; fifty-mile wind = a wind of fifty miles an hour; burberry = "Burberry gabardine" or special windproof clothing; whirly (pl. whirlies) = a whirlwind moving drift-snow in a winding path; night-watchman = night-watch; glaxo = "Glaxo" (a dried milk powder); primus = primus stove used for sledging; hoosh = a type of porridge made of pemmican and plasmon biscuits; tanks = canvas bags for carrying sledging supplies; boil-up = a meal during sledging; ramp = a slanted snowbank on the leeward side of an obstacle; radiant = a described appearance in clouds (especially cirro-stratus) that seems to emanate from a point on the horizon.

The following appended list may be of biological interest:

     Birds                                 Aves

Emperor penguin                          Aptenodytes forsteri
King penguin                             Aptenodytes patagonica
Adelie penguin                           Pygoscelis adeliae
Royal penguin                            Catarrhactes schlegeli
Victoria penguin                         Catarrhactes pachyrynchus
Gentoo or Rockhopper penguin             Pygoscelis papua

Wandering albatross                      Diomedea exulans
Mollymawk or Black-browed albatross      Diomedea melanophrys
Sooty albatross                          Phoebetria fuliginosa
Giant petrel or nelly                    Ossifraga gigantea
MacCormick's skua gull                   Megalestris maccormicki
Southern skua gull                       Megalestris antarctica
Antarctic petrel                         Thalassoeca antarctica
Silver-grey petrel or southern fulmar    Priocella glacialoides
Cape pigeon                              Daption capensis
Snow petrel                              Pagodroma nivea
Lesson's petrel                          Oestrelata lessoni
Wilson petrel                            Oceanites oceanicus
Storm petrel                             Fregetta melanogaster
Cape hen                                 Majaqueus oequinoctialis
Small prion or whale bird                Prion banksii
Crested tern                             Sterna sp.
Southern black-backed or Dominican gull  Larus dominicanus
Macquarie Island shag                    Phalacrocorax traversi
Mutton bird                              Puffinus griseus
Maori hen or "weka"                     Ocydromus scotti
 Seals                                    Pinnipedia

 Sea elephant                             Macrorhinus leoninus
 Sea-leopard                              Stenorhynchus leptonyax
 Weddell seal                             Leptonychotes weddelli
 Crab-eater seal                          Lobodon carcinophagus
 Ross seal                                Ommatophoca rossi

 Whales and Dolphins                      Cetacea

 Rorqual, finner, or blue whale           Balaenoptera sibbaldi
 Killer whale                             Orca gladiator
Seals                                    Pinnipedia

Sea elephant                             Macrorhinus leoninus  
Sea leopard                              Stenorhynchus leptonyax  
Weddell seal                             Leptonychotes weddelli  
Crab-eater seal                          Lobodon carcinophagus  
Ross seal                                Ommatophoca rossi  

Whales and Dolphins                      Cetacea

Rorqual, finner, or blue whale           Balaenoptera sibbaldi  
Killer whale                             Orca gladiator  
 APPENDIX V

 Medical Reports
APPENDIX V

 Health Reports
 Western Base (Queen Mary Land)

 by S. E. Jones, M.B., CH.M.

 There was a very marked absence of serious illness during the whole
 period of our stay at the Base.  After the 'Aurora' left Adelie Land
 on January 19, 1912, for her western cruise, an epidemic of influenza
 broke out.  It should be noted that one case occurred on the voyage
 south from Hobart, and then an interval of almost a month occurred
 before the infection spread.  An interesting feature of the outbreak
 was the fact that the recovery of those who were convalescing, when
 we arrived at Queen Mary Land, was much more rapid than was the case
 with those whose convalescence occurred on the Ship.

 By the careful use of snow-goggles during the summer, snow-blindness
 was practically prevented, and such cases as occurred yielded quickly
 when zinc and cocaine tablets were used and the eyes obtained rest.
 An undoubted factor in the causation of snow-blindness is the strain
 caused by the continual efforts at visual accommodation made
 necessary on dull days when the sun is obscured, and there is a
 complete absence of all light-and-shade contrast.

 Although frostbites were frequent during the winter months, immediate
 attention to the restoration of circulation prevented the occurrence
 of after-effects, so that no one suffered the loss of any more tissue
 than the superficial epithelium.  The nose, ears, fingers and toes
 were the parts which suffered first.

 Our supplies of food were excellent in point of view of variety.  Some
 tinned onions were responsible for several mild attacks of poisoning,
 but these were not used after our first experience.  There was no sign
 of scurvy in any form.

 Hoadley, on one occasion, had an unpleasant experience.  He was alone
 in the hut sleeping one night when he awoke to find the room filled
 with smoke.  On going outside he found that the chimney had become
 blocked with snow; as the fire was banked, the hut was filled with the
 gases from the imperfect combustion of the coal.  It was three or four
 days before Hoadley recovered from his experience, having marked
 symptoms of carbon monoxide poisoning.

 On my return from the Western Depot journey I found that Wild was
 suffering from an attack of herpes zoster.  The illness came on while
 he was out sledging, and he suffered severely from the pain and
 irritation.

 Beyond a few cases of minor illness, and one or two accidents, there
 was nothing of serious moment to report.
Western Base (Queen Mary Land)
by S. E. Jones, M.B., CH.M.
There was a noticeable lack of serious illness during our entire stay at the Base. After the 'Aurora' left Adelie Land on January 19, 1912, for her western cruise, an outbreak of influenza occurred. It's worth mentioning that one case appeared during the voyage south from Hobart, and then there was nearly a month before the infection spread. An interesting aspect of the outbreak was that those who were recovering when we arrived at Queen Mary Land bounced back much quicker than those who were recovering on the Ship.
By carefully using snow goggles in the summer, we were able to almost completely prevent snow blindness. The few cases that did occur responded quickly to zinc and cocaine tablets and rested eyes. A significant factor contributing to snow blindness is the strain from the constant effort to focus on dull days when the sun is hidden, and there’s no contrast between light and shadow.
Frostbite was common during the winter months, but quick action to restore circulation prevented any long-term effects, so no one lost more tissue than the surface layer. The nose, ears, fingers, and toes were the first areas affected.
Our food supplies were excellent in terms of variety. A few canned onions caused some mild food poisoning, but we stopped using them after the first incident. There were no signs of scurvy at all.
On one occasion, Hoadley had a bad experience. One night, he was alone in the hut sleeping when he woke up to find the room filled with smoke. When he went outside, he discovered that the chimney was blocked with snow; since the fire was banked, gases from the poorly burning coal filled the hut. It took him three or four days to recover, as he showed clear symptoms of carbon monoxide poisoning.
When I returned from the Western Depot journey, I found that Wild was suffering from shingles. The illness started while he was out sledging, and he experienced severe pain and discomfort.
Aside from a few minor illnesses and one or two accidents, there was nothing serious to report.
 Main Base (Adelie Land)

 by A. L. McLean, M.B., CH.M., B.A.

 Throughout the whole period of the Expedition—from December 2, 1911,
 to February 26, 1914—the health of the expedition was remarkably
 good.  Undoubtedly Antarctica has a salubrious climate, and it is
 simply because one returns in a measure to the primitive that such an
 ideal result is obtained.

 The first thing to resist is the cold, and additional clothing is the
 first and adequate means to such an end.  No one needs to be specially
 inured to a rigorous climate.  If he has a normal circulation he
 immediately reacts to a new set of temperature conditions, and in a
 few weeks may claim to be acclimatized.  Most of the members of the
 expedition were Australians, so that the change of latitudes was
 rather abrupt but none the less stimulating and healthful.

 Appetite for food had suddenly a new piquancy, hard manual work was
 a pleasure in a novel and wonderful environment, the intellect and
 imagination were quickened and the whole man embodied the mens sana
 in corpore sano.  That is why illness was practically unknown for more
 than two years; and, further, it may be said with partial truth that
 in the high sense of physical and mental fitness he possessed for a
 time, lies the explanation of the proverbial desire of an explorer
 to return to the ice-lands.

 Regular monthly examinations of the blood were made from the date of
 leaving Hobart in December 1911 until October 1912, with an interval
 of about nine weeks between the first and second examinations.  The
 haemoglobin or red colouring-matter went up with a leap and then very
 steadily increased in amount during the winter months in Adelie Land.
 The blood pressure became slightly more marked, the weight increased,
 but as one might have expected, the resistance to ordinary civilized
 germs was decreased.  With regard to weight, the maximum amount gained
 by a single individual during a period of eight weeks was almost two
 stones, and every one became heavier by as much as ten pounds.  As
 clinical evidence of the loss in immunity may be quoted the epidemic
 of influenza to which Dr. S. E. Jones referred.  As well, it was noted
 that several members had attacks of "boils" during the voyage
 southward; in Adelie Land during 1912 there were two instances of acute
 abscesses on the fingers (whitlows) and one jaw abscess.  It appears as
 if, with its new and unbounded energy of function, the body attempts to
 throw oft its waste products.  Then, too, experimental observations of
 opsonic index pointed towards the lowering of resistance, and, by the
 way, it was rather a remarkable fact that after a few months in Adelie
 Land, staphylococcus pyogenes aureus—a common germ in civilization-
 could not be cultivated artificially from the throat, nose or skin, of
 six individuals from whom monthly bacteriological cultures were made.

 Within the Hut, at a temperature which ranged from 40 degrees to
 45 degrees F., the number of micro-organisms continuously increased,
 if the exposure of agar plates at regular intervals (by night) gave
 a true indication.  The organisms were staphylocci albi, bacilli, yeasts,
 and moulds; the latter overgrowing the plate after it had been for forty
 eight hours in the incubator.

 Frostbites were common, but, perhaps for that reason, were not regarded
 seriously.  No one suffered permanent harm from being frost-bitten,
 though in several cases rather extensive blisters formed and nails and
 skin were lost.

 Whilst the Hut was being built, minor casualties often occurred; the
 common remedy being to cover the injured part with a small piece of
 gauze surrounded by adhesive tape; for open wounds will not heal
 when exposed to the cold.  The Greenland dogs had small accidents and
 ailments which often required treatment.

 On sledging journeys snow-blindness was an affection which sooner or
 later caught every one in an unguarded moment.  That moment was when
 he ceased to use goggles if the light were at all trying to his eyes.
 Prevention came first, and then the "zinc and cocaine" cure.

 Adelie Land can only be regarded as an intolerable country in which
 to live, owing to the never-ceasing winds.  Usage and necessity
 helped one to regard the weather in the best possible light; for the
 sake of a few hours of calm which might be expected to occasionally
 intervene between the long spells of the blizzards.  It is, therefore,
 with regret and some diffldence that I speak of the illness of Mr. S.
 N. Jeffryes, who took up so conscientiously the duties of wireless
 operator during the second year (1913); but upon whom the monotony
 of a troglodytic winter life made itself felt.  It is my hope that he
 is fast recovering his former vigour and enthusiasm.**

 So many miles of sledging were done at both Antarctic Bases in a
 climate which is surely without a parallel in the history of polar
 travelling, the Ship was so often in jeopardy during her three main
 cruises to the South, that we feel the meagre comment should be made
 on our providential return to civilization with the loss of two
 comrades whose memory will ever be imperishable to each one of us.
 Main Base (Adelie Land)

 by A. L. McLean, M.B., CH.M., B.A.

 Throughout the entire Expedition—from December 2, 1911, to February 26, 1914—the health of the team was remarkably good. Undoubtedly, Antarctica has a healthy climate, and it's mainly because people return somewhat to a more primitive state that such an ideal outcome is achieved.

 The first challenge is to combat the cold, and extra clothing is the primary and effective way to do this. No one needs to be specially prepared for a harsh climate. If someone has a normal circulation, they quickly adjust to a new range of temperatures, and within a few weeks, they can claim to be acclimatized. Most team members were Australians, so the change in latitude was quite sudden but nonetheless invigorating and beneficial.

 Food had unexpectedly new flavors, hard physical labor was enjoyable in this unique and fantastic setting, and both intellect and imagination were stimulated, leading to a healthy mind in a healthy body. This is why illness was almost nonexistent for more than two years; additionally, it's partly true that the heightened sense of physical and mental well-being experienced during that time explains the typical desire of explorers to return to the icy regions.

 Regular monthly blood tests were conducted from the departure from Hobart in December 1911 until October 1912, with an interval of about nine weeks between the first and second tests. Hemoglobin levels experienced a significant jump and then steadily increased throughout the winter months in Adelie Land. Blood pressure was slightly elevated, weight increased, but as expected, resistance to common civilized germs decreased. The maximum weight gain for an individual over an eight-week period was nearly two stone, and everyone became heavier by about ten pounds. Clinical evidence of reduced immunity was demonstrated by the influenza outbreak referred to by Dr. S. E. Jones. Additionally, it was noted that several members had episodes of "boils" during the journey south; in Adelie Land in 1912, there were two cases of serious finger abscesses (whitlows) and one jaw abscess. It seems that, with its newfound energy, the body tries to expel waste products. Furthermore, experimental observations of the opsonic index indicated a decrease in resistance, and it was quite remarkable that after a few months in Adelie Land, staphylococcus pyogenes aureus—a common germ in the civilized world—could not be cultivated artificially from the throats, noses, or skin of six individuals from whom monthly bacteriological cultures were taken.

Inside the Hut, where temperatures ranged from 40 to 45 degrees F, the number of microorganisms steadily increased, if exposure of agar plates at regular night intervals was an accurate indicator. The organisms included staphylococci albi, bacilli, yeasts, and molds; the latter expanded over the plate after being incubated for forty-eight hours.

Frostbite was common, but perhaps because of this, it was not taken too seriously. No one suffered lasting harm from frostbite, though extensive blisters formed in several cases, leading to lost nails and skin.

While the Hut was being constructed, minor injuries frequently occurred; the common remedy was to cover the injured area with a small gauze pad secured by adhesive tape since open wounds would not heal in the cold. The Greenland dogs also had minor accidents and ailments that often needed attention.

On sledging trips, snow blindness was an affliction that eventually caught everyone off guard. That moment typically occurred when someone stopped using goggles during bright conditions. Prevention was key, followed by the "zinc and cocaine" treatment.

Adelie Land can only be seen as an extremely harsh place to live because of the constant winds. Necessity and adaptation helped one to view the weather as positively as possible, hoping for even a few hours of calm that might occasionally break the long stretches of blizzards. It is, therefore, with regret and some reluctance that I mention the illness of Mr. S. N. Jeffryes, who took his responsibilities as a wireless operator very seriously during the second year (1913); however, the monotony of a cave-like winter lifestyle affected him. I hope he is quickly regaining his former energy and enthusiasm.

So many miles of sledging were completed at both Antarctic Bases in a climate that undoubtedly has no parallel in the history of polar exploration. The Ship was frequently in danger during her three main voyages south, leading us to feel that a brief comment should be made about our fortunate return to civilization, despite the loss of two comrades whose memories will always be cherished by each of us.
      ** With the advent of summer, Jeffryes became normal, but unfortunately
 suffered a temporary relapse upon his return to Australia.—D. M.
 APPENDIX VI

 Finance

 A General reference was made to the finances of the expedition in the
 Introduction.  Here is an extended statement which, more fully amplified
 with a detailed list of donations, will be again published when
 additional funds have been raised to pay off the debit balance and
 establish equilibrium.
      ** With summer's arrival, Jeffryes returned to normal, but sadly had a temporary setback when he got back to Australia.—D. M.  
APPENDIX VI  

Finance  

 A general reference was made to the finances of the expedition in the Introduction. Here is a more detailed statement, which will be further elaborated with a list of donations and published again when additional funds have been raised to settle the outstanding balance and achieve equilibrium.
 GRANTS AND DONATIONS

 AUSTRALIA, January 1911:                                           L

 Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science, L1000;
 R. Barr Smith (South Australia), L100; Hugh Denison (Sydney),
 L1000; Samuel Hordern (Sydney), L1000 (subsequently increased
 to L2500)...........................  4,000
GRANTS AND DONATIONS

AUSTRALIA, January 1911:                                           £

Australasian Association for the Advancement of Science, £1000;  
R. Barr Smith (South Australia), £100; Hugh Denison (Sydney),  
£1000; Samuel Hordern (Sydney), £1000 (later increased to £2500)...........................  4,000
 LONDON, June 1911:

 S. Hordern (Sydney), L1500 (second donation); Roderick Murchison
 (Melbourne), L1000; W. A. Horn (South Australia), L1000;
 Lord Strathcona, L1000; Eugene Sandow, L1050; Imperial Government,
 L2000; Royal Geographical Society, L500; Lionel Robinson (Sydney),
 L250; C. D. Mackellar, L150; G. P. Doolette, L150; G. Buckley,
 L150; Lord Denman, L100; Madame Melba (Melbourne), L100;
 S. Y. Buchanan, L100 (later increased to L200); Daily Mail,L100;
 Messrs. Bullivants L100, &c., aggregating an additional L593..  9,843

 AUSTRALIA, October 1911:

 Sydney: Government grant, L7000; collected by        L.
 Professor David, L50; 'Sydney Morning Herald',
 L100; Professor David's own donation and
 lecture proceeds, L100............... 7,250

 Melbourne: Government grant, L6000; collected by
 Professor Masson, L70............... 6,070

 Adelaide: Government grant, L5000; collected by
 Mr. Piper, L250 (including Angus L100, Simpson L85,
 Scarfe L50)....................  5,250

 Hobart: Government grant, L500; collected, L55...   555
 Commonwealth grant                                   5,000
                                                    ________
                                                                  24,125

                                     Carried forward......  37,968
LONDON, June 1911:

 S. Hordern (Sydney), £1500 (second donation); Roderick Murchison
 (Melbourne), £1000; W. A. Horn (South Australia), £1000;
 Lord Strathcona, £1000; Eugene Sandow, £1050; Imperial Government,
 £2000; Royal Geographical Society, £500; Lionel Robinson (Sydney),
 £250; C. D. Mackellar, £150; G. P. Doolette, £150; G. Buckley,
 £150; Lord Denman, £100; Madame Melba (Melbourne), £100;
 S. Y. Buchanan, £100 (later increased to £200); Daily Mail, £100;
 Messrs. Bullivants £100, etc., totaling an additional £593..  £9,843

 AUSTRALIA, October 1911:

 Sydney: Government grant, £7000; collected by
 Professor David, £50; 'Sydney Morning Herald',
 £100; Professor David's own donation and
 lecture proceeds, £100............... £7,250

 Melbourne: Government grant, £6000; collected by
 Professor Masson, £70............... £6,070

 Adelaide: Government grant, £5000; collected by
 Mr. Piper, £250 (including Angus £100, Simpson £85,
 Scarfe £50).................... £5,250

 Hobart: Government grant, £500; collected, £55... £555
 Commonwealth grant                                   £5,000
                                                    ________
                                                                  £24,125

                                     Carried forward...... £37,968
 LONDON, 1913:                       Brought forward......  37,969

 Sir Lucas Tooth, L1000 (Sydney); Imperial Treasury, L1000;
 Royal Geographical Society, L100; S. Y. Buchanan, L100;
 Lady Scott, L100; Commander Evans, L100; other members of
 Scott Expedition and general subscriptions, L227.......    2,627

 Australia, 1913:

 Commonwealth grant, L5000; collected by Professor David
 (approximately), L50......................  5,050

 Australia, 1914:

 Collected by Professor Masson (approximately), L80;
 G. J. R. Murray (Adelaide), L100; Sir Samuel Way, L50.....     230

 Collected in London, 1914....................   10

                                         Total moneys donated     L45,885
LONDON, 1913:                       Brought forward......  37,969

Sir Lucas Tooth, £1,000 (Sydney); Imperial Treasury, £1,000; Royal Geographical Society, £100; S. Y. Buchanan, £100; Lady Scott, £100; Commander Evans, £100; other members of the Scott Expedition and general subscriptions, £227.......    2,627

Australia, 1913:

Commonwealth grant, £5,000; collected by Professor David (approximately), £50......................  5,050

Australia, 1914:

Collected by Professor Masson (approximately), £80; G. J. R. Murray (Adelaide), £100; Sir Samuel Way, £50.....     230

Collected in London, 1914....................   10

                                         Total moneys donated     £45,885
 Assets realized and added to the fund:

 Sale of photos and newspaper articles, L490; sale
 of ship and materials, L3699; lectures, films, &c., L726..... 4,915

 Bills Owing                                  ...... 5,932   5,932

 Assets to be realized:
                                                  L

 In hand..................    560
 Owing ..................    340
 Anticipated sale of gear.........    570
                                               ——
        1,470

                 Debit balance.............   4,462
                 Total cost ** of Expedition........... 56,732
Assets realized and added to the fund:

Sale of photos and newspaper articles, £490; sale of ship and materials, £3,699; lectures, films, etc., £726..... £4,915

Bills Owing                                  ...... £5,932   £5,932

Assets to be realized:
                                                  £

In hand..................    £560
Owing ..................    £340
Anticipated sale of gear.........    £570
                                               ——
        £1,470

                 Debit balance.............   £4,462
                 Total cost ** of Expedition........... £56,732
 There is therefore a deficit of L4462 to be made up by the royalty
 on the sale of the book, lectures, donations, &c., and the cost of
 the publication of the scientific results, which will be approximately
 L8000, has yet to be defrayed.
There is, therefore, a shortfall of £4462 that needs to be covered by the royalties from the book sales, lectures, donations, etc., and the cost of publishing the scientific results, which will be around £8000, still needs to be paid.
      ** An estimate of the cost of the expedition should also take
 account of donations in kind, which, as can be gathered, were numerous.
 Facilities offered by harbour boards and valuable assistance extended
 in the matter of docking and repairing the 'Aurora', particularly in
 the case of the State of Victoria, and to a less extent in New South
 Wales.

 Then there were valuable contributions of coal, particularly by Mr.
 J. Brown of Newcastle (N.S.W.), Mr. H. D. Murphy (Melbourne),
 and the Lithgow Collieries Company.
 APPENDIX VII
      ** An estimate of the expedition's costs should also include in-kind donations, which were plentiful, as can be seen. Support provided by harbor boards and significant help with docking and repairing the 'Aurora', especially from the State of Victoria, and to a lesser degree from New South Wales.

 There were also important contributions of coal, notably from Mr. J. Brown of Newcastle (N.S.W.), Mr. H. D. Murphy (Melbourne), and the Lithgow Collieries Company.  
 APPENDIX VII
 Equipment

 Clothing

 With regard to the clothing, the main bulk was of woollen material
 as supplied by Jaeger of London.  This firm is unexcelled in the
 production of camel's-hair garments and has supplied most polar
 expeditions of recent years with underclothing, gloves, caps, and
 the like.  From the same firm we also secured heavy ski-boots,
 finnesko-crampons, and the blankets which were used at Winter Quarters
 at both Antarctic Bases.  Some of the Jaeger woollens were damaged
 by sea water on the voyage from London to Australia and were replaced
 by Eagley goods; an Australian brand, which proved very satisfactory.
 The Ship's Party were outfitted with Kaipoi woollens (New Zealand).

 Outer garments were made up to our design from Jaeger fleece by
 tailors in Hobart.  The suit consisted of a single garment, to be worn
 with combination underclothing, and was calculated to meet the
 requirements of a severe climate.

 An over-suit of wind-proof material, which may be worn when required,
 is a necessary adjunct to woollen clothing.  Such a suit should have
 the additional properties of being light, strong, not readily
 absorbing moisture, and not affected by the cold.  Burberry
 gabardine was found to possess all these properties, and two complete
 suits were made up for each man.  One suit consisted of three pieces,
 whilst the other was made of two; the blouse-jacket and helmet of the
 latter being combined.

 Furs, which were obtained from Norway, were restricted to sleeping
 bags, finnesko or fur-boots, and wolfskin mitts (Lapland).

 The outfit of clothing for the party at Macquarie Island and on the
 Ship, respectively, differed from that used in the Antarctic.  Warmer
 temperatures and wet conditions had to be taken into account, and so
 rubber boots, oilskins, and rubberized materials were provided as
 outer coverings.

 Food

 The food-stuffs were selected with at least as much consideration as
 was given to any of the other requisites.  The successful work of an
 expedition depends on the health of the men who form its members, and
 good and suitable food reduces to a minimum the danger of scurvy; a
 scourge which has marred many polar enterprises.  Thus our
 provisioning was arranged with care and as a result of my previous
 experience in the Antarctic with Sir Ernest Shackleton's Expedition.

 A summary which may be of possible use to future expeditions is
 appended below:

 In the matter of canned meats we had some six tons of the excellent
 Australian article supplied by the Sydney Meat Preserving Company,
 Ramornie Meat Company (N.S.W.), Baynes Brothers (Brisbane), and the
 Border (rabbit) Preserving Company of South Australia.  For use on
 the Ship three tons of salt beef and pork served to replenish the
 "harness cask," largely obtained in Melbourne from Cook and Sons.

 For a ton of sauces and pickles we were indebted to Brand and Company
 (London) and to Mason and Company (London).

 Of course fresh meat was consumed as far as possible; a number of
 live sheep being taken by the 'Aurora' on each cruise.  Some of these
 were killed and dressed after reaching 60 degrees south latitude and
 supplied our two Antarctic Bases with the luxury of fresh mutton
 about once a week throughout a year.

 One ton of preserved suet came from the firms of Hugon (Manchester)
 and Conrad (Adelaide).

 Almost all our bacon and ham, amounting to well over one ton, was of
 the Pineapple Brand (Sydney), and to the firm which supplied them we
 are indebted alike for the quality of its goods and for its generosity.

 Soups in endless variety, totalling two tons, came chiefly from the
 Flemington Meat Preserving Company (Melbourne).

 Fours tons of canned fish were supplied by C. & E. Morton (London).

 Variety in vegetables was considered important.  We decided to reduce
 the amount of dried vegetables in favour of canned vegetables.  About
 six and a half tons of the latter in addition to one ton of canned
 potatoes were consumed; from Laver Brothers (Melbourne) and Heinz
 (Pittsburgh).  There were one and a half tons of dried vegetables.
 In addition, large quantities of fresh potatoes and other vegetables
 were regularly carried by the 'Aurora', and many bags of new and old
 potatoes were landed at the Main Base.  In the frozen condition, the
 former kept satisfactorily, though they were somewhat sodden when
 thawed.  The old potatoes, on the other hand, became black and useless,
 partly owing to the comparatively high temperature of the ship's hold,
 and in part to the warmth of the sun during the first few weeks in
 Adelie Land.

 Canned fruits, to the extent of five tons, were supplied by Jones
 Brothers (Hobart) and Laver Brothers (Melbourne).  This stock was eked
 out by some two and a half tons of dried fruits, chiefly from South
 Australia.

 The management of Hartley (London) presented us with two tons of jam,
 and James Keiller and Son (London) with one ton of marmalade.

 Of the twelve tons of sugar and half a ton of syrup consumed, all were
 generously donated by the Colonial Sugar Refining Company (Sydney).

 For milk we were provided with two tons of Glaxo (a dry powder) which
 was used at the land bases, and a ton and a half of Nestle's condensed
 variety for use on the ship.

 Three tons of cereal meals, largely from Parsons (Sydney), were
 consumed.

 As one might have expected, the amount of flour used was enormous.
 In the thirteen tons of this commodity from Colman (London) there were
 three varieties, self-rising, plain, and wheatmeal flour, encased in
 stout metal linings within strong, well-finished cases of a convenient
 size.  Until required, the cases of flour were used to solidify the
 break-wind on the southern side of the Hut.

 Bird and Company (Birmingham) more than satisfied our needs in the
 matter of baking powder, custard powder, jelly crystals, and the
 like.

 There was over half a ton of fancy biscuits of excellent quality and
 great variety, for which we were indebted to Jacob and Company
 (Dublin), Arnott Brothers (Sydney), and Patria Biscuit Fabriek
 (Amsterdam).  "Hardtack," the name by which a plain wholemeal
 biscuit of good quality, made by Swallow and Ariell (Melbourne) was
 known, constituted the greater part of the remaining two and a half
 tons of ordinary biscuits.  "Hardtack" was much appreciated as a
 change from the usual "staff of life"—soda bread.

 For sledging we had secured one ton of biscuits specially prepared
 by the Plasmon Company (London) containing 30 per cent. of plasmon.
 These, together with one ton of pemmican and half a ton of emergency
 ration prepared by the Bovril Company (London), are specially referred
 to in the chapter on sledging equipment.

 Butter was an important item; the large stock of two and a half tons
 coming from the Colac Dairying Company (Melbourne).  The butter was
 taken fresh in fifty-six lb. blocks, packed in the usual export
 cases.  On the 'Aurora' it was carried as deck-cargo, and at the Main
 Base was stacked in the open air on the southern side of the Hut.  At
 the end of the second year (1913) it was still quite good; a fact
 which speaks well for the climate as a refrigerator.  Of Australian
 cheese we used half a ton, and this was supplied in forty-pound
 blocks.

 The firm of Messrs. Cadbury, well known for their cocoa and eating
 chocolate, supplied us with these commodities, and receive our
 unqualified praise for the standard of the articles and the way in
 which they were packed.  The total consumption was one ton of cocoa
 and half a ton of chocolate.

 The three-quarters of a ton of tea was donated by "Te Sol"
 (Guernsey) and Griffiths Brothers (Melbourne).  In both cases the
 articles were well packed and much appreciated.  Half a ton of coffee
 was used, partly supplied from London and partly donated by
 Griffiths Brothers.

 Rose's (London) lime juice, as an antiscorbutic, was mainly reserved
 for consumption on the Ship.  This lime juice was much in favour as a
 beverage.

 Other supplies, taken in bulk, and for which we are indebted to the
 manufacturers, are: one ton of Cerebos Salt, half a ton of Castle
 salt, one ton of Sunlight Soap, our complete requirements in toilet
 soap from Pears, candles from Price, matches from Bryant and May
 including special sledging vestas, and dried milk from the Trufood
 Company.

 Sweets, which were used for dessert and on special occasions, were
 presented by the firms of Fuller and Batger of London, and by Farrah
 of Harrogate, &c.  There were also small quantities of aerated waters,
 ales, wines, and whisky for each Base.**  At the Main Base, at least,
 there was no demand for whisky until penguin omelettes became
 fashionable.
Equipment

Clothing

Regarding clothing, most of it was made from wool supplied by Jaeger of London. This company is unmatched in producing camel's-hair garments and has provided most polar expeditions in recent years with underclothing, gloves, caps, and similar items. We also obtained heavy ski boots, finnesko crampons, and the blankets used at Winter Quarters at both Antarctic Bases from the same firm. Some of the Jaeger woolens were damaged by seawater during the trip from London to Australia and were replaced by Eagley goods, an Australian brand that turned out to be very satisfactory. The Ship's Party was outfitted with Kaipoi woolens (New Zealand).

The outer garments were custom-made from Jaeger fleece by tailors in Hobart. The suit was a single piece to be worn with combination underclothing and was designed to meet the needs of a harsh climate. 

A windproof oversuit, which can be worn when needed, is essential for woolen clothing. Such a suit should be light, strong, not easily absorb moisture, and not affected by the cold. Burberry gabardine was found to have all these qualities, and two complete suits were made for each man. One suit consisted of three pieces, while the other was made of two; the blouse-jacket and helmet of the latter were combined.

Furs obtained from Norway were limited to sleeping bags, finnesko or fur boots, and wolfskin mitts (Lapland).

The clothing for the party at Macquarie Island and on the Ship differed from that used in the Antarctic. Warmer temperatures and wet conditions had to be taken into account, so rubber boots, oilskin, and rubberized materials were provided for outer coverings.

Food

The food items were chosen with just as much care as any other supplies. The success of an expedition relies on the health of its members, and good, suitable food minimizes the risk of scurvy, a disease that has plagued many polar expeditions. Thus, our provisions were arranged carefully, drawing from my previous experience in the Antarctic with Sir Ernest Shackleton's Expedition.

A summary that might be useful for future expeditions is provided below:

In terms of canned meats, we had about six tons of high-quality Australian products from the Sydney Meat Preserving Company, Ramornie Meat Company (N.S.W.), Baynes Brothers (Brisbane), and the Border (rabbit) Preserving Company of South Australia. To replenish the "harness cask," we sourced three tons of salt beef and pork primarily from Cook and Sons in Melbourne.

For sauces and pickles, we relied on Brand and Company (London) and Mason and Company (London) for a ton.

Of course, we consumed fresh meat as much as possible; a number of live sheep were taken by the 'Aurora' on each trip. Some of these were killed and processed after reaching 60 degrees south latitude, providing our two Antarctic Bases with the luxury of fresh mutton about once a week throughout the year.

One ton of preserved suet came from Hugon (Manchester) and Conrad (Adelaide).

Almost all of our bacon and ham, over one ton, was from the Pineapple Brand (Sydney), and we are grateful to the company for both the quality of their products and their generosity.

We had two tons of soups in various types, primarily from the Flemington Meat Preserving Company (Melbourne).

Four tons of canned fish were supplied by C. & E. Morton (London).

We emphasized variety in vegetables, deciding to decrease the dried vegetables in favor of canned ones. About six and a half tons of canned vegetables, plus one ton of canned potatoes, were consumed from Laver Brothers (Melbourne) and Heinz (Pittsburgh). We also had one and a half tons of dried vegetables. Additionally, the 'Aurora' regularly carried large quantities of fresh potatoes and other vegetables, landing many bags of new and old potatoes at the Main Base. The fresh ones stored well in frozen conditions, though they became somewhat soggy when thawed. The old potatoes, however, turned black and unusable, partly due to the relatively high temperature of the ship's hold and partly because of the sun's warmth during the first few weeks in Adelie Land.

We received five tons of canned fruits from Jones Brothers (Hobart) and Laver Brothers (Melbourne), supplemented by around two and a half tons of dried fruits, mainly from South Australia.

Hartley (London) generously provided us with two tons of jam, and James Keiller and Son (London) supplied one ton of marmalade.

Of the twelve tons of sugar and half a ton of syrup consumed, all were generously donated by the Colonial Sugar Refining Company (Sydney).

For milk, we had two tons of Glaxo (a dry powder) for use at the land bases and one and a half tons of Nestlé's condensed variety for use on the ship.

We consumed three tons of cereal meals, mostly from Parsons (Sydney).

As expected, we used a massive amount of flour. The thirteen tons we received from Colman (London) included three varieties: self-rising, plain, and wheatmeal flour, all packed in sturdy metal linings within strong, well-finished cases of a convenient size. Until needed, the cases of flour were used to reinforce the windbreak on the southern side of the Hut.

Bird and Company (Birmingham) exceeded our requirements for baking powder, custard powder, jelly crystals, and similar products.

We had over half a ton of high-quality fancy biscuits, courtesy of Jacob and Company (Dublin), Arnott Brothers (Sydney), and Patria Biscuit Fabriek (Amsterdam). "Hardtack," which is a plain, high-quality wholemeal biscuit made by Swallow and Ariell (Melbourne), made up the bulk of the remaining two and a half tons of ordinary biscuits. "Hardtack" was much appreciated as a change from the usual "staff of life"—soda bread.

For sledging, we secured one ton of biscuits specially made by the Plasmon Company (London) that contained 30 percent plasmon. These, along with one ton of pemmican and half a ton of emergency rations prepared by the Bovril Company (London), are specifically mentioned in the chapter on sledging equipment.

Butter was essential; we had a large supply of two and a half tons from the Colac Dairying Company (Melbourne). The butter was taken fresh in fifty-six lb. blocks, packed in the usual export cases. On the 'Aurora,' it was carried as deck cargo, and at the Main Base, it was stored outdoors on the southern side of the Hut. By the end of the second year (1913), it remained in good condition, which reflects well on the climate's effectiveness as a refrigerator. We used half a ton of Australian cheese, supplied in forty-pound blocks.

The firm of Messrs. Cadbury, known for their cocoa and chocolate, supplied us with these products and received our full praise for the quality and packaging of their items. The total consumption was one ton of cocoa and half a ton of chocolate.

Three-quarters of a ton of tea was donated by "Te Sol" (Guernsey) and Griffiths Brothers (Melbourne). In both cases, the items were well-packed and greatly appreciated. We used half a ton of coffee, partially sourced from London and partially donated by Griffiths Brothers.

Rose's (London) lime juice, as a preventative for scurvy, was primarily reserved for use on the Ship. This lime juice was quite popular as a drink.

Other bulk supplies, for which we are grateful to the manufacturers, include one ton of Cerebos salt, half a ton of Castle salt, one ton of Sunlight soap, our complete needs for toilet soap from Pears, candles from Price, matches from Bryant and May, including special sledging vests, and dried milk from the Trufood Company.

Sweets, used for dessert and special occasions, were provided by Fuller and Batger of London, and by Farrah of Harrogate, etc. There were also small quantities of fizzy drinks, ales, wines, and whisky for each Base. At the Main Base, at least, there wasn’t a demand for whisky until penguin omelettes became fashionable.
      ** * Donated by Schweppes, Kopke, Burgoyne, and others.

 The smokers were well provided for by a generous donation of Capstan
 tobaccos, cigarettes and cigars from the British American Tobacco
 Company in London.  At a later date, when our Macquarie Island party
 was formed, the Sydney branch of the same firm met our added needs
 with the same generosity.

 There are many other items which have not yet found a place in this
 summary which cannot be acknowledged severally, but for which we are
 none the less grateful.  Mention is made of the following:  Horlick's
 Malted Milk, Neave's Health Diet, Brown and Polson's Cornflour,
 International Plasmon Company's Plasmon chocolate and Plasmon powder,
 Bovril and lime juice nodules manufactured by Bovril Limited,
 Colman's Mustard and Groats, Flemington Meat Company's desiccated
 soups, Seager's meats, Nestle's nut-milk chocolate, Escoffier's soups,
 &c.

 The cooking range which served us well for two years in the Hut at
 Adelie Land was from J. Smith and Wellstood (London); others were
 presented by Metters (Adelaide).

 The total supply of foods purchased and donated aggregated quite one
 hundred tons, exclusive of packing.  Much of this was assembled in
 London.  In Australia the Government Produce Department of Adelaide
 rendered valuable assistance.
      ** * Donated by Schweppes, Kopke, Burgoyne, and others.

 The smokers were well taken care of thanks to a generous donation of Capstan tobaccos, cigarettes, and cigars from the British American Tobacco Company in London. Later on, when our Macquarie Island team was formed, the Sydney branch of the same company met our additional needs with the same generosity.

 There are many other items that haven’t been mentioned in this summary that we can't acknowledge individually, but we are still very grateful for them. These include: Horlick's Malted Milk, Neave's Health Diet, Brown and Polson's Cornflour, products from the International Plasmon Company like Plasmon chocolate and Plasmon powder, Bovril and lime juice nodules made by Bovril Limited, Colman's Mustard and Groats, desiccated soups from the Flemington Meat Company, Seager's meats, Nestle's nut-milk chocolate, Escoffier's soups, etc.

 The cooking range that served us well for two years in the Hut at Adelie Land came from J. Smith and Wellstood (London); others were provided by Metters (Adelaide).

 The total supply of food purchased and donated amounted to over one hundred tons, not including packing. Much of this was gathered in London. In Australia, the Government Produce Department of Adelaide provided valuable assistance.
 TABLE OF FOOD-SUPPLIES FOR A TWELVE-MAN BASE

 The following are the food requirements for a party of twelve men
 wintering in the Antarctic.  It is our own store list, with slight
 modifications where these are found desirable.  The figures are based
 on the supposition that unlimited quantities of seal and penguin meat
 can be had on the spot, and, furthermore, are ample for a second
 year's requirements should the party be unavoidably detained.  The
 fare during the second year might be somewhat less varied, but would
 otherwise be sufficient.  Health was, of course, the first
 consideration in this selection, but economy was also studied.  The
 quantities are stated in pounds weight.

                                                                    lbs.
 Meats, tinned—Corned beef, 216; roast beef, 72; roast mutton, 72;
 boiled mutton, 72; Irish stew, 216; assorted meats, 168, including
 mutton cutlets, haricot mutton, ox tail, ox tongue, sausages, and
 brawn; sheep's tongues, 288; special meats, 192, including rabbit,
 hare, duck, fowl, and turkey................... 1296

 Live sheep—16 sheep to be dressed south of 60 degrees S. latitude
 (weight not included)

 Suet, tinned—400......................... 400

 Bacon and Ham—Bacon in sides, packed in salt, 250; ham, 250...  500

 Fish, tinned—Salmon, 360; haddocks, 96; kippered herrings, 216;
 herrings in tomato sauce, 72; fresh herrings, 72; sardines, 300;
 cods' roe, curried prawns, &c., 72..............,   1188

 Soups, assorted tinned, 1152..................   1152

 Vegetables, fresh, in wooden cases—new potatoes, 1200; onions,
 3601560
             Tinned—potatoes, 864; onions, 216; peas, 450;
 French beans, 450; spinach, 360; cabbage, 144; beetroot, 288;
 carrots, 288; parsnips, 144; turnips, 108; celery, 144;
 leeks, 72; champignons, 144; Boston baked beans, 144;
 tomatoes, 288.....................    3240

 Cereals and Dried Vegetables, &c.—Split peas, 112; lentils, 56;
 marrowfat peas, 56; haricot beans, 56; barley, 72; rice, 252;
 tapioca, 144; semolina, 56; macaroni, 56; rolled oats, 648;
 cornflour, 156........................    1664

 Flour, including plain, wholemeal, and self-rising......    4480
  Biscuits, &c.—Plasmon wholemeal, 1344; plain wholemeal, 560;
 assorted sweet, 560; cake tinned, 224; plum pudding, 224....   1712

 Fruit, tinned in syrup—peaches, 288; pears, 288; plums, 288;
 apricots, 288; pineapples, 288; apples, 288; gooseberries, 216;
 cherries, 216; mulberries, 48; strawberries, 48; red currants, 48;
 black currants, 48; raspberries, 48...............  2400

 Dried fruits—Prunes, 112; apples, 112; peaches, 56; nectarines, 56;
 apricots, 56; raisins seeded, 224; currants, 112; figs, 224;
 dates, 112; candied peel, 56..................  1120

 Sweets, &c.—Eating chocolate (chiefly for sledging) 504; assorted
 sweets, 168; crystallized fruits, 56; assorted nuts, 84.....   812

 Milk—as dried powder, 2400...................  2400

 Butter—in 56 lb. export cases, 1456..............  1456

 Cheese—in original blocks or tins, 240.............   240

 Cocoa, Tea, and Coffee—Cocoa, 576; tea, 288; coffee, 288....  1152

 Sugar, Jam, &c.—Sugar, 3584; jam, 1456; marmalade, 448;
 honey, 576; syrup, 288.....................   6352

 Sauces, Pickles, &c.—Tomato sauce, 180; Worcester sauce, 135;
 sweet pickles, 162; mango chutney, 81; assorted pickles
 (first quality) 216; vinegar, 210...............    984

 Cooking requisites—Baking powder (in addition to that in
 selfrising flour) 56; sodium bicarbonate, 1; ground mixed spice, 3;
 ground ginger, 4; whole cloves, 1; nutmegs, 2; assorted essences, 10;
 desiccated cocoanut, 12; mixed dried herbs, 2; dried mint, 6; dried
 parsley, 1; onion powder, 9; curry powder, 30; mustard, 30; black
 pepper, 12; white pepper, 12; table salt, 784..........   975

 Soap, &c.—Soap, 448; soda, 168.................   616

                                      (16 tons approx.)           35,699
 TABLE OF FOOD-SUPPLIES FOR A TWELVE-MAN BASE

 The following are the food requirements for a group of twelve men spending the winter in Antarctica. This is our own supply list, with some slight modifications where necessary. The amounts are based on the assumption that unlimited quantities of seal and penguin meat can be obtained locally, and are also sufficient for a second year’s needs if the group gets unexpectedly delayed. The food during the second year may be somewhat less varied, but would still be adequate. Health was, of course, our top priority in this selection, but we also considered cost-effectiveness. The quantities are listed in pounds.

                                                                    lbs.
 Meats, canned—Corned beef, 216; roast beef, 72; roast mutton, 72; 
 boiled mutton, 72; Irish stew, 216; assorted meats, 168, including 
 mutton cutlets, haricot mutton, ox tail, ox tongue, sausages, and 
 brawn; sheep's tongues, 288; special meats, 192, including rabbit, 
 hare, duck, fowl, and turkey................... 1296

 Live sheep—16 sheep to be dressed south of 60 degrees S. latitude 
 (weight not included)

 Suet, canned—400......................... 400

 Bacon and Ham—Bacon in sides, packed in salt, 250; ham, 250...  500

 Fish, canned—Salmon, 360; haddocks, 96; kippered herrings, 216; 
 herrings in tomato sauce, 72; fresh herrings, 72; sardines, 300; 
 cod roe, curried prawns, etc., 72..............,   1188

 Soups, assorted canned, 1152..................   1152

 Vegetables, fresh, in wooden cases—new potatoes, 1200; onions,
 3601560
             Canned—potatoes, 864; onions, 216; peas, 450; 
 French beans, 450; spinach, 360; cabbage, 144; beetroot, 288; 
 carrots, 288; parsnips, 144; turnips, 108; celery, 144; 
 leeks, 72; champignons, 144; Boston baked beans, 144; 
 tomatoes, 288.....................    3240

 Cereals and Dried Vegetables, etc.—Split peas, 112; lentils, 56; 
 marrowfat peas, 56; haricot beans, 56; barley, 72; rice, 252; 
 tapioca, 144; semolina, 56; macaroni, 56; rolled oats, 648; 
 cornflour, 156........................    1664

 Flour, including plain, wholemeal, and self-rising......    4480
  Biscuits, etc.—Plasmon wholemeal, 1344; plain wholemeal, 560; 
 assorted sweet, 560; cake canned, 224; plum pudding, 224....   1712

 Fruit, canned in syrup—peaches, 288; pears, 288; plums, 288; 
 apricots, 288; pineapples, 288; apples, 288; gooseberries, 216; 
 cherries, 216; mulberries, 48; strawberries, 48; red currants, 48; 
 black currants, 48; raspberries, 48...............  2400

 Dried fruits—Prunes, 112; apples, 112; peaches, 56; nectarines, 56; 
 apricots, 56; seeded raisins, 224; currants, 112; figs, 224; 
 dates, 112; candied peel, 56..................  1120

 Sweets, etc.—Eating chocolate (mainly for sledging) 504; assorted 
 sweets, 168; crystallized fruits, 56; assorted nuts, 84.....   812

 Milk—as dried powder, 2400...................  2400

 Butter—in 56 lb. export cases, 1456..............  1456

 Cheese—in original blocks or tins, 240.............   240

 Cocoa, Tea, and Coffee—Cocoa, 576; tea, 288; coffee, 288....  1152

 Sugar, Jam, etc.—Sugar, 3584; jam, 1456; marmalade, 448; 
 honey, 576; syrup, 288.....................   6352

 Sauces, Pickles, etc.—Tomato sauce, 180; Worcester sauce, 135; 
 sweet pickles, 162; mango chutney, 81; assorted pickles 
 (first quality) 216; vinegar, 210...............    984

 Cooking supplies—Baking powder (in addition to that in 
 self-rising flour) 56; sodium bicarbonate, 1; ground mixed spice, 3; 
 ground ginger, 4; whole cloves, 1; nutmegs, 2; assorted essences, 10; 
 desiccated coconut, 12; mixed dried herbs, 2; dried mint, 6; dried 
 parsley, 1; onion powder, 9; curry powder, 30; mustard, 30; black 
 pepper, 12; white pepper, 12; table salt, 784..........   975

 Soap, etc.—Soap, 448; soda, 168.................   616

                                      (16 tons approx.)           35,699
 Note.  These weights are exclusive of packing.  When high southern
 latitudes can be reached within three weeks, fresh eggs may be taken
 with advantage, preferably unfertilized, but care should be taken to
 freeze them as soon as possible, and not to allow them to thaw again
 until required for use.  It is advisable to take small quantities
 of whisky, ale, wines and lime juice.  Matches, candles, soap, and
 other toilet requirements, kerosene and fuel are not reckoned with
 here, appearing in a more general stores' list.  Certain medical
 comforts, such as malted milk and plasmon, may also be included.

 Medical Equipment

 The medical equipment consisted of a complete outfit of Burroughs
 and Wellcome's drug's, dressings, &c., and Allen and Hanbury's
 surgical instruments.  Sets, varying in character with particular
 requirements, were made up for the Ship and for each of the land
 parties.  Contained within the fifty-five boxes was a wonderful
 assortment of everything which could possibly have been required
 on a polar expedition.  There was in addition a set of Burroughs
 and Wellcome's medicines for the treatment of dogs.
Note. These weights do not include packaging. When high southern latitudes can be reached within three weeks, fresh eggs can be beneficial, preferably unfertilized, but they should be frozen as soon as possible, and not allowed to thaw until needed. It’s a good idea to bring small amounts of whisky, ale, wines, and lime juice. Matches, candles, soap, and other personal care items, kerosene, and fuel are not included here and will appear in a more general stores list. Certain medical supplies, like malted milk and plasmon, can also be included.

Medical Equipment

The medical equipment included a complete set of Burroughs and Wellcome's drugs, dressings, etc., along with Allen and Hanbury's surgical instruments. Sets were created with different requirements for the ship and each of the land parties. The fifty-five boxes contained a fantastic assortment of everything that could possibly be needed for a polar expedition. Additionally, there was a set of Burroughs and Wellcome's medicines for treating dogs.
 Scientific Equipment

 The scope of our projected scientific work necessitated extensive
 purchases, and these were amplified by loans from many scientific
 bodies and individuals.

 Instruments for surveying and navigation were loaned by the Royal
 Geographical Society and by the Admiralty, while many theodolites,
 chronometers, and half-chronometer watches were manufactured to order.

 An assortment of oceanographical gear was generously supplied through
 H. S. H. The Prince of Monaco, from the Institut Oceanographique
 of Monaco.  Dr. W. S. Bruce made similar donations and supervised the
 construction of our largest deep-sea dredge.  The three-thousand
 fathom tapered steel cables and mountings, designed to work the
 deep-water dredges, were supplied by Messrs. Bullivant.  Appliances
 were also loaned by Mr. J. T. Buchanan of the 'Challenger' Expedition
 and by the Commonwealth Fisheries Department.  The self-recording
 tide-gauges we employed were the property of the New South Wales
 Government, obtained through Mr. G. Halligan.

 The taxidermists' requirements, and other necessaries for the
 preservation of zoological specimens, were for the most part purchased,
 but great assistance was rendered through Professor Baldwin-Spencer
 by the National Museum of Melbourne and by the South Australian Museum,
 through the offices of Professor Stirling.  Articles of equipment for
 botanical work were loaned by Mr. J. H. Maiden, Director of the
 Botanical Gardens, Sydney.

 A supply of heavy cameras for base-station work and light cameras for
 sledging was purchased; our stock being amplified by many private
 cameras, especially those belonging to F. H. Hurley, photographer of
 the Expedition.  Special Lumiere plates and material for colour
 photography were not omitted, and, during the final cruise of the
 'Aurora', P. E. Correll employed the more recent Paget process for
 colour photography with good results.

 The programme of magnetic work was intended to be as extensive as
 possible.  In the matter of equipment we were very materially assisted
 by the Carnegie Institute through Dr. L. A. Bauer.  An instrument
 was also loaned through Mr. H. F. Skey of the Christchurch Magnetic
 Observatory.  A full set of Eschenhagen self-recording instruments
 was purchased, and in this and in other dispositions for the magnetic
 work we have to thank Dr. C. Chree, Director of the National Physical
 Laboratory, and Dr. C. C. Farr of University College, Christchurch.
 Captain Chetwynd kindly assisted in arrangements for the Ship's
 compasses.

 Two complete sets of Telefunken wireless apparatus were purchased from
 the Australasian Wireless Company.  The motors and dynamos were got
 from Buzzacott, Sydney, and the masts were built by Saxton and Binns,
 Sydney.  Manilla and tarred-hemp ropes were supplied on generous terms
 by Melbourne firms (chiefly Kinnear).

 The meteorological instruments were largely purchased from Negretti
 and Zambra, but a great number were loaned by the Commonwealth
 Meteorological Department (Director, Mr. H. A. Hunt) and by the
 British Meteorological Office (Director, Dr. W. N. Shaw).

 For astronomical work the following instruments were loaned, besides
 transit-theodolites and sextants:  a four-inch telescope by the
 Greenwich Observatory through the Astronomer Royal: a portable
 transit-theodolite by the Melbourne Observatory through the
 Director, Mr. P. Baracchi; two stellar sidereal chronometers by
 the Adelaide Observatory through the Astronomer, Mr. P. Dodwell.

 The apparatus for bacteriological and physiological work were got in
 Sydney, in arrangements and suggestions for which our thanks are due
 to Dr. Tidswell (Microbiological Laboratory) and Professor Welsh, of
 Sydney University.

 Artists' materials were supplied by Winsor and Newton, London, while
 the stationery was partly donated by John Sands, Limited, Sydney

 Geological, chemical, and physical apparatus were all acquired at the
 instance of the several workers.

 Adjuncts, such as a calculating machine, a typewriter, and duplicator
 were not forgotten.**

Scientific Equipment

The scope of our planned scientific work required extensive purchases, which were further supported by loans from various scientific organizations and individuals. Surveying and navigation instruments were loaned by the Royal Geographical Society and the Admiralty, while many theodolites, chronometers, and half-chronometer watches were custom-made for us. An assortment of oceanographic equipment was generously provided by H. S. H. The Prince of Monaco, through the Institut Oceanographique of Monaco. Dr. W. S. Bruce made similar contributions and oversaw the construction of our largest deep-sea dredge. The three-thousand fathom tapered steel cables and mounts designed for deep-water dredges were supplied by Messrs. Bullivant. Equipment was also loaned by Mr. J. T. Buchanan of the 'Challenger' Expedition and by the Commonwealth Fisheries Department. The self-recording tide gauges we used were owned by the New South Wales Government, acquired through Mr. G. Halligan. The taxidermist's supplies and other necessities for preserving zoological specimens were mostly purchased, but we received significant help from Professor Baldwin-Spencer at the National Museum of Melbourne and from the South Australian Museum through Professor Stirling. Equipment for botanical work was loaned by Mr. J. H. Maiden, Director of the Botanical Gardens in Sydney. We purchased heavy cameras for base-station work and lighter cameras for sledging; our collection was enhanced by many private cameras, especially those belonging to F. H. Hurley, the Expedition's photographer. We also included special Lumiere plates and materials for color photography. During the final cruise of the 'Aurora', P. E. Correll used the newer Paget process for color photography with good results. The magnetic work program was intended to be as comprehensive as possible. For equipment, we received significant support from the Carnegie Institute through Dr. L. A. Bauer. An instrument was also loaned by Mr. H. F. Skey of the Christchurch Magnetic Observatory. We purchased a full set of Eschenhagen self-recording instruments, and for this and other magnetic work arrangements, we owe our gratitude to Dr. C. Chree, Director of the National Physical Laboratory, and Dr. C. C. Farr of University College, Christchurch. Captain Chetwynd kindly assisted with arrangements for the ship's compasses. We purchased two complete sets of Telefunken wireless equipment from the Australasian Wireless Company. The motors and generators came from Buzzacott, Sydney, while the masts were built by Saxton and Binns, Sydney. Manila and tarred-hemp ropes were generously provided by Melbourne firms, primarily Kinnear. Most meteorological instruments were bought from Negretti and Zambra, but many were loaned by the Commonwealth Meteorological Department (Director, Mr. H. A. Hunt) and the British Meteorological Office (Director, Dr. W. N. Shaw). For astronomical work, the following instruments were loaned in addition to transit-theodolites and sextants: a four-inch telescope from the Greenwich Observatory through the Astronomer Royal; a portable transit-theodolite from the Melbourne Observatory through the Director, Mr. P. Baracchi; and two stellar sidereal chronometers from the Adelaide Observatory through the Astronomer, Mr. P. Dodwell. Bacteriological and physiological equipment was sourced in Sydney, for which our thanks go to Dr. Tidswell (Microbiological Laboratory) and Professor Welsh of Sydney University for their arrangements and suggestions. Artists' materials were supplied by Winsor and Newton, London, while some stationery was donated by John Sands, Limited, Sydney. Geological, chemical, and physical equipment were all acquired at the request of various researchers. We also made sure to include supplementary items like a calculating machine, a typewriter, and a duplicator.
      ** Acceptable donations of various articles were made by the firms of
 Ludowici, Sydney; Allen Taylor, Sydney; Sames and Company, Birmingham;
 Gamage, London; Gramophone Company, London; the Acetylene Corporation,
 London; Steel Trucks Ltd., &c.
      ** Acceptable donations of various items were made by the companies of
 Ludowici, Sydney; Allen Taylor, Sydney; Sames and Company, Birmingham;
 Gamage, London; Gramophone Company, London; the Acetylene Corporation,
 London; Steel Trucks Ltd., etc.
      **Through the offices of Mr. C. A. Bang we are indebted to "De
 Forenede Dampskibsselskab," of Copenhagen, for the transport of the
 dogs from Greenland.
      **Thanks to Mr. C. A. Bang, we owe our gratitude to "De Forenede Dampskibsselskab" of Copenhagen for transporting the dogs from Greenland.
 Apart from the acquisition of the instruments, there were long
 preparations to be made in the arrangement of the scientific programme
 and in the training of the observers.  In this department the
 Expedition was assisted by many friends.

 Thus Professor W. A. Haswell (Biology), Professor T. W. Edgeworth
 David (Geology), and Mr. H. A. Hunt (Meteorology), each drew up
 instructions relating to his respective sphere.  Training in
 astronomical work at the Melbourne Observatory was supervised by
 Mr. P. Baracchi, Director, and in magnetic work by the Department
 of Terrestrial Magnetism, Carnegie Institute (Director, Dr. L. A.
 Bauer).  Further, in the subject of magnetics, we have to thank
 especially Mr. E. Kidston of the Carnegie Institute for field
 tuition, and Mr. Baldwin of the Melbourne Observatory for
 demonstrations in the working of the Eschenhagen magnetographs.
 Professor J. A. Pollock gave us valuable advice on wireless and
 other physical subjects.  At the Australian Museum, Sydney, Mr.
 Hedley rendered assistance in the zoological preparations.  In the
 conduct of affairs we were assisted on many occasions by Messrs. W.
 S. Dun (Sydney), J. H. Maiden (Sydney), Robert Hall (Hobart), G.
 H. Knibbs (Melbourne),and to the presidents and members of the
 councils of the several Geographical Societies in Australia—as well,
 of course, as to those of the Royal Geographical Society, London.

 In conclusion, the proffered, disinterested help, of all the above
 and many other friends contrived to make our scientific equipment
 well-nigh complete and eminently up-to-date.
 INDEX

 Abrasion effects of drift snow,
 Abruzzi expedition 1900, rations
 Absolute Hut, the
 Acetylene Corporation, London, (note)
 Adare, Cape
 Adelaide Island
.........University
 'Adelie Blizzard'
........Land;
            the main base at; glaciation of; hurricanes of; Wilkes'
            account of; the Hut; drifts; wireless installation at;
            clothing for; Empire Day in; temperatures
 Admiralty Range
 Aerial Cove, depot
 Aeroplane sledge. See Air-tractor sledge
 Ainsworth, G F.,
         "Life on Macquarie Island;" "A Land of Storm and Mist,"
         "Through Another Year;" picked up by the 'Aurora',
         the home journey; account of
 Air-tractor sledge, the;
 Aladdin's Cave;
 Albatross
 Alden, Cape,
 Alexander I Island,
 Alexandra, Queen
 Allen and Hanbury, Messrs.
 Alligator Nunatak.
 'Amakura', the
 American expedition under Wilkes
........ Quadrant, the, accessibility; whaling industry in
 Amundsen, Captain; sledging dogs presented by
..........dog
 Anchor Rock
 Anemobiagraph, the
 Anemometers
 Anemones, preservation of
 Angas Mr. C.
 "Annie Hill,"
 Antarctic theory of distribution of flora
 Antarctica, history of discovery
 'Anthology of Australian Verse, An'
 Anthony, Messrs., of Melbourne
 'Archibald Russell', the
 Arnott Bros., Messrs.
 Asia, Southern, wind velocities
 'Astrolabe', D'Urville's journey in the
 Astronomer Royal, the
 Astronomical Hut, the
 "Atmospherics,"
 Auckland Islands
 'Aurora', the S.Y. plan and section; adaptation and fitting out;
    from Macquarie Island to Adelie Land; the first ice; landing of
    cargo at main base; new lands; food carried by the; return of the;
    observations secured on the; deep-sea soundings; at Macquarie Island;
    arrival at Port Lyttleton; at Melbourne; second deep-sea cruise;
    departure from Hobart, Christmas; visit to the main base, Adelie Land;
    reception by Wild; relief of Wild's party; arrival in Hobart; papers
    brought by the; stores laid at Caroline Cove; visits to Macquarie
    Island; at Dunedin; leaves Hobart on Southern trip to bring back the
    two parties; wireless communication with; the Homeward Cruise; list
    of ship's officers
.........Peak
 Auroral phenomena
 Australasian Association for Advancement of Science,
 Australian ensign hoisted
 Avalanche Rocks
 Avalanches,~
 Azimuth Hill;
        memorial cross on

 Bacteriology, work of the expedition,
 Bage, R., at the main base; work at the hut; the tide-gauge;
    transit house; food experiences; search for the dogs;
    with the Southern Sledging Party; return to the hut;
    on building a tent; snow-blindness; return to Aladdin's Cave;
    note left by, at Cathedral Grotto; return from the south;
    visit to the 'Aurora'; the relief expedition; winter work;
    wireless work; magnetograph records; the home journey;
     account of
 Baldwin, Mr.
 Baldwin-Spencer, Professor
 Balleny Islands
      John
 Bang, C. A. (note)
 Baracchi, Mr. P.
 Barometer, movements of the
 "Barrier," the, at the Winter Quarters
 "Barrier-formations,"
 Barron, Lady
........Sir Harry
 Barr-Smith, Mount
......Mr. Robert
 Basilisk, dog
 Bass Strait
 Bates, Mr. D. C.; request for weather reports
 Batger, Messrs.
 Bauer, Dr. L. A.
      Mr., Sealer at Macquarie Island
 Baynes Bros., Messrs.

 "Beaufort scale" of wind-pressure
 Belgian Antarctic expedition
 Bellingshausen, expedition of 1821
 "Benzine Hut,"
 Bergschrund
 Betli, dog
 Bickerton, F. H., at main base; work at the hut; erection of the
    wireless installation; food experiences; "bus driver";
    the air-tractor sledge; the Western sledging expedition;
    on tent pitching; his birthday; the relief party; winter work
    at the hut; wireless work; dredge constructed by; the home journey;
    account of
 Biology, work of the expedition
 Bird & Coy, Messrs.
 Birds, Antarctic, weight in relation to wing areas
 Birthday Camp
 Biscoe Island
........John, work
 Bishop and Clerk, islet
 Black Sunday
 Blair, J. H., Chief Officer on the 'Aurora'
 Blake, Cape
...... L R., work on Macquarie Island; visit to Sandy Bay;
           accident to; visits to Lusitania Bay; photographs taken by
           visits to the 'Aurora';  specimens obtained; sheepkilling;
           the home journey; account of
 Blizzard, puppy
.........the
 'Blizzard, The', poem
 Blood-pressure, observations by McLean,
 "Blue Billys,"
 "Board-sliding,"
 Bollons, Captain
 Borchgrevinck
 Borda, Cape
 Border (Rabbit) Preserving Coy.
 Bovril Coy., the
 Brand & Coy., Messrs.
 Bridge-playing at Western Base
 Bristow, Captain
 British Antarctic expedition
 British Expedition
 British Meteorological Office
 "Brothers (The),"
 Brown, Mr. John
 Brown & Polson, Messrs.
 Bruce, Dr. W. S.
........Rise
 Bruni Island
 Bryant & May, Messrs.
 Buchanan, Mr. J. Y.;
..........S. Y.
 Buckley, Mr. G.
 Budd Land;
 Buenos Ayres
 Bull, H. J.
 Bullivant, Messrs.
 Burberry, the
 Burroughs & Wellcome, Messrs.
 Buzzacott, Messrs.

 Cadbury, Messrs.
 Camp Cove
 Campbell & Sons, Messrs.
 Camping
 "Cannonading,"
 Canterbury Museum, Christchurch
 Cape Town
 Carbohydrates, definition of the term (note)
 Cardiff to Hobart, the journey
 Carnegie Institute
 Carnley Harbour
 Caroline Cove, Macquarie Island
 Carr, Cape
 Caruso, dog
 Castor, dog
 Cat, wild
 Catch Me Cave
 Cathedral Grotto, the
 'Challenger' expedition
 Charcot, Jean
.........Land
 Chetwynd, Captain
 Chocolate as barter
 Chree, Dr. C.,
 Christchurch, New Zealand
...........Magnetic Observatory
 'Christmas Carol, A'
...........Day, Dr. Mawson's; with the Southern Sledging Party;
            Madigan's account; with Bickerton's party; at Hobart;
            with Wild's party; with S. E. Jones's party;
            Ainsworth's account; on the homeward journey
 Chun, Professor, of Leipsic
 Close, J. H., at Main Base; at Aladdin's Cave; journey to the West;
       and the Near Eastern Party; journey to Commonwealth Bay;
       return from the East; back to Australia; account of
 Clothing for the expedition
 Clyde, wreck of the
 Coal-supply, difficulties of
 Coats Land
 Cocoa, value of,
 Colac Dairying Coy.
 Colman, Messrs.
 Colonel, dog
 Colonial Sugar Refining Coy.
 Commonwealth Bay
.............Fisheries Department
.............Meteorological Department
.............Weather Bureau, reports to
 Cormorant. See Shag
 Compass, variations of the; the bearing of the sun and the
          magnetic needle compared
 Conrad, Messrs.
 Cook, Captain James
 Copenhagen
 Coronae, lunar
 Correll, P. E., at Main Base; and the tide-gauge;
          production of 'The Washerwoman's Secret;
          the Eastern Coastal Party; at Horn Bluff,
          the search party; return to Australia;
          photographs taken by; the homeward journey;
          account of
.........Nunatak
 Cote Clarie
 Crampons, use of
 Crippen, dog
 Crown Fuel Company, briquettes

 'Daily Graphic'
.......'Mail'
 Dallman, Eduard
 Danish Geographical Society
 Darwin, Charles
 David Island
......Professor T. W. Edgeworth
 Davis, Captain J. K., appointment; arrival at Hobart; work of stowage;
        the journey to Macquarie Island; voyage in the Nimrod;
        at Macquarie Island; events on board; narrative quoted; return
        of the 'Aurora'; his decision regarding Wild's party; "The Ship's
        Story"; mission to London; visits to Macquarie Island;
        the homeward cruise; account of
.......Captain James, of Hobart, joins the 'Aurora'; efforts to recover
        ship's lost chain; account of
.......Sea
 "DeadBeat Gully,"
 Deakin, Hon. Alfred
 Declination of the magnetic needle
 Decouverte, Cape
 Delay Point
 Denison, Cape;
..........Mr. Hugh
 Denman Glacier, the
........Lord, messages to Antarctica; Finance
 Denny, Mr., visit to Macquarie
 D'Entrecasteaux Channel
 Depot Bay
 Depots maintained by the New Zealand Government
 Derwent River, the;
 Dietetics
 Disappointment Island
 'Discovery', voyage of the
...........Cape
 Dixson Island
        Mr. Hugh
 Dodwell, Mr. P.
 Dogs for the expedition, journey to Hobart; at the hut; harness for the;
       food for the; at Aladdin's Cave; with the sledging parties;
       the lost; used for food; presented to the 'Aurora' by Amundsen;
       with the Western Party; pups; quarrels
 Dolerite (note)
 Dominion Meteorological Office
 Doolette, Mr. G. P.
 Dovers, G., member of Wild's party; depot-laying party formed;
             surveying work; at Haswell Island; account of
 'Drake', H.M.S., wireless communication with
 Drift gauge, a
 Drift snow; abrasion effects of; electrical effects of
 Drygalski Island  (note)
..........Professor;
 Ducks
 Dun, W.S.
 'Dundonald', barque
 Dunedin
 D'Urville Sea;

 'Eagle' Cave
........schooner, wreck
 Earthquake shocks at Macquarie Island
 Eastern Barrier
........Coastal Party, formation; account of, by Madigan;
         instruments cached by
 Eclipse, lunar,
 Eitel, Mr. C. C.
 Elder, Mr.
.......Mount
 'Eliza Scott', the
 Empire Day, at the Western Base; on Adelie Land
 'Encyclopaedia Britannica', use of
 'Endeavour', the
 Enderby Island
........Land
 Equinox, effects of the
 Equipment of the expedition
 Erebus Cove
 "Erratics,"
 Esperance, Port
 Esquimaux, dogs of the; method with snow-blindness,
 Euphausia
 Evans, Commander
 Evensen, work of

 Farr, Dr. C. C.
 Fallieres Land
 'Fantome', H.M.S.
 Far-Eastern Party, the; the return of
 Farrah, Messrs.
 Fats, definition of term, (note)
 "Feather Bed" terrace
 Fiala, quoted
 Figure of Eight Island
 Filchner, Wilhelm
 Finance of the expedition
 Finnesko footwear
 Fisher, Hon. Andrew,
........wireless message to
 Fishing
 Fix, dog
 Flag depot
 Flagstaff Point, Carnley Harbour
 Flemington Meat Preserving Coy.
 Fletcher, F. D.
 Flora, Antarctic, theories concerning
 'Flying Fish', the
........Fox, working of the
 Flynn, Professor T. T.
 Foehn effect
 Food, for sledging journey, dietetics; rations; items;
       table of supplies
 Fram, dog
......voyage of the
 Franklin, dog
 Freshfield, Cape
 Fuller, Messrs.
 Fusilier, dog

 Gadget, dog
 Gamage, Messrs  (note)
 'Gauss', expedition of the
 Gaussberg
 Geographical results of the expedition
 Geological work of the expedition
 George, dog
........V, King, wireless message to,
 Georgia, South;
 Gerlache, Adrien de
..........Cape
 German Scientific Expedition; expedition of 1902, see Gauss
 Gillies, F., chief engineer of the 'Aurora'
.........Nunataks
 Ginger, dog
......Bitch, dog,
 Glacier, the continental,
 Glacier-ice, structural composition
 Glacier-tongues
 Glaciology, work of the expedition
 Glaxo
 Gloves
 Goggles for snow-blindness
 Golf at Western Base
 Gracht, Mr. Van Waterschoot van der
 'Grafton', wreck of the
 Graham's Land
 Gramophone Coy., London,  (note)
 Grampuses
 Grandmother, dog
 Gray, Cape
......P., second officer 'Aurora'
 Great Australian Bight
.....Britain, Antarctic Expeditions
.....Ross Barrier;
 Greely expedition of 1882
 Green Valley
 Greenland, dogs from
..........pup
 Greenwich Observatory
 Griffiths Brothers, Messrs.
 "Grottoes (The)," the hut at the Western Base, building; return
          of the sledging party; entrance and tunnels; the igloo;
          clearing the tunnels; return of the Western depot party;
          preparations for the Eastern summer journey; return of Wild;
          distances from; return of Jones's party; the flagstaff
 Guano deposits
 Gulls, Dominican or black backed
.......skua

 Haines, Mr., taxidermist
 Haldane, dog
 Hall, Robert
 Halligan, Mr. G.
 Hamilton, H., life at Macquarie Island; visits to Sandy Bay;
           biological work; reception of the 'Aurora';
           erection of the tide gauge; a dinghy for; visits to
           Lusitania Bay; photographs by; home journey; account of
.........Mount
 Hangar
 Hannan, W. H., at Main Base; work at the hut; wireless work;
           the drift gauge; as magnetician; working of the air-tractor
           sledge; the wireless at Winter Quarters; return to Australia;
           account of
 Harbour Board, Hobart
 Harness, sledging,
 Harrisson, C. T.; member of Wild's party; visit to the capsized berg,
            account; Hippo depot; meteorological work at The Grottoes;
            included in the Eastern summer journey; winch contrived by;
            account
 Hartley, Messrs.
 Hasselborough Bay
..............Captain
 Haswell Island
............Professor W. A.
 Hedley, Mr. C.
 Heinz, Messrs.
 Helen Glacier
 Henderson, Professor G. C..
 Henderson Island
 Hens, Cape
 'Hinemoa', rescue by
 'Hints to Travellers'
 Hippo Nunatak
 Hoadley, C. A.,  member Wild's party; party to lay depot formed;
          main western journey starting November; geological work;
          at Haswell Island; account
 Hobart
 Hodgeman, A. J., at Main Base; work at hut; Near Eastern Party;
          the cairn; return to the hut; journey of the Near Eastern
          Party; trip to Aladdin's Cave; on tent-pitching; investigation
          of snow ramp; the relief party; winter work at the hut;
          journey to Mount Murchison; the home journey; map of Mackellar
          Islets; account of
 Holliman, Captain,
 Holman, Hon., W. A.
 Hoosh
 Hordern, Mr. Samuel
 Horlick, Messrs.
 Horn Bluff
 "Horn Bluff," by C. T. Madigan
 Horn, Mr. W. A.
 Hoyle, pup
 Hugon, Messrs.
 Hunt, Mount
......Mr. H. A.
 Hunter, Cape
........J. G., at Main Base; biological work; parasitology;
               sledging; production of 'The Washerwoman's Secret';
               the Southern Supporting Party; expansion of the cave;
               return from the south; return to Australia; arrival
               with the 'Aurora'; fishing;the homeward journey;
               account of
 " Huntoylette,"
 Hurley, J. F., Main Base; camera work; observations; rescue of the dogs;
                production of 'The Washerwoman's Secret; the Southern
                Party; the cairn;pitching tent; "Lot's Wife";
                the 'Christmas Carol'; snow-blindness; return from the
                south; arrival with the 'Aurora'; sledging
 Hurricane-walking
 Hut, the Main Base, temperature; tunnels; the nightwatchman's duty
......Point, McMurdo Sound
 Hutchinson, sealer of Macquarie Island

 Ice, Arctic and Antarctic compared; the first; pack-ice; bergs;
        structural composition
 "Ice floods,"
 "Ice islands,"
 Ice-shafts, digging of
 "Icing-ship,"
 'Illustrated London News'
 Insect hunting

 Jack, dog
 Jackson, Port
 Jacob & Coy., Messrs.
 Jaeger fleece
 Japanese Antarctic expedition
 Jappy, dog
 Jeffreys Deep
 Jeffryes, S. N., wireless operator
 'Jessie Nichol', wreck
 John Bull, dog
 Johnson, dog
 Joinville Island
 Jones, Dr. S. E., autopsy on the dogs; member of Wild's party; party
                 formed to lay a depot on September; Wild's instructions
                 to; main western journey starting November; "Linking
                 up with Kaiser Wilhelm  Land," account by; discovery
                 of Antarctic petrels; view of Drygalski Island; account
                 of; medical report for Western Base
........Bros., Messrs.
 Journalists' Association
 Joyce, Mr. E., delivery of the dogs;
 Judge and Clerk, islet of; soundings
 Junction Corner

 Kaiser Wilhelm I Land, linking up with, account by Dr. S. E. Jones
 Kangaroo Island
 Keiller, Messrs. James & Son
 Kelp
 Kembla, Port
 Kemp, work of
 Kennedy, [A. L.] member of Wild's party; attempted trip with Wild for
          the minimum thermometer; Eastern summer journey; blocked on
          the ice-shelf with Wild; observations; account of
 Kerguelen Island
 Kidston, Mr. E.
 King Edward V Land
.....George V Land, naming of; map
 King' Birthday, at Western Base
................Island
 Kinsey, Mr. J. J.
 Kite, work with
 Knibbs, G. H.
 Knox Land
 Kristensen, Leonard

 Lake-ice
 Lamp, a non-magnetic
 Lampwick, uses of
 Larson, C. A.
 Laseron, C. F., Main Base; biological work; collection of petrel
                 skin; at Aladdin's Cave; production of The 'Washerwoman's
                 Secret'; the Southern Supporting Party; recording
                 Webb's observations; expansion of the Cave; journey
                 to Commonwealth Bay December 9; collection of eggs
                 and birds; return from the east; back to Australia;
                 account of
 Lassie, dog
 Lever Brothers, Messrs.
 Lewis, Sir Elliott
 Lithgrow Colleries
 "Lot's Wife,"
 Loubet Land
 Louis Phillippe Land
 Lucas Sounding-machine
 Lucas-Tooth, Sir Robert
 Ludowici, Messrs.  (note)
 Lusitania Bay;
..........the, sealing boat
 Lyttleton, Port, arrival of the 'Aurora'

 "M. H. S. Championship, " the start
 Mac, dog
 McClintock, expedition of 1850; rations
 Mackay, Dr. F. A.
 Mackellar Islet
 Mackellar Library
..........the Hon.C.D.
 McLean, Dr. A. L., autopsy on the dogs; at Main Base; electrical
                 observations; lines on 'The Blizzard'; erection of
                 the wireless; observations regarding seals; at
                 Aladdin's Cave; blood-pressure, observations;
                 at Cathedral Grotto; expedition of the Eastern Coastal
                 Party; snow-blindness; at Horn Bluff; photographs taken
                 by; return of; the relief expedition; winter work at
                 the Hut; founding of 'The Adelie Blizzard'; on illness
                 of Jeffryes; a wind episode; dredging operations;
                 biological specimen; the home journey; account;
                 medical report for Main Base
 McMurdo Sound, wind velocities, chart; the Scott expedition
 Macquarie Island, the base at; "Life on Macquarie Island," by G. F.
             Ainsworth; "A Land of Storm and Mist," by G. F. Ainsworth;
             "Through Another Year," by G. F. Ainsworth;
             Macquarie Island Party, list of
 Madigan, C. T., at Main Base; meteorological observations; at the Hut;
             electrical observation; spring exploits; journey to the
             west, September 1912; sledging; the Eastern Coastal Party;
             return to the Hut; his account of the expedition of the
             Eastern Coastal Party; "Horn Bluff and Penguin Point" by;
             depot of; visit to the 'Aurora'; care of the dogs; winter
             work at the Hut; journey to Mount Murchison; the home
             journey; account
...........Nunatak
 Magnetic Flat, the
.........meridian
.........needle, use for steering purposes
.........Pole, North
.........Pole, South, observations regarding the; Bage's search for;
             chart
 Magnetograph House; work of the magnetician
 Magnetometer, the
 Maiden, Mr. J. H.
 Main Base, Adelie Land, visit of the 'Aurora'; wireless installation at
...........Base Party, list of; return of members to Australia
 Maori cabbage (Stilbocarpa polaris)
......hens, see Wekas
 Martelli, Mr., assistant harbourmaster, Hobart
 Mary, dog
......Queen, message to Antarctica
 Mason Coy., Messrs.
 Masson Island
.......Professor, efforts to raise funds,
 Mawson, Dr., plans for the expedition; party of
 Medical equipment for the expedition
........reports
 Melba, Mme.
 Melbourne, arrival of the 'Aurora'; wireless calls; time signals from
...........Observatory
 Memorial cross on Azimuth Hill
 Men, choice of, for a polar campaign
 Mertz, Dr. Xavier, appointment; at Hobart, care of the dogs; at Main
               Base; meteorological observations; skiing; cooking;
               at Aladdin's Cave; journey to the southeast, September 11;
               the Far Eastern Party; the return journey; illness and
               death; Bage's parting from; meeting with the Eastward
               Coastal Party; Captain Davis's inquiries after; message
               to his relatives; account of
........Glacier
........Glacier-tongue
 Meteorology, work of the expedition; meteorological chart for April
                          1913
 Meteorite found
 Midsummer Day, temperature
 Midwinter Day at Western Base
 Mikkel, dog
 Mill, Dr. H. R., "Siege of the South Pole,"
.........Rise
 Minerals of Adelie Land
 Mitts
 Mollymawk rookery
 Monaco, Prince of
 Monagasque trawl
 Monkey, dog
 Moore, T. E. L.
 'Morning Herald', Sydney
 Morton, Messrs. C. & E.
 Motte, C. P de la
 Moyes, M. H., member of Wild's party; account of
 Moraine, terminal, Adelie Land
 'Morning', the, British expedition,
 Murchison, Mount;
...........Mr. Roderick
 Murphy, H. D., at Main Base; erection of the wireless installation;
                at Aladdin's Cave; journey to the southeast September 11;
                observations; formation of the Southern Supporting Party;
                return to the Hut; composition of party at Cathedral
                Grotto; return from the south; visit to the 'Aurora';
                return to Australia; account of
 Murphy, H. D. (senior)
 Murray, G. J. H.
 Mutton birds

 Nansen, expedition in the 'Fram'; 'Farthest North'; use of the primus
            stove,
........dog
 Nares, Captain G. S.
 National Museum, Melbourne
.........Physical Laboratory, London
 Near Eastern Party
 Neave, Messrs.
 Negretti & Zambra, Messrs.
 Nestle, Messrs.
 Neve
 New Zealand, depots maintained by; flora of, theories regarding
 Newnes, Sir George
 Nightbirds
 'Nimrod', the, voyages;
 Ninnis Glacier
.......Lieut. B. E. S., appointment; care of the dogs; at the Main Base;
                         clothing artifices; spring exploits; journey
                         to the southeast, September 11; the Far Eastern
                         Party; his death in the crevasse; Bage's parting
                         from; flag planted by; Captain Davis's inquiries
                         after; message to his relatives; account of
 "Nodules (The),"
 Nordensyold, Otto
 North, Cape
.......East Bay;
.......End
.......Head
 Northcliffe Glacier
 North's Land
 Notothenia
 "Nuggets (The)"

 Oates Land
 Observation Point
 Oceanography, results of expedition
 Oil, seal, methods of the sealers
 Organ Pipe Cliffs

 Pack-ice;
 Palmer Archipelago
.......Nathaniel
 Parisitology
 Parsons, Messrs.
 Parties for sledging, arrangement
 Patria Biscuit Fabriek
 Partridge & Twiss, Messrs.
 Pavlova, dog
 'Peacock', the;
 Peary, dog
 Pemmican
 Penguin Hill
 "Penguin Point," by C. T. Madigan
 Penguin rookeries;
 Penguins
........Adelie
........an Albino Penguin
........Emperor
........Gentoo
........King
........Royal
........Victoria,
 Pennant Hills
 'Perseverance', the
 Peter I Island
 Petrel Rookeries
 Petrels
........Antaretic
........Giant
........Lesson's
........Silver-grey or Southern Fulmar
........Snow
........Wilson
 Petrol, amount carried
 Pianoforte Berg
 "Piecrust"
 Pigeons, Cape
 Piper, Mr.
 Plasmon
 Pollock, Professor J. A.
 'Porpoise', the
 Posadowsky Bay
 Possession Nunataks
 Primmer, Mr.
 Primus heater, the
 Prince Luitpold Land
 Prion Banksii
 Proteins, value of
 "Puffometer," the
 Punch

 Quarantine Station, Hobart
 Queen Mary Land
 Queen's Wharf, Hobart

 Rabbits
 'Rachel Cohen', the
 Ramornie Meat Coy.
 Rations, daily polar; for the Far Eastern Party; for the sledge journey
          from the Western Base
 Rats
 Reid, Sir George,
......Glacier
 Robinson, Lionel
......Bay
......anemometer, the
 "Rock Flour,"
 Rocks, effect of wind and rain on
.......igneous
 Rose Island
.....Messrs.
 Ross Barrier
......dog
......Expedition
......Port
......Sea, the
 Royal Company Island
......Geographical Society.
 Royds, Cape
 Russian Antarctic Expeditions

 Sabrina Land
 'Sabrina', the
 Sails, value of
 St. Elmo's fire
 St. Vincent's Gulf
 Sames & Coy.
 Sandell, C. A., Wireless work at Macquarie Island; cooking; lantern
                 made by; visit to the 'Aurora'; erection of the
                 tide-gauge; sheepkilling; as barber; an accident to;
                 telephone installed by; lamp made by; the home journey;
                 account of
 Sandow, dog
........Mr. Eugene
 Sandy Bay, Hobart
...........Enderby Island
...........Macquarie Island
 "Sarcophagus," the
 Sastrugi
 Sawyer, A. J., wireless operator at Macquarie Island; visits to the
                'Aurora'; erection of the tide-gauge; leaves Macquarie
                Island; visit to the 'Tutanekai; account of
 Saxton & Binns, Messrs.
 Scarfe, Mr.
 Scientific equipment for the expedition,
...........work of the expedition
 'Scotia', the
 Scott, Captain, work of; voyage of the 'Discovery; voyage in the
                'Terra Nova'; rations allowed by; stay in Antarctica;
                 at McMurdo Sound; the disaster to; on Macquarie Island,
........Islands
........Lady
........the dog
 Scott Expedition Staff
 Scottish Antarctic Expedition
 Sea, temperature, effect of snow on
 Sea bears
 Sea-elephants; rookeries of the
 Seager, Messrs.
 Sea-ice
 Sea-leopards
 Sealers of Macquarie Island; methods of the
 Sea-lions
 Seals
......Crabeater
......Fur
......Hair
......Ross
......Weddell
 Sewing-machine, Wild's need of a
 Shack, the
 Shackleton Expedition
...........Ice-Shelf, the; establishment of the Western Base on;
                       winter and spring on; Western Party blocked on,
                       Wild's narrative; the 'Aurora' at
...........the dog
 Shags
 Shaw, Dr. W. N.
 Shelf-ice
 Shell Brand benzine and Shell kerosene
 Shoe Island
 " Shuteye," practice of
 Signatures of members of land parties
 Simpson, Mr.
 Skeats, Professor E., examination of the meteorite
 Skey, Mr. H. F.
 Skiing
 Sledge, the air-tractor
 Sledging; preparation of equipment; wood for sledges; harness for;
           a load; camping
 Smith & Wellstood, Messrs.
.......William, work of
 Snow, temperatures
 Snow-blindness
 Snow drift, electrical effects
 Snow gauges
.....Hill Island
 Soundings, Lucas automatic sounding machine
 South Australian Museum
......Orkney Islands
......Shetland Islands
 Southern Cross Depot, declination of the needle at
.........Ocean
.........Party; instruments cached by
.........Supporting Party,
 'Sphere', the
 Spratt, Messrs., care of the dogs
 Steel Trucks Ltd.
 Stewart Island (New Zealand)
 Stillwell, F. L., at Main Base; geological researches; map of Winter
                  Quarters; records; production of 'The Washerwoman's
                  Secret'; finding an albino penguin; the Near Eastern
                  Party; his sledge; pitching tent; journey of the Near
                  Eastern Party; the search party; return to Australia;
                  account of
...........Island
 Stirling, Professor
 Storm Bay
 Strathcona, Lord
............Mount
 Sun, the midnight; display of rings and arcs
 Suva, wireless station
 Swallow & Ariell, Messrs.
 Sweep, dog
 Swiss Confederation Day
.......the dog
 Switzerland, the dog.
 Sydney, Wilkes's expedition started from; Cathedral of; wood from;
              the harbour; wireless communication with
........Meat Preserving Coy.
 'Sydney Morning Herald', donation

 Tasman Sea
 Tasmania, hospitality of; soundings
 Taylor, Mr. Allen
 "Te Sol,"
 Tea
 Temperature, Foehn effect; in Adelie Land
 Tent-pitching; Bickerton on
 'Terebus and Error in Eruption'
 Termination Ice Tongue
............Land
 Terns
 'Terra Nova', Scott's voyage
 Terrestrial magnetism, work of the expedition
 "The Steps"
 Theodolite, use of the
 Tich, dog
 Tide-gauge, Bage's; use on Macquarie Island
 Tides, work of the expedition
 Tidswell, Dr.
 Tiger, dog
 Tooth, Sir R. Lucas
.......Lady Helen—see Helen Glacier
 'Toroa', s.s.
 Totten's Land
 Toucher, N. C.
 Transit House
 Trawl, Monagasque
 Trawling, experiences of the 'Aurora'
 Tussock grass
 'Tutanekai', the, relief of Macquarie Island

 'Ulimaroa', s.s., the
 Umbrella aerial, use of the
 Union Jack, hoisting the
 University College, Christchurch
 Urville, Dumont D', expedition under
.........the dog

 'Valdivia' expedition
 "Veranda Club"
 Verran, Hon. J.
 Vickers & Coy., Messrs.
 Victoria Land
 Vincennes, the

 Waite, Mr. E. R.
 'Washerwoman's Secret, The'
 "Watersky,"
 Watkins, Lieut., aviator
 Watson, A. D., at the Western Base; attempted trip with Wild for the
                minimum thermometer; preparation for the Eastern summer
                journey; blocked on the ice-shelf with Wild; fall into
                a crevasse
..........Bluff
 Watt, Hon. W.
 Way Archipelago
..............map
......Sir Samuel
 Weather, the, as a conversational subject
 Webb, E. N., at Main Base; care of the dogs; work at the Magnetograph
              House; photo-work; magnetic ice-cave of; his first camp;
              formation of the Southern Sledging Party; observations of
              the needle; use of the theodolite; building a break-wind;
              the toasts on Christmas Day; sighting Aladdin's Cave;
              return from the south; return to Australia; account of
 Weddell, James, work
.........Sea
 Wekas
 Wellington, Mount
.............wireless communication with
 Welsh, Professor
 Western Base, the party at; winter and spring at the; establishment and
              adventures by F. Wild; the geological shaft; "The Glacier
              Tongue"; Wild's party blocked on the Ice Shelf; linking
              up with Kaiser Wilhelm II Land, account by Dr. S. E. Jones;
              medical reports from
 West Point
 Western Sledging Party
 'Westralia', s.s.,
 Whalebirds
 Whales
 Whetter, Dr. L. A., at Main Base; the "Toggle King"; journey to the west;
                   the Western Party; meteorological work; preparations for
                   the air-tractor sledge trip; his birthday; on tent
                   pitching; investigations of a snow ramp; return; return
                   to Australia; account of
 "Whirlies,"
 Wild, Frank, the work at Hobart; working of the "flyingfox"; incidents
             on board; leader of the Western Base; the winter station on
             the ice shelf; rations for the expedition; arrangements with
             the 'Aurora'; return to Aladdin's Cave; his party at Western
             Base; relief of; reception of the 'Aurora'; winter and spring;
             land mapped out by; blocked on the ice shelf, narrative
 Wilkes, discoveries of; charts; Knox Land,
 Wilkes's Land
 Willesden-drill, tents
 Williamstown, Victoria
 Wind, velocities
 Winds, Bay of
 Winsor & Newton, Messrs.
 Winter quarters, Adelie Land
.............Stillwell's map
 Wireless Hill, establishment of the station;
.........installation range, in the Antarctic; report of Captain Davis;
          messages received by Hannam on the 'Aurora'; messages from,
          and to, Adelie Land; effect of ice on intensity of waves;
          work of the expedition; telefunken apparatus
 Worms, parasitical, in fish

 'Zelee', the
 Zip, the dog
 Zoological investigations
Apart from getting the instruments, there were extensive preparations to be done in organizing the scientific program and training the observers. The Expedition received help from many friends in this area.

Professor W. A. Haswell (Biology), Professor T. W. Edgeworth David (Geology), and Mr. H. A. Hunt (Meteorology) each created instructions related to their fields. Training in astronomy at the Melbourne Observatory was overseen by Mr. P. Baracchi, the Director, and training in magnetic work was handled by the Department of Terrestrial Magnetism at the Carnegie Institute (Director, Dr. L. A. Bauer). Additionally, in the area of magnetics, we are particularly grateful to Mr. E. Kidston from the Carnegie Institute for field training, and to Mr. Baldwin from the Melbourne Observatory for demonstrations on how to operate the Eschenhagen magnetographs. Professor J. A. Pollock provided us with valuable advice on wireless and other physical topics. At the Australian Museum in Sydney, Mr. Hedley assisted with the zoological preparations. We were also aided on many occasions by Messrs. W. S. Dun (Sydney), J. H. Maiden (Sydney), Robert Hall (Hobart), G. H. Knibbs (Melbourne), as well as the presidents and members of various Geographical Societies in Australia—including, of course, those from the Royal Geographical Society in London.

In summary, the generous, selfless help from all the individuals mentioned above and many other friends helped us make our scientific equipment nearly complete and very modern.
INDEX

 Abrasion effects of drift snow,  
 Abruzzi expedition 1900, rations  
 Absolute Hut, the  
 Acetylene Corporation, London, (note)  
 Adare, Cape  
 Adelaide Island  
 .........University  
 'Adelie Blizzard'  
 ........Land;  
 the main base at; glaciation of; hurricanes of; Wilkes' account of; the Hut; drifts; wireless installation at; clothing for; Empire Day in; temperatures  
 Admiralty Range  
 Aerial Cove, depot  
 Aeroplane sledge. See Air-tractor sledge  
 Ainsworth, G F.,  
 "Life on Macquarie Island;" "A Land of Storm and Mist,"  
 "Through Another Year;" picked up by the 'Aurora',  
 the home journey; account of  
 Air-tractor sledge, the;  
 Aladdin's Cave;  
 Albatross  
 Alden, Cape,  
 Alexander I Island,  
 Alexandra, Queen  
 Allen and Hanbury, Messrs.  
 Alligator Nunatak.  
 'Amakura', the  
 American expedition under Wilkes  
 ........ Quadrant, the, accessibility; whaling industry in  
 Amundsen, Captain; sledging dogs presented by  
 ..........dog  
 Anchor Rock  
 Anemobiagraph, the  
 Anemometers  
 Anemones, preservation of  
 Angas Mr. C.  
 "Annie Hill,"  
 Antarctic theory of distribution of flora  
 Antarctica, history of discovery  
 'Anthology of Australian Verse, An'  
 Anthony, Messrs., of Melbourne  
 'Archibald Russell', the  
 Arnott Bros., Messrs.  
 Asia, Southern, wind velocities  
 'Astrolabe', D'Urville's journey in the  
 Astronomer Royal, the  
 Astronomical Hut, the  
 "Atmospherics,"  
 Auckland Islands  
 'Aurora', the S.Y. plan and section; adaptation and fitting out;  
 from Macquarie Island to Adelie Land; the first ice; landing of  
 cargo at main base; new lands; food carried by the; return of the;  
 observations secured on the; deep-sea soundings; at Macquarie Island;  
 arrival at Port Lyttleton; at Melbourne; second deep-sea cruise;  
 departure from Hobart, Christmas; visit to the main base, Adelie Land;  
 reception by Wild; relief of Wild's party; arrival in Hobart; papers  
 brought by the; stores laid at Caroline Cove; visits to Macquarie  
 Island; at Dunedin; leaves Hobart on Southern trip to bring back the  
 two parties; wireless communication with; the Homeward Cruise; list  
 of ship's officers  
 .........Peak  
 Auroral phenomena  
 Australasian Association for Advancement of Science,  
 Australian ensign hoisted  
 Avalanche Rocks  
 Avalanches,~  
 Azimuth Hill;  
 memorial cross on  

 Bacteriology, work of the expedition,  
 Bage, R., at the main base; work at the hut; the tide-gauge;  
 transit house; food experiences; search for the dogs;  
 with the Southern Sledging Party; return to the hut;  
 on building a tent; snow-blindness; return to Aladdin's Cave;  
 note left by, at Cathedral Grotto; return from the south;  
 visit to the 'Aurora'; the relief expedition; winter work;  
 wireless work; magnetograph records; the home journey;  
 account of  
 Baldwin, Mr.  
 Baldwin-Spencer, Professor  
 Balleny Islands  
 John  
 Bang, C. A. (note)  
 Baracchi, Mr. P.  
 Barometer, movements of the  
 "Barrier," the, at the Winter Quarters  
 "Barrier-formations,"  
 Barron, Lady  
 ........Sir Harry  
 Barr-Smith, Mount  
 ......Mr. Robert  
 Basilisk, dog  
 Bass Strait  
 Bates, Mr. D. C.; request for weather reports  
 Batger, Messrs.  
 Bauer, Dr. L. A.  
 Mr., Sealer at Macquarie Island  
 Baynes Bros., Messrs.  

 "Beaufort scale" of wind-pressure  
 Belgian Antarctic expedition  
 Bellingshausen, expedition of 1821  
 "Benzine Hut,"  
 Bergschrund  
 Betli, dog  
 Bickerton, F. H., at main base; work at the hut; erection of the  
 wireless installation; food experiences; "bus driver";  
 the air-tractor sledge; the Western sledging expedition;  
 on tent pitching; his birthday; the relief party; winter work  
 at the hut; wireless work; dredge constructed by; the home journey;  
 account of  
 Biology, work of the expedition  
 Bird & Coy, Messrs.  
 Birds, Antarctic, weight in relation to wing areas  
 Birthday Camp  
 Biscoe Island  
 ........John, work  
 Bishop and Clerk, islet  
 Black Sunday  
 Blair, J. H., Chief Officer on the 'Aurora'  
 Blake, Cape  
 ...... L R., work on Macquarie Island; visit to Sandy Bay;  
 accident to; visits to Lusitania Bay; photographs taken by  
 visits to the 'Aurora'; specimens obtained; sheepkilling;  
 the home journey; account of  
 Blizzard, puppy  
 .........the  
 'Blizzard, The', poem  
 Blood-pressure, observations by McLean,  
 "Blue Billys,"  
 "Board-sliding,"  
 Bollons, Captain  
 Borchgrevinck  
 Borda, Cape  
 Border (Rabbit) Preserving Coy.  
 Bovril Coy., the  
 Brand & Coy., Messrs.  
 Bridge-playing at Western Base  
 Bristow, Captain  
 British Antarctic expedition  
 British Expedition  
 British Meteorological Office  
 "Brothers (The),"  
 Brown, Mr. John  
 Brown & Polson, Messrs.  
 Bruce, Dr. W. S.  
 ........Rise  
 Bruni Island  
 Bryant & May, Messrs.  
 Buchanan, Mr. J. Y.;  
 ..........S. Y.  
 Buckley, Mr. G.  
 Budd Land;  
 Buenos Ayres  
 Bull, H. J.  
 Bullivant, Messrs.  
 Burberry, the  
 Burroughs & Wellcome, Messrs.  
 Buzzacott, Messrs.  

 Cadbury, Messrs.  
 Camp Cove  
 Campbell & Sons, Messrs.  
 Camping  
 "Cannonading,"  
 Canterbury Museum, Christchurch  
 Cape Town  
 Carbohydrates, definition of the term (note)  
 Cardiff to Hobart, the journey  
 Carnegie Institute  
 Carnley Harbour  
 Caroline Cove, Macquarie Island  
 Carr, Cape  
 Caruso, dog  
 Castor, dog  
 Cat, wild  
 Catch Me Cave  
 Cathedral Grotto, the  
 'Challenger' expedition  
 Charcot, Jean  
 .........Land  
 Chetwynd, Captain  
 Chocolate as barter  
 Chree, Dr. C.,  
 Christchurch, New Zealand  
 ...........Magnetic Observatory  
 'Christmas Carol, A'  
 ...........Day, Dr. Mawson's; with the Southern Sledging Party;  
 Ainsworth's account; on the homeward journey  
 Chun, Professor, of Leipsic  
 Close, J. H., at Main Base; at Aladdin's Cave; journey to the West;  
 and the Near Eastern Party; journey to Commonwealth Bay;  
 return from the East; back to Australia; account of  
 Clothing for the expedition  
 Clyde, wreck of the  
 Coal-supply, difficulties of  
 Coats Land  
 Cocoa, value of,  
 Colac Dairying Coy.  
 Colman, Messrs.  
 Colonel, dog  
 Colonial Sugar Refining Coy.  
 Commonwealth Bay  
 .............Fisheries Department  
 .............Meteorological Department  
 .............Weather Bureau, reports to  
 Cormorant. See Shag  
 Compass, variations of the; the bearing of the sun and the  
 magnetic needle compared  
 Conrad, Messrs.  
 Cook, Captain James  
 Copenhagen  
 Coronae, lunar  
 Correll, P. E., at Main Base; and the tide-gauge;  
 production of 'The Washerwoman's Secret;  
 the Eastern Coastal Party; at Horn Bluff,  
 the search party; return to Australia;  
 photographs taken by; the homeward journey;  
 account of  
 .........Nunatak  
 Cote Clarie  
 Crampons, use of  
 Crippen, dog  
 Crown Fuel Company, briquettes  

 'Daily Graphic'  
 ....... 'Mail'  
 Dallman, Eduard  
 Danish Geographical Society  
 Darwin, Charles  
 David Island  
 ......Professor T. W. Edgeworth  
 Davis, Captain J. K., appointment; arrival at Hobart; work of stowage;  
 the journey to Macquarie Island; voyage in the Nimrod;  
 at Macquarie Island; events on board; narrative quoted; return  
 of the 'Aurora'; his decision regarding Wild's party; "The Ship's  
 Story"; mission to London; visits to Macquarie Island;  
 the homeward cruise; account of  
 .......Captain James, of Hobart, joins the 'Aurora'; efforts to recover  
 ship's lost chain; account of  
 .......Sea  
 "DeadBeat Gully,"  
 Deakin, Hon. Alfred  
 Declination of the magnetic needle  
 Decouverte, Cape  
 Delay Point  
 Denison, Cape;  
 ..........Mr. Hugh  
 Denman Glacier, the  
 ........Lord, messages to Antarctica; Finance  
 Denny, Mr., visit to Macquarie  
 D'Entrecasteaux Channel  
 Depot Bay  
 Depots maintained by the New Zealand Government  
 Derwent River, the;  
 Dietetics  
 Disappointment Island  
 'Discovery', voyage of the  
 ...........Cape  
 Dixson Island  
 Mr. Hugh  
 Dodwell, Mr. P.  
 Dogs for the expedition, journey to Hobart; at the hut; harness for the;  
 food for the; at Aladdin's Cave; with the sledging parties;  
 the lost; used for food; presented to the 'Aurora' by Amundsen;  
 with the Western Party; pups; quarrels  
 Dolerite (note)  
 Dominion Meteorological Office  
 Doolette, Mr. G. P.  
 Dovers, G., member of Wild's party; depot-laying party formed;  
 surveying work; at Haswell Island; account of  
 'Drake', H.M.S., wireless communication with  
 Drift gauge, a  
 Drift snow; abrasion effects of; electrical effects of  
 Drygalski Island  (note)  
 .........Professor;  
 Ducks  
 Dun, W.S.  
 'Dundonald', barque  
 Dunedin  
 D'Urville Sea;  

 'Eagle' Cave  
 ........schooner, wreck  
 Earthquake shocks at Macquarie Island  
 Eastern Barrier  
 ........Coastal Party, formation; account of, by Madigan;  
 instruments cached by  
 Eclipse, lunar,  
 Eitel, Mr. C. C.  
 Elder, Mr.  
 .......Mount  
 'Eliza Scott', the  
 Empire Day, at the Western Base; on Adelie Land  
 'Encyclopaedia Britannica', use of  
 'Endeavour', the  
 Enderby Island  
 ........Land  
 Equinox, effects of the  
 Equipment of the expedition  
 Erebus Cove  
 "Erratics,"  
 Esperance, Port  
 Esquimaux, dogs of the; method with snow-blindness,  
 Euphausia  
 Evans, Commander  
 Evensen, work of  

 Farr, Dr. C. C.  
 Fallieres Land  
 'Fantome', H.M.S.  
 Far-Eastern Party, the; the return of  
 Farrah, Messrs.  
 Fats, definition of term, (note)  
 "Feather Bed" terrace  
 Fiala, quoted  
 Figure of Eight Island  
 Filchner, Wilhelm  
 Finance of the expedition  
 Finnesko footwear  
 Fisher, Hon. Andrew,  
 ........wireless message to  
 Fishing  
 Fix, dog  
 Flag depot  
 Flagstaff Point, Carnley Harbour  
 Flemington Meat Preserving Coy.  
 Fletcher, F. D.  
 Flora, Antarctic, theories concerning  
 'Flying Fish', the  
 .........Fox, working of the  
 Flynn, Professor T. T.  
 Foehn effect  
 Food, for sledging journey, dietetics; rations; items;  
 table of supplies  
 Fram, dog  
 ......voyage of the  
 Franklin, dog  
 Freshfield, Cape  
 Fuller, Messrs.  
 Fusilier, dog  

 Gadget, dog  
 Gamage, Messrs  (note)  
 'Gauss', expedition of the  
 Gaussberg  
 Geographical results of the expedition  
 Geological work of the expedition  
 George, dog  
 ........V, King, wireless message to,  
 Georgia, South;  
 Gerlache, Adrien de  
 ..........Cape  
 German Scientific Expedition; expedition of 1902, see Gauss  
 Gillies, F., chief engineer of the 'Aurora'  
 .........Nunataks  
 Ginger, dog  
 ......Bitch, dog,  
 Glacier, the continental,  
 Glacier-ice, structural composition  
 Glacier-tongues  
 Glaciology, work of the expedition  
 Glaxo  
 Gloves  
 Goggles for snow-blindness  
 Golf at Western Base  
 Gracht, Mr. Van Waterschoot van der  
 'Grafton', wreck of the  
 Graham's Land  
 Gramophone Coy., London,  (note)  
 Grampuses  
 Grandmother, dog  
 Gray, Cape  
 ......P., second officer 'Aurora'  
 Great Australian Bight  
 .....Britain, Antarctic Expeditions  
 .....Ross Barrier;  
 Greely expedition of 1882  
 Green Valley  
 Greenland, dogs from  
 ..........pup  
 Greenwich Observatory  
 Griffiths Brothers, Messrs.  
 "Grottoes (The)," the hut at the Western Base, building; return  
 of the sledging party; entrance and tunnels; the igloo;  
 clearing the tunnels; return of the Western depot party;  
 preparations for the Eastern summer journey; return of Wild;  
 distances from; return of Jones's party; the flagstaff  
 Guano deposits  
 Gulls, Dominican or black backed  
 .......skua  

 Haines, Mr., taxidermist  
 Haldane, dog  
 Hall, Robert  
 Halligan, Mr. G.  
 Hamilton, H., life at Macquarie Island; visits to Sandy Bay;  
 biological work; reception of the 'Aurora';  
 erection of the tide gauge; a dinghy for; visits to  
 Lusitania Bay; photographs by; home journey; account of  
 .........Mount  
 Hangar  
 Hannan, W. H., at Main Base; work at the hut; wireless work;  
 the drift gauge; as magnetician; working of the air-tractor  
 sledge; the wireless at Winter Quarters; return to Australia;  
 account of  
 Harbour Board, Hobart  
 Harness, sledging,  
 Harrisson, C. T.; member of Wild's party; visit to the capsized berg,  
 account; Hippo depot; meteorological work at The Grottoes;  
 included in the Eastern summer journey; winch contrived by;  
 account  
 Hartley, Messrs.  
 Hasselborough Bay  
 ..............Captain  
 Haswell Island  
 ............Professor W. A.  
 Hedley, Mr. C.  
 Heinz, Messrs.  
 Helen Glacier  
 Henderson, Professor G. C..  
 Henderson Island  
 Hens, Cape  
 'Hinemoa', rescue by  
 'Hints to Travellers'  
 Hippo Nunatak  
 Hoadley, C. A.,  member Wild's party; party to lay depot formed;  
 main western journey starting November; geological work;  
 at Haswell Island; account  
 Hobart  
 Hodgeman, A. J., at Main Base; work at hut; Near Eastern Party;  
 the cairn; return to the hut; journey of the Near Eastern  
 Party; trip to Aladdin's Cave; on tent-pitching; investigation  
 of snow ramp; the relief party; winter work at the hut;  
 journey to Mount Murchison; the home journey; map of Mackellar  
 Islets; account of  
 Holliman, Captain,  
 Holman, Hon., W. A.  
 Hoosh  
 Hordern, Mr. Samuel  
 Horlick, Messrs.  
 Horn Bluff  
 "Horn Bluff," by C. T. Madigan  
 Horn, Mr. W. A.  
 Hoyle, pup  
 Hugon, Messrs.  
 Hunt, Mount  
 ......Mr. H. A.  
 Hunter, Cape  
 ........J. G., at Main Base; biological work; parasitology;  
 sledging; production of 'The Washerwoman's Secret';  
 the Southern Supporting Party; expansion of the cave;  
 return from the south; return to Australia; arrival  
 with the 'Aurora'; fishing; the homeward journey;  
 account of  
 " Huntoylette,"  
 Hurley, J. F., Main Base; camera work; observations; rescue of the dogs;  
 production of 'The Washerwoman's Secret; the Southern  
 Party; the cairn; pitching tent; "Lot's Wife";  
 the 'Christmas Carol'; snow-blindness; return from the  
 south; arrival with the 'Aurora'; sledging  
 Hurricane-walking  
 Hut, the Main Base, temperature; tunnels; the nightwatchman's duty  
 ......Point, McMurdo Sound  
 Hutchinson, sealer of Macquarie Island  

 Ice, Arctic and Antarctic compared; the first; pack-ice; bergs;  
 structural composition  
 "Ice floods,"  
 "Ice islands,"  
 Ice-shafts, digging of  
 "Icing-ship,"  
 'Illustrated London News'  
 Insect hunting  

 Jack, dog  
 Jackson, Port  
 Jacob & Coy., Messrs.  
 Jaeger fleece  
 Japanese Antarctic expedition  
 Jappy, dog  
 Jeffreys Deep  
 Jeffryes, S. N., wireless operator  
 'Jessie Nichol', wreck  
 John Bull, dog  
 Johnson, dog  
 Joinville Island  
 Jones, Dr. S. E., autopsy on the dogs; member of Wild's party; party  
 formed to lay a depot on September; Wild's instructions  
 to; main western journey starting November; "Linking  
 up with Kaiser Wilhelm  Land," account by; discovery  
 of Antarctic petrels; view of Drygalski Island; account  
 of; medical report for Western Base  
 ........Bros., Messrs.  
 Journalists' Association  
 Joyce, Mr. E., delivery of the dogs;  
 Judge and Clerk, islet of; soundings  
 Junction Corner  

 Kaiser Wilhelm I Land, linking up with, account by Dr. S. E. Jones  
 Kangaroo Island  
 Keiller, Messrs. James & Son  
 Kelp  
 Kembla, Port  
 Kemp, work of  
 Kennedy, [A. L.] member of Wild's party; attempted trip with  
 Wild for the minimum thermometer; Eastern summer journey; blocked on  
 the ice-shelf with Wild; observations; account of  
 Kerguelen Island  
 Kidston, Mr. E.  
 King Edward V Land  
 .....George V Land, naming of; map  
 King' Birthday, at Western Base  
 ................Island  
 Kinsey, Mr. J. J.  
 Kite, work with  
 Knibbs, G. H.  
 Knox Land  
 Kristensen, Leonard  

 Lake-ice  
 Lamp, a non-magnetic  
 Lampwick, uses of  
 Larson, C. A.  
 Laseron, C. F., Main Base; biological work; collection of petrel  
 skin; at Aladdin's Cave; production of The 'Washerwoman's  
 Secret'; the Southern Supporting Party; recording  
 Webb's observations; expansion of the Cave; journey  
 to Commonwealth Bay December 9; collection of eggs  
 and birds; return from the east; back to Australia;  
 account of  
 Lassie, dog  
 Lever Brothers, Messrs.  
 Lewis, Sir Elliott  
 Lithgrow Colleries  
 "Lot's Wife,"  
 Loubet Land  
 Louis Phillippe Land  
 Lucas Sounding-machine  
 Lucas-Tooth, Sir Robert  
 Ludowici, Messrs.  (note)  
 Lusitania Bay;  
 ..........the, sealing boat  
 Lyttleton, Port, arrival of the 'Aurora'  

 "M. H. S. Championship," the start  
 Mac, dog  
 McClintock, expedition of 1850; rations  
 Mackay, Dr. F. A.  
 Mackellar Islet  
 Mackellar Library  
 ..........the Hon.C.D.  
 McLean, Dr. A. L., autopsy on the dogs; at Main Base; electrical  
 observations; lines on 'The Blizzard'; erection of  
 the wireless; observations regarding seals; at  
 Aladdin's Cave; blood-pressure, observations;  
 at Cathedral Grotto; expedition of the Eastern Coastal  
 Party; snow-blindness; at Horn Bluff; photographs taken  
 by; return of; the relief expedition; winter work at  
 the Hut; founding of 'The Adelie Blizzard'; on illness  
 of Jeffryes; a wind episode; dredging operations;  
 biological specimen; the home journey; account;  
 medical report for Main Base  
 McMurdo Sound, wind velocities, chart; the Scott expedition  
 Macquarie Island, the base at; "Life on Macquarie Island," by G. F.  
 Ainsworth; "A Land of Storm and Mist," by G. F. Ainsworth;  
 "Through Another Year," by G. F. Ainsworth;  
 Macquarie Island Party, list of  
 Madigan, C. T., at Main Base; meteorological observations; at the Hut;  
 electrical observation; spring exploits; journey to the  
 west, September 1912; sledging; the Eastern Coastal Party;  
 return to the Hut; his account of the expedition of the  
 Eastern Coastal Party; "Horn Bluff and Penguin Point" by;  
 depot of; visit to the 'Aurora'; care of the dogs; winter  
 work at the Hut; journey to Mount Murchison; the home  
 journey; account  
 ...........Nunatak  
 Magnetic Flat, the  
 .........meridian  
 .........needle, use for steering purposes  
 .........Pole, North  
 .........Pole, South, observations regarding the; Bage's search for;  
 chart  
 Magnetograph House; work of the magnetician  
 Magnetometer, the  
 Maiden, Mr. J. H.  
 Main Base, Adelie Land, visit of the 'Aurora'; wireless installation at  
 ...........Base Party, list of; return of members to Australia  
 Maori cabbage (Stilbocarpa polaris)  
 ......hens, see Wekas  
 Martelli, Mr., assistant harbourmaster, Hobart  
 Mary, dog  
 ......Queen, message to Antarctica  
 Mason Coy., Messrs.  
 Masson Island  
 .......Professor, efforts to raise funds,  
 Mawson, Dr., plans for the expedition; party of  
 Medical equipment for the expedition  
 ........reports  
 Melba, Mme.  
 Melbourne, arrival of the 'Aurora'; wireless calls; time signals from  
 ...........Observatory  
 Memorial cross on Azimuth Hill  
 Men, choice of, for a polar campaign  
 Mertz, Dr. Xavier, appointment; at Hobart, care of the dogs; at Main  
 Base; meteorological observations; skiing; cooking;  
 at Aladdin's Cave; journey to the southeast, September 11;  
 the Far Eastern Party; the return journey; illness and  
 death; Bage's parting from; meeting with the Eastward  
 Coastal Party; Captain Davis's inquiries after; message  
 to his relatives; account of  
 ........Glacier  
 ........Glacier-tongue  
 Meteorology, work of the expedition; meteorological chart for April  
 1913  
 Meteorite found  
 Midsummer Day, temperature  
 Midwinter Day at Western Base  
 Mikkel, dog  
 Mill, Dr. H. R., "Siege of the South Pole,"  
 .........Rise  
 Minerals of Adelie Land  
 Mitts  
 Mollymawk rookery  
 Monaco, Prince of  
 Monagasque trawl  
 Monkey, dog  
 Moore, T. E. L.  
 'Morning Herald', Sydney  
 Morton, Messrs. C. & E.  
 Motte, C. P de la  
 Moyes, M. H., member of Wild's party; account of  
 Moraine, terminal, Adelie Land  
 'Morning', the, British expedition,  
 Murchison, Mount;  
 ...........Mr. Roderick  
 Murphy, H. D., at Main Base; erection of the wireless installation;  
 at Aladdin's Cave; journey to the southeast September 11;  
 observations; formation of the Southern Supporting Party;  
 return to the Hut; composition of party at Cathedral  
 Grotto; return from the south; visit to the 'Aurora';  
 return to Australia; account of  
 Murphy, H. D. (senior)  
 Murray, G. J. H.  
 Mutton birds  

 Nansen, expedition in the 'Fram'; 'Farthest North'; use of the primus  
 stove,  
 ........dog  
 Nares, Captain G. S.  
 National Museum, Melbourne  
 .........Physical Laboratory, London  
 Near Eastern Party  
 Neave, Messrs.  
 Negretti & Zambra, Messrs.  
 Nestle, Messrs.  
 Neve  
 New Zealand, depots maintained by; flora of, theories regarding  
 Newnes, Sir George  
 Nightbirds  
 'Nimrod', the, voyages;  
 Ninnis Glacier  
 .......Lieut. B. E. S., appointment; care of the dogs; at the Main Base;  
 clothing artifices; spring exploits; journey  
 to the southeast, September 11; the Far Eastern  
 Party; his death in the crevasse; Bage's parting  
 from; flag planted by; Captain Davis's inquiries  
 after; message to his relatives; account of  
 "Nodules (The),"  
 Nordensyold, Otto  
 North, Cape  
 .......East Bay;  
 .......End  
 .......Head  
 Northcliffe Glacier  
 North's Land  
 Notothenia  
 "Nuggets (The)"  

 Oates Land  
 Observation Point  
 Oceanography, results of expedition  
 Oil, seal, methods of the sealers  
 Organ Pipe Cliffs  

 Pack-ice;  
 Palmer Archipelago  
 .......Nathaniel  
 Parisitology  
 Parsons, Messrs.  
 Parties for sledging, arrangement  
 Patria Biscuit Fabriek  
 Partridge & Twiss, Messrs.  
 Pavlova, dog  
 'Peacock', the;  
 Peary, dog  
 Pemmican  
 Penguin Hill  
 "Penguin Point," by C. T. Madigan  
 Penguin rookeries;  
 Penguins  
 ........Adelie  
 ........an Albino Penguin  
 ........Emperor  
 ........Gentoo  
 ........King  
 ........Royal  
 ........Victoria,  
 Pennant Hills  
 'Perseverance', the  
 Peter I Island  
 Petrel Rookeries  
 Petrels  
 ........Antaretic  
 ........Giant  
 ........Lesson's  
 ........Silver-grey or Southern Fulmar  
 ........Snow  
 ........Wilson  
 Petrol, amount carried  
 Pianoforte Berg  
 "Piecrust"  
 Pigeons, Cape  
 Piper, Mr.  
 Plasmon  
 Pollock, Professor J. A.  
 'Porpoise', the  
 Posadowsky Bay  
 Possession Nunataks  
 Primmer, Mr.  
 Primus heater, the  
 Prince Luitpold Land  
 Prion Banksii  
 Proteins, value of  
 "Puffometer," the  
 Punch  

 Quarantine Station, Hobart  
 Queen Mary Land  
 Queen's Wharf, Hobart  

 Rabbits  
 'Rachel Cohen', the  
 Ramornie Meat Coy.  
 Rations, daily polar; for the Far Eastern Party; for the sledge journey  
 from the Western Base  
 Rats  
 Reid, Sir George,  
 .......Glacier  
 Robinson, Lionel  
 .......Bay  
 .......anemometer, the  
 "Rock Flour,"  
 Rocks, effect of wind and rain on  
 .......igneous  
 Rose Island  
 .....Messrs.  
 Ross Barrier  
 ......dog  
 ......Expedition  
 ......Port  
 ......Sea, the  
 Royal Company Island  
 ......Geographical Society.  
 Royds, Cape  
 Russian Antarctic Expeditions  

 Sabrina Land  
 'Sabrina', the  
 Sails, value of  
 St. Elmo's fire  
 St. Vincent's Gulf  
 Sames & Coy.  
 Sandell, C. A., Wireless work at Macquarie Island; cooking; lantern  
 made by; visit to the 'Aurora'; erection of the  
 tide-gauge; sheepkilling; as barber; an accident to;  
 telephone installed by; lamp made by; the home journey;  
 account of  
 Sandow, dog  
 ........Mr. Eugene  
 Sandy Bay, Hobart  
 ...........Enderby Island  
 ...........Macquarie Island  
 "Sarcophagus," the  
 Sastrugi  
 Sawyer, A. J., wireless operator at Macquarie Island; visits to the  
 'Aurora'; erection of the tide-gauge; leaves Macquarie  
 Island; visit to the 'Tutanekai; account of  
 Saxton & Binns, Messrs.  
 Scarfe, Mr.  
 Scientific equipment for the expedition,  
 ...........work of the expedition  
 'Scotia', the  
 Scott, Captain, work of; voyage of the 'Discovery; voyage in the  
 'Terra Nova'; rations allowed by; stay in Antarctica;  
 at McMurdo Sound; the disaster to; on Macquarie Island,  
 ........Islands  
 ........Lady  
 ........the dog  
 Scott Expedition Staff  
 Scottish Antarctic Expedition  
 Sea, temperature, effect of snow on  
 Sea bears  
 Sea-elephants; rookeries of the  
 Seager, Messrs.  
 Sea-ice  
 Sea-leopards  
 Sealers of Macquarie Island; methods of the  
 Sea-lions  
 Seals  
 ......Crabeater  
 ......Fur  
 ......Hair  
 ......Ross  
 ......Weddell  
 Sewing-machine, Wild's need of a  
 Shack, the  
 Shackleton Expedition  
 ...........Ice-Shelf, the; establishment of the Western Base on;  
 winter and spring on; Western Party blocked on,  
 Wild's narrative; the 'Aurora' at  
 ...........the dog  
 Shags  
 Shaw, Dr. W. N.  
 Shelf-ice  
 Shell Brand benzine and Shell kerosene  
 Shoe Island  
 " Shuteye," practice of  
 Signatures of members of land parties  
 Simpson, Mr.  
 Skeats, Professor E., examination of the meteorite  
 Skey, Mr. H. F.  
 Skiing  
 Sledge, the air-tractor  
 Sledging; preparation of equipment; wood for sledges; harness for;  
 a load; camping  
 Smith & Wellstood, Messrs.  
 .......William, work of  
 Snow, temperatures  
 Snow-blindness  
 Snow drift, electrical effects  
 Snow gauges  
 .....Hill Island  
 Soundings, Lucas automatic sounding machine  
 South Australian Museum  
 ......Orkney Islands  
 ......Shetland Islands  
 Southern Cross Depot, declination of the needle at  
 .........Ocean  
 .........Party; instruments cached by  
 .........Supporting Party,  
 'Sphere', the  
 Spratt, Messrs., care of the dogs  
 Steel Trucks Ltd.  
 Stewart Island (New Zealand)  
 Stillwell, F. L., at Main Base; geological researches; map of Winter  
 Quarters; records; production of 'The Washerwoman's  
 Secret'; finding an albino penguin; the Near Eastern  
 Party; his sledge; pitching tent; journey of the Near  
 Eastern Party; the search party; return to Australia;  
 account of  
 ...........Island  
 Stirling, Professor  
 Storm Bay  
 Strathcona, Lord  
 ............Mount  
 Sun, the midnight; display of rings and arcs  
 Suva, wireless station  
 Swallow & Ariell, Messrs.  
 Sweep, dog  
 Swiss Confederation Day  
 .......the dog  
 Switzerland, the dog.  
 Sydney, Wilkes's expedition started from; Cathedral of; wood from;  
 the harbour; wireless communication with  
 ........Meat Preserving Coy.  
 'Sydney Morning Herald', donation  

 Tasman Sea  
 Tasmania, hospitality of; soundings  
 Taylor, Mr. Allen  
 "Te Sol,"  
 Tea  
 Temperature, Foehn effect; in Adelie Land  
 Tent-pitching; Bickerton on  
 'Terebus and Error in Eruption'  
 Termination Ice Tongue  
 ............Land  
 Terns  
 'Terra Nova', Scott's voyage  
 Terrestrial magnetism, work of the expedition  
 "The Steps"  
 Theodolite, use of the  
 Tich, dog  
 Tide-gauge, Bage's; use on Macquarie Island  
 Tides, work of the expedition  
 Tidswell, Dr.  
 Tiger, dog  
 Tooth, Sir R. Lucas  
 .......Lady Helen—see Helen Glacier  
 'Toroa', s.s.  
 Totten's Land  
 Toucher, N. C.  
 Transit House  
 Trawl, Monagasque  
 Trawling, experiences of the 'Aurora'  
 Tussock grass  
 'Tutanekai', the, relief of Macquarie Island  

 'Ulimaroa', s.s., the  
 Umbrella aerial, use of the  
 Union Jack, hoisting the  
 University College, Christchurch  
 Urville, Dumont D', expedition under  
 .........the dog  

 'Valdivia' expedition  
 "Veranda Club"  
 Verran, Hon. J.  
 Vickers & Coy., Messrs.  
 Victoria Land  
 Vincennes, the  

 Waite, Mr. E. R.  
 'Washerwoman's Secret, The'  
 "Watersky,"  
 Watkins, Lieut., aviator  
 Watson, A. D., at the Western Base; attempted trip with Wild for the  
 minimum thermometer; preparation for the Eastern summer  
 journey; blocked on the ice-shelf with Wild; fall into  
 a crevasse  
 ..........Bluff  
 Watt, Hon. W.  
 Way Archipelago  
 ..............map  
 ......Sir Samuel  
 Weather, the, as a conversational subject  
 Webb, E. N., at Main Base; care of the dogs; work at the Magnetograph  
 House; photo-work; magnetic ice-cave of; his first camp;  
 formation of the Southern Sledging Party; observations of  
 the needle; use of the theodolite; building a break-wind;  
 the toasts on Christmas Day; sighting Aladdin's Cave;  
 return from the south; return to Australia; account of  
 Weddell, James, work  
 .........Sea  
 Wekas  
 Wellington, Mount  
 .............wireless communication with  
 Welsh, Professor  
 Western Base, the party at; winter and spring at the; establishment and  
 adventures by F. Wild; the geological shaft; "The Glacier  
 Tongue"; Wild's party blocked on the Ice Shelf; linking  
 up with Kaiser Wilhelm II Land, account by Dr. S. E. Jones;  
 medical reports from  
 West Point  
 Western Sledging Party  
 'Westralia', s.s.,  
 Whalebirds  
 Whales  
 Whetter, Dr. L. A., at Main Base; the "Toggle King"; journey to the west;  
 the Western Party; meteorological work; preparations for  
 the air-tractor sledge trip; his birthday; on tent  
 pitching; investigations of a snow ramp; return; return  
 to Australia; account of  
 "Whirlies,"  
 Wild, Frank, the work at Hobart; working of the "flyingfox"; incidents  
 on board; leader of the Western Base; the winter station on  
 the ice shelf; rations for the expedition; arrangements with  
 the 'Aurora'; return to Aladdin's Cave; his party at Western  
 Base; relief of; reception of the 'Aurora'; winter and spring;  
 land mapped out by; blocked on the ice shelf, narrative  
 Wilkes, discoveries of; charts; Knox Land,  
 Wilkes's Land  
 Willesden-drill, tents  
 Williamstown, Victoria  
 Wind, velocities  
 Winds, Bay of  
 Winsor & Newton, Messrs.  
 Winter quarters, Adelie Land  
 .............Stillwell's map  
 Wireless Hill, establishment of the station;  
 .........installation range, in the Antarctic; report of Captain Davis;  
 messages received by Hannam on the 'Aurora'; messages from,  
 and to, Adelie Land; effect of ice on intensity of waves;  
 work of the expedition; telefunken apparatus  
 Worms, parasitical, in fish  

 'Zelee', the  
 Zip, the dog  
 Zoological investigations  










ILLUSTRATIONS


sunarcs (2K)

txt1 (22K)

txt2 (6K)

txt3 (21K)

txt4 (18K)

txt5 (18K)

txt6 (13K)

txt7 (14K)

txt8 (14K)

txt9 (9K)

txt10 (18K)

txt11 (29K)

txt12 (11K)

txt13 (14K)

txt14 (15K)

txt15 (9K)

txt16 (12K)

txt17 (22K)

txt18 (5K)

txt19 (10K)

txt20 (6K)

txt21 (18K)

txt22 (12K)

txt23 (19K)

txt24 (3K)

txt25 (4K)

txt26 (20K)

txt27 (4K)

txt28 (9K)

txt29 (5K)

txt30 (17K)

txt31 (11K)

txt32 (11K)

txt33 (20K)

txt34 (19K)

txt35 (20K)




sunarcs (2K)

txt1 (22K)

txt2 (6K)

txt3 (21K)

txt4 (18K)

txt5 (18K)

txt6 (13K)

txt7 (14K)

txt8 (14K)

txt9 (9K)

txt10 (18K)

txt11 (29K)

txt12 (11K)

txt13 (14K)

txt14 (15K)

txt15 (9K)

txt16 (12K)

txt17 (22K)

txt18 (5K)

txt19 (10K)

txt20 (6K)

txt21 (18K)

txt22 (12K)

txt23 (19K)

txt24 (3K)

txt25 (4K)

txt26 (20K)

txt27 (4K)

txt28 (9K)

txt29 (5K)

txt30 (17K)

txt31 (11K)

txt32 (11K)

txt33 (20K)

txt34 (19K)

txt35 (20K)









Download ePUB

If you like this ebook, consider a donation!